diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'docs/htmldocs')
83 files changed, 9052 insertions, 10004 deletions
diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html b/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html index 044d347107..7330836f36 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/AccessControls.html @@ -1,23 +1,20 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups"><link rel="next" href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="groupmapping.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="locking.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AccessControls"></a>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 10, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920271">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920308">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920326">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920583">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920678">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920894">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922074">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922346">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922591">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922807">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922879">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923178">MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923186">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923224">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923303">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923425">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923653">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923805">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask - parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924134">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924210">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924224">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924604">I have set force user and Samba still makes root the owner of all the files - I touch!</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups"><link rel="next" href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="groupmapping.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="locking.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AccessControls"></a>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawing</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 10, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904266">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904395">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904735">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904829">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905040">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906251">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906323">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906623">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906631">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906675">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906755">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906887">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907132">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907693">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907788">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907802">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2908232">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2908284">MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2904188"></a><p> Advanced MS Windows users are frequently perplexed when file, directory and share manipulation of resources shared via Samba do not behave in the manner they might expect. MS Windows network -administrators are often confused regarding network access controls and what is the best way to -provide users with the type of access they need while protecting resources from the consequences -of untoward access capabilities. +administrators are often confused regarding network access controls and how to +provide users with the access they need while protecting resources from unauthorised access. </p><p> -Unix administrators frequently are not familiar with the MS Windows environment and in particular +Many UNIX administrators are unfamiliar with the MS Windows environment and in particular have difficulty in visualizing what the MS Windows user wishes to achieve in attempts to set file and directory access permissions. </p><p> The problem lies in the differences in how file and directory permissions and controls work between the two environments. This difference is one that Samba can not completely hide, even -though it does try to make the chasm transparent. -</p><p> +though it does try to bridge the chasm to a degree. +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2904225"></a><p> POSIX Access Control List technology has been available (along with Extended Attributes) -for Unix for many years, yet there is little evidence today of any significant use. This +for UNIX for many years, yet there is little evidence today of any significant use. This explains to some extent the slow adoption of ACLs into commercial Linux products. MS Windows administrators are astounded at this given that ACLs were a foundational capability of the now decade old MS Windows NT operating system. @@ -26,25 +23,24 @@ The purpose of this chapter is to present each of the points of control that are Samba-3 in the hope that this will help the network administrator to find the optimum method for delivering the best environment for MS Windows desktop users. </p><p> -This is an opportune point to mention that it should be borne in mind that Samba was created to -provide a means of interoperability and interchange of data between two operating environments -that are quite different. It was never the intent to make Unix/Linux like MS Windows NT. Instead -the purpose was an is to provide a sufficient level of exchange of data between the two environments. -What is available today extends well beyond early plans and expectations, yet the gap continues to -shrink. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920271"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This is an opportune point to mention that Samba was created to provide a means of interoperability +and interchange of data between differing operating environments. Samba has no intent change +UNIX/Linux into a platform like MS Windows. Instead the purpose was and is to provide a sufficient +level of exchange of data between the two environments. What is available today extends well +beyond early plans and expectations, yet the gap continues to shrink. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904266"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba offers a lot of flexibility in file system access management. These are the key access control facilities present in Samba today: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Samba Access Control Facilities</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>Unix File and Directory Permissions</em></span> + <span class="emphasis"><em>UNIX File and Directory Permissions</em></span> </p><p> - Samba honours and implements Unix file system access controls. Users + Samba honours and implements UNIX file system access controls. Users who access a Samba server will do so as a particular MS Windows user. This information is passed to the Samba server as part of the logon or connection setup process. Samba uses this user identity to validate whether or not the user should be given access to file system resources (files and directories). This chapter provides an overview for those - to whom the Unix permissions and controls are a little strange or unknown. + to whom the UNIX permissions and controls are a little strange or unknown. </p></li><li><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba Share Definitions</em></span> </p><p> @@ -63,22 +59,22 @@ shrink. easiest ways to affect access controls (restrictions) and can often do so with minimum invasiveness compared with other methods. </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>MS Windows ACLs through Unix POSIX ACLs</em></span> + <span class="emphasis"><em>MS Windows ACLs through UNIX POSIX ACLs</em></span> </p><p> - The use of POSIX ACLs on Unix/Linux is possible ONLY if the underlying + The use of POSIX ACLs on UNIX/Linux is possible ONLY if the underlying operating system supports them. If not, then this option will not be - available to you. Current Unix technology platforms have native support + available to you. Current UNIX technology platforms have native support for POSIX ACLs. There are patches for the Linux kernel that provide this also. Sadly, few Linux platforms ship today with native ACLs and Extended Attributes enabled. This chapter has pertinent information for users of platforms that support them. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920308"></a>File System Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904395"></a>File System Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Perhaps the most important recognition to be made is the simple fact that MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP -implement a totally divergent file system technology from what is provided in the Unix operating system +implement a totally divergent file system technology from what is provided in the UNIX operating system environment. Firstly we should consider what the most significant differences are, then we shall look at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920326"></a>MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Samba operates on top of the Unix file system. This means it is subject to Unix file system conventions +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2904414"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2904423"></a><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904431"></a>MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba operates on top of the UNIX file system. This means it is subject to UNIX file system conventions and permissions. It also means that if the MS Windows networking environment requires file system behaviour that differs from unix file system behaviour then somehow Samba is responsible for emulating that in a transparent and consistent manner. @@ -88,128 +84,108 @@ at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. but for the greater part we will stay within the bounds of default behaviour. Those wishing to explore to depths of control ability should review the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. </p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>File System Feature Comparison</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">Name Space</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows NT4 / 200x/ XP files names may be up to 254 characters long, Unix file names + MS Windows NT4 / 200x/ XP files names may be up to 254 characters long, UNIX file names may be 1023 characters long. In MS Windows file extensions indicate particular file types, - in Unix this is not so rigorously observed as all names are considered arbitrary. + in UNIX this is not so rigorously observed as all names are considered arbitrary. </p><p> - What MS Windows calls a Folder, Unix calls a directory, + What MS Windows calls a Folder, UNIX calls a directory. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Case Sensitivity</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows file names are generally Upper Case if made up of 8.3 (ie: 8 character file name + <a class="indexterm" name="id2904517"></a> + MS Windows file names are generally upper case if made up of 8.3 (ie: 8 character file name and 3 character extension. If longer than 8.3 file names are Case Preserving, and Case Insensitive. </p><p> - Unix file and directory names are Case Sensitive and Case Preserving. Samba implements the - MS Windows file name behaviour, but it does so as a user application. The Unix file system + UNIX file and directory names are case sensitive and case preserving. Samba implements the + MS Windows file name behaviour, but it does so as a user application. The UNIX file system provides no mechanism to perform case insensitive file name lookups. MS Windows does this by default. This means that Samba has to carry the processing overhead to provide features - that are NOT native to the Unix operating system environment. + that are NOT native to the UNIX operating system environment. </p><p> - Consider the following, all are unique Unix names but one single MS Windows file name: + Consider the following, all are unique UNIX names but one single MS Windows file name: <tt class="computeroutput"> MYFILE.TXT MyFile.txt myfile.txt </tt> - So clearly, In an MS Windows file name space these three files CAN NOT co-exist! But in Unix + So clearly, In an MS Windows file name space these three files CAN NOT co-exist! But in UNIX they can. So what should Samba do if all three are present? Answer, the one that is lexically first will be accessible to MS Windows users, the others are invisible and unaccessible - any other solution would be suicidal. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Directory Separators</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows and DOS uses the back-slash '\' as a directory delimiter, Unix uses the forward-slash '/' + MS Windows and DOS uses the back-slash '\' as a directory delimiter, UNIX uses the forward-slash '/' as it's directory delimiter. This is transparently handled by Samba. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Drive Identification</span></dt><dd><p> MS Windows products support a notion of drive letters, like <b class="command">C:</b> to represent - disk partitions. Unix has NO concept if separate identifiers for file partitions since each + disk partitions. UNIX has NO concept if separate identifiers for file partitions since each such file system is <tt class="filename">mounted</tt> to become part of the over-all directory tree. - The Unix directory tree begins at '/', just like the root of a DOS drive is specified like + The UNIX directory tree begins at '/', just like the root of a DOS drive is specified like <b class="command">C:\</b>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">File Naming Conventions</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows generally never experiences file names that begin with a '.', while in Unix these + MS Windows generally never experiences file names that begin with a '.', while in UNIX these are commonly found in a user's home directory. Files that begin with a '.' are typically - either start up files for various Unix applications, or they may be files that contain + either start up files for various UNIX applications, or they may be files that contain start-up configuration data. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Links and Short-Cuts</span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2904667"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2904678"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2904689"></a> + MS Windows make use of "links and Short-Cuts" that are actually special types of files that will - redirect an attempt to execute the file to the real location of the file. Unix knows of file and directory + redirect an attempt to execute the file to the real location of the file. UNIX knows of file and directory links, but they are entirely different from what MS Windows users are used to. </p><p> - Symbolic links are files in Unix that contain the actual location of the data (file OR directory). An + Symbolic links are files in UNIX that contain the actual location of the data (file OR directory). An operation (like read or write) will operate directly on the file referenced. Symbolic links are also referred to as 'soft links'. A hard link is something that MS Windows is NOT familiar with. It allows one physical file to be known simultaneously by more than one file name. </p></dd></dl></div><p> There are many other subtle differences that may cause the MS Windows administrator some temporary discomfort - in the process of becoming familiar with Unix/Linux. These are best left for a text that is dedicated to the - purpose of Unix/Linux training/education. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920583"></a>Managing Directories</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + in the process of becoming familiar with UNIX/Linux. These are best left for a text that is dedicated to the + purpose of UNIX/Linux training/education. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904735"></a>Managing Directories</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are three basic operations for managing directories, <b class="command">create, delete, rename</b>. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2920603"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.1. Managing directories with unix and windows</b></p><table summary="Managing directories with unix and windows" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Action</th><th align="center">MS Windows Command</th><th align="center">Unix Command</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">create</td><td align="center">md folder</td><td align="center">mkdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">delete</td><td align="center">rd folder</td><td align="center">rmdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">rename</td><td align="center">rename oldname newname</td><td align="center">mv oldname newname</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920678"></a>File and Directory Access Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2904754"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.1. Managing directories with unix and windows</b></p><table summary="Managing directories with unix and windows" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Action</th><th align="center">MS Windows Command</th><th align="center">UNIX Command</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">create</td><td align="center">md folder</td><td align="center">mkdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">delete</td><td align="center">rd folder</td><td align="center">rmdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">rename</td><td align="center">rename oldname newname</td><td align="center">mv oldname newname</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904829"></a>File and Directory Access Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The network administrator is strongly advised to read foundational training manuals and reference materials - regarding file and directory permissions maintenance. Much can be achieved with the basic Unix permissions + regarding file and directory permissions maintenance. Much can be achieved with the basic UNIX permissions without having to resort to more complex facilities like POSIX Access Control Lists (ACLs) or Extended Attributes (EAs). </p><p> - Unix/Linux file and directory access permissions involves setting three (3) primary sets of data and one (1) control set. - A Unix file listing looks as follows:- + UNIX/Linux file and directory access permissions involves setting three (3) primary sets of data and one (1) control set. + A UNIX file listing looks as follows:- - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">jht@frodo:~/stuff> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -la</tt></b> - total 632 - drwxr-xr-x 13 jht users 816 2003-05-12 22:56 . - drwxr-xr-x 37 jht users 3800 2003-05-12 22:29 .. - d--------- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado00 - d--x--x--x 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado01 - dr-xr-xr-x 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado02 - drwxrwxrwx 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado03 - drw-rw-rw- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado04 - d-w--w--w- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado05 - dr--r--r-- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado06 - drwxrwxrwt 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado07 - drwsrwsrwx 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado08 - ---------- 1 jht users 1242 2003-05-12 22:31 mydata00.lst - ---x--x--x 1 jht users 1674 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata01.lst - --w--w--w- 1 jht users 7754 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata02.lst - --wx-wx-wx 1 jht users 260179 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata03.lst - -r--r--r-- 1 jht users 21017 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata04.lst - -r-xr-xr-x 1 jht users 206339 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata05.lst - -rw-rw-rw- 1 jht users 41105 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata06.lst - -rwxrwxrwx 1 jht users 19312 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata07.lst - <tt class="prompt">jht@frodo:~/stuff></tt> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -la</tt></b> +total 632 +drwxr-xr-x 13 maryo gnomes 816 2003-05-12 22:56 . +drwxrwxr-x 37 maryo gnomes 3800 2003-05-12 22:29 .. +dr-xr-xr-x 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado02 +drwxrwxrwx 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado03 +drw-rw-rw- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado04 +d-w--w--w- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado05 +dr--r--r-- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado06 +drwsrwsrwx 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado08 +---------- 1 maryo gnomes 1242 2003-05-12 22:31 mydata00.lst +--w--w--w- 1 maryo gnomes 7754 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata02.lst +-r--r--r-- 1 maryo gnomes 21017 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata04.lst +-rw-rw-rw- 1 maryo gnomes 41105 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata06.lst +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt> +</pre><p> </p><p> - The columns above represent (from left to right): permissions, no blocks used, owner, group, size (bytes), access date, access time, file name. - </p><p> - The permissions field is made up of: - - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - <i><span class="comment"> JRV: Put this into a diagram of some sort</span></i> - [ type ] [ users ] [ group ] [ others ] [File, Directory Permissions] - [ d | l ] [ r w x ] [ r w x ] [ r w x ] - | | | | | | | | | | | - | | | | | | | | | | |-----> Can Execute, List files - | | | | | | | | | |-------> Can Write, Create files - | | | | | | | | |---------> Can Read, Read files - | | | | | | | |---------------> Can Execute, List files - | | | | | | |-----------------> Can Write, Create files - | | | | | |-------------------> Can Read, Read files - | | | | |-------------------------> Can Execute, List files - | | | |---------------------------> Can Write, Create files - | | |-----------------------------> Can Read, Read files - | |-----------------------------------> Is a symbolic Link - |---------------------------------------> Is a directory - </pre><p> + The columns above represent (from left to right): permissions, number of hard links to file, owner, group, size (bytes), access date, access time, file name. </p><p> + An overview of the permissions field can be found in <a href="AccessControls.html#access1" title="Figure 13.1. Overview of unix permissions field">the image below</a>. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="access1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 13.1. Overview of unix permissions field</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/access1.png" width="270" alt="Overview of unix permissions field"></div></div><p> Any bit flag may be unset. An unset bit flag is the equivalent of 'Can NOT' and is represented as a '-' character. - </p><div class="example"><a name="id2920816"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13.1. Example File</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2904965"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13.1. Example File</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> -rwxr-x--- Means: The owner (user) can read, write, execute the group can read and execute everyone else can NOT do anything with it </pre></div><p> </p><p> - Additional possibilities in the [type] field are: c = character device, b = block device, p = pipe device, s = Unix Domain Socket. + Additional possibilities in the [type] field are: c = character device, b = block device, p = pipe device, s = UNIX Domain Socket. </p><p> The letters `rwxXst' set permissions for the user, group and others as: read (r), write (w), execute (or access for directories) (x), execute only if the file is a directory or already has execute permission for some user (X), set user or group ID on execution (s), @@ -228,101 +204,101 @@ at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. the (x) execute flags are not set files can not be listed (seen) in the directory by anyone. The group can read files in the directory but can NOT create new files. NOTE: If files in the directory are set to be readable and writable for the group, then group members will be able to write to (or delete) them. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920894"></a>Share Definition Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905040"></a>Share Definition Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file sections that define a share control or affect access controls. Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922074"></a>User and Group Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905070"></a>User and Group Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> User and group based controls can prove very useful. In some situations it is distinctly desirable to affect all - file system operations as if a single user is doing this, the use of the <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> and - <i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> behaviour will achieve this. In other situations it may be necessary to affect a + file system operations as if a single user is doing this, the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2905084"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905097"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> behaviour will achieve this. In other situations it may be necessary to affect a paranoia level of control to ensure that only particular authorised persons will be able to access a share or - it's contents, here the use of the <i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> or the <i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> may + it's contents, here the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2905115"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> or the <a class="indexterm" name="id2905129"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> may be most useful. </p><p> As always, it is highly advisable to use the least difficult to maintain and the least ambiguous method for controlling access. Remember, that when you leave the scene someone else will need to provide assistance and if that person finds too great a mess, or if they do not understand what you have done then there is risk of Samba being removed and an alternative solution being adopted. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2922134"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.2. User and Group Based Controls</b></p><table summary="User and Group Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>admin users</td><td><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2905157"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.2. User and Group Based Controls</b></p><table summary="User and Group Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905214"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users who will be granted administrative privileges on the share. They will do all file operations as the super-user (root). Any user in this list will be able to do anything they like on the share, irrespective of file permissions. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force group</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905244"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Specifies a UNIX group name that will be assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting to this service. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force user</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905271"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Specifies a UNIX user name that will be assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service. This is useful for sharing files. Incorrect use can cause security problems. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>guest ok</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905299"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> If this parameter is set for a service, then no password is required to connect to the service. Privileges will be those of the guest account. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>invalid users</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905326"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that should not be allowed to login to this service. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>only user</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905353"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls whether connections with usernames not in the user list will be allowed. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>read list</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905379"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that are given read-only access to a service. Users in this list will not be given write access, no matter what the read only option is set to. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>username</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905406"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information - this is a complex and potentially misused parameter. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>valid users</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905440"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that should be allowed to login to this service. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>write list</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905466"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that are given read-write access to a service. - </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922346"></a>File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905491"></a>File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following file and directory permission based controls, if misused, can result in considerable difficulty to diagnose the cause of mis-configuration. Use them sparingly and carefully. By gradually introducing each one by one undesirable side-effects may be detected. In the event of a problem, always comment all of them out and then gradually re-introduce them in a controlled fashion. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2922367"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.3. File and Directory Permission Based Controls</b></p><table summary="File and Directory Permission Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>create mask</td><td><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2905512"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.3. File and Directory Permission Based Controls</b></p><table summary="File and Directory Permission Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905567"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>directory mask</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905599"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> The octal modes used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX directories. See also: directory security mask. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dos filemode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905626"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filemode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Enabling this parameter allows a user who has write access to the file to modify the permissions on it. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force create mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905652"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will always be set on a file created by Samba. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force directory mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905680"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will always be set on a directory created by Samba. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force directory security mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905708"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating UNIX permissions on a directory - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force security mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905736"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client manipulates UNIX permissions. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>hide unreadable</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905762"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unreadable</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Prevents clients from seeing the existence of files that cannot be read. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>hide unwriteable files</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905789"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unwriteable files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Prevents clients from seeing the existence of files that cannot be written to. Unwriteable directories are shown as usual. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>nt acl support</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905817"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This parameter controls whether smbd will attempt to map UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>security mask</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905844"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permissions on a file. - </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922591"></a>Miscellaneous Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - The following are documented because of the prevalence of administrators creating inadvertant barriers to file + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905871"></a>Miscellaneous Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following are documented because of the prevalence of administrators creating inadvertent barriers to file access by not understanding the full implications of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2922614"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.4. Other Controls</b></p><table summary="Other Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>case sensitive, default case, short preserve case</td><td><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2905893"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.4. Other Controls</b></p><table summary="Other Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="justify"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2905948"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2905962"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>default case</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2905976"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This means that all file name lookup will be done in a case sensitive manner. Files will be created with the precise filename Samba received from the MS Windows client. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>csc policy</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906004"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Client Side Caching Policy - parallels MS Windows client side file caching capabilities. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dont descend</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906031"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Allows to specify a comma-delimited list of directories that the server should always show as empty. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dos filetime resolution</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetime resolution</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++ when used against Samba shares. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dos filetimes</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906085"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetimes</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> DOS and Windows allows users to change file time stamps if they can write to the file. POSIX semantics prevent this. This options allows DOS and Windows behaviour. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>fake oplocks</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906112"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>fake oplocks</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants an oplock then the client is free to assume that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively cache file data. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>hide dot files, hide files, veto files</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906143"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide dot files</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2906157"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2906171"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Note: MS Windows Explorer allows over-ride of files marked as hidden so they will still be visible. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>read only</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906196"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> If this parameter is yes, then users of a service may not create or modify files in the service's directory. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>veto files</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2906224"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of files and directories that are neither visible nor accessible. - </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2922807"></a>Access Controls on Shares</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2906251"></a>Access Controls on Shares</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section deals with how to configure Samba per share access control restrictions. By default, Samba sets no restrictions on the share itself. Restrictions on the share itself can be set on MS Windows NT4/200x/XP shares. This can be a very effective way to limit who can @@ -339,9 +315,9 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c for Samba's tdb files is under <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var</tt>. If the <tt class="filename">tdbdump</tt> utility has been compiled and installed on your system, then you can examine the contents of this file by: <b class="userinput"><tt>tdbdump share_info.tdb</tt></b>. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922879"></a>Share Permissions Management</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906323"></a>Share Permissions Management</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The best tool for the task is platform dependant. Choose the best tool for your environment. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922892"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation/Server</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906336"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation/Server</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The tool you need to use to manage share permissions on a Samba server is the NT Server Manager. Server Manager is shipped with Windows NT4 Server products but not with Windows NT4 Workstation. You can obtain the NT Server Manager for MS Windows NT4 Workstation from Microsoft - see details below. @@ -351,9 +327,9 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c </p></li><li><p> Now click on the share that you wish to manage, then click on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> tab, next click on the <span class="guilabel">Permissions</span> tab. Now you can add or change access control settings as you wish. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922975"></a>Windows 200x/XP</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906419"></a>Windows 200x/XP</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> On <span class="application">MS Windows NT4/200x/XP</span> system access control lists on the share itself are set using native - tools, usually from filemanager. For example, in Windows 200x: right click on the shared folder, + tools, usually from file manager. For example, in Windows 200x: right click on the shared folder, then select <span class="guimenuitem">Sharing</span>, then click on <span class="guilabel">Permissions</span>. The default Windows NT4/200x permission allows <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span> Full Control on the Share. </p><p> @@ -380,71 +356,70 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c then effectively no user will be able to access the share. This is a result of what is known as ACL precedence. ie: Everyone with <span class="emphasis"><em>no access</em></span> means that MaryK who is part of the group <tt class="constant">Everyone</tt> will have no access even if this user is given explicit full control access. - </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923178"></a>MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923186"></a>Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows NT clients can use their native security settings - dialog box to view and modify the underlying UNIX permissions.</p><p>Note that this ability is careful not to compromise - the security of the UNIX host Samba is running on, and - still obeys all the file permission rules that a Samba - administrator can set.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> - All access to Unix/Linux system file via Samba is controlled at - the operating system file access control level. When trying to - figure out file access problems it is vitally important to identify - the identity of the Windows user as it is presented by Samba at - the point of file access. This can best be determined from the + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2906623"></a>MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906631"></a>Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Windows NT clients can use their native security settings dialog box to view and modify the + underlying UNIX permissions. + </p><p> + Note that this ability is careful not to compromise the security of the UNIX host Samba is running on, and + still obeys all the file permission rules that a Samba administrator can set. + </p><p> + Samba does not attempt to go beyond POSIX ACLs, so that the various finer-grained access control + options provided in Windows are actually ignore. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + All access to UNIX/Linux system files via Samba is controlled by the operating system file access controls. + When trying to figure out file access problems it is vitally important to find the identity of the Windows + user as it is presented by Samba at the point of file access. This can best be determined from the Samba log files. - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923224"></a>Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>From an NT4/2000/XP client, single-click with the right - mouse button on any file or directory in a Samba mounted - drive letter or UNC path. When the menu pops-up, click - on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> entry at the bottom of - the menu. This brings up the file properties dialog - box. Click on the tab <span class="guilabel">Security</span> and you - will see three buttons, <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span>, - <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span>, and <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span>. - The <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span> button will cause either - an error message <span class="errorname">A requested privilege is not held - by the client</span> to appear if the user is not the - NT Administrator, or a dialog which is intended to allow an - Administrator to add auditing requirements to a file if the - user is logged on as the NT Administrator. This dialog is - non-functional with a Samba share at this time, as the only - useful button, the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button will not currently - allow a list of users to be seen.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923303"></a>Viewing file ownership</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Clicking on the <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span> button - brings up a dialog box telling you who owns the given file. The - owner name will be of the form :</p><p><b class="command">"SERVER\user (Long name)"</b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of - the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of - the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> - is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the - GECOS field of the UNIX password database). Click on the - <span class="guibutton">Close </span> button to remove this dialog.</p><p>If the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> - is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> then the file owner will - be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt>.</p><p>The <span class="guibutton">Take Ownership</span> button will not allow - you to change the ownership of this file to yourself (clicking on - it will display a dialog box complaining that the user you are - currently logged onto the NT client cannot be found). The reason - for this is that changing the ownership of a file is a privileged - operation in UNIX, available only to the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> - user. As clicking on this button causes NT to attempt to change - the ownership of a file to the current user logged into the NT - client this will not work with Samba at this time.</p><p>There is an NT chown command that will work with Samba - and allow a user with Administrator privilege connected - to a Samba server as root to change the ownership of - files on both a local NTFS filesystem or remote mounted NTFS - or Samba drive. This is available as part of the <span class="application">Seclib - </span> NT security library written by Jeremy Allison of - the Samba Team, available from the main Samba ftp site.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923425"></a>Viewing File or Directory Permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The third button is the <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span> - button. Clicking on this brings up a dialog box that shows both - the permissions and the UNIX owner of the file or directory. - The owner is displayed in the form :</p><p><b class="command">"<i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>\ + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906675"></a>Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + From an NT4/2000/XP client, single-click with the right mouse button on any file or directory in a Samba + mounted drive letter or UNC path. When the menu pops-up, click on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> + entry at the bottom of the menu. This brings up the file properties dialog box. Click on the tab + <span class="guilabel">Security</span> and you will see three buttons, <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span>, + <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span>, and <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span> + button will cause either an error message <span class="errorname">A requested privilege is not held by the client</span> + to appear if the user is not the NT Administrator, or a dialog which is intended to allow an Administrator + to add auditing requirements to a file if the user is logged on as the NT Administrator. This dialog is + non-functional with a Samba share at this time, as the only useful button, the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> + button will not currently allow a list of users to be seen. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906755"></a>Viewing file ownership</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Clicking on the <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span> button brings up a dialog box telling you who owns + the given file. The owner name will be of the form: + </p><p> + <b class="command">"SERVER\user (Long name)"</b> + </p><p> + Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> + is the user name of the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> is the + descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the GECOS field of the UNIX password database). + Click on the <span class="guibutton">Close </span> button to remove this dialog. + </p><p> + If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2906818"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> + then the file owner will be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt>. + </p><p> + The <span class="guibutton">Take Ownership</span> button will not allow you to change the ownership of this file to + yourself (clicking on it will display a dialog box complaining that the user you are currently logged onto + the NT client cannot be found). The reason for this is that changing the ownership of a file is a privileged + operation in UNIX, available only to the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> user. As clicking on this button causes + NT to attempt to change the ownership of a file to the current user logged into the NT client this will + not work with Samba at this time.</p><p> + There is an NT chown command that will work with Samba and allow a user with Administrator privilege connected + to a Samba server as root to change the ownership of files on both a local NTFS filesystem or remote mounted NTFS + or Samba drive. This is available as part of the <span class="application">Seclib</span> NT security library written + by Jeremy Allison of the Samba-Team, available from the main Samba FTP site.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906887"></a>Viewing File or Directory Permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The third button is the <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span> button. Clicking on this brings up a dialog box + that shows both the permissions and the UNIX owner of the file or directory. The owner is displayed in the form: + </p><p><b class="command">"<i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>\ <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> - <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i>"</b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of - the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of - the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> - is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the - GECOS field of the UNIX password database).</p><p>If the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> - is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> then the file owner will - be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt> and the - permissions will be shown as NT "Full Control".</p><p>The permissions field is displayed differently for files - and directories, so I'll describe the way file permissions - are displayed first.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923516"></a>File Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The standard UNIX user/group/world triplet and + <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i>"</b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the Samba server, + <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of the UNIX user who owns the file, and + <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the + GECOS field of the UNIX password database).</p><p> + If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2906953"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> + then the file owner will be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt> and the permissions will be + shown as NT "Full Control". + </p><p> + The permissions field is displayed differently for files and directories, so I'll describe the way file permissions + are displayed first. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906986"></a>File Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The standard UNIX user/group/world triplet and the corresponding "read", "write", "execute" permissions triplets are mapped by Samba into a three element NT ACL with the 'r', 'w', and 'x' bits mapped into the corresponding @@ -459,14 +434,14 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c "change"</tt> or <tt class="constant">full control</tt> then usually the permissions will be prefixed by the words <tt class="constant"> "Special Access"</tt> in the NT display list.</p><p>But what happens if the file has no permissions allowed - for a particular UNIX user group or world component ? In order + for a particular UNIX user group or world component? In order to allow "no permissions" to be seen and modified then Samba overloads the NT <b class="command">"Take Ownership"</b> ACL attribute (which has no meaning in UNIX) and reports a component with no permissions as having the NT <b class="command">"O"</b> bit set. This was chosen of course to make it look like a zero, meaning zero permissions. More details on the decision behind this will - be given below.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923608"></a>Directory Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Directories on an NT NTFS file system have two + be given below.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2907088"></a>Directory Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Directories on an NT NTFS file system have two different sets of permissions. The first set of permissions is the ACL set on the directory itself, this is usually displayed in the first set of parentheses in the normal <tt class="constant">"RW"</tt> @@ -477,12 +452,12 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c inherited</tt> permissions that any file created within this directory would inherit.</p><p>Samba synthesises these inherited permissions for NT by returning as an NT ACL the UNIX permission mode that a new file - created by Samba on this share would receive.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923653"></a>Modifying file or directory permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Modifying file and directory permissions is as simple + created by Samba on this share would receive.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907132"></a>Modifying file or directory permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Modifying file and directory permissions is as simple as changing the displayed permissions in the dialog box, and clicking the <span class="guibutton">OK</span> button. However, there are limitations that a user needs to be aware of, and also interactions with the standard Samba permission masks and mapping of DOS - attributes that need to also be taken into account.</p><p>If the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> + attributes that need to also be taken into account.</p><p>If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2907161"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> then any attempt to set security permissions will fail with an <span class="errorname">"Access Denied" </span> message.</p><p>The first thing to note is that the <span class="guibutton">"Add"</span> @@ -511,59 +486,56 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c component and click the <span class="guibutton">Remove</span> button, or set the component to only have the special <tt class="constant">Take Ownership</tt> permission (displayed as <b class="command">"O" - </b>) highlighted.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923805"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + </b>) highlighted.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907296"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba create mask parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>There are four parameters to control interaction with the standard Samba create mask parameters. These are : - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907315"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907333"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907367"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> </p><p>Once a user clicks <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to apply the permissions Samba maps the given permissions into a user/group/world r/w/x triplet set, and then will check the changed permissions for a - file against the bits set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYMASK" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></a> parameter. Any bits that + file against the bits set in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2907397"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> parameter. Any bits that were changed that are not set to '1' in this parameter are left alone - in the file permissions.</p><p>Essentially, zero bits in the <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> + in the file permissions.</p><p>Essentially, zero bits in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907418"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> allowed to change, and one bits are those the user is allowed to change. </p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as - the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask - </tt></i></a> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907443"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file, set this parameter to 0777.</p><p>Next Samba checks the changed permissions for a file against - the bits set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCESECURITYMODE" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></a> parameter. Any bits + the bits set in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2907465"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> parameter. Any bits that were changed that correspond to bits set to '1' in this parameter are forced to be set.</p><p>Essentially, bits set in the <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode </tt></i> parameter may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a file, the user has always set to be 'on'.</p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value - as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCECREATEMODE" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>force - create mode</tt></i></a> parameter. + as the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907500"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file - with no restrictions set this parameter to 000.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>force + with no restrictions set this parameter to 000.</p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2907521"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> parameters are applied to the change request in that order.</p><p>For a directory Samba will perform the same operations as described above for a file except using the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt> directory security mask</tt></i> instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i>, and <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode </tt></i> parameter instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode - </tt></i>.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> parameter + </tt></i>.</p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2907582"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> parameter by default is set to the same value as the <i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask </tt></i> parameter and the <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i> parameter by default is set to the same value as - the <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> parameter. </p><p>In this way Samba enforces the permission restrictions that + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2907613"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> parameter. </p><p>In this way Samba enforces the permission restrictions that an administrator can set on a Samba share, whilst still allowing users to modify the permission bits within that restriction.</p><p>If you want to set up a share that allows users full control in modifying the permission bits on their files and directories and doesn't force any particular bits to be set 'on', then set the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in that share specific section : - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924134"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba maps some of the DOS attribute bits (such as "read + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907693"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Samba maps some of the DOS attribute bits (such as "read only") into the UNIX permissions of a file. This means there can be a conflict between the permission bits set via the security dialog and the permission bits set by the file attribute mapping. - </p><p>One way this can show up is if a file has no UNIX read access + </p></div><p>One way this can show up is if a file has no UNIX read access for the owner it will show up as "read only" in the standard file attributes tabbed dialog. Unfortunately this dialog is the same one that contains the security info in another tab.</p><p>What this can mean is that if the owner changes the permissions @@ -575,10 +547,10 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c permissions and clicking <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to get back to the attributes dialog you should always hit <span class="guibutton">Cancel</span> rather than <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to ensure that your changes - are not overridden.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924210"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + are not overridden.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2907788"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> File, Directory and Share access problems are very common on the mailing list. The following are examples taken from the mailing list in recent times. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924224"></a>Users can not write to a public share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907802"></a>Users can not write to a public share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> “<span class="quote"> We are facing some troubles with file / directory permissions. I can log on the domain as admin user(root), and there's a public share, on which everyone needs to have permission to create / modify files, but only @@ -587,74 +559,83 @@ are examples taken from the mailing list in recent times. </span>” </p><p> There are many ways to solve this problem, here are a few hints: - </p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 13.3. Example Solution:</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> Go to the top of the directory that is shared </p></li><li><p> Set the ownership to what ever public owner and group you want - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chown user.group {}\; - find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chmod 6775 'directory_name' - find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chmod 0775 {} \; - find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chown user.group {}\; - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chown user.group {}\; +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chmod 6775 'directory_name' +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chmod 0775 {} \; +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chown user.group {}\; +</pre><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The above will set the 'sticky bit' on all directories. Read your - Unix/Linux man page on what that does. It causes the OS to assign + UNIX/Linux man page on what that does. It causes the OS to assign to all files created in the directories the ownership of the directory. </p></div></li><li><p> Directory is: <i class="replaceable"><tt>/foodbar</tt></i> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack.engr /foodbar</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> - </p><p>This is the same as doing:</p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack /foodbar</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chgrp engr /foodbar</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p></div></li><li><p>Now do: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack.engr /foodbar</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This is the same as doing:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chgrp engr /foodbar</tt></b> +</pre></div></li><li><p>Now do: - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 6775 /foodbar</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al /foodbar/..</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 6775 /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al /foodbar/..</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p>You should see: - </p><pre class="screen"> - drwsrwsr-x 2 jack engr 48 2003-02-04 09:55 foodbar - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +drwsrwsr-x 2 jack engr 48 2003-02-04 09:55 foodbar +</pre><p> </p></li><li><p>Now do: - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>su - jill</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /foodbar</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>touch Afile</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>su - jill</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>touch Afile</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> You should see that the file <tt class="filename">Afile</tt> created by Jill will have ownership and permissions of Jack, as follows: - </p><pre class="screen"> - -rw-r--r-- 1 jack engr 0 2003-02-04 09:57 Afile - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +-rw-r--r-- 1 jack engr 0 2003-02-04 09:57 Afile +</pre><p> </p></li><li><p> Now in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for the share add: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - force create mode = 0775 - force directory mode = 6775 - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode = 0775</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force direcrtory mode = 6775</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The above are only needed <span class="emphasis"><em>if</em></span> your users are <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> members of the group you have used. ie: Within the OS do not have write permission on the directory. </p></div><p> An alternative is to set in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the share: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - force user = jack - force group = engr - </pre><p> - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924604"></a>I have set force user and Samba still makes <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> the owner of all the files - I touch!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - When you have a user in 'admin users', Samba will always do file operations for - this user as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, even if <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> has been set. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="groupmapping.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="locking.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force user = jack</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force group = engr</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908232"></a>I have set force user but Samba still makes <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> the owner of all the files I touch!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + When you have a user in <a class="indexterm" name="id2908248"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i>, samba will always do file operations for + this user as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, even if <a class="indexterm" name="id2908268"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> has been set. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908284"></a>MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> “<span class="quote">When userB saves a word document that is owned by userA the updated file is now owned by userB. + Why is Samba doing this? How do I fix this?</span>” + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> Word does the following when you modify/change a Word document: Word Creates a NEW document with + a temporary name, Word then closes the old document and deletes it, Word then renames the new document to the original document name. + There is NO mechanism by which Samba CAN IN ANY WAY know that the new document really should be owned by the owners + of the original file. Samba has no way of knowing that the file will be renamed by MS Word. As far as Samba is able + to tell, the file that gets created is a NEW file, not one that the application (Word) is updating. + </p><p> + There is a work-around to solve the permissions problem. That work-around involves understanding how you can manage file + system behaviour from within the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, as well as understanding how Unix file systems work. Set on the directory + in which you are changing word documents: <b class="command">chmod g+s 'directory_name'</b> This ensures that all files will + be created with the group that owns the directory. In smb.conf share declaration section set: + </p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode = 0660</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode = 0770</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><p> + These two settings will ensure that all directories and files that get created in the share will be read/writable by the + owner and group set on the directory itself. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="groupmapping.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="locking.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html b/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html index 296c684e24..1052f45e92 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/AdvancedNetworkManagement.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind"><link rel="next" href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="winbind.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AdvancedNetworkManagement"></a>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984570">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984759">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984858">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984876">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2985087">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2985283">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2985316">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts"><link rel="next" href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="winbind.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AdvancedNetworkManagement"></a>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943742">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943772">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943871">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943888">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944129">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944368">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944401">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> This section documents peripheral issues that are of great importance to network administrators who want to improve network resource access control, to automate the user environment, and to make their lives a little easier. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984570"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943742"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Often the difference between a working network environment and a well appreciated one can best be measured by the <span class="emphasis"><em>little things</em></span> that makes everything work more harmoniously. A key part of every network environment solution is the ability to remotely @@ -12,7 +12,7 @@ network operations. </p><p> This chapter presents information on each of these area. They are placed here, and not in other chapters, for ease of reference. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984759"></a>Remote Server Administration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943772"></a>Remote Server Administration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>How do I get 'User Manager' and 'Server Manager'?</em></span> </p><p> Since I don't need to buy an <span class="application">NT4 Server</span>, how do I get the 'User Manager for Domains', @@ -26,12 +26,12 @@ Click here to download the archived file <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softli The <span class="application">Windows NT 4.0</span> version of the 'User Manager for Domains' and 'Server Manager' are available from Microsoft via ftp from <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE" target="_top">ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE</a> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984858"></a>Remote Desktop Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943871"></a>Remote Desktop Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of possible remote desktop management solutions that range from free through costly. Do not let that put you off. Sometimes the most costly solutions is the most cost effective. In any case, you will need to draw your own conclusions as to which is the best tool in your network environment. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2984876"></a>Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943888"></a>Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following information was posted to the Samba mailing list at Apr 3 23:33:50 GMT 2003. It is presented in slightly edited form (with author details omitted for privacy reasons). The entire answer is reproduced below with some comments removed. @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ is the best tool in your network environment. NoMachine are encouraging and offering help to OSS/Free Software implementations for such a frontend too, even if it means competition to them (they have written to this effect even to the LTSP, KDE and GNOME developer mailing lists) - </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2985087"></a>Network Logon Script Magic</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944129"></a>Network Logon Script Magic</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section needs work. Volunteer contributions most welcome. Please send your patches or updates to <a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John Terpstra</a>. </p><p> @@ -209,7 +209,7 @@ This is the <tt class="filename">genlogon.pl</tt> file: </pre><p> </p><p> Those wishing to use more elaborate or capable logon processing system should check out the following sites: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon" target="_top">http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://www.kixtart.org" target="_top">http://www.kixtart.org</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a></td></tr></table><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2985283"></a>Adding printers without user intervention</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon" target="_top">http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://www.kixtart.org" target="_top">http://www.kixtart.org</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a></td></tr></table><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944368"></a>Adding printers without user intervention</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Printers may be added automatically during logon script processing through the use of: </p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -217,8 +217,8 @@ Printers may be added automatically during logon script processing through the u </pre><p> See the documentation in the <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">Microsoft knowledgebase article no: 189105</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2985316"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944401"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The information provided in this chapter has been reproduced from postings on the samba@samba.org mailing list. No implied endorsement or recommendation is offered. Administrators should conduct their own evaluation of alternatives and are encouraged to draw their own conclusions. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="winbind.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="winbind.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html b/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html index 854437acde..6d77a0ba65 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Appendixes.html @@ -1,4 +1,3 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part VI. Appendixes</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs"><link rel="next" href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="bugreport.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="compiling.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Appendixes"></a>Appendixes</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>36. <a href="compiling.html">How to compile SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3012145">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3012152">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3012182">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3013701">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3013750">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3013886">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014023">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014188">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014280">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014484">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014579">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="Portability.html">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3013478">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016009">SCO Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016039">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016210">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016254">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016261">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016287">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016294">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="Other-Clients.html">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3015663">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017016">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017023">How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017102">How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017164">How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017260">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017268">Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017357">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017388">Configure WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017433">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017464">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017481">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017528">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017601">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017625">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017736">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="speed.html">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018768">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018812">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018887">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018931">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018984">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019007">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019064">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019106">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019127">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019154">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019185">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="DNSDHCP.html">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id3018605">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="Further-Resources.html">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id3018765">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id3020416">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id3020431">Books</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="bugreport.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="compiling.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part VI. Appendixes</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs"><link rel="next" href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="bugreport.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="compiling.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Appendixes"></a>Appendixes</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>36. <a href="compiling.html">How to compile Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961265">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961282">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961320">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961581">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961644">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961798">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961978">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962144">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962499">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="Portability.html">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962662">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962750">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962780">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962953">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962995">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963002">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963029">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963036">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="Other-Clients.html">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963189">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963267">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963275">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963359">Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963411">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963512">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963519">Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963610">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963639">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963692">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963730">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963747">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963794">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963867">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963891">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2964079">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="speed.html">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964209">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964253">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964343">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964393">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964453">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964483">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964567">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964630">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964659">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964684">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964716">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="DNSDHCP.html">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id2964821">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="Further-Resources.html">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2964888">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2965278">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="bugreport.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="compiling.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 36. How to compile Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html b/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html index 9fac452023..f19bd6d2b3 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Backup.html @@ -1,13 +1,11 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"><link rel="next" href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="unicode.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SambaHA.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Backup"></a>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id3001533">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id3001557">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001533"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"><link rel="next" href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="unicode.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SambaHA.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Backup"></a>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2953871">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2953885">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953871"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -If you have something to contribute for this section please email it to -<a href="">jht@samba.org</a>/ -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001557"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953885"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> We need feedback from people who are backing up samba servers. We would like to know what software tools you are using to backup your samba server/s. </p><p> In particular, if you have any success and / or failure stories you could share with other users this would be appreciated. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="unicode.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SambaHA.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 29. High Availability Options</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="unicode.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SambaHA.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 29. High Availability Options</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html b/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html index 46ca8e15f7..8bfe11405f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/CUPS-printing.html @@ -1,54 +1,59 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"><link rel="next" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="printing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="VFS.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="CUPS-printing"></a>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Ciprian</span> <span class="surname">Vizitiu</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (3 June 2003) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953785">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953792">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953845">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953900">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953979">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954122">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954205">More complex smb.conf Settings for -CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954322">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954343">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954370">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954406">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954465">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954626">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954719">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954794">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954839">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954940">Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955028">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955125">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955238">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955308">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955397">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955420">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955560">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955747">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955864">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956034">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956120">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956222">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956377">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956434">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956519">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956831">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956944">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956960">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957012">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957066">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957282">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957510">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and -native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957666">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957897">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958024">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958100">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958116">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958155">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958227">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958289">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print -Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958310">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958474">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958550">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958605">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958646">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958712">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958729">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958763">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958784">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958811">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958865"> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958884">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958976">Prepare your smb.conf for -cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959022">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959220">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959278">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959310">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959360">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959582">What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959764">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959865">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960092">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960186">How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960273">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960308">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960361">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960474">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the -Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960608">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using -rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960723">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960836">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960925">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961015">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961177">Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961830">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961930">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962033">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962103">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962165">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962224">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962290">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962398">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963027">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963488">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963519">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963551">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963592">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963663">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963765">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963836">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963884">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963899">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964092">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964138">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964221">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964281">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964299">When not to use Samba to print to -CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964316">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964352">Where to find Documentation</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964364">How to ask for Help</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964377">Where to find Help</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964391">Appendix</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964398">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964612">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964919">Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2966041">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953785"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953792"></a>Features and Benefits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - The Common Unix Print System (<a href="http://www.cups.org/" target="_top">CUPS</a>) has become very popular. All - big Linux distributions now ship it as their default printing - system. But to many it is still a very mystical tool. Normally it - "just works" (TM). People tend to regard it as a sort of "black box", - which they don't want to look into, as long as it works OK. But once +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"><link rel="next" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="printing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="VFS.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="CUPS-printing"></a>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Ciprian</span> <span class="surname">Vizitiu</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (3 June 2003) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923750">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923756">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923811">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923880">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924213">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924395">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924750">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924770">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924825">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924894">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924971">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925317">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925951">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926092">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926179">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926285">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926306">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926501">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926862">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927043">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927153">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927264">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927459">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927523">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927675">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928022">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928168">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928183">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928246">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928335">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928581">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929083">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929420">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929572">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929667">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929677">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929741">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929936">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930169">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930255">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930344">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930400">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930476">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930493">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930538">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930560">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930614">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930637">Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930710">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930811">Prepare your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931030">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931268">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931460">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931493">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931837">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932052">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932180">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932551">How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932633">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932714">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932789">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932953">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933288">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933403">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933506">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934958">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935364">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935456">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935520">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935579">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935716">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935871">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936640">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937141">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937193">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937258">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937303">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937398">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937516">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937592">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937648">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937662">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937912">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937974">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938226">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938284">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938356">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938656">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938758">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938765">Win9x client can't install driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938787">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938835">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938893">Client can't connect to Samba printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938921">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939149">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939202">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939219">Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939249">Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939258">Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939297">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939331">"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939354">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939398">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939689">Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939734">cupsaddsmb does not work + with newly installed printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939796">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939905">Printer named "lp" +intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different +ones</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939953">Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940008">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923750"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923756"></a>Features and Benefits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The Common UNIX Print System (<a href="http://www.cups.org/" target="_top">CUPS</a>) has become very popular. All + major Linux distributions now ship it as their default printing + system. To many it is still a very mystical tool. Mostly, it + "just works" (TM). People tend to regard it as a "black box" + which they don't want to look into, as long as it works. But once there is a little problem, they are in trouble to find out where to - start debugging it. Also, even the most recent and otherwise excellent - printed Samba documentation has only limited attention paid to CUPS - printing, leaving out important pieces or even writing plain wrong - things about it. This demands rectification. But before you dive into - this chapter, make sure that you don't forget to refer to the - "Classical Printing" chapter also. It contains a lot of information - that is relevant for CUPS too. + start debugging it. Refer to the "Classical Printing" chapter also, it + contains a lot of information that is relevant for CUPS. </p><p> CUPS sports quite a few unique and powerful features. While their basic functions may be grasped quite easily, they are also new. Because they are different from other, more traditional printing systems, it is best to try and not apply any prior knowledge about - printing upon this new system. Rather try to start understand CUPS - from the beginning. This documentation will lead you here to a - complete understanding of CUPS, if you study all of the material - contained. But lets start with the most basic things first. Maybe this - is all you need for now. Then you can skip most of the other - paragraphs. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953845"></a>Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + printing upon this new system. Rather, try to understand CUPS + from the beginning. This documentation will lead you to a + complete understanding of CUPS. Let's start with the most basic + things first. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923811"></a>Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS is more than just a print spooling system. It is a complete printer management system that complies with the new IPP (<span class="emphasis"><em>Internet Printing Protocol</em></span>). IPP is an industry and IETF (<span class="emphasis"><em>Internet Engineering Task Force</em></span>) standard for network printing. Many of its functions can be managed remotely (or locally) via a web browser (giving you a - platform-independent access to the CUPS print server). In addition it - has the traditional commandline and several more modern GUI interfaces + platform-independent access to the CUPS print server). Additionally, it + has the traditional command line and several more modern GUI interfaces (GUI interfaces developed by 3rd parties, like KDE's overwhelming <a href="http://printing.kde.org/" target="_top">KDEPrint</a>). </p><p> @@ -60,80 +65,53 @@ Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2966041">An Overview of the C argue that CUPS is better! In any case, let us now move on to explore how one may configure CUPS for interfacing with MS Windows print clients via Samba. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953900"></a>Basic Configuration of CUPS support</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Printing with CUPS in the most basic <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> - setup in Samba 3.0 (as was true for 2.2.x) only needs two - settings: <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>printcap - = cups</tt></i>. CUPS itself doesn't need a printcap file - anymore. However, the <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> configuration - file knows two related directives: they control if such a file should - be automatically created and maintained by CUPS for the convenience of - third party applications (example: <i class="parameter"><tt>Printcap - /etc/printcap</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>PrintcapFormat - BSD</tt></i>). These legacy programs often require the existence of - printcap file containing printernames or they will refuse to - print. Make sure CUPS is set to generate and maintain a printcap! For - details see <b class="command">man cupsd.conf</b> and other CUPS-related - documentation, like the wealth of documents on your CUPS server + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923880"></a>Basic Configuration of CUPS support</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Printing with CUPS in the most basic <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setup in Samba 3.0 (as was true for 2.2.x) only needs two + settings: <a class="indexterm" name="id2923898"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2923912"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups. CUPS does not need a printcap file. + However, the <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> configuration file knows of two related directives that control + how such a file will be automatically created and maintained by CUPS for the convenience of third party + applications (example: <i class="parameter"><tt>Printcap /etc/printcap</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>PrintcapFormat BSD</tt></i>). + Legacy programs often require the existence of a printcap file containing printer names or they will refuse to + print. Make sure CUPS is set to generate and maintain a printcap file! For details see + <b class="command">man cupsd.conf</b> and other CUPS-related documentation, like the wealth of documents on your CUPS server itself: <a href="http://localhost:631/documentation.html" target="_top">http://localhost:631/documentation.html</a>. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953979"></a>Linking of smbd with libcups.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Samba has a very special relationship to CUPS. The reason is: Samba - can be compiled with CUPS library support. Most recent installations - have this support enabled, and per default CUPS linking is compiled + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923972"></a>Linking of smbd with libcups.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba has a very special relationship to CUPS. Samba can be compiled with CUPS library support. + Most recent installations have this support enabled. Per default CUPS linking is compiled into smbd and other Samba binaries. Of course, you can use CUPS even if Samba is not linked against <tt class="filename">libcups.so</tt> -- but there are some differences in required or supported configuration then. </p><p> - If SAMBA is compiled against libcups, then <i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = - cups</tt></i> uses the CUPS API to list printers, submit jobs, - query queues, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V commands with an - additional <b class="command">-oraw</b> option for printing. On a Linux - system, you can use the <b class="command">ldd</b> utility to find out - details (ldd may not be present on other OS platforms, or its function - may be embodied by a different command): - </p><pre class="screen"> - transmeta:/home/kurt # ldd `which smbd` - libssl.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libssl.so.0.9.6 (0x4002d000) - libcrypto.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libcrypto.so.0.9.6 (0x4005a000) - libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000) - [....] - </pre><p> - The line <tt class="computeroutput">libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 - (0x40123000)</tt> shows there is CUPS support compiled - into this version of Samba. If this is the case, and printing = cups - is set, then <span class="emphasis"><em>any otherwise manually set print command in - <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is ignored</em></span>. This is an - important point to remember! - </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Should you require -- for any reason -- to set your own - print commands, you can still do this by setting <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = - sysv</tt></i>. However, you'll loose all the benefits from the - close CUPS/Samba integration. You are on your own then to manually - configure the rest of the printing system commands (most important: - <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>; other commands are - <i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command, lpresume command, lpq command, lprm - command, queuepause command </tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>queue resume - command</tt></i>).</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954122"></a>Simple <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - To summarize, here is the simplest printing-related setup - for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to enable basic CUPS support: + When Samba is compiled against libcups, <a class="indexterm" name="id2924002"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups + uses the CUPS API to list printers, submit jobs, query queues, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V + commands with an additional <b class="command">-oraw</b> option for printing. On a Linux + system, you can use the <b class="command">ldd</b> utility to find out details (ldd may not be present on + other OS platforms, or its function may be embodied by a different command): </p><pre class="screen"> - - [global] - load printers = yes - printing = cups - printcap name = cups - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - browseable = no - public = yes - guest ok = yes - writable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = root, @ntadmins - - </pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ldd `which smbd`</tt></b> +libssl.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libssl.so.0.9.6 (0x4002d000) +libcrypto.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libcrypto.so.0.9.6 (0x4005a000) +libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000) +[....] +</pre><p> + The line <tt class="computeroutput">libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000)</tt> shows + there is CUPS support compiled into this version of Samba. If this is the case, and printing = cups + is set, then <span class="emphasis"><em>any otherwise manually set print command in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is ignored</em></span>. + This is an important point to remember! + </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Should it be necessary, for any reason, to set your own print commands, you can do this by setting + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924097"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv. However, you will loose all the benefits + of tight CUPS/Samba integration. When you do this you must manually configure the printing system commands + (most important: <a class="indexterm" name="id2924114"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>; other commands are + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924128"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924142"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924155"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924169"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924183"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2924197"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queue resume command</tt></i>).</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924213"></a>Simple <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To summarize, here is the simplest printing-related setup for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to enable basic CUPS support: + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2924241"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.1. Simplest printing-related smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root, @ntadmins</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> This is all you need for basic printing setup for CUPS. It will print all Graphic, Text, PDF and PostScript file submitted from Windows clients. However, most of your Windows users would not know how to @@ -148,67 +126,29 @@ Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2966041">An Overview of the C printer is not a PostScript device, the print data stream is "binary", sensible only for the target printer. Read on to learn which problem this may cause and how to avoid it. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954205"></a>More complex <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924395"></a>More complex <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here is a slightly more complex printing-related setup for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. It enables general CUPS printing support for all printers, but defines one printer share which is set up differently. -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [global] - printing = cups - printcap name = cups - load printers = yes - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - public = yes - guest ok = yes - writable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = root, @ntadmins - - [special_printer] - comment = A special printer with his own settings - path = /var/spool/samba-special - printing = sysv - printcap = lpstat - print command = echo "NEW: `date`: printfile %f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ;\ - echo " `date`: p-%p s-%s f-%f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ;\ - echo " `date`: j-%j J-%J z-%z c-%c" >> /tmp/smbprn.log :\ - rm %f - public = no - guest ok = no - writeable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = kurt - hosts deny = 0.0.0.0 - hosts allow = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60 - -</pre><p> -This special share is only there for my testing purposes. It doesn't -even write the print job to a file. It just logs the job parameters -known to Samba into the <tt class="filename">/tmp/smbprn.log</tt> file and -deletes the jobfile. Moreover, the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer -admin</tt></i> of this share is "kurt" (not the "@ntadmins" group); -guest access is not allowed; the share isn't announced in Network -Neighbourhood (so you need to know it is there), and it is only -allowing access from three hosts. To prevent CUPS kicking in and -taking over the print jobs for that share, we need to set -<i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = -lpstat</tt></i>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954322"></a>Advanced Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Before we dive into all the configuration options, let's clarify a few +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2924426"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.2. Overriding global CUPS settings for one printer</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root, @ntadmins</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[special_printer]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = A special printer with his own settings</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba-special</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = lpstat</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = echo "NEW: `date`: printfile %f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ; \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>echo " `date`: p-%p s-%s f-%f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ; \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>echo " `date`: j-%j J-%J z-%z c-%c" >> /tmp/smbprn.log : rm %f</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +This special share is only there for testing purposes. It does not write the print job to a file. It just logs the job parameters +known to Samba into the <tt class="filename">/tmp/smbprn.log</tt> file and deletes the jobfile. Moreover, the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2924692"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> of this share is "kurt" (not the "@ntadmins" group); +guest access is not allowed; the share isn not published to the Network Neighbourhood (so you need to know it is there), and it only +allows access from only three hosts. To prevent CUPS kicking in and taking over the print jobs for that share, we need to set +<a class="indexterm" name="id2924720"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2924733"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = lpstat. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924750"></a>Advanced Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Before we delve into all the configuration options, let us clarify a few points. <span class="emphasis"><em>Network printing needs to be organized and setup correctly</em></span>. Often this is not done correctly. Legacy systems -or small LANs in business environments often lack a clear design and -good housekeeping. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954343"></a>Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +or small business LAN environments often lack design and good housekeeping. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924770"></a>Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2924780"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2924790"></a><p> Many small office or home networks, as well as badly organized larger environments, allow each client a direct access to available network -printers. Generally, this is a bad idea. It often blocks one client's +printers. This is generally a bad idea. It often blocks one client's access to the printer when another client's job is printing. It also might freeze the first client's application while it is waiting to get rid of the job. Also, there are frequent complaints about various jobs @@ -217,18 +157,18 @@ is the usage of a "print server": it routes all jobs through one central system, which responds immediately, takes jobs from multiple concurrent clients at the same time and in turn transfers them to the printer(s) in the correct order. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954370"></a>CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Most traditionally configured Unix print servers acting on behalf of +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924825"></a>CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2924835"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2924844"></a><p> +Most traditionally configured UNIX print servers acting on behalf of Samba's Windows clients represented a really simple setup. Their only task was to manage the "raw" spooling of all jobs handed to them by Samba. This approach meant that the Windows clients were expected to -prepare the print job file in such a way that it became fit to be fed to -the printing device. Here a native (vendor-supplied) Windows printer +prepare the print job file that it s ready to be sent to the printing +device. Here a native (vendor-supplied) Windows printer driver for the target device needed to be installed on each and every client. </p><p> -Of course you can setup CUPS, Samba and your Windows clients in the +It is possible to configure CUPS, Samba and your Windows clients in the same, traditional and simple way. When CUPS printers are configured for RAW print-through mode operation it is the responsibility of the Samba client to fully render the print job (file). The file must be @@ -236,21 +176,23 @@ sent in a format that is suitable for direct delivery to the printer. Clients need to run the vendor-provided drivers to do this. In this case CUPS will NOT do any print file format conversion work. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954406"></a>Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924894"></a>Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The printer drivers on the Windows clients may be installed in two functionally different ways: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>manually install the drivers locally on each client, one by one; this yields the old <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> style printing; it uses a <tt class="filename">\\sambaserver\printershare</tt> -type of connection.</p></li><li><p>deposit and prepare the drivers (for later download) on +type of connection.</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2924937"></a> + deposit and prepare the drivers (for later download) on the print server (Samba); this enables the clients to use -"Point'n'Print" to get drivers semi-automatically installed the +"Point and Print" to get drivers semi-automatically installed the first time they access the printer; with this method NT/2K/XP clients use the <span class="emphasis"><em>SPOOLSS/MS-RPC</em></span> type printing calls.</p></li></ul></div><p> The second method is recommended for use over the first. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954465"></a>Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -<span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924971"></a>Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +<span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2924984"></a><p> If you use the first option (drivers are installed on the client side), there is one setting to take care of: CUPS needs to be told that it should allow "raw" printing of deliberate (binary) file @@ -263,16 +205,12 @@ be uncommented to allow RAW mode operation. In<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> make sure this line is present: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/octet-stream - </pre><p> In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt>, have this line: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2925053"></a><pre class="screen"> application/octet-stream application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - </pre><p> If these two files are not set up correctly for raw Windows client printing, you may encounter the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">Unable to @@ -281,7 +219,7 @@ convert file 0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file does not <span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> "raw" printing, it only <span class="emphasis"><em>allows</em></span> it. -</p></div><p><b>Background. </b> +</p></div><p><b>Background. </b><a class="indexterm" name="id2925119"></a> CUPS being a more security-aware printing system than traditional ones does not by default allow a user to send deliberate (possibly binary) data to printing devices. This could be easily abused to launch a @@ -298,7 +236,7 @@ This is all you need to know to get the CUPS/Samba combo printing locally installed. If you are not interested in background information about more advanced CUPS/Samba printing, simply skip the remaining sections of this chapter. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954626"></a>Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925177"></a>Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925185"></a><p> If you want to use the MS-RPC type printing, you must upload the drivers onto the Samba server first (<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share). For a discussion on how to deposit printer drivers on the @@ -306,23 +244,25 @@ Samba host (so that the Windows clients can download and use them via "Point'n'Print") please also refer to the previous chapter of this HOWTO Collection. There you will find a description or reference to three methods of preparing the client drivers on the Samba server: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the GUI, "Add Printer Wizard" +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2925224"></a><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the GUI, "Add Printer Wizard" <span class="emphasis"><em>upload-from-a-Windows-client</em></span> method;</p></li><li><p>the commandline, "smbclient/rpcclient" <span class="emphasis"><em>upload-from-a-UNIX-workstation</em></span> -method;</p></li><li><p>the <span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> Toolset +method;</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2925264"></a> + the <span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> Toolset method.</p></li></ul></div><p> These 3 methods apply to CUPS all the same. A new and more convenient way to load the Windows drivers into Samba is provided -provided if you use CUPS: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> +if you use CUPS: +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2925285"></a><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> utility.</p></li></ul></div><p> cupsaddsmb is discussed in much detail further below. But we will first explore the CUPS filtering system and compare the Windows and UNIX printing architectures. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954719"></a>Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Still reading on? Good. Let's go into more detail then. We now know +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925317"></a>Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925326"></a><p> +Are you still following this? Good. Let's go into more detail then. We now know how to set up a "dump" printserver, that is, a server which is spooling printjobs "raw", leaving the print data untouched. </p><p> @@ -343,13 +283,13 @@ server meeting these requirements, you'll first need to learn about how CUPS works and how you can enable its features. </p><p> What follows is the comparison of some fundamental concepts for -Windows and Unix printing; then is the time for a description of the +Windows and UNIX printing; then is the time for a description of the CUPS filtering system, how it works and how you can tweak it. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954794"></a>GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="gdipost"></a>GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925423"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925431"></a><p> Network printing is one of the most complicated and error-prone day-to-day tasks any user or an administrator may encounter. This is true for all OS platforms. And there are reasons for this. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2925447"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925456"></a><p> You can't expect for most file formats to just throw them towards printers and they get printed. There needs to be a file format conversion in between. The problem is: there is no common standard for @@ -361,7 +301,7 @@ into semi-official "standards", by being the most widely used PDLs many manufacturers who "roll their own" (their reasons may be unacceptable license fees for using printer-embedded PostScript interpreters, etc.). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954839"></a>Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925497"></a>Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925505"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925514"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925522"></a><p> In Windows OS, the format conversion job is done by the printer drivers. On MS Windows OS platforms all application programmers have at their disposal a built-in API, the GDI (<span class="emphasis"><em>Graphical Device @@ -378,16 +318,17 @@ the GDI, produces often a file format called EMF (<span class="emphasis"><em>Enh MetaFile</em></span>). The EMF is processed by the printer driver and converted to the printer-specific file format. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2925583"></a> To the GDI foundation in MS Windows, Apple has chosen to put paper and screen output on a common foundation for their -(BSD-Unix-based, did you know??) Mac OS X and Darwin Operating -Systems.Their <span class="emphasis"><em>Core Graphic Engine</em></span> uses a -<span class="emphasis"><em>PDF</em></span> derivate for all display work. +(BSD-UNIX-based, did you know??) Mac OS X and Darwin Operating +Systems. Their <span class="emphasis"><em>Core Graphic Engine</em></span> uses a +<span class="emphasis"><em>PDF</em></span> derivative for all display work. </p></div><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2954904"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.1. Windows Printing to a local Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" alt="Windows Printing to a local Printer"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954940"></a>Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In Unix and Linux, there is no comparable layer built into the OS +</p><div class="figure"><a name="small1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.1. Windows Printing to a local Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" width="270" alt="Windows Printing to a local Printer"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925650"></a>UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925657"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925665"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925673"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925682"></a><p> +In UNIX and Linux, there is no comparable layer built into the OS kernel(s) or the X (screen display) server. Every application is responsible for itself to create its print output. Fortunately, most use PostScript. That gives at least some common ground. Unfortunately, @@ -406,7 +347,7 @@ ready for prime time.) You can see this unfavorable inheritance up to the present day by looking into the various "font" directories on your system; there are separate ones for fonts used for X display and fonts to be used on paper. -</p><p><b>Background. </b> +</p><p><b>Background. </b><a class="indexterm" name="id2925741"></a> The PostScript programming language is an "invention" by Adobe Inc., but its specifications have been published to the full. Its strength lies in its powerful abilities to describe graphical objects (fonts, @@ -422,9 +363,9 @@ form and you will be reading its PostScript code, the language instructions which need to be interpreted by a rasterizer. Rasterizers produce pixel images, which may be displayed on screen by a viewer program or on paper by a printer. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955028"></a>PostScript and Ghostscript</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -So, Unix is lacking a common ground for printing on paper and -displaying on screen. Despite this unfavorable legacy for Unix, basic +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="post-and-ghost"></a>PostScript and Ghostscript</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925792"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925800"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2925811"></a><p> +So, UNIX is lacking a common ground for printing on paper and +displaying on screen. Despite this unfavorable legacy for UNIX, basic printing is fairly easy: if you have PostScript printers at your disposal! The reason is: these devices have a built-in PostScript language "interpreter", also called a <span class="emphasis"><em>Raster Image @@ -434,33 +375,35 @@ spit out your printed pages. Their RIP is doing all the hard work of converting the PostScript drawing commands into a bitmap picture as you see it on paper, in a resolution as done by your printer. This is no different to PostScript printing of a file from a Windows origin. -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Traditional Unix programs and printing systems -- while +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2925853"></a> +Traditional UNIX programs and printing systems -- while using PostScript -- are largely not PPD-aware. PPDs are "PostScript Printer Description" files. They enable you to specify and control all options a printer supports: duplexing, stapling, punching... Therefore -Unix users for a long time couldn't choose many of the supported +UNIX users for a long time couldn't choose many of the supported device and job options, unlike Windows or Apple users. But now there -is CUPS.... ;-) +is CUPS.... </p></div><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2955075"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.2. Printing to a Postscript Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/2small.png" alt="Printing to a Postscript Printer"></div></div><p> -</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small2"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.2. Printing to a Postscript Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/2small.png" width="270" alt="Printing to a Postscript Printer"></div></div><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2925928"></a><p> However, there are other types of printers out there. These don't know how to print PostScript. They use their own <span class="emphasis"><em>Page Description Language</em></span> (PDL, often proprietary). To print to them is much -more demanding. Since your Unix applications mostly produce +more demanding. Since your UNIX applications mostly produce PostScript, and since these devices don't understand PostScript, you need to convert the printfiles to a format suitable for your printer on the host, before you can send it away. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955125"></a>Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925951"></a>Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2925960"></a><p> Here is where <span class="emphasis"><em>Ghostscript</em></span> kicks in. Ghostscript is the traditional (and quite powerful) PostScript interpreter used on -Unix platforms. It is a RIP in software, capable to do a +UNIX platforms. It is a RIP in software, capable to do a <span class="emphasis"><em>lot</em></span> of file format conversions, for a very broad spectrum of hardware devices as well as software file formats. Ghostscript technology and drivers is what enables PostScript printing to non-PostScript hardware. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2955155"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.3. Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/3small.png" alt="Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small3"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.3. Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/3small.png" width="270" alt="Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers"></div></div><p> </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Use the "gs -h" command to check for all built-in "devices" of your Ghostscript version. If you specify e.g. a parameter of @@ -473,12 +416,12 @@ intervals, now by artofcode LLC. They are initially put under the "AFPL" license, but re-released under the GNU GPL as soon as the next AFPL version appears. GNU Ghostscript is probably the version installed on most Samba systems. But it has got some -deficiencies. Therefore ESP Ghostscript was developed as an +deficiencies. <a class="indexterm" name="id2926066"></a>Therefore ESP Ghostscript was developed as an enhancement over GNU Ghostscript, with lots of bug-fixes, additional devices and improvements. It is jointly maintained by developers from CUPS, Gimp-Print, MandrakeSoft, SuSE, RedHat and Debian. It includes the "cups" device (essential to print to non-PS printers from CUPS). -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955238"></a>PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926092"></a>PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2926100"></a><p> While PostScript in essence is a <span class="emphasis"><em>Page Description Language</em></span> (PDL) to represent the page layout in a <span class="emphasis"><em>device independent</em></span> way, real world print jobs are @@ -504,15 +447,16 @@ user selections are somehow written (in the form of special PostScript, PJL, JCL or vendor-dependent commands) into the PostScript file created by the driver. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926162"></a> A PostScript file that was created to contain device-specific commands for achieving a certain print job output (e.g. duplexed, stapled and punched) on a specific target machine, may not print as expected, or may not be printable at all on other models; it also may not be fit for further processing by software (e.g. by a PDF distilling program). -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955308"></a>CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926179"></a>CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS can handle all spec-compliant PPDs as supplied by the manufacturers for their PostScript models. Even if a -Unix/Linux-illiterate vendor might not have mentioned our favorite +UNIX/Linux-illiterate vendor might not have mentioned our favorite OS in his manuals and brochures -- you can safely trust this: <span class="emphasis"><em>if you get hold of the Windows NT version of the PPD, you can use it unchanged in CUPS</em></span> and thus access the full @@ -524,6 +468,8 @@ immediately. CUPS in all versions after 1.1.19 has a much more strict internal PPD parsing and checking code enabled; in case of printing trouble this online resource should be one of your first pitstops. </p></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926227"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926235"></a> For real PostScript printers <span class="emphasis"><em>don't</em></span> use the <span class="emphasis"><em>Foomatic</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic</em></span> PPDs from Linuxprinting.org. With these devices the original @@ -536,7 +482,7 @@ your LAN has the PostScript driver installed, just use access the Windows directory where all printer driver files are stored. First look in the <tt class="filename">W32X86/2</tt> subdir for the PPD you are seeking. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955397"></a>CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926285"></a>CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS also uses specially crafted PPDs to handle non-PostScript printers. These PPDs are usually not available from the vendors (and no, you can't just take the PPD of a Postscript printer with the same @@ -544,7 +490,7 @@ model name and hope it works for the non-PostScript version too). To understand how these PPDs work for non-PS printers we first need to dive deeply into the CUPS filtering and file format conversion architecture. Stay tuned. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2955420"></a>The CUPS Filtering Architecture</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2926306"></a>The CUPS Filtering Architecture</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The core of the CUPS filtering system is based on <span class="emphasis"><em>Ghostscript</em></span>. In addition to Ghostscript, CUPS uses some other filters of its own. You (or your OS vendor) may have @@ -570,23 +516,27 @@ Make sure your Ghostscript version has the "cups" device compiled in may encounter the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">Unable to convert file 0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. To have "cups" as a device in your Ghostscript, you either need to <span class="emphasis"><em>patch GNU -Ghostscript</em></span> and re-compile or use <a href="http://www.cups.org/ghostscript.php" target="_top">ESP Ghostscript</a>. The +Ghostscript</em></span> and re-compile or use <a class="indexterm" name="id2926410"></a><a href="http://www.cups.org/ghostscript.php" target="_top">ESP Ghostscript</a>. The superior alternative is ESP Ghostscript: it supports not just CUPS, but 300 other devices too (while GNU Ghostscript supports only about 180). Because of this broad output device support, ESP Ghostscript is the first choice for non-CUPS spoolers too. It is now recommended by Linuxprinting.org for all spoolers. </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926437"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926446"></a> CUPS printers may be setup to use <span class="emphasis"><em>external</em></span> rendering paths. One of the most common ones is provided by the <span class="emphasis"><em>Foomatic/cupsomatic</em></span> concept, from <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/" target="_top">Linuxprinting.org</a>. This uses the classical Ghostscript approach, doing everything in one step. It doesn't use the "cups" device, but one of the many others. However, even for Foomatic/cupsomatic usage, best results and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926483"></a> broadest printer model support is provided by ESP Ghostscript (more about cupsomatic/Foomatic, particularly the new version called now <span class="emphasis"><em>foomatic-rip</em></span>, follows below). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955560"></a>MIME types and CUPS Filters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926501"></a>MIME types and CUPS Filters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2926512"></a> CUPS reads the file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> (and all other files carrying a <tt class="filename">*.types</tt> suffix in the same directory) upon startup. These files contain the MIME @@ -595,10 +545,10 @@ auto-typing routines. The rule syntax is explained in the man page for <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> and in the comments section of the <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file itself. A simple rule reads like this: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926558"></a> </p><pre class="screen"> - application/pdf pdf string(0,%PDF) - </pre><p> This means: if a filename has either a <tt class="filename">.pdf</tt> suffix, or if the magic @@ -607,9 +557,7 @@ beginning of the file itself (offset 0 from the start), then it is a PDF file (<span class="emphasis"><em>application/pdf</em></span>). Another rule is this: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/postscript ai eps ps string(0,%!) string(0,<04>%!) - </pre><p> Its meaning: if the filename has one of the suffixes <tt class="filename">.ai</tt>, <tt class="filename">.eps</tt>, @@ -639,7 +587,7 @@ CUPS can handle ASCII text, HP-GL, PDF, PostScript, DVI and a lot of image formats (GIF. PNG, TIFF, JPEG, Photo-CD, SUN-Raster, PNM, PBM, SGI-RGB and some more) and their associated MIME types with its filters. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955747"></a>MIME type Conversion Rules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926707"></a>MIME type Conversion Rules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2926716"></a><p> CUPS reads the file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt> (and all other files named with a <tt class="filename">*.convs</tt> suffix in the same directory) upon startup. These files contain @@ -648,39 +596,31 @@ conversion filter which can produce the output from the input type and virtual costs associated with this conversion. One example line reads like this: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/pdf application/postscript 33 pdftops - </pre><p> This means that the <span class="emphasis"><em>pdftops</em></span> filter will take <span class="emphasis"><em>application/pdf</em></span> as input and produce <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> as output, the virtual cost of this operation is 33 CUPS-$. The next filter is more expensive, costing 66 CUPS-$: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2926777"></a><pre class="screen"> application/vnd.hp-HPGL application/postscript 66 hpgltops - </pre><p> This is the <span class="emphasis"><em>hpgltops</em></span>, which processes HP-GL plotter files to PostScript. -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2926804"></a><pre class="screen"> application/octet-stream - </pre><p> Here are two more examples: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2926827"></a><pre class="screen"> application/x-shell application/postscript 33 texttops text/plain application/postscript 33 texttops - </pre><p> The last two examples name the <span class="emphasis"><em>texttops</em></span> filter to work on "text/plain" as well as on "application/x-shell". (Hint: this differentiation is needed for the syntax highlighting feature of "texttops"). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955864"></a>Filter Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926862"></a>Filter Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2926870"></a><p> There are many more combinations named in mime.convs. However, you are not limited to use the ones pre-defined there. You can plug in any filter you like into the CUPS framework. It must meet, or must be made @@ -696,13 +636,13 @@ filenames or <tt class="filename">stdin</tt> as input and write to <span class="emphasis"><em>printer job user title copies options [filename]</em></span> </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The name of the printer queue (normally this is the name of the filter being run)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">job</span></dt><dd><p>The numeric job ID for the job being -printed</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the originating-user-name -attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the job-name attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The numeric value from the number-copies -attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The job options</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>(Optionally) The print request file (if missing, +printed</p></dd><dt><span class="term">user</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the originating-user-name +attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">title</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the job-name attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">copies</span></dt><dd><p>The numeric value from the number-copies +attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">options</span></dt><dd><p>The job options</p></dd><dt><span class="term">filename</span></dt><dd><p>(Optionally) The print request file (if missing, filters expected data fed through <tt class="filename">stdin</tt>). In most cases it is very easy to write a simple wrapper script around existing -filters to make them work with CUPS.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956034"></a>Prefilters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -As was said, PostScript is the central file format to any Unix based +filters to make them work with CUPS.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927043"></a>Prefilters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2927050"></a><p> +As was said, PostScript is the central file format to any UNIX based printing system. From PostScript, CUPS generates raster data to feed non-PostScript printers. </p><p> @@ -719,8 +659,8 @@ MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span> (<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> application/postscript), meaning it has the print options already embedded into the file. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2956084"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.4. Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/4small.png" alt="Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956120"></a>pstops</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small4"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.4. Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/4small.png" width="270" alt="Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927153"></a>pstops</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>pstops</em></span>is the filter to convert <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> to <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span>. It was said @@ -728,7 +668,7 @@ above that this filter inserts all device-specific print options (commands to the printer to ask for the duplexing of output, or stapling an punching it, etc.) into the PostScript file. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2956149"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.5. Adding Device-specific Print Options</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/5small.png" alt="Adding Device-specific Print Options"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small5"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.5. Adding Device-specific Print Options</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/5small.png" width="270" alt="Adding Device-specific Print Options"></div></div><p> </p><p> This is not all: other tasks performed by it are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -740,7 +680,7 @@ putting 2 or more logical pages on one sheet of paper (the so-called "number-up" function) </p></li><li><p>counting the pages of the job to insert the accounting information into the <tt class="filename">/var/log/cups/page_log</tt> -</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956222"></a>pstoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927264"></a>pstoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>pstoraster</em></span> is at the core of the CUPS filtering system. It is responsible for the first stage of the rasterization process. Its input is of MIME type application/vnd.cups-postscript; @@ -749,20 +689,20 @@ yet meant to be printable. Its aim is to serve as a general purpose input format for more specialized <span class="emphasis"><em>raster drivers</em></span>, that are able to generate device-specific printer data. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2956251"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.6. Postscript to intermediate Raster format</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/6small.png" alt="Postscript to intermediate Raster format"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small6"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.6. Postscript to intermediate Raster format</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/6small.png" width="270" alt="Postscript to intermediate Raster format"></div></div><p> </p><p> CUPS raster is a generic raster format with powerful features. It is able to include per-page information, color profiles and more to be used by the following downstream raster drivers. Its MIME type is registered with IANA and its specification is of course completely open. It is designed to make it very easy and inexpensive for -manufacturers to develop Linux and Unix raster drivers for their +manufacturers to develop Linux and UNIX raster drivers for their printer models, should they choose to do so. CUPS always takes care for the first stage of rasterization so these vendors don't need to care about Ghostscript complications (in fact, there is currently more than one vendor financing the development of CUPS raster drivers). </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2956304"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.7. CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/7small.png" alt="CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small7"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.7. CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/7small.png" width="270" alt="CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript"></div></div><p> </p><p> CUPS versions before version 1.1.15 were shipping a binary (or source code) standalone filter, named "pstoraster". pstoraster was derived @@ -776,7 +716,7 @@ integrated back into Ghostscript (now based on GNU Ghostscript version parameter. If your Ghostscript doesn't show a success on asking for <b class="command">gs -h |grep cups</b>, you might not be able to print. Update your Ghostscript then! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956377"></a>imagetops and imagetoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927459"></a>imagetops and imagetoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Above in the section about prefilters, we mentioned the prefilter that generates PostScript from image formats. The imagetoraster filter is used to convert directly from image to raster, without the @@ -784,13 +724,13 @@ intermediate PostScript stage. It is used more often than the above mentioned prefilters. Here is a summarizing flowchart of image file filtering: </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2956398"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.8. Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/8small.png" alt="Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956434"></a>rasterto [printers specific]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small8"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.8. Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/8small.png" width="270" alt="Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927523"></a>rasterto [printers specific]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS ships with quite some different raster drivers processing CUPS raster. On my system I find in /usr/lib/cups/filter/ these: -<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoalps, rastertobj, rastertoepson, rastertoescp, -rastertopcl, rastertoturboprint, rastertoapdk, rastertodymo, -rastertoescp, rastertohp</tt></i> and +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoalps</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertobj</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoepson</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoescp</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertopcl</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoturboprint</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoapdk</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertodymo</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoescp</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertohp</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i>. Don't worry if you have less than this; some of these are installed by commercial add-ons to CUPS (like <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoturboprint</tt></i>), others (like @@ -798,8 +738,8 @@ than this; some of these are installed by commercial add-ons to CUPS development projects (such as Gimp-Print) wanting to cooperate as closely as possible with CUPS. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2956484"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.9. Raster to Printer Specific formats</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/9small.png" alt="Raster to Printer Specific formats"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956519"></a>CUPS Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small9"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.9. Raster to Printer Specific formats</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/9small.png" width="270" alt="Raster to Printer Specific formats"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927675"></a>CUPS Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The last part of any CUPS filtering chain is a "backend". Backends are special programs that send the print-ready file to the final device. There is a separate backend program for any transfer @@ -854,7 +794,7 @@ This backend sends printfiles to printers shared by a Windows host. An example for CUPS device-URIs to use are: <tt class="filename">smb://workgroup/server/printersharename</tt> Or -<tt class="filename">Smb://server/printersharename</tt> +<tt class="filename">smb://server/printersharename</tt> or <tt class="filename">smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printersharename</tt> or @@ -880,13 +820,11 @@ printername). Not all of the mentioned backends may be present on your system or usable (depending on your hardware configuration). One test for all available CUPS backends is provided by the <span class="emphasis"><em>lpinfo</em></span> -utility. Used with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-v</tt></i> parameter, it lists +utility. Used with the <tt class="option">-v</tt> parameter, it lists all available backends: </p><pre class="screen"> - - lpinfo -v - -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956831"></a>cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpinfo -v</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928022"></a>cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2928030"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2928038"></a><p> "cupsomatic" filters may be the most widely used on CUPS installations. You must be clear about the fact that these were not developed by the CUPS people. They are a "Third Party" add-on to @@ -900,9 +838,7 @@ Printer & Driver Database at Linuxprinting.org. You can recognize these PPDs from the line calling the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic</em></span> filter: </p><pre class="screen"> - *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" - </pre><p> This line you may find amongst the first 40 or so lines of the PPD file. If you have such a PPD installed, the printer shows up in the @@ -911,7 +847,7 @@ the driver description. cupsomatic is a Perl script that runs Ghostscript, with all the complicated commandline options auto-constructed from the selected PPD and commandline options give to the printjob. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2928111"></a><p> However, cupsomatic is now deprecated. Its PPDs (especially the first generation of them, still in heavy use out there) are not meeting the Adobe specifications. You might also suffer difficulties when you try @@ -936,11 +872,11 @@ print-options from page to page, in the middle of a job. And the best thing is: the new foomatic-rip now works seamlessly with all legacy spoolers too (like LPRng, BSD-LPD, PDQ, PPR etc.), providing for them access to use PPDs for their printing! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956944"></a>The Complete Picture</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928168"></a>The Complete Picture</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you want to see an overview over all the filters and how they relate to each other, the complete picture of the puzzle is at the end of this document. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956960"></a><tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928183"></a><tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS auto-constructs all possible filtering chain paths for any given MIME type, and every printer installed. But how does it decide in favor or against a specific alternative? (There may often be cases, @@ -957,7 +893,7 @@ cost. This is a very efficient way to limit the load of any CUPS server by setting an appropriate "FilterLimit" value. A FilterLimit of 200 allows roughly 1 job at a time, while a FilterLimit of 1000 allows approximately 5 jobs maximum at a time. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957012"></a>"Raw" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928246"></a>"Raw" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can tell CUPS to print (nearly) any file "raw". "Raw" means it will not be filtered. CUPS will send the file to the printer "as is" without bothering if the printer is able to digest it. Users need to @@ -966,9 +902,7 @@ printing can happen on any queue if the "-o raw" option is specified on the command line. You can also set up raw-only queues by simply not associating any PPD with it. This command: </p><pre class="screen"> - - lpadmin -P rawprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -E - +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -P rawprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -E</tt></b> </pre><p> sets up a queue named "rawprinter", connected via the "socket" protocol (a.k.a. "HP JetDirect") to the device at IP address @@ -980,7 +914,7 @@ CUPS will automatically treat each job sent to a queue as a "raw" one, if it can't find a PPD associated with the queue. However, CUPS will only send known MIME types (as defined in its own mime.types file) and refuse others. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957066"></a>"application/octet-stream" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928335"></a>"application/octet-stream" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Any MIME type with no rule in the <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> file is regarded as unknown or <span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span> and will not be @@ -989,9 +923,7 @@ you will probably have experienced the fact that printjobs originating from Windows clients were not printed. You may have found an error message in your CUPS logs like: </p><pre class="screen"> - Unable to convert file 0 to printable format for job - </pre><p> To enable the printing of "application/octet-stream" files, edit these two files: @@ -1000,20 +932,16 @@ Both contain entries (at the end of the respective files) which must be uncommented to allow RAW mode operation for application/octet-stream. In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> make sure this line is present: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2928420"></a><pre class="screen"> application/octet-stream - </pre><p> This line (with no specific auto-typing rule set) makes all files not otherwise auto-typed a member of application/octet-stream. In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt>, have this line: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/octet-stream application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - -</pre><p> +</pre><a class="indexterm" name="id2928460"></a><p> This line tells CUPS to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>Null Filter</em></span> (denoted as "-", doing... nothing at all) on <span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>, and tag the result as @@ -1038,7 +966,7 @@ be one that is known to CUPS and an allowed one. The file recognizes MIME types. The file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt> decides which file conversion filter(s) may be applied to which MIME types. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957282"></a>PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928581"></a>PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2928590"></a><p> Originally PPDs were meant to be used for PostScript printers only. Here, they help to send device-specific commands and settings to the RIP which processes the jobfile. CUPS has extended this @@ -1051,10 +979,8 @@ printers the Ghostscript RIP runs on the host computer. </p><p> PPDs for a non-PS printer have a few lines that are unique to CUPS. The most important one looks similar to this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2928619"></a><pre class="screen"> *cupsFilter: application/vnd.cups-raster 66 rastertoprinter - </pre><p> It is the last piece in the CUPS filtering puzzle. This line tells the CUPS daemon to use as a last filter "rastertoprinter". This filter @@ -1070,24 +996,12 @@ CUPS by default ships only a few generic PPDs, but they are good for several hundred printer models. You may not be able to control different paper trays, or you may get larger margins than your specific model supports): -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">deskjet.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>older HP inkjet printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deskjet2.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>newer HP inkjet printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dymo.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>label printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">epson9.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">epson24.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">okidata9.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Okidata 9pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">okidat24.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Okidata 24pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stcolor.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>older Epson Stylus Color printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stcolor2.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>newer Epson Stylus Color printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stphoto.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>older Epson Stylus Photo printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stphoto2.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>newer Epson Stylus Photo printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">laserjet.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>all PCL printers. Further below is a discussion -of several other driver/PPD-packages suitable fur use with CUPS. -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957510"></a>Difference between <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> and -<span class="emphasis"><em>native CUPS</em></span> printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2928665"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 19.1. PPD's shipped with CUPS</b></p><table summary="PPD's shipped with CUPS" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">PPD file</th><th align="justify">Printer type</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">deskjet.ppd</td><td align="justify">older HP inkjet printers and compatible</td></tr><tr><td align="left">deskjet2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer HP inkjet printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">dymo.ppd</td><td align="justify">label printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">epson9.ppd</td><td align="justify">Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">epson24.ppd</td><td align="justify">Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">okidata9.ppd</td><td align="justify">Okidata 9pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">okidat24.ppd</td><td align="justify">Okidata 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stcolor.ppd</td><td align="justify">older Epson Stylus Color printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stcolor2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer Epson Stylus Color printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stphoto.ppd</td><td align="justify">older Epson Stylus Photo printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stphoto2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer Epson Stylus Photo printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">laserjet.ppd</td><td align="justify">all PCL printers. Further below is a discussion of several other driver/PPD-packages suitable for use with CUPS. </td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928848"></a>Difference between <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> and +<span class="emphasis"><em>native CUPS</em></span> printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2928866"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2928874"></a><p> Native CUPS rasterization works in two steps. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> First is the "pstoraster" step. It uses the special "cups" +<a class="indexterm" name="id2928898"></a> device from ESP Ghostscript 7.05.x as its tool </p></li><li><p> Second comes the "rasterdriver" step. It uses various @@ -1097,7 +1011,7 @@ Shareware/Non-Free, some are proprietary.</p></li></ul></div><p> Often this produces better quality (and has several more advantages) than other methods. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2957561"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.10. cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/10small.png" alt="cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small10"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.10. cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/10small.png" width="270" alt="cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS"></div></div><p> </p><p> One other method is the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> way. Note that cupsomatic is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> made by the CUPS @@ -1111,6 +1025,8 @@ other (non-CUPS) spoolers. An upgrade to foomatic-rip is strongly advised, especially if you are upgrading to a recent version of CUPS too. </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2929012"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2929021"></a> Both the cupsomatic (old) and the foomatic-rip (new) methods from Linuxprinting.org use the traditional Ghostscript print file processing, doing everything in a single step. It therefore relies on @@ -1132,7 +1048,7 @@ installation: Therefore the printfile bypasses the "pstoraster" filter cupsomatic hands the rendered file directly to the CUPS backend. The flowchart above illustrates the difference between native CUPS rendering and the Foomatic/cupsomatic method. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957666"></a>Examples for filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929083"></a>Examples for filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here are a few examples of commonly occurring filtering chains to illustrate the workings of CUPS. </p><p> @@ -1152,10 +1068,8 @@ PPD) into the new PostScript file; the file now is of PostScript MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span>;</p></li><li><p>the file goes to the <span class="emphasis"><em>socket</em></span> backend, which transfers the job to the printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> -The resulting filter chain therefore is: -</p><pre class="screen"> -pdftops --> pstops --> socket -</pre><p> + The resulting filter chain therefore is as drawn in <a href="CUPS-printing.html#pdftosocket" title="Figure 19.11. PDF to socket chain">the image below</a>. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="pdftosocket"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.11. PDF to socket chain</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/pdftosocket.png" width="270" alt="PDF to socket chain"></div></div><p> Assume your want to print the same filter to an USB-connected Epson Stylus Photo printer, installed with the CUPS <tt class="filename">stphoto2.ppd</tt>. The first few filtering stages @@ -1179,45 +1093,43 @@ does its work (as is indicated in the printer's PPD), creating the printer-specific raster data and embedding any user-selected print-options into the print data stream;</p></li><li><p>the file goes to the <span class="emphasis"><em>usb</em></span> backend, which transfers the job to the printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> -The resulting filter chain therefore is: -</p><pre class="screen"> -pdftops --> pstops --> pstoraster --> rastertoepson --> usb -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957897"></a>Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The resulting filter chain therefore is as drawn in <a href="CUPS-printing.html#pdftoepsonusb" title="Figure 19.12. PDF to USB chain">the image below</a>. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="pdftoepsonusb"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.12. PDF to USB chain</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/pdftoepsonusb.png" width="270" alt="PDF to USB chain"></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929420"></a>Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> On the internet you can find now many thousand CUPS-PPD files (with their companion filters), in many national languages, supporting more than 1000 non-PostScript models. -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/" target="_top">ESP -PrintPro (http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/)</a> (commercial, +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2929436"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2929448"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/" target="_top">ESP +PrintPro</a> (commercial, non-Free) is packaged with more than 3000 PPDs, ready for successful use "out of the box" on Linux, Mac OS X, IBM-AIX, -HP-UX, Sun-Solaris, SGI-IRIX, Compaq Tru64, Digital Unix and some +HP-UX, Sun-Solaris, SGI-IRIX, Compaq Tru64, Digital UNIX and some more commercial Unices (it is written by the CUPS developers themselves and its sales help finance the further development of CUPS, as they feed their creators).</p></li><li><p>the <a href="http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">Gimp-Print-Project -(http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/)</a> (GPL, Free Software) +</a> (GPL, Free Software) provides around 140 PPDs (supporting nearly 400 printers, many driven to photo quality output), to be used alongside the Gimp-Print CUPS filters;</p></li><li><p><a href="http://www.turboprint.com/" target="_top">TurboPrint -(http://www.turboprint.com/)</a> (Shareware, non-Free) supports +</a> (Shareware, non-Free) supports roughly the same amount of printers in excellent quality;</p></li><li><p><a href="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/" target="_top">OMNI -(http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/)</a> +</a> (LPGL, Free) is a package made by IBM, now containing support for more than 400 printers, stemming from the inheritance of IBM OS/2 Know-How ported over to Linux (CUPS support is in a Beta-stage at present);</p></li><li><p><a href="http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">HPIJS -(http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/)</a> (BSD-style licenses, Free) +</a> (BSD-style licenses, Free) supports around 150 of HP's own printers and is also providing excellent print quality now (currently available only via the Foomatic path);</p></li><li><p><a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/" target="_top">Foomatic/cupsomatic -(http://www.linuxprinting.org/)</a> (LPGL, Free) from +</a> (LPGL, Free) from Linuxprinting.org are providing PPDs for practically every Ghostscript filter known to the world (including Omni, Gimp-Print and HPIJS).</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The cupsomatic/Foomatic trick from Linuxprinting.org works differently from the other drivers. This is explained elsewhere in this document. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958024"></a>Printing with Interface Scripts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929572"></a>Printing with Interface Scripts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS also supports the usage of "interface scripts" as known from System V AT&T printing systems. These are often used for PCL printers, from applications that generate PCL print jobs. Interface @@ -1230,61 +1142,60 @@ realm. On HP-UX platforms they are more often used. You can use any working interface script on CUPS too. Just install the printer with the <b class="command">-i</b> option: </p><pre class="screen"> - - lpadmin -p pclprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -i /path/to/interface-script - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p pclprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 \ + -i /path/to/interface-script</tt></b> </pre><p> Interface scripts might be the "unknown animal" to many. However, with CUPS they provide the most easy way to plug in your own custom-written filtering script or program into one specific print queue (some information about the traditional usage of interface scripts is to be found at <a href="http://playground.sun.com/printing/documentation/interface.html" target="_top">http://playground.sun.com/printing/documentation/interface.html</a>). -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958100"></a>Network printing (purely Windows)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929667"></a>Network printing (purely Windows)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Network printing covers a lot of ground. To understand what exactly goes on with Samba when it is printing on behalf of its Windows clients, let's first look at a "purely Windows" setup: Windows clients with a Windows NT print server. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958116"></a>From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929677"></a>From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Windows clients printing to an NT-based print server have two options. They may -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>execute the driver locally and render the GDI output +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2929699"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2929707"></a><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>execute the driver locally and render the GDI output (EMF) into the printer specific format on their own, or</p></li><li><p>send the GDI output (EMF) to the server, where the driver is executed to render the printer specific output.</p></li></ul></div><p> Both print paths are shown in the flowcharts below. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958155"></a>Driver Execution on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929741"></a>Driver Execution on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the first case the print server must spool the file as "raw", meaning it shouldn't touch the jobfile and try to convert it in any -way. This is what traditional Unix-based print server can do too; and +way. This is what traditional UNIX-based print server can do too; and at a better performance and more reliably than NT print server. This is what most Samba administrators probably are familiar with. One advantage of this setup is that this "spooling-only" print server may -be used even if no driver(s) for Unix are available it is sufficient +be used even if no driver(s) for UNIX are available it is sufficient to have the Windows client drivers available and installed on the clients. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2958191"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.11. Print Driver execution on the Client</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/11small.png" alt="Print Driver execution on the Client"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958227"></a>Driver Execution on the Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small11"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.13. Print Driver execution on the Client</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/11small.png" width="270" alt="Print Driver execution on the Client"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929818"></a>Driver Execution on the Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2929822"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2929831"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2929839"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2929847"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2929855"></a><p> The other path executes the printer driver on the server. The clients transfers print files in EMF format to the server. The server uses the PostScript, PCL, ESC/P or other driver to convert the EMF file into -the printer-specific language. It is not possible for Unix to do the +the printer-specific language. It is not possible for UNIX to do the same. Currently there is no program or method to convert a Windows -client's GDI output on a Unix server into something a printer could +client's GDI output on a UNIX server into something a printer could understand. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2958249"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.12. Print Driver execution on the Server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/12small.png" alt="Print Driver execution on the Server"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small12"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.14. Print Driver execution on the Server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/12small.png" width="270" alt="Print Driver execution on the Server"></div></div><p> </p><p> However, there is something similar possible with CUPS. Read on... -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958289"></a>Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929936"></a>Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print Servers)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since UNIX print servers <span class="emphasis"><em>cannot</em></span> execute the Win32 program code on their platform, the picture is somewhat different. However, this doesn't limit your options all that much. In the contrary, you may have a way here to implement printing features which are not possible otherwise. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958310"></a>From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929956"></a>From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here is a simple recipe showing how you can take advantage of CUPS powerful features for the benefit of your Windows network printing clients: @@ -1296,12 +1207,11 @@ printer is a non-PostScript model. It also requires that you have a "driver" on the CUPS server. </p><p> Firstly, to enable CUPS based printing through Samba the -following options should be set in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file [globals] +following options should be set in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file [global] section: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = CUPS</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = CUPS</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2930017"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups</p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2930035"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups</p></li></ul></div><p> When these parameters are specified, all manually set print directives -(like <i class="parameter"><tt>print command =...</tt></i>, or <i class="parameter"><tt>lppause -command =...</tt></i>) in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> (as well as +(like <a class="indexterm" name="id2930055"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, or <a class="indexterm" name="id2930069"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>) in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> (as well as in samba itself) will be ignored. Instead, Samba will directly interface with CUPS through it's application program interface (API) - as long as Samba has been compiled with CUPS library (libcups) @@ -1310,12 +1220,12 @@ other print commands are set up, then printing will use the <span class="emphasis"><em>System V</em></span> AT&T command set, with the -oraw option automatically passing through (if you want your own defined print commands to work with a Samba that has CUPS support compiled in, -simply use <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i>). +simply use <a class="indexterm" name="id2930107"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv). </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2958439"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.13. Printing via CUPS/samba server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/13small.png" alt="Printing via CUPS/samba server"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958474"></a>Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="figure"><a name="small13"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.15. Printing via CUPS/samba server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/13small.png" width="270" alt="Printing via CUPS/samba server"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930169"></a>Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> use its own spool directory (it is set -by a line similar to <i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i>, +by a line similar to <a class="indexterm" name="id2930184"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba, in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>[printername]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). Samba receives the job in its own @@ -1331,8 +1241,8 @@ A Windows user authenticates only to Samba (by whatever means is configured). If Samba runs on the same host as CUPS, you only need to allow "localhost" to print. If they run on different machines, you need to make sure the Samba host gets access to printing on CUPS. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958550"></a>Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930255"></a>Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2930265"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2930273"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2930282"></a><p> PPDs can control all print device options. They are usually provided by the manufacturer; if you own a PostScript printer, that is. PPD files (PostScript Printer Descriptions) are always a component of @@ -1351,7 +1261,7 @@ or see if you have lphelp on your system). There are also some different GUI frontends on Linux/UNIX, which can present PPD options to users. PPD options are normally meant to be evaluated by the PostScript RIP on the real PostScript printer. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958605"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930344"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2930352"></a><p> CUPS doesn't limit itself to "real" PostScript printers in its usage of PPDs. The CUPS developers have extended the scope of the PPD concept, to also describe available device and driver options for @@ -1368,7 +1278,7 @@ the supplied PostScript. Thus CUPS lets all its printers appear as PostScript devices to its clients, because it can act as a PostScript RIP for those printers, processing the received PostScript code into a proper raster print format. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958646"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930400"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2930408"></a><p> CUPS-PPDs can also be used on Windows-Clients, on top of a "core" PostScript driver (now recommended is the "CUPS PostScript Driver for WindowsNT/2K/XP"; you can also use the Adobe one, with @@ -1384,13 +1294,13 @@ which always remain unfiltered per definition;</p></li><li><p>enable clients to driver, even for many different target printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> Using CUPS PPDs on Windows clients enables these to control all print job settings just as a UNIX client can do too. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958712"></a>Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930476"></a>Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This setup may be of special interest to people experiencing major problems in WTS environments. WTS need often a multitude of non-PostScript drivers installed to run their clients' variety of different printer models. This often imposes the price of much increased instability. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958729"></a>Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930493"></a>Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many Problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The reason is that in Win NT printer drivers run in "Kernel Mode", this introduces a high risk for the stability of the system @@ -1404,10 +1314,10 @@ of Death" on a regular basis? PostScript drivers generally are very well tested. They are not known to cause any problems, even though they run in Kernel Mode too. This might be because there have so far only been 2 different PostScript -drivers the ones from Adobe and the one from Microsoft. Both are +drivers: the ones from Adobe and the one from Microsoft. Both are very well tested and are as stable as you ever can imagine on Windows. The CUPS driver is derived from the Microsoft one. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958763"></a>Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930538"></a>Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In many cases, in an attempt to work around this problem, site administrators have resorted to restrict the allowed drivers installed on their WTS to one generic PCL- and one PostScript driver. This @@ -1415,7 +1325,7 @@ however restricts the clients in the amount of printer options available for them; often they can't get out more than simplex prints from one standard paper tray, while their devices could do much better, if driven by a different driver! ) -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958784"></a>CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930560"></a>CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2930569"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2930577"></a><p> Using a PostScript driver, enabled with a CUPS-PPD, seems to be a very elegant way to overcome all these shortcomings. There are, depending on the version of Windows OS you use, up to 3 different PostScript @@ -1427,8 +1337,8 @@ is a certain price for this too: a CUPS server acting as a PostScript RIP for its clients requires more CPU and RAM than when just acting as a "raw spooling" device. Plus, this setup is not yet widely tested, although the first feedbacks look very promising. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958811"></a>PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930614"></a>PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2930623"></a><p> More recent printer drivers on W2K and XP don't run in Kernel mode (unlike Win NT) any more. However, both operating systems can still use the NT drivers, running in Kernel mode (you can roughly tell which @@ -1444,14 +1354,14 @@ development efforts. This is what the CUPS people have done. The license doesn't allow them to publish the whole of the source code. However, they have released the "diff" under the GPL, and if you are owner of an "MS DDK for Win NT", you can check the driver yourself. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958865"></a> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930637"></a>Setting up CUPS for driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> As we have said before: all previously known methods to prepare client printer drivers on the Samba server for download and "Point'n'Print" convenience of Windows workstations are working with CUPS too. These methods were described in the previous chapter. In reality, this is a pure Samba business, and only relates to the Samba/Win client relationship. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958884"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>: the unknown Utility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930710"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>: the unknown Utility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2930721"></a><p> The cupsaddsmb utility (shipped with all current CUPS versions) is an alternative method to transfer printer drivers into the Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Remember, this share is where @@ -1476,53 +1386,26 @@ job-billing)</p></li></ul></div><p> However, currently only Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by the CUPS drivers. You will need to get the respective part of Adobe driver too if you need to support Windows 95, 98, and ME clients. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2958976"></a>Prepare your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for -cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930811"></a>Prepare your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Prior to running cupsaddsmb, you need the following settings in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [global] - load printers = yes - printing = cups - printcap name = cups - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - browseable = no - public = yes - guest ok = yes # setting depends on your requirements - writable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = root - - [print$] - comment = Printer Drivers - path = /etc/samba/drivers - browseable = yes - guest ok = no - read only = yes - write list = root - -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959022"></a>CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -CUPS users may get the exactly same packages from<a href="http://www.cups.org/software.html" target="_top"><span class="emphasis"><em>http://www.cups.org/software.html</em></span></a>. +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2930838"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.3. smb.conf for cupsaddsmb usage</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># setting depends on your requirements</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = root</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931030"></a>CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2931040"></a><p> +CUPS users may get the exactly same packages from <a href="http://www.cups.org/software.html" target="_top">http://www.cups.org/software.html</a>. It is a separate package from the CUPS base software files, tagged as -<span class="emphasis"><em>CUPS 1.1.x Windows NT/2k/XP Printer Driver for SAMBA +<span class="emphasis"><em>CUPS 1.1.x Windows NT/2k/XP Printer Driver for Samba (tar.gz, 192k)</em></span>. The filename to download is <tt class="filename">cups-samba-1.1.x.tar.gz</tt>. Upon untar-/unzip-ing, it will reveal these files: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# tar xvzf cups-samba-1.1.19.tar.gz - - cups-samba.install - cups-samba.license - cups-samba.readme - cups-samba.remove - cups-samba.ss - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tar xvzf cups-samba-1.1.19.tar.gz</tt></b> +cups-samba.install +cups-samba.license +cups-samba.readme +cups-samba.remove +cups-samba.ss </pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931102"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931113"></a> These have been packaged with the ESP meta packager software "EPM". The <tt class="filename">*.install</tt> and <tt class="filename">*.remove</tt> files are simple shell scripts, which @@ -1532,26 +1415,20 @@ too). Then it puts the content into <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>. This content includes 3 files: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# tar tv cups-samba.ss - - cupsdrvr.dll - cupsui.dll - cups.hlp - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tar tv cups-samba.ss</tt></b> +cupsdrvr.dll +cupsui.dll +cups.hlp </pre><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>cups-samba.install</em></span> shell scripts is easy to handle: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# ./cups-samba.install - - [....] - Installing software... - Updating file permissions... - Running post-install commands... - Installation is complete. - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./cups-samba.install</tt></b> +[....] +Installing software... +Updating file permissions... +Running post-install commands... +Installation is complete. </pre><p> The script should automatically put the driver files into the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt> directory. @@ -1564,10 +1441,8 @@ copy/move the file (after running the <b class="command">./cups-samba.install</b> script) manually to the right place. </p></div><pre class="screen"> - - cp /usr/share/drivers/cups.hlp /usr/share/cups/drivers/ - -</pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp /usr/share/drivers/cups.hlp /usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt></b> +</pre><a class="indexterm" name="id2931290"></a><p> This new CUPS PostScript driver is currently binary-only, but free of charge. No complete source code is provided (yet). The reason is this: it has been developed with the help of the <span class="emphasis"><em>Microsoft Driver @@ -1576,42 +1451,27 @@ Studio 6. Driver developers are not allowed to distribute the whole of the source code as Free Software. However, CUPS developers released the "diff" in source code under the GPL, so anybody with a license of Visual Studio and a DDK will be able to compile for him/herself. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959220"></a>Recognize the different Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931268"></a>Recognize the different Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The CUPS drivers don't support the "older" Windows 95/98/ME, but only the Windows NT/2000/XP client: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:] - cups.hlp - cupsdrvr.dll - cupsui.dll - -</pre><p> +</p><p>Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>cups.hlp</p></li><li><p>cupsdrvr.dll</p></li><li><p>cupsui.dll</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p> Adobe drivers are available for the older Windows 95/98/ME as well as the Windows NT/2000/XP clients. The set of files is different for the different platforms. -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [Windows 95, 98, and Me are supported by:] - ADFONTS.MFM - ADOBEPS4.DRV - ADOBEPS4.HLP - DEFPRTR2.PPD - ICONLIB.DLL - PSMON.DLL - - [Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:] - ADOBEPS5.DLL - ADOBEPSU.DLL - ADOBEPSU.HLP +</p><p>Windows 95, 98, and Me are supported by:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ADFONTS.MFM</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPS4.DRV</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPS4.HLP</p></li><li><p>DEFPRTR2.PPD</p></li><li><p>ICONLIB.DLL</p></li><li><p>PSMON.DLL</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p>Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:</p><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ADOBEPS5.DLL</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPSU.DLL</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPSU.HLP</p></li></ul></div><p> -</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> If both, the Adobe driver files and the CUPS driver files for the support of WinNT/2k/XP are present in , the Adobe ones will be ignored and the CUPS ones will be used. If you prefer -- for whatever reason -- to use Adobe-only drivers, move away the 3 CUPS driver files. The Win95/98/ME clients use the Adobe drivers in any case. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959278"></a>Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931460"></a>Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Acquiring the Adobe driver files seems to be unexpectedly difficult for many users. They are not available on the Adobe website as single files and the self-extracting and/or self-installing Windows-exe is @@ -1624,12 +1484,12 @@ Generic PostScript printer. After this, the client's where you can get them with smbclient from the CUPS host. A more detailed description about this is in the next (the CUPS printing) chapter. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959310"></a>ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931493"></a>ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2931506"></a><p> Users of the ESP Print Pro software are able to install their "Samba Drivers" package for this purpose with no problem. Retrieve the driver files from the normal download area of the ESP Print Pro software -at<a href="http://www.easysw.com/software.html" target="_top">http://www.easysw.com/software.html</a>. +at <a href="http://www.easysw.com/software.html" target="_top">http://www.easysw.com/software.html</a>. You need to locate the link labelled "SAMBA" amongst the <span class="emphasis"><em>Download Printer Drivers for ESP Print Pro 4.x</em></span> area and download the package. Once installed, you can prepare any @@ -1640,7 +1500,7 @@ driver files; i.e. mainly setup the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share, etc. The ESP Print Pro package includes the CUPS driver files as well as a (licensed) set of Adobe drivers for the Windows 95/98/ME client family. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959360"></a>Caveats to be considered</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931562"></a>Caveats to be considered</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2931572"></a><p> Once you have run the install script (and possibly manually moved the <tt class="filename">cups.hlp</tt> file to <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>), the driver is @@ -1651,6 +1511,7 @@ tree with <span class="emphasis"><em>WIN40</em></span> and "cupsaddsmb" (see also <b class="command">man cupsaddsmb</b> for CUPS since release 1.1.16). </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931636"></a> You may need to put root into the smbpasswd file by running <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>; this is especially important if you should run this whole procedure for the first time, and are not @@ -1672,6 +1533,7 @@ installations in the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt> directory. The new <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> (from 1.1.16) will automatically prefer "its own" drivers if it finds both. </p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931734"></a> Should your Win clients have had the old <tt class="filename">ADOBE*.*</tt> files for the Adobe PostScript driver installed, the download and installation of the new CUPS PostScript driver for Windows NT/2k/XP @@ -1679,8 +1541,7 @@ will fail at first. You need to wipe the old driver from the clients first. It is not enough to "delete" the printer, as the driver files will still be kept by the clients and re-used if you try to re-install the printer. To really get rid of the Adobe driver files on the -clients, open the "Printers" folder (possibly via <span class="emphasis"><em>Start ---> Settings --> Control Panel --> Printers</em></span>), +clients, open the "Printers" folder (possibly via <span class="emphasis"><em>Start, Settings, Control Panel, Printers</em></span>), right-click onto the folder background and select <span class="emphasis"><em>Server Properties</em></span>. When the new dialog opens, select the <span class="emphasis"><em>Drivers</em></span> tab. On the list select the driver you @@ -1690,20 +1551,23 @@ which uses that particular driver. You need to "delete" all printers using this driver in the "Printers" folder first. You will need Administrator privileges to do this. </p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931795"></a> Once you have successfully downloaded the CUPS PostScript driver to a client, you can easily switch all printers to this one by proceeding -as described elsewhere in the "Samba HOWTO Collection": either change +as described in <a href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support">the printing chapter</a>: either change a driver for an existing printer by running the "Printer Properties" dialog, or use <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with the <b class="command">setdriver</b> sub-command. </p></li></ol></div><p> -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959582"></a>What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931837"></a>Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You are interested in a comparison between the CUPS and the Adobe PostScript drivers? For our purposes these are the most important items which weigh in favor of the CUPS ones: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>no hassle with the Adobe EULA</p></li><li><p>no hassle with the question “<span class="quote">Where do I -get the ADOBE*.* driver files from?</span>”</p></li><li><p>the Adobe drivers (on request of the printer PPD +get the ADOBE*.* driver files from?</span>”</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931878"></a> + the Adobe drivers (on request of the printer PPD associated with them) often put a PJL header in front of the main PostScript part of the print file. Thus the printfile starts with <i class="parameter"><tt><1B >%-12345X</tt></i> or @@ -1712,8 +1576,10 @@ of <i class="parameter"><tt>%!PS</tt></i>). This leads to the CUPS daemon auto-typing the incoming file as a print-ready file, not initiating a pass through the "pstops" filter (to speak more technically, it is not regarded as the generic MIME type +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931916"></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span>, but as the more special MIME type +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931930"></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>application/cups.vnd-postscript</em></span>), which therefore also leads to the page accounting in <span class="emphasis"><em>/var/log/cups/page_log</em></span> not @@ -1743,7 +1609,7 @@ not disturb any other applications as they will regard it as a comment and simply ignore it).</p></li><li><p>the CUPS PostScript driver will be the heart of the fully fledged CUPS IPP client for Windows NT/2K/XP to be released soon (probably alongside the first Beta release for CUPS -1.2).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959764"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +1.2).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932052"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932062"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2932070"></a><p> The cupsaddsmb command copies the needed files into your <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Additionally, the PPD associated with this printer is copied from @@ -1752,124 +1618,111 @@ associated with this printer is copied from Windows client installations via Point'n'Print. Before we can run the command successfully, we need to be sure that we can authenticate towards Samba. If you have a small network you are probably using user -level security (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>). Probably your -root has already a Samba account. Otherwise, create it now, using -<b class="command">smbpasswd</b>: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - # smbpasswd -a root - New SMB password: [type in password 'secret'] - Retype new SMB password: [type in password 'secret'] - -</pre><p> +level security (<a class="indexterm" name="id2932107"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user). +</p><p> Here is an example of a successfully run cupsaddsmb command. </p><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -U root infotec_IS2027 - Password for root required to access localhost via SAMBA: [type in password 'secret'] - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U root infotec_IS2027</tt></b> +Password for root required to access localhost via Samba: <b class="userinput"><tt>['secret']</tt></b> </pre><p> To share <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> printers and drivers, use the -<i class="parameter"><tt>-a</tt></i> parameter instead of a printer name. Since +<tt class="option">-a</tt> parameter instead of a printer name. Since cupsaddsmb "exports" the printer drivers to Samba, it should be obvious that it only works for queues with a CUPS driver associated. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959865"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932180"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932188"></a><p> Probably you want to see what's going on. Use the -<i class="parameter"><tt>-v</tt></i> parameter to get a more verbose output. The +<tt class="option">-v</tt> parameter to get a more verbose output. The output below was edited for better readability: all "\" at the end of a line indicate that I inserted an artificial line break plus some indentation here: </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> You will see the root password for the Samba account printed on -screen. If you use remote access, the password will go over the wire -unencrypted! -</p></div><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -U root -v infotec_2105 - Password for root required to access localhost via SAMBA: - Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' -c 'mkdir W32X86;put \ - /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll W32X86/cupsui.dll;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp W32X86/cups.hlp' - added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] - NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \W32X86 - putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd (2328.8 kb/s) \ - (average 2328.8 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll as \W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll (9374.3 kb/s) \ - (average 5206.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll as \W32X86/cupsui.dll (8107.2 kb/s) \ - (average 5984.1 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp as \W32X86/cups.hlp (3475.0 kb/s) \ - (average 5884.7 kb/s) +screen. +</p></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932223"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2932234"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U root -v infotec_2105</tt></b> +Password for root required to access localhost via GANDALF: +Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'mkdir W32X86; \ + put /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll W32X86/cupsui.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp W32X86/cups.hlp' +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \W32X86 +putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll as \W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll as \W32X86/cupsui.dll +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp as \W32X86/cups.hlp - Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ - "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL: \ - RAW:NULL"' - cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll: \ - cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" - Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. +Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL: \ + RAW:NULL"' +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" +Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. - Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' -c 'mkdir WIN40;put \ - /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD; put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL - WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL;put /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL WIN40/PSMON.DLL;' +Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' \ +-c 'mkdir WIN40; \ + put /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL WIN40/PSMON.DLL;' added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \WIN40 - putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD (2328.8 kb/s) \ - (average 2328.8 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM as \WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM (9368.0 kb/s) \ - (average 6469.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV (9958.2 kb/s) \ - (average 8404.3 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP (8341.5 kb/s) \ - (average 8398.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD as \WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD (2195.9 kb/s) \ - (average 8254.3 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL as \WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL (8239.9 kb/s) \ - (average 8253.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL as \WIN40/PSMON.DLL (6222.2 kb/s) \ - (average 8188.5 kb/s) + putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM as \WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD as \WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL as \WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL as \WIN40/PSMON.DLL - Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' -c 'adddriver "Windows 4.0" \ - "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP: \ - PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP,PSMON.DLL, \ - ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL"' + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'adddriver "Windows 4.0" \ + "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP: \ + PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP,PSMON.DLL, \ + ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL"' cmd = adddriver "Windows 4.0" "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL: \ - ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP, \ + ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP, \ PSMON.DLL,ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL" Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. - Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ - -c 'setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105' + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105' cmd = setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105 Successfully set infotec_2105 to driver infotec_2105. </pre><p> -If you look closely, you'll discover your root password was transfered +If you look closely, you'll discover your root password was transferred unencrypted over the wire, so beware! Also, if you look further her, you'll discover error messages like NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION in between. They occur, because the directories WIN40 and W32X86 already existed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> driver download share (from a previous driver installation). They are harmless here. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960092"></a>Understanding cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932401"></a>Understanding cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932410"></a><p> What has happened? What did cupsaddsmb do? There are five stages of the procedure -</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>call the CUPS server via IPP and request the +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2932438"></a> + call the CUPS server via IPP and request the driver files and the PPD file for the named printer;</p></li><li><p>store the files temporarily in the local TEMPDIR (as defined in <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt>);</p></li><li><p>connect via smbclient to the Samba server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and put the files into the share's WIN40 (for Win95/98/ME) and W32X86/ (for WinNT/2k/XP) sub - directories;</p></li><li><p>connect via rpcclient to the Samba server and + directories;</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932482"></a> + connect via rpcclient to the Samba server and execute the "adddriver" command with the correct -parameters;</p></li><li><p>connect via rpcclient to the Samba server a second +parameters;</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932501"></a> + connect via rpcclient to the Samba server a second time and execute the "setdriver" command.</p></li></ol></div><p> Note, that you can run the cupsaddsmb utility with parameters to specify one remote host as Samba host and a second remote host as CUPS @@ -1878,10 +1731,8 @@ good idea try it and see more clearly what is going on (though in real life most people will have their CUPS and Samba servers run on the same host): </p><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -H sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername - -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960186"></a>How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932551"></a>How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> always check if the utility completed successfully in all fields. You need as a minimum these 3 messages amongst the output: @@ -1892,7 +1743,7 @@ installed.</em></span> # (for the WIN40 == Win9x/ME architecture...)</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Successfully set [printerXPZ] to driver [printerXYZ].</em></span></p></li></ol></div><p> These messages probably not easily recognized in the general -output. If you run cupsaddsmb with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-a</tt></i> +output. If you run cupsaddsmb with the <tt class="option">-a</tt> parameter (which tries to prepare <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> active CUPS printer drivers for download), you might miss if individual printers drivers had problems to install properly. Here a redirection of the @@ -1902,32 +1753,30 @@ It is impossible to see any diagnostic output if you don't run cupsaddsmb in verbose mode. Therefore we strongly recommend to not use the default quiet mode. It will hide any problems from you which might occur. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960273"></a>cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932633"></a>cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932642"></a><p> You can't get the standard cupsaddsmb command to run on a Samba PDC? You are asked for the password credential all over again and again and the command just will not take off at all? Try one of these variations: </p><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -U DOMAINNAME\\root -v printername - # cupsaddsmb -H SAMBA-PDC -U DOMAINNAME\\root -v printername - # cupsaddsmb -H SAMBA-PDC -U DOMAINNAME\\root -h cups-server -v printername - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U MIDEARTH\\root -v printername</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H SAURON -U MIDEARTH\\root -v printername</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H SAURON -U MIDEARTH\\root -h cups-server -v printername</tt></b> </pre><p> (Note the two backslashes: the first one is required to "escape" the second one). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960308"></a>cupsaddsmb Flowchart</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932714"></a>cupsaddsmb Flowchart</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932722"></a><p> Here is a chart about the procedures, commandflows and dataflows of the "cupaddsmb" command. Note again: cupsaddsmb is not intended to, and does not work with, "raw" queues! </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2960326"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.14. cupsaddsmb flowchart</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" alt="cupsaddsmb flowchart"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960361"></a>Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small14"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.16. cupsaddsmb flowchart</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/14small.png" width="270" alt="cupsaddsmb flowchart"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932789"></a>Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932796"></a><p> After cupsaddsmb completed, your driver is prepared for the clients to use. Here are the steps you must perform to download and install it via "Point'n'Print". From a Windows client, browse to the CUPS/Samba server; -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>open the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printers</em></span> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2932816"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p>open the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printers</em></span> share of Samba in Network Neighbourhood;</p></li><li><p>right-click on the printer in question;</p></li><li><p>from the opening context-menu select <span class="emphasis"><em>Install...</em></span> or @@ -1942,6 +1791,7 @@ an application like Winword, the new printer will appears in a <tt class="filename">\\SambaServer\PrinterName</tt> entry in the dropdown list of available printers. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932893"></a> cupsaddsmb will only reliably work with CUPS version 1.1.15 or higher and Samba from 2.2.4. If it doesn't work, or if the automatic printer driver download to the clients doesn't succeed, you can still manually @@ -1949,16 +1799,14 @@ install the CUPS printer PPD on top of the Adobe PostScript driver on clients. Then point the client's printer queue to the Samba printer share for a UNC type of connection: </p></div><pre class="screen"> - - net use lpt1: \\sambaserver\printershare /user:ntadmin - +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: \\sambaserver\printershare /user:ntadmin</tt></b> </pre><p> should you desire to use the CUPS networked PostScript RIP functions. (Note that user "ntadmin" needs to be a valid Samba user with the required privileges to access the printershare) This would set up the printer connection in the traditional <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> way (not using MS-RPC). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960474"></a>Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932953"></a>Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Soooo: printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print well, some don't print at all. Some jobs have problems with fonts, @@ -1984,7 +1832,7 @@ get a printout at all) (Adobe)</p></li><li><p>Sometimes you can choose <span cla Level</em></span>: in case of problems try <span class="emphasis"><em>2</em></span> instead of <span class="emphasis"><em>3</em></span> (the latest ESP Ghostscript package handles Level 3 PostScript very well) (Adobe).</p></li><li><p>Say <span class="emphasis"><em>Yes</em></span> to <span class="emphasis"><em>PostScript -Error Handler</em></span> (Adobe)</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960608"></a>Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +Error Handler</em></span> (Adobe)</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933086"></a>Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using rpcclient)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Of course you can run all the commands which are embedded into the cupsaddsmb convenience utility yourself, one by one, and hereby upload @@ -1992,9 +1840,18 @@ and prepare the driver files for future client downloads. </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>prepare Samba (a CUPS printqueue with the name of the printer should be there. We are providing the driver now);</p></li><li><p>copy all files to -<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]:</tt></i></p></li><li><p>run <b class="command">rpcclient adddriver</b> -(for each client architecture you want to support):</p></li><li><p>run <b class="command">rpcclient + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933136"></a> + run <b class="command">rpcclient adddriver</b> +(for each client architecture you want to support):</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933160"></a> + run <b class="command">rpcclient setdriver.</b></p></li></ol></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933182"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933193"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933204"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933215"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933226"></a> We are going to do this now. First, read the man page on "rpcclient" to get a first idea. Look at all the printing related sub-commands. <b class="command">enumprinters</b>, @@ -2005,7 +1862,7 @@ the MS-RPC protocol. You can use it to query (and command) a Win NT (or 2K/XP) PC too. MS-RPC is used by Windows clients, amongst other things, to benefit from the "Point'n'Print" features. Samba can now mimic this too. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960723"></a>A Check of the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933288"></a>A Check of the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> First let's have a little check of the rpcclient man page. Here are two relevant passages: </p><p> @@ -2038,18 +1895,16 @@ printer driver associated with an installed printer. The printer driver must already be correctly installed on the print server. </p><p> See also the enumprinters and enumdrivers commands for obtaining a list of installed printers and drivers. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960836"></a>Understanding the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933403"></a>Understanding the rpcclient man page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>exact</em></span> format isn't made too clear by the man page, since you have to deal with some parameters containing spaces. Here is a better description for it. We have line-broken the command and indicated the breaks with "\". Usually you would type the command in one line without the linebreaks: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2933427"></a><pre class="screen"> adddriver "Architecture" \ "LongPrinterName:DriverFile:DataFile:ConfigFile:HelpFile:\ LanguageMonitorFile:DataType:ListOfFiles,Comma-separated" - </pre><p> What the man pages denotes as a simple <config> keyword, does in reality consist of 8 colon-separated fields. The @@ -2074,22 +1929,22 @@ box now, and access it from a UNIX workstation. We will query it with <b class="command">rpcclient</b> to see what it tells us and try to understand the man page more clearly which we've read just now. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960925"></a>Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933506"></a>Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933518"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933528"></a> We could run <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with a <b class="command">getdriver</b> or a <b class="command">getprinter</b> subcommand (in level 3 verbosity) against it. Just sit down at UNIX or Linux workstation with the Samba utilities installed. Then type the following command: </p><pre class="screen"> - - rpcclient -U'USERNAME%PASSWORD' NT-SERVER-NAME -c 'getdriver printername 3' - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'USERNAME%PASSWORD' NT-SERVER-NAME -c 'getdriver printername 3'</tt></b> </pre><p> From the result it should become clear which is which. Here is an example from my installation: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' W2KSERVER -c'getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3' +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2933591"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' W2KSERVER \ + -c'getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3'</tt></b> cmd = getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3 [Windows NT x86] @@ -2119,15 +1974,16 @@ Some printer drivers list additional files under the label <span class="emphasis"><em>ListOfFiles,Comma-separated</em></span>. For the CUPS PostScript drivers we don't need any (nor would we for the Adobe PostScript driver): therefore the field will get a "NULL" entry. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961015"></a>What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933674"></a>What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> From the manpage (and from the quoted output of <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>, above) it becomes clear that you need to have certain conditions in order to make the manual uploading and initializing of the driver files succeed. The two rpcclient +<a class="indexterm" name="id2933693"></a> subcommands (<b class="command">adddriver</b> and <b class="command">setdriver</b>) need to encounter the following pre-conditions to complete successfully: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>you are connected as "printer admin", or root (note, +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>you are connected as <a class="indexterm" name="id2933728"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (note, that this is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> the "Printer Operators" group in NT, but the <span class="emphasis"><em>printer admin</em></span> group, as defined in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of @@ -2142,7 +1998,10 @@ to escape the "$": <b class="command">smbclient //sambaserver/print\$ root</b>);</p></li><li><p>the user you're connecting as must be able to write to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and create subdirectories;</p></li><li><p>the printer you are going to setup for the Windows -clients, needs to be installed in CUPS already;</p></li><li><p>the CUPS printer must be known to Samba, otherwise the +clients, needs to be installed in CUPS already;</p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933842"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2933853"></a> + the CUPS printer must be known to Samba, otherwise the <b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand fails with an NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL error. To check if the printer is known by Samba you may use the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> subcommand to @@ -2150,30 +2009,25 @@ rpcclient. A long-standing bug prevented a proper update of the printer list until every smbd process had received a SIGHUP or was restarted. Remember this in case you've created the CUPS printer just shortly ago and encounter problems: try restarting -Samba.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961177"></a>Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933889"></a>Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> We are going to install a printer driver now by manually executing all required commands. As this may seem a rather complicated process at first, we go through the procedure step by step, explaining every single action item as it comes up. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961194"></a>First Step: Install the Printer on CUPS</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# lpadmin -p mysmbtstprn -v socket://10.160.51.131:9100 -E -P /home/kurt/canonIR85.ppd - +</p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 19.1. Manual Driver Installation installation</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p class="title"><b>Install the Printer on CUPS</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p mysmbtstprn -v socket://10.160.51.131:9100 -E -P canonIR85.ppd</tt></b> </pre><p> This installs printer with the name <span class="emphasis"><em>mysmbtstprn</em></span> to the CUPS system. The printer is accessed via a socket (a.k.a. JetDirect or Direct TCP/IP) connection. You need to be root for this step -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961224"></a>Second Step (optional): Check if the Printer is recognized by -Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - - # rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep -C2 mysmbtstprn - - flags:[0x800000] - name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,,mysmbtstprn] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Check if the Printer is recognized by +Samba</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2933968"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep -C2 mysmbtstprn</tt></b> +flags:[0x800000] +name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,,mysmbtstprn] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] </pre><p> This should show the printer in the list. If not, stop and re-start the Samba daemon (smbd), or send a HUP signal: <b class="command">kill -HUP @@ -2185,24 +2039,25 @@ already. You need to know root's Samba password (as set by the following steps. Alternatively you can authenticate as one of the users from the "write list" as defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961288"></a>Third Step (optional): Check if Samba knows a Driver for the -Printer</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep driver - drivername:[] +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Check if Samba knows a Driver for the +Printer</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2934063"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2934074"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep driver </tt></b> +drivername:[] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep -C4 driv</tt></b> +servername:[\\kde-bitshop] +printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +sharename:[mysmbtstprn] +portname:[Samba Printer Port] +drivername:[] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +location:[] +sepfile:[] +printprocessor:[winprint] -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep -C4 driv - servername:[\\kde-bitshop] - printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - sharename:[mysmbtstprn] - portname:[Samba Printer Port] - drivername:[] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] - location:[] - sepfile:[] - printprocessor:[winprint] - -# rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost</tt></b> result was WERR_UNKNOWN_PRINTER_DRIVER </pre><p> @@ -2211,16 +2066,14 @@ This step was done for the purpose of demonstrating this condition. An attempt to connect to the printer at this stage will prompt the message along the lines: "The server has not the required printer driver installed". -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961326"></a>Fourth Step: Put all required Driver Files into Samba's -[print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# smbclient //localhost/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ - -c 'cd W32X86; \ - put /etc/cups/ppd/mysmbtstprn.ppd mysmbtstprn.PPD; \ - put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll cupsui.dll; \ - put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll cupsdrvr.dll; \ - put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp cups.hlp' - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Put all required Driver Files into Samba's +[print$]</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //localhost/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86; \ + put /etc/cups/ppd/mysmbtstprn.ppd mysmbtstprn.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll cupsui.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll cupsdrvr.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp cups.hlp'</tt></b> </pre><p> (Note that this command should be entered in one long single line. Line-breaks and the line-end indicating "\" has been inserted @@ -2230,31 +2083,26 @@ present in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. However, client would still not be able to install them, because Samba does not yet treat them as driver files. A client asking for the driver would still be presented with a "not installed here" message. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961377"></a>Fifth Step: Verify where the Driver Files are now</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/ - total 669 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:08 2 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 25 23:21 cupsdrvr.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 25 23:21 cupsui.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Verify where the Driver Files are now</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt></b> +total 669 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:08 2 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 25 23:21 cupsdrvr.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 25 23:21 cupsui.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD </pre><p> The driver files now are in the W32X86 architecture "root" of <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961415"></a>Sixth Step: Tell Samba that these are +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Tell Samba that these are <span class="emphasis"><em>Driver</em></span> Files -(<b class="command">adddriver</b>)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c `adddriver "Windows NT x86" "mydrivername: \ - cupsdrvr.dll:mysmbtstprn.PPD: \ - cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW[<span class="citation">:</span>]NULL" \ - localhost - - Printer Driver mydrivername successfully installed. - +(<b class="command">adddriver</b>)</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2934292"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c `adddriver "Windows NT x86" "mydrivername: \ + cupsdrvr.dll:mysmbtstprn.PPD: \ + cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" \ + localhost</tt></b> +Printer Driver mydrivername successfully installed. </pre><p> Note that your cannot repeat this step if it fails. It could fail even as a result of a simple typo. It will most likely have moved a part of @@ -2265,49 +2113,41 @@ driver. It is normally a good idea to use the same name as is used for the printername; however, in big installations you may use this driver for a number of printers which have obviously different names. So the name of the driver is not fixed. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961469"></a>Seventh Step: Verify where the Driver Files are now</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/ - total 1 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:22 2 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 - - -# ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/2 - total 5039 - [....] - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 13 13:53 cupsdrvr.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 13 13:53 cupsui.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Verify where the Driver Files are now</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt></b> +total 1 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:22 2 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/2</tt></b> +total 5039 +[....] +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 13 13:53 cupsdrvr.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 13 13:53 cupsui.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD </pre><p> Notice how step 6 did also move the driver files to the appropriate subdirectory. Compare with the situation after step 5. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961503"></a>Eighth Step (optional): Verify if Samba now recognizes the -Driver</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumdrivers 3' localhost | grep -B2 -A5 mydrivername - - Printer Driver Info 3: - Version: [2] - Driver Name: [mydrivername] - Architecture: [Windows NT x86] - Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] - Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] - Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] - Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Verify if Samba now recognizes the +Driver</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2934435"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumdrivers 3' localhost \ + | grep -B2 -A5 mydrivername</tt></b> +Printer Driver Info 3: +Version: [2] +Driver Name: [mydrivername] +Architecture: [Windows NT x86] +Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] +Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] +Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] +Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] </pre><p> Remember, this command greps for the name you did choose for the driver in step Six. This command must succeed before you can proceed. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961536"></a>Ninth Step: Tell Samba which Printer should use these Driver -Files (<b class="command">setdriver</b>)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'setdriver mysmbtstprn mydrivername' localhost - - Successfully set mysmbtstprn to driver mydrivername - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Tell Samba which Printer should use these Driver +Files (<b class="command">setdriver</b>)</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2934499"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'setdriver mysmbtstprn mydrivername' localhost</tt></b> +Successfully set mysmbtstprn to driver mydrivername </pre><p> Since you can bind any printername (=printqueue) to any driver, this is a very convenient way to setup many queues which use the same @@ -2315,50 +2155,53 @@ driver. You don't need to repeat all the previous steps for the setdriver command to succeed. The only pre-conditions are: <b class="command">enumdrivers</b> must find the driver and <b class="command">enumprinters</b> must find the printer. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961586"></a>Tenth Step (optional): Verify if Samba has this Association -recognized</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep driver - drivername:[mydrivername] +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Verify if Samba has this Association +recognized</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2934568"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2934579"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2934590"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep driver</tt></b> +drivername:[mydrivername] -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep -C4 driv - servername:[\\kde-bitshop] - printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - sharename:[mysmbtstprn] - portname:[Done] - drivername:[mydrivername] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] - location:[] - sepfile:[] - printprocessor:[winprint] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep -C4 driv</tt></b> +servername:[\\kde-bitshop] +printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +sharename:[mysmbtstprn] +portname:[Done] +drivername:[mydrivername] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +location:[] +sepfile:[] +printprocessor:[winprint] -# rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost - [Windows NT x86] - Printer Driver Info 3: - Version: [2] - Driver Name: [mydrivername] - Architecture: [Windows NT x86] - Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] - Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] - Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] - Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] - Monitorname: [] - Defaultdatatype: [RAW] - Monitorname: [] - Defaultdatatype: [RAW] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost</tt></b> +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [mydrivername] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] + Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] + Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] + Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [RAW] + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [RAW] -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep mysmbtstprn - name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,mydrivername,mysmbtstprn] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep mysmbtstprn</tt></b> + name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] + description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,mydrivername,mysmbtstprn] + comment:[mysmbtstprn] </pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934682"></a> Compare these results with the ones from steps 2 and 3. Note that every single of these commands show the driver is installed. Even the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> command now lists the driver on the "description" line. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961666"></a>Eleventh Step (optional): Tickle the Driver into a correct -Device Mode</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Tickle the Driver into a correct +Device Mode</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934720"></a> You certainly know how to install the driver on the client. In case you are not particularly familiar with Windows, here is a short recipe: browse the Network Neighbourhood, go to the Samba server, look @@ -2375,39 +2218,32 @@ It is important that you execute this step as a Samba printer admin to do this on Windows XP. It uses a commandline, which you may type into the "DOS box" (type root's smbpassword when prompted): </p><pre class="screen"> - - C:\> runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n \\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn" - +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n\ + \\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> </pre><p> -Change any printer setting once (like <span class="emphasis"><em>"portrait" ---> "landscape"</em></span>), click "Apply"; change the setting +Change any printer setting once (like changing <span class="emphasis"><em>"portrait" to + "landscape"</em></span>), click <span class="guibutton">Apply</span>; change the setting back. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961731"></a>Twelfth Step: Install the Printer on a Client -("Point'n'Print")</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - - C:\> rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn" - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Install the Printer on a Client +("Point'n'Print")</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2934817"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> </pre><p> If it doesn't work it could be a permission problem with the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961764"></a>Thirteenth Step (optional): Print a Test Page</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - - C:\> rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn" - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Thirteenth Step (optional): Print a Test Page</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> </pre><p> Then hit [TAB] 5 times, [ENTER] twice, [TAB] once and [ENTER] again and march to the printer. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961790"></a>Fourteenth Step (recommended): Study the Test Page</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Fourteenth Step (recommended): Study the Test Page</b></p><p> Hmmm.... just kidding! By now you know everything about printer installations and you don't need to read a word. Just put it in a frame and bolt it to the wall with the heading "MY FIRST RPCCLIENT-INSTALLED PRINTER" - why not just throw it away! -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961808"></a>Fifteenth Step (obligatory): Enjoy. Jump. Celebrate your -Success</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# echo "Cheeeeerioooooo! Success..." >> /var/log/samba/log.smbd - -</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961830"></a>Troubleshooting revisited</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Fifteenth Step (obligatory): Enjoy. Jump. Celebrate your +Success</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>echo "Cheeeeerioooooo! Success..." >> /var/log/samba/log.smbd</tt></b> +</pre></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934958"></a>Troubleshooting revisited</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The setdriver command will fail, if in Samba's mind the queue is not already there. You had promising messages about the: </p><pre class="screen"> @@ -2422,7 +2258,8 @@ a disappointing message like this one beneath? result was NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL </pre><p> -It is not good enough that <span class="emphasis"><em>you</em></span> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935002"></a> +It is not good enough that you can see the queue <span class="emphasis"><em>in CUPS</em></span>, using the <b class="command">lpstat -p ir85wm</b> command. A bug in most recent versions of Samba prevents the proper update of @@ -2431,26 +2268,35 @@ fails unless you re-start Samba or send a HUP to all smbd processes. To verify if this is the reason why Samba doesn't execute the setdriver command successfully, check if Samba "sees" the printer: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'enumprinters 0'| grep ir85wm +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2935035"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'enumprinters 0'| grep ir85wm</tt></b> printername:[ir85wm] - </pre><p> An alternative command could be this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'getprinter ir85wm' +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2935074"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'getprinter ir85wm' </tt></b> cmd = getprinter ir85wm flags:[0x800000] name:[\\transmeta\ir85wm] description:[\\transmeta\ir85wm,ir85wm,DPD] comment:[CUPS PostScript-Treiber for WinNT/2K/XP] - </pre><p> BTW, you can use these commands, plus a few more, of course, to install drivers on remote Windows NT print servers too! -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961930"></a>The printing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2935118"></a>The printing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935136"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935144"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935155"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935166"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935178"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935189"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935200"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935211"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935222"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935233"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935245"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935256"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935267"></a> Some mystery is associated with the series of files with a tdb-suffix appearing in every Samba installation. They are <tt class="filename">connections.tdb</tt>, @@ -2465,12 +2311,12 @@ tdb-suffix appearing in every Samba installation. They are <tt class="filename">ntprinters.tdb</tt>, <tt class="filename">sessionid.tdb</tt> and <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>. What is their purpose? -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962033"></a>Trivial DataBase Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935364"></a>Trivial DataBase Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2935372"></a><p> A Windows NT (Print) Server keeps track of all information needed to serve its duty toward its clients by storing entries in the Windows "Registry". Client queries are answered by reading from the registry, Administrator or user configuration settings are saved by writing into -the Registry. Samba and Unix obviously don't have such a kind of +the Registry. Samba and UNIX obviously don't have such a kind of Registry. Samba instead keeps track of all client related information in a series of <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files. (TDB = Trivial Data Base). These are often located in <tt class="filename">/var/lib/samba/</tt> @@ -2478,7 +2324,7 @@ or <tt class="filename">/var/lock/samba/</tt> . The printing related files are <tt class="filename">ntprinters.tdb</tt>, <tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt>,<tt class="filename">ntforms.tdb</tt> and <tt class="filename">ntdrivers.tdb</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962103"></a>Binary Format</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935456"></a>Binary Format</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files are not human readable. They are written in a binary format. "Why not ASCII?", you may ask. "After all, ASCII configuration files are a good and proofed tradition on UNIX." @@ -2491,7 +2337,7 @@ same time</em></span>. The file format of Samba's <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files allows for this provision. Many smbd processes may write to the same <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> file at the same time. This wouldn't be possible with pure ASCII files. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962165"></a>Losing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935520"></a>Losing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> It is very important that all <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files remain consistent over all write and read accesses. However, it may happen that these files <span class="emphasis"><em>do</em></span> get corrupted. (A @@ -2501,13 +2347,12 @@ etc.). In cases of trouble, a deletion of the old printing-related <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files may be the only option. You need to re-create all print related setup after that. Or you have made a backup of the <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files in time. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962224"></a>Using <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbbackup</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935579"></a>Using <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbbackup</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2935589"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2935603"></a><p> Samba ships with a little utility which helps the root user of your system to back up your <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files. If you run it with no argument, it prints a little usage message: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# tdbbackup +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tdbbackup</tt></b> Usage: tdbbackup [options] <fname...> Version:3.0a @@ -2518,32 +2363,30 @@ with no argument, it prints a little usage message: </pre><p> Here is how I backed up my printing.tdb file: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# ls - . browse.dat locking.tdb ntdrivers.tdb printing.tdb share_info.tdb - .. connections.tdb messages.tdb ntforms.tdb printing.tdbkp unexpected.tdb - brlock.tdb gmon.out namelist.debug ntprinters.tdb sessionid.tdb +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls</tt></b> +. browse.dat locking.tdb ntdrivers.tdb printing.tdb +.. share_info.tdb connections.tdb messages.tdb ntforms.tdb +printing.tdbkp unexpected.tdb brlock.tdb gmon.out namelist.debug +ntprinters.tdb sessionid.tdb - kde-bitshop:/var/lock/samba # tdbbackup -s .bak printing.tdb +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tdbbackup -s .bak printing.tdb</tt></b> printing.tdb : 135 records - kde-bitshop:/var/lock/samba # ls -l printing.tdb* +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l printing.tdb*</tt></b> -rw------- 1 root root 40960 May 2 03:44 printing.tdb -rw------- 1 root root 40960 May 2 03:44 printing.tdb.bak -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962290"></a>CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2935716"></a>CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2935724"></a><p> CUPS ships with good support for HP LaserJet type printers. You can install the generic driver as follows: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -m laserjet.ppd - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2935737"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -m laserjet.ppd</tt></b> </pre><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>-m</tt></i> switch will retrieve the +The <tt class="option">-m</tt> switch will retrieve the <tt class="filename">laserjet.ppd</tt> from the standard repository for not-yet-installed-PPDs, which CUPS typically stores in <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/model</tt>. Alternatively, you may use -<i class="parameter"><tt>-P /path/to/your.ppd</tt></i>. +<tt class="option">-P /path/to/your.ppd</tt>. </p><p> The generic laserjet.ppd however does not support every special option for every LaserJet-compatible model. It constitutes a sort of "least @@ -2555,6 +2398,7 @@ best used for each printer. Its database is kept current by the tireless work of Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft, who is also the principal author of the foomatic-rip utility. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2935835"></a> The former "cupsomatic" concept is now be replaced by the new, much more powerful "foomatic-rip". foomatic-rip is the successor of cupsomatic. cupsomatic is no longer maintained. Here is the new URL @@ -2565,7 +2409,7 @@ not work with PPDs generated for the old cupsomatic. The new-style PPDs are 100% compliant to the Adobe PPD specification. They are intended to be used by Samba and the cupsaddsmb utility also, to provide the driver files for the Windows clients also! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962398"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935871"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2935879"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2935887"></a><p> Nowadays most Linux distros rely on the utilities of Linuxprinting.org to create their printing related software (which, BTW, works on all UNIXes and on Mac OS X or Darwin too). It is not known as well as it @@ -2582,7 +2426,7 @@ its <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic.html" target="_top">Foomatic< database. Currently there are <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi" target="_top">245 drivers</a> in the database: many drivers support various models, and many models may be driven by different drivers; it's your choice! -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962453"></a>690 "perfect" Printers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2935943"></a>690 "perfect" Printers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> At present there are 690 devices dubbed as working "perfectly", 181 "mostly", 96 "partially" and 46 are "Paperweights". Keeping in mind that most of these are non-PostScript models (PostScript printers are @@ -2593,7 +2437,7 @@ doesn't also scan and copy and fax under GNU/Linux: then this is a truly astonishing achievement. Three years ago the number was not more than 500, and Linux or UNIX "printing" at the time wasn't anywhere near the quality it is today! -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962477"></a>How the "Printing HOWTO" started it all</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2935974"></a>How the "Printing HOWTO" started it all</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A few years ago <a href="http://www2.picante.com:81/~gtaylor/" target="_top">Grant Taylor</a> started it all. The roots of today's Linuxprinting.org are in the first <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/howto/" target="_top">Linux Printing @@ -2607,7 +2451,7 @@ hardware and driver zoo that made up Linux printing of the time. This database became the core component of today's Foomatic collection of tools and data. In the meantime it has moved to an XML representation of the data. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962522"></a>Foomatic's strange Name</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936022"></a>Foomatic's strange Name</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2936030"></a><p> "Why the funny name?", you ask. When it really took off, around spring 2000, CUPS was far less popular than today, and most systems used LPD, LPRng or even PDQ to print. CUPS shipped with a few generic "drivers" @@ -2630,7 +2474,7 @@ developments available for CUPS;</p></li><li><p>It made available a lot of addit to CUPS users (because often the "traditional" Ghostscript way of printing was the only one available);</p></li><li><p>It gave all the advanced CUPS options (web interface, GUI driver configurations) to users wanting (or needing) to use -Ghostscript filters.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962589"></a>cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Ghostscript filters.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936123"></a>cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2936133"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2936141"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2936149"></a><p> CUPS worked through a quickly-hacked up filter script named <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=cupsomatic&show=0" target="_top">cupsomatic</a>. cupsomatic ran the printfile through Ghostscript, constructing automatically the rather complicated command line needed. It just @@ -2664,8 +2508,8 @@ Foomatic up to versions 2.0.x required (ugly) Perl data structures attached the Linuxprinting.org PPDs for CUPS. It had a different "*omatic" script for every spooler, as well as different printer configuration files.. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962725"></a>7.13.1.5.The <span class="emphasis"><em>Grand Unification</em></span> -achieved...</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936304"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>Grand Unification</em></span> +achieved...</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2936316"></a><p> This all has changed in Foomatic versions 2.9 (Beta) and released as "stable" 3.0. This has now achieved the convergence of all *omatic scripts: it is called the <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0" target="_top">foomatic-rip</a>. @@ -2700,7 +2544,7 @@ sizes for many printers; and it will support printing on media drawn from different paper trays within the same job (in both cases: even where there is no support for this from Windows-based vendor printer drivers). -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962810"></a>Driver Development outside</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936409"></a>Driver Development outside</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Most driver development itself does not happen within Linuxprinting.org. Drivers are written by independent maintainers. Linuxprinting.org just pools all the information, and stores it in its @@ -2713,7 +2557,7 @@ the work is currently done in three projects. These are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/" target="_top">Omni</a> -- a Free Software project by IBM which tries to convert their printer driver knowledge from good-ol' OS/2 times into a modern, modular, -universal driver architecture for Linux/Unix (still Beta). This +universal driver architecture for Linux/UNIX (still Beta). This currently supports 437 models.</p></li><li><p><a href="http://hpinkjet.sf.net/" target="_top">HPIJS</a> -- a Free Software project by HP to provide the support for their own range of models (very mature, printing in most cases is perfect and @@ -2723,8 +2567,8 @@ effort, started by Michael Sweet (also lead developer for CUPS), now directed by Robert Krawitz, which has achieved an amazing level of photo print quality (many Epson users swear that its quality is better than the vendor drivers provided by Epson for the Microsoft -platforms). This currently supports 522 models.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962892"></a>Forums, Downloads, Tutorials, Howtos -- also for Mac OS X and -commercial Unix</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +platforms). This currently supports 522 models.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936490"></a>Forums, Downloads, Tutorials, Howtos -- also for Mac OS X and +commercial UNIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Linuxprinting.org today is the one-stop "shop" to download printer drivers. Look for printer information and <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org//kpfeifle/LinuxKongress2002/Tutorial/" target="_top">tutorials</a> or solve printing problems in its popular <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/newsportal/" target="_top">forums</a>. But @@ -2744,7 +2588,7 @@ of the Foomatic project. Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft is doing an excellent job in his spare time to maintain Linuxprinting.org and Foomatic. So if you use it often, please send him a note showing your appreciation. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962963"></a>Foomatic Database generated PPDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936564"></a>Foomatic Database generated PPDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Foomatic database is an amazing piece of ingenuity in itself. Not only does it keep the printer and driver information, but it is organized in a way that it can generate "PPD" files "on the fly" from @@ -2769,7 +2613,7 @@ GUI tools (like KDE's marvellous <a href="http://printing.kde.org/overview/kprin or the GNOME <a href="http://gtklp.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">"gtklp"</a>, "xpp" and the CUPS web interface) read the PPD too and use this information to present the available settings to the user as an intuitive menu selection. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963027"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936640"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here are the steps to install a foomatic-rip driven "LaserJet 4 Plus" compatible printer in CUPS (note that recent distributions of SuSE, UnitedLinux and Mandrake may ship with a complete package of @@ -2783,11 +2627,11 @@ link.</p></li><li><p>You'll arrive at a page listing all drivers working with this model (for all printers, there will always be <span class="emphasis"><em>one</em></span> recommended driver. Try this one first).</p></li><li><p>In our case ("HP LaserJet 4 Plus"), we'll arrive here: -<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus</a> + <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus</a> </p></li><li><p>The recommended driver is "ljet4".</p></li><li><p>There are several links provided here. You should visit them all, if you are not familiar with the Linuxprinting.org database.</p></li><li><p>There is a link to the database page for the "ljet4": -<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4</a> + <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4</a> On the driver's page, you'll find important and detailed information about how to use that driver within the various available spoolers.</p></li><li><p>Another link may lead you to the homepage of the @@ -2828,9 +2672,7 @@ the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/model/</tt> path and re-start cupsd).</p></li><li><p>Then install the printer with a suitable commandline, e.g.: </p><pre class="screen"> - -lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -P path/to/my-printer.ppd - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -P path/to/my-printer.ppd</tt></b> </pre></li><li><p>Note again this: for all the new-style "Foomatic-PPDs" from Linuxprinting.org, you also need a special "CUPS filter" named "foomatic-rip".Get the latest version of "foomatic-rip" from: <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0</a> @@ -2868,7 +2710,7 @@ the driver/model) contain support for a certain "device", representing the selected "driver" for your model (as shown by "gs -h")</p></li><li><p>foomatic-rip needs a new version of PPDs (PPD versions produced for cupsomatic don't work with -foomatic-rip).</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963488"></a>Page Accounting with CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +foomatic-rip).</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937141"></a>Page Accounting with CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2937150"></a><p> Often there are questions regarding "print quotas" wherein Samba users (that is, Windows clients) should not be able to print beyond a certain amount of pages or data volume per day, week or month. This @@ -2881,18 +2723,17 @@ Of course one could "hack" things with one's own scripts. But then there is CUPS. CUPS supports "quotas" which can be based on sizes of jobs or on the number of pages or both, and are spanning any time period you want. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963519"></a>Setting up Quotas</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937193"></a>Setting up Quotas</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2937200"></a><p> This is an example command how root would set a print quota in CUPS, assuming an existing printer named "quotaprinter": -</p><pre class="screen"> - - lpadmin -p quotaprinter -o job-quota-period=604800 -o job-k-limit=1024 -o job-page-limit=100 - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2937220"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p quotaprinter -o job-quota-period=604800 \ + -o job-k-limit=1024 -o job-page-limit=100</tt></b> </pre><p> This would limit every single user to print 100 pages or 1024 KB of data (whichever comes first) within the last 604,800 seconds ( = 1 week). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963551"></a>Correct and incorrect Accounting</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937258"></a>Correct and incorrect Accounting</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For CUPS to count correctly, the printfile needs to pass the CUPS "pstops" filter, otherwise it uses a "dummy" count of "1". Some printfiles don't pass it (eg: image files) but then those are mostly 1 @@ -2906,8 +2747,8 @@ driver there) to have the chance to get accounting done. If the printer is a non-PostScript model, you need to let CUPS do the job to convert the file to a print-ready format for the target printer. This will be working for currently about 1,000 different printer models, -see <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi</a>). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963592"></a>Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +see <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi" target="_top">the driver list at linuxprinting.org/</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937303"></a>Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before CUPS-1.1.16 your only option was to use the Adobe PostScript Driver on the Windows clients. The output of this driver was not always passed through the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba side, and @@ -2920,14 +2761,14 @@ From CUPS-1.1.16 onward you can use the "CUPS PostScript Driver for Windows NT/2K/XP clients" (which is tagged in the download area of http://www.cups.org/ as the "cups-samba-1.1.16.tar.gz" package). It does <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> work for Win9x/ME clients. But it guarantees: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>to not write an PJL-header</p></li><li><p>to still read and support all PJL-options named in the +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2937350"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p>to not write an PJL-header</p></li><li><p>to still read and support all PJL-options named in the driver PPD with its own means</p></li><li><p> that the file will pass through the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba server</p></li><li><p>to page-count correctly the printfile</p></li></ul></div><p> You can read more about the setup of this combination in the manpage for "cupsaddsmb" (which is only present with CUPS installed, and only current from CUPS 1.1.16). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963663"></a>The page_log File Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937398"></a>The page_log File Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2937407"></a><p> These are the items CUPS logs in the "page_log" for every single <span class="emphasis"><em>page</em></span> of a job: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Printer name</p></li><li><p>User name</p></li><li><p>Job ID</p></li><li><p>Time of printing</p></li><li><p>the page number</p></li><li><p>the number of copies</p></li><li><p>a billing information string @@ -2936,20 +2777,18 @@ single <span class="emphasis"><em>page</em></span> of a job: Here is an extract of my CUPS server's page_log file to illustrate the format and included items: </p><pre class="screen"> - - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 1 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 2 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 3 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 4 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - DigiMaster9110 boss 402 [22/Apr/2003:10:33:22 +0100] 1 440 finance-dep 10.160.51.33 - +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 1 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 2 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 3 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 4 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +DigiMaster9110 boss 402 [22/Apr/2003:10:33:22 +0100] 1 440 finance-dep 10.160.51.33 </pre><p> This was job ID "401", printed on "infotec_IS2027" by user "kurt", a 64-page job printed in 3 copies and billed to "#marketing", sent from IP address 10.160.50.13. The next job had ID "402", was sent by user "boss" from IP address 10.160.51.33,printed from one page 440 copies and is set to be billed to "finance-dep". -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963765"></a>Possible Shortcomings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937516"></a>Possible Shortcomings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> What flaws or shortcomings are there with this quota system? </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the ones named above (wrongly logged job in case of printer hardware failure, etc.)</p></li><li><p>in reality, CUPS counts the job pages that are being @@ -2958,12 +2797,12 @@ processed in <span class="emphasis"><em>software</em></span> (that is, going thr printing device. Thus if there is a jam while printing the 5th sheet out of 1000 and the job is aborted by the printer, the "page count" will still show the figure of 1000 for that job</p></li><li><p>all quotas are the same for all users (no flexibility -to give the boss a higher quota than the clerk) no support for +to give the boss a higher quota than the clerk), no support for groups</p></li><li><p>no means to read out the current balance or the "used-up" number of current quota</p></li><li><p>a user having used up 99 sheets of 100 quota will still be able to send and print a 1,000 sheet job</p></li><li><p>a user being denied a job because of a filled-up quota doesn't get a meaningful error message from CUPS other than -"client-error-not-possible".</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963836"></a>Future Developments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"client-error-not-possible".</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937592"></a>Future Developments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is the best system currently available, and there are huge improvements under development for CUPS 1.2: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>page counting will go into the "backends" (these talk @@ -2971,9 +2810,9 @@ directly to the printer and will increase the count in sync with the actual printing process: thus a jam at the 5th sheet will lead to a stop in the counting)</p></li><li><p>quotas will be handled more flexibly</p></li><li><p>probably there will be support for users to inquire their "accounts" in advance</p></li><li><p>probably there will be support for some other tools -around this topic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963884"></a>Other Accounting Tools</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +around this topic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937648"></a>Other Accounting Tools</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> PrintAnalyzer, pyKota, printbill, LogReport. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963899"></a>Additional Material</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937662"></a>Additional Material</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A printer queue with <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> PPD associated to it is a "raw" printer and all files will go directly there as received by the spooler. The exceptions are file types "application/octet-stream" @@ -2994,10 +2833,8 @@ where "normally" the native CUPS "pstoraster" filter would k in. cupsomatic by-passes pstoraster, "kidnaps" the printfile from CUPS away and re-directs it to go through Ghostscript. CUPS accepts this, because the associated CUPS-O-Matic-/Foomatic-PPD specifies: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" </pre><p> This line persuades CUPS to hand the file to cupsomatic, once it has successfully converted it to the MIME type @@ -3009,30 +2846,24 @@ Jobs arriving from Windows which are auto-typed CUPS is widely configurable and flexible, even regarding its filtering mechanism. Another workaround in some situations would be to have in <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> entries as follows: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - application/postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - + application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - </pre><p> This would prevent all Postscript files from being filtered (rather, they will through the virtual <span class="emphasis"><em>nullfilter</em></span> denoted with "-"). This could only be useful for PS printers. If you want to print PS code on non-PS printers (provided they support ASCII text printing) an entry as follows could be useful: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - */* application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + */* application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - </pre><p> and would effectively send <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> files to the backend without further processing. </p><p> Lastly, you could have the following entry: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 my_PJL_stripping_filter - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 my_PJL_stripping_filter </pre><p> You will need to write a <span class="emphasis"><em>my_PJL_stripping_filter</em></span> (could be a shellscript) that parses the PostScript and removes the @@ -3051,16 +2882,15 @@ the jobs of hundreds of users on some big machine, where no user is allowed to have direct access (such as when the operators often need to load the proper paper type before running the 10,000 page job requested by marketing for the mailing, etc.). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964092"></a>Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937912"></a>Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba print files pass through two "spool" directories. One is the -incoming directory managed by Samba, (set in the <span class="emphasis"><em>path = -/var/spool/samba</em></span> directive in the -<span class="emphasis"><em>[printers]</em></span> section of +incoming directory managed by Samba, (set in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2937929"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba directive in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). The other is the spool directory of your UNIX print subsystem. For CUPS it is normally <tt class="filename">/var/spool/cups/</tt>, as set by the cupsd.conf directive <tt class="filename">RequestRoot /var/spool/cups</tt>. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964138"></a>CUPS Configuration Settings explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937974"></a>CUPS Configuration Settings explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Some important parameter settings in the CUPS configuration file <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">PreserveJobHistory Yes</span></dt><dd><p> @@ -3084,34 +2914,32 @@ maximum to 0 disables this functionality. The default setting is </p></dd></dl></div><p> (There are also additional settings for "MaxJobsPerUser" and "MaxJobsPerPrinter"...) -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964221"></a>Pre-conditions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938069"></a>Pre-conditions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For everything to work as announced, you need to have three things: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a Samba-smbd which is compiled against "libcups" (Check on Linux by running "ldd `which smbd`")</p></li><li><p>a Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of -"printing = cups"</p></li><li><p>another Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of -"printcap = cups"</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2938105"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups</p></li><li><p>another Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of + <a class="indexterm" name="id2938131"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> In this case all other manually set printing-related commands (like -"print command", "lpq command", "lprm command", "lppause command" or -"lpresume command") are ignored and they should normally have no +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938153"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938167"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938180"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938194"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i> or +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938208"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>) are ignored and they should normally have no influence what-so-ever on your printing. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964281"></a>Manual Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you want to do things manually, replace the "printing = -cups" by "printing = bsd". Then your manually set commands may work -(haven't tested this), and a "print command = lp -d %P %s; rm %s" +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938226"></a>Manual Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you want to do things manually, replace the <a class="indexterm" name="id2938237"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups +by <a class="indexterm" name="id2938250"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd. Then your manually set commands may work +(haven't tested this), and a <a class="indexterm" name="id2938266"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> = lp -d %P %s; rm %s" may do what you need. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964299"></a>When <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> to use Samba to print to -CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964316"></a>In Case of Trouble.....</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938284"></a>In Case of Trouble.....</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you have more problems, post the output of these commands to the CUPS or Samba mailing lists (choose the one which seems more relevant to your problem): </p><pre class="screen"> - - grep -v ^# /etc/cups/cupsd.conf | grep -v ^$ - grep -v ^# /etc/samba/smb.conf | grep -v ^$ | grep -v "^;" - +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -v ^# /etc/cups/cupsd.conf | grep -v ^$</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -v ^# /etc/samba/smb.conf | grep -v ^$ | grep -v "^;"</tt></b> </pre><p> (adapt paths as needed). These commands leave out the empty lines and lines with comments, providing the "naked settings" in a @@ -3119,18 +2947,12 @@ compact way. Don't forget to name the CUPS and Samba versions you are using! This saves bandwidth and makes for easier readability for experts (and you are expecting experts to read them, right? ;-) -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964352"></a>Where to find Documentation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964364"></a>How to ask for Help</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964377"></a>Where to find Help</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964391"></a>Appendix</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964398"></a>Printing <span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938356"></a>Printing <span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> From time to time the question arises, how you can print <span class="emphasis"><em>to</em></span> a Windows attached printer <span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> Samba. Normally the local connection -"Windows host <--> printer" would be done by USB or parallel +from Windows host to printer would be done by USB or parallel cable, but this doesn't matter to Samba. From here only an SMB connection needs to be opened to the Windows host. Of course, this printer must be "shared" first. As you have learned by now, CUPS uses @@ -3142,33 +2964,29 @@ is in the CUPS backend directory. This resides usually in file there. It should be a symlink to <tt class="filename">smbspool</tt> which file must exist and be executable: </p><pre class="screen"> - - # ls -l /usr/lib/cups/backend/ - total 253 - drwxr-xr-x 3 root root 720 Apr 30 19:04 . - drwxr-xr-x 6 root root 125 Dec 19 17:13 .. - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 canon - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 epson - lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 3 Apr 17 22:50 http -> ipp - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 17316 Apr 17 22:50 ipp - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 15420 Apr 20 17:01 lpd - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 8656 Apr 20 17:01 parallel - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 2162 Mar 31 23:15 pdfdistiller - lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 25 Apr 30 19:04 ptal -> /usr/local/sbin/ptal-cups - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 6284 Apr 20 17:01 scsi - lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 17 Apr 2 03:11 smb -> /usr/bin/smbspool - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 7912 Apr 20 17:01 socket - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 9012 Apr 20 17:01 usb - -# ls -l `which smbspool` - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 563245 Dec 28 14:49 /usr/bin/smbspool - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /usr/lib/cups/backend/</tt></b> +total 253 +drwxr-xr-x 3 root root 720 Apr 30 19:04 . +drwxr-xr-x 6 root root 125 Dec 19 17:13 .. +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 canon +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 epson +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 3 Apr 17 22:50 http -> ipp +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 17316 Apr 17 22:50 ipp +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 15420 Apr 20 17:01 lpd +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 8656 Apr 20 17:01 parallel +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 2162 Mar 31 23:15 pdfdistiller +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 25 Apr 30 19:04 ptal -> /usr/sbin/ptal-cups +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 6284 Apr 20 17:01 scsi +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 17 Apr 2 03:11 smb -> /usr/bin/smbspool +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 7912 Apr 20 17:01 socket +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 9012 Apr 20 17:01 usb + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l `which smbspool`</tt></b> +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 563245 Dec 28 14:49 /usr/bin/smbspool </pre><p> If this symlink doesn't exist, create it: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# ln -s `which smbspool` /usr/lib/cups/backend/smb - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s `which smbspool` /usr/lib/cups/backend/smb</tt></b> </pre><p> smbspool has been written by Mike Sweet from the CUPS folks. It is included and ships with Samba. It may also be used with print @@ -3185,9 +3003,8 @@ the Windows host, etc. </p><p> To install a printer with the smb backend on CUPS, use this command: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# lpadmin -p winprinter -v smb://WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename -P /path/to/PPD - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p winprinter -v smb://WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename \ + -P /path/to/PPD</tt></b> </pre><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>PPD</em></span> must be able to direct CUPS to generate the print data for the target model. For PostScript printers just use @@ -3196,13 +3013,7 @@ what can you do if the printer is only accessible with a password? Or if the printer's host is part of another workgroup? This is provided for: you can include the required parameters as part of the <tt class="filename">smb://</tt> device-URI. Like this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - smb://WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename - smb://username:password@WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename - smb://username:password@WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename - -</pre><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>smb://WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename </p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</p></li></ul></div><p> Note that the device-URI will be visible in the process list of the Samba server (e.g. when someone uses the <b class="command">ps -aux</b> command on Linux), even if the username and passwords are sanitized @@ -3213,337 +3024,41 @@ doesn't require a password! Printing will only work if you have a working netbios name resolution up and running. Note that this is a feature of CUPS and you don't necessarily need to have smbd running (but who wants that? :-). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964612"></a>More CUPS filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938656"></a>More CUPS filtering Chains</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following diagrams reveal how CUPS handles print jobs. -</p><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# CUPS in and of itself has this (general) filter chain (CAPITAL -# letters are FILE-FORMATS or MIME types, other are filters (this is -# true for pre-1.1.15 of pre-4.3 versions of CUPS and ESP PrintPro): -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstoraster # as shipped with CUPS, independent from any Ghostscipt -# | # installation on the system -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER -# | -# V -# rastertosomething (e.g. Gimp-Print filters may be plugged in here) -# | (= "raster driver") -# V -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC -# | -# V -# backend -# -# -# ESP PrintPro has some enhanced "rastertosomething" filters as compared to -# CUPS, and also a somewhat improved "pstoraster" filter. -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# This is how "cupsomatic" comes into play: -# ========================================= -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT ----------------+ -# | V -# V cupsomatic -# pstoraster (constructs complicated -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") Ghostscript commandline -# | to let the file be -# V processed by a -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER "-sDEVICE=s.th." -# | call...) -# V | -# rastertosomething V -# | (= "raster driver") +-------------------------+ -# | | Ghostscript at work.... | -# V | | -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC *-------------------------+ -# | | -# V | -# backend <------------------------------------+ -# | -# V -# THE PRINTER -# -# -# Note, that cupsomatic "kidnaps" the printfile after the -# "APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRPT" stage and deviates it gh -# the CUPS-external, systemwide Ghostscript installation, bypassing the -# "pstoraster" filter (therefore also bypassing the CUPS-raster-drivers -# "rastertosomething", and hands the rasterized file directly to the CUPS -# backend... -# -# cupsomatic is not made by the CUPS developers. It is an independent -# contribution to printing development, made by people from -# Linuxprinting.org. (see also http://www.cups.org/cups-help.html) -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# And this is how it works for ESP PrintPro from 4.3: -# =================================================== -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# gsrip -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER -# | -# V -# rastertosomething (e.g. Gimp-Print filters may be plugged in here) -# | (= "raster driver") -# V -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC -# | -# V -# backend -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# This is how "cupsomatic" would come into play with ESP PrintPro: -# ================================================================ -# -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT ----------------+ -# | V -# V cupsomatic -# gsrip (constructs complicated -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") Ghostscript commandline -# | to let the file be -# V processed by a -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER "-sDEVICE=s.th." -# | call...) -# V | -# rastertosomething V -# | (= "raster driver") +-------------------------+ -# | | Ghostscript at work.... | -# V | | -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC *-------------------------+ -# | | -# V | -# backend <------------------------------------+ -# | -# V -# THE PRINTER -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# And this is how it works for CUPS from 1.1.15: -# ============================================== -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT-----+ -# +------------------v------------------------------+ -# | Ghostscript | -# | at work... | -# | (with | -# | "-sDEVICE=cups") | -# | | -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") | -# | | -# +------------------v------------------------------+ -# | -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER >-------+ -# | -# V -# rastertosomething -# | (= "raster driver") -# V -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC -# | -# V -# backend -# -# -# NOTE: since version 1.1.15 CUPS "outsourced" the pstoraster process to -# Ghostscript. GNU Ghostscript needs to be patched to handle the -# CUPS requirement; ESP Ghostscript has this builtin. In any case, -# "gs -h" needs to show up a "cups" device. pstoraster is now a -# calling an appropriate "gs -sDEVICE=cups..." commandline to do -# the job. It will output "application/vnd.cup-raster", which will -# be finally processed by a CUPS raster driver "rastertosomething" -# Note the difference to "cupsomatic", which will <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> output -# CUPS-raster, but a final version of the printfile, ready to be -# sent to the printer. cupsomatic also doesn't use the "cups" -# devicemode in Ghostscript, but one of the classical devicemodes.... -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# And this is how it works for CUPS from 1.1.15, with cupsomatic included: -# ======================================================================== -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT-----+ -# +------------------v------------------------------+ -# | Ghostscript . Ghostscript at work.... | -# | at work... . (with "-sDEVICE= | -# | (with . s.th." | -# | "-sDEVICE=cups") . | -# | . | -# | (CUPS standard) . (cupsomatic) | -# | . | -# | (= "postscript interpreter") | -# | . | -# +------------------v--------------v---------------+ -# | | -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER >-------+ | -# | | -# V | -# rastertosomething | -# | (= "raster driver") | -# V | -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC >------------------------+ -# | -# V -# backend -# -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -########################################################################## -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2964919"></a>Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -This is a short description of how to debug printing problems -with Samba. This describes how to debug problems with printing from -a SMB client to a Samba server, not the other way around. -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Win9x client can't install driver</span></dt><dd><p>For Win9x clients require the printer names to be 8 +</p><div class="figure"><a name="cups1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.17. Filtering chain 1</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/cups1.png" width="270" alt="Filtering chain 1"></div></div><div class="figure"><a name="cups2"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.18. Filtering chain with cupsomatic</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/cups2.png" width="270" alt="Filtering chain with cupsomatic"></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938758"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938765"></a>Win9x client can't install driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>For Win9x clients require the printer names to be 8 chars (or "8 plus 3 chars suffix") max; otherwise the driver files won't get transferred when you want to download them from -Samba.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">testparm</span></dt><dd><p>Run <b class="command">testparm</b>: It will tell you if -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters are in the wrong -section. Many people have had the "printer admin" parameter in the -<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section and experienced -problems. "testparm" will tell you if it sees -this.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for a root password in a -neverending loop</span></dt><dd><p>Have you <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>? Have +Samba.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938787"></a>"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you <a class="indexterm" name="id2938800"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user? Have you used <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> to give root a Samba account? You can do 2 things: open another terminal and execute <b class="command">smbpasswd -a root</b> to create the account, and continue with entering the password into the first terminal. Or break out of the loop by hitting ENTER twice (without trying to type a -password).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." -message (but I swear there is one!)</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Have you enabled printer sharing on CUPS? This means: +password).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938835"></a>"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you enabled printer sharing on CUPS? This means: do you have a <i class="parameter"><tt><Location /printers>....</Location></tt></i> section in CUPS server's <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> which doesn't deny access to the host you run "cupsaddsmb" from? It <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> be an issue if you use cupsaddsmb remotely, or if you use it with a -<i class="parameter"><tt>-h</tt></i> parameter: <b class="command">cupsaddsmb -H -sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</b>. -</p></li><li><p>Is your +<tt class="option">-h</tt> parameter: <b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H + sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</tt></b>. +</p><p>Is your "TempDir" directive in <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsd.conf</em></span> set to a valid value and is it writeable? -</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't connect client to Samba printer.</span></dt><dd><p>Use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check which user +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938893"></a>Client can't connect to Samba printer</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check which user you are from Samba's point of view. Do you have the privileges to write into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> -share?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't reconnect to Samba under a new account -from Win2K/XP</span></dt><dd><p>Once you are connected as the "wrong" user (for -example as "nobody", which often occurs if you have <i class="parameter"><tt>map to -guest = bad user</tt></i>), Windows Explorer will not accept an +share?</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938921"></a>Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Once you are connected as the "wrong" user (for +example as "nobody", which often occurs if you have +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938935"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user), Windows Explorer will not accept an attempt to connect again as a different user. There won't be any byte transfered on the wire to Samba, but still you'll see a stupid error message which makes you think that Samba has denied access. Use @@ -3556,61 +3071,59 @@ indicating a renewed connection attempt? Shut all Explorer Windows. This makes Windows forget what it has cached in its memory as established connections. Then re-connect as the right user. Best method is to use a DOS terminal window and <span class="emphasis"><em>first</em></span> -do <b class="command">net use z: \\SAMBAHOST\print$ /user:root</b>. Check +do <b class="userinput"><tt>net use z: \\GANDALF\print$ /user:root</tt></b>. Check with <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are connected under a different account. Now open the "Printers" folder (on the Samba server in the <span class="emphasis"><em>Network Neighbourhood</em></span>), right-click the printer in question and select -<span class="emphasis"><em>Connect...</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the -"wrong" user</span></dt><dd><p>You see per <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are +<span class="emphasis"><em>Connect...</em></span></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939149"></a>Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You see per <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are connected as user "nobody"; while you wanted to be "root" or -"printeradmin"? This is probably due to <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest = bad -user</tt></i>, which silently connects you under the guest account, +"printeradmin"? This is probably due to +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939171"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user, which silently connects you under the guest account, when you gave (maybe by accident) an incorrect username. Remove -<i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>, if you want to prevent -this.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on -NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</span></dt><dd><p>First delete all "old" Adobe-using printers. Then +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939187"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>, if you want to prevent +this.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939202"></a>Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>First delete all "old" Adobe-using printers. Then delete all "old" Adobe drivers. (On Win2K/XP, right-click in background of "Printers" folder, select "Server Properties...", select -tab "Drivers" and delete here).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't use "cupsaddsmb"on a Samba server which is -a PDC</span></dt><dd><p>Do you use the "naked" root user name? Try to do it -this way: <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb -U DOMAINNAME\\root -v -printername</em></span> (note the two backslashes: the first one is -required to "escape" the second one).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I deleted a printer on Win2K; but I still see -its driver</span></dt><dd><p>Deleting a printer on the client won't delete the +tab "Drivers" and delete here).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939219"></a>Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Do you use the "naked" root user name? Try to do it +this way: <b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAINNAME</tt></i>\\root -v +<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i></tt></b>> (note the two backslashes: the first one is +required to "escape" the second one).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939249"></a>Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Deleting a printer on the client won't delete the driver too (to verify, right-click on the white background of the "Printers" folder, select "Server Properties" and click on the "Drivers" tab). These same old drivers will be re-used when you try to install a printer with the same name. If you want to update to a new driver, delete the old ones first. Deletion is only possible if no -other printer uses the same driver.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Win2K/XP "Local Security -Policies"</span></dt><dd><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Local Security Policies</em></span> may not +other printer uses the same driver.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939258"></a>Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Local Security Policies</em></span> may not allow the installation of unsigned drivers. "Local Security Policies" may not allow the installation of printer drivers at -all.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install -printers for all local users"</span></dt><dd><p>Windows XP handles SMB printers on a "per-user" basis. +all.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939297"></a>WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows XP handles SMB printers on a "per-user" basis. This means every user needs to install the printer himself. To have a printer available for everybody, you might want to use the built-in IPP client capabilities of WinXP. Add a printer with the print path of <span class="emphasis"><em>http://cupsserver:631/printers/printername</em></span>. Still looking into this one: maybe a "logon script" could automatically install printers for all -users.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"Print Change Notify" functions on -NT-clients</span></dt><dd><p>For "print change notify" functions on NT++ clients, +users.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939331"></a>"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>For "print change notify" functions on NT++ clients, these need to run the "Server" service first (re-named to <span class="emphasis"><em>File & Print Sharing for MS Networks</em></span> in -XP).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">WinXP-SP1</span></dt><dd><p>WinXP-SP1 introduced a <span class="emphasis"><em>Point and Print +XP).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939354"></a>WinXP-SP1</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>WinXP-SP1 introduced a <span class="emphasis"><em>Point and Print Restriction Policy</em></span> (this restriction doesn't apply to "Administrator" or "Power User" groups of users). In Group Policy -Object Editor: go to <span class="emphasis"><em>User Configuration --> -Administrative Templates --> Control Panel --> +Object Editor: go to <span class="emphasis"><em>User Configuration, + Administrative Templates, Control Panel, Printers</em></span>. The policy is automatically set to <span class="emphasis"><em>Enabled</em></span> and the <span class="emphasis"><em>Users can only Point and Print to machines in their Forest</em></span> . You probably need to change it to <span class="emphasis"><em>Disabled</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>Users can only Point and Print to these servers</em></span> in order to make -driver downloads from Samba possible.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't set and save default print options for all -users on Win2K/XP</span></dt><dd><p>How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way (it is not +driver downloads from Samba possible.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939398"></a>Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way (it is not very easy to find out, though). There are 3 different ways to bring you to a dialog that <span class="emphasis"><em>seems</em></span> to set everything. All three dialogs <span class="emphasis"><em>look</em></span> the same. Only one of them @@ -3650,13 +3163,13 @@ Do you see any difference? I don't either... However, only the last one, which you arrived at with steps "C.1.-6." will save any settings permanently and be the defaults for new users. If you want all clients to get the same defaults, you need to conduct these steps <span class="emphasis"><em>as -Administrator</em></span> (<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in +Administrator</em></span> (<a class="indexterm" name="id2939650"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) <span class="emphasis"><em>before</em></span> a client downloads the driver (the clients can later set their own <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user defaults</em></span> by following the procedures <span class="emphasis"><em>A.</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>B.</em></span> -above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">What are the most common blunders in driver -settings on Windows clients?</span></dt><dd><p>Don't use <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for +above).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939689"></a>Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Don't use <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for Speed</em></span>: use <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for Portability</em></span> instead (Adobe PS Driver) Don't use <span class="emphasis"><em>Page Independence: No</em></span>: always @@ -3668,8 +3181,8 @@ printer</em></span> (Adobe PS Driver). For <span class="emphasis"><em>TrueType Download Options</em></span> choose <span class="emphasis"><em>Outline</em></span>. Use PostScript Level 2, if you are having trouble with a non-PS printer, and if -there is a choice.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't make <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> work -with newly installed printer</span></dt><dd><p>Symptom: the last command of +there is a choice.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939734"></a><b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> does not work + with newly installed printer</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Symptom: the last command of <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> doesn't complete successfully: <b class="command">cmd = setdriver printername printername</b> result was NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL then possibly the printer was not yet @@ -3678,23 +3191,23 @@ Neighbourhood</em></span>? Did it show up in <b class="command">rpcclient hostname -c 'enumprinters'</b>? Restart smbd (or send a <b class="command">kill -HUP</b> to all processes listed by <b class="command">smbstatus</b> and try -again.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">My permissions on +again.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939796"></a>Permissions on <tt class="filename">/var/spool/samba/</tt> get reset after each -reboot</span></dt><dd><p>Have you by accident set the CUPS spool directory to +reboot</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you by accident set the CUPS spool directory to the same location? (<i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/samba/</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> or the other way round: <tt class="filename">/var/spool/cups/</tt> is set as -<i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939835"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i>> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section). These <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be different. Set <i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/cups/</tt></i> in -<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> and <i class="parameter"><tt>path = -/var/spool/samba</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2939874"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = +/var/spool/samba in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Otherwise cupsd will sanitize permissions to its spool directory with each restart, and -printing will not work reliably.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">My printers work fine: just the printer named "lp" +printing will not work reliably.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939905"></a>Printer named "lp" intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different -ones</span></dt><dd><p>It is a very bad idea to name any printer "lp". This -is the traditional Unix name for the default printer. CUPS may be set +ones</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is a very bad idea to name any printer "lp". This +is the traditional UNIX name for the default printer. CUPS may be set up to do an automatic creation of "Implicit Classes". This means, to group all printers with the same name to a pool of devices, and loadbalancing the jobs across them in a round-robin fashion. Chances @@ -3703,31 +3216,10 @@ receive his jobs and send your own to his device unwittingly. To have tight control over the printer names, set <i class="parameter"><tt>BrowseShortNames No</tt></i>. It will present any printer as "printername@cupshost" then, giving you a better control over what may happen in a large -networked environment.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">How do I "watch" my Samba server?</span></dt><dd><p>You can use <b class="command">tail -f -/var/log/samba/log.smbd</b> (you may need a different path) to -see a live scrolling of all log messages. <b class="command">smbcontrol smbd -debuglevel</b> tells you which verbosity goes into the -logs. <b class="command">smbcontrol smbd debug 3</b> sets the verbosity to -a quite high level (you can choose from 0 to 10 or 100). This works -"on the fly", without the need to restart the smbd daemon. Don't use -more than 3 initially; or you'll drown in an ocean of -messages.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't use Samba from my WinXP Home box, while -access from WinXP Prof works flawlessly</span></dt><dd><p>You have our condolences! WinXP home has been -completely neutered by Microsoft as compared to WinXP Prof: you can -not log into a WinNT domain. It cannot join a Win NT domain as a -member server. While it is possible to access domain resources, users -don't have "single sign-on". They need to supply username and password -each time they connect to a resource. Logon scripts and roaming -profiles are not supported. It can serve file and print shares; but -only in "share-mode security" level. It can not use "user-mode -security" (what Windows 95/98/ME still can -do).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Where do I find the Adobe PostScript driver files -I need for "cupsaddsmb"?</span></dt><dd><p>Use <b class="command">smbclient</b> to connect to any +networked environment.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939953"></a>Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use <b class="command">smbclient</b> to connect to any Windows box with a shared PostScript printer: <b class="command">smbclient //windowsbox/print\$ -U guest</b>. You can navigate to the <tt class="filename">W32X86/2</tt> subdir to <b class="command">mget ADOBE*</b> and other files or to <tt class="filename">WIN40/0</tt> to do the same. -- Another option is to download the <tt class="filename">*.exe</tt> packaged -files from the Adobe website.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2966041"></a>An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2966052"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.15. CUPS Printing Overview</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/a_small.png" alt="CUPS Printing Overview"></div></div><p> -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="printing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="VFS.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +files from the Adobe website.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940008"></a>An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="figure"><a name="a_small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.19. CUPS Printing Overview</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/a_small.png" width="270" alt="CUPS Printing Overview"></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="printing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="VFS.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html b/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html index 395be92345..ab34354e2d 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ClientConfig.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers"><link rel="next" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="StandAloneServer.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="optional.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ClientConfig"></a>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2901966">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2901966"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers"><link rel="next" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="StandAloneServer.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="optional.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ClientConfig"></a>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2893778">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893778"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="StandAloneServer.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="optional.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part III. Advanced Configuration</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="StandAloneServer.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="optional.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part III. Advanced Configuration</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html b/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html index dadf6b989a..1472c1925b 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/DNSDHCP.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning"><link rel="next" href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="speed.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Further-Resources.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="DNSDHCP"></a>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id3018605">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018605"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning"><link rel="next" href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="speed.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Further-Resources.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="DNSDHCP"></a>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id2964821">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964821"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="speed.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Further-Resources.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 41. Further Resources</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="speed.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Further-Resources.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 41. Further Resources</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html b/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html index dbb85dea6e..64c38702fd 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/FastStart.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA"><link rel="next" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="install.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="type.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="FastStart"></a>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2886744">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886744"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA"><link rel="next" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="install.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="type.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="FastStart"></a>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2884787">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884787"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="install.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="type.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part II. Server Configuration Basics</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="install.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="type.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part II. Server Configuration Basics</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html b/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html index 8030190ed4..8464c480c2 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Further-Resources.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 41. Further Resources</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="ix01.html" title="Index"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 41. Further Resources</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="DNSDHCP.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ix01.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Further-Resources"></a>Chapter 41. Further Resources</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 1, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id3018765">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id3020416">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id3020431">Books</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018765"></a>Websites</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 41. Further Resources</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="ix01.html" title="Index"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 41. Further Resources</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="DNSDHCP.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ix01.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Further-Resources"></a>Chapter 41. Further Resources</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 1, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2964888">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2965278">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964888"></a>Websites</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <a href="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/cifs.txt" target="_top"> <span class="emphasis"><em>CIFS: Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny</em></span> by "Hobbit"</a> </p></li><li><p> @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ <span class="emphasis"><em>WFWG: Password Caching and How It Affects LAN Manager Security</em></span> at Microsoft Knowledge Base </a> - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3020416"></a>Related updates from Microsoft</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2965278"></a>Related updates from Microsoft</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q92/5/88.asp" target="_top"> <span class="emphasis"><em>Enhanced Encryption for Windows 95 Password Cache</em></span> </a> @@ -97,4 +97,4 @@ <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q136/4/18.asp" target="_top"> <span class="emphasis"><em>Windows for Workgroups Sharing Updates</em></span> </a> - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3020431"></a>Books</h2></div></div><div></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="DNSDHCP.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ix01.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Index</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="DNSDHCP.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ix01.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Index</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html b/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html index 8938b84c42..8422c52073 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/InterdomainTrusts.html @@ -1,10 +1,11 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba"><link rel="next" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="securing-samba.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="msdfs.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="InterdomainTrusts"></a>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Rafal</span> <span class="surname">Szczesniak</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org">mimir@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933376">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933404">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933488">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933501">NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933586">NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933622">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933649">Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933790">Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933922">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933937">Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba"><link rel="next" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="securing-samba.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="msdfs.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="InterdomainTrusts"></a>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Rafal</span> <span class="surname">Szczesniak</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org">mimir@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawing</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911605">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911633">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911721">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911750">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911822">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911868">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912046">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912232">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912370">NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912476">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911584"></a><p> Samba-3 supports NT4 style domain trust relationships. This is feature that many sites will want to use if they migrate to Samba-3 from and NT4 style domain and do NOT want to adopt Active Directory or an LDAP based authentication back end. This section explains some background information regarding trust relationships and how to create them. It is now -possible for Samba-3 to NT4 trust (and vice versa), as well as Samba3 to Samba3 trusts. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933376"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +possible for Samba-3 to trust NT4 (and vice versa), as well as to create Samba3-to-Samba3 +trusts. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911605"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 can participate in Samba-to-Samba as well as in Samba-to-MS Windows NT4 style trust relationships. This imparts to Samba similar scalability as is possible with MS Windows NT4. @@ -14,10 +15,10 @@ database such as LDAP, and given it's ability to run in Primary as well as Backu modes, the administrator would be well advised to consider alternatives to the use of Interdomain trusts simply because by the very nature of how this works it is fragile. That was, after all, a key reason for the development and adoption of Microsoft Active Directory. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933404"></a>Trust Relationship Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911633"></a>Trust Relationship Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows NT3.x/4.0 type security domains employ a non-hierarchical security structure. The limitations of this architecture as it affects the scalability of MS Windows networking -in large organisations is well known. Additionally, the flat-name space that results from +in large organisations is well known. Additionally, the flat namespace that results from this design significantly impacts the delegation of administrative responsibilities in large and diverse organisations. </p><p> @@ -43,45 +44,91 @@ relationship, and WHITE and BLUE have a trust relationship, then it holds that t implied trust between the RED and BLUE domains. ie: Relationships are explicit and not transitive. </p><p> + New to MS Windows 2000 ADS security contexts is the fact that trust relationships are two-way by default. Also, all inter-ADS domain trusts are transitive. In the case of the RED, WHITE and BLUE domains above, with Windows 2000 and ADS the RED and BLUE domains CAN trust each other. This is an inherent feature of ADS domains. Samba-3 implements MS Windows NT4 style Interdomain trusts and interoperates with MS Windows 200x ADS security domains in similar manner to MS Windows NT4 style domains. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933488"></a>Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There are two steps to creating an interdomain trust relationship. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933501"></a>NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911721"></a>Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are two steps to creating an interdomain trust relationship. To effect a two-way trust +relationship it is necessary for each domain administrator to create a trust account for the +other domain to use in verifying security credentials. + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911738"></a> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911750"></a>Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For MS Windows NT4, all domain trust relationships are configured using the -<span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>. To affect a two way trust relationship it is -necessary for each domain administrator to make available (for use by an external domain) it's -security resources. This is done from the Domain User Manager Policies entry on the menu bar. -From the <span class="guimenu">Policy</span> menu, select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>, then -next to the lower box that is labelled <span class="guilabel">Permitted to Trust this Domain</span> are two -buttons, <span class="guibutton">Add</span> and <span class="guibutton">Remove</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Add</span> -button will open a panel in which needs to be entered the remote domain that will be able to assign -user rights to your domain. In addition it is necessary to enter a password -that is specific to this trust relationship. The password needs to be -typed twice (for standard confirmation). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933586"></a>NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>. This is done from the Domain User Manager Policies +entry on the menu bar. From the <span class="guimenu">Policy</span> menu, select +<span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>. Next to the lower box labelled +<span class="guilabel">Permitted to Trust this Domain</span> are two buttons, <span class="guibutton">Add</span> +and <span class="guibutton">Remove</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button will open a panel in which +to enter the name of the remote domain that will be able to assign access rights to users in +your domain. You will also need to enter a password for this trust relationship, which the +trusting domain will use when authenticating users from the trusted domain. +The password needs to be typed twice (for standard confirmation). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911822"></a>Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911833"></a> A trust relationship will work only when the other (trusting) domain makes the appropriate connections with the trusted domain. To consummate the trust relationship the administrator will launch the Domain User Manager, from the menu select Policies, then select Trust Relationships, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button that is next to the box that is labelled <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span>. A panel will open in which must be entered the name of the remote domain as well as the password assigned to that trust. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933622"></a>Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911868"></a>Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911877"></a><p> +A two-way trust relationship is created when two one-way trusts are created, one in each direction. +Where a one-way trust has been established between two MS Windows NT4 domains (let's call them +DomA and DomB) the following facilities are created: +</p><div class="figure"><a name="trusts1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 16.1. Trusts overview</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/trusts1.png" width="270" alt="Trusts overview"></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + DomA (completes the trust connection) Trusts DomB + </p></li><li><p> + DomA is the Trusting domain + </p></li><li><p> + DomB is the Trusted domain (originates the trust account) + </p></li><li><p> + Users in DomB can access resources in DomA + </p></li><li><p> + Users in DomA can NOT access resources in DomB + </p></li><li><p> + Global groups from DomB CAN be used in DomA + </p></li><li><p> + Global groups from DomA can NOT be used in DomB + </p></li><li><p> + DomB DOES appear in the logon dialog box on client workstations in DomA + </p></li><li><p> + DomA does NOT appear in the logon dialog box on client workstations in DomB + </p></li></ul></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Users / Groups in a trusting domain can NOT be granted rights, permissions or access + to a trusted domain. + </p></li><li><p> + The trusting domain CAN access and use accounts (Users / Global Groups) in the + trusted domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Administrators of the trusted domain CAN be granted admininstrative rights in the + trusting domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Users in a trusted domain CAN be given rights and privileges in the trusting + domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Trusted domain Global Groups CAN be given rights and permissions in the trusting + domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Global Groups from the trusted domain CAN be made members in Local Groups on + MS Windows domain member machines. + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912046"></a>Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This description is meant to be a fairly short introduction about how to set up a Samba server so that it could participate in interdomain trust relationships. Trust relationship support in Samba is in its early stage, so lot of things don't work yet. </p><p> -Each of the procedures described below is treated as they were performed with Windows NT4 Server on -one end. The remote end could just as well be another Samba-3 domain. It can be clearly seen, after -reading this document, that combining Samba-specific parts of what's written below leads to trust -between domains in purely Samba environment. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933649"></a>Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In order to set the Samba PDC to be the trusted party of the relationship first you need -to create special account for the domain that will be the trusting party. To do that, +Each of the procedures described below assumes the peer domain in the trust relationship is +controlled by a Windows NT4 server. However, the remote end could just as well be another +Samba-3 domain. It can be clearly seen, after reading this document, that combining +Samba-specific parts of what's written below leads to trust between domains in a purely Samba +environment. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="samba-trusted-domain"></a>Samba as the Trusted Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In order to set the Samba PDC to be the trusted party of the relationship you first need +to create a special account for the domain that will be the trusting party. To do that, you can use the 'smbpasswd' utility. Creating the trusted domain account is very similar to creating a trusted machine account. Suppose, your domain is called SAMBA, and the remote domain is called RUMBA. The first step @@ -89,9 +136,9 @@ will be to issue this command from your favourite shell: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -a -i rumba</tt></b> - New SMB password: XXXXXXXX - Retype SMB password: XXXXXXXX - Added user rumba$ +New SMB password: <b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXXX</tt></b> +Retype SMB password: <b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXXX</tt></b> +Added user rumba$ </pre><p> where <tt class="option">-a</tt> means to add a new account into the @@ -104,29 +151,29 @@ After issuing this command you'll be asked to enter the password for the account. You can use any password you want, but be aware that Windows NT will not change this password until 7 days following account creation. After the command returns successfully, you can look at the entry for the new account -(in the standard way depending on your configuration) and see that account's name is -really RUMBA$ and it has 'I' flag in the flags field. Now you're ready to confirm +(in the standard way as appropriate for your configuration) and see that account's name is +really RUMBA$ and it has the 'I' flag set in the flags field. Now you're ready to confirm the trust by establishing it from Windows NT Server. -</p><p> -Open <span class="application">User Manager for Domains</span> and from menu -<span class="guimenu">Policies</span> select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships...</span>. -Right beside <span class="guilabel">Trusted domains</span> list box press the +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2912170"></a><p> +Open <span class="application">User Manager for Domains</span> and from the +<span class="guimenu">Policies</span> menu, select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships...</span>. +Right beside the <span class="guilabel">Trusted domains</span> list box press the <span class="guimenu">Add...</span> button. You will be prompted for the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Type in SAMBA, as this is -your domain name, and the password used at the time of account creation. +the name of the remote domain, and the password used at the time of account creation. Press OK and, if everything went without incident, you will see <tt class="computeroutput">Trusted domain relationship successfully established</tt> message. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933790"></a>Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912232"></a>Samba as the Trusting Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This time activities are somewhat reversed. Again, we'll assume that your domain controlled by the Samba PDC is called SAMBA and NT-controlled domain is called RUMBA. </p><p> -The very first thing requirement is to add an account for the SAMBA domain on RUMBA's PDC. -</p><p> +The very first step is to add an account for the SAMBA domain on RUMBA's PDC. +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2912253"></a><p> Launch the <span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>, then from the menu select <span class="guimenu">Policies</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>. -Now, next to <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span> box press the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> -button, and type in the name of the trusted domain (SAMBA) and password securing +Now, next to the <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span> box press the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> +button, and type in the name of the trusted domain (SAMBA) and the password to use in securing the relationship. </p><p> The password can be arbitrarily chosen. It is easy to change the password @@ -138,38 +185,39 @@ Using your favourite shell while being logged in as root, issue this command: <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc trustdom establish rumba</tt></b> </p><p> You will be prompted for the password you just typed on your Windows NT4 Server box. -Do not worry if you see an error message that mentions a returned code of -<span class="errorname">NT_STATUS_NOLOGON_INTERDOMAIN_TRUST_ACCOUNT</span>. It means the +Do not worry if you see an error message that mentions a return code of +NT_STATUS_NOLOGON_INTERDOMAIN_TRUST_ACCOUNT. It means the password you gave is correct and the NT4 Server says the account is ready for interdomain connection and not for ordinary -connection. After that, be patient it can take a while (especially -in large networks), you should see the <tt class="computeroutput">Success</tt> message. +connection. After that, be patient; it can take a while (especially +in large networks), but eventually you should see the <tt class="computeroutput">Success</tt> message. Congratulations! Your trust relationship has just been established. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Note that you have to run this command as root because you must have write access to the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> file. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933922"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912370"></a>NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Although <span class="application">Domain User Manager</span> is not present in Windows 2000, it is +also possible to establish an NT4-style trust relationship with a Windows 2000 domain +controller running in mixed mode as the trusting server. It should also be possible for +Samba to trust a Windows 2000 server, however, more testing is still needed in this area. +</p><p> +After <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain" title="Samba as the Trusted Domain">creating the interdomain trust account on the +Samba server</a> as described above, open <span class="application">Active Directory Domains and +Trusts</span> on the AD controller of the domain whose resources you wish Samba users +to have access to. Remember that since NT4-style trusts are not transitive, if you want +your users to have access to multiple mixed-mode domains in your AD forest, you will need to +repeat this process for each of those domains. With <span class="application">Active Directory Domains +and Trusts</span> open, right-click on the name of the Active Directory domain that +will trust our Samba domain and choose <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>, then click on +the <span class="guilabel">Trusts</span> tab. In the upper part of the panel, you will see a list box +labelled <span class="guilabel">Domains trusted by this domain:</span>, and an +<span class="guilabel">Add...</span> button next to it. Press this button, and just as with NT4, you +will be prompted for the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Press OK, and +after a moment, Active Directory will respond with <tt class="computeroutput">The trusted domain has +been added and the trust has been verified.</tt> Your Samba users can now be +granted acess to resources in the AD domain. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912476"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Interdomain trust relationships should NOT be attempted on networks that are unstable or that suffer regular outages. Network stability and integrity are key concerns with distributed trusted domains. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933937"></a>Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Like many, I administer multiple LANs connected together using NT trust - relationships. This was implemented about 4 years ago. I now have the - occasion to consider performing this same task again, but this time, I - would like to implement it solely through samba - no Microsoft PDCs - anywhere. - </p><p> - I have read documentation on samba.org regarding NT-style trust - relationships and am now wondering, can I do what I want to? I already - have successfully implemented 2 samba servers, but they are not PDCs. - They merely act as file servers. I seem to remember, and it appears to - be true (according to samba.org) that trust relationships are a - challenge. - </p><p> - Please provide any helpful feedback that you may have. - </p><p> - These are almost complete in Samba 3.0 snapshots. The main catch - is getting winbindd to be able to allocate UID/GIDs for trusted - users/groups. See the updated Samba HOWTO collection for more - details. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="securing-samba.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="msdfs.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 15. Securing Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="securing-samba.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="msdfs.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 15. Securing Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html b/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html index f9c2539112..51a22f14fa 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/IntroSMB.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="next" href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="introduction.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="install.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="IntroSMB"></a>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 14, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885613">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885824">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885978">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886047">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886135">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886209">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="next" href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="introduction.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="install.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="IntroSMB"></a>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 14, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2817919">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2817978">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818169">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818237">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818345">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818430">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></div><p>“<span class="quote"> "If you understand what you're doing, you're not learning anything." -- Anonymous </span>”</p><p> @@ -7,7 +7,7 @@ transport protocol. In fact, it can support any SMB/CIFS-enabled client. One of strengths is that you can use it to blend your mix of Windows and Linux machines together without requiring a separate Windows NT/2000/2003 Server. Samba is actively being developed by a global team of about 30 active programmers and was originally developed by Andrew Tridgell. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885613"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2817919"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Once long ago, there was a buzzword referred to as DCE/RPC. This stood for Distributed Computing Environment/Remote Procedure Calls and conceptually was a good idea. It was originally developed by Apollo/HP as NCA 1.0 (Network Computing Architecture) and only @@ -33,7 +33,7 @@ been dutifully waded through during the information-gathering stages of this pro are *still* many missing pieces... While often tedious, at least the way has been generously littered with occurrences of clapping hand to forehead and muttering 'crikey, what are they thinking? -</em></span></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885824"></a>Terminology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +</em></span></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2817978"></a>Terminology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> SMB: Acronym for "Server Message Block". This is Microsoft's file and printer sharing protocol. </p></li><li><p> CIFS: Acronym for "Common Internet File System". Around 1996, Microsoft apparently @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ thinking? W3K: Acronym for Windows 2003 Server </p></li></ul></div><p>If you plan on getting help, make sure to subscribe to the Samba Mailing List (available at <a href="http://www.samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org</a>). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885978"></a>Related Projects</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2818169"></a>Related Projects</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are currently two network filesystem client projects for Linux that are directly related to Samba: SMBFS and CIFS VFS. These are both available in the Linux kernel itself. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -105,7 +105,7 @@ nothing to do with acting as a file and print server for SMB/CIFS clients. There are other Open Source CIFS client implementations, such as the <a href="http://jcifs.samba.org/" target="_top">jCIFS project</a> which provides an SMB client toolkit written in Java. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886047"></a>SMB Methodology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2818237"></a>SMB Methodology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Traditionally, SMB uses UDP port 137 (NetBIOS name service, or netbios-ns), UDP port 138 (NetBIOS datagram service, or netbios-dgm), and TCP port 139 (NetBIOS session service, or netbios-ssn). Anyone looking at their network with a good @@ -137,7 +137,7 @@ up a single file. In general, SMB sessions are established in the following orde A good way to examine this process in depth is to try out <a href="http://www.securityfriday.com/ToolDownload/SWB/swb_doc.html" target="_top">SecurityFriday's SWB program</a>. It allows you to walk through the establishment of a SMB/CIFS session step by step. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886135"></a>Epilogue</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2818345"></a>Epilogue</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> What's fundamentally wrong is that nobody ever had any taste when they did it. Microsoft has been very much into making the user interface look good, but internally it's just a complete mess. And even people who program for Microsoft @@ -166,9 +166,9 @@ not the completely clueless user who probably sits there shivering thinking That's what's really irritating to me." </span>”</p><p>-- <a href="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/boot.txt" target="_top">Linus Torvalds, from an interview with BOOT Magazine, Sept 1998</a> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886209"></a>Miscellaneous</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2818430"></a>Miscellaneous</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter is Copyright 2003 David Lechnyr (david at lechnyr dot com). Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/licenses/fdl.txt. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="introduction.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="install.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part I. General Installation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="introduction.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="install.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part I. General Installation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html b/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html index 72c6269f0e..b561492644 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/NT4Migration.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0"><link rel="next" href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SWAT.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NT4Migration"></a>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3001339">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3001368">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004043">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004381">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004462">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004704">Samba Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0"><link rel="next" href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SWAT.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NT4Migration"></a>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955644">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955669">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956108">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956323">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956414">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956670">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This is a rough guide to assist those wishing to migrate from NT4 domain control to Samba-3 based domain control. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001339"></a>Planning and Getting Started</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2955644"></a>Planning and Getting Started</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the IT world there is often a saying that all problems are encountered because of poor planning. The corollary to this saying is that not all problems can be anticipated and planned for. Then again, good planning will anticipate most show stopper type situations. @@ -9,65 +9,62 @@ and planned for. Then again, good planning will anticipate most show stopper typ Those wishing to migrate from MS Windows NT4 domain control to a Samba-3 domain control environment would do well to develop a detailed migration plan. So here are a few pointers to help migration get under way. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3001368"></a>Objectives</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955669"></a>Objectives</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The key objective for most organisations will be to make the migration from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 domain control as painless as possible. One of the challenges you may experience in your migration process may well be one of convincing management that the new environment should remain in place. Many who have introduced open source technologies have experienced pressure to return to a Microsoft based platform solution at the first sign of trouble. </p><p> -It is strongly advised that before attempting a migration to a Samba-3 controlled network -that every possible effort be made to gain all-round commitment to the change. Firstly, you -should know precisely <span class="emphasis"><em>why</em></span> the change is important for the organisation. -Possible motivations to make a change include: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Improve network manageability</td></tr><tr><td>Obtain better user level functionality</td></tr><tr><td>Reduce network operating costs</td></tr><tr><td>Reduce exposure caused by Microsoft withdrawal of NT4 support</td></tr><tr><td>Avoid MS License 6 implications</td></tr><tr><td>Reduce organisation's dependency on Microsoft</td></tr></table><p> -It is vital that it be well recognised that Samba-3 is NOT MS Windows NT4. Samba-3 offers -an alternative solution that is both different from MS Windows NT4 and that offers some -advantages compared with it. It should also be recognised that Samba-3 lacks many of the +Before attempting a migration to a Samba-3 controlled network make every possible effort to +gain all-round commitment to the change. Know precisely <span class="emphasis"><em>why</em></span> the change +is important for the organisation. Possible motivations to make a change include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Improve network manageability</p></li><li><p>Obtain better user level functionality</p></li><li><p>Reduce network operating costs</p></li><li><p>Reduce exposure caused by Microsoft withdrawal of NT4 support</p></li><li><p>Avoid MS License 6 implications</p></li><li><p>Reduce organisation's dependency on Microsoft</p></li></ul></div><p> +Make sure that everyone knows that Samba-3 is NOT MS Windows NT4. Samba-3 offers +an alternative solution that is both different from MS Windows NT4 and that offers +advantages compared with it. Gain recognition that Samba-3 lacks many of the features that Microsoft has promoted as core values in migration from MS Windows NT4 to MS Windows 2000 and beyond (with or without Active Directory services). </p><p> What are the features that Samba-3 can NOT provide? -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Active Directory Server</td></tr><tr><td>Group Policy Objects (in Active Directory)</td></tr><tr><td>Machine Policy objects</td></tr><tr><td>Logon Scripts in Active Directory</td></tr><tr><td>Software Application and Access Controls in Active Directory</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Active Directory Server</p></li><li><p>Group Policy Objects (in Active Directory)</p></li><li><p>Machine Policy objects</p></li><li><p>Logon Scripts in Active Directory</p></li><li><p>Software Application and Access Controls in Active Directory</p></li></ul></div><p> The features that Samba-3 DOES provide and that may be of compelling interest to your site includes: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Lower Cost of Ownership</td></tr><tr><td>Global availability of support with no strings attached</td></tr><tr><td>Dynamic SMB Servers (ie:Can run more than one server per Unix/Linux system)</td></tr><tr><td>Creation of on-the-fly logon scripts</td></tr><tr><td>Creation of on-the-fly Policy Files</td></tr><tr><td>Greater Stability, Reliability, Performance and Availability</td></tr><tr><td>Manageability via an ssh connection</td></tr><tr><td>Flexible choices of back-end authentication technologies (tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam)</td></tr><tr><td>Ability to implement a full single-sign-on architecture</td></tr><tr><td>Ability to distribute authentication systems for absolute minimum wide area network bandwidth demand</td></tr></table><p> -Before migrating a network from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 it is vital that all necessary factors are -considered. Users should be educated about changes they may experience so that the change will be a -welcome one and not become an obstacle to the work they need to do. The following are some of the -factors that will go into a successful migration: -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3002882"></a>Domain Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Lower Cost of Ownership</p></li><li><p>Global availability of support with no strings attached</p></li><li><p>Dynamic SMB Servers (ie:Can run more than one server per Unix/Linux system)</p></li><li><p>Creation of on-the-fly logon scripts</p></li><li><p>Creation of on-the-fly Policy Files</p></li><li><p>Greater Stability, Reliability, Performance and Availability</p></li><li><p>Manageability via an ssh connection</p></li><li><p>Flexible choices of back-end authentication technologies (tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam)</p></li><li><p>Ability to implement a full single-sign-on architecture</p></li><li><p>Ability to distribute authentication systems for absolute minimum wide area network bandwidth demand</p></li></ul></div><p> +Before migrating a network from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 consider all necessary factors. Users +should be educated about changes they may experience so that the change will be a welcome one +and not become an obstacle to the work they need to do. The following are factors that will +help ensure a successful migration: +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955881"></a>Domain Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 can be configured as a domain controller, a back-up domain controller (probably best called a secondary controller), a domain member, or as a stand-alone server. The Windows network security domain context should be sized and scoped before implementation. Particular attention needs to be paid to the location of the primary domain controller (PDC) as well as backup controllers (BDCs). -It should be noted that one way in which Samba-3 differs from Microsoft technology is that if one -chooses to use an LDAP authentication backend then the same database can be used by several different -domains. This means that in a complex organisation there can be a single LDAP database, that itself -can be distributed, that can simultaneously serve multiple domains (that can also be widely distributed). +One way in which Samba-3 differs from Microsoft technology is that if one chooses to use an LDAP +authentication backend then the same database can be used by several different domains. In a +complex organisation there can be a single LDAP database, which itself can be distributed (ie: Have +a master server and multiple slave servers) that can simultaneously serve multiple domains. </p><p> -It is recommended that from a design perspective, the number of users per server, as well as the number -of servers, per domain should be scaled according to needs and should also consider server capacity -and network bandwidth. +From a design perspective, the number of users per server, as well as the number of servers, per +domain should be scaled taking into consideration server capacity and network bandwidth. </p><p> -A physical network segment may house several domains, each of which may span multiple network segments. -Where domains span routed network segments it is most advisable to consider and test the performance -implications of the design and layout of a network. A Centrally located domain controller that is being -designed to serve multiple routed network segments may result in severe performance problems if the -response time (eg: ping timing) between the remote segment and the PDC is more than 100 ms. In situations -where the delay is too long it is highly recommended to locate a backup controller (BDC) to serve as -the local authentication and access control server. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3002935"></a>Server Share and Directory Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There are few cardinal rules to effective network design that can be broken with impunity. -The most important rule of effective network management is that simplicity is king in every -well controlled network. Every part of the infrastructure must be managed, the more complex -it is, the greater will be the demand of keeping systems secure and functional. +A physical network segment may house several domains. Each may span multiple network segments. +Where domains span routed network segments, consider and test the performance implications of +the design and layout of a network. A Centrally located domain controller that is designed to +serve multiple routed network segments may result in severe performance problems. Check the +response time (eg: ping timing) between the remote segment and the PDC. If long (more than 100 ms) +locate a backup controller (BDC) on the remote segmanet to serve as the local authentication and +access control server. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955930"></a>Server Share and Directory Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are cardinal rules to effective network design. These can not be broken with impunity. +The most important rule: Simplicity is king in every well controlled network. Every part of +the infrastructure must be managed, the more complex it is, the greater will be the demand +of keeping systems secure and functional. </p><p> -The nature of the data that must be stored needs to be born in mind when deciding how many -shares must be created. The physical disk space layout should also be taken into account -when designing where share points will be created. Keep in mind that all data needs to be -backed up, thus the simpler the disk layout the easier it will be to keep track of what must -be backed up to tape or other off-line storage medium. Always plan and implement for minimum +Keep in mind the nature of how data must be share. Physical disk space layout should be considered +carefully. Some data must be backed up. The simpler the disk layout the easier it will be to +keep track of backed needs. Identify what back media will be meet needs, consider backup to tape +, CD-ROM or (DVD-ROM), or other off-line storage medium. Plan and implement for minimum maintenance. Leave nothing to chance in your design, above all, do not leave backups to chance: Backup and test, validate every backup, create a disaster recovery plan and prove that it works. </p><p> @@ -75,54 +72,70 @@ Users should be grouped according to data access control needs. File and directo is best controlled via group permissions and the use of the "sticky bit" on group controlled directories may substantially avoid file access complaints from samba share users. </p><p> -Many network administrators who are new to the game will attempt to use elaborate techniques -to set access controls, on files, directories, shares, as well as in share definitions. -There is the ever present danger that that administrator's successor will not understand the -complex mess that has been inherited. Remember, apparent job security through complex design -and implementation may ultimately cause loss of operations and downtime to users as the new -administrator learns to untangle your web. Keep access controls simple and effective and -make sure that users will never be interrupted by the stupidity of complexity. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3002997"></a>Logon Scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Please refer to the section of this document on Advanced Network Administration for information -regarding the network logon script options for Samba-3. Logon scripts can help to ensure that -all users gain share and printer connections they need. +Inexperienced network administrators often attempt elaborate techniques to set access +controls on files, directories, shares, as well as in share definitions. +Keep your design and implementation simple and document your design extensively. Have others +audit your documentation. Do not create a complex mess that your successor will not understand. +Remember, job security through complex design and implementation may cause loss of operations +and downtime to users as the new administrator learns to untangle your knots. Keep access +controls simple and effective and make sure that users will never be interrupted by stupid +complexity. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955990"></a>Logon Scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Logon scripts can help to ensure that all users gain share and printer connections they need. </p><p> -Logon scripts can be created on-the-fly so that all commands executed are specific to the -rights and privileges granted to the user. The preferred controls should be affected through +Logon scripts can be created 'on-the-fly' so that all commands executed are specific to the +rights and priviliges granted to the user. The preferred controls should be affected through group membership so that group information can be used to custom create a logon script using -the <i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i> parameters to the <tt class="filename">NETLOGON</tt> share. +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2956012"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i> parameters to the <i class="parameter"><tt>NETLOGON</tt></i> share. </p><p> Some sites prefer to use a tool such as <b class="command">kixstart</b> to establish a controlled user environment. In any case you may wish to do a google search for logon script process controls. In particular, you may wish to explore the use of the Microsoft knowledgebase article KB189105 that deals with how to add printers without user intervention via the logon script process. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3003055"></a>Profile Migration/Creation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2956054"></a>Profile Migration/Creation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> User and Group Profiles may be migrated using the tools described in the section titled Desktop Profile Management. </p><p> Profiles may also be managed using the Samba-3 tool <b class="command">profiles</b>. This tool allows the MS Windows NT style security identifiers (SIDs) that are stored inside the profile NTuser.DAT file to be changed to the SID of the Samba-3 domain. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3004018"></a>User and Group Accounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2956084"></a>User and Group Accounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> It is possible to migrate all account settings from an MS Windows NT4 domain to Samba-3. Before attempting to migrate user and group accounts it is STRONGLY advised to create in Samba-3 the -groups that are present on the MS Windows NT4 domain <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> to connect these to -suitable Unix/Linux groups. Following this simple advice will mean that all user and group attributes +groups that are present on the MS Windows NT4 domain <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> to map these to +suitable Unix/Linux groups. By following this simple advice all user and group attributes should migrate painlessly. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3004043"></a>Steps In Migration Process</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956108"></a>Steps In Migration Process</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The approximate migration process is described below. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> You will have an NT4 PDC that has the users, groups, policies and profiles to be migrated </p></li><li><p> -Samba-3 set up as a DC with netlogon share, profile share, etc. -</p></li></ul></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 31.1. The Account Migration Process</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p>Create a BDC account for the samba server using NT Server Manager</p><ol type="a"><li><p>Samba must NOT be running</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>lsaquery</p></li><li><p>Note the SID returned</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net getsid -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note the SID</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note the SID, now check that all three SIDS reported are the same!</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -L</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note - did the users migrate?</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>initGrps.sh <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Now check that all groups are recognised</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note - check that all group membership has been migrated</p></li></ol></li></ol></div><p> -Now it is time to migrate all the profiles, then migrate all policy files. -More later. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3004381"></a>Migration Options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Based on feedback from many sites as well as from actual installation and maintenance -experience sites that wish to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba -based solution fit into three basic categories. -</p><div class="table"><a name="id3004398"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.1. The 3 Major Site Types</b></p><table summary="The 3 Major Site Types" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Number of Users</th><th>Description</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>< 50</td><td><p>Want simple conversion with NO pain</p></td></tr><tr><td>50 - 250</td><td><p>Want new features, can manage some in-house complexity</p></td></tr><tr><td>> 250</td><td><p>Solution/Implementation MUST scale well, complex needs. Cross departmental decision process. Local expertise in most areas</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3004462"></a>Planning for Success</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 set up as a DC with netlogon share, profile share, etc. Configure the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file +to fucntion as a BDC. ie: <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = No</tt></i>. +</p></li></ul></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 31.1. The Account Migration Process</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p>Create a BDC account for the samba server using NT Server Manager</p><ol type="a"><li><p>Samba must NOT be running</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -L</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note - did the users migrate?</p></li></ol></li><li><p> + Now assign each of the UNIX groups to NT groups: + (Note: It may be useful to copy this text to a script called + <tt class="filename">initGroups.sh</tt>) + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +#!/bin/bash +#### Keep this as a shell script for future re-use + +# First assign well known domain global groups +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=ntadmins +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Guests" unixgroup=nobody +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Users" unixgroup=users + +# Now for our added domain global groups +net groupmap add ntgroup="Designers" unixgroup=designers type=d rid=3200 +net groupmap add ntgroup="Engineers" unixgroup=engineers type=d rid=3210 +net groupmap add ntgroup="QA Team" unixgroup=qateam type=d rid=3220 +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Now check that all groups are recognised</p></li></ol></li></ol></div><p> +Now migrate all the profiles, then migrate all policy files. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2956323"></a>Migration Options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Sites that wish to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba based solution +generally fit into three basic categories. +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2956338"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.1. The 3 Major Site Types</b></p><table summary="The 3 Major Site Types" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Number of Users</th><th align="justify">Description</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">< 50</td><td align="justify"><p>Want simple conversion with NO pain</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">50 - 250</td><td align="justify"><p>Want new features, can manage some in-house complexity</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">> 250</td><td align="justify"><p>Solution/Implementation MUST scale well, complex needs. Cross departmental decision process. Local expertise in most areas</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956414"></a>Planning for Success</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are three basic choices for sites that intend to migrate from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -132,7 +145,7 @@ to Samba-3. </p></li><li><p> Complete Redesign (completely new solution) </p></li></ul></div><p> -No matter what choice you make, the following rules will minimise down-stream problems: +Minimise down-stream problems by: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Take sufficient time </p></li><li><p> @@ -141,62 +154,25 @@ No matter what choice you make, the following rules will minimise down-stream pr Test ALL assumptions </p></li><li><p> Test full roll-out program, including workstation deployment - </p></li></ul></div><div class="table"><a name="id3004535"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.2. Nature of the Conversion Choices</b></p><table summary="Nature of the Conversion Choices" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Simple</th><th>Upgraded</th><th>Redesign</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td><p>Make use of minimal OS specific features</p></td><td><p>Translate NT4 features to new host OS features</p></td><td><p>Decide:</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Suck all accounts from NT4 into Samba-3</p></td><td><p>Copy and improve:</p></td><td><p>Authentication Regime (database location and access)</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Make least number of operational changes</p></td><td><p>Make progressive improvements</p></td><td><p>Desktop Management Methods</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Take least amount of time to migrate</p></td><td><p>Minimise user impact</p></td><td><p>Better Control of Desktops / Users</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Live versus Isolated Conversion</p></td><td><p>Maximise functionality</p></td><td><p>Identify Needs for: Manageability, Scalability, Security, Availability</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Integrate Samba-3 then migrate while users are active, then Change of control (ie: swap out)</p></td><td><p>Take advantage of lower maintenance opportunity</p></td><td><p></p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3004704"></a>Samba Implementation Choices</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> -Authentication database back end - Winbind (external Samba or NT4/200x server) - Can use pam_mkhomedir.so to auto-create home dirs - External server could use Active Directory or NT4 Domain - -Database type - smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam - -Access Control Points - On the Share itself (Use NT4 Server Manager) - On the file system - Unix permissions on files and directories - Enable Posix ACLs in file system? - Through Samba share parameters - Not recommended - except as only resort - -Policies (migrate or create new ones) - Group Policy Editor (NT4) - Watch out for Tattoo effect - -User and Group Profiles - Platform specific so use platform tool to change from a Local - to a Roaming profile Can use new profiles tool to change SIDs - (NTUser.DAT) - -Logon Scripts (Know how they work) - -User and Group mapping to Unix/Linux - username map facility may be needed - Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups - Use pdbedit to set/change user configuration -NOTE: -If migrating to LDAP back end it may be easier to dump initial LDAP database -to LDIF, then edit, then reload into LDAP - - OS specific scripts / programs may be needed - Add / delete Users - Note OS limits on size of name (Linux 8 chars) - NT4 up to 254 chars - Add / delete machines - Applied only to domain members (note up to 16 chars) - Add / delete Groups - Note OS limits on size and nature - Linux limit is 16 char, - no spaces and no upper case chars (groupadd) - -Migration Tools - Domain Control (NT4 Style) - Profiles, Policies, Access Controls, Security - -Migration Tools - Samba: net, rpcclient, smbpasswd, pdbedit, profiles - Windows: NT4 Domain User Manager, Server Manager (NEXUS) - -Authentication - New SAM back end (smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam) -</pre><p> -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SWAT.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0 </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="table"><a name="id2956485"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.2. Nature of the Conversion Choices</b></p><table summary="Nature of the Conversion Choices" border="1"><colgroup><col align="justify"><col align="justify"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="justify">Simple</th><th align="justify">Upgraded</th><th align="justify">Redesign</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="justify"><p>Make use of minimal OS specific features</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Translate NT4 features to new host OS features</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Decide:</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Suck all accounts from NT4 into Samba-3</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Copy and improve:</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Authentication Regime (database location and access)</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Make least number of operational changes</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Make progressive improvements</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Desktop Management Methods</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Take least amount of time to migrate</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Minimise user impact</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Better Control of Desktops / Users</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Live versus Isolated Conversion</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Maximise functionality</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Identify Needs for: Manageability, Scalability, Security, Availability</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Integrate Samba-3 then migrate while users are active, then Change of control (ie: swap out)</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Take advantage of lower maintenance opportunity</p></td><td align="justify"><p></p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2956670"></a>Samba-3 Implementation Choices</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Authentication database/back end:</span></dt><dd><p> + Samba-3 can use an external authentication backend: + </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind (external Samba or NT4/200x server)</p></li><li><p>External server could use Active Directory or NT4 Domain</p></li><li><p>Can use pam_mkhomedir.so to auto-create home dirs</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><p> + Samba-3 can use a local authentication backend: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Access Control Points:</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>On the Share itself - using Share ACLs</p></li><li><p>On the file system - using UNIX permissions on files and directories</p><p>Note: Can Enable Posix ACLs in file system also</p></li><li><p>Through Samba share parameters - Not recommended - except as last resort</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">Policies (migrate or create new ones):</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Using Group Policy Editor (NT4)</p></li><li><p>- Watch out for Tattoo effect</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">User and Group Profiles:</span></dt><dd><p> + Platform specific so use platform tool to change from a Local to a Roaming profile + Can use new profiles tool to change SIDs (NTUser.DAT) + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Logon Scripts:</span></dt><dd><p> + Know how they work + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">User and Group mapping to Unix/Linux:</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>username map facility may be needed</p></li><li><p>Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups</p></li><li><p>Use pdbedit to set/change user configuration</p><p> + NOTE: When migrating to LDAP back, end it may be easier to dump initial + LDAP database to LDIF, then edit, then reload into LDAP + </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">OS specific scripts/programs may be needed:</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Add/Delete Users: Note OS limits on size of name + (Linux 8 chars) NT4 up to 254 chars</p></li><li><p>Add/Delete Machines: Applied only to domain members + (Note: Machine names may be limited to 16 characters)</p></li><li><p>Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups</p></li><li><p>Add/Delete Groups: Note OS limits on size and nature. + Linux limit is 16 char, no spaces and no upper case chars (groupadd)</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">Migration Tools:</span></dt><dd><p> + Domain Control (NT4 Style) Profiles, Policies, Access Controls, Security + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Samba: net, rpcclient, smbpasswd, pdbedit, profiles</p></li><li><p>Windows: NT4 Domain User Manager, Server Manager (NEXUS)</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="SWAT.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0 </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html b/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html index eb4d9858ca..4507c0067f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/NetworkBrowsing.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="next" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="optional.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="passdb.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NetworkBrowsing"></a>Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 5, 1998</p></div><div><p class="pubdate">Updated: April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903558">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903637">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903747">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903764">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903926">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904058">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904194">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904320">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904541">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904811">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904967">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904984">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905013">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905122">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905183">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905341">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905540">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905565">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905650">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905663">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905730">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905867">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905914">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906021">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906100">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906720">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906735">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906764">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="next" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="optional.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="passdb.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NetworkBrowsing"></a>Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 5, 1998</p></div><div><p class="pubdate">Updated: April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2893931">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894333">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894584">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894750">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894896">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895446">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895844">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896022">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896045">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896081">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896240">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896317">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896504">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896761">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896787">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896875">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896889">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896967">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897133">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897187">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897308">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897396">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898078">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898092">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898121">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898166">I get an Unable to browse the network error</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This document contains detailed information as well as a fast track guide to implementing browsing across subnets and / or across workgroups (or domains). WINS is the best tool for resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses. WINS is @@ -9,11 +9,11 @@ over TCP/IP. Samba-3 and later also supports this mode of operation. When the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP has been disabled then the primary means for resolution of MS Windows machine names is via DNS and Active Directory. The following information assumes that your site is running NetBIOS over TCP/IP. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903558"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893931"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Someone once referred to the past in terms of: <span class="emphasis"><em>They were the worst of times, they were the best of times. The more we look back, them more we long for what was and hope it never returns!</em></span>. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2893952"></a><p> For many MS Windows network administrators, that statement sums up their feelings about NetBIOS networking precisely. For those who mastered NetBIOS networking, its fickle nature was just par for the course. For those who never quite managed to tame its @@ -38,63 +38,55 @@ help Samba to affect stable WINS operations beyond the normal scope of MS WINS. </p><p> Please note that WINS is exclusively a service that applies only to those systems that run NetBIOS over TCP/IP. MS Windows 200x / XP have the capacity to turn off -support for NetBIOS, in which case WINS is of no relevance. Samba-3 supports this also. +support for NetBIOS, in which case WINS is of no relevance. Samba supports this also. </p><p> For those networks on which NetBIOS has been disabled (ie: WINS is NOT required) the use of DNS is necessary for host name resolution. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903637"></a>What is Browsing?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894019"></a>What is Browsing?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> To most people browsing means that they can see the MS Windows and Samba servers in the Network Neighborhood, and when the computer icon for a particular server is clicked, it opens up and shows the shares and printers available on the target server. </p><p> What seems so simple is in fact a very complex interaction of different technologies. The technologies (or methods) employed in making all of this work includes: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>MS Windows machines register their presence to the network</td></tr><tr><td>Machines announce themselves to other machines on the network</td></tr><tr><td>One or more machine on the network collates the local announcements</td></tr><tr><td>The client machine finds the machine that has the collated list of machines</td></tr><tr><td>The client machine is able to resolve the machine names to IP addresses</td></tr><tr><td>The client machine is able to connect to a target machine</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>MS Windows machines register their presence to the network</p></li><li><p>Machines announce themselves to other machines on the network</p></li><li><p>One or more machine on the network collates the local announcements</p></li><li><p>The client machine finds the machine that has the collated list of machines</p></li><li><p>The client machine is able to resolve the machine names to IP addresses</p></li><li><p>The client machine is able to connect to a target machine</p></li></ul></div><p> The Samba application that controls browse list management and name resolution is called <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt>. The configuration parameters involved in nmbd's operation are: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - - Browsing options: - ----------------- - * os level - lm announce - lm interval - * preferred master - * local master - * domain master - browse list - enhanced browsing - - Name Resolution Method: - ----------------------- - * name resolve order - - WINS options: - ------------- - dns proxy - wins proxy - * wins server - * wins support - wins hook -</pre><p> +</p><p>Browsing options: <a class="indexterm" name="id2894104"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894118"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894131"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894145"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894159"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894173"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894187"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894201"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enhanced browsing</tt></i>. +</p><p>Name Resolution Method: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894218"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>(*). +</p><p>WINS options: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894238"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dns proxy</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894251"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins proxy</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894265"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894279"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2894293"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins hook</tt></i>. +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2894308"></a><p> For Samba, the WINS Server and WINS Support are mutually exclusive options. Those marked with an '*' are the only options that commonly MAY need to be modified. Even if not one of these parameters is set <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> will still do it's job. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903747"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894333"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Firstly, all MS Windows networking uses SMB (Server Message Block) based messaging. SMB messaging may be implemented with or without NetBIOS. MS Windows 200x supports NetBIOS over TCP/IP for backwards compatibility. Microsoft is intent on phasing out NetBIOS support. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903764"></a>NetBIOS over TCP/IP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894349"></a>NetBIOS over TCP/IP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba implements NetBIOS, as does MS Windows NT / 200x / XP, by encapsulating it over TCP/IP. MS Windows products can do likewise. NetBIOS based networking uses broadcast messaging to affect browse list management. When running NetBIOS over TCP/IP, this uses UDP based messaging. UDP messages can be broadcast or unicast. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2894367"></a><p> Normally, only unicast UDP messaging can be forwarded by routers. The -<b class="command">remote announce</b> parameter to smb.conf helps to project browse announcements +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894378"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter to smb.conf helps to project browse announcements to remote network segments via unicast UDP. Similarly, the -<b class="command">remote browse sync</b> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894395"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> implements browse list collation using unicast UDP. </p><p> Secondly, in those networks where Samba is the only SMB server technology, @@ -102,12 +94,13 @@ wherever possible <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> should be configured on one (1) server. This makes it easy to manage the browsing environment. If each network segment is configured with it's own Samba WINS server, then the only way to get cross segment browsing to work is by using the -<b class="command">remote announce</b> and the <b class="command">remote browse sync</b> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894434"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2894448"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameters to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894474"></a> If only one WINS server is used for an entire multi-segment network then -the use of the <b class="command">remote announce</b> and the -<b class="command">remote browse sync</b> parameters should NOT be necessary. +the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2894484"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> and the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894498"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameters should NOT be necessary. </p><p> As of Samba 3 WINS replication is being worked on. The bulk of the code has been committed, but it still needs maturation. This is NOT a supported feature @@ -118,7 +111,7 @@ Right now Samba WINS does not support MS-WINS replication. This means that when setting up Samba as a WINS server there must only be one <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> configured as a WINS server on the network. Some sites have used multiple Samba WINS servers for redundancy (one server per subnet) and then used -<b class="command">remote browse sync</b> and <b class="command">remote announce</b> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894536"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2894552"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> to affect browse list collation across all segments. Note that this means clients will only resolve local names, and must be configured to use DNS to resolve names on other subnets in order to resolve the IP addresses of the servers they can see @@ -129,7 +122,10 @@ Lastly, take note that browse lists are a collection of unreliable broadcast messages that are repeated at intervals of not more than 15 minutes. This means that it will take time to establish a browse list and it can take up to 45 minutes to stabilise, particularly across network segments. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903926"></a>TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894584"></a>TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894596"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894604"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894613"></a> All TCP/IP using systems use various forms of host name resolution. The primary methods for TCP/IP hostname resolutions involves either a static file (<tt class="filename">/etc/hosts </tt>) or DNS (the Domain Name System). DNS is the technology that makes @@ -152,7 +148,7 @@ it follows a defined path: </p></li><li><p> Looks up entries in LMHOSTS. It is located in <tt class="filename">C:\WinNT\System32\Drivers\etc</tt>. - </p></li></ol></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2894710"></a><p> Windows 200x / XP can register it's host name with a Dynamic DNS server. You can force register with a Dynamic DNS server in Windows 200x / XP using: <b class="command">ipconfig /registerdns</b> @@ -165,8 +161,8 @@ consequently network services will be severely impaired. The use of Dynamic DNS is highly recommended with Active Directory, in which case the use of BIND9 is preferred for it's ability to adequately support the SRV (service) records that are needed for Active Directory. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904058"></a>DNS and Active Directory</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Occasionally we hear from Unix network administrators who want to use a Unix based Dynamic +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894750"></a>DNS and Active Directory</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2894758"></a><p> +Occasionally we hear from UNIX network administrators who want to use a UNIX based Dynamic DNS server in place of the Microsoft DNS server. While this might be desirable to some, the MS Windows 200x DNS server is auto-configured to work with Active Directory. It is possible to use BIND version 8 or 9, but it will almost certainly be necessary to create service records @@ -187,7 +183,7 @@ The following are some of the default service records that Active Directory requ </p></li><li><p>_ldap._tcp.<span class="emphasis"><em>Site</em></span>.gc.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>DomainTree</em></span></p><p> Used by MS Windows clients to locate site configuration dependent Global Catalog server. - </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904194"></a>How Browsing Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894896"></a>How Browsing Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows machines register their NetBIOS names (ie: the machine name for each service type in operation) on start up. The exact method by which this name registration @@ -201,7 +197,7 @@ resolution to the local subnet, unless LMHOSTS is used to list all names and IP addresses. In such situations Samba provides a means by which the Samba server name may be forcibly injected into the browse list of a remote MS Windows network (using the -<b class="command">remote announce</b> parameter). +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894933"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter). </p><p> Where a WINS server is used, the MS Windows client will use UDP unicast to register with the WINS server. Such packets can be routed @@ -229,20 +225,18 @@ will annoy users because they will have to put up with protracted inability to use the network services. </p><p> Samba supports a feature that allows forced synchronisation -of browse lists across routed networks using the <b class="command">remote -browse sync</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +of browse lists across routed networks using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2894996"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. This causes Samba to contact the local master browser on a remote network and to request browse list synchronisation. This effectively bridges two networks that are separated by routers. The two remote networks may use either broadcast based name resolution or WINS -based name resolution, but it should be noted that the <b class="command">remote -browse sync</b> parameter provides browse list synchronisation - and +based name resolution, but it should be noted that the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895025"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter provides browse list synchronisation - and that is distinct from name to address resolution, in other words, for cross subnet browsing to function correctly it is essential that a name to address resolution mechanism be provided. This mechanism could be via DNS, <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>, and so on. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904320"></a>Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="DMB"></a>Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To set up cross subnet browsing on a network containing machines in up to be in a WORKGROUP, not an NT Domain you need to set up one Samba server to be the Domain Master Browser (note that this is *NOT* @@ -261,20 +255,13 @@ workgroup name. To set up a Samba server as a domain master browser, set the following option in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> -The domain master browser should also preferrably be the local master +The domain master browser should also preferably be the local master browser for its own subnet. In order to achieve this set the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = yes - local master = yes - preferred master = yes - os level = 65 -</pre><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2895160"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.1. Domain master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> The domain master browser may be the same machine as the WINS server, if you require. @@ -288,20 +275,15 @@ to use these). To make a Samba server a local master browser set the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = yes - preferred master = yes - os level = 65 -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2895251"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.2. Local master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> Do not do this for more than one Samba server on each subnet, or they will war with each other over which is to be the local master browser. </p><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i> parameter allows Samba to act as a -local master browser. The <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> causes nmbd -to force a browser election on startup and the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2895317"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i> parameter allows Samba to act as a +local master browser. The <a class="indexterm" name="id2895334"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> causes nmbd +to force a browser election on startup and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895349"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter sets Samba high enough so that it should win any browser elections. </p><p> If you have an NT machine on the subnet that you wish to @@ -310,13 +292,8 @@ becoming a local master browser by setting the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = no - preferred master = no - os level = 0 -</pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904541"></a>Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2895389"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.3. smb.conf for not being a master browser</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895446"></a>Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you are adding Samba servers to a Windows NT Domain then you must not set up a Samba server as a domain master browser. By default, a Windows NT Primary Domain Controller for a domain @@ -328,18 +305,13 @@ with WINS instead of the PDC. For subnets other than the one containing the Windows NT PDC you may set up Samba servers as local master browsers as described. To make a Samba server a local master browser set -the following options in the <b class="command">[global]</b> section +the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = yes - preferred master = yes - os level = 65 -</pre><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2895495"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.4. Local master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> If you wish to have a Samba server fight the election with machines -on the same subnet you may set the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter +on the same subnet you may set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895556"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter to lower levels. By doing this you can tune the order of machines that will become local master browsers if they are running. For more details on this see the section <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master" title="Forcing Samba to be the master"> @@ -353,38 +325,33 @@ ever becoming a local master browser by setting following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = no - preferred master = no - os level = 0 -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2895612"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.5. smb.conf for not being a master browser</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="browse-force-master"></a>Forcing Samba to be the master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Who becomes the <i class="parameter"><tt>master browser</tt></i> is determined by an election +Who becomes the master browser is determined by an election process using broadcasts. Each election packet contains a number of parameters which determine what precedence (bias) a host should have in the election. By default Samba uses a very low precedence and thus loses elections to just about anyone else. </p><p> -If you want Samba to win elections then just set the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> global +If you want Samba to win elections then just set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895696"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to a higher number. It defaults to 0. Using 34 would make it win all elections over every other system (except other samba systems!) </p><p> -A <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> of 2 would make it beat WfWg and Win95, but not MS Windows +A <a class="indexterm" name="id2895722"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> of 2 would make it beat WfWg and Win95, but not MS Windows NT/2K Server. A MS Windows NT/2K Server domain controller uses level 32. </p><p>The maximum os level is 255</p><p> If you want Samba to force an election on startup, then set the -<i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. Samba will +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895748"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. Samba will then have a slight advantage over other potential master browsers that are not preferred master browsers. Use this parameter with care, as if you have two hosts (whether they are Windows 95 or NT or -Samba) on the same local subnet both set with <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to +Samba) on the same local subnet both set with <a class="indexterm" name="id2895778"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then periodically and continually they will force an election in order to become the local master browser. </p><p> -If you want Samba to be a <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master browser</tt></i>, then it is -recommended that you also set <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, because + If you want Samba to be a <span class="emphasis"><em>domain master browser</em></span>, then it is +recommended that you also set <a class="indexterm" name="id2895807"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, because Samba will not become a domain master browser for the whole of your LAN or WAN if it is not also a local master browser on its own broadcast isolated subnet. @@ -396,10 +363,10 @@ attempt to become the domain master browser every 5 minutes. They will find that another Samba server is already the domain master browser and will fail. This provides automatic redundancy, should the current domain master browser fail. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904811"></a>Making Samba the domain master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895844"></a>Making Samba the domain master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The domain master is responsible for collating the browse lists of multiple subnets so that browsing can occur between subnets. You can -make Samba act as the domain master by setting <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i> +make Samba act as the domain master by setting <a class="indexterm" name="id2895858"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = yes in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. By default it will not be a domain master. </p><p> Note that you should <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> set Samba to be the domain master for a @@ -411,8 +378,8 @@ master browsers on other subnets and then contact them to synchronise browse lists. </p><p> If you want Samba to be the domain master then I suggest you also set -the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> high enough to make sure it wins elections, and set -<i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, to get Samba to force an election on +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895904"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> high enough to make sure it wins elections, and set +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895919"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, to get Samba to force an election on startup. </p><p> Note that all your servers (including Samba) and clients should be @@ -438,31 +405,31 @@ If, however, both Samba and your clients are using a WINS server, then: resolve the NetBIOS name of that host. as long as that host has registered its NetBIOS name with the same WINS server, the user will be able to see that host. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904967"></a>Note about broadcast addresses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896022"></a>Note about broadcast addresses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If your network uses a "0" based broadcast address (for example if it ends in a 0) then you will strike problems. Windows for Workgroups does not seem to support a 0's broadcast and you will probably find that browsing and name lookups won't work. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904984"></a>Multiple interfaces</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896045"></a>Multiple interfaces</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba now supports machines with multiple network interfaces. If you -have multiple interfaces then you will need to use the <b class="command">interfaces</b> +have multiple interfaces then you will need to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896057"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to configure them. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905013"></a>Use of the Remote Announce parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter of +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896081"></a>Use of the Remote Announce parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2896090"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> can be used to forcibly ensure that all the NetBIOS names on a network get announced to a remote network. -The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - remote announce = a.b.c.d [e.f.g.h] ... -</pre><p> +The syntax of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896115"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce = a.b.c.d [e.f.g.h] ...</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - remote announce = a.b.c.d/WORKGROUP [e.f.g.h/WORKGROUP] ... -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce = a.b.c.d/WORKGROUP [e.f.g.h/WORKGROUP] ...</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> and -<i class="replaceable"><tt>e.f.g.h</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>is either the LMB (Local Master Browser) IP address +<i class="replaceable"><tt>e.f.g.h</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2896185"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896196"></a> + + is either the LMB (Local Master Browser) IP address or the broadcast address of the remote network. ie: the LMB is at 192.168.1.10, or the address could be given as 192.168.1.255 where the netmask @@ -478,22 +445,20 @@ NetBIOS machine names will end up looking like they belong to that workgroup, this may cause name resolution problems and should be avoided. </p></dd></dl></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905122"></a>Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896240"></a>Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2896250"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is used to announce to another LMB that it must synchronise its NetBIOS name list with our Samba LMB. It works ONLY if the Samba server that has this option is simultaneously the LMB on its network segment. </p><p> -The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter is: +The syntax of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896279"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -remote browse sync = <i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync = a.b.c.d</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> is either the IP address of the remote LMB or else is the network broadcast address of the remote segment. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905183"></a>WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896317"></a>WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Use of WINS (either Samba WINS <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> MS Windows NT Server WINS) is highly recommended. Every NetBIOS machine registers its name together with a name_type value for each of several types of service it has available. @@ -534,36 +499,34 @@ lookup attempts by other clients and will therefore cause workstation access errors. </p><p> To configure Samba as a WINS server just add -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> -file [globals] section. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896406"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +file [global] section. </p><p> To configure Samba to register with a WINS server just add -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = a.b.c.d</tt></i> to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file <i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i> section. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896434"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = a.b.c.d to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section. </p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p> -Never use both <i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> together -with <i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = a.b.c.d</tt></i> +Never use both <a class="indexterm" name="id2896466"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes together +with <a class="indexterm" name="id2896482"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = a.b.c.d particularly not using it's own IP address. Specifying both will cause <span class="application">nmbd</span> to refuse to start! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905341"></a>Setting up a WINS server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896504"></a>Setting up a WINS server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Either a Samba machine or a Windows NT Server machine may be set up as a WINS server. To set a Samba machine to be a WINS server you must add the following option to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file on the selected machine : -in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i> section add the line +in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section add the line </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - wins support = yes -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> Versions of Samba prior to 1.9.17 had this parameter default to yes. If you have any older versions of Samba on your network it is strongly suggested you upgrade to a recent version, or at the very least set the parameter to 'no' on all these machines. </p><p> -Machines with <i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> will keep a list of +Machines with <a class="indexterm" name="id2896564"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes will keep a list of all NetBIOS names registered with them, acting as a DNS for NetBIOS names. </p><p> You should set up only ONE WINS server. Do NOT set the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> option on more than one Samba +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896585"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes option on more than one Samba server. </p><p> To set up a Windows NT Server as a WINS server you need to set up @@ -575,7 +538,7 @@ participate in these replications. It is possible in the future that a Samba->Samba WINS replication protocol may be defined, in which case more than one Samba machine could be set up as a WINS server but currently only one Samba server should have the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> parameter set. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896621"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes parameter set. </p><p> After the WINS server has been configured you must ensure that all machines participating on the network are configured with the address @@ -586,17 +549,15 @@ in Windows 95 or Windows NT. To tell a Samba server the IP address of the WINS server add the following line to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of all <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - wins server = <name or IP address> -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = <name or IP address></tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> where <name or IP address> is either the DNS name of the WINS server machine or its IP address. </p><p> Note that this line MUST NOT BE SET in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file of the Samba server acting as the WINS server itself. If you set both the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> option and the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = <name></tt></i> option then +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896719"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes option and the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896734"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = <name> option then nmbd will fail to start. </p><p> There are two possible scenarios for setting up cross subnet browsing. @@ -604,13 +565,13 @@ The first details setting up cross subnet browsing on a network containing Windows 95, Samba and Windows NT machines that are not configured as part of a Windows NT Domain. The second details setting up cross subnet browsing on networks that contain NT Domains. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905540"></a>WINS Replication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896761"></a>WINS Replication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 permits WINS replication through the use of the <tt class="filename">wrepld</tt> utility. This tool is not currently capable of being used as it is still in active development. As soon as this tool becomes moderately functional we will prepare man pages and enhance this section of the documentation to provide usage and technical details. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905565"></a>Static WINS Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Adding static entries to your Samba-3 WINS server is actually fairly easy. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896787"></a>Static WINS Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Adding static entries to your Samba WINS server is actually fairly easy. All you have to do is add a line to <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt>, typically located in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var/locks</tt>. </p><p> @@ -639,10 +600,10 @@ To make it static, all that has to be done is set the TTL to 0: Though this method works with early Samba-3 versions, there's a possibility that it may change in future versions if WINS replication is added. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905650"></a>Helpful Hints</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896875"></a>Helpful Hints</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following hints should be carefully considered as they are stumbling points for many new network administrators. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905663"></a>Windows Networking Protocols</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896889"></a>Windows Networking Protocols</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Do NOT use more than one (1) protocol on MS Windows machines </p></div><p> A very common cause of browsing problems results from installing more than @@ -672,34 +633,27 @@ differently from MS Windows NT4. Generally, where a server does NOT support the newer or extended protocol, these will fall back to the NT4 protocols. </em></span></p><p> The safest rule of all to follow it this - USE ONLY ONE PROTOCOL! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905730"></a>Name Resolution Order</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896967"></a>Name Resolution Order</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses can take place using a number of methods. The only ones that can provide NetBIOS name_type information are: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>WINS: the best tool!</td></tr><tr><td>LMHOSTS: is static and hard to maintain.</td></tr><tr><td>Broadcast: uses UDP and can not resolve names across remote segments.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>WINS: the best tool!</p></li><li><p>LMHOSTS: is static and hard to maintain.</p></li><li><p>Broadcast: uses UDP and can not resolve names across remote segments.</p></li></ul></div><p> Alternative means of name resolution includes: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>: is static, hard to maintain, and lacks name_type info</td></tr><tr><td>DNS: is a good choice but lacks essential name_type info.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>: is static, hard to maintain, and lacks name_type info</p></li><li><p>DNS: is a good choice but lacks essential name_type info.</p></li></ul></div><p> Many sites want to restrict DNS lookups and want to avoid broadcast name -resolution traffic. The <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is -of great help here. The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> -parameter is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -name resolve order = wins lmhosts bcast host -</pre><p> +resolution traffic. The <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is of great help here. +The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = wins lmhosts bcast host</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -name resolve order = wins lmhosts (eliminates bcast and host) -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = wins lmhosts (eliminates bcast and host)</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> The default is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -name resolve order = host lmhost wins bcast -</pre><p> -where "host" refers the the native methods used by the Unix system +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = host lmhost wins bcast</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +where "host" refers to the native methods used by the UNIX system to implement the gethostbyname() function call. This is normally controlled by <tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905867"></a>Technical Overview of browsing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2897133"></a>Technical Overview of browsing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> SMB networking provides a mechanism by which clients can access a list -of machines in a network, a so-called <i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>. This list +of machines in a network, a so-called <a class="indexterm" name="id2897145"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>. This list contains machines that are ready to offer file and/or print services to other machines within the network. Thus it does not include machines which aren't currently able to do server tasks. The browse @@ -717,7 +671,7 @@ Where NetBIOS over TCP/IP is enabled use of a WINS server is highly recommended to aid the resolution of NetBIOS (SMB) names to IP addresses. WINS allows remote segment clients to obtain NetBIOS name_type information that can NOT be provided by any other means of name resolution. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905914"></a>Browsing support in Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2897187"></a>Browsing support in Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba facilitates browsing. The browsing is supported by <span class="application">nmbd</span> and is also controlled by options in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. Samba can act as a local browse master for a workgroup and the ability @@ -744,15 +698,15 @@ WINS server capabilities. In a Samba-only environment, it is recommended that you use one and only one Samba server as your WINS server. </p></div><p> To get browsing to work you need to run nmbd as usual, but will need -to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2897254"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to control what workgroup Samba becomes a part of. </p><p> Samba also has a useful option for a Samba server to offer itself for browsing on another subnet. It is recommended that this option is only used for 'unusual' purposes: announcements over the internet, for -example. See <i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> in the +example. See <a class="indexterm" name="id2897285"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906021"></a>Problem resolution</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2897308"></a>Problem resolution</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If something doesn't work then hopefully the log.nmbd file will help you track down the problem. Try a debug level of 2 or 3 for finding problems. Also note that the current browse list usually gets stored @@ -763,7 +717,7 @@ type the server name as <tt class="filename">\\SERVER</tt> in filemanager then hit enter and filemanager should display the list of available shares. </p><p> Some people find browsing fails because they don't have the global -<i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> set to a valid account. Remember that the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2897349"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> set to a valid account. Remember that the IPC$ connection that lists the shares is done as guest, and thus you must have a valid guest account. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em> @@ -777,7 +731,7 @@ server resources. The other big problem people have is that their broadcast address, netmask or IP address is wrong (specified with the "interfaces" option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906100"></a>Browsing across subnets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2897396"></a>Browsing across subnets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since the release of Samba 1.9.17(alpha1), Samba has supported the replication of browse lists across subnet boundaries. This section describes how to set this feature up in different settings. @@ -798,32 +752,14 @@ be they Windows 95, Windows NT, or Samba servers must have the IP address of a WINS server given to them by a DHCP server, or by manual configuration (for Win95 and WinNT, this is in the TCP/IP Properties, under Network settings) for Samba this is in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906150"></a>How does cross subnet browsing work ?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2897445"></a>How does cross subnet browsing work ?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Cross subnet browsing is a complicated dance, containing multiple moving parts. It has taken Microsoft several years to get the code that achieves this correct, and Samba lags behind in some areas. Samba is capable of cross subnet browsing when configured correctly. </p><p> -Consider a network set up as follows : -</p><p> - -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - (DMB) - N1_A N1_B N1_C N1_D N1_E - | | | | | - ------------------------------------------------------- - | subnet 1 | - +---+ +---+ - |R1 | Router 1 Router 2 |R2 | - +---+ +---+ - | | - | subnet 2 subnet 3 | - -------------------------- ------------------------------------ - | | | | | | | | - N2_A N2_B N2_C N2_D N3_A N3_B N3_C N3_D - (WINS) -</pre><p> -</p><p> + Consider a network set up as <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browsing1" title="Figure 10.1. Cross subnet browsing example">in the diagram below</a>. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="browsing1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 10.1. Cross subnet browsing example</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/browsing1.png" width="270" alt="Cross subnet browsing example"></div></div><p> Consisting of 3 subnets (1, 2, 3) connected by two routers (R1, R2) - these do not pass broadcasts. Subnet 1 has 5 machines on it, subnet 2 has 4 machines, subnet 3 has 4 machines. Assume @@ -865,7 +801,7 @@ At this point the browse lists look as follows (these are the machines you would see in your network neighborhood if you looked in it on a particular network right now). </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2906267"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.1. Browse subnet example 1</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 1" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2897579"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.1. Browse subnet example 1</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 1" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> Note that at this point all the subnets are separate, no machine is seen across any of the subnets. @@ -887,7 +823,9 @@ the MasterAnnouncement packet it schedules a synchronization request to the sender of that packet. After both synchronizations are done the browse lists look like : </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2906382"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.2. Browse subnet example 2</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 2" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2897692"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.2. Browse subnet example 2</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 2" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. </p><p> @@ -895,14 +833,17 @@ At this point users looking in their network neighborhood on subnets 1 or 2 will see all the servers on both, users on subnet 3 will still only see the servers on their own subnet. </p><p> -The same sequence of events that occured for N2_B now occurs +The same sequence of events that occurred for N2_B now occurs for the local master browser on subnet 3 (N3_D). When it synchronizes browse lists with the domain master browser (N1_A) it gets both the server entries on subnet 1, and those on subnet 2. After N3_D has synchronized with N1_C and vica-versa the browse lists look like. </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2906481"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.3. Browse subnet example 3</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 3" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2897805"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.3. Browse subnet example 3</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 3" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. </p><p> @@ -915,7 +856,13 @@ with the domain master browser (N1_C) and will receive the missing server entries. Finally - and as a steady state (if no machines are removed or shut off) the browse lists will look like : </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2906581"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.4. Browse subnet example 4</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 4" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2897922"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.4. Browse subnet example 4</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 4" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), +N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), +N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), +N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. </p><p> @@ -936,11 +883,11 @@ If either router R1 or R2 fails the following will occur: be able to access servers on its local subnet, by using subnet-isolated broadcast NetBIOS name resolution. The effects are similar to that of losing access to a DNS server. - </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2906720"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2898078"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many questions are asked on the mailing lists regarding browsing. The majority of browsing problems originate out of incorrect configuration of NetBIOS name resolution. Some are of particular note. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906735"></a>How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898092"></a>How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba's nmbd process controls all browse list handling. Under normal circumstances it is safe to restart nmbd. This will effectively flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache and cause it to be rebuilt. Note that this does NOT make certain that a rogue machine name will not re-appear @@ -950,8 +897,11 @@ want to clear a rogue machine from the list then every machine on the network wi shut down and restarted at after all machines are down. Failing a complete restart, the only other thing you can do is wait until the entry times out and is then flushed from the list. This may take a long time on some networks (months). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906764"></a>My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898121"></a>My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Your guest account is probably invalid for some reason. Samba uses the guest account for browsing in smbd. Check that your guest account is valid. -</p><p>See also <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="optional.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="passdb.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part III. Advanced Configuration </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p><p>See also <a class="indexterm" name="id2898142"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898166"></a>I get an <span class="errorname">Unable to browse the network</span> error</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This error can have multiple causes:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>There is no local master browser. Configure <span class="application">nmbd</span> + or any other machine to serve as local master browser.</p></li><li><p>You can not log onto the machine that is the local master + browser. Can you logon to it as guest user? </p></li><li><p>There is no IP connectivity to the local master browser. + Can you reach it by broadcast?</p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="optional.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="passdb.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part III. Advanced Configuration </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html b/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html index a5e7740cf0..dffa1122ac 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Other-Clients.html @@ -1,8 +1,7 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability"><link rel="next" href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Portability.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="speed.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Other-Clients"></a>Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jim</span> <span class="surname">McDonough</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">5 Mar 2001</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3015663">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017016">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017023">How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017102">How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017164">How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017260">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017268">Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017357">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017388">Configure WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017433">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017464">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017481">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017528">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017601">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017625">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id3017736">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></div><p>This chapter contains client-specific information.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3015663"></a>Macintosh clients?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Yes. <a href="http://www.thursby.com/" target="_top">Thursby</a> now has a CIFS Client / Server called <a href="http://www.thursby.com/products/dave.html" target="_top">DAVE</a> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability"><link rel="next" href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Portability.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="speed.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Other-Clients"></a>Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jim</span> <span class="surname">McDonough</span></h3><span class="contrib">OS/2</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">5 Mar 2001</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963189">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963267">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963275">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963359">Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963411">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963512">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963519">Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963610">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963639">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963692">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963730">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963747">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963794">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963867">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963891">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2964079">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></div><p>This chapter contains client-specific information.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963189"></a>Macintosh clients?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Yes. <a href="http://www.thursby.com/" target="_top">Thursby</a> now has a CIFS Client / Server called <a href="http://www.thursby.com/products/dave.html" target="_top">DAVE</a> </p><p> They test it against Windows 95, Windows NT and samba for compatibility issues. At the time of writing, DAVE was at version @@ -21,10 +20,8 @@ What Samba offers MS Windows users, these packages offer to Macs. For more info on these packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see <a href="http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html" target="_top">http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html</a> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3017016"></a>OS2 Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017023"></a>How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>A more complete answer to this question can be - found on <a href="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/warp.html" target="_top"> - http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/warp.html</a>.</p><p>Basically, you need three components:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>The File and Print Client ('IBM Peer')</td></tr><tr><td>TCP/IP ('Internet support') </td></tr><tr><td>The "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver ('TCPBEUI')</td></tr></table><p>Installing the first two together with the base operating +</p><p>Newer versions of the Macintosh (Mac OS X) include Samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963267"></a>OS2 Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963275"></a>Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Basically, you need three components:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The File and Print Client ('IBM Peer')</p></li><li><p>TCP/IP ('Internet support') </p></li><li><p>The "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver ('TCPBEUI')</p></li></ul></div><p>Installing the first two together with the base operating system on a blank system is explained in the Warp manual. If Warp has already been installed, but you now want to install the networking support, use the "Selective Install for Networking" @@ -39,14 +36,12 @@ packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see to the "Names List", or specify a WINS server ('NetBIOS Nameserver' in IBM and RFC terminology). For Warp Connect you may need to download an update for 'IBM Peer' to bring it on - the same level as Warp 4. See the webpage mentioned above.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017102"></a>How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You can use the free Microsoft LAN Manager 2.2c Client + the same level as Warp 4. See the webpage mentioned above.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963359"></a>Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You can use the free Microsoft LAN Manager 2.2c Client for OS/2 from <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/" target="_top"> ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/</a>. - See <a href="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/lanman.html" target="_top"> - http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/lanman.html</a> for - more information on how to install and use this client. In + In a nutshell, edit the file \OS2VER in the root directory of the OS/2 boot partition and add the lines:</p><pre class="programlisting"> 20=setup.exe @@ -57,14 +52,12 @@ packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see or NS2000 driver from <a href="ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/" target="_top"> ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/</a> instead. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017164"></a>How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>First, create a share called <i class="parameter"><tt>[PRINTDRV]</tt></i> that is + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963411"></a>Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>First, create a share called <i class="parameter"><tt>[PRINTDRV]</tt></i> that is world-readable. Copy your OS/2 driver files there. Note that the .EA_ files must still be separate, so you will need to use the original install files, and not copy an installed driver from an OS/2 system.</p><p>Install the NT driver first for that printer. Then, - add to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> a parameter, <i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map = - <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i></tt></i>. Then, in the file + add to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> a parameter, <a class="indexterm" name="id2963445"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i> = filename. Then, in the file specified by <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i>, map the name of the NT driver name to the OS/2 driver name as follows:</p><p><i class="parameter"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>nt driver name</tt></i> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>os2 driver name</tt></i>.<i class="replaceable"><tt>device name</tt></i></tt></i>, e.g.:</p><p><i class="parameter"><tt> @@ -74,7 +67,7 @@ packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see you the driver is not available. On the second attempt, it will work. This is fixed simply by adding the device name to the mapping, after which it will work on the first attempt. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3017260"></a>Windows for Workgroups</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017268"></a>Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use the latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft if you use Windows + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963512"></a>Windows for Workgroups</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963519"></a>Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use the latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft if you use Windows for Workgroups. </p><p>The early TCP/IP stacks had lots of bugs.</p><p> Microsoft has released an incremental upgrade to their TCP/IP 32-Bit @@ -89,7 +82,7 @@ fixed. New files include <tt class="filename">WINSOCK.DLL</tt>, <tt class="filename">TRACERT.EXE</tt>, <tt class="filename">NETSTAT.EXE</tt>, and <tt class="filename">NBTSTAT.EXE</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017357"></a>Delete .pwl files after password change</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963610"></a>Delete .pwl files after password change</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> WfWg does a lousy job with passwords. I find that if I change my password on either the unix box or the PC the safest thing to do is to delete the .pwl files in the windows directory. The PC will complain about not finding the files, but will soon get over it, allowing you to enter the new password. @@ -98,20 +91,20 @@ If you don't do this you may find that WfWg remembers and uses the old password, even if you told it a new one. </p><p> Often WfWg will totally ignore a password you give it in a dialog box. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017388"></a>Configure WfW password handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963639"></a>Configuring WfW password handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is a program call admincfg.exe on the last disk (disk 8) of the WFW 3.11 disk set. To install it type <b class="userinput"><tt>EXPAND A:\ADMINCFG.EX_ C:\WINDOWS\ADMINCFG.EXE</tt></b>. Then add an icon for it via the <span class="application">Program Manager</span> <span class="guimenu">New</span> Menu. This program allows you to control how WFW handles passwords. ie disable Password Caching etc -for use with <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017433"></a>Case handling of passwords</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows for Workgroups uppercases the password before sending it to the server. Unix passwords can be case-sensitive though. Check the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">smb.conf(5)</a> information on <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> to specify what characters samba should try to uppercase when checking.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017464"></a>Use TCP/IP as default protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To support print queue reporting you may find +for use with <a class="indexterm" name="id2963677"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963692"></a>Case handling of passwords</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows for Workgroups uppercases the password before sending it to the server. Unix passwords can be case-sensitive though. Check the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> information on <a class="indexterm" name="id2963713"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> to specify what characters samba should try to uppercase when checking.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963730"></a>Use TCP/IP as default protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To support print queue reporting you may find that you have to use TCP/IP as the default protocol under WfWg. For some reason if you leave NetBEUI as the default it may break the print queue reporting on some systems. -It is presumably a WfWg bug.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017481"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Note that some people have found that setting <i class="parameter"><tt>DefaultRcvWindow</tt></i> in +It is presumably a WfWg bug.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963747"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Note that some people have found that setting <i class="parameter"><tt>DefaultRcvWindow</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[MSTCP]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">SYSTEM.INI</tt> file under WfWg to 3072 gives a big improvement. I don't know why. @@ -121,7 +114,7 @@ performance with a large value (16384 or larger). Other people have reported that anything over 3072 slows things down enormously. One person even reported a speed drop of a factor of 30 when he went from 3072 to 8192. I don't know why. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3017528"></a>Windows '95/'98</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963794"></a>Windows '95/'98</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When using Windows 95 OEM SR2 the following updates are recommended where Samba is being used. Please NOTE that the above change will affect you once these updates have been installed. @@ -135,11 +128,11 @@ install the <b class="command">OLEUPD.EXE</b> fix. This fix may stop your machine from hanging for an extended period when exiting Outlook and you may also notice a significant speedup when accessing network neighborhood services. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3017601"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963867"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Configure the win95 TCPIP registry settings to give better performance. I use a program called <b class="command">MTUSPEED.exe</b> which I got off the net. There are various other utilities of this type freely available. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3017625"></a>Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963891"></a>Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are several annoyances with Windows 2000 SP2. One of which only appears when using a Samba server to host user profiles to Windows 2000 SP2 clients in a Windows domain. This assumes @@ -148,26 +141,19 @@ likely occur if it is not. </p><p> In order to serve profiles successfully to Windows 2000 SP2 clients (when not operating as a PDC), Samba must have -<i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support = no</tt></i> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2963913"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> = no added to the file share which houses the roaming profiles. If this is not done, then the Windows 2000 SP2 client will complain about not being able to access the profile (Access Denied) and create multiple copies of it on disk (DOMAIN.user.001, DOMAIN.user.002, etc...). See the -<a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">smb.conf(5)</a> man page +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more details on this option. Also note that the -<i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter was formally a global parameter in +<a class="indexterm" name="id2963940"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter was formally a global parameter in releases prior to Samba 2.2.2. </p><p> The following is a minimal profile share: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - [profile] - path = /export/profile - create mask = 0600 - directory mask = 0700 - nt acl support = no - read only = no -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2963963"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 38.1. Minimal profile share</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[profile]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export/profile</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask = 0600</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask = 0700</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> The reason for this bug is that the Win2k SP2 client copies the security descriptor for the profile which contains the Samba server's SID, and not the domain SID. The client @@ -175,12 +161,12 @@ compares the SID for SAMBA\user and realizes it is different that the one assigned to DOMAIN\user. Hence the reason for the <span class="errorname">access denied</span> message. </p><p> -By disabling the <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter, Samba will send +By disabling the <a class="indexterm" name="id2964043"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter, Samba will send the Win2k client a response to the QuerySecurityDescriptor trans2 call which causes the client to set a default ACL for the profile. This default ACL includes </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DOMAIN\user "Full Control"</em></span>></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This bug does not occur when using winbind to -create accounts on the Samba host for Domain users.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3017736"></a>Windows NT 3.1</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>If you have problems communicating across routers with Windows -NT 3.1 workstations, read <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;%5BLN%5D;Q103765" target="_top">this Microsoft Knowledge Base article</a>. +create accounts on the Samba host for Domain users.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964079"></a>Windows NT 3.1</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>If you have problems communicating across routers with Windows +NT 3.1 workstations, read <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;Q103765" target="_top">this Microsoft Knowledge Base article</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Portability.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="speed.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 37. Portability </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Portability.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="speed.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 37. Portability </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html b/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html index 775cd6cc16..754ca9b686 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/PolicyMgmt.html @@ -1,10 +1,10 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management"><link rel="next" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="PolicyMgmt"></a>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2984380">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2984435">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986217">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986312">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986445">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986697">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986798">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986819">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986839">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986883">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2987030">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2987044">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management"><link rel="next" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="PolicyMgmt"></a>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944479">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944538">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944652">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944748">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944880">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945132">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945238">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945277">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945301">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945346">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945496">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945511">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This chapter summarises the current state of knowledge derived from personal practice and knowledge from samba mailing list subscribers. Before reproduction of posted information effort has been made to validate the information provided. Where additional information was uncovered through this validation it is provided also. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984380"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944479"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When MS Windows NT3.5 was introduced the hot new topic was the ability to implement Group Policies for users and group. Then along came MS Windows NT4 and a few sites started to adopt this capability. How do we know that? By way of the number of "booboos" @@ -23,9 +23,9 @@ the deployment in many sites. This chapter reviews techniques and methods that c be used to exploit opportunities for automation of control over user desktops and network client workstations. </p><p> -A tool new to Samba-3 may become an important part of the future Samba Administrators' +A tool new to Samba may become an important part of the future Samba Administrators' arsenal. The <b class="command">editreg</b> tool is described in this document. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984435"></a>Creating and Managing System Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944538"></a>Creating and Managing System Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Under MS Windows platforms, particularly those following the release of MS Windows NT4 and MS Windows 95) it is possible to create a type of file that would be placed in the NETLOGON share of a domain controller. As the client logs onto the network @@ -54,13 +54,13 @@ be a step forward, but improved functionality comes at a great price. Before embarking on the configuration of network and system policies it is highly advisable to read the documentation available from Microsoft's web site regarding <a href="http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp" target="_top"> -Implementing Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0 from http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp</a> available from Microsoft. +Implementing Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0</a> available from Microsoft. There are a large number of documents in addition to this old one that should also be read and understood. Try searching on the Microsoft web site for "Group Policies". </p><p> What follows is a very brief discussion with some helpful notes. The information provided here is incomplete - you are warned. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986217"></a>Windows 9x/Me Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944652"></a>Windows 9x/Me Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You need the Win98 Group Policy Editor to set Group Profiles up under Windows 9x/Me. It can be found on the Original full product Win98 installation CD under <tt class="filename">tools/reskit/netadmin/poledit</tt>. Install this using the @@ -86,7 +86,7 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. <tt class="filename">grouppol.inf</tt>. Log off and on again a couple of times and see if Win98 picks up group policies. Unfortunately this needs to be done on every Win9x/Me machine that uses group policies. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986312"></a>Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944748"></a>Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To create or edit <tt class="filename">ntconfig.pol</tt> you must use the NT Server Policy Editor, <b class="command">poledit.exe</b> which is included with NT4 Server but <span class="emphasis"><em>not NT Workstation</em></span>. There is a Policy Editor on a NT4 @@ -107,14 +107,14 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. be extracted as well. It is also possible to downloaded the policy template files for Office97 and get a copy of the policy editor. Another possible location is with the Zero Administration Kit available for download from Microsoft. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2986421"></a>Registry Spoiling</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944857"></a>Registry Spoiling</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> With NT4 style registry based policy changes, a large number of settings are not automatically reversed as the user logs off. Since the settings that were in the NTConfig.POL file were applied to the client machine registry and that apply to the hive key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE are permanent until explicitly reversed. This is known as tattooing. It can have serious consequences down-stream and the administrator must be extremely careful not to lock out the ability to manage the machine at a later date. - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986445"></a>MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944880"></a>MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Windows NT4 System policies allows setting of registry parameters specific to users, groups and computers (client workstations) that are members of the NT4 style domain. Such policy file will work with MS Windows 2000 / XP clients also. @@ -151,7 +151,7 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. to any number of concurrently applicable (and applied) policy sets (GPOs). Active Directory allows the administrator to also set filters over the policy settings. No such equivalent capability exists with NT4 style policy files. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2986546"></a>Administration of Win2K / XP Policies</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944981"></a>Administration of Win2K / XP Policies</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Instead of using the tool called <span class="application">The System Policy Editor</span>, commonly called Poledit (from the executable name <b class="command">poledit.exe</b>), <span class="acronym">GPOs</span> are created and managed using a <span class="application">Microsoft Management Console</span> <span class="acronym">(MMC)</span> snap-in as follows:</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -177,10 +177,10 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. The MS Windows 2000 Resource Kit contains a tool called gpolmig.exe. This tool can be used to migrate an NT4 NTConfig.POL file into a Windows 200x style GPO. Be VERY careful how you use this powerful tool. Please refer to the resource kit manuals for specific usage information. - </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2986697"></a>Managing Account/User Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945132"></a>Managing Account/User Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Policies can define a specific user's settings or the settings for a group of users. The resulting policy file contains the registry settings for all users, groups, and computers that will be using -the policy file. Separate policy files for each user, group, or computer are not not necessary. +the policy file. Separate policy files for each user, group, or computer are not necessary. </p><p> If you create a policy that will be automatically downloaded from validating domain controllers, you should name the file NTconfig.POL. As system administrator, you have the option of renaming the @@ -203,20 +203,27 @@ in a manner that works in conjunction with user profiles, the user management en MS Windows NT4/200x/XP allows per domain as well as per user account restrictions to be applied. Common restrictions that are frequently used includes: </p><p> -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Logon Hours</td></tr><tr><td>Password Aging</td></tr><tr><td>Permitted Logon from certain machines only</td></tr><tr><td>Account type (Local or Global)</td></tr><tr><td>User Rights</td></tr></table><p> -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986798"></a>Samba Editreg Toolset</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Describe in detail the benefits of <b class="command">editreg</b> and how to use it. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986819"></a>Windows NT4/200x</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Logon Hours</p></li><li><p>Password Aging</p></li><li><p>Permitted Logon from certain machines only</p></li><li><p>Account type (Local or Global)</p></li><li><p>User Rights</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945238"></a>Samba Editreg Toolset</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A new tool called <b class="command">editreg</b> is under development. This tool can be used + to edit registry files (called NTUser.DAT) that are stored in user and group profiles. + NTConfig.POL files have the same structure as the NTUser.DAT file and can be editted using + this tool. <b class="command">editreg</b> is being built with the intent to enable NTConfig.POL + files to be saved in text format and to permit the building of new NTConfig.POL files with + extended capabilities. It is proving difficult to realise this capability, so do not be surprised + if this feature does not materialise. Formal capabilities will be announced at the time that + this tool is released for production use. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945277"></a>Windows NT4/200x</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The tools that may be used to configure these types of controls from the MS Windows environment are: The NT4 User Manager for domains, the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor, the registry editor (regedt32.exe). Under MS Windows 200x/XP this is done using the Microsoft Management Console (MMC) with appropriate "snap-ins", the registry editor, and potentially also the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986839"></a>Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945301"></a>Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> With a Samba Domain Controller, the new tools for managing of user account and policy information includes: <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>, <b class="command">pdbedit</b>, <b class="command">net</b>, <b class="command">rpcclient</b>. The administrator should read the man pages for these tools and become familiar with their use. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2986883"></a>System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945346"></a>System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following attempts to document the order of processing of system and user policies following a system reboot and as part of the user logon: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -225,7 +232,7 @@ reboot and as part of the user logon: </p></li><li><p> Where Active Directory is involved, an ordered list of Group Policy Objects (GPOs) is downloaded and applied. The list may include GPOs that: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Apply to the location of machines in a Directory</td></tr><tr><td>Apply only when settings have changed</td></tr><tr><td>Depend on configuration of scope of applicability: local, site, domain, organizational unit, etc.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Apply to the location of machines in a Directory</p></li><li><p>Apply only when settings have changed</p></li><li><p>Depend on configuration of scope of applicability: local, site, domain, organizational unit, etc.</p></li></ul></div><p> No desktop user interface is presented until the above have been processed. </p></li><li><p> Execution of start-up scripts (hidden and synchronous by default). @@ -236,7 +243,7 @@ reboot and as part of the user logon: </p></li><li><p> An ordered list of User GPOs is obtained. The list contents depends on what is configured in respect of: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Is user a domain member, thus subject to particular policies</td></tr><tr><td>Loopback enablement, and the state of the loopback policy (Merge or Replace)</td></tr><tr><td>Location of the Active Directory itself</td></tr><tr><td>Has the list of GPOs changed. No processing is needed if not changed.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Is user a domain member, thus subject to particular policies</p></li><li><p>Loopback enablement, and the state of the loopback policy (Merge or Replace)</p></li><li><p>Location of the Active Directory itself</p></li><li><p>Has the list of GPOs changed. No processing is needed if not changed.</p></li></ul></div><p> </p></li><li><p> User Policies are applied from Active Directory. Note: There are several types. </p></li><li><p> @@ -246,15 +253,15 @@ reboot and as part of the user logon: </p></li><li><p> The User Interface as determined from the GPOs is presented. Note: In a Samba domain (like and NT4 Domain) machine (system) policies are applied at start-up, User policies are applied at logon. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2987030"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945496"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Policy related problems can be very difficult to diagnose and even more difficult to rectify. The following collection demonstrates only basic issues. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2987044"></a>Policy Does Not Work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Question: We have created the <tt class="filename">config.pol</tt> file and put it in the <span class="emphasis"><em>NETLOGON</em></span> share. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945511"></a>Policy Does Not Work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">We have created the <tt class="filename">config.pol</tt> file and put it in the <span class="emphasis"><em>NETLOGON</em></span> share. It has made no difference to our Win XP Pro machines, they just don't see it. IT worked fine with Win 98 but does not -work any longer since we upgraded to Win XP Pro. Any hints? +work any longer since we upgraded to Win XP Pro. Any hints?</span>” </p><p> -<span class="emphasis"><em>ANSWER:</em></span> Policy files are NOT portable between Windows 9x / Me and MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP based +Policy files are NOT portable between Windows 9x / Me and MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP based platforms. You need to use the NT4 Group Policy Editor to create a file called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> so that it is in the correct format for your MS Windows XP Pro clients. -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html b/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html index bb2c20ac9f..50d14207d0 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Portability.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 37. Portability</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA"><link rel="next" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 37. Portability</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="compiling.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Other-Clients.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Portability"></a>Chapter 37. Portability</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3013478">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016009">SCO Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016039">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016210">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016254">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016261">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016287">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id3016294">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>Samba works on a wide range of platforms but the interface all the +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 37. Portability</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile Samba"><link rel="next" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 37. Portability</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="compiling.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Other-Clients.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Portability"></a>Chapter 37. Portability</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962662">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962750">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962780">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962953">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962995">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963002">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963029">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963036">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>Samba works on a wide range of platforms but the interface all the platforms provide is not always compatible. This chapter contains -platform-specific information about compiling and using samba.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3013478"></a>HPUX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +platform-specific information about compiling and using samba.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962662"></a>HPUX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> HP's implementation of supplementary groups is, er, non-standard (for hysterical reasons). There are two group files, <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/logingroup</tt>; the system maps UIDs to numbers using the former, but @@ -20,15 +20,15 @@ allowed range. On HPUX you must use gcc or the HP ANSI compiler. The free compiler that comes with HP-UX is not ANSI compliant and cannot compile Samba. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3016009"></a>SCO Unix</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you run an old version of SCO Unix then you may need to get important +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962750"></a>SCO UNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you run an old version of SCO UNIX then you may need to get important TCP/IP patches for Samba to work correctly. Without the patch, you may encounter corrupt data transfers using samba. </p><p> The patch you need is UOD385 Connection Drivers SLS. It is available from SCO (<a href="ftp://ftp.sco.com/" target="_top">ftp.sco.com</a>, directory SLS, files uod385a.Z and uod385a.ltr.Z). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3016039"></a>DNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962780"></a>DNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> DNIX has a problem with seteuid() and setegid(). These routines are needed for Samba to work correctly, but they were left out of the DNIX C library for some reason. @@ -73,8 +73,8 @@ _seteuid: </pre><p> after creating the above files you then assemble them using </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as seteuid.s</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as setegid.s</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as seteuid.s</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as setegid.s</tt></b> </pre><p> that should produce the files <tt class="filename">seteuid.o</tt> and <tt class="filename">setegid.o</tt> @@ -87,7 +87,7 @@ LIBSM = setegid.o seteuid.o -ln You should then remove the line: </p><pre class="programlisting"> #define NO_EID -</pre><p>from the DNIX section of <tt class="filename">includes.h</tt></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3016210"></a>RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre><p>from the DNIX section of <tt class="filename">includes.h</tt></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962953"></a>RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> By default RedHat Rembrandt-II during installation adds an entry to <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> as follows: </p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -101,10 +101,10 @@ is the master browse list holder and who is the master browser. </p><p> Corrective Action: Delete the entry after the word loopback in the line starting 127.0.0.1 -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3016254"></a>AIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3016261"></a>Sequential Read Ahead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962995"></a>AIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963002"></a>Sequential Read Ahead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Disabling Sequential Read Ahead using <b class="userinput"><tt>vmtune -r 0</tt></b> improves Samba performance significantly. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3016287"></a>Solaris</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3016294"></a>Locking improvements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Some people have been experiencing problems with F_SETLKW64/fcntl +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2963029"></a>Solaris</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2963036"></a>Locking improvements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Some people have been experiencing problems with F_SETLKW64/fcntl when running Samba on Solaris. The built in file locking mechanism was not scalable. Performance would degrade to the point where processes would get into loops of trying to lock a file. It would try a lock, then fail, @@ -125,4 +125,4 @@ and rebuild samba. Nsswitch on Solaris 9 refuses to use the winbind nss module. This behavior is fixed by Sun in patch 113476-05 which as of March 2003 is not in any roll-up packages. -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="compiling.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Other-Clients.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="compiling.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Other-Clients.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 36. How to compile Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html b/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html index 0b9a40df62..765ae4b0c4 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ProfileMgmt.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies"><link rel="next" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pam.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ProfileMgmt"></a>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988251">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988285">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988326">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988731">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989902">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989967">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990232">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990290">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990336">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990356">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990504">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991058">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991562">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991575">How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991638">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991859">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2988251"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies"><link rel="next" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pam.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ProfileMgmt"></a>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945611">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945646">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945686">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946178">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947427">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947512">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947770">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947828">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947873">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947893">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948045">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948600">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949100">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949130">Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949201">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949414">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945611"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Roaming Profiles are feared by some, hated by a few, loved by many, and a Godsend for some administrators. </p><p> @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ problem to others. In particular, users of mobile computing tools, where often t be a sustained network connection, are often better served by purely Local Profiles. This chapter provides information to help the Samba administrator to deal with those situations also. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2988285"></a>Roaming Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945646"></a>Roaming Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Roaming profiles support is different for Win9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x. </p></div><p> Before discussing how to configure roaming profiles, it is useful to see how @@ -24,21 +24,17 @@ profiles are restricted to being stored in the user's home directory. </p><p> Windows NT4/200x clients send a NetSAMLogon RPC request, which contains many fields, including a separate field for the location of the user's profiles. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2988326"></a>Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945686"></a>Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section documents how to configure Samba for MS Windows client profile support. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2988340"></a>NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945699"></a>NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To support Windows NT4/200x clients, in the [global] section of smb.conf set the following (for example): </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> This is typically implemented like: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon path = \\%L\Profiles\%u -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%L\Profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where %L translates to the name of the Samba server and %u translates to the user name </p><p> The default for this option is <tt class="filename">\\%N\%U\profile</tt>, @@ -51,31 +47,26 @@ semantics of %L and %N, as well as %U and %u. MS Windows NT/2K clients at times do not disconnect a connection to a server between logons. It is recommended to NOT use the <i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i> meta-service name as part of the profile share path. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2988432"></a>Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> - To support Windows 9x / Me clients, you must use the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. Samba has +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945807"></a>Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To support Windows 9x / Me clients, you must use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2945819"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. Samba has now been fixed so that <b class="userinput"><tt>net use /home</tt></b> now works as well, and it, too, relies on the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter. </p><p> By using the logon home parameter, you are restricted to putting Win9x / Me profiles in the user's home directory. But wait! There is a trick you can use. If you set the following in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> then your Windows 9x / Me clients will dutifully put their clients in a subdirectory of your home directory called <tt class="filename">.profiles</tt> (thus making them hidden). </p><p> Not only that, but <b class="userinput"><tt>net use /home</tt></b> will also work, because of a feature in Windows 9x / Me. It removes any directory stuff off the end of the home directory area and only uses the server and share portion. That is, it looks like you -specified <tt class="filename">\\%L\%U</tt> for <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2988541"></a>Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +specified <tt class="filename">\\%L\%U</tt> for <a class="indexterm" name="id2945923"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945938"></a>Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can support profiles for both Win9X and WinNT clients by setting both the -<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameters. For example: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon home = \\%L\%u\.profiles - logon path = \\%L\profiles\%u -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2988580"></a>Disabling Roaming Profile Support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2945951"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2945965"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameters. For example: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%u\.profiles</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%L\profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2946006"></a>Disabling Roaming Profile Support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A question often asked is “<span class="quote">How may I enforce use of local profiles?</span>” or “<span class="quote">How do I disable Roaming Profiles?</span>” </p><p> @@ -83,13 +74,11 @@ There are three ways of doing this: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">In <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p> Affect the following settings and ALL clients will be forced to use a local profile: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon home = - logon path = - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">MS Windows Registry:</span></dt><dd><p> By using the Microsoft Management Console gpedit.msc to instruct your MS Windows XP machine to use only a local profile. This of course modifies registry settings. The full path to the option is: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> Local Computer Policy\ Computer Configuration\ @@ -112,15 +101,15 @@ profiles. The specifics of how to convert a local profile to a roaming profile, or a roaming profile to a local one vary according to the version of MS Windows you are running. Consult the Microsoft MS Windows Resource Kit for your version of Windows for specific information. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2988731"></a>Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2988739"></a>Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946178"></a>Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2946186"></a>Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user first logs in on Windows 9X, the file user.DAT is created, as are folders <tt class="filename">Start Menu</tt>, <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">Programs</tt> and <tt class="filename">Nethood</tt>. These directories and their contents will be merged with the local versions stored in <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username</tt> on subsequent logins, taking the most recent from each. You will need to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> -options <i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case = yes</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case = yes</tt></i> and -<i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive = no</tt></i> in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts +options <a class="indexterm" name="id2946240"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case</tt></i> = yes, <a class="indexterm" name="id2946255"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i> = yes and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946269"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i> = no in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts in any of the profile folders. </p><p> The user.DAT file contains all the user's preferences. If you wish to @@ -153,11 +142,11 @@ domain and profiles downloaded from it, if that domain logon server supports it), user name and user's password. </p><p> Once the user has been successfully validated, the Windows 9x / Me machine -will inform you that <tt class="computeroutput">The user has not logged on before' and asks you - if you wish to save the user's preferences?</tt> Select <span class="guibutton">yes</span>. +will inform you that <tt class="computeroutput">The user has not logged on before</tt> and asks you +<tt class="computeroutput">Do you wish to save the user's preferences?</tt>. Select <span class="guibutton">yes</span>. </p><p> Once the Windows 9x / Me client comes up with the desktop, you should be able -to examine the contents of the directory specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> +to examine the contents of the directory specified in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2946457"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> on the samba server and verify that the <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">Start Menu</tt>, <tt class="filename">Programs</tt> and <tt class="filename">Nethood</tt> folders have been created. </p><p> @@ -171,14 +160,14 @@ the newest folders and short-cuts from each set. If you have made the folders / files read-only on the samba server, then you will get errors from the Windows 9x / Me machine on logon and logout, as it attempts to merge the local and the remote profile. Basically, if -you have any errors reported by the Windows 9x / Me machine, check the Unix file +you have any errors reported by the Windows 9x / Me machine, check the UNIX file permissions and ownership rights on the profile directory contents, on the samba server. </p><p> If you have problems creating user profiles, you can reset the user's local desktop cache, as shown below. When this user then next logs in, they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". -</p><div class="orderedlist"><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Before deleting the contents of the directory listed in the ProfilePath (this is likely to be <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username)</tt>, ask them if they @@ -189,7 +178,7 @@ they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". This will have the effect of removing the local (read-only hidden system file) user.DAT in their profile directory, as well as the local "desktop", "nethood", "start menu" and "programs" folders. - </p></div><ol type="1"><li><p> + </p></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> instead of logging in under the [user, password, domain] dialog, press <span class="guibutton">escape</span>. </p></li><li><p> @@ -206,7 +195,7 @@ they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". </p></li><li><p> log off the windows 9x / Me client. </p></li><li><p> - check the contents of the profile path (see <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> described + check the contents of the profile path (see <a class="indexterm" name="id2946668"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> described above), and delete the <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> or <tt class="filename">user.MAN</tt> file for the user, making a backup if required. </p></li></ol></div><p> @@ -218,14 +207,14 @@ If you have access to an Windows NT4/200x server, then first set up roaming prof and / or netlogons on the Windows NT4/200x server. Make a packet trace, or examine the example packet traces provided with Windows NT4/200x server, and see what the differences are with the equivalent samba trace. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2989233"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2946726"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user first logs in to a Windows NT Workstation, the profile NTuser.DAT is created. The profile location can be now specified -through the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter. +through the <a class="indexterm" name="id2946739"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter. </p><p> There is a parameter that is now available for use with NT Profiles: -<i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i>. This should be set to <tt class="filename">H:</tt> or any other drive, and -should be used in conjunction with the new "logon home" parameter. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2946758"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i>. This should be set to <tt class="filename">H:</tt> or any other drive, and +should be used in conjunction with the new <a class="indexterm" name="id2946781"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. </p><p> The entry for the NT4 profile is a _directory_ not a file. The NT help on profiles mentions that a directory is also created with a .PDS @@ -247,7 +236,7 @@ turns a profile into a mandatory one. </p><p> The case of the profile is significant. The file must be called <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> or, for a mandatory profile, <tt class="filename">NTuser.MAN</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2989391"></a>Windows 2000/XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2946911"></a>Windows 2000/XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must first convert the profile from a local profile to a domain profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -266,8 +255,7 @@ profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: Click on the 'Look in" area that lists the machine name, when you click here it will open up a selection box. Click on the domain to which the profile must be accessible. - </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You will need to log on if a logon box opens up. Eg: In the connect - as: <i class="replaceable"><tt>MIDEARTH</tt></i>\root, password: <i class="replaceable"><tt>mypassword</tt></i>.</p></div></li><li><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You will need to log on if a logon box opens up. Eg: In the connect as: <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>\root, password: <i class="replaceable"><tt>mypassword</tt></i>.</p></div></li><li><p> To make the profile capable of being used by anyone select 'Everyone' </p></li><li><p> Click <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. The Selection box will close. @@ -275,12 +263,12 @@ profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: Now click on the <span class="guibutton">Ok</span> button to create the profile in the path you nominated. </p></li></ol></div><p> -Done. You now have a profile that can be edited using the samba-3.0.0 +Done. You now have a profile that can be edited using the samba <b class="command">profiles</b> tool. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Under NT/2K the use of mandatory profiles forces the use of MS Exchange storage of mail data. That keeps desktop profiles usable. -</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> +</p></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 24.2. Windows XP Service Pack 1</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> This is a security check new to Windows XP (or maybe only Windows XP service pack 1). It can be disabled via a group policy in Active Directory. The policy is:</p><p><tt class="filename">Computer Configuration\Administrative Templates\System\User @@ -297,7 +285,7 @@ On the XP workstation log in with an Administrator account. </p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guimenu">Start</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Run</span></p></li><li><p>Type: <b class="userinput"><tt>mmc</tt></b></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>A Microsoft Management Console should appear.</p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guimenu">File</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Add/Remove Snap-in...</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Add</span></p></li><li><p>Double-Click: <span class="guiicon">Group Policy</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">Finish</span>, <span class="guibutton">Close</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>In the "Console Root" window:</p></li><li><p>Expand: <span class="guiicon">Local Computer Policy</span>, <span class="guiicon">Computer Configuration</span>, <span class="guiicon">Administrative Templates</span>, <span class="guiicon">System</span>, <span class="guiicon">User Profiles</span></p></li><li><p>Double-Click: <span class="guilabel">Do not check for user ownership of Roaming Profile Folders</span></p></li><li><p>Select: <span class="guilabel">Enabled</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>Close the whole console. You do not need to save the settings (this refers to the console settings rather than the policies you have - changed).</p></li><li><p>Reboot</p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989902"></a>Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + changed).</p></li><li><p>Reboot</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947427"></a>Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Sharing of desktop profiles between Windows versions is NOT recommended. Desktop profiles are an evolving phenomenon and profiles for later versions of MS Windows clients add features that may interfere with earlier versions @@ -308,18 +296,18 @@ version resulting in loss of profile information content when that user logs on again with the newer version of MS Windows. </p><p> If you then want to share the same Start Menu / Desktop with W9x/Me, you will -need to specify a common location for the profiles. The smb.conf parameters -that need to be common are <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> and -<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. +need to specify a common location for the profiles. The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters +that need to be common are <a class="indexterm" name="id2947463"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2947477"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. </p><p> If you have this set up correctly, you will find separate <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> and <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> files in the same profile directory. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989967"></a>Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947512"></a>Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is nothing to stop you specifying any path that you like for the location of users' profiles. Therefore, you could specify that the profile be stored on a samba server, or any other SMB server, as long as that SMB server supports encrypted passwords. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2989984"></a>Windows NT4 Profile Management Tools</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2947528"></a>Windows NT4 Profile Management Tools</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Unfortunately, the Resource Kit information is specific to the version of MS Windows NT4/200x. The correct resource kit is required for each platform. </p><p> @@ -336,17 +324,13 @@ domain is not a member of a trust relationship with your NT4 PDC.</p></div></li> <tt class="filename">c:\temp\foobar</tt></p></li><li><p>Click on the button <span class="guibutton">Change</span> in the <span class="guilabel">Permitted to use</span> box.</p></li><li><p>Click on the group 'Everyone' and then click <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. This closes the 'choose user' box.</p></li><li><p>Now click <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li></ol></div><p> Follow the above for every profile you need to migrate. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2990153"></a>Side bar Notes</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2947698"></a>Side bar Notes</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You should obtain the SID of your NT4 domain. You can use smbpasswd to do -this. Read the man page.</p><p> -With Samba-3.0.0 alpha code you can import all you NT4 domain accounts -using the net samsync method. This way you can retain your profile -settings as well as all your users. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2990175"></a>moveuser.exe</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +this. Read the man page.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2947712"></a>moveuser.exe</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The W2K professional resource kit has moveuser.exe. moveuser.exe changes the security of a profile from one user to another. This allows the account domain to change, and/or the user name to change. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2990191"></a>Get SID</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2947728"></a>Get SID</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can identify the SID by using GetSID.exe from the Windows NT Server 4.0 Resource Kit. </p><p> @@ -359,7 +343,7 @@ users who have logged on to this computer. (To find the profile information for the user whose locally cached profile you want to move, find the SID for the user with the GetSID.exe utility.) Inside of the appropriate user's subkey, you will see a string value named ProfileImagePath. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2990232"></a>Mandatory profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2947770"></a>Mandatory profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A Mandatory Profile is a profile that the user does NOT have the ability to overwrite. During the user's session it may be possible to change the desktop environment, but as the user logs out all changes made will be lost. If it is desired to NOT allow the @@ -375,7 +359,7 @@ file in the copied profile and rename it to NTUser.MAN. </p><p> For MS Windows 9x / Me it is the <tt class="filename">User.DAT</tt> file that must be renamed to <tt class="filename">User.MAN</tt> to affect a mandatory profile. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2990290"></a>Creating/Managing Group Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2947828"></a>Creating/Managing Group Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Most organisations are arranged into departments. There is a nice benefit in this fact since usually most users in a department will require the same desktop applications and the same desktop layout. MS Windows NT4/200x/XP will allow the @@ -390,14 +374,14 @@ the now modified profile. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Be careful with group profiles, if the user who is a member of a group also has a personal profile, then the result will be a fusion (merge) of the two. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2990336"></a>Default Profile for Windows Users</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2947873"></a>Default Profile for Windows Users</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows 9x / Me and NT4/200x/XP will use a default profile for any user for whom a profile does not already exist. Armed with a knowledge of where the default profile is located on the Windows workstation, and knowing which registry keys affect the path from which the default profile is created, it is possible to modify the default profile to one that has been optimised for the site. This has significant administrative advantages. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2990356"></a>MS Windows 9x/Me</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947893"></a>MS Windows 9x/Me</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To enable default per use profiles in Windows 9x / Me you can either use the <span class="application">Windows 98 System Policy Editor</span> or change the registry directly. </p><p> @@ -409,7 +393,7 @@ select <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span>, click on the enable box. Do To modify the registry directly, launch the <span class="application">Registry Editor</span> (<b class="command">regedit.exe</b>), select the hive <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Network\Logon</tt>. Now add a DWORD type key with the name "User Profiles", to enable user profiles set the value to 1, to disable user profiles set it to 0. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2990454"></a>How User Profiles Are Handled in Windows 9x / Me?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2947996"></a>How User Profiles Are Handled in Windows 9x / Me?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user logs on to a Windows 9x / Me machine, the local profile path, <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Software\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList</tt>, is checked for an existing entry for that user: @@ -425,7 +409,7 @@ If a User Profile is not found in either location, the Default User Profile from machine is used and is copied to a newly created folder for the logged on user. At log off, any changes that the user made are written to the user's local profile. If the user has a roaming profile, the changes are written to the user's profile on the server. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2990504"></a>MS Windows NT4 Workstation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948045"></a>MS Windows NT4 Workstation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> On MS Windows NT4 the default user profile is obtained from the location <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles</tt> which in a default installation will translate to <tt class="filename">C:\WinNT\Profiles</tt>. Under this directory on a clean install there will be @@ -436,7 +420,7 @@ system users. The <tt class="filename">Default User</tt> directory contains menu customisable per user depending on the profile settings chosen/created. </p><p> When a new user first logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine a new profile is created from: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>All Users settings</td></tr><tr><td>Default User settings (contains the default NTUser.DAT file)</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>All Users settings</p></li><li><p>Default User settings (contains the default NTUser.DAT file)</p></li></ul></div><p> When a user logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine that is a member of a Microsoft security domain the following steps are followed in respect of profile handling: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -468,8 +452,8 @@ will stored in the <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt> lo also remain stored in the same way, unless the following registry key is created: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> - HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\winlogon\ - "DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001 +HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ +winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001 </pre><p> In which case, the local copy (in <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt>) will be @@ -488,7 +472,7 @@ are controlled by entries on Windows NT4 is: </p><p> The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are: </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2990854"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.1. User Shell Folder registry keys default values</b></p><table summary="User Shell Folder registry keys default values" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu </td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2948397"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.1. User Shell Folder registry keys default values</b></p><table summary="User Shell Folder registry keys default values" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu </td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> The registry key that contains the location of the default profile settings is: </p><p> @@ -496,8 +480,8 @@ The registry key that contains the location of the default profile settings is: </p><p> The default entries are: -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2990998"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.2. Defaults of profile settings registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of profile settings registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td>Common Desktop</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Common Programs</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Common Start Menu</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Common Startup</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2991058"></a>MS Windows 200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2948541"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.2. Defaults of profile settings registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of profile settings registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td>Common Desktop</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Common Programs</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Common Start Menu</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Common Startup</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948600"></a>MS Windows 200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> MS Windows XP Home Edition does use default per user profiles, but can not participate in domain security, can not log onto an NT/ADS style domain, and thus can obtain the profile only from itself. While there are benefits in doing this the beauty of those MS Windows @@ -546,7 +530,7 @@ are controlled by entries on Windows 200x/XP is: </p><p> The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are: </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2991253"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.3. Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Cache</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Temporary Internet Files</td></tr><tr><td>Cookies</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Cookies</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>History</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\History</td></tr><tr><td>Local AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Local Settings</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings</td></tr><tr><td>My Pictures</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents\My Pictures</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>Personal</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr><tr><td>Templates</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Templates</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2948802"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.3. Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Cache</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Temporary Internet Files</td></tr><tr><td>Cookies</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Cookies</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>History</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\History</td></tr><tr><td>Local AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Local Settings</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings</td></tr><tr><td>My Pictures</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents\My Pictures</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>Personal</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr><tr><td>Templates</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Templates</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> There is also an entry called "Default" that has no value set. The default entry is of type <tt class="constant">REG_SZ</tt>, all the others are of type <tt class="constant">REG_EXPAND_SZ</tt>. @@ -562,18 +546,21 @@ You could also use: </p><p><tt class="filename">\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SambaServer</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>FolderShare</tt></i>\%USERNAME%</tt></p><p> in which case the default folders will be stored in the server named <i class="replaceable"><tt>SambaServer</tt></i> in the share called <i class="replaceable"><tt>FolderShare</tt></i> under a directory that has the name of the MS Windows -user as seen by the Linux/Unix file system. +user as seen by the Linux/UNIX file system. </p><p> Please note that once you have created a default profile share, you MUST migrate a user's profile (default or custom) to it. </p><p> MS Windows 200x/XP profiles may be <span class="emphasis"><em>Local</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>Roaming</em></span>. A roaming profile will be cached locally unless the following registry key is created: -</p><p><tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001</tt></p><p> +</p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ + winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001</pre><p> In which case, the local cache copy will be deleted on logout. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2991562"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949100"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following are some typical errors/problems/questions that have been asked. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2991575"></a>How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949130"></a>Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> With samba-2.2.x the choice you have is to enable or disable roaming profiles support. It is a global only setting. The default is to have roaming profiles and the default path will locate them in the user's home @@ -585,42 +572,40 @@ those machines on which roaming profile support is NOT wanted it is then necessary to disable roaming profile handling in the registry of each such machine. </p><p> -With samba-3.0.0 (soon to be released) you can have a global profile -setting in smb.conf _AND_ you can over-ride this by per-user settings +With samba-3 you can have a global profile +setting in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> _AND_ you can over-ride this by per-user settings using the Domain User Manager (as with MS Windows NT4/ Win 2Kx). </p><p> In any case, you can configure only one profile per user. That profile can be either: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>A profile unique to that user</td></tr><tr><td>A mandatory profile (one the user can not change)</td></tr><tr><td>A group profile (really should be mandatory ie:unchangable)</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2991638"></a>Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A profile unique to that user</p></li><li><p>A mandatory profile (one the user can not change)</p></li><li><p>A group profile (really should be mandatory ie:unchangable)</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949201"></a>Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A user requested the following: “<span class="quote"> - I dont want Roaming profile to be implemented, I just want to give users - local profiles only. -... - Please help me I am totally lost with this error from past two days I tried - everything and googled around quite a bit but of no help. Please help me. +I do not want Roaming profiles to be implemented. I want to give users a local profile alone. ... +Please help me I am totally lost with this error. For the past two days I tried everything, I googled +around but found no useful pointers. Please help me. </span>”</p><p> -Your choices are: - - -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Local profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - I know of no registry keys that will allow auto-deletion of LOCAL profiles on log out - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>can use auto-delete on logout option</td></tr><tr><td>requires a registry key change on workstation</td></tr></table><p> - - Your choices are: - - </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Personal Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - - should be preserved on a central server - - workstations 'cache' (store) a local copy - - used in case the profile can not be downloaded - at next logon - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Group profiles</span></dt><dd><p>- loaded from a central place</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Mandatory profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - - can be personal or group - - can NOT be changed (except by an administrator - </p></dd></dl></div><p> +The choices are: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Local profiles:</span></dt><dd><p> + I know of no registry keys that will allow auto-deletion of LOCAL profiles on log out + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Roaming profiles:</span></dt><dd><p> + As a user logs onto the network a centrally stored profile is copied to the workstation + to form a local profile. This local profile will persist (remain on the workstation disk) + unless a registry key is changed that will cause this profile to be automatically deleted + on logout. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +The <span class="emphasis"><em>Roaming Profile</em></span> choices are: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Personal Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> + These are typically stored in a profile share on a central (or conveniently located + local) server. + </p><p> + Workstations 'cache' (store) a local copy of the profile. This cached copy is used when + the profile can not be downloaded at next logon. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Group profiles</span></dt><dd><p>These are loaded from a central profile server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Mandatory profiles</span></dt><dd><p> + Mandatory profiles can be created for a user as well as for any group that a user + is a member of. Mandatory profiles can NOT be changed by ordinary users. Only the administrator + can change or reconfigure a mandatory profile. </p></dd></dl></div><p> - -</p><p> A WinNT4/2K/XP profile can vary in size from 130KB to off the scale. Outlook PST files are most often part of the profile and can be many GB in size. On average (in a well controlled environment) roaming profile size of @@ -634,47 +619,34 @@ controls of how they can be changed as well as good discipline make up for a problem free site. </p><p> Microsoft's answer to the PST problem is to store all email in an MS -Exchange Server back-end. But this is another story ...! -</p><p> -So, having LOCAL profiles means: - -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>If lots of users user each machine - lot's of local disk storage needed for local profiles</td></tr><tr><td>Every workstation the user logs into has it's own profile - can be very different from machine to machine</td></tr></table><p> - -On the other hand, having roaming profiles means: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>The network administrator can control EVERY aspect of user profiles</td></tr><tr><td>With the use of mandatory profiles - a drastic reduction in network management overheads</td></tr><tr><td>User unhappiness about not being able to change their profiles soon fades as they get used to being able to work reliably</td></tr></table><p> - +Exchange Server back-end. This removes the need for a PST file. </p><p> -I have managed and installed MANY NT/2K networks and have NEVER found one -where users who move from machine to machine are happy with local -profiles. In the long run local profiles bite them. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2991859"></a>Changing the default profile</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> -When the client tries to logon to the PDC it looks for a profile to download -where do I put this default profile. +LOCAL profiles mean: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>If each machine is used my many users then much local disk storage is needed for local profiles</p></li><li><p>Every workstation the user logs into has it's own profile, these can be very different from machine to machine</p></li></ul></div><p> +On the other hand, use of roaming profiles means: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The network administrator can control the desktop environment of all users.</p></li><li><p>Use of mandatory profiles drasitcally reduces network management overheads.</p></li><li><p>In the long run users will be experience fewer problems.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949414"></a>Changing the default profile</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> +“<span class="quote"> +When the client logs onto the domain controller it searches for a profile to download, +where do I put this default profile? </span>”</p><p> -Firstly, your samba server need to be configured as a domain controller. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - server = user - os level = 32 (or more) - domain logons = Yes -</pre><p> -Plus you need to have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share that is world readable. +Firstly, the samba server needs to be configured as a domain controller. +This can be done by setting in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 32 (or more)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +There must be an <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share that is world readable. It is a good idea to add a logon script to pre-set printer and drive connections. There is also a facility for automatically synchronizing the workstation time clock with that of the logon server (another good thing to do). </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> To invoke auto-deletion of roaming profile from the local -workstation cache (disk storage) you need to use the <span class="application">Group Policy Editor</span> +workstation cache (disk storage) use the <span class="application">Group Policy Editor</span> to create a file called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> with the appropriate entries. This file needs to be located in the <i class="parameter"><tt>netlogon</tt></i> share root directory.</p></div><p> -Oh, of course the windows clients need to be members of the domain. -Workgroup machines do NOT do network logons - so they never see domain -profiles. +Windows clients need to be members of the domain. Workgroup machines do NOT use network logons so +they do not interoperate with domain profiles. </p><p> -Secondly, for roaming profiles you need: - - logon path = \\%N\profiles\%U (with some such path) - logon drive = H: (Z: is the default) - - Plus you need a PROFILES share that is world writable. -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pam.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 23. System and Account Policies </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +For roaming profiles add to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%N\profiles\%U</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Default logon drive is Z:</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive = H:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># This requires a PROFILES share that is world writable.</td></tr></table><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="PolicyMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pam.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 23. System and Account Policies </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html b/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html index b4067d75d8..30df1ed778 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/SWAT.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC"><link rel="next" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NT4Migration.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="troubleshooting.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SWAT"></a>Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3003929">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3003963">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006322">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006435">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006499">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006604">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006669">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006733">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006781">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006833">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006856">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC"><link rel="next" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NT4Migration.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="troubleshooting.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SWAT"></a>Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957030">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957079">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957316">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957428">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957493">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957601">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957665">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957730">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957777">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957829">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957853">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> There are many and varied opinions regarding the usefulness or otherwise of SWAT. No matter how hard one tries to produce the perfect configuration tool it remains an object of personal taste. SWAT is a tool that will allow web based configuration @@ -6,7 +6,7 @@ of samba. It has a wizard that may help to get samba configured quickly, it has sensitive help on each smb.conf parameter, it provides for monitoring of current state of connection information, and it allows network wide MS Windows network password management. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3003929"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2957030"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are network administrators who believe that it is a good idea to write systems documentation inside configuration files, for them SWAT will aways be a nasty tool. SWAT does not store the configuration file in any intermediate form, rather, it stores only the @@ -18,9 +18,9 @@ internal ordering. So before using SWAT please be warned - SWAT will completely replace your smb.conf with a fully optimised file that has been stripped of all comments you might have placed there and only non-default settings will be written to the file. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3003963"></a>Enabling SWAT for use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957079"></a>Enabling SWAT for use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> SWAT should be installed to run via the network super daemon. Depending on which system -your Unix/Linux system has you will have either an <b class="command">inetd</b> or +your UNIX/Linux system has you will have either an <b class="command">inetd</b> or <b class="command">xinetd</b> based system. </p><p> The nature and location of the network super-daemon varies with the operating system @@ -72,7 +72,7 @@ So long as you log onto SWAT as the user <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></s full change and commit ability. The buttons that will be exposed includes: <span class="guibutton">HOME</span>, <span class="guibutton">GLOBALS</span>, <span class="guibutton">SHARES</span>, <span class="guibutton">PRINTERS</span>, <span class="guibutton">WIZARD</span>, <span class="guibutton">STATUS</span>, <span class="guibutton">VIEW</span>, <span class="guibutton">PASSWORD</span>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006322"></a>Securing SWAT through SSL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957316"></a>Securing SWAT through SSL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Lots of people have asked about how to setup SWAT with SSL to allow for secure remote administration of Samba. Here is a method that works, courtesy of Markus Krieger </p><p> @@ -82,22 +82,22 @@ Modifications to the swat setup are as following: </p></li><li><p> generate certificate and private key - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/bin/openssl req -new -x509 -days 365 -nodes -config \ - /usr/share/doc/packages/stunnel/stunnel.cnf \ + /usr/share/doc/packages/stunnel/stunnel.cnf \ -out /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -keyout /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem</tt></b> - </pre></li><li><p> +</pre></li><li><p> remove swat-entry from [x]inetd </p></li><li><p> start stunnel - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>stunnel -p /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -d 901 \ -l /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat </tt></b> - </pre></li></ol></div><p> +</pre></li></ol></div><p> afterwords simply contact to swat by using the URL <a href="https://myhost:901" target="_top">https://myhost:901</a>, accept the certificate and the SSL connection is up. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006435"></a>The SWAT Home Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957428"></a>The SWAT Home Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The SWAT title page provides access to the latest Samba documentation. The manual page for each samba component is accessible from this page as are the Samba-HOWTO-Collection (this document) as well as the O'Reilly book "Using Samba". @@ -105,15 +105,14 @@ document) as well as the O'Reilly book "Using Samba". Administrators who wish to validate their samba configuration may obtain useful information from the man pages for the diagnostic utilities. These are available from the SWAT home page also. One diagnostic tool that is NOT mentioned on this page, but that is particularly -useful is <b class="command">ethereal</b>, available from <a href="http://www.ethereal.com" target="_top"> -http://www.ethereal.com</a>. +useful is <a href="http://www.ethereal.com/" target="_top"><b class="command">ethereal</b></a>. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> SWAT can be configured to run in <span class="emphasis"><em>demo</em></span> mode. This is NOT recommended as it runs SWAT without authentication and with full administrative ability. ie: Allows changes to smb.conf as well as general operation with root privileges. The option that creates this ability is the <tt class="option">-a</tt> flag to swat. <span class="emphasis"><em>Do not use this in any production environment.</em></span> -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006499"></a>Global Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957493"></a>Global Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Globals button will expose a page that allows configuration of the global parameters in smb.conf. There are three levels of exposure of the parameters: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -126,8 +125,8 @@ in smb.conf. There are three levels of exposure of the parameters: will want to tamper with. </p></li></ul></div><p> To switch to other than <span class="emphasis"><em>Basic</em></span> editing ability click on either the -<span class="emphasis"><em>Advanced</em></span> or the <span class="emphasis"><em>Developer</em></span> dial, then click the -<span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button. +<span class="emphasis"><em>Advanced</em></span> or the <span class="emphasis"><em>Developer</em></span> button. You may also +do this by clicking on the radio button, then click the <span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button. </p><p> After making any changes to configuration parameters make sure that you click on the <span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button before moving to another area otherwise @@ -135,7 +134,7 @@ your changes will be immediately lost. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> SWAT has context sensitive help. To find out what each parameter is for simply click the <span class="guibutton">Help</span> link to the left of the configuration parameter. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006604"></a>Share Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957601"></a>Share Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To affect a currently configured share, simply click on the pull down button between the <span class="guibutton">Choose Share</span> and the <span class="guibutton">Delete Share</span> buttons, select the share you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the @@ -145,7 +144,7 @@ select the share you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the To create a new share, next to the button labelled <span class="guibutton">Create Share</span> enter into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Create Share</span> button. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006669"></a>Printers Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957665"></a>Printers Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To affect a currently configured printer, simply click on the pull down button between the <span class="guibutton">Choose Printer</span> and the <span class="guibutton">Delete Printer</span> buttons, select the printer you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the @@ -155,7 +154,7 @@ select the printer you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on th To create a new printer, next to the button labelled <span class="guibutton">Create Printer</span> enter into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Create Printer</span> button. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006733"></a>The SWAT Wizard</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957730"></a>The SWAT Wizard</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The purpose if the SWAT Wizard is to help the Microsoft knowledgeable network administrator to configure Samba with a minimum of effort. </p><p> @@ -171,7 +170,7 @@ Finally, there are a limited set of options that will determine what type of ser will be configured for, whether it will be a WINS server, participate as a WINS client, or operate with no WINS support. By clicking on one button you can elect to expose (or not) user home directories. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006781"></a>The Status Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957777"></a>The Status Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The status page serves a limited purpose. Firstly, it allows control of the samba daemons. The key daemons that create the samba server environment are: <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">winbindd</span>. </p><p> @@ -182,11 +181,11 @@ conditions with minimal effort. </p><p> Lastly, the Status page may be used to terminate specific smbd client connections in order to free files that may be locked. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006833"></a>The View Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957829"></a>The View Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This page allows the administrator to view the optimised <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file and, if you are particularly masochistic, will permit you also to see all possible global configuration parameters and their settings. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3006856"></a>The Password Change Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2957853"></a>The Password Change Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Password Change page is a popular tool. This tool allows the creation, deletion, deactivation and reactivation of MS Windows networking users on the local machine. Alternatively, you can use this tool to change a local password for a user account. @@ -197,4 +196,4 @@ required. </p><p> One popular use for this tool is to change user passwords across a range of remote MS Windows servers. -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NT4Migration.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="troubleshooting.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part V. Troubleshooting</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NT4Migration.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="troubleshooting.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part V. Troubleshooting</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html b/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html index 603c87d574..97e48f3e27 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Samba-Developers-Guide.html @@ -12,10 +12,7 @@ Please send updates to Jelmer Vernooij. This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source distribution. A copy can be found on-line at http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt -"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-Developers-Guide"></a>SAMBA Developers Guide</h1></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">SAMBA Team</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="legalnotice"><p><b>Attributions. </b> - </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="#netbios" title="Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes">Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Luke Leighton</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#architecture" title="Chapter 2. Samba Architecture">Samba Architecture</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Dan Shearer</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#debug" title="Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system">The samba DEBUG system</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Chris Hertel</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#CodingSuggestions" title="Chapter 4. Coding Suggestions">Coding Suggestions</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Steve French</p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce</p></li><li><p>Andrew Bartlett</p></li><li><p>Tim Potter</p></li><li><p>Martin Pool</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#internals" title="Chapter 5. Samba Internals">Samba Internals</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Chappell <<a href="mailto:David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu" target="_top">David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#parsing" title="Chapter 6. The smb.conf file">The smb.conf file</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Chris Hertel</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#unix-smb" title="Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World">NetBIOS in a Unix World</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#tracing" title="Chapter 8. Tracing samba system calls">Tracing samba system calls</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#windows-debug" title="Chapter 9. Finding useful information on windows">Finding useful information on windows</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#ntdomain" title="Chapter 10. NT Domain RPC's">NT Domain RPC's</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Luke Leighton <<a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">lkcl@switchboard.net</a>></p></li><li><p>Paul Ashton <<a href="mailto:paul@argo.demon.co.uk" target="_top">paul@argo.demon.co.uk</a>></p></li><li><p>Duncan Stansfield <<a href="mailto:duncans@sco.com" target="_top">duncans@sco.com</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#printing" title="Chapter 11. Samba Printing Internals">Samba Printing Internals</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#wins" title="Chapter 12. Samba WINS Internals">Samba WINS Internals</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#sam" title="Chapter 13. The Upcoming SAM System">The Upcoming SAM System</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Bartlett</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#pwencrypt" title="Chapter 14. LanMan and NT Password Encryption">LanMan and NT Password Encryption</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#modules" title="Chapter 15. Modules">Modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#rpc-plugin" title="Chapter 16. RPC Pluggable Modules">RPC Pluggable Modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Anthony Liguori <<a href="mailto:aliguor@us.ibm.com" target="_top">aliguor@us.ibm.com</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#vfs" title="Chapter 17. VFS Modules">VFS Modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy <<a href="mailto:ab@samba.org" target="_top">ab@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher <<a href="mailto:metze@metzemix.de" target="_top">metze@metzemix.de</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#Packaging" title="Chapter 18. Notes to packagers">Notes to packagers</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#contributing" title="Chapter 19. Contributing code">Contributing code</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div><p> - - </p></div></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p> +"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-Developers-Guide"></a>SAMBA Developers Guide</h1></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Last Update</em></span> : Fri Jun 6 00:45:54 CEST 2003 </p><p> This book is a collection of documents that might be useful for @@ -29,15 +26,15 @@ Please send updates to <a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">Jelmer Ve This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <a href="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt" target="_top">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</a> -</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="#netbios">Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2800515">NETBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800602">BROADCAST NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800633">NBNS NetBIOS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#architecture">Samba Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2797071">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797281">Multithreading and Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797319">Threading smbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797394">Threading nmbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797461">nbmd Design</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#debug">The samba DEBUG system</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2796882">New Output Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797018">The DEBUG() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867347">The DEBUGADD() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867392">The DEBUGLVL() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867497">New Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867504">dbgtext()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867524">dbghdr()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867547">format_debug_text()</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>4. <a href="#CodingSuggestions">Coding Suggestions</a></dt><dt>5. <a href="#internals">Samba Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866920">Character Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866946">The new functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868198">Macros in byteorder.h</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869122">CVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869136">PVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869150">SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869163">SVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869179">IVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869193">SVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869208">IVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869222">SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869236">SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869251">SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869265">SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869280">RSVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869294">RIVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869308">RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869323">RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869339">LAN Manager Samba API</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869375">Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869526">Return value</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869611">Code character table</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#parsing">The smb.conf file</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868950">Lexical Analysis</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869043">Handling of Whitespace</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869099">Handling of Line Continuation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870758">Line Continuation Quirks</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870856">Syntax</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870928">About params.c</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#unix-smb">NetBIOS in a Unix World</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870375">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870400">Usernames</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870628">File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870665">Passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870702">Locking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871641">Deny Modes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871672">Trapdoor UIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871697">Port numbers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871742">Protocol Complexity</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#tracing">Tracing samba system calls</a></dt><dt>9. <a href="#windows-debug">Finding useful information on windows</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871397">Netlogon debugging output</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>10. <a href="#ntdomain">NT Domain RPC's</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872364">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873295">Sources</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873330">Credits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2873367">Notes and Structures</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873375">Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873451">Enumerations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873665">Structures</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876614">MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876627">MSRPC Pipes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876729">Header</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877600">Tail</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877647">RPC Bind / Bind Ack</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877826">NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877991">LSA Open Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878118">LSA Query Info Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878223">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878315">LSA Open Secret</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878424">LSA Close</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878490">LSA Lookup SIDS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878700">LSA Lookup Names</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878926">NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879087">LSA Request Challenge</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879222">LSA Authenticate 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879369">LSA Server Password Set</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879484">LSA SAM Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879598">LSA SAM Logoff</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879689">\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879701">Query for PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879969">SAM Logon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880294">SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880339">Net Share Enum</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880558">Net Server Get Info</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880674">Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880682">Definitions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880845">Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880942">Comments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880991">SIDs and RIDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881031">Well-known SIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881346">Well-known RIDS</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#printing">Samba Printing Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2890028">Abstract</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890044"> +</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2796811">Attributions</a></dt><dt>1. <a href="#netbios">Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2800281">NETBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800366">BROADCAST NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800396">NBNS NetBIOS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#architecture">Samba Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2800511">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800565">Multithreading and Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800603">Threading smbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800677">Threading nmbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800740">nbmd Design</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#debug">The samba DEBUG system</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2800810">New Output Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800946">The DEBUG() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801076">The DEBUGADD() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801121">The DEBUGLVL() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801232">New Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801239">dbgtext()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801258">dbghdr()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801281">format_debug_text()</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>4. <a href="#CodingSuggestions">Coding Suggestions</a></dt><dt>5. <a href="#internals">Samba Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801753">Character Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801778">The new functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801936">Macros in byteorder.h</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801949">CVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801963">PVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801977">SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801990">SVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802006">IVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802020">SVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802035">IVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802049">SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802063">SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802078">SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802092">SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802106">RSVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802121">RIVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802135">RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802150">RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2802166">LAN Manager Samba API</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802202">Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866095">Return value</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866180">Code character table</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#parsing">The smb.conf file</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866300">Lexical Analysis</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866391">Handling of Whitespace</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866447">Handling of Line Continuation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866511">Line Continuation Quirks</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866608">Syntax</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866679">About params.c</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#unix-smb">NetBIOS in a Unix World</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866728">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866753">Usernames</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866834">File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866872">Passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866916">Locking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866978">Deny Modes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867009">Trapdoor UIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867034">Port numbers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867088">Protocol Complexity</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#tracing">Tracing samba system calls</a></dt><dt>9. <a href="#windows-debug">Finding useful information on windows</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867492">Netlogon debugging output</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>10. <a href="#ntdomain">NT Domain RPC's</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867633">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867832">Sources</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867868">Credits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2867906">Notes and Structures</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867913">Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867989">Enumerations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868203">Structures</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2871153">MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871166">MSRPC Pipes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871268">Header</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872139">Tail</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872184">RPC Bind / Bind Ack</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872365">NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872530">LSA Open Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872655">LSA Query Info Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872763">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872853">LSA Open Secret</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872963">LSA Close</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873028">LSA Lookup SIDS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873238">LSA Lookup Names</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2873464">NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873625">LSA Request Challenge</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873759">LSA Authenticate 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873906">LSA Server Password Set</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874022">LSA SAM Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874125">LSA SAM Logoff</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874216">\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874229">Query for PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874497">SAM Logon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874822">SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874867">Net Share Enum</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875087">Net Server Get Info</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875203">Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875211">Definitions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875373">Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875471">Comments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875519">SIDs and RIDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875558">Well-known SIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875874">Well-known RIDS</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#printing">Samba Printing Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876159">Abstract</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876175"> Printing Interface to Various Back ends -</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890298"> +</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876271"> Print Queue TDB's -</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890507"> +</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876487"> ChangeID and Client Caching of Printer Information -</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890520"> +</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876500"> Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify -</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#wins">Samba WINS Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889988">WINS Failover</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#sam">The Upcoming SAM System</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889789">Security in the 'new SAM'</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891316">Standalone from UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891349">Handles and Races in the new SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891418">Layers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891425">Application</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891441">SAM Interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891468">SAM Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891490">SAM Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891497">Special Module: sam_passdb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891516">sam_ads</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891555">Memory Management</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891645">Testing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#pwencrypt">LanMan and NT Password Encryption</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892285">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892310">How does it work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891197">The smbpasswd file</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#modules">Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892236">Advantages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893136">Loading modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893169">Static modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894111">Shared modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2894139">Writing modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894200">Static/Shared selection in configure.in</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#rpc-plugin">RPC Pluggable Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892904">About</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892923">General Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#vfs">VFS Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895215">The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895223">The general interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895338">Possible VFS operation layers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895409">The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895418">Initialization and registration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895609">How the Modules handle per connection data</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895852">Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895860">Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896401">Some Notes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896408">Implement TRANSPARENT functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896432">Implement OPAQUE functions</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#Packaging">Notes to packagers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895009">Versioning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895042">Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="#contributing">Contributing code</a></dt></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="netbios"></a>Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Luke</span> <span class="surname">Leighton</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 June 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2800515">NETBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800602">BROADCAST NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800633">NBNS NetBIOS</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800515"></a>NETBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#wins">Samba WINS Internals</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876880">WINS Failover</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#sam">The Upcoming SAM System</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2877009">Security in the 'new SAM'</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877139">Standalone from UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877166">Handles and Races in the new SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877235">Layers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2877242">Application</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877258">SAM Interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877286">SAM Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2877308">SAM Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2877315">Special Module: sam_passdb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877333">sam_ads</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2877362">Memory Management</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877454">Testing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#pwencrypt">LanMan and NT Password Encryption</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2877592">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877615">How does it work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877715">The smbpasswd file</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#modules">Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878082">Advantages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878130">Loading modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878163">Static modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878204">Shared modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878231">Writing modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878293">Static/Shared selection in configure.in</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#rpc-plugin">RPC Pluggable Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878489">About</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878508">General Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#vfs">VFS Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878716">The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878723">The general interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878839">Possible VFS operation layers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878926">The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878934">Initialization and registration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879115">How the Modules handle per connection data</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879360">Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879367">Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879871">Some Notes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879878">Implement TRANSPARENT functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879903">Implement OPAQUE functions</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#Packaging">Notes to packagers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879969">Versioning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880004">Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="#contributing">Contributing code</a></dt></dl></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2796811"></a>Attributions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><a href="#netbios" title="Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes">Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Luke Leighton</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#architecture" title="Chapter 2. Samba Architecture">Samba Architecture</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Dan Shearer</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#debug" title="Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system">The samba DEBUG system</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Chris Hertel</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#CodingSuggestions" title="Chapter 4. Coding Suggestions">Coding Suggestions</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Steve French</p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce</p></li><li><p>Andrew Bartlett</p></li><li><p>Tim Potter</p></li><li><p>Martin Pool</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#internals" title="Chapter 5. Samba Internals">Samba Internals</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Chappell <<a href="mailto:David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu" target="_top">David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#parsing" title="Chapter 6. The smb.conf file">The smb.conf file</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Chris Hertel</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#unix-smb" title="Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World">NetBIOS in a Unix World</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#tracing" title="Chapter 8. Tracing samba system calls">Tracing samba system calls</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#windows-debug" title="Chapter 9. Finding useful information on windows">Finding useful information on windows</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#ntdomain" title="Chapter 10. NT Domain RPC's">NT Domain RPC's</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Luke Leighton <<a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">lkcl@switchboard.net</a>></p></li><li><p>Paul Ashton <<a href="mailto:paul@argo.demon.co.uk" target="_top">paul@argo.demon.co.uk</a>></p></li><li><p>Duncan Stansfield <<a href="mailto:duncans@sco.com" target="_top">duncans@sco.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#printing" title="Chapter 11. Samba Printing Internals">Samba Printing Internals</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#wins" title="Chapter 12. Samba WINS Internals">Samba WINS Internals</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#sam" title="Chapter 13. The Upcoming SAM System">The Upcoming SAM System</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Bartlett</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#pwencrypt" title="Chapter 14. LanMan and NT Password Encryption">LanMan and NT Password Encryption</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#modules" title="Chapter 15. Modules">Modules</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#rpc-plugin" title="Chapter 16. RPC Pluggable Modules">RPC Pluggable Modules</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Anthony Liguori <<a href="mailto:aliguor@us.ibm.com" target="_top">aliguor@us.ibm.com</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#vfs" title="Chapter 17. VFS Modules">VFS Modules</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy <<a href="mailto:ab@samba.org" target="_top">ab@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher <<a href="mailto:metze@metzemix.de" target="_top">metze@metzemix.de</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#Packaging" title="Chapter 18. Notes to packagers">Notes to packagers</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#contributing" title="Chapter 19. Contributing code">Contributing code</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="netbios"></a>Chapter 1. Definition of NetBIOS Protocol and Name Resolution Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Luke</span> <span class="surname">Leighton</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 June 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2800281">NETBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800366">BROADCAST NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800396">NBNS NetBIOS</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800281"></a>NETBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> NetBIOS runs over the following tranports: TCP/IP; NetBEUI and IPX/SPX. Samba only uses NetBIOS over TCP/IP. For details on the TCP/IP NetBIOS Session Service NetBIOS Datagram Service, and NetBIOS Names, see @@ -78,7 +75,7 @@ NetBIOS names are either UNIQUE or GROUP. Only one application can claim a UNIQUE NetBIOS name on a network. </p><p> There are two kinds of NetBIOS Name resolution: Broadcast and Point-to-Point. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800602"></a>BROADCAST NetBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800366"></a>BROADCAST NetBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Clients can claim names, and therefore offer services on successfully claimed names, on their broadcast-isolated subnet. One way to get NetBIOS services (such as browsing: see ftp.microsoft.com/drg/developr/CIFS/browdiff.txt; and @@ -90,7 +87,7 @@ find that some of your hosts spend 95 percent of their time dealing with broadcast traffic. [If you have IPX/SPX on your LAN or WAN, you will find that this is already happening: a packet analyzer will show, roughly every twelve minutes, great swathes of broadcast traffic!]. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800633"></a>NBNS NetBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800396"></a>NBNS NetBIOS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> rfc1001.txt describes, amongst other things, the implementation and use of, a 'NetBIOS Name Service'. NT/AS offers 'Windows Internet Name Service' which is fully rfc1001/2 compliant, but has had to take specific action @@ -131,7 +128,7 @@ WINS Clients therefore claim names from the WINS server. If the WINS server allows them to register a name, the client's NetBIOS session service can then offer services on this name. Other WINS clients will then contact the WINS server to resolve a NetBIOS name. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="architecture"></a>Chapter 2. Samba Architecture</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> November 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2797071">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797281">Multithreading and Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797319">Threading smbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797394">Threading nmbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797461">nbmd Design</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797071"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="architecture"></a>Chapter 2. Samba Architecture</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Dan</span> <span class="surname">Shearer</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> November 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2800511">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800565">Multithreading and Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800603">Threading smbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800677">Threading nmbd</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800740">nbmd Design</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800511"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This document gives a general overview of how Samba works internally. The Samba Team has tried to come up with a model which is the best possible compromise between elegance, portability, security @@ -142,7 +139,7 @@ It also tries to answer some of the frequently asked questions such as: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> Is Samba secure when running on Unix? The xyz platform? What about the root priveliges issue? -</p></li><li><p>Pros and cons of multithreading in various parts of Samba</p></li><li><p>Why not have a separate process for name resolution, WINS, and browsing?</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797281"></a>Multithreading and Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li><li><p>Pros and cons of multithreading in various parts of Samba</p></li><li><p>Why not have a separate process for name resolution, WINS, and browsing?</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800565"></a>Multithreading and Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> People sometimes tout threads as a uniformly good thing. They are very nice in their place but are quite inappropriate for smbd. nmbd is another matter, and multi-threading it would be very nice. @@ -159,7 +156,7 @@ smbd multi-threaded. Multi-threading would actually make Samba much slower, less scalable, less portable and much less robust. The fact that we use a separate process for each connection is one of Samba's biggest advantages. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797319"></a>Threading smbd</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800603"></a>Threading smbd</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A few problems that would arise from a threaded smbd are: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> It's not only to create threads instead of processes, but you @@ -184,7 +181,7 @@ A few problems that would arise from a threaded smbd are: </p></li><li><p> we couldn't use the system locking calls as the locking context of fcntl() is a process, not a thread. -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797394"></a>Threading nmbd</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800677"></a>Threading nmbd</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This would be ideal, but gets sunk by portability requirements. </p><p> Andrew tried to write a test threads library for nmbd that used only @@ -211,7 +208,7 @@ packet that arrives. Having a pool of processes is possible but is nasty to program cleanly due to the enormous amount of shared data (in complex structures) between the processes. We can't rely on each platform having a shared memory system. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797461"></a>nbmd Design</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800740"></a>nbmd Design</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Originally Andrew used recursion to simulate a multi-threaded environment, which use the stack enormously and made for really confusing debugging sessions. Luke Leighton rewrote it to use a @@ -228,11 +225,11 @@ a single process. </p><p> Then Jeremy rewrote nmbd. The packet data in nmbd isn't what's on the wire. It's a nice format that is very amenable to processing but still -keeps the idea of a distinct packet. See "struct packet_struct" in +keeps the idea of a distinct packet. See "struct packet_struct" in nameserv.h. It has all the detail but none of the on-the-wire mess. This makes it ideal for using in disk or memory-based databases for browsing and WINS support. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="debug"></a>Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Chris</span> <span class="surname">Hertel</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 1998</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2796882">New Output Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2797018">The DEBUG() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867347">The DEBUGADD() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867392">The DEBUGLVL() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867497">New Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867504">dbgtext()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867524">dbghdr()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867547">format_debug_text()</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2796882"></a>New Output Syntax</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="debug"></a>Chapter 3. The samba DEBUG system</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Chris</span> <span class="surname">Hertel</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 1998</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2800810">New Output Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2800946">The DEBUG() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801076">The DEBUGADD() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801121">The DEBUGLVL() Macro</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801232">New Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801239">dbgtext()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801258">dbghdr()</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801281">format_debug_text()</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800810"></a>New Output Syntax</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The syntax of a debugging log file is represented as: </p><pre class="programlisting"> >debugfile< :== { >debugmsg< } @@ -285,16 +282,16 @@ by a newline. Note that in the above example the function names are not listed on the header line. That's because the example above was generated on an SGI Indy, and the SGI compiler doesn't support the __FUNCTION__ macro. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2797018"></a>The DEBUG() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2800946"></a>The DEBUG() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Use of the DEBUG() macro is unchanged. DEBUG() takes two parameters. The first is the message level, the second is the body of a function call to the Debug1() function. </p><p>That's confusing.</p><p>Here's an example which may help a bit. If you would write</p><pre class="programlisting"> -printf( "This is a %s message.\n", "debug" ); +printf( "This is a %s message.\n", "debug" ); </pre><p> to send the output to stdout, then you would write </p><pre class="programlisting"> -DEBUG( 0, ( "This is a %s message.\n", "debug" ) ); +DEBUG( 0, ( "This is a %s message.\n", "debug" ) ); </pre><p> to send the output to the debug file. All of the normal printf() formatting escapes work. @@ -319,12 +316,12 @@ DEBUG() is called, the new input is simply appended. DEBUG() has been used to write partial lines. Here's a simple (dumb) example of the kind of thing I'm talking about: </p><pre class="programlisting"> - DEBUG( 0, ("The test returned " ) ); + DEBUG( 0, ("The test returned " ) ); if( test() ) - DEBUG(0, ("True") ); + DEBUG(0, ("True") ); else - DEBUG(0, ("False") ); - DEBUG(0, (".\n") ); + DEBUG(0, ("False") ); + DEBUG(0, (".\n") ); </pre><p> Without the format buffer, the output (assuming test() returned true) would look like this: @@ -336,35 +333,35 @@ would look like this: [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(261) . </pre><p>Which isn't much use. The format buffer kludge fixes this problem. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867347"></a>The DEBUGADD() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801076"></a>The DEBUGADD() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In addition to the kludgey solution to the broken line problem described above, there is a clean solution. The DEBUGADD() macro never generates a header. It will append new text to the current debug message even if the format buffer is empty. The syntax of the DEBUGADD() macro is the same as that of the DEBUG() macro. </p><pre class="programlisting"> - DEBUG( 0, ("This is the first line.\n" ) ); - DEBUGADD( 0, ("This is the second line.\nThis is the third line.\n" ) ); + DEBUG( 0, ("This is the first line.\n" ) ); + DEBUGADD( 0, ("This is the second line.\nThis is the third line.\n" ) ); </pre><p>Produces</p><pre class="programlisting"> [1998/07/30 16:00:51, 0] file.c:function(512) This is the first line. This is the second line. This is the third line. -</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867392"></a>The DEBUGLVL() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801121"></a>The DEBUGLVL() Macro</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> One of the problems with the DEBUG() macro was that DEBUG() lines tended to get a bit long. Consider this example from nmbd_sendannounce.c: </p><pre class="programlisting"> - DEBUG(3,("send_local_master_announcement: type %x for name %s on subnet %s for workgroup %s\n", + DEBUG(3,("send_local_master_announcement: type %x for name %s on subnet %s for workgroup %s\n", type, global_myname, subrec->subnet_name, work->work_group)); </pre><p> One solution to this is to break it down using DEBUG() and DEBUGADD(), as follows: </p><pre class="programlisting"> - DEBUG( 3, ( "send_local_master_announcement: " ) ); - DEBUGADD( 3, ( "type %x for name %s ", type, global_myname ) ); - DEBUGADD( 3, ( "on subnet %s ", subrec->subnet_name ) ); - DEBUGADD( 3, ( "for workgroup %s\n", work->work_group ) ); + DEBUG( 3, ( "send_local_master_announcement: " ) ); + DEBUGADD( 3, ( "type %x for name %s ", type, global_myname ) ); + DEBUGADD( 3, ( "on subnet %s ", subrec->subnet_name ) ); + DEBUGADD( 3, ( "for workgroup %s\n", work->work_group ) ); </pre><p> A similar, but arguably nicer approach is to use the DEBUGLVL() macro. This macro returns True if the message level is less than or equal to @@ -372,10 +369,10 @@ the global DEBUGLEVEL value, so: </p><pre class="programlisting"> if( DEBUGLVL( 3 ) ) { - dbgtext( "send_local_master_announcement: " ); - dbgtext( "type %x for name %s ", type, global_myname ); - dbgtext( "on subnet %s ", subrec->subnet_name ); - dbgtext( "for workgroup %s\n", work->work_group ); + dbgtext( "send_local_master_announcement: " ); + dbgtext( "type %x for name %s ", type, global_myname ); + dbgtext( "on subnet %s ", subrec->subnet_name ); + dbgtext( "for workgroup %s\n", work->work_group ); } </pre><p>(The dbgtext() function is explained below.)</p><p>There are a few advantages to this scheme:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> The test is performed only once. @@ -385,7 +382,7 @@ within the DEBUGLVL() block. </p></li><li><p> Processing that is only relevant to debug output can be contained within the DEBUGLVL() block. -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867497"></a>New Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867504"></a>dbgtext()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801232"></a>New Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801239"></a>dbgtext()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This function prints debug message text to the debug file (and possibly to syslog) via the format buffer. The function uses a variable argument list just like printf() or Debug1(). The @@ -394,7 +391,7 @@ and then passed to format_debug_text(). If you use DEBUGLVL() you will probably print the body of the message using dbgtext(). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867524"></a>dbghdr()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801258"></a>dbghdr()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is the function that writes a debug message header. Headers are not processed via the format buffer. Also note that if the format buffer is not empty, a call to dbghdr() will not @@ -402,7 +399,7 @@ produce any output. See the comments in dbghdr() for more info. </p><p> It is not likely that this function will be called directly. It is used by DEBUG() and DEBUGADD(). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867547"></a>format_debug_text()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801281"></a>format_debug_text()</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is a static function in debug.c. It stores the output text for the body of the message in a buffer until it encounters a newline. When the newline character is found, the buffer is @@ -484,7 +481,7 @@ Here are some other suggestions: reason: consistency </p></li><li><p> don't explicitly extern functions (they are autogenerated by - "make proto" into proto.h) + "make proto" into proto.h) reason: consistency </p></li><li><p> use endian safe macros when unpacking SMBs (see byteorder.h and @@ -553,7 +550,7 @@ The suggestions above are simply that, suggestions, but the information may help in reducing the routine rework done on new code. The preceeding list is expected to change routinely as new support routines and macros are added. -</p></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="internals"></a>Chapter 5. Samba Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Chappell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu">David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 May 1996</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2866920">Character Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866946">The new functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868198">Macros in byteorder.h</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869122">CVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869136">PVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869150">SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869163">SVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869179">IVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869193">SVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869208">IVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869222">SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869236">SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869251">SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869265">SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869280">RSVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869294">RIVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869308">RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869323">RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869339">LAN Manager Samba API</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869375">Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869526">Return value</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869611">Code character table</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866920"></a>Character Handling</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="internals"></a>Chapter 5. Samba Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Chappell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu">David.Chappell@mail.trincoll.edu</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 May 1996</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2801753">Character Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801778">The new functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801936">Macros in byteorder.h</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801949">CVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801963">PVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801977">SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801990">SVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802006">IVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802020">SVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802035">IVALS(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802049">SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802063">SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802078">SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802092">SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802106">RSVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802121">RIVAL(buf,pos)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802135">RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802150">RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2802166">LAN Manager Samba API</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802202">Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866095">Return value</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866180">Code character table</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801753"></a>Character Handling</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section describes character set handling in Samba, as implemented in Samba 3.0 and above </p><p> @@ -563,12 +560,12 @@ strings to/from DOS codepages. The problem is that there was no way of telling if a particular char* is in dos codepage or unix codepage. This led to a nightmare of code that tried to cope with particular cases without handlingt the general case. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866946"></a>The new functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801778"></a>The new functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The new system works like this: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> - all char* strings inside Samba are "unix" strings. These are - multi-byte strings that are in the charset defined by the "unix - charset" option in smb.conf. + all char* strings inside Samba are "unix" strings. These are + multi-byte strings that are in the charset defined by the "unix + charset" option in smb.conf. </p></li><li><p> there is no single fixed character set for unix strings, but any character set that is used does need the following properties: @@ -621,32 +618,32 @@ The new system works like this: like strchr_m(). I know this is very slow, and we will eventually speed it up but right now we want this stuff correct not fast. </p></li><li><p> - all lp_ functions now return unix strings. The magic "DOS" flag on + all lp_ functions now return unix strings. The magic "DOS" flag on parameters is gone. </p></li><li><p> all vfs functions take unix strings. Don't convert when passing to them -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868198"></a>Macros in byteorder.h</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801936"></a>Macros in byteorder.h</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section describes the macros defined in byteorder.h. These macros are used extensively in the Samba code. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869122"></a>CVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801949"></a>CVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> returns the byte at offset pos within buffer buf as an unsigned character. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869136"></a>PVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of CVAL(buf,pos) cast to type unsigned integer.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869150"></a>SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the byte at offset pos within buffer buf to value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869163"></a>SVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801963"></a>PVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of CVAL(buf,pos) cast to type unsigned integer.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801977"></a>SCVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the byte at offset pos within buffer buf to value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2801990"></a>SVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at offset pos within buffer buf. An integer of this type is sometimes - refered to as "USHORT". -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869179"></a>IVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset -pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869193"></a>SVALS(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the signed short (16 bit) little-endian integer at -offset pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869208"></a>IVALS(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos -within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869222"></a>SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at offset pos within -buffer buf to value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869236"></a>SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos within buffer -buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869251"></a>SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the short (16 bit) signed little-endian integer at offset pos within -buffer buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869265"></a>SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos withing buffer -buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869280"></a>RSVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at -offset pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869294"></a>RIVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset -pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869308"></a>RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at + refered to as "USHORT". +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802006"></a>IVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset +pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802020"></a>SVALS(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the signed short (16 bit) little-endian integer at +offset pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802035"></a>IVALS(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos +within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802049"></a>SSVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the unsigned short (16 bit) little-endian integer at offset pos within +buffer buf to value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802063"></a>SIVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the unsigned 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos within buffer +buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802078"></a>SSVALS(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the short (16 bit) signed little-endian integer at offset pos within +buffer buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802092"></a>SIVALS(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the signed 32 bit little-endian integer at offset pos withing buffer +buf to the value val.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802106"></a>RSVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at +offset pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802121"></a>RIVAL(buf,pos)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>returns the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset +pos within buffer buf.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802135"></a>RSSVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the value of the unsigned short (16 bit) big-endian integer at offset pos within buffer buf to value val. -refered to as "USHORT".</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869323"></a>RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset -pos within buffer buf to value val.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869339"></a>LAN Manager Samba API</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +refered to as "USHORT".</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802150"></a>RSIVAL(buf,pos,val)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>sets the value of the unsigned 32 bit big-endian integer at offset +pos within buffer buf to value val.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2802166"></a>LAN Manager Samba API</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section describes the functions need to make a LAN Manager RPC call. This information had been obtained by examining the Samba code and the LAN Manager 2.0 API documentation. It should not be considered entirely @@ -659,7 +656,7 @@ call_api(int prcnt, int drcnt, int mprcnt, int mdrcnt, </p><p> This function is defined in client.c. It uses an SMB transaction to call a remote api. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869375"></a>Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The parameters are as follows:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802202"></a>Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The parameters are as follows:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> prcnt: the number of bytes of parameters begin sent. </p></li><li><p> drcnt: the number of bytes of data begin sent. @@ -692,8 +689,8 @@ in the manual, not the data which is actually passed. An ASCIIZ string describing the data structure which ought to be returned. </p></li><li><p> Any parameters which appear in the function call, as defined in the LAN -Manager API documentation, after the "Server" and up to and including the -"uLevel" parameters. +Manager API documentation, after the "Server" and up to and including the +"uLevel" parameters. </p></li><li><p> An unsigned 16 bit integer which gives the size in bytes of the buffer we will use to receive the returned array of data structures. Presumably this @@ -704,7 +701,7 @@ substructures apply, this string is of zero length. </p></li></ol></div><p> The code in client.c always calls call_api() with no data. It is unclear when a non-zero length data buffer would be sent. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869526"></a>Return value</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866095"></a>Return value</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The returned parameters (pointed to by rparam), in their order of appearance are:</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> An unsigned 16 bit integer which contains the API function's return code. @@ -721,9 +718,9 @@ It is also possible that this may sometimes be the number of bytes returned. </p></li></ol></div><p> When call_api() returns, rparam points to the returned parameters. The first if these is the result code. It will be zero if the API call -suceeded. This value by be read with "SVAL(rparam,0)". +suceeded. This value by be read with "SVAL(rparam,0)". </p><p> -The second parameter may be read as "SVAL(rparam,2)". It is a 16 bit offset +The second parameter may be read as "SVAL(rparam,2)". It is a 16 bit offset which indicates what the base address of the returned data buffer was when it was built on the server. It should be used to correct pointer before use. @@ -732,10 +729,10 @@ The returned data buffer contains the array of returned data structures. Note that all pointers must be adjusted before use. The function fix_char_ptr() in client.c can be used for this purpose. </p><p> -The third parameter (which may be read as "SVAL(rparam,4)") has something to +The third parameter (which may be read as "SVAL(rparam,4)") has something to do with indicating the amount of data returned or possibly the amount of data which can be returned if enough buffer space is allowed. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869611"></a>Code character table</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866180"></a>Code character table</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Certain data structures are described by means of ASCIIz strings containing code characters. These are the code characters: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -758,7 +755,7 @@ r pointer to returned data buffer??? L length in bytes of returned data buffer??? </p></li><li><p> h number of bytes of information available??? -</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="parsing"></a>Chapter 6. The smb.conf file</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Chris</span> <span class="surname">Hertel</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">November 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2868950">Lexical Analysis</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869043">Handling of Whitespace</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869099">Handling of Line Continuation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870758">Line Continuation Quirks</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870856">Syntax</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870928">About params.c</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868950"></a>Lexical Analysis</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="parsing"></a>Chapter 6. The smb.conf file</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Chris</span> <span class="surname">Hertel</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">November 1997</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2866300">Lexical Analysis</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866391">Handling of Whitespace</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866447">Handling of Line Continuation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866511">Line Continuation Quirks</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866608">Syntax</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866679">About params.c</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866300"></a>Lexical Analysis</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Basically, the file is processed on a line by line basis. There are four types of lines that are recognized by the lexical analyzer (params.c): @@ -785,7 +782,7 @@ ignores them. The latter two line types are scanned for These are the only tokens passed to the parameter loader (loadparm.c). Parameter names and values are divided from one another by an equal sign: '='. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869043"></a>Handling of Whitespace</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866391"></a>Handling of Whitespace</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Whitespace is defined as all characters recognized by the isspace() function (see ctype(3C)) except for the newline character ('\n') The newline is excluded because it identifies the end of the line. @@ -800,7 +797,7 @@ the exception of carriage return characters ('\r'), all of which are removed. </p></li><li><p> Leading and trailing whitespace is removed from names and values. -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869099"></a>Handling of Line Continuation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866447"></a>Handling of Line Continuation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Long section header and parameter lines may be extended across multiple lines by use of the backslash character ('\\'). Line continuation is ignored for blank and comment lines. @@ -823,7 +820,7 @@ line, plus the four preceeding the word 'with' in the second line. Line continuation characters are ignored on blank lines and at the end of comments. They are *only* recognized within section and parameter lines. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870758"></a>Line Continuation Quirks</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Note the following example:</p><pre class="programlisting"> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866511"></a>Line Continuation Quirks</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Note the following example:</p><pre class="programlisting"> param name = parameter value string \ \ with line continuation. @@ -847,7 +844,7 @@ terminating character, and the rest of the line is ignored. The lines </pre><p>are read as</p><pre class="programlisting"> [section name] param name = value -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870856"></a>Syntax</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The syntax of the smb.conf file is as follows:</p><pre class="programlisting"> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866608"></a>Syntax</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The syntax of the smb.conf file is as follows:</p><pre class="programlisting"> <file> :== { <section> } EOF <section> :== <section header> { <parameter line> } <section header> :== '[' NAME ']' @@ -866,12 +863,12 @@ terminating character, and the rest of the line is ignored. The lines A parameter line is divided into a NAME and a VALUE. The *first* equal sign on the line separates the NAME from the VALUE. The VALUE is terminated by a newline character (NL = '\n'). -</p></li></ol></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870928"></a>About params.c</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866679"></a>About params.c</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The parsing of the config file is a bit unusual if you are used to lex, yacc, bison, etc. Both lexical analysis (scanning) and parsing are performed by params.c. Values are loaded via callbacks to loadparm.c. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unix-smb"></a>Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 1995</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2870375">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870400">Usernames</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870628">File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870665">Passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870702">Locking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871641">Deny Modes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871672">Trapdoor UIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871697">Port numbers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871742">Protocol Complexity</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870375"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unix-smb"></a>Chapter 7. NetBIOS in a Unix World</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 1995</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2866728">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866753">Usernames</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866834">File Ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866872">Passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866916">Locking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866978">Deny Modes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867009">Trapdoor UIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867034">Port numbers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867088">Protocol Complexity</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866728"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is a short document that describes some of the issues that confront a SMB implementation on unix, and how Samba copes with them. They may help people who are looking at unix<->PC @@ -879,7 +876,7 @@ interoperability. </p><p> It was written to help out a person who was writing a paper on unix to PC connectivity. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870400"></a>Usernames</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866753"></a>Usernames</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The SMB protocol has only a loose username concept. Early SMB protocols (such as CORE and COREPLUS) have no username concept at all. Even in later protocols clients often attempt operations @@ -890,20 +887,20 @@ Unix security is based around username/password pairs. A unix box should not allow clients to do any substantive operation without some sort of validation. </p><p> -The problem mostly manifests itself when the unix server is in "share -level" security mode. This is the default mode as the alternative -"user level" security mode usually forces a client to connect to the +The problem mostly manifests itself when the unix server is in "share +level" security mode. This is the default mode as the alternative +"user level" security mode usually forces a client to connect to the server as the same user for each connected share, which is inconvenient in many sites. </p><p> -In "share level" security the client normally gives a username in the -"session setup" protocol, but does not supply an accompanying -password. The client then connects to resources using the "tree -connect" protocol, and supplies a password. The problem is that the +In "share level" security the client normally gives a username in the +"session setup" protocol, but does not supply an accompanying +password. The client then connects to resources using the "tree +connect" protocol, and supplies a password. The problem is that the user on the PC types the username and the password in different contexts, unaware that they need to go together to give access to the server. The username is normally the one the user typed in when they -"logged onto" the PC (this assumes Windows for Workgroups). The +"logged onto" the PC (this assumes Windows for Workgroups). The password is the one they chose when connecting to the disk or printer. </p><p> The user often chooses a totally different username for their login as @@ -916,9 +913,9 @@ in the vast majority of cases. The methods include username maps, the service%user syntax, the saving of session setup usernames for later validation and the derivation of the username from the service name (either directly or via the user= option). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870628"></a>File Ownership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The commonly used SMB protocols have no way of saying "you can't do -that because you don't own the file". They have, in fact, no concept +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866834"></a>File Ownership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The commonly used SMB protocols have no way of saying "you can't do +that because you don't own the file". They have, in fact, no concept of file ownership at all. </p><p> This brings up all sorts of interesting problems. For example, when @@ -928,13 +925,13 @@ receive the wrong date. This is because the utime() call under unix only succeeds for the owner of the file, or root, even if the file is world writeable. For security reasons Samba does all file operations as the validated user, not root, so the utime() fails. This can stuff -up shared development diectories as programs like "make" will not get +up shared development diectories as programs like "make" will not get file time comparisons right. </p><p> There are several possible solutions to this problem, including username mapping, and forcing a specific username for particular shares. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870665"></a>Passwords</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866872"></a>Passwords</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many SMB clients uppercase passwords before sending them. I have no idea why they do this. Interestingly WfWg uppercases the password only if the server is running a protocol greater than COREPLUS, so @@ -943,20 +940,20 @@ obviously it isn't just the data entry routines that are to blame. Unix passwords are case sensitive. So if users use mixed case passwords they are in trouble. </p><p> -Samba can try to cope with this by either using the "password level" +Samba can try to cope with this by either using the "password level" option which causes Samba to try the offered password with up to the -specified number of case changes, or by using the "password server" +specified number of case changes, or by using the "password server" option which allows Samba to do its validation via another machine (typically a WinNT server). </p><p> Samba supports the password encryption method used by SMB clients. Note that the use of password encryption in Microsoft -networking leads to password hashes that are "plain text equivalent". +networking leads to password hashes that are "plain text equivalent". This means that it is *VERY* important to ensure that the Samba smbpasswd file containing these password hashes is only readable by the root user. See the documentation ENCRYPTION.txt for more details. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870702"></a>Locking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866916"></a>Locking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since samba 2.2, samba supports other types of locking as well. This section is outdated. </p><p> @@ -981,14 +978,14 @@ a unix environment because few unix programs use byte range locking. The stress of huge numbers of lock requests from dos/windows clients can kill the daemon on some systems. </p><p> -The second major problem is the "opportunistic locking" requested by +The second major problem is the "opportunistic locking" requested by some clients. If a client requests opportunistic locking then it is asking the server to notify it if anyone else tries to do something on the same file, at which time the client will say if it is willing to give up its lock. Unix has no simple way of implementing opportunistic locking, and currently Samba has no support for it. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871641"></a>Deny Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -When a SMB client opens a file it asks for a particular "deny mode" to +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866978"></a>Deny Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When a SMB client opens a file it asks for a particular "deny mode" to be placed on the file. These modes (DENY_NONE, DENY_READ, DENY_WRITE, DENY_ALL, DENY_FCB and DENY_DOS) specify what actions should be allowed by anyone else who tries to use the file at the same time. If @@ -1001,7 +998,7 @@ directory or a shared memory implementation. The lock file method is clumsy and consumes processing and file resources, the shared memory implementation is vastly prefered and is turned on by default for those systems that support it. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871672"></a>Trapdoor UIDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867009"></a>Trapdoor UIDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A SMB session can run with several uids on the one socket. This happens when a user connects to two shares with different usernames. To cope with this the unix server needs to switch uids @@ -1009,11 +1006,11 @@ within the one process. On some unixes (such as SCO) this is not possible. This means that on those unixes the client is restricted to a single uid. </p><p> -Note that you can also get the "trapdoor uid" message for other +Note that you can also get the "trapdoor uid" message for other reasons. Please see the FAQ for details. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871697"></a>Port numbers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There is a convention that clients on sockets use high "unprivilaged" -port numbers (>1000) and connect to servers on low "privilaged" port +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867034"></a>Port numbers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There is a convention that clients on sockets use high "unprivilaged" +port numbers (>1000) and connect to servers on low "privilaged" port numbers. This is enforced in Unix as non-root users can't open a socket for listening on port numbers less than 1000. </p><p> @@ -1034,13 +1031,13 @@ to any of these OSes unless they are running as root. The answer comes back, but it goes to port 137 which the unix user can't listen on. Interestingly WinNT3.1 got this right - it sends node status responses back to the source port in the request. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871742"></a>Protocol Complexity</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There are many "protocol levels" in the SMB protocol. It seems that +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867088"></a>Protocol Complexity</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are many "protocol levels" in the SMB protocol. It seems that each time new functionality was added to a Microsoft operating system, they added the equivalent functions in a new protocol level of the SMB -protocol to "externalise" the new capabilities. +protocol to "externalise" the new capabilities. </p><p> -This means the protocol is very "rich", offering many ways of doing +This means the protocol is very "rich", offering many ways of doing each file operation. This means SMB servers need to be complex and large. It also means it is very difficult to make them bug free. It is not just Samba that suffers from this problem, other servers such as @@ -1048,19 +1045,19 @@ WinNT don't support every variation of every call and it has almost certainly been a headache for MS developers to support the myriad of SMB calls that are available. </p><p> -There are about 65 "top level" operations in the SMB protocol (things +There are about 65 "top level" operations in the SMB protocol (things like SMBread and SMBwrite). Some of these include hundreds of sub-functions (SMBtrans has at least 120 sub-functions, like DosPrintQAdd and NetSessionEnum). All of them take several options that can change the way they work. Many take dozens of possible -"information levels" that change the structures that need to be -returned. Samba supports all but 2 of the "top level" functions. It +"information levels" that change the structures that need to be +returned. Samba supports all but 2 of the "top level" functions. It supports only 8 (so far) of the SMBtrans sub-functions. Even NT doesn't support them all. </p><p> -Samba currently supports up to the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, which is the +Samba currently supports up to the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, which is the one preferred by Win95 and WinNT3.5. Luckily this protocol level has a -"capabilities" field which specifies which super-duper new-fangled +"capabilities" field which specifies which super-duper new-fangled options the server suports. This helps to make the implementation of this protocol level much easier. </p><p> @@ -1105,13 +1102,13 @@ You'll notice that it produces a LOT of output. It is showing you the arguments to every system call that the program makes and the result. Very little happens in a program without a system call so you get lots of output. You'll also find that it produces a lot of -"preamble" stuff showing the loading of shared libraries etc. Ignore +"preamble" stuff showing the loading of shared libraries etc. Ignore this (unless its going wrong!) </p><p> For example, the only line that really matters in the <b class="command">strace echo hello</b> output is: </p><pre class="programlisting"> -write(1, "hello\n", 6) = 6 +write(1, "hello\n", 6) = 6 </pre><p>all the rest is just setting up to run the program.</p><p> Ok, now you're familiar with strace. To use it on Samba you need to strace the running smbd daemon. The way I tend ot use it is to first @@ -1121,10 +1118,10 @@ find which process ID that client is attached to, then as root I do stderr output from this command to a file for later perusal. For example, if I'm using a csh style shell: </p><p><b class="command">strace -f -p 3872 >& strace.out</b></p><p>or with a sh style shell:</p><p><b class="command">strace -f -p 3872 > strace.out 2>&1</b></p><p> -Note the "-f" option. This is only available on some systems, and +Note the "-f" option. This is only available on some systems, and allows you to trace not just the current process, but any children it forks. This is great for finding printing problems caused by the -"print command" being wrong. +"print command" being wrong. </p><p> Once you are attached you then can do whatever it is on the client that is causing problems and you will capture all the system calls @@ -1135,20 +1132,20 @@ output for strings that I know will appear when the problem happens. For example, if I am having touble with permissions on a file I would search for that files name in the strace output and look at the surrounding lines. Another trick is to match up file descriptor -numbers and "follow" what happens to an open file until it is closed. +numbers and "follow" what happens to an open file until it is closed. </p><p> Beyond this you will have to use your initiative. To give you an idea of what you are looking for here is a piece of strace output that shows that <tt class="filename">/dev/null</tt> is not world writeable, which causes printing to fail with Samba: </p><pre class="programlisting"> -[pid 28268] open("/dev/null", O_RDWR) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied) -[pid 28268] open("/dev/null", O_WRONLY) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied) +[pid 28268] open("/dev/null", O_RDWR) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied) +[pid 28268] open("/dev/null", O_WRONLY) = -1 EACCES (Permission denied) </pre><p> The process is trying to first open <tt class="filename">/dev/null</tt> read-write then read-only. Both fail. This means <tt class="filename">/dev/null</tt> has incorrect permissions. -</p></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="windows-debug"></a>Chapter 9. Finding useful information on windows</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2871397">Netlogon debugging output</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871397"></a>Netlogon debugging output</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p>stop netlogon service on PDC</p></li><li><p>rename original netlogon.dll to netlogon.dll.original</p></li><li><p>copy checked version of netlogon.dll to system32 directory</p></li><li><p>set HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\Netlogon\Parameters\DBFlag to 0x20000004</p></li><li><p>start netlogon service on PDC</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ntdomain"></a>Chapter 10. NT Domain RPC's</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Luke</span> <span class="surname">Leighton</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net">lkcl@switchboard.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Ashton</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paul@argo.demon.co.uk">paul@argo.demon.co.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Duncan</span> <span class="surname">Stansfield</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:duncans@sco.com">duncans@sco.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">01 November 97(version 0.0.24)</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2872364">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873295">Sources</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873330">Credits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2873367">Notes and Structures</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873375">Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873451">Enumerations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873665">Structures</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876614">MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876627">MSRPC Pipes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876729">Header</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877600">Tail</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877647">RPC Bind / Bind Ack</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877826">NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877991">LSA Open Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878118">LSA Query Info Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878223">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878315">LSA Open Secret</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878424">LSA Close</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878490">LSA Lookup SIDS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878700">LSA Lookup Names</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878926">NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879087">LSA Request Challenge</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879222">LSA Authenticate 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879369">LSA Server Password Set</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879484">LSA SAM Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879598">LSA SAM Logoff</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879689">\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879701">Query for PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879969">SAM Logon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880294">SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880339">Net Share Enum</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880558">Net Server Get Info</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880674">Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880682">Definitions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880845">Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880942">Comments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880991">SIDs and RIDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881031">Well-known SIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881346">Well-known RIDS</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2872364"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="windows-debug"></a>Chapter 9. Finding useful information on windows</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2867492">Netlogon debugging output</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867492"></a>Netlogon debugging output</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p>stop netlogon service on PDC</p></li><li><p>rename original netlogon.dll to netlogon.dll.original</p></li><li><p>copy checked version of netlogon.dll to system32 directory</p></li><li><p>set HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\Netlogon\Parameters\DBFlag to 0x20000004</p></li><li><p>start netlogon service on PDC</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ntdomain"></a>Chapter 10. NT Domain RPC's</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Luke</span> <span class="surname">Leighton</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net">lkcl@switchboard.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Ashton</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paul@argo.demon.co.uk">paul@argo.demon.co.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Duncan</span> <span class="surname">Stansfield</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:duncans@sco.com">duncans@sco.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">01 November 97(version 0.0.24)</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2867633">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867832">Sources</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867868">Credits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2867906">Notes and Structures</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867913">Notes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867989">Enumerations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868203">Structures</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2871153">MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871166">MSRPC Pipes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871268">Header</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872139">Tail</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872184">RPC Bind / Bind Ack</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872365">NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872530">LSA Open Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872655">LSA Query Info Policy</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872763">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872853">LSA Open Secret</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872963">LSA Close</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873028">LSA Lookup SIDS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873238">LSA Lookup Names</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2873464">NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873625">LSA Request Challenge</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873759">LSA Authenticate 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873906">LSA Server Password Set</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874022">LSA SAM Logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874125">LSA SAM Logoff</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874216">\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874229">Query for PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874497">SAM Logon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874822">SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874867">Net Share Enum</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875087">Net Server Get Info</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875203">Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875211">Definitions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875373">Protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875471">Comments</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875519">SIDs and RIDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875558">Well-known SIDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875874">Well-known RIDS</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867633"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This document contains information to provide an NT workstation with login services, without the need for an NT server. It is the sgml version of <a href="http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/cifsntdomain.txt" target="_top">http://mailhost.cb1.com/~lkcl/cifsntdomain.txt</a>, controlled by Luke. </p><p> @@ -1181,7 +1178,7 @@ NT workstation, and enabling full debugging in NETLOGON. This is achieved by setting the following REG_SZ registry key to 0x1ffffff: </p><p><tt class="filename">HKLM\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Services\Netlogon\Parameters</tt></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Incorrect direct editing of the registry can cause your machine to fail. Then again, so can incorrect implementation of this -protocol. See "Liability:" above.</em></span></p><p> +protocol. See "Liability:" above.</em></span></p><p> Bear in mind that each packet over-the-wire will have its origin in an API call. Therefore, there are likely to be structures, enumerations and defines that are usefully documented elsewhere. @@ -1194,12 +1191,12 @@ Failure to return this error code will make the workstation report that it is already a member of the domain.</p></li><li><p>the cryptographic side of the NetrServerPasswordSet command, which would allow the workstation to change its password. This password is used to generate the long-term session key. [It is possible to reject this -command, and keep the default workstation password].</p></li></ol></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873295"></a>Sources</h3></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>cket Traces from Netmonitor (Service Pack 1 and above)</td></tr><tr><td>ul Ashton and Luke Leighton's other "NT Domain" doc.</td></tr><tr><td>FS documentation - cifs6.txt</td></tr><tr><td>FS documentation - cifsrap2.txt</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873330"></a>Credits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Paul Ashton: loads of work with Net Monitor; understanding the NT authentication system; reference implementation of the NT domain support on which this document is originally based.</td></tr><tr><td>Duncan Stansfield: low-level analysis of MSRPC Pipes.</td></tr><tr><td>Linus Nordberg: producing c-code from Paul's crypto spec.</td></tr><tr><td>Windows Sourcer development team</td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2873367"></a>Notes and Structures</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873375"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> -In the SMB Transact pipes, some "Structures", described here, appear to be +command, and keep the default workstation password].</p></li></ol></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867832"></a>Sources</h3></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>cket Traces from Netmonitor (Service Pack 1 and above)</td></tr><tr><td>ul Ashton and Luke Leighton's other "NT Domain" doc.</td></tr><tr><td>FS documentation - cifs6.txt</td></tr><tr><td>FS documentation - cifsrap2.txt</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867868"></a>Credits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Paul Ashton: loads of work with Net Monitor; understanding the NT authentication system; reference implementation of the NT domain support on which this document is originally based.</td></tr><tr><td>Duncan Stansfield: low-level analysis of MSRPC Pipes.</td></tr><tr><td>Linus Nordberg: producing c-code from Paul's crypto spec.</td></tr><tr><td>Windows Sourcer development team</td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867906"></a>Notes and Structures</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867913"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> +In the SMB Transact pipes, some "Structures", described here, appear to be 4-byte aligned with the SMB header, at their start. Exactly which -"Structures" need aligning is not precisely known or documented. +"Structures" need aligning is not precisely known or documented. </p></li><li><p> -In the UDP NTLOGON Mailslots, some "Structures", described here, appear to be +In the UDP NTLOGON Mailslots, some "Structures", described here, appear to be 2-byte aligned with the start of the mailslot, at their start. </p></li><li><p> Domain SID is of the format S-revision-version-auth1-auth2...authN. @@ -1222,15 +1219,15 @@ into or taken out of the SMB data stream. if the count is non-zero, then the pointer is also non-zero. immediately following the pointer is the count again, followed by an array of container sub-structures. the count appears a third time after the last sub-structure. -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873451"></a>Enumerations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873459"></a>MSRPC Header type</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>command number in the msrpc packet header</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Request:</span></dt><dd><p>0x00</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Response:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Bind:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0B</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_BindAck:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0C</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873534"></a>MSRPC Packet info</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The meaning of these flags is undocumented</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">FirstFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x01 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LastFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotaFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x04 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RecRespond:</span></dt><dd><p>0x08 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NoMultiplex:</span></dt><dd><p>0x10 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotForIdemp:</span></dt><dd><p>0x20 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotforBcast:</span></dt><dd><p>0x40 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NoUuid:</span></dt><dd><p>0x80 </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873665"></a>Structures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873672"></a>VOID *</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>sizeof VOID* is 32 bits.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873683"></a>char</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>sizeof char is 8 bits.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873695"></a>UTIME</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>UTIME is 32 bits, indicating time in seconds since 01jan1970. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873708"></a>NTTIME</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>NTTIME is 64 bits. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873720"></a>DOM_SID (domain SID structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num of sub-authorities in domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8</span></dt><dd><p>SID revision number</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8</span></dt><dd><p>num of sub-authorities in domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[6]</span></dt><dd><p>6 bytes for domain SID - Identifier Authority.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[n_subauths]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID sub-authorities</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the domain SID is documented elsewhere.</em></span> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873813"></a>STR (string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>STR (string) is a char[] : a null-terminated string of ascii characters.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873827"></a>UNIHDR (unicode string header) </h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>max length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - undocumented.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873883"></a>UNIHDR2 (unicode string header plus buffer pointer)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873925"></a>UNISTR (unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>null-terminated string of unicode characters.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873953"></a>NAME (length-indicated unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>null-terminated string of unicode characters.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873995"></a>UNISTR2 (aligned unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>max length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>string of uncode characters</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874081"></a>OBJ_ATTR (object attributes)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0x18 - length (in bytes) including the length field.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - root directory (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - object name (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - attributes (undocumented)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - security descriptior (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - security quality of service</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874174"></a>POL_HND (LSA policy handle)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[20]</span></dt><dd><p>policy handle</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874201"></a>DOM_SID2 (domain SID structure, SIDS stored in unicode)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - SID type</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID unicode string</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: there is a conflict between the unicode string header and the unicode string itself as to which to use to indicate string length. this will need to be resolved.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the SID type indicates, for example, an alias; a well-known group etc. this is documented somewhere.</em></span></p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874288"></a>DOM_RID (domain RID structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - well-known SID. 1 - user SID (see ShowACLs)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>domain RID </p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - domain index out of above reference domains</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874358"></a>LOG_INFO (server, account, client structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: account name is the logon client name from the LSA Request Challenge, with a $ on the end of it, in upper case.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>account name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>sec_chan - security channel type</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client machine unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874457"></a>CLNT_SRV (server, client names structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client machine unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874535"></a>CREDS (credentials + time stamp)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>credentials</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UTIME</span></dt><dd><p>time stamp</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874576"></a>CLNT_INFO2 (server, client structure, client credentials)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will beused in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to - maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_SRV</span></dt><dd><p>client and server names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>???? padding, for 4-byte alignment with SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to client credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials + client time</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874658"></a>CLNT_INFO (server, account, client structure, client credentials)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will be used in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LOG_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>logon account info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials + client time</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874711"></a>ID_INFO_1 (id info structure, auth level 1)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>ptr_id_info_1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>param control</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT64</span></dt><dd><p>logon ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>user name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>workgroup name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>arc4 LM OWF Password</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>arc4 NT OWF Password</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>user name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>workstation name unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874881"></a>SAM_INFO (sam logon/logoff id info structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: presumably, the return credentials is supposedly for the server to verify that the credential chain hasn't been compromised.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_INFO2</span></dt><dd><p>client identification/authentication info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to return credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CRED</span></dt><dd><p>return credentials - ignored.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>logon level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting"> +</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867989"></a>Enumerations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2867997"></a>MSRPC Header type</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>command number in the msrpc packet header</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Request:</span></dt><dd><p>0x00</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Response:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_Bind:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0B</p></dd><dt><span class="term">MSRPC_BindAck:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0C</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868072"></a>MSRPC Packet info</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The meaning of these flags is undocumented</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">FirstFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x01 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LastFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotaFrag:</span></dt><dd><p>0x04 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RecRespond:</span></dt><dd><p>0x08 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NoMultiplex:</span></dt><dd><p>0x10 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotForIdemp:</span></dt><dd><p>0x20 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NotforBcast:</span></dt><dd><p>0x40 </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NoUuid:</span></dt><dd><p>0x80 </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2868203"></a>Structures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868210"></a>VOID *</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>sizeof VOID* is 32 bits.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868221"></a>char</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>sizeof char is 8 bits.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868232"></a>UTIME</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>UTIME is 32 bits, indicating time in seconds since 01jan1970. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868246"></a>NTTIME</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>NTTIME is 64 bits. documented in cifs6.txt (section 3.5 page, page 30).</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868258"></a>DOM_SID (domain SID structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num of sub-authorities in domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8</span></dt><dd><p>SID revision number</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8</span></dt><dd><p>num of sub-authorities in domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[6]</span></dt><dd><p>6 bytes for domain SID - Identifier Authority.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[n_subauths]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID sub-authorities</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the domain SID is documented elsewhere.</em></span> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868352"></a>STR (string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>STR (string) is a char[] : a null-terminated string of ascii characters.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868365"></a>UNIHDR (unicode string header) </h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>max length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - undocumented.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868422"></a>UNIHDR2 (unicode string header plus buffer pointer)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868463"></a>UNISTR (unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>null-terminated string of unicode characters.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868491"></a>NAME (length-indicated unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>null-terminated string of unicode characters.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868534"></a>UNISTR2 (aligned unicode string)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>max length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>length of unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16[]</span></dt><dd><p>string of uncode characters</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868619"></a>OBJ_ATTR (object attributes)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0x18 - length (in bytes) including the length field.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - root directory (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - object name (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - attributes (undocumented)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>0 - security descriptior (pointer)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - security quality of service</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868713"></a>POL_HND (LSA policy handle)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[20]</span></dt><dd><p>policy handle</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868740"></a>DOM_SID2 (domain SID structure, SIDS stored in unicode)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - SID type</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID unicode string</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: there is a conflict between the unicode string header and the unicode string itself as to which to use to indicate string length. this will need to be resolved.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the SID type indicates, for example, an alias; a well-known group etc. this is documented somewhere.</em></span></p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868826"></a>DOM_RID (domain RID structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - well-known SID. 1 - user SID (see ShowACLs)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>domain RID </p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - domain index out of above reference domains</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868896"></a>LOG_INFO (server, account, client structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: account name is the logon client name from the LSA Request Challenge, with a $ on the end of it, in upper case.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>account name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>sec_chan - security channel type</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client machine unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868996"></a>CLNT_SRV (server, client names structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client machine unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869073"></a>CREDS (credentials + time stamp)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>credentials</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UTIME</span></dt><dd><p>time stamp</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869114"></a>CLNT_INFO2 (server, client structure, client credentials)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will beused in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to + maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_SRV</span></dt><dd><p>client and server names</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>???? padding, for 4-byte alignment with SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to client credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials + client time</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869196"></a>CLNT_INFO (server, account, client structure, client credentials)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: whenever this structure appears in a request, you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received, because they will be used in subsequent credential checks. the presumed intention is to maintain an authenticated request/response trail.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LOG_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>logon account info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials + client time</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869248"></a>ID_INFO_1 (id info structure, auth level 1)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>ptr_id_info_1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>param control</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT64</span></dt><dd><p>logon ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>user name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>workgroup name unicode header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>arc4 LM OWF Password</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>arc4 NT OWF Password</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>user name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>workstation name unicode string</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869420"></a>SAM_INFO (sam logon/logoff id info structure)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: presumably, the return credentials is supposedly for the server to verify that the credential chain hasn't been compromised.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_INFO2</span></dt><dd><p>client identification/authentication info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to return credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CRED</span></dt><dd><p>return credentials - ignored.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>logon level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting"> switch (switch_value) case 1: { ID_INFO_1 id_info_1; } -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874984"></a>GID (group id info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>group id</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>user attributes (only used by NT 3.1 and 3.51)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875023"></a>DOM_REF (domain reference info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num referenced domains?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>32 - max number of entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - num referenced domains?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2[num_ref_doms-1]</span></dt><dd><p>referenced domain unicode string headers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID[num_ref_doms]</span></dt><dd><p>referenced domain SIDs</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875166"></a>DOM_INFO (domain info, levels 3 and 5 are the same))</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>??? padding to get 4-byte alignment with start of SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>domain name string length * 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>domain name string length * 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name string buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID string buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name (unicode string)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875279"></a>USER_INFO (user logon info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: it would be nice to know what the 16 byte user session key is for.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>logon time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>logoff time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>kickoff time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password last set time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password can change time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password must change time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>username unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>user's full name unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon script unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>profile path unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>home directory unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>home directory drive unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>logon count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>bad password count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>User ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>Group ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer to groups.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>user flags</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>user session key</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon domain unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented logon domain id pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[40]</span></dt><dd><p>40 undocumented padding bytes. future expansion?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - num_other_sids?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>NULL - undocumented pointer to other domain SIDs.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>username unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>user's full name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon script unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>profile path unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>home directory unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>home directory drive unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">GID[num_groups]</span></dt><dd><p>group info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon domain unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID[num_sids]</span></dt><dd><p>other domain SIDs?</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875843"></a>SH_INFO_1_PTR (pointers to level 1 share info strings)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: see cifsrap2.txt section5, page 10.</em></span></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>0 for shi1_type indicates a Disk.</td></tr><tr><td>1 for shi1_type indicates a Print Queue.</td></tr><tr><td>2 for shi1_type indicates a Device.</td></tr><tr><td>3 for shi1_type indicates an IPC pipe.</td></tr><tr><td>0x8000 0000 (top bit set in shi1_type) indicates a hidden share.</td></tr></table><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_netname - pointer to net name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_type - type of share. 0 - undocumented.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_remark - pointer to comment.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875937"></a>SH_INFO_1_STR (level 1 share info strings)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_netname - unicode string of net name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_remark - unicode string of comment.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875980"></a>SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>share container with 0 entries:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - Buffer</p></dd></dl></div><p>share container with > 0 entries:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>non-zero - Buffer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SH_INFO_1_PTR[EntriesRead]</span></dt><dd><p>share entry pointers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SH_INFO_1_STR[EntriesRead]</span></dt><dd><p>share entry strings</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - padding</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876149"></a>SERVER_INFO_101</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: see cifs6.txt section 6.4 - the fields described therein will be of assistance here. for example, the type listed below is the same as fServerType, which is described in 6.4.1. </em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_WORKSTATION</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000001 All workstations</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000002 All servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SQLSERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000004 Any server running with SQL server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_CTRL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000008 Primary domain controller</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_BAKCTRL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000010 Backup domain controller</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_TIME_SOURCE</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000020 Server running the timesource service</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_AFP</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000040 Apple File Protocol servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_NOVELL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000080 Novell servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MEMBER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000100 Domain Member</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_PRINTQ_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000200 Server sharing print queue</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DIALIN_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000400 Server running dialin service.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_XENIX_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000800 Xenix server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_NT</span></dt><dd><p>0x00001000 NT server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_WFW</span></dt><dd><p>0x00002000 Server running Windows for </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SERVER_NT</span></dt><dd><p>0x00008000 Windows NT non DC server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_POTENTIAL_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00010000 Server that can run the browser service</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_BACKUP_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00020000 Backup browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_MASTER_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00040000 Master browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MASTER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00080000 Domain Master Browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_LOCAL_LIST_ONLY</span></dt><dd><p>0x40000000 Enumerate only entries marked "local"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_ENUM</span></dt><dd><p>0x80000000 Enumerate Domains. The pszServer and pszDomain parameters must be NULL.</p></dd></dl></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>500 - platform_id</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - major version</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - minor version</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>type (SV_TYPE_... bit field)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to comment</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>sv101_name - unicode string of server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>sv_101_comment - unicode string of server comment.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876614"></a>MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>For details on the SMB Transact Named Pipe, see cifs6.txt</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876627"></a>MSRPC Pipes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869524"></a>GID (group id info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>group id</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>user attributes (only used by NT 3.1 and 3.51)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869562"></a>DOM_REF (domain reference info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num referenced domains?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>32 - max number of entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - num referenced domains?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR2[num_ref_doms-1]</span></dt><dd><p>referenced domain unicode string headers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID[num_ref_doms]</span></dt><dd><p>referenced domain SIDs</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869705"></a>DOM_INFO (domain info, levels 3 and 5 are the same))</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>??? padding to get 4-byte alignment with start of SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>domain name string length * 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>domain name string length * 2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name string buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID string buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>domain name (unicode string)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869818"></a>USER_INFO (user logon info)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: it would be nice to know what the 16 byte user session key is for.</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>logon time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>logoff time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>kickoff time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password last set time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password can change time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NTTIME</span></dt><dd><p>password must change time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>username unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>user's full name unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon script unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>profile path unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>home directory unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>home directory drive unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>logon count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>bad password count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>User ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>Group ID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer to groups.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>user flags</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>user session key</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNIHDR</span></dt><dd><p>logon domain unicode string header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented logon domain id pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[40]</span></dt><dd><p>40 undocumented padding bytes. future expansion?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - num_other_sids?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>NULL - undocumented pointer to other domain SIDs.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>username unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>user's full name unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon script unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>profile path unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>home directory unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>home directory drive unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num groups</p></dd><dt><span class="term">GID[num_groups]</span></dt><dd><p>group info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon domain unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID[num_sids]</span></dt><dd><p>other domain SIDs?</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870381"></a>SH_INFO_1_PTR (pointers to level 1 share info strings)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: see cifsrap2.txt section5, page 10.</em></span></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>0 for shi1_type indicates a Disk.</td></tr><tr><td>1 for shi1_type indicates a Print Queue.</td></tr><tr><td>2 for shi1_type indicates a Device.</td></tr><tr><td>3 for shi1_type indicates an IPC pipe.</td></tr><tr><td>0x8000 0000 (top bit set in shi1_type) indicates a hidden share.</td></tr></table><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_netname - pointer to net name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_type - type of share. 0 - undocumented.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_remark - pointer to comment.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870475"></a>SH_INFO_1_STR (level 1 share info strings)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_netname - unicode string of net name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>shi1_remark - unicode string of comment.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870518"></a>SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>share container with 0 entries:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - Buffer</p></dd></dl></div><p>share container with > 0 entries:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>non-zero - Buffer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SH_INFO_1_PTR[EntriesRead]</span></dt><dd><p>share entry pointers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SH_INFO_1_STR[EntriesRead]</span></dt><dd><p>share entry strings</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>EntriesRead</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - padding</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870687"></a>SERVER_INFO_101</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: see cifs6.txt section 6.4 - the fields described therein will be of assistance here. for example, the type listed below is the same as fServerType, which is described in 6.4.1. </em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_WORKSTATION</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000001 All workstations</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000002 All servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SQLSERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000004 Any server running with SQL server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_CTRL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000008 Primary domain controller</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_BAKCTRL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000010 Backup domain controller</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_TIME_SOURCE</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000020 Server running the timesource service</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_AFP</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000040 Apple File Protocol servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_NOVELL</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000080 Novell servers</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MEMBER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000100 Domain Member</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_PRINTQ_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000200 Server sharing print queue</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DIALIN_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000400 Server running dialin service.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_XENIX_SERVER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00000800 Xenix server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_NT</span></dt><dd><p>0x00001000 NT server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_WFW</span></dt><dd><p>0x00002000 Server running Windows for </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_SERVER_NT</span></dt><dd><p>0x00008000 Windows NT non DC server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_POTENTIAL_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00010000 Server that can run the browser service</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_BACKUP_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00020000 Backup browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_MASTER_BROWSER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00040000 Master browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_MASTER</span></dt><dd><p>0x00080000 Domain Master Browser server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_LOCAL_LIST_ONLY</span></dt><dd><p>0x40000000 Enumerate only entries marked "local"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SV_TYPE_DOMAIN_ENUM</span></dt><dd><p>0x80000000 Enumerate Domains. The pszServer and pszDomain parameters must be NULL.</p></dd></dl></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>500 - platform_id</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>5 - major version</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>4 - minor version</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>type (SV_TYPE_... bit field)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to comment</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>sv101_name - unicode string of server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>sv_101_comment - unicode string of server comment.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with start of the SMB header.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871153"></a>MSRPC over Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>For details on the SMB Transact Named Pipe, see cifs6.txt</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871166"></a>MSRPC Pipes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The MSRPC is conducted over an SMB Transact Pipe with a name of <tt class="filename">\PIPE\</tt>. You must first obtain a 16 bit file handle, by sending a SMBopenX with the pipe name <tt class="filename">\PIPE\srvsvc</tt> for @@ -1269,21 +1266,21 @@ To be resolved: lkcl/01nov97 there appear to be two additional bytes after the null-terminated \PIPE\ name for the RPC pipe. Values seen so far are listed below:</p><pre class="programlisting"> initial SMBopenX request: RPC API command 0x26 params: - "\\PIPE\\lsarpc" 0x65 0x63; 0x72 0x70; 0x44 0x65; - "\\PIPE\\srvsvc" 0x73 0x76; 0x4E 0x00; 0x5C 0x43; -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876729"></a>Header</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>[section to be rewritten, following receipt of work by Duncan Stansfield]</p><p>Interesting note: if you set packed data representation to 0x0100 0000 -then all 4-byte and 2-byte word ordering is turned around!</p><p>The start of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes begins with:</p><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>offset: </b>00</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>5 - RPC major version</p><p><b>offset: </b>01</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - RPC minor version</p><p><b>offset: </b>02</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>2 - RPC response packet</p><p><b>offset: </b>03</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>3 - (FirstFrag bit-wise or with LastFrag)</p><p><b>offset: </b>04</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0x1000 0000 - packed data representation</p><p><b>offset: </b>08</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>fragment length - data size (bytes) inc header and tail.</p><p><b>offset: </b>0A</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - authentication length </p><p><b>offset: </b>0C</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>call identifier. matches 12th UINT32 of incoming RPC data.</p><p><b>offset: </b>10</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>allocation hint - data size (bytes) minus header and tail.</p><p><b>offset: </b>14</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - presentation context identifier</p><p><b>offset: </b>16</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - cancel count</p><p><b>offset: </b>17</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>in replies: 0 - reserved; in requests: opnum - see #defines.</p><p><b>offset: </b>18</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>......</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>start of data (goes on for allocation_hint bytes)</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2876919"></a>RPC_Packet for request, response, bind and bind acknowledgement</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8 versionmaj</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x05)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 versionmin</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 type</span></dt><dd><p>one of the MSRPC_Type enums</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 flags</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00 for Bind, 0x03 for Request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 representation</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00000010)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 fraglength</span></dt><dd><p>the length of the data section of the SMB trans packet</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 authlength</span></dt><dd><p></p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 callid</span></dt><dd><p>call identifier. (e.g. 0x00149594)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p>the remainder of the packet depending on the "type"</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877052"></a>Interface identification</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the interfaces are numbered. as yet I haven't seen more than one interface used on the same pipe name srvsvc</p><pre class="programlisting"> + "\\PIPE\\lsarpc" 0x65 0x63; 0x72 0x70; 0x44 0x65; + "\\PIPE\\srvsvc" 0x73 0x76; 0x4E 0x00; 0x5C 0x43; +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871268"></a>Header</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>[section to be rewritten, following receipt of work by Duncan Stansfield]</p><p>Interesting note: if you set packed data representation to 0x0100 0000 +then all 4-byte and 2-byte word ordering is turned around!</p><p>The start of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes begins with:</p><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>offset: </b>00</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>5 - RPC major version</p><p><b>offset: </b>01</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - RPC minor version</p><p><b>offset: </b>02</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>2 - RPC response packet</p><p><b>offset: </b>03</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>3 - (FirstFrag bit-wise or with LastFrag)</p><p><b>offset: </b>04</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0x1000 0000 - packed data representation</p><p><b>offset: </b>08</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>fragment length - data size (bytes) inc header and tail.</p><p><b>offset: </b>0A</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - authentication length </p><p><b>offset: </b>0C</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>call identifier. matches 12th UINT32 of incoming RPC data.</p><p><b>offset: </b>10</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT32</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>allocation hint - data size (bytes) minus header and tail.</p><p><b>offset: </b>14</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT16</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - presentation context identifier</p><p><b>offset: </b>16</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>0 - cancel count</p><p><b>offset: </b>17</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>UINT8</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>in replies: 0 - reserved; in requests: opnum - see #defines.</p><p><b>offset: </b>18</p><p><b>Variable type: </b>......</p><p><b>Variable data: </b>start of data (goes on for allocation_hint bytes)</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871457"></a>RPC_Packet for request, response, bind and bind acknowledgement</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8 versionmaj</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x05)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 versionmin</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 type</span></dt><dd><p>one of the MSRPC_Type enums</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 flags</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00 for Bind, 0x03 for Request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 representation</span></dt><dd><p>reply same as request (0x00000010)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 fraglength</span></dt><dd><p>the length of the data section of the SMB trans packet</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 authlength</span></dt><dd><p></p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 callid</span></dt><dd><p>call identifier. (e.g. 0x00149594)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p>the remainder of the packet depending on the "type"</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871591"></a>Interface identification</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the interfaces are numbered. as yet I haven't seen more than one interface used on the same pipe name srvsvc</p><pre class="programlisting"> abstract (0x4B324FC8, 0x01D31670, 0x475A7812, 0x88E16EBF, 0x00000003) transfer (0x8A885D04, 0x11C91CEB, 0x0008E89F, 0x6048102B, 0x00000002) -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877078"></a>RPC_Iface RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8 byte[16]</span></dt><dd><p>16 bytes of number</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 version</span></dt><dd><p>the interface number</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877117"></a>RPC_ReqBind RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the remainder of the packet after the header if "type" was Bind in the response header, "type" should be BindAck</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxtsize</span></dt><dd><p>maximum transmission fragment size (0x1630)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxrsize</span></dt><dd><p>max receive fragment size (0x1630)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 assocgid</span></dt><dd><p>associated group id (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 numelements</span></dt><dd><p>the number of elements (0x1)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 contextid</span></dt><dd><p>presentation context identifier (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 numsyntaxes</span></dt><dd><p>the number of syntaxes (has always been 1?)(0x1)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* abstractint USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>num and vers. of interface client is using</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* transferint USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>num and vers. of interface to use for replies</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877258"></a>RPC_Address RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 length</span></dt><dd><p>length of the string including null terminator</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* port USE string</span></dt><dd><p>the string above in single byte, null terminated form</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877298"></a>RPC_ResBind RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the response to place after the header in the reply packet</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxtsize</span></dt><dd><p>same as request</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxrsize</span></dt><dd><p>same as request</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 assocgid</span></dt><dd><p>zero</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* secondaddr USE RPC_Address</span></dt><dd><p>the address string, as described earlier</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 numresults</span></dt><dd><p>the number of results (0x01)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 result</span></dt><dd><p>result (0x00 = accept)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 reason</span></dt><dd><p>reason (0x00 = no reason specified)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* transfersyntax USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>the transfer syntax from the request</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877448"></a>RPC_ReqNorm RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the remainder of the packet after the header for every other other request</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32 allochint</span></dt><dd><p>the size of the stub data in bytes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 prescontext</span></dt><dd><p>presentation context identifier (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 opnum</span></dt><dd><p>operation number (0x15)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p>a packet dependent on the pipe name (probably the interface) and the op number)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2877519"></a>RPC_ResNorm RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32 allochint</span></dt><dd><p># size of the stub data in bytes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 prescontext</span></dt><dd><p># presentation context identifier (same as request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 cancelcount</span></dt><dd><p># cancel count? (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 reserved</span></dt><dd><p># 0 - one byte padding</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p># the remainder of the reply</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877600"></a>Tail</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The end of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes ends with:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">......</span></dt><dd><p>end of data</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>return code</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877647"></a>RPC Bind / Bind Ack</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871618"></a>RPC_Iface RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT8 byte[16]</span></dt><dd><p>16 bytes of number</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 version</span></dt><dd><p>the interface number</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871657"></a>RPC_ReqBind RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the remainder of the packet after the header if "type" was Bind in the response header, "type" should be BindAck</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxtsize</span></dt><dd><p>maximum transmission fragment size (0x1630)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxrsize</span></dt><dd><p>max receive fragment size (0x1630)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 assocgid</span></dt><dd><p>associated group id (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 numelements</span></dt><dd><p>the number of elements (0x1)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 contextid</span></dt><dd><p>presentation context identifier (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 numsyntaxes</span></dt><dd><p>the number of syntaxes (has always been 1?)(0x1)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* abstractint USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>num and vers. of interface client is using</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* transferint USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>num and vers. of interface to use for replies</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871796"></a>RPC_Address RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 length</span></dt><dd><p>length of the string including null terminator</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* port USE string</span></dt><dd><p>the string above in single byte, null terminated form</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871836"></a>RPC_ResBind RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the response to place after the header in the reply packet</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxtsize</span></dt><dd><p>same as request</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 maxrsize</span></dt><dd><p>same as request</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32 assocgid</span></dt><dd><p>zero</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* secondaddr USE RPC_Address</span></dt><dd><p>the address string, as described earlier</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 numresults</span></dt><dd><p>the number of results (0x01)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>4-byte alignment padding, against SMB header</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 result</span></dt><dd><p>result (0x00 = accept)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 reason</span></dt><dd><p>reason (0x00 = no reason specified)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* transfersyntax USE RPC_Iface</span></dt><dd><p>the transfer syntax from the request</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871987"></a>RPC_ReqNorm RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>the remainder of the packet after the header for every other other request</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32 allochint</span></dt><dd><p>the size of the stub data in bytes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 prescontext</span></dt><dd><p>presentation context identifier (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 opnum</span></dt><dd><p>operation number (0x15)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p>a packet dependent on the pipe name (probably the interface) and the op number)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872059"></a>RPC_ResNorm RW</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32 allochint</span></dt><dd><p># size of the stub data in bytes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16 prescontext</span></dt><dd><p># presentation context identifier (same as request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 cancelcount</span></dt><dd><p># cancel count? (0x0)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8 reserved</span></dt><dd><p># 0 - one byte padding</p></dd><dt><span class="term">* stub USE TvPacket</span></dt><dd><p># the remainder of the reply</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872139"></a>Tail</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The end of each of the NTLSA and NETLOGON named pipes ends with:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">......</span></dt><dd><p>end of data</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>return code</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872184"></a>RPC Bind / Bind Ack</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> RPC Binds are the process of associating an RPC pipe (e.g \PIPE\lsarpc) -with a "transfer syntax" (see RPC_Iface structure). The purpose for doing +with a "transfer syntax" (see RPC_Iface structure). The purpose for doing this is unknown. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_ResBind SMB Transact request is sent with two uint16 setup parameters. The first is 0x0026; the second is the file handle returned by the SMBopenX Transact response.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_ResBind members maxtsize, maxrsize and assocgid are the same in the response as the same members in the RPC_ReqBind. The RPC_ResBind member transfersyntax is the same in the response as the</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_ResBind response member secondaddr contains the name of what is presumed to be the service behind the RPC pipe. The - mapping identified so far is:</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">initial SMBopenX request:</span></dt><dd><p>RPC_ResBind response:</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\srvsvc"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\ntsvcs"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\samr"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\lsass"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\lsarpc"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\lsass"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\wkssvc"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\wksvcs"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\NETLOGON"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\NETLOGON"</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_Packet fraglength member in both the Bind Request and Bind Acknowledgment must contain the length of the entire RPC data, including the RPC_Packet header.</em></span></p><p>Request:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>RPC_Packet</td></tr><tr><td>RPC_ReqBind</td></tr></table><p>Response:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>RPC_Packet</td></tr><tr><td>RPC_ResBind</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877826"></a>NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Establish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</td></tr><tr><td>Open an RPC Pipe with the name "\\PIPE\\lsarpc". Store the file handle.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</td></tr><tr><td>Send an LSA Open Policy request. Store the Policy Handle.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the Policy Handle, send LSA Query Info Policy requests, etc.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the Policy Handle, send an LSA Close.</td></tr><tr><td>Close the IPC$ share.</td></tr></table><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LSA Open Policy:</span></dt><dd><p>0x2c</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Query Info Policy:</span></dt><dd><p>0x07</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0d</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Open Secret:</span></dt><dd><p>0xff</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Lookup SIDs:</span></dt><dd><p>0xfe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Lookup Names:</span></dt><dd><p>0xfd</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Close:</span></dt><dd><p>0x00</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877991"></a>LSA Open Policy</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The policy handle can be anything you like.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878004"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name - unicode string starting with two '\'s</p></dd><dt><span class="term">OBJ_ATTR</span></dt><dd><p>object attributes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>1 - desired access</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878075"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">return</span></dt><dd><p>0 - indicates success</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878118"></a>LSA Query Info Policy</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The info class in response must be the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878132"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>info class (also a policy handle?)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878170"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>info class (same as info class in request).</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting"> + mapping identified so far is:</em></span></p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">initial SMBopenX request:</span></dt><dd><p>RPC_ResBind response:</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\srvsvc"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\ntsvcs"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\samr"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\lsass"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\lsarpc"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\lsass"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\wkssvc"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\wksvcs"</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"\\PIPE\\NETLOGON"</span></dt><dd><p>"\\PIPE\\NETLOGON"</p></dd></dl></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The RPC_Packet fraglength member in both the Bind Request and Bind Acknowledgment must contain the length of the entire RPC data, including the RPC_Packet header.</em></span></p><p>Request:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>RPC_Packet</td></tr><tr><td>RPC_ReqBind</td></tr></table><p>Response:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>RPC_Packet</td></tr><tr><td>RPC_ResBind</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872365"></a>NTLSA Transact Named Pipe</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Establish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</td></tr><tr><td>Open an RPC Pipe with the name "\\PIPE\\lsarpc". Store the file handle.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</td></tr><tr><td>Send an LSA Open Policy request. Store the Policy Handle.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the Policy Handle, send LSA Query Info Policy requests, etc.</td></tr><tr><td>Using the Policy Handle, send an LSA Close.</td></tr><tr><td>Close the IPC$ share.</td></tr></table><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LSA Open Policy:</span></dt><dd><p>0x2c</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Query Info Policy:</span></dt><dd><p>0x07</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0d</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Open Secret:</span></dt><dd><p>0xff</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Lookup SIDs:</span></dt><dd><p>0xfe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Lookup Names:</span></dt><dd><p>0xfd</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Close:</span></dt><dd><p>0x00</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872530"></a>LSA Open Policy</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The policy handle can be anything you like.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872543"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name - unicode string starting with two '\'s</p></dd><dt><span class="term">OBJ_ATTR</span></dt><dd><p>object attributes</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>1 - desired access</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872613"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">return</span></dt><dd><p>0 - indicates success</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872655"></a>LSA Query Info Policy</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: The info class in response must be the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872670"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>info class (also a policy handle?)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872708"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>info class (same as info class in request).</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting"> switch (info class) case 3: case 5: @@ -1292,11 +1289,11 @@ DOM_INFO domain info, levels 3 and 5 (are the same). } return 0 - indicates success -</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878223"></a>LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878230"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>no extra data</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878243"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - enumeration context</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - entries read</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - trust information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">return</span></dt><dd><p>0x8000 001a - "no trusted domains" success code</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878315"></a>LSA Open Secret</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878322"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>no extra data</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878334"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0x0C00 0034 - "no such secret" success code</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878424"></a>LSA Close</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878432"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>policy handle to be closed</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878459"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>0s - closed policy handle (all zeros)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878490"></a>LSA Lookup SIDS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878504"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*[num_entries] undocumented domain SID pointers to be looked up. -</span></dt><dd><p>DOM_SID[num_entries] domain SIDs to be looked up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>completely undocumented 16 bytes.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878604"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">DOM_REF</span></dt><dd><p>domain reference response</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID2[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878700"></a>LSA Lookup Names</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878714"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NAME[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>names to be looked up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[]</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented bytes - falsely translated SID structure?</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878828"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">DOM_REF</span></dt><dd><p>domain reference response</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_RID[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878926"></a>NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>tablish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</td></tr><tr><td>en an RPC Pipe with the name "\\PIPE\\NETLOGON". Store the file handle.</td></tr><tr><td>ing the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</td></tr><tr><td>eate Client Challenge. Send LSA Request Challenge. Store Server Challenge.</td></tr><tr><td>lculate Session Key. Send an LSA Auth 2 Challenge. Store Auth2 Challenge.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA Srv PW Set. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logon . Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logoff. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>ose the IPC$ share.</td></tr></table><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LSA Request Challenge:</span></dt><dd><p>0x04</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Server Password Set:</span></dt><dd><p>0x06</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA SAM Logon:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA SAM Logoff:</span></dt><dd><p>0x03</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Auth 2:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0f</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Logon Control:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0e</p></dd></dl></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879087"></a>LSA Request Challenge</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon client is the machine, not the user.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the initial LanManager password hash, against which the challenge is issued, is the machine name itself (lower case). there will becalls issued (LSA Server Password Set) which will change this, later. refusing these calls allows you to always deal with the same password (i.e the LM# of the machine name in lower case).</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879119"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>client challenge</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879189"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>server challenge</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879222"></a>LSA Authenticate 2</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: neg_flags in the response is the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879252"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LOG_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>client identification info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 4-byte align with start of SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>neg_flags - negotiated flags (usual value is 0x0000 01ff)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879321"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>neg_flags - same as neg_flags in request.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success. failure value unknown.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879369"></a>LSA Server Password Set</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the new password is suspected to be a DES encryption using the old password to generate the key.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the server credentials are constructed from the client-calculated credentials and the client time + 1 second.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879408"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>client identification/authentication info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[]</span></dt><dd><p>new password - undocumented.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879450"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success; 0xC000 006a indicates failure</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879484"></a>LSA SAM Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872763"></a>LSA Enumerate Trusted Domains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872771"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>no extra data</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872783"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - enumeration context</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - entries read</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - trust information</p></dd><dt><span class="term">return</span></dt><dd><p>0x8000 001a - "no trusted domains" success code</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872853"></a>LSA Open Secret</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872860"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>no extra data</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872872"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>0 - undocumented</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0x0C00 0034 - "no such secret" success code</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872963"></a>LSA Close</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872970"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>policy handle to be closed</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872997"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>0s - closed policy handle (all zeros)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873028"></a>LSA Lookup SIDS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873042"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*[num_entries] undocumented domain SID pointers to be looked up. +</span></dt><dd><p>DOM_SID[num_entries] domain SIDs to be looked up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[16]</span></dt><dd><p>completely undocumented 16 bytes.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873142"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">DOM_REF</span></dt><dd><p>domain reference response</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_SID2[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873238"></a>LSA Lookup Names</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: num_entries in response must be same as num_entries in request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873252"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">POL_HND</span></dt><dd><p>LSA policy handle</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain SID buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented domain name buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">NAME[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>names to be looked up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[]</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented bytes - falsely translated SID structure?</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873366"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">DOM_REF</span></dt><dd><p>domain reference response</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">DOM_RID[num_entries]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SIDs (from Request, listed above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>num_entries (listed above)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2873464"></a>NETLOGON rpc Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The sequence of actions taken on this pipe are:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>tablish a connection to the IPC$ share (SMBtconX). use encrypted passwords.</td></tr><tr><td>en an RPC Pipe with the name "\\PIPE\\NETLOGON". Store the file handle.</td></tr><tr><td>ing the file handle, send a Set Named Pipe Handle state to 0x4300.</td></tr><tr><td>eate Client Challenge. Send LSA Request Challenge. Store Server Challenge.</td></tr><tr><td>lculate Session Key. Send an LSA Auth 2 Challenge. Store Auth2 Challenge.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA Srv PW Set. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logon . Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>lc/Verify Client Creds. Send LSA SAM Logoff. Calc/Verify Server Creds.</td></tr><tr><td>ose the IPC$ share.</td></tr></table><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LSA Request Challenge:</span></dt><dd><p>0x04</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Server Password Set:</span></dt><dd><p>0x06</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA SAM Logon:</span></dt><dd><p>0x02</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA SAM Logoff:</span></dt><dd><p>0x03</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Auth 2:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0f</p></dd><dt><span class="term">LSA Logon Control:</span></dt><dd><p>0x0e</p></dd></dl></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873625"></a>LSA Request Challenge</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon server name starts with two '\' characters and is upper case.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: logon client is the machine, not the user.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the initial LanManager password hash, against which the challenge is issued, is the machine name itself (lower case). there will becalls issued (LSA Server Password Set) which will change this, later. refusing these calls allows you to always deal with the same password (i.e the LM# of the machine name in lower case).</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873657"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon server unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>logon client unicode string</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>client challenge</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873727"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>server challenge</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873759"></a>LSA Authenticate 2</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: neg_flags in the response is the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873790"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">LOG_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>client identification info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>client-calculated credentials</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 4-byte align with start of SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>neg_flags - negotiated flags (usual value is 0x0000 01ff)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873859"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">char[8]</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>neg_flags - same as neg_flags in request.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success. failure value unknown.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873906"></a>LSA Server Password Set</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the new password is suspected to be a DES encryption using the old password to generate the key.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: in between request and response, calculate the client credentials, and check them against the client-calculated credentials (this process uses the previously received client credentials).</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: the server credentials are constructed from the client-calculated credentials and the client time + 1 second.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: you must take a copy of the client-calculated credentials received here, because they will be used in subsequent authentication packets.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873946"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CLNT_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>client identification/authentication info</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[]</span></dt><dd><p>new password - undocumented.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873988"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success; 0xC000 006a indicates failure</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874022"></a>LSA SAM Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Note: valid_user is True iff the username and password hash are valid for the requested domain. -</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879498"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SAM_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>sam_id structure</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879526"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting"> +</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874036"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SAM_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>sam_id structure</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874063"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><pre class="programlisting"> if (valid_user) { UINT16 3 - switch value indicating USER_INFO structure. @@ -1316,16 +1313,16 @@ else return 0xC000 0064 - NT_STATUS_NO_SUCH_USER. } -</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879598"></a>LSA SAM Logoff</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874125"></a>LSA SAM Logoff</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Note: presumably, the SAM_INFO structure is validated, and a (currently undocumented) error code returned if the Logoff is invalid. -</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879612"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SAM_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>sam_id structure</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879639"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success. undocumented failure indication.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879689"></a>\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874140"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">SAM_INFO</span></dt><dd><p>sam_id structure</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874167"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>undocumented buffer pointer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">CREDS</span></dt><dd><p>server credentials. server time stamp appears to be ignored.</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success. undocumented failure indication.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2874216"></a>\\MAILSLOT\NET\NTLOGON</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Note: mailslots will contain a response mailslot, to which the response should be sent. the target NetBIOS name is REQUEST_NAME<20>, where REQUEST_NAME is the name of the machine that sent the request. -</em></span></p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879701"></a>Query for PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879721"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0007 - Query for PDC</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>response mailslot</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879848"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x000A - Respose to Query for PDC</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name (in uppercase)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion (same as received in request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken (same as received in request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token (same as received in request)</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879969"></a>SAM Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: machine name in response is preceded by two '\' characters.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: user name in the response is presumably the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879997"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0012 - SAM Logon</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>request count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>user name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>response mailslot</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>alloweable account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID size</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[sid_size]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID, of sid_size bytes.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>???? padding to 4? 2? -byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880180"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0013 - Response to SAM Logon</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>user name - workstation trust account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name </p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880294"></a>SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Net Share Enum</span></dt><dd><p>0x0f</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Net Server Get Info</span></dt><dd><p>0x15</p></dd></dl></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880339"></a>Net Share Enum</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: share level and switch value in the response are presumably the same as those in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: cifsrap2.txt (section 5) may be of limited assistance here.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880360"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer (to server name?)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>share level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</span></dt><dd><p>share info with 0 entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>preferred maximum length (0xffff ffff)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880485"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>share level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</span></dt><dd><p>share info (only added if share info ptr is non-zero)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880558"></a>Net Server Get Info</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: level is the same value as in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880572"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch level</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880613"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SERVER_INFO_101</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SERVER_INFO_101</span></dt><dd><p>server info (only added if server info ptr is non-zero)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880674"></a>Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880682"></a>Definitions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Add(A1,A2)</span></dt><dd><p>Intel byte ordered addition of corresponding 4 byte words in arrays A1 and A2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">E(K,D)</span></dt><dd><p>DES ECB encryption of 8 byte data D using 7 byte key K</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lmowf()</span></dt><dd><p>Lan man hash</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntowf()</span></dt><dd><p>NT hash</p></dd><dt><span class="term">PW</span></dt><dd><p>md4(machine_password) == md4(lsadump $machine.acc) == +</em></span></p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874229"></a>Query for PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874249"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0007 - Query for PDC</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>response mailslot</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874376"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x000A - Respose to Query for PDC</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name (in uppercase)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to 2-byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion (same as received in request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken (same as received in request)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token (same as received in request)</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874497"></a>SAM Logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: machine name in response is preceded by two '\' characters.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: NTversion, LMNTtoken, LM20token in response are the same as those given in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: user name in the response is presumably the same as that in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874525"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0012 - SAM Logon</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>request count</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>user name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">STR</span></dt><dd><p>response mailslot</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>alloweable account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID size</p></dd><dt><span class="term">char[sid_size]</span></dt><dd><p>domain SID, of sid_size bytes.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>???? padding to 4? 2? -byte align with start of mailslot.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874708"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>0x0013 - Response to SAM Logon</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>machine name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>user name - workstation trust account</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR</span></dt><dd><p>domain name </p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>NTversion</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LMNTtoken</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT16</span></dt><dd><p>LM20token</p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2874822"></a>SRVSVC Transact Named Pipe</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Defines for this pipe, identifying the query are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Net Share Enum</span></dt><dd><p>0x0f</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Net Server Get Info</span></dt><dd><p>0x15</p></dd></dl></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874867"></a>Net Share Enum</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: share level and switch value in the response are presumably the same as those in the request.</em></span></p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: cifsrap2.txt (section 5) may be of limited assistance here.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874888"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer (to server name?)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT8[]</span></dt><dd><p>padding to get unicode string 4-byte aligned with the start of the SMB header.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>share level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</span></dt><dd><p>share info with 0 entries</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>preferred maximum length (0xffff ffff)</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875013"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>share level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch value</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SHARE_INFO_1_CTR</span></dt><dd><p>share info (only added if share info ptr is non-zero)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875087"></a>Net Server Get Info</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note: level is the same value as in the request.</em></span></p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875100"></a>Request</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UNISTR2</span></dt><dd><p>server name</p></dd><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch level</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875141"></a>Response</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">UINT32</span></dt><dd><p>switch level</p></dd><dt><span class="term">VOID*</span></dt><dd><p>pointer to SERVER_INFO_101</p></dd><dt><span class="term">SERVER_INFO_101</span></dt><dd><p>server info (only added if server info ptr is non-zero)</p></dd></dl></div><p>return 0 - indicates success</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875203"></a>Cryptographic side of NT Domain Authentication</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875211"></a>Definitions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Add(A1,A2)</span></dt><dd><p>Intel byte ordered addition of corresponding 4 byte words in arrays A1 and A2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">E(K,D)</span></dt><dd><p>DES ECB encryption of 8 byte data D using 7 byte key K</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lmowf()</span></dt><dd><p>Lan man hash</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ntowf()</span></dt><dd><p>NT hash</p></dd><dt><span class="term">PW</span></dt><dd><p>md4(machine_password) == md4(lsadump $machine.acc) == pwdump(machine$) (initially) == md4(lmowf(unicode(machine))) -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ARC4(K,Lk,D,Ld)</span></dt><dd><p>ARC4 encryption of data D of length Ld with key K of length Lk</p></dd><dt><span class="term">v[m..n(,l)]</span></dt><dd><p>subset of v from bytes m to n, optionally padded with zeroes to length l</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Cred(K,D)</span></dt><dd><p>E(K[7..7,7],E(K[0..6],D)) computes a credential</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Time()</span></dt><dd><p>4 byte current time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Cc,Cs</span></dt><dd><p>8 byte client and server challenges Rc,Rs: 8 byte client and server credentials</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880845"></a>Protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> +</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ARC4(K,Lk,D,Ld)</span></dt><dd><p>ARC4 encryption of data D of length Ld with key K of length Lk</p></dd><dt><span class="term">v[m..n(,l)]</span></dt><dd><p>subset of v from bytes m to n, optionally padded with zeroes to length l</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Cred(K,D)</span></dt><dd><p>E(K[7..7,7],E(K[0..6],D)) computes a credential</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Time()</span></dt><dd><p>4 byte current time</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Cc,Cs</span></dt><dd><p>8 byte client and server challenges Rc,Rs: 8 byte client and server credentials</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875373"></a>Protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> C->S ReqChal,Cc S->C Cs </pre><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -1361,7 +1358,7 @@ S: Ts = Time() S->C Cred(Ks,Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1)),userinfo(logon script,UID,SIDs,etc) C: assert(Rs == Cred(Ks,Cred(Rc+Tc+1)) C: Rc = Cred(Ks,Rc+Tc+1) -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880942"></a>Comments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875471"></a>Comments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> On first joining the domain the session key could be computed by anyone listening in on the network as the machine password has a well known value. Until the machine is rebooted it will use this session @@ -1382,30 +1379,30 @@ returned by the server. The password OWFs should NOT be sent over the network reversibly encrypted. They should be sent using ARC4(Ks,md4(owf)) with the server computing the same function using the owf values in the SAM. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880991"></a>SIDs and RIDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875519"></a>SIDs and RIDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> SIDs and RIDs are well documented elsewhere. </p><p> A SID is an NT Security ID (see DOM_SID structure). They are of the form: </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>revision-NN-SubAuth1-SubAuth2-SubAuth3... </td></tr><tr><td>revision-0xNNNNNNNNNNNN-SubAuth1-SubAuth2-SubAuth3...</td></tr></table><p> currently, the SID revision is 1. The Sub-Authorities are known as Relative IDs (RIDs). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881031"></a>Well-known SIDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881038"></a>Universal well-known SIDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Null SID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-0-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">World</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-1-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Local</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-2-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Owner ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Group ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Owner Server ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Group Server ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-3</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Non-unique IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-4</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881165"></a>NT well-known SIDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">NT Authority</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Dialup</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Network</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Batch</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-3</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Interactive</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-4</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Service</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-6</p></dd><dt><span class="term">AnonymousLogon(aka null logon session)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-7</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Proxy</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-8</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ServerLogon(aka domain controller account)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-8</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Logon IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-5-X-Y</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(NT non-unique IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-0x15-...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Built-in domain)</span></dt><dd><p>s-1-5-0x20</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881346"></a>Well-known RIDS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875558"></a>Well-known SIDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875566"></a>Universal well-known SIDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Null SID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-0-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">World</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-1-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Local</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-2-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Owner ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-0</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Group ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Owner Server ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Creator Group Server ID</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-3-3</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Non-unique IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-4</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875693"></a>NT well-known SIDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">NT Authority</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Dialup</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-1</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Network</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-2</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Batch</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-3</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Interactive</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-4</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Service</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-6</p></dd><dt><span class="term">AnonymousLogon(aka null logon session)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-7</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Proxy</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-8</p></dd><dt><span class="term">ServerLogon(aka domain controller account)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-8</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Logon IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-5-X-Y</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(NT non-unique IDs)</span></dt><dd><p>S-1-5-0x15-...</p></dd><dt><span class="term">(Built-in domain)</span></dt><dd><p>s-1-5-0x20</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875874"></a>Well-known RIDS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A RID is a sub-authority value, as part of either a SID, or in the case of Group RIDs, part of the DOM_GID structure, in the USER_INFO_1 structure, in the LSA SAM Logon response. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881360"></a>Well-known RID users</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b>DOMAIN_USER_RID_ADMIN</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>01F4</p><p><b>Groupname: </b>DOMAIN_USER_RID_GUEST</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>01F5</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881409"></a>Well-known RID groups</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_ADMINS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0200</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0201</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_GUESTS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0202</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881468"></a>Well-known RID aliases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ADMINS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0220</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0221</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_GUESTS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0222</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_POWER_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0223</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ACCOUNT_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0224</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_SYSTEM_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0225</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_PRINT_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0226</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_BACKUP_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0227</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_REPLICATOR</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0228</p></div></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 11. Samba Printing Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2890028">Abstract</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890044"> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875888"></a>Well-known RID users</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b>DOMAIN_USER_RID_ADMIN</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>01F4</p><p><b>Groupname: </b>DOMAIN_USER_RID_GUEST</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>01F5</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875936"></a>Well-known RID groups</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_ADMINS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0200</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0201</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_GROUP_RID_GUESTS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0202</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875996"></a>Well-known RID aliases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="segmentedlist"><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ADMINS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0220</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0221</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_GUESTS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0222</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_POWER_USERS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0223</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_ACCOUNT_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0224</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_SYSTEM_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0225</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_PRINT_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0226</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_BACKUP_OPS</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0227</p><p><b>Groupname: </b> DOMAIN_ALIAS_RID_REPLICATOR</p><p><b>????: </b>0x0000</p><p><b>RID: </b>0228</p></div></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 11. Samba Printing Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2876159">Abstract</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876175"> Printing Interface to Various Back ends -</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890298"> +</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876271"> Print Queue TDB's -</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890507"> +</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876487"> ChangeID and Client Caching of Printer Information -</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890520"> +</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876500"> Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify -</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890028"></a>Abstract</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876159"></a>Abstract</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The purpose of this document is to provide some insight into Samba's printing functionality and also to describe the semantics of certain features of Windows client printing. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890044"></a> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876175"></a> Printing Interface to Various Back ends </h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba uses a table of function pointers to seven functions. The @@ -1416,10 +1413,10 @@ Currently there are only two printing back end implementations defined. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a generic set of functions for working with standard UNIX printing subsystems</p></li><li><p>a set of CUPS specific functions (this is only enabled if - the CUPS libraries were located at compile time).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890298"></a> + the CUPS libraries were located at compile time).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876271"></a> Print Queue TDB's </h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba provides periodic caching of the output from the "lpq command" +Samba provides periodic caching of the output from the "lpq command" for performance reasons. This cache time is configurable in seconds. Obviously the longer the cache time the less often smbd will be required to exec a copy of lpq. However, the accuracy of the print @@ -1439,7 +1436,7 @@ There are two ways in which a a print job can be entered into a print queue's TDB. The first is to submit the job from a Windows client which will insert the job information directly into the TDB. The second method is to have the print job picked up by executing the -"lpq command". +"lpq command". </p><pre class="programlisting"> /* included from printing.h */ struct printjob { @@ -1460,9 +1457,9 @@ struct printjob { }; </pre><p> The current manifestation of the printjob structure contains a field -for the UNIX job id returned from the "lpq command" and a Windows job +for the UNIX job id returned from the "lpq command" and a Windows job ID (32-bit bounded by PRINT_MAX_JOBID). When a print job is returned -by the "lpq command" that does not match an existing job in the queue's +by the "lpq command" that does not match an existing job in the queue's TDB, a 32-bit job ID above the <*vance doesn't know what word is missing here*> is generating by adding UNIX_JOB_START to the id reported by lpq. </p><p> @@ -1477,7 +1474,7 @@ steps ( refer to <tt class="filename">print.c:print_queue_update()</tt> ): stored in <tt class="constant">LOCK/<i class="replaceable"><tt>printer_name</tt></i></tt>. If so, then do not update the TDB.</p></li><li><p>Lock the mutex entry in the TDB and store our own pid. Check that this succeeded, else fail.</p></li><li><p>Store the updated time stamp for the new cache - listing</p></li><li><p>Retrieve the queue listing via "lpq command"</p></li><li><pre class="programlisting"> + listing</p></li><li><p>Retrieve the queue listing via "lpq command"</p></li><li><pre class="programlisting"> foreach job in the queue { if the job is a UNIX job, create a new entry; @@ -1492,7 +1489,7 @@ steps ( refer to <tt class="filename">print.c:print_queue_update()</tt> ): }</pre></li><li><p>Delete any jobs in the TDB that are not in the in the lpq listing</p></li><li><p>Store the print queue status in the TDB</p></li><li><p>update the cache time stamp again</p></li></ol></div><p> Note that it is the contents of this TDB that is returned to Windows -clients and not the actual listing from the "lpq command". +clients and not the actual listing from the "lpq command". </p><p> The NT_DEVICEMODE stored as part of the printjob structure is used to store a pointer to a non-default DeviceMode associated with the print @@ -1505,11 +1502,11 @@ and the job has the printer's device mode associated with it by default. Only non-default Device Mode are stored with print jobs in the print queue TDB. Otherwise, the Device Mode is obtained from the printer object when the client issues a GetJob(level == 2) request. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890507"></a> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876487"></a> ChangeID and Client Caching of Printer Information </h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> [To be filled in later] -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890520"></a> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876500"></a> Windows NT/2K Printer Change Notify </h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When working with Windows NT+ clients, it is possible for a @@ -1607,13 +1604,13 @@ handle for notification. Samba currently uses the snum of the printer for this which can break if the list of services has been modified since the notification handle was registered.</p></li><li><p>The size is either (a) the string length in UNICODE for strings, (b) the size in bytes of the security descriptor, or (c) 0 for -data values.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="wins"></a>Chapter 12. Samba WINS Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2889988">WINS Failover</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889988"></a>WINS Failover</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +data values.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="wins"></a>Chapter 12. Samba WINS Internals</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2876880">WINS Failover</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876880"></a>WINS Failover</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The current Samba codebase possesses the capability to use groups of WINS servers that share a common namespace for NetBIOS name registration and resolution. The formal parameter syntax is </p><pre class="programlisting"> WINS_SERVER_PARAM = SERVER [ SEPARATOR SERVER_LIST ] - WINS_SERVER_PARAM = "wins server" + WINS_SERVER_PARAM = "wins server" SERVER = ADDR[:TAG] ADDR = ip_addr | fqdn TAG = string @@ -1626,7 +1623,7 @@ A simple example of a valid wins server setting is wins server = 192.168.1.2 192.168.1.3 </pre><p> In the event that no TAG is defined in for a SERVER in the list, smbd assigns a default -TAG of "*". A TAG is used to group servers of a shared NetBIOS namespace together. Upon +TAG of "*". A TAG is used to group servers of a shared NetBIOS namespace together. Upon startup, nmbd will attempt to register the netbios name value with one server in each tagged group. </p><p> @@ -1637,7 +1634,7 @@ interface names in the tags is only by convention and is not a technical require wins server = 192.168.1.2:eth0 192.168.1.3:eth0 192.168.2.2:eth1 </pre><p> Using this configuration, nmbd would attempt to register the server's NetBIOS name -with one WINS server in each group. Because the "eth0" group has two servers, the +with one WINS server in each group. Because the "eth0" group has two servers, the second server would only be used when a registration (or resolution) request to the first server in that group timed out. </p><p> @@ -1649,7 +1646,7 @@ If a timeout occurs when querying a specific WINS server, that server is marked prevent further timeouts and the next server in the WINS group is contacted. Once marked as dead, Samba will not attempt to contact that server for name registration/resolution queries for a period of 10 minutes. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="sam"></a>Chapter 13. The Upcoming SAM System</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Bartlett</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">1 October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2889789">Security in the 'new SAM'</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891316">Standalone from UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891349">Handles and Races in the new SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891418">Layers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891425">Application</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891441">SAM Interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891468">SAM Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891490">SAM Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891497">Special Module: sam_passdb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891516">sam_ads</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891555">Memory Management</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891645">Testing</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889789"></a>Security in the 'new SAM'</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>One of the biggest problems with passdb is it's implementation of +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="sam"></a>Chapter 13. The Upcoming SAM System</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Bartlett</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">1 October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2877009">Security in the 'new SAM'</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877139">Standalone from UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877166">Handles and Races in the new SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877235">Layers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2877242">Application</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877258">SAM Interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877286">SAM Modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2877308">SAM Modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2877315">Special Module: sam_passdb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877333">sam_ads</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2877362">Memory Management</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877454">Testing</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877009"></a>Security in the 'new SAM'</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>One of the biggest problems with passdb is it's implementation of 'security'. Access control is on a 'are you root at the moment' basis, and it has no concept of NT ACLs. Things like ldapsam had to add 'magic' 'are you root' checks.</p><p>We took this very seriously when we started work, and the new structure @@ -1709,7 +1706,7 @@ actual data store (like the LDAP server). </p><p> Finally, we have generic get_sec_desc() and set_sec_desc() routines to allow external ACL manipulation. These do lookups based on SID. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891316"></a>Standalone from UNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877139"></a>Standalone from UNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> One of the primary tenants of the 'new SAM' is that it would not attempt to deal with 'what unix id for that'. This would be left to the 'SMS' (Sid Mapping System') or SID farm, and probably administered via @@ -1719,7 +1716,7 @@ Accounts not preexisting in unix would be served up via winbind. </p><p> This is an *optional* part, and my preferred end-game. We have a fare way to go before things like winbind up to it however. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891349"></a>Handles and Races in the new SAM</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877166"></a>Handles and Races in the new SAM</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> One of the things that the 'new SAM' work has tried to face is both compatibility with existing code, and a closer alignment to the SAMR interface. I consider SAMR to be a 'primary customer' to the this work, @@ -1744,11 +1741,11 @@ have *really* changed. 'conflicting' updates: Currently we don't deal with this (in passdb or the new sam stuff), but the design is sufficiently flexible to 'deny' a second update. I don't foresee locking records however. -</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891418"></a>Layers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891425"></a>Application</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877235"></a>Layers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877242"></a>Application</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is where smbd, samtest and whatever end-user replacement we have for pdbedit sits. They use only the SAM interface, and do not get 'special knowledge' of what is below them. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891441"></a>SAM Interface</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877258"></a>SAM Interface</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This level 'owns' the various handle structures, the get/set routines on those structures and provides the public interface. The application layer may initialize a 'context' to be passed to all interface routines, @@ -1759,7 +1756,7 @@ abstraction to the modules below, and arrange for their initial loading. </p><p> We could possibly add ACL checking at this layer, to avoid discrepancies in implementation modules. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891468"></a>SAM Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877286"></a>SAM Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> These do not communicate with the application directly, only by setting values in the handles, and receiving requests from the interface. These modules are responsible for translating values from the handle's @@ -1767,13 +1764,13 @@ modules are responsible for translating values from the handle's to 'know' things like it's own domain SID, domain name, and any other state attached to the SAM. Simpler modules may call back to some helper routine. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891490"></a>SAM Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891497"></a>Special Module: sam_passdb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877308"></a>SAM Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877315"></a>Special Module: sam_passdb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order for there to be a smooth transition, kai is writing a module that reads existing passdb backends, and translates them into SAM replies. (Also pulling data from the account policy DB etc). We also intend to write a module that does the reverse - gives the SAM a passdb interface. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891516"></a>sam_ads</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877333"></a>sam_ads</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is the first of the SAM modules to be committed to the tree - mainly because I needed to coordinate work with metze (who authored most of it). This module aims to use Samba's libads code to provide an @@ -1785,7 +1782,7 @@ the construction of an Samba AD DC. </p><p> We also intend to construct a Samba 2.2/3.0 compatible ldap module, again using libads code. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891555"></a>Memory Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877362"></a>Memory Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The 'new SAM' development effort also concerned itself with getting a sane implementation of memory management. It was decided that we would be (as much as possible) talloc based, using an 'internal talloc @@ -1814,7 +1811,7 @@ NT_USER_TOKEN *access_token, uint32 access_desired, const DOM_SID NTSTATUS sam_enum_accounts(const SAM_CONTEXT *context, const NT_USER_TOKEN *access_token, const DOM_SID *domainsid, uint16 acct_ctrl, int32 *account_count, SAM_ACCOUNT_ENUM **accounts) -</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891645"></a>Testing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877454"></a>Testing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Testing is vital in any piece of software, and Samba is certainly no exception. In designing this new subsystem, we have taken care to ensure it is easily tested, independent of outside protocols. @@ -1843,13 +1840,13 @@ Because the 'new SAM' is NT ACL based, there will be a command to specify an arbitrary NT ACL, but for now it uses 'system' by default. </p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pwencrypt"></a>Chapter 14. LanMan and NT Password Encryption</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><br> <tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</a>></tt><br> - </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">19 Apr 1999</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2892285">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892310">How does it work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891197">The smbpasswd file</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892285"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>With the development of LanManager and Windows NT + </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">19 Apr 1999</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2877592">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877615">How does it work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877715">The smbpasswd file</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877592"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>With the development of LanManager and Windows NT compatible password encryption for Samba, it is now able to validate user connections in exactly the same way as a LanManager or Windows NT server.</p><p>This document describes how the SMB password encryption algorithm works and what issues there are in choosing whether you want to use it. You should read it carefully, especially - the part about security and the "PROS and CONS" section.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892310"></a>How does it work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>LanManager encryption is somewhat similar to UNIX + the part about security and the "PROS and CONS" section.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877615"></a>How does it work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>LanManager encryption is somewhat similar to UNIX password encryption. The server uses a file containing a hashed value of a user's password. This is created by taking the user's plaintext password, capitalising it, and either @@ -1857,7 +1854,7 @@ specify an arbitrary NT ACL, but for now it uses 'system' by default. This 14 byte value is used as two 56 bit DES keys to encrypt a 'magic' eight byte value, forming a 16 byte value which is stored by the server and client. Let this value be known as - the "hashed password".</p><p>Windows NT encryption is a higher quality mechanism, + the "hashed password".</p><p>Windows NT encryption is a higher quality mechanism, consisting of doing an MD4 hash on a Unicode version of the user's password. This also produces a 16 byte hash value that is non-reversible.</p><p>When a client (LanManager, Windows for WorkGroups, Windows @@ -1866,11 +1863,11 @@ specify an arbitrary NT ACL, but for now it uses 'system' by default. protocol that the client and server will use. In the reply to this request the Samba server generates and appends an 8 byte, random value - this is stored in the Samba server after the reply is sent - and is known as the "challenge". The challenge is different for + and is known as the "challenge". The challenge is different for every client connection.</p><p>The client then uses the hashed password (16 byte values described above), appended with 5 null bytes, as three 56 bit DES keys, each of which is used to encrypt the challenge 8 byte - value, forming a 24 byte value known as the "response".</p><p>In the SMB call SMBsessionsetupX (when user level security + value, forming a 24 byte value known as the "response".</p><p>In the SMB call SMBsessionsetupX (when user level security is selected) or the call SMBtconX (when share level security is selected), the 24 byte response is returned by the client to the Samba server. For Windows NT protocol levels the above calculation @@ -1886,7 +1883,7 @@ specify an arbitrary NT ACL, but for now it uses 'system' by default. know the correct password and is denied access.</p><p>Note that the Samba server never knows or stores the cleartext of the user's password - just the 16 byte hashed values derived from it. Also note that the cleartext password or 16 byte hashed values - are never transmitted over the network - thus increasing security.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891197"></a>The smbpasswd file</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a name="SMBPASSWDFILEFORMAT"></a><p>In order for Samba to participate in the above protocol + are never transmitted over the network - thus increasing security.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2877715"></a>The smbpasswd file</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a name="SMBPASSWDFILEFORMAT"></a><p>In order for Samba to participate in the above protocol it must be able to look up the 16 byte hashed values given a user name. Unfortunately, as the UNIX password value is also a one way hash function (ie. it is impossible to retrieve the cleartext of the user's @@ -1927,7 +1924,7 @@ username:uid:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX: to 32 ascii hexadecimal digits (0-9, A-F). These are an ascii representation of the 16 byte hashed value of a user's password.</p><p>To set a user to have no password (not recommended), edit the file using vi, and replace the first 11 characters with the ascii text - <tt class="constant">"NO PASSWORD"</tt> (minus the quotes).</p><p>For example, to clear the password for user bob, his smbpasswd file + <tt class="constant">"NO PASSWORD"</tt> (minus the quotes).</p><p>For example, to clear the password for user bob, his smbpasswd file entry would look like :</p><pre class="programlisting"> bob:100:NO PASSWORDXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX: [U ]:LCT-00000000:Bob's full name:/bobhome:/bobshell @@ -1943,10 +1940,10 @@ bob:100:NO PASSWORDXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX:XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX: to enable this on your server.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note : </em></span>This file should be protected very carefully. Anyone with access to this file can (with enough knowledge of the protocols) gain access to your SMB server. The file is thus more - sensitive than a normal unix <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file.</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="modules"></a>Chapter 15. Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 19 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2892236">Advantages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893136">Loading modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893169">Static modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894111">Shared modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2894139">Writing modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894200">Static/Shared selection in configure.in</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892236"></a>Advantages</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + sensitive than a normal unix <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file.</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="modules"></a>Chapter 15. Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 19 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2878082">Advantages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878130">Loading modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878163">Static modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878204">Shared modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878231">Writing modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878293">Static/Shared selection in configure.in</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878082"></a>Advantages</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The new modules system has the following advantages: </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Transparent loading of static and shared modules (no need -for a subsystem to know about modules)</td></tr><tr><td>Simple selection between shared and static modules at configure time</td></tr><tr><td>"preload modules" option for increasing performance for stable modules</td></tr><tr><td>No nasty #define stuff anymore</td></tr><tr><td>All backends are available as plugin now (including pdb_ldap and pdb_tdb)</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893136"></a>Loading modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +for a subsystem to know about modules)</td></tr><tr><td>Simple selection between shared and static modules at configure time</td></tr><tr><td>"preload modules" option for increasing performance for stable modules</td></tr><tr><td>No nasty #define stuff anymore</td></tr><tr><td>All backends are available as plugin now (including pdb_ldap and pdb_tdb)</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878130"></a>Loading modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Some subsystems in samba use different backends. These backends can be either statically linked in to samba or available as a plugin. A subsystem should have a function that allows a module to register itself. For example, @@ -1956,7 +1953,7 @@ NTSTATUS smb_register_passdb(int version, const char *name, pdb_init_function in </pre><p> This function will be called by the initialisation function of the module to register itself. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893169"></a>Static modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878163"></a>Static modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The modules system compiles a list of initialisation functions for the static modules of each subsystem. This is a define. For example, it is here currently (from <tt class="filename">include/config.h</tt>): @@ -1966,7 +1963,7 @@ it is here currently (from <tt class="filename">include/config.h</tt>): </pre><p> These functions should be called before the subsystem is used. That should be done when the subsystem is initialised or first used. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894111"></a>Shared modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878204"></a>Shared modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If a subsystem needs a certain backend, it should check if it has already been registered. If the backend hasn't been registered already, the subsystem should call smb_probe_module(char *subsystem, char *backend). @@ -1976,7 +1973,7 @@ is a slash, smb_probe_module() tries to load the module from the absolute path specified in 'backend'. </p><p>After smb_probe_module() has been executed, the subsystem should check again if the module has been registered. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894139"></a>Writing modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878231"></a>Writing modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Each module has an initialisation function. For modules that are included with samba this name is '<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>_<i class="replaceable"><tt>backend</tt></i>_init'. For external modules (that will never be built-in, but only available as a module) this name is always 'init_module'. (In the case of modules included with samba, the configure system will add a #define subsystem_backend_init() init_module()). The prototype for these functions is: @@ -1987,11 +1984,11 @@ registration functions. The function should return NT_STATUS_OK on success and NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL or a more useful nt error code on failure.</p><p>For example, pdb_ldap_init() contains: </p><pre class="programlisting"> NTSTATUS pdb_ldap_init(void) { -smb_register_passdb(PASSDB_INTERFACE_VERSION, "ldapsam", pdb_init_ldapsam); -smb_register_passdb(PASSDB_INTERFACE_VERSION, "ldapsam_nua", pdb_init_ldapsam_nua); +smb_register_passdb(PASSDB_INTERFACE_VERSION, "ldapsam", pdb_init_ldapsam); +smb_register_passdb(PASSDB_INTERFACE_VERSION, "ldapsam_nua", pdb_init_ldapsam_nua); return NT_STATUS_OK; } -</pre><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894200"></a>Static/Shared selection in configure.in</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878293"></a>Static/Shared selection in configure.in</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Some macros in configure.in generate the various defines and substs that are necessary for the system to work correct. All modules that should be built by default have to be added to the variable 'default_modules'. @@ -2001,22 +1998,24 @@ On the bottom of configure.in, SMB_MODULE() should be called for each module and SMB_SUBSYSTEM() for each subsystem. </p><p>Syntax:</p><pre class="programlisting"> SMB_MODULE(<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>_<i class="replaceable"><tt>backend</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>object files</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>plugin name</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem name</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>static_action</tt></i>, <i class="replaceable"><tt>shared_action</tt></i>) -SMB_SUBSYSTEM(<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>) -</pre><p>Also, make sure to add the correct directives to -<tt class="filename">Makefile.in</tt>. <i class="replaceable"><tt>@SUBSYSTEM_STATIC@</tt></i> -will be replaced with a list of objects files of the modules that need to -be linked in statically. <i class="replaceable"><tt>@SUBSYSTEM_MODULES@</tt></i> will +SMB_SUBSYSTEM(<i class="replaceable"><tt>subsystem</tt></i>,<i class="replaceable"><tt>depfile</tt></i>) +</pre><p>The depfile for a certain subsystem is the file that calls the +initialisation functions for the statically built in modules.</p><p> +<i class="replaceable"><tt>@SUBSYSTEM_MODULES@</tt></i> in Makefile.in will be replaced with the names of the plugins to build. </p><p>You must make sure all .c files that contain defines that can be changed by ./configure are rebuilded in the 'modules_clean' make target. Practically, this means all c files that contain <b class="command">static_init_subsystem;</b> calls need to be rebuilded. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="rpc-plugin"></a>Chapter 16. RPC Pluggable Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Anthony</span> <span class="surname">Liguori</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:aliguor@us.ibm.com">aliguor@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">January 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2892904">About</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892923">General Overview</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892904"></a>About</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +There currently also is a configure.in command called SMB_MODULE_PROVIVES(). +This is used for modules that register multiple things. It should not +be used as probing will most likely disappear in the future.</p></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="rpc-plugin"></a>Chapter 16. RPC Pluggable Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Anthony</span> <span class="surname">Liguori</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:aliguor@us.ibm.com">aliguor@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">January 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2878489">About</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878508">General Overview</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878489"></a>About</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This document describes how to make use the new RPC Pluggable Modules features of Samba 3.0. This architecture was added to increase the maintainability of Samba allowing RPC Pipes to be worked on separately from the main CVS branch. The RPM architecture will also allow third-party vendors to add functionality to Samba through plug-ins. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892923"></a>General Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878508"></a>General Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When an RPC call is sent to smbd, smbd tries to load a shared library by the name <tt class="filename">librpc_<pipename>.so</tt> to handle the call if it doesn't know how to handle the call internally. For instance, LSA calls @@ -2033,7 +2032,7 @@ NTSTATUS rpc_pipe_register_commands(int version, const char *clnt, const char *s argument.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">clnt</span></dt><dd><p>the Client name of the named pipe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">srv</span></dt><dd><p>the Server name of the named pipe</p></dd><dt><span class="term">cmds</span></dt><dd><p>a list of api_structs that map RPC ordinal numbers to function calls</p></dd><dt><span class="term">size</span></dt><dd><p>the number of api_structs contained in cmds</p></dd></dl></div><p> See rpc_server/srv_reg.c and rpc_server/srv_reg_nt.c for a small example of how to use this library. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="vfs"></a>Chapter 17. VFS Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:ab@samba.org">ab@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:metze@metzemix.de">metze@metzemix.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 May 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2895215">The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895223">The general interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895338">Possible VFS operation layers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895409">The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895418">Initialization and registration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895609">How the Modules handle per connection data</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895852">Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895860">Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896401">Some Notes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896408">Implement TRANSPARENT functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896432">Implement OPAQUE functions</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895215"></a>The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895223"></a>The general interface</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="vfs"></a>Chapter 17. VFS Modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:ab@samba.org">ab@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:metze@metzemix.de">metze@metzemix.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 May 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2878716">The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878723">The general interface</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878839">Possible VFS operation layers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878926">The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878934">Initialization and registration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879115">How the Modules handle per connection data</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879360">Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879367">Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879871">Some Notes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879878">Implement TRANSPARENT functions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879903">Implement OPAQUE functions</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878716"></a>The Samba (Posix) VFS layer</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878723"></a>The general interface</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Each VFS operation has a vfs_op_type, a function pointer and a handle pointer in the struct vfs_ops and tree macros to make it easier to call the operations. (Take a look at <tt class="filename">include/vfs.h</tt> and <tt class="filename">include/vfs_macros.h</tt>.) @@ -2129,7 +2128,7 @@ DO NOT ACCESS conn->vfs.ops.* directly !!! (tofd), (fsp), (fromfd), (header), (offset), (count))) ... -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895338"></a>Possible VFS operation layers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878839"></a>Possible VFS operation layers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> These values are used by the VFS subsystem when building the conn->vfs and conn->vfs_opaque structs for a connection with multiple VFS modules. Internally, Samba differentiates only opaque and transparent layers at this process. @@ -2158,7 +2157,7 @@ typedef enum _vfs_op_layer { SMB_VFS_LAYER_SCANNER /* - Checks data and possibly initiates additional */ /* file activity like logging to files _inside_ samba VFS */ } vfs_op_layer; -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895409"></a>The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895418"></a>Initialization and registration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878926"></a>The Interaction between the Samba VFS subsystem and the modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878934"></a>Initialization and registration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> As each Samba module a VFS module should have a </p><pre class="programlisting">NTSTATUS vfs_example_init(void);</pre><p> function if it's staticly linked to samba or </p><pre class="programlisting">NTSTATUS init_module(void);</pre><p> function if it's a shared module. @@ -2196,9 +2195,9 @@ static vfs_op_tuple example_op_tuples[] = { NTSTATUS init_module(void) { - return smb_register_vfs(SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION, "example", example_op_tuples); + return smb_register_vfs(SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION, "example", example_op_tuples); } -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895609"></a>How the Modules handle per connection data</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Each VFS function has as first parameter a pointer to the modules vfs_handle_struct. +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879115"></a>How the Modules handle per connection data</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Each VFS function has as first parameter a pointer to the modules vfs_handle_struct. </p><pre class="programlisting"> typedef struct vfs_handle_struct { struct vfs_handle_struct *next, *prev; @@ -2208,7 +2207,7 @@ typedef struct vfs_handle_struct { void *data; void (*free_data)(void **data); } vfs_handle_struct; -</pre><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">param</span></dt><dd><p>this is the module parameter specified in the <b class="command">vfs objects</b> parameter.</p><p>e.g. for 'vfs objects = example:test' param would be "test".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">vfs_next</span></dt><dd><p>This vfs_ops struct contains the information for calling the next module operations. +</pre><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">param</span></dt><dd><p>this is the module parameter specified in the <b class="command">vfs objects</b> parameter.</p><p>e.g. for 'vfs objects = example:test' param would be "test".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">vfs_next</span></dt><dd><p>This vfs_ops struct contains the information for calling the next module operations. Use the SMB_VFS_NEXT_* macros to call a next module operations and don't access handle->vfs_next.ops.* directly!</p></dd><dt><span class="term">conn</span></dt><dd><p>This is a pointer back to the connection_struct to witch the handle belongs.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">data</span></dt><dd><p>This is a pointer for holding module private data. You can alloc data with connection life time on the handle->conn->mem_ctx TALLOC_CTX. @@ -2218,14 +2217,14 @@ you can set this function pointer to NULL.</p></dd></dl></div><p>Some useful MAC </p><pre class="programlisting"> #define SMB_VFS_HANDLE_GET_DATA(handle, datap, type, ret) { \ if (!(handle)||((datap=(type *)(handle)->data)==NULL)) { \ - DEBUG(0,("%s() failed to get vfs_handle->data!\n",FUNCTION_MACRO)); \ + DEBUG(0,("%s() failed to get vfs_handle->data!\n",FUNCTION_MACRO)); \ ret; \ } \ } #define SMB_VFS_HANDLE_SET_DATA(handle, datap, free_fn, type, ret) { \ if (!(handle)) { \ - DEBUG(0,("%s() failed to set handle->data!\n",FUNCTION_MACRO)); \ + DEBUG(0,("%s() failed to set handle->data!\n",FUNCTION_MACRO)); \ ret; \ } else { \ if ((handle)->free_data) { \ @@ -2299,20 +2298,20 @@ you can set this function pointer to NULL.</p></dd></dl></div><p>Some useful MAC (handle)->vfs_next.handles.sendfile,\ (tofd), (fsp), (fromfd), (header), (offset), (count))) ... -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895852"></a>Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895860"></a>Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> -Add "vfs_handle_struct *handle, " as first parameter to all vfs operation functions. +</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879360"></a>Upgrading to the New VFS Interface</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879367"></a>Upgrading from 2.2.* and 3.0aplha modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> +Add "vfs_handle_struct *handle, " as first parameter to all vfs operation functions. e.g. example_connect(connection_struct *conn, const char *service, const char *user); -> example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle, connection_struct *conn, const char *service, const char *user); </p></li><li><p> -Replace "default_vfs_ops." with "smb_vfs_next_". +Replace "default_vfs_ops." with "smb_vfs_next_". e.g. default_vfs_ops.connect(conn, service, user); -> smb_vfs_next_connect(conn, service, user); </p></li><li><p> -Uppercase all "smb_vfs_next_*" functions. +Uppercase all "smb_vfs_next_*" functions. e.g. smb_vfs_next_connect(conn, service, user); -> SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(conn, service, user); </p></li><li><p> -Add "handle, " as first parameter to all SMB_VFS_NEXT_*() calls. +Add "handle, " as first parameter to all SMB_VFS_NEXT_*() calls. e.g. SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(conn, service, user); -> SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(handle, conn, service, user); </p></li><li><p> @@ -2412,7 +2411,7 @@ e.g. </p><pre class="programlisting"> NTSTATUS init_module(void) { - return smb_register_vfs(SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION,"example",example_op_tuples); + return smb_register_vfs(SMB_VFS_INTERFACE_VERSION,"example",example_op_tuples); } </pre><p> </p></li><li><p> @@ -2448,14 +2447,14 @@ static int example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle, /* alloc our private data */ data = (struct example_privates *)talloc_zero(conn->mem_ctx, sizeof(struct example_privates)); if (!data) { - DEBUG(0,("talloc_zero() failed\n")); + DEBUG(0,("talloc_zero() failed\n")); return -1; } /* init out private data */ - data->some_string = talloc_strdup(conn->mem_ctx,"test"); + data->some_string = talloc_strdup(conn->mem_ctx,"test"); if (!data->some_string) { - DEBUG(0,("talloc_strdup() failed\n")); + DEBUG(0,("talloc_strdup() failed\n")); return -1; } @@ -2481,7 +2480,7 @@ static int example_close(vfs_handle_struct *handle, files_struct *fsp, int fd) SMB_VFS_HANDLE_GET_DATA(handle, data, struct example_privates, return -1); /* do something here...*/ - DEBUG(0,("some_string: %s\n",data->some_string)); + DEBUG(0,("some_string: %s\n",data->some_string)); return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CLOSE(handle, fsp, fd); } @@ -2495,7 +2494,7 @@ static void free_example_privates(void **datap) SAFE_FREE(data->some_string); SAFE_FREE(data); - datap = NULL; + *datap = NULL; return; } @@ -2509,14 +2508,14 @@ static int example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle, /* alloc our private data */ data = (struct example_privates *)malloc(sizeof(struct example_privates)); if (!data) { - DEBUG(0,("malloc() failed\n")); + DEBUG(0,("malloc() failed\n")); return -1; } /* init out private data */ - data->some_string = strdup(conn->mem_ctx,"test"); + data->some_string = strdup("test"); if (!data->some_string) { - DEBUG(0,("strdup() failed\n")); + DEBUG(0,("strdup() failed\n")); return -1; } @@ -2526,7 +2525,7 @@ static int example_connect(vfs_handle_struct *handle, * we need to specify a free_function because we used malloc() and strdup(). * (return -1 if something failed.) */ - SMB_VFS_HANDLE_SET_DATA(handle, data, NULL, struct example_privates, return -1); + SMB_VFS_HANDLE_SET_DATA(handle, data, free_example_privates, struct example_privates, return -1); return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CONNECT(handle,conn,service,user); } @@ -2541,7 +2540,7 @@ static int example_close(vfs_handle_struct *handle, files_struct *fsp, int fd) SMB_VFS_HANDLE_GET_DATA(handle, data, struct example_privates, return -1); /* do something here...*/ - DEBUG(0,("some_string: %s\n",data->some_string)); + DEBUG(0,("some_string: %s\n",data->some_string)); return SMB_VFS_NEXT_CLOSE(handle, fsp, fd); } @@ -2562,7 +2561,7 @@ for your module. </p></li><li><p> Compiling & Testing... </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure <tt class="option">--enable-developer</tt></tt></b> ...</td></tr><tr><td><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></td></tr><tr><td>Try to fix all compiler warnings</td></tr><tr><td><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></td></tr><tr><td>Testing, Testing, Testing ...</td></tr></table><p> -</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896401"></a>Some Notes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896408"></a>Implement TRANSPARENT functions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879871"></a>Some Notes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879878"></a>Implement TRANSPARENT functions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Avoid writing functions like this: </p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -2573,7 +2572,7 @@ static int example_close(vfs_handle_struct *handle, files_struct *fsp, int fd) </pre><p> Overload only the functions you really need to! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896432"></a>Implement OPAQUE functions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879903"></a>Implement OPAQUE functions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you want to just implement a better version of a default samba opaque function (e.g. like a disk_free() function for a special filesystem) @@ -2589,16 +2588,16 @@ e.g. for a readonly filesystem. static int example_rename(vfs_handle_struct *handle, connection_struct *conn, char *oldname, char *newname) { - DEBUG(10,("function rename() not allowed on vfs 'example'\n")); + DEBUG(10,("function rename() not allowed on vfs 'example'\n")); errno = ENOSYS; return -1; } -</pre></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Packaging"></a>Chapter 18. Notes to packagers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2895009">Versioning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895042">Modules</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895009"></a>Versioning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please, please update the version number in +</pre></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Packaging"></a>Chapter 18. Notes to packagers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2879969">Versioning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880004">Modules</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879969"></a>Versioning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please, please update the version number in <tt class="filename">source/include/version.h</tt> to include the versioning of your package. This makes it easier to distinguish standard samba builds from custom-build samba builds (distributions often patch packages). For example, a good version would be: </p><pre class="programlisting"> Version 2.999+3.0.alpha21-5 for Debian -</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895042"></a>Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba now has support for building parts of samba as plugins. This +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880004"></a>Modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba now has support for building parts of samba as plugins. This makes it possible to, for example, put ldap or mysql support in a seperate package, thus making it possible to have a normal samba package not depending on ldap or mysql. To build as much parts of samba diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/Samba-HOWTO-Collection.html b/docs/htmldocs/Samba-HOWTO-Collection.html index 27faf25f17..566f0b4068 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/Samba-HOWTO-Collection.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/Samba-HOWTO-Collection.html @@ -16,20 +16,13 @@ insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obt from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTOs - they are a source of inspiration and application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. -"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-HOWTO-Collection"></a>SAMBA Project Documentation</h1></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><h4 class="editedby">Edited by</h4><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="legalnotice"><p> -This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) -version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source -distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <a href="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt" target="_top">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</a> -</p><p><b>Attributions. </b> - </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a href="#IntroSMB" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba">Introduction to Samba</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Lechnyr <<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com" target="_top">david@lechnyr.com</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#install" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Karl Auer</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#FastStart" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#ServerType" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes">Server Types and Security Modes</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org" target="_top">dbannon@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#samba-bdc" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control">Backup Domain Control</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Volker Lendecke <<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE" target="_top">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#StandAloneServer" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers">Stand-Alone Servers</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#ClientConfig" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#NetworkBrowsing" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Databases</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Olivier (lem) Lemaire <<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org" target="_top">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#groupmapping" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups">Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jean François Micouleau</p></li><li><p>Gerald Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#AccessControls" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#locking" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking">File and Record Locking</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Eric Roseme <<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com" target="_top">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#securing-samba" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">Securing Samba</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#InterdomainTrusts" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Rafal Szczesniak <<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org" target="_top">mimir@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#msdfs" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Shirish Kalele <<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#printing" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support">Classical Printing Support</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de" target="_top">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#CUPS-printing" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de" target="_top">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></p></li><li><p>Ciprian Vizitiu <<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org" target="_top">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>> (drawings) </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#VFS" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules">Stackable VFS modules</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Tim Potter</p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce (original vfs_skel README) </p></li><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy (original vfs_netatalk docs) </p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher (Update for multiple modules) </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Tim Potter <<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au" target="_top">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Naag Mummaneni <<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com" target="_top">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#AdvancedNetworkManagement" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management">Advanced Network Management</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#PolicyMgmt" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">System and Account Policies</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#ProfileMgmt" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management">Desktop Profile Management</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#pam" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net" target="_top">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#integrate-ms-networks" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#unicode" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode/Charsets</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>TAKAHASHI Motonobu <<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com" target="_top">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#Backup" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques">Samba Backup Techniques</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#SambaHA" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options">High Availability Options</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#upgrading-to-3.0" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#NT4Migration" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#SWAT" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#diagnosis" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">The Samba checklist</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#problems" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org" target="_top">dbannon@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#bugreport" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs">Reporting Bugs</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p> Someone; Tridge or Karl Auer perhaps?</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#compiling" title="Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA">How to compile SAMBA</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p> Someone; Jerry perhaps?</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#Portability" title="Chapter 37. Portability">Portability</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#Other-Clients" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jim McDonough <<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com" target="_top">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#speed" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning">Samba Performance Tuning</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Paul Cochrane <<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk" target="_top">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#DNSDHCP" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="#Further-Resources" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources">Further Resources</a></span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Lechnyr <<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com" target="_top">david@lechnyr.com</a>></p></li></ul></div></dd></dl></div><p> - - </p></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Monday April 21, 2003</p></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p> +"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-HOWTO-Collection"></a>SAMBA Project Documentation</h1></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><h4 class="editedby">Edited by</h4><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Monday April 21, 2003</p></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p> This book is a collection of HOWTOs added to Samba documentation over the years. Samba is always under development, and so is its' documentation. This release of the documentation represents a major revision or layout as well as contents. The most recent version of this document can be found at <a href="http://www.samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> -on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to +on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to <a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">Jelmer Vernooij</a>, <a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John H. Terpstra</a> or <a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">Gerald (Jerry) Carter</a>. @@ -38,47 +31,53 @@ The Samba-Team would like to express sincere thanks to the many people who have or without their knowledge contributed to this update. The size and scope of this project would not have been possible without significant community contribution. A not insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obtained -from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. +from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTOs - they are a source of inspiration and application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. -</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>I. <a href="#introduction">General Installation</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>1. <a href="#IntroSMB">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868116">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868327">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868481">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868550">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868638">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868711">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#install">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869372">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869412">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869449">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869599">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869643">Try listing the shares available on your - server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869694">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869795">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869858">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869892">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869904">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870119">I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#FastStart">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869247">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>II. <a href="#type">Server Configuration Basics</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>4. <a href="#ServerType">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871270">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871366">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871450">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871565">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871698">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871820">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872071">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872158">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872383">Seamless Windows Network Integration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872559">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872587">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872620">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872649">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872682">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="#samba-pdc">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874489">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874793">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874809">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875020">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875340">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875639">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875661">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875676">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876003">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876111">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876118">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876157">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." -or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876206">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876277">The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876340">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876367">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#samba-bdc">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878532">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878705">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878734">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878954">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878975">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879001">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879047">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879149">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879210">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879224">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879254">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879287">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879332">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#domain-member">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880401">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880516">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880692">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880944">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881141">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881203">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881406">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881788">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881929">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882013">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882376">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2882398">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2882423">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882455">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#StandAloneServer">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884809">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885005">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885077">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885092">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885142">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885356">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="#ClientConfig">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884469">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>III. <a href="#optional">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>10. <a href="#NetworkBrowsing">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886062">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886141">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886251">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886267">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886430">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886562">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2886698">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886824">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887045">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887315">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887471">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887488">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887517">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887626">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2887687">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2887846">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888045">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888070">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888154">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888167">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888234">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888372">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888419">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888526">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888605">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2889225">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889240">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889269">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#passdb">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892812">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893140">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893204">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893458">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893513">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893545">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893811">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893963">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893999">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894038">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894145">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894173">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895689">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896493">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896501">Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896516">Users are being added to the wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896576">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#groupmapping">Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2903953">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904055">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904246">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904310">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904325">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904393">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904485">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904501">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904562">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#AccessControls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902775">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902812">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902830">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903087">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903183">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2903398">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904578">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904850">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905095">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905311">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905383">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905682">MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905690">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905728">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905807">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905929">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906157">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906309">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask - parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906639">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2906714">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2906729">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907109">I have set force user and Samba still makes root the owner of all the files - I touch!</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#locking">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910721">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910776">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910908">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911554">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911664">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911924">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2912154">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912180">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2912260">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912291">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2912365">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2912394">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#securing-samba">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914448">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914481">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914555">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914574">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914645">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914697">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914749">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914805">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914866">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2914907">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914932">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914949">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914974">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#InterdomainTrusts">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915881">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915909">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915993">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916006">NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916091">NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916127">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916155">Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916295">Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916428">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916443">Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#msdfs">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915783">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917436">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#printing">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917027">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917095">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917133">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917203">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918120">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918450">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918559">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918652">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2918721">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918810">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2919116">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919220">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2919234">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919616">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919945">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920166">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920216">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920741">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921021">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921186">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921338">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921450">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921521">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921752">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921913">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2922008">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922192">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with -rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2923912">"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2923933">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924131">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924420">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924516">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924657">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924690">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925127">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925430">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925673">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a -different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925771">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926117">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926188">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2926210">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2926256">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926297">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926316">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926340">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2926492">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926822">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926867">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927036">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927051">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2927064">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927097">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="#CUPS-printing">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936290">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936298">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936350">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936405">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936484">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936628">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936710">More complex smb.conf Settings for -CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936828">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936848">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936875">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936912">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936970">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937131">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2937224">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937300">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937344">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937445">Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937533">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937630">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937742">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937813">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937902">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2937925">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2938065">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938252">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938369">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938539">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938624">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938727">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938883">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938940">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939024">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939336">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939448">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939464">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939517">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939571">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939786">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940015">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and -native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940170">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940401">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940530">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940605">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940620">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940659">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940731">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940794">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print -Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940814">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940978">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941054">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941110">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941150">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941216">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941233">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941268">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941289">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941316">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941369"> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941388">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941480">Prepare your smb.conf for -cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941526">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941724">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941782">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941814">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941864">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942086">What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942268">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942369">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942596">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942690">How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942777">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942812">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942865">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942978">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the -Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943112">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using -rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943227">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943340">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943429">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943519">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943682">Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944334">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944435">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944537">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944608">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944670">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944728">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944795">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944903">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2945532">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2945993">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946024">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946056">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946097">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946169">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946270">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946341">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946390">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946404">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946598">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946644">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946726">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946787">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946805">When not to use Samba to print to -CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946822">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946857">Where to find Documentation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946870">How to ask for Help</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946883">Where to find Help</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946896">Appendix</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946904">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2947118">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2947424">Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2948546">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="#VFS">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2960717">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960735">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960826">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2960833">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960871">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960995">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961013">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961151">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2961195">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2961218">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961273">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2961303">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="#winbind">Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962201">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962229">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962301">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962361">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2962392">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962420">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962454">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962477">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962613">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962685">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962720">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2962747">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962776">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962851">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962944">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2964563">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2964582">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="#AdvancedNetworkManagement">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967075">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2967264">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2967363">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967381">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2967592">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967788">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2967822">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="#PolicyMgmt">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2966885">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2966939">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2968722">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2968817">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2968950">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2969202">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2969303">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969324">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969344">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2969388">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969535">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2969549">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="#ProfileMgmt">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2970756">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2970790">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2970831">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2971236">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972407">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972472">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2972737">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972795">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972841">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2972861">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2973009">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2973563">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2974067">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2974080">How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2974143">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2974365">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="#pam">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2978309">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2978577">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2978595">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979265">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979567">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979625">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979709">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2980075">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2980089">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="#integrate-ms-networks">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982211">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982236">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982281">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982337">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982462">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982506">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982548">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2982637">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982784">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982829">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983073">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983105">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983130">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2983200">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983216">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983248">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983300">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="#unicode">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2984418">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984620">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984690">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984790">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984835">Japanese charsets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="#Backup">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2984038">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984063">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="#SambaHA">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2985605">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>IV. <a href="#migration">Migration and Updating</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>30. <a href="#upgrading-to-3.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2984190">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984215">Obsolete configuration options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2985825">Password Backend</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="#NT4Migration">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983845">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983873">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2986549">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2986887">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986968">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2987210">Samba Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="#SWAT">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986434">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986468">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2988827">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2988941">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989005">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989110">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989175">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989239">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989287">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989339">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989362">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>V. <a href="#troubleshooting">Troubleshooting</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>33. <a href="#diagnosis">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2988578">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2990437">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2990614">The tests</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2991790">Still having troubles?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="#problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2993414">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993555">Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993839">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993884">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994036">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="#bugreport">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994775">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994997">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995034">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995176">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995284">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995331">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>VI. <a href="#Appendixes">Appendixes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>36. <a href="#compiling">How to compile SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994651">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994658">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994688">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2996207">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996256">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996392">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2996529">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2996694">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2996786">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996990">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2997085">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="#Portability">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2995985">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998515">SCO Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998546">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998716">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998760">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998767">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2998793">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998800">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="#Other-Clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998169">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999522">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2999529">How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999608">How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999670">How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2999766">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2999774">Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999864">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999894">Configure WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999940">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999970">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999988">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3000034">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3000107">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3000131">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3000242">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="#speed">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3001274">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001319">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001394">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001437">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001490">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001513">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001570">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001612">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001633">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001658">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001692">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="#DNSDHCP">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3001112">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="#Further-Resources">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3001272">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3002922">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3002990">Books</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3001039">Index</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-figures"><p><b>List of Figures</b></p><dl><dt>19.1. <a href="#id2937409">Windows Printing to a local Printer</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="#id2937580">Printing to a Postscript Printer</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="#id2937660">Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</a></dt><dt>19.4. <a href="#id2938589">Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</a></dt><dt>19.5. <a href="#id2938654">Adding Device-specific Print Options</a></dt><dt>19.6. <a href="#id2938756">Postscript to intermediate Raster format</a></dt><dt>19.7. <a href="#id2938809">CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</a></dt><dt>19.8. <a href="#id2938904">Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</a></dt><dt>19.9. <a href="#id2938988">Raster to Printer Specific formats</a></dt><dt>19.10. <a href="#id2940065">cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</a></dt><dt>19.11. <a href="#id2940695">Print Driver execution on the Client</a></dt><dt>19.12. <a href="#id2940753">Print Driver execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>19.13. <a href="#id2940943">Printing via CUPS/samba server</a></dt><dt>19.14. <a href="#id2942830">cupsaddsmb flowchart</a></dt><dt>19.15. <a href="#id2948557">CUPS Printing Overview</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-tables"><p><b>List of Tables</b></p><dl><dt>7.1. <a href="#id2881417">Assumptions</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="#id2888772">Browse subnet example 1</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="#id2888886">Browse subnet example 2</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="#id2888985">Browse subnet example 3</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="#id2889086">Browse subnet example 4</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="#id2895163">Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="#id2895850">Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>11.3. <a href="#id2895975">MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="#id2903107">Managing directories with unix and windows</a></dt><dt>13.2. <a href="#id2904638">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.3. <a href="#id2904871">File and Directory Permission Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.4. <a href="#id2905118">Other Controls</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="#id2960912">Extended Auditing Log Information</a></dt><dt>24.1. <a href="#id2973359">User Shell Folder registry keys default values</a></dt><dt>24.2. <a href="#id2973503">Defaults of profile settings registry keys</a></dt><dt>24.3. <a href="#id2973759">Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</a></dt><dt>25.1. <a href="#id2979741">Options recognized by pam_smbpass</a></dt><dt>31.1. <a href="#id2986904">The 3 Major Site Types</a></dt><dt>31.2. <a href="#id2987041">Nature of the Conversion Choices</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-examples"><p><b>List of Examples</b></p><dl><dt>12.1. <a href="#id2904348">smbgrpadd.sh</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="#id2903320">Example File</a></dt></dl></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="introduction"></a>General Installation</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2866833"></a>Preparing Samba for Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba +</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2796910">Legal Notice</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2799782">Attributions</a></dt><dt>I. <a href="#introduction">General Installation</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>1. <a href="#IntroSMB">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801584">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801642">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801779">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801848">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801936">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802009">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#install">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802151">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802195">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802232">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866164">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866210">Try listing the shares available on your + server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866267">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866384">Try connecting from another SMB client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866468">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866500">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866513">Large number of smbd processes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866612">"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866630">"The network name cannot be found"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#FastStart">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866757">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>II. <a href="#type">Server Configuration Basics</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>4. <a href="#ServerType">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866937">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867038">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867124">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867244">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867382">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867518">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867776">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867877">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2868158">Password checking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868359">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868387">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868427">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868463">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868503">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="#samba-pdc">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868835">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869049">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869064">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869309">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869698">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870186">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870238">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870253">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870678">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870825">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870831">'$' cannot be included in machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870890">Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870945">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871029">The machine trust account not accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871102">Account disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871135">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871156">Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#samba-bdc">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871317">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871494">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871522">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871772">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871793">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871819">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2871833">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871968">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872125">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872138">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872169">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872196">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872240">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#domain-member">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872448">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873061">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873276">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873347">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873995">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874178">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874307">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874683">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874706">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874732">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874764">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#StandAloneServer">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874966">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875004">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875078">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875598">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="#ClientConfig">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875663">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>III. <a href="#optional">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>10. <a href="#NetworkBrowsing">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875816">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876217">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876469">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876635">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876781">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877309">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877716">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877893">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877911">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877946">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878104">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878182">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878371">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878627">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878652">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878737">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878750">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878822">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878986">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879046">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879168">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879254">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879936">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879950">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879979">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880021">I get an Unable to browse the network error</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#passdb">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880302">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880315">Backwards Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880417">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880590">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880717">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880966">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881151">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881423">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2881676">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881717">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881758">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881871">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881898">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2883727">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2884575">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884582">Users can not logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2884627">Users being added to wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2884738">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#groupmapping">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885202">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885422">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885489">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885503">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885582">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885658">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885674">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885742">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885768">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#AccessControls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886024">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886154">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886489">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886582">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2886810">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888020">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888092">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888391">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888399">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888444">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888523">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888655">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888889">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889446">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2889526">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889540">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889969">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890022">MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#locking">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2890270">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890336">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2890479">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891158">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891268">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891665">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891896">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891924">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892003">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892032">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892106">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892144">Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892167">Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892198">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#securing-samba">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892365">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892398">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892471">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892490">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892590">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892650">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892717">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892774">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892867">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892926">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892950">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892968">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892992">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#InterdomainTrusts">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893283">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893311">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893400">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893428">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893500">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893547">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893725">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893918">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2894055">NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894162">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#msdfs">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894231">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894506">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#printing">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894626">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894693">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894730">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894801">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895354">A simple Configuration to Print</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895518">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895606">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895939">Extended Sample Configuration to Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896270">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897534">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897592">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2898261">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2898591">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2898740">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2898892">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899004">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899475">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2899643">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2899736">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899935">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2901625">Client Driver Install Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2901643">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2901839">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902136">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902231">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2902399">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902431">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902874">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903470">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a +different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903569">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903854">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903932">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2903954">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2903998">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904040">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904059">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904083">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904236">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904556">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904602">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904779">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904793">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904800">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904834">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="#CUPS-printing">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904970">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904977">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905020">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905074">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905408">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905584">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905929">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905949">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905999">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906051">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906119">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2906432">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907029">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907154">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907241">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907348">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2907370">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2907545">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907903">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908080">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908183">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908292">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908476">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908539">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908691">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909039">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909176">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909191">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909245">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909312">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909544">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910018">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910331">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910470">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2910560">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910577">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910632">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2910813">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911043">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911125">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911206">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911255">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911328">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911345">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911379">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911400">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911445">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911506">Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911524">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911625">Prepare your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911845">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912128">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912268">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912301">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912629">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912835">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912958">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913264">How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913349">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913427">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913497">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913646">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2913973">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914086">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914186">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915566">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915962">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916041">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916103">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916162">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916297">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916436">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917129">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2917602">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917645">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917708">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917748">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917829">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917938">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918010">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918058">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918072">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918267">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2918326">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918564">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918622">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918682">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918955">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2796634">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2796642">Win9x client can't install driver</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919061">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919107">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919163">Client can't connect to Samba printer</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919497">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919582">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919635">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919649">Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919678">Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919695">Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919711">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919733">"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919752">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919794">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920067">Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920114">cupsaddsmb does not work + with newly installed printer</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920175">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920284">Printer named "lp" +intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different +ones</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920314">Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2920369">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="#VFS">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2920538">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920556">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920786">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2920793">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920835">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920965">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920984">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921153">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921198">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921220">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921286">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="#winbind">Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921516">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921611">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921688">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921756">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921786">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921815">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921849">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921872">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922009">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922081">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922128">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2922156">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2922164">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922231">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922333">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2923890">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2923909">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2923962">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="#AdvancedNetworkManagement">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924071">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924101">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924200">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924218">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924438">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924711">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924744">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="#PolicyMgmt">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924822">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924888">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924999">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925094">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925227">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2925491">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925596">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925636">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925655">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2925700">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925851">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925865">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="#ProfileMgmt">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925964">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925999">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2926040">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926530">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927776">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927861">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2928114">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928172">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928216">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2928237">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928385">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928939">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2929447">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2929460">Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2929529">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2929742">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="#pam">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2930024">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2930271">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2930288">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2930969">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931283">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931361">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931445">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2931826">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2931839">pam_winbind problem</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931926">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="#integrate-ms-networks">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932164">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932188">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932259">Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932315">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932456">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932499">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932551">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2932655">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932922">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932985">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933234">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933266">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933298">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2933416">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2933432">Pinging works only in one way</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933465">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933517">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="#unicode">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2933721">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933765">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933835">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933962">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933992">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934130">Common errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934137">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="#Backup">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934250">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934264">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="#SambaHA">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934334">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>IV. <a href="#migration">Migration and Updating</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>30. <a href="#upgrading-to-3.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934473">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934602">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934617">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934744">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935140">Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2935215">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2935222">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935456">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935505">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935529">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935648">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935672">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="#NT4Migration">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936004">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936029">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936467">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936679">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936770">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937026">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="#SWAT">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937386">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937426">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937663">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937775">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937837">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937944">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938008">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938072">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938120">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938171">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938195">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>V. <a href="#troubleshooting">Troubleshooting</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>33. <a href="#diagnosis">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2938325">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938359">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="#problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940060">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940082">Debugging with Samba itself</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940195">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940216">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940268">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940586">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940626">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940778">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="#bugreport">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940906">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940969">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941006">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941215">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941348">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941395">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>VI. <a href="#Appendixes">Appendixes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>36. <a href="#compiling">How to compile Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941554">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941570">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941600">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941849">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941913">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942063">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942242">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2942409">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942763">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="#Portability">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942927">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943015">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943044">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943217">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943261">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943268">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943294">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943299">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="#Other-Clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943452">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943531">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943538">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943607">Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943660">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943760">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943768">Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943858">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943888">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943941">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943979">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943996">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944042">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944116">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944140">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944326">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="#speed">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944458">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944501">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944592">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944641">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944701">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944732">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944816">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944879">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944908">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944932">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944965">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="#DNSDHCP">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2945070">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="#Further-Resources">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2945137">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2945545">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2945614">Index</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-figures"><p><b>List of Figures</b></p><dl><dt>5.1. <a href="#domain-example">An Example Domain</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="#browsing1">Cross subnet browsing example</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="#idmap-diag">IDMAP</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="#idmap-group-diag">IDMAP groups</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="#access1">Overview of unix permissions field</a></dt><dt>16.1. <a href="#trusts1">Trusts overview</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="#small1">Windows Printing to a local Printer</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="#small2">Printing to a Postscript Printer</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="#small3">Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</a></dt><dt>19.4. <a href="#small4">Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</a></dt><dt>19.5. <a href="#small5">Adding Device-specific Print Options</a></dt><dt>19.6. <a href="#small6">Postscript to intermediate Raster format</a></dt><dt>19.7. <a href="#small7">CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</a></dt><dt>19.8. <a href="#small8">Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</a></dt><dt>19.9. <a href="#small9">Raster to Printer Specific formats</a></dt><dt>19.10. <a href="#small10">cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</a></dt><dt>19.11. <a href="#pdftosocket">PDF to socket chain</a></dt><dt>19.12. <a href="#pdftoepsonusb">PDF to USB chain</a></dt><dt>19.13. <a href="#small11">Print Driver execution on the Client</a></dt><dt>19.14. <a href="#small12">Print Driver execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>19.15. <a href="#small13">Printing via CUPS/samba server</a></dt><dt>19.16. <a href="#small14">cupsaddsmb flowchart</a></dt><dt>19.17. <a href="#cups1">Filtering chain 1</a></dt><dt>19.18. <a href="#cups2">Filtering chain with cupsomatic</a></dt><dt>19.19. <a href="#a_small">CUPS Printing Overview</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-tables"><p><b>List of Tables</b></p><dl><dt>7.1. <a href="#id2873569">Assumptions</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="#id2879437">Browse subnet example 1</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="#id2879550">Browse subnet example 2</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="#id2879662">Browse subnet example 3</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="#id2879779">Browse subnet example 4</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="#id2883118">Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="#id2883914">Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>11.3. <a href="#id2884046">MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="#id2886508">Managing directories with unix and windows</a></dt><dt>13.2. <a href="#id2886925">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.3. <a href="#id2887281">File and Directory Permission Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.4. <a href="#id2887661">Other Controls</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="#id2909623">PPD's shipped with CUPS</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="#id2920882">Extended Auditing Log Information</a></dt><dt>24.1. <a href="#id2928735">User Shell Folder registry keys default values</a></dt><dt>24.2. <a href="#id2928879">Defaults of profile settings registry keys</a></dt><dt>24.3. <a href="#id2929134">Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</a></dt><dt>25.1. <a href="#id2931477">Options recognized by pam_smbpass</a></dt><dt>26.1. <a href="#id2932688">Unique NetBIOS names</a></dt><dt>26.2. <a href="#id2932758">Group Names</a></dt><dt>30.1. <a href="#id2935241">TDB File Descriptions</a></dt><dt>31.1. <a href="#id2936694">The 3 Major Site Types</a></dt><dt>31.2. <a href="#id2936841">Nature of the Conversion Choices</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-examples"><p><b>List of Examples</b></p><dl><dt>2.1. <a href="#id2802256">Simplest possible smb.conf file</a></dt><dt>5.1. <a href="#pdc-example">smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>5.2. <a href="#id2870309">smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>6.1. <a href="#id2871704">Minimal smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>6.2. <a href="#id2871983">Minimal setup for being a BDC</a></dt><dt>8.1. <a href="#id2875123">smb.conf for Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt>8.2. <a href="#id2875442">smb.conf for anonymous printing</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="#id2877023">Domain master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="#id2877114">Local master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="#id2877252">smb.conf for not being a master browser</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="#id2877358">Local master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.5. <a href="#id2877475">smb.conf for not being a master browser</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="#idmapbackendexample"></a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="#id2882685">Configuration with LDAP</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="#id2885526">smbgrpadd.sh</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="#id2886704">Example File</a></dt><dt>14.1. <a href="#id2891471">Share with some files oplocked</a></dt><dt>14.2. <a href="#id2891612"></a></dt><dt>17.1. <a href="#id2894342">smb.conf with DFS configured</a></dt><dt>18.1. <a href="#id2895382">Simple configuration with BSD printing</a></dt><dt>18.2. <a href="#extbsdpr">Extended configuration with BSD printing</a></dt><dt>18.3. <a href="#id2899046">[print\$] example</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="#id2905436">Simplest printing-related smb.conf</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="#id2905615">Overriding global CUPS settings for one printer</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="#id2911654">smb.conf for cupsaddsmb usage</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="#id2920594">smb.conf with VFS modules</a></dt><dt>20.2. <a href="#id2920694">smb.conf with multiple VFS modules</a></dt><dt>21.1. <a href="#id2922722">smb.conf for winbind set-up</a></dt><dt>33.1. <a href="#id2938408">smb.conf with [tmp] share</a></dt><dt>38.1. <a href="#id2944212">Minimal profile share</a></dt></dl></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2796910"></a>Legal Notice</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) +version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source +distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <a href="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt" target="_top">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</a> +</p></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2799782"></a>Attributions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><a href="#IntroSMB" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba">Introduction to Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Lechnyr <<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com" target="_top">david@lechnyr.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#install" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Karl Auer</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#FastStart" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#ServerType" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes">Server Types and Security Modes</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org" target="_top">dbannon@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#samba-bdc" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control">Backup Domain Control</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Volker Lendecke <<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE" target="_top">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#StandAloneServer" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers">Stand-Alone Servers</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#ClientConfig" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#NetworkBrowsing" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Databases</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Olivier (lem) Lemaire <<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org" target="_top">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#groupmapping" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jean François Micouleau</p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#AccessControls" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>> (drawing) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#locking" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking">File and Record Locking</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Eric Roseme <<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com" target="_top">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#securing-samba" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">Securing Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#InterdomainTrusts" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Rafal Szczesniak <<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org" target="_top">mimir@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>> (drawing) </p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net" target="_top">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#msdfs" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Shirish Kalele <<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#printing" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support">Classical Printing Support</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de" target="_top">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#CUPS-printing" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de" target="_top">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></p></li><li><p>Ciprian Vizitiu <<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org" target="_top">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>> (drawings) </p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>> (drawings) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#VFS" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules">Stackable VFS modules</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Tim Potter</p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce (original vfs_skel README) </p></li><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy (original vfs_netatalk docs) </p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher (Update for multiple modules) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#AdvancedNetworkManagement" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management">Advanced Network Management</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#PolicyMgmt" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">System and Account Policies</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#ProfileMgmt" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management">Desktop Profile Management</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#pam" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net" target="_top">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#integrate-ms-networks" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#unicode" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode/Charsets</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>TAKAHASHI Motonobu <<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com" target="_top">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#Backup" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques">Samba Backup Techniques</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#SambaHA" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options">High Availability Options</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#upgrading-to-3.0" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#NT4Migration" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#SWAT" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#diagnosis" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">The Samba checklist</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#problems" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org" target="_top">dbannon@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#bugreport" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs">Reporting Bugs</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#compiling" title="Chapter 36. How to compile Samba">How to compile Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#Portability" title="Chapter 37. Portability">Portability</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#Other-Clients" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jim McDonough <<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com" target="_top">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>> (OS/2) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#speed" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning">Samba Performance Tuning</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Paul Cochrane <<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk" target="_top">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#DNSDHCP" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="#Further-Resources" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources">Further Resources</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="introduction"></a>General Installation</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2801502"></a>Preparing Samba for Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba and how to configure the parts of samba you will most likely need. -PLEASE read this.</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="#IntroSMB">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868116">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868327">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868481">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868550">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868638">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868711">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#install">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869372">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869412">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869449">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869599">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869643">Try listing the shares available on your - server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869694">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869795">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869858">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869892">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869904">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870119">I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#FastStart">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869247">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="IntroSMB"></a>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 14, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2868116">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868327">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868481">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868550">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868638">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868711">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></div><p>“<span class="quote"> -"If you understand what you're doing, you're not learning anything." +PLEASE read this.</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="#IntroSMB">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2801584">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801642">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801779">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801848">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801936">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802009">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="#install">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802151">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802195">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802232">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866164">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866210">Try listing the shares available on your + server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866267">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866384">Try connecting from another SMB client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866468">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866500">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866513">Large number of smbd processes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866612">"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866630">"The network name cannot be found"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="#FastStart">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866757">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="IntroSMB"></a>Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 14, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2801584">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801642">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801779">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801848">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2801936">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802009">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +"If you understand what you're doing, you're not learning anything." -- Anonymous </span>”</p><p> Samba is a file and print server for Windows-based clients using TCP/IP as the underlying @@ -86,7 +85,7 @@ transport protocol. In fact, it can support any SMB/CIFS-enabled client. One of strengths is that you can use it to blend your mix of Windows and Linux machines together without requiring a separate Windows NT/2000/2003 Server. Samba is actively being developed by a global team of about 30 active programmers and was originally developed by Andrew Tridgell. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868116"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801584"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Once long ago, there was a buzzword referred to as DCE/RPC. This stood for Distributed Computing Environment/Remote Procedure Calls and conceptually was a good idea. It was originally developed by Apollo/HP as NCA 1.0 (Network Computing Architecture) and only @@ -94,12 +93,12 @@ ran over UDP. When there was a need to run it over TCP so that it would be compa with DECnet 3.0, it was redesigned, submitted to The Open Group, and officially became known as DCE/RPC. Microsoft came along and decided, rather than pay $20 per seat to license this technology, to reimplement DCE/RPC themselves as MSRPC. From this, the -concept continued in the form of SMB (Server Message Block, or the "what") using the -NetBIOS (Network Basic Input/Output System, or the "how") compatibility layer. You can +concept continued in the form of SMB (Server Message Block, or the "what") using the +NetBIOS (Network Basic Input/Output System, or the "how") compatibility layer. You can run SMB (i.e., transport) over several different protocols; many different implementations arose as a result, including NBIPX (NetBIOS over IPX, NwLnkNb, or NWNBLink) and NBT (NetBIOS over TCP/IP, or NetBT). As the years passed, NBT became the most common form -of implementation until the advance of "Direct-Hosted TCP" -- the Microsoft marketing +of implementation until the advance of "Direct-Hosted TCP" -- the Microsoft marketing term for eliminating NetBIOS entirely and running SMB by itself across TCP port 445 only. As of yet, direct-hosted TCP has yet to catch on. </p><p> @@ -112,23 +111,23 @@ been dutifully waded through during the information-gathering stages of this pro are *still* many missing pieces... While often tedious, at least the way has been generously littered with occurrences of clapping hand to forehead and muttering 'crikey, what are they thinking? -</em></span></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868327"></a>Terminology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - SMB: Acronym for "Server Message Block". This is Microsoft's file and printer sharing protocol. +</em></span></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801642"></a>Terminology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + SMB: Acronym for "Server Message Block". This is Microsoft's file and printer sharing protocol. </p></li><li><p> - CIFS: Acronym for "Common Internet File System". Around 1996, Microsoft apparently - decided that SMB needed the word "Internet" in it, so they changed it to CIFS. + CIFS: Acronym for "Common Internet File System". Around 1996, Microsoft apparently + decided that SMB needed the word "Internet" in it, so they changed it to CIFS. </p></li><li><p> Direct-Hosted: A method of providing file/printer sharing services over port 445/tcp only using DNS for name resolution instead of WINS. </p></li><li><p> - IPC: Acronym for "Inter-Process Communication". A method to communicate specific + IPC: Acronym for "Inter-Process Communication". A method to communicate specific information between programs. </p></li><li><p> Marshalling: - A method of serializing (i.e., sequential ordering of) variable data suitable for transmission via a network connection or storing in a file. The source data can be re-created using a similar process called unmarshalling. </p></li><li><p> - NetBIOS: Acronym for "Network Basic Input/Output System". This is not a protocol; + NetBIOS: Acronym for "Network Basic Input/Output System". This is not a protocol; it is a method of communication across an existing protocol. This is a standard which was originally developed for IBM by Sytek in 1983. To exaggerate the analogy a bit, it can help to think of this in comparison your computer's BIOS -- it controls the @@ -139,15 +138,15 @@ thinking? brilliant people tend to interchange NetBIOS with terms like NetBEUI without a second thought; this will cause no end (and no doubt) of confusion. </p></li><li><p> - NetBEUI: Acronym for the "NetBIOS Extended User Interface". Unlike NetBIOS, NetBEUI + NetBEUI: Acronym for the "NetBIOS Extended User Interface". Unlike NetBIOS, NetBEUI is a protocol, not a standard. It is also not routable, so traffic on one side of a router will be unable to communicate with the other side. Understanding NetBEUI is not essential to deciphering SMB; however it helps to point out that it is not the same as NetBIOS and to improve your score in trivia at parties. NetBEUI was originally - referred to by Microsoft as "NBF", or "The Windows NT NetBEUI Frame protocol driver". + referred to by Microsoft as "NBF", or "The Windows NT NetBEUI Frame protocol driver". It is not often heard from these days. </p></li><li><p> - NBT: Acronym for "NetBIOS over TCP"; also known as "NetBT". Allows the continued use + NBT: Acronym for "NetBIOS over TCP"; also known as "NetBT". Allows the continued use of NetBIOS traffic proxied over TCP/IP. As a result, NetBIOS names are made to IP addresses and NetBIOS name types are conceptually equivalent to TCP/IP ports. This is how file and printer sharing are accomplished in Windows 95/98/ME. They @@ -162,7 +161,7 @@ thinking? W3K: Acronym for Windows 2003 Server </p></li></ul></div><p>If you plan on getting help, make sure to subscribe to the Samba Mailing List (available at <a href="http://www.samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org</a>). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868481"></a>Related Projects</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801779"></a>Related Projects</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are currently two network filesystem client projects for Linux that are directly related to Samba: SMBFS and CIFS VFS. These are both available in the Linux kernel itself. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -184,21 +183,21 @@ nothing to do with acting as a file and print server for SMB/CIFS clients. There are other Open Source CIFS client implementations, such as the <a href="http://jcifs.samba.org/" target="_top">jCIFS project</a> which provides an SMB client toolkit written in Java. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868550"></a>SMB Methodology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801848"></a>SMB Methodology</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Traditionally, SMB uses UDP port 137 (NetBIOS name service, or netbios-ns), UDP port 138 (NetBIOS datagram service, or netbios-dgm), and TCP port 139 (NetBIOS session service, or netbios-ssn). Anyone looking at their network with a good packet sniffer will be amazed at the amount of traffic generated by just opening up a single file. In general, SMB sessions are established in the following order: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - "TCP Connection" - establish 3-way handshake (connection) to port 139/tcp + "TCP Connection" - establish 3-way handshake (connection) to port 139/tcp or 445/tcp. </p></li><li><p> - "NetBIOS Session Request" - using the following "Calling Names": The local + "NetBIOS Session Request" - using the following "Calling Names": The local machine's NetBIOS name plus the 16th character 0x00; The server's NetBIOS name plus the 16th character 0x20 </p></li><li><p> - "SMB Negotiate Protocol" - determine the protocol dialect to use, which will + "SMB Negotiate Protocol" - determine the protocol dialect to use, which will be one of the following: PC Network Program 1.0 (Core) - share level security mode only; Microsoft Networks 1.03 (Core Plus) - share level security mode only; Lanman1.0 (LAN Manager 1.0) - uses Challenge/Response @@ -216,7 +215,7 @@ up a single file. In general, SMB sessions are established in the following orde A good way to examine this process in depth is to try out <a href="http://www.securityfriday.com/ToolDownload/SWB/swb_doc.html" target="_top">SecurityFriday's SWB program</a>. It allows you to walk through the establishment of a SMB/CIFS session step by step. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868638"></a>Epilogue</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2801936"></a>Epilogue</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> What's fundamentally wrong is that nobody ever had any taste when they did it. Microsoft has been very much into making the user interface look good, but internally it's just a complete mess. And even people who program for Microsoft @@ -240,61 +239,52 @@ halts in the middle of something that shouldn't be strange. Normally it works fine and then once in a blue moon for some completely unknown reason, it's dead, and nobody knows why. Not Microsoft, not the experienced user and certainly not the completely clueless user who probably sits there shivering thinking -"What did I do wrong?" when they didn't do anything wrong at all. +"What did I do wrong?" when they didn't do anything wrong at all. </span>”</p><p>“<span class="quote"> -That's what's really irritating to me." +That's what's really irritating to me." </span>”</p><p>-- <a href="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/boot.txt" target="_top">Linus Torvalds, from an interview with BOOT Magazine, Sept 1998</a> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868711"></a>Miscellaneous</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2802009"></a>Miscellaneous</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter is Copyright 2003 David Lechnyr (david at lechnyr dot com). Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/licenses/fdl.txt. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="install"></a>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Karl</span> <span class="surname">Auer</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2869372">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869412">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869449">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869599">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869643">Try listing the shares available on your - server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869694">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869795">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869858">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869892">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869904">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870119">I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869372"></a>Obtaining and installing samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="install"></a>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Karl</span> <span class="surname">Auer</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2802151">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2802195">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2802232">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866164">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2866210">Try listing the shares available on your + server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866267">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866384">Try connecting from another SMB client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866468">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866500">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866513">Large number of smbd processes</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866612">"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2866630">"The network name cannot be found"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2802151"></a>Obtaining and installing samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Binary packages of samba are included in almost any Linux or - Unix distribution. There are also some packages available at + UNIX distribution. There are also some packages available at <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">the samba homepage</a>. - </p><p>If you need to compile samba from source, check the - <a href="#compiling" title="Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA">appropriate appendix chapter</a>.</p><p>If you have already installed samba, or if your operating system + </p><p>If you need to compile samba from source, check + <a href="#compiling" title="Chapter 36. How to compile Samba">the chapter about compiling samba from scratch</a>.</p><p>If you have already installed samba, or if your operating system was pre-installed with samba, then you may not need to bother with this chapter. On the other hand, you may want to read this chapter anyhow - for information about updating samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869412"></a>Configuring samba (smb.conf)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + for information about updating samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2802195"></a>Configuring samba (smb.conf)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba's configuration is stored in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, that usually resides in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt> or <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt>. You can either edit this file yourself or do it using one of the many graphical tools that are available, such as the web-based interface swat, that is included with samba. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869449"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2802232"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are sample configuration files in the examples subdirectory in the distribution. I suggest you read them carefully so you can see how the options go together in practice. See the man page for all the options. </p><p> The simplest useful configuration file would be something like this: </p><p> - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - workgroup = MYGROUP - - [homes] - guest ok = no - read only = no - </pre><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2802256"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2.1. Simplest possible smb.conf file</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> This will allow connections by anyone with an account on the server, using either - their login name or "<i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i>" as the service name. + their login name or <i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i>" as the service name. (Note that the workgroup that Samba must also be set.) </p><p> - Make sure you put the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the same place - you specified in the <tt class="filename">Makefile</tt> (the default is to - look for it in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/</tt>). + Make sure you put the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the correct place + (usually in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba</tt>). </p><p> For more information about security settings for the - <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share please refer to the chapter - <a href="#securing-samba" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">Securing Samba</a>. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2869544"></a>Test your config file with <b class="command">testparm</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share please refer to + <a href="#securing-samba" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">"Securing Samba"</a>. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2866111"></a>Test your config file with <b class="command">testparm</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> It's important that you test the validity of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file using the <span class="application">testparm</span> program. If testparm runs OK then it will list the loaded services. If not it will give an error message. @@ -302,7 +292,7 @@ Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/li Make sure it runs OK and that the services look reasonable before proceeding. </p><p> Always run testparm again when you change <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>! - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869599"></a>SWAT</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866164"></a>SWAT</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> SWAT is a web-based interface that helps you configure samba. SWAT might not be available in the samba package on your platform, but in a separate package. Please read the swat manpage @@ -318,9 +308,10 @@ Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/li machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent in the clear over the wire. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869643"></a>Try listing the shares available on your - server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L - <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>You should get back a list of shares available on + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866210"></a>Try listing the shares available on your + server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p>You should get back a list of shares available on your server. If you don't then something is incorrectly setup. Note that this method can also be used to see what shares are available on other LanManager clients (such as WfWg).</p><p>If you choose user level security then you may find @@ -328,68 +319,31 @@ Software Foundation. A copy of the license is available at http://www.gnu.org/li See the <b class="command">smbclient</b> man page for details. (you can force it to list the shares without a password by adding the option -U% to the command line. This will not work - with non-Samba servers)</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869694"></a>Try connecting with the unix client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient <i class="replaceable"><tt> - //yourhostname/aservice</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>Typically the <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i> + with non-Samba servers)</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866267"></a>Try connecting with the unix client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient <i class="replaceable"><tt> //yourhostname/aservice</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p>Typically the <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i> would be the name of the host where you installed <span class="application">smbd</span>. The <i class="replaceable"><tt>aservice</tt></i> is any service you have defined in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. Try your user name if you just have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> section in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>For example if your unix host is <i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i> - and your login name is <i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> you would type:</p><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //<i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>/<i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> - </tt></b></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869795"></a>Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Try mounting disks. eg:</p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use d: \\servername\service - </tt></b></p><p>Try printing. eg:</p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: - \\servername\spoolservice</tt></b></p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>print filename - </tt></b></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869858"></a>What If Things Don't Work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Then you might read the file chapter - <a href="#diagnosis" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">Diagnosis</a> and the - FAQ. If you are still stuck then try to follow - the <a href="#problems" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and Solving Problems chapter</a> - Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide, - so maybe someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it. </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869892"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The following questions and issues get raised on the samba mailing list over and over again. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869904"></a>Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -“<span class="quote"> -Site that is running Samba on an AIX box. They are sharing out about 2 terabytes using samba. -Samba was installed using smitty and the binaries. We seem to be experiencing a memory problem -with this box. When I do a <b class="command">svmon -Pu</b> the monitoring program shows that <span class="application">smbd</span> has several -processes of smbd running: -</span>” -</p><p> - “<span class="quote"> -Is samba suppose to start this many different smbd processes? Or does it run as one smbd process? Also -is it normal for it to be taking up this much memory? -</span>” -</p><p> + and your login name is <i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> you would type:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //<i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>/<i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866384"></a>Try connecting from another SMB client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Try mounting disks. from a DOS, Windows or OS/2 client, eg:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use d: \\servername\service</tt></b> +</pre><p>Try printing. eg:</p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -Inuse * 4096 = amount of memory being used by this process - - Pid Command Inuse Pin Pgsp Virtual 64-bit Mthrd - 20950 smbd 33098 1906 181 5017 N N - 22262 smbd 9104 1906 5410 - 21060 smbd 9048 1906 181 5479 N N - 25972 smbd 8678 1906 181 5109 N N - 24524 smbd 8674 1906 181 5105 N N - 19262 smbd 8582 1906 181 5013 N N - 20722 smbd 8572 1906 181 5003 N N - 21454 smbd 8572 1906 181 5003 N N - 28946 smbd 8567 1906 181 4996 N N - 24076 smbd 8566 1906 181 4996 N N - 20138 smbd 8566 1906 181 4996 N N - 17608 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 21820 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 26940 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 19884 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 9912 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 25800 smbd 8564 1906 181 4995 N N - 20452 smbd 8564 1906 181 4995 N N - 18592 smbd 8562 1906 181 4993 N N - 28216 smbd 8521 1906 181 4954 N N - 19110 smbd 8404 1906 181 4862 N N - - Total memory used: 841,592,832 bytes +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: \\servername\spoolservice</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>print filename</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866468"></a>What If Things Don't Work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Then you might read the file chapter <a href="#diagnosis" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">diagnosis</a> + and the FAQ. If you are still stuck then refer to <a href="#problems" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">"Analysing and solving problems"</a>. + Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide, + so maybe someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866500"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following questions and issues get raised on the samba mailing list over and over again. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866513"></a>Large number of smbd processes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba consists on three core programs: <span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">winbindd</span>. <span class="application">nmbd</span> is the name server message daemon, <span class="application">smbd</span> is the server message daemon, <span class="application">winbindd</span> is the daemon that @@ -403,19 +357,20 @@ two (2) instances - one to handle the WINS requests. connection made. That is why you are seeing so many of them, one (1) per client connection. </p><p> <span class="application">winbindd</span> will run as one or two daemons, depending on whether or not it is being -run in "split mode" (in which case there will be two instances). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870119"></a>I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Your loopback device isn't working correctly. Make sure it's running. </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="FastStart"></a>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2869247">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869247"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +run in "split mode" (in which case there will be two instances). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866612"></a>"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Your loopback device isn't working correctly. Make sure it's configured properly. The loopback device is an internal (virtual) network device with + the ip address 127.0.0.1. Read your OS documentation for details + on how to configure the loopback on your system.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2866630"></a>"<span class="errorname">The network name cannot be found</span>"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This error can be caused by one of these misconfigurations: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You specified an nonexisting <a class="indexterm" name="id2866655"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> for the share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> </p></li><li><p>The user you are trying to access the share with does not + have sufficient permissions to access the <a class="indexterm" name="id2866684"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> for the share. Both read (r) and access (x) should be possible.</p></li><li><p>The share you are trying to access does not exist.</p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="FastStart"></a>Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2866757">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866757"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="type"></a>Server Configuration Basics</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2869315"></a>First Steps in Server Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="type"></a>Server Configuration Basics</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2866784"></a>First Steps in Server Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba can operate in various modes within SMB networks. This HOWTO section contains information on configuring samba to function as the type of server your network requires. Please read this section carefully. -</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>4. <a href="#ServerType">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871270">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871366">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871450">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871565">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871698">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871820">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872071">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872158">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872383">Seamless Windows Network Integration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872559">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872587">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872620">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872649">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872682">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="#samba-pdc">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874489">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874793">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874809">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875020">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875340">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875639">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875661">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875676">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876003">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876111">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876118">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876157">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." -or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876206">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876277">The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876340">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876367">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#samba-bdc">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878532">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878705">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878734">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878954">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878975">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879001">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879047">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879149">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879210">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879224">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879254">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879287">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879332">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#domain-member">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880401">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880516">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880692">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880944">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881141">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881203">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881406">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881788">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881929">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882013">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882376">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2882398">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2882423">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882455">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#StandAloneServer">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884809">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885005">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885077">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885092">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885142">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885356">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="#ClientConfig">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884469">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ServerType"></a>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2871270">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871366">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871450">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871565">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871698">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871820">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872071">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872158">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872383">Seamless Windows Network Integration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872559">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872587">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872620">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872649">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872682">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>4. <a href="#ServerType">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2866937">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867038">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867124">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867244">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867382">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867518">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867776">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867877">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2868158">Password checking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868359">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868387">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868427">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868463">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868503">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="#samba-pdc">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868835">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869049">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869064">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869309">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869698">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870186">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870238">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870253">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870678">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870825">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870831">'$' cannot be included in machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870890">Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870945">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871029">The machine trust account not accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871102">Account disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871135">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871156">Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="#samba-bdc">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871317">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871494">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871522">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871772">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871793">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871819">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2871833">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871968">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872125">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872138">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872169">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872196">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872240">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="#domain-member">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872448">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873061">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873276">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873347">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873995">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874178">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874307">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874683">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874706">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874732">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874764">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="#StandAloneServer">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874966">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875004">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875078">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875598">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="#ClientConfig">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875663">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ServerType"></a>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2866937">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867038">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867124">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2867244">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867382">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867518">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867776">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2867877">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2868158">Password checking</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868359">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2868387">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868427">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868463">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2868503">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This chapter provides information regarding the types of server that Samba may be configured to be. A Microsoft network administrator who wishes to migrate to or to use Samba will want to know what, within a Samba context, terms familiar to MS Windows @@ -425,10 +380,11 @@ modes function BEFORE we get into the details of how to configure the server its The chapter provides an overview of the security modes of which Samba is capable and how these relate to MS Windows servers and clients. </p><p> -Firstly we should recognise the question so often asked, "Why would I want to use Samba?" -So, in those chapters where the answer may be important you will see a section that highlights -features and benefits. These may be for or against Samba. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871270"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A question often asked is, "Why would I want to use Samba?" Most chapters contain a section +that highlights features and benefits. We hope that the information provided will help to +answer this question. Be warned though, we want to be fair and reasonable, so not all +features are positive towards Samba so the benefit may be on the side of our competition. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2866937"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Two men were walking down a dusty road, when one suddenly kicked up a small red stone. It hurt his toe and lodged in his sandal. He took the stone out and cursed it with a passion and fury fitting his anguish. The other looked at the stone and said, that is a garnet - I @@ -440,7 +396,7 @@ pleasure, but if you are forced upon it and have no time for its secrets then it a source of discomfort. </p><p> Samba started out as a project that sought to provide interoperability for MS Windows 3.x -clients with a Unix server. It has grown up a lot since its humble beginnings and now provides +clients with a UNIX server. It has grown up a lot since its humble beginnings and now provides features and functionality fit for large scale deployment. It also has some warts. In sections like this one we will tell of both. </p><p> @@ -464,14 +420,14 @@ So now, what are the benefits of features mentioned in this chapter? greater flexibility than MS Windows NT4 and in many cases a significantly higher utility than Active Directory domains with MS Windows 200x. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871366"></a>Server Types</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Administrators of Microsoft networks often refer to three -different type of servers:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Domain Controller</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Primary Domain Controller</td></tr><tr><td>Backup Domain Controller</td></tr><tr><td>ADS Domain Controller</td></tr></table></li><li><p>Domain Member Server</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Active Directory Member Server</td></tr><tr><td>NT4 Style Domain Member Server</td></tr></table></li><li><p>Stand Alone Server</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867038"></a>Server Types</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Administrators of Microsoft networks often refer to three +different type of servers:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Domain Controller</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div></li><li><p>Domain Member Server</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>Active Directory Domain Server</p></li><li><p>NT4 Style Domain Domain Server</p></li></ul></div></li><li><p>Stand Alone Server</p></li></ul></div><p> The chapters covering Domain Control, Backup Domain Control and Domain Membership provide -pertinent information regarding Samba-3 configuration for each of these server roles. +pertinent information regarding Samba configuration for each of these server roles. The reader is strongly encouraged to become intimately familiar with the information presented. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871450"></a>Samba Security Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In this section the function and purpose of Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2867124"></a>Samba Security Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In this section the function and purpose of Samba's <a class="indexterm" name="id2867135"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> modes are described. An accurate understanding of how Samba implements each security mode as well as how to configure MS Windows clients for each mode will significantly reduce user complaints and administrator heartache. @@ -486,7 +442,7 @@ ways that allow the security levels to be implemented. In actual fact, Samba imp <span class="emphasis"><em>ADS</em></span>, and <span class="emphasis"><em>SERVER</em></span> modes. They are documented in this chapter. </p><p> -A SMB server tells the client at startup what <i class="parameter"><tt>security level</tt></i> + A SMB server tells the client at startup what <span class="emphasis"><em>security level</em></span> it is running. There are two options: <span class="emphasis"><em>share level</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>user level</em></span>. Which of these two the client receives affects the way the client then tries to authenticate itself. It does not directly affect @@ -494,8 +450,8 @@ the way the client then tries to authenticate itself. It does not directly affec but it fits in with the client/server approach of SMB. In SMB everything is initiated and controlled by the client, and the server can only tell the client what is available and whether an action is allowed. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871565"></a>User Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -We will describe <i class="parameter"><tt>user level</tt></i> security first, as it's simpler. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867244"></a>User Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We will describe <span class="emphasis"><em>user level</em></span> security first, as it's simpler. In <span class="emphasis"><em>user level</em></span> security, the client will send a <span class="emphasis"><em>session setup</em></span> command directly after the protocol negotiation. This contains a username and password. The server can either accept or reject that @@ -512,13 +468,11 @@ It is also possible for a client to send multiple <span class="emphasis"><em>ses requests. When the server responds, it gives the client a <span class="emphasis"><em>uid</em></span> to use as an authentication tag for that username/password. The client can maintain multiple authentication contexts in this way (WinDD is an example of an application that does this). -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871659"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2867336"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that sets <span class="emphasis"><em>User Level Security</em></span> is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - security = user -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> This is the default setting since samba-2.2.x. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871698"></a>Share Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867382"></a>Share Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Ok, now for share level security. In share level security, the client authenticates itself separately for each share. It will send a password along with each <span class="emphasis"><em>tree connection</em></span> (share mount). It does not explicitly send a @@ -538,104 +492,92 @@ level security. They normally send a valid username but no password. Samba recor this username in a list of <span class="emphasis"><em>possible usernames</em></span>. When the client then does a <span class="emphasis"><em>tree connection</em></span> it also adds to this list the name of the share they try to connect to (useful for home directories) and any users -listed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>user =</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> line. The password is then checked +listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2867441"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> line. The password is then checked in turn against these <span class="emphasis"><em>possible usernames</em></span>. If a match is found then the client is authenticated as that user. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871778"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2867470"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that sets <span class="emphasis"><em>Share Level Security</em></span> is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - security = share -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = share</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> Please note that there are reports that recent MS Windows clients do not like to work with share mode security servers. You are strongly discouraged from using share level security. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871820"></a>Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -When Samba is operating in <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i> mode, +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867518"></a>Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When Samba is operating in <a class="indexterm" name="id2867530"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain mode, the Samba server has a domain security trust account (a machine account) and will cause all authentication requests to be passed through to the domain controllers. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871842"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2867549"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Samba as a Domain Member Server </em></span></p><p> This method involves addition of the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - security = domain - workgroup = "name_of_NT_domain" -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> In order for this method to work, the Samba server needs to join the MS Windows NT security domain. This is done as follows: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p>On the MS Windows NT domain controller, using the Server Manager, add a machine account for the Samba server. - </p></li><li><p>Next, on the Unix/Linux system execute:</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j DOMAIN_NAME -r PDC_NAME</tt></b> (samba-2.x)</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -U administrator%password</tt></b> (samba-3)</p></li></ol></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -As of Samba-2.2.4 the Samba 2.2.x series can auto-join a Windows NT4 style Domain just -by executing: + </p></li><li><p>Next, on the UNIX/Linux system execute:</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -U administrator%password</tt></b></pre></li></ol></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Samba-2.2.4 and later can auto-join a Windows NT4 style Domain just by executing: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> -r <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> -r <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> \ + -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> </pre><p> -As of Samba-3 the same can be done by executing: +Samba-3 can do the same by executing: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> </pre><p> -It is not necessary with Samba-3 to specify the <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> or the <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> as it -figures this out from the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. +It is not necessary with Samba-3 to specify the <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> or the +<i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> as it figures this out from the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. </p></div><p> -Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard Unix account -for each user in order to assign a uid once the account has been authenticated by +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard UNIX account +for each user in order to assign a UID once the account has been authenticated by the remote Windows DC. This account can be blocked to prevent logons by clients other than -MS Windows through things such as setting an invalid shell in the +MS Windows through means such as setting an invalid shell in the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry. </p><p> An alternative to assigning UIDs to Windows users on a Samba member server is -presented in the <a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">Winbind Overview</a> chapter -in this HOWTO collection. +presented in <a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts">the chapter about winbind</a>. </p><p> -For more information of being a domain member, see the <a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain -Member</a> section of this Howto. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872071"></a>ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + For more information of being a domain member, see <a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter about domain membership</a>. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867776"></a>ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Both Samba 2.2 and 3.0 can join an Active Directory domain. This is -possible even if the domain is run in native mode. Active Directory in -native mode perfectly allows NT4-style domain members, contrary to +possible if the domain is run in native mode. Active Directory in +native mode perfectly allows NT4-style domain members. This is contrary to popular belief. The only thing that Active Directory in native mode prohibits is Backup Domain Controllers running NT4. </p><p> -If you are running Active Directory starting with Samba 3.0 you can -however join as a native AD member. Why would you want to do that? +If you are using Active Directory, starting with Samba-3 you can +join as a native AD member. Why would you want to do that? Your security policy might prohibit the use of NT-compatible authentication protocols. All your machines are running Windows 2000 -and above and all use full Kerberos. In this case Samba as a NT4-style +and above and all use Kerberos. In this case Samba as a NT4-style domain would still require NT-compatible authentication data. Samba in -AD-member mode can accept Kerberos. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872101"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> - realm = your.kerberos.REALM - security = ADS -</pre><p> - The following parameter may be required: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - ads server = your.kerberos.server -</pre><p> -Please refer to the <a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> and <a href="#ads-member" title="Samba ADS Domain Membership">Active Directory -Membership</a> sections for more information regarding this configuration option. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872158"></a>Server Security (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +AD-member mode can accept Kerberos tickets. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2867806"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>realm = your.kerberos.REALM</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = ADS</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +The following parameter may be required: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server = your.kerberos.server</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +Please refer to <a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter on domain membership</a> +for more information regarding this configuration option. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2867877"></a>Server Security (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Server security mode is a left over from the time when Samba was not capable of acting as a domain member server. It is highly recommended NOT to use this feature. Server security mode has many draw backs. The draw backs include: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Potential Account Lockout on MS Windows NT4/200x password servers</td></tr><tr><td>Lack of assurance that the password server is the one specified</td></tr><tr><td>Does not work with Winbind, particularly needed when storing profiles remotely</td></tr><tr><td>This mode may open connections to the password server, and keep them open for extended periods.</td></tr><tr><td>Security on the Samba server breaks badly when the remote password server suddenly shuts down</td></tr><tr><td>With this mode there is NO security account in the domain that the password server belongs to for the Samba server.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Potential Account Lockout on MS Windows NT4/200x password servers</p></li><li><p>Lack of assurance that the password server is the one specified</p></li><li><p>Does not work with Winbind, particularly needed when storing profiles remotely</p></li><li><p>This mode may open connections to the password server, and keep them open for extended periods.</p></li><li><p>Security on the Samba server breaks badly when the remote password server suddenly shuts down</p></li><li><p>With this mode there is NO security account in the domain that the password server belongs to for the Samba server.</p></li></ul></div><p> In server security mode the Samba server reports to the client that it is in user level security. The client then does a <span class="emphasis"><em>session setup</em></span> as described earlier. The Samba server takes the username/password that the client sends and attempts to login to the -<i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> by sending exactly the same username/password that +<a class="indexterm" name="id2867950"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> by sending exactly the same username/password that it got from the client. If that server is in user level security and accepts the password, then Samba accepts the clients connection. This allows the Samba server to use another SMB -server as the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>. +server as the <a class="indexterm" name="id2867970"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>. </p><p> You should also note that at the very start of all this, where the server tells the client what security level it is in, it also tells the client if it supports encryption. If it does then it supplies the client with a random cryptkey. The client will then send all passwords in encrypted form. Samba supports this type of encryption by default. </p><p> -The parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> means that Samba reports to clients that +The parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2867997"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server means that Samba reports to clients that it is running in <span class="emphasis"><em>user mode</em></span> but actually passes off all authentication requests to another <span class="emphasis"><em>user mode</em></span> server. This requires an additional -parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> that points to the real authentication server. +parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2868023"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> that points to the real authentication server. That real authentication server can be another Samba server or can be a Windows NT server, the later natively capable of encrypted password support. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> @@ -646,17 +588,13 @@ lookups because the choice of the target authentication server is arbitrary and be determined from a domain name. In essence, a Samba server that is in <span class="emphasis"><em>server security mode</em></span> is operating in what used to be known as workgroup mode. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2872314"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2868067"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Using MS Windows NT as an authentication server </em></span></p><p> This method involves the additions of the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - encrypt passwords = Yes - security = server - password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_a_DC" -</pre><p> -There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and password pair was valid -or not. One uses the reply information provided as part of the authentication messaging +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_a_DC"</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and password pair was valid. +One uses the reply information provided as part of the authentication messaging process, the other uses just an error code. </p><p> The down-side of this mode of configuration is the fact that for security reasons Samba @@ -665,9 +603,9 @@ server fails to reject the username and password pair then an alternative mode o identification of validation is used. Where a site uses password lock out after a certain number of failed authentication attempts this will result in user lockouts. </p><p> -Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard Unix account +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard UNIX account for the user, though this account can be blocked to prevent logons by non-SMB/CIFS clients. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2872383"></a>Seamless Windows Network Integration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868158"></a>Password checking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows clients may use encrypted passwords as part of a challenge/response authentication model (a.k.a. NTLMv1 and NTLMv2) or alone, or clear text strings for simple password based authentication. It should be realized that with the SMB protocol, @@ -681,7 +619,7 @@ is encrypted in two ways: </p></li><li><p>The password is converted to upper case, and then padded or truncated to 14 bytes. This string is then appended with 5 bytes of NULL characters and split to - form two 56 bit DES keys to encrypt a "magic" 8 byte value. + form two 56 bit DES keys to encrypt a "magic" 8 byte value. The resulting 16 bytes form the LanMan hash. </p></li></ul></div><p> MS Windows 95 pre-service pack 1, MS Windows NT versions 3.x and version 4.0 @@ -704,29 +642,26 @@ is definitely not a good idea to re-enable plain text password support in such c The following parameters can be used to work around the issue of Windows 9x clients upper casing usernames and password before transmitting them to the SMB server when using clear text authentication. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDLEVEL" target="_top">password level</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>integer</tt></i> - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMELEVEL" target="_top">username level</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>integer</tt></i> -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password level = integer</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>username level = integer</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> By default Samba will lower case the username before attempting to lookup the user in the database of local system accounts. Because UNIX usernames conventionally -only contain lower case character, the <i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> parameter +only contain lower-case character, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2868286"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> parameter is rarely needed. </p><p> -However, passwords on UNIX systems often make use of mixed case characters. +However, passwords on UNIX systems often make use of mixed-case characters. This means that in order for a user on a Windows 9x client to connect to a Samba -server using clear text authentication, the <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> -must be set to the maximum number of upper case letter which <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> -appear is a password. Note that the server OS uses the traditional DES version -of crypt(), a <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> of 8 will result in case +server using clear text authentication, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2868308"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> +must be set to the maximum number of upper case letters which <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> +appear in a password. Note that if the server OS uses the traditional DES version +of crypt(), a <a class="indexterm" name="id2868330"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> of 8 will result in case insensitive passwords as seen from Windows users. This will also result in longer login times as Samba has to compute the permutations of the password string and try them one by one until a match is located (or all combinations fail). </p><p> -The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords where ever +The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords wherever Samba is used. Most attempts to apply the registry change to re-enable plain text passwords will eventually lead to user complaints and unhappiness. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2872559"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868359"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> We all make mistakes. It is Ok to make mistakes, so long as they are made in the right places and at the right time. A mistake that causes lost productivity is seldom tolerated. A mistake made in a developmental test lab is expected. @@ -736,32 +671,29 @@ on the Samba mailing lists. Many of these are avoidable by doing you homework be a Samba implementation. Some are the result of misunderstanding of the English language. The English language has many turns of phrase that are potentially vague and may be highly confusing to those for whom English is not their native tongue. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872587"></a>What makes Samba a SERVER?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2868387"></a>What makes Samba a SERVER?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To some the nature of the Samba <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span> mode is very obvious, but entirely -wrong all the same. It is assumed that <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> means that Samba +wrong all the same. It is assumed that <a class="indexterm" name="id2868403"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server means that Samba will act as a server. Not so! See above - this setting means that Samba will <span class="emphasis"><em>try</em></span> to use another SMB server as its source of user authentication alone. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872620"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i> does NOT really make Samba behave +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2868427"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2868445"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain does NOT really make Samba behave as a Domain Controller! This setting means we want Samba to be a domain member! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872649"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Member?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Guess! So many others do. But whatever you do, do NOT think that <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2868463"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Member?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Guess! So many others do. But whatever you do, do NOT think that <a class="indexterm" name="id2868474"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user makes Samba act as a domain member. Read the manufacturers manual before the warranty expires! See -the <a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Member</a> section of this Howto for more information. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872682"></a>Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter about domain membership</a> for more information. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2868503"></a>Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> Why does server_validate() simply give up rather than re-establishing its connection to the password server? Though I am not fluent in the SMB protocol, perhaps the cluster server process passes along to its client workstation the session key it receives from the password server, which means the password hashes submitted by the client would not work on a subsequent -connection, whose session key would be different. So server_validate() must give up. -</p><p> -Indeed. That's why security = server is at best a nasty hack. Please use security = domain. -<i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> mode is also known as pass-through authentication. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-pdc"></a>Chapter 5. Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2874489">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874793">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874809">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875020">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875340">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875639">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875661">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875676">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876003">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876111">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876118">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876157">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." -or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876206">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876277">The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876340">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876367">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p><b><span class="emphasis"><em>The Essence of Learning:</em></span> </b> +connection, whose session key would be different. So server_validate() must give up.</span>” +</p><p> + Indeed. That's why <a class="indexterm" name="id2868531"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server is at best a nasty hack. Please use <a class="indexterm" name="id2868545"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2868558"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server mode is also known as pass-through authentication. +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-pdc"></a>Chapter 5. Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2868835">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869049">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2869064">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2869309">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2869698">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870186">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870238">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870253">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870678">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2870825">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2870831">'$' cannot be included in machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870890">Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2870945">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871029">The machine trust account not accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871102">Account disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871135">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871156">Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p><b><span class="emphasis"><em>The Essence of Learning:</em></span> </b> There are many who approach MS Windows networking with incredible misconceptions. That's OK, because it gives the rest of us plenty of opportunity to be of assistance. Those who really want help would be well advised to become familiar with information @@ -769,18 +701,18 @@ that is already available. </p><p> The reader is advised NOT to tackle this section without having first understood and mastered some basics. MS Windows networking is not particularly forgiving of -misconfiguration. Users of MS Windows networking are likely to complain bitterly -of persistent niggles that may be caused by broken network or system configuration. +misconfiguration. Users of MS Windows networking are likely to complain +of persistent niggles that may be caused by a broken network configuration. To a great many people however, MS Windows networking starts with a domain controller that in some magical way is expected to solve all ills. -</p><p> +</p><div class="figure"><a name="domain-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 5.1. An Example Domain</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/domain.png" width="270" alt="An Example Domain"></div></div><p> From the Samba mailing list one can readily identify many common networking issues. If you are not clear on the following subjects, then it will do much good to read the sections of this HOWTO that deal with it. These are the most common causes of MS Windows networking problems: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Basic TCP/IP configuration</td></tr><tr><td>NetBIOS name resolution</td></tr><tr><td>Authentication configuration</td></tr><tr><td>User and Group configuration</td></tr><tr><td>Basic File and Directory Permission Control in Unix/Linux</td></tr><tr><td>Understanding of how MS Windows clients interoperate in a network - environment</td></tr></table><p> -Do not be put off; on the surface of it MS Windows networking seems so simple that any fool +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Basic TCP/IP configuration</p></li><li><p>NetBIOS name resolution</p></li><li><p>Authentication configuration</p></li><li><p>User and Group configuration</p></li><li><p>Basic File and Directory Permission Control in UNIX/Linux</p></li><li><p>Understanding of how MS Windows clients interoperate in a network + environment</p></li></ul></div><p> +Do not be put off; on the surface of it MS Windows networking seems so simple that anyone can do it. In fact, it is not a good idea to set up an MS Windows network with inadequate training and preparation. But let's get our first indelible principle out of the way: <span class="emphasis"><em>It is perfectly OK to make mistakes!</em></span> In the right place and at @@ -791,7 +723,7 @@ burden on an organisation. Where is the right place to make mistakes? Only out of harm's way! If you are going to make mistakes, then please do this on a test network, away from users and in such a way as to not inflict pain on others. Do your learning on a test network. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2874489"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2868835"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>What is the key benefit of Microsoft Domain security?</em></span> </p><p> In a word, <span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span>, or SSO for short. To many, this is the holy @@ -802,13 +734,18 @@ and they will be able to log onto the network and access resources (shares, file as if they are sitting at their home (personal) workstation. This is a feature of the Domain security protocols. </p><p> -The benefits of Domain security are fully available to those sites that deploy a Samba PDC. +The benefits of Domain security are available to those sites that deploy a Samba PDC. +A Domain provides a unique network security identifier (SID). Domain user and group security +identifiers are comprised of the network SID plus a relative identifier (RID) that is unique to +the account. User and Group SIDs (the network SID plus the RID) can be used to create Access Control +Lists (ACLs) attached to network resources to provide organizational access control. UNIX systems +know only of local security identifiers. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Network clients of an MS Windows Domain security environment must be Domain members to be able to gain access to the advanced features provided. Domain membership involves more than just setting the workgroup name to the Domain name. It requires the creation of a Domain trust account for the workstation (called a machine account). Please refer to the chapter on -<a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> for more information. +<a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">setting up samba as a domain member</a> for more information. </p></div><p> The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -816,8 +753,7 @@ The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: </p></li><li><p> Adding users via the User Manager for Domains. This can be done on any MS Windows client using the Nexus toolkit that is available from Microsoft's web site. - At some later date Samba-3 may get support for the use of the Microsoft Management - Console for user management. + Samba-3 supports the use of the Microsoft Management Console for user management. </p></li><li><p> Introduces replaceable and multiple user account (authentication) back ends. In the case where the back end is placed in an LDAP database, @@ -831,14 +767,18 @@ The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: The following functionalities are NOT provided by Samba-3: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> SAM replication with Windows NT4 Domain Controllers - (i.e. a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa) + (i.e. a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa). This means samba + cannot operate as a BDC when the PDC is Microsoft-based or + replicate account data to Windows-BDC's. </p></li><li><p> Acting as a Windows 2000 Domain Controller (i.e. Kerberos and Active Directory) - In point of fact, Samba-3 DOES have some Active Directory Domain Control ability that is at this time purely experimental <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> that is certain to change as it becomes a fully supported feature some time - during the Samba-3 (or later) life cycle. + during the Samba-3 (or later) life cycle. However, Active Directory is + more then just SMB - it's also LDAP, Kerberos, DHCP and other protocols + (with proprietary extensions, of course). </p></li></ul></div><p> Windows 9x / Me / XP Home clients are not true members of a domain for reasons outlined in this chapter. The protocol for support of Windows 9x / Me style network (domain) logons @@ -847,67 +787,33 @@ for some time. These clients use the old LanMan Network Logon facilities that ar in Samba since approximately the Samba-1.9.15 series. </p><p> Samba-3 has an implementation of group mapping between Windows NT groups -and Unix groups (this is really quite complicated to explain in a short space). This is -discussed more fully in the <a href="#groupmapping" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups">Group Mapping</a> chapter. +and UNIX groups (this is really quite complicated to explain in a short space). This is +discussed more fully in <a href="#groupmapping" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups">the chapter on group mapping</a>. </p><p> Samba-3, like an MS Windows NT4 PDC or a Windows 200x Active Directory, needs to store -user and machine trust account information in a suitable backend data store. With Samba-3 -there can be multiple back-ends for this including: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> - the plain ASCII file stored used by - earlier versions of Samba. This file configuration option requires - a Unix/Linux system account for EVERY entry (ie: both for user and for - machine accounts). This file will be located in the <span class="emphasis"><em>private</em></span> - directory (default is /usr/local/samba/lib/private or on linux /etc/samba). - </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> - a binary database backend that will be - stored in the <span class="emphasis"><em>private</em></span> directory in a file called - <span class="emphasis"><em>passdb.tdb</em></span>. The key benefit of this binary format - file is that it can store binary objects that can not be accommodated - in the traditional plain text smbpasswd file. These permit the extended - account controls that MS Windows NT4 and later also have. - </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>ldapsam</em></span> - An LDAP based back-end. Permits the - LDAP server to be specified. eg: ldap://localhost or ldap://frodo.murphy.com. - Like the tdbsam, ldapsam permits the storing of extended account attributes - for control of things like: Permitted access times, password activation and - expiry, permitted points of access (workstation names), per user profile - location, and much more. - </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>ldapsam_compat</em></span> - An LDAP back-end that maintains backwards - compatibility with the behaviour of samba-2.2.x. You should use this in the process - of migrating from samba-2.2.x to samba-3 if you do not want to rebuild your LDAP - database. - </p></li></ul></div><p> -Read the chapter about <a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database</a> for details -regarding the choices available and how to configure them. -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -The new tdbsam and ldapsam account backends store substantially more information than -smbpasswd is capable of. The new backend database includes capacity to specify -per user settings for many parameters, over-riding global settings given in the -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. eg: logon drive, logon home, logon path, etc. -Thus, with samba-3 it is possible to have a default system configuration for profiles, -and on a per user basis to over-ride this for those users who should not be subject -to the default configuration. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2874793"></a>Basics of Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +user and machine trust account information in a suitable backend data store. +Refer <a href="#machine-trust-accounts" title="MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts">to the section on machine trust accounts</a>. With Samba-3 there can be multiple +back-ends for this. A complete discussion of account database backends can be found in +<a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter on Account Information Databases</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869049"></a>Basics of Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Over the years, public perceptions of what Domain Control really is has taken on an almost mystical nature. Before we branch into a brief overview of Domain Control, there are three basic types of domain controllers: -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874809"></a>Domain Controller Types</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869064"></a>Domain Controller Types</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>Primary Domain Controller</em></span> or PDC plays an important role in the MS -Windows NT4 and Windows 200x Domain Control architecture, but not in the manner that so many -expect. There is folk lore that dictates that because of it's role in the MS Windows -network, the PDC should be the most powerful and most capable machine in the network. +Windows NT4. In Windows 200x Domain Control architecture this role is held by domain controllers. +There is folk lore that dictates that because of it's role in the MS Windows +network, the domain controllers should be the most powerful and most capable machine in the network. As strange as it may seem to say this here, good over all network performance dictates that -the entire infrastructure needs to be balanced. It is advisable to invest more in the Backup -Domain Controllers and Stand-Alone (or Domain Member) servers than in the PDC. +the entire infrastructure needs to be balanced. It is advisable to invest more in Stand-Alone +(or Domain Member) servers than in the domain controllers. </p><p> -In the case of MS Windows NT4 style domains, it is the PDC seeds the Domain Control database, -a part of the Windows registry called the SAM (Security Account Manager). It plays a key +In the case of MS Windows NT4 style domains, it is the PDC that initiates a new Domain Control database. +This forms a part of the Windows registry called the SAM (Security Account Manager). It plays a key part in NT4 type domain user authentication and in synchronisation of the domain authentication database with Backup Domain Controllers. </p><p> -With MS Windows 200x Server based Active Directory domains, one domain controller seeds a potential +With MS Windows 200x Server based Active Directory domains, one domain controller initiates a potential hierarchy of domain controllers, each with their own area of delegated control. The master domain controller has the ability to override any down-stream controller, but a down-line controller has control only over it's down-line. With Samba-3 this functionality can be implemented using an @@ -915,9 +821,7 @@ LDAP based user and machine account back end. </p><p> New to Samba-3 is the ability to use a back-end database that holds the same type of data as the NT4 style SAM (Security Account Manager) database (one of the registry files). -The Samba-3 SAM can be specified via the smb.conf file parameter -<i class="parameter"><tt>passwd backend</tt></i> and valid options include -<span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, nisplussam, xmlsam, mysqlsam, guest</em></span>. +<sup>[<a name="id2869141" href="#ftn.id2869141">1</a>]</sup> </p><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>Backup Domain Controller</em></span> or BDC plays a key role in servicing network authentication requests. The BDC is biased to answer logon requests in preference to the PDC. @@ -941,11 +845,14 @@ excluding the SAM replication components. However, please be aware that Samba-3 MS Windows 200x domain control protocols also. </p><p> At this time any appearance that Samba-3 is capable of acting as an -<span class="emphasis"><em>ADS Domain Controller</em></span> is limited and experimental in nature. +<span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Controller</em></span> in native ADS mode is limited and experimental in nature. This functionality should not be used until the Samba-Team offers formal support for it. At such a time, the documentation will be revised to duly reflect all configuration and -management requirements. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875020"></a>Preparing for Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +management requirements. Samba can act as a NT4-style DC in a Windows 2000/XP +environment. However, there are certain compromises: + +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>No machine policy files</p></li><li><p>No Group Policy Objects</p></li><li><p>No synchronously executed AD logon scripts</p></li><li><p>Can't use ANY Active Directory management tools to manage users and machines</p></li><li><p>Registry changes tattoo the main registry, while with AD they do NOT. ie: Leave permanent changes in effect</p></li><li><p>Without AD you can not peprform the function of exporting specific applications to specific users or groups</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2869309"></a>Preparing for Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are two ways that MS Windows machines may interact with each other, with other servers, and with Domain Controllers: Either as <span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-Alone</em></span> systems, more commonly called <span class="emphasis"><em>Workgroup</em></span> members, or as full participants in a security system, @@ -967,23 +874,22 @@ Domain it triggers a machine password change. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> When running a Domain all MS Windows NT / 200x / XP Professional clients should be configured as full Domain Members - IF A SECURE NETWORK IS WANTED. If the machine is NOT made a member of the -Domain, then it will operate like a workgroup (stand-alone) machine. Please refer the -<a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> chapter for information regarding - HOW to make your MS Windows clients Domain members. +Domain, then it will operate like a workgroup (stand-alone) machine. Please refer to +<a href="#domain-member" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter on domain membership</a> for information regarding HOW to make your MS Windows clients Domain members. </p></div><p> The following are necessary for configuring Samba-3 as an MS Windows NT4 style PDC for MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP clients. -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</td></tr><tr><td>Correct designation of the Server Role (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>)</td></tr><tr><td>Consistent configuration of Name Resolution (See chapter on <a href="#NetworkBrowsing" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Browsing</a> and on - <a href="#integrate-ms-networks" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">MS Windows network Integration</a>)</td></tr><tr><td>Domain logons for Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional clients</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of Roaming Profiles or explicit configuration to force local profile usage</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of Network/System Policies</td></tr><tr><td>Adding and managing domain user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>Configuring MS Windows client machines to become domain members</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</p></li><li><p>Correct designation of the Server Role (<a class="indexterm" name="id2869424"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user)</p></li><li><p>Consistent configuration of Name Resolution (See chapter on <a href="#NetworkBrowsing" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Network Browsing</a> and on + <a href="#integrate-ms-networks" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">Integrating Unix into Windows networks</a>)</p></li><li><p>Domain logons for Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional clients</p></li><li><p>Configuration of Roaming Profiles or explicit configuration to force local profile usage</p></li><li><p>Configuration of Network/System Policies</p></li><li><p>Adding and managing domain user accounts</p></li><li><p>Configuring MS Windows client machines to become domain members</p></li></ul></div><p> The following provisions are required to serve MS Windows 9x / Me Clients: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</td></tr><tr><td>Correct designation of the Server Role (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>)</td></tr><tr><td>Network Logon Configuration (Since Windows 9x / XP Home are not technically domain - members, they do not really participate in the security aspects of Domain logons as such)</td></tr><tr><td>Roaming Profile Configuration</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of System Policy handling</td></tr><tr><td>Installation of the Network driver "Client for MS Windows Networks" and configuration - to log onto the domain</td></tr><tr><td>Placing Windows 9x / Me clients in user level security - if it is desired to allow - all client share access to be controlled according to domain user / group identities.</td></tr><tr><td>Adding and managing domain user accounts</td></tr></table><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</p></li><li><p>Correct designation of the Server Role (<a class="indexterm" name="id2869517"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user)</p></li><li><p>Network Logon Configuration (Since Windows 9x / XP Home are not technically domain + members, they do not really participate in the security aspects of Domain logons as such)</p></li><li><p>Roaming Profile Configuration</p></li><li><p>Configuration of System Policy handling</p></li><li><p>Installation of the Network driver "Client for MS Windows Networks" and configuration + to log onto the domain</p></li><li><p>Placing Windows 9x / Me clients in user level security - if it is desired to allow + all client share access to be controlled according to domain user / group identities.</p></li><li><p>Adding and managing domain user accounts</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Roaming Profiles and System/Network policies are advanced network administration topics that are covered in the <a href="#ProfileMgmt" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management">Profile Management</a> and -<a href="#PolicyMgmt" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">Policy Management</a> chapters of this document. However, these are not necessarily specific -to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking concepts. +<a href="#PolicyMgmt" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">Policy Management</a> chapters of this document. However, these are not +necessarily specific to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking concepts. </p></div><p> A Domain Controller is an SMB/CIFS server that: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -998,120 +904,86 @@ A Domain Controller is an SMB/CIFS server that: Provides a share called NETLOGON </p></li></ul></div><p> For Samba to provide these is rather easy to configure. Each Samba Domain Controller must provide -the NETLOGON service which Samba calls the <span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span> functionality +the NETLOGON service which Samba calls the <a class="indexterm" name="id2869647"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i> functionality (after the name of the parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file). Additionally, one (1) server in a Samba-3 -Domain must advertise itself as the domain master browser. This causes the Primary Domain Controller +Domain must advertise itself as the domain master browser<sup>[<a name="id2869672" href="#ftn.id2869672">2</a>]</sup>. This causes the Primary Domain Controller to claim domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies it as a domain master browser for its given domain/workgroup. Local master browsers in the same domain/workgroup on broadcast-isolated subnets then ask for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area network. Browser clients will then contact their local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list, instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875340"></a>Domain Control - Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2869698"></a>Domain Control - Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The first step in creating a working Samba PDC is to understand the parameters necessary -in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Here we attempt to explain the parameters that are covered in -the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. -</p><p> -Here is an example <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for acting as a PDC: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - ; Basic server settings - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME" target="_top">netbios name</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>POGO</tt></i> - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP" target="_top">workgroup</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>NARNIA</tt></i> - - ; User and Machine Account Backends - ; Choices are: tdbsam, smbpasswd, ldapsam, mysqlsam, xmlsam, guest - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND" target="_top">passdb backend</a> = ldapsam, guest - - ; we should act as the domain and local master browser - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OSLEVEL" target="_top">os level</a> = 64 - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PERFERREDMASTER" target="_top">preferred master</a> = yes - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER" target="_top">domain master</a> = yes - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER" target="_top">local master</a> = yes - - ; security settings (must user security = user) - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSUSER" target="_top">security</a> = user - - ; encrypted passwords are a requirement for a PDC (default = Yes) - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt passwords</a> = yes - - ; support domain logons - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS" target="_top">domain logons</a> = yes - - ; where to store user profiles? - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH" target="_top">logon path</a> = \\%N\profiles\%u - - ; where is a user's home directory and where should it be mounted at? - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONDRIVE" target="_top">logon drive</a> = H: - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME" target="_top">logon home</a> = \\homeserver\%u\winprofile - - ; specify a generic logon script for all users - ; this is a relative **DOS** path to the [netlogon] share - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONSCRIPT" target="_top">logon script</a> = logon.cmd - - ; necessary share for domain controller - [netlogon] - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH" target="_top">path</a> = /usr/local/samba/lib/netlogon - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY" target="_top">read only</a> = yes - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST" target="_top">write list</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>ntadmin</tt></i> - - ; share for storing user profiles - [profiles] - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH" target="_top">path</a> = /export/smb/ntprofile - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY" target="_top">read only</a> = no - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK" target="_top">create mask</a> = 0600 - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK" target="_top">directory mask</a> = 0700 -</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. An example <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for acting as a PDC can be found in the example +<a href="#pdc-example" title="Example 5.1. smb.conf for being a PDC">for being a PDC</a>. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="pdc-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5.1. smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = BELERIAND</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam, guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 33</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%N\profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive = H:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\homeserver\%u\winprofile</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script = logon.cmd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = ntadmin</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[profiles]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/profiles</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask = 0600</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask = 0700</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +The basic options shown above are explained as follows: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">passdb backend</span></dt><dd><p> + This contains all the user and group account information. Acceptable values for a PDC + are: <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam</em></span>. The 'guest' entry provides needed + default accounts.</p><p> + Where is is intended to use backup domain controllers (BDCs) the only logical choice is + to use LDAP so that the passdb backend can be distributed. The tdbsam and smbpasswd files + can not effectively be distributed and therefore should not be used. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Domain Control Parameters</span></dt><dd><p> + The parameters <span class="emphasis"><em>os level, preferred master, domain master, security, + encrypt passwords, domain logons</em></span> play a central role in assuring domain + control and network logon support.</p><p> + The <span class="emphasis"><em>os level</em></span> must be set at or above a value of 32. A domain controller + must be the domain master browser, must be set in <span class="emphasis"><em>user</em></span> mode security, + must support Microsoft compatible encrypted passwords, and must provide the network logon + service (domain logons). Encrypted passwords must be enabled, for more details on how + to do this, refer to <a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter on account information databases</a>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Environment Parameters</span></dt><dd><p> + The parameters <span class="emphasis"><em>logon path, logon home, logon drive, logon script</em></span> are + environment support settings that help to facilitate client logon operations and that help + to provide automated control facilities to ease network management overheads. Please refer + to the man page information for these parameters. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NETLOGON Share</span></dt><dd><p> + The NETLOGON share plays a central role in domain logon and domain membership support. + This share is provided on all Microsoft domain controllers. It is used to provide logon + scripts, to store Group Policy files (NTConfig.POL), as well as to locate other common + tools that may be needed for logon processing. This is an essential share on a domain controller. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">PROFILE Share</span></dt><dd><p> + This share is used to store user desktop profiles. Eash user must have a directory at the root + of this share. This directory must be write enabled for the user and must be globally read enabled. + Samba-3 has a VFS module called 'fake_permissions' that may be installed on this share. This will + allow a Samba administrator to make the directory read only to everyone. Of course this is useful + only after the profile has been properly created. + </p></dd></dl></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The above parameters make for a full set of parameters that may define the server's mode -of operation. The following parameters are the essentials alone: - -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - workgroup = NARNIA - domain logons = Yes - domain master = Yes - security = User -</pre><p> - -The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for a -more complete environment. -</p></div><p> -There are a couple of points to emphasize in the above configuration. -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - Encrypted passwords must be enabled. For more details on how - to do this, refer to <a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database chapter</a>. - </p></li><li><p> - The server must support domain logons and have a - <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share - </p></li><li><p> - The server must be the domain master browser in order for Windows - client to locate the server as a DC. Please refer to the various - Network Browsing documentation included with this distribution for - details. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875639"></a>Samba ADS Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba-3 is not and can not act as an Active Directory Server. It can not truly function as +of operation. The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters are the essentials alone: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = BELERIAND</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = User</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for +more complete explanation. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870186"></a>Samba ADS Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 is not, and can not act as, an Active Directory Server. It can not truly function as an Active Directory Primary Domain Controller. The protocols for some of the functionality -the Active Directory Domain Controllers is have been partially implemented on an experimental -only basis. Please do NOT expect Samba-3 to support these protocols - nor should you depend -on any such functionality either now or in the future. The Samba-Team may well remove such -experimental features or may change their behaviour. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875661"></a>Domain and Network Logon Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The subject of Network or Domain Logons is discussed here because it rightly forms +the Active Directory Domain Controllers has been partially implemented on an experimental +only basis. Please do NOT expect Samba-3 to support these protocols. Do not depend +on any such functionality either now or in the future. The Samba-Team may remove these +experimental features or may change their behaviour. This is mentioned for the benefit of those +who have discovered secret capabilities in samba-3 and who have asked when this functionality will be +completed. The answer is: Maybe or maybe never! +</p><p> +To be sure: Samba-3 is designed to provide most of the functionality that Microsoft Windows NT4 style +domain controllers have. Samba-3 does NOT have all the capabilities of Windows NT4, but it does have +a number of features that Windows NT4 domain contollers do not have. In short, Samba-3 is not NT4 and it +is not Windows Server 200x and it is not an Active Directory server. We hope this is plain and simple +enough for all to understand. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870238"></a>Domain and Network Logon Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The subject of Network or Domain Logons is discussed here because it forms an integral part of the essential functionality that is provided by a Domain Controller. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2875676"></a>Domain Network Logon Service</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870253"></a>Domain Network Logon Service</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> All Domain Controllers must run the netlogon service (<span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span> -in Samba). One Domain Controller must be configured with <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = Yes</tt></i> -(the Primary Domain Controller); on ALL Backup Domain Controllers <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = No</tt></i> +in Samba). One Domain Controller must be configured with <a class="indexterm" name="id2870270"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = Yes +(the Primary Domain Controller); on ALL Backup Domain Controllers <a class="indexterm" name="id2870287"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = No must be set. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875709"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - domain logons = Yes - domain master = (Yes on PDC, No on BDCs) - - [netlogon] - comment = Network Logon Service - path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon - guest ok = Yes - browseable = No -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875729"></a>The Special Case of MS Windows XP Home Edition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870302"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="example"><a name="id2870309"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5.2. smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = (Yes on PDC, No on BDCs)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Network Logon Service</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = No</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870393"></a>The Special Case of MS Windows XP Home Edition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> MS Windows XP Home Edition does not have the ability to join any type of Domain security facility. Unlike, MS Windows 9x / Me, MS Windows XP Home Edition also completely lacks the ability to log onto a network. @@ -1123,8 +995,10 @@ MS Windows XP Professional. </p><p> Now that this has been said, please do NOT ask the mailing list, or email any of the Samba-Team members with your questions asking how to make this work. It can't be done. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2875765"></a>The Special Case of Windows 9x / Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same thing in terms of network +If it can be done, then to do so would violate your software license agreement with +Microsoft, and we recommend that you do not do that. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2870431"></a>The Special Case of Windows 9x / Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same in terms of network browsing. The difference is that a distributable authentication database is associated with a domain, for secure login access to a network. Also, different access rights can be granted to users if they @@ -1145,7 +1019,7 @@ which are the focus of this section. When an SMB client in a domain wishes to logon, it broadcasts requests for a logon server. The first one to reply gets the job, and validates its password using whatever mechanism the Samba administrator has installed. -It is possible (but very stupid) to create a domain where the user +It is possible (but ill advised ) to create a domain where the user database is not shared between servers, i.e. they are effectively workgroup servers advertising themselves as participating in a domain. This demonstrates how authentication is quite different from but closely @@ -1196,14 +1070,17 @@ The main difference between a PDC and a Windows 9x logon server configuration is </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Password encryption is not required for a Windows 9x logon server. But note that beginning with MS Windows 98 the default setting is that plain-text - password support has been disabled. It can be re-enabled with the registry + password support is disabled. It can be re-enabled with the registry changes that are documented in the chapter on Policies. </p></li><li><p> Windows 9x/ME clients do not require and do not use machine trust accounts. </p></li></ul></div><p> A Samba PDC will act as a Windows 9x logon server; after all, it does provide the network logon services that MS Windows 9x / Me expect to find. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876003"></a>Security Mode and Master Browsers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Use of plain-text passwords is strongly discouraged. Where used they are easily detected +using a sniffer tool to examine network traffic. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870678"></a>Security Mode and Master Browsers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a few comments to make in order to tie up some loose ends. There has been much debate over the issue of whether or not it is ok to configure Samba as a Domain Controller in security @@ -1220,24 +1097,25 @@ are two distinctly different functions), it is not a good idea to do so. You should remember that the DC must register the DOMAIN<#1b> NetBIOS name. This is the name used by Windows clients to locate the DC. Windows clients do not distinguish between the DC and the DMB. +A DMB is a Domain Master Browser - see <a href="#DMB" title="Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing">Domain Master Browser</a>. For this reason, it is very wise to configure the Samba DC as the DMB. </p><p> Now back to the issue of configuring a Samba DC to use a mode other -than <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>. If a Samba host is configured to use +than <a class="indexterm" name="id2870747"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. If a Samba host is configured to use another SMB server or DC in order to validate user connection requests, then it is a fact that some other machine on the network -(the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>) knows more about the user than the Samba host. +(the <a class="indexterm" name="id2870765"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>) knows more about the user than the Samba host. 99% of the time, this other host is a domain controller. Now -in order to operate in domain mode security, the <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> parameter +in order to operate in domain mode security, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2870782"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> parameter must be set to the name of the Windows NT domain (which already has a domain controller). If the domain does NOT already have a Domain Controller then you do not yet have a Domain! </p><p> Configuring a Samba box as a DC for a domain that already by definition has a PDC is asking for trouble. Therefore, you should always configure the Samba DC -to be the DMB for its domain and set <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>. +to be the DMB for its domain and set <a class="indexterm" name="id2870806"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. This is the only officially supported mode of operation. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876111"></a>Common Problems and Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876118"></a>I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2870825"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870831"></a>'$' cannot be included in machine name</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A 'machine account', (typically) stored in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>, takes the form of the machine name with a '$' appended. FreeBSD (and other BSD systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name. @@ -1245,24 +1123,26 @@ systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name. The problem is only in the program used to make the entry. Once made, it works perfectly. Create a user without the '$'. Then use <b class="command">vipw</b> to edit the entry, adding the '$'. Or create the whole entry with vipw if you like; make sure you use a unique User ID! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876157"></a>I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." -or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The UNIX tool <b class="command">vipw</b> is a common tool for directly editting the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870890"></a>Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." +or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an +existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</span>”</p><p> This happens if you try to create a machine trust account from the machine itself and already have a connection (e.g. mapped drive) to a share (or IPC$) on the Samba PDC. The following command will remove all network drive connections: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">C:\WINNT\></tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net use * /d</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use * /d</tt></b> </pre><p> Further, if the machine is already a 'member of a workgroup' that is the same name as the domain you are joining (bad idea) you will get this message. Change the workgroup name to something else, it does not matter what, reboot, and try again. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876206"></a>The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2870945"></a>The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading to a newer version of the Samba code I get the message, <span class="errorname">The system can not log you on (C000019B), Please try again or consult your -system administrator</span> when attempting to logon. +system administrator</span> when attempting to logon.</span>” </p><p> This occurs when the domain SID stored in the secrets.tdb database is changed. The most common cause of a change in domain SID is when @@ -1277,14 +1157,18 @@ The reset or change the domain SID you can use the net command as follows: <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid 'OLDNAME'</tt></b> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net setlocalsid 'SID'</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876277"></a>The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -When I try to join the domain I get the message <span class="errorname">The machine account +</p><p> +Workstation machine trust accounts work only with the Domain (or network) SID. If this SID changes +then domain members (workstations) will not be able to log onto the domain. The original Domain SID +can be recovered from the secrets.tdb file. The alternative is to visit each workstation to re-join +it to the domain. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871029"></a>The machine trust account not accessible</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">When I try to join the domain I get the message <span class="errorname">The machine account for this computer either does not exist or is not accessible</span>. What's -wrong? +wrong?</span>” </p><p> This problem is caused by the PDC not having a suitable machine trust account. -If you are using the <i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> method to create +If you are using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2871056"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> method to create accounts then this would indicate that it has not worked. Ensure the domain admin user system is working. </p><p> @@ -1300,31 +1184,42 @@ Some people have also reported that inconsistent subnet masks between the Samba server and the NT client can cause this problem. Make sure that these are consistent for both client and server. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876340"></a>When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871102"></a>Account disabled</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, + I get a message about my account being disabled.</span>”</p><p> Enable the user accounts with <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -e <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> </tt></b>, this is normally done as an account is created. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876367"></a>Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871135"></a>Domain Controller Unavailable</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</span>”</p><p> A domain controller has to announce on the network who it is. This usually takes a while. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-bdc"></a>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Volker</span> <span class="surname">Lendecke</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2878532">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878705">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878734">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878954">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878975">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879001">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879047">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879149">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879210">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879224">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879254">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879287">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879332">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871156"></a>Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>After successfully joining the domain user logons fail with one of two messages:</p><p>One to the effect that the domain controller can not be found, the other claiming that the + account does not exist in the domain or that the password is incorrect.</p><p>This may be due to incompatible settings between + the Windows client and the Samba-3 server for <span class="emphasis"><em>schannel</em></span> (secure channel) settings + or <span class="emphasis"><em>smb signing</em></span> settings. Check your samba settings for <span class="emphasis"><em> + client schannel, server schannel, client signing, server signing</em></span> by executing: + <b class="command">testparm -v | more</b> and looking for the value of these parameters. + </p><p> + Also use the Microsoft Management Console - Local Security Settings. This tool is available from the + Control Panel. The Policy settings are found in the Local Policies / Securty Options area and are prefixed by + <span class="emphasis"><em>Secure Channel: ..., and Digitally sign ...</em></span>. + </p><p> + It is important that these be set consistently with the Samba-3 server settings. + </p></div></div><div class="footnotes"><br><hr width="100" align="left"><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2869141" href="#id2869141">1</a>] </sup>See also <a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter on Account Information Databases</a>.</p></div><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2869672" href="#id2869672">2</a>] </sup>See also <a href="#NetworkBrowsing" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">the chapter about network browsing</a></p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-bdc"></a>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Volker</span> <span class="surname">Lendecke</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2871317">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871494">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871522">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871772">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871793">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2871819">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2871833">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2871968">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2872125">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872138">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872169">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872196">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2872240">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> Before you continue reading in this section, please make sure that you are comfortable -with configuring a Samba Domain Controller as described in the -<a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a> chapter. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878532"></a>Features And Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +with configuring a Samba Domain Controller as described in <a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">chapter on setting up Samba as a PDC</a>. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871317"></a>Features And Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is one of the most difficult chapters to summarise. It does not matter what we say here for someone will still draw conclusions and / or approach the Samba-Team with expectations that are either not yet capable of being delivered, or that can be achieved far more -effectively using a totally different approach. Since this HOWTO is already so large and -extensive, we have taken the decision to provide sufficient (but not comprehensive) -information regarding Backup Domain Control. In the event that you should have a persistent -concern that is not addressed in this HOWTO document then please email +effectively using a totally different approach. In the event that you should have a persistent +concern that is not addressed in this book then please email <a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John H Terpstra</a> clearly setting out your requirements and / or question and we will do our best to provide a solution. </p><p> Samba-3 is capable of acting as a Backup Domain Controller to another Samba Primary Domain -Controller. A Samba-3 PDC can operate with an LDAP Account backend. The Samba-3 BDC can -operate with a slave LDAP server for the Account backend. This effectively gives samba a high -degree of scalability. This is a very sweet (nice) solution for large organisations. +Controller. A Samba-3 PDC can operate with an LDAP Account backend. The LDAP backend can be +either a common master LDAP server, or a slave server. The use of a slave LDAP server has the +benefit that when the master is down clients may still be able to log onto the network. +This effectively gives samba a high degree of scalability iand is a very sweet (nice) solution +for large organisations. </p><p> While it is possible to run a Samba-3 BDC with non-LDAP backend, the administrator will need to figure out precisely what is the best way to replicate (copy / distribute) the @@ -1349,8 +1244,9 @@ lets consider each possible option and look at the pro's and con's for each theo </p><p> Arguments Against: Complexity </p></li><li><p> - Passdb Backend is tdbsam based, BDCs use cron based "net rpc vampire" to - suck down the Accounts database from the PDC + Passdb Backend is tdbsam based, BDCs use cron based <span class="emphasis"><em>net rpc vampire</em></span> to + obtain the Accounts database from the PDC and place them into the Samba SAM. + <span class="emphasis"><em>net rpc vampire</em></span> is a Samba function of the "net" command. </p><p> Arguments For: It would be a nice solution </p><p> @@ -1371,7 +1267,7 @@ lets consider each possible option and look at the pro's and con's for each theo Arguments Against: All machine trust accounts and user accounts will be locally maintained. Domain users will NOT be able to roam from office to office. This is a broken and flawed solution. Do NOT do this. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878705"></a>Essential Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871494"></a>Essential Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A Domain Controller is a machine that is able to answer logon requests from network workstations. Microsoft LanManager and IBM LanServer were two early products that provided this capability. The technology has become known as the LanMan Netlogon service. @@ -1381,7 +1277,7 @@ and with it a new form of the network logon service that has extended functional This service became known as the NT NetLogon Service. The nature of this service has changed with the evolution of MS Windows NT and today provides a very complex array of services that are implemented over a complex spectrum of technologies. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878734"></a>MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871522"></a>MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Whenever a user logs into a Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional Workstation, the workstation connects to a Domain Controller (authentication server) to validate the username and password that the user entered are valid. If the information entered @@ -1439,32 +1335,29 @@ one of the BDCs can be promoted to a PDC. If this happens while the original PDC line then it is automatically demoted to a BDC. This is an important aspect of Domain Controller management. The tool that is used to affect a promotion or a demotion is the Server Manager for Domains. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2878883"></a>Example PDC Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2871673"></a>Example PDC Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since version 2.2 Samba officially supports domain logons for all current Windows Clients, including Windows NT4, 2003 and XP Professional. For samba to be enabled as a PDC some parameters in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> have to be set: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - workgroup = SAMBA - domain master = yes - domain logons = yes -</pre><p> -Several other things like a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> and a <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share also need to be set along with +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2871704"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.1. Minimal smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +Several other things like a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> and a +<i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share also need to be set along with settings for the profile path, the users home drive, etc.. This will not be covered in this -chapter, for more information please refer to the chapter on <a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878954"></a>Active Directory Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +chapter, for more information please refer to <a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">the chapter about samba as a PDC</a>. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871772"></a>Active Directory Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> As of the release of MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory, this information is now stored in a directory that can be replicated and for which partial or full administrative control can be delegated. Samba-3 is NOT able to be a Domain Controller within an Active Directory tree, and it can not be an Active Directory server. This means that Samba-3 also can NOT act as a Backup Domain Controller to an Active Directory Domain Controller. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878975"></a>What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871793"></a>What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every machine that is a Domain Controller for the domain SAMBA has to register the NetBIOS group name SAMBA<#1c> with the WINS server and/or by broadcast on the local network. The PDC also registers the unique NetBIOS name SAMBA<#1b> with the WINS server. The name type <#1b> name is normally reserved for the Domain Master Browser, a role that has nothing to do with anything related to authentication, but the Microsoft Domain implementation requires the domain master browser to be on the same machine as the PDC. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879001"></a>How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871819"></a>How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> An MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional workstation in the domain SAMBA that wants a local user to be authenticated has to find the domain controller for SAMBA. It does this by doing a NetBIOS name query for the group name SAMBA<#1c>. It assumes that each @@ -1472,22 +1365,22 @@ of the machines it gets back from the queries is a domain controller and can ans requests. To not open security holes both the workstation and the selected domain controller authenticate each other. After that the workstation sends the user's credentials (name and password) to the local Domain Controller, for validation. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879047"></a>Backup Domain Controller Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2871833"></a>Backup Domain Controller Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Several things have to be done: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> The domain SID has to be the same on the PDC and the BDC. This used to be stored in the file private/MACHINE.SID. This file is not created - anymore since Samba 2.2.5 or even earlier. Nowadays the domain SID is - stored in the file private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb + since Samba 2.2.5. Nowadays the domain SID is stored in the file + private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb from the PDC to the BDC does not work, as the BDC would generate a new SID for itself and override the domain SID with this new BDC SID.</p><p> To retrieve the domain SID from the PDC or an existing BDC and store it in the secrets.tdb, execute: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc getsid</tt></b> - </pre></li><li><p> - The Unix user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc getsid</tt></b> +</pre></li><li><p> + The UNIX user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the BDC. This means that both the /etc/passwd and /etc/group have to be replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This can be done manually whenever changes are made, or the PDC is set up as a NIS master @@ -1507,23 +1400,30 @@ Several things have to be done: BDC. This can be done manually whenever login scripts are changed, or it can be done automatically together with the smbpasswd synchronization. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879149"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2871968"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Finally, the BDC has to be found by the workstations. This can be done by setting: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - workgroup = SAMBA - domain master = no - domain logons = yes -</pre><p> -in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> of the BDC. This makes the BDC +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2871983"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.2. Minimal setup for being a BDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam://slave-ldap.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +In the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> of the BDC. This makes the BDC only register the name SAMBA<#1c> with the WINS server. This is no problem as the name SAMBA<#1c> is a NetBIOS group name that is meant to -be registered by more than one machine. The parameter 'domain master = -no' forces the BDC not to register SAMBA<#1b> which as a unique NetBIOS +be registered by more than one machine. The parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2872052"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = no +forces the BDC not to register SAMBA<#1b> which as a unique NetBIOS name is reserved for the Primary Domain Controller. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879210"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><p> +The <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> will redirect the <b class="command">winbindd</b> utility to +use the LDAP database to resolve all UIDs and GIDs for UNIX accounts. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Samba-3 has introduced a new ID mapping facility. One of the features of this facility is that it +allows greater flexibility in how user and group IDs are handled in respect of NT Domain User and Group +SIDs. One of the new facilities provides for explicitly ensuring that UNIX / Linux UID and GID values +will be consistent on the PDC, all BDCs and all Domain Member servers. The parameter that controls this +is called <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i>. Please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information +regarding it's behaviour. Do NOT set this parameter except where an LDAP backend (ldapsam) is in use. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2872125"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> As this is a rather new area for Samba there are not many examples that we may refer to. Keep watching for updates to this section. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879224"></a>Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872138"></a>Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This problem will occur when occur when the passdb (SAM) files are copied from a central server but the local Backup Domain Controllers. Local machine trust account password updates are not copied back to the central server. The newer machine account password is then over @@ -1534,18 +1434,15 @@ to proceed and the account expiry error will be reported. </p><p> The solution: use a more robust passdb backend, such as the ldapsam backend, setting up an slave LDAP server for each BDC, and a master LDAP server for the PDC. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879254"></a>Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872169"></a>Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> With version 2.2, no. The native NT4 SAM replication protocols have not yet been fully implemented. The Samba Team is working on understanding and implementing the protocols, -but this work has not been finished for version 2.2. -</p><p> -With version 3.0, the work on both the replication protocols and a suitable storage -mechanism has progressed, and some form of NT4 BDC support is expected soon. +but this work has not been finished for Samba-3. </p><p> -Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes. The main reason for implementing a +Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes, but only to a Samba PDC. The main reason for implementing a BDC is availability. If the PDC is a Samba machine, a second Samba machine can be set up to service logon requests whenever the PDC is down. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879287"></a>How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872196"></a>How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Replication of the smbpasswd file is sensitive. It has to be done whenever changes to the SAM are made. Every user's password change is done in the smbpasswd file and has to be replicated to the BDC. So replicating the smbpasswd file very often is necessary. @@ -1559,12 +1456,12 @@ to type a password. As said a few times before, use of this method is broken and flawed. Machine trust accounts will go out of sync, resulting in a very broken domain. This method is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> recommended. Try using LDAP instead. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879332"></a>Can I do this all with LDAP?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872240"></a>Can I do this all with LDAP?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The simple answer is YES. Samba's pdb_ldap code supports binding to a replica LDAP server, and will also follow referrals and rebind to the master if it ever needs to make a modification to the database. (Normally BDCs are read only, so this will not occur often). -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="domain-member"></a>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2880401">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880516">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880692">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880944">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881141">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881203">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881406">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881788">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881929">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882013">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882376">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2882398">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2882423">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2882455">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="domain-member"></a>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2872448">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873061">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873276">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873347">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2873995">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874178">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874307">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874683">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2874706">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2874732">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2874764">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> Domain Membership is a subject of vital concern, Samba must be able to participate as a member server in a Microsoft Domain security context, and Samba must be capable of providing Domain machine member trust accounts, @@ -1574,12 +1471,11 @@ This chapter covers background information pertaining to domain membership, Samba configuration for it, and MS Windows client procedures for joining a domain. Why is this necessary? Because both are areas in which there exists within the current MS Windows networking world and particularly in the -Unix/Linux networking and administration world, a considerable level of +UNIX/Linux networking and administration world, a considerable level of mis-information, incorrect understanding, and a lack of knowledge. Hopefully this chapter will fill the voids. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880401"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -MS Windows workstations and servers that want to participate in domain -security need to +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2872448"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows workstations and servers that want to participate in domain security need to be made Domain members. Participating in Domain security is often called <span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span> or <span class="acronym">SSO</span> for short. This chapter describes the process that must be followed to make a workstation @@ -1614,11 +1510,11 @@ Domain membership has many advantages: client or server, other than the central Domain database (either NT4/Samba SAM style Domain, NT4 Domain that is back ended with an LDAP directory, or via an Active Directory infrastructure) - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880516"></a>MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="machine-trust-accounts"></a>MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2872579"></a><p> A machine trust account is an account that is used to authenticate a client machine (rather than a user) to the Domain Controller server. In Windows terminology, -this is known as a "Computer Account." +this is known as a "Computer Account." </p><p> The password of a machine trust account acts as the shared secret for secure communication with the Domain Controller. This is a security @@ -1639,12 +1535,12 @@ as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> A Domain Security Account (stored in the - <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> that has been configured in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2872629"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> that has been configured in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. The precise nature of the account information that is stored depends on the type of backend database that has been chosen. </p><p> The older format of this data is the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database - which contains the unix login ID, the Unix user identifier (UID), and the + which contains the UNIX login ID, the UNIX user identifier (UID), and the LanMan and NT encrypted passwords. There is also some other information in this file that we do not need to concern ourselves with here. </p><p> @@ -1653,57 +1549,70 @@ as follows: older <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file did. The extra information enables new user account controls to be used. </p></li><li><p> - A corresponding Unix account, typically stored in + A corresponding UNIX account, typically stored in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. Work is in progress to allow a - simplified mode of operation that does not require Unix user accounts, but + simplified mode of operation that does not require UNIX user accounts, but this may not be a feature of the early releases of Samba-3. </p></li></ul></div><p> -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2872712"></a><p> There are three ways to create machine trust accounts: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - Manual creation from the Unix/Linux command line. Here, both the Samba and - corresponding Unix account are created by hand. + Manual creation from the UNIX/Linux command line. Here, both the Samba and + corresponding UNIX account are created by hand. </p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2872744"></a> Using the MS Windows NT4 Server Manager (either from an NT4 Domain member server, or using the Nexus toolkit available from the Microsoft web site. This tool can be run from any MS Windows machine so long as the user is logged on as the administrator account. </p></li><li><p> - "On-the-fly" creation. The Samba machine trust account is automatically + "On-the-fly" creation. The Samba machine trust account is automatically created by Samba at the time the client is joined to the domain. - (For security, this is the recommended method.) The corresponding Unix + (For security, this is the recommended method.) The corresponding UNIX account may be created automatically or manually. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880692"></a>Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2872769"></a>Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The first step in manually creating a machine trust account is to manually -create the corresponding Unix account in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. +create the corresponding UNIX account in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. This can be done using <b class="command">vipw</b> or another 'add user' command -that is normally used to create new Unix accounts. The following is an example for a Linux based Samba server: -</p><p> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/sbin/useradd -g 100 -d /dev/null -c <i class="replaceable"><tt>"machine nickname"</tt></i> -s /bin/false <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$ </tt></b> +that is normally used to create new UNIX accounts. The following is an example for a Linux based Samba server: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2872799"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2872808"></a> + + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/sbin/useradd -g 100 -d /dev/null -c <i class="replaceable"><tt>"machine nickname"</tt></i> \ + -s /bin/false <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$ </tt></b> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>passwd -l <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2872869"></a> On *BSD systems, this can be done using the <b class="command">chpass</b> utility: </p><p> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chpass -a "<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$:*:101:100::0:0:Workstation <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin"</tt></b> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chpass -a \ + "<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$:*:101:100::0:0:Workstation <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin"</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry will list the machine name -with a "$" appended, won't have a password, will have a null shell and no +with a "$" appended, won't have a password, will have a null shell and no home directory. For example a machine named 'doppy' would have an <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry like this: </p><pre class="programlisting"> -doppy$:x:505:501:<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i>:/dev/null:/bin/false +doppy$:x:505:100:<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i>:/dev/null:/bin/false </pre><p> Above, <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i> can be any descriptive name for the client, i.e., BasementComputer. <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i> absolutely must be the NetBIOS -name of the client to be joined to the domain. The "$" must be +name of the client to be joined to the domain. The "$" must be appended to the NetBIOS name of the client or Samba will not recognize this as a machine trust account. </p><p> -Now that the corresponding Unix account has been created, the next step is to create +Now that the corresponding UNIX account has been created, the next step is to create the Samba account for the client containing the well-known initial -machine trust account password. This can be done using the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html" target="_top"><b class="command">smbpasswd(8)</b></a> command +machine trust account password. This can be done using the +<b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command as shown here: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> @@ -1712,28 +1621,32 @@ as shown here: </p><p> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i> is the machine's NetBIOS name. The RID of the new machine account is generated from the UID of -the corresponding Unix account. +the corresponding UNIX account. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Join the client to the domain immediately</h3><p> Manually creating a machine trust account using this method is the equivalent of creating a machine trust account on a Windows NT PDC using + <a class="indexterm" name="id2873036"></a> the <span class="application">Server Manager</span>. From the time at which the account is created to the time which the client joins the domain and changes the password, your domain is vulnerable to an intruder joining your domain using a machine with the same NetBIOS name. A PDC inherently trusts members of the domain and will serve out a large degree of user information to such clients. You have been warned! - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880944"></a>Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873061"></a>Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the machine from which you are trying to manage the domain is an -<span class="application">MS Windows NT4 workstation</span> +<span class="application">MS Windows NT4 workstation or MS Windows 200x / XP Professional</span> then the tool of choice is the package called <b class="command">SRVTOOLS.EXE</b>. -When executed in the target directory this will unpack -<b class="command">SrvMge.exe</b> and <b class="command">UsrMgr.exe</b> (both are -Domain Management tools for MS Windows NT4 workstation. +When executed in the target directory this will unpack <b class="command">SrvMge.exe</b> +and <b class="command">UsrMgr.exe</b> (both are domain management tools for MS Windows NT4 workstation). +</p><p> +If your workstation is a <span class="application">Microsoft Windows 9x/Me</span> family product + you should download the <b class="command">Nexus.exe</b> package from the Microsoft web site. +When executed from the target directory this will unpack the same tools but for use on +this platform. </p><p> -If your workstation is any other MS Windows product you should download the -<b class="command">Nexus.exe</b> package from the Microsoft web site. When executed -from the target directory this will unpack the same tools but for use on -<span class="application">MS Windows 9x/Me/200x/XP</span>. +Further information about these tools may be obtained from the following locations: +<a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;173673" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;173673</a> +<a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;172540" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;172540</a> </p><p> Launch the <b class="command">srvmgr.exe</b> (Server Manager for Domains) and follow these steps: </p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 7.1. Server Manager Account Machine Account Management</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -1753,25 +1666,21 @@ Launch the <b class="command">srvmgr.exe</b> (Server Manager for Domains) and fo <span class="guilabel">Add NT Workstation of Server</span>, then enter the machine name in the field provided, then click the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881141"></a>"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873276"></a>"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The second (and recommended) way of creating machine trust accounts is simply to allow the Samba server to create them as needed when the client is joined to the domain. -</p><p>Since each Samba machine trust account requires a corresponding Unix account, a method -for automatically creating the Unix account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the -<a href="smb.conf.5.html#ADDMACHINESCRIPT" target="_top">add machine script</a> option in -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This method is not required, however; corresponding Unix +</p><p>Since each Samba machine trust account requires a corresponding UNIX account, a method +for automatically creating the UNIX account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the +add machine script option in +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This method is not required, however; corresponding UNIX accounts may also be created manually. </p><p> Below is an example for a RedHat Linux system. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - # <...remainder of parameters...> - add machine script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 -s /bin/false -M %u -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881203"></a>Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># <...remainder of parameters...></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 -s /bin/false -M %u </tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873347"></a>Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The procedure for making an MS Windows workstation of server a member of the domain varies with the version of Windows: -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881216"></a>Windows 200x XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873360"></a>Windows 200x XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When the user elects to make the client a domain member, Windows 200x prompts for an account and password that has privileges to create machine accounts in the domain. A Samba administrative account (i.e., a Samba account that has root privileges on the @@ -1785,13 +1694,13 @@ with the version of Windows: The name of the account that is used to create domain member machine accounts can be anything the network administrator may choose. If it is other than <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> then this is easily mapped to root using the file pointed to be the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter - <i class="parameter"><tt>username map = /etc/samba/smbusers</tt></i>. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2873412"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i> = /etc/samba/smbusers. </p><p> The session key of the Samba administrative account acts as an encryption key for setting the password of the machine trust account. The machine trust account will be created on-the-fly, or updated if it already exists. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881283"></a>Windows NT4</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873436"></a>Windows NT4</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the machine trust account was created manually, on the Identification Changes menu enter the domain name, but do not check the box <span class="guilabel">Create a Computer Account in the Domain</span>. @@ -1804,8 +1713,8 @@ with the version of Windows: Domain</span>. In this case, joining the domain proceeds as above for Windows 2000 (i.e., you must supply a Samba administrative account when prompted). - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2881324"></a>Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Joining a Samba client to a domain is documented in - the <a href="#domain-member-server" title="Domain Member Server">Domain Member Server</a> section of this chapter chapter. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2873477"></a>Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Joining a Samba client to a domain is documented in + <a href="#domain-member-server" title="Domain Member Server">the domain member chapter</a>. </p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="domain-member-server"></a>Domain Member Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This mode of server operation involves the Samba machine being made a member of a domain security context. This means by definition that all user @@ -1821,46 +1730,38 @@ This can be LDAP (from OpenLDAP), or Sun's iPlanet, of NetWare Directory Server, etc. </em></span> </p><p> -Please refer to the <a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control chapter</a> +Please refer to <a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">the chapter on setting up a PDC</a> for more information regarding how to create a domain machine account for a domain member server as well as for information regarding how to enable the Samba domain member machine to join the domain and to be fully trusted by it. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881406"></a>Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2881417"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 7.1. Assumptions</b></p><table summary="Assumptions" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">SERV1</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Win2K/NT domain name:</td><td align="left">DOM</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's PDC NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">DOMPDC</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's BDC NetBIOS names:</td><td align="left">DOMBDC1 and DOMBDC2</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873558"></a>Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2873569"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 7.1. Assumptions</b></p><table summary="Assumptions" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">SERV1</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Win2K/NT domain name:</td><td align="left">MIDEARTH</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's PDC NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">DOMPDC</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's BDC NetBIOS names:</td><td align="left">DOMBDC1 and DOMBDC2</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> First, you must edit your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to tell Samba it should now use domain security. </p><p> -Change (or add) your <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY" target="_top"> -<i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a> line in the [global] section + Change (or add) your + <a class="indexterm" name="id2873642"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> line in the [global] section of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to read: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -security = domain -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> -Next change the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> -workgroup</tt></i></a> line in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> +Next change the <a class="indexterm" name="id2873686"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> line in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section to read: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -workgroup = DOM -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> as this is the name of the domain we are joining. </p><p> -You must also have the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top"> -<i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i></a> set to <tt class="constant">yes +You must also have the parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2873735"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> set to <tt class="constant">yes </tt> in order for your users to authenticate to the NT PDC. </p><p> -Finally, add (or modify) a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER" target="_top"> -<i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i></a> line in the [global] +Finally, add (or modify) a <a class="indexterm" name="id2873760"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> line in the [global] section to read: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2 -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> These are the primary and backup domain controllers Samba will attempt to contact in order to authenticate users. Samba will @@ -1872,9 +1773,7 @@ Alternatively, if you want smbd to automatically determine the list of Domain controllers to use for authentication, you may set this line to be: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -password server = * -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = *</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> This method allows Samba to use exactly the same mechanism that NT does. This method either broadcasts or uses a WINS database in order to @@ -1883,7 +1782,7 @@ find domain controllers to authenticate against. In order to actually join the domain, you must run this command: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -S DOMPDC -U<i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator%password</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S DOMPDC -U<i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator%password</tt></i></tt></b> </pre><p> </p><p> If the <tt class="option">-S DOMPDC</tt> argument is not given then @@ -1900,8 +1799,8 @@ you will see the message: <tt class="computeroutput">Joined domain DOM.</tt> or <tt class="computeroutput">Joined 'SERV1' to realm 'MYREALM'</tt> </p><p> -in your terminal window. See the <a href="net.8.html" target="_top"> -net(8)</a> man page for more details. +in your terminal window. See the +<b class="command">net</b> man page for more details. </p><p> This process joins the server to the domain without having to create the machine trust account on the PDC beforehand. @@ -1919,21 +1818,25 @@ security for your system, and should be treated as carefully as a shadow password file. </p><p> Finally, restart your Samba daemons and get ready for -clients to begin using domain security! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881788"></a>Why is this better than security = server?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +clients to begin using domain security! The way you can restart your +samba daemons depends on your distribution, but in most cases running +</p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt>/etc/init.d/samba restart +</pre><p> +does the job. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2873995"></a>Why is this better than security = server?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Currently, domain security in Samba doesn't free you from -having to create local Unix users to represent the users attaching +having to create local UNIX users to represent the users attaching to your server. This means that if domain user <tt class="constant">DOM\fred </tt> attaches to your domain security Samba server, there needs -to be a local Unix user fred to represent that user in the Unix +to be a local UNIX user fred to represent that user in the UNIX filesystem. This is very similar to the older Samba security mode -<a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSSERVER" target="_top">security = server</a>, +security = server, where Samba would pass through the authentication request to a Windows NT server in the same way as a Windows 95 or Windows 98 server would. </p><p> -Please refer to the <a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">Winbind</a> chapter -for information on a system to automatically -assign UNIX uids and gids to Windows NT Domain users and groups. + Please refer to <a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts">the chapter on winbind</a> for information on a system +to automatically assign UNIX uids and gids to Windows NT Domain users and groups. </p><p> The advantage to domain-level security is that the authentication in domain-level security is passed down the authenticated @@ -1943,11 +1846,11 @@ exactly the same way NT servers do (i.e., you can add Samba servers into a resource domain and have the authentication passed on from a resource domain PDC to an account domain PDC). </p><p> -In addition, with <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> every Samba +In addition, with <a class="indexterm" name="id2874050"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server every Samba daemon on a server has to keep a connection open to the authenticating server for as long as that daemon lasts. This can drain the connection resources on a Microsoft NT server and cause it to run -out of available connections. With <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i>, +out of available connections. With <a class="indexterm" name="id2874069"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain, however, the Samba daemons connect to the PDC/BDC only for as long as is necessary to authenticate the user, and then drop the connection, thus conserving PDC connection resources. @@ -1961,41 +1864,39 @@ Much of the text of this document was first published in the Web magazine <a href="http://www.linuxworld.com" target="_top">LinuxWorld</a> as the article <a href="http://www.linuxworld.com/linuxworld/lw-1998-10/lw-10-samba.html" target="_top">Doing the NIS/NT Samba</a>. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="ads-member"></a>Samba ADS Domain Membership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="ads-member"></a>Samba ADS Domain Membership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2874135"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2874144"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2874155"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2874163"></a><p> This is a rough guide to setting up Samba 3.0 with Kerberos authentication against a Windows2000 KDC. A familiarity with Kerberos is assumed. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881929"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874178"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must use at least the following 3 options in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - realm = your.kerberos.REALM - security = ADS - encrypt passwords = yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>realm = your.kerberos.REALM</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = ADS</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> In case samba can't figure out your ads server using your realm name, use the -<i class="parameter"><tt>ads server</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - ads server = your.kerberos.server -</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2874239"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server = your.kerberos.server</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> You do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> need a smbpasswd file, and older clients will be authenticated as -if <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i>, although it won't do any harm and +if <a class="indexterm" name="id2874286"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain, although it won't do any harm and allows you to have local users not in the domain. It is expected that the above required options will change soon when active directory integration will get better. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2882013"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874307"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The minimal configuration for <tt class="filename">krb5.conf</tt> is: </p><pre class="programlisting"> +[libdefaults] + default_realm = YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM + [realms] - YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { - kdc = your.kerberos.server + YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { + kdc = your.kerberos.server } -</pre><p> +</pre><a class="indexterm" name="id2874343"></a><p> Test your config by doing a <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i>@<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i></tt></b> and making sure that your password is accepted by the Win2000 KDC. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The realm must be uppercase or you will get <span class="errorname">Cannot find KDC for -requested realm while getting initial credentials</span> error. +requested realm while getting initial credentials</span> error (Kerberos +is case-sensitive!). </p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Time between the two servers must be synchronized. You will get a <span class="errorname">kinit(v5): Clock skew too great while getting initial credentials</span> @@ -2020,60 +1921,60 @@ is only needed if you want Kerberos support for <span class="application">smbd</ </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-create-machine-account"></a>Create the computer account</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> As a user that has write permission on the Samba private directory (usually root) run: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -U Administrator%password</tt></b> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads join -U Administrator%password</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882222"></a>Possible errors</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2874526"></a>Possible errors</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">ADS support not compiled in</span></span></dt><dd><p>Samba must be reconfigured (remove config.cache) and recompiled (make clean all install) after the Kerberos libs and headers are installed. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">net join prompts for user name</span></span></dt><dd><p>You need to login to the domain using <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">net ads join prompts for user name</span></span></dt><dd><p>You need to login to the domain using <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i>@<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i></tt></b>. <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i> must be a user who has rights to add a machine to the domain. </p></dd></dl></div><p> </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-server"></a>Test your server setup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the join was successful, you will see a new computer account with the -NetBIOS name of your Samba server in Active Directory (in the "Computers" +NetBIOS name of your Samba server in Active Directory (in the "Computers" folder under Users and Computers. </p><p> On a Windows 2000 client try <b class="userinput"><tt>net use * \\server\share</tt></b>. You should be logged in with Kerberos without needing to know a password. If this fails then run <b class="userinput"><tt>klist tickets</tt></b>. Did you get a ticket for the server? Does it have an encoding type of DES-CBC-MD5 ? -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-smbclient"></a>Testing with <span class="application">smbclient</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-smbclient"></a>Testing with <span class="application">smbclient</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2874651"></a><p> On your Samba server try to login to a Win2000 server or your Samba server using <span class="application">smbclient</span> and Kerberos. Use <span class="application">smbclient</span> as usual, but -specify the <i class="parameter"><tt>-k</tt></i> option to choose Kerberos authentication. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2882376"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +specify the <tt class="option">-k</tt> option to choose Kerberos authentication. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874683"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must change administrator password at least once after DC install, to create the right encoding types </p><p> W2k doesn't seem to create the _kerberos._udp and _ldap._tcp in -their defaults DNS setup. Maybe fixed in service packs? -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2882398"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +their defaults DNS setup. Maybe this will be fixed later in service packs. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2874706"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the process of adding / deleting / re-adding domain member machine accounts there are many traps for the unwary player and there are many “<span class="quote">little</span>” things that can go wrong. It is particularly interesting how often subscribers on the samba mailing list have concluded -after repeated failed attempts to add a machine account that it is necessary to "re-install" +after repeated failed attempts to add a machine account that it is necessary to "re-install" MS Windows on t he machine. In truth, it is seldom necessary to reinstall because of this type of problem. The real solution is often very simple, and with understanding of how MS Windows -networking functions. easily overcome. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2882423"></a>Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -<span class="emphasis"><em>Problem:</em></span> A Windows workstation was reinstalled. The original domain machine +networking functions easy to overcome. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874732"></a>Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote"> A Windows workstation was reinstalled. The original domain machine account was deleted and added immediately. The workstation will not join the domain if I use the same machine name. Attempts to add the machine fail with a message that the machine already -exists on the network - I know it doesn't. Why is this failing? +exists on the network - I know it doesn't. Why is this failing?</span>” </p><p> The original name is still in the NetBIOS name cache and must expire after machine account deletion BEFORE adding that same name as a domain member again. The best advice is to delete the old account and then to add the machine with a new name. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2882455"></a>Adding Machine to Domain Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Adding a Windows 200x or XP Professional machine to the Samba PDC Domain fails with a +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2874764"></a>Adding Machine to Domain Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">Adding a Windows 200x or XP Professional machine to the Samba PDC Domain fails with a message that, <span class="errorname">The machine could not be added at this time, there is a network problem. -Please try again later.</span> Why? + Please try again later.</span> Why?</span>” </p><p> -You should check that there is an <i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +You should check that there is an <a class="indexterm" name="id2874791"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. If there is not, please add one that is appropriate for your OS platform. If a script -has been defined you will need to debug it's operation. Increase the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> +has been defined you will need to debug it's operation. Increase the <a class="indexterm" name="id2874816"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to level 10, then try to rejoin the domain. Check the logs to see which operation is failing. </p><p> @@ -2082,21 +1983,21 @@ Possible causes include: The script does not actually exist, or could not be located in the path specified. </p><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective Action:</em></span> Fix it. Make sure that when run manually - that the script will add both the Unix system account _and_ the Samba SAM account. + that the script will add both the UNIX system account _and_ the Samba SAM account. </p></li><li><p> - The machine could not be added to the Unix system accounts file <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> + The machine could not be added to the UNIX system accounts file <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> </p><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective Action:</em></span> Check that the machine name is a legal Unix - system account name. ie: If the Unix utility <b class="command">useradd</b> is called + <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective Action:</em></span> Check that the machine name is a legal UNIX + system account name. ie: If the UNIX utility <b class="command">useradd</b> is called then make sure that the machine name you are trying to add can be added using this tool. <b class="command">Useradd</b> on some systems will not allow any upper case characters nor will it allow spaces in the name. - </p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="StandAloneServer"></a>Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2884809">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885005">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885077">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885092">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885142">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885356">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="StandAloneServer"></a>Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2874966">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875004">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875078">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2875598">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> Stand-Alone servers are independent of Domain Controllers on the network. They are NOT domain members and function more like workgroup servers. In many cases a stand-alone server is configured with a minimum of security control with the intent that all data served will be readily accessible to all users. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884809"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2874966"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Stand-Alone servers can be as secure or as insecure as needs dictate. They can have simple or complex configurations. Above all, despite the hoopla about Domain security they remain a very common installation. @@ -2113,7 +2014,7 @@ that are queued off a single central server. Everyone needs to be able to print to the printers, there is no need to affect any access controls and no files will be served from the print server. Again a share mode stand-alone server makes a great solution. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885005"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875004"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The term <span class="emphasis"><em>stand-alone server</em></span> means that the server will provide local authentication and access control for all resources that are available from it. In general this means that there will be a @@ -2135,50 +2036,37 @@ local or on a remote server, even if from the Samba protocol perspective the Samba server is NOT a member of a domain security context. </p><p> Through the use of PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) and nsswitch -(the name service switcher) the source of authentication may reside on +(the name service switcher, which maintains the unix user database) the source of authentication may reside on another server. We would be inclined to call this the authentication server. -This means that the Samba server may use the local Unix/Linux system password database +This means that the Samba server may use the local UNIX/Linux system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>), may use a local smbpasswd file, or may use an LDAP back end, or even via PAM and Winbind another CIFS/SMB server for authentication. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885077"></a>Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875078"></a>Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following examples are designed to inspire simplicity. It is too easy to attempt a high level of creativity and to introduce too much complexity in server and network design. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885092"></a>Reference Documentation Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="RefDocServer"></a>Reference Documentation Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Configuration of a read-only data server that EVERYONE can access is very simple. Here is the smb.conf file that will do this. Assume that all the reference documents are stored in the directory /export, that the documents are owned by a user other than nobody. No home directories are shared, that are no users in the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> -Unix system database. This is a very simple system to administer. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - # Global parameters - [global] - workgroup = MYGROUP - netbios name = REFDOCS - security = SHARE - passdb backend = guest - wins server = 192.168.1.1 - - [data] - comment = Data - path = /export - guest only = Yes -</pre><p> +UNIX system database. This is a very simple system to administer. +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2875123"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8.1. smb.conf for Reference Documentation Server</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># Global parameters</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = SHARE</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = 192.168.1.1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[data]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest only = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> In the above example the machine name is set to REFDOCS, the workgroup is set to the name of the local workgroup so that the machine will appear in with systems users are familiar -with. The only password backend required is the "guest" backend so as to allow default +with. The only password backend required is the "guest" backend so as to allow default unprivileged account names to be used. Given that there is a WINS server on this network we do use it. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885142"></a>Central Print Serving</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="SimplePrintServer"></a>Central Print Serving</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Configuration of a simple print server is very simple if you have all the right tools on your system. </p><div class="orderedlist"><p class="title"><b> Assumptions:</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> The print server must require no administration </p></li><li><p> The print spooling and processing system on our print server will be CUPS. - (Please refer to the <a href="#CUPS-printing" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">CUPS Printing</a> chapter for more information). + (Please refer to <a href="#CUPS-printing" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">the chapter about CUPS</a> for more information). </p></li><li><p> All printers that the print server will service will be network printers. They will be correctly configured, by the administrator, @@ -2192,76 +2080,67 @@ In this example our print server will spool all incoming print jobs to Samba to the CUPS print processor. Since all incoming connections will be as the anonymous (guest) user, two things will be required: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Enabling Anonymous Printing</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p> - The Unix/Linux system must have a <b class="command">guest</b> account. + The UNIX/Linux system must have a <b class="command">guest</b> account. The default for this is usually the account <b class="command">nobody</b>. To find the correct name to use for your version of Samba do the following: - </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -s -v | grep "guest account"</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -s -v | grep "guest account"</tt></b> +</pre><p> Then make sure that this account exists in your system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>). </p></li><li><p> The directory into which Samba will spool the file must have write access for the guest account. The following commands will ensure that this directory is available for use: - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mkdir /var/spool/samba</tt></b> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown nobody.nobody /var/spool/samba</tt></b> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod a+rwt /var/spool/samba</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p></li></ul></div><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - # Global parameters - [global] - workgroup = MYGROUP - netbios name = PTRSVR1 - security = SHARE - passdb backend = guest - wins server = 192.168.1.1 - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - printer admin = root - guest ok = Yes - printable = Yes - printing = cups - use client driver = Yes - browseable = No </pre><p> -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885356"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2875442"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8.2. smb.conf for anonymous printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># Global parameters</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = SHARE</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = noldor</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = No</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875598"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The greatest mistake so often made is to make a network configuration too complex. It pays to use the simplest solution that will meet the needs of the moment. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ClientConfig"></a>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2884469">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884469"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ClientConfig"></a>Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2875663">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875663"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="optional"></a>Advanced Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2884234"></a>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="optional"></a>Advanced Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2875691"></a>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba has several features that you might want or might not want to use. The chapters in this part each cover specific Samba features. -</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>10. <a href="#NetworkBrowsing">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886062">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886141">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886251">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886267">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886430">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886562">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2886698">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886824">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887045">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887315">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887471">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887488">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887517">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887626">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2887687">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2887846">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888045">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888070">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888154">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888167">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888234">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888372">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888419">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888526">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888605">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2889225">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889240">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889269">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#passdb">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892812">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893140">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893204">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893458">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893513">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893545">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893811">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893963">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893999">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894038">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894145">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894173">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895689">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896493">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896501">Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896516">Users are being added to the wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896576">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#groupmapping">Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2903953">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904055">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904246">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904310">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904325">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904393">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904485">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904501">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904562">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#AccessControls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902775">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902812">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902830">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903087">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903183">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2903398">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904578">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904850">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905095">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905311">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905383">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905682">MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905690">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905728">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905807">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905929">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906157">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906309">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask - parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906639">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2906714">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2906729">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907109">I have set force user and Samba still makes root the owner of all the files - I touch!</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#locking">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910721">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910776">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910908">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911554">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911664">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911924">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2912154">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912180">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2912260">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912291">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2912365">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2912394">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#securing-samba">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914448">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914481">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914555">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914574">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914645">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914697">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914749">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914805">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914866">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2914907">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914932">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914949">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914974">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#InterdomainTrusts">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915881">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915909">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915993">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916006">NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916091">NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916127">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916155">Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916295">Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916428">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916443">Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#msdfs">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915783">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917436">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#printing">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917027">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917095">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917133">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917203">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918120">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918450">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918559">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918652">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2918721">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918810">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2919116">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919220">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2919234">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919616">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919945">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920166">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920216">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920741">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921021">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921186">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921338">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921450">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921521">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921752">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921913">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2922008">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922192">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with -rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2923912">"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2923933">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924131">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924420">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924516">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924657">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924690">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925127">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925430">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925673">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a -different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925771">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926117">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926188">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2926210">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2926256">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926297">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926316">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926340">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2926492">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926822">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926867">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927036">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927051">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2927064">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927097">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="#CUPS-printing">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936290">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936298">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936350">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936405">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936484">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936628">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936710">More complex smb.conf Settings for -CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936828">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936848">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936875">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936912">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936970">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937131">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2937224">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937300">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937344">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937445">Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937533">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937630">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937742">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937813">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937902">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2937925">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2938065">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938252">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938369">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938539">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938624">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938727">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938883">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938940">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939024">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939336">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939448">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939464">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939517">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939571">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939786">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940015">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and -native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940170">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940401">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940530">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940605">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940620">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940659">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940731">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940794">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print -Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940814">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940978">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941054">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941110">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941150">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941216">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941233">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941268">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941289">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941316">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941369"> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941388">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941480">Prepare your smb.conf for -cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941526">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941724">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941782">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941814">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941864">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942086">What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942268">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942369">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942596">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942690">How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942777">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942812">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942865">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942978">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the -Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943112">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using -rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943227">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943340">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943429">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943519">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943682">Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944334">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944435">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944537">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944608">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944670">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944728">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944795">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944903">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2945532">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2945993">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946024">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946056">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946097">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946169">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946270">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946341">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946390">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946404">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946598">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946644">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946726">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946787">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946805">When not to use Samba to print to -CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946822">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946857">Where to find Documentation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946870">How to ask for Help</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946883">Where to find Help</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946896">Appendix</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946904">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2947118">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2947424">Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2948546">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="#VFS">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2960717">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960735">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960826">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2960833">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960871">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960995">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961013">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961151">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2961195">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2961218">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961273">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2961303">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="#winbind">Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962201">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962229">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962301">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962361">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2962392">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962420">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962454">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962477">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962613">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962685">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962720">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2962747">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962776">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962851">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962944">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2964563">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2964582">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="#AdvancedNetworkManagement">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967075">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2967264">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2967363">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967381">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2967592">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967788">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2967822">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="#PolicyMgmt">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2966885">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2966939">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2968722">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2968817">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2968950">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2969202">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2969303">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969324">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969344">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2969388">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969535">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2969549">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="#ProfileMgmt">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2970756">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2970790">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2970831">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2971236">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972407">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972472">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2972737">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972795">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972841">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2972861">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2973009">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2973563">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2974067">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2974080">How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2974143">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2974365">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="#pam">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2978309">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2978577">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2978595">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979265">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979567">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979625">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979709">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2980075">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2980089">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="#integrate-ms-networks">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982211">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982236">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982281">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982337">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982462">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982506">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982548">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2982637">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982784">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982829">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983073">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983105">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983130">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2983200">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983216">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983248">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983300">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="#unicode">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2984418">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984620">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984690">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984790">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984835">Japanese charsets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="#Backup">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2984038">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984063">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="#SambaHA">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2985605">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NetworkBrowsing"></a>Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 5, 1998</p></div><div><p class="pubdate">Updated: April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2886062">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886141">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886251">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886267">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886430">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886562">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2886698">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886824">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887045">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887315">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887471">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887488">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887517">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887626">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2887687">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2887846">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888045">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888070">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888154">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888167">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888234">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888372">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888419">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888526">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888605">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2889225">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889240">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889269">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>10. <a href="#NetworkBrowsing">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2875816">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876217">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876469">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876635">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876781">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877309">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877716">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877893">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877911">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877946">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878104">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878182">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878371">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878627">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878652">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878737">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878750">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878822">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878986">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879046">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879168">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879254">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879936">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879950">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879979">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880021">I get an Unable to browse the network error</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="#passdb">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880302">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880315">Backwards Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880417">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880590">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880717">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880966">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881151">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881423">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2881676">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881717">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881758">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881871">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881898">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2883727">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2884575">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884582">Users can not logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2884627">Users being added to wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2884738">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="#groupmapping">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885202">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885422">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885489">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885503">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885582">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885658">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885674">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885742">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885768">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="#AccessControls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886024">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886154">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886489">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886582">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2886810">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888020">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888092">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888391">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888399">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888444">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888523">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888655">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888889">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889446">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2889526">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889540">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889969">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890022">MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="#locking">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2890270">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890336">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2890479">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891158">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891268">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891665">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891896">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891924">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892003">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892032">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892106">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892144">Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892167">Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892198">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="#securing-samba">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892365">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892398">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892471">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892490">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892590">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892650">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892717">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892774">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892867">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892926">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892950">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892968">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892992">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="#InterdomainTrusts">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893283">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893311">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893400">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893428">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893500">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893547">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893725">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893918">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2894055">NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894162">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="#msdfs">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894231">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894506">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="#printing">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894626">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894693">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894730">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894801">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895354">A simple Configuration to Print</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895518">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895606">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895939">Extended Sample Configuration to Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896270">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897534">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897592">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2898261">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2898591">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2898740">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2898892">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899004">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899475">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2899643">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2899736">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899935">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2901625">Client Driver Install Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2901643">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2901839">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902136">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902231">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2902399">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902431">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902874">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903470">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a +different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903569">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903854">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903932">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2903954">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2903998">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904040">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904059">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904083">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904236">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904556">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904602">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904779">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904793">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904800">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904834">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="#CUPS-printing">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904970">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904977">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905020">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905074">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905408">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905584">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905929">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905949">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905999">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906051">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906119">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2906432">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907029">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907154">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907241">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907348">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2907370">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2907545">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907903">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908080">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908183">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908292">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908476">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908539">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908691">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909039">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909176">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909191">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909245">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909312">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909544">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910018">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910331">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910470">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2910560">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910577">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910632">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2910813">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911043">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911125">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911206">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911255">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911328">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911345">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911379">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911400">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911445">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911506">Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911524">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911625">Prepare your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911845">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912128">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912268">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912301">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912629">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912835">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912958">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913264">How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913349">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913427">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913497">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913646">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2913973">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914086">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914186">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915566">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915962">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916041">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916103">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916162">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916297">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916436">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917129">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2917602">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917645">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917708">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917748">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917829">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917938">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918010">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918058">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918072">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918267">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2918326">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918564">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918622">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918682">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918955">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2796634">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2796642">Win9x client can't install driver</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919061">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919107">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919163">Client can't connect to Samba printer</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919497">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919582">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919635">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919649">Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919678">Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919695">Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919711">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919733">"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919752">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919794">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920067">Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920114">cupsaddsmb does not work + with newly installed printer</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920175">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920284">Printer named "lp" +intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different +ones</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920314">Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2920369">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="#VFS">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2920538">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920556">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920786">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2920793">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920835">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920965">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920984">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921153">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921198">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921220">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921286">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="#winbind">Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921516">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921611">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921688">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921756">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921786">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921815">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921849">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921872">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922009">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922081">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922128">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2922156">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2922164">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922231">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922333">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2923890">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2923909">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2923962">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="#AdvancedNetworkManagement">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924071">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924101">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924200">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924218">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924438">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924711">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924744">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="#PolicyMgmt">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924822">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924888">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924999">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925094">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925227">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2925491">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925596">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925636">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925655">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2925700">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925851">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925865">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="#ProfileMgmt">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925964">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925999">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2926040">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926530">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927776">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927861">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2928114">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928172">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928216">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2928237">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928385">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928939">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2929447">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2929460">Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2929529">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2929742">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="#pam">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2930024">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2930271">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2930288">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2930969">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931283">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931361">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931445">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2931826">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2931839">pam_winbind problem</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931926">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="#integrate-ms-networks">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932164">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932188">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932259">Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932315">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932456">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932499">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932551">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2932655">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932922">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932985">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933234">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933266">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933298">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2933416">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2933432">Pinging works only in one way</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933465">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933517">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="#unicode">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2933721">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933765">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933835">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933962">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933992">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934130">Common errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934137">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="#Backup">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934250">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934264">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="#SambaHA">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934334">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NetworkBrowsing"></a>Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">July 5, 1998</p></div><div><p class="pubdate">Updated: April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2875816">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876217">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876469">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2876635">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2876781">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877309">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877716">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877893">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877911">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2877946">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878104">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878182">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878371">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878627">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878652">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878737">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2878750">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2878822">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2878986">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879046">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879168">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879254">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2879936">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2879950">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2879979">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880021">I get an Unable to browse the network error</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This document contains detailed information as well as a fast track guide to implementing browsing across subnets and / or across workgroups (or domains). WINS is the best tool for resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses. WINS is @@ -2272,11 +2151,11 @@ over TCP/IP. Samba-3 and later also supports this mode of operation. When the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP has been disabled then the primary means for resolution of MS Windows machine names is via DNS and Active Directory. The following information assumes that your site is running NetBIOS over TCP/IP. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886062"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875816"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Someone once referred to the past in terms of: <span class="emphasis"><em>They were the worst of times, they were the best of times. The more we look back, them more we long for what was and hope it never returns!</em></span>. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2875837"></a><p> For many MS Windows network administrators, that statement sums up their feelings about NetBIOS networking precisely. For those who mastered NetBIOS networking, its fickle nature was just par for the course. For those who never quite managed to tame its @@ -2301,63 +2180,55 @@ help Samba to affect stable WINS operations beyond the normal scope of MS WINS. </p><p> Please note that WINS is exclusively a service that applies only to those systems that run NetBIOS over TCP/IP. MS Windows 200x / XP have the capacity to turn off -support for NetBIOS, in which case WINS is of no relevance. Samba-3 supports this also. +support for NetBIOS, in which case WINS is of no relevance. Samba supports this also. </p><p> For those networks on which NetBIOS has been disabled (ie: WINS is NOT required) the use of DNS is necessary for host name resolution. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886141"></a>What is Browsing?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2875904"></a>What is Browsing?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> To most people browsing means that they can see the MS Windows and Samba servers in the Network Neighborhood, and when the computer icon for a particular server is clicked, it opens up and shows the shares and printers available on the target server. </p><p> What seems so simple is in fact a very complex interaction of different technologies. The technologies (or methods) employed in making all of this work includes: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>MS Windows machines register their presence to the network</td></tr><tr><td>Machines announce themselves to other machines on the network</td></tr><tr><td>One or more machine on the network collates the local announcements</td></tr><tr><td>The client machine finds the machine that has the collated list of machines</td></tr><tr><td>The client machine is able to resolve the machine names to IP addresses</td></tr><tr><td>The client machine is able to connect to a target machine</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>MS Windows machines register their presence to the network</p></li><li><p>Machines announce themselves to other machines on the network</p></li><li><p>One or more machine on the network collates the local announcements</p></li><li><p>The client machine finds the machine that has the collated list of machines</p></li><li><p>The client machine is able to resolve the machine names to IP addresses</p></li><li><p>The client machine is able to connect to a target machine</p></li></ul></div><p> The Samba application that controls browse list management and name resolution is called <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt>. The configuration parameters involved in nmbd's operation are: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - - Browsing options: - ----------------- - * os level - lm announce - lm interval - * preferred master - * local master - * domain master - browse list - enhanced browsing - - Name Resolution Method: - ----------------------- - * name resolve order - - WINS options: - ------------- - dns proxy - wins proxy - * wins server - * wins support - wins hook -</pre><p> +</p><p>Browsing options: <a class="indexterm" name="id2875988"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876002"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876016"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876030"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876044"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876072"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876085"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enhanced browsing</tt></i>. +</p><p>Name Resolution Method: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876103"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>(*). +</p><p>WINS options: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876122"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dns proxy</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876136"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins proxy</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876150"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876163"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i>(*), + <a class="indexterm" name="id2876178"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins hook</tt></i>. +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2876193"></a><p> For Samba, the WINS Server and WINS Support are mutually exclusive options. Those marked with an '*' are the only options that commonly MAY need to be modified. Even if not one of these parameters is set <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> will still do it's job. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886251"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876217"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Firstly, all MS Windows networking uses SMB (Server Message Block) based messaging. SMB messaging may be implemented with or without NetBIOS. MS Windows 200x supports NetBIOS over TCP/IP for backwards compatibility. Microsoft is intent on phasing out NetBIOS support. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886267"></a>NetBIOS over TCP/IP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876233"></a>NetBIOS over TCP/IP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba implements NetBIOS, as does MS Windows NT / 200x / XP, by encapsulating it over TCP/IP. MS Windows products can do likewise. NetBIOS based networking uses broadcast messaging to affect browse list management. When running NetBIOS over TCP/IP, this uses UDP based messaging. UDP messages can be broadcast or unicast. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2876251"></a><p> Normally, only unicast UDP messaging can be forwarded by routers. The -<b class="command">remote announce</b> parameter to smb.conf helps to project browse announcements +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876262"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter to smb.conf helps to project browse announcements to remote network segments via unicast UDP. Similarly, the -<b class="command">remote browse sync</b> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876280"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> implements browse list collation using unicast UDP. </p><p> Secondly, in those networks where Samba is the only SMB server technology, @@ -2365,12 +2236,13 @@ wherever possible <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> should be configured on one (1) server. This makes it easy to manage the browsing environment. If each network segment is configured with it's own Samba WINS server, then the only way to get cross segment browsing to work is by using the -<b class="command">remote announce</b> and the <b class="command">remote browse sync</b> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876319"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2876333"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameters to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876359"></a> If only one WINS server is used for an entire multi-segment network then -the use of the <b class="command">remote announce</b> and the -<b class="command">remote browse sync</b> parameters should NOT be necessary. +the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2876368"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> and the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876382"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameters should NOT be necessary. </p><p> As of Samba 3 WINS replication is being worked on. The bulk of the code has been committed, but it still needs maturation. This is NOT a supported feature @@ -2381,7 +2253,7 @@ Right now Samba WINS does not support MS-WINS replication. This means that when setting up Samba as a WINS server there must only be one <tt class="filename">nmbd</tt> configured as a WINS server on the network. Some sites have used multiple Samba WINS servers for redundancy (one server per subnet) and then used -<b class="command">remote browse sync</b> and <b class="command">remote announce</b> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876422"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2876436"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> to affect browse list collation across all segments. Note that this means clients will only resolve local names, and must be configured to use DNS to resolve names on other subnets in order to resolve the IP addresses of the servers they can see @@ -2392,7 +2264,10 @@ Lastly, take note that browse lists are a collection of unreliable broadcast messages that are repeated at intervals of not more than 15 minutes. This means that it will take time to establish a browse list and it can take up to 45 minutes to stabilise, particularly across network segments. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886430"></a>TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876469"></a>TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876480"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876488"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876497"></a> All TCP/IP using systems use various forms of host name resolution. The primary methods for TCP/IP hostname resolutions involves either a static file (<tt class="filename">/etc/hosts </tt>) or DNS (the Domain Name System). DNS is the technology that makes @@ -2415,7 +2290,7 @@ it follows a defined path: </p></li><li><p> Looks up entries in LMHOSTS. It is located in <tt class="filename">C:\WinNT\System32\Drivers\etc</tt>. - </p></li></ol></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2876594"></a><p> Windows 200x / XP can register it's host name with a Dynamic DNS server. You can force register with a Dynamic DNS server in Windows 200x / XP using: <b class="command">ipconfig /registerdns</b> @@ -2428,8 +2303,8 @@ consequently network services will be severely impaired. The use of Dynamic DNS is highly recommended with Active Directory, in which case the use of BIND9 is preferred for it's ability to adequately support the SRV (service) records that are needed for Active Directory. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886562"></a>DNS and Active Directory</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Occasionally we hear from Unix network administrators who want to use a Unix based Dynamic +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2876635"></a>DNS and Active Directory</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2876642"></a><p> +Occasionally we hear from UNIX network administrators who want to use a UNIX based Dynamic DNS server in place of the Microsoft DNS server. While this might be desirable to some, the MS Windows 200x DNS server is auto-configured to work with Active Directory. It is possible to use BIND version 8 or 9, but it will almost certainly be necessary to create service records @@ -2450,7 +2325,7 @@ The following are some of the default service records that Active Directory requ </p></li><li><p>_ldap._tcp.<span class="emphasis"><em>Site</em></span>.gc.ms-dcs.<span class="emphasis"><em>DomainTree</em></span></p><p> Used by MS Windows clients to locate site configuration dependent Global Catalog server. - </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886698"></a>How Browsing Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2876781"></a>How Browsing Functions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows machines register their NetBIOS names (ie: the machine name for each service type in operation) on start up. The exact method by which this name registration @@ -2464,7 +2339,7 @@ resolution to the local subnet, unless LMHOSTS is used to list all names and IP addresses. In such situations Samba provides a means by which the Samba server name may be forcibly injected into the browse list of a remote MS Windows network (using the -<b class="command">remote announce</b> parameter). +<a class="indexterm" name="id2876810"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter). </p><p> Where a WINS server is used, the MS Windows client will use UDP unicast to register with the WINS server. Such packets can be routed @@ -2492,20 +2367,18 @@ will annoy users because they will have to put up with protracted inability to use the network services. </p><p> Samba supports a feature that allows forced synchronisation -of browse lists across routed networks using the <b class="command">remote -browse sync</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +of browse lists across routed networks using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2876873"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. This causes Samba to contact the local master browser on a remote network and to request browse list synchronisation. This effectively bridges two networks that are separated by routers. The two remote networks may use either broadcast based name resolution or WINS -based name resolution, but it should be noted that the <b class="command">remote -browse sync</b> parameter provides browse list synchronisation - and +based name resolution, but it should be noted that the <a class="indexterm" name="id2876902"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter provides browse list synchronisation - and that is distinct from name to address resolution, in other words, for cross subnet browsing to function correctly it is essential that a name to address resolution mechanism be provided. This mechanism could be via DNS, <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>, and so on. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886824"></a>Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="DMB"></a>Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To set up cross subnet browsing on a network containing machines in up to be in a WORKGROUP, not an NT Domain you need to set up one Samba server to be the Domain Master Browser (note that this is *NOT* @@ -2524,20 +2397,13 @@ workgroup name. To set up a Samba server as a domain master browser, set the following option in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> -The domain master browser should also preferrably be the local master +The domain master browser should also preferably be the local master browser for its own subnet. In order to achieve this set the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = yes - local master = yes - preferred master = yes - os level = 65 -</pre><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2877023"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.1. Domain master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> The domain master browser may be the same machine as the WINS server, if you require. @@ -2551,20 +2417,15 @@ to use these). To make a Samba server a local master browser set the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = yes - preferred master = yes - os level = 65 -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2877114"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.2. Local master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> Do not do this for more than one Samba server on each subnet, or they will war with each other over which is to be the local master browser. </p><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i> parameter allows Samba to act as a -local master browser. The <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> causes nmbd -to force a browser election on startup and the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2877180"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i> parameter allows Samba to act as a +local master browser. The <a class="indexterm" name="id2877196"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> causes nmbd +to force a browser election on startup and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2877212"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter sets Samba high enough so that it should win any browser elections. </p><p> If you have an NT machine on the subnet that you wish to @@ -2573,13 +2434,8 @@ becoming a local master browser by setting the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = no - preferred master = no - os level = 0 -</pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887045"></a>Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2877252"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.3. smb.conf for not being a master browser</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877309"></a>Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you are adding Samba servers to a Windows NT Domain then you must not set up a Samba server as a domain master browser. By default, a Windows NT Primary Domain Controller for a domain @@ -2591,18 +2447,13 @@ with WINS instead of the PDC. For subnets other than the one containing the Windows NT PDC you may set up Samba servers as local master browsers as described. To make a Samba server a local master browser set -the following options in the <b class="command">[global]</b> section +the following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = yes - preferred master = yes - os level = 65 -</pre><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2877358"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.4. Local master browser smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 65</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> If you wish to have a Samba server fight the election with machines -on the same subnet you may set the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter +on the same subnet you may set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2877419"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> parameter to lower levels. By doing this you can tune the order of machines that will become local master browsers if they are running. For more details on this see the section <a href="#browse-force-master" title="Forcing Samba to be the master"> @@ -2616,38 +2467,33 @@ ever becoming a local master browser by setting following options in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - domain master = no - local master = no - preferred master = no - os level = 0 -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2877475"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 10.5. smb.conf for not being a master browser</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="browse-force-master"></a>Forcing Samba to be the master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Who becomes the <i class="parameter"><tt>master browser</tt></i> is determined by an election +Who becomes the master browser is determined by an election process using broadcasts. Each election packet contains a number of parameters which determine what precedence (bias) a host should have in the election. By default Samba uses a very low precedence and thus loses elections to just about anyone else. </p><p> -If you want Samba to win elections then just set the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> global +If you want Samba to win elections then just set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2877559"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to a higher number. It defaults to 0. Using 34 would make it win all elections over every other system (except other samba systems!) </p><p> -A <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> of 2 would make it beat WfWg and Win95, but not MS Windows +A <a class="indexterm" name="id2877585"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> of 2 would make it beat WfWg and Win95, but not MS Windows NT/2K Server. A MS Windows NT/2K Server domain controller uses level 32. </p><p>The maximum os level is 255</p><p> If you want Samba to force an election on startup, then set the -<i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. Samba will +<a class="indexterm" name="id2877610"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> global option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. Samba will then have a slight advantage over other potential master browsers that are not preferred master browsers. Use this parameter with care, as if you have two hosts (whether they are Windows 95 or NT or -Samba) on the same local subnet both set with <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to +Samba) on the same local subnet both set with <a class="indexterm" name="id2877641"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then periodically and continually they will force an election in order to become the local master browser. </p><p> -If you want Samba to be a <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master browser</tt></i>, then it is -recommended that you also set <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, because + If you want Samba to be a <span class="emphasis"><em>domain master browser</em></span>, then it is +recommended that you also set <a class="indexterm" name="id2877670"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, because Samba will not become a domain master browser for the whole of your LAN or WAN if it is not also a local master browser on its own broadcast isolated subnet. @@ -2659,10 +2505,10 @@ attempt to become the domain master browser every 5 minutes. They will find that another Samba server is already the domain master browser and will fail. This provides automatic redundancy, should the current domain master browser fail. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887315"></a>Making Samba the domain master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877716"></a>Making Samba the domain master</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The domain master is responsible for collating the browse lists of multiple subnets so that browsing can occur between subnets. You can -make Samba act as the domain master by setting <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i> +make Samba act as the domain master by setting <a class="indexterm" name="id2877730"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = yes in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. By default it will not be a domain master. </p><p> Note that you should <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> set Samba to be the domain master for a @@ -2674,8 +2520,8 @@ master browsers on other subnets and then contact them to synchronise browse lists. </p><p> If you want Samba to be the domain master then I suggest you also set -the <i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> high enough to make sure it wins elections, and set -<i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, to get Samba to force an election on +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2877774"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i> high enough to make sure it wins elections, and set +<a class="indexterm" name="id2877790"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, to get Samba to force an election on startup. </p><p> Note that all your servers (including Samba) and clients should be @@ -2701,31 +2547,31 @@ If, however, both Samba and your clients are using a WINS server, then: resolve the NetBIOS name of that host. as long as that host has registered its NetBIOS name with the same WINS server, the user will be able to see that host. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887471"></a>Note about broadcast addresses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If your network uses a "0" based broadcast address (for example if it + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877893"></a>Note about broadcast addresses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If your network uses a "0" based broadcast address (for example if it ends in a 0) then you will strike problems. Windows for Workgroups does not seem to support a 0's broadcast and you will probably find that browsing and name lookups won't work. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887488"></a>Multiple interfaces</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877911"></a>Multiple interfaces</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba now supports machines with multiple network interfaces. If you -have multiple interfaces then you will need to use the <b class="command">interfaces</b> +have multiple interfaces then you will need to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2877922"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to configure them. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887517"></a>Use of the Remote Announce parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter of +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2877946"></a>Use of the Remote Announce parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2877956"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> can be used to forcibly ensure that all the NetBIOS names on a network get announced to a remote network. -The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - remote announce = a.b.c.d [e.f.g.h] ... -</pre><p> +The syntax of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2877981"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> parameter is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce = a.b.c.d [e.f.g.h] ...</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - remote announce = a.b.c.d/WORKGROUP [e.f.g.h/WORKGROUP] ... -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce = a.b.c.d/WORKGROUP [e.f.g.h/WORKGROUP] ...</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> and -<i class="replaceable"><tt>e.f.g.h</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>is either the LMB (Local Master Browser) IP address +<i class="replaceable"><tt>e.f.g.h</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2878051"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878062"></a> + + is either the LMB (Local Master Browser) IP address or the broadcast address of the remote network. ie: the LMB is at 192.168.1.10, or the address could be given as 192.168.1.255 where the netmask @@ -2741,22 +2587,20 @@ NetBIOS machine names will end up looking like they belong to that workgroup, this may cause name resolution problems and should be avoided. </p></dd></dl></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887626"></a>Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878104"></a>Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2878115"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is used to announce to another LMB that it must synchronise its NetBIOS name list with our Samba LMB. It works ONLY if the Samba server that has this option is simultaneously the LMB on its network segment. </p><p> -The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter is: +The syntax of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2878144"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i> parameter is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -remote browse sync = <i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync = a.b.c.d</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>a.b.c.d</tt></i> is either the IP address of the remote LMB or else is the network broadcast address of the remote segment. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887687"></a>WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878182"></a>WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Use of WINS (either Samba WINS <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> MS Windows NT Server WINS) is highly recommended. Every NetBIOS machine registers its name together with a name_type value for each of several types of service it has available. @@ -2797,36 +2641,34 @@ lookup attempts by other clients and will therefore cause workstation access errors. </p><p> To configure Samba as a WINS server just add -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> -file [globals] section. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878272"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +file [global] section. </p><p> To configure Samba to register with a WINS server just add -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = a.b.c.d</tt></i> to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file <i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i> section. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878300"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = a.b.c.d to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section. </p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p> -Never use both <i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> together -with <i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = a.b.c.d</tt></i> +Never use both <a class="indexterm" name="id2878332"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes together +with <a class="indexterm" name="id2878348"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = a.b.c.d particularly not using it's own IP address. Specifying both will cause <span class="application">nmbd</span> to refuse to start! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887846"></a>Setting up a WINS server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878371"></a>Setting up a WINS server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Either a Samba machine or a Windows NT Server machine may be set up as a WINS server. To set a Samba machine to be a WINS server you must add the following option to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file on the selected machine : -in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i> section add the line +in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section add the line </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - wins support = yes -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> Versions of Samba prior to 1.9.17 had this parameter default to yes. If you have any older versions of Samba on your network it is strongly suggested you upgrade to a recent version, or at the very least set the parameter to 'no' on all these machines. </p><p> -Machines with <i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> will keep a list of +Machines with <a class="indexterm" name="id2878430"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes will keep a list of all NetBIOS names registered with them, acting as a DNS for NetBIOS names. </p><p> You should set up only ONE WINS server. Do NOT set the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> option on more than one Samba +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878452"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes option on more than one Samba server. </p><p> To set up a Windows NT Server as a WINS server you need to set up @@ -2838,7 +2680,7 @@ participate in these replications. It is possible in the future that a Samba->Samba WINS replication protocol may be defined, in which case more than one Samba machine could be set up as a WINS server but currently only one Samba server should have the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> parameter set. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878487"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes parameter set. </p><p> After the WINS server has been configured you must ensure that all machines participating on the network are configured with the address @@ -2849,17 +2691,15 @@ in Windows 95 or Windows NT. To tell a Samba server the IP address of the WINS server add the following line to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of all <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files : </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - wins server = <name or IP address> -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = <name or IP address></tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> where <name or IP address> is either the DNS name of the WINS server machine or its IP address. </p><p> Note that this line MUST NOT BE SET in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file of the Samba server acting as the WINS server itself. If you set both the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = yes</tt></i> option and the -<i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = <name></tt></i> option then +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878585"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i> = yes option and the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2878600"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i> = <name> option then nmbd will fail to start. </p><p> There are two possible scenarios for setting up cross subnet browsing. @@ -2867,20 +2707,20 @@ The first details setting up cross subnet browsing on a network containing Windows 95, Samba and Windows NT machines that are not configured as part of a Windows NT Domain. The second details setting up cross subnet browsing on networks that contain NT Domains. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888045"></a>WINS Replication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878627"></a>WINS Replication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 permits WINS replication through the use of the <tt class="filename">wrepld</tt> utility. This tool is not currently capable of being used as it is still in active development. As soon as this tool becomes moderately functional we will prepare man pages and enhance this section of the documentation to provide usage and technical details. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888070"></a>Static WINS Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Adding static entries to your Samba-3 WINS server is actually fairly easy. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878652"></a>Static WINS Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Adding static entries to your Samba WINS server is actually fairly easy. All you have to do is add a line to <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt>, typically located in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var/locks</tt>. </p><p> Entries in <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt> take the form of </p><pre class="programlisting"> -"NAME#TYPE" TTL ADDRESS+ FLAGS +"NAME#TYPE" TTL ADDRESS+ FLAGS </pre><p> where NAME is the NetBIOS name, TYPE is the NetBIOS type, TTL is the @@ -2890,22 +2730,22 @@ flags for the registration. </p><p> A typical dynamic entry looks like: </p><pre class="programlisting"> -"MADMAN#03" 1055298378 192.168.1.2 66R +"MADMAN#03" 1055298378 192.168.1.2 66R </pre><p> To make it static, all that has to be done is set the TTL to 0: </p><pre class="programlisting"> -"MADMAN#03" 0 192.168.1.2 66R +"MADMAN#03" 0 192.168.1.2 66R </pre><p> </p><p> Though this method works with early Samba-3 versions, there's a possibility that it may change in future versions if WINS replication is added. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888154"></a>Helpful Hints</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878737"></a>Helpful Hints</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following hints should be carefully considered as they are stumbling points for many new network administrators. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888167"></a>Windows Networking Protocols</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878750"></a>Windows Networking Protocols</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Do NOT use more than one (1) protocol on MS Windows machines </p></div><p> A very common cause of browsing problems results from installing more than @@ -2917,7 +2757,7 @@ of precedence for winning this election process. A machine running Samba or Windows NT will be biased so that the most suitable machine will predictably win and thus retain it's role. </p><p> -The election process is "fought out" so to speak over every NetBIOS network +The election process is "fought out" so to speak over every NetBIOS network interface. In the case of a Windows 9x machine that has both TCP/IP and IPX installed and has NetBIOS enabled over both protocols the election will be decided over both protocols. As often happens, if the Windows 9x machine is @@ -2935,34 +2775,27 @@ differently from MS Windows NT4. Generally, where a server does NOT support the newer or extended protocol, these will fall back to the NT4 protocols. </em></span></p><p> The safest rule of all to follow it this - USE ONLY ONE PROTOCOL! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888234"></a>Name Resolution Order</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2878822"></a>Name Resolution Order</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Resolution of NetBIOS names to IP addresses can take place using a number of methods. The only ones that can provide NetBIOS name_type information are: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>WINS: the best tool!</td></tr><tr><td>LMHOSTS: is static and hard to maintain.</td></tr><tr><td>Broadcast: uses UDP and can not resolve names across remote segments.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>WINS: the best tool!</p></li><li><p>LMHOSTS: is static and hard to maintain.</p></li><li><p>Broadcast: uses UDP and can not resolve names across remote segments.</p></li></ul></div><p> Alternative means of name resolution includes: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>: is static, hard to maintain, and lacks name_type info</td></tr><tr><td>DNS: is a good choice but lacks essential name_type info.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt>: is static, hard to maintain, and lacks name_type info</p></li><li><p>DNS: is a good choice but lacks essential name_type info.</p></li></ul></div><p> Many sites want to restrict DNS lookups and want to avoid broadcast name -resolution traffic. The <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is -of great help here. The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> -parameter is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -name resolve order = wins lmhosts bcast host -</pre><p> +resolution traffic. The <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is of great help here. +The syntax of the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = wins lmhosts bcast host</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -name resolve order = wins lmhosts (eliminates bcast and host) -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = wins lmhosts (eliminates bcast and host)</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> The default is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -name resolve order = host lmhost wins bcast -</pre><p> -where "host" refers the the native methods used by the Unix system +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order = host lmhost wins bcast</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +where "host" refers to the native methods used by the UNIX system to implement the gethostbyname() function call. This is normally controlled by <tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888372"></a>Technical Overview of browsing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2878986"></a>Technical Overview of browsing</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> SMB networking provides a mechanism by which clients can access a list -of machines in a network, a so-called <i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>. This list +of machines in a network, a so-called <a class="indexterm" name="id2878999"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i>. This list contains machines that are ready to offer file and/or print services to other machines within the network. Thus it does not include machines which aren't currently able to do server tasks. The browse @@ -2980,7 +2813,7 @@ Where NetBIOS over TCP/IP is enabled use of a WINS server is highly recommended to aid the resolution of NetBIOS (SMB) names to IP addresses. WINS allows remote segment clients to obtain NetBIOS name_type information that can NOT be provided by any other means of name resolution. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888419"></a>Browsing support in Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879046"></a>Browsing support in Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba facilitates browsing. The browsing is supported by <span class="application">nmbd</span> and is also controlled by options in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. Samba can act as a local browse master for a workgroup and the ability @@ -3007,15 +2840,15 @@ WINS server capabilities. In a Samba-only environment, it is recommended that you use one and only one Samba server as your WINS server. </p></div><p> To get browsing to work you need to run nmbd as usual, but will need -to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2879114"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to control what workgroup Samba becomes a part of. </p><p> Samba also has a useful option for a Samba server to offer itself for browsing on another subnet. It is recommended that this option is only used for 'unusual' purposes: announcements over the internet, for -example. See <i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> in the +example. See <a class="indexterm" name="id2879144"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888526"></a>Problem resolution</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879168"></a>Problem resolution</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If something doesn't work then hopefully the log.nmbd file will help you track down the problem. Try a debug level of 2 or 3 for finding problems. Also note that the current browse list usually gets stored @@ -3026,7 +2859,7 @@ type the server name as <tt class="filename">\\SERVER</tt> in filemanager then hit enter and filemanager should display the list of available shares. </p><p> Some people find browsing fails because they don't have the global -<i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> set to a valid account. Remember that the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2879209"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> set to a valid account. Remember that the IPC$ connection that lists the shares is done as guest, and thus you must have a valid guest account. </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em> @@ -3038,9 +2871,9 @@ name of the currently logged in user to query the IPC$ share. MS Windows server resources. </em></span></p><p> The other big problem people have is that their broadcast address, -netmask or IP address is wrong (specified with the "interfaces" option +netmask or IP address is wrong (specified with the "interfaces" option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888605"></a>Browsing across subnets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879254"></a>Browsing across subnets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since the release of Samba 1.9.17(alpha1), Samba has supported the replication of browse lists across subnet boundaries. This section describes how to set this feature up in different settings. @@ -3061,32 +2894,14 @@ be they Windows 95, Windows NT, or Samba servers must have the IP address of a WINS server given to them by a DHCP server, or by manual configuration (for Win95 and WinNT, this is in the TCP/IP Properties, under Network settings) for Samba this is in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888654"></a>How does cross subnet browsing work ?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2879303"></a>How does cross subnet browsing work ?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Cross subnet browsing is a complicated dance, containing multiple moving parts. It has taken Microsoft several years to get the code that achieves this correct, and Samba lags behind in some areas. Samba is capable of cross subnet browsing when configured correctly. </p><p> -Consider a network set up as follows : -</p><p> - -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - (DMB) - N1_A N1_B N1_C N1_D N1_E - | | | | | - ------------------------------------------------------- - | subnet 1 | - +---+ +---+ - |R1 | Router 1 Router 2 |R2 | - +---+ +---+ - | | - | subnet 2 subnet 3 | - -------------------------- ------------------------------------ - | | | | | | | | - N2_A N2_B N2_C N2_D N3_A N3_B N3_C N3_D - (WINS) -</pre><p> -</p><p> + Consider a network set up as <a href="#browsing1" title="Figure 10.1. Cross subnet browsing example">in the diagram below</a>. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="browsing1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 10.1. Cross subnet browsing example</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/browsing1.png" width="270" alt="Cross subnet browsing example"></div></div><p> Consisting of 3 subnets (1, 2, 3) connected by two routers (R1, R2) - these do not pass broadcasts. Subnet 1 has 5 machines on it, subnet 2 has 4 machines, subnet 3 has 4 machines. Assume @@ -3128,7 +2943,7 @@ At this point the browse lists look as follows (these are the machines you would see in your network neighborhood if you looked in it on a particular network right now). </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2888772"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.1. Browse subnet example 1</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 1" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2879437"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.1. Browse subnet example 1</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 1" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> Note that at this point all the subnets are separate, no machine is seen across any of the subnets. @@ -3150,7 +2965,9 @@ the MasterAnnouncement packet it schedules a synchronization request to the sender of that packet. After both synchronizations are done the browse lists look like : </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2888886"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.2. Browse subnet example 2</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 2" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2879550"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.2. Browse subnet example 2</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 2" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. </p><p> @@ -3158,14 +2975,17 @@ At this point users looking in their network neighborhood on subnets 1 or 2 will see all the servers on both, users on subnet 3 will still only see the servers on their own subnet. </p><p> -The same sequence of events that occured for N2_B now occurs +The same sequence of events that occurred for N2_B now occurs for the local master browser on subnet 3 (N3_D). When it synchronizes browse lists with the domain master browser (N1_A) it gets both the server entries on subnet 1, and those on subnet 2. After N3_D has synchronized with N1_C and vica-versa the browse lists look like. </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2888985"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.3. Browse subnet example 3</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 3" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2879662"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.3. Browse subnet example 3</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 3" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. </p><p> @@ -3178,7 +2998,13 @@ with the domain master browser (N1_C) and will receive the missing server entries. Finally - and as a steady state (if no machines are removed or shut off) the browse lists will look like : </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2889086"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.4. Browse subnet example 4</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 4" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="left">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="left">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="left">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="left">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2879779"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 10.4. Browse subnet example 4</b></p><table summary="Browse subnet example 4" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Subnet</th><th align="left">Browse Master</th><th align="justify">List</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">Subnet1</td><td align="left">N1_C</td><td align="justify">N1_A, N1_B, N1_C, N1_D, N1_E, +N2_A(*), N2_B(*), N2_C(*), N2_D(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), +N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet2</td><td align="left">N2_B</td><td align="justify">N2_A, N2_B, N2_C, N2_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N3_A(*), N3_B(*), +N3_C(*), N3_D(*)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Subnet3</td><td align="left">N3_D</td><td align="justify">N3_A, N3_B, N3_C, N3_D, N1_A(*), +N1_B(*), N1_C(*), N1_D(*), N1_E(*), N2_A(*), N2_B(*), +N2_C(*), N2_D(*)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> Servers with a (*) after them are non-authoritative names. </p><p> @@ -3199,11 +3025,11 @@ If either router R1 or R2 fails the following will occur: be able to access servers on its local subnet, by using subnet-isolated broadcast NetBIOS name resolution. The effects are similar to that of losing access to a DNS server. - </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889225"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2879936"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many questions are asked on the mailing lists regarding browsing. The majority of browsing problems originate out of incorrect configuration of NetBIOS name resolution. Some are of particular note. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889240"></a>How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879950"></a>How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba's nmbd process controls all browse list handling. Under normal circumstances it is safe to restart nmbd. This will effectively flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache and cause it to be rebuilt. Note that this does NOT make certain that a rogue machine name will not re-appear @@ -3213,33 +3039,37 @@ want to clear a rogue machine from the list then every machine on the network wi shut down and restarted at after all machines are down. Failing a complete restart, the only other thing you can do is wait until the entry times out and is then flushed from the list. This may take a long time on some networks (months). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889269"></a>My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2879979"></a>My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Your guest account is probably invalid for some reason. Samba uses the guest account for browsing in smbd. Check that your guest account is valid. -</p><p>See also <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="passdb"></a>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Olivier (lem)</span> <span class="surname">Lemaire</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IDEALX<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 24, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2892812">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893140">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893204">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893458">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893513">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893545">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893811">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893963">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893999">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894038">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894145">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894173">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895689">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2896493">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896501">Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896516">Users are being added to the wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896576">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> -Samba-3 implements a new capability to work concurrently with multiple account backends. -The possible new combinations of password backends allows Samba-3 a degree of flexibility +</p><p>See also <a class="indexterm" name="id2879997"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880021"></a>I get an <span class="errorname">Unable to browse the network</span> error</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This error can have multiple causes:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>There is no local master browser. Configure <span class="application">nmbd</span> + or any other machine to serve as local master browser.</p></li><li><p>You can not log onto the machine that is the local master + browser. Can you logon to it as guest user? </p></li><li><p>There is no IP connectivity to the local master browser. + Can you reach it by broadcast?</p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="passdb"></a>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Olivier (lem)</span> <span class="surname">Lemaire</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IDEALX<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 24, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2880302">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880315">Backwards Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880417">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2880590">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2880717">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2880966">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881151">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881423">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2881676">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2881717">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881758">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881871">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2881898">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2883727">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2884575">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2884582">Users can not logon</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2884627">Users being added to wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2884738">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +Samba 3 implements a new capability to work concurrently with multiple account backends. +The possible new combinations of password backends allows Samba 3 a degree of flexibility and scalability that previously could be achieved only with MS Windows Active Directory. This chapter describes the new functionality and how to get the most out of it. </p><p> In the course of development of Samba-3, a number of requests were received to provide the ability to migrate MS Windows NT4 SAM accounts to Samba-3 without the need to provide -matching Unix/Linux accounts. We called this the <span class="emphasis"><em>Non Unix Accounts (NUA)</em></span> +matching UNIX/Linux accounts. We called this the <span class="emphasis"><em>Non UNIX Accounts (NUA)</em></span> capability. The intent was that an administrator could decide to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> -backend and by simply specifying <span class="emphasis"><em>"passdb backend = tdbsam_nua, guest"</em></span> -this would allow Samba-3 to implement a solution that did not use Unix accounts per se. Late +backend and by simply specifying <a class="indexterm" name="id2880269"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam_nua +this would allow Samba-3 to implement a solution that did not use UNIX accounts per se. Late in the development cycle, the team doing this work hit upon some obstacles that prevents this solution from being used. Given the delays with Samba-3 release a decision was made to NOT deliver this functionality until a better method of recognising NT Group SIDs from NT User SIDs could be found. This feature may thus return during the life cycle for the Samba-3 series. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -Samba-3.0.0 does NOT support Non-Unix Account (NUA) operation. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892812"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 does NOT support Non-UNIX Account (NUA) operation for user accounts. +Samba-3 does support NUA operation for machine accounts. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880302"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 provides for complete backwards compatibility with Samba-2.2.x functionality as follows: -</p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>Backwards Compatibility Backends</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">Plain Text:</span></dt><dd><p> - This option uses nothing but the Unix/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880315"></a>Backwards Compatibility Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Plain Text:</span></dt><dd><p> + This option uses nothing but the UNIX/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> style back end. On systems that have PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) support all PAM modules are supported. The behaviour is just as it was with Samba-2.2.x, and the protocol limitations imposed by MS Windows clients @@ -3261,13 +3091,9 @@ as follows: This option is provided primarily as a migration tool, although there is no reason to force migration at this time. Note that this tool will eventually be deprecated. - </p></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880417"></a>New Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: -</p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>New Backends</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">guest:</span></dt><dd><p> - This is <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> required as the last backend specified. - It provides the ability to handle guest account requirements for access to - resources like <i class="parameter"><tt>IPC$</tt></i> which is used for browsing. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">tdbsam:</span></dt><dd><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">tdbsam:</span></dt><dd><p> This backend provides a rich database backend for local servers. This backend is NOT suitable for multiple domain controller (ie: PDC + one or more BDC) installations. @@ -3293,7 +3119,7 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: </p><p> The new LDAP implementation significantly expands the control abilities that were possible with prior versions of Samba. It is now possible to specify - "per user" profile settings, home directories, account access controls, and + "per user" profile settings, home directories, account access controls, and much more. Corporate sites will see that the Samba-Team has listened to their requests both for capability and to allow greater scalability. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">mysqlsam (MySQL based backend):</span></dt><dd><p> @@ -3309,10 +3135,7 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: The xmlsam option can be useful for account migration between database backends or backups. Use of this tool will allow the data to be edited before migration into another backend format. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">nisplussam:</span></dt><dd><p> - The NIS+ based passdb backend. Takes name NIS domain as an - optional argument. Only works with Sun NIS+ servers. - </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893140"></a>Technical Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2880590"></a>Technical Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Old windows clients send plain text passwords over the wire. Samba can check these passwords by crypting them and comparing them to the hash stored in the unix user database. </p><p> @@ -3327,16 +3150,16 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: In addition to differently encrypted passwords, windows also stores certain data for each user that is not stored in a unix user database. e.g: workstations the user may logon from, the location where the users' profile is stored, and so on. Samba retrieves and stores this - information using a <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Commonly available backends are LDAP, plain text + information using a <a class="indexterm" name="id2880630"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Commonly available backends are LDAP, plain text file, MySQL and nisplus. For more information, see the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> regarding the - <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> parameter. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893204"></a>Important Notes About Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2880654"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> parameter. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-diag"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 11.1. IDMAP</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP"></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880717"></a>Important Notes About Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The unix and SMB password encryption techniques seem similar on the surface. This similarity is, however, only skin deep. The unix scheme typically sends clear text passwords over the network when logging in. This is bad. The SMB encryption scheme never sends the cleartext password over the network but it does store the 16 byte hashed values on disk. This is also bad. Why? Because the 16 byte hashed values - are a "password equivalent". You cannot derive the user's password from them, but + are a "password equivalent". You cannot derive the user's password from them, but they could potentially be used in a modified client to gain access to a server. This would require considerable technical knowledge on behalf of the attacker but is perfectly possible. You should thus treat the data stored in whatever passdb @@ -3354,12 +3177,12 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: </p><p> The following versions of MS Windows do not support full domain security protocols, although they may log onto a domain environment: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>MS DOS Network client 3.0 with the basic network redirector installed</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 95 with the network redirector update installed</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 98 [se]</td></tr><tr><td>Windows Me</td></tr></table><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>MS DOS Network client 3.0 with the basic network redirector installed</p></li><li><p>Windows 95 with the network redirector update installed</p></li><li><p>Windows 98 [se]</p></li><li><p>Windows Me</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> MS Windows XP Home does not have facilities to become a domain member and it can not participate in domain logons. </p></div><p> The following versions of MS Windows fully support domain security protocols. - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Windows NT 3.5x</td></tr><tr><td>Windows NT 4.0</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 2000 Professional</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 200x Server/Advanced Server</td></tr><tr><td>Windows XP Professional</td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows NT 3.5x</p></li><li><p>Windows NT 4.0</p></li><li><p>Windows 2000 Professional</p></li><li><p>Windows 200x Server/Advanced Server</p></li><li><p>Windows XP Professional</p></li></ul></div><p> All current release of Microsoft SMB/CIFS clients support authentication via the SMB Challenge/Response mechanism described here. Enabling clear text authentication does not disable the ability of the client to participate in encrypted authentication. @@ -3372,7 +3195,7 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: (broken) only the cached (encrypted) password will be sent to the resource server to affect a auto-reconnect. If the resource server does not support encrypted passwords the auto-reconnect will fail. <span class="emphasis"><em>USE OF ENCRYPTED PASSWORDS IS STRONGLY ADVISED.</em></span> - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893368"></a>Advantages of Encrypted Passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not passed across + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880875"></a>Advantages of Encrypted Passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not passed across the network. Someone using a network sniffer cannot just record passwords going to the SMB server.</p></li><li><p>Plain text passwords are not stored anywhere in memory or on disk.</p></li><li><p>WinNT doesn't like talking to a server @@ -3383,32 +3206,44 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: only things you can do to stop this is to use SMB encryption. </p></li><li><p>Encrypted password support allows automatic share (resource) reconnects.</p></li><li><p>Encrypted passwords are essential for PDC/BDC - operation.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893422"></a>Advantages of non-encrypted passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not kept + operation.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2880929"></a>Advantages of non-encrypted passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not kept on disk, and are NOT cached in memory. </p></li><li><p>Uses same password file as other unix services such as login and ftp</p></li><li><p>Use of other services (such as telnet and ftp) which send plain text passwords over the net, so sending them for SMB - isn't such a big deal.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893458"></a>Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Every operation in Unix/Linux requires a user identifier (UID), just as in + isn't such a big deal.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2880966"></a>Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Every operation in UNIX/Linux requires a user identifier (UID), just as in MS Windows NT4 / 200x this requires a Security Identifier (SID). Samba provides - two means for mapping an MS Windows user to a Unix/Linux UID. + two means for mapping an MS Windows user to a UNIX/Linux UID. </p><p> Firstly, all Samba SAM (Security Account Manager database) accounts require - a Unix/Linux UID that the account will map to. As users are added to the account - information database, Samba-3 will call the <i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> - interface to add the account to the Samba host OS. In essence, all accounts in + a UNIX/Linux UID that the account will map to. As users are added to the account + information database, Samba will call the <a class="indexterm" name="id2880988"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> + interface to add the account to the Samba host OS. In essence all accounts in the local SAM require a local user account. </p><p> - The second way to affect Windows SID to Unix UID mapping is via the + The second way to affect Windows SID to UNIX UID mapping is via the <span class="emphasis"><em>idmap uid, idmap gid</em></span> parameters in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Please refer to the man page for information about these parameters. These parameters are essential when mapping users from a remote SAM server. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893513"></a>Account Management Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba-3 provides two (2) tools for management of User and machine accounts. These tools are + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="idmapbackend"></a>Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba-3 has a special facility that makes it possible to maintain identical UIDs and GIDs + on all servers in a distributed network. A distributed network is one where there exists + a PDC, one or more BDCs and/or one or more domain member servers. Why is this important? + This is important if files are being shared over more than one protocol (eg: NFS) and where + users are copying files across UNIX/Linux systems using tools such as <b class="command">rsync</b>. + </p><p> + The special facility is enabled using a parameter called <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i>. + The default setting for this parameter is an empty string. Administrators should NOT set this + parameter except when an LDAP based passdb backend is in use. An example of use is: + </p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="idmapbackendexample"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.1. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam://ldap-server.quenya.org:636</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="acctmgmttools"></a>Account Management Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba provides two (2) tools for management of User and machine accounts. These tools are called <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> and <b class="command">pdbedit</b>. A third tool is under development but is NOT expected to ship in time for Samba-3.0.0. The new tool will be a TCL/TK GUI tool that looks much like the MS Windows NT4 Domain User Manager - hopefully this will be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893545"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881151"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The smbpasswd utility is a utility similar to the <b class="command">passwd</b> or <b class="command">yppasswd</b> programs. It maintains the two 32 byte password fields in the passdb backend. @@ -3422,19 +3257,19 @@ be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. if changing an NT Domain user's password). </p><p> <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> can be used to: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>add</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>delete</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>enable</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>disable</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>set to NULL</em></span> user passwords</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>manage interdomain trust accounts</em></span></td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>add</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>delete</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>enable</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>disable</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>set to NULL</em></span> user passwords</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>manage interdomain trust accounts</em></span></p></li></ul></div><p> To run smbpasswd as a normal user just type: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">Old SMB password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Old SMB password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> For <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> type old value here - or hit return if there was no old password - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">Repeat New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Repeat New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> If the old value does not match the current value stored for that user, or the two new values do not match each other, then the password will not be changed. @@ -3454,10 +3289,10 @@ be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. </p><p> For more details on using <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> refer to the man page (the definitive reference). - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893811"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>pdbedit</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881423"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>pdbedit</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <b class="command">pdbedit</b> is a tool that can be used only by root. It is used to manage the passdb backend. <b class="command">pdbedit</b> can be used to: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>add, remove or modify user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>listing user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>migrate user accounts</td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>add, remove or modify user accounts</p></li><li><p>listing user accounts</p></li><li><p>migrate user accounts</p></li></ul></div><p> The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> tool is the only one that can manage the account security and policy settings. It is capable of all operations that smbpasswd can do as well as a super set of them. @@ -3469,50 +3304,60 @@ be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. The following is an example of the user account information that is stored in a tdbsam password backend. This listing was produced by running: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv met</tt></b> - Unix username: met - NT username: - Account Flags: [UX ] - User SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-2004 - Primary Group SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-1201 - Full Name: Melissa E Terpstra - Home Directory: \\frodo\met\Win9Profile - HomeDir Drive: H: - Logon Script: scripts\logon.bat - Profile Path: \\frodo\Profiles\met - Domain: MIDEARTH - Account desc: - Workstations: melbelle - Munged dial: - Logon time: 0 - Logoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT - Kickoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT - Password last set: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT - Password can change: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT - Password must change: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT - </pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893963"></a>Password Backends</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba-3 offers the greatest flexibility in backend account database design of any SMB/CIFS server +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv met</tt></b> +UNIX username: met +NT username: +Account Flags: [UX ] +User SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-2004 +Primary Group SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-1201 +Full Name: Melissa E Terpstra +Home Directory: \\frodo\met\Win9Profile +HomeDir Drive: H: +Logon Script: scripts\logon.bat +Profile Path: \\frodo\Profiles\met +Domain: MIDEARTH +Account desc: +Workstations: melbelle +Munged dial: +Logon time: 0 +Logoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +Kickoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +Password last set: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT +Password can change: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT +Password must change: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +</pre><p> + The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> tool allows migration of authentication (account) + databases from one backend to another. For example: To migrate accounts from an + old <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database to a <i class="parameter"><tt>tdbsam</tt></i> + backend: + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2881606"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam, smbpasswd. + </p></li><li><p> + Execute: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -i smbpassed -e tdbsam</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p> + Now remove the <i class="parameter"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></i> from the passdb backend + configuration in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + </p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2881676"></a>Password Backends</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba offers the greatest flexibility in backend account database design of any SMB/CIFS server technology available today. The flexibility is immediately obvious as one begins to explore this capability. </p><p> It is possible to specify not only multiple different password backends, but even multiple backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[globals] - passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/passdb.tdb, \ - tdbsam:/etc/samba/old-passdb.tdb, guest -</pre><p> -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893999"></a>Plain Text</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/passdb.tdb, tdbsam:/etc/samba/old-passdb.tdb</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881717"></a>Plain Text</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Older versions of Samba retrieved user information from the unix user database and eventually some other fields from the file <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/smbpasswd</tt>. When password encryption is disabled, no SMB specific data is stored at all. Instead all operations are conducted via the way that the Samba host OS will access its <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> database. eg: On Linux systems that is done via PAM. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894038"></a>smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Traditionally, when configuring <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt - passwords = yes</a> in Samba's <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, user account + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881758"></a>smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Traditionally, when configuring <a class="indexterm" name="id2881768"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes in Samba's <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, user account information such as username, LM/NT password hashes, password change times, and account flags have been stored in the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd(5)</tt> file. There are several disadvantages to this approach for sites with very large numbers of users (counted @@ -3538,10 +3383,10 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: is commonly referred to as the samdb interface (previously this was called the passdb API, and is still so named in the Samba CVS trees). </p><p> - Samba-3 provides an enhanced set of passdb backends that overcome the deficiencies + Samba provides an enhanced set of passdb backends that overcome the deficiencies of the smbpasswd plain text database. These are tdbsam, ldapsam, and xmlsam. Of these ldapsam will be of most interest to large corporate or enterprise sites. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894145"></a>tdbsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba can store user and machine account data in a "TDB" (Trivial Database). + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881871"></a>tdbsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba can store user and machine account data in a "TDB" (Trivial Database). Using this backend doesn't require any additional configuration. This backend is recommended for new installations that do not require LDAP. </p><p> @@ -3549,7 +3394,7 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: that have 250 or more users. Additionally, tdbsam is not capable of scaling for use in sites that require PDB/BDC implementations that requires replication of the account database. Clearly, for reason of scalability, the use of ldapsam should be encouraged. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894173"></a>ldapsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2881898"></a>ldapsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a few points to stress that the ldapsam does not provide. The LDAP support referred to in the this documentation does not include: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A means of retrieving user account information from @@ -3557,8 +3402,8 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: The second item can be accomplished by using LDAP NSS and PAM modules. LGPL versions of these libraries can be obtained from PADL Software (<a href="http://www.padl.com/" target="_top">http://www.padl.com/</a>). More - information about the configuration of these packages may be found at "LDAP, - System Administration; Gerald Carter, O'Reilly; Chapter 6: Replacing NIS". + information about the configuration of these packages may be found at "LDAP, + System Administration; Gerald Carter, O'Reilly; Chapter 6: Replacing NIS". Refer to <a href="http://safari.oreilly.com/?XmlId=1-56592-491-6" target="_top"> http://safari.oreilly.com/?XmlId=1-56592-491-6</a> for those who might wish to know more about configuration and administration of an OpenLDAP server. @@ -3572,28 +3417,30 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: and has a working directory server already installed. For more information on LDAP architectures and Directories, please refer to the following sites. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>OpenLDAP - <a href="http://www.openldap.org/" target="_top">http://www.openldap.org/</a></p></li><li><p>iPlanet Directory Server - - <a href="http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory" target="_top">http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory</a></p></li></ul></div><p> + <a href="http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory" target="_top">http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory</a></p></li></ul></div><p> Two additional Samba resources which may prove to be helpful are </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The <a href="http://www.unav.es/cti/ldap-smb/ldap-smb-3-howto.html" target="_top">Samba-PDC-LDAP-HOWTO</a> maintained by Ignacio Coupeau.</p></li><li><p>The NT migration scripts from <a href="http://samba.idealx.org/" target="_top">IDEALX</a> that are geared to manage users and group in such a Samba-LDAP Domain Controller configuration. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894325"></a>Supported LDAP Servers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882050"></a>Supported LDAP Servers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The LDAP ldapsam code has been developed and tested using the OpenLDAP 2.0 and 2.1 server and client libraries. The same code should work with Netscape's Directory Server and client SDK. However, there are bound to be compile errors and bugs. These should not be hard to fix. Please submit fixes via <a href="#bugreport" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs">Bug reporting facility</a>. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894351"></a>Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882076"></a>Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba 3.0 includes the necessary schema file for OpenLDAP 2.0 in <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP/samba.schema</tt>. The sambaSamAccount objectclass is given here: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> -objectclass ( 1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.3 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY - DESC 'Samba Auxiliary Account' - MUST ( uid $ rid ) - MAY ( cn $ lmPassword $ ntPassword $ pwdLastSet $ logonTime $ - logoffTime $ kickoffTime $ pwdCanChange $ pwdMustChange $ acctFlags $ - displayName $ smbHome $ homeDrive $ scriptPath $ profilePath $ - description $ userWorkstations $ primaryGroupID $ domain )) +objectclass ( 1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.6 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY + DESC 'Samba 3.0 Auxiliary SAM Account' + MUST ( uid $ sambaSID ) + MAY ( cn $ sambaLMPassword $ sambaNTPassword $ sambaPwdLastSet $ + sambaLogonTime $ sambaLogoffTime $ sambaKickoffTime $ + sambaPwdCanChange $ sambaPwdMustChange $ sambaAcctFlags $ + displayName $ sambaHomePath $ sambaHomeDrive $ sambaLogonScript $ + sambaProfilePath $ description $ sambaUserWorkstations $ + sambaPrimaryGroupSID $ sambaDomainName )) </pre><p> </p><p> The <tt class="filename">samba.schema</tt> file has been formatted for OpenLDAP 2.0/2.1. @@ -3617,7 +3464,7 @@ objectclass ( 1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.3 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY and functioning correctly. This division of information makes it possible to store all Samba account information in LDAP, but still maintain UNIX account information in NIS while the network is transitioning to a full LDAP infrastructure. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894458"></a>OpenLDAP configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882187"></a>OpenLDAP configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To include support for the sambaSamAccount object in an OpenLDAP directory server, first copy the samba.schema file to slapd's configuration directory. The samba.schema file can be found in the directory <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP</tt> @@ -3651,7 +3498,7 @@ include /etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema like in the following example, to speed up searches made on sambaSamAccount objectclasses (and possibly posixAccount and posixGroup as well). </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> # Indices to maintain ## required by OpenLDAP index objectclass eq @@ -3678,7 +3525,7 @@ index default sub Create the new index by executing: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -./sbin/slapindex -f slapd.conf +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>./sbin/slapindex -f slapd.conf </pre><p> </p><p> Remember to restart slapd after making these changes: @@ -3686,34 +3533,34 @@ index default sub </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/etc/init.d/slapd restart</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894646"></a>Initialise the LDAP database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882382"></a>Initialise the LDAP database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before you can add accounts to the LDAP database you must create the account containers that they will be stored in. The following LDIF file should be modified to match your needs (ie: Your DNS entries, etc.). </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> # Organization for Samba Base -dn: dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: dc=quenya,dc=org objectclass: dcObject objectclass: organization -dc: plainjoe -o: Terpstra Org Network +dc: quenya +o: Quenya Org Network description: The Samba-3 Network LDAP Example # Organizational Role for Directory Management -dn: cn=Manager,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: cn=Manager,dc=quenya,dc=org objectclass: organizationalRole cn: Manager description: Directory Manager # Setting up container for users -dn: ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org objectclass: top objectclass: organizationalUnit ou: People # Setting up admin handle for People OU -dn: cn=admin,ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: cn=admin,ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org cn: admin objectclass: top objectclass: organizationalRole @@ -3735,70 +3582,39 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Before Samba can access the LDAP server you need to store the LDAP admin password into the Samba-3 <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> database by: - </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894774"></a>Configuring Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882509"></a>Configuring Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following parameters are available in smb.conf only if your version of samba was built with LDAP support. Samba automatically builds with LDAP support if the LDAP libraries are found. - </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND" target="_top">passdb backend = ldapsam:url</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSSL" target="_top">ldap ssl</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN" target="_top">ldap admin dn</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX" target="_top">ldap suffix</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPFILTER" target="_top">ldap filter</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPMACHINSUFFIX" target="_top">ldap machine suffix</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPUSERSUFFIX" target="_top">ldap user suffix</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPDELETEDN" target="_top">ldap delete dn</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPPASSWDSYNC" target="_top">ldap passwd sync</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPTRUSTIDS" target="_top">ldap trust ids</a></p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><p>LDAP related smb.conf options: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882527"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = ldapsam:url, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882543"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882556"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882570"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882583"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882597"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882611"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882625"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882639"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2882653"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap trust ids</tt></i>. + </p><p> These are described in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page and so will not be repeated here. However, a sample smb.conf file for use with an LDAP directory could appear as </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -## /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf -[global] - security = user - encrypt passwords = yes - - netbios name = TASHTEGO - workgroup = NARNIA - - # ldap related parameters - - # define the DN to use when binding to the directory servers - # The password for this DN is not stored in smb.conf. Rather it - # must be set by using 'smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secretpw</tt></i>' to store the - # passphrase in the secrets.tdb file. If the "ldap admin dn" values - # change, this password will need to be reset. - ldap admin dn = "cn=Samba Manager,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org" - - # Define the SSL option when connecting to the directory - # ('off', 'start tls', or 'on' (default)) - ldap ssl = start tls - - # syntax: passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://server-name[:port] - passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://funball.samba.org, guest - - # smbpasswd -x delete the entire dn-entry - ldap delete dn = no - - # the machine and user suffix added to the base suffix - # wrote WITHOUT quotes. NULL suffixes by default - ldap user suffix = ou=People - ldap machine suffix = ou=Systems - - # Trust unix account information in LDAP - # (see the smb.conf manpage for details) - ldap trust ids = Yes - - # specify the base DN to use when searching the directory - ldap suffix = "ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org" - - # generally the default ldap search filter is ok - # ldap filter = "(&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaSamAccount))" -</pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2894972"></a>Accounts and Groups management</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2882685"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.2. Configuration with LDAP</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = TASHTEGO</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = NARNIA</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># ldap related parameters</td></tr><tr><td># define the DN to use when binding to the directory servers</td></tr><tr><td># The password for this DN is not stored in smb.conf. Rather it</td></tr><tr><td># must be set by using 'smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secretpw</tt></i>' to store the</td></tr><tr><td># passphrase in the secrets.tdb file. If the "ldap admin dn" values</td></tr><tr><td># change, this password will need to be reset.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn = "cn=Samba Manager,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org"</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Define the SSL option when connecting to the directory</td></tr><tr><td># ('off', 'start tls', or 'on' (default))</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = start tls</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># syntax: passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://server-name[:port]</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://funball.samba.org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># smbpasswd -x delete the entire dn-entry</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># the machine and user suffix added to the base suffix</td></tr><tr><td># wrote WITHOUT quotes. NULL suffixes by default</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix = ou=People</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix = ou=Systems</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Trust unix account information in LDAP</td></tr><tr><td># (see the smb.conf manpage for details)</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap trust ids = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># specify the base DN to use when searching the directory</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix = "ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org"</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># generally the default ldap search filter is ok</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter = "(&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaSamAccount))"</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882906"></a>Accounts and Groups management</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> As users accounts are managed through the sambaSamAccount objectclass, you should modify your existing administration tools to deal with sambaSamAccount attributes. </p><p> Machines accounts are managed with the sambaSamAccount objectclass, just like users accounts. However, it's up to you to store those accounts in a different tree of your LDAP namespace: you should use - "ou=Groups,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" to store groups and - "ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" to store users. Just configure your + "ou=Groups,dc=quenya,dc=org" to store groups and + "ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org" to store users. Just configure your NSS and PAM accordingly (usually, in the /etc/ldap.conf configuration file). </p><p> @@ -3806,7 +3622,7 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz groups. This means that Samba makes use of the posixGroup objectclass. For now, there is no NT-like group system management (global and local groups). - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895009"></a>Security and sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2882943"></a>Security and sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are two important points to remember when discussing the security of sambaSamAccount entries in the directory. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Never</em></span> retrieve the lmPassword or @@ -3817,13 +3633,13 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz on the details of LM/NT password hashes, refer to the <a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database</a> section of this chapter. </p><p> - To remedy the first security issue, the <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter defaults - to require an encrypted session (<i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = on</tt></i>) using + To remedy the first security issue, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2883003"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter defaults + to require an encrypted session (<a class="indexterm" name="id2883024"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = on) using the default port of <tt class="constant">636</tt> when contacting the directory server. When using an OpenLDAP server, it is possible to use the use the StartTLS LDAP extended operation in the place of LDAPS. In either case, you are strongly discouraged to disable this security - (<i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = off</tt></i>). + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2883046"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = off). </p><p> Note that the LDAPS protocol is deprecated in favor of the LDAPv3 StartTLS extended operation. However, the OpenLDAP library still provides support for @@ -3834,86 +3650,85 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz following ACL in <tt class="filename">slapd.conf</tt>: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> -## allow the "ldap admin dn" access, but deny everyone else +## allow the "ldap admin dn" access, but deny everyone else access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword - by dn="cn=Samba Admin,ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" write + by dn="cn=Samba Admin,ou=people,dc=quenya,dc=org" write by * none </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895146"></a>LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2883102"></a>LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The sambaSamAccount objectclass is composed of the following attributes: </p><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2895163"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.1. Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</b></p><table summary="Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt></td><td align="left">the LANMAN password 16-byte hash stored as a character - representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt></td><td align="left">the NT password hash 16-byte stored as a character - representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">pwdLastSet</tt></td><td align="left">The integer time in seconds since 1970 when the - <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> attributes were last set. - </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">acctFlags</tt></td><td align="left">string of 11 characters surrounded by square brackets [] + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2883118"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.1. Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</b></p><table summary="Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLMPassword</tt></td><td align="justify">the LANMAN password 16-byte hash stored as a character +representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaNTPassword</tt></td><td align="justify">the NT password hash 16-byte stored as a character + representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdLastSet</tt></td><td align="justify">The integer time in seconds since 1970 when the + <tt class="constant">sambaLMPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">sambaNTPassword</tt> attributes were last set. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaAcctFlags</tt></td><td align="justify">string of 11 characters surrounded by square brackets [] representing account flags such as U (user), W(workstation), X(no password expiration), I(Domain trust account), H(Home dir required), S(Server trust account), - and D(disabled).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">logonTime</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">logoffTime</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">kickoffTime</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">pwdCanChange</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">pwdMustChange</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">homeDrive</tt></td><td align="left">specifies the drive letter to which to map the - UNC path specified by homeDirectory. The drive letter must be specified in the form "X:" - where X is the letter of the drive to map. Refer to the "logon drive" parameter in the - smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">scriptPath</tt></td><td align="left">The scriptPath property specifies the path of + and D(disabled).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogonTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogoffTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaKickoffTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdCanChange</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdMustChange</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaHomeDrive</tt></td><td align="justify">specifies the drive letter to which to map the + UNC path specified by sambaHomePath. The drive letter must be specified in the form "X:" + where X is the letter of the drive to map. Refer to the "logon drive" parameter in the + smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogonScript</tt></td><td align="justify">The sambaLogonScript property specifies the path of the user's logon script, .CMD, .EXE, or .BAT file. The string can be null. The path - is relative to the netlogon share. Refer to the "logon script" parameter in the - smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">profilePath</tt></td><td align="left">specifies a path to the user's profile. + is relative to the netlogon share. Refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id2883286"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i> parameter in the + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaProfilePath</tt></td><td align="justify">specifies a path to the user's profile. This value can be a null string, a local absolute path, or a UNC path. Refer to the - "logon path" parameter in the smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">smbHome</tt></td><td align="left">The homeDirectory property specifies the path of - the home directory for the user. The string can be null. If homeDrive is set and specifies - a drive letter, homeDirectory should be a UNC path. The path must be a network - UNC path of the form <tt class="filename">\\server\share\directory</tt>. This value can be a null string. - Refer to the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information. - </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">userWorkstation</tt></td><td align="left">character string value currently unused. - </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">rid</tt></td><td align="left">the integer representation of the user's relative identifier - (RID).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">primaryGroupID</tt></td><td align="left">the relative identifier (RID) of the primary group - of the user.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">domain</tt></td><td align="left">domain the user is part of.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2883321"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaHomePath</tt></td><td align="justify">The sambaHomePath property specifies the path of +the home directory for the user. The string can be null. If sambaHomeDrive is set and specifies +a drive letter, sambaHomePath should be a UNC path. The path must be a network +UNC path of the form <tt class="filename">\\server\share\directory</tt>. This value can be a null string. +Refer to the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaUserWorkstations</tt></td><td align="justify">character string value currently unused. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaSID</tt></td><td align="justify">The security identifier(SID) of the user. The windows equivalent of unix uid's.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPrimaryGroupSID</tt></td><td align="justify">the relative identifier (RID) of the primary group + of the user.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaDomainName</tt></td><td align="justify">domain the user is part of.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> The majority of these parameters are only used when Samba is acting as a PDC of a domain (refer to the <a href="#samba-pdc" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Samba as a primary domain controller</a> chapter for details on how to configure Samba as a Primary Domain Controller). The following four attributes are only stored with the sambaSamAccount entry if the values are non-default values: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>smbHome</td></tr><tr><td>scriptPath</td></tr><tr><td>logonPath</td></tr><tr><td>homeDrive</td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>sambaHomePath</p></li><li><p>sambaLogonScript</p></li><li><p>sambaProfilePath</p></li><li><p>sambaHomeDrive</p></li></ul></div><p> These attributes are only stored with the sambaSamAccount entry if the values are non-default values. For example, assume TASHTEGO has now been - configured as a PDC and that <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%u</tt></i> was defined in - its <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. When a user named "becky" logons to the domain, - the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> string is expanded to \\TASHTEGO\becky. - If the smbHome attribute exists in the entry "uid=becky,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org", + configured as a PDC and that <a class="indexterm" name="id2883477"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> = \\%L\%u was defined in + its <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. When a user named "becky" logons to the domain, + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2883500"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> string is expanded to \\TASHTEGO\becky. + If the smbHome attribute exists in the entry "uid=becky,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org", this value is used. However, if this attribute does not exist, then the value - of the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter is used in its place. Samba + of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2883517"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter is used in its place. Samba will only write the attribute value to the directory entry if the value is something other than the default (e.g. <tt class="filename">\\MOBY\becky</tt>). - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895512"></a>Example LDIF Entries for a sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2883543"></a>Example LDIF Entries for a sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following is a working LDIF with the inclusion of the posixAccount objectclass: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> - dn: uid=guest2, ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org - ntPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 - pwdMustChange: 2147483647 - primaryGroupID: 1201 - lmPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE - pwdLastSet: 1010179124 - logonTime: 0 + dn: uid=guest2, ou=people,dc=quenya,dc=org + sambaNTPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 + sambaPwdMustChange: 2147483647 + sambaPrimaryGroupSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-513 + sambaNTPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE + sambaPwdLastSet: 1010179124 + sambaLogonTime: 0 objectClass: sambaSamAccount uid: guest2 - kickoffTime: 2147483647 - acctFlags: [UX ] - logoffTime: 2147483647 - rid: 19006 - pwdCanChange: 0 + sambaKickoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaAcctFlags: [UX ] + sambaLogoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5006 + sambaPwdCanChange: 0 </pre><p> </p><p> The following is an LDIF entry for using both the sambaSamAccount and posixAccount objectclasses: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> - dn: uid=gcarter, ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org - logonTime: 0 + dn: uid=gcarter, ou=people,dc=quenya,dc=org + sambaLogonTime: 0 displayName: Gerald Carter - lmPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE - primaryGroupID: 1201 + sambaLMPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE + sambaPrimaryGroupSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-1201 objectClass: posixAccount objectClass: sambaSamAccount - acctFlags: [UX ] + sambaAcctFlags: [UX ] userPassword: {crypt}BpM2ej8Rkzogo uid: gcarter uidNumber: 9000 @@ -3921,60 +3736,59 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword loginShell: /bin/bash logoffTime: 2147483647 gidNumber: 100 - kickoffTime: 2147483647 - pwdLastSet: 1010179230 - rid: 19000 + sambaKickoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaPwdLastSet: 1010179230 + sambaSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004 homeDirectory: /home/tashtego/gcarter - pwdCanChange: 0 - pwdMustChange: 2147483647 - ntPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 + sambaPwdCanChange: 0 + sambaPwdMustChange: 2147483647 + sambaNTPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 </pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895574"></a>Password synchronisation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2883609"></a>Password synchronisation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since version 3.0 samba can update the non-samba (LDAP) password stored with an account. When using pam_ldap, this allows changing both unix and windows passwords at once. - </p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i> options can have the following values:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">yes</span></dt><dd><p>When the user changes his password, update + </p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2883627"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i> options can have the following values:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">yes</span></dt><dd><p>When the user changes his password, update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt>, <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt> - and the <tt class="constant">password</tt> fields.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">no</span></dt><dd><p>Only update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">only</span></dt><dd><p>Only update the LDAP password and let the LDAP server worry - about the other fields. This option is only available when the LDAP server supports LDAP_EXOP_X_MODIFY_PASSWD. </p></dd></dl></div><p>More information can be found in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPPASSWDSYNC" target="_top">smb.conf</a> manpage. - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895689"></a>MySQL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + and the <tt class="constant">password</tt> fields.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">no</span></dt><dd><p>Only update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">only</span></dt><dd><p>Only update the LDAP password and let the LDAP server worry about the other fields. This option is only available on some LDAP servers. <sup>[<a name="id2883711" href="#ftn.id2883711">3</a>]</sup></p></dd></dl></div><p>More information can be found in the smb.conf manpage. + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2883727"></a>MySQL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every so often someone will come along with a great new idea. Storing of user accounts in an SQL backend is one of them. Those who want to do this are in the best position to know what the specific benefits are to them. This may sound like a cop-out, but in truth we can not attempt to document every nitty little detail why certain things of marginal utility to the bulk of Samba users might make sense to the rest. In any case, the following instructions should help the determined SQL user to implement a working system. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895709"></a>Creating the database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2883748"></a>Creating the database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You either can set up your own table and specify the field names to pdb_mysql (see below for the column names) or use the default table. The file <tt class="filename">examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt> contains the correct queries to create the required tables. Use the command : - </p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mysql -u<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> -h<i class="replaceable"><tt>hostname</tt></i> -p<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i> \ -<i class="replaceable"><tt>databasename</tt></i> < <tt class="filename">/path/to/samba/examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt></tt></b></pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2895772"></a>Configuring</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>This plugin lacks some good documentation, but here is some short info:</p><p>Add a the following to the <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> variable in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - passdb backend = [other-plugins] mysql:identifier [other-plugins] - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mysql -u<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> -h<i class="replaceable"><tt>hostname</tt></i> -p<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i> \ +<i class="replaceable"><tt>databasename</tt></i> < <tt class="filename">/path/to/samba/examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2883816"></a>Configuring</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>This plugin lacks some good documentation, but here is some short info:</p><p>Add a the following to the <a class="indexterm" name="id2883830"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> variable in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = [other-plugins] mysql:identifier [other-plugins]</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p>The identifier can be any string you like, as long as it doesn't collide with the identifiers of other plugins or other instances of pdb_mysql. If you - specify multiple pdb_mysql.so entries in <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>, you also need to + specify multiple pdb_mysql.so entries in <a class="indexterm" name="id2883875"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>, you also need to use different identifiers! </p><p> Additional options can be given through the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section. </p><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2895850"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.2. Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql host</td><td align="left">host name, defaults to 'localhost'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql password</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql user</td><td align="left">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql database</td><td align="left">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql port</td><td align="left">defaults to 3306</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:table</td><td align="left">Name of the table containing users</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2883914"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.2. Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="justify">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">mysql host</td><td align="justify">host name, defaults to 'localhost'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql password</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql user</td><td align="justify">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql database</td><td align="justify">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql port</td><td align="justify">defaults to 3306</td></tr><tr><td align="left">table</td><td align="justify">Name of the table containing users</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Since the password for the MySQL user is stored in the - <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, you should make the the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, you should make the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file readable only to the user that runs Samba This is considered a security bug and will be fixed soon. </p></div><p>Names of the columns in this table (I've added column types those columns should have first):</p><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2895975"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.3. MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Type</th><th align="left">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">identifier:logon time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:logoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:kickoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:pass last set time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:pass can change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:pass must change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">unix username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:domain column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT domain user is part of</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:nt username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:fullname column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Full name of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:home dir column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Unix homedir path</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:dir drive column</td><td align="left">varchar(2)</td><td align="left">Directory drive path (eg: 'H:')</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:logon script column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Batch file to run on client side when logging on</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:profile path column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Path of profile</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:acct desc column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Some ASCII NT user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:workstations column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Workstations user can logon to (or NULL for all)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown string column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">unknown string</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:munged dial column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:user sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT user SID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:group sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT group ID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:lanman pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">encrypted lanman password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:nt pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">encrypted nt passwd</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:plain pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">plaintext password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:acct control column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">nt user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown 3 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:logon divs column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:hours len column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown 5 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown 6 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">unknown</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2884046"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.3. MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Type</th><th align="justify">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">logon time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">logoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">kickoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass last set time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass can change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass must change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">unix username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">domain column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT domain user is part of</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nt username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">fullname column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Full name of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">home dir column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">UNIX homedir path</td></tr><tr><td align="left">dir drive column</td><td align="left">varchar(2)</td><td align="justify">Directory drive path (eg: 'H:')</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon script column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Batch file to run on client side when logging on</td></tr><tr><td align="left">profile path column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Path of profile</td></tr><tr><td align="left">acct desc column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Some ASCII NT user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">workstations column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Workstations user can logon to (or NULL for all)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown string column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">unknown string</td></tr><tr><td align="left">munged dial column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">user sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT user SID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">group sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT group ID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">lanman pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">encrypted lanman password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nt pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">encrypted nt passwd</td></tr><tr><td align="left">plain pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">plaintext password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">acct control column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">nt user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 3 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon divs column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">hours len column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 5 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 6 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">unknown</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> Eventually, you can put a colon (:) after the name of each column, which should specify the column to update when updating the table. You can also specify nothing behind the colon - then the data from the field will not be updated. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2896354"></a>Using plaintext passwords or encrypted password</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2884435"></a>Using plaintext passwords or encrypted password</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> I strongly discourage the use of plaintext passwords, however, you can use them: </p><p> If you would like to use plaintext passwords, set @@ -3984,7 +3798,7 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword </p><p> If you use encrypted passwords, set the 'identifier:plain pass column' to 'NULL' (without the quotes). This is the default. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2896385"></a>Getting non-column data from the table</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2884465"></a>Getting non-column data from the table</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> It is possible to have not all data in the database and making some 'constant'. </p><p> For example, you can set 'identifier:fullname column' to : @@ -3999,80 +3813,73 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword </p><p> To import data, use: <tt class="prompt">$ </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -i xml:filename</tt></b> - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896493"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896501"></a>Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - People forget to put their users in their backend and then complain Samba won't authorize them. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896516"></a>Users are being added to the wrong backend database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884575"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884582"></a>Users can not logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I've installed samba, but now I can't log on with my unix account!</span>”</p><p>Make sure your user has been added to the current samba <a class="indexterm" name="id2884600"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Read the section <a href="#acctmgmttools" title="Account Management Tools">Account Management Tools</a> for details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884627"></a>Users being added to wrong backend database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A few complaints have been received from users that just moved to Samba-3. The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries were causing problems, new accounts were being added to the old smbpasswd file, not to the tdbsam passdb.tdb file: </p><p> - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - [globals] - ... - passdb backend = smbpasswd, tdbsam, guest - ... - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = smbpasswd, tdbsam</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table><p> </p><p> Samba will add new accounts to the first entry in the <span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend</em></span> parameter entry. If you want to update to the tdbsam, then change the entry to: </p><p> - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - [globals] - ... - passdb backend = tdbsam, smbpasswd, guest - ... - </pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896576"></a>auth methods does not work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - If you explicitly set an 'auth methods' parameter, guest must be specified as the first - entry on the line. Eg: <i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods = guest sam</tt></i>. + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam, smbpasswd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884738"></a>auth methods does not work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + If you explicitly set an <a class="indexterm" name="id2884749"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> parameter, guest must be specified as the first + entry on the line. Eg: <a class="indexterm" name="id2884756"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> = guest sam. </p><p> - This is the exact opposite of the requirement for the <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backed</tt></i> + This is the exact opposite of the requirement for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2884784"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> option, where it must be the <span class="emphasis"><em>LAST</em></span> parameter on the line. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="groupmapping"></a>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jean François</span> <span class="surname">Micouleau</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2903953">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904055">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904246">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904310">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904325">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904393">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904485">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904501">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904562">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="footnotes"><br><hr width="100" align="left"><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2883711" href="#id2883711">3</a>] </sup>Only when the LDAP server supports LDAP_EXOP_X_MODIFY_PASSWD</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="groupmapping"></a>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jean François</span> <span class="surname">Micouleau</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885202">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885422">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885489">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885503">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885582">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2885658">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2885674">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885742">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2885768">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2884895"></a><p> Starting with Samba-3, new group mapping functionality is available to create associations - between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. The <i class="parameter"><tt>groupmap</tt></i> subcommand + between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. The <b class="command">groupmap</b> subcommand included with the <span class="application">net</span> tool can be used to manage these associations. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> The first immediate reason to use the group mapping on a Samba PDC, is that + <a class="indexterm" name="id2884936"></a> the <i class="parameter"><tt>domain admin group</tt></i> has been removed and should no longer be specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This parameter was used to give the listed users membership in the <tt class="constant">Domain Admins</tt> Windows group which gave local admin rights on their workstations (in default configurations). - </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903953"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884967"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba allows the administrator to create MS Windows NT4 / 200x group accounts and to - arbitrarily associate them with Unix/Linux group accounts. - </p><p> - Group accounts can be managed using the MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows 200x MMC tools - so long as appropriate interface scripts have been provided to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. - </p><p> + arbitrarily associate them with UNIX/Linux group accounts. + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2884983"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2884991"></a><p> + Group accounts can be managed using the MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows 200x / XP Professional MMC tools. + Appropriate interface scripts should be provided in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> if it is desired that UNIX / Linux system + accounts should be automatically created when these tools are used. In the absence of these scripts, and + so long as winbind is running, Samba accounts group accounts that are created using these tools will be + allocated UNIX UIDs/GIDs from the parameters set by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2885018"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i>/<a class="indexterm" name="id2885031"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> settings + in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-group-diag"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 12.1. IDMAP groups</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-groups.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP groups"></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2885101"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2885108"></a><p> Administrators should be aware that where <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> group interface scripts make - direct calls to the Unix/Linux system tools (eg: the shadow utilities, <b class="command">groupadd</b>, - <b class="command">groupdel</b>, <b class="command">groupmod</b>) then the resulting Unix/Linux group names will be subject + direct calls to the UNIX/Linux system tools (eg: the shadow utilities, <b class="command">groupadd</b>, + <b class="command">groupdel</b>, <b class="command">groupmod</b>) then the resulting UNIX/Linux group names will be subject to any limits imposed by these tools. If the tool does NOT allow upper case characters or space characters, then the creation of an MS Windows NT4 / 200x style group of - <i class="parameter"><tt>Engineering Managers</tt></i> will attempt to create an identically named - Unix/Linux group, an attempt that will of course fail! - </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Engineering Managers</em></span> will attempt to create an identically named + UNIX/Linux group, an attempt that will of course fail! + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2885160"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2885168"></a><p> There are several possible work-arounds for the operating system tools limitation. One - method is to use a script that generates a name for the Unix/Linux system group that - fits the operating system limits, and that then just passes the Unix/Linux group id (GID) + method is to use a script that generates a name for the UNIX/Linux system group that + fits the operating system limits, and that then just passes the UNIX/Linux group id (GID) back to the calling Samba interface. This will provide a dynamic work-around solution. </p><p> - Another work-around is to manually create a Unix/Linux group, then manually create the + Another work-around is to manually create a UNIX/Linux group, then manually create the MS Windows NT4 / 200x group on the Samba server and then use the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> tool to connect the two to each other. - </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904055"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885202"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When installing <span class="application">MS Windows NT4 / 200x</span> on a computer, the installation program creates default users and groups, notably the <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group, and gives that group privileges necessary privileges to perform essential system tasks. eg: Ability to change the date and time or to kill (or close) any process running on the local machine. - </p><p> + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2885231"></a><p> The 'Administrator' user is a member of the 'Administrators' group, and thus inherits 'Administrators' group privileges. If a 'joe' user is created to be a member of the 'Administrator' group, 'joe' has exactly the same rights as 'Administrator'. </p><p> - When an MS Windows NT4 / W200x is made a domain member, the "Domain Admins" group of the + When an MS Windows NT4 / W200x is made a domain member, the "Domain Admins" group of the PDC is added to the local 'Administrators' group of the workstation. Every member of the 'Domain Administrators' group inherits the rights of the local 'Administrators' group when logging on the workstation. @@ -4087,58 +3894,58 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword domadm:x:502:joe,john,mary </pre><p> </p></li><li><p> - Map this domadm group to the "Domain Admins" group by running the command: - </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=domadm</tt></b> - </pre><p> + Map this domadm group to the "Domain Admins" group by running the command: </p><p> - The quotes around "Domain Admins" are necessary due to the space in the group name. +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=domadm</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2885344"></a><p> + The quotes around "Domain Admins" are necessary due to the space in the group name. Also make sure to leave no whitespace surrounding the equal character (=). </p></li></ol></div><p> Now joe, john and mary are domain administrators! - </p><p> + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2885365"></a><p> It is possible to map any arbitrary UNIX group to any Windows NT4 / 200x group as well as making any UNIX group a Windows domain group. For example, if you wanted to include a UNIX group (e.g. acct) in a ACL on a local file or printer on a domain member machine, you would flag that group as a domain group by running the following on the Samba PDC: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup="Accounting" unixgroup=acct</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup="Accounting" unixgroup=acct</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> Be aware that the RID parameter is a unsigned 32 bit integer that should normally start at 1000. However, this rid must not overlap with any RID assigned - to a user. Verifying this is done differently depending on on the passdb backend + to a user. Verifying this is done differently depending on the passdb backend you are using. Future versions of the tools may perform the verification automatically, but for now the burden is on you. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904246"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885422"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can list the various groups in the mapping database by executing <b class="command">net groupmap list</b>. Here is an example: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b> - System Administrators (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-1002) -> sysadmin - Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -> domadmin - Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -> domuser - Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -> domguest - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b> +System Administrators (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-1002) -> sysadmin +Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -> domadmin +Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -> domuser +Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -> domguest +</pre><p> </p><p> For complete details on <b class="command">net groupmap</b>, refer to the net(8) man page. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904310"></a>Configuration Scripts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885489"></a>Configuration Scripts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Everyone needs tools. Some of us like to create our own, others prefer to use canned tools (ie: prepared by someone else for general use). - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904325"></a>Sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> add group script</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - A script to great complying group names for use by the Samba group interfaces: + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885503"></a>Sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> add group script</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A script to create complying group names for use by the Samba group interfaces: </p><p> -</p><div class="example"><a name="id2904348"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.1. smbgrpadd.sh</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2885526"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.1. smbgrpadd.sh</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/bash # Add the group using normal system groupadd tool. groupadd smbtmpgrp00 -thegid=`cat /etc/group | grep smbtmpgrp00 | cut -d ":" -f3` +thegid=`cat /etc/group | grep smbtmpgrp00 | cut -d ":" -f3` # Now change the name to what we want for the MS Windows networking end cp /etc/group /etc/group.bak @@ -4150,81 +3957,91 @@ exit 0 </pre></div><p> </p><p> The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the above script would look like: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - add group script = /path_to_tool/smbgrpadd.sh %g - </pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904393"></a>Script to configure Group Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - In our example we have created a Unix/Linux group called <i class="parameter"><tt>ntadmin</tt></i>. - Our script will create the additional groups <i class="parameter"><tt>Engineers, Marketoids, Gnomes</tt></i>: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script = /path_to_tool/smbgrpadd.sh %g</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885582"></a>Script to configure Group Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In our example we have created a UNIX/Linux group called <span class="emphasis"><em>ntadmin</em></span>. + Our script will create the additional groups <span class="emphasis"><em>Orks</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>Elves</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>Gnomes</em></span>: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/bash -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=ntadmin -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Users" unixgroup=users -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Guests" unixgroup=nobody -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Administrators" unixgroup=root -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Users" unixgroup=users -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Guests" unixgroup=nobody -net groupmap modify ntgroup="System Operators" unixgroup=sys -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Account Operators" unixgroup=root -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Backup Operators" unixgroup=bin -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Print Operators" unixgroup=lp -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Replicators" unixgroup=daemon -net groupmap modify ntgroup="Power Users" unixgroup=sys +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=ntadmin +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Users" unixgroup=users +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Guests" unixgroup=nobody +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Administrators" unixgroup=root +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Users" unixgroup=users +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Guests" unixgroup=nobody +net groupmap modify ntgroup="System Operators" unixgroup=sys +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Account Operators" unixgroup=root +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Backup Operators" unixgroup=bin +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Print Operators" unixgroup=lp +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Replicators" unixgroup=daemon +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Power Users" unixgroup=sys -#groupadd Engineers -#groupadd Marketoids -#groupadd Gnomes +groupadd Orks +groupadd Elves +groupadd Gnomes -#net groupmap add ntgroup="Engineers" unixgroup=Engineers type=d -#net groupmap add ntgroup="Marketoids" unixgroup=Marketoids type=d -#net groupmap add ntgroup="Gnomes" unixgroup=Gnomes type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Orks" unixgroup=Orks type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Elves" unixgroup=Elves type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Gnomes" unixgroup=Gnomes type=d </pre><p> </p><p> Of course it is expected that the administrator will modify this to suit local needs. For information regarding the use of the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> tool please refer to the man page. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904485"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885658"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> At this time there are many little surprises for the unwary administrator. In a real sense it is imperative that every step of automated control scripts must be carefully tested manually before putting them into active service. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904501"></a>Adding Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885674"></a>Adding Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is a common problem when the <b class="command">groupadd</b> is called directly - by the Samba interface script for the <i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i> in + by the Samba interface script for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2885694"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> The most common cause of failure is an attempt to add an MS Windows group account that has either an upper case character and/or a space character in it. </p><p> There are three possible work-arounds. Firstly, use only group names that comply - with the limitations of the Unix/Linux <b class="command">groupadd</b> system tool. + with the limitations of the UNIX/Linux <b class="command">groupadd</b> system tool. The second involves use of the script mentioned earlier in this chapter, and the - third option is to manually create a Unix/Linux group account that can substitute + third option is to manually create a UNIX/Linux group account that can substitute for the MS Windows group name, then use the procedure listed above to map that group to the MS Windows group. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904562"></a>Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885742"></a>Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2885751"></a><p> Samba-3 does NOT support nested groups from the MS Windows control environment. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AccessControls"></a>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 10, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2902775">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902812">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902830">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903087">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903183">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2903398">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904578">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904850">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905095">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905311">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905383">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905682">MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905690">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905728">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905807">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905929">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906157">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906309">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask - parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906639">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2906714">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2906729">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907109">I have set force user and Samba still makes root the owner of all the files - I touch!</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885768"></a>Adding <span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Users</em></span> to the <span class="emphasis"><em>Power Users</em></span> group</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> + What must I do to add Domain Users to the Power Users group? + </span>”</p><p> + The Power Users group is a group that is local to each Windows + 200x / XP Professional workstation. You can not add the Domain Users group to the Power Users + group automatically, this must be done on each workstation by logging in as the local workstation + <span class="emphasis"><em>administrator</em></span> and then using click on Start / Control Panel / Users and Passwords + now click on the 'Advanced' tab, then on the 'Advanced' Button. + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2885807"></a><p> + Now click on 'Groups', then double click on 'Power Users'. This will launch the panel to add users + or groups to the local machine 'Power Uses' group. Click on the 'Add' button, select the domain + from which the 'Domain Users' group is to be added, double click on the 'Domain Users' group, then + click on the 'Ok' button. Note: If a logon box is presented during this process please remember to + enter the connect as DOMAIN\UserName. ie: For the domain MIDEARTH and the user 'root' enter + MIDEARTH\root. + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AccessControls"></a>Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawing</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 10, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2886024">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886154">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886489">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2886582">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2886810">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888020">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888092">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2888391">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2888399">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888444">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888523">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888655">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2888889">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889446">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2889526">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2889540">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2889969">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890022">MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2885947"></a><p> Advanced MS Windows users are frequently perplexed when file, directory and share manipulation of resources shared via Samba do not behave in the manner they might expect. MS Windows network -administrators are often confused regarding network access controls and what is the best way to -provide users with the type of access they need while protecting resources from the consequences -of untoward access capabilities. +administrators are often confused regarding network access controls and how to +provide users with the access they need while protecting resources from unauthorised access. </p><p> -Unix administrators frequently are not familiar with the MS Windows environment and in particular +Many UNIX administrators are unfamiliar with the MS Windows environment and in particular have difficulty in visualizing what the MS Windows user wishes to achieve in attempts to set file and directory access permissions. </p><p> The problem lies in the differences in how file and directory permissions and controls work between the two environments. This difference is one that Samba can not completely hide, even -though it does try to make the chasm transparent. -</p><p> +though it does try to bridge the chasm to a degree. +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2885983"></a><p> POSIX Access Control List technology has been available (along with Extended Attributes) -for Unix for many years, yet there is little evidence today of any significant use. This +for UNIX for many years, yet there is little evidence today of any significant use. This explains to some extent the slow adoption of ACLs into commercial Linux products. MS Windows administrators are astounded at this given that ACLs were a foundational capability of the now decade old MS Windows NT operating system. @@ -4233,25 +4050,24 @@ The purpose of this chapter is to present each of the points of control that are Samba-3 in the hope that this will help the network administrator to find the optimum method for delivering the best environment for MS Windows desktop users. </p><p> -This is an opportune point to mention that it should be borne in mind that Samba was created to -provide a means of interoperability and interchange of data between two operating environments -that are quite different. It was never the intent to make Unix/Linux like MS Windows NT. Instead -the purpose was an is to provide a sufficient level of exchange of data between the two environments. -What is available today extends well beyond early plans and expectations, yet the gap continues to -shrink. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902775"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This is an opportune point to mention that Samba was created to provide a means of interoperability +and interchange of data between differing operating environments. Samba has no intent change +UNIX/Linux into a platform like MS Windows. Instead the purpose was and is to provide a sufficient +level of exchange of data between the two environments. What is available today extends well +beyond early plans and expectations, yet the gap continues to shrink. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886024"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba offers a lot of flexibility in file system access management. These are the key access control facilities present in Samba today: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Samba Access Control Facilities</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>Unix File and Directory Permissions</em></span> + <span class="emphasis"><em>UNIX File and Directory Permissions</em></span> </p><p> - Samba honours and implements Unix file system access controls. Users + Samba honours and implements UNIX file system access controls. Users who access a Samba server will do so as a particular MS Windows user. This information is passed to the Samba server as part of the logon or connection setup process. Samba uses this user identity to validate whether or not the user should be given access to file system resources (files and directories). This chapter provides an overview for those - to whom the Unix permissions and controls are a little strange or unknown. + to whom the UNIX permissions and controls are a little strange or unknown. </p></li><li><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba Share Definitions</em></span> </p><p> @@ -4270,22 +4086,22 @@ shrink. easiest ways to affect access controls (restrictions) and can often do so with minimum invasiveness compared with other methods. </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>MS Windows ACLs through Unix POSIX ACLs</em></span> + <span class="emphasis"><em>MS Windows ACLs through UNIX POSIX ACLs</em></span> </p><p> - The use of POSIX ACLs on Unix/Linux is possible ONLY if the underlying + The use of POSIX ACLs on UNIX/Linux is possible ONLY if the underlying operating system supports them. If not, then this option will not be - available to you. Current Unix technology platforms have native support + available to you. Current UNIX technology platforms have native support for POSIX ACLs. There are patches for the Linux kernel that provide this also. Sadly, few Linux platforms ship today with native ACLs and Extended Attributes enabled. This chapter has pertinent information for users of platforms that support them. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902812"></a>File System Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886154"></a>File System Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Perhaps the most important recognition to be made is the simple fact that MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP -implement a totally divergent file system technology from what is provided in the Unix operating system +implement a totally divergent file system technology from what is provided in the UNIX operating system environment. Firstly we should consider what the most significant differences are, then we shall look at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902830"></a>MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Samba operates on top of the Unix file system. This means it is subject to Unix file system conventions +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2886173"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2886182"></a><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886190"></a>MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba operates on top of the UNIX file system. This means it is subject to UNIX file system conventions and permissions. It also means that if the MS Windows networking environment requires file system behaviour that differs from unix file system behaviour then somehow Samba is responsible for emulating that in a transparent and consistent manner. @@ -4295,128 +4111,108 @@ at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. but for the greater part we will stay within the bounds of default behaviour. Those wishing to explore to depths of control ability should review the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. </p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>File System Feature Comparison</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">Name Space</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows NT4 / 200x/ XP files names may be up to 254 characters long, Unix file names + MS Windows NT4 / 200x/ XP files names may be up to 254 characters long, UNIX file names may be 1023 characters long. In MS Windows file extensions indicate particular file types, - in Unix this is not so rigorously observed as all names are considered arbitrary. + in UNIX this is not so rigorously observed as all names are considered arbitrary. </p><p> - What MS Windows calls a Folder, Unix calls a directory, + What MS Windows calls a Folder, UNIX calls a directory. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Case Sensitivity</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows file names are generally Upper Case if made up of 8.3 (ie: 8 character file name + <a class="indexterm" name="id2886276"></a> + MS Windows file names are generally upper case if made up of 8.3 (ie: 8 character file name and 3 character extension. If longer than 8.3 file names are Case Preserving, and Case Insensitive. </p><p> - Unix file and directory names are Case Sensitive and Case Preserving. Samba implements the - MS Windows file name behaviour, but it does so as a user application. The Unix file system + UNIX file and directory names are case sensitive and case preserving. Samba implements the + MS Windows file name behaviour, but it does so as a user application. The UNIX file system provides no mechanism to perform case insensitive file name lookups. MS Windows does this by default. This means that Samba has to carry the processing overhead to provide features - that are NOT native to the Unix operating system environment. + that are NOT native to the UNIX operating system environment. </p><p> - Consider the following, all are unique Unix names but one single MS Windows file name: + Consider the following, all are unique UNIX names but one single MS Windows file name: <tt class="computeroutput"> MYFILE.TXT MyFile.txt myfile.txt </tt> - So clearly, In an MS Windows file name space these three files CAN NOT co-exist! But in Unix + So clearly, In an MS Windows file name space these three files CAN NOT co-exist! But in UNIX they can. So what should Samba do if all three are present? Answer, the one that is lexically first will be accessible to MS Windows users, the others are invisible and unaccessible - any other solution would be suicidal. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Directory Separators</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows and DOS uses the back-slash '\' as a directory delimiter, Unix uses the forward-slash '/' + MS Windows and DOS uses the back-slash '\' as a directory delimiter, UNIX uses the forward-slash '/' as it's directory delimiter. This is transparently handled by Samba. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Drive Identification</span></dt><dd><p> MS Windows products support a notion of drive letters, like <b class="command">C:</b> to represent - disk partitions. Unix has NO concept if separate identifiers for file partitions since each + disk partitions. UNIX has NO concept if separate identifiers for file partitions since each such file system is <tt class="filename">mounted</tt> to become part of the over-all directory tree. - The Unix directory tree begins at '/', just like the root of a DOS drive is specified like + The UNIX directory tree begins at '/', just like the root of a DOS drive is specified like <b class="command">C:\</b>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">File Naming Conventions</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows generally never experiences file names that begin with a '.', while in Unix these + MS Windows generally never experiences file names that begin with a '.', while in UNIX these are commonly found in a user's home directory. Files that begin with a '.' are typically - either start up files for various Unix applications, or they may be files that contain + either start up files for various UNIX applications, or they may be files that contain start-up configuration data. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Links and Short-Cuts</span></dt><dd><p> - MS Windows make use of "links and Short-Cuts" that are actually special types of files that will - redirect an attempt to execute the file to the real location of the file. Unix knows of file and directory + <a class="indexterm" name="id2886426"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2886437"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2886448"></a> + + MS Windows make use of "links and Short-Cuts" that are actually special types of files that will + redirect an attempt to execute the file to the real location of the file. UNIX knows of file and directory links, but they are entirely different from what MS Windows users are used to. </p><p> - Symbolic links are files in Unix that contain the actual location of the data (file OR directory). An + Symbolic links are files in UNIX that contain the actual location of the data (file OR directory). An operation (like read or write) will operate directly on the file referenced. Symbolic links are also referred to as 'soft links'. A hard link is something that MS Windows is NOT familiar with. It allows one physical file to be known simultaneously by more than one file name. </p></dd></dl></div><p> There are many other subtle differences that may cause the MS Windows administrator some temporary discomfort - in the process of becoming familiar with Unix/Linux. These are best left for a text that is dedicated to the - purpose of Unix/Linux training/education. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903087"></a>Managing Directories</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + in the process of becoming familiar with UNIX/Linux. These are best left for a text that is dedicated to the + purpose of UNIX/Linux training/education. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886489"></a>Managing Directories</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are three basic operations for managing directories, <b class="command">create, delete, rename</b>. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2903107"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.1. Managing directories with unix and windows</b></p><table summary="Managing directories with unix and windows" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Action</th><th align="center">MS Windows Command</th><th align="center">Unix Command</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">create</td><td align="center">md folder</td><td align="center">mkdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">delete</td><td align="center">rd folder</td><td align="center">rmdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">rename</td><td align="center">rename oldname newname</td><td align="center">mv oldname newname</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903183"></a>File and Directory Access Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2886508"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.1. Managing directories with unix and windows</b></p><table summary="Managing directories with unix and windows" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Action</th><th align="center">MS Windows Command</th><th align="center">UNIX Command</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">create</td><td align="center">md folder</td><td align="center">mkdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">delete</td><td align="center">rd folder</td><td align="center">rmdir folder</td></tr><tr><td align="center">rename</td><td align="center">rename oldname newname</td><td align="center">mv oldname newname</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886582"></a>File and Directory Access Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The network administrator is strongly advised to read foundational training manuals and reference materials - regarding file and directory permissions maintenance. Much can be achieved with the basic Unix permissions + regarding file and directory permissions maintenance. Much can be achieved with the basic UNIX permissions without having to resort to more complex facilities like POSIX Access Control Lists (ACLs) or Extended Attributes (EAs). </p><p> - Unix/Linux file and directory access permissions involves setting three (3) primary sets of data and one (1) control set. - A Unix file listing looks as follows:- + UNIX/Linux file and directory access permissions involves setting three (3) primary sets of data and one (1) control set. + A UNIX file listing looks as follows:- - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">jht@frodo:~/stuff> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -la</tt></b> - total 632 - drwxr-xr-x 13 jht users 816 2003-05-12 22:56 . - drwxr-xr-x 37 jht users 3800 2003-05-12 22:29 .. - d--------- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado00 - d--x--x--x 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado01 - dr-xr-xr-x 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado02 - drwxrwxrwx 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado03 - drw-rw-rw- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado04 - d-w--w--w- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado05 - dr--r--r-- 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado06 - drwxrwxrwt 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado07 - drwsrwsrwx 2 jht users 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado08 - ---------- 1 jht users 1242 2003-05-12 22:31 mydata00.lst - ---x--x--x 1 jht users 1674 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata01.lst - --w--w--w- 1 jht users 7754 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata02.lst - --wx-wx-wx 1 jht users 260179 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata03.lst - -r--r--r-- 1 jht users 21017 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata04.lst - -r-xr-xr-x 1 jht users 206339 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata05.lst - -rw-rw-rw- 1 jht users 41105 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata06.lst - -rwxrwxrwx 1 jht users 19312 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata07.lst - <tt class="prompt">jht@frodo:~/stuff></tt> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -la</tt></b> +total 632 +drwxr-xr-x 13 maryo gnomes 816 2003-05-12 22:56 . +drwxrwxr-x 37 maryo gnomes 3800 2003-05-12 22:29 .. +dr-xr-xr-x 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado02 +drwxrwxrwx 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado03 +drw-rw-rw- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado04 +d-w--w--w- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado05 +dr--r--r-- 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado06 +drwsrwsrwx 2 maryo gnomes 48 2003-05-12 22:29 muchado08 +---------- 1 maryo gnomes 1242 2003-05-12 22:31 mydata00.lst +--w--w--w- 1 maryo gnomes 7754 2003-05-12 22:33 mydata02.lst +-r--r--r-- 1 maryo gnomes 21017 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata04.lst +-rw-rw-rw- 1 maryo gnomes 41105 2003-05-12 22:32 mydata06.lst +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt> +</pre><p> </p><p> - The columns above represent (from left to right): permissions, no blocks used, owner, group, size (bytes), access date, access time, file name. - </p><p> - The permissions field is made up of: - - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - <i><span class="comment"> JRV: Put this into a diagram of some sort</span></i> - [ type ] [ users ] [ group ] [ others ] [File, Directory Permissions] - [ d | l ] [ r w x ] [ r w x ] [ r w x ] - | | | | | | | | | | | - | | | | | | | | | | |-----> Can Execute, List files - | | | | | | | | | |-------> Can Write, Create files - | | | | | | | | |---------> Can Read, Read files - | | | | | | | |---------------> Can Execute, List files - | | | | | | |-----------------> Can Write, Create files - | | | | | |-------------------> Can Read, Read files - | | | | |-------------------------> Can Execute, List files - | | | |---------------------------> Can Write, Create files - | | |-----------------------------> Can Read, Read files - | |-----------------------------------> Is a symbolic Link - |---------------------------------------> Is a directory - </pre><p> + The columns above represent (from left to right): permissions, number of hard links to file, owner, group, size (bytes), access date, access time, file name. </p><p> + An overview of the permissions field can be found in <a href="#access1" title="Figure 13.1. Overview of unix permissions field">the image below</a>. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="access1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 13.1. Overview of unix permissions field</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/access1.png" width="270" alt="Overview of unix permissions field"></div></div><p> Any bit flag may be unset. An unset bit flag is the equivalent of 'Can NOT' and is represented as a '-' character. - </p><div class="example"><a name="id2903320"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13.1. Example File</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2886704"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 13.1. Example File</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> -rwxr-x--- Means: The owner (user) can read, write, execute the group can read and execute everyone else can NOT do anything with it </pre></div><p> </p><p> - Additional possibilities in the [type] field are: c = character device, b = block device, p = pipe device, s = Unix Domain Socket. + Additional possibilities in the [type] field are: c = character device, b = block device, p = pipe device, s = UNIX Domain Socket. </p><p> The letters `rwxXst' set permissions for the user, group and others as: read (r), write (w), execute (or access for directories) (x), execute only if the file is a directory or already has execute permission for some user (X), set user or group ID on execution (s), @@ -4435,101 +4231,101 @@ at how Samba helps to bridge the differences. the (x) execute flags are not set files can not be listed (seen) in the directory by anyone. The group can read files in the directory but can NOT create new files. NOTE: If files in the directory are set to be readable and writable for the group, then group members will be able to write to (or delete) them. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903398"></a>Share Definition Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886810"></a>Share Definition Access Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file sections that define a share control or affect access controls. Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904578"></a>User and Group Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886837"></a>User and Group Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> User and group based controls can prove very useful. In some situations it is distinctly desirable to affect all - file system operations as if a single user is doing this, the use of the <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> and - <i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> behaviour will achieve this. In other situations it may be necessary to affect a + file system operations as if a single user is doing this, the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886852"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2886865"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i> behaviour will achieve this. In other situations it may be necessary to affect a paranoia level of control to ensure that only particular authorised persons will be able to access a share or - it's contents, here the use of the <i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> or the <i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> may + it's contents, here the use of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886884"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> or the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886897"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i> may be most useful. </p><p> As always, it is highly advisable to use the least difficult to maintain and the least ambiguous method for controlling access. Remember, that when you leave the scene someone else will need to provide assistance and if that person finds too great a mess, or if they do not understand what you have done then there is risk of Samba being removed and an alternative solution being adopted. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2904638"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.2. User and Group Based Controls</b></p><table summary="User and Group Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>admin users</td><td><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2886925"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.2. User and Group Based Controls</b></p><table summary="User and Group Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2886982"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users who will be granted administrative privileges on the share. They will do all file operations as the super-user (root). Any user in this list will be able to do anything they like on the share, irrespective of file permissions. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force group</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887012"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Specifies a UNIX group name that will be assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting to this service. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force user</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887039"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Specifies a UNIX user name that will be assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service. This is useful for sharing files. Incorrect use can cause security problems. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>guest ok</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887068"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> If this parameter is set for a service, then no password is required to connect to the service. Privileges will be those of the guest account. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>invalid users</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887095"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that should not be allowed to login to this service. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>only user</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887121"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls whether connections with usernames not in the user list will be allowed. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>read list</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887148"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that are given read-only access to a service. Users in this list will not be given write access, no matter what the read only option is set to. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>username</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887176"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information - this is a complex and potentially misused parameter. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>valid users</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887208"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that should be allowed to login to this service. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>write list</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887235"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of users that are given read-write access to a service. - </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904850"></a>File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887260"></a>File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following file and directory permission based controls, if misused, can result in considerable difficulty to diagnose the cause of mis-configuration. Use them sparingly and carefully. By gradually introducing each one by one undesirable side-effects may be detected. In the event of a problem, always comment all of them out and then gradually re-introduce them in a controlled fashion. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2904871"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.3. File and Directory Permission Based Controls</b></p><table summary="File and Directory Permission Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>create mask</td><td><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2887281"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.3. File and Directory Permission Based Controls</b></p><table summary="File and Directory Permission Based Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887336"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>directory mask</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887367"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> The octal modes used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX directories. See also: directory security mask. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dos filemode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887394"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filemode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Enabling this parameter allows a user who has write access to the file to modify the permissions on it. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force create mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887421"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will always be set on a file created by Samba. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force directory mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887447"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit permissions that will always be set on a directory created by Samba. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force directory security mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887476"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating UNIX permissions on a directory - </p></td></tr><tr><td>force security mode</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887504"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client manipulates UNIX permissions. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>hide unreadable</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887530"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unreadable</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Prevents clients from seeing the existence of files that cannot be read. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>hide unwriteable files</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887557"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unwriteable files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Prevents clients from seeing the existence of files that cannot be written to. Unwriteable directories are shown as usual. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>nt acl support</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887585"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This parameter controls whether smbd will attempt to map UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>security mask</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887611"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Controls UNIX permission bits modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permissions on a file. - </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905095"></a>Miscellaneous Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - The following are documented because of the prevalence of administrators creating inadvertant barriers to file + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887639"></a>Miscellaneous Controls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following are documented because of the prevalence of administrators creating inadvertent barriers to file access by not understanding the full implications of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2905118"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.4. Other Controls</b></p><table summary="Other Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>case sensitive, default case, short preserve case</td><td><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2887661"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 13.4. Other Controls</b></p><table summary="Other Controls" border="1"><colgroup><col align="justify"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Control Parameter</th><th align="center">Description - Action - Notes</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887716"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2887730"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>default case</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2887744"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This means that all file name lookup will be done in a case sensitive manner. Files will be created with the precise filename Samba received from the MS Windows client. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>csc policy</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887772"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Client Side Caching Policy - parallels MS Windows client side file caching capabilities. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dont descend</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887799"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Allows to specify a comma-delimited list of directories that the server should always show as empty. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dos filetime resolution</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887826"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetime resolution</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual C++ when used against Samba shares. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>dos filetimes</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887853"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetimes</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> DOS and Windows allows users to change file time stamps if they can write to the file. POSIX semantics prevent this. This options allows DOS and Windows behaviour. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>fake oplocks</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887882"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>fake oplocks</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants an oplock then the client is free to assume that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively cache file data. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>hide dot files, hide files, veto files</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887912"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide dot files</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2887926"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2887939"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> Note: MS Windows Explorer allows over-ride of files marked as hidden so they will still be visible. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>read only</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887966"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> If this parameter is yes, then users of a service may not create or modify files in the service's directory. - </p></td></tr><tr><td>veto files</td><td><p> + </p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><a class="indexterm" name="id2887993"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></td><td align="justify"><p> List of files and directories that are neither visible nor accessible. - </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905311"></a>Access Controls on Shares</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888020"></a>Access Controls on Shares</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section deals with how to configure Samba per share access control restrictions. By default, Samba sets no restrictions on the share itself. Restrictions on the share itself can be set on MS Windows NT4/200x/XP shares. This can be a very effective way to limit who can @@ -4546,9 +4342,9 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c for Samba's tdb files is under <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/var</tt>. If the <tt class="filename">tdbdump</tt> utility has been compiled and installed on your system, then you can examine the contents of this file by: <b class="userinput"><tt>tdbdump share_info.tdb</tt></b>. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905383"></a>Share Permissions Management</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888092"></a>Share Permissions Management</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The best tool for the task is platform dependant. Choose the best tool for your environment. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2905397"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation/Server</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888105"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation/Server</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The tool you need to use to manage share permissions on a Samba server is the NT Server Manager. Server Manager is shipped with Windows NT4 Server products but not with Windows NT4 Workstation. You can obtain the NT Server Manager for MS Windows NT4 Workstation from Microsoft - see details below. @@ -4558,9 +4354,9 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c </p></li><li><p> Now click on the share that you wish to manage, then click on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> tab, next click on the <span class="guilabel">Permissions</span> tab. Now you can add or change access control settings as you wish. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2905479"></a>Windows 200x/XP</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888188"></a>Windows 200x/XP</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> On <span class="application">MS Windows NT4/200x/XP</span> system access control lists on the share itself are set using native - tools, usually from filemanager. For example, in Windows 200x: right click on the shared folder, + tools, usually from file manager. For example, in Windows 200x: right click on the shared folder, then select <span class="guimenuitem">Sharing</span>, then click on <span class="guilabel">Permissions</span>. The default Windows NT4/200x permission allows <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span> Full Control on the Share. </p><p> @@ -4587,72 +4383,71 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c then effectively no user will be able to access the share. This is a result of what is known as ACL precedence. ie: Everyone with <span class="emphasis"><em>no access</em></span> means that MaryK who is part of the group <tt class="constant">Everyone</tt> will have no access even if this user is given explicit full control access. - </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905682"></a>MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905690"></a>Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows NT clients can use their native security settings - dialog box to view and modify the underlying UNIX permissions.</p><p>Note that this ability is careful not to compromise - the security of the UNIX host Samba is running on, and - still obeys all the file permission rules that a Samba - administrator can set.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> - All access to Unix/Linux system file via Samba is controlled at - the operating system file access control level. When trying to - figure out file access problems it is vitally important to identify - the identity of the Windows user as it is presented by Samba at - the point of file access. This can best be determined from the + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888391"></a>MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888399"></a>Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Windows NT clients can use their native security settings dialog box to view and modify the + underlying UNIX permissions. + </p><p> + Note that this ability is careful not to compromise the security of the UNIX host Samba is running on, and + still obeys all the file permission rules that a Samba administrator can set. + </p><p> + Samba does not attempt to go beyond POSIX ACLs, so that the various finer-grained access control + options provided in Windows are actually ignore. + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + All access to UNIX/Linux system files via Samba is controlled by the operating system file access controls. + When trying to figure out file access problems it is vitally important to find the identity of the Windows + user as it is presented by Samba at the point of file access. This can best be determined from the Samba log files. - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905728"></a>Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>From an NT4/2000/XP client, single-click with the right - mouse button on any file or directory in a Samba mounted - drive letter or UNC path. When the menu pops-up, click - on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> entry at the bottom of - the menu. This brings up the file properties dialog - box. Click on the tab <span class="guilabel">Security</span> and you - will see three buttons, <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span>, - <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span>, and <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span>. - The <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span> button will cause either - an error message <span class="errorname">A requested privilege is not held - by the client</span> to appear if the user is not the - NT Administrator, or a dialog which is intended to allow an - Administrator to add auditing requirements to a file if the - user is logged on as the NT Administrator. This dialog is - non-functional with a Samba share at this time, as the only - useful button, the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button will not currently - allow a list of users to be seen.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905807"></a>Viewing file ownership</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Clicking on the <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span> button - brings up a dialog box telling you who owns the given file. The - owner name will be of the form :</p><p><b class="command">"SERVER\user (Long name)"</b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of - the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of - the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> - is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the - GECOS field of the UNIX password database). Click on the - <span class="guibutton">Close </span> button to remove this dialog.</p><p>If the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> - is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> then the file owner will - be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt>.</p><p>The <span class="guibutton">Take Ownership</span> button will not allow - you to change the ownership of this file to yourself (clicking on - it will display a dialog box complaining that the user you are - currently logged onto the NT client cannot be found). The reason - for this is that changing the ownership of a file is a privileged - operation in UNIX, available only to the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> - user. As clicking on this button causes NT to attempt to change - the ownership of a file to the current user logged into the NT - client this will not work with Samba at this time.</p><p>There is an NT chown command that will work with Samba - and allow a user with Administrator privilege connected - to a Samba server as root to change the ownership of - files on both a local NTFS filesystem or remote mounted NTFS - or Samba drive. This is available as part of the <span class="application">Seclib - </span> NT security library written by Jeremy Allison of - the Samba Team, available from the main Samba ftp site.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905929"></a>Viewing File or Directory Permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The third button is the <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span> - button. Clicking on this brings up a dialog box that shows both - the permissions and the UNIX owner of the file or directory. - The owner is displayed in the form :</p><p><b class="command">"<i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>\ + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888444"></a>Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + From an NT4/2000/XP client, single-click with the right mouse button on any file or directory in a Samba + mounted drive letter or UNC path. When the menu pops-up, click on the <span class="guilabel">Properties</span> + entry at the bottom of the menu. This brings up the file properties dialog box. Click on the tab + <span class="guilabel">Security</span> and you will see three buttons, <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span>, + <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span>, and <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Auditing</span> + button will cause either an error message <span class="errorname">A requested privilege is not held by the client</span> + to appear if the user is not the NT Administrator, or a dialog which is intended to allow an Administrator + to add auditing requirements to a file if the user is logged on as the NT Administrator. This dialog is + non-functional with a Samba share at this time, as the only useful button, the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> + button will not currently allow a list of users to be seen. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888523"></a>Viewing file ownership</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Clicking on the <span class="guibutton">Ownership</span> button brings up a dialog box telling you who owns + the given file. The owner name will be of the form: + </p><p> + <b class="command">"SERVER\user (Long name)"</b> + </p><p> + Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> + is the user name of the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> is the + descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the GECOS field of the UNIX password database). + Click on the <span class="guibutton">Close </span> button to remove this dialog. + </p><p> + If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2888586"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> + then the file owner will be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt>. + </p><p> + The <span class="guibutton">Take Ownership</span> button will not allow you to change the ownership of this file to + yourself (clicking on it will display a dialog box complaining that the user you are currently logged onto + the NT client cannot be found). The reason for this is that changing the ownership of a file is a privileged + operation in UNIX, available only to the <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> user. As clicking on this button causes + NT to attempt to change the ownership of a file to the current user logged into the NT client this will + not work with Samba at this time.</p><p> + There is an NT chown command that will work with Samba and allow a user with Administrator privilege connected + to a Samba server as root to change the ownership of files on both a local NTFS filesystem or remote mounted NTFS + or Samba drive. This is available as part of the <span class="application">Seclib</span> NT security library written + by Jeremy Allison of the Samba-Team, available from the main Samba FTP site.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888655"></a>Viewing File or Directory Permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The third button is the <span class="guibutton">Permissions</span> button. Clicking on this brings up a dialog box + that shows both the permissions and the UNIX owner of the file or directory. The owner is displayed in the form: + </p><p><b class="command">"<i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>\ <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> - <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i>"</b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of - the Samba server, <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of - the UNIX user who owns the file, and <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> - is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the - GECOS field of the UNIX password database).</p><p>If the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> - is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> then the file owner will - be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt> and the - permissions will be shown as NT "Full Control".</p><p>The permissions field is displayed differently for files - and directories, so I'll describe the way file permissions - are displayed first.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906021"></a>File Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The standard UNIX user/group/world triplet and - the corresponding "read", "write", "execute" permissions + <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i>"</b></p><p>Where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i> is the NetBIOS name of the Samba server, + <i class="replaceable"><tt>user</tt></i> is the user name of the UNIX user who owns the file, and + <i class="replaceable"><tt>(Long name)</tt></i> is the descriptive string identifying the user (normally found in the + GECOS field of the UNIX password database).</p><p> + If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2888720"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> + then the file owner will be shown as the NT user <tt class="constant">"Everyone"</tt> and the permissions will be + shown as NT "Full Control". + </p><p> + The permissions field is displayed differently for files and directories, so I'll describe the way file permissions + are displayed first. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888753"></a>File Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>The standard UNIX user/group/world triplet and + the corresponding "read", "write", "execute" permissions triplets are mapped by Samba into a three element NT ACL with the 'r', 'w', and 'x' bits mapped into the corresponding NT permissions. The UNIX world permissions are mapped into @@ -4663,20 +4458,20 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c group</span> icon respectively followed by the list of permissions allowed for the UNIX user and group.</p><p>As many UNIX permission sets don't map into common NT names such as <tt class="constant">read</tt>, <tt class="constant"> - "change"</tt> or <tt class="constant">full control</tt> then + "change"</tt> or <tt class="constant">full control</tt> then usually the permissions will be prefixed by the words <tt class="constant"> - "Special Access"</tt> in the NT display list.</p><p>But what happens if the file has no permissions allowed - for a particular UNIX user group or world component ? In order - to allow "no permissions" to be seen and modified then Samba - overloads the NT <b class="command">"Take Ownership"</b> ACL attribute + "Special Access"</tt> in the NT display list.</p><p>But what happens if the file has no permissions allowed + for a particular UNIX user group or world component? In order + to allow "no permissions" to be seen and modified then Samba + overloads the NT <b class="command">"Take Ownership"</b> ACL attribute (which has no meaning in UNIX) and reports a component with - no permissions as having the NT <b class="command">"O"</b> bit set. + no permissions as having the NT <b class="command">"O"</b> bit set. This was chosen of course to make it look like a zero, meaning zero permissions. More details on the decision behind this will - be given below.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2906112"></a>Directory Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Directories on an NT NTFS file system have two + be given below.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888845"></a>Directory Permissions</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Directories on an NT NTFS file system have two different sets of permissions. The first set of permissions is the ACL set on the directory itself, this is usually displayed - in the first set of parentheses in the normal <tt class="constant">"RW"</tt> + in the first set of parentheses in the normal <tt class="constant">"RW"</tt> NT style. This first set of permissions is created by Samba in exactly the same way as normal file permissions are, described above, and is displayed in the same way.</p><p>The second set of directory permissions has no real meaning @@ -4684,15 +4479,15 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c inherited</tt> permissions that any file created within this directory would inherit.</p><p>Samba synthesises these inherited permissions for NT by returning as an NT ACL the UNIX permission mode that a new file - created by Samba on this share would receive.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906157"></a>Modifying file or directory permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Modifying file and directory permissions is as simple + created by Samba on this share would receive.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888889"></a>Modifying file or directory permissions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Modifying file and directory permissions is as simple as changing the displayed permissions in the dialog box, and clicking the <span class="guibutton">OK</span> button. However, there are limitations that a user needs to be aware of, and also interactions with the standard Samba permission masks and mapping of DOS - attributes that need to also be taken into account.</p><p>If the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> + attributes that need to also be taken into account.</p><p>If the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2888918"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> is set to <tt class="constant">false</tt> then any attempt to set - security permissions will fail with an <span class="errorname">"Access Denied" - </span> message.</p><p>The first thing to note is that the <span class="guibutton">"Add"</span> + security permissions will fail with an <span class="errorname">"Access Denied" + </span> message.</p><p>The first thing to note is that the <span class="guibutton">"Add"</span> button will not return a list of users in Samba (it will give an error message of <span class="errorname">The remote procedure call failed and did not execute</span>). This means that you can only @@ -4701,13 +4496,13 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c only permissions that UNIX actually has.</p><p>If a permission triplet (either user, group, or world) is removed from the list of permissions in the NT dialog box, then when the <span class="guibutton">OK</span> button is pressed it will - be applied as "no permissions" on the UNIX side. If you then - view the permissions again the "no permissions" entry will appear - as the NT <b class="command">"O"</b> flag, as described above. This + be applied as "no permissions" on the UNIX side. If you then + view the permissions again the "no permissions" entry will appear + as the NT <b class="command">"O"</b> flag, as described above. This allows you to add permissions back to a file or directory once - you have removed them from a triplet component.</p><p>As UNIX supports only the "r", "w" and "x" bits of - an NT ACL then if other NT security attributes such as "Delete - access" are selected then they will be ignored when applied on + you have removed them from a triplet component.</p><p>As UNIX supports only the "r", "w" and "x" bits of + an NT ACL then if other NT security attributes such as "Delete + access" are selected then they will be ignored when applied on the Samba server.</p><p>When setting permissions on a directory the second set of permissions (in the second set of parentheses) is by default applied to all files within that directory. If this @@ -4717,61 +4512,58 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c user/group/world component then you may either highlight the component and click the <span class="guibutton">Remove</span> button, or set the component to only have the special <tt class="constant">Take - Ownership</tt> permission (displayed as <b class="command">"O" - </b>) highlighted.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906309"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + Ownership</tt> permission (displayed as <b class="command">"O" + </b>) highlighted.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889049"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba create mask parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>There are four parameters to control interaction with the standard Samba create mask parameters. These are : - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2889069"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2889086"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2889103"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2889120"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> </p><p>Once a user clicks <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to apply the permissions Samba maps the given permissions into a user/group/world r/w/x triplet set, and then will check the changed permissions for a - file against the bits set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYMASK" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></a> parameter. Any bits that + file against the bits set in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2889150"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> parameter. Any bits that were changed that are not set to '1' in this parameter are left alone - in the file permissions.</p><p>Essentially, zero bits in the <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> + in the file permissions.</p><p>Essentially, zero bits in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2889171"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> allowed to change, and one bits are those the user is allowed to change. </p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value as - the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask - </tt></i></a> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2889196"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file, set this parameter to 0777.</p><p>Next Samba checks the changed permissions for a file against - the bits set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCESECURITYMODE" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></a> parameter. Any bits + the bits set in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2889218"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> parameter. Any bits that were changed that correspond to bits set to '1' in this parameter are forced to be set.</p><p>Essentially, bits set in the <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode </tt></i> parameter may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security on a file, the user has always set to be 'on'.</p><p>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to the same value - as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#FORCECREATEMODE" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>force - create mode</tt></i></a> parameter. + as the <a class="indexterm" name="id2889253"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i> parameter. To allow a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file - with no restrictions set this parameter to 000.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>force + with no restrictions set this parameter to 000.</p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2889274"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i> parameters are applied to the change request in that order.</p><p>For a directory Samba will perform the same operations as described above for a file except using the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt> directory security mask</tt></i> instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i>, and <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode </tt></i> parameter instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode - </tt></i>.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> parameter + </tt></i>.</p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2889335"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i> parameter by default is set to the same value as the <i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask </tt></i> parameter and the <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i> parameter by default is set to the same value as - the <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> parameter. </p><p>In this way Samba enforces the permission restrictions that + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2889366"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i> parameter. </p><p>In this way Samba enforces the permission restrictions that an administrator can set on a Samba share, whilst still allowing users to modify the permission bits within that restriction.</p><p>If you want to set up a share that allows users full control in modifying the permission bits on their files and directories and doesn't force any particular bits to be set 'on', then set the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in that share specific section : - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906639"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba maps some of the DOS attribute bits (such as "read - only") into the UNIX permissions of a file. This means there can + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask = 0777</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode = 0</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889446"></a>Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Samba maps some of the DOS attribute bits (such as "read + only") into the UNIX permissions of a file. This means there can be a conflict between the permission bits set via the security dialog and the permission bits set by the file attribute mapping. - </p><p>One way this can show up is if a file has no UNIX read access - for the owner it will show up as "read only" in the standard + </p></div><p>One way this can show up is if a file has no UNIX read access + for the owner it will show up as "read only" in the standard file attributes tabbed dialog. Unfortunately this dialog is the same one that contains the security info in another tab.</p><p>What this can mean is that if the owner changes the permissions to allow themselves read access using the security dialog, clicks @@ -4782,10 +4574,10 @@ Before using any of the following options please refer to the man page for <tt c permissions and clicking <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to get back to the attributes dialog you should always hit <span class="guibutton">Cancel</span> rather than <span class="guibutton">OK</span> to ensure that your changes - are not overridden.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2906714"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + are not overridden.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889526"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> File, Directory and Share access problems are very common on the mailing list. The following are examples taken from the mailing list in recent times. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906729"></a>Users can not write to a public share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889540"></a>Users can not write to a public share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> “<span class="quote"> We are facing some troubles with file / directory permissions. I can log on the domain as admin user(root), and there's a public share, on which everyone needs to have permission to create / modify files, but only @@ -4794,80 +4586,89 @@ are examples taken from the mailing list in recent times. </span>” </p><p> There are many ways to solve this problem, here are a few hints: - </p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 13.3. Example Solution:</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> Go to the top of the directory that is shared </p></li><li><p> Set the ownership to what ever public owner and group you want - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chown user.group {}\; - find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chmod 6775 'directory_name' - find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chmod 0775 {} \; - find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chown user.group {}\; - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chown user.group {}\; +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type d -exec chmod 6775 'directory_name' +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chmod 0775 {} \; +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt>find 'directory_name' -type f -exec chown user.group {}\; +</pre><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The above will set the 'sticky bit' on all directories. Read your - Unix/Linux man page on what that does. It causes the OS to assign + UNIX/Linux man page on what that does. It causes the OS to assign to all files created in the directories the ownership of the directory. </p></div></li><li><p> Directory is: <i class="replaceable"><tt>/foodbar</tt></i> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack.engr /foodbar</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> - </p><p>This is the same as doing:</p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack /foodbar</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chgrp engr /foodbar</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p></div></li><li><p>Now do: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack.engr /foodbar</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This is the same as doing:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown jack /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chgrp engr /foodbar</tt></b> +</pre></div></li><li><p>Now do: - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 6775 /foodbar</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al /foodbar/..</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 6775 /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al /foodbar/..</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p>You should see: - </p><pre class="screen"> - drwsrwsr-x 2 jack engr 48 2003-02-04 09:55 foodbar - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +drwsrwsr-x 2 jack engr 48 2003-02-04 09:55 foodbar +</pre><p> </p></li><li><p>Now do: - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>su - jill</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /foodbar</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>touch Afile</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>su - jill</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /foodbar</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>touch Afile</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -al</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> You should see that the file <tt class="filename">Afile</tt> created by Jill will have ownership and permissions of Jack, as follows: - </p><pre class="screen"> - -rw-r--r-- 1 jack engr 0 2003-02-04 09:57 Afile - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +-rw-r--r-- 1 jack engr 0 2003-02-04 09:57 Afile +</pre><p> </p></li><li><p> Now in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for the share add: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - force create mode = 0775 - force directory mode = 6775 - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode = 0775</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force direcrtory mode = 6775</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The above are only needed <span class="emphasis"><em>if</em></span> your users are <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> members of the group you have used. ie: Within the OS do not have write permission on the directory. </p></div><p> An alternative is to set in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the share: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - force user = jack - force group = engr - </pre><p> - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907109"></a>I have set force user and Samba still makes <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> the owner of all the files - I touch!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - When you have a user in 'admin users', Samba will always do file operations for - this user as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, even if <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> has been set. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="locking"></a>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Eric</span> <span class="surname">Roseme</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">HP Oplocks Usage Recommendations Whitepaper<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2910721">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910776">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910908">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911554">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911664">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911924">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2912154">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912180">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2912260">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912291">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2912365">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2912394">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></div><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force user = jack</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force group = engr</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889969"></a>I have set force user but Samba still makes <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> the owner of all the files I touch!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + When you have a user in <a class="indexterm" name="id2889986"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i>, samba will always do file operations for + this user as <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span>, even if <a class="indexterm" name="id2890005"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> has been set. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890022"></a>MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> “<span class="quote">When userB saves a word document that is owned by userA the updated file is now owned by userB. + Why is Samba doing this? How do I fix this?</span>” + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Answer:</em></span> Word does the following when you modify/change a Word document: Word Creates a NEW document with + a temporary name, Word then closes the old document and deletes it, Word then renames the new document to the original document name. + There is NO mechanism by which Samba CAN IN ANY WAY know that the new document really should be owned by the owners + of the original file. Samba has no way of knowing that the file will be renamed by MS Word. As far as Samba is able + to tell, the file that gets created is a NEW file, not one that the application (Word) is updating. + </p><p> + There is a work-around to solve the permissions problem. That work-around involves understanding how you can manage file + system behaviour from within the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, as well as understanding how Unix file systems work. Set on the directory + in which you are changing word documents: <b class="command">chmod g+s 'directory_name'</b> This ensures that all files will + be created with the group that owns the directory. In smb.conf share declaration section set: + </p><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode = 0660</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode = 0770</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p><p> + These two settings will ensure that all directories and files that get created in the share will be read/writable by the + owner and group set on the directory itself. + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="locking"></a>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Eric</span> <span class="surname">Roseme</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">HP Oplocks Usage Recommendations Whitepaper<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2890270">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2890336">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2890479">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891158">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891268">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2891665">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2891896">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2891924">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892003">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892032">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892106">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892144">Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892167">Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892198">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></div><p> One area which causes trouble for many network administrators is locking. The extent of the problem is readily evident from searches over the internet. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910721"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890270"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba provides all the same locking semantics that MS Windows clients expect and that MS Windows NT4 / 200x servers provide also. </p><p> @@ -4889,13 +4690,13 @@ settings on the MS Windows client. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Sometimes it is necessary to disable locking control settings BOTH on the Samba server as well as on each MS Windows client! -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910776"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890336"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are two types of locking which need to be performed by a SMB server. The first is <span class="emphasis"><em>record locking</em></span> which allows a client to lock a range of bytes in a open file. The second is the <span class="emphasis"><em>deny modes</em></span> that are specified when a file is open. </p><p> -Record locking semantics under Unix is very different from record locking under +Record locking semantics under UNIX are very different from record locking under Windows. Versions of Samba before 2.2 have tried to use the native fcntl() unix system call to implement proper record locking between different Samba clients. This can not be fully correct due to several reasons. The simplest is the fact @@ -4906,29 +4707,29 @@ many more differences, too many to be listed here. </p><p> Samba 2.2 and above implements record locking completely independent of the underlying unix system. If a byte range lock that the client requests happens -to fall into the range 0-2^31, Samba hands this request down to the Unix system. +to fall into the range 0-2^31, Samba hands this request down to the UNIX system. All other locks can not be seen by unix anyway. </p><p> -Strictly a SMB server should check for locks before every read and write call on -a file. Unfortunately with the way fcntl() works this can be slow and may overstress +Strictly an SMB server should check for locks before every read and write call on +a file. Unfortunately with the way fcntl() works this can be slow and may over-stress the <b class="command">rpc.lockd</b>. It is also almost always unnecessary as clients are supposed to independently make locking calls before reads and writes anyway if locking is important to them. By default Samba only makes locking calls when explicitly asked -to by a client, but if you set <i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking = yes</tt></i> then it +to by a client, but if you set <a class="indexterm" name="id2890404"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking</tt></i> = yes then it will make lock checking calls on every read and write. </p><p> -You can also disable by range locking completely using <i class="parameter"><tt>locking = no</tt></i>. +You can also disable byte range locking completely using <a class="indexterm" name="id2890424"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>locking</tt></i> = no. This is useful for those shares that don't support locking or don't need it (such as cdroms). In this case Samba fakes the return codes of locking calls to tell clients that everything is OK. </p><p> -The second class of locking is the <i class="parameter"><tt>deny modes</tt></i>. These +The second class of locking is the <span class="emphasis"><em>deny modes</em></span>. These are set by an application when it opens a file to determine what types of access should be allowed simultaneously with its open. A client may ask for <tt class="constant">DENY_NONE</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_READ</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_WRITE</tt> or <tt class="constant">DENY_ALL</tt>. There are also special compatibility modes called <tt class="constant">DENY_FCB</tt> and <tt class="constant">DENY_DOS</tt>. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910908"></a>Opportunistic Locking Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890479"></a>Opportunistic Locking Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Opportunistic locking (Oplocks) is invoked by the Windows file system (as opposed to an API) via registry entries (on the server AND client) for the purpose of enhancing network performance when accessing a file @@ -4954,7 +4755,7 @@ other processes. operations on the cached local file. </p><p> If a second process attempts to open the file, the open - is deferred while the redirector "breaks" the original + is deferred while the redirector "breaks" the original oplock. The oplock break signals the caching client to write the local file back to the server, flush the local locks, and discard read-ahead data. The break is @@ -4994,12 +4795,12 @@ The actual decision that a user or administrator should consider is whether it is sensible to share amongst multiple users data that will be cached locally on a client. In many cases the answer is no. Deciding when to cache or not cache data is the real question, and thus -"opportunistic locking" should be treated as a toggle for client-side -caching. Turn it "ON" when client-side caching is desirable and -reliable. Turn it "OFF" when client-side caching is redundant, +"opportunistic locking" should be treated as a toggle for client-side +caching. Turn it "ON" when client-side caching is desirable and +reliable. Turn it "OFF" when client-side caching is redundant, unreliable, or counter-productive. </p><p> -Opportunistic locking is by default set to "on" by Samba on all +Opportunistic locking is by default set to "on" by Samba on all configured shares, so careful attention should be given to each case to determine if the potential benefit is worth the potential for delays. The following recommendations will help to characterize the environment @@ -5051,7 +4852,7 @@ In mission critical high availability environments, careful attention should be given to opportunistic locking. Ideally, comprehensive testing should be done with all affected applications with oplocks enabled and disabled. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911199"></a>Exclusively Accessed Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890780"></a>Exclusively Accessed Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Opportunistic locking is most effective when it is confined to shares that are exclusively accessed by a single user, or by only one user at a time. Because the true value of opportunistic locking is the local @@ -5060,7 +4861,7 @@ mechanism will cause a delay. </p><p> Home directories are the most obvious examples of where the performance benefit of opportunistic locking can be safely realized. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911224"></a>Multiple-Accessed Shares or Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890805"></a>Multiple-Accessed Shares or Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> As each additional user accesses a file in a share with opportunistic locking enabled, the potential for delays and resulting perceived poor performance increases. When multiple users are accessing a file on a @@ -5072,17 +4873,17 @@ of the caching user. As each additional client attempts to access a file with oplocks set, the potential performance improvement is negated and eventually results in a performance bottleneck. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911253"></a>Unix or NFS Client Accessed Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Local Unix and NFS clients access files without a mandatory +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890834"></a>UNIX or NFS Client Accessed Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Local UNIX and NFS clients access files without a mandatory file locking mechanism. Thus, these client platforms are incapable of initiating an oplock break request from the server to a Windows client -that has a file cached. Local Unix or NFS file access can therefore +that has a file cached. Local UNIX or NFS file access can therefore write to a file that has been cached by a Windows client, which exposes the file to likely data corruption. </p><p> -If files are shared between Windows clients, and either local Unix +If files are shared between Windows clients, and either local UNIX or NFS users, then turn opportunistic locking off. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911279"></a>Slow and/or Unreliable Networks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890860"></a>Slow and/or Unreliable Networks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The biggest potential performance improvement for opportunistic locking occurs when the client-side caching of reads and writes delivers the most differential over sending those reads and writes over the wire. @@ -5097,7 +4898,7 @@ the most advantageous scenario to utilize opportunistic locking. If the network is slow, unreliable, or a WAN, then do not configure opportunistic locking if there is any chance of multiple users regularly opening the same file. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911312"></a>Multi-User Databases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890894"></a>Multi-User Databases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Multi-user databases clearly pose a risk due to their very nature - they are typically heavily accessed by numerous users at random intervals. Placing a multi-user database on a share with opportunistic @@ -5105,7 +4906,7 @@ locking enabled will likely result in a locking management bottleneck on the Samba server. Whether the database application is developed in-house or a commercially available product, ensure that the share has opportunistic locking disabled. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911334"></a>PDM Data Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890914"></a>PDM Data Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Process Data Management (PDM) applications such as IMAN, Enovia, and Clearcase, are increasing in usage with Windows client platforms, and therefore SMB data stores. PDM applications manage multi-user @@ -5118,8 +4919,8 @@ application and PDM server to negotiate and maintain. It is appropriate to eliminate the client OS from any caching tasks, and the server from any oplock management, by disabling opportunistic locking on the share. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911375"></a>Beware of Force User</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba includes an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter called <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> that changes +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2890942"></a>Beware of Force User</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba includes an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter called <a class="indexterm" name="id2890960"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> that changes the user accessing a share from the incoming user to whatever user is defined by the smb.conf variable. If opportunistic locking is enabled on a share, the change in user access causes an oplock break to be sent @@ -5131,26 +4932,26 @@ to overcome the lost oplock break. </p><p> Avoid the combination of the following: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> share configuration. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2891007"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> share configuration. </p></li><li><p> Slow or unreliable networks </p></li><li><p> Opportunistic Locking Enabled - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911453"></a>Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891044"></a>Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba provides opportunistic locking parameters that allow the administrator to adjust various properties of the oplock mechanism to account for timing and usage levels. These parameters provide good versatility for implementing oplocks in environments where they would likely cause problems. The parameters are: -<i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i>, -<i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i>. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891061"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891075"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i>. </p><p> For most users, administrators, and environments, if these parameters are required, then the better option is to simply turn oplocks off. -The samba SWAT help text for both parameters reads "DO NOT CHANGE THIS -PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." +The samba SWAT help text for both parameters reads "DO NOT CHANGE THIS +PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." This is good advice. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911496"></a>Mission Critical High Availability</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891101"></a>Mission Critical High Availability</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> In mission critical high availability environments, data integrity is often a priority. Complex and expensive configurations are implemented to ensure that if a client loses connectivity with a file server, a @@ -5180,10 +4981,10 @@ In mission critical high availability environments, careful attention should be given to opportunistic locking. Ideally, comprehensive testing should be done with all affected applications with oplocks enabled and disabled. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911554"></a>Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891158"></a>Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Opportunistic Locking is a unique Windows file locking feature. It is not really file locking, but is included in most discussions of Windows -file locking, so is considered a defacto locking feature. +file locking, so is considered a de facto locking feature. Opportunistic Locking is actually part of the Windows client file caching mechanism. It is not a particularly robust or reliable feature when implemented on the variety of customized networks that exist in @@ -5202,7 +5003,7 @@ file, the first client receives a break and must synchronise the file back to th This can give significant performance gains in some cases; some programs insist on synchronising the contents of the entire file back to the server for a single change. </p><p> -Level1 Oplocks (aka just plain "oplocks") is another term for opportunistic locking. +Level1 Oplocks (aka just plain "oplocks") is another term for opportunistic locking. </p><p> Level2 Oplocks provides opportunistic locking for a file that will be treated as <span class="emphasis"><em>read only</em></span>. Typically this is used on files that are read-only or @@ -5214,7 +5015,7 @@ file locking with the under lying OS, SGI IRIX and Linux are the only two OS's t oplock aware at this time. </p><p> Unless your system supports kernel oplocks, you should disable oplocks if you are -accessing the same files from both Unix/Linux and SMB clients. Regardless, oplocks should +accessing the same files from both UNIX/Linux and SMB clients. Regardless, oplocks should always be disabled if you are sharing a database file (e.g., Microsoft Access) between multiple clients, as any break the first client receives will affect synchronisation of the entire file (not just the single record), which will result in a noticeable performance @@ -5230,29 +5031,23 @@ of your client sending oplock breaks and will instead want to disable oplocks fo </p><p> Another factor to consider is the perceived performance of file access. If oplocks provide no measurable speed benefit on your network, it might not be worth the hassle of dealing with them. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911664"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891268"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the following we examine two distinct aspects of Samba locking controls. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911677"></a>Disabling Oplocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891281"></a>Disabling Oplocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can disable oplocks on a per-share basis with the following: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[acctdata] - oplocks = False - level2 oplocks = False -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[acctdata]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks = False</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>level2 oplocks = False</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> The default oplock type is Level1. Level2 Oplocks are enabled on a per-share basis in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> Alternately, you could disable oplocks on a per-file basis within the share: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - veto oplock files = /*.mdb/*.MDB/*.dbf/*.DBF/ -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /*.mdb/*.MDB/*.dbf/*.DBF/</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> If you are experiencing problems with oplocks as apparent from Samba's log entries, you may want to play it safe and disable oplocks and level2 oplocks. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911740"></a>Disabling Kernel OpLocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891378"></a>Disabling Kernel OpLocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Kernel OpLocks is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that notifies Samba (if the UNIX kernel has the capability to send a Windows client an oplock break) when a UNIX process is attempting to open the file that is @@ -5265,11 +5060,8 @@ send an oplock break, then the kernel oplocks parameter enables Samba to send the oplock break. Kernel oplocks are enabled on a per-server basis in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] -kernel oplocks = yes -</pre><p> -The default is "no". + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +The default is "no". </p><p> Veto OpLocks is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that identifies specific files for which Oplocks are disabled. When a Windows client opens a file that @@ -5283,41 +5075,26 @@ caching without the risk of data corruption. Veto Oplocks can be enabled on a per-share basis, or globally for the entire server, in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"><font color="red"><title>Example Veto OpLock Settings</title></font> -[global] - veto oplock files = /filename.htm/*.txt/ - -[share_name] - veto oplock files = /*.exe/filename.ext/ -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2891471"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 14.1. Share with some files oplocked</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /filename.htm/*.txt/</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /*.exe/filename.ext/</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> -<span class="emphasis"><em>Oplock break wait time</em></span> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that adjusts the time + <a class="indexterm" name="id2891525"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that adjusts the time interval for Samba to reply to an oplock break request. Samba -recommends "DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND -UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." Oplock Break Wait Time can only be +recommends "DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND +UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." Oplock Break Wait Time can only be configured globally in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - oplock break wait time = 0 (default) -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time = 0 (default)</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Oplock break contention limit</em></span> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that limits the response of the Samba server to grant an oplock if the configured number of contending clients reaches the limit specified by the -parameter. Samba recommends "DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU -HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." Oplock Break +parameter. Samba recommends "DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU +HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." Oplock Break Contention Limit can be enable on a per-share basis, or globally for the entire server, in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - oplock break contention limit = 2 (default) - -[share_name] - oplock break contention limit = 2 (default) -</pre><p> -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911924"></a>MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2891612"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 14.2. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break contention limit = 2 (default)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break contention limit = 2 (default)</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891665"></a>MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is a known issue when running applications (like Norton Anti-Virus) on a Windows 2000/ XP workstation computer that can affect any application attempting to access shared database files across a network. This is a result of a default setting configured in the Windows 2000/XP @@ -5409,7 +5186,7 @@ An illustration of how level II oplocks work: station holds any oplock on the file. Because the workstations can have no cached writes or locks at this point, they need not respond to the break-to-none advisory; all they need do is invalidate locally cashed read-ahead data. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912154"></a>Workstation Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891896"></a>Workstation Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanWorkstation\Parameters @@ -5418,7 +5195,7 @@ An illustration of how level II oplocks work: </pre><p> Indicates whether the redirector should use opportunistic-locking (oplock) performance enhancement. This parameter should be disabled only to isolate problems. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912180"></a>Server Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891924"></a>Server Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanServer\Parameters @@ -5447,8 +5224,8 @@ the server disables raw I/O and opportunistic locking for this connection. Specifies the time that the server waits for a client to respond to an oplock break request. Smaller values can allow detection of crashed clients more quickly but can potentially cause loss of cached data. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912260"></a>Persistent Data Corruption</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you have applied all of the settings discussed in this paper but data corruption problems +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892003"></a>Persistent Data Corruption</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you have applied all of the settings discussed in this chapter but data corruption problems and other symptoms persist, here are some additional things to check out: </p><p> We have credible reports from developers that faulty network hardware, such as a single @@ -5458,7 +5235,7 @@ rebuild the data files in question. This involves creating a new data file with same definition as the file to be rebuilt and transferring the data from the old file to the new one. There are several known methods for doing this that can be found in our Knowledge Base. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912291"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892032"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In some sites locking problems surface as soon as a server is installed, in other sites locking problems may not surface for a long time. Almost without exception, when a locking problem does surface it will cause embarrassment and potential data corruption. @@ -5488,18 +5265,23 @@ so far: report on https://bugzilla.samba.org without delay. Make sure that you give as much information as you possibly can to help isolate the cause and to allow reproduction of the problem (an essential step in problem isolation and correction). - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912365"></a>locking.tdb error messages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - > We are seeing lots of errors in the samba logs like: - > - > tdb(/usr/local/samba_2.2.7/var/locks/locking.tdb): rec_read bad magic - > 0x4d6f4b61 at offset=36116 - > - > What do these mean? - </pre><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892106"></a>locking.tdb error messages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + We are seeing lots of errors in the samba logs like: +</span>” +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +tdb(/usr/local/samba_2.2.7/var/locks/locking.tdb): rec_read bad magic + 0x4d6f4b61 at offset=36116 +</pre><p> +“<span class="quote"> + What do these mean? + </span>” </p><p> Corrupted tdb. Stop all instances of smbd, delete locking.tdb, restart smbd. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912394"></a>Additional Reading</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892144"></a>Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This is a bug in Windows XP. More information can be + found in <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/?id=812937" target="_top">Microsoft Knowledge Base article 812937</a>.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892167"></a>Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">It sometimes takes approximately 35 seconds to delete files over the network after XP SP1 has been applied</span>”</p><p>This is a bug in Windows XP. More information can be + found in <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/?id=811492" target="_top"> + Microsoft Knowledge Base article 811492</a>.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892198"></a>Additional Reading</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> You may want to check for an updated version of this white paper on our Web site from time to time. Many of our white papers are updated as information changes. For those papers, the Last Edited date is always at the top of the paper. @@ -5511,27 +5293,27 @@ Windows Base Services > Files and I/O > SDK Documentation > File Storag > About File Systems > Opportunistic Locks, Microsoft Corporation. <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/fileio/storage_5yk3.asp" target="_top">http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/en-us/fileio/storage_5yk3.asp</a> </p><p> -Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q224992 "Maintaining Transactional Integrity with OPLOCKS", +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q224992 "Maintaining Transactional Integrity with OPLOCKS", Microsoft Corporation, April 1999, <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q224992" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q224992</a>. </p><p> -Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q296264 "Configuring Opportunistic Locking in Windows 2000", +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q296264 "Configuring Opportunistic Locking in Windows 2000", Microsoft Corporation, April 2001, <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q296264" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q296264</a>. </p><p> -Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q129202 "PC Ext: Explanation of Opportunistic Locking on Windows NT", +Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q129202 "PC Ext: Explanation of Opportunistic Locking on Windows NT", Microsoft Corporation, April 1995, <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="securing-samba"></a>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 26, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2914448">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914481">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914555">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914574">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914645">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914697">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914749">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914805">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914866">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2914907">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914932">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2914949">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914974">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914448"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="securing-samba"></a>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 26, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2892365">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892398">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892471">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892490">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892590">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892650">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892717">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892774">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892867">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2892926">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892950">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2892968">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2892992">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892365"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This note was attached to the Samba 2.2.8 release notes as it contained an important security fix. The information contained here applies to Samba installations in general. </p><p> -A new apprentice reported for duty to the Chief Engineer of a boiler house. He said, "Here I am, -if you will show me the boiler I'll start working on it." Then engineer replied, "You're leaning -on it!" +A new apprentice reported for duty to the Chief Engineer of a boiler house. He said, "Here I am, +if you will show me the boiler I'll start working on it." Then engineer replied, "You're leaning +on it!" </p><p> Security concerns are just like that: You need to know a little about the subject to appreciate how obvious most of it really is. The challenge for most of us is to discover that first morsel of knowledge with which we may unlock the secrets of the masters. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914481"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892398"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are three level at which security principals must be observed in order to render a site at least moderately secure. These are: the perimeter firewall, the configuration of the host server that is running Samba, and Samba itself. @@ -5541,60 +5323,52 @@ the latest protocols to permit more secure MS Windows file and print operations. </p><p> Samba may be secured from connections that originate from outside the local network. This may be done using <span class="emphasis"><em>host based protection</em></span> (using samba's implementation of a technology -known as "tcpwrappers", or it may be done be using <span class="emphasis"><em>interface based exclusion</em></span> +known as "tcpwrappers", or it may be done be using <span class="emphasis"><em>interface based exclusion</em></span> so that <span class="application">smbd</span> will bind only to specifically permitted interfaces. It is also -possible to set specific share or resource based exclusions, eg: on the <i class="parameter"><tt>IPC$</tt></i> -auto-share. The <i class="parameter"><tt>IPC$</tt></i> share is used for browsing purposes as well as to establish +possible to set specific share or resource based exclusions, eg: on the <i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i> +auto-share. The <i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i> share is used for browsing purposes as well as to establish TCP/IP connections. </p><p> Another method by which Samba may be secured is by way of setting Access Control Entries in an Access Control List on the shares themselves. This is discussed in the chapter on File, Directory and Share Access Control. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914555"></a>Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892471"></a>Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The key challenge of security is the fact that protective measures suffice at best only to close the door on known exploits and breach techniques. Never assume that because you have followed these few measures that the Samba server is now an impenetrable fortress! Given the history of information systems so far, it is only a matter of time before someone will find yet another vulnerability. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914574"></a>Using host based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892490"></a>Using host based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In many installations of Samba the greatest threat comes for outside your immediate network. By default Samba will accept connections from any host, which means that if you run an insecure version of Samba on a host that is directly connected to the Internet you can be especially vulnerable. </p><p> - One of the simplest fixes in this case is to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and - <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> options in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file to only + One of the simplest fixes in this case is to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2892512"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2892526"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> options in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file to only allow access to your server from a specific range of hosts. An example might be: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - hosts allow = 127.0.0.1 192.168.2.0/24 192.168.3.0/24 - hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0 - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 127.0.0.1 192.168.2.0/24 192.168.3.0/24</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> The above will only allow SMB connections from 'localhost' (your own computer) and from the two private networks 192.168.2 and 192.168.3. All other connections will be refused as soon as the client sends its first packet. The refusal will be marked as a <span class="errorname">not listening on called name</span> error. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914645"></a>User based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892590"></a>User based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you want to restrict access to your server to valid users only then the following - method may be of use. In the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> <i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i> section put: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - valid users = @smbusers, jacko - </pre><p> + method may be of use. In the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section put: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users = @smbusers, jacko</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> What this does is, it restricts all server access to either the user <span class="emphasis"><em>jacko</em></span> or to members of the system group <span class="emphasis"><em>smbusers</em></span>. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914697"></a>Using interface protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892650"></a>Using interface protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> By default Samba will accept connections on any network interface that it finds on your system. That means if you have a ISDN line or a PPP connection to the Internet then Samba will accept connections on those links. This may not be what you want. </p><p> You can change this behaviour using options like the following: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - interfaces = eth* lo - bind interfaces only = yes - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces = eth* lo</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> This tells Samba to only listen for connections on interfaces with a name starting with 'eth' such as eth0, eth1, plus on the loopback interface called 'lo'. The name you will need to use depends on what @@ -5606,7 +5380,7 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. connection refused reply. In that case no Samba code is run at all as the operating system has been told not to pass connections from that interface to any samba process. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914749"></a>Using a firewall</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892717"></a>Using a firewall</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many people use a firewall to deny access to services that they don't want exposed outside their network. This can be a very good idea, although I would recommend using it in conjunction with the above @@ -5619,7 +5393,7 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. The last one is important as many older firewall setups may not be aware of it, given that this port was only added to the protocol in recent years. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914805"></a>Using a IPC$ share deny</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892774"></a>Using a IPC$ share deny</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the above methods are not suitable, then you could also place a more specific deny on the IPC$ share that is used in the recently discovered security hole. This allows you to offer access to other @@ -5627,11 +5401,7 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. hosts. </p><p> To do that you could use: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> -[ipc$] - hosts allow = 192.168.115.0/24 127.0.0.1 - hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0 - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[ipc$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 192.168.115.0/24 127.0.0.1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> this would tell Samba that IPC$ connections are not allowed from anywhere but the two listed places (localhost and a local subnet). Connections to other shares would still be allowed. As the @@ -5646,42 +5416,44 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. </p><p> This is not recommended unless you cannot use one of the other methods listed above for some reason. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914866"></a>NTLMv2 Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892867"></a>NTLMv2 Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To configure NTLMv2 authentication the following registry keys are worth knowing about: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> + </p><pre class="screen"> [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa] - "lmcompatibilitylevel"=dword:00000003 - + "lmcompatibilitylevel"=dword:00000003 + </pre><p> + </p><p> 0x3 - Send NTLMv2 response only. Clients will use NTLMv2 authentication, use NTLMv2 session security if the server supports it. Domain controllers accept LM, NTLM and NTLMv2 authentication. - + </p><p> + </p><pre class="screen"> [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa\MSV1_0] - "NtlmMinClientSec"=dword:00080000 - + "NtlmMinClientSec"=dword:00080000 + </pre><p> + </p><p> 0x80000 - NTLMv2 session security. If either NtlmMinClientSec or NtlmMinServerSec is set to 0x80000, the connection will fail if NTLMv2 session security is not negotiated. - </pre><p> - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914907"></a>Upgrading Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892926"></a>Upgrading Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Please check regularly on <a href="http://www.samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> for updates and important announcements. Occasionally security releases are made and it is highly recommended to upgrade Samba when a security vulnerability -is discovered. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914932"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +is discovered. Check with your OS vendor for OS specific upgrades. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892950"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If all of samba and host platform configuration were really as intuitive as one might like then this section would not be necessary. Security issues are often vexing for a support person to resolve, not because of the complexity of the problem, but for reason that most administrators who post what turns out to be a security problem request are totally convinced that the problem is with Samba. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914949"></a>Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892968"></a>Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is a very common problem. Red Hat Linux (as do others) will install a default firewall. With the default firewall in place only traffic on the loopback adapter (IP address 127.0.0.1) will be allowed through the firewall. </p><p> The solution is either to remove the firewall (stop it) or to modify the firewall script to allow SMB networking traffic through. See section above in this chapter. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914974"></a>Why can users access home directories of other users?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892992"></a>Why can users access home directories of other users?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> “<span class="quote"> We are unable to keep individual users from mapping to any other user's home directory once they have supplied a valid password! They only need @@ -5710,27 +5482,24 @@ out to be a security problem request are totally convinced that the problem is w the policies and permissions he or she desires. </p><p> Samba does allow the setup you require when you have set the - <i class="parameter"><tt>only user = yes</tt></i> option on the share, is that you have not set the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2893052"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i> = yes option on the share, is that you have not set the valid users list for the share. </p><p> Note that only user works in conjunction with the users= list, so to get the behavior you require, add the line : - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - users = %S - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>users = %S</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> this is equivalent to: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - valid users = %S - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users = %S</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> to the definition of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share, as recommended in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="InterdomainTrusts"></a>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Rafal</span> <span class="surname">Szczesniak</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org">mimir@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2915881">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915909">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915993">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916006">NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916091">NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916127">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916155">Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916295">Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916428">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916443">Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="InterdomainTrusts"></a>Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Rafal</span> <span class="surname">Szczesniak</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org">mimir@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawing</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2893283">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893311">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893400">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2893428">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893500">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893547">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2893725">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2893918">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2894055">NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894162">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2893263"></a><p> Samba-3 supports NT4 style domain trust relationships. This is feature that many sites will want to use if they migrate to Samba-3 from and NT4 style domain and do NOT want to adopt Active Directory or an LDAP based authentication back end. This section explains some background information regarding trust relationships and how to create them. It is now -possible for Samba-3 to NT4 trust (and vice versa), as well as Samba3 to Samba3 trusts. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915881"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +possible for Samba-3 to trust NT4 (and vice versa), as well as to create Samba3-to-Samba3 +trusts. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893283"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 can participate in Samba-to-Samba as well as in Samba-to-MS Windows NT4 style trust relationships. This imparts to Samba similar scalability as is possible with MS Windows NT4. @@ -5740,10 +5509,10 @@ database such as LDAP, and given it's ability to run in Primary as well as Backu modes, the administrator would be well advised to consider alternatives to the use of Interdomain trusts simply because by the very nature of how this works it is fragile. That was, after all, a key reason for the development and adoption of Microsoft Active Directory. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915909"></a>Trust Relationship Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893311"></a>Trust Relationship Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows NT3.x/4.0 type security domains employ a non-hierarchical security structure. The limitations of this architecture as it affects the scalability of MS Windows networking -in large organisations is well known. Additionally, the flat-name space that results from +in large organisations is well known. Additionally, the flat namespace that results from this design significantly impacts the delegation of administrative responsibilities in large and diverse organisations. </p><p> @@ -5769,45 +5538,91 @@ relationship, and WHITE and BLUE have a trust relationship, then it holds that t implied trust between the RED and BLUE domains. ie: Relationships are explicit and not transitive. </p><p> + New to MS Windows 2000 ADS security contexts is the fact that trust relationships are two-way by default. Also, all inter-ADS domain trusts are transitive. In the case of the RED, WHITE and BLUE domains above, with Windows 2000 and ADS the RED and BLUE domains CAN trust each other. This is an inherent feature of ADS domains. Samba-3 implements MS Windows NT4 style Interdomain trusts and interoperates with MS Windows 200x ADS security domains in similar manner to MS Windows NT4 style domains. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915993"></a>Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There are two steps to creating an interdomain trust relationship. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916006"></a>NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893400"></a>Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are two steps to creating an interdomain trust relationship. To effect a two-way trust +relationship it is necessary for each domain administrator to create a trust account for the +other domain to use in verifying security credentials. + +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893417"></a> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893428"></a>Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For MS Windows NT4, all domain trust relationships are configured using the -<span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>. To affect a two way trust relationship it is -necessary for each domain administrator to make available (for use by an external domain) it's -security resources. This is done from the Domain User Manager Policies entry on the menu bar. -From the <span class="guimenu">Policy</span> menu, select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>, then -next to the lower box that is labelled <span class="guilabel">Permitted to Trust this Domain</span> are two -buttons, <span class="guibutton">Add</span> and <span class="guibutton">Remove</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Add</span> -button will open a panel in which needs to be entered the remote domain that will be able to assign -user rights to your domain. In addition it is necessary to enter a password -that is specific to this trust relationship. The password needs to be -typed twice (for standard confirmation). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916091"></a>NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>. This is done from the Domain User Manager Policies +entry on the menu bar. From the <span class="guimenu">Policy</span> menu, select +<span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>. Next to the lower box labelled +<span class="guilabel">Permitted to Trust this Domain</span> are two buttons, <span class="guibutton">Add</span> +and <span class="guibutton">Remove</span>. The <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button will open a panel in which +to enter the name of the remote domain that will be able to assign access rights to users in +your domain. You will also need to enter a password for this trust relationship, which the +trusting domain will use when authenticating users from the trusted domain. +The password needs to be typed twice (for standard confirmation). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893500"></a>Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2893511"></a> A trust relationship will work only when the other (trusting) domain makes the appropriate connections with the trusted domain. To consummate the trust relationship the administrator will launch the Domain User Manager, from the menu select Policies, then select Trust Relationships, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button that is next to the box that is labelled <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span>. A panel will open in which must be entered the name of the remote domain as well as the password assigned to that trust. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2916127"></a>Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893547"></a>Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2893555"></a><p> +A two-way trust relationship is created when two one-way trusts are created, one in each direction. +Where a one-way trust has been established between two MS Windows NT4 domains (let's call them +DomA and DomB) the following facilities are created: +</p><div class="figure"><a name="trusts1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 16.1. Trusts overview</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/trusts1.png" width="270" alt="Trusts overview"></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + DomA (completes the trust connection) Trusts DomB + </p></li><li><p> + DomA is the Trusting domain + </p></li><li><p> + DomB is the Trusted domain (originates the trust account) + </p></li><li><p> + Users in DomB can access resources in DomA + </p></li><li><p> + Users in DomA can NOT access resources in DomB + </p></li><li><p> + Global groups from DomB CAN be used in DomA + </p></li><li><p> + Global groups from DomA can NOT be used in DomB + </p></li><li><p> + DomB DOES appear in the logon dialog box on client workstations in DomA + </p></li><li><p> + DomA does NOT appear in the logon dialog box on client workstations in DomB + </p></li></ul></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Users / Groups in a trusting domain can NOT be granted rights, permissions or access + to a trusted domain. + </p></li><li><p> + The trusting domain CAN access and use accounts (Users / Global Groups) in the + trusted domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Administrators of the trusted domain CAN be granted admininstrative rights in the + trusting domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Users in a trusted domain CAN be given rights and privileges in the trusting + domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Trusted domain Global Groups CAN be given rights and permissions in the trusting + domain. + </p></li><li><p> + Global Groups from the trusted domain CAN be made members in Local Groups on + MS Windows domain member machines. + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893725"></a>Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This description is meant to be a fairly short introduction about how to set up a Samba server so that it could participate in interdomain trust relationships. Trust relationship support in Samba is in its early stage, so lot of things don't work yet. </p><p> -Each of the procedures described below is treated as they were performed with Windows NT4 Server on -one end. The remote end could just as well be another Samba-3 domain. It can be clearly seen, after -reading this document, that combining Samba-specific parts of what's written below leads to trust -between domains in purely Samba environment. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916155"></a>Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In order to set the Samba PDC to be the trusted party of the relationship first you need -to create special account for the domain that will be the trusting party. To do that, +Each of the procedures described below assumes the peer domain in the trust relationship is +controlled by a Windows NT4 server. However, the remote end could just as well be another +Samba-3 domain. It can be clearly seen, after reading this document, that combining +Samba-specific parts of what's written below leads to trust between domains in a purely Samba +environment. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="samba-trusted-domain"></a>Samba as the Trusted Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In order to set the Samba PDC to be the trusted party of the relationship you first need +to create a special account for the domain that will be the trusting party. To do that, you can use the 'smbpasswd' utility. Creating the trusted domain account is very similar to creating a trusted machine account. Suppose, your domain is called SAMBA, and the remote domain is called RUMBA. The first step @@ -5815,9 +5630,9 @@ will be to issue this command from your favourite shell: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -a -i rumba</tt></b> - New SMB password: XXXXXXXX - Retype SMB password: XXXXXXXX - Added user rumba$ +New SMB password: <b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXXX</tt></b> +Retype SMB password: <b class="userinput"><tt>XXXXXXXX</tt></b> +Added user rumba$ </pre><p> where <tt class="option">-a</tt> means to add a new account into the @@ -5830,29 +5645,29 @@ After issuing this command you'll be asked to enter the password for the account. You can use any password you want, but be aware that Windows NT will not change this password until 7 days following account creation. After the command returns successfully, you can look at the entry for the new account -(in the standard way depending on your configuration) and see that account's name is -really RUMBA$ and it has 'I' flag in the flags field. Now you're ready to confirm +(in the standard way as appropriate for your configuration) and see that account's name is +really RUMBA$ and it has the 'I' flag set in the flags field. Now you're ready to confirm the trust by establishing it from Windows NT Server. -</p><p> -Open <span class="application">User Manager for Domains</span> and from menu -<span class="guimenu">Policies</span> select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships...</span>. -Right beside <span class="guilabel">Trusted domains</span> list box press the +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2893856"></a><p> +Open <span class="application">User Manager for Domains</span> and from the +<span class="guimenu">Policies</span> menu, select <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships...</span>. +Right beside the <span class="guilabel">Trusted domains</span> list box press the <span class="guimenu">Add...</span> button. You will be prompted for the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Type in SAMBA, as this is -your domain name, and the password used at the time of account creation. +the name of the remote domain, and the password used at the time of account creation. Press OK and, if everything went without incident, you will see <tt class="computeroutput">Trusted domain relationship successfully established</tt> message. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916295"></a>Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893918"></a>Samba as the Trusting Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This time activities are somewhat reversed. Again, we'll assume that your domain controlled by the Samba PDC is called SAMBA and NT-controlled domain is called RUMBA. </p><p> -The very first thing requirement is to add an account for the SAMBA domain on RUMBA's PDC. -</p><p> +The very first step is to add an account for the SAMBA domain on RUMBA's PDC. +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2893939"></a><p> Launch the <span class="application">Domain User Manager</span>, then from the menu select <span class="guimenu">Policies</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Trust Relationships</span>. -Now, next to <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span> box press the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> -button, and type in the name of the trusted domain (SAMBA) and password securing +Now, next to the <span class="guilabel">Trusted Domains</span> box press the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> +button, and type in the name of the trusted domain (SAMBA) and the password to use in securing the relationship. </p><p> The password can be arbitrarily chosen. It is easy to change the password @@ -5864,61 +5679,60 @@ Using your favourite shell while being logged in as root, issue this command: <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc trustdom establish rumba</tt></b> </p><p> You will be prompted for the password you just typed on your Windows NT4 Server box. -Do not worry if you see an error message that mentions a returned code of -<span class="errorname">NT_STATUS_NOLOGON_INTERDOMAIN_TRUST_ACCOUNT</span>. It means the +Do not worry if you see an error message that mentions a return code of +NT_STATUS_NOLOGON_INTERDOMAIN_TRUST_ACCOUNT. It means the password you gave is correct and the NT4 Server says the account is ready for interdomain connection and not for ordinary -connection. After that, be patient it can take a while (especially -in large networks), you should see the <tt class="computeroutput">Success</tt> message. +connection. After that, be patient; it can take a while (especially +in large networks), but eventually you should see the <tt class="computeroutput">Success</tt> message. Congratulations! Your trust relationship has just been established. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Note that you have to run this command as root because you must have write access to the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> file. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2916428"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894055"></a>NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Although <span class="application">Domain User Manager</span> is not present in Windows 2000, it is +also possible to establish an NT4-style trust relationship with a Windows 2000 domain +controller running in mixed mode as the trusting server. It should also be possible for +Samba to trust a Windows 2000 server, however, more testing is still needed in this area. +</p><p> +After <a href="#samba-trusted-domain" title="Samba as the Trusted Domain">creating the interdomain trust account on the +Samba server</a> as described above, open <span class="application">Active Directory Domains and +Trusts</span> on the AD controller of the domain whose resources you wish Samba users +to have access to. Remember that since NT4-style trusts are not transitive, if you want +your users to have access to multiple mixed-mode domains in your AD forest, you will need to +repeat this process for each of those domains. With <span class="application">Active Directory Domains +and Trusts</span> open, right-click on the name of the Active Directory domain that +will trust our Samba domain and choose <span class="guimenuitem">Properties</span>, then click on +the <span class="guilabel">Trusts</span> tab. In the upper part of the panel, you will see a list box +labelled <span class="guilabel">Domains trusted by this domain:</span>, and an +<span class="guilabel">Add...</span> button next to it. Press this button, and just as with NT4, you +will be prompted for the trusted domain name and the relationship password. Press OK, and +after a moment, Active Directory will respond with <tt class="computeroutput">The trusted domain has +been added and the trust has been verified.</tt> Your Samba users can now be +granted acess to resources in the AD domain. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894162"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Interdomain trust relationships should NOT be attempted on networks that are unstable or that suffer regular outages. Network stability and integrity are key concerns with distributed trusted domains. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916443"></a>Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Like many, I administer multiple LANs connected together using NT trust - relationships. This was implemented about 4 years ago. I now have the - occasion to consider performing this same task again, but this time, I - would like to implement it solely through samba - no Microsoft PDCs - anywhere. - </p><p> - I have read documentation on samba.org regarding NT-style trust - relationships and am now wondering, can I do what I want to? I already - have successfully implemented 2 samba servers, but they are not PDCs. - They merely act as file servers. I seem to remember, and it appears to - be true (according to samba.org) that trust relationships are a - challenge. - </p><p> - Please provide any helpful feedback that you may have. - </p><p> - These are almost complete in Samba 3.0 snapshots. The main catch - is getting winbindd to be able to allocate UID/GIDs for trusted - users/groups. See the updated Samba HOWTO collection for more - details. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="msdfs"></a>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Shirish</span> <span class="surname">Kalele</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team & Veritas Software<br></span><div class="address"><p><br> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="msdfs"></a>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Shirish</span> <span class="surname">Kalele</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team & Veritas Software<br></span><div class="address"><p><br> <tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</a>></tt><br> - </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 Jul 2000</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2915783">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917436">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915783"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 Jul 2000</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2894231">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894506">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894231"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Distributed File System (or DFS) provides a means of separating the logical view of files and directories that users see from the actual physical locations of these resources on the network. It allows for higher availability, smoother storage expansion, load balancing etc. </p><p> - For information about DFS, refer to - <a href="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp" target="_top"> - Microsoft documentation at http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp</a>. + For information about DFS, refer to the +<a href="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp" target="_top">Microsoft documentation</a>. </p><p> - This document explains how to host a DFS tree on a Unix machine (for DFS-aware + This document explains how to host a DFS tree on a UNIX machine (for DFS-aware clients to browse) using Samba. </p><p> - To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the <i class="parameter"><tt>--with-msdfs</tt></i> + To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the <tt class="option">--with-msdfs</tt> option. Once built, a Samba server can be made a DFS server by setting the global - boolean <a href="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTMSDFS" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> host msdfs</tt></i></a> - parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf </tt> file. You designate a share as a DFS - root using the share level boolean <a href="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> - msdfs root</tt></i></a> parameter. A DFS root directory on Samba hosts DFS + boolean <a class="indexterm" name="id2894278"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i> + parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. You designate a share as a DFS + root using the share level boolean <a class="indexterm" name="id2894300"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i> parameter. A DFS root directory on Samba hosts DFS links in the form of symbolic links that point to other servers. For example, a symbolic link <tt class="filename">junction->msdfs:storage1\share1</tt> in the share directory acts as the DFS junction. When DFS-aware clients attempt to access the junction link, @@ -5927,23 +5741,14 @@ distributed trusted domains. DFS trees on Samba work with all DFS-aware clients ranging from Windows 95 to 200x. </p><p> Here's an example of setting up a DFS tree on a Samba server. - </p><pre class="programlisting"> -# The smb.conf file: -[global] - netbios name = SMOKEY - host msdfs = yes - -[dfs] - path = /export/dfsroot - msdfs root = yes - </pre><p>In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our dfs links to + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2894342"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 17.1. smb.conf with DFS configured</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[dfs]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export/dfsroot</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p>In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our DFS links to other servers on the network.</p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /export/dfsroot</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown root /export/dfsroot</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</tt></b> - </pre><p>You should set up the permissions and ownership of +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown root /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</tt></b> +</pre><p>You should set up the permissions and ownership of the directory acting as the DFS root such that only designated users can create, delete or modify the msdfs links. Also note that symlink names should be all lowercase. This limitation exists @@ -5952,22 +5757,21 @@ distributed trusted domains. network shares you want, and start Samba.</p><p>Users on DFS-aware clients can now browse the DFS tree on the Samba server at \\samba\dfs. Accessing links linka or linkb (which appear as directories to the client) - takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917436"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows clients need to be rebooted - if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a dfs + takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894506"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows clients need to be rebooted + if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a DFS root or vice versa. A better way is to introduce a - new share and make it the dfs root.</p></li><li><p>Currently there's a restriction that msdfs + new share and make it the DFS root.</p></li><li><p>Currently there's a restriction that msdfs symlink names should all be lowercase.</p></li><li><p>For security purposes, the directory acting as the root of the DFS tree should have ownership and permissions set so that only designated users can - modify the symbolic links in the directory.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 32, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2917027">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917095">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917133">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917203">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918120">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918450">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918559">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918652">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2918721">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918810">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2919116">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919220">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2919234">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919616">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919945">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920166">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920216">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920741">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921021">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921186">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921338">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921450">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921521">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921752">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921913">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2922008">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922192">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with -rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2923912">"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2923933">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924131">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924420">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924516">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924657">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924690">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925127">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925430">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925673">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a -different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925771">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926117">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926188">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2926210">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2926256">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926297">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926316">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926340">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2926492">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926822">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926867">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927036">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927051">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2927064">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927097">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917027"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + modify the symbolic links in the directory.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2894626">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894693">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2894730">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894801">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895354">A simple Configuration to Print</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2895518">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2895606">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2895939">Extended Sample Configuration to Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896270">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897534">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2897592">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2898261">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2898591">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2898740">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2898892">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899004">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899475">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2899643">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2899736">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2899935">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2901625">Client Driver Install Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2901643">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2901839">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902136">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902231">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2902399">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2902431">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2902874">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903470">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a +different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903569">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903854">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2903932">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2903954">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2903998">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904040">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904059">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904083">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2904236">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904556">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904602">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904779">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904793">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904800">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2904834">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894626"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Printing is often a mission-critical service for the users. Samba can provide this service reliably and seamlessly for a client network consisting of Windows workstations. </p><p> -A Samba-3.0 print service may be run on a Standalone or a Domain +A Samba print service may be run on a Standalone or a Domain member server, side by side with file serving functions, or on a dedicated print server. It can be made as tight or as loosely secured as needs dictate. Configurations may be simple or complex. Available @@ -5975,10 +5779,10 @@ authentication schemes are essentially the same as described for file services in previous chapters. Overall, Samba's printing support is now able to replace an NT or Windows 2000 print server full-square, with additional benefits in many cases. Clients may download and -install drivers and printers through their familiar "Point'n'Print" -mechanism. Printer installations executed by "Logon Scripts" are no +install drivers and printers through their familiar "Point'n'Print" +mechanism. Printer installations executed by "Logon Scripts" are no problem. Administrators can upload and manage drivers to be used by -clients through the familiar "Add Printer Wizard". As an additional +clients through the familiar "Add Printer Wizard". As an additional benefit, driver and printer management may be run from the command line or through scripts, making it more efficient in case of large numbers of printers. If a central accounting of print jobs (tracking every @@ -5991,24 +5795,24 @@ implemented by the more traditional UNIX (BSD- and System V-style) printing systems. Many things apply to CUPS, the newer Common UNIX Printing System, too; so if you use CUPS, you might be tempted to jump to the next chapter -- but you will certainly miss a few things if you -do so. Better read this chapter too. +do so. Better to read this chapter too. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Most of the given examples have been verified on Windows XP Professional clients. Where this document describes the responses to commands given, bear in mind that Windows 2000 clients are very similar, but may differ in details. Windows NT is somewhat different again. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917095"></a>Technical Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2894693"></a>Technical Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba's printing support always relies on the installed print -subsystem of the Unix OS it runs on. Samba is a "middleman". It takes +subsystem of the UNIX OS it runs on. Samba is a "middleman". It takes printfiles from Windows (or other SMB) clients and passes them to the real printing system for further processing. Therefore it needs to -"talk" to two sides: to the Windows print clients and to the Unix +"talk" to two sides: to the Windows print clients and to the UNIX printing system. Hence we must differentiate between the various client OS types each of which behave differently, as well as the various UNIX print subsystems, which themselves have different features and are accessed differently. This part of the Samba HOWTO -Collection deals with the "traditional" way of Unix printing first; +Collection deals with the "traditional" way of UNIX printing first; the next chapter covers in great detail the more modern <span class="emphasis"><em>Common UNIX Printing System</em></span> (CUPS). @@ -6016,113 +5820,104 @@ the next chapter covers in great detail the more modern </p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p>CUPS users, be warned: don't just jump on to the next chapter. You might miss important information contained only here!</p></div><p> -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917133"></a>What happens if you send a Job from a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894730"></a>What happens if you send a Job from a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To successfully print a job from a Windows client via a Samba print server to a UNIX printer, there are 6 (potentially 7) stages: -</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Windows opens a connection to the printershare</p></li><li><p>Samba must authenticate the user</p></li><li><p>Windows sends a copy of the printfile over the network +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Windows opens a connection to the printer share</p></li><li><p>Samba must authenticate the user</p></li><li><p>Windows sends a copy of the printfile over the network into Samba's spooling area</p></li><li><p>Windows closes the connection again</p></li><li><p>Samba invokes the print command to hand the file over -to the UNIX print subsystem's spooling area</p></li><li><p>The Unix print subsystem processes the print +to the UNIX print subsystem's spooling area</p></li><li><p>The UNIX print subsystem processes the print job</p></li><li><p>The printfile may need to be explicitly deleted -from the Samba spooling area.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917203"></a>Printing Related Configuration Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +from the Samba spooling area.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894801"></a>Printing Related Configuration Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of configuration parameters in controlling Samba's printing behaviour. Please also refer to the man page for smb.conf to acquire an overview about these. As with other parameters, there are -Global Level (tagged with a "<span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span>" in the listings) and -Service Level ("<span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>") parameters. +Global Level (tagged with a "<span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span>" in the listings) and +Service Level ("<span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>") parameters. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Service Level Parameters</span></dt><dd><p>These <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> go into the -<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of -. In this case they define the default +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +In this case they define the default behaviour of all individual or service level shares (provided those don't have a different setting defined for the same parameter, thus overriding the global default).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Global Parameters</span></dt><dd><p>These <span class="emphasis"><em>may not</em></span> go into individual -shares. If they go in by error, the "testparm" utility can discover -this (if you run it) and tell you so.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918120"></a>Parameters Recommended for Use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters directly -related to printing are used in Samba-3. See also the +shares. If they go in by error, the "testparm" utility can discover +this (if you run it) and tell you so.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2894888"></a>Parameters Recommended for Use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters directly +related to printing are used in Samba. See also the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for detailed explanations: -</p><p><b>List of printing related parameters in Samba-3. </b> -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Global level parameters:</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name (G), printcap (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (G)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> - -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Service level parameters:</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>print command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printable (S), print ok (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name (S), printer (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = [cups|bsd|lprng...] (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p>Global level parameters: <a class="indexterm" name="id2894917"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894932"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894946"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894960"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894974"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2894988"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895002"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895016"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2895030"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895044"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895072"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i>. +</p><p>Service level parameters: <a class="indexterm" name="id2895090"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895104"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895118"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895132"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895146"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895160"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895174"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895188"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895202"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895216"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2895229"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print ok </tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895242"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2895258"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895271"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895285"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = [cups|bsd|lprng...], +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895299"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895313"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2895327"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i>. </p><p> Samba's printing support implements the Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls (MS-RPC) methods for printing. These are used by Windows NT (and -later) print servers. The old "LanMan" protocol is still supported as +later) print servers. The old "LanMan" protocol is still supported as a fallback resort, and for older clients to use. More details will follow further beneath. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918450"></a>Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Two new parameters that were added in Samba 2.2.2, are still present -in Samba-3.0. Both of these options are described in the -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page and are disabled by -default. <span class="emphasis"><em>Use them with caution!</em></span> -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss(G)</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> This is -provided for better support of Samba 2.0.x backwards capability. It -will disable Samba's support for MS-RPC printing and yield identical -printing behaviour to Samba 2.0.x.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (G)</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> was provided -for using local printer drivers on Windows NT/2000 clients. It does -not apply to Windows 95/98/ME clients.</p></dd></dl></div><p><b>Parameters "for backward compatibility only", use with caution. </b> -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918559"></a>Parameters no longer in use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba users upgrading from 2.2.x to 3.0 need to be aware that some -previously available settings are no longer supported (as was -announced some time ago). Here is a list of them: -</p><p><b>"old" parameters, removed in Samba-3. </b> -The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters have been -deprecated already in Samba 2.2 and are now completely removed from -Samba-3. You cannot use them in new 3.0 installations: - -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>postscript (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918652"></a>A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895354"></a>A simple Configuration to Print</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here is a very simple example configuration for print related settings -in the file. If you compare it with your -own system's , you probably find some +in the file. If you compare it with your own system's , you probably find some additional parameters included there (as pre-configured by your OS vendor). Further below is a discussion and explanation of the parameters. Note, that this example doesn't use many parameters. However, in many environments these are enough to provide a valid - which enables all clients to print. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - printing = bsd - load printers = yes - - [printers] - path = /var/spool/samba - printable = yes - public = yes - writable = no -</pre><p> -This is only an example configuration. Many settings, if not -explicitly set to a specific value, are used and set by Samba -implicitly to its own default, because these have been compiled in. -To see all settings, let root use the <b class="command">testparm</b> -utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> also gives warnings if you have -mis-configured certain things. Its complete output is easily 340 lines -and more. You may want to pipe it through a pager program. +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file which enables all clients to print. +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2895382"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.1. Simple configuration with BSD printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +This is only an example configuration. Samba assigns default values to all +configuration parameters. On the whole the defaults are conservative and +sensible. When a parameter is specified in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file this overwrites +the default value. The <b class="command">testparm</b> utility when run as root +is capable of reporting all setting, both default as well as <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file +settings. <b class="command">Testparm</b> gives warnings for all mis-configured +settings. The complete output is easily 340 lines and more, so you may want +to pipe it through a pager program. </p><p> The syntax for the configuration file is easy to grasp. You should know that is not very picky about its syntax. It has been explained elsewhere in this document. A short -reminder: It even tolerates some spelling errors (like "browsable" -instead of "browseable"). Most spelling is case-insensitive. Also, you -can use "Yes|No" or "True|False" for boolean settings. Lists of names +reminder: It even tolerates some spelling errors (like "browsable" +instead of "browseable"). Most spelling is case-insensitive. Also, you +can use "Yes|No" or "True|False" for boolean settings. Lists of names may be separated by commas, spaces or tabs. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918721"></a>Verification of "Settings in Use" with <b class="command">testparm</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895518"></a>Verification of "Settings in Use" with <b class="command">testparm</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To see all (or at least most) printing related settings in Samba, including the implicitly used ones, try the command outlined below -(hit "ENTER" twice!). It greps for all occurrences of "lp", "print", -"spool", "driver", "ports" and "[" in testparm's output and gives you +(hit "ENTER" twice!). It greps for all occurrences of "lp", "print", +"spool", "driver", "ports" and "[" in testparm's output and gives you a nice overview about the running smbd's print configuration. (Note that this command does not show individually created printer shares, or the spooling paths in each case). Here is the output of my Samba setup, with exactly the same settings in as shown above: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v | egrep "(lp|print|spool|driver|ports|\[)"</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v | egrep "(lp|print|spool|driver|ports|\[)"</tt></b> Load smb config files from /etc/samba/smb.conf.simpleprinting - Processing section "[homes]" - Processing section "[printers]" + Processing section "[homes]" + Processing section "[printers]" [global] smb ports = 445 139 @@ -6159,21 +5954,21 @@ as shown above: You can easily verify which settings were implicitly added by Samba's default behaviour. <span class="emphasis"><em>Don't forget about this point: it may be important in your future dealings with Samba.</em></span> -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> testparm in Samba-3.0 behaves differently from 2.2.x: used -without the "-v" switch it only shows you the settings actually +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> testparm in samba 3 behaves differently from 2.2.x: used +without the "-v" switch it only shows you the settings actually written into ! To see the complete -configuration used, add the "-v" parameter to testparm.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918810"></a>A little Experiment to warn you</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +configuration used, add the "-v" parameter to testparm.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2895606"></a>A little Experiment to warn you</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Should you need to troubleshoot at any stage, please always come back -to this point first and verify if "testparm" shows the parameters you +to this point first and verify if "testparm" shows the parameters you expect! To give you an example from personal experience as a warning, -try to just "comment out" the <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>" +try to just "comment out" the <a class="indexterm" name="id2895621"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>" parameter. If your 2.2.x system behaves like mine, you'll see this: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>grep "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>grep "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf # load printers = Yes - # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!! - -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf | egrep "(load printers)" + # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!! + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf | egrep "(load printers)" load printers = Yes </pre><p> @@ -6182,20 +5977,20 @@ prevent Samba from publishing my printers, it still did! Oh Boy -- it cost me quite some time to find out the reason. But I am not fooled any more... at least not by this ;-) </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -A1 "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -A1 "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf</tt></b> load printers = No # This setting is what I mean!! # load printers = Yes # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!! -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v smb.conf.simpleprinting | egrep "(load printers)"</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v smb.conf.simpleprinting | egrep "(load printers)"</tt></b> load printers = No </pre><p> Only when setting the parameter explicitly to -"<i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = No</tt></i>" +"<a class="indexterm" name="id2895714"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = No" would Samba recognize my intentions. So my strong advice is: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Never rely on "commented out" parameters!</p></li><li><p>Always set it up explicitly as you intend it to +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Never rely on "commented out" parameters!</p></li><li><p>Always set it up explicitly as you intend it to behave.</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">testparm</b> to uncover hidden settings which might not reflect your intentions.</p></li></ul></div><p> You can have a working Samba print configuration with this @@ -6219,8 +6014,8 @@ ask <b class="command">testparm</b> what the Samba print configuration would be, if you used this minimalistic file as your real : </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf-minimal | egrep "(print|lpq|spool|driver|ports|[)"</tt></b> - Processing section "[printers]" +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v smb.conf-minimal | egrep "(print|lpq|spool|driver|ports|[)"</tt></b> + Processing section "[printers]" WARNING: [printers] service MUST be printable! No path in service printers - using /tmp @@ -6252,8 +6047,8 @@ testparm issued 2 warnings: <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section as printable, and</p></li><li><p>because we didn't tell it which spool directory to use.</p></li></ul></div><p> -However, this was not fatal, and Samba-3.0 will default to values that -will work here. But, please!, don't rely on this and don't use this +However, this was not fatal, and samba will default to values that +will work here. Please, don't rely on this and don't use this example! This was only meant to make you careful to design and specify your setup to be what you really want it to be. The outcome on your system may vary for some parameters, since you may have a Samba built @@ -6265,61 +6060,20 @@ comment sign at the front). At first I regarded this as a bug in my Samba version(s). But the man page states: “<span class="quote">Internal whitespace in a parameter value is retained verbatim.</span>” This means that a line consisting of, for example, -</p><pre class="screen"> -printing = lprng #This defines LPRng as the printing system" -</pre><p> -will regard the whole of the string after the "=" +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># This defines LPRng as the printing system"</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = lprng</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +will regard the whole of the string after the "=" sign as the value you want to define. And this is an invalid value that will be ignored, and a default value used instead.] -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919116"></a>Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Here we show a more verbose example configuration for print related -settings in an . Below is a discussion +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2895939"></a>Extended Sample Configuration to Print</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In <a href="#extbsdpr" title="Example 18.2. Extended configuration with BSD printing">the extended BSD configuration example</a> we show a more verbose example configuration for print related + settings in BSD-printing style environment . Below is a discussion and explanation of the various parameters. We chose to use BSD-style printing here, because we guess it is still the most commonly used system on legacy Linux installations (new installs now predominantly have CUPS, which is discussed entirely in the next chapter of this document). Note, that this example explicitly names many parameters -which don't need to be stated because they are set by default. You -might be able to do with a leaner .</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> -if you read access it with the Samba Web Administration Tool (SWAT), -and then write it to disk again, it will be optimized in a way such -that it doesn't contain any superfluous parameters and comments. SWAT -organizes the file for best performance. Remember that each smbd -re-reads the Samba configuration once a minute, and that each -connection spawns an smbd process of its own, so it is not a bad idea -to optimize the in environments with -hundreds or thousands of clients.</p></div><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - printing = bsd - load printers = yes - show add printer wizard = yes - printcap name = /etc/printcap - printer admin = @ntadmin, root - total print jobs = 100 - lpq cache time = 20 - use client driver = no - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - printable = yes - path = /var/spool/samba - browseable = no - guest ok = yes - public = yes - read only = yes - writable = no - - [my_printer_name] - comment = Printer with Restricted Access - path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer - printer admin = kurt - browseable = yes - printable = yes - writeable = no - hosts allow = 0.0.0.0 - hosts deny = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60 - guest ok = no -</pre><p> +which don't need to be specified because they are set by default. You +might be able to do with a leaner <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p><div class="example"><a name="extbsdpr"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.2. Extended configuration with BSD printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = /etc/printcap</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin, root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs = 100</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time = 20</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no </tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[my_printer_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer with Restricted Access</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 0.0.0.0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> This <span class="emphasis"><em>also</em></span> is only an example configuration. You may not find all the settings in your own (as pre-configured by your OS @@ -6329,32 +6083,32 @@ default, because these have been compiled in. To see all settings, let root use the <b class="command">testparm</b> utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> also gives warnings if you have mis-configured certain things.. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2919220"></a>Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896270"></a>Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Following is a discussion of the settings from above shown example. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919234"></a>The [global] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896282"></a>The [global] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section is one of 4 special sections (along with [<i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>...) It contains all parameters which apply to the server as a whole. It is the place for parameters which -have only a "global" meaning (G). It may also contain service level -parameters (S) which then define default settings for all other +have only a "global" meaning. It may also contain service level +parameters which then define default settings for all other sections and shares. This way you can simplify the configuration and avoid setting the same value repeatedly. (Within each individual -section or share you may however override these globally set "share -level" settings and specify other values). -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this causes Samba to use default print commands +section or share you may however override these globally set "share +level" settings and specify other values). +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896338"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd</span></dt><dd><p> this causes Samba to use default print commands applicable for the BSD (a.k.a. RFC 1179 style or LPR/LPD) printing -system. In general, the "printing" parameter informs Samba about the +system. In general, the "printing" parameter informs Samba about the print subsystem it should expect. Samba supports CUPS, LPD, LPRNG, SYSV, HPUX, AIX, QNX and PLP. Each of these systems defaults to a -different <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> (and other queue control -commands).</p><div class="caution" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Caution</h3><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is +different <a class="indexterm" name="id2896364"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> (and other queue control +commands).</p><div class="caution" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Caution</h3><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2896384"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is normally a service level parameter. Since it is included here in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section, it will take effect for all -printer shares that are not defined differently. Samba-3.0 no longer -supports the SOFTQ printing system.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba to create automatically all -available printer shares. "Available" printer shares are discovered by +printer shares that are not defined differently. Samba 3 no longer +supports the SOFTQ printing system.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896413"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba to create automatically all +available printer shares. "Available" printer shares are discovered by scanning the printcap file. All created printer shares are also loaded for browsing. If you use this parameter, you do not need to specify separate shares for each printer. Each automatically created printer @@ -6362,8 +6116,7 @@ share will clone the configuration options found in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section. (A <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = no</tt></i> setting will allow you to specify each UNIX printer you want to share separately, leaving out some you don't want to be -publicly visible and available). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = -yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this setting is normally +publicly visible and available). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896462"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> this setting is normally enabled by default (even if the parameter is not written into the ). It makes the <span class="guiicon">Add Printer Wizard</span> icon show up in the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder of the Samba host's @@ -6374,38 +6127,38 @@ will not suffice!). The Add Printer Wizard lets you upload printer drivers to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and associate it with a printer (if the respective queue exists there before the action), or exchange a printer's driver against any other previously -uploaded driver. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs = 100</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this setting sets the upper limit to 100 print jobs +uploaded driver. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896532"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i> = 100</span></dt><dd><p> this setting sets the upper limit to 100 print jobs being active on the Samba server at any one time. Should a client submit a job which exceeds this number, a “<span class="quote">no more space available on server</span>” type of error message will be returned by -Samba to the client. A setting of "0" (the default) means there is +Samba to the client. A setting of "0" (the default) means there is <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> limit at all! -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = /etc/printcap</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba where to look for a list of +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896570"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i> = /etc/printcap</span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba where to look for a list of available printer names. (If you use CUPS, make sure that a printcap -file is written: this is controlled by the "Printcap" directive of +file is written: this is controlled by the "Printcap" directive of <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt>). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> members of the ntadmin group should be able to add -drivers and set printer properties ("ntadmin" is only an example name, +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896604"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = @ntadmin</span></dt><dd><p> members of the ntadmin group should be able to add +drivers and set printer properties ("ntadmin" is only an example name, it needs to be a valid UNIX group name); root is implicitly always a -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. The "@" sign precedes group names in +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896628"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. The "@" sign precedes group names in . A printer admin can do anything to printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC -(see below). Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> +(see below). Note that the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896646"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter is normally a share level parameter, so you may associate different groups to different printer shares in larger installations, -if you use the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter on the +if you use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896661"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter on the share levels). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time = 20</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this controls the cache time for the results of the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896681"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i> = 20</span></dt><dd><p> this controls the cache time for the results of the lpq command. It prevents the lpq command being called too often and reduces load on a heavily used print server. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, this setting only +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896707"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, this setting only takes effect for Win NT/2k/XP clients (and not for Win 95/98/ME). Its default value is <tt class="constant">No</tt> (or <tt class="constant">False</tt>). It must <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be enabled on print shares (with a <tt class="constant">yes</tt> or <tt class="constant">true</tt> setting) which have valid drivers installed on the Samba server! For more detailed explanations see the man page of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919616"></a>The [printers] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896767"></a>The [printers] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is the second special section. If a section with this name appears in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, users are able to connect to any printer specified in the Samba host's printcap file, @@ -6415,59 +6168,58 @@ section as a general convenience shortcut to share all printers with minimal configuration. It is also a container for settings which should apply as default to all printers. (For more details see the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.) Settings inside this -container must be share level parameters (S). -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All printers</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the <i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> is shown next to +container must be share level parameters. +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896809"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = All printers</span></dt><dd><p> the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896828"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> is shown next to the share if a client queries the server, either via <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span> or with the <b class="command">net view</b> command to list available shares. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> please note well, that the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896862"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> please note well, that the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> service <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be declared as printable. If you specify otherwise, smbd will refuse to load at startup. This parameter allows connected clients to open, write to and submit spool files into the -directory specified with the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter for +directory specified with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2896896"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter for this service. It is used by Samba to differentiate printer shares from -file shares. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this must point to a directory used by Samba to spool +file shares. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896916"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba</span></dt><dd><p>this must point to a directory used by Samba to spool incoming print files. <span class="emphasis"><em>It must not be the same as the spool directory specified in the configuration of your UNIX print subsystem!</em></span> The path would typically point to a directory -which is world writeable, with the "sticky" bit set to it. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is always set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> if -<i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i>. It makes the +which is world writeable, with the "sticky" bit set to it. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2896949"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> this is always set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> if +<a class="indexterm" name="id2896973"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes. It makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer]</tt></i> share itself invisible in the list of available shares in a <b class="command">net view</b> command or in the Explorer browse list. (Note that you will of course see the individual printers). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897007"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then no password is required to connect to the printers service. Access will be granted with the -privileges of the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. On many systems the -guest account will map to a user named "nobody". This user is in the UNIX +privileges of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2897033"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. On many systems the +guest account will map to a user named "nobody". This user is in the UNIX passwd file with an empty password, but with no valid UNIX login. (Note: on some systems the guest account might not have the privilege to be able to print. Test this by logging in as your guest user using <b class="command">su - guest</b> and run a system print command like -</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>lpr -P printername /etc/motd</tt></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is a synonym for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = -yes</tt></i>. Since we have <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i>, +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>lpr -P printername /etc/motd</tt></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897074"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>public</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> this is a synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id2897094"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes. Since we have <a class="indexterm" name="id2897108"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes, it really doesn't need to be here! (This leads to the interesting question: “<span class="quote">What, if I by accident have to contradictory settings for the same share?</span>” The answer is: the last one encountered by -Samba wins. The "winner" is shown by testparm. Testparm doesn't +Samba wins. The "winner" is shown by testparm. Testparm doesn't complain about different settings of the same parameter for the same -share! You can test this by setting up multiple lines for the "guest -account" parameter with different usernames, and then run testparm to +share! You can test this by setting up multiple lines for the "guest +account" parameter with different usernames, and then run testparm to see which one is actually used by Samba.) -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this normally (for other types of shares) prevents +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897139"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>this normally (for other types of shares) prevents users creating or modifying files in the service's directory. However, -in a "printable" service, it is <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> allowed to +in a "printable" service, it is <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> allowed to write to the directory (if user privileges allow the connection), but -only via print spooling operations. "Normal" write operations are not -allowed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> -synonym for <i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i> -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919945"></a>Any [my_printer_name] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +only via print spooling operations. "Normal" write operations are not +allowed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897173"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> +synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id2897193"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2897210"></a>Any [my_printer_name] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If a section appears in the , which is -tagged as <i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i>, Samba presents it as +tagged as <a class="indexterm" name="id2897220"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes, Samba presents it as a printer share to its clients. Note, that Win95/98/ME clients may have problems with connecting or loading printer drivers if the share name has more than 8 characters! Also be very careful if you give a @@ -6476,66 +6228,65 @@ client's connection request to a certain sharename, Samba always tries to find file shares with that name first; if it finds one, it will connect to this and will never ultimately connect to a printer with the same name! -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer with Restricted Access</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the comment says it all. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> here we set the spooling area for this printer to +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897262"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Printer with Restricted Access</span></dt><dd><p> the comment says it all. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897287"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</span></dt><dd><p> here we set the spooling area for this printer to another directory than the default. It is not a requirement to set it differently, but the option is available. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the printer admin definition is different for this +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897314"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = kurt</span></dt><dd><p> the printer admin definition is different for this explicitly defined printer share from the general <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> share. It is not a requirement; we did it to show that it is possible if you want it. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> we also made this printer browseable (so that the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897347"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> we also made this printer browseable (so that the clients may conveniently find it when browsing the <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span>). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 10.160.50.,10.160.51.</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>here we exercise a certain degree of access control -by using the <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> parameters. Note, that +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897380"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897403"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897427"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> = 10.160.50.,10.160.51.</span></dt><dd><p>here we exercise a certain degree of access control +by using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2897449"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2897463"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> parameters. Note, that this is not by any means a safe bet. It is not a way to secure your printers. This line accepts all clients from a certain subnet in a first evaluation of access control -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = turbo_xp,10.160.50.23,10.160.51.60 -</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>all listed hosts are not allowed here (even if they -belong to the "allowed subnets"). As you can see, you could name IP +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897484"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> = turbo_xp,10.160.50.23,10.160.51.60</span></dt><dd><p>all listed hosts are not allowed here (even if they +belong to the "allowed subnets"). As you can see, you could name IP addresses as well as NetBIOS hostnames here. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this printer is not open for the guest account! -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920166"></a>Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897510"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p>this printer is not open for the guest account! +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2897534"></a>Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In each section defining a printer (or in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section), a <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter may be defined. It sets a command to process the files which have been placed into the Samba print spool directory for that printer. (That spool directory was, if you -remember, set up with the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> +remember, set up with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2897564"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter). Typically, this command will submit the spool file to the Samba host's print subsystem, using the suitable system print command. But there is no requirement that this needs to be the case. For debugging purposes or some other reason you may want to do -something completely different than "print" the file. An example is a +something completely different than "print" the file. An example is a command that just copies the print file to a temporary location for further investigation when you need to debug printing. If you craft your own print commands (or even develop print command shell scripts), make sure you pay attention to the need to remove the files from the Samba spool directory. Otherwise your hard disk may soon suffer from shortage of free space. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920216"></a>Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2897592"></a>Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You learned earlier on, that Samba in most cases uses its built-in settings for many parameters if it can not find an explicitly stated one in its configuration file. The same is true for the -<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>. The default print command varies -depending on the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing =...</tt></i> parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2897606"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>. The default print command varies +depending on the <a class="indexterm" name="id2897622"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter setting. In the commands listed below, you will notice some parameters of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span> where <span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> is <span class="emphasis"><em>p, s, J</em></span> etc. These letters stand for -"printername", "spoolfile" and "job ID" respectively. They are +"printername", "spoolfile" and "job ID" respectively. They are explained in more detail further below. Here is an overview (excluding the special case of CUPS, which is discussed in the next chapter): -</p><div class="informaltable"><table border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">If this setting is active...</th><th align="left">...this is used in lieu of an explicit command:</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lpr -r -P%p %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -c -P%p %s; rm %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -r -P%p -s %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpstat -o%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">lprm -P%p %j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="informaltable"><table border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">If this setting is active...</th><th align="left">...this is used in lieu of an explicit command:</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897700"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lpr -r -P%p %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897731"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -c -P%p %s; rm %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897762"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -r -P%p -s %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897794"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897824"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpstat -o%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897855"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897885"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">lprm -P%p %j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897916"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897947"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2897977"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lppause command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2898008"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2898033"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2898058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lpresume command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2898090"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2898115"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> We excluded the special CUPS case here, because it is discussed in the next chapter. Just a short summary. For <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = CUPS</tt></i>: If SAMBA is compiled against libcups, it uses the CUPS API to submit jobs, etc. (It is a good idea also to set -<i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = cups</tt></i> in case your +<a class="indexterm" name="id2898153"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups in case your <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> is set to write its autogenerated printcap file to an unusual place). Otherwise Samba maps to the System V printing commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it uses @@ -6546,7 +6297,7 @@ manually set print command will be ignored! Having listed the above mappings here, you should note that there used to be a <span class="emphasis"><em>bug</em></span> in recent 2.2.x versions which prevented the mapping from taking effect. It lead to the -"bsd|aix|lprng|plp" settings taking effect for all other systems, for +"bsd|aix|lprng|plp" settings taking effect for all other systems, for the most important commands (the <b class="command">print</b> command, the <b class="command">lpq</b> command and the <b class="command">lprm</b> command). The <b class="command">lppause</b> command and the @@ -6558,9 +6309,9 @@ check which command takes effect. Then check that this command is adequate and actually works for your installed print subsystem. It is always a good idea to explicitly set up your configuration files the way you want them to work and not rely on any built-in defaults. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920741"></a>Setting up your own Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898261"></a>Setting up your own Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> After a print job has finished spooling to a service, the -<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> will be used by Samba via a +<a class="indexterm" name="id2898273"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> will be used by Samba via a <span class="emphasis"><em>system()</em></span> call to process the spool file. Usually the command specified will submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem. But there is no requirement at all that this must @@ -6571,7 +6322,7 @@ processed. </p><p> There is no difficulty with using your own customized print commands with the traditional printing systems. However, if you don't wish to -"roll your own", you should be well informed about the default +"roll your own", you should be well informed about the default built-in commands that Samba uses for each printing subsystem (see the table above). In all the commands listed in the last paragraphs you see parameters of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span> These are @@ -6601,7 +6352,7 @@ spool files will be created but not processed! And (most importantly): print files will not be removed, so they will start filling your Samba hard disk. </p><p> -Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the "nobody" +Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the "nobody" account. If this happens, create an alternative guest account and supply it with the privilege to print. Set up this guest account in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section with the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest @@ -6613,22 +6364,16 @@ expand the included environment variables as usual. (The syntax to include a UNIX environment variable <i class="parameter"><tt>$variable</tt></i> in or in the Samba print command is <i class="parameter"><tt>%$variable</tt></i>.) To give you a working -<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> example, the following will log a +<a class="indexterm" name="id2898492"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> example, the following will log a print job to <tt class="filename">/tmp/print.log</tt>, print the file, then remove it. Note that ';' is the usual separator for commands in shell scripts: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - - print command = echo Printing %s >> /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s - -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = echo Printing %s >> /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> You may have to vary your own command considerably from this example depending on how you normally print files on your system. The default -for the <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter varies depending on the setting of -the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter. Another example is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921021"></a>Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2898541"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter varies depending on the setting of +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2898557"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter. Another example is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2898591"></a>Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before version 2.2.0, Samba's print server support for Windows clients was limited to the level of <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> printing calls. This is the same protocol level as Windows 9x PCs offer when @@ -6643,16 +6388,14 @@ The additional functionality provided by the new SPOOLSS support includes: 95/98/NT/2000 clients upon demand (<span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>); </p></li><li><p>Uploading of printer drivers via the Windows NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span> (APW) or the -<span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> tool set (refer to <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net</a>); +<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">Imprints</a> tool set. </p></li><li><p>Support for the native MS-RPC printing calls such as -StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See the MSDN documentation -at <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">http://msdn.microsoft.com/</a> -for more information on the Win32 printing API);</p></li><li><p>Support for NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Access Control + StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See the <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">MSDN documentation</a> for more information on the Win32 printing API);</p></li><li><p>Support for NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Access Control Lists</em></span> (ACL) on printer objects;</p></li><li><p>Improved support for printer queue manipulation through the use of internal databases for spooled job information (implemented by various <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files).</p></li></ul></div><p> -One other benefit of an update is this: Samba-3 is able to publish +One other benefit of an update is this: Samba 3 is able to publish all its printers in Active Directory (or LDAP)! </p><p> One slight difference is here: it is possible on a Windows NT print @@ -6666,10 +6409,10 @@ rather they can print directly to any printer on another Windows NT host using MS-RPC. This of course assumes that the printing client has the necessary privileges on the remote host serving the printer. The default permissions assigned by Windows NT to a printer gives the -"Print" permissions to the well-known <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span> -group. (The older clients of type Win9x can only print to "shared" +"Print" permissions to the well-known <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span> +group. (The older clients of type Win9x can only print to "shared" printers). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921186"></a>Client Drivers on Samba Server for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898740"></a>Client Drivers on Samba Server for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is still confusion about what all this means: <span class="emphasis"><em>Is it or is it not a requirement for printer drivers to be installed on a Samba host in order to support printing from Windows clients?</em></span> The @@ -6702,12 +6445,12 @@ etc.).</p></li></ul></div><p> Please take additional note of the following fact: <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba does not use these uploaded drivers in any way to process spooled files</em></span>. Drivers are utilized entirely by the clients, who -download and install them via the "Point'n'Print" mechanism supported +download and install them via the "Point'n'Print" mechanism supported by Samba. The clients use these drivers to generate print files in the -format the printer (or the Unix print system) requires. Print files -received by Samba are handed over to the Unix printing system, which +format the printer (or the UNIX print system) requires. Print files +received by Samba are handed over to the UNIX printing system, which is responsible for all further processing, if needed. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921338"></a>The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><b> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898892"></a>The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><b> <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> vs. <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer$]</tt></i> . </b> Versions of Samba prior to 2.2 made it possible to use a share @@ -6723,7 +6466,7 @@ files associated with that printer. Another parameter named <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> provided a means of defining the printer driver name to be sent to the client. These parameters, including the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i> parameter, -are now removed and can not be used in installations of Samba-3.0. +are now removed and can not be used in installations of samba-3. Now the share name <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is used for the location of downloadable printer drivers. It is taken from the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service created by Windows NT PCs when @@ -6733,10 +6476,10 @@ access (in the context of its ACLs) in order to support printer driver down- and uploads. Don't fear -- this does not mean Windows 9x clients are thrown aside now. They can use Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share support just fine. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921450"></a>Creating the [print$] Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899004"></a>Creating the [print$] Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order to support the up- and downloading of printer driver files, you must first configure a file share named -<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. The "public" name of this share is +<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. The "public" name of this share is hard coded in Samba's internals (because it is hard coded in the MS Windows clients too). It cannot be renamed since Windows clients are programmed to search for a service of exactly this name if they want @@ -6747,42 +6490,25 @@ add the global parameters and create the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> file share (of course, some of the parameter values, such as 'path' are arbitrary and should be replaced with appropriate values for your site): -</p><pre class="screen"> - [global] - ; members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set - ; printer properties. root is implicitly always a 'printer admin'. - printer admin = @ntadmin - [....] - - [printers] - [....] - - [print$] - comment = Printer Driver Download Area - path = /etc/samba/drivers - browseable = yes - guest ok = yes - read only = yes - write list = @ntadmin, root -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2899046"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.3. [print\$] example</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set</td></tr><tr><td># printer properties. root is implicitly always a 'printer admin'.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Driver Download Area</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = @ntadmin, root</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> Of course, you also need to ensure that the directory named by the -<i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter exists on the Unix file system. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921521"></a>Parameters in the [print$] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2899172"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter exists on the UNIX file system. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899189"></a>Parameters in the [print$] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is a special section in . It contains settings relevant to potential printer driver download and local installation by clients. -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Driver -Download Area</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the comment appears next to the share name if it is +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2899217"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Printer Driver + Download Area</span></dt><dd><p> the comment appears next to the share name if it is listed in a share list (usually Windows clients won't see it often but it will also appear up in a <b class="command">smbclient -L sambaserver -</b> output). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/printers</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is the path to the location of the Windows +</b> output). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2899252"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /etc/samba/printers</span></dt><dd><p> this is the path to the location of the Windows driver file deposit from the UNIX point of -view.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share -"invisible" in Network Neighbourhood to clients. However, you can -still "mount" it from any client using the <b class="command">net use -g:\\sambaserver\print$</b> command in a "DOS box" or the -"Connect network drive" menu from Windows -Explorer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this gives read only access to this share for all +view.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2899277"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> this makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share +"invisible" in Network Neighbourhood to clients. However, you can +still "mount" it from any client using the <b class="command">net use +g:\\sambaserver\print$</b> command in a "DOS box" or the +"Connect network drive" menu from Windows +Explorer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2899319"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>this gives read only access to this share for all guest users. Access may be used to download and install printer drivers on clients. The requirement for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i> depends upon how your site is configured. If users @@ -6795,28 +6521,28 @@ validated by the Domain Controller in order to logon to the Windows NT session), then guest access is not necessary. Of course, in a workgroup environment where you just want to be able to print without worrying about silly accounts and security, then configure the share -for guest access. You'll probably want to add <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest -= Bad User</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section +for guest access. You'll probably want to add <a class="indexterm" name="id2899365"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = Bad User in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section as well. Make sure you understand what this parameter does before using it. -</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>as we don't want everybody to upload driver files (or +</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2899392"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>as we don't want everybody to upload driver files (or even change driver settings) we tagged this share as not -writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = @ntadmin,root</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> was made -read only by the previous setting, we need to create a "write list" -also. UNIX groups (denoted with a leading "@" character) and users +writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2899418"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i> = @ntadmin,root</span></dt><dd><p>since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> was made +read only by the previous setting, we need to create a "write list" +also. UNIX groups (denoted with a leading "@" character) and users listed here are allowed write access (as an exception to the general -public's "read-only" access), which they need to update files on the +public's "read-only" access), which they need to update files on the share. Normally you will want to only name administrative level user accounts in this setting. Check the file system permissions to make sure these accounts can copy files to the share. If this is a non-root account, then the account should also be mentioned in the global -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin </tt></i> parameter. See the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2899455"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin </tt></i> parameter. See the man page for more information on -configuring file shares. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921752"></a>Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +configuring file shares. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899475"></a>Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order for a Windows NT print server to support the downloading of driver files by multiple client architectures, you must create several subdirectories within the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service -(i.e. the Unix directory named by the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> +(i.e. the UNIX directory named by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2899495"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter). These correspond to each of the supported client architectures. Samba follows this model as well. Just like the name of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share itself, the subdirectories @@ -6828,11 +6554,11 @@ Therefore, create a directory tree below the to support. </p><pre class="programlisting"> [print$]--+-- - |--W32X86 # serves drivers to "Windows NT x86" - |--WIN40 # serves drivers to "Windows 95/98" - |--W32ALPHA # serves drivers to "Windows NT Alpha_AXP" - |--W32MIPS # serves drivers to "Windows NT R4000" - |--W32PPC # serves drivers to "Windows NT PowerPC" + |--W32X86 # serves drivers to "Windows NT x86" + |--WIN40 # serves drivers to "Windows 95/98" + |--W32ALPHA # serves drivers to "Windows NT Alpha_AXP" + |--W32MIPS # serves drivers to "Windows NT R4000" + |--W32PPC # serves drivers to "Windows NT PowerPC" </pre><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Required permissions</h3><p> In order to add a new driver to your Samba host, one of two conditions must hold true: @@ -6851,7 +6577,7 @@ client workstation. Open <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span> or Once you have located the server, navigate to its <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. You should see an initial listing of printers that matches the printer shares defined on your Samba host. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921913"></a>Installing Drivers into [print$]</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2899643"></a>Installing Drivers into [print$]</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> You have successfully created the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share in ? And Samba has re-read its configuration? Good. But you are not yet ready to take off. The @@ -6869,11 +6595,11 @@ Properties</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></s from any Windows NT/2k/XP client workstation.</p></li></ul></div><p> The latter option is probably the easier one (even if the only entrance to this realm seems a little bit weird at first). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922008"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899736"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The initial listing of printers in the Samba host's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder accessed from a client's Explorer -will have no real printer driver assigned to them. By default, in -Samba-3 (as in 2.2.1 and later) this driver name is set to a NULL +will have no real printer driver assigned to them. By default +this driver name is set to a NULL string. This must be changed now. The local <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span>, run from NT/2000/XP clients, will help us in this task. @@ -6904,18 +6630,18 @@ Once the APW is started, the procedure is exactly the same as the one you are familiar with in Windows (we assume here that you are familiar with the printer driver installations procedure on Windows NT). Make sure your connection is in fact setup as a user with -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> privileges (if in doubt, use +<a class="indexterm" name="id2899872"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> privileges (if in doubt, use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check for this). If you wish to install printer drivers for client operating systems other than <span class="application">Windows NT x86</span>, you will need to use the <span class="guilabel">Sharing</span> tab of the printer properties dialog. </p><p> Assuming you have connected with an administrative (or root) account -(as named by the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter), +(as named by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2899914"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter), you will also be able to modify other printer properties such as ACLs and default device settings using this dialog. For the default device settings, please consider the advice given further below. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922192"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899935"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with <b class="command">rpcclient</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The second way to install printer drivers into <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and set them up in a valid way can be @@ -6930,7 +6656,7 @@ time with the <b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand.</p></li></ol></div><p> We will provide detailed hints for each of these steps in the next few paragraphs. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922300"></a>Identifying the Driver Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900043"></a>Identifying the Driver Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To find out about the driver files, you have two options: you could investigate the driver CD which comes with your printer. Study the <tt class="filename">*.inf</tt> file on the CD, if it is contained. This @@ -6978,35 +6704,35 @@ create scripts to automate the procedure for a large number of printers and drivers. Note the different quotes used to overcome the different spaces in between words: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' -c 'getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3' TURBO_XP</tt></b> - cmd = getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3 - - [Windows NT x86] - Printer Driver Info 3: - Version: [2] - Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)] - Architecture: [Windows NT x86] - Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.DLL] - Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.ppd] - Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.DLL] - Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.HLP] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' -c \ + 'getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3' TURBO_XP</tt></b> +cmd = getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3 + +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.DLL] + Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.ppd] + Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.DLL] + Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.HLP] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.INI] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.dat] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.cat] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hre] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.vnd] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hlp] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01Aux.dll] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.NTF] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.INI] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.dat] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.cat] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hre] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.vnd] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hlp] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01Aux.dll] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.NTF] - Monitorname: [] - Defaultdatatype: [] - + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [] </pre><p> You may notice, that this driver has quite a big number of <span class="guilabel">Dependentfiles</span> (I know worse cases however). Also, @@ -7023,17 +6749,17 @@ can also host the Win9x drivers, even if itself runs on Windows NT, Since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share is usually accessible through the <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span>, you can also use the UNC notation from Windows Explorer to poke at it. The Win9x driver files will end -up in subdirectory "0" of the "WIN40" directory. The full path to +up in subdirectory "0" of the "WIN40" directory. The full path to access them will be <tt class="filename">\\WINDOWSHOST\print$\WIN40\0\</tt>. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> more recent drivers on Windows 2000 and Windows XP are -installed into the "3" subdirectory instead of the "2". The version 2 +installed into the "3" subdirectory instead of the "2". The version 2 of drivers, as used in Windows NT, were running in Kernel Mode. Windows 2000 changed this. While it still can use the Kernel Mode drivers (if this is enabled by the Admin), its native mode for printer drivers is User Mode execution. This requires drivers designed for -this. These type of drivers install into the "3" subdirectory. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922629"></a>Collecting the Driver Files from a Windows Host's +this. These type of drivers install into the "3" subdirectory. +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900368"></a>Collecting the Driver Files from a Windows Host's [print$] Share</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Now we need to collect all the driver files we identified. in our previous step. Where do we get them from? Well, why not retrieve them @@ -7046,15 +6772,15 @@ listing is edited to include linebreaks for readability: <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //TURBO_XP/print\$ -U'Danka%xxxx' \ -c 'cd W32X86/2;mget HD*_de.* \ hd*ppd Hd*_de.* Hddm*dll HDN*Aux.DLL'</tt></b> - added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Got a positive name query response from 10.160.50.8 ( 10.160.50.8 ) - Domain=[DEVELOPMENT] OS=[Windows 5.1] Server=[Windows 2000 LAN Manager] - <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.ABD? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>n</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.def? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> - getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def of size 428 as Hddm91c1_de.def (22.0 kb/s) (average 22.0 kb/s) - <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.DLL? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> - getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL of size 876544 as Hddm91c1_de.DLL (737.3 kb/s) (average 737.3 kb/s) - [...] +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.50.8 ( 10.160.50.8 ) +Domain=[DEVELOPMENT] OS=[Windows 5.1] Server=[Windows 2000 LAN Manager] +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.ABD? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>n</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.def? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> +getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def of size 428 as Hddm91c1_de.def +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.DLL? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> +getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL of size 876544 as Hddm91c1_de.DLL +[...] </pre><p> After this command is complete, the files are in our current local @@ -7069,7 +6795,7 @@ files for these architectures are in the WIN40/0/ subdir. Once we are complete, we can run <b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> to store the collected files on the Samba server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922781"></a>Depositing the Driver Files into [print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900518"></a>Depositing the Driver Files into [print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> So, now we are going to put the driver files into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Remember, the UNIX path to this share has been defined previously in your @@ -7080,9 +6806,9 @@ your <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share maps to the UNIX path go here: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>for all Windows NT, 2000 and XP clients into <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt> <span class="emphasis"><em>but -*not*(yet) into the "2" subdir</em></span>!</p></li><li><p>for all Windows 95, 98 and ME clients into +*not*(yet) into the "2" subdir</em></span>!</p></li><li><p>for all Windows 95, 98 and ME clients into <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/WIN40/</tt> -- <span class="emphasis"><em>but *not* -(yet) into the "0" subdir</em></span>!</p></li></ul></div><p> +(yet) into the "0" subdir</em></span>!</p></li></ul></div><p> We again use smbclient to transfer the driver files across the network. We specify the same files and paths as were leaked to us by running <b class="command">getdriver</b> against the original @@ -7090,7 +6816,8 @@ running <b class="command">getdriver</b> against the original store the files into a <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba/UNIX</em></span> print server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share... </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U'root%xxxx' -c 'cd W32X86; put HDNIS01_de.DLL; \ + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U'root%xxxx' -c \ + 'cd W32X86; put HDNIS01_de.DLL; \ put Hddm91c1_de.ppd; put HDNIS01U_de.DLL; \ put HDNIS01U_de.HLP; put Hddm91c1_de.DLL; \ put Hddm91c1_de.INI; put Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL; \ @@ -7099,78 +6826,77 @@ store the files into a <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba/UNIX</em></span> print s put Hddm91c1_de.vnd; put Hddm91c1_de.hlp; \ put Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP; put HDNIS01Aux.dll; \ put HDNIS01_de.NTF'</tt></b> - added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] - putting file HDNIS01_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.DLL (4465.5 kb/s) (average 4465.5 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.ppd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.ppd (12876.8 kb/s) (average 4638.9 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01U_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.DLL (20249.8 kb/s) (average 5828.3 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01U_de.HLP as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.HLP (9652.8 kb/s) (average 5899.8 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.DLL (23777.7 kb/s) (average 10400.6 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.INI as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.INI (98.6 kb/s) (average 10329.0 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL (22931.5 kb/s) (average 10501.7 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat (2462.8 kb/s) (average 10393.0 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat (4925.3 kb/s) (average 10356.3 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.def as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.def (417.9 kb/s) (average 10290.1 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.hre as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hre (22571.3 kb/s) (average 11338.5 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.vnd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.vnd (3384.6 kb/s) (average 10754.3 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.hlp as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hlp (18406.8 kb/s) (average 10839.8 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP (20278.3 kb/s) (average 11386.3 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01Aux.dll as \W32X86\HDNIS01Aux.dll (14994.6 kb/s) (average 11405.2 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01_de.NTF as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.NTF (23390.2 kb/s) (average 13170.8 kb/s) - +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +putting file HDNIS01_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.ppd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.ppd +putting file HDNIS01U_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.DLL +putting file HDNIS01U_de.HLP as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.HLP +putting file Hddm91c1_de.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.INI as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.INI +putting file Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat +putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat +putting file Hddm91c1_de.def as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.def +putting file Hddm91c1_de.hre as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hre +putting file Hddm91c1_de.vnd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.vnd +putting file Hddm91c1_de.hlp as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hlp +putting file Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP +putting file HDNIS01Aux.dll as \W32X86\HDNIS01Aux.dll +putting file HDNIS01_de.NTF as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.NTF </pre><p> Phewww -- that was a lot of typing! Most drivers are a lot smaller -- many only having 3 generic PostScript driver files plus 1 PPD. Note, -that while we did retrieve the files from the "2" subdirectory of the -"W32X86" directory from the Windows box, we <span class="emphasis"><em>don't</em></span> +that while we did retrieve the files from the "2" subdirectory of the +"W32X86" directory from the Windows box, we <span class="emphasis"><em>don't</em></span> put them (for now) in this same subdirectory of the Samba box! This re-location will automatically be done by the <b class="command">adddriver</b> command which we will run shortly (and don't forget to also put the files for the Win95/98/ME architecture into the <tt class="filename">WIN40/</tt> subdirectory should you need them). -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923017"></a>Check if the Driver Files are there (with smbclient)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900731"></a>Check if the Driver Files are there (with smbclient)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> For now we verify that our files are there. This can be done with <b class="command">smbclient</b> too (but of course you can log in via SSH also and do this through a standard UNIX shell access too): </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' -c 'cd W32X86; pwd; dir; cd 2; pwd; dir'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86; pwd; dir; cd 2; pwd; dir'</tt></b> added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] - - Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ - . D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 - .. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003 - 2 D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 - HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available - - Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\ - . D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 - .. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 - ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 - laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003 - ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 - ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 - PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003 - 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available - +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + +Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ +. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +.. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003 +2 D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 +HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available + +Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\ +. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 +.. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003 +ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available </pre><p> Notice that there are already driver files present in the <tt class="filename">2</tt> subdir (probably from a previous @@ -7183,7 +6909,7 @@ Point'n'Print. The reason is: Samba doesn't know yet that these files are something special, namely <span class="emphasis"><em>printer driver files</em></span> and it doesn't know yet to which print queue(s) these driver files belong. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923178"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900890"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with <b class="command">adddriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> So, next you must tell Samba about the special category of the files you just uploaded into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. This @@ -7192,21 +6918,23 @@ prompt Samba to register the driver files into its internal TDB database files. The following command and its output has been edited, again, for readability: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" "dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ - Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ - NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ - Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ - Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF, \ - Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS</tt></b> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ +"dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ +Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ + NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF, \ + Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS</tt></b> - cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" "dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL: \ - HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ - Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ - Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ +"dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL: \ + HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" - Printer Driver dm9110 successfully installed. +Printer Driver dm9110 successfully installed. </pre><p> After this step the driver should be recognized by Samba on the print @@ -7218,7 +6946,7 @@ files successfully, but render the driver unworkable. So take care! Hints about the syntax of the adddriver command are in the man page. The CUPS printing chapter of this HOWTO collection provides a more detailed description, if you should need it. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923278"></a>Check how Driver Files have been moved after +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900990"></a>Check how Driver Files have been moved after <b class="command">adddriver</b> finished</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> One indication for Samba's recognition of the files as driver files is the <tt class="computeroutput">successfully installed</tt> message. @@ -7227,9 +6955,9 @@ Another one is the fact, that our files have been moved by the subdirectory. You can check this again with <b class="command">smbclient</b>: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -Uroot%xxxx -c 'cd W32X86;dir;pwd;cd 2;dir;pwd'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -Uroot%xx -c 'cd W32X86;dir;pwd;cd 2;dir;pwd'</tt></b> added interface ip=10.160.51.162 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ . D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003 @@ -7266,7 +6994,7 @@ subdirectory. You can check this again with </pre><p> Another verification is that the timestamp of the printing TDB files is now updated (and possibly their filesize has increased). -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923446"></a>Check if the Driver is recognized by Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901159"></a>Check if the Driver is recognized by Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Now the driver should be registered with Samba. We can easily verify this, and will do so in a moment. However, this driver is <span class="emphasis"><em>not yet</em></span> associated with a particular @@ -7291,13 +7019,13 @@ right-click the white background (with no printer highlighted). Select <span class="guilabel">Drivers</span> tab you will see the new driver listed now. This view enables you to also inspect the list of files belonging to that driver<span class="emphasis"><em> (this doesn't work on Windows NT, but only on -Windows 2000 and Windows XP. WinNT doesn't provide the "Drivers" +Windows 2000 and Windows XP. WinNT doesn't provide the "Drivers" tab).</em></span>. An alternative, much quicker method for Windows 2000/XP to start this dialog is by typing into a DOS box (you must of course adapt the name to your Samba server instead of <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i>): </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /s /t2 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p>from a UNIX prompt run this command (or a variant thereof), where <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> is the name of the Samba -host and "xxxx" represents the actual Samba password assigned to root: +host and "xxxx" represents the actual Samba password assigned to root: </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'enumdrivers' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b></p><p> You will see a listing of all drivers Samba knows about. Your new one should be amongst them. But it is only listed under the <i class="parameter"><tt>[Windows NT @@ -7310,27 +7038,27 @@ time. Our new driver only shows up for <span class="application">Windows NT 4.0 or 2000</span>. To have it present for <span class="application">Windows 95, 98 and ME</span> you'll have to repeat the whole procedure with the WIN40 architecture and subdirectory. -</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923650"></a>A side note: you are not bound to specific driver names</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901363"></a>A side note: you are not bound to specific driver names</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can name the driver as you like. If you repeat the <b class="command">adddriver</b> step, with the same files as before, but with a different driver name, it will work the same: </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx \ - -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ - "myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ - Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ - NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ - Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ - Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ + Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ + NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS </tt></b> - cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" - "myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:\ + cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" + "myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:\ HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" Printer Driver myphantasydrivername successfully installed. @@ -7339,16 +7067,16 @@ You will also be able to bind that driver to any print queue (however, you are responsible yourself that you associate drivers to queues which make sense to the target printer). Note, that you can't run the <b class="command">rpcclient</b> <b class="command">adddriver</b> command -repeatedly. Each run "consumes" the files you had put into the +repeatedly. Each run "consumes" the files you had put into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share by moving them into the respective subdirectories. So you <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> precede an <b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> command before each -<b class="command">rpcclient ... adddriver</b>" command. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923761"></a>La Grande Finale: Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with +<b class="command">rpcclient ... adddriver</b>" command. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901473"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with <b class="command">setdriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba still needs to know <span class="emphasis"><em>which</em></span> printer's driver this is. It needs to create a mapping of the driver to a printer, and -store this info in its "memory", the TDB files. The <b class="command">rpcclient +store this info in its "memory", the TDB files. The <b class="command">rpcclient setdriver</b> command achieves exactly this: </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%xxxx' -c 'setdriver dm9110 myphantasydrivername' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i></tt></b> @@ -7364,8 +7092,8 @@ name I intended: </pre><p> The syntax of the command is <b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>sambapassword</tt></i>' -c 'setdriver -"<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>" -"<i class="replaceable"><tt>drivername</tt></i>' +"<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>" +"<i class="replaceable"><tt>drivername</tt></i>' <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-Hostname</tt></i></tt></b> . -- Now we have done *most* of the work. But not yet all.... </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> @@ -7374,26 +7102,25 @@ known to Samba already. A bug in 2.2.x prevented Samba from recognizing freshly installed printers. You had to restart Samba, or at least send a HUP signal to all running smbd processes to work around this: -<b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</tt></b>. </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923912"></a>"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</tt></b>. </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2901625"></a>Client Driver Install Procedure</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A famous philosopher said once: “<span class="quote">The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating</span>”. The proof for our setup lies in the printing. So let's install the printer driver onto the client PCs. This is not as straightforward as it may seem. Read on. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923933"></a>The first Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901643"></a>The first Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Especially important is the installation onto the first client PC (for each architectural platform separately). Once this is done correctly, all further clients are easy to setup and shouldn't need further attention. What follows is a description for the recommended first procedure. You work now from a client workstation. First you should guarantee that your connection is not unwittingly mapped to -<i class="parameter"><tt>bad user</tt></i> "nobody". In a DOS box type: +<span class="emphasis"><em>bad user</em></span> "nobody". In a DOS box type: </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net use \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\print$ /user:root</tt></b></p><p> Replace root, if needed, by another valid <i class="replaceable"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> user as given in the definition. Should you already be connected as a different user, you'll get an error message. There is no easy way to get rid of that connection, because -Windows doesn't seem to know a concept of "logging off" from a share +Windows doesn't seem to know a concept of "logging off" from a share connection (don't confuse this with logging off from the local workstation; that is a different matter). You can try to close <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> Windows file explorer and Internet Explorer @@ -7414,16 +7141,16 @@ samba-server) should now have appeared in your -- <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span>). </p><p> Most likely you are now tempted to try and print a test page. After -all, you now can open the printer properties and on the "General" tab, +all, you now can open the printer properties and on the "General" tab, there is a button offering to do just that. But chances are that you get an error message saying <span class="errorname">Unable to print Test Page</span>. The reason might be that there is not yet a -valid Device Mode set for the driver, or that the "Printer Driver -Data" set is still incomplete. +valid Device Mode set for the driver, or that the "Printer Driver +Data" set is still incomplete. </p><p> -You must now make sure that a valid "Device Mode" is set for the +You must now make sure that a valid "Device Mode" is set for the driver. Don't fear -- we will explain now what that means. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924131"></a>IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901839"></a>IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order for a printer to be truly usable by a Windows NT/2K/XP client, it must possess: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> generated by @@ -7450,7 +7177,7 @@ This can be achieved by accessing the drivers remotely from an NT (or 2k/XP) client, as is discussed in the next paragraphs. </p><p> Be aware, that a valid Device Mode can only be initiated by a -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (the reason should be +<a class="indexterm" name="id2901935"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (the reason should be obvious). Device Modes can only correctly be set by executing the printer driver program itself. Since Samba can not execute this Win32 platform driver code, it sets this field initially to NULL (which is @@ -7460,9 +7187,9 @@ are uploaded to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share with the help of the APW or rpcclient. </p><p> The generation and setting of a first valid Device Mode however -requires some "tickling" from a client, to set it on the Samba +requires some "tickling" from a client, to set it on the Samba server. The easiest means of doing so is to simply change the page -orientation on the server's printer. This "executes" enough of the +orientation on the server's printer. This "executes" enough of the printer driver program on the client for the desired effect to happen, and feeds back the new Device Mode to our Samba server. You can use the native Windows NT/2K/XP printer properties page from a Window client @@ -7474,7 +7201,7 @@ followed the last section's description)</p></li><li><p>At the bottom of the con <span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span> entry further above, you need to click that one first to achieve the driver installation as shown in the last section)</p></li><li><p>Go to the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> tab; click on -<span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span></p></li><li><p>Change the "Portrait" page setting to "Landscape" (and +<span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span></p></li><li><p>Change the "Portrait" page setting to "Landscape" (and back)</p></li><li><p>(Oh, and make sure to <span class="emphasis"><em>apply</em></span> changes between swapping the page orientation to cause the change to actually take effect...).</p></li><li><p>While you're at it, you may optionally also want to @@ -7495,7 +7222,7 @@ properties. Others may crash the client's spooler service. So use this parameter with caution. It is always better to have the client generate a valid device mode for the printer and store it on the server for you. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924420"></a>Further Client Driver Install Procedures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902136"></a>Further Client Driver Install Procedures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every further driver may be done by any user, along the lines described above: Browse network, open printers folder on Samba server, right-click printer and choose <span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span>. Once @@ -7515,12 +7242,12 @@ rundll32 shell32.dll,Control_RunDLL MAIN.CPL @2 You can enter the commands either inside a <span class="guilabel">DOS box</span> window or in the <span class="guimenuitem">Run command...</span> field from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span> menu. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924516"></a>Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902231"></a>Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> After you installed the driver on the Samba server (in its <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share, you should always make sure that your first client installation completes correctly. Make it a habit for yourself to build that the very first connection from a client as -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. This is to make sure that: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2902252"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. This is to make sure that: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> a first valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> is really initialized (see above for more explanation details), and that</p></li><li><p> the default print settings of your printer for all @@ -7534,30 +7261,33 @@ set to <span class="emphasis"><em>Letter</em></span>, when you are all using </p><p> To connect as root to a Samba printer, try this command from a Windows 2K/XP DOS box command prompt: -</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>"</tt></b> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n + \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>"</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> You will be prompted for root's Samba-password; type it, wait a few seconds, click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span> and proceed to set the job options as should be used as defaults by all clients. Alternatively, instead of root you can name one other member -of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admins</tt></i> from the setting. +of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2902370"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> from the setting. </p><p> Now all the other users downloading and installing the driver the same way (called <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>) will have the same defaults set for them. If you miss this step you'll get a lot of helpdesk calls from your users. But maybe you like to talk to people.... ;-) -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924657"></a>Other Gotchas</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902399"></a>Other Gotchas</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Your driver is installed. It is ready for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span> installation by the clients now. You <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> have tried to download and use it onto your first client machine now. But wait... let's make you acquainted first with a few tips and tricks you may find useful. For -example, suppose you didn't manage to "set the defaults" on the +example, suppose you didn't manage to "set the defaults" on the printer, as advised in the preceding paragraphs? And your users complain about various issues (such as “<span class="quote">We need to set the paper size for each job from Letter to A4 and it won't store it!</span>”) -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924690"></a>Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902431"></a>Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The last sentence might be viewed with mixed feelings by some users and admins. They have struggled for hours and hours and couldn't arrive at a point were their settings seemed to be saved. It is not their @@ -7565,8 +7295,8 @@ fault. The confusing thing is this: in the multi-tabbed dialog that pops up when you right-click the printer name and select <span class="guimenuitem">Properties...</span>, you can arrive at two identically looking dialogs, each claiming that they help you to set printer options, -in three different ways. Here is the definite answer to the "Samba -Default Driver Setting FAQ": +in three different ways. Here is the definite answer to the "Samba +Default Driver Setting FAQ": </p><p><b>“<span class="quote">I can't set and save default print options for all users on Win2K/XP! Why not?</span>” </b> How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way.... (it is not very @@ -7578,7 +7308,7 @@ dialogs <span class="emphasis"><em>look</em></span> the same. Only one of them Administrator to do this for all users. Here is how I reproduce it in on XP Professional: -</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first "wrong" way: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first "wrong" way: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer @@ -7586,7 +7316,7 @@ folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer select in context menu <span class="guimenu">Printing Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>Look at this dialog closely and remember what it looks like.</p></li></ol></div><p> -</p></li><li><p>The second "wrong" way: +</p></li><li><p>The second "wrong" way: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="guimenu">Printers</span> folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer (<span class="emphasis"><em>remoteprinter on @@ -7595,16 +7325,16 @@ cupshost</em></span>) and select in the context menu tab</p></li><li><p>Click on the button <span class="guibutton">Printing Preferences...</span></p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Keep this dialog open and go back to the parent dialog.</p></li></ol></div><p> -</p></li><li><p>The third, the "correct" way: (should you do +</p></li><li><p>The third, the "correct" way: (should you do this from the beginning, just carry out steps 1. and 2. from second -"way" above) +"way" above) </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Click on the <span class="guilabel">Advanced</span> -tab. (Hmmm... if everything is "Grayed Out", then you are not logged +tab. (Hmmm... if everything is "Grayed Out", then you are not logged in as a user with enough privileges).</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span> button.</p></li><li><p>On any of the two new tabs, click on the <span class="guilabel">Advanced...</span> button.</p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Compare this one to the other, -identical looking one from "B.5" or A.3".</p></li></ol></div><p> +identical looking one from "B.5" or A.3".</p></li></ol></div><p> </p></li></ol></div><p> Do you see any difference in the two settings dialogs? I don't @@ -7612,24 +7342,24 @@ either. However, only the last one, which you arrived at with steps C.1.-6. will permanently save any settings which will then become the defaults for new users. If you want all clients to have the same defaults, you need to conduct these steps as administrator -(<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in ) +(<a class="indexterm" name="id2902717"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in ) <span class="emphasis"><em>before</em></span> a client downloads the driver (the clients can later set their own <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user defaults</em></span> by following the procedures <span class="emphasis"><em>A.</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>B.</em></span> above...). (This is new: Windows 2000 and Windows XP allow <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user</em></span> default settings and the ones the administrator gives them, before they set up their own). -The "parents" of the identically looking dialogs have a slight +The "parents" of the identically looking dialogs have a slight difference in their window names: one is called <tt class="computeroutput">Default Print Values for Printer Foo on Server -Bar"</tt> (which is the one you need) and the other is -called "<tt class="computeroutput">Print Settings for Printer Foo on Server -Bar</tt>". The last one is the one you arrive at when you +Bar"</tt> (which is the one you need) and the other is +called "<tt class="computeroutput">Print Settings for Printer Foo on Server +Bar</tt>". The last one is the one you arrive at when you right-click on the printer and select <span class="guimenuitem">Print Settings...</span>. This is the one what you were taught to use back in the days of Windows NT! So it is only natural to try the same way with Win2k or WinXP. You wouldn't dream -that there is now a different "clicking path" to arrive at an +that there is now a different "clicking path" to arrive at an identically looking, but functionally different dialog to set defaults for all users! </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p>Try (on Win2000 and WinXP) to run this command (as a user @@ -7644,9 +7374,9 @@ rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SE </tt></b></p><p> to see the tab with the <span class="guilabel">Printing Preferences...</span> button (the one which doesn't set system-wide defaults). You can -start the commands from inside a DOS box" or from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span> +start the commands from inside a DOS box" or from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span> -- <span class="guimenuitem">Run...</span> menu. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925127"></a>Supporting large Numbers of Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902874"></a>Supporting large Numbers of Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> One issue that has arisen during the recent development phase of Samba is the need to support driver downloads for 100's of printers. Using Windows NT APW here is somewhat awkward (to say the least). If you @@ -7696,7 +7426,8 @@ following is an example of how this could be accomplished: </pre><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> "<i class="replaceable"><tt>Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)</tt></i>"'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c \ + 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> "<i class="replaceable"><tt>Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)</tt></i>"'</tt></b> cmd = setdriver dm9110 Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PPD) Successfully set dm9110 to driver Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS). </pre><p> @@ -7706,7 +7437,8 @@ following is an example of how this could be accomplished: cmd = enumprinters flags:[0x800000] name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] - description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS),110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS),\ + 110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] [....] </pre><p> @@ -7722,18 +7454,19 @@ following is an example of how this could be accomplished: cmd = enumprinters flags:[0x800000] name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] - description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,myphantasydrivername,110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,myphantasydrivername,\ + 110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] [....] </pre><p> It may be not easy to recognize: but the first call to -<b class="command">enumprinters</b> showed the "dm9110" printer with an +<b class="command">enumprinters</b> showed the "dm9110" printer with an empty string where the driver should have been listed (between the 2 -commas in the "description" field). After the +commas in the "description" field). After the <b class="command">setdriver</b> command succeeded, all is well. (The CUPS Printing chapter has more info about the installation of printer drivers with the help of <b class="command">rpcclient</b>). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925430"></a>Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903177"></a>Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> By default, Samba exhibits all printer shares defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> in the <span class="guiicon">Printers...</span> folder. Also located in this folder @@ -7741,29 +7474,29 @@ is the Windows NT Add Printer Wizard icon. The APW will be shown only if: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>...the connected user is able to successfully execute an <b class="command">OpenPrinterEx(\\server)</b> with administrative -privileges (i.e. root or <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>). +privileges (i.e. root or <a class="indexterm" name="id2903223"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>). </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Try this from a Windows 2K/XP DOS box command prompt: </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> runas /netonly /user:root rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i> </tt></b></p><p> and click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Preferences...</span> </p></div></li><li><p>... contains the setting -<i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = yes</tt></i> (the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903277"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes (the default).</p></li></ul></div><p> The APW can do various things: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>upload a new driver to the Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share;</p></li><li><p>associate an uploaded driver with an existing (but -still "driverless") print queue;</p></li><li><p>exchange the currently used driver for an existing +still "driverless") print queue;</p></li><li><p>exchange the currently used driver for an existing print queue with one that has been uploaded before;</p></li><li><p>add an entirely new printer to the Samba host (only in -conjunction with a working <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i>; -a corresponding <i class="parameter"><tt>delete printer command</tt></i> for +conjunction with a working <a class="indexterm" name="id2903334"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i>; +a corresponding <a class="indexterm" name="id2903350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>delete printer command</tt></i> for removing entries from the <span class="guiicon">Printers...</span> folder may be provided too)</p></li></ul></div><p> The last one (add a new printer) requires more effort than the previous ones. In order to use the APW to successfully add a printer -to a Samba server, the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> must +to a Samba server, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2903380"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> must have a defined value. The program hook must successfully add the -printer to the Unix print system (i.e. to +printer to the UNIX print system (i.e. to <tt class="filename">/etc/printcap</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/printers.conf</tt> or other appropriate files) and to if necessary. @@ -7773,13 +7506,11 @@ exist, smbd will execute the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> and reparse to the to attempt to locate the new printer share. If the share is still not defined, an error of <span class="errorname">Access Denied</span> is -returned to the client. Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer -command</tt></i> is executed under the context of the connected -user, not necessarily a root account. A <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest = bad -user</tt></i> may have connected you unwittingly under the wrong +returned to the client. Note that the <a class="indexterm" name="id2903429"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> is executed under the context of the connected +user, not necessarily a root account. A <a class="indexterm" name="id2903446"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user may have connected you unwittingly under the wrong privilege; you should check it by using the <b class="command">smbstatus</b> command. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925673"></a>Weird Error Message <span class="errorname">Cannot connect under a +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903470"></a>Weird Error Message <span class="errorname">Cannot connect under a different Name</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Once you are connected with the wrong credentials, there is no means to reverse the situation other than to close all Explorer windows, and @@ -7789,7 +7520,7 @@ perhaps reboot. connections to a server or a shared resource by the same user utilizing the several user names are not allowed. Disconnect all previous connections to the server, resp. the shared resource, and try -again.</tt></p></li><li><p>Every attempt to "connect a network drive" to +again.</tt></p></li><li><p>Every attempt to "connect a network drive" to <tt class="filename">\\SAMBASERVER\\print$</tt> to z: is countered by the pertinacious message. <tt class="computeroutput">This network folder is currently connected under different credentials (username and password). @@ -7809,20 +7540,20 @@ message. You close all Explorer Windows and start it again. You try to connect - and this times it works! Windows seems to cache connection info somewhere and doesn't keep it up to date (if you are unlucky you might need to reboot to get rid of the error message). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925771"></a>Be careful when assembling Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903569"></a>Be careful when assembling Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You need to be very careful when you take notes about the files and belonging to a particular driver. Don't confuse the files for driver -version "0" (for Win95/98/ME, going into -<tt class="filename">[print$]/WIN/0/</tt>), driver version "2" (Kernel Mode +version "0" (for Win95/98/ME, going into +<tt class="filename">[print$]/WIN/0/</tt>), driver version "2" (Kernel Mode driver for WinNT, going into <tt class="filename">[print$]/W32X86/2/</tt> <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> be used on Win2K/XP too), and driver version -"3" (non-Kernel Mode driver going into +"3" (non-Kernel Mode driver going into <tt class="filename">[print$]/W32X86/3/</tt> <span class="emphasis"><em>can not</em></span> be used on WinNT). Very often these different driver versions contain files carrying the same name; but still the files are very different! Also, if you look at them from the Windows Explorer (they reside in <tt class="filename">%WINDOWS%\system32\spool\drivers\W32X86\</tt>) you -will probably see names in capital letters, while an "enumdrivers" +will probably see names in capital letters, while an "enumdrivers" command from Samba would show mixed or lower case letters. So it is easy to confuse them. If you install them manually using <b class="command">rpcclient</b> and subcommands, you may even succeed @@ -7895,7 +7626,7 @@ reasons: Defaultdatatype: [] </pre><p> -If we write the "version 2" files and the "version 3" files +If we write the "version 2" files and the "version 3" files into different text files and compare the result, we see this picture: </p><pre class="screen"> @@ -7933,7 +7664,7 @@ comparison: </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>for i in cns3g.hlp cns3gui.dll cns3g.dll; do \ smbclient //10.160.50.8/print\$ -U 'Administrator%xxxx' \ - -c "cd W32X86/3; dir $i; cd .. ; cd 2; dir $i"; \ + -c "cd W32X86/3; dir $i; cd .. ; cd 2; dir $i"; \ done</tt></b> CNS3G.HLP A 122981 Thu May 30 02:31:00 2002 @@ -7950,39 +7681,39 @@ In my example were even more differences than shown here. Conclusion: you must be very careful to select the correct driver files for each driver version. Don't rely on the names alone. Don't interchange files belonging to different driver versions. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926117"></a>Samba and Printer Ports</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903854"></a>Samba and Printer Ports</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Windows NT/2000 print servers associate a port with each printer. These normally take the form of <tt class="filename">LPT1:</tt>, <tt class="filename">COM1:</tt>, <tt class="filename">FILE:</tt>, etc. Samba must also support the concept of ports associated with a printer. By -default, only one printer port, named "Samba Printer Port", exists on -a system. Samba does not really need such a "port" in order to print; +default, only one printer port, named "Samba Printer Port", exists on +a system. Samba does not really need such a "port" in order to print; it rather is a requirement of Windows clients. They insist on being told about an available port when they request this info, otherwise they throw an error message at you. So Samba fakes the port information to keep the Windows clients happy. </p><p> -Note that Samba does not support the concept of "Printer Pooling" +Note that Samba does not support the concept of "Printer Pooling" internally either. Printer Pooling assigns a logical printer to multiple ports as a form of load balancing or fail over. </p><p> If you require that multiple ports be defined for some reason or another (“<span class="quote">My users and my Boss should not know that they are working with Samba</span>”), possesses a -<i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> which can be used to define +<a class="indexterm" name="id2903913"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> which can be used to define an external program that generates a listing of ports on a system. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926188"></a>Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903932"></a>Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> So - printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print well, some don't print at all. Some jobs have problems with fonts, which don't look good at all. Some jobs print fast, and some are dead-slow. We can't cover it all; but we want to encourage you to read -the little paragraph about "Avoiding the wrong PostScript Driver -Settings" in the CUPS Printing part of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2926210"></a>The Imprints Toolset</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +the little paragraph about "Avoiding the wrong PostScript Driver +Settings" in the CUPS Printing part of this document. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903954"></a>The Imprints Toolset</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Imprints tool set provides a UNIX equivalent of the Windows NT Add Printer Wizard. For complete information, please refer to the Imprints web site -at<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a> +at <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a> as well as the documentation included with the imprints source distribution. This section will only provide a brief introduction to the features of Imprints. @@ -7995,20 +7726,20 @@ coordinate your efforts on the samba-technical mailing list. The toolset is still in usable form; but only for a series of older printer models, where there are prepared packages to use. Packages for more up to date print devices are needed if Imprints should have a -future.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926256"></a>What is Imprints?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +future.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903998"></a>What is Imprints?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Imprints is a collection of tools for supporting these goals: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Providing a central repository information regarding Windows NT and 95/98 printer driver packages</p></li><li><p>Providing the tools necessary for creating the Imprints printer driver packages.</p></li><li><p>Providing an installation client which will obtain printer drivers from a central internet (or intranet) Imprints Server repository and install them on remote Samba and Windows NT4 print -servers.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926297"></a>Creating Printer Driver Packages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +servers.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904040"></a>Creating Printer Driver Packages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The process of creating printer driver packages is beyond the scope of this document (refer to Imprints.txt also included with the Samba distribution for more information). In short, an Imprints driver package is a gzipped tarball containing the driver files, related INF files, and a control file needed by the installation client. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926316"></a>The Imprints Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904059"></a>The Imprints Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Imprints server is really a database server that may be queried via standard HTTP mechanisms. Each printer entry in the database has an associated URL for the actual downloading of the package. Each @@ -8016,7 +7747,7 @@ package is digitally signed via GnuPG which can be used to verify that package downloaded is actually the one referred in the Imprints database. It is strongly recommended that this security check <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be disabled. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926340"></a>The Installation Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904083"></a>The Installation Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> More information regarding the Imprints installation client is available in the <tt class="filename">Imprints-Client-HOWTO.ps</tt> file included with the imprints source package. @@ -8037,9 +7768,9 @@ wrapped around smbclient and rpcclient </p></li><li><p>rpcclient: Issue an AddPrinterEx() MS-RPC to actually create the printer</p></li></ul></div><p> One of the problems encountered when implementing the Imprints tool set was the name space issues between various supported client -architectures. For example, Windows NT includes a driver named "Apple -LaserWriter II NTX v51.8" and Windows 95 calls its version of this -driver "Apple LaserWriter II NTX" +architectures. For example, Windows NT includes a driver named "Apple +LaserWriter II NTX v51.8" and Windows 95 calls its version of this +driver "Apple LaserWriter II NTX" </p><p> The problem is how to know what client drivers have been uploaded for a printer. An astute reader will remember that the Windows NT Printer @@ -8057,7 +7788,7 @@ if is has not already been installed? The way of sidestepping this limitation is to require that all Imprints printer driver packages include both the Intel Windows NT and 95/98 printer drivers and that NT driver is installed first. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2926492"></a>Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904236"></a>Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following MS Knowledge Base article may be of some help if you need to handle Windows 2000 clients: <span class="emphasis"><em>How to Add Printers with No User Interaction in Windows 2000.</em></span> ( <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a> @@ -8067,7 +7798,7 @@ The ideas sketched out below are inspired by this article. It describes a commandline method which can be applied to install network and local printers and their drivers. This is most useful if integrated in Logon Scripts. You can see what options are -available by typing in a command prompt ("DOS box") this: +available by typing in a command prompt ("DOS box") this: </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /?</tt></b></p><p> A window pops up which shows you all of the commandline switches available. An extensive list of examples is also provided. This is @@ -8077,22 +7808,16 @@ what a client logon script might contain, with a short explanation of what the lines actually do (it works if 2k/XP Windows clients access printers via Samba, but works for Windows-based print servers too): </p><pre class="screen"> -<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /dn /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-IPDS" /q</tt></b> -<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> -<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /y /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /dn /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-IPDS" /q</tt></b> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> +<b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /y /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> </pre><p> Here is a list of the used commandline parameters: -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">/dn</span></dt><dd><p>deletes a network printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/q</span></dt><dd><p>quiet modus</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/n</span></dt><dd><p>names a printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/in</span></dt><dd><p>adds a network printer connection</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/y</span></dt><dd><p>sets printer as default printer</p></dd></dl></div><p> -I have tested this with a Samba 2.2.7a and a Samba-3alpha24 -installation and Windows XP Professional clients. Note that this -specific command set works with network print queues (installing -local print queues requires different parameters, but this is of no -interest here). -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Line 1 deletes a possibly existing previous network +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">/dn</span></dt><dd><p>deletes a network printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/q</span></dt><dd><p>quiet modus</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/n</span></dt><dd><p>names a printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/in</span></dt><dd><p>adds a network printer connection</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/y</span></dt><dd><p>sets printer as default printer</p></dd></dl></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Line 1 deletes a possibly existing previous network printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-IPDS</em></span> (which had used native Windows drivers with LPRng that were removed from the server which was converted to CUPS). The <b class="command">/q</b> at the end eliminates -"Confirm" or error dialog boxes popping up. They should not be +"Confirm" or error dialog boxes popping up. They should not be presented to the user logging on.</p></li><li><p>Line 2 adds the new printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-PS</em></span> (which actually is same physical device but is now run by the new CUPS printing system and associated @@ -8108,7 +7833,7 @@ default printer). The default printer selection may of course be different for different users.</p></li></ul></div><p> Note that the second line only works if the printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-PS</em></span> has an already working print queue -on "sambacupsserver", and if the printer drivers have successfully been +on "sambacupsserver", and if the printer drivers have successfully been uploaded (via <b class="command">APW</b> , <b class="command">smbclient/rpcclient</b> or <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b>) into the @@ -8124,7 +7849,7 @@ every time a user logs in; it's really quick anyway (1 to 2 seconds). </p><p> The additional benefits for this are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>It puts in place any printer default setup changes -automatically at every user logon.</p></li><li><p>It allows for "roaming" users' login into the domain from +automatically at every user logon.</p></li><li><p>It allows for "roaming" users' login into the domain from different workstations.</p></li></ul></div><p> Since network printers are installed per user this much simplifies the process of keeping the installation up-to-date. The extra few seconds @@ -8132,7 +7857,7 @@ at logon time will not really be noticeable. Printers can be centrally added, changed, and deleted at will on the server with no user intervention required on the clients (you just need to keep the logon scripts up to date). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2926822"></a>The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904556"></a>The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command can be configured to be a shell script or program executed by Samba. It is triggered by running the APW from a client against the Samba print server. The APW asks the @@ -8144,25 +7869,24 @@ on legacy systems, or execute the <b class="command">lpadmin</b> command on more modern systems) and create the associated share in , then the APW will in effect really create a new printer on Samba and the UNIX print subsystem! -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2926867"></a>Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The basic "NT-style" printer driver management has not changed +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904602"></a>Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The basic "NT-style" printer driver management has not changed considerably in 3.0 over the 2.2.x releases (apart from many small improvements). Here migration should be quite easy, especially if you followed previous advice to stop using deprecated parameters in your setup. For migrations from an existing 2.0.x setup, or if you -continued "Win9x-style" printing in your Samba 2.2 installations, it +continued "Win9x-style" printing in your Samba 2.2 installations, it is more of an effort. Please read the appropriate release notes and the HOWTO Collection for 2.2. You can follow several paths. Here are possible scenarios for migration: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You need to study and apply the new Windows NT printer -and driver support. Previously used parameters "<i class="parameter"><tt>printer -driver file</tt></i>", " <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i>" and -"<i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i>" are no longer +and driver support. Previously used parameters <i class="parameter"><tt>printer +driver file</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> and +<i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i> are no longer supported.</p></li><li><p>If you want to take advantage of WinNT printer driver support you also need to migrate the Win9x/ME drivers to the new setup.</p></li><li><p>An existing <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file -(the one specified in the now removed parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>printer -driver file = ...</tt></i>) will work no longer with Samba-3.0. In + (the one specified in the now removed parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i>) will work no longer with samba 3. In 3.0, smbd attempts to locate a Win9x/ME driver files for the printer in <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and additional settings in the TDB and only there; if it fails it will <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> (as 2.2.x @@ -8170,7 +7894,7 @@ used to do) drop down to using a <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> (and all associated parameters). The make_printerdef tool is removed and there is no backwards compatibility for this.</p></li><li><p>You need to install a Windows 9x driver into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share for a printer on your Samba -host. The driver files will be stored in the "WIN40/0" subdirectory of +host. The driver files will be stored in the "WIN40/0" subdirectory of <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>, and some other settings and info go into the printing-related TDBs.</p></li><li><p>If you want to migrate an existing <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file into the new setup, the current @@ -8178,162 +7902,137 @@ only solution is to use the Windows NT APW to install the NT drivers and the 9x drivers. This can be scripted using smbclient and rpcclient. See the Imprints installation client at: </p><p> -<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top"><span class="emphasis"><em>http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</em></span></a> + <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a> </p><p> for an example. See also the discussion of rpcclient usage in the -"CUPS Printing" section.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2927036"></a>Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"CUPS Printing" section.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904779"></a>Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> We will publish an update to this section shortly. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2927051"></a>Common Errors and Problems</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Here are a few typical errors and problems people have -encountered. You can avoid them. Read on. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927064"></a>I give my root password but I don't get access</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Don't confuse the root password which is valid for the Unix system +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904793"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904800"></a>I give my root password but I don't get access</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Don't confuse the root password which is valid for the UNIX system (and in most cases stored in the form of a one-way hash in a file named <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>) with the password used to authenticate against Samba!. Samba doesn't know the UNIX password; for root to access Samba resources via Samba-type access, a Samba account for root must be created first. This is often done with the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927097"></a>My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Don't use the existing Unix print system spool directory for the Samba +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904834"></a>My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Don't use the existing UNIX print system spool directory for the Samba spool directory. It may seem convenient and a saving of space, but it only leads to problems. The two <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be separate. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="CUPS-printing"></a>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Ciprian</span> <span class="surname">Vizitiu</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (3 June 2003) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2936290">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936298">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936350">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936405">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936484">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936628">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936710">More complex smb.conf Settings for -CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936828">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936848">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936875">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936912">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936970">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937131">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2937224">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937300">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937344">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937445">Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937533">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937630">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937742">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937813">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937902">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2937925">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2938065">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938252">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938369">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938539">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938624">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938727">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938883">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938940">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939024">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939336">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939448">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939464">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939517">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939571">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2939786">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940015">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and -native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940170">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940401">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940530">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940605">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940620">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940659">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940731">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940794">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print -Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940814">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940978">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941054">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941110">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941150">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941216">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941233">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941268">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941289">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941316">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941369"> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941388">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941480">Prepare your smb.conf for -cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941526">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941724">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941782">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941814">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941864">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942086">What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942268">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942369">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942596">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942690">How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942777">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942812">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942865">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942978">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the -Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943112">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using -rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943227">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943340">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943429">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943519">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943682">Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944334">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944435">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944537">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944608">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944670">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944728">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944795">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944903">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2945532">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2945993">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946024">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946056">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946097">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946169">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946270">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946341">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946390">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946404">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946598">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946644">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946726">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946787">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946805">When not to use Samba to print to -CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946822">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946857">Where to find Documentation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946870">How to ask for Help</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2946883">Where to find Help</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2946896">Appendix</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2946904">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2947118">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2947424">Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2948546">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936290"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936298"></a>Features and Benefits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - The Common Unix Print System (<a href="http://www.cups.org/" target="_top">CUPS</a>) has become very popular. All - big Linux distributions now ship it as their default printing - system. But to many it is still a very mystical tool. Normally it - "just works" (TM). People tend to regard it as a sort of "black box", - which they don't want to look into, as long as it works OK. But once +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="CUPS-printing"></a>Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Ciprian</span> <span class="surname">Vizitiu</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><span class="contrib">drawings</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (3 June 2003) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2904970">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2904977">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905020">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905074">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905408">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905584">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2905929">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2905949">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2905999">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906051">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906119">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2906432">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907029">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907154">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907241">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907348">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2907370">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2907545">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2907903">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908080">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908183">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908292">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908476">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908539">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2908691">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909039">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909176">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909191">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909245">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909312">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909544">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910018">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910331">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910470">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2910560">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910577">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910632">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2910813">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911043">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911125">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911206">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911255">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911328">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911345">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911379">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911400">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911445">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2911506">Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2911524">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911625">Prepare your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2911845">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912128">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912268">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912301">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912629">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912835">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2912958">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913264">How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913349">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913427">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913497">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2913646">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2913973">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914086">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914186">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2915566">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2915962">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916041">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916103">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2916162">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2916297">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2916436">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917129">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2917602">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2917645">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917708">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917748">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917829">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2917938">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918010">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918058">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918072">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918267">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2918326">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918564">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2918622">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918682">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2918955">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2796634">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2796642">Win9x client can't install driver</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919061">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919107">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919163">Client can't connect to Samba printer</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919497">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919582">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919635">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919649">Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919678">Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919695">Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919711">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919733">"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919752">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2919794">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920067">Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920114">cupsaddsmb does not work + with newly installed printer</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920175">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920284">Printer named "lp" +intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different +ones</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920314">Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2920369">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2904970"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904977"></a>Features and Benefits</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The Common UNIX Print System (<a href="http://www.cups.org/" target="_top">CUPS</a>) has become very popular. All + major Linux distributions now ship it as their default printing + system. To many it is still a very mystical tool. Mostly, it + "just works" (TM). People tend to regard it as a "black box" + which they don't want to look into, as long as it works. But once there is a little problem, they are in trouble to find out where to - start debugging it. Also, even the most recent and otherwise excellent - printed Samba documentation has only limited attention paid to CUPS - printing, leaving out important pieces or even writing plain wrong - things about it. This demands rectification. But before you dive into - this chapter, make sure that you don't forget to refer to the - "Classical Printing" chapter also. It contains a lot of information - that is relevant for CUPS too. + start debugging it. Refer to the "Classical Printing" chapter also, it + contains a lot of information that is relevant for CUPS. </p><p> CUPS sports quite a few unique and powerful features. While their basic functions may be grasped quite easily, they are also new. Because they are different from other, more traditional printing systems, it is best to try and not apply any prior knowledge about - printing upon this new system. Rather try to start understand CUPS - from the beginning. This documentation will lead you here to a - complete understanding of CUPS, if you study all of the material - contained. But lets start with the most basic things first. Maybe this - is all you need for now. Then you can skip most of the other - paragraphs. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936350"></a>Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + printing upon this new system. Rather, try to understand CUPS + from the beginning. This documentation will lead you to a + complete understanding of CUPS. Let's start with the most basic + things first. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905020"></a>Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS is more than just a print spooling system. It is a complete printer management system that complies with the new IPP (<span class="emphasis"><em>Internet Printing Protocol</em></span>). IPP is an industry and IETF (<span class="emphasis"><em>Internet Engineering Task Force</em></span>) standard for network printing. Many of its functions can be managed remotely (or locally) via a web browser (giving you a - platform-independent access to the CUPS print server). In addition it - has the traditional commandline and several more modern GUI interfaces + platform-independent access to the CUPS print server). Additionally, it + has the traditional command line and several more modern GUI interfaces (GUI interfaces developed by 3rd parties, like KDE's overwhelming <a href="http://printing.kde.org/" target="_top">KDEPrint</a>). </p><p> - CUPS allows creation of "raw" printers (ie: NO print file - format translation) as well as "smart" printers (i.e. CUPS does + CUPS allows creation of "raw" printers (ie: NO print file + format translation) as well as "smart" printers (i.e. CUPS does file format conversion as required for the printer). In many ways this gives CUPS similar capabilities to the MS Windows print monitoring system. Of course, if you are a CUPS advocate, you would argue that CUPS is better! In any case, let us now move on to explore how one may configure CUPS for interfacing with MS Windows print clients via Samba. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936405"></a>Basic Configuration of CUPS support</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Printing with CUPS in the most basic <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> - setup in Samba 3.0 (as was true for 2.2.x) only needs two - settings: <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>printcap - = cups</tt></i>. CUPS itself doesn't need a printcap file - anymore. However, the <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> configuration - file knows two related directives: they control if such a file should - be automatically created and maintained by CUPS for the convenience of - third party applications (example: <i class="parameter"><tt>Printcap - /etc/printcap</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>PrintcapFormat - BSD</tt></i>). These legacy programs often require the existence of - printcap file containing printernames or they will refuse to - print. Make sure CUPS is set to generate and maintain a printcap! For - details see <b class="command">man cupsd.conf</b> and other CUPS-related - documentation, like the wealth of documents on your CUPS server + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905074"></a>Basic Configuration of CUPS support</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Printing with CUPS in the most basic <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setup in Samba 3.0 (as was true for 2.2.x) only needs two + settings: <a class="indexterm" name="id2905093"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905107"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups. CUPS does not need a printcap file. + However, the <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> configuration file knows of two related directives that control + how such a file will be automatically created and maintained by CUPS for the convenience of third party + applications (example: <i class="parameter"><tt>Printcap /etc/printcap</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>PrintcapFormat BSD</tt></i>). + Legacy programs often require the existence of a printcap file containing printer names or they will refuse to + print. Make sure CUPS is set to generate and maintain a printcap file! For details see + <b class="command">man cupsd.conf</b> and other CUPS-related documentation, like the wealth of documents on your CUPS server itself: <a href="http://localhost:631/documentation.html" target="_top">http://localhost:631/documentation.html</a>. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936484"></a>Linking of smbd with libcups.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Samba has a very special relationship to CUPS. The reason is: Samba - can be compiled with CUPS library support. Most recent installations - have this support enabled, and per default CUPS linking is compiled + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905167"></a>Linking of smbd with libcups.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba has a very special relationship to CUPS. Samba can be compiled with CUPS library support. + Most recent installations have this support enabled. Per default CUPS linking is compiled into smbd and other Samba binaries. Of course, you can use CUPS even if Samba is not linked against <tt class="filename">libcups.so</tt> -- but there are some differences in required or supported configuration then. </p><p> - If SAMBA is compiled against libcups, then <i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = - cups</tt></i> uses the CUPS API to list printers, submit jobs, - query queues, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V commands with an - additional <b class="command">-oraw</b> option for printing. On a Linux - system, you can use the <b class="command">ldd</b> utility to find out - details (ldd may not be present on other OS platforms, or its function - may be embodied by a different command): + When Samba is compiled against libcups, <a class="indexterm" name="id2905197"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups + uses the CUPS API to list printers, submit jobs, query queues, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V + commands with an additional <b class="command">-oraw</b> option for printing. On a Linux + system, you can use the <b class="command">ldd</b> utility to find out details (ldd may not be present on + other OS platforms, or its function may be embodied by a different command): </p><pre class="screen"> - transmeta:/home/kurt # ldd `which smbd` - libssl.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libssl.so.0.9.6 (0x4002d000) - libcrypto.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libcrypto.so.0.9.6 (0x4005a000) - libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000) - [....] - </pre><p> - The line <tt class="computeroutput">libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 - (0x40123000)</tt> shows there is CUPS support compiled - into this version of Samba. If this is the case, and printing = cups - is set, then <span class="emphasis"><em>any otherwise manually set print command in - <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is ignored</em></span>. This is an - important point to remember! - </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Should you require -- for any reason -- to set your own - print commands, you can still do this by setting <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = - sysv</tt></i>. However, you'll loose all the benefits from the - close CUPS/Samba integration. You are on your own then to manually - configure the rest of the printing system commands (most important: - <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>; other commands are - <i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command, lpresume command, lpq command, lprm - command, queuepause command </tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>queue resume - command</tt></i>).</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936628"></a>Simple <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - To summarize, here is the simplest printing-related setup - for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to enable basic CUPS support: - </p><pre class="screen"> - - [global] - load printers = yes - printing = cups - printcap name = cups - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - browseable = no - public = yes - guest ok = yes - writable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = root, @ntadmins - - </pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ldd `which smbd`</tt></b> +libssl.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libssl.so.0.9.6 (0x4002d000) +libcrypto.so.0.9.6 => /usr/lib/libcrypto.so.0.9.6 (0x4005a000) +libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000) +[....] +</pre><p> + The line <tt class="computeroutput">libcups.so.2 => /usr/lib/libcups.so.2 (0x40123000)</tt> shows + there is CUPS support compiled into this version of Samba. If this is the case, and printing = cups + is set, then <span class="emphasis"><em>any otherwise manually set print command in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is ignored</em></span>. + This is an important point to remember! + </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Should it be necessary, for any reason, to set your own print commands, you can do this by setting + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905291"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv. However, you will loose all the benefits + of tight CUPS/Samba integration. When you do this you must manually configure the printing system commands + (most important: <a class="indexterm" name="id2905308"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>; other commands are + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905322"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905336"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905350"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905364"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905378"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2905392"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queue resume command</tt></i>).</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905408"></a>Simple <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To summarize, here is the simplest printing-related setup for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to enable basic CUPS support: + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2905436"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.1. Simplest printing-related smb.conf</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root, @ntadmins</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> This is all you need for basic printing setup for CUPS. It will print all Graphic, Text, PDF and PostScript file submitted from Windows clients. However, most of your Windows users would not know how to @@ -8343,92 +8042,54 @@ Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2948546">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Proce driver. Your users also very rarely send files from the command line. Unlike UNIX clients, they hardly submit graphic, text or PDF formatted files directly to the spooler. They nearly exclusively print - from GUI applications, with a "printer driver" hooked in between the + from GUI applications, with a "printer driver" hooked in between the applications native format and the print data stream. If the backend - printer is not a PostScript device, the print data stream is "binary", + printer is not a PostScript device, the print data stream is "binary", sensible only for the target printer. Read on to learn which problem this may cause and how to avoid it. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936710"></a>More complex <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905584"></a>More complex <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Settings for CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here is a slightly more complex printing-related setup for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. It enables general CUPS printing support for all printers, but defines one printer share which is set up differently. -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [global] - printing = cups - printcap name = cups - load printers = yes - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - public = yes - guest ok = yes - writable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = root, @ntadmins - - [special_printer] - comment = A special printer with his own settings - path = /var/spool/samba-special - printing = sysv - printcap = lpstat - print command = echo "NEW: `date`: printfile %f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ;\ - echo " `date`: p-%p s-%s f-%f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ;\ - echo " `date`: j-%j J-%J z-%z c-%c" >> /tmp/smbprn.log :\ - rm %f - public = no - guest ok = no - writeable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = kurt - hosts deny = 0.0.0.0 - hosts allow = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60 - -</pre><p> -This special share is only there for my testing purposes. It doesn't -even write the print job to a file. It just logs the job parameters -known to Samba into the <tt class="filename">/tmp/smbprn.log</tt> file and -deletes the jobfile. Moreover, the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer -admin</tt></i> of this share is "kurt" (not the "@ntadmins" group); -guest access is not allowed; the share isn't announced in Network -Neighbourhood (so you need to know it is there), and it is only -allowing access from three hosts. To prevent CUPS kicking in and -taking over the print jobs for that share, we need to set -<i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = -lpstat</tt></i>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936828"></a>Advanced Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Before we dive into all the configuration options, let's clarify a few +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2905615"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.2. Overriding global CUPS settings for one printer</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root, @ntadmins</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[special_printer]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = A special printer with his own settings</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba-special</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = lpstat</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = echo "NEW: `date`: printfile %f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ; \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>echo " `date`: p-%p s-%s f-%f" >> /tmp/smbprn.log ; \</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>echo " `date`: j-%j J-%J z-%z c-%c" >> /tmp/smbprn.log : rm %f</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +This special share is only there for testing purposes. It does not write the print job to a file. It just logs the job parameters +known to Samba into the <tt class="filename">/tmp/smbprn.log</tt> file and deletes the jobfile. Moreover, the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905879"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> of this share is "kurt" (not the "@ntadmins" group); +guest access is not allowed; the share isn not published to the Network Neighbourhood (so you need to know it is there), and it only +allows access from only three hosts. To prevent CUPS kicking in and taking over the print jobs for that share, we need to set +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905899"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2905912"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = lpstat. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2905929"></a>Advanced Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Before we delve into all the configuration options, let us clarify a few points. <span class="emphasis"><em>Network printing needs to be organized and setup correctly</em></span>. Often this is not done correctly. Legacy systems -or small LANs in business environments often lack a clear design and -good housekeeping. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936848"></a>Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +or small business LAN environments often lack design and good housekeeping. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905949"></a>Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2905958"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2905970"></a><p> Many small office or home networks, as well as badly organized larger environments, allow each client a direct access to available network -printers. Generally, this is a bad idea. It often blocks one client's +printers. This is generally a bad idea. It often blocks one client's access to the printer when another client's job is printing. It also might freeze the first client's application while it is waiting to get rid of the job. Also, there are frequent complaints about various jobs being printed with their pages mixed with each other. A better concept -is the usage of a "print server": it routes all jobs through one +is the usage of a "print server": it routes all jobs through one central system, which responds immediately, takes jobs from multiple concurrent clients at the same time and in turn transfers them to the printer(s) in the correct order. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936875"></a>CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Most traditionally configured Unix print servers acting on behalf of +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2905999"></a>CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906008"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906017"></a><p> +Most traditionally configured UNIX print servers acting on behalf of Samba's Windows clients represented a really simple setup. Their only -task was to manage the "raw" spooling of all jobs handed to them by +task was to manage the "raw" spooling of all jobs handed to them by Samba. This approach meant that the Windows clients were expected to -prepare the print job file in such a way that it became fit to be fed to -the printing device. Here a native (vendor-supplied) Windows printer +prepare the print job file that it s ready to be sent to the printing +device. Here a native (vendor-supplied) Windows printer driver for the target device needed to be installed on each and every client. </p><p> -Of course you can setup CUPS, Samba and your Windows clients in the +It is possible to configure CUPS, Samba and your Windows clients in the same, traditional and simple way. When CUPS printers are configured for RAW print-through mode operation it is the responsibility of the Samba client to fully render the print job (file). The file must be @@ -8436,24 +8097,26 @@ sent in a format that is suitable for direct delivery to the printer. Clients need to run the vendor-provided drivers to do this. In this case CUPS will NOT do any print file format conversion work. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936912"></a>Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906051"></a>Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The printer drivers on the Windows clients may be installed in two functionally different ways: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>manually install the drivers locally on each client, one by one; this yields the old <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> style printing; it uses a <tt class="filename">\\sambaserver\printershare</tt> -type of connection.</p></li><li><p>deposit and prepare the drivers (for later download) on +type of connection.</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2906094"></a> + deposit and prepare the drivers (for later download) on the print server (Samba); this enables the clients to use -"Point'n'Print" to get drivers semi-automatically installed the +"Point and Print" to get drivers semi-automatically installed the first time they access the printer; with this method NT/2K/XP clients use the <span class="emphasis"><em>SPOOLSS/MS-RPC</em></span> type printing calls.</p></li></ul></div><p> The second method is recommended for use over the first. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936970"></a>Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -<span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906119"></a>Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +<span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>!</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906132"></a><p> If you use the first option (drivers are installed on the client side), there is one setting to take care of: CUPS needs to be told -that it should allow "raw" printing of deliberate (binary) file +that it should allow "raw" printing of deliberate (binary) file formats. The CUPS files that need to be correctly set for RAW mode printers to work are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>/etc/cups/mime.types @@ -8463,68 +8126,66 @@ be uncommented to allow RAW mode operation. In<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> make sure this line is present: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/octet-stream - </pre><p> In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt>, have this line: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2906200"></a><pre class="screen"> application/octet-stream application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - </pre><p> If these two files are not set up correctly for raw Windows client printing, you may encounter the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">Unable to convert file 0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>editing the <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt> and the <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file does not -<span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> "raw" printing, it only +<span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> "raw" printing, it only <span class="emphasis"><em>allows</em></span> it. -</p></div><p><b>Background. </b> +</p></div><p><b>Background. </b><a class="indexterm" name="id2906266"></a> CUPS being a more security-aware printing system than traditional ones does not by default allow a user to send deliberate (possibly binary) data to printing devices. This could be easily abused to launch a -"Denial of Service" attack on your printer(s), causing at the least -the loss of a lot of paper and ink. "Unknown" data are tagged by CUPS +"Denial of Service" attack on your printer(s), causing at the least +the loss of a lot of paper and ink. "Unknown" data are tagged by CUPS as <span class="emphasis"><em>MIME type: application/octet-stream</em></span> and not allowed to go to the printer. By default, you can only send other -(known) MIME types "raw". Sending data "raw" means that CUPS does not +(known) MIME types "raw". Sending data "raw" means that CUPS does not try to convert them and passes them to the printer untouched (see next chapter for even more background explanations). </p><p> This is all you need to know to get the CUPS/Samba combo printing -"raw" files prepared by Windows clients, which have vendor drivers +"raw" files prepared by Windows clients, which have vendor drivers locally installed. If you are not interested in background information about more advanced CUPS/Samba printing, simply skip the remaining sections of this chapter. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937131"></a>Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906306"></a>Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906315"></a><p> If you want to use the MS-RPC type printing, you must upload the drivers onto the Samba server first (<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share). For a discussion on how to deposit printer drivers on the Samba host (so that the Windows clients can download and use them via -"Point'n'Print") please also refer to the previous chapter of this +"Point'n'Print") please also refer to the previous chapter of this HOWTO Collection. There you will find a description or reference to three methods of preparing the client drivers on the Samba server: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the GUI, "Add Printer Wizard" +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2906342"></a><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the GUI, "Add Printer Wizard" <span class="emphasis"><em>upload-from-a-Windows-client</em></span> -method;</p></li><li><p>the commandline, "smbclient/rpcclient" +method;</p></li><li><p>the commandline, "smbclient/rpcclient" <span class="emphasis"><em>upload-from-a-UNIX-workstation</em></span> -method;</p></li><li><p>the <span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> Toolset +method;</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2906380"></a> + the <span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> Toolset method.</p></li></ul></div><p> These 3 methods apply to CUPS all the same. A new and more convenient way to load the Windows drivers into Samba is provided -provided if you use CUPS: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> +if you use CUPS: +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2906402"></a><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> utility.</p></li></ul></div><p> cupsaddsmb is discussed in much detail further below. But we will first explore the CUPS filtering system and compare the Windows and UNIX printing architectures. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937224"></a>Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Still reading on? Good. Let's go into more detail then. We now know -how to set up a "dump" printserver, that is, a server which is spooling -printjobs "raw", leaving the print data untouched. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2906432"></a>Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906442"></a><p> +Are you still following this? Good. Let's go into more detail then. We now know +how to set up a "dump" printserver, that is, a server which is spooling +printjobs "raw", leaving the print data untouched. </p><p> Possibly you need to setup CUPS in a more smart way. The reasons could be manifold: @@ -8535,33 +8196,33 @@ peaks in printing? Which departments prints how much?</p></li><li><p>Maybe you are asked to setup a print quota system: users should not be able to print more jobs, once they have surpassed a given limit per period?</p></li><li><p>Maybe your previous network printing setup is a mess -and shall be re-organized from a clean beginning?</p></li><li><p>Maybe you have experiencing too many "Blue Screens", -originating from poorly debugged printer drivers running in NT "kernel -mode"?</p></li></ul></div><p> +and shall be re-organized from a clean beginning?</p></li><li><p>Maybe you have experiencing too many "Blue Screens", +originating from poorly debugged printer drivers running in NT "kernel +mode"?</p></li></ul></div><p> These goals cannot be achieved by a raw print server. To build a server meeting these requirements, you'll first need to learn about how CUPS works and how you can enable its features. </p><p> What follows is the comparison of some fundamental concepts for -Windows and Unix printing; then is the time for a description of the +Windows and UNIX printing; then is the time for a description of the CUPS filtering system, how it works and how you can tweak it. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937300"></a>GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="gdipost"></a>GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906532"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906540"></a><p> Network printing is one of the most complicated and error-prone day-to-day tasks any user or an administrator may encounter. This is true for all OS platforms. And there are reasons for this. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2906556"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906564"></a><p> You can't expect for most file formats to just throw them towards printers and they get printed. There needs to be a file format conversion in between. The problem is: there is no common standard for print file formats across all manufacturers and printer types. While <span class="emphasis"><em>PostScript</em></span> (trademark held by Adobe), and, to an extent, <span class="emphasis"><em>PCL</em></span> (trademark held by HP), have developed -into semi-official "standards", by being the most widely used PDLs +into semi-official "standards", by being the most widely used PDLs (<span class="emphasis"><em>Page Description Languages</em></span>), there are still -many manufacturers who "roll their own" (their reasons may be +many manufacturers who "roll their own" (their reasons may be unacceptable license fees for using printer-embedded PostScript interpreters, etc.). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937344"></a>Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906600"></a>Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906609"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906618"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906626"></a><p> In Windows OS, the format conversion job is done by the printer drivers. On MS Windows OS platforms all application programmers have at their disposal a built-in API, the GDI (<span class="emphasis"><em>Graphical Device @@ -8571,23 +8232,24 @@ all Windows programs, to draw pictures, fonts and documents <span class="emphasis"><em>on screen</em></span> as well as <span class="emphasis"><em>on paper</em></span> (=print). Therefore printer driver developers can standardize on a well-defined GDI output for their own driver -input. Achieving WYSIWYG ("What You See Is What You Get") is +input. Achieving WYSIWYG ("What You See Is What You Get") is relatively easy, because the on-screen graphic primitives, as well as the on-paper drawn objects, come from one common source. This source, the GDI, produces often a file format called EMF (<span class="emphasis"><em>Enhanced MetaFile</em></span>). The EMF is processed by the printer driver and converted to the printer-specific file format. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2906676"></a> To the GDI foundation in MS Windows, Apple has chosen to put paper and screen output on a common foundation for their -(BSD-Unix-based, did you know??) Mac OS X and Darwin Operating -Systems.Their <span class="emphasis"><em>Core Graphic Engine</em></span> uses a -<span class="emphasis"><em>PDF</em></span> derivate for all display work. +(BSD-UNIX-based, did you know??) Mac OS X and Darwin Operating +Systems. Their <span class="emphasis"><em>Core Graphic Engine</em></span> uses a +<span class="emphasis"><em>PDF</em></span> derivative for all display work. </p></div><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2937409"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.1. Windows Printing to a local Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" alt="Windows Printing to a local Printer"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937445"></a>Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In Unix and Linux, there is no comparable layer built into the OS +</p><div class="figure"><a name="small1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.1. Windows Printing to a local Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" width="270" alt="Windows Printing to a local Printer"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2906741"></a>UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906749"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906757"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906766"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906774"></a><p> +In UNIX and Linux, there is no comparable layer built into the OS kernel(s) or the X (screen display) server. Every application is responsible for itself to create its print output. Fortunately, most use PostScript. That gives at least some common ground. Unfortunately, @@ -8597,17 +8259,17 @@ the same document is displayed on screen and how it is presented on paper. WYSIWYG is more difficult to achieve. This goes back to the time decades ago, when the predecessors of <span class="emphasis"><em>X.org</em></span>, designing the UNIX foundations and protocols for Graphical User -Interfaces refused to take over responsibility for "paper output" +Interfaces refused to take over responsibility for "paper output" also, as some had demanded at the time, and restricted itself to -"on-screen only". (For some years now, the "Xprint" project has been +"on-screen only". (For some years now, the "Xprint" project has been under development, attempting to build printing support into the X framework, including a PostScript and a PCL driver, but it is not yet ready for prime time.) You can see this unfavorable inheritance up to -the present day by looking into the various "font" directories on your +the present day by looking into the various "font" directories on your system; there are separate ones for fonts used for X display and fonts to be used on paper. -</p><p><b>Background. </b> -The PostScript programming language is an "invention" by Adobe Inc., +</p><p><b>Background. </b><a class="indexterm" name="id2906821"></a> +The PostScript programming language is an "invention" by Adobe Inc., but its specifications have been published to the full. Its strength lies in its powerful abilities to describe graphical objects (fonts, shapes, patterns, lines, curves, dots...), their attributes (color, @@ -8616,69 +8278,71 @@ shift...) them. Because of its open specification, anybody with the skill can start writing his own implementation of a PostScript interpreter and use it to display PostScript files on screen or on paper. Most graphical output devices are based on the concept of -"raster images" or "pixels" (one notable exception are pen +"raster images" or "pixels" (one notable exception are pen plotters). Of course, you can look at a PostScript file in its textual form and you will be reading its PostScript code, the language instructions which need to be interpreted by a rasterizer. Rasterizers produce pixel images, which may be displayed on screen by a viewer program or on paper by a printer. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937533"></a>PostScript and Ghostscript</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -So, Unix is lacking a common ground for printing on paper and -displaying on screen. Despite this unfavorable legacy for Unix, basic +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="post-and-ghost"></a>PostScript and Ghostscript</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2906885"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906893"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2906904"></a><p> +So, UNIX is lacking a common ground for printing on paper and +displaying on screen. Despite this unfavorable legacy for UNIX, basic printing is fairly easy: if you have PostScript printers at your disposal! The reason is: these devices have a built-in PostScript -language "interpreter", also called a <span class="emphasis"><em>Raster Image +language "interpreter", also called a <span class="emphasis"><em>Raster Image Processor</em></span> (RIP), (which makes them more expensive than other types of printers); throw PostScript towards them, and they will spit out your printed pages. Their RIP is doing all the hard work of converting the PostScript drawing commands into a bitmap picture as you see it on paper, in a resolution as done by your printer. This is no different to PostScript printing of a file from a Windows origin. -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Traditional Unix programs and printing systems -- while -using PostScript -- are largely not PPD-aware. PPDs are "PostScript -Printer Description" files. They enable you to specify and control all +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2906942"></a> +Traditional UNIX programs and printing systems -- while +using PostScript -- are largely not PPD-aware. PPDs are "PostScript +Printer Description" files. They enable you to specify and control all options a printer supports: duplexing, stapling, punching... Therefore -Unix users for a long time couldn't choose many of the supported +UNIX users for a long time couldn't choose many of the supported device and job options, unlike Windows or Apple users. But now there -is CUPS.... ;-) +is CUPS.... </p></div><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2937580"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.2. Printing to a Postscript Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/2small.png" alt="Printing to a Postscript Printer"></div></div><p> -</p><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small2"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.2. Printing to a Postscript Printer</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/2small.png" width="270" alt="Printing to a Postscript Printer"></div></div><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907006"></a><p> However, there are other types of printers out there. These don't know how to print PostScript. They use their own <span class="emphasis"><em>Page Description Language</em></span> (PDL, often proprietary). To print to them is much -more demanding. Since your Unix applications mostly produce +more demanding. Since your UNIX applications mostly produce PostScript, and since these devices don't understand PostScript, you need to convert the printfiles to a format suitable for your printer on the host, before you can send it away. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937630"></a>Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907029"></a>Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2907037"></a><p> Here is where <span class="emphasis"><em>Ghostscript</em></span> kicks in. Ghostscript is the traditional (and quite powerful) PostScript interpreter used on -Unix platforms. It is a RIP in software, capable to do a +UNIX platforms. It is a RIP in software, capable to do a <span class="emphasis"><em>lot</em></span> of file format conversions, for a very broad spectrum of hardware devices as well as software file formats. Ghostscript technology and drivers is what enables PostScript printing to non-PostScript hardware. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2937660"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.3. Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/3small.png" alt="Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small3"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.3. Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/3small.png" width="270" alt="Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers"></div></div><p> </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> -Use the "gs -h" command to check for all built-in "devices" of your +Use the "gs -h" command to check for all built-in "devices" of your Ghostscript version. If you specify e.g. a parameter of <i class="parameter"><tt>-sDEVICE=png256</tt></i> on your Ghostscript command line, you are asking Ghostscript to convert the input into a PNG -file. Naming a "device" on the commandline is the most important +file. Naming a "device" on the commandline is the most important single parameter to tell Ghostscript how exactly it should render the input. New Ghostscript versions are released at fairly regular intervals, now by artofcode LLC. They are initially put under the -"AFPL" license, but re-released under the GNU GPL as soon as the next +"AFPL" license, but re-released under the GNU GPL as soon as the next AFPL version appears. GNU Ghostscript is probably the version installed on most Samba systems. But it has got some -deficiencies. Therefore ESP Ghostscript was developed as an +deficiencies. <a class="indexterm" name="id2907085"></a>Therefore ESP Ghostscript was developed as an enhancement over GNU Ghostscript, with lots of bug-fixes, additional devices and improvements. It is jointly maintained by developers from CUPS, Gimp-Print, MandrakeSoft, SuSE, RedHat and Debian. It includes -the "cups" device (essential to print to non-PS printers from CUPS). -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937742"></a>PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +the "cups" device (essential to print to non-PS printers from CUPS). +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907154"></a>PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2907162"></a><p> While PostScript in essence is a <span class="emphasis"><em>Page Description Language</em></span> (PDL) to represent the page layout in a <span class="emphasis"><em>device independent</em></span> way, real world print jobs are @@ -8704,15 +8368,16 @@ user selections are somehow written (in the form of special PostScript, PJL, JCL or vendor-dependent commands) into the PostScript file created by the driver. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907224"></a> A PostScript file that was created to contain device-specific commands for achieving a certain print job output (e.g. duplexed, stapled and punched) on a specific target machine, may not print as expected, or may not be printable at all on other models; it also may not be fit for further processing by software (e.g. by a PDF distilling program). -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937813"></a>CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907241"></a>CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS can handle all spec-compliant PPDs as supplied by the manufacturers for their PostScript models. Even if a -Unix/Linux-illiterate vendor might not have mentioned our favorite +UNIX/Linux-illiterate vendor might not have mentioned our favorite OS in his manuals and brochures -- you can safely trust this: <span class="emphasis"><em>if you get hold of the Windows NT version of the PPD, you can use it unchanged in CUPS</em></span> and thus access the full @@ -8724,6 +8389,8 @@ immediately. CUPS in all versions after 1.1.19 has a much more strict internal PPD parsing and checking code enabled; in case of printing trouble this online resource should be one of your first pitstops. </p></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907289"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907297"></a> For real PostScript printers <span class="emphasis"><em>don't</em></span> use the <span class="emphasis"><em>Foomatic</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic</em></span> PPDs from Linuxprinting.org. With these devices the original @@ -8736,7 +8403,7 @@ your LAN has the PostScript driver installed, just use access the Windows directory where all printer driver files are stored. First look in the <tt class="filename">W32X86/2</tt> subdir for the PPD you are seeking. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937902"></a>CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907348"></a>CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS also uses specially crafted PPDs to handle non-PostScript printers. These PPDs are usually not available from the vendors (and no, you can't just take the PPD of a Postscript printer with the same @@ -8744,7 +8411,7 @@ model name and hope it works for the non-PostScript version too). To understand how these PPDs work for non-PS printers we first need to dive deeply into the CUPS filtering and file format conversion architecture. Stay tuned. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937925"></a>The CUPS Filtering Architecture</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2907370"></a>The CUPS Filtering Architecture</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The core of the CUPS filtering system is based on <span class="emphasis"><em>Ghostscript</em></span>. In addition to Ghostscript, CUPS uses some other filters of its own. You (or your OS vendor) may have @@ -8760,33 +8427,37 @@ given input data format. </p><p> If CUPS rasterizes a PostScript file <span class="emphasis"><em>natively</em></span> to a bitmap, this is done in 2 stages: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the first stage uses a Ghostscript device named "cups" +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the first stage uses a Ghostscript device named "cups" (this is since version 1.1.15) and produces a generic raster format -called "CUPS raster". -</p></li><li><p>the second stage uses a "raster driver" which converts +called "CUPS raster". +</p></li><li><p>the second stage uses a "raster driver" which converts the generic CUPS raster to a device specific raster.</p></li></ul></div><p> -Make sure your Ghostscript version has the "cups" device compiled in +Make sure your Ghostscript version has the "cups" device compiled in (check with <b class="command">gs -h | grep cups</b>). Otherwise you may encounter the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">Unable to convert file -0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. To have "cups" as a +0</tt> in your CUPS error_log file. To have "cups" as a device in your Ghostscript, you either need to <span class="emphasis"><em>patch GNU -Ghostscript</em></span> and re-compile or use <a href="http://www.cups.org/ghostscript.php" target="_top">ESP Ghostscript</a>. The +Ghostscript</em></span> and re-compile or use <a class="indexterm" name="id2907462"></a><a href="http://www.cups.org/ghostscript.php" target="_top">ESP Ghostscript</a>. The superior alternative is ESP Ghostscript: it supports not just CUPS, but 300 other devices too (while GNU Ghostscript supports only about 180). Because of this broad output device support, ESP Ghostscript is the first choice for non-CUPS spoolers too. It is now recommended by Linuxprinting.org for all spoolers. </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907490"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907498"></a> CUPS printers may be setup to use <span class="emphasis"><em>external</em></span> rendering paths. One of the most common ones is provided by the <span class="emphasis"><em>Foomatic/cupsomatic</em></span> concept, from <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/" target="_top">Linuxprinting.org</a>. This uses the classical Ghostscript approach, doing everything in one -step. It doesn't use the "cups" device, but one of the many +step. It doesn't use the "cups" device, but one of the many others. However, even for Foomatic/cupsomatic usage, best results and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907528"></a> broadest printer model support is provided by ESP Ghostscript (more about cupsomatic/Foomatic, particularly the new version called now <span class="emphasis"><em>foomatic-rip</em></span>, follows below). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938065"></a>MIME types and CUPS Filters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907545"></a>MIME types and CUPS Filters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2907557"></a> CUPS reads the file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> (and all other files carrying a <tt class="filename">*.types</tt> suffix in the same directory) upon startup. These files contain the MIME @@ -8795,10 +8466,10 @@ auto-typing routines. The rule syntax is explained in the man page for <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> and in the comments section of the <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file itself. A simple rule reads like this: +</p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2907602"></a> </p><pre class="screen"> - application/pdf pdf string(0,%PDF) - </pre><p> This means: if a filename has either a <tt class="filename">.pdf</tt> suffix, or if the magic @@ -8807,9 +8478,7 @@ beginning of the file itself (offset 0 from the start), then it is a PDF file (<span class="emphasis"><em>application/pdf</em></span>). Another rule is this: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/postscript ai eps ps string(0,%!) string(0,<04>%!) - </pre><p> Its meaning: if the filename has one of the suffixes <tt class="filename">.ai</tt>, <tt class="filename">.eps</tt>, @@ -8839,7 +8508,7 @@ CUPS can handle ASCII text, HP-GL, PDF, PostScript, DVI and a lot of image formats (GIF. PNG, TIFF, JPEG, Photo-CD, SUN-Raster, PNM, PBM, SGI-RGB and some more) and their associated MIME types with its filters. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938252"></a>MIME type Conversion Rules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907752"></a>MIME type Conversion Rules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2907760"></a><p> CUPS reads the file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt> (and all other files named with a <tt class="filename">*.convs</tt> suffix in the same directory) upon startup. These files contain @@ -8848,39 +8517,31 @@ conversion filter which can produce the output from the input type and virtual costs associated with this conversion. One example line reads like this: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/pdf application/postscript 33 pdftops - </pre><p> This means that the <span class="emphasis"><em>pdftops</em></span> filter will take <span class="emphasis"><em>application/pdf</em></span> as input and produce <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> as output, the virtual cost of this operation is 33 CUPS-$. The next filter is more expensive, costing 66 CUPS-$: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907822"></a><pre class="screen"> application/vnd.hp-HPGL application/postscript 66 hpgltops - </pre><p> This is the <span class="emphasis"><em>hpgltops</em></span>, which processes HP-GL plotter files to PostScript. -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907849"></a><pre class="screen"> application/octet-stream - </pre><p> Here are two more examples: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2907872"></a><pre class="screen"> application/x-shell application/postscript 33 texttops text/plain application/postscript 33 texttops - </pre><p> The last two examples name the <span class="emphasis"><em>texttops</em></span> filter -to work on "text/plain" as well as on "application/x-shell". (Hint: +to work on "text/plain" as well as on "application/x-shell". (Hint: this differentiation is needed for the syntax highlighting feature of -"texttops"). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938369"></a>Filter Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"texttops"). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2907903"></a>Filter Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2907910"></a><p> There are many more combinations named in mime.convs. However, you are not limited to use the ones pre-defined there. You can plug in any filter you like into the CUPS framework. It must meet, or must be made @@ -8890,24 +8551,24 @@ needs, and put in the right lines in <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> and <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt>, then it will work seamlessly inside CUPS! </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> -The mentioned "CUPS requirements" for filters are simple. Take +The mentioned "CUPS requirements" for filters are simple. Take filenames or <tt class="filename">stdin</tt> as input and write to <tt class="filename">stdout</tt>. They should take these 5 or 6 arguments: <span class="emphasis"><em>printer job user title copies options [filename]</em></span> </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The name of the printer queue (normally this is the name of the filter being run)</p></dd><dt><span class="term">job</span></dt><dd><p>The numeric job ID for the job being -printed</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the originating-user-name -attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the job-name attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The numeric value from the number-copies -attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>The job options</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Printer</span></dt><dd><p>(Optionally) The print request file (if missing, +printed</p></dd><dt><span class="term">user</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the originating-user-name +attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">title</span></dt><dd><p>The string from the job-name attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">copies</span></dt><dd><p>The numeric value from the number-copies +attribute</p></dd><dt><span class="term">options</span></dt><dd><p>The job options</p></dd><dt><span class="term">filename</span></dt><dd><p>(Optionally) The print request file (if missing, filters expected data fed through <tt class="filename">stdin</tt>). In most cases it is very easy to write a simple wrapper script around existing -filters to make them work with CUPS.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938539"></a>Prefilters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -As was said, PostScript is the central file format to any Unix based +filters to make them work with CUPS.</p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908080"></a>Prefilters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2908088"></a><p> +As was said, PostScript is the central file format to any UNIX based printing system. From PostScript, CUPS generates raster data to feed non-PostScript printers. </p><p> But what is happening if you send one of the supported non-PS formats -to print? Then CUPS runs "pre-filters" on these input formats to +to print? Then CUPS runs "pre-filters" on these input formats to generate PostScript first. There are pre-filters to create PS from ASCII text, PDF, DVI or HP-GL. The outcome of these filters is always of MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> (meaning that @@ -8919,8 +8580,8 @@ MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span> (<span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> application/postscript), meaning it has the print options already embedded into the file. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2938589"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.4. Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/4small.png" alt="Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938624"></a>pstops</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small4"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.4. Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/4small.png" width="270" alt="Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908183"></a>pstops</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>pstops</em></span>is the filter to convert <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> to <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span>. It was said @@ -8928,19 +8589,19 @@ above that this filter inserts all device-specific print options (commands to the printer to ask for the duplexing of output, or stapling an punching it, etc.) into the PostScript file. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2938654"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.5. Adding Device-specific Print Options</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/5small.png" alt="Adding Device-specific Print Options"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small5"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.5. Adding Device-specific Print Options</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/5small.png" width="270" alt="Adding Device-specific Print Options"></div></div><p> </p><p> This is not all: other tasks performed by it are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> selecting the range of pages to be printed (if you choose to -print only pages "3, 6, 8-11, 16, 19-21", or only the odd numbered +print only pages "3, 6, 8-11, 16, 19-21", or only the odd numbered ones) </p></li><li><p> putting 2 or more logical pages on one sheet of paper (the -so-called "number-up" function) +so-called "number-up" function) </p></li><li><p>counting the pages of the job to insert the accounting information into the <tt class="filename">/var/log/cups/page_log</tt> -</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938727"></a>pstoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908292"></a>pstoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>pstoraster</em></span> is at the core of the CUPS filtering system. It is responsible for the first stage of the rasterization process. Its input is of MIME type application/vnd.cups-postscript; @@ -8949,34 +8610,34 @@ yet meant to be printable. Its aim is to serve as a general purpose input format for more specialized <span class="emphasis"><em>raster drivers</em></span>, that are able to generate device-specific printer data. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2938756"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.6. Postscript to intermediate Raster format</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/6small.png" alt="Postscript to intermediate Raster format"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small6"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.6. Postscript to intermediate Raster format</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/6small.png" width="270" alt="Postscript to intermediate Raster format"></div></div><p> </p><p> CUPS raster is a generic raster format with powerful features. It is able to include per-page information, color profiles and more to be used by the following downstream raster drivers. Its MIME type is registered with IANA and its specification is of course completely open. It is designed to make it very easy and inexpensive for -manufacturers to develop Linux and Unix raster drivers for their +manufacturers to develop Linux and UNIX raster drivers for their printer models, should they choose to do so. CUPS always takes care for the first stage of rasterization so these vendors don't need to care about Ghostscript complications (in fact, there is currently more than one vendor financing the development of CUPS raster drivers). </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2938809"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.7. CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/7small.png" alt="CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small7"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.7. CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/7small.png" width="270" alt="CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript"></div></div><p> </p><p> CUPS versions before version 1.1.15 were shipping a binary (or source -code) standalone filter, named "pstoraster". pstoraster was derived +code) standalone filter, named "pstoraster". pstoraster was derived from GNU Ghostscript 5.50, and could be installed besides and in addition to any GNU or AFPL Ghostscript package without conflicting. </p><p> From version 1.1.15, this has changed. The functions for this has been integrated back into Ghostscript (now based on GNU Ghostscript version -7.05). The "pstoraster" filter is now a simple shell script calling +7.05). The "pstoraster" filter is now a simple shell script calling <b class="command">gs</b> with the <b class="command">-sDEVICE=cups</b> parameter. If your Ghostscript doesn't show a success on asking for <b class="command">gs -h |grep cups</b>, you might not be able to print. Update your Ghostscript then! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938883"></a>imagetops and imagetoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908476"></a>imagetops and imagetoraster</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Above in the section about prefilters, we mentioned the prefilter that generates PostScript from image formats. The imagetoraster filter is used to convert directly from image to raster, without the @@ -8984,13 +8645,13 @@ intermediate PostScript stage. It is used more often than the above mentioned prefilters. Here is a summarizing flowchart of image file filtering: </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2938904"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.8. Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/8small.png" alt="Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938940"></a>rasterto [printers specific]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small8"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.8. Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/8small.png" width="270" alt="Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908539"></a>rasterto [printers specific]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS ships with quite some different raster drivers processing CUPS raster. On my system I find in /usr/lib/cups/filter/ these: -<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoalps, rastertobj, rastertoepson, rastertoescp, -rastertopcl, rastertoturboprint, rastertoapdk, rastertodymo, -rastertoescp, rastertohp</tt></i> and +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoalps</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertobj</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoepson</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoescp</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertopcl</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoturboprint</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoapdk</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertodymo</tt></i>, +<i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoescp</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertohp</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoprinter</tt></i>. Don't worry if you have less than this; some of these are installed by commercial add-ons to CUPS (like <i class="parameter"><tt>rastertoturboprint</tt></i>), others (like @@ -8998,13 +8659,13 @@ than this; some of these are installed by commercial add-ons to CUPS development projects (such as Gimp-Print) wanting to cooperate as closely as possible with CUPS. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2938988"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.9. Raster to Printer Specific formats</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/9small.png" alt="Raster to Printer Specific formats"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939024"></a>CUPS Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The last part of any CUPS filtering chain is a "backend". Backends + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small9"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.9. Raster to Printer Specific formats</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/9small.png" width="270" alt="Raster to Printer Specific formats"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908691"></a>CUPS Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The last part of any CUPS filtering chain is a "backend". Backends are special programs that send the print-ready file to the final device. There is a separate backend program for any transfer -"protocol" of sending printjobs over the network, or for every local -interface. Every CUPS printqueue needs to have a CUPS "device-URI" +"protocol" of sending printjobs over the network, or for every local +interface. Every CUPS printqueue needs to have a CUPS "device-URI" associated with it. The device URI is the way to encode the backend used to send the job to its destination. Network device-URIs are using two slashes in their syntax, local device URIs only one, as you can @@ -9031,8 +8692,8 @@ This backend sends printfiles to LPR/LPD connected network printers. An example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: <tt class="filename">lpd://remote_host_name/remote_queue_name</tt> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">AppSocket/HP JetDirect</span></dt><dd><p> -This backend sends printfiles to AppSocket (a.k.a. "HP -JetDirect") connected network printers. An example for the CUPS +This backend sends printfiles to AppSocket (a.k.a. "HP +JetDirect") connected network printers. An example for the CUPS device-URI to use is: <tt class="filename">socket://10.11.12.13:9100</tt> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ipp</span></dt><dd><p> @@ -9054,7 +8715,7 @@ This backend sends printfiles to printers shared by a Windows host. An example for CUPS device-URIs to use are: <tt class="filename">smb://workgroup/server/printersharename</tt> Or -<tt class="filename">Smb://server/printersharename</tt> +<tt class="filename">smb://server/printersharename</tt> or <tt class="filename">smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printersharename</tt> or @@ -9067,11 +8728,11 @@ root user create it: <b class="command">ln -s `which smbspool` </p></dd></dl></div><p> It is easy to write your own backends as Shell or Perl scripts, if you need any modification or extension to the CUPS print system. One -reason could be that you want to create "special" printers which send -the printjobs as email (through a "mailto:/" backend), convert them to -PDF (through a "pdfgen:/" backend) or dump them to "/dev/null" (In +reason could be that you want to create "special" printers which send +the printjobs as email (through a "mailto:/" backend), convert them to +PDF (through a "pdfgen:/" backend) or dump them to "/dev/null" (In fact I have the system-wide default printer set up to be connected to -a "devnull:/" backend: there are just too many people sending jobs +a "devnull:/" backend: there are just too many people sending jobs without specifying a printer, or scripts and programs which don't name a printer. The system-wide default deletes the job and sends a polite mail back to the $USER asking him to always specify a correct @@ -9080,29 +8741,25 @@ printername). Not all of the mentioned backends may be present on your system or usable (depending on your hardware configuration). One test for all available CUPS backends is provided by the <span class="emphasis"><em>lpinfo</em></span> -utility. Used with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-v</tt></i> parameter, it lists +utility. Used with the <tt class="option">-v</tt> parameter, it lists all available backends: </p><pre class="screen"> - - lpinfo -v - -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939336"></a>cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -"cupsomatic" filters may be the most widely used on CUPS +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpinfo -v</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909039"></a>cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2909047"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2909055"></a><p> +"cupsomatic" filters may be the most widely used on CUPS installations. You must be clear about the fact that these were not -developed by the CUPS people. They are a "Third Party" add-on to +developed by the CUPS people. They are a "Third Party" add-on to CUPS. They utilize the traditional Ghostscript devices to render jobs for CUPS. When troubleshooting, you should know about the difference. Here the whole rendering process is done in one stage, -inside Ghostscript, using an appropriate "device" for the target -printer. cupsomatic uses PPDs which are generated from the "Foomatic" +inside Ghostscript, using an appropriate "device" for the target +printer. cupsomatic uses PPDs which are generated from the "Foomatic" Printer & Driver Database at Linuxprinting.org. </p><p> You can recognize these PPDs from the line calling the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic</em></span> filter: </p><pre class="screen"> - - *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" - + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" </pre><p> This line you may find amongst the first 40 or so lines of the PPD file. If you have such a PPD installed, the printer shows up in the @@ -9111,18 +8768,18 @@ the driver description. cupsomatic is a Perl script that runs Ghostscript, with all the complicated commandline options auto-constructed from the selected PPD and commandline options give to the printjob. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2909122"></a><p> However, cupsomatic is now deprecated. Its PPDs (especially the first generation of them, still in heavy use out there) are not meeting the Adobe specifications. You might also suffer difficulties when you try -to download them with "Point'n'Print" to Windows clients. A better, +to download them with "Point'n'Print" to Windows clients. A better, and more powerful successor is now in a very stable Beta-version available: it is called <span class="emphasis"><em>foomatic-rip</em></span>. To use foomatic-rip as a filter with CUPS, you need the new-type PPDs. These have a similar, but different line: </p><pre class="screen"> - *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 foomatic-rip" + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 foomatic-rip" </pre><p> The PPD generating engine at Linuxprinting.org has been revamped. @@ -9136,11 +8793,11 @@ print-options from page to page, in the middle of a job. And the best thing is: the new foomatic-rip now works seamlessly with all legacy spoolers too (like LPRng, BSD-LPD, PDQ, PPR etc.), providing for them access to use PPDs for their printing! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939448"></a>The Complete Picture</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909176"></a>The Complete Picture</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you want to see an overview over all the filters and how they relate to each other, the complete picture of the puzzle is at the end of this document. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939464"></a><tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909191"></a><tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> CUPS auto-constructs all possible filtering chain paths for any given MIME type, and every printer installed. But how does it decide in favor or against a specific alternative? (There may often be cases, @@ -9148,39 +8805,37 @@ where there is a choice of two or more possible filtering chains for the same target printer). Simple: you may have noticed the figures in the 3rd column of the mime.convs file. They represent virtual costs assigned to this filter. Every possible filtering chain will sum up to -a total "filter cost". CUPS decides for the most "inexpensive" route. +a total "filter cost". CUPS decides for the most "inexpensive" route. </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> The setting of <i class="parameter"><tt>FilterLimit 1000</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> will not allow more filters to run concurrently than will consume a total of 1000 virtual filter cost. This is a very efficient way to limit the load of any CUPS -server by setting an appropriate "FilterLimit" value. A FilterLimit of +server by setting an appropriate "FilterLimit" value. A FilterLimit of 200 allows roughly 1 job at a time, while a FilterLimit of 1000 allows approximately 5 jobs maximum at a time. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939517"></a>"Raw" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -You can tell CUPS to print (nearly) any file "raw". "Raw" means it -will not be filtered. CUPS will send the file to the printer "as is" +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909245"></a>"Raw" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +You can tell CUPS to print (nearly) any file "raw". "Raw" means it +will not be filtered. CUPS will send the file to the printer "as is" without bothering if the printer is able to digest it. Users need to take care themselves that they send sensible data formats only. Raw -printing can happen on any queue if the "-o raw" option is specified +printing can happen on any queue if the "-o raw" option is specified on the command line. You can also set up raw-only queues by simply not associating any PPD with it. This command: </p><pre class="screen"> - - lpadmin -P rawprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -E - +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -P rawprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -E</tt></b> </pre><p> -sets up a queue named "rawprinter", connected via the "socket" -protocol (a.k.a. "HP JetDirect") to the device at IP address +sets up a queue named "rawprinter", connected via the "socket" +protocol (a.k.a. "HP JetDirect") to the device at IP address 11.12.1.3.14, using port 9100. (If you had added a PPD with <b class="command">-P /path/to/PPD</b> to this command line, you would -have installed a "normal" printqueue. +have installed a "normal" printqueue. </p><p> -CUPS will automatically treat each job sent to a queue as a "raw" one, +CUPS will automatically treat each job sent to a queue as a "raw" one, if it can't find a PPD associated with the queue. However, CUPS will only send known MIME types (as defined in its own mime.types file) and refuse others. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939571"></a>"application/octet-stream" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909312"></a>"application/octet-stream" printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Any MIME type with no rule in the <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> file is regarded as unknown or <span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span> and will not be @@ -9189,56 +8844,50 @@ you will probably have experienced the fact that printjobs originating from Windows clients were not printed. You may have found an error message in your CUPS logs like: </p><pre class="screen"> - Unable to convert file 0 to printable format for job - </pre><p> -To enable the printing of "application/octet-stream" files, edit +To enable the printing of "application/octet-stream" files, edit these two files: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt></p></li></ul></div><p> Both contain entries (at the end of the respective files) which must be uncommented to allow RAW mode operation for application/octet-stream. In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> make sure this line is present: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2909395"></a><pre class="screen"> application/octet-stream - </pre><p> This line (with no specific auto-typing rule set) makes all files not otherwise auto-typed a member of application/octet-stream. In <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt>, have this line: </p><pre class="screen"> - application/octet-stream application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - -</pre><p> +</pre><a class="indexterm" name="id2909435"></a><p> This line tells CUPS to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>Null Filter</em></span> -(denoted as "-", doing... nothing at all) on +(denoted as "-", doing... nothing at all) on <span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>, and tag the result as <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-raw</em></span>. This last one is always a green light to the CUPS scheduler to now hand the file over -to the "backend" connecting to the printer and sending it over. +to the "backend" connecting to the printer and sending it over. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Editing the <tt class="filename">mime.convs</tt> and the <tt class="filename">mime.types</tt> file does not -<span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> "raw" printing, it only +<span class="emphasis"><em>enforce</em></span> "raw" printing, it only <span class="emphasis"><em>allows</em></span> it. </p></div><p><b>Background. </b> CUPS being a more security-aware printing system than traditional ones does not by default allow one to send deliberate (possibly binary) data to printing devices. (This could be easily abused to launch a Denial of Service attack on your printer(s), causing at least the loss -of a lot of paper and ink...) "Unknown" data are regarded by CUPS +of a lot of paper and ink...) "Unknown" data are regarded by CUPS as <span class="emphasis"><em>MIME type</em></span> <span class="emphasis"><em>application/octet-stream</em></span>. While you -<span class="emphasis"><em>can</em></span> send data "raw", the MIME type for these must +<span class="emphasis"><em>can</em></span> send data "raw", the MIME type for these must be one that is known to CUPS and an allowed one. The file -<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> defines the "rules" how CUPS +<tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> defines the "rules" how CUPS recognizes MIME types. The file <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.convs</tt> decides which file conversion filter(s) may be applied to which MIME types. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939786"></a>PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909544"></a>PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2909552"></a><p> Originally PPDs were meant to be used for PostScript printers only. Here, they help to send device-specific commands and settings to the RIP which processes the jobfile. CUPS has extended this @@ -9251,18 +8900,16 @@ printers the Ghostscript RIP runs on the host computer. </p><p> PPDs for a non-PS printer have a few lines that are unique to CUPS. The most important one looks similar to this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2909582"></a><pre class="screen"> *cupsFilter: application/vnd.cups-raster 66 rastertoprinter - </pre><p> It is the last piece in the CUPS filtering puzzle. This line tells the -CUPS daemon to use as a last filter "rastertoprinter". This filter -should be served as input an "application/vnd.cups-raster" MIME type +CUPS daemon to use as a last filter "rastertoprinter". This filter +should be served as input an "application/vnd.cups-raster" MIME type file. Therefore CUPS should auto-construct a filtering chain, which delivers as its last output the specified MIME type. This is then -taken as input to the specified "rastertoprinter" filter. After this -the last filter has done its work ("rastertoprinter" is a Gimp-Print +taken as input to the specified "rastertoprinter" filter. After this +the last filter has done its work ("rastertoprinter" is a Gimp-Print filter), the file should go to the backend, which sends it to the output device. </p><p> @@ -9270,34 +8917,22 @@ CUPS by default ships only a few generic PPDs, but they are good for several hundred printer models. You may not be able to control different paper trays, or you may get larger margins than your specific model supports): -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">deskjet.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>older HP inkjet printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">deskjet2.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>newer HP inkjet printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dymo.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>label printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">epson9.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">epson24.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">okidata9.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Okidata 9pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">okidat24.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>Okidata 24pin impact printers and compatible -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stcolor.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>older Epson Stylus Color printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stcolor2.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>newer Epson Stylus Color printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stphoto.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>older Epson Stylus Photo printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">stphoto2.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>newer Epson Stylus Photo printers -</p></dd><dt><span class="term">laserjet.ppd</span></dt><dd><p>all PCL printers. Further below is a discussion -of several other driver/PPD-packages suitable fur use with CUPS. -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940015"></a>Difference between <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> and -<span class="emphasis"><em>native CUPS</em></span> printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2909623"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 19.1. PPD's shipped with CUPS</b></p><table summary="PPD's shipped with CUPS" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">PPD file</th><th align="justify">Printer type</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">deskjet.ppd</td><td align="justify">older HP inkjet printers and compatible</td></tr><tr><td align="left">deskjet2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer HP inkjet printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">dymo.ppd</td><td align="justify">label printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">epson9.ppd</td><td align="justify">Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">epson24.ppd</td><td align="justify">Epson 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">okidata9.ppd</td><td align="justify">Okidata 9pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">okidat24.ppd</td><td align="justify">Okidata 24pin impact printers and compatible </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stcolor.ppd</td><td align="justify">older Epson Stylus Color printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stcolor2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer Epson Stylus Color printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stphoto.ppd</td><td align="justify">older Epson Stylus Photo printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">stphoto2.ppd</td><td align="justify">newer Epson Stylus Photo printers </td></tr><tr><td align="left">laserjet.ppd</td><td align="justify">all PCL printers. Further below is a discussion of several other driver/PPD-packages suitable for use with CUPS. </td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909807"></a>Difference between <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> and +<span class="emphasis"><em>native CUPS</em></span> printing</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2909825"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2909833"></a><p> Native CUPS rasterization works in two steps. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> -First is the "pstoraster" step. It uses the special "cups" +First is the "pstoraster" step. It uses the special "cups" +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909856"></a> device from ESP Ghostscript 7.05.x as its tool </p></li><li><p> -Second comes the "rasterdriver" step. It uses various +Second comes the "rasterdriver" step. It uses various device-specific filters; there are several vendors who provide good quality filters for this step, some are Free Software, some are Shareware/Non-Free, some are proprietary.</p></li></ul></div><p> Often this produces better quality (and has several more advantages) than other methods. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2940065"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.10. cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/10small.png" alt="cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small10"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.10. cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/10small.png" width="270" alt="cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS"></div></div><p> </p><p> One other method is the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic/foomatic-rip</em></span> way. Note that cupsomatic is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> made by the CUPS @@ -9311,6 +8946,8 @@ other (non-CUPS) spoolers. An upgrade to foomatic-rip is strongly advised, especially if you are upgrading to a recent version of CUPS too. </p><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909965"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909974"></a> Both the cupsomatic (old) and the foomatic-rip (new) methods from Linuxprinting.org use the traditional Ghostscript print file processing, doing everything in a single step. It therefore relies on @@ -9323,22 +8960,22 @@ Of course, you can use both methods side by side on one system (and even for one printer, if you set up different queues), and find out which works best for you. </p><p> -cupsomatic "kidnaps" the printfile after the +cupsomatic "kidnaps" the printfile after the <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span> stage and deviates it through the CUPS-external, system wide Ghostscript -installation: Therefore the printfile bypasses the "pstoraster" filter +installation: Therefore the printfile bypasses the "pstoraster" filter (and thus also bypasses the CUPS-raster-drivers -"rastertosomething"). After Ghostscript finished its rasterization, +"rastertosomething"). After Ghostscript finished its rasterization, cupsomatic hands the rendered file directly to the CUPS backend. The flowchart above illustrates the difference between native CUPS rendering and the Foomatic/cupsomatic method. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940170"></a>Examples for filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910018"></a>Examples for filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here are a few examples of commonly occurring filtering chains to illustrate the workings of CUPS. </p><p> Assume you want to print a PDF file to a HP JetDirect-connected PostScript printer, but you want to print the pages 3-5, 7, 11-13 -only, and you want to print them "2-up" and "duplex": +only, and you want to print them "2-up" and "duplex": </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>your print options (page selection as required, 2-up, duplex) are passed to CUPS on the commandline;</p></li><li><p>the (complete) PDF file is sent to CUPS and autotyped as <span class="emphasis"><em>application/pdf</em></span>;</p></li><li><p>the file therefore first must pass the @@ -9346,16 +8983,14 @@ duplex) are passed to CUPS on the commandline;</p></li><li><p>the (complete) PDF MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> (a preview here would still show all pages of the original PDF);</p></li><li><p>the file then passes the <span class="emphasis"><em>pstops</em></span> filter which applies the commandline options: it selects the pages -2-5, 7 and 11-13, creates and imposed layout "2 pages on 1 sheet" and -inserts the correct "duplex" command (as is defined in the printer's +2-5, 7 and 11-13, creates and imposed layout "2 pages on 1 sheet" and +inserts the correct "duplex" command (as is defined in the printer's PPD) into the new PostScript file; the file now is of PostScript MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/vnd.cups-postscript</em></span>;</p></li><li><p>the file goes to the <span class="emphasis"><em>socket</em></span> backend, which transfers the job to the printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> -The resulting filter chain therefore is: -</p><pre class="screen"> -pdftops --> pstops --> socket -</pre><p> + The resulting filter chain therefore is as drawn in <a href="#pdftosocket" title="Figure 19.11. PDF to socket chain">the image below</a>. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="pdftosocket"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.11. PDF to socket chain</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/pdftosocket.png" width="270" alt="PDF to socket chain"></div></div><p> Assume your want to print the same filter to an USB-connected Epson Stylus Photo printer, installed with the CUPS <tt class="filename">stphoto2.ppd</tt>. The first few filtering stages @@ -9365,10 +9000,10 @@ duplex) are passed to CUPS on the commandline;</p></li><li><p>the (complete) PDF <span class="emphasis"><em>application/pdf</em></span>;</p></li><li><p>the file therefore first must pass the <span class="emphasis"><em>pdftops</em></span> pre-filter, which produces PostScript MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span> (a preview here -would still show all pages of the original PDF);</p></li><li><p>the file then passes the "pstops" filter which applies +would still show all pages of the original PDF);</p></li><li><p>the file then passes the "pstops" filter which applies the commandline options: it selects the pages 2-5, 7 and 11-13, -creates and imposed layout "2 pages on 1 sheet" and inserts the -correct "duplex" command... (OOoops -- this printer and his PPD +creates and imposed layout "2 pages on 1 sheet" and inserts the +correct "duplex" command... (OOoops -- this printer and his PPD don't support duplex printing at all -- this option will be ignored then) into the new PostScript file; the file now is of PostScript MIME type @@ -9379,46 +9014,44 @@ does its work (as is indicated in the printer's PPD), creating the printer-specific raster data and embedding any user-selected print-options into the print data stream;</p></li><li><p>the file goes to the <span class="emphasis"><em>usb</em></span> backend, which transfers the job to the printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> -The resulting filter chain therefore is: -</p><pre class="screen"> -pdftops --> pstops --> pstoraster --> rastertoepson --> usb -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940401"></a>Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The resulting filter chain therefore is as drawn in <a href="#pdftoepsonusb" title="Figure 19.12. PDF to USB chain">the image below</a>. +</p><div class="figure"><a name="pdftoepsonusb"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.12. PDF to USB chain</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/pdftoepsonusb.png" width="270" alt="PDF to USB chain"></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910331"></a>Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> On the internet you can find now many thousand CUPS-PPD files (with their companion filters), in many national languages, supporting more than 1000 non-PostScript models. -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/" target="_top">ESP -PrintPro (http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/)</a> (commercial, +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2910347"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2910357"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="http://wwwl.easysw.com/printpro/" target="_top">ESP +PrintPro</a> (commercial, non-Free) is packaged with more than 3000 PPDs, ready for -successful use "out of the box" on Linux, Mac OS X, IBM-AIX, -HP-UX, Sun-Solaris, SGI-IRIX, Compaq Tru64, Digital Unix and some +successful use "out of the box" on Linux, Mac OS X, IBM-AIX, +HP-UX, Sun-Solaris, SGI-IRIX, Compaq Tru64, Digital UNIX and some more commercial Unices (it is written by the CUPS developers themselves and its sales help finance the further development of CUPS, as they feed their creators).</p></li><li><p>the <a href="http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">Gimp-Print-Project -(http://gimp-print.sourceforge.net/)</a> (GPL, Free Software) +</a> (GPL, Free Software) provides around 140 PPDs (supporting nearly 400 printers, many driven to photo quality output), to be used alongside the Gimp-Print CUPS filters;</p></li><li><p><a href="http://www.turboprint.com/" target="_top">TurboPrint -(http://www.turboprint.com/)</a> (Shareware, non-Free) supports +</a> (Shareware, non-Free) supports roughly the same amount of printers in excellent quality;</p></li><li><p><a href="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/" target="_top">OMNI -(http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/)</a> +</a> (LPGL, Free) is a package made by IBM, now containing support for more than 400 printers, stemming from the inheritance of IBM OS/2 Know-How ported over to Linux (CUPS support is in a Beta-stage at present);</p></li><li><p><a href="http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">HPIJS -(http://hpinkjet.sourceforge.net/)</a> (BSD-style licenses, Free) +</a> (BSD-style licenses, Free) supports around 150 of HP's own printers and is also providing excellent print quality now (currently available only via the Foomatic path);</p></li><li><p><a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/" target="_top">Foomatic/cupsomatic -(http://www.linuxprinting.org/)</a> (LPGL, Free) from +</a> (LPGL, Free) from Linuxprinting.org are providing PPDs for practically every Ghostscript filter known to the world (including Omni, Gimp-Print and HPIJS).</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The cupsomatic/Foomatic trick from Linuxprinting.org works differently from the other drivers. This is explained elsewhere in this document. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940530"></a>Printing with Interface Scripts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -CUPS also supports the usage of "interface scripts" as known from +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910470"></a>Printing with Interface Scripts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +CUPS also supports the usage of "interface scripts" as known from System V AT&T printing systems. These are often used for PCL printers, from applications that generate PCL print jobs. Interface scripts are specific to printer models. They have a similar role as @@ -9430,61 +9063,60 @@ realm. On HP-UX platforms they are more often used. You can use any working interface script on CUPS too. Just install the printer with the <b class="command">-i</b> option: </p><pre class="screen"> - - lpadmin -p pclprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 -i /path/to/interface-script - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p pclprinter -v socket://11.12.13.14:9100 \ + -i /path/to/interface-script</tt></b> </pre><p> -Interface scripts might be the "unknown animal" to many. However, +Interface scripts might be the "unknown animal" to many. However, with CUPS they provide the most easy way to plug in your own custom-written filtering script or program into one specific print queue (some information about the traditional usage of interface scripts is to be found at <a href="http://playground.sun.com/printing/documentation/interface.html" target="_top">http://playground.sun.com/printing/documentation/interface.html</a>). -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940605"></a>Network printing (purely Windows)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910560"></a>Network printing (purely Windows)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Network printing covers a lot of ground. To understand what exactly goes on with Samba when it is printing on behalf of its Windows -clients, let's first look at a "purely Windows" setup: Windows clients +clients, let's first look at a "purely Windows" setup: Windows clients with a Windows NT print server. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940620"></a>From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910577"></a>From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Windows clients printing to an NT-based print server have two options. They may -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>execute the driver locally and render the GDI output +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2910590"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2910598"></a><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>execute the driver locally and render the GDI output (EMF) into the printer specific format on their own, or</p></li><li><p>send the GDI output (EMF) to the server, where the driver is executed to render the printer specific output.</p></li></ul></div><p> Both print paths are shown in the flowcharts below. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940659"></a>Driver Execution on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In the first case the print server must spool the file as "raw", +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910632"></a>Driver Execution on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In the first case the print server must spool the file as "raw", meaning it shouldn't touch the jobfile and try to convert it in any -way. This is what traditional Unix-based print server can do too; and +way. This is what traditional UNIX-based print server can do too; and at a better performance and more reliably than NT print server. This is what most Samba administrators probably are familiar with. One -advantage of this setup is that this "spooling-only" print server may -be used even if no driver(s) for Unix are available it is sufficient +advantage of this setup is that this "spooling-only" print server may +be used even if no driver(s) for UNIX are available it is sufficient to have the Windows client drivers available and installed on the clients. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2940695"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.11. Print Driver execution on the Client</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/11small.png" alt="Print Driver execution on the Client"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940731"></a>Driver Execution on the Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small11"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.13. Print Driver execution on the Client</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/11small.png" width="270" alt="Print Driver execution on the Client"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910701"></a>Driver Execution on the Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2910707"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2910715"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2910724"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2910732"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2910740"></a><p> The other path executes the printer driver on the server. The clients transfers print files in EMF format to the server. The server uses the PostScript, PCL, ESC/P or other driver to convert the EMF file into -the printer-specific language. It is not possible for Unix to do the +the printer-specific language. It is not possible for UNIX to do the same. Currently there is no program or method to convert a Windows -client's GDI output on a Unix server into something a printer could +client's GDI output on a UNIX server into something a printer could understand. </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2940753"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.12. Print Driver execution on the Server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/12small.png" alt="Print Driver execution on the Server"></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small12"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.14. Print Driver execution on the Server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/12small.png" width="270" alt="Print Driver execution on the Server"></div></div><p> </p><p> However, there is something similar possible with CUPS. Read on... -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940794"></a>Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910813"></a>Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print Servers)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since UNIX print servers <span class="emphasis"><em>cannot</em></span> execute the Win32 program code on their platform, the picture is somewhat different. However, this doesn't limit your options all that much. In the contrary, you may have a way here to implement printing features which are not possible otherwise. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940814"></a>From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910833"></a>From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here is a simple recipe showing how you can take advantage of CUPS powerful features for the benefit of your Windows network printing clients: @@ -9493,15 +9125,14 @@ server.</p></li><li><p>Let the CUPS server render the PostScript into device specific raster format.</p></li></ul></div><p> This requires the clients to use a PostScript driver (even if the printer is a non-PostScript model. It also requires that you have a -"driver" on the CUPS server. +"driver" on the CUPS server. </p><p> Firstly, to enable CUPS based printing through Samba the -following options should be set in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file [globals] +following options should be set in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file [global] section: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = CUPS</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = CUPS</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2910891"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups</p></li><li><p><a class="indexterm" name="id2910909"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups</p></li></ul></div><p> When these parameters are specified, all manually set print directives -(like <i class="parameter"><tt>print command =...</tt></i>, or <i class="parameter"><tt>lppause -command =...</tt></i>) in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> (as well as +(like <a class="indexterm" name="id2910929"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, or <a class="indexterm" name="id2910943"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>) in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> (as well as in samba itself) will be ignored. Instead, Samba will directly interface with CUPS through it's application program interface (API) - as long as Samba has been compiled with CUPS library (libcups) @@ -9510,12 +9141,12 @@ other print commands are set up, then printing will use the <span class="emphasis"><em>System V</em></span> AT&T command set, with the -oraw option automatically passing through (if you want your own defined print commands to work with a Samba that has CUPS support compiled in, -simply use <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv</tt></i>). +simply use <a class="indexterm" name="id2910981"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv). </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2940943"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.13. Printing via CUPS/samba server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/13small.png" alt="Printing via CUPS/samba server"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940978"></a>Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="figure"><a name="small13"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.15. Printing via CUPS/samba server</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/13small.png" width="270" alt="Printing via CUPS/samba server"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911043"></a>Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> use its own spool directory (it is set -by a line similar to <i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i>, +by a line similar to <a class="indexterm" name="id2911058"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba, in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>[printername]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). Samba receives the job in its own @@ -9525,14 +9156,14 @@ directive, in a line that defaults to <i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/cups</tt></i>). CUPS checks the access rights of its spool dir and resets it to healthy values with every re-start. We have seen quite some people who had used a common spooling space for Samba -and CUPS, and were struggling for weeks with this "problem". +and CUPS, and were struggling for weeks with this "problem". </p><p> A Windows user authenticates only to Samba (by whatever means is configured). If Samba runs on the same host as CUPS, you only need to -allow "localhost" to print. If they run on different machines, you +allow "localhost" to print. If they run on different machines, you need to make sure the Samba host gets access to printing on CUPS. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941054"></a>Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911125"></a>Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911135"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2911143"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2911151"></a><p> PPDs can control all print device options. They are usually provided by the manufacturer; if you own a PostScript printer, that is. PPD files (PostScript Printer Descriptions) are always a component of @@ -9540,7 +9171,7 @@ PostScript printer drivers on MS Windows or Apple Mac OS systems. They are ASCII files containing user-selectable print options, mapped to appropriate PostScript, PCL or PJL commands for the target printer. Printer driver GUI dialogs translate these options -"on-the-fly" into buttons and drop-down lists for the user to select. +"on-the-fly" into buttons and drop-down lists for the user to select. </p><p> CUPS can load, without any conversions, the PPD file from any Windows (NT is recommended) PostScript driver and handle the options. There is @@ -9551,8 +9182,8 @@ or see if you have lphelp on your system). There are also some different GUI frontends on Linux/UNIX, which can present PPD options to users. PPD options are normally meant to be evaluated by the PostScript RIP on the real PostScript printer. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941110"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -CUPS doesn't limit itself to "real" PostScript printers in its usage +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911206"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911214"></a><p> +CUPS doesn't limit itself to "real" PostScript printers in its usage of PPDs. The CUPS developers have extended the scope of the PPD concept, to also describe available device and driver options for non-PostScript printers through CUPS-PPDs. @@ -9568,10 +9199,10 @@ the supplied PostScript. Thus CUPS lets all its printers appear as PostScript devices to its clients, because it can act as a PostScript RIP for those printers, processing the received PostScript code into a proper raster print format. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941150"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911255"></a>PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911263"></a><p> CUPS-PPDs can also be used on Windows-Clients, on top of a -"core" PostScript driver (now recommended is the "CUPS PostScript -Driver for WindowsNT/2K/XP"; you can also use the Adobe one, with +"core" PostScript driver (now recommended is the "CUPS PostScript +Driver for WindowsNT/2K/XP"; you can also use the Adobe one, with limitations). This feature enables CUPS to do a few tricks no other spooler can do: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>act as a networked PostScript RIP (Raster Image @@ -9579,35 +9210,35 @@ Processor), handling printfiles from all client platforms in a uniform way;</p></li><li><p>act as a central accounting and billing server, since all files are passed through the pstops filter and are therefore logged in the CUPS <tt class="filename">page_log</tt> file. -<span class="emphasis"><em>NOTE:</em></span> this can not happen with "raw" print jobs, +<span class="emphasis"><em>NOTE:</em></span> this can not happen with "raw" print jobs, which always remain unfiltered per definition;</p></li><li><p>enable clients to consolidate on a single PostScript driver, even for many different target printers.</p></li></ul></div><p> Using CUPS PPDs on Windows clients enables these to control all print job settings just as a UNIX client can do too. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941216"></a>Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911328"></a>Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This setup may be of special interest to people experiencing major problems in WTS environments. WTS need often a multitude of non-PostScript drivers installed to run their clients' variety of different printer models. This often imposes the price of much increased instability. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941233"></a>Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911345"></a>Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many Problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The reason is that in Win NT printer drivers run in "Kernel -Mode", this introduces a high risk for the stability of the system +The reason is that in Win NT printer drivers run in "Kernel +Mode", this introduces a high risk for the stability of the system if the driver is not really stable and well-tested. And there are a lot of bad drivers out there! Especially notorious is the example of the PCL printer driver that had an additional sound module running, to notify users via soundcard of their finished jobs. Do I -need to say that this one was also reliably causing "Blue Screens -of Death" on a regular basis? +need to say that this one was also reliably causing "Blue Screens +of Death" on a regular basis? </p><p> PostScript drivers generally are very well tested. They are not known to cause any problems, even though they run in Kernel Mode too. This might be because there have so far only been 2 different PostScript -drivers the ones from Adobe and the one from Microsoft. Both are +drivers: the ones from Adobe and the one from Microsoft. Both are very well tested and are as stable as you ever can imagine on Windows. The CUPS driver is derived from the Microsoft one. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941268"></a>Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911379"></a>Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In many cases, in an attempt to work around this problem, site administrators have resorted to restrict the allowed drivers installed on their WTS to one generic PCL- and one PostScript driver. This @@ -9615,7 +9246,7 @@ however restricts the clients in the amount of printer options available for them; often they can't get out more than simplex prints from one standard paper tray, while their devices could do much better, if driven by a different driver! ) -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941289"></a>CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911400"></a>CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911410"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2911418"></a><p> Using a PostScript driver, enabled with a CUPS-PPD, seems to be a very elegant way to overcome all these shortcomings. There are, depending on the version of Windows OS you use, up to 3 different PostScript @@ -9625,14 +9256,14 @@ used with many different PPDs). The clients will be able to (again) chose paper trays, duplex printing and other settings. However, there is a certain price for this too: a CUPS server acting as a PostScript RIP for its clients requires more CPU and RAM than when just acting as -a "raw spooling" device. Plus, this setup is not yet widely tested, +a "raw spooling" device. Plus, this setup is not yet widely tested, although the first feedbacks look very promising. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941316"></a>PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911445"></a>PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911454"></a><p> More recent printer drivers on W2K and XP don't run in Kernel mode (unlike Win NT) any more. However, both operating systems can still use the NT drivers, running in Kernel mode (you can roughly tell which -is which as the drivers in subdirectory "2" of "W32X86" are "old" +is which as the drivers in subdirectory "2" of "W32X86" are "old" ones). As was said before, the Adobe as well as the Microsoft PostScript drivers are not known to cause any stability problems. The CUPS driver is derived from the Microsoft one. There is a simple @@ -9642,16 +9273,16 @@ includes the source code of the Microsoft driver, and licensees of Visual Studio are allowed to use and modify it for their own driver development efforts. This is what the CUPS people have done. The license doesn't allow them to publish the whole of the source code. -However, they have released the "diff" under the GPL, and if you are -owner of an "MS DDK for Win NT", you can check the driver yourself. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941369"></a> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +However, they have released the "diff" under the GPL, and if you are +owner of an "MS DDK for Win NT", you can check the driver yourself. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911506"></a>Setting up CUPS for driver Download</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> As we have said before: all previously known methods to prepare client -printer drivers on the Samba server for download and "Point'n'Print" +printer drivers on the Samba server for download and "Point'n'Print" convenience of Windows workstations are working with CUPS too. These methods were described in the previous chapter. In reality, this is a pure Samba business, and only relates to the Samba/Win client relationship. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941388"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>: the unknown Utility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911524"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>: the unknown Utility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911536"></a><p> The cupsaddsmb utility (shipped with all current CUPS versions) is an alternative method to transfer printer drivers into the Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Remember, this share is where @@ -9676,82 +9307,49 @@ job-billing)</p></li></ul></div><p> However, currently only Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by the CUPS drivers. You will need to get the respective part of Adobe driver too if you need to support Windows 95, 98, and ME clients. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941480"></a>Prepare your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for -cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911625"></a>Prepare your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Prior to running cupsaddsmb, you need the following settings in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [global] - load printers = yes - printing = cups - printcap name = cups - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - browseable = no - public = yes - guest ok = yes # setting depends on your requirements - writable = no - printable = yes - printer admin = root - - [print$] - comment = Printer Drivers - path = /etc/samba/drivers - browseable = yes - guest ok = no - read only = yes - write list = root - -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941526"></a>CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -CUPS users may get the exactly same packages from<a href="http://www.cups.org/software.html" target="_top"><span class="emphasis"><em>http://www.cups.org/software.html</em></span></a>. +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2911654"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 19.3. smb.conf for cupsaddsmb usage</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># setting depends on your requirements</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = root</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911845"></a>CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2911854"></a><p> +CUPS users may get the exactly same packages from <a href="http://www.cups.org/software.html" target="_top">http://www.cups.org/software.html</a>. It is a separate package from the CUPS base software files, tagged as -<span class="emphasis"><em>CUPS 1.1.x Windows NT/2k/XP Printer Driver for SAMBA +<span class="emphasis"><em>CUPS 1.1.x Windows NT/2k/XP Printer Driver for Samba (tar.gz, 192k)</em></span>. The filename to download is <tt class="filename">cups-samba-1.1.x.tar.gz</tt>. Upon untar-/unzip-ing, it will reveal these files: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# tar xvzf cups-samba-1.1.19.tar.gz - - cups-samba.install - cups-samba.license - cups-samba.readme - cups-samba.remove - cups-samba.ss - -</pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tar xvzf cups-samba-1.1.19.tar.gz</tt></b> +cups-samba.install +cups-samba.license +cups-samba.readme +cups-samba.remove +cups-samba.ss +</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911916"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2911927"></a> These have been packaged with the ESP meta packager software -"EPM". The <tt class="filename">*.install</tt> and +"EPM". The <tt class="filename">*.install</tt> and <tt class="filename">*.remove</tt> files are simple shell scripts, which untars the <tt class="filename">*.ss</tt> (the <tt class="filename">*.ss</tt> is -nothing else but a tar-archive, which can be untar-ed by "tar" +nothing else but a tar-archive, which can be untar-ed by "tar" too). Then it puts the content into <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>. This content includes 3 files: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# tar tv cups-samba.ss - - cupsdrvr.dll - cupsui.dll - cups.hlp - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tar tv cups-samba.ss</tt></b> +cupsdrvr.dll +cupsui.dll +cups.hlp </pre><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>cups-samba.install</em></span> shell scripts is easy to handle: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# ./cups-samba.install - - [....] - Installing software... - Updating file permissions... - Running post-install commands... - Installation is complete. - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./cups-samba.install</tt></b> +[....] +Installing software... +Updating file permissions... +Running post-install commands... +Installation is complete. </pre><p> The script should automatically put the driver files into the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt> directory. @@ -9764,54 +9362,37 @@ copy/move the file (after running the <b class="command">./cups-samba.install</b> script) manually to the right place. </p></div><pre class="screen"> - - cp /usr/share/drivers/cups.hlp /usr/share/cups/drivers/ - -</pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp /usr/share/drivers/cups.hlp /usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt></b> +</pre><a class="indexterm" name="id2912102"></a><p> This new CUPS PostScript driver is currently binary-only, but free of charge. No complete source code is provided (yet). The reason is this: it has been developed with the help of the <span class="emphasis"><em>Microsoft Driver Developer Kit</em></span> (DDK) and compiled with Microsoft Visual Studio 6. Driver developers are not allowed to distribute the whole of the source code as Free Software. However, CUPS developers released -the "diff" in source code under the GPL, so anybody with a license of +the "diff" in source code under the GPL, so anybody with a license of Visual Studio and a DDK will be able to compile for him/herself. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941724"></a>Recognize the different Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The CUPS drivers don't support the "older" Windows 95/98/ME, but only +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912128"></a>Recognize the different Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The CUPS drivers don't support the "older" Windows 95/98/ME, but only the Windows NT/2000/XP client: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:] - cups.hlp - cupsdrvr.dll - cupsui.dll - -</pre><p> +</p><p>Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>cups.hlp</p></li><li><p>cupsdrvr.dll</p></li><li><p>cupsui.dll</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p> Adobe drivers are available for the older Windows 95/98/ME as well as the Windows NT/2000/XP clients. The set of files is different for the different platforms. -</p><pre class="screen"> - - [Windows 95, 98, and Me are supported by:] - ADFONTS.MFM - ADOBEPS4.DRV - ADOBEPS4.HLP - DEFPRTR2.PPD - ICONLIB.DLL - PSMON.DLL - - [Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:] - ADOBEPS5.DLL - ADOBEPSU.DLL - ADOBEPSU.HLP +</p><p>Windows 95, 98, and Me are supported by:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ADFONTS.MFM</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPS4.DRV</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPS4.HLP</p></li><li><p>DEFPRTR2.PPD</p></li><li><p>ICONLIB.DLL</p></li><li><p>PSMON.DLL</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p>Windows NT, 2000, and XP are supported by:</p><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ADOBEPS5.DLL</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPSU.DLL</p></li><li><p>ADOBEPSU.HLP</p></li></ul></div><p> -</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> If both, the Adobe driver files and the CUPS driver files for the support of WinNT/2k/XP are present in , the Adobe ones will be ignored and the CUPS ones will be used. If you prefer -- for whatever reason -- to use Adobe-only drivers, move away the 3 CUPS driver files. The Win95/98/ME clients use the Adobe drivers in any case. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941782"></a>Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912268"></a>Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Acquiring the Adobe driver files seems to be unexpectedly difficult for many users. They are not available on the Adobe website as single files and the self-extracting and/or self-installing Windows-exe is @@ -9824,13 +9405,13 @@ Generic PostScript printer. After this, the client's where you can get them with smbclient from the CUPS host. A more detailed description about this is in the next (the CUPS printing) chapter. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941814"></a>ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Users of the ESP Print Pro software are able to install their "Samba -Drivers" package for this purpose with no problem. Retrieve the driver +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912301"></a>ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2912311"></a><p> +Users of the ESP Print Pro software are able to install their "Samba +Drivers" package for this purpose with no problem. Retrieve the driver files from the normal download area of the ESP Print Pro software -at<a href="http://www.easysw.com/software.html" target="_top">http://www.easysw.com/software.html</a>. -You need to locate the link labelled "SAMBA" amongst the +at <a href="http://www.easysw.com/software.html" target="_top">http://www.easysw.com/software.html</a>. +You need to locate the link labelled "SAMBA" amongst the <span class="emphasis"><em>Download Printer Drivers for ESP Print Pro 4.x</em></span> area and download the package. Once installed, you can prepare any driver by simply highlighting the printer in the Printer Manager GUI @@ -9840,7 +9421,7 @@ driver files; i.e. mainly setup the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share, etc. The ESP Print Pro package includes the CUPS driver files as well as a (licensed) set of Adobe drivers for the Windows 95/98/ME client family. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941864"></a>Caveats to be considered</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912362"></a>Caveats to be considered</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2912371"></a><p> Once you have run the install script (and possibly manually moved the <tt class="filename">cups.hlp</tt> file to <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt>), the driver is @@ -9848,9 +9429,10 @@ ready to be put into Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share (w <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/drivers/</tt> and contains a subdir tree with <span class="emphasis"><em>WIN40</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>W32X86</em></span> branches): You do this by running -"cupsaddsmb" (see also <b class="command">man cupsaddsmb</b> for +"cupsaddsmb" (see also <b class="command">man cupsaddsmb</b> for CUPS since release 1.1.16). </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912436"></a> You may need to put root into the smbpasswd file by running <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>; this is especially important if you should run this whole procedure for the first time, and are not @@ -9870,62 +9452,67 @@ It is not harmful if you still have the <tt class="filename">ADOBE*.*</tt> driver files from previous installations in the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/drivers/</tt> directory. The new <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span> (from 1.1.16) will -automatically prefer "its own" drivers if it finds both. +automatically prefer "its own" drivers if it finds both. </p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912533"></a> Should your Win clients have had the old <tt class="filename">ADOBE*.*</tt> files for the Adobe PostScript driver installed, the download and installation of the new CUPS PostScript driver for Windows NT/2k/XP will fail at first. You need to wipe the old driver from the clients -first. It is not enough to "delete" the printer, as the driver files +first. It is not enough to "delete" the printer, as the driver files will still be kept by the clients and re-used if you try to re-install the printer. To really get rid of the Adobe driver files on the -clients, open the "Printers" folder (possibly via <span class="emphasis"><em>Start ---> Settings --> Control Panel --> Printers</em></span>), +clients, open the "Printers" folder (possibly via <span class="emphasis"><em>Start, Settings, Control Panel, Printers</em></span>), right-click onto the folder background and select <span class="emphasis"><em>Server Properties</em></span>. When the new dialog opens, select the <span class="emphasis"><em>Drivers</em></span> tab. On the list select the driver you want to delete and click on the <span class="emphasis"><em>Delete</em></span> button. This will only work if there is not one single printer left -which uses that particular driver. You need to "delete" all printers -using this driver in the "Printers" folder first. You will need +which uses that particular driver. You need to "delete" all printers +using this driver in the "Printers" folder first. You will need Administrator privileges to do this. </p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912587"></a> Once you have successfully downloaded the CUPS PostScript driver to a client, you can easily switch all printers to this one by proceeding -as described elsewhere in the "Samba HOWTO Collection": either change -a driver for an existing printer by running the "Printer Properties" +as described in <a href="#printing" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support">the printing chapter</a>: either change +a driver for an existing printer by running the "Printer Properties" dialog, or use <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with the <b class="command">setdriver</b> sub-command. </p></li></ol></div><p> -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942086"></a>What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912629"></a>Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You are interested in a comparison between the CUPS and the Adobe PostScript drivers? For our purposes these are the most important items which weigh in favor of the CUPS ones: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>no hassle with the Adobe EULA</p></li><li><p>no hassle with the question “<span class="quote">Where do I -get the ADOBE*.* driver files from?</span>”</p></li><li><p>the Adobe drivers (on request of the printer PPD +get the ADOBE*.* driver files from?</span>”</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912669"></a> + the Adobe drivers (on request of the printer PPD associated with them) often put a PJL header in front of the main PostScript part of the print file. Thus the printfile starts with <i class="parameter"><tt><1B >%-12345X</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt><escape>%-12345X</tt></i> instead of <i class="parameter"><tt>%!PS</tt></i>). This leads to the CUPS daemon auto-typing the incoming file as a print-ready file, -not initiating a pass through the "pstops" filter (to speak more +not initiating a pass through the "pstops" filter (to speak more technically, it is not regarded as the generic MIME type +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912706"></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span>, but as the more special MIME type +<a class="indexterm" name="id2912720"></a> <span class="emphasis"><em>application/cups.vnd-postscript</em></span>), which therefore also leads to the page accounting in <span class="emphasis"><em>/var/log/cups/page_log</em></span> not receiving the exact number of pages; instead the dummy page number -of "1" is logged in a standard setup)</p></li><li><p>the Adobe driver has more options to "mis-configure" the +of "1" is logged in a standard setup)</p></li><li><p>the Adobe driver has more options to "mis-configure" the PostScript generated by it (like setting it inadvertently to <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for Speed</em></span>, instead of <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for Portability</em></span>, which could lead to CUPS being unable to process it)</p></li><li><p>the CUPS PostScript driver output sent by Windows clients to the CUPS server will be guaranteed to be auto-typed always as generic MIME type <span class="emphasis"><em>application/postscript</em></span>, -thusly passing through the CUPS "pstops" filter and logging the +thusly passing through the CUPS "pstops" filter and logging the correct number of pages in the <tt class="filename">page_log</tt> for accounting and quota purposes</p></li><li><p>the CUPS PostScript driver supports the sending of additional standard (IPP) print options by Win NT/2k/XP clients. Such @@ -9943,7 +9530,7 @@ not disturb any other applications as they will regard it as a comment and simply ignore it).</p></li><li><p>the CUPS PostScript driver will be the heart of the fully fledged CUPS IPP client for Windows NT/2K/XP to be released soon (probably alongside the first Beta release for CUPS -1.2).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942268"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +1.2).</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912835"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2912844"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2912852"></a><p> The cupsaddsmb command copies the needed files into your <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Additionally, the PPD associated with this printer is copied from @@ -9952,125 +9539,112 @@ associated with this printer is copied from Windows client installations via Point'n'Print. Before we can run the command successfully, we need to be sure that we can authenticate towards Samba. If you have a small network you are probably using user -level security (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>). Probably your -root has already a Samba account. Otherwise, create it now, using -<b class="command">smbpasswd</b>: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - # smbpasswd -a root - New SMB password: [type in password 'secret'] - Retype new SMB password: [type in password 'secret'] - -</pre><p> +level security (<a class="indexterm" name="id2912890"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user). +</p><p> Here is an example of a successfully run cupsaddsmb command. </p><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -U root infotec_IS2027 - Password for root required to access localhost via SAMBA: [type in password 'secret'] - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U root infotec_IS2027</tt></b> +Password for root required to access localhost via Samba: <b class="userinput"><tt>['secret']</tt></b> </pre><p> To share <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> printers and drivers, use the -<i class="parameter"><tt>-a</tt></i> parameter instead of a printer name. Since -cupsaddsmb "exports" the printer drivers to Samba, it should be +<tt class="option">-a</tt> parameter instead of a printer name. Since +cupsaddsmb "exports" the printer drivers to Samba, it should be obvious that it only works for queues with a CUPS driver associated. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942369"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2912958"></a>Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2912965"></a><p> Probably you want to see what's going on. Use the -<i class="parameter"><tt>-v</tt></i> parameter to get a more verbose output. The -output below was edited for better readability: all "\" at the end of +<tt class="option">-v</tt> parameter to get a more verbose output. The +output below was edited for better readability: all "\" at the end of a line indicate that I inserted an artificial line break plus some indentation here: </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> You will see the root password for the Samba account printed on -screen. If you use remote access, the password will go over the wire -unencrypted! -</p></div><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -U root -v infotec_2105 - Password for root required to access localhost via SAMBA: - Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' -c 'mkdir W32X86;put \ - /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll W32X86/cupsui.dll;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp W32X86/cups.hlp' - added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] - NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \W32X86 - putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd (2328.8 kb/s) \ - (average 2328.8 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll as \W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll (9374.3 kb/s) \ - (average 5206.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll as \W32X86/cupsui.dll (8107.2 kb/s) \ - (average 5984.1 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp as \W32X86/cups.hlp (3475.0 kb/s) \ - (average 5884.7 kb/s) +screen. +</p></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2912994"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2913004"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U root -v infotec_2105</tt></b> +Password for root required to access localhost via GANDALF: +Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'mkdir W32X86; \ + put /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll W32X86/cupsui.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp W32X86/cups.hlp' +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \W32X86 +putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \W32X86/infotec_2105.ppd +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll as \W32X86/cupsdrvr.dll +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll as \W32X86/cupsui.dll +putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp as \W32X86/cups.hlp - Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ - "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL: \ - RAW:NULL"' - cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll: \ - cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" - Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. +Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL: \ + RAW:NULL"' +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "infotec_2105:cupsdrvr.dll:infotec_2105.ppd:cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" +Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. - Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' -c 'mkdir WIN40;put \ - /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD; put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD;put \ - /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL - WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL;put /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL WIN40/PSMON.DLL;' +Running command: smbclient //localhost/print\$ -N -U'root%secret' \ +-c 'mkdir WIN40; \ + put /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL WIN40/PSMON.DLL;' added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION making remote directory \WIN40 - putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD (2328.8 kb/s) \ - (average 2328.8 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM as \WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM (9368.0 kb/s) \ - (average 6469.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV (9958.2 kb/s) \ - (average 8404.3 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP (8341.5 kb/s) \ - (average 8398.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD as \WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD (2195.9 kb/s) \ - (average 8254.3 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL as \WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL (8239.9 kb/s) \ - (average 8253.6 kb/s) - putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL as \WIN40/PSMON.DLL (6222.2 kb/s) \ - (average 8188.5 kb/s) + putting file /var/spool/cups/tmp/3e98bf2d333b5 as \WIN40/infotec_2105.PPD + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADFONTS.MFM as \WIN40/ADFONTS.MFM + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.DRV as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.DRV + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ADOBEPS4.HLP as \WIN40/ADOBEPS4.HLP + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/DEFPRTR2.PPD as \WIN40/DEFPRTR2.PPD + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/ICONLIB.DLL as \WIN40/ICONLIB.DLL + putting file /usr/share/cups/drivers/PSMON.DLL as \WIN40/PSMON.DLL - Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' -c 'adddriver "Windows 4.0" \ - "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP: \ - PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP,PSMON.DLL, \ - ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL"' - cmd = adddriver "Windows 4.0" "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL: \ - ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP, \ - PSMON.DLL,ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL" + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'adddriver "Windows 4.0" \ + "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL:ADOBEPS4.HLP: \ + PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP,PSMON.DLL, \ + ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL"' + cmd = adddriver "Windows 4.0" "infotec_2105:ADOBEPS4.DRV:infotec_2105.PPD:NULL: \ + ADOBEPS4.HLP:PSMON.DLL:RAW:ADOBEPS4.DRV,infotec_2105.PPD,ADOBEPS4.HLP, \ + PSMON.DLL,ADFONTS.MFM,DEFPRTR2.PPD,ICONLIB.DLL" Printer Driver infotec_2105 successfully installed. - Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ - -c 'setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105' + Running command: rpcclient localhost -N -U'root%secret' \ + -c 'setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105' cmd = setdriver infotec_2105 infotec_2105 Successfully set infotec_2105 to driver infotec_2105. </pre><p> -If you look closely, you'll discover your root password was transfered +If you look closely, you'll discover your root password was transferred unencrypted over the wire, so beware! Also, if you look further her, you'll discover error messages like NT_STATUS_OBJECT_NAME_COLLISION in between. They occur, because the directories WIN40 and W32X86 already existed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> driver download share (from a previous driver installation). They are harmless here. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942596"></a>Understanding cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913117"></a>Understanding cupsaddsmb</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2913126"></a><p> What has happened? What did cupsaddsmb do? There are five stages of the procedure -</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>call the CUPS server via IPP and request the +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2913153"></a> + call the CUPS server via IPP and request the driver files and the PPD file for the named printer;</p></li><li><p>store the files temporarily in the local TEMPDIR (as defined in <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt>);</p></li><li><p>connect via smbclient to the Samba server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and put the files into the share's WIN40 (for Win95/98/ME) and W32X86/ (for WinNT/2k/XP) sub - directories;</p></li><li><p>connect via rpcclient to the Samba server and -execute the "adddriver" command with the correct -parameters;</p></li><li><p>connect via rpcclient to the Samba server a second -time and execute the "setdriver" command.</p></li></ol></div><p> + directories;</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913197"></a> + connect via rpcclient to the Samba server and +execute the "adddriver" command with the correct +parameters;</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913216"></a> + connect via rpcclient to the Samba server a second +time and execute the "setdriver" command.</p></li></ol></div><p> Note, that you can run the cupsaddsmb utility with parameters to specify one remote host as Samba host and a second remote host as CUPS host. Especially if you want to get a deeper understanding, it is a @@ -10078,10 +9652,8 @@ good idea try it and see more clearly what is going on (though in real life most people will have their CUPS and Samba servers run on the same host): </p><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -H sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername - -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942690"></a>How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913264"></a>How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> always check if the utility completed successfully in all fields. You need as a minimum these 3 messages amongst the output: @@ -10092,7 +9664,7 @@ installed.</em></span> # (for the WIN40 == Win9x/ME architecture...)</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Successfully set [printerXPZ] to driver [printerXYZ].</em></span></p></li></ol></div><p> These messages probably not easily recognized in the general -output. If you run cupsaddsmb with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-a</tt></i> +output. If you run cupsaddsmb with the <tt class="option">-a</tt> parameter (which tries to prepare <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> active CUPS printer drivers for download), you might miss if individual printers drivers had problems to install properly. Here a redirection of the @@ -10102,46 +9674,45 @@ It is impossible to see any diagnostic output if you don't run cupsaddsmb in verbose mode. Therefore we strongly recommend to not use the default quiet mode. It will hide any problems from you which might occur. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942777"></a>cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913349"></a>cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2913357"></a><p> You can't get the standard cupsaddsmb command to run on a Samba PDC? You are asked for the password credential all over again and again and the command just will not take off at all? Try one of these variations: </p><pre class="screen"> - - # cupsaddsmb -U DOMAINNAME\\root -v printername - # cupsaddsmb -H SAMBA-PDC -U DOMAINNAME\\root -v printername - # cupsaddsmb -H SAMBA-PDC -U DOMAINNAME\\root -h cups-server -v printername - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U MIDEARTH\\root -v printername</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H SAURON -U MIDEARTH\\root -v printername</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H SAURON -U MIDEARTH\\root -h cups-server -v printername</tt></b> </pre><p> (Note the two backslashes: the first one is required to -"escape" the second one). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942812"></a>cupsaddsmb Flowchart</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"escape" the second one). +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913427"></a>cupsaddsmb Flowchart</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2913435"></a><p> Here is a chart about the procedures, commandflows and -dataflows of the "cupaddsmb" command. Note again: cupsaddsmb is -not intended to, and does not work with, "raw" queues! +dataflows of the "cupaddsmb" command. Note again: cupsaddsmb is +not intended to, and does not work with, "raw" queues! </p><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2942830"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.14. cupsaddsmb flowchart</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/1small.png" alt="cupsaddsmb flowchart"></div></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942865"></a>Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="figure"><a name="small14"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.16. cupsaddsmb flowchart</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/14small.png" width="270" alt="cupsaddsmb flowchart"></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913497"></a>Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2913504"></a><p> After cupsaddsmb completed, your driver is prepared for the clients to use. Here are the steps you must perform to download and install it -via "Point'n'Print". From a Windows client, browse to the CUPS/Samba +via "Point'n'Print". From a Windows client, browse to the CUPS/Samba server; -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>open the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printers</em></span> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2913522"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p>open the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printers</em></span> share of Samba in Network Neighbourhood;</p></li><li><p>right-click on the printer in question;</p></li><li><p>from the opening context-menu select <span class="emphasis"><em>Install...</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>Connect...</em></span> (depending on the Windows version you use).</p></li></ul></div><p> After a few seconds, there should be a new printer in your -client's <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> "Printers" folder: On Windows +client's <span class="emphasis"><em>local</em></span> "Printers" folder: On Windows XP it will follow a naming convention of <span class="emphasis"><em>PrinterName on -SambaServer</em></span>. (In my current case it is "infotec_2105 on -kde-bitshop"). If you want to test it and send your first job from +SambaServer</em></span>. (In my current case it is "infotec_2105 on +kde-bitshop"). If you want to test it and send your first job from an application like Winword, the new printer will appears in a <tt class="filename">\\SambaServer\PrinterName</tt> entry in the dropdown list of available printers. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913594"></a> cupsaddsmb will only reliably work with CUPS version 1.1.15 or higher and Samba from 2.2.4. If it doesn't work, or if the automatic printer driver download to the clients doesn't succeed, you can still manually @@ -10149,16 +9720,14 @@ install the CUPS printer PPD on top of the Adobe PostScript driver on clients. Then point the client's printer queue to the Samba printer share for a UNC type of connection: </p></div><pre class="screen"> - - net use lpt1: \\sambaserver\printershare /user:ntadmin - +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: \\sambaserver\printershare /user:ntadmin</tt></b> </pre><p> should you desire to use the CUPS networked PostScript RIP -functions. (Note that user "ntadmin" needs to be a valid Samba user +functions. (Note that user "ntadmin" needs to be a valid Samba user with the required privileges to access the printershare) This would set up the printer connection in the traditional <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> way (not using MS-RPC). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942978"></a>Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913646"></a>Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Soooo: printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print well, some don't print at all. Some jobs have problems with fonts, @@ -10184,7 +9753,7 @@ get a printout at all) (Adobe)</p></li><li><p>Sometimes you can choose <span cla Level</em></span>: in case of problems try <span class="emphasis"><em>2</em></span> instead of <span class="emphasis"><em>3</em></span> (the latest ESP Ghostscript package handles Level 3 PostScript very well) (Adobe).</p></li><li><p>Say <span class="emphasis"><em>Yes</em></span> to <span class="emphasis"><em>PostScript -Error Handler</em></span> (Adobe)</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943112"></a>Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +Error Handler</em></span> (Adobe)</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2913780"></a>Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using rpcclient)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Of course you can run all the commands which are embedded into the cupsaddsmb convenience utility yourself, one by one, and hereby upload @@ -10192,10 +9761,19 @@ and prepare the driver files for future client downloads. </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>prepare Samba (a CUPS printqueue with the name of the printer should be there. We are providing the driver now);</p></li><li><p>copy all files to -<i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]:</tt></i></p></li><li><p>run <b class="command">rpcclient adddriver</b> -(for each client architecture you want to support):</p></li><li><p>run <b class="command">rpcclient + <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913829"></a> + run <b class="command">rpcclient adddriver</b> +(for each client architecture you want to support):</p></li><li><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913853"></a> + run <b class="command">rpcclient setdriver.</b></p></li></ol></div><p> -We are going to do this now. First, read the man page on "rpcclient" +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913875"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913886"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913897"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913908"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913919"></a> +We are going to do this now. First, read the man page on "rpcclient" to get a first idea. Look at all the printing related sub-commands. <b class="command">enumprinters</b>, <b class="command">enumdrivers</b>, <b class="command">enumports</b>, @@ -10203,9 +9781,9 @@ sub-commands. <b class="command">enumprinters</b>, the most interesting ones. rpcclient implements an important part of the MS-RPC protocol. You can use it to query (and command) a Win NT (or 2K/XP) PC too. MS-RPC is used by Windows clients, amongst other -things, to benefit from the "Point'n'Print" features. Samba can now +things, to benefit from the "Point'n'Print" features. Samba can now mimic this too. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943227"></a>A Check of the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913973"></a>A Check of the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> First let's have a little check of the rpcclient man page. Here are two relevant passages: </p><p> @@ -10225,9 +9803,9 @@ Help File Name:\ Language Monitor Name:\ Default Data Type:\ Comma Separated list of Files -</pre><p>Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </p><p>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors +</pre><p>Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </p><p>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors since these only apply to local printers whose driver can make use of -a bi-directional link for communication. This field should be "NULL". +a bi-directional link for communication. This field should be "NULL". On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a driver must already be installed prior to adding the driver or else the RPC will fail @@ -10238,34 +9816,32 @@ printer driver associated with an installed printer. The printer driver must already be correctly installed on the print server. </p><p> See also the enumprinters and enumdrivers commands for obtaining a list of installed printers and drivers. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943340"></a>Understanding the rpcclient man Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914086"></a>Understanding the rpcclient man page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>exact</em></span> format isn't made too clear by the man page, since you have to deal with some parameters containing spaces. Here is a better description for it. We have line-broken the -command and indicated the breaks with "\". Usually you would type the +command and indicated the breaks with "\". Usually you would type the command in one line without the linebreaks: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - adddriver "Architecture" \ - "LongPrinterName:DriverFile:DataFile:ConfigFile:HelpFile:\ - LanguageMonitorFile:DataType:ListOfFiles,Comma-separated" - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2914109"></a><pre class="screen"> + adddriver "Architecture" \ + "LongPrinterName:DriverFile:DataFile:ConfigFile:HelpFile:\ + LanguageMonitorFile:DataType:ListOfFiles,Comma-separated" </pre><p> What the man pages denotes as a simple <config> keyword, does in reality consist of 8 colon-separated fields. The last field may take multiple (in some, very insane, cases, even 20 different additional files. This might sound confusing at first. -Note, that what the man pages names the "LongPrinterName" in -reality should rather be called the "Driver Name". You can name it +Note, that what the man pages names the "LongPrinterName" in +reality should rather be called the "Driver Name". You can name it anything you want, as long as you use this name later in the <span class="emphasis"><em>rpcclient ... setdriver</em></span> command. For practical reasons, many name the driver the same as the printer. </p><p> True: it isn't simple at all. I hear you asking: -<span class="emphasis"><em>How do I know which files are "Driver -File", "Data File", "Config File", "Help File" and "Language -Monitor File" in each case?</em></span> -- For an answer you may +<span class="emphasis"><em>How do I know which files are "Driver +File", "Data File", "Config File", "Help File" and "Language +Monitor File" in each case?</em></span> -- For an answer you may want to have a look at how a Windows NT box with a shared printer presents the files to us. Remember, that this whole procedure has to be developed by the Samba Team by overhearing the traffic caused @@ -10274,23 +9850,23 @@ box now, and access it from a UNIX workstation. We will query it with <b class="command">rpcclient</b> to see what it tells us and try to understand the man page more clearly which we've read just now. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943429"></a>Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914186"></a>Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914198"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914209"></a> We could run <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with a <b class="command">getdriver</b> or a <b class="command">getprinter</b> subcommand (in level 3 verbosity) against it. Just sit down at UNIX or Linux workstation with the Samba utilities installed. Then type the following command: </p><pre class="screen"> - - rpcclient -U'USERNAME%PASSWORD' NT-SERVER-NAME -c 'getdriver printername 3' - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'USERNAME%PASSWORD' NT-SERVER-NAME -c 'getdriver printername 3'</tt></b> </pre><p> From the result it should become clear which is which. Here is an example from my installation: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' W2KSERVER -c'getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3' - cmd = getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3 +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2914272"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' W2KSERVER \ + -c'getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3'</tt></b> + cmd = getdriver "DANKA InfoStream Virtual Printer" 3 [Windows NT x86] Printer Driver Info 3: @@ -10315,34 +9891,38 @@ example from my installation: </pre><p> Some printer drivers list additional files under the label -"Dependentfiles": these would go into the last field +"Dependentfiles": these would go into the last field <span class="emphasis"><em>ListOfFiles,Comma-separated</em></span>. For the CUPS PostScript drivers we don't need any (nor would we for the Adobe -PostScript driver): therefore the field will get a "NULL" entry. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943519"></a>What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +PostScript driver): therefore the field will get a "NULL" entry. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914333"></a>What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> From the manpage (and from the quoted output of <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb</em></span>, above) it becomes clear that you need to have certain conditions in order to make the manual uploading and initializing of the driver files succeed. The two rpcclient +<a class="indexterm" name="id2914353"></a> subcommands (<b class="command">adddriver</b> and <b class="command">setdriver</b>) need to encounter the following pre-conditions to complete successfully: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>you are connected as "printer admin", or root (note, -that this is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> the "Printer Operators" group in +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>you are connected as <a class="indexterm" name="id2914387"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (note, +that this is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> the "Printer Operators" group in NT, but the <span class="emphasis"><em>printer admin</em></span> group, as defined in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>);</p></li><li><p>copy all required driver files to <tt class="filename">\\sambaserver\print$\w32x86</tt> and <tt class="filename">\\sambaserver\print$\win40</tt> as appropriate. They -will end up in the "0" respective "2" subdirectories later -- for now +will end up in the "0" respective "2" subdirectories later -- for now <span class="emphasis"><em>don't</em></span> put them there, they'll be automatically used by the <b class="command">adddriver</b> subcommand.! (if you use -"smbclient" to put the driver files into the share, note that you need -to escape the "$": <b class="command">smbclient //sambaserver/print\$ -U +"smbclient" to put the driver files into the share, note that you need +to escape the "$": <b class="command">smbclient //sambaserver/print\$ -U root</b>);</p></li><li><p>the user you're connecting as must be able to write to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and create subdirectories;</p></li><li><p>the printer you are going to setup for the Windows -clients, needs to be installed in CUPS already;</p></li><li><p>the CUPS printer must be known to Samba, otherwise the +clients, needs to be installed in CUPS already;</p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914496"></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2914508"></a> + the CUPS printer must be known to Samba, otherwise the <b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand fails with an NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL error. To check if the printer is known by Samba you may use the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> subcommand to @@ -10350,164 +9930,145 @@ rpcclient. A long-standing bug prevented a proper update of the printer list until every smbd process had received a SIGHUP or was restarted. Remember this in case you've created the CUPS printer just shortly ago and encounter problems: try restarting -Samba.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943682"></a>Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914542"></a>Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> We are going to install a printer driver now by manually executing all required commands. As this may seem a rather complicated process at first, we go through the procedure step by step, explaining every single action item as it comes up. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943698"></a>First Step: Install the Printer on CUPS</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# lpadmin -p mysmbtstprn -v socket://10.160.51.131:9100 -E -P /home/kurt/canonIR85.ppd - +</p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 19.1. Manual Driver Installation installation</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p class="title"><b>Install the Printer on CUPS</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p mysmbtstprn -v socket://10.160.51.131:9100 -E -P canonIR85.ppd</tt></b> </pre><p> This installs printer with the name <span class="emphasis"><em>mysmbtstprn</em></span> to the CUPS system. The printer is accessed via a socket (a.k.a. JetDirect or Direct TCP/IP) connection. You need to be root for this step -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943729"></a>Second Step (optional): Check if the Printer is recognized by -Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - - # rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep -C2 mysmbtstprn - - flags:[0x800000] - name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,,mysmbtstprn] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Check if the Printer is recognized by +Samba</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2914623"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep -C2 mysmbtstprn</tt></b> +flags:[0x800000] +name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,,mysmbtstprn] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] </pre><p> This should show the printer in the list. If not, stop and re-start the Samba daemon (smbd), or send a HUP signal: <b class="command">kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</b>. Check again. Troubleshoot and repeat until -success. Note the "empty" field between the two commas in the -"description" line. Here would the driver name appear if there was one +success. Note the "empty" field between the two commas in the +"description" line. Here would the driver name appear if there was one already. You need to know root's Samba password (as set by the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command) for this step and most of the following steps. Alternatively you can authenticate as one of the -users from the "write list" as defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for +users from the "write list" as defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943792"></a>Third Step (optional): Check if Samba knows a Driver for the -Printer</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep driver - drivername:[] - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep -C4 driv - servername:[\\kde-bitshop] - printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - sharename:[mysmbtstprn] - portname:[Samba Printer Port] - drivername:[] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] - location:[] - sepfile:[] - printprocessor:[winprint] +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Check if Samba knows a Driver for the +Printer</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2914711"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2914722"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep driver </tt></b> +drivername:[] + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep -C4 driv</tt></b> +servername:[\\kde-bitshop] +printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +sharename:[mysmbtstprn] +portname:[Samba Printer Port] +drivername:[] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +location:[] +sepfile:[] +printprocessor:[winprint] -# rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost</tt></b> result was WERR_UNKNOWN_PRINTER_DRIVER </pre><p> Neither method of the three commands shown above should show a driver. This step was done for the purpose of demonstrating this condition. An attempt to connect to the printer at this stage will prompt the -message along the lines: "The server has not the required printer -driver installed". -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943830"></a>Fourth Step: Put all required Driver Files into Samba's -[print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# smbclient //localhost/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ - -c 'cd W32X86; \ - put /etc/cups/ppd/mysmbtstprn.ppd mysmbtstprn.PPD; \ - put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll cupsui.dll; \ - put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll cupsdrvr.dll; \ - put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp cups.hlp' - +message along the lines: "The server has not the required printer +driver installed". +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Put all required Driver Files into Samba's +[print$]</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //localhost/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86; \ + put /etc/cups/ppd/mysmbtstprn.ppd mysmbtstprn.PPD; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsui.dll cupsui.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cupsdrvr.dll cupsdrvr.dll; \ + put /usr/share/cups/drivers/cups.hlp cups.hlp'</tt></b> </pre><p> (Note that this command should be entered in one long single -line. Line-breaks and the line-end indicating "\" has been inserted +line. Line-breaks and the line-end indicating "\" has been inserted for readability reasons.) This step is <span class="emphasis"><em>required</em></span> for the next one to succeed. It makes the driver files physically present in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. However, clients would still not be able to install them, because Samba does not yet treat them as driver files. A client asking for the driver would still -be presented with a "not installed here" message. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943881"></a>Fifth Step: Verify where the Driver Files are now</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/ - total 669 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:08 2 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 25 23:21 cupsdrvr.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 25 23:21 cupsui.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD - -</pre><p> -The driver files now are in the W32X86 architecture "root" of +be presented with a "not installed here" message. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Verify where the Driver Files are now</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt></b> +total 669 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:08 2 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 25 23:21 cupsdrvr.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 25 23:21 cupsui.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD +</pre><p> +The driver files now are in the W32X86 architecture "root" of <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943920"></a>Sixth Step: Tell Samba that these are +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Tell Samba that these are <span class="emphasis"><em>Driver</em></span> Files -(<b class="command">adddriver</b>)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c `adddriver "Windows NT x86" "mydrivername: \ - cupsdrvr.dll:mysmbtstprn.PPD: \ - cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW[<span class="citation">:</span>]NULL" \ - localhost - - Printer Driver mydrivername successfully installed. - +(<b class="command">adddriver</b>)</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2914932"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c `adddriver "Windows NT x86" "mydrivername: \ + cupsdrvr.dll:mysmbtstprn.PPD: \ + cupsui.dll:cups.hlp:NULL:RAW:NULL" \ + localhost</tt></b> +Printer Driver mydrivername successfully installed. </pre><p> Note that your cannot repeat this step if it fails. It could fail even as a result of a simple typo. It will most likely have moved a part of -the driver files into the "2" subdirectory. If this step fails, you +the driver files into the "2" subdirectory. If this step fails, you need to go back to the fourth step and repeat it, before you can try this one again. In this step you need to choose a name for your driver. It is normally a good idea to use the same name as is used for the printername; however, in big installations you may use this driver for a number of printers which have obviously different names. So the name of the driver is not fixed. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943974"></a>Seventh Step: Verify where the Driver Files are now</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/ - total 1 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:22 2 - drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 - - -# ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/2 - total 5039 - [....] - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 13 13:53 cupsdrvr.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 13 13:53 cupsui.dll - -rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Verify where the Driver Files are now</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/</tt></b> +total 1 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 532 May 25 23:22 2 +drwxr-sr-x 2 root ntadmin 670 May 16 03:15 3 + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /etc/samba/drivers/W32X86/2</tt></b> +total 5039 +[....] +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 14234 May 25 23:21 cups.hlp +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 278380 May 13 13:53 cupsdrvr.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 215848 May 13 13:53 cupsui.dll +-rwxr--r-- 1 root ntadmin 169458 May 25 23:21 mysmbtstprn.PPD </pre><p> Notice how step 6 did also move the driver files to the appropriate subdirectory. Compare with the situation after step 5. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944008"></a>Eighth Step (optional): Verify if Samba now recognizes the -Driver</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumdrivers 3' localhost | grep -B2 -A5 mydrivername - - Printer Driver Info 3: - Version: [2] - Driver Name: [mydrivername] - Architecture: [Windows NT x86] - Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] - Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] - Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] - Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Verify if Samba now recognizes the +Driver</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2915053"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumdrivers 3' localhost \ + | grep -B2 -A5 mydrivername</tt></b> +Printer Driver Info 3: +Version: [2] +Driver Name: [mydrivername] +Architecture: [Windows NT x86] +Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] +Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] +Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] +Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] </pre><p> Remember, this command greps for the name you did choose for the driver in step Six. This command must succeed before you can proceed. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944041"></a>Ninth Step: Tell Samba which Printer should use these Driver -Files (<b class="command">setdriver</b>)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'setdriver mysmbtstprn mydrivername' localhost - - Successfully set mysmbtstprn to driver mydrivername - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Tell Samba which Printer should use these Driver +Files (<b class="command">setdriver</b>)</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2915118"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'setdriver mysmbtstprn mydrivername' localhost</tt></b> +Successfully set mysmbtstprn to driver mydrivername </pre><p> Since you can bind any printername (=printqueue) to any driver, this is a very convenient way to setup many queues which use the same @@ -10515,99 +10076,95 @@ driver. You don't need to repeat all the previous steps for the setdriver command to succeed. The only pre-conditions are: <b class="command">enumdrivers</b> must find the driver and <b class="command">enumprinters</b> must find the printer. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944091"></a>Tenth Step (optional): Verify if Samba has this Association -recognized</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep driver - drivername:[mydrivername] +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Verify if Samba has this Association +recognized</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2915186"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2915197"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2915208"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep driver</tt></b> +drivername:[mydrivername] -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost | grep -C4 driv - servername:[\\kde-bitshop] - printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - sharename:[mysmbtstprn] - portname:[Done] - drivername:[mydrivername] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] - location:[] - sepfile:[] - printprocessor:[winprint] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'getprinter mysmbtstprn 2' localhost \ + | grep -C4 driv</tt></b> +servername:[\\kde-bitshop] +printername:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] +sharename:[mysmbtstprn] +portname:[Done] +drivername:[mydrivername] +comment:[mysmbtstprn] +location:[] +sepfile:[] +printprocessor:[winprint] -# rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost - [Windows NT x86] - Printer Driver Info 3: - Version: [2] - Driver Name: [mydrivername] - Architecture: [Windows NT x86] - Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] - Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] - Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] - Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] - Monitorname: [] - Defaultdatatype: [RAW] - Monitorname: [] - Defaultdatatype: [RAW] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U root%xxxx -c 'getdriver mysmbtstprn' localhost</tt></b> +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [mydrivername] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsdrvr.dll] + Datafile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\mysmbtstprn.PPD] + Configfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cupsui.dll] + Helpfile: [\\kde-bitshop\print$\W32X86\2\cups.hlp] + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [RAW] + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [RAW] -# rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep mysmbtstprn - name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] - description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,mydrivername,mysmbtstprn] - comment:[mysmbtstprn] +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'enumprinters' localhost | grep mysmbtstprn</tt></b> + name:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn] + description:[\\kde-bitshop\mysmbtstprn,mydrivername,mysmbtstprn] + comment:[mysmbtstprn] </pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915300"></a> Compare these results with the ones from steps 2 and 3. Note that every single of these commands show the driver is installed. Even the <b class="command">enumprinters</b> command now lists the driver -on the "description" line. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944171"></a>Eleventh Step (optional): Tickle the Driver into a correct -Device Mode</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +on the "description" line. +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>(optional) Tickle the Driver into a correct +Device Mode</b></p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915338"></a> You certainly know how to install the driver on the client. In case you are not particularly familiar with Windows, here is a short recipe: browse the Network Neighbourhood, go to the Samba server, look for the shares. You should see all shared Samba printers. Double-click on the one in question. The driver should get installed, and the network connection set up. An alternative way is to -open the "Printers (and Faxes)" folder, right-click on the printer in -question and select "Connect" or "Install". As a result, a new printer -should have appeared in your client's local "Printers (and Faxes)" -folder, named something like "printersharename on Sambahostname". +open the "Printers (and Faxes)" folder, right-click on the printer in +question and select "Connect" or "Install". As a result, a new printer +should have appeared in your client's local "Printers (and Faxes)" +folder, named something like "printersharename on Sambahostname". </p><p> It is important that you execute this step as a Samba printer admin (as defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). Here is another method to do this on Windows XP. It uses a commandline, which you may type -into the "DOS box" (type root's smbpassword when prompted): +into the "DOS box" (type root's smbpassword when prompted): </p><pre class="screen"> - - C:\> runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n \\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn" - +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n\ + \\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> </pre><p> -Change any printer setting once (like <span class="emphasis"><em>"portrait" ---> "landscape"</em></span>), click "Apply"; change the setting +Change any printer setting once (like changing <span class="emphasis"><em>"portrait" to + "landscape"</em></span>), click <span class="guibutton">Apply</span>; change the setting back. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944235"></a>Twelfth Step: Install the Printer on a Client -("Point'n'Print")</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - - C:\> rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn" - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Install the Printer on a Client +("Point'n'Print")</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2915426"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /in /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> </pre><p> If it doesn't work it could be a permission problem with the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944268"></a>Thirteenth Step (optional): Print a Test Page</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - - C:\> rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn" - +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Thirteenth Step (optional): Print a Test Page</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /n "\\sambacupsserver\mysmbtstprn"</tt></b> </pre><p> Then hit [TAB] 5 times, [ENTER] twice, [TAB] once and [ENTER] again and march to the printer. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944295"></a>Fourteenth Step (recommended): Study the Test Page</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Fourteenth Step (recommended): Study the Test Page</b></p><p> Hmmm.... just kidding! By now you know everything about printer installations and you don't need to read a word. Just put it in a -frame and bolt it to the wall with the heading "MY FIRST -RPCCLIENT-INSTALLED PRINTER" - why not just throw it away! -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944313"></a>Fifteenth Step (obligatory): Enjoy. Jump. Celebrate your -Success</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> - -# echo "Cheeeeerioooooo! Success..." >> /var/log/samba/log.smbd - -</pre></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944334"></a>Troubleshooting revisited</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +frame and bolt it to the wall with the heading "MY FIRST +RPCCLIENT-INSTALLED PRINTER" - why not just throw it away! +</p></li><li><p class="title"><b>Fifteenth Step (obligatory): Enjoy. Jump. Celebrate your +Success</b></p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>echo "Cheeeeerioooooo! Success..." >> /var/log/samba/log.smbd</tt></b> +</pre></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915566"></a>Troubleshooting revisited</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The setdriver command will fail, if in Samba's mind the queue is not already there. You had promising messages about the: </p><pre class="screen"> @@ -10615,42 +10172,52 @@ already there. You had promising messages about the: Printer Driver ABC successfully installed. </pre><p> -after the "adddriver" parts of the procedure? But you are also seeing +after the "adddriver" parts of the procedure? But you are also seeing a disappointing message like this one beneath? </p><pre class="screen"> result was NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL </pre><p> -It is not good enough that <span class="emphasis"><em>you</em></span> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915607"></a> +It is not good enough that you can see the queue <span class="emphasis"><em>in CUPS</em></span>, using the <b class="command">lpstat -p ir85wm</b> command. A bug in most recent versions of Samba prevents the proper update of the queuelist. The recognition of newly installed CUPS printers fails unless you re-start Samba or send a HUP to all smbd processes. To verify if this is the reason why Samba doesn't -execute the setdriver command successfully, check if Samba "sees" +execute the setdriver command successfully, check if Samba "sees" the printer: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'enumprinters 0'| grep ir85wm +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2915634"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'enumprinters 0'| grep ir85wm</tt></b> printername:[ir85wm] - </pre><p> An alternative command could be this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -# rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'getprinter ir85wm' +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2915673"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient transmeta -N -U'root%secret' -c 'getprinter ir85wm' </tt></b> cmd = getprinter ir85wm flags:[0x800000] name:[\\transmeta\ir85wm] description:[\\transmeta\ir85wm,ir85wm,DPD] comment:[CUPS PostScript-Treiber for WinNT/2K/XP] - </pre><p> BTW, you can use these commands, plus a few more, of course, to install drivers on remote Windows NT print servers too! -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944435"></a>The printing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2915718"></a>The printing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915734"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915743"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915754"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915765"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915776"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915788"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915799"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915810"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915821"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915832"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915843"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915854"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915866"></a> Some mystery is associated with the series of files with a tdb-suffix appearing in every Samba installation. They are <tt class="filename">connections.tdb</tt>, @@ -10665,12 +10232,12 @@ tdb-suffix appearing in every Samba installation. They are <tt class="filename">ntprinters.tdb</tt>, <tt class="filename">sessionid.tdb</tt> and <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>. What is their purpose? -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944537"></a>Trivial DataBase Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915962"></a>Trivial DataBase Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2915970"></a><p> A Windows NT (Print) Server keeps track of all information needed to serve its duty toward its clients by storing entries in the Windows -"Registry". Client queries are answered by reading from the registry, +"Registry". Client queries are answered by reading from the registry, Administrator or user configuration settings are saved by writing into -the Registry. Samba and Unix obviously don't have such a kind of +the Registry. Samba and UNIX obviously don't have such a kind of Registry. Samba instead keeps track of all client related information in a series of <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files. (TDB = Trivial Data Base). These are often located in <tt class="filename">/var/lib/samba/</tt> @@ -10678,10 +10245,10 @@ or <tt class="filename">/var/lock/samba/</tt> . The printing related files are <tt class="filename">ntprinters.tdb</tt>, <tt class="filename">printing.tdb</tt>,<tt class="filename">ntforms.tdb</tt> and <tt class="filename">ntdrivers.tdb</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944608"></a>Binary Format</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916041"></a>Binary Format</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files are not human readable. They are -written in a binary format. "Why not ASCII?", you may ask. "After all, -ASCII configuration files are a good and proofed tradition on UNIX." +written in a binary format. "Why not ASCII?", you may ask. "After all, +ASCII configuration files are a good and proofed tradition on UNIX." -- The reason for this design decision by the Samba Team is mainly performance. Samba needs to be fast; it runs a separate <b class="command">smbd</b> process for each client connection, in some @@ -10691,7 +10258,7 @@ same time</em></span>. The file format of Samba's <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files allows for this provision. Many smbd processes may write to the same <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> file at the same time. This wouldn't be possible with pure ASCII files. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944670"></a>Losing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916103"></a>Losing <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> It is very important that all <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files remain consistent over all write and read accesses. However, it may happen that these files <span class="emphasis"><em>do</em></span> get corrupted. (A @@ -10701,13 +10268,12 @@ etc.). In cases of trouble, a deletion of the old printing-related <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files may be the only option. You need to re-create all print related setup after that. Or you have made a backup of the <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files in time. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944728"></a>Using <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbbackup</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916162"></a>Using <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbbackup</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2916172"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2916186"></a><p> Samba ships with a little utility which helps the root user of your system to back up your <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files. If you run it with no argument, it prints a little usage message: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# tdbbackup +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tdbbackup</tt></b> Usage: tdbbackup [options] <fname...> Version:3.0a @@ -10718,36 +10284,34 @@ with no argument, it prints a little usage message: </pre><p> Here is how I backed up my printing.tdb file: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# ls - . browse.dat locking.tdb ntdrivers.tdb printing.tdb share_info.tdb - .. connections.tdb messages.tdb ntforms.tdb printing.tdbkp unexpected.tdb - brlock.tdb gmon.out namelist.debug ntprinters.tdb sessionid.tdb +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls</tt></b> +. browse.dat locking.tdb ntdrivers.tdb printing.tdb +.. share_info.tdb connections.tdb messages.tdb ntforms.tdb +printing.tdbkp unexpected.tdb brlock.tdb gmon.out namelist.debug +ntprinters.tdb sessionid.tdb - kde-bitshop:/var/lock/samba # tdbbackup -s .bak printing.tdb +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>tdbbackup -s .bak printing.tdb</tt></b> printing.tdb : 135 records - kde-bitshop:/var/lock/samba # ls -l printing.tdb* +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l printing.tdb*</tt></b> -rw------- 1 root root 40960 May 2 03:44 printing.tdb -rw------- 1 root root 40960 May 2 03:44 printing.tdb.bak -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944795"></a>CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2916297"></a>CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2916305"></a><p> CUPS ships with good support for HP LaserJet type printers. You can install the generic driver as follows: -</p><pre class="screen"> - -lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -m laserjet.ppd - +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2916320"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -m laserjet.ppd</tt></b> </pre><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>-m</tt></i> switch will retrieve the +The <tt class="option">-m</tt> switch will retrieve the <tt class="filename">laserjet.ppd</tt> from the standard repository for not-yet-installed-PPDs, which CUPS typically stores in <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/model</tt>. Alternatively, you may use -<i class="parameter"><tt>-P /path/to/your.ppd</tt></i>. +<tt class="option">-P /path/to/your.ppd</tt>. </p><p> The generic laserjet.ppd however does not support every special option -for every LaserJet-compatible model. It constitutes a sort of "least -denominator" of all the models. If for some reason it is ruled out to +for every LaserJet-compatible model. It constitutes a sort of "least +denominator" of all the models. If for some reason it is ruled out to you to pay for the commercially available ESP Print Pro drivers, your first move should be to consult the database on <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi</a>. Linuxprinting.org has excellent recommendations about which driver is @@ -10755,8 +10319,9 @@ best used for each printer. Its database is kept current by the tireless work of Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft, who is also the principal author of the foomatic-rip utility. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -The former "cupsomatic" concept is now be replaced by the new, much -more powerful "foomatic-rip". foomatic-rip is the successor of +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916407"></a> +The former "cupsomatic" concept is now be replaced by the new, much +more powerful "foomatic-rip". foomatic-rip is the successor of cupsomatic. cupsomatic is no longer maintained. Here is the new URL to the Foomatic-3.0 database:<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi</a>. If you upgrade to foomatic-rip, don't forget to also upgrade to the @@ -10765,7 +10330,7 @@ not work with PPDs generated for the old cupsomatic. The new-style PPDs are 100% compliant to the Adobe PPD specification. They are intended to be used by Samba and the cupsaddsmb utility also, to provide the driver files for the Windows clients also! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944903"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916436"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2916444"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2916452"></a><p> Nowadays most Linux distros rely on the utilities of Linuxprinting.org to create their printing related software (which, BTW, works on all UNIXes and on Mac OS X or Darwin too). It is not known as well as it @@ -10782,63 +10347,63 @@ its <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic.html" target="_top">Foomatic< database. Currently there are <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/driver_list.cgi" target="_top">245 drivers</a> in the database: many drivers support various models, and many models may be driven by different drivers; it's your choice! -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944958"></a>690 "perfect" Printers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -At present there are 690 devices dubbed as working "perfectly", 181 -"mostly", 96 "partially" and 46 are "Paperweights". Keeping in mind +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916477"></a>690 "perfect" Printers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +At present there are 690 devices dubbed as working "perfectly", 181 +"mostly", 96 "partially" and 46 are "Paperweights". Keeping in mind that most of these are non-PostScript models (PostScript printers are automatically supported supported by CUPS to perfection, by using their own manufacturer-provided Windows-PPD...), and that a -multifunctional device never qualifies as working "perfectly" if it +multifunctional device never qualifies as working "perfectly" if it doesn't also scan and copy and fax under GNU/Linux: then this is a truly astonishing achievement. Three years ago the number was not -more than 500, and Linux or UNIX "printing" at the time wasn't +more than 500, and Linux or UNIX "printing" at the time wasn't anywhere near the quality it is today! -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2944982"></a>How the "Printing HOWTO" started it all</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916531"></a>How the "Printing HOWTO" started it all</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A few years ago <a href="http://www2.picante.com:81/~gtaylor/" target="_top">Grant Taylor</a> started it all. The roots of today's Linuxprinting.org are in the first <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/howto/" target="_top">Linux Printing HOWTO</a> which he authored. As a side-project to this document, which served many Linux users and admins to guide their first steps in this complicated and delicate setup (to a scientist, printing is -"applying a structured deposition of distinct patterns of ink or toner -particles on paper substrates" <span class="emphasis"><em>;-)</em></span>, he started to +"applying a structured deposition of distinct patterns of ink or toner +particles on paper substrates" <span class="emphasis"><em>;-)</em></span>, he started to build in a little Postgres database with information about the hardware and driver zoo that made up Linux printing of the time. This database became the core component of today's Foomatic collection of tools and data. In the meantime it has moved to an XML representation of the data. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945028"></a>Foomatic's strange Name</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -"Why the funny name?", you ask. When it really took off, around spring +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916577"></a>Foomatic's strange Name</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2916586"></a><p> +"Why the funny name?", you ask. When it really took off, around spring 2000, CUPS was far less popular than today, and most systems used LPD, -LPRng or even PDQ to print. CUPS shipped with a few generic "drivers" +LPRng or even PDQ to print. CUPS shipped with a few generic "drivers" (good for a few hundred different printer models). These didn't support many device-specific options. CUPS also shipped with its own -built-in rasterization filter ("pstoraster", derived from +built-in rasterization filter ("pstoraster", derived from Ghostscript). On the other hand, CUPS provided brilliant support for <span class="emphasis"><em>controlling</em></span> all printer options through -standardized and well-defined "PPD files" (PostScript Printers +standardized and well-defined "PPD files" (PostScript Printers Description files). Plus, CUPS was designed to be easily extensible. </p><p> Grant already had in his database a respectable compilation -of facts about a many more printers, and the Ghostscript "drivers" +of facts about a many more printers, and the Ghostscript "drivers" they run with. His idea, to generate PPDs from the database info and use them to make standard Ghostscript filters work within CUPS, -proved to work very well. It also "killed several birds with one -stone": +proved to work very well. It also "killed several birds with one +stone": </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>It made all current and future Ghostscript filter developments available for CUPS;</p></li><li><p>It made available a lot of additional printer models -to CUPS users (because often the "traditional" Ghostscript way of +to CUPS users (because often the "traditional" Ghostscript way of printing was the only one available);</p></li><li><p>It gave all the advanced CUPS options (web interface, GUI driver configurations) to users wanting (or needing) to use -Ghostscript filters.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945095"></a>cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Ghostscript filters.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916653"></a>cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2916661"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2916670"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2916678"></a><p> CUPS worked through a quickly-hacked up filter script named <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=cupsomatic&show=0" target="_top">cupsomatic</a>. cupsomatic ran the printfile through Ghostscript, constructing automatically the rather complicated command line needed. It just required to be copied into the CUPS system to make it work. To -"configure" the way cupsomatic controls the Ghostscript rendering +"configure" the way cupsomatic controls the Ghostscript rendering process, it needs a CUPS-PPD. This PPD is generated directly from the contents of the database. For CUPS and the respective printer/filter -combo another Perl script named "CUPS-O-Matic" did the PPD +combo another Perl script named "CUPS-O-Matic" did the PPD generation. After that was working, Grant implemented within a few days a similar thing for two other spoolers. Names chosen for the config-generator scripts were <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=lpdomatic&show=0" target="_top">PDQ-O-Matic</a> @@ -10856,25 +10421,25 @@ printers. He also developed the support for other spoolers, like <a href="http://ppr.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">PPR</a> (via ppromatic), <a href="http://sourceforge.net/projects/lpr/" target="_top">GNUlpr</a> and <a href="http://www.lprng.org/" target="_top">LPRng</a> (both via an extended -lpdomatic) and "spoolerless" printing (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=directomatic&show=0" target="_top">directomatic</a>).... +lpdomatic) and "spoolerless" printing (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/download.cgi?filename=directomatic&show=0" target="_top">directomatic</a>).... </p><p> -So, to answer your question: "Foomatic" is the general name for all -the overlapping code and data behind the "*omatic" scripts.... -- +So, to answer your question: "Foomatic" is the general name for all +the overlapping code and data behind the "*omatic" scripts.... -- Foomatic up to versions 2.0.x required (ugly) Perl data structures attached the Linuxprinting.org PPDs for CUPS. It had a different -"*omatic" script for every spooler, as well as different printer +"*omatic" script for every spooler, as well as different printer configuration files.. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945229"></a>7.13.1.5.The <span class="emphasis"><em>Grand Unification</em></span> -achieved...</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916817"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>Grand Unification</em></span> +achieved...</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2916829"></a><p> This all has changed in Foomatic versions 2.9 (Beta) and released as -"stable" 3.0. This has now achieved the convergence of all *omatic +"stable" 3.0. This has now achieved the convergence of all *omatic scripts: it is called the <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0" target="_top">foomatic-rip</a>. This single script is the unification of the previously different spooler-specific *omatic scripts. foomatic-rip is used by all the different spoolers alike. Because foomatic-rip can read PPDs (both the original PostScript printer PPDs and the Linuxprinting.org-generated ones), all of a sudden all supported spoolers can have the power of -PPDs at their disposal; users only need to plug "foomatic-rip" into +PPDs at their disposal; users only need to plug "foomatic-rip" into their system.... For users there is improved media type and source support; paper sizes and trays are easier to configure. </p><p> @@ -10900,7 +10465,7 @@ sizes for many printers; and it will support printing on media drawn from different paper trays within the same job (in both cases: even where there is no support for this from Windows-based vendor printer drivers). -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945316"></a>Driver Development outside</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916912"></a>Driver Development outside</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Most driver development itself does not happen within Linuxprinting.org. Drivers are written by independent maintainers. Linuxprinting.org just pools all the information, and stores it in its @@ -10913,7 +10478,7 @@ the work is currently done in three projects. These are: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="http://www-124.ibm.com/developerworks/oss/linux/projects/omni/" target="_top">Omni</a> -- a Free Software project by IBM which tries to convert their printer driver knowledge from good-ol' OS/2 times into a modern, modular, -universal driver architecture for Linux/Unix (still Beta). This +universal driver architecture for Linux/UNIX (still Beta). This currently supports 437 models.</p></li><li><p><a href="http://hpinkjet.sf.net/" target="_top">HPIJS</a> -- a Free Software project by HP to provide the support for their own range of models (very mature, printing in most cases is perfect and @@ -10923,9 +10488,9 @@ effort, started by Michael Sweet (also lead developer for CUPS), now directed by Robert Krawitz, which has achieved an amazing level of photo print quality (many Epson users swear that its quality is better than the vendor drivers provided by Epson for the Microsoft -platforms). This currently supports 522 models.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945397"></a>Forums, Downloads, Tutorials, Howtos -- also for Mac OS X and -commercial Unix</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Linuxprinting.org today is the one-stop "shop" to download printer +platforms). This currently supports 522 models.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2916991"></a>Forums, Downloads, Tutorials, Howtos -- also for Mac OS X and +commercial UNIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Linuxprinting.org today is the one-stop "shop" to download printer drivers. Look for printer information and <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org//kpfeifle/LinuxKongress2002/Tutorial/" target="_top">tutorials</a> or solve printing problems in its popular <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/newsportal/" target="_top">forums</a>. But it's not just for GNU/Linux: users and admins of <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/macosx/" target="_top">commercial UNIX @@ -10944,17 +10509,17 @@ of the Foomatic project. Till Kamppeter from MandrakeSoft is doing an excellent job in his spare time to maintain Linuxprinting.org and Foomatic. So if you use it often, please send him a note showing your appreciation. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2945467"></a>Foomatic Database generated PPDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2917064"></a>Foomatic Database generated PPDs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Foomatic database is an amazing piece of ingenuity in itself. Not only does it keep the printer and driver information, but it is -organized in a way that it can generate "PPD" files "on the fly" from +organized in a way that it can generate "PPD" files "on the fly" from its internal XML-based datasets. While these PPDs are modelled to the -Adobe specification of "PostScript Printer Descriptions" (PPDs), the +Adobe specification of "PostScript Printer Descriptions" (PPDs), the Linuxprinting.org/Foomatic-PPDs don't normally drive PostScript printers: they are used to describe all the bells and whistles you could ring or blow on an Epson Stylus inkjet, or a HP Photosmart or -what-have-you. The main "trick" is one little additional line, not -envisaged by the PPD specification, starting with the "*cupsFilter" +what-have-you. The main "trick" is one little additional line, not +envisaged by the PPD specification, starting with the "*cupsFilter" keyword: it tells the CUPS daemon how to proceed with the PostScript print file (old-style Foomatic-PPDs named the <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsomatic</em></span> filter script, while the new-style @@ -10965,12 +10530,12 @@ filter or internal device setting it should ask from Ghostscript to convert the PostScript printjob into a raster format ready for the target device. This usage of PPDs to describe the options of non-PS printers was the invention of the CUPS developers. The rest is easy: -GUI tools (like KDE's marvellous <a href="http://printing.kde.org/overview/kprinter.phtml" target="_top">"kprinter"</a>, -or the GNOME <a href="http://gtklp.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">"gtklp"</a>, "xpp" and the CUPS +GUI tools (like KDE's marvellous <a href="http://printing.kde.org/overview/kprinter.phtml" target="_top">"kprinter"</a>, +or the GNOME <a href="http://gtklp.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">"gtklp"</a>, "xpp" and the CUPS web interface) read the PPD too and use this information to present the available settings to the user as an intuitive menu selection. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2945532"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Here are the steps to install a foomatic-rip driven "LaserJet 4 Plus" +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917129"></a>foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Here are the steps to install a foomatic-rip driven "LaserJet 4 Plus" compatible printer in CUPS (note that recent distributions of SuSE, UnitedLinux and Mandrake may ship with a complete package of Foomatic-PPDs plus the foomatic-rip utility. going directly to @@ -10982,12 +10547,12 @@ Linuxprinting.org ensures you to get the latest driver/PPD files): link.</p></li><li><p>You'll arrive at a page listing all drivers working with this model (for all printers, there will always be <span class="emphasis"><em>one</em></span> recommended driver. Try this one -first).</p></li><li><p>In our case ("HP LaserJet 4 Plus"), we'll arrive here: -<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus</a> -</p></li><li><p>The recommended driver is "ljet4".</p></li><li><p>There are several links provided here. You should +first).</p></li><li><p>In our case ("HP LaserJet 4 Plus"), we'll arrive here: + <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_printer.cgi?recnum=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus</a> +</p></li><li><p>The recommended driver is "ljet4".</p></li><li><p>There are several links provided here. You should visit them all, if you are not familiar with the Linuxprinting.org -database.</p></li><li><p>There is a link to the database page for the "ljet4": -<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4</a> +database.</p></li><li><p>There is a link to the database page for the "ljet4": + <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4</a> On the driver's page, you'll find important and detailed information about how to use that driver within the various available spoolers.</p></li><li><p>Another link may lead you to the homepage of the @@ -10996,7 +10561,7 @@ setup instructions for CUPS (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/cups-doc.html PDQ (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/pdq-doc.html" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/pdq-doc.html</a>), LPD, LPRng and GNUlpr (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/lpd-doc.html" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/lpd-doc.html</a>) as well as PPR (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppr-doc.html" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppr-doc.html)</a> -or "spooler-less" printing (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/direct-doc.html" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/direct-doc.html</a> +or "spooler-less" printing (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/direct-doc.html" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/direct-doc.html</a> ).</p></li><li><p>You can view the PPD in your browser through this link: <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppd-o-matic.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus&show=1" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/ppd-o-matic.cgi?driver=ljet4&printer=HP-LaserJet_4_Plus&show=1</a> </p></li><li><p>You can also (most importantly) @@ -11006,18 +10571,18 @@ model and the driver; this is, once installed, working transparently for the user. Later you'll only need to choose resolution, paper size etc. from the web-based menu, or from the print dialog GUI, or from the commandline.</p></li><li><p>Should you have ended up on the driver's page (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/show_driver.cgi?driver=ljet4</a>), -you can choose to use the "PPD-O-Matic" online PPD generator -program.</p></li><li><p>Select the exact model and check either "download" or -"display PPD file" and click on "Generate PPD file".</p></li><li><p>If you save the PPD file from the browser view, please -don't use "cut'n'past" (since it could possibly damage line endings -and tabs, which makes the PPD likely to fail its duty), but use "Save -as..." in your browser's menu. (Best is to use the "download" option +you can choose to use the "PPD-O-Matic" online PPD generator +program.</p></li><li><p>Select the exact model and check either "download" or +"display PPD file" and click on "Generate PPD file".</p></li><li><p>If you save the PPD file from the browser view, please +don't use "cut'n'past" (since it could possibly damage line endings +and tabs, which makes the PPD likely to fail its duty), but use "Save +as..." in your browser's menu. (Best is to use the "download" option from the web page directly).</p></li><li><p>Another very interesting part on each driver page is the <span class="emphasis"><em>Show execution details</em></span> button. If you select your printer model and click that button, you will get displayed a complete Ghostscript command line, enumerating all options available for that driver/printermodel combo. This is a great way to -"Learn Ghostscript By Doing". It is also an excellent "cheat sheet" +"Learn Ghostscript By Doing". It is also an excellent "cheat sheet" for all experienced users who need to re-construct a good command line for that damn printing script, but can't remember the exact syntax. ;-)</p></li><li><p>Some time during your visit to Linuxprinting.org, save @@ -11028,12 +10593,10 @@ the <tt class="filename">/usr/share/cups/model/</tt> path and re-start cupsd).</p></li><li><p>Then install the printer with a suitable commandline, e.g.: </p><pre class="screen"> - -lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -P path/to/my-printer.ppd - -</pre></li><li><p>Note again this: for all the new-style "Foomatic-PPDs" -from Linuxprinting.org, you also need a special "CUPS filter" named -"foomatic-rip".Get the latest version of "foomatic-rip" from: <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0</a> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p laserjet4plus -v parallel:/dev/lp0 -E -P path/to/my-printer.ppd</tt></b> +</pre></li><li><p>Note again this: for all the new-style "Foomatic-PPDs" +from Linuxprinting.org, you also need a special "CUPS filter" named +"foomatic-rip".Get the latest version of "foomatic-rip" from: <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=0</a> </p></li><li><p>The foomatic-rip Perlscript itself also makes some interesting reading (<a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=1" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/foomatic2.9/download.cgi?filename=foomatic-rip&show=1</a>), because it is very well documented by Till's inline comments (even @@ -11041,8 +10604,8 @@ non-Perl hackers will learn quite a bit about printing by reading it... ;-)</p></li><li><p>Save foomatic-rip either directly in <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/filter/foomatic-rip</tt> or somewhere in your $PATH (and don't forget to make it world-executable). Again, -don't save by "copy'n'paste" but use the appropriate link, or the -"Save as..." menu item in your browser.</p></li><li><p>If you save foomatic-rip in your $PATH, create a symlink: +don't save by "copy'n'paste" but use the appropriate link, or the +"Save as..." menu item in your browser.</p></li><li><p>If you save foomatic-rip in your $PATH, create a symlink: <b class="command">cd /usr/lib/cups/filter/ ; ln -s `which foomatic-rip`</b>. For CUPS to discover this new available filter at startup, you need to re-start @@ -11058,18 +10621,18 @@ data should look like and which printer commands to embed into the data stream. </p><p> You need: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A "foomatic+something" PPD -- but it this not enough +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A "foomatic+something" PPD -- but it this not enough to print with CUPS (it is only <span class="emphasis"><em>one</em></span> important -component)</p></li><li><p>The "foomatic-rip" filter script (Perl) in +component)</p></li><li><p>The "foomatic-rip" filter script (Perl) in /usr/lib/cups/filters/</p></li><li><p>Perl to make foomatic-rip run</p></li><li><p>Ghostscript (because it is doing the main work, controlled by the PPD/foomatic-rip combo) to produce the raster data fit for your printermodel's consumption</p></li><li><p>Ghostscript <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> (depending on -the driver/model) contain support for a certain "device", representing -the selected "driver" for your model (as shown by "gs --h")</p></li><li><p>foomatic-rip needs a new version of PPDs (PPD versions +the driver/model) contain support for a certain "device", representing +the selected "driver" for your model (as shown by "gs +-h")</p></li><li><p>foomatic-rip needs a new version of PPDs (PPD versions produced for cupsomatic don't work with -foomatic-rip).</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945993"></a>Page Accounting with CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Often there are questions regarding "print quotas" wherein Samba users +foomatic-rip).</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917602"></a>Page Accounting with CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2917611"></a><p> +Often there are questions regarding "print quotas" wherein Samba users (that is, Windows clients) should not be able to print beyond a certain amount of pages or data volume per day, week or month. This feature is dependent on the real print subsystem you're using. @@ -11077,58 +10640,57 @@ Samba's part is always to receive the job files from the clients (filtered <span class="emphasis"><em>or</em></span> unfiltered) and hand it over to this printing subsystem. </p><p> -Of course one could "hack" things with one's own scripts. But then -there is CUPS. CUPS supports "quotas" which can be based on sizes of +Of course one could "hack" things with one's own scripts. But then +there is CUPS. CUPS supports "quotas" which can be based on sizes of jobs or on the number of pages or both, and are spanning any time period you want. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946024"></a>Setting up Quotas</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917645"></a>Setting up Quotas</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2917653"></a><p> This is an example command how root would set a print quota in CUPS, -assuming an existing printer named "quotaprinter": -</p><pre class="screen"> - - lpadmin -p quotaprinter -o job-quota-period=604800 -o job-k-limit=1024 -o job-page-limit=100 - +assuming an existing printer named "quotaprinter": +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2917671"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p quotaprinter -o job-quota-period=604800 \ + -o job-k-limit=1024 -o job-page-limit=100</tt></b> </pre><p> This would limit every single user to print 100 pages or 1024 KB of data (whichever comes first) within the last 604,800 seconds ( = 1 week). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946056"></a>Correct and incorrect Accounting</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917708"></a>Correct and incorrect Accounting</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For CUPS to count correctly, the printfile needs to pass the CUPS -"pstops" filter, otherwise it uses a "dummy" count of "1". Some +"pstops" filter, otherwise it uses a "dummy" count of "1". Some printfiles don't pass it (eg: image files) but then those are mostly 1 page jobs anyway. This also means that proprietary drivers for the target printer running on the client computers and CUPS/Samba, which -then spool these files as "raw" (i.e. leaving them untouched, not -filtering them), will be counted as "1-pagers" too! +then spool these files as "raw" (i.e. leaving them untouched, not +filtering them), will be counted as "1-pagers" too! </p><p> You need to send PostScript from the clients (i.e. run a PostScript driver there) to have the chance to get accounting done. If the printer is a non-PostScript model, you need to let CUPS do the job to convert the file to a print-ready format for the target printer. This will be working for currently about 1,000 different printer models, -see <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi" target="_top">http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi</a>). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946097"></a>Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +see <a href="http://www.linuxprinting.org/printer_list.cgi" target="_top">the driver list at linuxprinting.org/</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917748"></a>Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before CUPS-1.1.16 your only option was to use the Adobe PostScript Driver on the Windows clients. The output of this driver was not -always passed through the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba side, and +always passed through the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba side, and therefore was not counted correctly (the reason is that it often, -depending on the "PPD" being used, wrote a "PJL"-header in front of +depending on the "PPD" being used, wrote a "PJL"-header in front of the real PostScript which caused CUPS to skip pstops and go directly -to the "pstoraster" stage). +to the "pstoraster" stage). </p><p> -From CUPS-1.1.16 onward you can use the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2K/XP clients" (which is tagged in the download area of -http://www.cups.org/ as the "cups-samba-1.1.16.tar.gz" package). It does +From CUPS-1.1.16 onward you can use the "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2K/XP clients" (which is tagged in the download area of +http://www.cups.org/ as the "cups-samba-1.1.16.tar.gz" package). It does <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> work for Win9x/ME clients. But it guarantees: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>to not write an PJL-header</p></li><li><p>to still read and support all PJL-options named in the -driver PPD with its own means</p></li><li><p> that the file will pass through the "pstops" filter +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917786"></a><ul type="disc"><li><p>to not write an PJL-header</p></li><li><p>to still read and support all PJL-options named in the +driver PPD with its own means</p></li><li><p> that the file will pass through the "pstops" filter on the CUPS/Samba server</p></li><li><p>to page-count correctly the printfile</p></li></ul></div><p> You can read more about the setup of this combination in the manpage -for "cupsaddsmb" (which is only present with CUPS installed, and only +for "cupsaddsmb" (which is only present with CUPS installed, and only current from CUPS 1.1.16). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946169"></a>The page_log File Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -These are the items CUPS logs in the "page_log" for every +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917829"></a>The page_log File Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2917838"></a><p> +These are the items CUPS logs in the "page_log" for every single <span class="emphasis"><em>page</em></span> of a job: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Printer name</p></li><li><p>User name</p></li><li><p>Job ID</p></li><li><p>Time of printing</p></li><li><p>the page number</p></li><li><p>the number of copies</p></li><li><p>a billing information string (optional)</p></li><li><p>the host which sent the job (included since version @@ -11136,103 +10698,93 @@ single <span class="emphasis"><em>page</em></span> of a job: Here is an extract of my CUPS server's page_log file to illustrate the format and included items: </p><pre class="screen"> - - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 1 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 2 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 3 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 4 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 - DigiMaster9110 boss 402 [22/Apr/2003:10:33:22 +0100] 1 440 finance-dep 10.160.51.33 - -</pre><p> -This was job ID "401", printed on "infotec_IS2027" by user "kurt", a -64-page job printed in 3 copies and billed to "#marketing", sent -from IP address 10.160.50.13. The next job had ID "402", was sent by -user "boss" from IP address 10.160.51.33,printed from one page 440 -copies and is set to be billed to "finance-dep". -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946270"></a>Possible Shortcomings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 1 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 2 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 3 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +infotec_IS2027 kurt 401 [22/Apr/2003:10:28:43 +0100] 4 3 #marketing 10.160.50.13 +DigiMaster9110 boss 402 [22/Apr/2003:10:33:22 +0100] 1 440 finance-dep 10.160.51.33 +</pre><p> +This was job ID "401", printed on "infotec_IS2027" by user "kurt", a +64-page job printed in 3 copies and billed to "#marketing", sent +from IP address 10.160.50.13. The next job had ID "402", was sent by +user "boss" from IP address 10.160.51.33,printed from one page 440 +copies and is set to be billed to "finance-dep". +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917938"></a>Possible Shortcomings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> What flaws or shortcomings are there with this quota system? </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the ones named above (wrongly logged job in case of printer hardware failure, etc.)</p></li><li><p>in reality, CUPS counts the job pages that are being processed in <span class="emphasis"><em>software</em></span> (that is, going through the -"RIP") rather than the physical sheets successfully leaving the +"RIP") rather than the physical sheets successfully leaving the printing device. Thus if there is a jam while printing the 5th sheet out -of 1000 and the job is aborted by the printer, the "page count" will +of 1000 and the job is aborted by the printer, the "page count" will still show the figure of 1000 for that job</p></li><li><p>all quotas are the same for all users (no flexibility -to give the boss a higher quota than the clerk) no support for +to give the boss a higher quota than the clerk), no support for groups</p></li><li><p>no means to read out the current balance or the -"used-up" number of current quota</p></li><li><p>a user having used up 99 sheets of 100 quota will +"used-up" number of current quota</p></li><li><p>a user having used up 99 sheets of 100 quota will still be able to send and print a 1,000 sheet job</p></li><li><p>a user being denied a job because of a filled-up quota doesn't get a meaningful error message from CUPS other than -"client-error-not-possible".</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946341"></a>Future Developments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"client-error-not-possible".</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918010"></a>Future Developments</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is the best system currently available, and there are huge improvements under development for CUPS 1.2: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>page counting will go into the "backends" (these talk +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>page counting will go into the "backends" (these talk directly to the printer and will increase the count in sync with the actual printing process: thus a jam at the 5th sheet will lead to a stop in the counting)</p></li><li><p>quotas will be handled more flexibly</p></li><li><p>probably there will be support for users to inquire -their "accounts" in advance</p></li><li><p>probably there will be support for some other tools -around this topic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946390"></a>Other Accounting Tools</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +their "accounts" in advance</p></li><li><p>probably there will be support for some other tools +around this topic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918058"></a>Other Accounting Tools</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> PrintAnalyzer, pyKota, printbill, LogReport. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946404"></a>Additional Material</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918072"></a>Additional Material</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A printer queue with <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> PPD associated to it is a -"raw" printer and all files will go directly there as received by the -spooler. The exceptions are file types "application/octet-stream" -which need "passthrough feature" enabled. "Raw" queues don't do any +"raw" printer and all files will go directly there as received by the +spooler. The exceptions are file types "application/octet-stream" +which need "passthrough feature" enabled. "Raw" queues don't do any filtering at all, they hand the file directly to the CUPS backend. This backend is responsible for the sending of the data to the device -(as in the "device URI" notation: <tt class="filename">lpd://, socket://, +(as in the "device URI" notation: <tt class="filename">lpd://, socket://, smb://, ipp://, http://, parallel:/, serial:/, usb:/</tt> etc.) </p><p> -"cupsomatic"/Foomatic are <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> native CUPS drivers +"cupsomatic"/Foomatic are <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> native CUPS drivers and they don't ship with CUPS. They are a Third Party add-on, developed at Linuxprinting.org. As such, they are a brilliant hack to make all models (driven by Ghostscript drivers/filters in traditional spoolers) also work via CUPS, with the same (good or bad!) quality as -in these other spoolers. "cupsomatic" is only a vehicle to execute a +in these other spoolers. "cupsomatic" is only a vehicle to execute a ghostscript commandline at that stage in the CUPS filtering chain, -where "normally" the native CUPS "pstoraster" filter would kick -in. cupsomatic by-passes pstoraster, "kidnaps" the printfile from CUPS +where "normally" the native CUPS "pstoraster" filter would kick +in. cupsomatic by-passes pstoraster, "kidnaps" the printfile from CUPS away and re-directs it to go through Ghostscript. CUPS accepts this, because the associated CUPS-O-Matic-/Foomatic-PPD specifies: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + *cupsFilter: "application/vnd.cups-postscript 0 cupsomatic" </pre><p> This line persuades CUPS to hand the file to cupsomatic, once it has successfully converted it to the MIME type -"application/vnd.cups-postscript". This conversion will not happen for +"application/vnd.cups-postscript". This conversion will not happen for Jobs arriving from Windows which are auto-typed -"application/octet-stream", with the according changes in +"application/octet-stream", with the according changes in <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> in place. </p><p> CUPS is widely configurable and flexible, even regarding its filtering mechanism. Another workaround in some situations would be to have in <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/mime.types</tt> entries as follows: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - application/postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + application/postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - + application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - </pre><p> This would prevent all Postscript files from being filtered (rather, they will through the virtual <span class="emphasis"><em>nullfilter</em></span> -denoted with "-"). This could only be useful for PS printers. If you +denoted with "-"). This could only be useful for PS printers. If you want to print PS code on non-PS printers (provided they support ASCII text printing) an entry as follows could be useful: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - */* application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> + */* application/vnd.cups-raw 0 - </pre><p> and would effectively send <span class="emphasis"><em>all</em></span> files to the backend without further processing. </p><p> Lastly, you could have the following entry: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 my_PJL_stripping_filter - +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +application/vnd.cups-postscript application/vnd.cups-raw 0 my_PJL_stripping_filter </pre><p> You will need to write a <span class="emphasis"><em>my_PJL_stripping_filter</em></span> (could be a shellscript) that parses the PostScript and removes the @@ -11241,39 +10793,38 @@ unwanted PJL. This would need to conform to CUPS filter design username, jobtitle, copies, print options and possibly the filename). It would be installed as world executable into <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/filters/</tt> and will be called by CUPS -if it encounters a MIME type "application/vnd.cups-postscript". +if it encounters a MIME type "application/vnd.cups-postscript". </p><p> CUPS can handle <span class="emphasis"><em>-o job-hold-until=indefinite</em></span>. -This keeps the job in the queue "on hold". It will only be printed +This keeps the job in the queue "on hold". It will only be printed upon manual release by the printer operator. This is a requirement in -many "central reproduction departments", where a few operators manage +many "central reproduction departments", where a few operators manage the jobs of hundreds of users on some big machine, where no user is allowed to have direct access (such as when the operators often need to load the proper paper type before running the 10,000 page job requested by marketing for the mailing, etc.). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946598"></a>Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba print files pass through two "spool" directories. One is the -incoming directory managed by Samba, (set in the <span class="emphasis"><em>path = -/var/spool/samba</em></span> directive in the -<span class="emphasis"><em>[printers]</em></span> section of +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918267"></a>Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba print files pass through two "spool" directories. One is the +incoming directory managed by Samba, (set in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918280"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba directive in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). The other is the spool directory of your UNIX print subsystem. For CUPS it is normally <tt class="filename">/var/spool/cups/</tt>, as set by the cupsd.conf directive <tt class="filename">RequestRoot /var/spool/cups</tt>. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946644"></a>CUPS Configuration Settings explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918326"></a>CUPS Configuration Settings explained</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Some important parameter settings in the CUPS configuration file <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">PreserveJobHistory Yes</span></dt><dd><p> This keeps some details of jobs in cupsd's mind (well it keeps the -"c12345", "c12346" etc. files in the CUPS spool directory, which do a +"c12345", "c12346" etc. files in the CUPS spool directory, which do a similar job as the old-fashioned BSD-LPD control files). This is set -to "Yes" as a default. +to "Yes" as a default. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">PreserveJobFiles Yes</span></dt><dd><p> This keeps the job files themselves in cupsd's mind -(well it keeps the "d12345", "d12346" etc. files in the CUPS spool -directory...). This is set to "No" as the CUPS +(well it keeps the "d12345", "d12346" etc. files in the CUPS spool +directory...). This is set to "No" as the CUPS default. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="emphasis"><em>"MaxJobs 500"</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="emphasis"><em>"MaxJobs 500"</em></span></span></dt><dd><p> This directive controls the maximum number of jobs that are kept in memory. Once the number of jobs reaches the limit, the oldest completed job is automatically purged from the system to @@ -11282,98 +10833,86 @@ pending or active then the new job will be rejected. Setting the maximum to 0 disables this functionality. The default setting is 0. </p></dd></dl></div><p> -(There are also additional settings for "MaxJobsPerUser" and -"MaxJobsPerPrinter"...) -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946726"></a>Pre-conditions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +(There are also additional settings for "MaxJobsPerUser" and +"MaxJobsPerPrinter"...) +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918407"></a>Pre-conditions</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For everything to work as announced, you need to have three things: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a Samba-smbd which is compiled against "libcups" (Check -on Linux by running "ldd `which smbd`")</p></li><li><p>a Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of -"printing = cups"</p></li><li><p>another Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of -"printcap = cups"</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a Samba-smbd which is compiled against "libcups" (Check +on Linux by running "ldd `which smbd`")</p></li><li><p>a Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of + <a class="indexterm" name="id2918443"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups</p></li><li><p>another Samba-<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> setting of + <a class="indexterm" name="id2918469"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> In this case all other manually set printing-related commands (like -"print command", "lpq command", "lprm command", "lppause command" or -"lpresume command") are ignored and they should normally have no +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918490"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918504"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918518"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918532"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i> or +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918546"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>) are ignored and they should normally have no influence what-so-ever on your printing. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946787"></a>Manual Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you want to do things manually, replace the "printing = -cups" by "printing = bsd". Then your manually set commands may work -(haven't tested this), and a "print command = lp -d %P %s; rm %s" +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918564"></a>Manual Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you want to do things manually, replace the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918574"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = cups +by <a class="indexterm" name="id2918588"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd. Then your manually set commands may work +(haven't tested this), and a <a class="indexterm" name="id2918604"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> = lp -d %P %s; rm %s" may do what you need. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946805"></a>When <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> to use Samba to print to -CUPS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946822"></a>In Case of Trouble.....</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918622"></a>In Case of Trouble.....</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you have more problems, post the output of these commands to the CUPS or Samba mailing lists (choose the one which seems more relevant to your problem): </p><pre class="screen"> - - grep -v ^# /etc/cups/cupsd.conf | grep -v ^$ - grep -v ^# /etc/samba/smb.conf | grep -v ^$ | grep -v "^;" - +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -v ^# /etc/cups/cupsd.conf | grep -v ^$</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>grep -v ^# /etc/samba/smb.conf | grep -v ^$ | grep -v "^;"</tt></b> </pre><p> (adapt paths as needed). These commands leave out the empty -lines and lines with comments, providing the "naked settings" in a +lines and lines with comments, providing the "naked settings" in a compact way. Don't forget to name the CUPS and Samba versions you are using! This saves bandwidth and makes for easier readability for experts (and you are expecting experts to read them, right? ;-) -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946857"></a>Where to find Documentation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946870"></a>How to ask for Help</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946883"></a>Where to find Help</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -[TO BE DONE] -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2946896"></a>Appendix</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2946904"></a>Printing <span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918682"></a>Printing <span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> From time to time the question arises, how you can print <span class="emphasis"><em>to</em></span> a Windows attached printer <span class="emphasis"><em>from</em></span> Samba. Normally the local connection -"Windows host <--> printer" would be done by USB or parallel +from Windows host to printer would be done by USB or parallel cable, but this doesn't matter to Samba. From here only an SMB connection needs to be opened to the Windows host. Of course, this -printer must be "shared" first. As you have learned by now, CUPS uses +printer must be "shared" first. As you have learned by now, CUPS uses <span class="emphasis"><em>backends</em></span> to talk to printers and other servers. To talk to Windows shared printers you need to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>smb</em></span> (surprise, surprise!) backend. Check if this is in the CUPS backend directory. This resides usually in -<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/backend/</tt>. You need to find a "smb" +<tt class="filename">/usr/lib/cups/backend/</tt>. You need to find a "smb" file there. It should be a symlink to <tt class="filename">smbspool</tt> which file must exist and be executable: </p><pre class="screen"> - - # ls -l /usr/lib/cups/backend/ - total 253 - drwxr-xr-x 3 root root 720 Apr 30 19:04 . - drwxr-xr-x 6 root root 125 Dec 19 17:13 .. - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 canon - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 epson - lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 3 Apr 17 22:50 http -> ipp - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 17316 Apr 17 22:50 ipp - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 15420 Apr 20 17:01 lpd - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 8656 Apr 20 17:01 parallel - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 2162 Mar 31 23:15 pdfdistiller - lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 25 Apr 30 19:04 ptal -> /usr/local/sbin/ptal-cups - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 6284 Apr 20 17:01 scsi - lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 17 Apr 2 03:11 smb -> /usr/bin/smbspool - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 7912 Apr 20 17:01 socket - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 9012 Apr 20 17:01 usb - -# ls -l `which smbspool` - -rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 563245 Dec 28 14:49 /usr/bin/smbspool - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l /usr/lib/cups/backend/</tt></b> +total 253 +drwxr-xr-x 3 root root 720 Apr 30 19:04 . +drwxr-xr-x 6 root root 125 Dec 19 17:13 .. +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 canon +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 10692 Feb 16 21:29 epson +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 3 Apr 17 22:50 http -> ipp +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 17316 Apr 17 22:50 ipp +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 15420 Apr 20 17:01 lpd +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 8656 Apr 20 17:01 parallel +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 2162 Mar 31 23:15 pdfdistiller +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 25 Apr 30 19:04 ptal -> /usr/sbin/ptal-cups +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 6284 Apr 20 17:01 scsi +lrwxrwxrwx 1 root root 17 Apr 2 03:11 smb -> /usr/bin/smbspool +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 7912 Apr 20 17:01 socket +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 9012 Apr 20 17:01 usb + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ls -l `which smbspool`</tt></b> +-rwxr-xr-x 1 root root 563245 Dec 28 14:49 /usr/bin/smbspool </pre><p> If this symlink doesn't exist, create it: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# ln -s `which smbspool` /usr/lib/cups/backend/smb - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s `which smbspool` /usr/lib/cups/backend/smb</tt></b> </pre><p> smbspool has been written by Mike Sweet from the CUPS folks. It is included and ships with Samba. It may also be used with print subsystems other than CUPS, to spool jobs to Windows printer shares. To -set up printer "winprinter" on CUPS, you need to have a "driver" for +set up printer "winprinter" on CUPS, you need to have a "driver" for it. Essentially this means to convert the print data on the CUPS/Samba host to a format that the printer can digest (the Windows host is unable to convert any files you may send). This also means you should @@ -11385,9 +10924,8 @@ the Windows host, etc. </p><p> To install a printer with the smb backend on CUPS, use this command: </p><pre class="screen"> - -# lpadmin -p winprinter -v smb://WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename -P /path/to/PPD - +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>lpadmin -p winprinter -v smb://WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename \ + -P /path/to/PPD</tt></b> </pre><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>PPD</em></span> must be able to direct CUPS to generate the print data for the target model. For PostScript printers just use @@ -11396,13 +10934,7 @@ what can you do if the printer is only accessible with a password? Or if the printer's host is part of another workgroup? This is provided for: you can include the required parameters as part of the <tt class="filename">smb://</tt> device-URI. Like this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - - smb://WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename - smb://username:password@WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename - smb://username:password@WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename - -</pre><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>smb://WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename </p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@WORKGROUP/WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@WINDOWSNETBIOSNAME/printersharename</p></li></ul></div><p> Note that the device-URI will be visible in the process list of the Samba server (e.g. when someone uses the <b class="command">ps -aux</b> command on Linux), even if the username and passwords are sanitized @@ -11413,337 +10945,41 @@ doesn't require a password! Printing will only work if you have a working netbios name resolution up and running. Note that this is a feature of CUPS and you don't necessarily need to have smbd running (but who wants that? :-). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947118"></a>More CUPS filtering Chains</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918955"></a>More CUPS filtering Chains</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following diagrams reveal how CUPS handles print jobs. -</p><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# CUPS in and of itself has this (general) filter chain (CAPITAL -# letters are FILE-FORMATS or MIME types, other are filters (this is -# true for pre-1.1.15 of pre-4.3 versions of CUPS and ESP PrintPro): -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstoraster # as shipped with CUPS, independent from any Ghostscipt -# | # installation on the system -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER -# | -# V -# rastertosomething (e.g. Gimp-Print filters may be plugged in here) -# | (= "raster driver") -# V -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC -# | -# V -# backend -# -# -# ESP PrintPro has some enhanced "rastertosomething" filters as compared to -# CUPS, and also a somewhat improved "pstoraster" filter. -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# This is how "cupsomatic" comes into play: -# ========================================= -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT ----------------+ -# | V -# V cupsomatic -# pstoraster (constructs complicated -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") Ghostscript commandline -# | to let the file be -# V processed by a -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER "-sDEVICE=s.th." -# | call...) -# V | -# rastertosomething V -# | (= "raster driver") +-------------------------+ -# | | Ghostscript at work.... | -# V | | -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC *-------------------------+ -# | | -# V | -# backend <------------------------------------+ -# | -# V -# THE PRINTER -# -# -# Note, that cupsomatic "kidnaps" the printfile after the -# "APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRPT" stage and deviates it gh -# the CUPS-external, systemwide Ghostscript installation, bypassing the -# "pstoraster" filter (therefore also bypassing the CUPS-raster-drivers -# "rastertosomething", and hands the rasterized file directly to the CUPS -# backend... -# -# cupsomatic is not made by the CUPS developers. It is an independent -# contribution to printing development, made by people from -# Linuxprinting.org. (see also http://www.cups.org/cups-help.html) -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# And this is how it works for ESP PrintPro from 4.3: -# =================================================== -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# gsrip -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER -# | -# V -# rastertosomething (e.g. Gimp-Print filters may be plugged in here) -# | (= "raster driver") -# V -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC -# | -# V -# backend -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# This is how "cupsomatic" would come into play with ESP PrintPro: -# ================================================================ -# -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT ----------------+ -# | V -# V cupsomatic -# gsrip (constructs complicated -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") Ghostscript commandline -# | to let the file be -# V processed by a -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER "-sDEVICE=s.th." -# | call...) -# V | -# rastertosomething V -# | (= "raster driver") +-------------------------+ -# | | Ghostscript at work.... | -# V | | -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC *-------------------------+ -# | | -# V | -# backend <------------------------------------+ -# | -# V -# THE PRINTER -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# And this is how it works for CUPS from 1.1.15: -# ============================================== -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT-----+ -# +------------------v------------------------------+ -# | Ghostscript | -# | at work... | -# | (with | -# | "-sDEVICE=cups") | -# | | -# | (= "postscipt interpreter") | -# | | -# +------------------v------------------------------+ -# | -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER >-------+ -# | -# V -# rastertosomething -# | (= "raster driver") -# V -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC -# | -# V -# backend -# -# -# NOTE: since version 1.1.15 CUPS "outsourced" the pstoraster process to -# Ghostscript. GNU Ghostscript needs to be patched to handle the -# CUPS requirement; ESP Ghostscript has this builtin. In any case, -# "gs -h" needs to show up a "cups" device. pstoraster is now a -# calling an appropriate "gs -sDEVICE=cups..." commandline to do -# the job. It will output "application/vnd.cup-raster", which will -# be finally processed by a CUPS raster driver "rastertosomething" -# Note the difference to "cupsomatic", which will <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> output -# CUPS-raster, but a final version of the printfile, ready to be -# sent to the printer. cupsomatic also doesn't use the "cups" -# devicemode in Ghostscript, but one of the classical devicemodes.... -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -######################################################################### -</pre><pre class="screen"> -######################################################################### -# -# And this is how it works for CUPS from 1.1.15, with cupsomatic included: -# ======================================================================== -# -# SOMETHNG-FILEFORMAT -# | -# V -# somethingtops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/POSTSCRIPT -# | -# V -# pstops -# | -# V -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-POSTSCRIPT-----+ -# +------------------v------------------------------+ -# | Ghostscript . Ghostscript at work.... | -# | at work... . (with "-sDEVICE= | -# | (with . s.th." | -# | "-sDEVICE=cups") . | -# | . | -# | (CUPS standard) . (cupsomatic) | -# | . | -# | (= "postscript interpreter") | -# | . | -# +------------------v--------------v---------------+ -# | | -# APPLICATION/VND.CUPS-RASTER >-------+ | -# | | -# V | -# rastertosomething | -# | (= "raster driver") | -# V | -# SOMETHING-DEVICE-SPECIFIC >------------------------+ -# | -# V -# backend -# -# -# NOTE: Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to -# CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. -# -########################################################################## -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2947424"></a>Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -This is a short description of how to debug printing problems -with Samba. This describes how to debug problems with printing from -a SMB client to a Samba server, not the other way around. -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Win9x client can't install driver</span></dt><dd><p>For Win9x clients require the printer names to be 8 -chars (or "8 plus 3 chars suffix") max; otherwise the driver files +</p><div class="figure"><a name="cups1"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.17. Filtering chain 1</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/cups1.png" width="270" alt="Filtering chain 1"></div></div><div class="figure"><a name="cups2"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.18. Filtering chain with cupsomatic</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/cups2.png" width="270" alt="Filtering chain with cupsomatic"></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Gimp-Print and some other 3rd-Party-Filters (like TurboPrint) to +CUPS and ESP PrintPro plug-in where rastertosomething is noted. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2796634"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2796642"></a>Win9x client can't install driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>For Win9x clients require the printer names to be 8 +chars (or "8 plus 3 chars suffix") max; otherwise the driver files won't get transferred when you want to download them from -Samba.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">testparm</span></dt><dd><p>Run <b class="command">testparm</b>: It will tell you if -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters are in the wrong -section. Many people have had the "printer admin" parameter in the -<i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section and experienced -problems. "testparm" will tell you if it sees -this.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for a root password in a -neverending loop</span></dt><dd><p>Have you <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>? Have +Samba.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919061"></a>"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you <a class="indexterm" name="id2919072"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user? Have you used <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> to give root a Samba account? You can do 2 things: open another terminal and execute <b class="command">smbpasswd -a root</b> to create the account, and continue with entering the password into the first terminal. Or break out of the loop by hitting ENTER twice (without trying to type a -password).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." -message (but I swear there is one!)</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Have you enabled printer sharing on CUPS? This means: +password).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919107"></a>"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you enabled printer sharing on CUPS? This means: do you have a <i class="parameter"><tt><Location /printers>....</Location></tt></i> section in CUPS server's <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> which doesn't deny access to -the host you run "cupsaddsmb" from? It <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> be +the host you run "cupsaddsmb" from? It <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> be an issue if you use cupsaddsmb remotely, or if you use it with a -<i class="parameter"><tt>-h</tt></i> parameter: <b class="command">cupsaddsmb -H -sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</b>. -</p></li><li><p>Is your -"TempDir" directive in +<tt class="option">-h</tt> parameter: <b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -H + sambaserver -h cupsserver -v printername</tt></b>. +</p><p>Is your +"TempDir" directive in <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsd.conf</em></span> set to a valid value and is it writeable? -</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't connect client to Samba printer.</span></dt><dd><p>Use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check which user +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919163"></a>Client can't connect to Samba printer</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check which user you are from Samba's point of view. Do you have the privileges to write into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> -share?</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't reconnect to Samba under a new account -from Win2K/XP</span></dt><dd><p>Once you are connected as the "wrong" user (for -example as "nobody", which often occurs if you have <i class="parameter"><tt>map to -guest = bad user</tt></i>), Windows Explorer will not accept an +share?</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919497"></a>Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Once you are connected as the "wrong" user (for +example as "nobody", which often occurs if you have +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919510"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user), Windows Explorer will not accept an attempt to connect again as a different user. There won't be any byte transfered on the wire to Samba, but still you'll see a stupid error message which makes you think that Samba has denied access. Use @@ -11751,73 +10987,71 @@ message which makes you think that Samba has denied access. Use PIDs. You still can't re-connect and get the dreaded <tt class="computeroutput">You can't connect with a second account from the same machine</tt> message, as soon as you are trying? And you -don't see any single byte arriving at Samba (see logs; use "ethereal") +don't see any single byte arriving at Samba (see logs; use "ethereal") indicating a renewed connection attempt? Shut all Explorer Windows. This makes Windows forget what it has cached in its memory as established connections. Then re-connect as the right user. Best method is to use a DOS terminal window and <span class="emphasis"><em>first</em></span> -do <b class="command">net use z: \\SAMBAHOST\print$ /user:root</b>. Check +do <b class="userinput"><tt>net use z: \\GANDALF\print$ /user:root</tt></b>. Check with <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are connected under a -different account. Now open the "Printers" folder (on the Samba server +different account. Now open the "Printers" folder (on the Samba server in the <span class="emphasis"><em>Network Neighbourhood</em></span>), right-click the printer in question and select -<span class="emphasis"><em>Connect...</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the -"wrong" user</span></dt><dd><p>You see per <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are -connected as user "nobody"; while you wanted to be "root" or -"printeradmin"? This is probably due to <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest = bad -user</tt></i>, which silently connects you under the guest account, +<span class="emphasis"><em>Connect...</em></span></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919582"></a>Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You see per <b class="command">smbstatus</b> that you are +connected as user "nobody"; while you wanted to be "root" or +"printeradmin"? This is probably due to +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919603"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user, which silently connects you under the guest account, when you gave (maybe by accident) an incorrect username. Remove -<i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>, if you want to prevent -this.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on -NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</span></dt><dd><p>First delete all "old" Adobe-using printers. Then -delete all "old" Adobe drivers. (On Win2K/XP, right-click in -background of "Printers" folder, select "Server Properties...", select -tab "Drivers" and delete here).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't use "cupsaddsmb"on a Samba server which is -a PDC</span></dt><dd><p>Do you use the "naked" root user name? Try to do it -this way: <span class="emphasis"><em>cupsaddsmb -U DOMAINNAME\\root -v -printername</em></span> (note the two backslashes: the first one is -required to "escape" the second one).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I deleted a printer on Win2K; but I still see -its driver</span></dt><dd><p>Deleting a printer on the client won't delete the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2919619"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i>, if you want to prevent +this.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919635"></a>Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>First delete all "old" Adobe-using printers. Then +delete all "old" Adobe drivers. (On Win2K/XP, right-click in +background of "Printers" folder, select "Server Properties...", select +tab "Drivers" and delete here).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919649"></a>Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Do you use the "naked" root user name? Try to do it +this way: <b class="userinput"><tt>cupsaddsmb -U <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAINNAME</tt></i>\\root -v +<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i></tt></b>> (note the two backslashes: the first one is +required to "escape" the second one).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919678"></a>Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Deleting a printer on the client won't delete the driver too (to verify, right-click on the white background of the -"Printers" folder, select "Server Properties" and click on the -"Drivers" tab). These same old drivers will be re-used when you try to +"Printers" folder, select "Server Properties" and click on the +"Drivers" tab). These same old drivers will be re-used when you try to install a printer with the same name. If you want to update to a new driver, delete the old ones first. Deletion is only possible if no -other printer uses the same driver.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Win2K/XP "Local Security -Policies"</span></dt><dd><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Local Security Policies</em></span> may not -allow the installation of unsigned drivers. "Local Security Policies" +other printer uses the same driver.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919695"></a>Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Local Security Policies</em></span> may not +allow the installation of unsigned drivers. "Local Security Policies" may not allow the installation of printer drivers at -all.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install -printers for all local users"</span></dt><dd><p>Windows XP handles SMB printers on a "per-user" basis. +all.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919711"></a>WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows XP handles SMB printers on a "per-user" basis. This means every user needs to install the printer himself. To have a printer available for everybody, you might want to use the built-in IPP client capabilities of WinXP. Add a printer with the print path of <span class="emphasis"><em>http://cupsserver:631/printers/printername</em></span>. -Still looking into this one: maybe a "logon script" could +Still looking into this one: maybe a "logon script" could automatically install printers for all -users.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">"Print Change Notify" functions on -NT-clients</span></dt><dd><p>For "print change notify" functions on NT++ clients, -these need to run the "Server" service first (re-named to +users.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919733"></a>"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>For "print change notify" functions on NT++ clients, +these need to run the "Server" service first (re-named to <span class="emphasis"><em>File & Print Sharing for MS Networks</em></span> in -XP).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">WinXP-SP1</span></dt><dd><p>WinXP-SP1 introduced a <span class="emphasis"><em>Point and Print +XP).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919752"></a>WinXP-SP1</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>WinXP-SP1 introduced a <span class="emphasis"><em>Point and Print Restriction Policy</em></span> (this restriction doesn't apply to -"Administrator" or "Power User" groups of users). In Group Policy -Object Editor: go to <span class="emphasis"><em>User Configuration --> -Administrative Templates --> Control Panel --> +"Administrator" or "Power User" groups of users). In Group Policy +Object Editor: go to <span class="emphasis"><em>User Configuration, + Administrative Templates, Control Panel, Printers</em></span>. The policy is automatically set to <span class="emphasis"><em>Enabled</em></span> and the <span class="emphasis"><em>Users can only Point and Print to machines in their Forest</em></span> . You probably need to change it to <span class="emphasis"><em>Disabled</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>Users can only Point and Print to these servers</em></span> in order to make -driver downloads from Samba possible.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't set and save default print options for all -users on Win2K/XP</span></dt><dd><p>How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way (it is not +driver downloads from Samba possible.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2919794"></a>Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>How are you doing it? I bet the wrong way (it is not very easy to find out, though). There are 3 different ways to bring you to a dialog that <span class="emphasis"><em>seems</em></span> to set everything. All three dialogs <span class="emphasis"><em>look</em></span> the same. Only one of them <span class="emphasis"><em>does</em></span> what you intend. You need to be Administrator or Print Administrator to do this for all users. Here is how I do in on XP: -</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first "wrong" way: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="A"><li><p>The first "wrong" way: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printers</em></span> folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer @@ -11825,7 +11059,7 @@ folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer select in context menu <span class="emphasis"><em>Printing Preferences...</em></span></p></li><li><p>Look at this dialog closely and remember what it looks like.</p></li></ol></div><p> -</p></li><li><p>The second "wrong" way: +</p></li><li><p>The second "wrong" way: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Open the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printers</em></span> folder.</p></li><li><p>Right-click on the printer (<span class="emphasis"><em>remoteprinter on @@ -11834,29 +11068,29 @@ cupshost</em></span>) and select in the context menu tab</p></li><li><p>Click on the button <span class="emphasis"><em>Printing Preferences...</em></span></p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Keep this dialog open and go back to the parent dialog.</p></li></ol></div><p> -</p></li><li><p>The third, the "correct" way: (should you do +</p></li><li><p>The third, the "correct" way: (should you do this from the beginning, just carry out steps 1. and 2. from second -"way" above) +"way" above) </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Click on the <span class="emphasis"><em>Advanced</em></span> -tab. (Hmmm... if everything is "Grayed Out", then you are not logged +tab. (Hmmm... if everything is "Grayed Out", then you are not logged in as a user with enough privileges).</p></li><li><p>Click on the <span class="emphasis"><em>Printing Defaults...</em></span> button.</p></li><li><p>On any of the two new tabs, click on the <span class="emphasis"><em>Advanced...</em></span> button.</p></li><li><p>A new dialog opens. Compare this one to the other, -identical looking one from "B.5" or A.3".</p></li></ol></div><p> +identical looking one from "B.5" or A.3".</p></li></ol></div><p> </p></li></ol></div><p> Do you see any difference? I don't either... However, only the last -one, which you arrived at with steps "C.1.-6." will save any settings +one, which you arrived at with steps "C.1.-6." will save any settings permanently and be the defaults for new users. If you want all clients to get the same defaults, you need to conduct these steps <span class="emphasis"><em>as -Administrator</em></span> (<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in +Administrator</em></span> (<a class="indexterm" name="id2920027"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) <span class="emphasis"><em>before</em></span> a client downloads the driver (the clients can later set their own <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user defaults</em></span> by following the procedures <span class="emphasis"><em>A.</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>B.</em></span> -above).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">What are the most common blunders in driver -settings on Windows clients?</span></dt><dd><p>Don't use <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for +above).</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920067"></a>Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Don't use <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for Speed</em></span>: use <span class="emphasis"><em>Optimize for Portability</em></span> instead (Adobe PS Driver) Don't use <span class="emphasis"><em>Page Independence: No</em></span>: always @@ -11868,91 +11102,63 @@ printer</em></span> (Adobe PS Driver). For <span class="emphasis"><em>TrueType Download Options</em></span> choose <span class="emphasis"><em>Outline</em></span>. Use PostScript Level 2, if you are having trouble with a non-PS printer, and if -there is a choice.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't make <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> work -with newly installed printer</span></dt><dd><p>Symptom: the last command of +there is a choice.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920114"></a><b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> does not work + with newly installed printer</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Symptom: the last command of <b class="command">cupsaddsmb</b> doesn't complete successfully: <b class="command">cmd = setdriver printername printername</b> result was NT_STATUS_UNSUCCESSFUL then possibly the printer was not yet -"recognized" by Samba. Did it show up in <span class="emphasis"><em>Network +"recognized" by Samba. Did it show up in <span class="emphasis"><em>Network Neighbourhood</em></span>? Did it show up in <b class="command">rpcclient hostname -c 'enumprinters'</b>? Restart smbd (or send a <b class="command">kill -HUP</b> to all processes listed by <b class="command">smbstatus</b> and try -again.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">My permissions on +again.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920175"></a>Permissions on <tt class="filename">/var/spool/samba/</tt> get reset after each -reboot</span></dt><dd><p>Have you by accident set the CUPS spool directory to +reboot</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Have you by accident set the CUPS spool directory to the same location? (<i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/samba/</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> or the other way round: <tt class="filename">/var/spool/cups/</tt> is set as -<i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2920213"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i>> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section). These <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be different. Set <i class="parameter"><tt>RequestRoot /var/spool/cups/</tt></i> in -<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> and <i class="parameter"><tt>path = -/var/spool/samba</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> +<tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2920252"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = +/var/spool/samba in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Otherwise cupsd will sanitize permissions to its spool directory with each restart, and -printing will not work reliably.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">My printers work fine: just the printer named "lp" +printing will not work reliably.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920284"></a>Printer named "lp" intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different -ones</span></dt><dd><p>It is a very bad idea to name any printer "lp". This -is the traditional Unix name for the default printer. CUPS may be set -up to do an automatic creation of "Implicit Classes". This means, to +ones</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is a very bad idea to name any printer "lp". This +is the traditional UNIX name for the default printer. CUPS may be set +up to do an automatic creation of "Implicit Classes". This means, to group all printers with the same name to a pool of devices, and loadbalancing the jobs across them in a round-robin fashion. Chances -are high that someone else has an "lp" named printer too. You may +are high that someone else has an "lp" named printer too. You may receive his jobs and send your own to his device unwittingly. To have tight control over the printer names, set <i class="parameter"><tt>BrowseShortNames -No</tt></i>. It will present any printer as "printername@cupshost" +No</tt></i>. It will present any printer as "printername@cupshost" then, giving you a better control over what may happen in a large -networked environment.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">How do I "watch" my Samba server?</span></dt><dd><p>You can use <b class="command">tail -f -/var/log/samba/log.smbd</b> (you may need a different path) to -see a live scrolling of all log messages. <b class="command">smbcontrol smbd -debuglevel</b> tells you which verbosity goes into the -logs. <b class="command">smbcontrol smbd debug 3</b> sets the verbosity to -a quite high level (you can choose from 0 to 10 or 100). This works -"on the fly", without the need to restart the smbd daemon. Don't use -more than 3 initially; or you'll drown in an ocean of -messages.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">I can't use Samba from my WinXP Home box, while -access from WinXP Prof works flawlessly</span></dt><dd><p>You have our condolences! WinXP home has been -completely neutered by Microsoft as compared to WinXP Prof: you can -not log into a WinNT domain. It cannot join a Win NT domain as a -member server. While it is possible to access domain resources, users -don't have "single sign-on". They need to supply username and password -each time they connect to a resource. Logon scripts and roaming -profiles are not supported. It can serve file and print shares; but -only in "share-mode security" level. It can not use "user-mode -security" (what Windows 95/98/ME still can -do).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Where do I find the Adobe PostScript driver files -I need for "cupsaddsmb"?</span></dt><dd><p>Use <b class="command">smbclient</b> to connect to any +networked environment.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920314"></a>Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use <b class="command">smbclient</b> to connect to any Windows box with a shared PostScript printer: <b class="command">smbclient //windowsbox/print\$ -U guest</b>. You can navigate to the <tt class="filename">W32X86/2</tt> subdir to <b class="command">mget ADOBE*</b> and other files or to <tt class="filename">WIN40/0</tt> to do the same. -- Another option is to download the <tt class="filename">*.exe</tt> packaged -files from the Adobe website.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2948546"></a>An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -</p><div class="figure"><a name="id2948557"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.15. CUPS Printing Overview</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/a_small.png" alt="CUPS Printing Overview"></div></div><p> -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="VFS"></a>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Simo</span> <span class="surname">Sorce</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_skel README</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_netatalk docs</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><span class="contrib">Update for multiple modules</span></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2960717">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960735">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960826">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2960833">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960871">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2960995">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961013">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961151">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2961195">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2961218">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2961273">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2961303">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960717"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +files from the Adobe website.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920369"></a>An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="figure"><a name="a_small"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 19.19. CUPS Printing Overview</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/a_small.png" width="270" alt="CUPS Printing Overview"></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="VFS"></a>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Simo</span> <span class="surname">Sorce</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_skel README</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_netatalk docs</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><span class="contrib">Update for multiple modules</span></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2920538">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920556">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920786">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2920793">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920835">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920965">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2920984">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921153">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921198">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921220">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921286">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920538"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since Samba-3, there is support for stackable VFS(Virtual File System) modules. Samba passes each request to access the unix file system thru the loaded VFS modules. This chapter covers all the modules that come with the samba source and references to some external modules. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960735"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920556"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If not supplied with your platform distribution binary Samba package you may have problems to compile these modules, as shared libraries are compiled and linked in different ways on different systems. They currently have been tested against GNU/Linux and IRIX. </p><p> To use the VFS modules, create a share similar to the one below. The -important parameter is the <b class="command">vfs objects</b> parameter where +important parameter is the <a class="indexterm" name="id2920577"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i> parameter where you can list one or more VFS modules by name. For example, to log all access to files and put deleted files in a recycle bin: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[audit] - comment = Audited /data directory - path = /data - vfs objects = audit recycle - writeable = yes - browseable = yes -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2920594"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 20.1. smb.conf with VFS modules</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[audit]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Audited /data directory</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects = audit recycle</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> The modules are used in the order in which they are specified. </p><p> @@ -11964,46 +11170,52 @@ directory in the root directory of the samba installation (usually Some modules can be used twice for the same share. This can be done using a configuration similar to the one below. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[test] - comment = VFS TEST - path = /data - writeable = yes - browseable = yes - vfs objects = example:example1 example example:test - example1: parameter = 1 - example: parameter = 5 - test: parameter = 7 -</pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960826"></a>Included modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960833"></a>audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2920694"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 20.2. smb.conf with multiple VFS modules</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[test]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = VFS TEST</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects = example:example1 example example:test</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>example1: parameter = 1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>example: parameter = 5</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>test: parameter = 7</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920786"></a>Included modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920793"></a>audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A simple module to audit file access to the syslog facility. The following operations are logged: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>share</td></tr><tr><td>connect/disconnect</td></tr><tr><td>directory opens/create/remove</td></tr><tr><td>file open/close/rename/unlink/chmod</td></tr></table><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960871"></a>extd_audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>share</p></li><li><p>connect/disconnect</p></li><li><p>directory opens/create/remove</p></li><li><p>file open/close/rename/unlink/chmod</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920835"></a>extd_audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This module is identical with the <span class="emphasis"><em>audit</em></span> module above except that it sends audit logs to both syslog as well as the smbd log file/s. The loglevel for this module is set in the smb.conf file. </p><p> The logging information that will be written to the smbd log file is controlled by - the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. The + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2920859"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. The following information will be recorded: - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2960912"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 20.1. Extended Auditing Log Information</b></p><table summary="Extended Auditing Log Information" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Log Level</th><th align="center">Log Details - File and Directory Operations</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">0</td><td align="left">Creation / Deletion</td></tr><tr><td align="center">1</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Permission Changes</td></tr><tr><td align="center">2</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Perm Change / Open / Close</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2960995"></a>fake_perms</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2920882"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 20.1. Extended Auditing Log Information</b></p><table summary="Extended Auditing Log Information" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Log Level</th><th align="center">Log Details - File and Directory Operations</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">0</td><td align="left">Creation / Deletion</td></tr><tr><td align="center">1</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Permission Changes</td></tr><tr><td align="center">2</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Perm Change / Open / Close</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920965"></a>fake_perms</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This module was created to allow Roaming Profile files and directories to be set (on the Samba server under Unix) as read only. This module will if installed on the Profiles share will report to the client that the Profile files and directories are writable. This satisfies the client even though the files will never be overwritten as the client logs out or shuts down. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961013"></a>recycle</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920984"></a>recycle</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A recycle-bin like module. When used any unlink call will be intercepted and files moved to the recycle - directory instead of being deleted. + directory instead of being deleted. This gives the same + effect as the "Recycle Bin" on Windows computers. </p><p>Supported options: - </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:keeptree</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:versions</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:touch</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:maxsize</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude_dir</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:noversions</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd></dl></div><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961151"></a>netatalk</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository</span></dt><dd><p>Relative path of the directory where deleted files should be moved to</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:keeptree</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether the directory structure should + be kept or if the files in the directory that is being + deleted should be kept seperately in the recycle bin. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:versions</span></dt><dd><p>If this option is set, two files + with the same name that are deleted will both + be kept in the recycle bin. Newer deleted versions + of a file will be called "Copy #x of <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i>".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:touch</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether a file's access + date should be touched when the file is moved to + the recycle bin.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:maxsize</span></dt><dd><p>Files that are larger than the number + of bytes specified by this parameter will + not be put into the recycle bin.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude</span></dt><dd><p>List of files that should not + be put into the recycle bin when deleted, but deleted + in the regular way.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude_dir</span></dt><dd><p>Contains a list of directories. When files from + these directories are deleted, they are not put into the + recycle bin, but deleted in the regular way. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:noversions</span></dt><dd><p>Opposite of <i class="parameter"><tt>recycle:versions</tt></i>. If both options are specified, this one takes precedence.</p></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921153"></a>netatalk</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A netatalk module, that will ease co-existence of samba and netatalk file sharing services. </p><p>Advantages compared to the old netatalk module: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>it doesn't care about creating of .AppleDouble forks, just keeps them in sync</td></tr><tr><td>if a share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> doesn't contain .AppleDouble item in hide or veto list, it will be added automatically</td></tr></table><p> - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961195"></a>VFS modules available elsewhere</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>it doesn't care about creating of .AppleDouble forks, just keeps them in sync</p></li><li><p>if a share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> doesn't contain .AppleDouble item in hide or veto list, it will be added automatically</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921198"></a>VFS modules available elsewhere</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section contains a listing of various other VFS modules that have been posted but don't currently reside in the Samba CVS tree for one reason or another (e.g. it is easy for the maintainer @@ -12011,14 +11223,14 @@ to have his or her own CVS tree). </p><p> No statements about the stability or functionality of any module should be implied due to its presence here. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961218"></a>DatabaseFS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921220"></a>DatabaseFS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> URL: <a href="http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php" target="_top">http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php</a> </p><p>By <a href="mailto:elorimer@css.tayloru.edu" target="_top">Eric Lorimer</a>.</p><p> I have created a VFS module which implements a fairly complete read-only filesystem. It presents information from a database as a filesystem in a modular and generic way to allow different databases to be used (originally designed for organizing MP3s under directories such as - "Artists," "Song Keywords," etc... I have since applied it to a student + "Artists," "Song Keywords," etc... I have since applied it to a student roster database very easily). The directory structure is stored in the database itself and the module makes no assumptions about the database structure beyond the table it requires to run. @@ -12026,25 +11238,47 @@ should be implied due to its presence here. Any feedback would be appreciated: comments, suggestions, patches, etc... If nothing else, hopefully it might prove useful for someone else who wishes to create a virtual filesystem. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961273"></a>vscan</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>URL: <a href="http://www.openantivirus.org/" target="_top">http://www.openantivirus.org/</a></p><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921286"></a>vscan</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>URL: <a href="http://www.openantivirus.org/" target="_top">http://www.openantivirus.org/</a></p><p> samba-vscan is a proof-of-concept module for Samba, which uses the VFS (virtual file system) features of Samba 2.2.x/3.0 alphaX. Of course, Samba has to be compiled with VFS support. samba-vscan supports various virus scanners and is maintained by Rainer Link. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961303"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="winbind"></a>Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</h2></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Naag</span> <span class="surname">Mummaneni</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">27 June 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2962201">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962229">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962301">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962361">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2962392">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962420">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962454">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962477">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962613">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962685">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962720">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2962747">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2962776">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962851">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2962944">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2964563">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2964582">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962201"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through - a unified logon has been considered a "holy grail" in heterogeneous - computing environments for a long time. We present - <span class="emphasis"><em>winbind</em></span>, a component of the Samba suite - of programs as a solution to the unified logon problem. Winbind - uses a UNIX implementation - of Microsoft RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name - Service Switch to allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate - as UNIX users on a UNIX machine. This paper describes the winbind - system, explaining the functionality it provides, how it is configured, - and how it works internally.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962229"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="winbind"></a>Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</h2></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Naag</span> <span class="surname">Mummaneni</span></h3><span class="contrib">Notes for Solaris</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="surname">Trostel</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">SNAP<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com">jtrostel@snapserver.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">27 June 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2921516">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921611">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921688">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921756">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2921786">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2921815">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921849">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2921872">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922009">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922081">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922128">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2922156">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2922164">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922231">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2922333">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2923890">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2923909">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2923962">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921516"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through a unified logon has + been considered a "holy grail" in heterogeneous computing environments for + a long time. + </p><p> + There is one other facility without which UNIX and Microsoft Windows network + interoperability would suffer greatly. It is imperative that there be a + mechanism for sharing files across UNIX systems and to be able to assign + domain user and group ownerships with integrity. + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>winbind</em></span> is a component of the Samba suite of programs + solves the unified logon problem. Winbind uses a UNIX implementation of Microsoft + RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name Service Switch to + allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate as UNIX users on a UNIX + machine. This chapter describes the winbind system, explaining the functionality + it provides, how it is configured, and how it works internally. + </p><p> + Winbind provides three separate functions: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Authentication of user credentials (via PAM) + </p></li><li><p> + Identity resolution (via NSS)` + </p></li><li><p> + Windindd maintains a database called winbind_idmap.tdb in which it stores + mappings between UNIX UIDs / GIDs and NT SIDs. This mapping is used only + for users and groups that do not have a local UID/GID. It stored the UID/GID + allocated from the idmap uid/gid range that it has mapped to the NT SID. + If <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> has been specified as ldapsam:url + then instead of using a local mapping winbindd will obtain this information + from the LDAP database. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + If winbindd is not running, then smbd (which calls winbindd) will fall back to + using purely local information from /etc/passwd and /etc/group and no dynamic + mapping will be used. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921611"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have different models for representing user and group information and use different technologies for implementing them. This fact has made it difficult to integrate the two systems in a satisfactory @@ -12065,7 +11299,7 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? tasks for the system administrator when maintaining users and groups on either system. The winbind system provides a simple and elegant solution to all three components of the unified logon - problem.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962301"></a>What Winbind Provides</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by + problem.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921688"></a>What Winbind Provides</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by allowing a UNIX box to become a full member of a NT domain. Once this is done the UNIX box will see NT users and groups as if they were native UNIX users and groups, allowing the NT domain @@ -12078,7 +11312,7 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? (via the NSS name resolution modules in the C library) this redirection to the NT domain controller is completely transparent.</p><p>Users on the UNIX machine can then use NT user and group - names as they would use "native" UNIX names. They can chown files + names as they would use "native" UNIX names. They can chown files so that they are owned by NT domain users or even login to the UNIX machine and run a UNIX X-Window session as a domain user.</p><p>The only obvious indication that Winbind is being used is that user and group names take the form DOMAIN\user and @@ -12089,7 +11323,7 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? to provide authentication via a NT domain to any PAM enabled applications. This capability solves the problem of synchronizing passwords between systems since all passwords are stored in a single - location (on the domain controller).</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962361"></a>Target Uses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an + location (on the domain controller).</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921756"></a>Target Uses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an existing NT based domain infrastructure into which they wish to put UNIX workstations or servers. Winbind will allow these organizations to deploy UNIX workstations without having to @@ -12099,12 +11333,12 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? be used is as a central part of UNIX based appliances. Appliances that provide file and print services to Microsoft based networks will be able to use Winbind to provide seamless integration of - the appliance into the domain.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962392"></a>How Winbind Works</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system is designed around a client/server + the appliance into the domain.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921786"></a>How Winbind Works</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system is designed around a client/server architecture. A long running <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon listens on a UNIX domain socket waiting for requests to arrive. These requests are generated by the NSS and PAM clients and processed sequentially.</p><p>The technologies used to implement winbind are described - in detail below.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962420"></a>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway + in detail below.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921815"></a>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway by various Samba Team members to decode various aspects of the Microsoft Remote Procedure Call (MSRPC) system. This system is used for most network related operations between @@ -12117,7 +11351,7 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? users or groups. Other MSRPC calls can be used to authenticate NT domain users and to change user passwords. By directly querying a Windows PDC for user and group information, winbind maps the - NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962454"></a>Microsoft Active Directory Services</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921849"></a>Microsoft Active Directory Services</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since late 2001, Samba has gained the ability to interact with Microsoft Windows 2000 using its 'Native Mode' protocols, rather than the NT4 RPC services. @@ -12126,7 +11360,7 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? same way as a Win2k client would, and in so doing provide a much more efficient and effective winbind implementation. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962477"></a>Name Service Switch</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921872"></a>Name Service Switch</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is present in many UNIX operating systems. It allows system information such as hostnames, mail aliases and user information to be resolved from different sources. For example, a standalone @@ -12147,8 +11381,8 @@ There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? When a UNIX application makes a request to do a lookup the C library looks in <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> for a line which matches the service type being requested, for - example the "passwd" service type is used when user or group names - are looked up. This config line species which implementations + example the "passwd" service type is used when user or group names + are looked up. This config line specifies which implementations of that service should be tried and in what order. If the passwd config line is:</p><pre class="programlisting"> passwd: files example @@ -12161,9 +11395,9 @@ passwd: files example result to the application.</p><p>This NSS interface provides a very easy way for Winbind to hook into the operating system. All that needs to be done is to put <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> in <tt class="filename">/lib/</tt> - then add "winbind" into <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> at + then add "winbind" into <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> at the appropriate place. The C library will then call Winbind to - resolve user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962613"></a>Pluggable Authentication Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM, + resolve user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922009"></a>Pluggable Authentication Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM, is a system for abstracting authentication and authorization technologies. With a PAM module it is possible to specify different authentication methods for different system applications without @@ -12188,7 +11422,7 @@ passwd: files example is copied to <tt class="filename">/lib/security/</tt> and the PAM control files for relevant services are updated to allow authentication via winbind. See the PAM documentation - for more details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962685"></a>User and Group ID Allocation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>When a user or group is created under Windows NT + for more details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922081"></a>User and Group ID Allocation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>When a user or group is created under Windows NT is it allocated a numerical relative identifier (RID). This is slightly different to UNIX which has a range of numbers that are used to identify users, and the same range in which to identify @@ -12201,7 +11435,7 @@ passwd: files example time, winbind will have mapped all Windows NT users and groups to UNIX user ids and group ids.</p><p>The results of this mapping are stored persistently in an ID mapping database held in a tdb database). This ensures that - RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962720"></a>Result Caching</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>An active system can generate a lot of user and group + RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922128"></a>Result Caching</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>An active system can generate a lot of user and group name lookups. To reduce the network cost of these lookups winbind uses a caching scheme based on the SAM sequence number supplied by NT domain controllers. User or group information returned @@ -12212,23 +11446,12 @@ passwd: files example the PDC and compared against the sequence number of the cached entry. If the sequence numbers do not match, then the cached information is discarded and up to date information is requested directly - from the PDC.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962747"></a>Installation and Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Many thanks to John Trostel <a href="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com" target="_top">jtrostel@snapserver.com</a> -for providing the HOWTO for this section. -</p><p> -This HOWTO describes how to get winbind services up and running -to control access and authenticate users on your Linux box using -the winbind services which come with SAMBA 3.0. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962776"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + from the PDC.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2922156"></a>Installation and Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922164"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section describes the procedures used to get winbind up and -running on a RedHat 7.1 system. Winbind is capable of providing access +running. Winbind is capable of providing access and authentication control for Windows Domain users through an NT or Win2K PDC for 'regular' services, such as telnet a nd ftp, as well for SAMBA services. -</p><p> -This HOWTO has been written from a 'RedHat-centric' perspective, so if -you are using another distribution, you may have to modify the instructions -somewhat to fit the way your distribution works. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Why should I to this?</em></span> </p><p>This allows the SAMBA administrator to rely on the @@ -12244,7 +11467,7 @@ somewhat to fit the way your distribution works. SAMBA server, this HOWTO is for you. That said, I am no NT or PAM expert, so you may find a better or easier way to accomplish these tasks. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962851"></a>Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922231"></a>Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you have a Samba configuration file that you are currently using... <span class="emphasis"><em>BACK IT UP!</em></span> If your system already uses PAM, <span class="emphasis"><em>back up the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> directory @@ -12271,33 +11494,18 @@ winbind modules, you should have at least the pam libraries resident on your system. For recent RedHat systems (7.1, for instance), that means <tt class="filename">pam-0.74-22</tt>. For best results, it is helpful to also install the development packages in <tt class="filename">pam-devel-0.74-22</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962944"></a>Testing Things Out</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922333"></a>Testing Things Out</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before starting, it is probably best to kill off all the SAMBA related daemons running on your server. Kill off all <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> processes that may be running. To use PAM, you will want to make sure that you have the -standard PAM package (for RedHat) which supplies the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> +standard PAM package which supplies the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> directory structure, including the pam modules are used by pam-aware services, several pam libraries, and the <tt class="filename">/usr/doc</tt> and <tt class="filename">/usr/man</tt> entries for pam. Winbind built better in SAMBA if the pam-devel package was also installed. This package includes the header files needed to compile pam-aware applications. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963006"></a>Configure and compile SAMBA</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The configuration and compilation of SAMBA is pretty straightforward. -The first three steps may not be necessary depending upon -whether or not you have previously built the Samba binaries. -</p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">autoconf</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make clean</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">rm config.cache</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">./configure</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make install</b> -</pre><p> -This will, by default, install SAMBA in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba</tt>. -See the main SAMBA documentation if you want to install SAMBA somewhere else. -It will also build the winbindd executable and libraries. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963118"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf</tt> and the +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922395"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf</tt> and the winbind libraries on Linux and Solaris</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The libraries needed to run the <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon through nsswitch need to be copied to their proper locations, so @@ -12332,7 +11540,7 @@ is faster (and you don't need to reboot) if you do it manually: </p><p> This makes <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind</tt> available to winbindd and echos back a check to you. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963326"></a>NSS Winbind on AIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>(This section is only for those running AIX)</p><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922602"></a>NSS Winbind on AIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>(This section is only for those running AIX)</p><p> The winbind AIX identification module gets built as libnss_winbind.so in the nsswitch directory of the samba source. This file can be copied to /usr/lib/security, and the AIX naming convention would indicate that it @@ -12347,45 +11555,30 @@ supports identification, but there have been success reports using the standard winbind pam module for authentication. Use caution configuring loadable authentication modules as it is possible to make it impossible to logon to the system. More information about the AIX authentication -module API can be found at "Kernel Extensions and Device Support -Programming Concepts for AIX": <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixprggd/kernextc/sec_load_mod.htm" target="_top"> +module API can be found at "Kernel Extensions and Device Support +Programming Concepts for AIX": <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixprggd/kernextc/sec_load_mod.htm" target="_top"> Chapter 18. Loadable Authentication Module Programming Interface</a> and more information on administering the modules at <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixbman/baseadmn/iandaadmin.htm" target="_top"> -"System Management Guide: Operating System and Devices"</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963405"></a>Configure smb.conf</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"System Management Guide: Operating System and Devices"</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922674"></a>Configure smb.conf</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Several parameters are needed in the smb.conf file to control the behavior of <span class="application">winbindd</span>. Configure <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> These are described in more detail in the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> man page. My <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file was modified to include the following entries in the [global] section: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - <...> - # separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR" target="_top">winbind separator</a> = + - # use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDUID" target="_top">idmap uid</a> = 10000-20000 - # use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDGID" target="_top">idmap gid</a> = 10000-20000 - # allow enumeration of winbind users and groups - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS" target="_top">winbind enum users</a> = yes - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMGROUP" target="_top">winbind enum groups</a> = yes - # give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access) - <a href="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR" target="_top">template homedir</a> = /home/winnt/%D/%U - <a href="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATESHELL" target="_top">template shell</a> = /bin/bash -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963522"></a>Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2922722"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 21.1. smb.conf for winbind set-up</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td># separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator = +</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid = 10000-20000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid = 10000-20000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># allow enumeration of winbind users and groups</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access)</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir = /home/winnt/%D/%U</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>template shell = /bin/bash</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922833"></a>Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Enter the following command to make the SAMBA server join the PDC domain, where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> is the name of your Windows domain and <i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator</tt></i> is a domain user who has administrative privileges in the domain. </p><p> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/net join -S PDC -U Administrator</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/net rpc join -S PDC -U Administrator</tt></b> </p><p> -The proper response to the command should be: "Joined the domain -<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>" where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> +The proper response to the command should be: "Joined the domain +<i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>" where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> is your DOMAIN name. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963576"></a>Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2922889"></a>Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Eventually, you will want to modify your smb startup script to automatically invoke the winbindd daemon when the other parts of SAMBA start, but it is possible to test out just the winbind @@ -12427,8 +11620,7 @@ your PDC. For example, I get the following response: CEO+krbtgt CEO+TsInternetUser </pre><p> -Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind -separator</tt></i> is '+'. + Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <a class="indexterm" name="id2923034"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i> is '+'. </p><p> You can do the same sort of thing to get group information from the PDC: @@ -12457,7 +11649,7 @@ directories and default shells. The same thing can be done for groups with the command </p><p> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent group</tt></b> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2963817"></a>Fix the init.d startup scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2963825"></a>Linux</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923138"></a>Fix the init.d startup scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2923145"></a>Linux</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon needs to start up after the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> daemons are running. To accomplish this task, you need to modify the startup scripts of your system. @@ -12469,18 +11661,18 @@ startup script starts up <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="app function in the script looks like this: </p><pre class="programlisting"> start() { - KIND="SMB" - echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + KIND="SMB" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/smbd $SMBDOPTIONS RETVAL=$? echo - KIND="NMB" - echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + KIND="NMB" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd $NMBDOPTIONS RETVAL2=$? echo - KIND="Winbind" - echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " + KIND="Winbind" + echo -n $"Starting $KIND services: " daemon /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd RETVAL3=$? echo @@ -12504,26 +11696,26 @@ The 'stop' function has a corresponding entry to shut down the services and looks like this: </p><pre class="programlisting"> stop() { - KIND="SMB" - echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + KIND="SMB" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " killproc smbd RETVAL=$? echo - KIND="NMB" - echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + KIND="NMB" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " killproc nmbd RETVAL2=$? echo - KIND="Winbind" - echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " + KIND="Winbind" + echo -n $"Shutting down $KIND services: " killproc winbindd RETVAL3=$? [ $RETVAL -eq 0 -a $RETVAL2 -eq 0 -a $RETVAL3 -eq 0 ] && \ rm -f /var/lock/subsys/smb - echo "" + echo "" return $RETVAL } -</pre></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2963987"></a>Solaris</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind doesn't work on Solaris 9, see the <a href="#winbind-solaris9" title="Winbind on Solaris 9">Portability</a> chapter for details.</p><p>On Solaris, you need to modify the +</pre></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2923308"></a>Solaris</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind doesn't work on Solaris 9, see the <a href="#winbind-solaris9" title="Winbind on Solaris 9">Portability</a> chapter for details.</p><p>On Solaris, you need to modify the <tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/samba.server</tt> startup script. It usually only starts smbd and nmbd but should now start winbindd too. If you have samba installed in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt>, @@ -12542,12 +11734,12 @@ the file could contains something like this: pid=`/usr/bin/ps -e | /usr/bin/grep -w $1 | /usr/bin/sed -e 's/^ *//' -e 's/ .*//'` - [ "$pid" != "" ] && kill $pid + [ "$pid" != "" ] && kill $pid } # Start/stop processes required for samba server - case "$1" in + case "$1" in 'start') # @@ -12572,7 +11764,7 @@ the file could contains something like this: ;; *) - echo "Usage: /etc/init.d/samba.server { start | stop }" + echo "Usage: /etc/init.d/samba.server { start | stop }" ;; esac </pre><p> @@ -12586,11 +11778,11 @@ in the script above with: </p><pre class="programlisting"> /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2964105"></a>Restarting</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2923426"></a>Restarting</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you restart the <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemons at this point, you should be able to connect to the samba server as a domain member just as if you were a local user. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2964142"></a>Configure Winbind and PAM</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2923462"></a>Configure Winbind and PAM</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you have made it this far, you know that winbindd and samba are working together. If you want to use winbind to provide authentication for other services, keep reading. The pam configuration files need to be altered in @@ -12610,7 +11802,7 @@ your other pam security modules. On my RedHat system, this was the modules reside in <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security</tt>. </p><p> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/pam_winbind.so /lib/security</tt></b> -</p><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2964248"></a>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2923568"></a>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/samba</tt> file does not need to be changed. I just left this file as it was: </p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -12637,7 +11829,7 @@ have individual directories for the domain users already present on the server, or change the home directory template to a general directory for all domain users. These can be easily set using the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> global entry -<i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i>. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2923675"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i>. </p><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/ftp</tt> file can be changed to allow winbind ftp access in a manner similar to the @@ -12670,10 +11862,10 @@ same way. It now looks like this: In this case, I added the </p><pre class="programlisting">auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so</pre><p> lines as before, but also added the </p><pre class="programlisting">required pam_securetty.so</pre><p> above it, to disallow root logins over the network. I also added a -<b class="command">sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</b> +</p><pre class="programlisting">sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</pre><p> line after the <b class="command">winbind.so</b> line to get rid of annoying double prompts for passwords. -</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2964472"></a>Solaris-specific configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2923800"></a>Solaris-specific configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> The /etc/pam.conf needs to be changed. I changed this file so that my Domain users can logon both locally as well as telnet.The following are the changes that I made.You can customize the pam.conf file as per your requirements,but @@ -12681,7 +11873,7 @@ be sure of those changes because in the worst case it will leave your system nearly impossible to boot. </p><pre class="programlisting"> # - #ident "@(#)pam.conf 1.14 99/09/16 SMI" + #ident "@(#)pam.conf 1.14 99/09/16 SMI" # # Copyright (c) 1996-1999, Sun Microsystems, Inc. # All Rights Reserved. @@ -12745,15 +11937,15 @@ annoying double prompts for passwords. </p><p> Now restart your Samba and try connecting through your application that you configured in the pam.conf. -</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964563"></a>Conclusion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service +</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923890"></a>Conclusion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service Switch, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and appropriate Microsoft RPC calls have allowed us to provide seamless integration of Microsoft Windows NT domain users on a UNIX system. The result is a great reduction in the administrative - cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964582"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current + cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923909"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current released version that we hope to overcome in future releases:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind is currently only available for - the Linux, Solaris and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating + the Linux, Solaris, AIX and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating systems are certainly possible. For such ports to be feasible, we require the C library of the target operating system to support the Name Service Switch and Pluggable Authentication @@ -12765,11 +11957,18 @@ configured in the pam.conf. containing this information is corrupted or destroyed.</p></li><li><p>Currently the winbind PAM module does not take into account possible workstation and logon time restrictions that may be been set for Windows NT users, this is - instead up to the PDC to enforce.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AdvancedNetworkManagement"></a>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2967075">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2967264">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2967363">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967381">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2967592">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2967788">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2967822">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> + instead up to the PDC to enforce.</p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923962"></a>NSCD Problem Warning</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + Do NOT under ANY circumstances run <b class="command">nscd</b> on any system + on which <b class="command">winbind</b> is running. + </p></div><p> + If <b class="command">nscd</b> is running on the UNIX/Linux system, then + even though NSSWITCH is correctly configured it will NOT be possible to resolve + domain users and groups for file and directory controls. + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="AdvancedNetworkManagement"></a>Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2924071">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924101">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924200">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924218">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924438">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924711">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2924744">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> This section documents peripheral issues that are of great importance to network administrators who want to improve network resource access control, to automate the user environment, and to make their lives a little easier. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967075"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924071"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Often the difference between a working network environment and a well appreciated one can best be measured by the <span class="emphasis"><em>little things</em></span> that makes everything work more harmoniously. A key part of every network environment solution is the ability to remotely @@ -12779,7 +11978,7 @@ network operations. </p><p> This chapter presents information on each of these area. They are placed here, and not in other chapters, for ease of reference. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967264"></a>Remote Server Administration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924101"></a>Remote Server Administration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>How do I get 'User Manager' and 'Server Manager'?</em></span> </p><p> Since I don't need to buy an <span class="application">NT4 Server</span>, how do I get the 'User Manager for Domains', @@ -12793,12 +11992,12 @@ Click here to download the archived file <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softli The <span class="application">Windows NT 4.0</span> version of the 'User Manager for Domains' and 'Server Manager' are available from Microsoft via ftp from <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE" target="_top">ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/Softlib/MSLFILES/SRVTOOLS.EXE</a> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967363"></a>Remote Desktop Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924200"></a>Remote Desktop Management</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of possible remote desktop management solutions that range from free through costly. Do not let that put you off. Sometimes the most costly solutions is the most cost effective. In any case, you will need to draw your own conclusions as to which is the best tool in your network environment. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2967381"></a>Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924218"></a>Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following information was posted to the Samba mailing list at Apr 3 23:33:50 GMT 2003. It is presented in slightly edited form (with author details omitted for privacy reasons). The entire answer is reproduced below with some comments removed. @@ -12817,7 +12016,7 @@ is the best tool in your network environment. > Any ideas/experience would be appreciated :) </pre><p> </p><p> - Answer provided: Check out the new offer from NoMachine, "NX" software: + Answer provided: Check out the new offer from NoMachine, "NX" software: <a href="http://www.nomachine.com/" target="_top">http://www.nomachine.com/</a>. </p><p> It implements a very easy-to-use interface to the remote X protocol as @@ -12830,18 +12029,18 @@ is the best tool in your network environment. </p><p> I could test drive their (public) RedHat machine in Italy, over a loaded internet connection, with enabled thumbnail previews in KDE konqueror - which popped up immediately on "mouse-over". From inside that (remote X) + which popped up immediately on "mouse-over". From inside that (remote X) session I started a rdesktop session on another, a Windows XP machine. To test the performance, I played Pinball. I am proud to announce here that my score was 631750 points at first try... </p><p> - NX performs better on my local LAN than any of the other "pure" + NX performs better on my local LAN than any of the other "pure" connection methods I am using from time to time: TightVNC, rdesktop or remote X. It is even faster than a direct crosslink connection between two nodes. </p><p> I even got sound playing from the remote X app to my local boxes, and - had a working "copy'n'paste" from an NX window (running a KDE session + had a working "copy'n'paste" from an NX window (running a KDE session in Italy) to my Mozilla mailing agent... These guys are certainly doing something right! </p><p> @@ -12886,7 +12085,7 @@ is the best tool in your network environment. NoMachine are encouraging and offering help to OSS/Free Software implementations for such a frontend too, even if it means competition to them (they have written to this effect even to the LTSP, KDE and GNOME developer mailing lists) - </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967592"></a>Network Logon Script Magic</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924438"></a>Network Logon Script Magic</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section needs work. Volunteer contributions most welcome. Please send your patches or updates to <a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John Terpstra</a>. </p><p> @@ -12928,31 +12127,31 @@ This is the <tt class="filename">genlogon.pl</tt> file: # Log client connection #($sec,$min,$hour,$mday,$mon,$year,$wday,$yday,$isdst) = localtime(time); ($sec,$min,$hour,$mday,$mon,$year,$wday,$yday,$isdst) = localtime(time); - open LOG, ">>/var/log/samba/netlogon.log"; - print LOG "$mon/$mday/$year $hour:$min:$sec - User $ARGV[0] logged into $ARGV[1]\n"; + open LOG, ">>/var/log/samba/netlogon.log"; + print LOG "$mon/$mday/$year $hour:$min:$sec - User $ARGV[0] logged into $ARGV[1]\n"; close LOG; # Start generating logon script - open LOGON, ">/shared/netlogon/$ARGV[0].bat"; - print LOGON "\@ECHO OFF\r\n"; + open LOGON, ">/shared/netlogon/$ARGV[0].bat"; + print LOGON "\@ECHO OFF\r\n"; # Connect shares just use by Software Development group - if ($ARGV[1] eq "SOFTDEV" || $ARGV[0] eq "softdev") + if ($ARGV[1] eq "SOFTDEV" || $ARGV[0] eq "softdev") { - print LOGON "NET USE M: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SOURCE\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE M: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SOURCE\r\n"; } # Connect shares just use by Technical Support staff - if ($ARGV[1] eq "SUPPORT" || $ARGV[0] eq "support") + if ($ARGV[1] eq "SUPPORT" || $ARGV[0] eq "support") { - print LOGON "NET USE S: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SUPPORT\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE S: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\SUPPORT\r\n"; } # Connect shares just used by Administration staff - If ($ARGV[1] eq "ADMIN" || $ARGV[0] eq "admin") + If ($ARGV[1] eq "ADMIN" || $ARGV[0] eq "admin") { - print LOGON "NET USE L: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\ADMIN\r\n"; - print LOGON "NET USE K: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\MKTING\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE L: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\ADMIN\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE K: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\MKTING\r\n"; } # Now connect Printers. We handle just two or three users a little @@ -12962,13 +12161,13 @@ This is the <tt class="filename">genlogon.pl</tt> file: if ($ARGV[0] eq 'jim' || $ARGV[0] eq 'yvonne') { - print LOGON "NET USE LPT2: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; - print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT2: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; } else { - print LOGON "NET USE LPT1: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; - print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT1: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\LJET3\r\n"; + print LOGON "NET USE LPT3: \\\\$ARGV[2]\\FAXQ\r\n"; } # All done! Close the output file. @@ -12976,7 +12175,7 @@ This is the <tt class="filename">genlogon.pl</tt> file: </pre><p> </p><p> Those wishing to use more elaborate or capable logon processing system should check out the following sites: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon" target="_top">http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://www.kixtart.org" target="_top">http://www.kixtart.org</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a></td></tr></table><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2967788"></a>Adding printers without user intervention</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon" target="_top">http://www.craigelachie.org/rhacer/ntlogon</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://www.kixtart.org" target="_top">http://www.kixtart.org</a></td></tr><tr><td><a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a></td></tr></table><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924711"></a>Adding printers without user intervention</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Printers may be added automatically during logon script processing through the use of: </p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -12984,20 +12183,20 @@ Printers may be added automatically during logon script processing through the u </pre><p> See the documentation in the <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.asp?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">Microsoft knowledgebase article no: 189105</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2967822"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924744"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The information provided in this chapter has been reproduced from postings on the samba@samba.org mailing list. No implied endorsement or recommendation is offered. Administrators should conduct their own evaluation of alternatives and are encouraged to draw their own conclusions. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="PolicyMgmt"></a>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2966885">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2966939">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2968722">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2968817">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2968950">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2969202">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2969303">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969324">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969344">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2969388">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2969535">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2969549">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="PolicyMgmt"></a>Chapter 23. System and Account Policies</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2924822">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2924888">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2924999">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925094">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925227">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2925491">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925596">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925636">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925655">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2925700">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925851">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2925865">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This chapter summarises the current state of knowledge derived from personal practice and knowledge from samba mailing list subscribers. Before reproduction of posted information effort has been made to validate the information provided. Where additional information was uncovered through this validation it is provided also. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2966885"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924822"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When MS Windows NT3.5 was introduced the hot new topic was the ability to implement Group Policies for users and group. Then along came MS Windows NT4 and a few sites -started to adopt this capability. How do we know that? By way of the number of "booboos" +started to adopt this capability. How do we know that? By way of the number of "booboos" (or mistakes) administrators made and then requested help to resolve. </p><p> By the time that MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory was released, administrators @@ -13013,9 +12212,9 @@ the deployment in many sites. This chapter reviews techniques and methods that c be used to exploit opportunities for automation of control over user desktops and network client workstations. </p><p> -A tool new to Samba-3 may become an important part of the future Samba Administrators' +A tool new to Samba may become an important part of the future Samba Administrators' arsenal. The <b class="command">editreg</b> tool is described in this document. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2966939"></a>Creating and Managing System Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2924888"></a>Creating and Managing System Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Under MS Windows platforms, particularly those following the release of MS Windows NT4 and MS Windows 95) it is possible to create a type of file that would be placed in the NETLOGON share of a domain controller. As the client logs onto the network @@ -13044,13 +12243,13 @@ be a step forward, but improved functionality comes at a great price. Before embarking on the configuration of network and system policies it is highly advisable to read the documentation available from Microsoft's web site regarding <a href="http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp" target="_top"> -Implementing Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0 from http://www.microsoft.com/ntserver/management/deployment/planguide/prof_policies.asp</a> available from Microsoft. +Implementing Profiles and Policies in Windows NT 4.0</a> available from Microsoft. There are a large number of documents in addition to this old one that should also -be read and understood. Try searching on the Microsoft web site for "Group Policies". +be read and understood. Try searching on the Microsoft web site for "Group Policies". </p><p> What follows is a very brief discussion with some helpful notes. The information provided here is incomplete - you are warned. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968722"></a>Windows 9x/Me Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2924999"></a>Windows 9x/Me Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You need the Win98 Group Policy Editor to set Group Profiles up under Windows 9x/Me. It can be found on the Original full product Win98 installation CD under <tt class="filename">tools/reskit/netadmin/poledit</tt>. Install this using the @@ -13076,7 +12275,7 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. <tt class="filename">grouppol.inf</tt>. Log off and on again a couple of times and see if Win98 picks up group policies. Unfortunately this needs to be done on every Win9x/Me machine that uses group policies. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968817"></a>Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925094"></a>Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To create or edit <tt class="filename">ntconfig.pol</tt> you must use the NT Server Policy Editor, <b class="command">poledit.exe</b> which is included with NT4 Server but <span class="emphasis"><em>not NT Workstation</em></span>. There is a Policy Editor on a NT4 @@ -13097,14 +12296,14 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. be extracted as well. It is also possible to downloaded the policy template files for Office97 and get a copy of the policy editor. Another possible location is with the Zero Administration Kit available for download from Microsoft. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2968926"></a>Registry Spoiling</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2925205"></a>Registry Spoiling</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> With NT4 style registry based policy changes, a large number of settings are not automatically reversed as the user logs off. Since the settings that were in the NTConfig.POL file were applied to the client machine registry and that apply to the hive key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE are permanent until explicitly reversed. This is known as tattooing. It can have serious consequences down-stream and the administrator must be extremely careful not to lock out the ability to manage the machine at a later date. - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2968950"></a>MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925227"></a>MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Windows NT4 System policies allows setting of registry parameters specific to users, groups and computers (client workstations) that are members of the NT4 style domain. Such policy file will work with MS Windows 2000 / XP clients also. @@ -13141,7 +12340,7 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. to any number of concurrently applicable (and applied) policy sets (GPOs). Active Directory allows the administrator to also set filters over the policy settings. No such equivalent capability exists with NT4 style policy files. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2969051"></a>Administration of Win2K / XP Policies</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2925328"></a>Administration of Win2K / XP Policies</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Instead of using the tool called <span class="application">The System Policy Editor</span>, commonly called Poledit (from the executable name <b class="command">poledit.exe</b>), <span class="acronym">GPOs</span> are created and managed using a <span class="application">Microsoft Management Console</span> <span class="acronym">(MMC)</span> snap-in as follows:</p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -13167,10 +12366,10 @@ here is incomplete - you are warned. The MS Windows 2000 Resource Kit contains a tool called gpolmig.exe. This tool can be used to migrate an NT4 NTConfig.POL file into a Windows 200x style GPO. Be VERY careful how you use this powerful tool. Please refer to the resource kit manuals for specific usage information. - </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2969202"></a>Managing Account/User Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925491"></a>Managing Account/User Policies</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Policies can define a specific user's settings or the settings for a group of users. The resulting policy file contains the registry settings for all users, groups, and computers that will be using -the policy file. Separate policy files for each user, group, or computer are not not necessary. +the policy file. Separate policy files for each user, group, or computer are not necessary. </p><p> If you create a policy that will be automatically downloaded from validating domain controllers, you should name the file NTconfig.POL. As system administrator, you have the option of renaming the @@ -13193,20 +12392,27 @@ in a manner that works in conjunction with user profiles, the user management en MS Windows NT4/200x/XP allows per domain as well as per user account restrictions to be applied. Common restrictions that are frequently used includes: </p><p> -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Logon Hours</td></tr><tr><td>Password Aging</td></tr><tr><td>Permitted Logon from certain machines only</td></tr><tr><td>Account type (Local or Global)</td></tr><tr><td>User Rights</td></tr></table><p> -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969303"></a>Samba Editreg Toolset</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Describe in detail the benefits of <b class="command">editreg</b> and how to use it. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969324"></a>Windows NT4/200x</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Logon Hours</p></li><li><p>Password Aging</p></li><li><p>Permitted Logon from certain machines only</p></li><li><p>Account type (Local or Global)</p></li><li><p>User Rights</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925596"></a>Samba Editreg Toolset</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A new tool called <b class="command">editreg</b> is under development. This tool can be used + to edit registry files (called NTUser.DAT) that are stored in user and group profiles. + NTConfig.POL files have the same structure as the NTUser.DAT file and can be editted using + this tool. <b class="command">editreg</b> is being built with the intent to enable NTConfig.POL + files to be saved in text format and to permit the building of new NTConfig.POL files with + extended capabilities. It is proving difficult to realise this capability, so do not be surprised + if this feature does not materialise. Formal capabilities will be announced at the time that + this tool is released for production use. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925636"></a>Windows NT4/200x</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The tools that may be used to configure these types of controls from the MS Windows environment are: The NT4 User Manager for domains, the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor, the registry editor (regedt32.exe). Under MS Windows 200x/XP this is done using the Microsoft Management Console (MMC) with appropriate - "snap-ins", the registry editor, and potentially also the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969344"></a>Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + "snap-ins", the registry editor, and potentially also the NT4 System and Group Policy Editor. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925655"></a>Samba PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> With a Samba Domain Controller, the new tools for managing of user account and policy information includes: <b class="command">smbpasswd</b>, <b class="command">pdbedit</b>, <b class="command">net</b>, <b class="command">rpcclient</b>. The administrator should read the man pages for these tools and become familiar with their use. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2969388"></a>System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925700"></a>System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following attempts to document the order of processing of system and user policies following a system reboot and as part of the user logon: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -13215,7 +12421,7 @@ reboot and as part of the user logon: </p></li><li><p> Where Active Directory is involved, an ordered list of Group Policy Objects (GPOs) is downloaded and applied. The list may include GPOs that: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Apply to the location of machines in a Directory</td></tr><tr><td>Apply only when settings have changed</td></tr><tr><td>Depend on configuration of scope of applicability: local, site, domain, organizational unit, etc.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Apply to the location of machines in a Directory</p></li><li><p>Apply only when settings have changed</p></li><li><p>Depend on configuration of scope of applicability: local, site, domain, organizational unit, etc.</p></li></ul></div><p> No desktop user interface is presented until the above have been processed. </p></li><li><p> Execution of start-up scripts (hidden and synchronous by default). @@ -13226,7 +12432,7 @@ reboot and as part of the user logon: </p></li><li><p> An ordered list of User GPOs is obtained. The list contents depends on what is configured in respect of: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Is user a domain member, thus subject to particular policies</td></tr><tr><td>Loopback enablement, and the state of the loopback policy (Merge or Replace)</td></tr><tr><td>Location of the Active Directory itself</td></tr><tr><td>Has the list of GPOs changed. No processing is needed if not changed.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Is user a domain member, thus subject to particular policies</p></li><li><p>Loopback enablement, and the state of the loopback policy (Merge or Replace)</p></li><li><p>Location of the Active Directory itself</p></li><li><p>Has the list of GPOs changed. No processing is needed if not changed.</p></li></ul></div><p> </p></li><li><p> User Policies are applied from Active Directory. Note: There are several types. </p></li><li><p> @@ -13236,18 +12442,18 @@ reboot and as part of the user logon: </p></li><li><p> The User Interface as determined from the GPOs is presented. Note: In a Samba domain (like and NT4 Domain) machine (system) policies are applied at start-up, User policies are applied at logon. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2969535"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925851"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Policy related problems can be very difficult to diagnose and even more difficult to rectify. The following collection demonstrates only basic issues. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2969549"></a>Policy Does Not Work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Question: We have created the <tt class="filename">config.pol</tt> file and put it in the <span class="emphasis"><em>NETLOGON</em></span> share. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2925865"></a>Policy Does Not Work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">We have created the <tt class="filename">config.pol</tt> file and put it in the <span class="emphasis"><em>NETLOGON</em></span> share. It has made no difference to our Win XP Pro machines, they just don't see it. IT worked fine with Win 98 but does not -work any longer since we upgraded to Win XP Pro. Any hints? +work any longer since we upgraded to Win XP Pro. Any hints?</span>” </p><p> -<span class="emphasis"><em>ANSWER:</em></span> Policy files are NOT portable between Windows 9x / Me and MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP based +Policy files are NOT portable between Windows 9x / Me and MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP based platforms. You need to use the NT4 Group Policy Editor to create a file called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> so that it is in the correct format for your MS Windows XP Pro clients. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ProfileMgmt"></a>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2970756">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2970790">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2970831">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2971236">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972407">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972472">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2972737">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972795">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2972841">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2972861">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2973009">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2973563">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2974067">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2974080">How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2974143">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2974365">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2970756"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ProfileMgmt"></a>Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2925964">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2925999">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2926040">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2926530">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927776">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2927861">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2928114">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928172">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928216">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2928237">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928385">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2928939">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2929447">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2929460">Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2929529">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2929742">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925964"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Roaming Profiles are feared by some, hated by a few, loved by many, and a Godsend for some administrators. </p><p> @@ -13260,7 +12466,7 @@ problem to others. In particular, users of mobile computing tools, where often t be a sustained network connection, are often better served by purely Local Profiles. This chapter provides information to help the Samba administrator to deal with those situations also. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2970790"></a>Roaming Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2925999"></a>Roaming Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Roaming profiles support is different for Win9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x. </p></div><p> Before discussing how to configure roaming profiles, it is useful to see how @@ -13273,21 +12479,17 @@ profiles are restricted to being stored in the user's home directory. </p><p> Windows NT4/200x clients send a NetSAMLogon RPC request, which contains many fields, including a separate field for the location of the user's profiles. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2970831"></a>Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926040"></a>Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section documents how to configure Samba for MS Windows client profile support. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2970844"></a>NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926053"></a>NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To support Windows NT4/200x clients, in the [global] section of smb.conf set the following (for example): </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\profileserver\profileshare\profilepath\%U\moreprofilepath</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> This is typically implemented like: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon path = \\%L\Profiles\%u -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%L\Profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where %L translates to the name of the Samba server and %u translates to the user name </p><p> The default for this option is <tt class="filename">\\%N\%U\profile</tt>, @@ -13300,31 +12502,26 @@ semantics of %L and %N, as well as %U and %u. MS Windows NT/2K clients at times do not disconnect a connection to a server between logons. It is recommended to NOT use the <i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i> meta-service name as part of the profile share path. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2970937"></a>Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> - To support Windows 9x / Me clients, you must use the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. Samba has +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926161"></a>Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + To support Windows 9x / Me clients, you must use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2926173"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. Samba has now been fixed so that <b class="userinput"><tt>net use /home</tt></b> now works as well, and it, too, relies on the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter. </p><p> By using the logon home parameter, you are restricted to putting Win9x / Me profiles in the user's home directory. But wait! There is a trick you can use. If you set the following in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%U\.profiles</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> then your Windows 9x / Me clients will dutifully put their clients in a subdirectory of your home directory called <tt class="filename">.profiles</tt> (thus making them hidden). </p><p> Not only that, but <b class="userinput"><tt>net use /home</tt></b> will also work, because of a feature in Windows 9x / Me. It removes any directory stuff off the end of the home directory area and only uses the server and share portion. That is, it looks like you -specified <tt class="filename">\\%L\%U</tt> for <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971046"></a>Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +specified <tt class="filename">\\%L\%U</tt> for <a class="indexterm" name="id2926277"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926293"></a>Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can support profiles for both Win9X and WinNT clients by setting both the -<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameters. For example: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon home = \\%L\%u\.profiles - logon path = \\%L\profiles\%u -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971085"></a>Disabling Roaming Profile Support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926306"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2926319"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameters. For example: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%u\.profiles</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%L\profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926360"></a>Disabling Roaming Profile Support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A question often asked is “<span class="quote">How may I enforce use of local profiles?</span>” or “<span class="quote">How do I disable Roaming Profiles?</span>” </p><p> @@ -13332,13 +12529,11 @@ There are three ways of doing this: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">In <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p> Affect the following settings and ALL clients will be forced to use a local profile: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - logon home = - logon path = - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">MS Windows Registry:</span></dt><dd><p> By using the Microsoft Management Console gpedit.msc to instruct your MS Windows XP machine to use only a local profile. This of course modifies registry settings. The full path to the option is: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> Local Computer Policy\ Computer Configuration\ @@ -13361,15 +12556,15 @@ profiles. The specifics of how to convert a local profile to a roaming profile, or a roaming profile to a local one vary according to the version of MS Windows you are running. Consult the Microsoft MS Windows Resource Kit for your version of Windows for specific information. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2971236"></a>Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971244"></a>Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2926530"></a>Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2926538"></a>Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user first logs in on Windows 9X, the file user.DAT is created, as are folders <tt class="filename">Start Menu</tt>, <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">Programs</tt> and <tt class="filename">Nethood</tt>. These directories and their contents will be merged with the local versions stored in <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username</tt> on subsequent logins, taking the most recent from each. You will need to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> -options <i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case = yes</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case = yes</tt></i> and -<i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive = no</tt></i> in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts +options <a class="indexterm" name="id2926594"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case</tt></i> = yes, <a class="indexterm" name="id2926609"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i> = yes and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2926623"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i> = no in order to maintain capital letters in shortcuts in any of the profile folders. </p><p> The user.DAT file contains all the user's preferences. If you wish to @@ -13402,11 +12597,11 @@ domain and profiles downloaded from it, if that domain logon server supports it), user name and user's password. </p><p> Once the user has been successfully validated, the Windows 9x / Me machine -will inform you that <tt class="computeroutput">The user has not logged on before' and asks you - if you wish to save the user's preferences?</tt> Select <span class="guibutton">yes</span>. +will inform you that <tt class="computeroutput">The user has not logged on before</tt> and asks you +<tt class="computeroutput">Do you wish to save the user's preferences?</tt>. Select <span class="guibutton">yes</span>. </p><p> Once the Windows 9x / Me client comes up with the desktop, you should be able -to examine the contents of the directory specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> +to examine the contents of the directory specified in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2926811"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> on the samba server and verify that the <tt class="filename">Desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">Start Menu</tt>, <tt class="filename">Programs</tt> and <tt class="filename">Nethood</tt> folders have been created. </p><p> @@ -13420,14 +12615,14 @@ the newest folders and short-cuts from each set. If you have made the folders / files read-only on the samba server, then you will get errors from the Windows 9x / Me machine on logon and logout, as it attempts to merge the local and the remote profile. Basically, if -you have any errors reported by the Windows 9x / Me machine, check the Unix file +you have any errors reported by the Windows 9x / Me machine, check the UNIX file permissions and ownership rights on the profile directory contents, on the samba server. </p><p> If you have problems creating user profiles, you can reset the user's local desktop cache, as shown below. When this user then next logs in, -they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". -</p><div class="orderedlist"><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> +they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". +</p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Before deleting the contents of the directory listed in the ProfilePath (this is likely to be <tt class="filename">c:\windows\profiles\username)</tt>, ask them if they @@ -13437,8 +12632,8 @@ they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". </p><p> This will have the effect of removing the local (read-only hidden system file) user.DAT in their profile directory, as well as the - local "desktop", "nethood", "start menu" and "programs" folders. - </p></div><ol type="1"><li><p> + local "desktop", "nethood", "start menu" and "programs" folders. + </p></div><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> instead of logging in under the [user, password, domain] dialog, press <span class="guibutton">escape</span>. </p></li><li><p> @@ -13455,7 +12650,7 @@ they will be told that they are logging in "for the first time". </p></li><li><p> log off the windows 9x / Me client. </p></li><li><p> - check the contents of the profile path (see <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> described + check the contents of the profile path (see <a class="indexterm" name="id2927017"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> described above), and delete the <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> or <tt class="filename">user.MAN</tt> file for the user, making a backup if required. </p></li></ol></div><p> @@ -13467,14 +12662,14 @@ If you have access to an Windows NT4/200x server, then first set up roaming prof and / or netlogons on the Windows NT4/200x server. Make a packet trace, or examine the example packet traces provided with Windows NT4/200x server, and see what the differences are with the equivalent samba trace. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971738"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2927080"></a>Windows NT4 Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user first logs in to a Windows NT Workstation, the profile NTuser.DAT is created. The profile location can be now specified -through the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter. +through the <a class="indexterm" name="id2927093"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter. </p><p> There is a parameter that is now available for use with NT Profiles: -<i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i>. This should be set to <tt class="filename">H:</tt> or any other drive, and -should be used in conjunction with the new "logon home" parameter. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2927113"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i>. This should be set to <tt class="filename">H:</tt> or any other drive, and +should be used in conjunction with the new <a class="indexterm" name="id2927135"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter. </p><p> The entry for the NT4 profile is a _directory_ not a file. The NT help on profiles mentions that a directory is also created with a .PDS @@ -13496,7 +12691,7 @@ turns a profile into a mandatory one. </p><p> The case of the profile is significant. The file must be called <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> or, for a mandatory profile, <tt class="filename">NTuser.MAN</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2971896"></a>Windows 2000/XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2927266"></a>Windows 2000/XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must first convert the profile from a local profile to a domain profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -13512,11 +12707,10 @@ profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: </p></li><li><p> In the <span class="guilabel">Permitted to use</span> box, click on the <span class="guibutton">Change</span> button. </p></li><li><p> - Click on the 'Look in" area that lists the machine name, when you click + Click on the 'Look in" area that lists the machine name, when you click here it will open up a selection box. Click on the domain to which the profile must be accessible. - </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You will need to log on if a logon box opens up. Eg: In the connect - as: <i class="replaceable"><tt>MIDEARTH</tt></i>\root, password: <i class="replaceable"><tt>mypassword</tt></i>.</p></div></li><li><p> + </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You will need to log on if a logon box opens up. Eg: In the connect as: <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>\root, password: <i class="replaceable"><tt>mypassword</tt></i>.</p></div></li><li><p> To make the profile capable of being used by anyone select 'Everyone' </p></li><li><p> Click <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. The Selection box will close. @@ -13524,12 +12718,12 @@ profile on the MS Windows workstation as follows: Now click on the <span class="guibutton">Ok</span> button to create the profile in the path you nominated. </p></li></ol></div><p> -Done. You now have a profile that can be edited using the samba-3.0.0 +Done. You now have a profile that can be edited using the samba <b class="command">profiles</b> tool. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Under NT/2K the use of mandatory profiles forces the use of MS Exchange storage of mail data. That keeps desktop profiles usable. -</p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> +</p></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 24.2. Windows XP Service Pack 1</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> This is a security check new to Windows XP (or maybe only Windows XP service pack 1). It can be disabled via a group policy in Active Directory. The policy is:</p><p><tt class="filename">Computer Configuration\Administrative Templates\System\User @@ -13543,10 +12737,10 @@ the following (N.B. I don't know for sure that this will work in the same way as a domain group policy): </p></li><li><p> On the XP workstation log in with an Administrator account. -</p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guimenu">Start</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Run</span></p></li><li><p>Type: <b class="userinput"><tt>mmc</tt></b></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>A Microsoft Management Console should appear.</p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guimenu">File</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Add/Remove Snap-in...</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Add</span></p></li><li><p>Double-Click: <span class="guiicon">Group Policy</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">Finish</span>, <span class="guibutton">Close</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>In the "Console Root" window:</p></li><li><p>Expand: <span class="guiicon">Local Computer Policy</span>, <span class="guiicon">Computer Configuration</span>, +</p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guimenu">Start</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Run</span></p></li><li><p>Type: <b class="userinput"><tt>mmc</tt></b></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>A Microsoft Management Console should appear.</p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guimenu">File</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Add/Remove Snap-in...</span>, <span class="guimenuitem">Add</span></p></li><li><p>Double-Click: <span class="guiicon">Group Policy</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">Finish</span>, <span class="guibutton">Close</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>In the "Console Root" window:</p></li><li><p>Expand: <span class="guiicon">Local Computer Policy</span>, <span class="guiicon">Computer Configuration</span>, <span class="guiicon">Administrative Templates</span>, <span class="guiicon">System</span>, <span class="guiicon">User Profiles</span></p></li><li><p>Double-Click: <span class="guilabel">Do not check for user ownership of Roaming Profile Folders</span></p></li><li><p>Select: <span class="guilabel">Enabled</span></p></li><li><p>Click: <span class="guibutton">OK</span></p></li><li><p>Close the whole console. You do not need to save the settings (this refers to the console settings rather than the policies you have - changed).</p></li><li><p>Reboot</p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2972407"></a>Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + changed).</p></li><li><p>Reboot</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927776"></a>Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Sharing of desktop profiles between Windows versions is NOT recommended. Desktop profiles are an evolving phenomenon and profiles for later versions of MS Windows clients add features that may interfere with earlier versions @@ -13557,18 +12751,18 @@ version resulting in loss of profile information content when that user logs on again with the newer version of MS Windows. </p><p> If you then want to share the same Start Menu / Desktop with W9x/Me, you will -need to specify a common location for the profiles. The smb.conf parameters -that need to be common are <i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> and -<i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. +need to specify a common location for the profiles. The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters +that need to be common are <a class="indexterm" name="id2927812"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2927827"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. </p><p> If you have this set up correctly, you will find separate <tt class="filename">user.DAT</tt> and <tt class="filename">NTuser.DAT</tt> files in the same profile directory. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2972472"></a>Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2927861"></a>Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is nothing to stop you specifying any path that you like for the location of users' profiles. Therefore, you could specify that the profile be stored on a samba server, or any other SMB server, as long as that SMB server supports encrypted passwords. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2972489"></a>Windows NT4 Profile Management Tools</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2927878"></a>Windows NT4 Profile Management Tools</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Unfortunately, the Resource Kit information is specific to the version of MS Windows NT4/200x. The correct resource kit is required for each platform. </p><p> @@ -13578,24 +12772,20 @@ On your NT4 Domain Controller, right click on <span class="guiicon">My Computer< select the tab labelled <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span>. </p></li><li><p> Select a user profile you want to migrate and click on it. -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>I am using the term "migrate" loosely. You can copy a profile to +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>I am using the term "migrate" loosely. You can copy a profile to create a group profile. You can give the user 'Everyone' rights to the profile you copy this to. That is what you need to do, since your samba domain is not a member of a trust relationship with your NT4 PDC.</p></div></li><li><p>Click the <span class="guibutton">Copy To</span> button.</p></li><li><p>In the box labelled <span class="guilabel">Copy Profile to</span> add your new path, eg: <tt class="filename">c:\temp\foobar</tt></p></li><li><p>Click on the button <span class="guibutton">Change</span> in the <span class="guilabel">Permitted to use</span> box.</p></li><li><p>Click on the group 'Everyone' and then click <span class="guibutton">OK</span>. This closes the 'choose user' box.</p></li><li><p>Now click <span class="guibutton">OK</span>.</p></li></ol></div><p> Follow the above for every profile you need to migrate. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2972658"></a>Side bar Notes</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928042"></a>Side bar Notes</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You should obtain the SID of your NT4 domain. You can use smbpasswd to do -this. Read the man page.</p><p> -With Samba-3.0.0 alpha code you can import all you NT4 domain accounts -using the net samsync method. This way you can retain your profile -settings as well as all your users. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2972680"></a>moveuser.exe</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +this. Read the man page.</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928057"></a>moveuser.exe</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The W2K professional resource kit has moveuser.exe. moveuser.exe changes the security of a profile from one user to another. This allows the account domain to change, and/or the user name to change. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2972696"></a>Get SID</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928073"></a>Get SID</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can identify the SID by using GetSID.exe from the Windows NT Server 4.0 Resource Kit. </p><p> @@ -13608,7 +12798,7 @@ users who have logged on to this computer. (To find the profile information for the user whose locally cached profile you want to move, find the SID for the user with the GetSID.exe utility.) Inside of the appropriate user's subkey, you will see a string value named ProfileImagePath. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972737"></a>Mandatory profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2928114"></a>Mandatory profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A Mandatory Profile is a profile that the user does NOT have the ability to overwrite. During the user's session it may be possible to change the desktop environment, but as the user logs out all changes made will be lost. If it is desired to NOT allow the @@ -13624,7 +12814,7 @@ file in the copied profile and rename it to NTUser.MAN. </p><p> For MS Windows 9x / Me it is the <tt class="filename">User.DAT</tt> file that must be renamed to <tt class="filename">User.MAN</tt> to affect a mandatory profile. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972795"></a>Creating/Managing Group Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2928172"></a>Creating/Managing Group Profiles</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Most organisations are arranged into departments. There is a nice benefit in this fact since usually most users in a department will require the same desktop applications and the same desktop layout. MS Windows NT4/200x/XP will allow the @@ -13634,19 +12824,19 @@ profile is assigned access rights for the user group that needs to be given acce to the group profile. </p><p> The next step is rather important. <span class="emphasis"><em>Please note:</em></span> Instead of assigning a group profile -to users (ie: Using User Manager) on a "per user" basis, the group itself is assigned +to users (ie: Using User Manager) on a "per user" basis, the group itself is assigned the now modified profile. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Be careful with group profiles, if the user who is a member of a group also has a personal profile, then the result will be a fusion (merge) of the two. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2972841"></a>Default Profile for Windows Users</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2928216"></a>Default Profile for Windows Users</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows 9x / Me and NT4/200x/XP will use a default profile for any user for whom a profile does not already exist. Armed with a knowledge of where the default profile is located on the Windows workstation, and knowing which registry keys affect the path from which the default profile is created, it is possible to modify the default profile to one that has been optimised for the site. This has significant administrative advantages. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2972861"></a>MS Windows 9x/Me</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928237"></a>MS Windows 9x/Me</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To enable default per use profiles in Windows 9x / Me you can either use the <span class="application">Windows 98 System Policy Editor</span> or change the registry directly. </p><p> @@ -13657,8 +12847,8 @@ select <span class="guilabel">User Profiles</span>, click on the enable box. Do </p><p> To modify the registry directly, launch the <span class="application">Registry Editor</span> (<b class="command">regedit.exe</b>), select the hive <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Network\Logon</tt>. Now add a DWORD type key with the name -"User Profiles", to enable user profiles set the value to 1, to disable user profiles set it to 0. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2972959"></a>How User Profiles Are Handled in Windows 9x / Me?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"User Profiles", to enable user profiles set the value to 1, to disable user profiles set it to 0. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928336"></a>How User Profiles Are Handled in Windows 9x / Me?</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When a user logs on to a Windows 9x / Me machine, the local profile path, <tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Software\Microsoft\Windows\CurrentVersion\ProfileList</tt>, is checked for an existing entry for that user: @@ -13674,7 +12864,7 @@ If a User Profile is not found in either location, the Default User Profile from machine is used and is copied to a newly created folder for the logged on user. At log off, any changes that the user made are written to the user's local profile. If the user has a roaming profile, the changes are written to the user's profile on the server. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2973009"></a>MS Windows NT4 Workstation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928385"></a>MS Windows NT4 Workstation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> On MS Windows NT4 the default user profile is obtained from the location <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles</tt> which in a default installation will translate to <tt class="filename">C:\WinNT\Profiles</tt>. Under this directory on a clean install there will be @@ -13685,7 +12875,7 @@ system users. The <tt class="filename">Default User</tt> directory contains menu customisable per user depending on the profile settings chosen/created. </p><p> When a new user first logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine a new profile is created from: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>All Users settings</td></tr><tr><td>Default User settings (contains the default NTUser.DAT file)</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>All Users settings</p></li><li><p>Default User settings (contains the default NTUser.DAT file)</p></li></ul></div><p> When a user logs onto an MS Windows NT4 machine that is a member of a Microsoft security domain the following steps are followed in respect of profile handling: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -13717,8 +12907,8 @@ will stored in the <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt> lo also remain stored in the same way, unless the following registry key is created: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> - HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\winlogon\ - "DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001 +HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ +winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001 </pre><p> In which case, the local copy (in <tt class="filename">%SystemRoot%\Profiles\%USERNAME%</tt>) will be @@ -13737,7 +12927,7 @@ are controlled by entries on Windows NT4 is: </p><p> The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are: </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2973359"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.1. User Shell Folder registry keys default values</b></p><table summary="User Shell Folder registry keys default values" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu </td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2928735"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.1. User Shell Folder registry keys default values</b></p><table summary="User Shell Folder registry keys default values" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu </td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> The registry key that contains the location of the default profile settings is: </p><p> @@ -13745,8 +12935,8 @@ The registry key that contains the location of the default profile settings is: </p><p> The default entries are: -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2973503"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.2. Defaults of profile settings registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of profile settings registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td>Common Desktop</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Common Programs</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Common Start Menu</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Common Startup</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2973563"></a>MS Windows 200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2928879"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.2. Defaults of profile settings registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of profile settings registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td>Common Desktop</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Common Programs</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Common Start Menu</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Common Startup</td><td>%SystemRoot%\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928939"></a>MS Windows 200x/XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> MS Windows XP Home Edition does use default per user profiles, but can not participate in domain security, can not log onto an NT/ADS style domain, and thus can obtain the profile only from itself. While there are benefits in doing this the beauty of those MS Windows @@ -13795,9 +12985,9 @@ are controlled by entries on Windows 200x/XP is: </p><p> The above hive key contains a list of automatically managed folders. The default entries are: </p><p> -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2973759"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.3. Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Cache</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Temporary Internet Files</td></tr><tr><td>Cookies</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Cookies</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>History</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\History</td></tr><tr><td>Local AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Local Settings</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings</td></tr><tr><td>My Pictures</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents\My Pictures</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>Personal</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr><tr><td>Templates</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Templates</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2929134"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 24.3. Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</b></p><table summary="Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Name</th><th>Default Value</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Cache</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Temporary Internet Files</td></tr><tr><td>Cookies</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Cookies</td></tr><tr><td>Desktop</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Desktop</td></tr><tr><td>Favorites</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Favorites</td></tr><tr><td>History</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\History</td></tr><tr><td>Local AppData</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings\Application Data</td></tr><tr><td>Local Settings</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Local Settings</td></tr><tr><td>My Pictures</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents\My Pictures</td></tr><tr><td>NetHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\NetHood</td></tr><tr><td>Personal</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\My Documents</td></tr><tr><td>PrintHood</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\PrintHood</td></tr><tr><td>Programs</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs</td></tr><tr><td>Recent</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Recent</td></tr><tr><td>SendTo</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\SendTo</td></tr><tr><td>Start Menu</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu</td></tr><tr><td>Startup</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Start Menu\Programs\Startup</td></tr><tr><td>Templates</td><td>%USERPROFILE%\Templates</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> -There is also an entry called "Default" that has no value set. The default entry is of type <tt class="constant">REG_SZ</tt>, all +There is also an entry called "Default" that has no value set. The default entry is of type <tt class="constant">REG_SZ</tt>, all the others are of type <tt class="constant">REG_EXPAND_SZ</tt>. </p><p> It makes a huge difference to the speed of handling roaming user profiles if all the folders are @@ -13811,18 +13001,21 @@ You could also use: </p><p><tt class="filename">\\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SambaServer</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>FolderShare</tt></i>\%USERNAME%</tt></p><p> in which case the default folders will be stored in the server named <i class="replaceable"><tt>SambaServer</tt></i> in the share called <i class="replaceable"><tt>FolderShare</tt></i> under a directory that has the name of the MS Windows -user as seen by the Linux/Unix file system. +user as seen by the Linux/UNIX file system. </p><p> Please note that once you have created a default profile share, you MUST migrate a user's profile (default or custom) to it. </p><p> MS Windows 200x/XP profiles may be <span class="emphasis"><em>Local</em></span> or <span class="emphasis"><em>Roaming</em></span>. A roaming profile will be cached locally unless the following registry key is created: -</p><p><tt class="filename">HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001</tt></p><p> +</p><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\Software\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\ + winlogon\"DeleteRoamingCache"=dword:00000001</pre><p> In which case, the local cache copy will be deleted on logout. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2974067"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929447"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following are some typical errors/problems/questions that have been asked. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974080"></a>How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929460"></a>Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> With samba-2.2.x the choice you have is to enable or disable roaming profiles support. It is a global only setting. The default is to have roaming profiles and the default path will locate them in the user's home @@ -13834,42 +13027,40 @@ those machines on which roaming profile support is NOT wanted it is then necessary to disable roaming profile handling in the registry of each such machine. </p><p> -With samba-3.0.0 (soon to be released) you can have a global profile -setting in smb.conf _AND_ you can over-ride this by per-user settings +With samba-3 you can have a global profile +setting in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> _AND_ you can over-ride this by per-user settings using the Domain User Manager (as with MS Windows NT4/ Win 2Kx). </p><p> In any case, you can configure only one profile per user. That profile can be either: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>A profile unique to that user</td></tr><tr><td>A mandatory profile (one the user can not change)</td></tr><tr><td>A group profile (really should be mandatory ie:unchangable)</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974143"></a>Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A profile unique to that user</p></li><li><p>A mandatory profile (one the user can not change)</p></li><li><p>A group profile (really should be mandatory ie:unchangable)</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929529"></a>Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A user requested the following: “<span class="quote"> - I dont want Roaming profile to be implemented, I just want to give users - local profiles only. -... - Please help me I am totally lost with this error from past two days I tried - everything and googled around quite a bit but of no help. Please help me. +I do not want Roaming profiles to be implemented. I want to give users a local profile alone. ... +Please help me I am totally lost with this error. For the past two days I tried everything, I googled +around but found no useful pointers. Please help me. </span>”</p><p> -Your choices are: - - -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Local profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - I know of no registry keys that will allow auto-deletion of LOCAL profiles on log out - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>can use auto-delete on logout option</td></tr><tr><td>requires a registry key change on workstation</td></tr></table><p> - - Your choices are: - - </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Personal Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - - should be preserved on a central server - - workstations 'cache' (store) a local copy - - used in case the profile can not be downloaded - at next logon - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Group profiles</span></dt><dd><p>- loaded from a central place</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Mandatory profiles</span></dt><dd><p> - - can be personal or group - - can NOT be changed (except by an administrator - </p></dd></dl></div><p> +The choices are: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Local profiles:</span></dt><dd><p> + I know of no registry keys that will allow auto-deletion of LOCAL profiles on log out + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Roaming profiles:</span></dt><dd><p> + As a user logs onto the network a centrally stored profile is copied to the workstation + to form a local profile. This local profile will persist (remain on the workstation disk) + unless a registry key is changed that will cause this profile to be automatically deleted + on logout. + </p></dd></dl></div><p> +The <span class="emphasis"><em>Roaming Profile</em></span> choices are: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Personal Roaming profiles</span></dt><dd><p> + These are typically stored in a profile share on a central (or conveniently located + local) server. + </p><p> + Workstations 'cache' (store) a local copy of the profile. This cached copy is used when + the profile can not be downloaded at next logon. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Group profiles</span></dt><dd><p>These are loaded from a central profile server</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Mandatory profiles</span></dt><dd><p> + Mandatory profiles can be created for a user as well as for any group that a user + is a member of. Mandatory profiles can NOT be changed by ordinary users. Only the administrator + can change or reconfigure a mandatory profile. </p></dd></dl></div><p> - -</p><p> A WinNT4/2K/XP profile can vary in size from 130KB to off the scale. Outlook PST files are most often part of the profile and can be many GB in size. On average (in a well controlled environment) roaming profile size of @@ -13883,52 +13074,39 @@ controls of how they can be changed as well as good discipline make up for a problem free site. </p><p> Microsoft's answer to the PST problem is to store all email in an MS -Exchange Server back-end. But this is another story ...! -</p><p> -So, having LOCAL profiles means: - -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>If lots of users user each machine - lot's of local disk storage needed for local profiles</td></tr><tr><td>Every workstation the user logs into has it's own profile - can be very different from machine to machine</td></tr></table><p> - -On the other hand, having roaming profiles means: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>The network administrator can control EVERY aspect of user profiles</td></tr><tr><td>With the use of mandatory profiles - a drastic reduction in network management overheads</td></tr><tr><td>User unhappiness about not being able to change their profiles soon fades as they get used to being able to work reliably</td></tr></table><p> - +Exchange Server back-end. This removes the need for a PST file. </p><p> -I have managed and installed MANY NT/2K networks and have NEVER found one -where users who move from machine to machine are happy with local -profiles. In the long run local profiles bite them. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2974365"></a>Changing the default profile</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> -When the client tries to logon to the PDC it looks for a profile to download -where do I put this default profile. +LOCAL profiles mean: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>If each machine is used my many users then much local disk storage is needed for local profiles</p></li><li><p>Every workstation the user logs into has it's own profile, these can be very different from machine to machine</p></li></ul></div><p> +On the other hand, use of roaming profiles means: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The network administrator can control the desktop environment of all users.</p></li><li><p>Use of mandatory profiles drasitcally reduces network management overheads.</p></li><li><p>In the long run users will be experience fewer problems.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929742"></a>Changing the default profile</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<span class="emphasis"><em>Question:</em></span> +“<span class="quote"> +When the client logs onto the domain controller it searches for a profile to download, +where do I put this default profile? </span>”</p><p> -Firstly, your samba server need to be configured as a domain controller. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - server = user - os level = 32 (or more) - domain logons = Yes -</pre><p> -Plus you need to have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share that is world readable. +Firstly, the samba server needs to be configured as a domain controller. +This can be done by setting in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 32 (or more)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +There must be an <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share that is world readable. It is a good idea to add a logon script to pre-set printer and drive connections. There is also a facility for automatically synchronizing the workstation time clock with that of the logon server (another good thing to do). </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> To invoke auto-deletion of roaming profile from the local -workstation cache (disk storage) you need to use the <span class="application">Group Policy Editor</span> +workstation cache (disk storage) use the <span class="application">Group Policy Editor</span> to create a file called <tt class="filename">NTConfig.POL</tt> with the appropriate entries. This file needs to be located in the <i class="parameter"><tt>netlogon</tt></i> share root directory.</p></div><p> -Oh, of course the windows clients need to be members of the domain. -Workgroup machines do NOT do network logons - so they never see domain -profiles. +Windows clients need to be members of the domain. Workgroup machines do NOT use network logons so +they do not interoperate with domain profiles. </p><p> -Secondly, for roaming profiles you need: - - logon path = \\%N\profiles\%U (with some such path) - logon drive = H: (Z: is the default) - - Plus you need a PROFILES share that is world writable. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pam"></a>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2978309">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2978577">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2978595">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979265">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979567">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979625">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2979709">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2980075">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2980089">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +For roaming profiles add to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%N\profiles\%U</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Default logon drive is Z:</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive = H:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># This requires a PROFILES share that is world writable.</td></tr></table><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pam"></a>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2930024">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2930271">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2930288">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2930969">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931283">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931361">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931445">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2931826">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2931839">pam_winbind problem</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2931926">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This chapter you should help you to deploy winbind based authentication on any PAM enabled -Unix/Linux system. Winbind can be used to enable user level application access authentication +UNIX/Linux system. Winbind can be used to enable user level application access authentication from any MS Windows NT Domain, MS Windows 200x Active Directory based domain, or any Samba based domain environment. It will also help you to configure PAM based local host access controls that are appropriate to your Samba configuration. @@ -13936,9 +13114,9 @@ controls that are appropriate to your Samba configuration. In addition to knowing how to configure winbind into PAM, you will learn generic PAM management possibilities and in particular how to deploy tools like pam_smbpass.so to your advantage. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -The use of Winbind require more than PAM configuration alone. Please refer to <a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">the Winbind chapter</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978309"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -A number of Unix systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the xxxxBSD family and Linux, +The use of Winbind require more than PAM configuration alone. Please refer to <a href="#winbind" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts">the Winbind chapter</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930024"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A number of UNIX systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the xxxxBSD family and Linux, now utilize the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) facility to provide all authentication, authorization and resource control services. Prior to the introduction of PAM, a decision to use an alternative to the system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>) @@ -13951,38 +13129,38 @@ authentication/authorization infrastructure. PAM is configured either through o <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> (Solaris), or by editing individual files that are located in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt>. </p><p> -On PAM enabled Unix/Linux systems it is an easy matter to configure the system to use any +On PAM enabled UNIX/Linux systems it is an easy matter to configure the system to use any authentication backend, so long as the appropriate dynamically loadable library modules are available for it. The backend may be local to the system, or may be centralised on a remote server. </p><p> PAM support modules are available for: -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt></span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> - There are several PAM modules that interact with this standard Unix user +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>:</span></dt><dd><p> + There are several PAM modules that interact with this standard UNIX user database. The most common are called: pam_unix.so, pam_unix2.so, pam_pwdb.so and pam_userdb.so. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Kerberos</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Kerberos:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_krb5.so module allows the use of any Kerberos compliant server. This tool is used to access MIT Kerberos, Heimdal Kerberos, and potentially Microsoft Active Directory (if enabled). - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LDAP</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LDAP:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_ldap.so module allows the use of any LDAP v2 or v3 compatible backend server. Commonly used LDAP backend servers include: OpenLDAP v2.0 and v2.1, Sun ONE iDentity server, Novell eDirectory server, Microsoft Active Directory. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NetWare Bindery</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NetWare Bindery:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_ncp_auth.so module allows authentication off any bindery enabled NetWare Core Protocol based server. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Password</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Password:</span></dt><dd><p> This module, called pam_smbpass.so, will allow user authentication off the passdb backend that is configured in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Server</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Server:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_smb_auth.so module is the original MS Windows networking authentication tool. This module has been somewhat outdated by the Winbind module. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Winbind</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Winbind:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_winbind.so module allows Samba to obtain authentication from any MS Windows Domain Controller. It can just as easily be used to authenticate users for access to any PAM enabled application. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RADIUS</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RADIUS:</span></dt><dd><p> There is a PAM RADIUS (Remote Access Dial-In User Service) authentication module. In most cases the administrator will need to locate the source code for this tool and compile and install it themselves. RADIUS protocols are @@ -13995,12 +13173,12 @@ of distributed samba domain controllers that can provide wide are network bandwi efficient authentication services for PAM capable systems. In effect, this allows the deployment of centrally managed and maintained distributed authentication from a single user account database. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978577"></a>Technical Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2930271"></a>Technical Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> PAM is designed to provide the system administrator with a great deal of flexibility in configuration of the privilege granting applications of their system. The local configuration of system security controlled by PAM is contained in one of two places: either the single system file, /etc/pam.conf; or the /etc/pam.d/ directory. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978595"></a>PAM Configuration Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930288"></a>PAM Configuration Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In this section we discuss the correct syntax of and generic options respected by entries to these files. PAM specific tokens in the configuration file are case insensitive. The module paths, however, are case sensitive since they indicate a file's name and reflect the case dependence of typical file-systems. @@ -14015,32 +13193,31 @@ default location then it is not necessary to specify the path. In the case of Linux, the default location is <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt>. If the module is located outside the default then the path must be specified as: </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> auth required /other_path/pam_strange_module.so </pre><p> -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2978651"></a>Anatomy of <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> Entries</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2930347"></a>Anatomy of <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> Entries</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The remaining information in this subsection was taken from the documentation of the Linux-PAM project. For more information on PAM, see -<a href="http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/" target="_top"> -http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam</a> The Official Linux-PAM home page. +<a href="http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/" target="_top">The Official Linux-PAM home page</a> </p><p> A general configuration line of the /etc/pam.conf file has the following form: </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> service-name module-type control-flag module-path args </pre><p> </p><p> Below, we explain the meaning of each of these tokens. The second (and more recently adopted) way of configuring Linux-PAM is via the contents of the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> directory. Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this method. -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">service-name</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">service-name:</span></dt><dd><p> The name of the service associated with this entry. Frequently the service name is the conventional name of the given application. For example, `ftpd', `rlogind' and `su', etc. . </p><p> There is a special service-name, reserved for defining a default authentication mechanism. It has the name `OTHER' and may be specified in either lower or upper case characters. Note, when there is a module specified for a named service, the `OTHER' entries are ignored. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-type</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-type:</span></dt><dd><p> One of (currently) four types of module. The four types are as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>auth:</em></span> this module type provides two aspects of authenticating the user. @@ -14062,7 +13239,7 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me <span class="emphasis"><em>password:</em></span> this last module type is required for updating the authentication token associated with the user. Typically, there is one module for each `challenge/response' based authentication (auth) module-type. - </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">control-flag</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">control-flag:</span></dt><dd><p> The control-flag is used to indicate how the PAM library will react to the success or failure of the module it is associated with. Since modules can be stacked (modules of the same type execute in series, one after another), the control-flags determine the relative importance of each module. The application @@ -14106,9 +13283,9 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me The more elaborate (newer) syntax is much more specific and gives the administrator a great deal of control over how the user is authenticated. This form of the control flag is delimited with square brackets and consists of a series of value=action tokens: - </p><pre class="screen"> - [value1=action1 value2=action2 ...] - </pre><p> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +[value1=action1 value2=action2 ...] +</pre><p> Here, value1 is one of the following return values: success; open_err; symbol_err; service_err; system_err; buf_err; perm_denied; auth_err; cred_insufficient; authinfo_unavail; user_unknown; maxtries; new_authtok_reqd; acct_expired; session_err; cred_unavail; cred_expired; cred_err; no_module_data; conv_err; @@ -14163,7 +13340,7 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me <span class="emphasis"><em>[ ... value=action ... ]</em></span> control syntax, it is possible for an application to be configured to support binary prompts with compliant clients, but to gracefully fall over into an alternative authentication mode for older, legacy, applications. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-path</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-path:</span></dt><dd><p> The path-name of the dynamically loadable object file; the pluggable module itself. If the first character of the module path is `/', it is assumed to be a complete path. If this is not the case, the given module path is appended to the default module path: <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt> (but see the notes above). @@ -14174,7 +13351,7 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me to syslog(3). For a list of generic options see the next section. </p><p> Note, if you wish to include spaces in an argument, you should surround that argument with square brackets. For example: - </p><pre class="screen"> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> squid auth required pam_mysql.so user=passwd_query passwd=mada \ db=eminence [query=select user_name from internet_service where \ user_name='%u' and password=PASSWORD('%p') and \ @@ -14182,19 +13359,19 @@ squid auth required pam_mysql.so user=passwd_query passwd=mada \ </pre><p> Note, when using this convention, you can include `[' characters inside the string, and if you wish to include a `]' character inside the string that will survive the argument parsing, you should use `\['. In other words: - </p><pre class="screen"> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> [..[..\]..] --> ..[..].. </pre><p> Any line in (one of) the configuration file(s), that is not formatted correctly, will generally tend (erring on the side of caution) to make the authentication process fail. A corresponding error is written to the system log files with a call to syslog(3). - </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979265"></a>Example System Configurations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2930969"></a>Example System Configurations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following is an example <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> configuration file. This example had all options been uncommented is probably not usable as it stacks many conditions before allowing successful completion of the login process. Essentially all conditions can be disabled by commenting them out except the calls to <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2979296"></a>PAM: original login config</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2931000"></a>PAM: original login config</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `login' service # @@ -14209,10 +13386,10 @@ session required pam_pwdb.so # session optional pam_lastlog.so # password required pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2979322"></a>PAM: login using pam_smbpass</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2931038"></a>PAM: login using pam_smbpass</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> PAM allows use of replaceable modules. Those available on a sample system include: </p><p><tt class="prompt">$</tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/bin/ls /lib/security</tt></b> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> pam_access.so pam_ftp.so pam_limits.so pam_ncp_auth.so pam_rhosts_auth.so pam_stress.so pam_cracklib.so pam_group.so pam_listfile.so @@ -14236,7 +13413,7 @@ hashes. This database is stored in either <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt>, or in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba.d/smbpasswd</tt>, depending on the -Samba implementation for your Unix/Linux system. The +Samba implementation for your UNIX/Linux system. The <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> module is provided by Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the <tt class="option">--with-pam_smbpass</tt> options when running Samba's @@ -14244,7 +13421,7 @@ Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the on the <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt> module, see the documentation in the <tt class="filename">source/pam_smbpass</tt> directory of the Samba source distribution. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `login' service # @@ -14255,7 +13432,7 @@ password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay </pre><p> The following is the PAM configuration file for a particular Linux system. The default condition uses <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service # @@ -14269,7 +13446,7 @@ smbpasswd database even for basic samba authentication. Such a decision could also be made for the passwd program and would thus allow the smbpasswd passwords to be changed using the passwd program. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service # @@ -14288,24 +13465,24 @@ authentication to be configured in a single central file. The on the basis that it allows for easier administration. As with all issues in life though, every decision makes trade-offs, so you may want examine the PAM documentation for further helpful information. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979567"></a>smb.conf PAM Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There is an option in smb.conf called <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS" target="_top">obey pam restrictions</a>. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931283"></a>smb.conf PAM Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There is an option in smb.conf called <a class="indexterm" name="id2931292"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i>. The following is from the on-line help for this option in SWAT; </p><p> -When Samba-3 is configured to enable PAM support (i.e. +When Samba is configured to enable PAM support (i.e. <tt class="option">--with-pam</tt>), this parameter will control whether or not Samba should obey PAM's account and session management directives. The default behavior is to use PAM for clear text authentication only and to ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of -<a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt passwords = yes</a>. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2931323"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes. The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB password encryption. -</p><p>Default: <i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions = no</tt></i></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979625"></a>Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><p>Default: <a class="indexterm" name="id2931344"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i> = no</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931361"></a>Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> All operating systems depend on the provision of users credentials acceptable to the platform. -Unix requires the provision of a user identifier (UID) as well as a group identifier (GID). +UNIX requires the provision of a user identifier (UID) as well as a group identifier (GID). These are both simple integer type numbers that are obtained from a password backend such as <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. </p><p> @@ -14329,7 +13506,7 @@ Microsoft Active Directory Service (ADS) in so far as reduction of wide area net The rid to unix id database is the only location where the user and group mappings are stored by winbindd. If this file is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for winbindd to determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user and group rids. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979709"></a>Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931445"></a>Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> pam_smbpass is a PAM module which can be used on conforming systems to keep the smbpasswd (Samba password) database in sync with the unix password file. PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) is an API supported @@ -14342,24 +13519,23 @@ concerned about the presence of suid root binaries on your system, it is recommended that you use pam_winbind instead. </p><p> Options recognized by this module are as follows: -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2979741"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 25.1. Options recognized by pam_smbpass</b></p><table summary="Options recognized by pam_smbpass" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">debug</td><td align="left">log more debugging info</td></tr><tr><td align="left">audit</td><td align="left">like debug, but also logs unknown usernames</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_first_pass</td><td align="left">don't prompt the user for passwords; take them from PAM_ items instead</td></tr><tr><td align="left">try_first_pass</td><td align="left">try to get the password from a previous PAM module, fall back to prompting the user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_authtok</td><td align="left">like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set. (intended for stacking password modules only)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">not_set_pass</td><td align="left">don't make passwords used by this module available to other modules.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nodelay</td><td align="left">don't insert ~1 second delays on authentication failure.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nullok</td><td align="left">null passwords are allowed.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nonull</td><td align="left">null passwords are not allowed. Used to override the Samba configuration.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">migrate</td><td align="left">only meaningful in an "auth" context; used to update smbpasswd file with a password used for successful authentication.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">smbconf=<i class="replaceable"><tt>file</tt></i></td><td align="left">specify an alternate path to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2931477"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 25.1. Options recognized by pam_smbpass</b></p><table summary="Options recognized by pam_smbpass" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">debug</td><td align="justify">log more debugging info</td></tr><tr><td align="left">audit</td><td align="justify">like debug, but also logs unknown usernames</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_first_pass</td><td align="justify">don't prompt the user for passwords; take them from PAM_ items instead</td></tr><tr><td align="left">try_first_pass</td><td align="justify">try to get the password from a previous PAM module, fall back to prompting the user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_authtok</td><td align="justify">like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set. (intended for stacking password modules only)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">not_set_pass</td><td align="justify">don't make passwords used by this module available to other modules.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nodelay</td><td align="justify">don't insert ~1 second delays on authentication failure.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nullok</td><td align="justify">null passwords are allowed.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nonull</td><td align="justify">null passwords are not allowed. Used to override the Samba configuration.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">migrate</td><td align="justify">only meaningful in an "auth" context; used to update smbpasswd file with a password used for successful authentication.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">smbconf=<i class="replaceable"><tt>file</tt></i></td><td align="justify">specify an alternate path to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> -Thanks go to the following people: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="mailto:morgan@transmeta.com" target="_top">Andrew Morgan</a>, for providing the Linux-PAM - framework, without which none of this would have happened</td></tr><tr><td><a href="gafton@redhat.com" target="_top">Christian Gafton</a> and Andrew Morgan again, for the - pam_pwdb module upon which pam_smbpass was originally based</td></tr><tr><td><a href="lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">Luke Leighton</a> for being receptive to the idea, +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="mailto:morgan@transmeta.com" target="_top">Andrew Morgan</a>, for providing the Linux-PAM + framework, without which none of this would have happened</p></li><li><p><a href="mailto:gafton@redhat.com" target="_top">Christian Gafton</a> and Andrew Morgan again, for the + pam_pwdb module upon which pam_smbpass was originally based</p></li><li><p><a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">Luke Leighton</a> for being receptive to the idea, and for the occasional good-natured complaint about the project's status - that keep me working on it :)</td></tr></table><p>. + that keep me working on it :)</p></li></ul></div><p>. </p><p> The following are examples of the use of pam_smbpass.so in the format of Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> files structure. Those wishing to implement this tool on other platforms will need to adapt this appropriately. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2979941"></a>Password Synchronisation Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2931691"></a>Password Synchronisation Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to make sure private/smbpasswd is kept in sync when /etc/passwd (/etc/shadow) is changed. Useful when an expired password might be changed by an application (such as ssh). -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # password-sync # @@ -14370,13 +13546,13 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass password required pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass session required pam_unix.so -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2979974"></a>Password Migration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2931724"></a>Password Migration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to migrate from plaintext to encrypted passwords for Samba. Unlike other methods, this can be used for users who have never connected to Samba shares: password migration takes place when users ftp in, login using ssh, pop their mail, etc. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # password-migration # @@ -14389,11 +13565,11 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass session required pam_unix.so -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980009"></a>Mature Password Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2931759"></a>Mature Password Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration for a 'mature' smbpasswd installation. private/smbpasswd is fully populated, and we consider it an error if -the smbpasswd doesn't exist or doesn't match the Unix password. -</p><pre class="screen"> +the smbpasswd doesn't exist or doesn't match the UNIX password. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # password-mature # @@ -14404,11 +13580,11 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass password required pam_smbpass.so use_authtok use_first_pass session required pam_unix.so -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980041"></a>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2931790"></a>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration that shows pam_smbpass used together with pam_krb5. This could be useful on a Samba PDC that is also a member of a Kerberos realm. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # kdc-pdc # @@ -14420,13 +13596,15 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass password required pam_krb5.so use_authtok try_first_pass session required pam_krb5.so -</pre></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2980075"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2931826"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> PAM can be a very fickle and sensitive to configuration glitches. Here we look at a few cases from the Samba mailing list. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980089"></a>pam_winbind problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - I have the following PAM configuration: +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931839"></a>pam_winbind problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + I have the following PAM configuration: + </span>” </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass nullok @@ -14436,18 +13614,61 @@ account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth </pre><p> -</p><p> - When I open a new console with [ctrl][alt][F1], then I cant log in with my user "pitie". - I've tried with user "scienceu+pitie" also. </p><p> - Answer: The problem may lie with your inclusion of <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack.so + “<span class="quote"> + When I open a new console with [ctrl][alt][F1], then I cant log in with my user "pitie". + I've tried with user "scienceu+pitie" also. +</span>” + </p><p> + The problem may lie with your inclusion of <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack.so service=system-auth</tt></i>. That file often contains a lot of stuff that may duplicate what you're already doing. Try commenting out the pam_stack lines for auth and account and see if things work. If they do, look at <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt> and copy only what you need from it into your <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> file. Alternatively, if you want all services to use winbind, you can put the winbind-specific stuff in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt>. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="integrate-ms-networks"></a>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (Jan 01 2001) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2982211">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982236">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982281">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982337">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982462">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982506">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982548">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2982637">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2982784">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2982829">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983073">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983105">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983130">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2983200">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983216">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983248">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2983300">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2931926"></a>Winbind is not resolving users and groups</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + My smb.conf file is correctly configured. I have specified + <a class="indexterm" name="id2931940"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i> = 12000, + and <a class="indexterm" name="id2931955"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> = 3000-3500 + and <b class="command">winbind</b> is running. When I do the following it all works fine. +</span>” + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -u</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+maryo +MIDEARTH+jackb +MIDEARTH+ameds +... +MIDEARTH+root + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -g</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+Domain Users +MIDEARTH+Domain Admins +MIDEARTH+Domain Guests +... +MIDEARTH+Accounts + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent passwd</tt></b> +root:x:0:0:root:/root:/bin/bash +bin:x:1:1:bin:/bin:/bin/bash +... +maryo:x:15000:15003:Mary Orville:/home/MIDEARTH/maryo:/bin/false +</pre><p> + “<span class="quote"> + But the following command just fails: +</span>” +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown 'maryo' a_file</tt></b> +chown: `maryo': invalid user +</pre><p> +“<span class="quote"> +This is driving me nuts! What can be wrong? +</span>” + </p><p> + Your system is likely running <b class="command">nscd</b>, the name service + caching daemon. Shut it down, do NOT restart it! You will find your problem resolved. + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="integrate-ms-networks"></a>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (Jan 01 2001) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2932164">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932188">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932259">Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932315">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932456">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932499">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932551">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2932655">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2932922">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2932985">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933234">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933266">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933298">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2933416">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2933432">Pinging works only in one way</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933465">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933517">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932131"></a><p> This section deals with NetBIOS over TCP/IP name to IP address resolution. If your MS Windows clients are NOT configured to use NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section does not apply to your installation. If your installation involves use of @@ -14458,15 +13679,15 @@ NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section may help you to resolve networking problem to NOT run NetBEUI at all. Note also that there is NO such thing as NetBEUI over TCP/IP - the existence of such a protocol is a complete and utter mis-apprehension. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2982211"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932164"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many MS Windows network administrators have never been exposed to basic TCP/IP -networking as it is implemented in a Unix/Linux operating system. Likewise, many Unix and +networking as it is implemented in a UNIX/Linux operating system. Likewise, many UNIX and Linux administrators have not been exposed to the intricacies of MS Windows TCP/IP based networking (and may have no desire to be either). </p><p> This chapter gives a short introduction to the basics of how a name can be resolved to it's IP address for each operating system environment. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2982236"></a>Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932188"></a>Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since the introduction of MS Windows 2000 it is possible to run MS Windows networking without the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP. NetBIOS over TCP/IP uses UDP port 137 for NetBIOS name resolution and uses TCP port 139 for NetBIOS session services. When NetBIOS over @@ -14479,17 +13700,19 @@ Name Service or WINS), TCP port 139 AND TCP port 445 (for actual file and print </p></div><p> When NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled the use of DNS is essential. Most installations that disable NetBIOS over TCP/IP today use MS Active Directory Service (ADS). ADS requires +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932233"></a> Dynamic DNS with Service Resource Records (SRV RR) and with Incremental Zone Transfers (IXFR). +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932246"></a> Use of DHCP with ADS is recommended as a further means of maintaining central control over client workstation network configuration. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2982281"></a>Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932259"></a>Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The key configuration files covered in this section are: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2982337"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Contains a static list of IP Addresses and names. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932315"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Contains a static list of IP addresses and names. eg: -</p><pre class="screen"> - 127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain - 192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain +192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box </pre><p> The purpose of <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is to provide a name resolution mechanism so that uses do not need to remember @@ -14497,10 +13720,10 @@ IP addresses. </p><p> Network packets that are sent over the physical network transport layer communicate not via IP addresses but rather using the Media -Access Control address, or MAC address. IP Addresses are currently +Access Control address, or MAC address. IP addresses are currently 32 bits in length and are typically presented as four (4) decimal numbers that are separated by a dot (or period). eg: 168.192.1.1. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2932364"></a><p> MAC Addresses use 48 bits (or 6 bytes) and are typically represented as two digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons. eg: 40:8e:0a:12:34:56 @@ -14517,8 +13740,8 @@ be assigned per MAC address. One address must be the primary IP address, this is the address that will be returned in the ARP reply. </p><p> When a user or a process wants to communicate with another machine -the protocol implementation ensures that the "machine name" or "host -name" is resolved to an IP address in a manner that is controlled +the protocol implementation ensures that the "machine name" or "host +name" is resolved to an IP address in a manner that is controlled by the TCP/IP configuration control files. The file <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is one such file. </p><p> @@ -14533,15 +13756,15 @@ MAC addresses only; their own unique address and the address ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff. The reply packet from an ARP request will contain the MAC address and the primary IP address for each interface. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2932429"></a><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file is foundational to all -Unix/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minimum will contain +UNIX/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minimum will contain the localhost and local network interface IP addresses and the primary names by which they are known within the local machine. This file helps to prime the pump so that a basic level of name resolution can exist before any other method of name resolution becomes available. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2982462"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932456"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This file tells the name resolution libraries: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The name of the domain to which the machine belongs @@ -14551,41 +13774,41 @@ This file tells the name resolution libraries: </p></li><li><p>The name or IP address of available Domain Name Servers that may be asked to perform name to address translation lookups - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2982506"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932499"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932512"></a><p> <tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt> is the primary means by which the setting in /etc/resolv.conf may be affected. It is a critical configuration file. This file controls the order by which name resolution may proceed. The typical structure is: -</p><pre class="screen"> - order hosts,bind - multi on +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +order hosts,bind +multi on </pre><p> then both addresses should be returned. Please refer to the man page for host.conf for further details. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2982548"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932551"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932563"></a><p> This file controls the actual name resolution targets. The file typically has resolver object specifications as follows: -</p><pre class="screen"> - # /etc/nsswitch.conf - # - # Name Service Switch configuration file. - # +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# /etc/nsswitch.conf +# +# Name Service Switch configuration file. +# - passwd: compat - # Alternative entries for password authentication are: - # passwd: compat files nis ldap winbind - shadow: compat - group: compat +passwd: compat +# Alternative entries for password authentication are: +# passwd: compat files nis ldap winbind +shadow: compat +group: compat - hosts: files nis dns - # Alternative entries for host name resolution are: - # hosts: files dns nis nis+ hesiod db compat ldap wins - networks: nis files dns +hosts: files nis dns +# Alternative entries for host name resolution are: +# hosts: files dns nis nis+ hesiod db compat ldap wins +networks: nis files dns - ethers: nis files - protocols: nis files - rpc: nis files - services: nis files +ethers: nis files +protocols: nis files +rpc: nis files +services: nis files </pre><p> Of course, each of these mechanisms requires that the appropriate facilities and/or services are correctly configured. @@ -14593,27 +13816,27 @@ facilities and/or services are correctly configured. It should be noted that unless a network request/message must be sent, TCP/IP networks are silent. All TCP/IP communications assumes a principal of speaking only when necessary. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2932608"></a><p> Starting with version 2.2.0 samba has Linux support for extensions to the name service switch infrastructure so that linux clients will be able to obtain resolution of MS Windows NetBIOS names to IP Addresses. To gain this functionality Samba needs to be compiled -with appropriate arguments to the make command (ie: <b class="userinput"><tt>make +with appropriate arguments to the make command (i.e.: <b class="userinput"><tt>make nsswitch/libnss_wins.so</tt></b>). The resulting library should then be installed in the <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> directory and -the "wins" parameter needs to be added to the "hosts:" line in +the "wins" parameter needs to be added to the "hosts:" line in the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file. At this point it -will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by it's NetBIOS +will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by its NetBIOS machine name, so long as that machine is within the workgroup to which both the samba machine and the MS Windows machine belong. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2982637"></a>Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932655"></a>Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows networking is predicated about the name each machine is given. This name is known variously (and inconsistently) as -the "computer name", "machine name", "networking name", "netbios name", -"SMB name". All terms mean the same thing with the exception of -"netbios name" which can apply also to the name of the workgroup or the -domain name. The terms "workgroup" and "domain" are really just a -simply name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names +the "computer name", "machine name", "networking name", "netbios name", +or "SMB name". All terms mean the same thing with the exception of +"netbios name" which can apply also to the name of the workgroup or the +domain name. The terms "workgroup" and "domain" are really just a +simple name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names are exactly 16 characters in length. The 16th character is reserved. It is used to store a one byte value that indicates service level information for the NetBIOS name that is registered. A NetBIOS machine @@ -14621,25 +13844,14 @@ name is therefore registered for each service type that is provided by the client/server. </p><p> The following are typical NetBIOS name/service type registrations: -</p><pre class="screen"> - Unique NetBIOS Names: - MACHINENAME<00> = Server Service is running on MACHINENAME - MACHINENAME<03> = Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name) - MACHINENAME<20> = LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME - WORKGROUP<1b> = Domain Master Browser - - Group Names: - WORKGROUP<03> = Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP - WORKGROUP<1c> = Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers - WORKGROUP<1d> = Local Master Browsers - WORKGROUP<1e> = Internet Name Resolvers -</pre><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2932688"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 26.1. Unique NetBIOS names</b></p><table summary="Unique NetBIOS names" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<00></td><td align="justify">Server Service is running on MACHINENAME</td></tr><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<03></td><td align="justify">Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<20></td><td align="justify">LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1b></td><td align="justify">Domain Master Browser</td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="table"><a name="id2932758"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 26.2. Group Names</b></p><table summary="Group Names" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<03></td><td align="justify">Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1c></td><td align="justify">Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1d></td><td align="justify">Local Master Browsers</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1e></td><td align="justify">Internet Name Resolvers</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2932830"></a> It should be noted that all NetBIOS machines register their own names as per the above. This is in vast contrast to TCP/IP installations where traditionally the system administrator will determine in the /etc/hosts or in the DNS database what names are associated with each IP address. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2932845"></a><p> One further point of clarification should be noted, the <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file and the DNS records do not provide the NetBIOS name type information that MS Windows clients depend on to locate the type of service that may @@ -14648,12 +13860,12 @@ wants to locate a domain logon server. It finds this service and the IP address of a server that provides it by performing a lookup (via a NetBIOS broadcast) for enumeration of all machines that have registered the name type *<1c>. A logon request is then sent to each -IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. Which -ever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services. +IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. +Whichever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services. </p><p> -The name "workgroup" or "domain" really can be confusing since these +The name "workgroup" or "domain" really can be confusing since these have the added significance of indicating what is the security -architecture of the MS Windows network. The term "workgroup" indicates +architecture of the MS Windows network. The term "workgroup" indicates that the primary nature of the network environment is that of a peer-to-peer design. In a WORKGROUP all machines are responsible for their own security, and generally such security is limited to use of @@ -14677,7 +13889,7 @@ NBT or NetBT, the NetBIOS over TCP/IP. MS Windows machines use a complex array of name resolution mechanisms. Since we are primarily concerned with TCP/IP this demonstration is limited to this area. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2982784"></a>The NetBIOS Name Cache</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932922"></a>The NetBIOS Name Cache</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> All MS Windows machines employ an in memory buffer in which is stored the NetBIOS names and IP addresses for all external machines that that machine has communicated with over the @@ -14691,11 +13903,11 @@ an attempt to exchange a message with that machine will be subject to time-out delays. i.e.: Its name is in the cache, so a name resolution lookup will succeed, but the machine can not respond. This can be frustrating for users - but it is a characteristic of the protocol. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2932955"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2932963"></a><p> The MS Windows utility that allows examination of the NetBIOS -name cache is called "nbtstat". The Samba equivalent of this +name cache is called "nbtstat". The Samba equivalent of this is called <b class="command">nmblookup</b>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2982829"></a>The LMHOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932985"></a>The LMHOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2932993"></a><p> This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in <tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains the IP Address and the machine name in matched pairs. The @@ -14703,102 +13915,103 @@ the IP Address and the machine name in matched pairs. The to IP address mapping. </p><p> It typically looks like: -</p><pre class="screen"> - # Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp. - # - # This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS - # over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98 - # - # This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to NT computernames - # (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line. - # The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the - # corresponding computername. The address and the computername - # should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character - # is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions - # below). - # - # This file is compatible with Microsoft LAN Manager 2.x TCP/IP lmhosts - # files and offers the following extensions: - # - # #PRE - # #DOM:<domain> - # #INCLUDE <filename> - # #BEGIN_ALTERNATE - # #END_ALTERNATE - # \0xnn (non-printing character support) - # - # Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause - # the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are - # not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails. - # - # Following an entry with the "#DOM:<domain>" tag will associate the - # entry with the domain specified by <domain>. This affects how the - # browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload - # the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a - # #PRE to the line. The <domain> is always preloaded although it will not - # be shown when the name cache is viewed. - # - # Specifying "#INCLUDE <filename>" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT) - # software to seek the specified <filename> and parse it as if it were - # local. <filename> is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a - # centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server. - # It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the - # server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive. - # In addition the share "public" in the example below must be in the - # LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to - # be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under - # \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\parameters\nullsessionshares - # in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there. - # - # The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE - # statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include - # will cause the group to succeed. - # - # Finally, non-printing characters can be embedded in mappings by - # first surrounding the NetBIOS name in quotations, then using the - # \0xnn notation to specify a hex value for a non-printing character. - # - # The following example illustrates all of these extensions: - # - # 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC - # 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server - # 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server - # 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include - # - # #BEGIN_ALTERNATE - # #INCLUDE \\localsrv\public\lmhosts - # #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts - # #END_ALTERNATE - # - # In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special - # character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are - # preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used - # to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv" - # system is unavailable. - # - # Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup, - # so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance. - # Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the - # end of this file. -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983073"></a>HOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp. +# +# This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS +# over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98 +# +# This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to NT computernames +# (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line. +# The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the +# corresponding computername. The address and the computername +# should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character +# is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions +# below). +# +# This file is compatible with Microsoft LAN Manager 2.x TCP/IP lmhosts +# files and offers the following extensions: +# +# #PRE +# #DOM:<domain> +# #INCLUDE <filename> +# #BEGIN_ALTERNATE +# #END_ALTERNATE +# \0xnn (non-printing character support) +# +# Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause +# the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are +# not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails. +# +# Following an entry with the "#DOM:<domain>" tag will associate the +# entry with the domain specified by <domain>. This affects how the +# browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload +# the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a +# #PRE to the line. The <domain> is always preloaded although it will not +# be shown when the name cache is viewed. +# +# Specifying "#INCLUDE <filename>" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT) +# software to seek the specified <filename> and parse it as if it were +# local. <filename> is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a +# centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server. +# It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the +# server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive. +# In addition the share "public" in the example below must be in the +# LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to +# be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under +# \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\ +# parameters\nullsessionshares +# in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there. +# +# The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE +# statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include +# will cause the group to succeed. +# +# Finally, non-printing characters can be embedded in mappings by +# first surrounding the NetBIOS name in quotations, then using the +# \0xnn notation to specify a hex value for a non-printing character. +# +# The following example illustrates all of these extensions: +# +# 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC +# 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server +# 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server +# 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include +# +# #BEGIN_ALTERNATE +# #INCLUDE \\localsrv\public\lmhosts +# #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts +# #END_ALTERNATE +# +# In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special +# character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are +# preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used +# to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv" +# system is unavailable. +# +# Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup, +# so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance. +# Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the +# end of this file. +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933234"></a>HOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in <tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains the IP Address and the IP hostname in matched pairs. It can be used by the name resolution infrastructure in MS Windows, depending on how the TCP/IP environment is configured. This file is in -every way the equivalent of the Unix/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983105"></a>DNS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +every way the equivalent of the UNIX/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933266"></a>DNS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2933274"></a><p> This capability is configured in the TCP/IP setup area in the network -configuration facility. If enabled an elaborate name resolution sequence -is followed the precise nature of which is dependant on what the NetBIOS -Node Type parameter is configured to. A Node Type of 0 means use -NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is first used if the name +configuration facility. If enabled, an elaborate name resolution sequence +is followed the precise nature of which is dependant on how the NetBIOS +Node Type parameter is configured. A Node Type of 0 means that +NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is used if the name that is the subject of a name lookup is not found in the NetBIOS name cache. If that fails then DNS, HOSTS and LMHOSTS are checked. If set to Node Type 8, then a NetBIOS Unicast (over UDP Unicast) is sent to the WINS Server to obtain a lookup before DNS, HOSTS, LMHOSTS, or broadcast lookup is used. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983130"></a>WINS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933298"></a>WINS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2933306"></a><p> A WINS (Windows Internet Name Server) service is the equivalent of the rfc1001/1002 specified NBNS (NetBIOS Name Server). A WINS server stores the names and IP addresses that are registered by a Windows client @@ -14806,24 +14019,20 @@ if the TCP/IP setup has been given at least one WINS Server IP Address. </p><p> To configure Samba to be a WINS server the following parameter needs to be added to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="screen"> - wins support = Yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> To configure Samba to use a WINS server the following parameters are needed in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="screen"> - wins support = No - wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = No</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i> is the IP address of the WINS server. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2983200"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><p>For information about setting up Samba as a WINS server, read + <a href="#NetworkBrowsing" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">the chapter on network browsing</a>.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933416"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> TCP/IP network configuration problems find every network administrator sooner or later. The cause can be anything from keyboard mishaps, forgetfulness, simple mistakes, and carelessness. Of course, no one is every deliberately careless! -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983216"></a>My Boomerang Won't Come Back</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Well, the real complaint said, "I can ping my samba server from Windows, but I can - not ping my Windows machine from the samba server." +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933432"></a>Pinging works only in one way</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">I can ping my samba server from Windows, but I can + not ping my Windows machine from the samba server.</span>” </p><p> The Windows machine was at IP Address 192.168.1.2 with netmask 255.255.255.0, the Samba server (Linux) was at IP Address 192.168.1.130 with netmask 255.255.255.128. @@ -14831,49 +14040,49 @@ carelessness. Of course, no one is every deliberately careless! </p><p> Due to inconsistent netmasks, the Windows machine was on network 192.168.1.0/24, while the Samba server was on network 192.168.1.128/25 - logically a different network. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983248"></a>Very Slow Network Connections</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933465"></a>Very Slow Network Connections</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A common causes of slow network response includes: - </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Client is configured to use DNS and DNS server is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use remote DNS server, but remote connection is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use a WINS server, but there is no WINS server</p></li><li><p>Client is NOT configured to use a WINS server, but there is a WINS server</p></li><li><p>Firewall is filtering our DNS or WINS traffic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983300"></a>Samba server name change problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - The name of the samba server was changed, samba was restarted, samba server can not be + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Client is configured to use DNS and DNS server is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use remote DNS server, but remote connection is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use a WINS server, but there is no WINS server</p></li><li><p>Client is NOT configured to use a WINS server, but there is a WINS server</p></li><li><p>Firewall is filtering our DNS or WINS traffic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2933517"></a>Samba server name change problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">The name of the samba server was changed, samba was restarted, samba server can not be pinged by new name from MS Windows NT4 Workstation, but it does still respond to ping using - the old name. Why? + the old name. Why?</span>” </p><p> From this description three (3) things are rather obvious: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>WINS is NOT in use, only broadcast based name resolution is used</p></li><li><p>The samba server was renamed and restarted within the last 10-15 minutes</p></li><li><p>The old samba server name is still in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 Workstation</p></li></ul></div><p> To find what names are present in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 machine, open a cmd shell, then: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - C:\temp\>nbtstat -n +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>nbtstat -n</tt></b> - NetBIOS Local Name Table + NetBIOS Local Name Table - Name Type Status - ------------------------------------------------ - SLACK <03> UNIQUE Registered - ADMINISTRATOR <03> UNIQUE Registered - SLACK <00> UNIQUE Registered - SARDON <00> GROUP Registered - SLACK <20> UNIQUE Registered - SLACK <1F> UNIQUE Registered + Name Type Status +------------------------------------------------ +FRODO <03> UNIQUE Registered +ADMINSTRATOR <03> UNIQUE Registered +FRODO <00> UNIQUE Registered +SARDON <00> GROUP Registered +FRODO <20> UNIQUE Registered +FRODO <1F> UNIQUE Registered - C:\Temp\>nbtstat -c +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt>nbtstat -c - NetBIOS Remote Cache Name Table + NetBIOS Remote Cache Name Table - Name Type Host Address Life [sec] - -------------------------------------------------------------- - FRODO <20> UNIQUE 192.168.1.1 240 + Name Type Host Address Life [sec] +-------------------------------------------------------------- +GANDALF <20> UNIQUE 192.168.1.1 240 - C:\Temp\> - </pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt> +</pre><p> </p><p> - In the above example, FRODO is the Samba server and SLACK is the MS Windows NT4 Workstation. - The first listing shows the contents of the Local Name Table (ie: Identity information on + In the above example, GANDALF is the Samba server and FRODO is the MS Windows NT4 Workstation. + The first listing shows the contents of the Local Name Table (i.e.: Identity information on the MS Windows workstation), the second shows the NetBIOS name in the NetBIOS name cache. The name cache contains the remote machines known to this workstation. - </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unicode"></a>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">TAKAHASHI</span> <span class="surname">Motonobu</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 March 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2984418">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984620">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984690">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984790">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984835">Japanese charsets</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984418"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unicode"></a>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">TAKAHASHI</span> <span class="surname">Motonobu</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 March 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2933721">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933765">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933835">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933962">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2933992">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934130">Common errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934137">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933721"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every industry eventually matures. One of the great areas of maturation is in the focus that has been given over the past decade to make it possible for anyone anywhere to use a computer. It has not always been that way, in fact, not so long @@ -14881,14 +14090,13 @@ ago it was common for software to be written for exclusive use in the country of origin. </p><p> Of all the effort that has been brought to bear on providing native language support -for all computer users, the efforts of the Openi18n organisation is deserving of -special mention. For more information about Openi18n please refer to: -<a href="#">http://www.openi18n.org/</a>. +for all computer users, the efforts of the <a href="http://www.openi18n.org/" target="_top">Openi18n organisation</a> is deserving of +special mention. </p><p> Samba-2.x supported a single locale through a mechanism called <span class="emphasis"><em>codepages</em></span>. Samba-3 is destined to become a truly trans-global file and printer sharing platform. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984620"></a>What are charsets and unicode?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933765"></a>What are charsets and unicode?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Computers communicate in numbers. In texts, each number will be translated to a corresponding letter. The meaning that will be assigned to a certain number depends on the <span class="emphasis"><em>character set(charset) @@ -14905,84 +14113,233 @@ is more then all possible characters one could think of. They are called multibyte charsets (because they use more then one byte to store one character). </p><p> -A standardised multibyte charset is unicode, info is available at -<a href="http://www.unicode.org/" target="_top">www.unicode.org</a>. -A big advantage of using a multibyte charset is that you only need one; no -need to make sure two computers use the same charset when they are + A standardised multibyte charset is <a href="http://www.unicode.org/" target="_top">unicode</a>. +A big advantage of using a multibyte charset is that you only need one; there +is no need to make sure two computers use the same charset when they are communicating. -</p><p>Old windows clients used to use single-byte charsets, named +</p><p>Old windows clients use single-byte charsets, named 'codepages' by Microsoft. However, there is no support for negotiating the charset to be used in the smb protocol. Thus, you -have to make sure you are using the same charset when talking to an old client. +have to make sure you are using the same charset when talking to an older client. Newer clients (Windows NT, 2K, XP) talk unicode over the wire. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984690"></a>Samba and charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933835"></a>Samba and charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> As of samba 3.0, samba can (and will) talk unicode over the wire. Internally, samba knows of three kinds of character sets: -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2933856"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> This is the charset used internally by your operating system. - The default is <tt class="constant">ASCII</tt>, which is fine for most - systems. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba will use to print messages + The default is <tt class="constant">UTF-8</tt>, which is fine for most + systems. The default in previous samba releases was <tt class="constant">ASCII</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2933893"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba will use to print messages on your screen. It should generally be the same as the <b class="command">unix charset</b>. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba uses when communicating with + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2933927"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba uses when communicating with DOS and Windows 9x clients. It will talk unicode to all newer clients. The default depends on the charsets you have installed on your system. - Run <b class="command">testparm -v | grep "dos charset"</b> to see + Run <b class="command">testparm -v | grep "dos charset"</b> to see what the default is on your system. - </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984790"></a>Conversion from old names</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Because previous samba versions did not do any charset conversion, + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933962"></a>Conversion from old names</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Because previous samba versions did not do any charset conversion, characters in filenames are usually not correct in the unix charset but only -for the local charset used by the DOS/Windows clients.</p><p>The following script from Steve Langasek converts all -filenames from CP850 to the iso8859-15 charset.</p><p> -<tt class="prompt">#</tt><b class="userinput"><tt>find <i class="replaceable"><tt>/path/to/share</tt></i> -type f -exec bash -c 'CP="{}"; ISO=`echo -n "$CP" | iconv -f cp850 \ - -t iso8859-15`; if [ "$CP" != "$ISO" ]; then mv "$CP" "$ISO"; fi' \; -</tt></b> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984835"></a>Japanese charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba doesn't work correctly with Japanese charsets yet. Here are -points of attention when setting it up:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You should set <i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method = -hash</tt></i></p></li><li><p>There are various iconv() implementations around and not +for the local charset used by the DOS/Windows clients.</p><p>Bjoern Jacke has written a utility named <a href="http://j3e.de/linux/convmv/" target="_top">convm</a> that can convert whole directory + structures to different charsets with one single command. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933992"></a>Japanese charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba doesn't work correctly with Japanese charsets yet. Here are +points of attention when setting it up:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You should set <a class="indexterm" name="id2934012"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i> = hash</p></li><li><p>There are various iconv() implementations around and not all of them work equally well. glibc2's iconv() has a critical problem in CP932. libiconv-1.8 works with CP932 but still has some problems and -does not work with EUC-JP.</p></li><li><p>You should set <i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset = CP932</tt></i>, not -Shift_JIS, SJIS...</p></li><li><p>Currently only <i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset = CP932</tt></i> +does not work with EUC-JP.</p></li><li><p>You should set <a class="indexterm" name="id2934042"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i> = CP932, not +Shift_JIS, SJIS...</p></li><li><p>Currently only <a class="indexterm" name="id2934062"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = CP932 will work (but still has some problems...) because of iconv() issues. -<i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset = EUC-JP</tt></i> doesn't work well because of -iconv() issues.</p></li><li><p>Currently Samba 3.0 does not support <i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset -= UTF8-MAC/CAP/HEX/JIS*</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>More information (in Japanese) is available at: <a href="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html" target="_top">http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html</a>.</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Backup"></a>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2984038">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984063">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984038"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2934077"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = EUC-JP doesn't work well because of +iconv() issues.</p></li><li><p>Currently Samba 3.0 does not support <a class="indexterm" name="id2934098"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = UTF8-MAC/CAP/HEX/JIS*</p></li></ul></div><p>More information (in Japanese) is available at: <a href="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html" target="_top">http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html</a>.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934130"></a>Common errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934137"></a>CP850.so can't be found</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">Samba is complaining about a missing <tt class="filename">CP850.so</tt> file</span>”.</p><p>CP850 is the default <a class="indexterm" name="id2934162"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i>. The <a class="indexterm" name="id2934176"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i> is used to convert data to the codepage used by your dos clients. If you don't have any dos clients, you can safely ignore this message. </p><p>CP850 should be supported by your local iconv implementation. Make sure you have all the required packages installed. If you compiled samba from source, make sure configure found iconv.</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Backup"></a>Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2934250">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934264">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934250"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -If you have something to contribute for this section please email it to -<a href="#">jht@samba.org</a>/ -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984063"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934264"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> We need feedback from people who are backing up samba servers. We would like to know what software tools you are using to backup your samba server/s. </p><p> In particular, if you have any success and / or failure stories you could share with other users this would be appreciated. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SambaHA"></a>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2985605">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2985605"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SambaHA"></a>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2934334">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934334"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="migration"></a>Migration and Updating</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>30. <a href="#upgrading-to-3.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2984190">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984215">Obsolete configuration options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2985825">Password Backend</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="#NT4Migration">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983845">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983873">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2986549">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2986887">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986968">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2987210">Samba Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="#SWAT">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986434">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986468">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2988827">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2988941">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989005">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989110">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989175">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989239">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989287">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989339">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989362">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="upgrading-to-3.0"></a>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2984190">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2984215">Obsolete configuration options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2985825">Password Backend</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984190"></a>Charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>You might experience problems with special characters -when communicating with old DOS clients. Codepage -support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter -<a href="#unicode" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode support</a> for details. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2984215"></a>Obsolete configuration options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In 3.0, the following configuration options have been removed. -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>printer driver (replaced by new driver procedures) </td></tr><tr><td>printer driver file (replaced by new driver procedures)</td></tr><tr><td>printer driver location (replaced by new driver procedures)</td></tr><tr><td>use rhosts</td></tr><tr><td>postscript</td></tr><tr><td>client code page (replaced by dos charset)</td></tr><tr><td>vfs path</td></tr><tr><td>vfs options</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2985825"></a>Password Backend</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Effective with the release of samba-3 it is now imperative that the password backend -be correctly defined in smb.conf. -</p><p> -Those migrating from samba-2.x with plaintext password support need the following: -<span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend = guest</em></span>. -</p><p> -Those migrating from samba-2.x with encrypted password support should add to smb.conf -<span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend = smbpasswd, guest</em></span>. -</p><p> -LDAP using Samba-2.x systems can continue to operate with the following entry -<span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend = ldapsam_compat, guest</em></span>. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NT4Migration"></a>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2983845">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2983873">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2986549">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2986887">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986968">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2987210">Samba Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="migration"></a>Migration and Updating</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>30. <a href="#upgrading-to-3.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934473">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934602">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934617">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934744">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935140">Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2935215">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2935222">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935456">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935505">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935529">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935648">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935672">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="#NT4Migration">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936004">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936029">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936467">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936679">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936770">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937026">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="#SWAT">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937386">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937426">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937663">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937775">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937837">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937944">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938008">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938072">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938120">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938171">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938195">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="upgrading-to-3.0"></a>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">June 30, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2934473">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934602">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2934617">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2934744">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935140">Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2935215">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2935222">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935456">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935505">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935529">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935648">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2935672">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934473"></a>New Features in Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Major new features: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Active Directory support. This release is able to join a ADS realm + as a member server and authenticate users using LDAP/kerberos. + </p></li><li><p> + Unicode support. Samba will now negotiate UNICODE on the wire and + internally there is now a much better infrastructure for multi-byte + and UNICODE character sets. + </p></li><li><p> + New authentication system. The internal authentication system has + been almost completely rewritten. Most of the changes are internal, + but the new auth system is also very configurable. + </p></li><li><p> + New filename mangling system. The filename mangling system has been + completely rewritten. An internal database now stores mangling maps + persistently. This needs lots of testing. + </p></li><li><p> + New "net" command. A new "net" command has been added. It is + somewhat similar to the "net" command in windows. Eventually we + plan to replace a bunch of other utilities (such as smbpasswd) + with subcommands in "net", at the moment only a few things are + implemented. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba now negotiates NT-style status32 codes on the wire. This + improves error handling a lot. + </p></li><li><p> + Better Windows 2000/XP/2003 printing support including publishing + printer attributes in active directory + </p></li><li><p> + New loadable RPC modules + </p></li><li><p> + New dual-daemon winbindd support (-B) for better performance + </p></li><li><p> + Support for migrating from a Windows NT 4.0 domain to a Samba + domain and maintaining user, group and domain SIDs + </p></li><li><p> + Support for establishing trust relationships with Windows NT 4.0 + domain controllers + </p></li><li><p> + Initial support for a distributed Winbind architecture using + an LDAP directory for storing SID to uid/gid mappings + </p></li><li><p> + Major updates to the Samba documentation tree. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +Plus lots of other improvements! +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934602"></a>Configuration Parameter Changes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section contains a brief listing of changes to smb.conf options +in the 3.0.0 release. Please refer to the smb.conf(5) man page for +complete descriptions of new or modified parameters. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934617"></a>Removed Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>(order alphabetically):</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>admin log </p></li><li><p>alternate permissions </p></li><li><p>character set </p></li><li><p>client codepage </p></li><li><p>code page directory </p></li><li><p>coding system </p></li><li><p>domain admin group </p></li><li><p>domain guest group </p></li><li><p>force unknown acl user </p></li><li><p>nt smb support </p></li><li><p>post script </p></li><li><p>printer driver </p></li><li><p>printer driver file </p></li><li><p>printer driver location </p></li><li><p>status </p></li><li><p>total print jobs </p></li><li><p>use rhosts </p></li><li><p>valid chars </p></li><li><p>vfs options </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934744"></a>New Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>(new parameters have been grouped by function):</p><p>Remote management</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>abort shutdown script </p></li><li><p>shutdown script </p></li></ul></div><p>User and Group Account Management</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>add group script </p></li><li><p>add machine script </p></li><li><p>add user to group script </p></li><li><p>algorithmic rid base </p></li><li><p>delete group script </p></li><li><p>delete user from group script </p></li><li><p>passdb backend </p></li><li><p>set primary group script </p></li></ul></div><p>Authentication</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>auth methods </p></li><li><p>ads server </p></li><li><p>realm </p></li></ul></div><p>Protocol Options</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>client lanman auth </p></li><li><p>client NTLMv2 auth </p></li><li><p>client schannel </p></li><li><p>client signing </p></li><li><p>client use spnego </p></li><li><p>disable netbios </p></li><li><p>ntlm auth </p></li><li><p>paranoid server security </p></li><li><p>server schannel </p></li><li><p>smb ports </p></li><li><p>use spnego </p></li></ul></div><p>File Service</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>get quota command </p></li><li><p>hide special files </p></li><li><p>hide unwriteable files </p></li><li><p>hostname lookups </p></li><li><p>kernel change notify </p></li><li><p>mangle prefix </p></li><li><p>msdfs proxy </p></li><li><p>set quota command </p></li><li><p>use sendfile </p></li><li><p>vfs objects </p></li></ul></div><p>Printing</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>max reported print jobs </p></li></ul></div><p>UNICODE and Character Sets</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>display charset </p></li><li><p>dos charset </p></li><li><p>unicode </p></li><li><p>unix charset </p></li></ul></div><p>SID to uid/gid Mappings</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>idmap backend </p></li><li><p>idmap gid </p></li><li><p>idmap only </p></li><li><p>idmap uid </p></li></ul></div><p>LDAP</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ldap delete dn </p></li><li><p>ldap group suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap idmap suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap machine suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap passwd sync </p></li><li><p>ldap trust ids </p></li><li><p>ldap user suffix </p></li></ul></div><p>General Configuration</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>preload modules </p></li><li><p>privatedir </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935140"></a>Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>encrypt passwords (enabled by default) </p></li><li><p>mangling method (set to 'hash2' by default) </p></li><li><p>passwd chat </p></li><li><p>passwd program </p></li><li><p>restrict anonymous (integer value) </p></li><li><p>security (new 'ads' value) </p></li><li><p>strict locking (enabled by default) </p></li><li><p>winbind cache time (increased to 5 minutes) </p></li><li><p>winbind uid (deprecated in favor of 'idmap uid') </p></li><li><p>winbind gid (deprecated in favor of 'idmap gid') </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2935215"></a>New Functionality</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935222"></a>Databases</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section contains brief descriptions of any new databases + introduced in Samba 3.0. Please remember to backup your existing + ${lock directory}/*tdb before upgrading to Samba 3.0. Samba will + upgrade databases as they are opened (if necessary), but downgrading + from 3.0 to 2.2 is an unsupported path. + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2935241"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 30.1. TDB File Descriptions</b></p><table summary="TDB File Descriptions" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Name</th><th align="justify">Description</th><th align="center">Backup?</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">account_policy</td><td align="justify">User policy settings</td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">gencache</td><td align="justify">Generic caching db</td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">group_mapping</td><td align="justify"><p>Mapping table from Windows groups/SID to unix groups</p></td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">idmap</td><td align="justify"><p>new ID map table from SIDS to UNIX uids/gids</p></td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">namecache</td><td align="justify">Name resolution cache entries</td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">netlogon_unigrp</td><td align="justify"><p>Cache of universal group membership obtained when operating + as a member of a Windows domain</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">printing/*.tdb</td><td align="justify"><p>Cached output from 'lpq command' created on a per print + service basis</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">registry</td><td align="justify"><p>Read-only samba registry skeleton that provides support for + exporting various db tables via the winreg RPCs</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935456"></a>Changes in Behavior</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following issues are known changes in behavior between Samba 2.2 and + Samba 3.0 that may affect certain installations of Samba. + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + When operating as a member of a Windows domain, Samba 2.2 would + map any users authenticated by the remote DC to the 'guest account' + if a uid could not be obtained via the getpwnam() call. Samba 3.0 + rejects the connection as NT_STATUS_LOGON_FAILURE. There is no + current work around to re-establish the 2.2 behavior. + </p></li><li><p> + When adding machines to a Samba 2.2 controlled domain, the + 'add user script' was used to create the UNIX identity of the + machine trust account. Samba 3.0 introduces a new 'add machine + script' that must be specified for this purpose. Samba 3.0 will + not fall back to using the 'add user script' in the absence of + an 'add machine script' + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935505"></a>Charsets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You might experience problems with special characters when communicating with old DOS + clients. Codepage support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter + <a href="#unicode" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode support</a> for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935529"></a>Passdb Backends and Authentication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There have been a few new changes that Samba administrators should be + aware of when moving to Samba 3.0. + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Encrypted passwords have been enabled by default in order to + inter-operate better with out-of-the-box Windows client + installations. This does mean that either (a) a samba account + must be created for each user, or (b) 'encrypt passwords = no' + must be explicitly defined in smb.conf. + </p></li><li><p> + Inclusion of new <a class="indexterm" name="id2935568"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = ads option for integration + with an Active Directory domain using the native Windows + Kerberos 5 and LDAP protocols. + </p></li></ol></div><p> + Samba 3.0 also includes the possibility of setting up chains + of authentication methods + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2935590"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i>) and account + storage backends + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2935605"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>). + Please refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> + man page and <a href="#passdb" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter about account information databases</a> for details. While both parameters assume sane default + values, it is likely that you will need to understand what the + values actually mean in order to ensure Samba operates correctly. + </p><p> + Certain functions of the smbpasswd(8) tool have been split between the + new smbpasswd(8) utility, the net(8) tool, and the new pdbedit(8) + utility. See the respective man pages for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935648"></a>Charsets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You might experience problems with special characters when communicating with old DOS + clients. Codepage support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter + <a href="#unicode" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode support</a> for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935672"></a>LDAP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section outlines the new features affecting Samba / LDAP integration. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2935684"></a>New Schema</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A new object class (sambaSamAccount) has been introduced to replace + the old sambaAccount. This change aids us in the renaming of attributes + to prevent clashes with attributes from other vendors. There is a + conversion script (examples/LDAP/convertSambaAccount) to modify and LDIF + file to the new schema. + </p><p> + Example: + </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt>ldapsearch .... -b "ou=people,dc=..." > old.ldif + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt>convertSambaAccount <DOM SID> old.ldif new.ldif + </pre><p> + The <DOM SID> can be obtained by running 'net getlocalsid <DOMAINNAME> + on the Samba PDC as root. + </p><p> + The old sambaAccount schema may still be used by specifying the + "ldapsam_compat" passdb backend. However, the sambaAccount and + associated attributes have been moved to the historical section of + the schema file and must be uncommented before use if needed. + The 2.2 object class declaration for a sambaAccount has not changed + in the 3.0 samba.schema file. + </p><p> + Other new object classes and their uses include: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + sambaDomain - domain information used to allocate rids + for users and groups as necessary. The attributes are added + in 'ldap suffix' directory entry automatically if + an idmap uid/gid range has been set and the 'ldapsam' + passdb backend has been selected. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaGroupMapping - an object representing the + relationship between a posixGroup and a Windows + group/SID. These entries are stored in the 'ldap + group suffix' and managed by the 'net groupmap' command. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaUnixIdPool - created in the 'ldap idmap suffix' entry + automatically and contains the next available 'idmap uid' and + 'idmap gid' + </p></li><li><p> + sambaIdmapEntry - object storing a mapping between a + SID and a UNIX uid/gid. These objects are created by the + idmap_ldap module as needed. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2935797"></a>New Suffix for Searching</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following new smb.conf parameters have been added to aid in directing + certain LDAP queries when 'passdb backend = ldapsam://...' has been + specified. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ldap suffix - used to search for user and computer accounts</p></li><li><p>ldap user suffix - used to store user accounts</p></li><li><p>ldap machine suffix - used to store machine trust accounts</p></li><li><p>ldap group suffix - location of posixGroup/sambaGroupMapping entries</p></li><li><p>ldap idmap suffix - location of sambaIdmapEntry objects</p></li></ul></div><p> + If an 'ldap suffix' is defined, it will be appended to all of the + remaining sub-suffix parameters. In this case, the order of the suffix + listings in smb.conf is important. Always place the 'ldap suffix' first + in the list. + </p><p> + Due to a limitation in Samba's smb.conf parsing, you should not surround + the DN's with quotation marks. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2935863"></a>IdMap LDAP support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba 3.0 supports an ldap backend for the idmap subsystem. The + following options would inform Samba that the idmap table should be + stored on the directory server onterose in the "ou=idmap,dc=plainjoe, + dc=org" partition. + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldap:ldap://onterose/</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix = ou=idmap,dc=plainjoe,dc=org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid = 40000-50000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid = 40000-50000</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + This configuration allows winbind installations on multiple servers to + share a uid/gid number space, thus avoiding the interoperability problems + with NFS that were present in Samba 2.2. + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="NT4Migration"></a>Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 3, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2936004">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936029">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2936467">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2936679">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2936770">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937026">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This is a rough guide to assist those wishing to migrate from NT4 domain control to Samba-3 based domain control. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2983845"></a>Planning and Getting Started</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936004"></a>Planning and Getting Started</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the IT world there is often a saying that all problems are encountered because of poor planning. The corollary to this saying is that not all problems can be anticipated and planned for. Then again, good planning will anticipate most show stopper type situations. @@ -14990,120 +14347,133 @@ and planned for. Then again, good planning will anticipate most show stopper typ Those wishing to migrate from MS Windows NT4 domain control to a Samba-3 domain control environment would do well to develop a detailed migration plan. So here are a few pointers to help migration get under way. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2983873"></a>Objectives</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936029"></a>Objectives</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The key objective for most organisations will be to make the migration from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 domain control as painless as possible. One of the challenges you may experience in your migration process may well be one of convincing management that the new environment should remain in place. Many who have introduced open source technologies have experienced pressure to return to a Microsoft based platform solution at the first sign of trouble. </p><p> -It is strongly advised that before attempting a migration to a Samba-3 controlled network -that every possible effort be made to gain all-round commitment to the change. Firstly, you -should know precisely <span class="emphasis"><em>why</em></span> the change is important for the organisation. -Possible motivations to make a change include: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Improve network manageability</td></tr><tr><td>Obtain better user level functionality</td></tr><tr><td>Reduce network operating costs</td></tr><tr><td>Reduce exposure caused by Microsoft withdrawal of NT4 support</td></tr><tr><td>Avoid MS License 6 implications</td></tr><tr><td>Reduce organisation's dependency on Microsoft</td></tr></table><p> -It is vital that it be well recognised that Samba-3 is NOT MS Windows NT4. Samba-3 offers -an alternative solution that is both different from MS Windows NT4 and that offers some -advantages compared with it. It should also be recognised that Samba-3 lacks many of the +Before attempting a migration to a Samba-3 controlled network make every possible effort to +gain all-round commitment to the change. Know precisely <span class="emphasis"><em>why</em></span> the change +is important for the organisation. Possible motivations to make a change include: +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Improve network manageability</p></li><li><p>Obtain better user level functionality</p></li><li><p>Reduce network operating costs</p></li><li><p>Reduce exposure caused by Microsoft withdrawal of NT4 support</p></li><li><p>Avoid MS License 6 implications</p></li><li><p>Reduce organisation's dependency on Microsoft</p></li></ul></div><p> +Make sure that everyone knows that Samba-3 is NOT MS Windows NT4. Samba-3 offers +an alternative solution that is both different from MS Windows NT4 and that offers +advantages compared with it. Gain recognition that Samba-3 lacks many of the features that Microsoft has promoted as core values in migration from MS Windows NT4 to MS Windows 2000 and beyond (with or without Active Directory services). </p><p> What are the features that Samba-3 can NOT provide? -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Active Directory Server</td></tr><tr><td>Group Policy Objects (in Active Directory)</td></tr><tr><td>Machine Policy objects</td></tr><tr><td>Logon Scripts in Active Directory</td></tr><tr><td>Software Application and Access Controls in Active Directory</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Active Directory Server</p></li><li><p>Group Policy Objects (in Active Directory)</p></li><li><p>Machine Policy objects</p></li><li><p>Logon Scripts in Active Directory</p></li><li><p>Software Application and Access Controls in Active Directory</p></li></ul></div><p> The features that Samba-3 DOES provide and that may be of compelling interest to your site includes: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Lower Cost of Ownership</td></tr><tr><td>Global availability of support with no strings attached</td></tr><tr><td>Dynamic SMB Servers (ie:Can run more than one server per Unix/Linux system)</td></tr><tr><td>Creation of on-the-fly logon scripts</td></tr><tr><td>Creation of on-the-fly Policy Files</td></tr><tr><td>Greater Stability, Reliability, Performance and Availability</td></tr><tr><td>Manageability via an ssh connection</td></tr><tr><td>Flexible choices of back-end authentication technologies (tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam)</td></tr><tr><td>Ability to implement a full single-sign-on architecture</td></tr><tr><td>Ability to distribute authentication systems for absolute minimum wide area network bandwidth demand</td></tr></table><p> -Before migrating a network from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 it is vital that all necessary factors are -considered. Users should be educated about changes they may experience so that the change will be a -welcome one and not become an obstacle to the work they need to do. The following are some of the -factors that will go into a successful migration: -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2985388"></a>Domain Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Lower Cost of Ownership</p></li><li><p>Global availability of support with no strings attached</p></li><li><p>Dynamic SMB Servers (ie:Can run more than one server per Unix/Linux system)</p></li><li><p>Creation of on-the-fly logon scripts</p></li><li><p>Creation of on-the-fly Policy Files</p></li><li><p>Greater Stability, Reliability, Performance and Availability</p></li><li><p>Manageability via an ssh connection</p></li><li><p>Flexible choices of back-end authentication technologies (tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam)</p></li><li><p>Ability to implement a full single-sign-on architecture</p></li><li><p>Ability to distribute authentication systems for absolute minimum wide area network bandwidth demand</p></li></ul></div><p> +Before migrating a network from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3 consider all necessary factors. Users +should be educated about changes they may experience so that the change will be a welcome one +and not become an obstacle to the work they need to do. The following are factors that will +help ensure a successful migration: +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936240"></a>Domain Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 can be configured as a domain controller, a back-up domain controller (probably best called a secondary controller), a domain member, or as a stand-alone server. The Windows network security domain context should be sized and scoped before implementation. Particular attention needs to be paid to the location of the primary domain controller (PDC) as well as backup controllers (BDCs). -It should be noted that one way in which Samba-3 differs from Microsoft technology is that if one -chooses to use an LDAP authentication backend then the same database can be used by several different -domains. This means that in a complex organisation there can be a single LDAP database, that itself -can be distributed, that can simultaneously serve multiple domains (that can also be widely distributed). -</p><p> -It is recommended that from a design perspective, the number of users per server, as well as the number -of servers, per domain should be scaled according to needs and should also consider server capacity -and network bandwidth. -</p><p> -A physical network segment may house several domains, each of which may span multiple network segments. -Where domains span routed network segments it is most advisable to consider and test the performance -implications of the design and layout of a network. A Centrally located domain controller that is being -designed to serve multiple routed network segments may result in severe performance problems if the -response time (eg: ping timing) between the remote segment and the PDC is more than 100 ms. In situations -where the delay is too long it is highly recommended to locate a backup controller (BDC) to serve as -the local authentication and access control server. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2985441"></a>Server Share and Directory Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There are few cardinal rules to effective network design that can be broken with impunity. -The most important rule of effective network management is that simplicity is king in every -well controlled network. Every part of the infrastructure must be managed, the more complex -it is, the greater will be the demand of keeping systems secure and functional. -</p><p> -The nature of the data that must be stored needs to be born in mind when deciding how many -shares must be created. The physical disk space layout should also be taken into account -when designing where share points will be created. Keep in mind that all data needs to be -backed up, thus the simpler the disk layout the easier it will be to keep track of what must -be backed up to tape or other off-line storage medium. Always plan and implement for minimum +One way in which Samba-3 differs from Microsoft technology is that if one chooses to use an LDAP +authentication backend then the same database can be used by several different domains. In a +complex organisation there can be a single LDAP database, which itself can be distributed (ie: Have +a master server and multiple slave servers) that can simultaneously serve multiple domains. +</p><p> +From a design perspective, the number of users per server, as well as the number of servers, per +domain should be scaled taking into consideration server capacity and network bandwidth. +</p><p> +A physical network segment may house several domains. Each may span multiple network segments. +Where domains span routed network segments, consider and test the performance implications of +the design and layout of a network. A Centrally located domain controller that is designed to +serve multiple routed network segments may result in severe performance problems. Check the +response time (eg: ping timing) between the remote segment and the PDC. If long (more than 100 ms) +locate a backup controller (BDC) on the remote segmanet to serve as the local authentication and +access control server. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936290"></a>Server Share and Directory Layout</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +There are cardinal rules to effective network design. These can not be broken with impunity. +The most important rule: Simplicity is king in every well controlled network. Every part of +the infrastructure must be managed, the more complex it is, the greater will be the demand +of keeping systems secure and functional. +</p><p> +Keep in mind the nature of how data must be share. Physical disk space layout should be considered +carefully. Some data must be backed up. The simpler the disk layout the easier it will be to +keep track of backed needs. Identify what back media will be meet needs, consider backup to tape +, CD-ROM or (DVD-ROM), or other off-line storage medium. Plan and implement for minimum maintenance. Leave nothing to chance in your design, above all, do not leave backups to chance: Backup and test, validate every backup, create a disaster recovery plan and prove that it works. </p><p> Users should be grouped according to data access control needs. File and directory access -is best controlled via group permissions and the use of the "sticky bit" on group controlled +is best controlled via group permissions and the use of the "sticky bit" on group controlled directories may substantially avoid file access complaints from samba share users. </p><p> -Many network administrators who are new to the game will attempt to use elaborate techniques -to set access controls, on files, directories, shares, as well as in share definitions. -There is the ever present danger that that administrator's successor will not understand the -complex mess that has been inherited. Remember, apparent job security through complex design -and implementation may ultimately cause loss of operations and downtime to users as the new -administrator learns to untangle your web. Keep access controls simple and effective and -make sure that users will never be interrupted by the stupidity of complexity. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2985503"></a>Logon Scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Please refer to the section of this document on Advanced Network Administration for information -regarding the network logon script options for Samba-3. Logon scripts can help to ensure that -all users gain share and printer connections they need. -</p><p> -Logon scripts can be created on-the-fly so that all commands executed are specific to the -rights and privileges granted to the user. The preferred controls should be affected through +Inexperienced network administrators often attempt elaborate techniques to set access +controls on files, directories, shares, as well as in share definitions. +Keep your design and implementation simple and document your design extensively. Have others +audit your documentation. Do not create a complex mess that your successor will not understand. +Remember, job security through complex design and implementation may cause loss of operations +and downtime to users as the new administrator learns to untangle your knots. Keep access +controls simple and effective and make sure that users will never be interrupted by stupid +complexity. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936350"></a>Logon Scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Logon scripts can help to ensure that all users gain share and printer connections they need. +</p><p> +Logon scripts can be created 'on-the-fly' so that all commands executed are specific to the +rights and priviliges granted to the user. The preferred controls should be affected through group membership so that group information can be used to custom create a logon script using -the <i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i> parameters to the <tt class="filename">NETLOGON</tt> share. +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2936371"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i> parameters to the <i class="parameter"><tt>NETLOGON</tt></i> share. </p><p> Some sites prefer to use a tool such as <b class="command">kixstart</b> to establish a controlled user environment. In any case you may wish to do a google search for logon script process controls. In particular, you may wish to explore the use of the Microsoft knowledgebase article KB189105 that deals with how to add printers without user intervention via the logon script process. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2985560"></a>Profile Migration/Creation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936413"></a>Profile Migration/Creation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> User and Group Profiles may be migrated using the tools described in the section titled Desktop Profile Management. </p><p> Profiles may also be managed using the Samba-3 tool <b class="command">profiles</b>. This tool allows the MS Windows NT style security identifiers (SIDs) that are stored inside the profile NTuser.DAT file to be changed to the SID of the Samba-3 domain. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2986523"></a>User and Group Accounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2936443"></a>User and Group Accounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> It is possible to migrate all account settings from an MS Windows NT4 domain to Samba-3. Before attempting to migrate user and group accounts it is STRONGLY advised to create in Samba-3 the -groups that are present on the MS Windows NT4 domain <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> to connect these to -suitable Unix/Linux groups. Following this simple advice will mean that all user and group attributes +groups that are present on the MS Windows NT4 domain <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> to map these to +suitable Unix/Linux groups. By following this simple advice all user and group attributes should migrate painlessly. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986549"></a>Steps In Migration Process</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936467"></a>Steps In Migration Process</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The approximate migration process is described below. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> You will have an NT4 PDC that has the users, groups, policies and profiles to be migrated </p></li><li><p> -Samba-3 set up as a DC with netlogon share, profile share, etc. -</p></li></ul></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 31.1. The Account Migration Process</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p>Create a BDC account for the samba server using NT Server Manager</p><ol type="a"><li><p>Samba must NOT be running</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>lsaquery</p></li><li><p>Note the SID returned</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net getsid -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note the SID</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note the SID, now check that all three SIDS reported are the same!</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -L</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note - did the users migrate?</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>initGrps.sh <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Now check that all groups are recognised</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note - check that all group membership has been migrated</p></li></ol></li></ol></div><p> -Now it is time to migrate all the profiles, then migrate all policy files. -More later. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2986887"></a>Migration Options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Based on feedback from many sites as well as from actual installation and maintenance -experience sites that wish to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba -based solution fit into three basic categories. -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2986904"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.1. The 3 Major Site Types</b></p><table summary="The 3 Major Site Types" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Number of Users</th><th>Description</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td>< 50</td><td><p>Want simple conversion with NO pain</p></td></tr><tr><td>50 - 250</td><td><p>Want new features, can manage some in-house complexity</p></td></tr><tr><td>> 250</td><td><p>Solution/Implementation MUST scale well, complex needs. Cross departmental decision process. Local expertise in most areas</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986968"></a>Planning for Success</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 set up as a DC with netlogon share, profile share, etc. Configure the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file +to fucntion as a BDC. ie: <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = No</tt></i>. +</p></li></ul></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 31.1. The Account Migration Process</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p>Create a BDC account for the samba server using NT Server Manager</p><ol type="a"><li><p>Samba must NOT be running</p></li></ol></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMNAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc vampire -S <i class="replaceable"><tt>NT4PDC</tt></i> -U administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>passwd</tt></i></tt></b></p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -L</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Note - did the users migrate?</p></li></ol></li><li><p> + Now assign each of the UNIX groups to NT groups: + (Note: It may be useful to copy this text to a script called + <tt class="filename">initGroups.sh</tt>) + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +#!/bin/bash +#### Keep this as a shell script for future re-use + +# First assign well known domain global groups +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=ntadmins +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Guests" unixgroup=nobody +net groupmap modify ntgroup="Domain Users" unixgroup=users + +# Now for our added domain global groups +net groupmap add ntgroup="Designers" unixgroup=designers type=d rid=3200 +net groupmap add ntgroup="Engineers" unixgroup=engineers type=d rid=3210 +net groupmap add ntgroup="QA Team" unixgroup=qateam type=d rid=3220 +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b></p><ol type="a"><li><p>Now check that all groups are recognised</p></li></ol></li></ol></div><p> +Now migrate all the profiles, then migrate all policy files. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936679"></a>Migration Options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Sites that wish to migrate from MS Windows NT4 Domain Control to a Samba based solution +generally fit into three basic categories. +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2936694"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.1. The 3 Major Site Types</b></p><table summary="The 3 Major Site Types" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Number of Users</th><th align="justify">Description</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">< 50</td><td align="justify"><p>Want simple conversion with NO pain</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">50 - 250</td><td align="justify"><p>Want new features, can manage some in-house complexity</p></td></tr><tr><td align="left">> 250</td><td align="justify"><p>Solution/Implementation MUST scale well, complex needs. Cross departmental decision process. Local expertise in most areas</p></td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936770"></a>Planning for Success</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are three basic choices for sites that intend to migrate from MS Windows NT4 to Samba-3. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -15113,7 +14483,7 @@ to Samba-3. </p></li><li><p> Complete Redesign (completely new solution) </p></li></ul></div><p> -No matter what choice you make, the following rules will minimise down-stream problems: +Minimise down-stream problems by: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Take sufficient time </p></li><li><p> @@ -15122,65 +14492,28 @@ No matter what choice you make, the following rules will minimise down-stream pr Test ALL assumptions </p></li><li><p> Test full roll-out program, including workstation deployment - </p></li></ul></div><div class="table"><a name="id2987041"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.2. Nature of the Conversion Choices</b></p><table summary="Nature of the Conversion Choices" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th>Simple</th><th>Upgraded</th><th>Redesign</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td><p>Make use of minimal OS specific features</p></td><td><p>Translate NT4 features to new host OS features</p></td><td><p>Decide:</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Suck all accounts from NT4 into Samba-3</p></td><td><p>Copy and improve:</p></td><td><p>Authentication Regime (database location and access)</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Make least number of operational changes</p></td><td><p>Make progressive improvements</p></td><td><p>Desktop Management Methods</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Take least amount of time to migrate</p></td><td><p>Minimise user impact</p></td><td><p>Better Control of Desktops / Users</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Live versus Isolated Conversion</p></td><td><p>Maximise functionality</p></td><td><p>Identify Needs for: Manageability, Scalability, Security, Availability</p></td></tr><tr><td><p>Integrate Samba-3 then migrate while users are active, then Change of control (ie: swap out)</p></td><td><p>Take advantage of lower maintenance opportunity</p></td><td><p></p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2987210"></a>Samba Implementation Choices</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> -Authentication database back end - Winbind (external Samba or NT4/200x server) - Can use pam_mkhomedir.so to auto-create home dirs - External server could use Active Directory or NT4 Domain - -Database type - smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam - -Access Control Points - On the Share itself (Use NT4 Server Manager) - On the file system - Unix permissions on files and directories - Enable Posix ACLs in file system? - Through Samba share parameters - Not recommended - except as only resort - -Policies (migrate or create new ones) - Group Policy Editor (NT4) - Watch out for Tattoo effect - -User and Group Profiles - Platform specific so use platform tool to change from a Local - to a Roaming profile Can use new profiles tool to change SIDs - (NTUser.DAT) - -Logon Scripts (Know how they work) - -User and Group mapping to Unix/Linux - username map facility may be needed - Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups - Use pdbedit to set/change user configuration -NOTE: -If migrating to LDAP back end it may be easier to dump initial LDAP database -to LDIF, then edit, then reload into LDAP - - OS specific scripts / programs may be needed - Add / delete Users - Note OS limits on size of name (Linux 8 chars) - NT4 up to 254 chars - Add / delete machines - Applied only to domain members (note up to 16 chars) - Add / delete Groups - Note OS limits on size and nature - Linux limit is 16 char, - no spaces and no upper case chars (groupadd) - -Migration Tools - Domain Control (NT4 Style) - Profiles, Policies, Access Controls, Security - -Migration Tools - Samba: net, rpcclient, smbpasswd, pdbedit, profiles - Windows: NT4 Domain User Manager, Server Manager (NEXUS) - -Authentication - New SAM back end (smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam) -</pre><p> -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SWAT"></a>Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2986434">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2986468">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2988827">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2988941">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989005">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989110">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989175">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989239">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989287">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989339">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2989362">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="table"><a name="id2936841"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 31.2. Nature of the Conversion Choices</b></p><table summary="Nature of the Conversion Choices" border="1"><colgroup><col align="justify"><col align="justify"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="justify">Simple</th><th align="justify">Upgraded</th><th align="justify">Redesign</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="justify"><p>Make use of minimal OS specific features</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Translate NT4 features to new host OS features</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Decide:</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Suck all accounts from NT4 into Samba-3</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Copy and improve:</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Authentication Regime (database location and access)</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Make least number of operational changes</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Make progressive improvements</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Desktop Management Methods</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Take least amount of time to migrate</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Minimise user impact</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Better Control of Desktops / Users</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Live versus Isolated Conversion</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Maximise functionality</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Identify Needs for: Manageability, Scalability, Security, Availability</p></td></tr><tr><td align="justify"><p>Integrate Samba-3 then migrate while users are active, then Change of control (ie: swap out)</p></td><td align="justify"><p>Take advantage of lower maintenance opportunity</p></td><td align="justify"><p></p></td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937026"></a>Samba-3 Implementation Choices</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Authentication database/back end:</span></dt><dd><p> + Samba-3 can use an external authentication backend: + </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind (external Samba or NT4/200x server)</p></li><li><p>External server could use Active Directory or NT4 Domain</p></li><li><p>Can use pam_mkhomedir.so to auto-create home dirs</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><p> + Samba-3 can use a local authentication backend: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, mysqlsam</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Access Control Points:</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>On the Share itself - using Share ACLs</p></li><li><p>On the file system - using UNIX permissions on files and directories</p><p>Note: Can Enable Posix ACLs in file system also</p></li><li><p>Through Samba share parameters - Not recommended - except as last resort</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">Policies (migrate or create new ones):</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Using Group Policy Editor (NT4)</p></li><li><p>- Watch out for Tattoo effect</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">User and Group Profiles:</span></dt><dd><p> + Platform specific so use platform tool to change from a Local to a Roaming profile + Can use new profiles tool to change SIDs (NTUser.DAT) + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Logon Scripts:</span></dt><dd><p> + Know how they work + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">User and Group mapping to Unix/Linux:</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>username map facility may be needed</p></li><li><p>Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups</p></li><li><p>Use pdbedit to set/change user configuration</p><p> + NOTE: When migrating to LDAP back, end it may be easier to dump initial + LDAP database to LDIF, then edit, then reload into LDAP + </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">OS specific scripts/programs may be needed:</span></dt><dd><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Add/Delete Users: Note OS limits on size of name + (Linux 8 chars) NT4 up to 254 chars</p></li><li><p>Add/Delete Machines: Applied only to domain members + (Note: Machine names may be limited to 16 characters)</p></li><li><p>Use 'net groupmap' to connect NT4 groups to Unix groups</p></li><li><p>Add/Delete Groups: Note OS limits on size and nature. + Linux limit is 16 char, no spaces and no upper case chars (groupadd)</p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">Migration Tools:</span></dt><dd><p> + Domain Control (NT4 Style) Profiles, Policies, Access Controls, Security + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Samba: net, rpcclient, smbpasswd, pdbedit, profiles</p></li><li><p>Windows: NT4 Domain User Manager, Server Manager (NEXUS)</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SWAT"></a>Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">April 21, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2937386">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2937426">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937663">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937775">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937837">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2937944">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938008">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938072">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938120">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938171">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938195">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> There are many and varied opinions regarding the usefulness or otherwise of SWAT. No matter how hard one tries to produce the perfect configuration tool it remains an object of personal taste. SWAT is a tool that will allow web based configuration @@ -15188,7 +14521,7 @@ of samba. It has a wizard that may help to get samba configured quickly, it has sensitive help on each smb.conf parameter, it provides for monitoring of current state of connection information, and it allows network wide MS Windows network password management. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2986434"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2937386"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are network administrators who believe that it is a good idea to write systems documentation inside configuration files, for them SWAT will aways be a nasty tool. SWAT does not store the configuration file in any intermediate form, rather, it stores only the @@ -15200,9 +14533,9 @@ internal ordering. So before using SWAT please be warned - SWAT will completely replace your smb.conf with a fully optimised file that has been stripped of all comments you might have placed there and only non-default settings will be written to the file. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2986468"></a>Enabling SWAT for use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937426"></a>Enabling SWAT for use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> SWAT should be installed to run via the network super daemon. Depending on which system -your Unix/Linux system has you will have either an <b class="command">inetd</b> or +your UNIX/Linux system has you will have either an <b class="command">inetd</b> or <b class="command">xinetd</b> based system. </p><p> The nature and location of the network super-daemon varies with the operating system @@ -15254,7 +14587,7 @@ So long as you log onto SWAT as the user <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></s full change and commit ability. The buttons that will be exposed includes: <span class="guibutton">HOME</span>, <span class="guibutton">GLOBALS</span>, <span class="guibutton">SHARES</span>, <span class="guibutton">PRINTERS</span>, <span class="guibutton">WIZARD</span>, <span class="guibutton">STATUS</span>, <span class="guibutton">VIEW</span>, <span class="guibutton">PASSWORD</span>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2988827"></a>Securing SWAT through SSL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937663"></a>Securing SWAT through SSL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Lots of people have asked about how to setup SWAT with SSL to allow for secure remote administration of Samba. Here is a method that works, courtesy of Markus Krieger </p><p> @@ -15264,38 +14597,37 @@ Modifications to the swat setup are as following: </p></li><li><p> generate certificate and private key - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/bin/openssl req -new -x509 -days 365 -nodes -config \ - /usr/share/doc/packages/stunnel/stunnel.cnf \ + /usr/share/doc/packages/stunnel/stunnel.cnf \ -out /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -keyout /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem</tt></b> - </pre></li><li><p> +</pre></li><li><p> remove swat-entry from [x]inetd </p></li><li><p> start stunnel - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>stunnel -p /etc/stunnel/stunnel.pem -d 901 \ -l /usr/local/samba/bin/swat swat </tt></b> - </pre></li></ol></div><p> +</pre></li></ol></div><p> afterwords simply contact to swat by using the URL <a href="https://myhost:901" target="_top">https://myhost:901</a>, accept the certificate and the SSL connection is up. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2988941"></a>The SWAT Home Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937775"></a>The SWAT Home Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The SWAT title page provides access to the latest Samba documentation. The manual page for each samba component is accessible from this page as are the Samba-HOWTO-Collection (this -document) as well as the O'Reilly book "Using Samba". +document) as well as the O'Reilly book "Using Samba". </p><p> Administrators who wish to validate their samba configuration may obtain useful information from the man pages for the diagnostic utilities. These are available from the SWAT home page also. One diagnostic tool that is NOT mentioned on this page, but that is particularly -useful is <b class="command">ethereal</b>, available from <a href="http://www.ethereal.com" target="_top"> -http://www.ethereal.com</a>. +useful is <a href="http://www.ethereal.com/" target="_top"><b class="command">ethereal</b></a>. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> SWAT can be configured to run in <span class="emphasis"><em>demo</em></span> mode. This is NOT recommended as it runs SWAT without authentication and with full administrative ability. ie: Allows changes to smb.conf as well as general operation with root privileges. The option that creates this ability is the <tt class="option">-a</tt> flag to swat. <span class="emphasis"><em>Do not use this in any production environment.</em></span> -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989005"></a>Global Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937837"></a>Global Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Globals button will expose a page that allows configuration of the global parameters in smb.conf. There are three levels of exposure of the parameters: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -15308,8 +14640,8 @@ in smb.conf. There are three levels of exposure of the parameters: will want to tamper with. </p></li></ul></div><p> To switch to other than <span class="emphasis"><em>Basic</em></span> editing ability click on either the -<span class="emphasis"><em>Advanced</em></span> or the <span class="emphasis"><em>Developer</em></span> dial, then click the -<span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button. +<span class="emphasis"><em>Advanced</em></span> or the <span class="emphasis"><em>Developer</em></span> button. You may also +do this by clicking on the radio button, then click the <span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button. </p><p> After making any changes to configuration parameters make sure that you click on the <span class="guibutton">Commit Changes</span> button before moving to another area otherwise @@ -15317,7 +14649,7 @@ your changes will be immediately lost. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> SWAT has context sensitive help. To find out what each parameter is for simply click the <span class="guibutton">Help</span> link to the left of the configuration parameter. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989110"></a>Share Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937944"></a>Share Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To affect a currently configured share, simply click on the pull down button between the <span class="guibutton">Choose Share</span> and the <span class="guibutton">Delete Share</span> buttons, select the share you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the @@ -15327,7 +14659,7 @@ select the share you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the To create a new share, next to the button labelled <span class="guibutton">Create Share</span> enter into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Create Share</span> button. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989175"></a>Printers Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938008"></a>Printers Settings</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To affect a currently configured printer, simply click on the pull down button between the <span class="guibutton">Choose Printer</span> and the <span class="guibutton">Delete Printer</span> buttons, select the printer you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on the @@ -15337,7 +14669,7 @@ select the printer you wish to operate on, then to edit the settings click on th To create a new printer, next to the button labelled <span class="guibutton">Create Printer</span> enter into the text field the name of the share to be created, then click on the <span class="guibutton">Create Printer</span> button. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989239"></a>The SWAT Wizard</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938072"></a>The SWAT Wizard</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The purpose if the SWAT Wizard is to help the Microsoft knowledgeable network administrator to configure Samba with a minimum of effort. </p><p> @@ -15353,7 +14685,7 @@ Finally, there are a limited set of options that will determine what type of ser will be configured for, whether it will be a WINS server, participate as a WINS client, or operate with no WINS support. By clicking on one button you can elect to expose (or not) user home directories. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989287"></a>The Status Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938120"></a>The Status Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The status page serves a limited purpose. Firstly, it allows control of the samba daemons. The key daemons that create the samba server environment are: <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">winbindd</span>. </p><p> @@ -15364,11 +14696,11 @@ conditions with minimal effort. </p><p> Lastly, the Status page may be used to terminate specific smbd client connections in order to free files that may be locked. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989339"></a>The View Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938171"></a>The View Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This page allows the administrator to view the optimised <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file and, if you are particularly masochistic, will permit you also to see all possible global configuration parameters and their settings. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2989362"></a>The Password Change Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938195"></a>The Password Change Page</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Password Change page is a popular tool. This tool allows the creation, deletion, deactivation and reactivation of MS Windows networking users on the local machine. Alternatively, you can use this tool to change a local password for a user account. @@ -15379,7 +14711,7 @@ required. </p><p> One popular use for this tool is to change user passwords across a range of remote MS Windows servers. -</p></div></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="troubleshooting"></a>Troubleshooting</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>33. <a href="#diagnosis">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2988578">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2990437">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2990614">The tests</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2991790">Still having troubles?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="#problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2993414">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993555">Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993839">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993884">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994036">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="#bugreport">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994775">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994997">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995034">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995176">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995284">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995331">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="diagnosis"></a>Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Wed Jan 15</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2988578">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2990437">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2990614">The tests</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2991790">Still having troubles?</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2988578"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="troubleshooting"></a>Troubleshooting</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>33. <a href="#diagnosis">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2938325">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938359">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="#problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940060">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940082">Debugging with Samba itself</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940195">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940216">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940268">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940586">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940626">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940778">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="#bugreport">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940906">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940969">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941006">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941215">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941348">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941395">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="diagnosis"></a>Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Wed Jan 15</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2938325">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938359">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938325"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This file contains a list of tests you can perform to validate your Samba server. It also tells you what the likely cause of the problem is if it fails any one of these steps. If it passes all these tests @@ -15391,10 +14723,10 @@ the earlier tests. However, do not stop at the first error as there have been some instances when continuing with the tests has helped to solve a problem. </p><p> -If you send one of the samba mailing lists an email saying "it doesn't work" +If you send one of the samba mailing lists an email saying "it doesn't work" and you have not followed this test procedure then you should not be surprised if your email is ignored. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2990437"></a>Assumptions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938359"></a>Assumptions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In all of the tests it is assumed you have a Samba server called BIGSERVER and a PC called ACLIENT both in workgroup TESTGROUP. </p><p> @@ -15404,14 +14736,7 @@ It is also assumed you know the name of an available share in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. I will assume this share is called <i class="replaceable"><tt>tmp</tt></i>. You can add a <i class="replaceable"><tt>tmp</tt></i> share like this by adding the following to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - -[tmp] - comment = temporary files - path = /tmp - read only = yes - -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2938408"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 33.1. smb.conf with [tmp] share</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = temporary files </tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /tmp</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> These tests assume version 3.0 or later of the samba suite. Some commands shown did not exist in earlier versions. @@ -15424,7 +14749,7 @@ file points to name servers that really do exist. Also, if you do not have DNS server access for name resolution please check that the settings for your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file results in <b class="command">dns proxy = no</b>. The best way to check this is with <b class="userinput"><tt>testparm smb.conf</tt></b>. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2938508"></a><p> It is helpful to monitor the log files during testing by using the <b class="command">tail -F <i class="replaceable"><tt>log_file_name</tt></i></b> in a separate terminal console (use ctrl-alt-F1 through F6 or multiple terminals in X). @@ -15435,7 +14760,7 @@ depending on how or if you specified logging in your <tt class="filename">smb.co </p><p> If you make changes to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file while going through these test, don't forget to restart <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2990614"></a>The tests</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 33.1. Diagnosing your samba server</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938586"></a>The tests</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 33.1. Diagnosing your samba server</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2938602"></a><ol type="1"><li><p> In the directory in which you store your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>testparm smb.conf</tt></b>. If it reports any errors then your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file is faulty. @@ -15448,7 +14773,7 @@ Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>ping BIGSERVER</tt></b> from the PC and the unix box. If you don't get a valid response then your TCP/IP software is not correctly installed. </p><p> -Note that you will need to start a "dos prompt" window on the PC to +Note that you will need to start a "dos prompt" window on the PC to run ping. </p><p> If you get a message saying <span class="errorname">host not found</span> or similar then your DNS @@ -15468,7 +14793,7 @@ This is a common problem that is often overlooked. Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L BIGSERVER</tt></b> on the unix box. You should get a list of available shares back. </p><p> -If you get a error message containing the string "Bad password" then +If you get a error message containing the string "Bad password" then you probably have either an incorrect <b class="command">hosts allow</b>, <b class="command">hosts deny</b> or <b class="command">valid users</b> line in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, or your guest account is not @@ -15481,13 +14806,15 @@ that file incorrectly. If you installed it as a daemon then check that it is running, and check that the netbios-ssn port is in a LISTEN state using <b class="userinput"><tt>netstat -a</tt></b>. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938860"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2938869"></a> Some Unix / Linux systems use <b class="command">xinetd</b> in place of <b class="command">inetd</b>. Check your system documentation for the location of the control file/s for your particular system implementation of this network super daemon. </p></div><p> If you get a <span class="errorname">session request failed</span> then the server refused the -connection. If it says "Your server software is being unfriendly" then +connection. If it says "Your server software is being unfriendly" then its probably because you have invalid command line parameters to <span class="application">smbd</span>, or a similar fatal problem with the initial startup of <span class="application">smbd</span>. Also check your config file (<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>) for syntax errors with <span class="application">testparm</span> @@ -15497,26 +14824,20 @@ files exist. There are a number of reasons for which smbd may refuse or decline a session request. The most common of these involve one or more of the following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - hosts deny = ALL - hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy - bind interfaces only = Yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = ALL</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> In the above, no allowance has been made for any session requests that will automatically translate to the loopback adapter address 127.0.0.1. To solve this problem change these lines to: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - hosts deny = ALL - hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127. -</pre><p> -Do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> use the <b class="command">bind interfaces only</b> parameter where you +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = ALL</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127.</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +Do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2939025"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> parameter where you may wish to use the samba password change facility, or where <span class="application">smbclient</span> may need to access a local service for name resolution or for local resource -connections. (Note: the <b class="command">bind interfaces only</b> parameter deficiency +connections. (Note: the <a class="indexterm" name="id2939051"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> parameter deficiency where it will not allow connections to the loopback address will be fixed soon). </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939072"></a> Another common cause of these two errors is having something already running on port <tt class="constant">139</tt>, such as Samba (ie: <span class="application">smbd</span> is running from <span class="application">inetd</span> already) or @@ -15559,20 +14880,20 @@ messages from several hosts. If this doesn't give a similar result to the previous test then nmblookup isn't correctly getting your broadcast address through its automatic mechanism. In this case you should experiment with the -<b class="command">interfaces</b> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to manually configure your IP +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939242"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to manually configure your IP address, broadcast and netmask. </p><p> If your PC and server aren't on the same subnet then you will need to -use the <i class="parameter"><tt>-B</tt></i> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs +use the <tt class="option">-B</tt> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs subnet. </p><p> This test will probably fail if your subnet mask and broadcast address are not correct. (Refer to TEST 3 notes above). -</p></li><li><p> +</p></li><li><a class="indexterm" name="id2939290"></a><p> Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //BIGSERVER/TMP</tt></b>. You should then be prompted for a password. You should use the password of the account you are logged into the unix box with. If you want to test with -another account then add the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U <i class="replaceable"><tt>accountname</tt></i></tt></i> option to the end of +another account then add the <tt class="option">-U <i class="replaceable"><tt>accountname</tt></i></tt> option to the end of the command line. eg: <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe</tt></b> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> @@ -15582,21 +14903,20 @@ as follows: </p></div><p> Once you enter the password you should get the <tt class="prompt">smb></tt> prompt. If you don't then look at the error message. If it says <span class="errorname">invalid network -name</span> then the service <span class="emphasis"><em>"tmp"</em></span> is not correctly setup in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +name</span> then the service <span class="emphasis"><em>"tmp"</em></span> is not correctly setup in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. </p><p> If it says <span class="errorname">bad password</span> then the likely causes are: </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> you have shadow passwords (or some other password system) but didn't compile in support for them in <span class="application">smbd</span> </p></li><li><p> - your <b class="command">valid users</b> configuration is incorrect + your <a class="indexterm" name="id2939411"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> configuration is incorrect </p></li><li><p> - you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <b class="command">password - level</b> option at a high enough level + you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <a class="indexterm" name="id2939433"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> option at a high enough level </p></li><li><p> - the <b class="command">path =</b> line in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Check it with <span class="application">testparm</span> + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2939457"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> line in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Check it with <span class="application">testparm</span> </p></li><li><p> - you enabled password encryption but didn't map unix to samba users + you enabled password encryption but didn't map unix to samba users. Run </p><pre class="screen"><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -a <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i></tt></b></pre><p>. </p></li></ol></div><p> Once connected you should be able to use the commands <b class="command">dir</b> <b class="command">get</b> <b class="command">put</b> etc. @@ -15605,7 +14925,7 @@ especially check that the amount of free disk space shown is correct when you type <b class="command">dir</b>. </p></li><li><p> On the PC, type the command <b class="userinput"><tt>net view \\BIGSERVER</tt></b>. You will -need to do this from within a "dos prompt" window. You should get back a +need to do this from within a "dos prompt" window. You should get back a list of available shares on the server. </p><p> If you get a <span class="errorname">network name not found</span> or similar error then netbios @@ -15646,14 +14966,13 @@ installed or your smb.conf is incorrect. make sure your <b class="command">hosts and other config lines in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> are correct. </p><p> It's also possible that the server can't work out what user name to -connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line <i class="parameter"><tt>user = -<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i></tt></i> to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i> section of +connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line <a class="indexterm" name="id2939744"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> = username to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> is the username corresponding to the password you typed. If you find this fixes things you may need the username mapping option. </p><p> It might also be the case that your client only sends encrypted passwords -and you have <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = no</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +and you have <a class="indexterm" name="id2939783"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = no in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Turn it back on to fix. </p></li><li><p> Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -M <i class="replaceable"><tt>testgroup</tt></i></tt></b> where @@ -15664,30 +14983,33 @@ master browser for that workgroup. If you don't then the election process has failed. Wait a minute to see if it is just being slow then try again. If it still fails after that then look at the browsing options you have set in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Make -sure you have <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i> to ensure that +sure you have <a class="indexterm" name="id2939847"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> = yes to ensure that an election is held at startup. </p></li><li><p> ->From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should +From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should appear in the browse list of your local workgroup (or the one you -specified in smb.conf). You should be able to double click on the name -of the server and get a list of shares. If you get a "invalid -password" error when you do then you are probably running WinNT and it +specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). You should be able to double click on the name +of the server and get a list of shares. If you get a "invalid +password" error when you do then you are probably running WinNT and it is refusing to browse a server that has no encrypted password capability and is in user level security mode. In this case either set -<i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> AND -<i class="parameter"><tt>password server = Windows_NT_Machine</tt></i> in your -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, or make sure <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i> is -set to "yes". -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2991790"></a>Still having troubles?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Read the chapter on -<a href="#problems" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and Solving Problems</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="problems"></a>Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 Apr 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2993414">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993555">Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993839">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2993884">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994036">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939889"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server AND +<a class="indexterm" name="id2939902"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = Windows_NT_Machine in your +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, or make sure <a class="indexterm" name="id2939924"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> is +set to "yes". +</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="problems"></a>Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 Apr 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2940060">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2940082">Debugging with Samba itself</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940195">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940216">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940268">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2940586">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940626">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940778">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></div><p> There are many sources of information available in the form of mailing lists, RFC's and documentation. The docs that come with the samba distribution contain very good explanations of -general SMB topics such as browsing.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2993414"></a>Diagnostics tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +general SMB topics such as browsing.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940060"></a>Diagnostics tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>With SMB networking, it is often not immediately clear what +the cause is of a certain problem. Samba itself provides rather +useful information, but in some cases you might have to fall back +to using a <span class="emphasis"><em>sniffer</em></span>. A sniffer is a program that +listens on your LAN, analyses the data sent on it and displays it +on the screen.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940082"></a>Debugging with Samba itself</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> One of the best diagnostic tools for debugging problems is Samba itself. You can use the <tt class="option">-d option</tt> for both <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> to specify what -<i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i> at which to run. See the man pages on smbd, nmbd and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2940113"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i> at which to run. See the man pages on smbd, nmbd and smb.conf for more information on debugging options. The debug level can range from 1 (the default) to 10 (100 for debugging passwords). </p><p> @@ -15706,14 +15028,19 @@ typing in your password, you can attach gdb and continue. </p><p> Some useful samba commands worth investigating: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm | more</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</tt></b> -</pre><p> -An SMB enabled version of tcpdump is available from -<a href="http://www.tcpdump.org/" target="_top">http://www.tcpdup.org/</a>. -Ethereal, another good packet sniffer for Unix and Win32 -hosts, can be downloaded from <a href="http://www.ethereal.com/" target="_top">http://www.ethereal.com</a>. -</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm | more</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940195"></a>Tcpdump</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><a href="http://www.tcpdump.org/" target="_top">Tcpdump</a> was the first +unix sniffer with SMB support. It is a command-line utility and +nowadays, it's SMB support is somewhat less then that of ethereal +and tethereal.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940216"></a>Ethereal</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a href="http://www.ethereal.com/" target="_top">Ethereal</a> is a graphical +sniffer, available for both unix (Gtk) and Windows. Ethereal's +SMB support is very good.</p><p>For details on the use of ethereal, read the well-written +ethereal User Guide.</p><p> +Listen for data on ports 137, 138, 139 and 445. E.g. +use the filter <b class="userinput"><tt>port 137 or port 138 or port 139 or port 445</tt></b>.</p><p>A console version of ethereal is available as well and is called +<b class="command">tethereal</b>.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940268"></a>The Windows Network Monitor</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For tracing things on the Microsoft Windows NT, Network Monitor (aka. netmon) is available on the Microsoft Developer Network CD's, the Windows NT Server install CD and the SMS CD's. The version of @@ -15723,7 +15050,7 @@ The version on the NT Server install CD will only allow monitoring of network traffic directed to the local NT box and broadcasts on the local subnet. Be aware that Ethereal can read and write netmon formatted files. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2993555"></a>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940289"></a>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Installing netmon on an NT workstation requires a couple of steps. The following are for installing Netmon V4.00.349, which comes with Microsoft Windows NT Server 4.0, on Microsoft Windows NT @@ -15756,17 +15083,17 @@ Now copy the files from the NT Server in <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\Syste to <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.*</tt> on the Workstation and set permissions as you deem appropriate for your site. You will need administrative rights on the NT box to run netmon. -</p><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940558"></a>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an 9x Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To install Netmon on a Windows 9x box install the network monitor agent from the Windows 9x CD (<tt class="filename">\admin\nettools\netmon</tt>). There is a readme file located with the netmon driver files on the CD if you need information on how to do this. Copy the files from a working Netmon installation. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2993839"></a>Useful URLs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940586"></a>Useful URLs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at <a href="http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html" target="_top"> http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html</a>. </p></li><li><p>FTP site for older SMB specs: <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/" target="_top"> - ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2993884"></a>Getting help from the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940626"></a>Getting help from the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of Samba related mailing lists. Go to <a href="http://samba.org" target="_top">http://samba.org</a>, click on your nearest mirror and then click on <b class="command">Support</b> and then click on <b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. @@ -15776,10 +15103,10 @@ For questions relating to Samba TNG go to It has been requested that you don't post questions about Samba-TNG to the main stream Samba lists.</p><p> If you post a message to one of the lists please observe the following guide lines : -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are not paid and they never guarantee to produce a particular feature at a particular time. Any time lines are 'best guess' and nothing more. -</p></li><li><p> Always mention what version of samba you are using and what +</p></li><li><p>Always mention what version of samba you are using and what operating system its running under. You should probably list the relevant sections of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, at least the options in [global] that affect PDC support.</p></li><li><p>In addition to the version, if you obtained Samba via @@ -15800,15 +15127,14 @@ error messages.</p></li><li><p>(Possibly) If you have a complete netmon trace ( the pipe to the error ) you can send the *.CAP file as well.</p></li><li><p>Please think carefully before attaching a document to an email. Consider pasting the relevant parts into the body of the message. The samba mailing lists go to a huge number of people, do they all need a copy of your -smb.conf in their attach directory?</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2994036"></a>How to get off the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To have your name removed from a samba mailing list, go to the +smb.conf in their attach directory?</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940778"></a>How to get off the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To have your name removed from a samba mailing list, go to the same place you went to to get on it. Go to <a href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>, click on your nearest mirror and then click on <b class="command">Support</b> and -then click on <b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. Or perhaps see -<a href="http://lists.samba.org/mailman/roster/samba-ntdom" target="_top">here</a> +then click on <b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. </p><p> Please don't post messages to the list asking to be removed, you will just be referred to the above address (unless that process failed in some way...) -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="bugreport"></a>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">Someone; Tridge or Karl Auer perhaps?</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 June 1997 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2994775">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994997">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995034">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995176">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995284">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2995331">Patches</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2994775"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please report bugs using +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="bugreport"></a>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 June 1997 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2940906">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2940969">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941006">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941215">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941348">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941395">Patches</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940906"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please report bugs using <a href="https://bugzilla.samba.org/" target="_top">bugzilla</a>.</p><p> Please take the time to read this file before you submit a bug report. Also, please see if it has changed between releases, as we @@ -15818,7 +15144,7 @@ Please also do as much as you can yourself to help track down the bug. Samba is maintained by a dedicated group of people who volunteer their time, skills and efforts. We receive far more mail about it than we can possibly answer, so you have a much higher chance of an answer -and a fix if you send us a "developer friendly" bug report that lets +and a fix if you send us a "developer friendly" bug report that lets us fix it fast. </p><p> Do not assume that if you post the bug to the comp.protocols.smb @@ -15830,7 +15156,7 @@ that list that may be able to help you. You may also like to look though the recent mailing list archives, which are conveniently accessible on the Samba web pages at <a href="http://samba.org/samba/" target="_top">http://samba.org/samba/</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2994997"></a>General info</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940969"></a>General info</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before submitting a bug report check your config for silly errors. Look in your log files for obvious messages that tell you that you've misconfigured something and run testparm to test your config @@ -15842,42 +15168,38 @@ This is very important. If you include part of a log file with your bug report then be sure to annotate it with exactly what you were doing on the client at the time, and exactly what the results were. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995034"></a>Debug levels</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941006"></a>Debug levels</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the bug has anything to do with Samba behaving incorrectly as a server (like refusing to open a file) then the log files will probably be very useful. Depending on the problem a log level of between 3 and 10 showing the problem may be appropriate. A higher level gives more detail, but may use too much disk space. </p><p> -To set the debug level use the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in your +To set the debug level use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2941026"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. You may also find it useful to set the log level higher for just one machine and keep separate logs for each machine. -To do this use: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -log level = 10 -log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m -include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m -</pre><p> +To do this add the following lines to your main <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>log level = 10</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> then create a file <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i></tt> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i> is the name of the client you wish to debug. In that file put any <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> commands you want, for example -<i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> may be useful. This also allows you to +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941118"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> may be useful. This also allows you to experiment with different security systems, protocol levels etc on just one machine. </p><p> -The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> -is synonymous with the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> that has +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry <a class="indexterm" name="id2941145"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> +is synonymous with the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2941160"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> that has been used in older versions of Samba and is being retained for backwards compatibility of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files. </p><p> -As the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> value is increased you will record +As the <a class="indexterm" name="id2941186"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> value is increased you will record a significantly increasing level of debugging information. For most debugging operations you may not need a setting higher than <tt class="constant">3</tt>. Nearly all bugs can be tracked at a setting of <tt class="constant">10</tt>, but be prepared for a VERY large volume of log data. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995176"></a>Internal errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941215"></a>Internal errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you get a <span class="errorname">INTERNAL ERROR</span> message in your log files it means that Samba got an unexpected signal while running. It is probably a segmentation fault and almost certainly means a bug in Samba (unless @@ -15890,13 +15212,13 @@ include it in your bug report. </p><p> You should also detail how to reproduce the problem, if possible. Please make this reasonably detailed. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2941250"></a><p> You may also find that a core file appeared in a <tt class="filename">corefiles</tt> subdirectory of the directory where you keep your samba log files. This file is the most useful tool for tracking down the bug. To use it you do this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd core</tt></b> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2941273"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2941281"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd core</tt></b> </pre><p> adding appropriate paths to smbd and core so gdb can find them. If you don't have gdb then try <b class="userinput"><tt>dbx</tt></b>. Then within the debugger @@ -15910,7 +15232,7 @@ disassemble the routine that called it) and try to work out exactly where the problem is by looking at the surrounding code. Even if you don't know assembly, including this info in the bug report can be useful. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995284"></a>Attaching to a running process</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941348"></a>Attaching to a running process</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Unfortunately some unixes (in particular some recent linux kernels) refuse to dump a core file if the task has changed uid (which smbd does often). To debug with this sort of system you could try to attach @@ -15920,34 +15242,33 @@ to the running process using Then use <b class="command">c</b> to continue and try to cause the core dump using the client. The debugger should catch the fault and tell you where it occurred. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995331"></a>Patches</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941395"></a>Patches</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2941403"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2941411"></a><p> The best sort of bug report is one that includes a fix! If you send us patches please use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -u</tt></b> format if your version of diff supports it, otherwise use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -c4</tt></b>. Make sure you do the diff against a clean version of the source and let me know exactly what version you used. -</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Appendixes"></a>Appendixes</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>36. <a href="#compiling">How to compile SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994651">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994658">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994688">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2996207">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996256">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996392">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2996529">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2996694">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2996786">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996990">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2997085">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="#Portability">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2995985">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998515">SCO Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998546">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998716">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998760">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998767">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2998793">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998800">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="#Other-Clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998169">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999522">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2999529">How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999608">How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999670">How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2999766">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2999774">Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999864">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999894">Configure WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999940">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999970">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999988">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3000034">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3000107">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3000131">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3000242">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="#speed">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3001274">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001319">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001394">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001437">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001490">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001513">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001570">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001612">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001633">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001658">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001692">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="#DNSDHCP">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3001112">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="#Further-Resources">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3001272">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3002922">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3002990">Books</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="compiling"></a>Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">Someone; Jerry perhaps?</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 22 May 2001 </p></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 18 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2994651">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2994658">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2994688">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2996207">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996256">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996392">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2996529">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2996694">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2996786">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2996990">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2997085">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Appendixes"></a>Appendixes</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>36. <a href="#compiling">How to compile Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941554">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941570">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941600">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941849">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941913">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942063">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942242">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2942409">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942763">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="#Portability">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942927">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943015">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943044">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943217">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943261">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943268">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943294">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943299">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="#Other-Clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943452">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943531">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943538">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943607">Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943660">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943760">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943768">Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943858">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943888">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943941">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943979">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943996">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944042">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944116">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944140">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944326">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="#speed">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944458">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944501">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944592">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944641">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944701">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944732">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944816">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944879">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944908">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944932">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944965">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="#DNSDHCP">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2945070">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="#Further-Resources">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2945137">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2945545">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="compiling"></a>Chapter 36. How to compile Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 22 May 2001 </p></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 18 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2941554">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2941570">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941600">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2941849">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2941913">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942063">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942242">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2942409">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2942763">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> You can obtain the samba source from the <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">samba website</a>. To obtain a development version, you can download samba from CVS or using rsync. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2994651"></a>Access Samba source code via CVS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2994658"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941554"></a>Access Samba source code via CVS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2941562"></a><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941570"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba is developed in an open environment. Developers use CVS -(Concurrent Versioning System) to "checkin" (also known as -"commit") new source code. Samba's various CVS branches can +(Concurrent Versioning System) to "checkin" (also known as +"commit") new source code. Samba's various CVS branches can be accessed via anonymous CVS using the instructions detailed in this chapter. </p><p> This chapter is a modified version of the instructions found at <a href="http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html" target="_top">http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html</a> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2994688"></a>CVS Access to samba.org</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941600"></a>CVS Access to samba.org</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The machine samba.org runs a publicly accessible CVS repository for access to the source code of several packages, including samba, rsync, distcc, ccache and jitterbug. There are two main ways of accessing the CVS server on this host. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2994705"></a>Access via CVSweb</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2941616"></a>Access via CVSweb</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2941625"></a><p> You can access the source code via your favourite WWW browser. This allows you to access the contents of individual files in the repository and also to look at the revision @@ -15955,7 +15276,7 @@ history and commit logs of individual files. You can also ask for a diff listing between any two versions on the repository. </p><p> Use the URL : <a href="http://samba.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb" target="_top">http://samba.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb</a> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996017"></a>Access via cvs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2941658"></a>Access via cvs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can also access the source code via a normal cvs client. This gives you much more control over what you can do with the repository and allows you to checkout whole source trees @@ -15995,7 +15316,7 @@ on this system just substitute the correct package name </p><p> CVS branches other then HEAD can be obtained by using the <tt class="option">-r</tt> and defining a tag name. A list of branch tag names - can be found on the "Development" page of the samba web site. A common + can be found on the "Development" page of the samba web site. A common request is to obtain the latest 3.0 release code. This could be done by using the following command: </p><p> @@ -16005,7 +15326,7 @@ on this system just substitute the correct package name the following command from within the samba directory: </p><p> <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs update -d -P</tt></b> - </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2996207"></a>Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941849"></a>Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2941857"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2941865"></a><p> pserver.samba.org also exports unpacked copies of most parts of the CVS tree at <a href="ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked" target="_top">ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked</a> and also via anonymous rsync at <a href="rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/" target="_top">rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/</a>. I recommend using rsync rather than ftp. @@ -16014,7 +15335,7 @@ on this system just substitute the correct package name The disadvantage of the unpacked trees is that they do not support automatic merging of local changes like CVS does. rsync access is most convenient for an initial install. - </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2996256"></a>Verifying Samba's PGP signature</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941913"></a>Verifying Samba's PGP signature</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In these days of insecurity, it's strongly recommended that you verify the PGP signature for any source file before installing it. Even if you're not downloading from a mirror site, verifying PGP signatures should be a @@ -16022,39 +15343,43 @@ standard reflex. </p><p> With that said, go ahead and download the following files: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> -<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> </pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2941973"></a> The first file is the PGP signature for the Samba source file; the other is the Samba public PGP key itself. Import the public PGP key with: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --import samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --import samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> </pre><p> And verify the Samba source code integrity with: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gzip -d samba-2.2.8a.tar.gz</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --verify samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gzip -d samba-2.2.8a.tar.gz</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --verify samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> </pre><p> -If you receive a message like, "Good signature from Samba Distribution -Verification Key..." +If you receive a message like, "Good signature from Samba Distribution +Verification Key..." then all is well. The warnings about trust relationships can be ignored. An example of what you would not want to see would be: -</p><tt class="computeroutput"> - gpg: BAD signature from "Samba Distribution Verification Key" -</tt></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2996392"></a>Building the Binaries</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To do this, first run the program <b class="userinput"><tt>./configure +</p><p> +<tt class="computeroutput"> + gpg: BAD signature from "Samba Distribution Verification Key" + </tt> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2942063"></a>Building the Binaries</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2942071"></a><p> + To do this, first run the program <b class="userinput"><tt>./configure </tt></b> in the source directory. This should automatically configure Samba for your operating system. If you have unusual - needs then you may wish to run</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure --help - </tt></b></p><p>first to see what special options you can enable. - Then executing</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></p><p>will create the binaries. Once it's successfully - compiled you can use </p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make install</tt></b></p><p>to install the binaries and manual pages. You can - separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installbin - </tt></b></p><p>and</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installman - </tt></b></p><p>Note that if you are upgrading for a previous version + needs then you may wish to run</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure --help +</tt></b></pre><p>first to see what special options you can enable. + Then executing</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2942117"></a><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></pre><p>will create the binaries. Once it's successfully + compiled you can use </p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make install</tt></b></pre><p>to install the binaries and manual pages. You can + separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installbin +</tt></b></pre><p>and</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installman + </tt></b></pre><p>Note that if you are upgrading for a previous version of Samba you might like to know that the old versions of - the binaries will be renamed with a ".old" extension. You - can go back to the previous version with</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make revert - </tt></b></p><p>if you find this version a disaster!</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996529"></a>Compiling samba with Active Directory support</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>In order to compile samba with ADS support, you need to have installed + the binaries will be renamed with a ".old" extension. You + can go back to the previous version with</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make revert +</tt></b></pre><p>if you find this version a disaster!</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942242"></a>Compiling samba with Active Directory support</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>In order to compile samba with ADS support, you need to have installed on your system:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the MIT kerberos development libraries (either install from the sources or use a package). The Heimdal libraries will not work.</p></li><li><p>the OpenLDAP development libraries.</p></li></ul></div><p>If your kerberos libraries are in a non-standard location then @@ -16066,16 +15391,17 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: #define HAVE_LDAP 1 </pre><p>If it doesn't then configure did not find your krb5 libraries or your ldap libraries. Look in <tt class="filename">config.log</tt> to figure - out why and fix it.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996610"></a>Installing the required packages for Debian</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On Debian you need to install the following packages:</p><p> - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>libkrb5-dev</td></tr><tr><td>krb5-user</td></tr></table><p> - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996642"></a>Installing the required packages for RedHat</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On RedHat this means you should have at least: </p><p> - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>krb5-workstation (for kinit)</td></tr><tr><td>krb5-libs (for linking with)</td></tr><tr><td>krb5-devel (because you are compiling from source)</td></tr></table><p> + out why and fix it.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942323"></a>Installing the required packages for Debian</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On Debian you need to install the following packages:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>libkrb5-dev</p></li><li><p>krb5-user</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942355"></a>Installing the required packages for RedHat</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On RedHat this means you should have at least: </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>krb5-workstation (for kinit)</p></li><li><p>krb5-libs (for linking with)</p></li><li><p>krb5-devel (because you are compiling from source)</p></li></ul></div><p> </p><p>in addition to the standard development environment.</p><p>Note that these are not standard on a RedHat install, and you may need - to get them off CD2.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2996694"></a>Starting the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span></h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>You must choose to start <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> either + to get them off CD2.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2942409"></a>Starting the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span></h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2942429"></a><p>You must choose to start <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> either as daemons or from <span class="application">inetd</span>. Don't try to do both! Either you can put them in <tt class="filename"> inetd.conf</tt> and have them started on demand - by <span class="application">inetd</span>, or you can start them as + by <span class="application">inetd</span> or <span class="application">xinetd</span>, + or you can start them as daemons either from the command line or in <tt class="filename"> /etc/rc.local</tt>. See the man pages for details on the command line options. Take particular care to read @@ -16083,7 +15409,7 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: Samba. In many cases you must be root.</p><p>The main advantage of starting <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> using the recommended daemon method is that they will respond slightly more quickly to an initial connection - request.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996786"></a>Starting from inetd.conf</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>The following will be different if + request.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942516"></a>Starting from inetd.conf</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2942524"></a><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>The following will be different if you use NIS, NIS+ or LDAP to distribute services maps.</p></div><p>Look at your <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>. What is defined at port 139/tcp. If nothing is defined then add a line like this:</p><pre class="programlisting">netbios-ssn 139/tcp</pre><p>similarly for 137/udp you should have an entry like:</p><pre class="programlisting">netbios-ns 137/udp</pre><p>Next edit your <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> @@ -16092,12 +15418,13 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: netbios-ns dgram udp wait root /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd nmbd </pre><p>The exact syntax of <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> varies between unixes. Look at the other entries in inetd.conf - for a guide.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Some unixes already have entries like netbios_ns + for a guide. </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2942614"></a><p>Some distributions use xinetd instead of inetd. Consult the + xinetd manual for configuration information.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Some unixes already have entries like netbios_ns (note the underscore) in <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>. You must either edit <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> to make them consistent. - </p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On many systems you may need to use the - <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to specify the IP + </p></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2942657"></a><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On many systems you may need to use the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2942669"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to specify the IP address and netmask of your interfaces. Run <span class="application">ifconfig</span> as root if you don't know what the broadcast is for your @@ -16108,8 +15435,9 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: This means you shouldn't use spaces between the options and arguments, or you should use a script, and start the script from <b class="command">inetd</b>.</p></div><p>Restart <span class="application">inetd</span>, perhaps just send - it a HUP. If you have installed an earlier version of <span class="application">nmbd</span> then - you may need to kill <span class="application">nmbd</span> as well.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996990"></a>Alternative: starting it as a daemon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To start the server as a daemon you should create + it a HUP. </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>killall -HUP inetd</tt></b> + </pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942763"></a>Alternative: starting it as a daemon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2942771"></a><p>To start the server as a daemon you should create a script something like this one, perhaps calling it <tt class="filename">startsmb</tt>.</p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/sh @@ -16121,17 +15449,9 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: </p><p>To kill it send a kill signal to the processes <span class="application">nmbd</span> and <span class="application">smbd</span>.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>If you use the SVR4 style init system then you may like to look at the <tt class="filename">examples/svr4-startup</tt> - script to make Samba fit into that system.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2997085"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> -I'm using gcc 3 and I've compiled Samba-3 from the CVS and the -binaries are very large files (40 Mb and 20 Mb). I've the same result with -<tt class="option">--enable-shared</tt> ? -</span>” -</p><p> -The dwarf format used by GCC 3 for storing debugging symbols is very inefficient. -Strip the binaries, don't compile with -g or compile with -gstabs. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Portability"></a>Chapter 37. Portability</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2995985">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998515">SCO Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998546">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998716">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2998760">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998767">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2998793">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2998800">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>Samba works on a wide range of platforms but the interface all the + script to make Samba fit into that system.</p></div></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Portability"></a>Chapter 37. Portability</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2942927">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943015">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943044">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943217">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943261">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943268">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943294">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943299">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p>Samba works on a wide range of platforms but the interface all the platforms provide is not always compatible. This chapter contains -platform-specific information about compiling and using samba.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995985"></a>HPUX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +platform-specific information about compiling and using samba.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2942927"></a>HPUX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> HP's implementation of supplementary groups is, er, non-standard (for hysterical reasons). There are two group files, <tt class="filename">/etc/group</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/logingroup</tt>; the system maps UIDs to numbers using the former, but @@ -16151,15 +15471,15 @@ allowed range. On HPUX you must use gcc or the HP ANSI compiler. The free compiler that comes with HP-UX is not ANSI compliant and cannot compile Samba. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2998515"></a>SCO Unix</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you run an old version of SCO Unix then you may need to get important +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943015"></a>SCO UNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you run an old version of SCO UNIX then you may need to get important TCP/IP patches for Samba to work correctly. Without the patch, you may encounter corrupt data transfers using samba. </p><p> The patch you need is UOD385 Connection Drivers SLS. It is available from SCO (<a href="ftp://ftp.sco.com/" target="_top">ftp.sco.com</a>, directory SLS, files uod385a.Z and uod385a.ltr.Z). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2998546"></a>DNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943044"></a>DNIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> DNIX has a problem with seteuid() and setegid(). These routines are needed for Samba to work correctly, but they were left out of the DNIX C library for some reason. @@ -16204,8 +15524,8 @@ _seteuid: </pre><p> after creating the above files you then assemble them using </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as seteuid.s</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as setegid.s</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as seteuid.s</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>as setegid.s</tt></b> </pre><p> that should produce the files <tt class="filename">seteuid.o</tt> and <tt class="filename">setegid.o</tt> @@ -16218,11 +15538,11 @@ LIBSM = setegid.o seteuid.o -ln You should then remove the line: </p><pre class="programlisting"> #define NO_EID -</pre><p>from the DNIX section of <tt class="filename">includes.h</tt></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2998716"></a>RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre><p>from the DNIX section of <tt class="filename">includes.h</tt></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943217"></a>RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> By default RedHat Rembrandt-II during installation adds an entry to <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> as follows: </p><pre class="programlisting"> - 127.0.0.1 loopback "hostname"."domainname" + 127.0.0.1 loopback "hostname"."domainname" </pre><p> </p><p> This causes Samba to loop back onto the loopback interface. @@ -16232,10 +15552,10 @@ is the master browse list holder and who is the master browser. </p><p> Corrective Action: Delete the entry after the word loopback in the line starting 127.0.0.1 -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2998760"></a>AIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2998767"></a>Sequential Read Ahead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943261"></a>AIX</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943268"></a>Sequential Read Ahead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Disabling Sequential Read Ahead using <b class="userinput"><tt>vmtune -r 0</tt></b> improves Samba performance significantly. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2998793"></a>Solaris</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2998800"></a>Locking improvements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Some people have been experiencing problems with F_SETLKW64/fcntl +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943294"></a>Solaris</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943299"></a>Locking improvements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Some people have been experiencing problems with F_SETLKW64/fcntl when running Samba on Solaris. The built in file locking mechanism was not scalable. Performance would degrade to the point where processes would get into loops of trying to lock a file. It would try a lock, then fail, @@ -16256,11 +15576,10 @@ and rebuild samba. Nsswitch on Solaris 9 refuses to use the winbind nss module. This behavior is fixed by Sun in patch 113476-05 which as of March 2003 is not in any roll-up packages. -</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Other-Clients"></a>Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jim</span> <span class="surname">McDonough</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">5 Mar 2001</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2998169">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999522">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2999529">How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999608">How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999670">How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2999766">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2999774">Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999864">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999894">Configure WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999940">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999970">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2999988">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3000034">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id3000107">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id3000131">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3000242">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></div><p>This chapter contains client-specific information.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2998169"></a>Macintosh clients?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Yes. <a href="http://www.thursby.com/" target="_top">Thursby</a> now has a CIFS Client / Server called <a href="http://www.thursby.com/products/dave.html" target="_top">DAVE</a> +</p></div></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Other-Clients"></a>Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jim</span> <span class="surname">McDonough</span></h3><span class="contrib">OS/2</span><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IBM<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">5 Mar 2001</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2943452">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943531">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943538">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943607">Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943660">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2943760">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2943768">Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943858">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943888">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943941">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943979">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2943996">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944042">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="#id2944116">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="#id2944140">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944326">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></div><p>This chapter contains client-specific information.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943452"></a>Macintosh clients?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Yes. <a href="http://www.thursby.com/" target="_top">Thursby</a> now has a CIFS Client / Server called <a href="http://www.thursby.com/products/dave.html" target="_top">DAVE</a> </p><p> They test it against Windows 95, Windows NT and samba for compatibility issues. At the time of writing, DAVE was at version @@ -16279,32 +15598,28 @@ What Samba offers MS Windows users, these packages offer to Macs. For more info on these packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see <a href="http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html" target="_top">http://www.eats.com/linux_mac_win.html</a> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999522"></a>OS2 Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999529"></a>How can I configure OS/2 Warp Connect or - OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>A more complete answer to this question can be - found on <a href="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/warp.html" target="_top"> - http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/samba/warp.html</a>.</p><p>Basically, you need three components:</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>The File and Print Client ('IBM Peer')</td></tr><tr><td>TCP/IP ('Internet support') </td></tr><tr><td>The "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver ('TCPBEUI')</td></tr></table><p>Installing the first two together with the base operating +</p><p>Newer versions of the Macintosh (Mac OS X) include Samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943531"></a>OS2 Client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943538"></a>Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Basically, you need three components:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The File and Print Client ('IBM Peer')</p></li><li><p>TCP/IP ('Internet support') </p></li><li><p>The "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver ('TCPBEUI')</p></li></ul></div><p>Installing the first two together with the base operating system on a blank system is explained in the Warp manual. If Warp has already been installed, but you now want to install the - networking support, use the "Selective Install for Networking" - object in the "System Setup" folder.</p><p>Adding the "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver is not described + networking support, use the "Selective Install for Networking" + object in the "System Setup" folder.</p><p>Adding the "NetBIOS over TCP/IP" driver is not described in the manual and just barely in the online documentation. Start - MPTS.EXE, click on OK, click on "Configure LAPS" and click - on "IBM OS/2 NETBIOS OVER TCP/IP" in 'Protocols'. This line + MPTS.EXE, click on OK, click on "Configure LAPS" and click + on "IBM OS/2 NETBIOS OVER TCP/IP" in 'Protocols'. This line is then moved to 'Current Configuration'. Select that line, - click on "Change number" and increase it from 0 to 1. Save this + click on "Change number" and increase it from 0 to 1. Save this configuration.</p><p>If the Samba server(s) is not on your local subnet, you can optionally add IP names and addresses of these servers - to the "Names List", or specify a WINS server ('NetBIOS + to the "Names List", or specify a WINS server ('NetBIOS Nameserver' in IBM and RFC terminology). For Warp Connect you may need to download an update for 'IBM Peer' to bring it on - the same level as Warp 4. See the webpage mentioned above.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999608"></a>How can I configure OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), - OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You can use the free Microsoft LAN Manager 2.2c Client + the same level as Warp 4. See the webpage mentioned above.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943607"></a>Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>You can use the free Microsoft LAN Manager 2.2c Client for OS/2 from <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/" target="_top"> ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/BusSys/Clients/LANMAN.OS2/</a>. - See <a href="http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/lanman.html" target="_top"> - http://carol.wins.uva.nl/~leeuw/lanman.html</a> for - more information on how to install and use this client. In + In a nutshell, edit the file \OS2VER in the root directory of the OS/2 boot partition and add the lines:</p><pre class="programlisting"> 20=setup.exe @@ -16315,14 +15630,12 @@ packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see or NS2000 driver from <a href="ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/" target="_top"> ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/pub/os2/network/ndis/</a> instead. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999670"></a>How do I get printer driver download working - for OS/2 clients?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>First, create a share called <i class="parameter"><tt>[PRINTDRV]</tt></i> that is + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943660"></a>Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>First, create a share called <i class="parameter"><tt>[PRINTDRV]</tt></i> that is world-readable. Copy your OS/2 driver files there. Note that the .EA_ files must still be separate, so you will need to use the original install files, and not copy an installed driver from an OS/2 system.</p><p>Install the NT driver first for that printer. Then, - add to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> a parameter, <i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map = - <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i></tt></i>. Then, in the file + add to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> a parameter, <a class="indexterm" name="id2943694"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i> = filename. Then, in the file specified by <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i>, map the name of the NT driver name to the OS/2 driver name as follows:</p><p><i class="parameter"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>nt driver name</tt></i> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>os2 driver name</tt></i>.<i class="replaceable"><tt>device name</tt></i></tt></i>, e.g.:</p><p><i class="parameter"><tt> @@ -16332,7 +15645,7 @@ packages, Samba, and Linux (and other UNIX-based systems) see you the driver is not available. On the second attempt, it will work. This is fixed simply by adding the device name to the mapping, after which it will work on the first attempt. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999766"></a>Windows for Workgroups</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999774"></a>Use latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use the latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft if you use Windows + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943760"></a>Windows for Workgroups</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943768"></a>Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Use the latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft if you use Windows for Workgroups. </p><p>The early TCP/IP stacks had lots of bugs.</p><p> Microsoft has released an incremental upgrade to their TCP/IP 32-Bit @@ -16347,7 +15660,7 @@ fixed. New files include <tt class="filename">WINSOCK.DLL</tt>, <tt class="filename">TRACERT.EXE</tt>, <tt class="filename">NETSTAT.EXE</tt>, and <tt class="filename">NBTSTAT.EXE</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999864"></a>Delete .pwl files after password change</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943858"></a>Delete .pwl files after password change</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> WfWg does a lousy job with passwords. I find that if I change my password on either the unix box or the PC the safest thing to do is to delete the .pwl files in the windows directory. The PC will complain about not finding the files, but will soon get over it, allowing you to enter the new password. @@ -16356,20 +15669,20 @@ If you don't do this you may find that WfWg remembers and uses the old password, even if you told it a new one. </p><p> Often WfWg will totally ignore a password you give it in a dialog box. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999894"></a>Configure WfW password handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943888"></a>Configuring WfW password handling</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is a program call admincfg.exe on the last disk (disk 8) of the WFW 3.11 disk set. To install it type <b class="userinput"><tt>EXPAND A:\ADMINCFG.EX_ C:\WINDOWS\ADMINCFG.EXE</tt></b>. Then add an icon for it via the <span class="application">Program Manager</span> <span class="guimenu">New</span> Menu. This program allows you to control how WFW handles passwords. ie disable Password Caching etc -for use with <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999940"></a>Case handling of passwords</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows for Workgroups uppercases the password before sending it to the server. Unix passwords can be case-sensitive though. Check the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">smb.conf(5)</a> information on <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> to specify what characters samba should try to uppercase when checking.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999970"></a>Use TCP/IP as default protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To support print queue reporting you may find +for use with <a class="indexterm" name="id2943925"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943941"></a>Case handling of passwords</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows for Workgroups uppercases the password before sending it to the server. Unix passwords can be case-sensitive though. Check the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> information on <a class="indexterm" name="id2943961"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> to specify what characters samba should try to uppercase when checking.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943979"></a>Use TCP/IP as default protocol</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To support print queue reporting you may find that you have to use TCP/IP as the default protocol under WfWg. For some reason if you leave NetBEUI as the default it may break the print queue reporting on some systems. -It is presumably a WfWg bug.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999988"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Note that some people have found that setting <i class="parameter"><tt>DefaultRcvWindow</tt></i> in +It is presumably a WfWg bug.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943996"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Note that some people have found that setting <i class="parameter"><tt>DefaultRcvWindow</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[MSTCP]</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">SYSTEM.INI</tt> file under WfWg to 3072 gives a big improvement. I don't know why. @@ -16379,7 +15692,7 @@ performance with a large value (16384 or larger). Other people have reported that anything over 3072 slows things down enormously. One person even reported a speed drop of a factor of 30 when he went from 3072 to 8192. I don't know why. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3000034"></a>Windows '95/'98</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944042"></a>Windows '95/'98</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When using Windows 95 OEM SR2 the following updates are recommended where Samba is being used. Please NOTE that the above change will affect you once these updates have been installed. @@ -16393,11 +15706,11 @@ install the <b class="command">OLEUPD.EXE</b> fix. This fix may stop your machine from hanging for an extended period when exiting Outlook and you may also notice a significant speedup when accessing network neighborhood services. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000107"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944116"></a>Speed improvement</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Configure the win95 TCPIP registry settings to give better performance. I use a program called <b class="command">MTUSPEED.exe</b> which I got off the net. There are various other utilities of this type freely available. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3000131"></a>Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944140"></a>Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are several annoyances with Windows 2000 SP2. One of which only appears when using a Samba server to host user profiles to Windows 2000 SP2 clients in a Windows domain. This assumes @@ -16406,26 +15719,19 @@ likely occur if it is not. </p><p> In order to serve profiles successfully to Windows 2000 SP2 clients (when not operating as a PDC), Samba must have -<i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support = no</tt></i> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944161"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> = no added to the file share which houses the roaming profiles. If this is not done, then the Windows 2000 SP2 client will complain about not being able to access the profile (Access Denied) and create multiple copies of it on disk (DOMAIN.user.001, DOMAIN.user.002, etc...). See the -<a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top">smb.conf(5)</a> man page +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more details on this option. Also note that the -<i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter was formally a global parameter in +<a class="indexterm" name="id2944189"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter was formally a global parameter in releases prior to Samba 2.2.2. </p><p> The following is a minimal profile share: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - [profile] - path = /export/profile - create mask = 0600 - directory mask = 0700 - nt acl support = no - read only = no -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2944212"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 38.1. Minimal profile share</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[profile]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export/profile</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask = 0600</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask = 0700</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> The reason for this bug is that the Win2k SP2 client copies the security descriptor for the profile which contains the Samba server's SID, and not the domain SID. The client @@ -16433,15 +15739,15 @@ compares the SID for SAMBA\user and realizes it is different that the one assigned to DOMAIN\user. Hence the reason for the <span class="errorname">access denied</span> message. </p><p> -By disabling the <i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter, Samba will send +By disabling the <a class="indexterm" name="id2944292"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i> parameter, Samba will send the Win2k client a response to the QuerySecurityDescriptor trans2 call which causes the client to set a default ACL for the profile. This default ACL includes -</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DOMAIN\user "Full Control"</em></span>></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This bug does not occur when using winbind to -create accounts on the Samba host for Domain users.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3000242"></a>Windows NT 3.1</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>If you have problems communicating across routers with Windows -NT 3.1 workstations, read <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;%5BLN%5D;Q103765" target="_top">this Microsoft Knowledge Base article</a>. +</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DOMAIN\user "Full Control"</em></span>></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This bug does not occur when using winbind to +create accounts on the Samba host for Domain users.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944326"></a>Windows NT 3.1</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>If you have problems communicating across routers with Windows +NT 3.1 workstations, read <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;Q103765" target="_top">this Microsoft Knowledge Base article</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="speed"></a>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Cochrane</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Dundee Limb Fitting Centre<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id3001274">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001319">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001394">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001437">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001490">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001513">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001570">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001612">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001633">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001658">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3001692">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001274"></a>Comparisons</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="speed"></a>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Cochrane</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Dundee Limb Fitting Centre<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2944458">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944501">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944592">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944641">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944701">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944732">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944816">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944879">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944908">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944932">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2944965">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944458"></a>Comparisons</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Samba server uses TCP to talk to the client. Thus if you are trying to see if it performs well you should really compare it to programs that use the same protocol. The most readily available @@ -16463,14 +15769,14 @@ suspect the biggest factor is not Samba vs some other system but the hardware and drivers used on the various systems. Given similar hardware Samba should certainly be competitive in speed with other systems. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001319"></a>Socket options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944501"></a>Socket options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of socket options that can greatly affect the performance of a TCP based server like Samba. </p><p> The socket options that Samba uses are settable both on the command line with the <tt class="option">-O</tt> option, or in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page describes how +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2944535"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page describes how to set these and gives recommendations. </p><p> Getting the socket options right can make a big difference to your @@ -16479,11 +15785,11 @@ much. The correct settings are very dependent on your local network. </p><p> The socket option TCP_NODELAY is the one that seems to make the biggest single difference for most networks. Many people report that -adding <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options = TCP_NODELAY</tt></i> doubles the read +adding <a class="indexterm" name="id2944572"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> = TCP_NODELAY doubles the read performance of a Samba drive. The best explanation I have seen for this is that the Microsoft TCP/IP stack is slow in sending tcp ACKs. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001394"></a>Read size</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The option <i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i> affects the overlap of disk +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944592"></a>Read size</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The option <a class="indexterm" name="id2944601"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i> affects the overlap of disk reads/writes with network reads/writes. If the amount of data being transferred in several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and SMBreadbraw) is larger than this value then the server begins writing @@ -16499,10 +15805,10 @@ The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely that the best value will vary greatly between systems anyway. A value over 65536 is pointless and will cause you to allocate memory unnecessarily. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001437"></a>Max xmit</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -At startup the client and server negotiate a <i class="parameter"><tt>maximum transmit</tt></i> size, +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944641"></a>Max xmit</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + At startup the client and server negotiate a <i class="parameter"><tt>maximum transmit</tt></i> size, which limits the size of nearly all SMB commands. You can set the -maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit = </tt></i> option +maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2944662"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Note that this is the maximum size of SMB requests that Samba will accept, but not the maximum size that the *client* will accept. The client maximum receive size is sent to Samba by the client and Samba @@ -16513,41 +15819,41 @@ clients may perform better with a smaller transmit unit. Trying values of less than 2048 is likely to cause severe problems. </p><p> In most cases the default is the best option. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001490"></a>Log level</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you set the log level (also known as <i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i>) higher than 2 +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944701"></a>Log level</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you set the log level (also known as <a class="indexterm" name="id2944711"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i>) higher than 2 then you may suffer a large drop in performance. This is because the server flushes the log file after each operation, which can be very expensive. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001513"></a>Read raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944732"></a>Read raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2944742"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency file read operation. A server may choose to not support it, -however. and Samba makes support for <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> optional, with it +however. and Samba makes support for <a class="indexterm" name="id2944758"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> optional, with it being enabled by default. </p><p> -In some cases clients don't handle <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> very well and actually +In some cases clients don't handle <a class="indexterm" name="id2944776"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> very well and actually get lower performance using it than they get using the conventional read operations. </p><p> -So you might like to try <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw = no</tt></i> and see what happens on your +So you might like to try <a class="indexterm" name="id2944797"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> = no and see what happens on your network. It might lower, raise or not affect your performance. Only testing can really tell. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001570"></a>Write raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944816"></a>Write raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2944826"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency file write operation. A server may choose to not support it, -however. and Samba makes support for <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> optional, with it +however. and Samba makes support for <a class="indexterm" name="id2944843"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> optional, with it being enabled by default. </p><p> -Some machines may find <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> slower than normal write, in which +Some machines may find <a class="indexterm" name="id2944861"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> slower than normal write, in which case you may wish to change this option. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001612"></a>Slow Logins</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944879"></a>Slow Logins</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Slow logins are almost always due to the password checking time. Using -the lowest practical <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> will improve things. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001633"></a>Client tuning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +the lowest practical <a class="indexterm" name="id2944890"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> will improve things. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944908"></a>Client tuning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Often a speed problem can be traced to the client. The client (for example Windows for Workgroups) can often be tuned for better TCP performance. Check the sections on the various clients in <a href="#Other-Clients" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients">Samba and Other Clients</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001658"></a>Samba performance problem due changing kernel</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944932"></a>Samba performance problem due changing kernel</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Hi everyone. I am running Gentoo on my server and samba 2.2.8a. Recently I changed kernel version from linux-2.4.19-gentoo-r10 to linux-2.4.20-wolk4.0s. And now I have performance issue with samba. Ok @@ -16562,7 +15868,7 @@ Grab mii-tool and check the duplex settings on the NIC. My guess is that it is a link layer issue, not an application layer problem. Also run ifconfig and verify that the framing error, collisions, etc... look normal for ethernet. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001692"></a>Corrupt tdb Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944965"></a>Corrupt tdb Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Well today it happened, Our first major problem using samba. Our samba PDC server has been hosting 3 TB of data to our 500+ users [Windows NT/XP] for the last 3 years using samba, no problem. @@ -16580,12 +15886,12 @@ Q2) What I also would like to mention is that the service latency seems a lot lower then before the locks cleanup, any ideas on keeping it top notch? </p><p> A2) Yes! Same answer as for Q1! -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="DNSDHCP"></a>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id3001112">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001112"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="DNSDHCP"></a>Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2945070">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945070"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Further-Resources"></a>Chapter 41. Further Resources</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Lechnyr</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Unofficial HOWTO<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com">david@lechnyr.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 1, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id3001272">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3002922">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="#id3002990">Books</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001272"></a>Websites</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> +</p></div></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="Further-Resources"></a>Chapter 41. Further Resources</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 1, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="#id2945137">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="#id2945545">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945137"></a>Websites</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <a href="http://hr.uoregon.edu/davidrl/cifs.txt" target="_top"> - <span class="emphasis"><em>CIFS: Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny</em></span> by "Hobbit"</a> + <span class="emphasis"><em>CIFS: Common Insecurities Fail Scrutiny</em></span> by "Hobbit"</a> </p></li><li><p> <a href="http://afr.com/it/2002/10/01/FFXDF43AP6D.html" target="_top"> <span class="emphasis"><em>Doing the Samba on Windows</em></span> by Financial Review @@ -16608,7 +15914,7 @@ It is planned for the published release of this document. </a> </p></li><li><p> <a href="http://www.phrack.org/phrack/60/p60-0x0b.txt" target="_top"> - <span class="emphasis"><em>SMB/CIFS by The Root</em></span> by "ledin" + <span class="emphasis"><em>SMB/CIFS by The Root</em></span> by "ledin" </a> </p></li><li><p> <a href="http://www.linux-mag.com/1999-09/samba_01.html" target="_top"> @@ -16670,7 +15976,12 @@ It is planned for the published release of this document. <span class="emphasis"><em>WFWG: Password Caching and How It Affects LAN Manager Security</em></span> at Microsoft Knowledge Base </a> - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3002922"></a>Related updates from Microsoft</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + </p></li><li><p> + <a href="http://www2.sphaero.org/docs/#W2K" target="_top"> + <span class="emphasis"><em>W2K Samba deploy HOWTO</em></span> + by Arnaud Loonstra + </a> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2945545"></a>Related updates from Microsoft</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q92/5/88.asp" target="_top"> <span class="emphasis"><em>Enhanced Encryption for Windows 95 Password Cache</em></span> </a> @@ -16682,4 +15993,42 @@ It is planned for the published release of this document. <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/support/kb/articles/q136/4/18.asp" target="_top"> <span class="emphasis"><em>Windows for Workgroups Sharing Updates</em></span> </a> - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3002990"></a>Books</h2></div></div><div></div></div></div></div></div><div class="index"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id3001039"></a>Index</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="index"></div></div></div></body></html> + </p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="index"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2945614"></a>Index</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="index"><div class="indexdiv"><h3>Symbols</h3><dl><dt>"Domain Admins" group, <a href="#id2885202">Discussion</a></dt><dt>"Domain Users" group, <a href="#id2885768">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt><dt>"Printers" folder, <a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a>, <a href="#id2913497">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>"raw" printing, <a href="#id2905999">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>/etc/host.conf, <a href="#id2932499">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt>/etc/hosts, <a href="#id2932315">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt>/etc/nsswitch.conf, <a href="#id2932551">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt><dt>8.3</dt><dd><dl><dt>file names, <a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>A</h3><dl><dt>ACLs, <a href="#AccessControls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dt>Active Directory, <a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>add group script, <a href="#id2885674">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt>add machine script, <a href="#id2871029">The machine trust account not accessible</a>, <a href="#id2874764">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt>add printer command, <a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>add printer wizard, <a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt><dt>add user script, <a href="#id2880966">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt>addprinter command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>admin users, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889969">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt>Administrator, <a href="#id2885202">Discussion</a></dt><dt>ADS (see Active Directory)</dt><dt>ads server, <a href="#id2874178">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt>application/cups.vnd-postscript, <a href="#id2912629">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt>application/octet-stream, <a href="#id2906119">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a>, <a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a>, <a href="#id2909312">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt>application/pdf, <a href="#id2907545">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt>application/postscript, <a href="#id2912629">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt>application/vnd.cups-raster, <a href="#id2909544">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt>application/vnd.cups-raw, <a href="#id2906119">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt>auth methods, <a href="#id2884738">auth methods does not work</a>, <a href="#id2935529">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>B</h3><dl><dt>bind interfaces only, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>brlock.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>browse list, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#id2878986">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dt>browseable, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>C</h3><dl><dt>case sensitive, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="#id2926538">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>chpass, <a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>comment, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt>configure, <a href="#id2942063">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dt>connections.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>core files, <a href="#id2941215">Internal errors</a></dt><dt>create mask, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>csc policy, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>CUPS</dt><dd><dl><dt>Page Accounting, <a href="#id2917602">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dt>quotas, <a href="#id2917645">Setting up Quotas</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>CUPS-PPD, <a href="#id2916653">cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</a></dt><dt>cupsaddsmb, <a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a>, <a href="#id2911524">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a>, <a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a>, <a href="#id2912835">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="#id2912958">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a>, <a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="#id2913349">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a>, <a href="#id2913427">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt>cupsomatic, <a href="#id2907241">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a>, <a href="#id2907370">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="#id2909039">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a>, <a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a>, <a href="#id2916653">cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</a></dt><dt>CVS, <a href="#id2941554">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>web, <a href="#id2941616">Access via CVSweb</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>D</h3><dl><dt>daemon, <a href="#id2942763">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt><dt>DDK, <a href="#id2911445">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a>, <a href="#id2911845">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt>debug, <a href="#id2941215">Internal errors</a></dt><dt>debug level, <a href="#id2940082">Debugging with Samba itself</a>, <a href="#id2944701">Log level</a></dt><dt>debuglevel, <a href="#id2941006">Debug levels</a></dt><dt>default case, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>delete printer command, <a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>deleteprinter command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>DHCP, <a href="#id2932188">Background Information</a></dt><dt>diff, <a href="#id2941395">Patches</a></dt><dt>directory mask, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>directory security mask, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>disable spoolss, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>display charset, <a href="#id2933835">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt>DNS, <a href="#id2876469">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a>, <a href="#id2933266">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>Active Directory, <a href="#id2876635">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt><dt>Dynamic, <a href="#id2932188">Background Information</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>dns proxy, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>domain admin group, <a href="#groupmapping">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dt>domain logons, <a href="#id2869309">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt><dt>domain master, <a href="#id2870253">Domain Network Logon Service</a>, <a href="#id2871968">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#id2877716">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt>dont descend, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>dos charset, <a href="#id2933835">Samba and charsets</a>, <a href="#id2933992">Japanese charsets</a>, <a href="#id2934137">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt><dt>dos filemode, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>dos filetime resolution, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>dos filetimes, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>E</h3><dl><dt>EMF, <a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="#id2910577">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a>, <a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>encrypt passwords, <a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="#id2881758">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a>, <a href="#id2931283">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>enhanced browsing, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>enumports command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2903854">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt>EPM (see ESP meta packager)</dt><dt>ESC/P, <a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>ESP</dt><dd><dl><dt>Ghostscript, <a href="#id2907370">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt>meta packager, <a href="#id2911845">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt>Print Pro, <a href="#id2910331">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a>, <a href="#id2912301">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Extended Attributes, <a href="#AccessControls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>F</h3><dl><dt>fake oplocks, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>File System, <a href="#id2886154">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dt>foomatic, <a href="#id2907241">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a>, <a href="#id2907370">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="#id2909039">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a>, <a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a>, <a href="#id2916436">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a>, <a href="#id2916577">Foomatic's strange Name</a></dt><dt>foomatic-rip, <a href="#id2909807">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a>, <a href="#id2916297">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a>, <a href="#id2916436">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a>, <a href="#id2916817">The Grand Unification +achieved...</a></dt><dt>force create mode, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force directory mode, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force directory security mode, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force group, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>force security mode, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force user, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889969">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a>, <a href="#id2890942">Beware of Force User</a></dt><dt>ftp, <a href="#id2941849">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>G</h3><dl><dt>gdb, <a href="#id2941215">Internal errors</a></dt><dt>GDI, <a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="#id2910577">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a>, <a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>GhostScript, <a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="#id2907029">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also PostScript)</dt></dl></dd><dt>Ghostscript</dt><dd><dl><dt>ESP (see ESP GhostScript)</dt></dl></dd><dt>GID, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>GPG, <a href="#id2941913">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt>groupadd, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>groupdel, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>groups</dt><dd><dl><dt>domain, <a href="#id2885202">Discussion</a></dt><dt>mapping, <a href="#groupmapping">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dt>nested, <a href="#id2885742">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>guest account, <a href="#id2879168">Problem resolution</a>, <a href="#id2879979">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a>, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt>guest ok, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>H</h3><dl><dt>hide dot files, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>hide files, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>hide unreadable, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>hide unwriteable files, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>host msdfs, <a href="#id2894231">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>hosts allow, <a href="#id2892490">Using host based protection</a>, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>hosts deny, <a href="#id2892490">Using host based protection</a>, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>I</h3><dl><dt>idmap gid, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="#id2931926">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt><dt>idmap uid, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="#id2931926">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt><dt>ifconfig, <a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>imprints, <a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt><dt>inetd, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a>, <a href="#id2942409">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a>, <a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>Interdomain Trusts, <a href="#InterdomainTrusts">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>completing, <a href="#id2893500">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt>creating, <a href="#id2893400">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dt>Facilities, <a href="#id2893547">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>interfaces, <a href="#id2877911">Multiple interfaces</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a>, <a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>invalid users, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>IPP, <a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>K</h3><dl><dt>KDC, <a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>Kerberos, <a href="#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>kinit, <a href="#id2874307">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>L</h3><dl><dt>ldap admin dn, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap delete dn, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap filter, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap machine suffix, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap passwd sync, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="#id2883609">Password synchronisation</a></dt><dt>ldap ssl, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="#id2882943">Security and sambaSamAccount</a></dt><dt>ldap suffix, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap trust ids, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap user suffix, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>libnss_wins.so, <a href="#id2932551">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt><dt>Links</dt><dd><dl><dt>hard, <a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>soft, <a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Linuxprinting.org, <a href="#id2916297">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dt>lm announce, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>lm interval, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>LMB (see Local Master Browser)</dt><dt>LMHOSTS, <a href="#id2932985">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt>load printers, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2895606">A little Experiment to warn you</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>local master, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt>Local Master Browser, <a href="#id2877946">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt>locking, <a href="#id2890336">Discussion</a></dt><dt>locking.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>log files</dt><dd><dl><dt>monitoring, <a href="#id2938359">Assumptions</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>log level, <a href="#id2874764">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a>, <a href="#id2920835">extd_audit</a>, <a href="#id2941006">Debug levels</a></dt><dt>logon drive, <a href="#id2927080">Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt>logon home, <a href="#id2883102">LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a>, <a href="#id2926161">Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</a>, <a href="#id2926293">Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</a>, <a href="#id2927080">Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="#id2927776">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt>logon path, <a href="#id2883102">LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a>, <a href="#id2926293">Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</a>, <a href="#id2926538">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a>, <a href="#id2927080">Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="#id2927776">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt>logon script, <a href="#id2883102">LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a></dt><dt>lpadmin, <a href="#id2916297">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a>, <a href="#id2917645">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt>lppause command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lpq cache time, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>lpq command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lpresume command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lprm command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lpstat, <a href="#id2915566">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>M</h3><dl><dt>MAC Addresses, <a href="#id2932315">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt>machine trust accounts, <a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>creating, <a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>make, <a href="#id2942063">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dt>mangling method, <a href="#id2933992">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt>map to guest, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a>, <a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a>, <a href="#id2919497">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a>, <a href="#id2919582">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt>max print jobs, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>max xmit, <a href="#id2944641">Max xmit</a></dt><dt>messages.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>MIME, <a href="#id2907545">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a>, <a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a>, <a href="#id2907903">Filter Requirements</a>, <a href="#id2909312">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt>min print space, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>msdfs root, <a href="#id2894231">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>N</h3><dl><dt>name resolve order, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>nbtstat, <a href="#id2932922">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt>NetBIOS, <a href="#id2875816">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="#id2876469">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a>, <a href="#integrate-ms-networks">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a>, <a href="#id2932655">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dt>NetBIOS-less, <a href="#id2876469">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt>nmblookup, <a href="#id2932922">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt>nt acl support, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2888523">Viewing file ownership</a>, <a href="#id2888655">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a>, <a href="#id2888889">Modifying file or directory permissions</a>, <a href="#id2944140">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt>ntdrivers.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>ntforms.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>NTFS, <a href="#id2886154">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dt>ntprinters.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>O</h3><dl><dt>obey pam restrictions, <a href="#id2931283">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt>only user, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2892992">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt><dt>oplock break wait time, <a href="#id2891044">Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</a>, <a href="#id2891378">Disabling Kernel OpLocks</a></dt><dt>oplock contention limit, <a href="#id2891044">Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</a></dt><dt>os level, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a>, <a href="#id2877309">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a>, <a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a>, <a href="#id2877716">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt>os2 driver map, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2943660">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>P</h3><dl><dt>page_log, <a href="#id2917829">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt>passdb backend, <a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="#passdb">Account Information Databases</a>, <a href="#id2880590">Technical Information</a>, <a href="#id2881423">The pdbedit Command</a>, <a href="#id2882509">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="#id2883816">Configuring</a>, <a href="#id2884582">Users can not logon</a>, <a href="#id2884738">auth methods does not work</a>, <a href="#id2935529">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt>password level, <a href="#id2868158">Password checking</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a>, <a href="#id2943941">Case handling of passwords</a>, <a href="#id2944879">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt>password server, <a href="#id2867877">Server Security (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="#id2870678">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>patch, <a href="#id2941395">Patches</a></dt><dt>path, <a href="#id2866630">"The network name cannot be found"</a>, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897534">Print Commands</a>, <a href="#id2899004">Creating the [print$] Share</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899475">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a>, <a href="#id2911043">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a>, <a href="#id2918267">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a>, <a href="#id2920175">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>PCL, <a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a>, <a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a>, <a href="#id2911125">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dt>PDF, <a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="#id2907154">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt>pdf, <a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>PDL, <a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt>PJL, <a href="#id2911125">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a>, <a href="#id2912629">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a>, <a href="#id2917748">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>point and print, <a href="#id2906051">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a>, <a href="#id2906306">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a>, <a href="#id2909039">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a>, <a href="#id2912835">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="#id2913497">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>PostScript, <a href="#id2906432">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a>, <a href="#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a>, <a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="#id2908080">Prefilters</a>, <a href="#id2910701">Driver Execution on the Server</a>, <a href="#id2911125">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a>, <a href="#id2911400">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a>, <a href="#id2911845">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also Ghostscript)</dt><dt>RIP, <a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>PPD, <a href="#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="#id2907154">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a>, <a href="#id2909544">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a>, <a href="#id2911206">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a>, <a href="#id2911255">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a>, <a href="#id2911400">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a>, <a href="#id2913497">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>CUPS (see CUPS-PPD)</dt></dl></dd><dt>preferred master, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a>, <a href="#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a>, <a href="#id2877716">Making Samba the domain master</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>preserve case, <a href="#id2926538">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>print command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897592">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a>, <a href="#id2898261">Setting up your own Print Commands</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a>, <a href="#id2918564">Manual Configuration</a></dt><dt>print ok , <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>printable, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>printcap, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2897592">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a>, <a href="#id2905074">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2905584">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a>, <a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>printcap name, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>printer, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>printer admin, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899736">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a>, <a href="#id2901839">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a>, <a href="#id2902231">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a>, <a href="#id2902431">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a>, <a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a>, <a href="#id2905584">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a>, <a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="#id2919794">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt>printer name, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>printing, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897592">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a>, <a href="#id2898261">Setting up your own Print Commands</a>, <a href="#id2905074">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="#id2905584">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a>, <a href="#id2910833">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="#id2918407">Pre-conditions</a>, <a href="#id2918564">Manual Configuration</a></dt><dt>printing.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>PrintPro (see ESP Print Pro)</dt><dt>public, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>Q</h3><dl><dt>queue resume command, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt>queuepause command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2905167">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt>queueresume command, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>R</h3><dl><dt>read list, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>read only, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt>read raw, <a href="#id2944732">Read raw</a></dt><dt>read size, <a href="#id2944592">Read size</a></dt><dt>remote announce, <a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="#id2876781">How Browsing Functions</a>, <a href="#id2877946">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a>, <a href="#id2879046">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt>remote browse sync, <a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="#id2876781">How Browsing Functions</a>, <a href="#id2878104">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt><dt>root preexec, <a href="#id2936350">Logon Scripts</a></dt><dt>rpcclient</dt><dd><dl><dt>adddriver, <a href="#id2912958">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a>, <a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="#id2914086">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a>, <a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>enumdrivers, <a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>enumports, <a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dt>enumprinters, <a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a>, <a href="#id2915566">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt><dt>getdriver, <a href="#id2914186">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>getprinter, <a href="#id2914186">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a>, <a href="#id2915566">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt><dt>setdriver, <a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a>, <a href="#id2912958">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a>, <a href="#id2913117">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="#id2913780">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="#id2914333">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="#id2914542">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>rsync, <a href="#id2941849">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>S</h3><dl><dt>secrets.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>security, <a href="#id2867124">Samba Security Modes</a>, <a href="#id2867518">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="#id2867877">Server Security (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="#id2868387">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a>, <a href="#id2868427">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a>, <a href="#id2868463">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a>, <a href="#id2868503">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a>, <a href="#id2869309">Preparing for Domain Control</a>, <a href="#id2870678">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="#id2873995">Why is this better than security = server?</a>, <a href="#id2874178">Setup your smb.conf</a>, <a href="#id2912835">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="#id2919061">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a>, <a href="#id2935529">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a>, <a href="#id2943888">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt>security mask, <a href="#id2887260">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2889049">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>Server Manager, <a href="#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>sessionid.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>share_info.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>short preserve case, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="#id2926538">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>Short-Cuts, <a href="#id2886190">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>show add printer wizard, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="#id2903177">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>SID, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>Single Sign On, <a href="#id2912362">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt>smbclient, <a href="#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>socket options, <a href="#id2944501">Socket options</a></dt><dt>spooling</dt><dd><dl><dt>central, <a href="#id2905949">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt>peer-to-peer, <a href="#id2905949">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>spooling-only, <a href="#id2905999">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>strict locking, <a href="#id2890336">Discussion</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>T</h3><dl><dt>TDB, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a>, <a href="#id2915962">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>backing up (see tdbbackup)</dt></dl></dd><dt>tdbbackup, <a href="#id2916162">Using tdbbackup</a></dt><dt>template homedir, <a href="#id2923568">Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</a></dt><dt>testparm, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>text/plain, <a href="#id2907752">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>total print jobs, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>U</h3><dl><dt>UDP, <a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt>UID, <a href="#id2884967">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>unexpected.tdb, <a href="#id2915718">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>unix charset, <a href="#id2933835">Samba and charsets</a>, <a href="#id2933992">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt>use client driver, <a href="#id2894888">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="#id2896282">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>user, <a href="#id2867382">Share Level Security</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>User Manager, <a href="#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a>, <a href="#id2893918">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt>useradd, <a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>username, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>username level, <a href="#id2868158">Password checking</a></dt><dt>username map, <a href="#id2873360">Windows 200x XP Professional</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>V</h3><dl><dt>valid users, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2938586">The tests</a></dt><dt>veto files, <a href="#id2887639">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>vfs objects, <a href="#id2920556">Discussion</a></dt><dt>vipw, <a href="#id2872769">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>W</h3><dl><dt>winbind separator, <a href="#id2922889">Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</a></dt><dt>WINS, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#id2876233">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="#id2933298">WINS Lookup</a></dt><dt>wins hook, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>wins proxy, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>wins server, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#id2878182">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a>, <a href="#id2878371">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt>wins support, <a href="#id2875904">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="#id2878182">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a>, <a href="#id2878371">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt>workgroup, <a href="#id2870678">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="#id2873558">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="#id2879046">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt>write list, <a href="#id2886837">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="#id2899189">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt>write raw, <a href="#id2944816">Write raw</a></dt><dt>writeable, <a href="#id2896767">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="#id2897210">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>WYSIWYG, <a href="#id2906600">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>X</h3><dl><dt>X Window System, <a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt>xinetd, <a href="#id2942516">Starting from inetd.conf</a> (see inetd)</dt><dt>Xprint, <a href="#id2906741">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt></dl></div></div></div></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html b/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html index ba82f6ad0f..39ab6b91d8 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/SambaHA.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques"><link rel="next" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 29. High Availability Options</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Backup.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="migration.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SambaHA"></a>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id3003099">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3003099"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques"><link rel="next" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 29. High Availability Options</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Backup.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="migration.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="SambaHA"></a>Chapter 29. High Availability Options</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id2953955">Note</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953955"></a>Note</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This chapter did not make it into this release. It is planned for the published release of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Backup.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="migration.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part IV. Migration and Updating</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Backup.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="migration.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part IV. Migration and Updating</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html b/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html index 01f03662ae..7b5b7117a6 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ServerType.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="next" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="type.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-pdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ServerType"></a>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888767">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888862">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888947">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889062">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889195">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889317">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889568">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889655">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889880">Seamless Windows Network Integration</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890056">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890084">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890117">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890146">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890179">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="next" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="type.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-pdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="ServerType"></a>Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2884977">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885071">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885157">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885276">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885414">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885551">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885808">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885909">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886191">Password checking</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886386">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886414">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886453">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886490">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886529">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This chapter provides information regarding the types of server that Samba may be configured to be. A Microsoft network administrator who wishes to migrate to or to use Samba will want to know what, within a Samba context, terms familiar to MS Windows @@ -8,10 +8,11 @@ modes function BEFORE we get into the details of how to configure the server its The chapter provides an overview of the security modes of which Samba is capable and how these relate to MS Windows servers and clients. </p><p> -Firstly we should recognise the question so often asked, "Why would I want to use Samba?" -So, in those chapters where the answer may be important you will see a section that highlights -features and benefits. These may be for or against Samba. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888767"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A question often asked is, "Why would I want to use Samba?" Most chapters contain a section +that highlights features and benefits. We hope that the information provided will help to +answer this question. Be warned though, we want to be fair and reasonable, so not all +features are positive towards Samba so the benefit may be on the side of our competition. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884977"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Two men were walking down a dusty road, when one suddenly kicked up a small red stone. It hurt his toe and lodged in his sandal. He took the stone out and cursed it with a passion and fury fitting his anguish. The other looked at the stone and said, that is a garnet - I @@ -23,7 +24,7 @@ pleasure, but if you are forced upon it and have no time for its secrets then it a source of discomfort. </p><p> Samba started out as a project that sought to provide interoperability for MS Windows 3.x -clients with a Unix server. It has grown up a lot since its humble beginnings and now provides +clients with a UNIX server. It has grown up a lot since its humble beginnings and now provides features and functionality fit for large scale deployment. It also has some warts. In sections like this one we will tell of both. </p><p> @@ -47,14 +48,14 @@ So now, what are the benefits of features mentioned in this chapter? greater flexibility than MS Windows NT4 and in many cases a significantly higher utility than Active Directory domains with MS Windows 200x. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888862"></a>Server Types</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Administrators of Microsoft networks often refer to three -different type of servers:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Domain Controller</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Primary Domain Controller</td></tr><tr><td>Backup Domain Controller</td></tr><tr><td>ADS Domain Controller</td></tr></table></li><li><p>Domain Member Server</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Active Directory Member Server</td></tr><tr><td>NT4 Style Domain Member Server</td></tr></table></li><li><p>Stand Alone Server</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885071"></a>Server Types</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Administrators of Microsoft networks often refer to three +different type of servers:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Domain Controller</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div></li><li><p>Domain Member Server</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>Active Directory Domain Server</p></li><li><p>NT4 Style Domain Domain Server</p></li></ul></div></li><li><p>Stand Alone Server</p></li></ul></div><p> The chapters covering Domain Control, Backup Domain Control and Domain Membership provide -pertinent information regarding Samba-3 configuration for each of these server roles. +pertinent information regarding Samba configuration for each of these server roles. The reader is strongly encouraged to become intimately familiar with the information presented. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888947"></a>Samba Security Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In this section the function and purpose of Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2885157"></a>Samba Security Modes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +In this section the function and purpose of Samba's <a class="indexterm" name="id2885168"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> modes are described. An accurate understanding of how Samba implements each security mode as well as how to configure MS Windows clients for each mode will significantly reduce user complaints and administrator heartache. @@ -69,7 +70,7 @@ ways that allow the security levels to be implemented. In actual fact, Samba imp <span class="emphasis"><em>ADS</em></span>, and <span class="emphasis"><em>SERVER</em></span> modes. They are documented in this chapter. </p><p> -A SMB server tells the client at startup what <i class="parameter"><tt>security level</tt></i> + A SMB server tells the client at startup what <span class="emphasis"><em>security level</em></span> it is running. There are two options: <span class="emphasis"><em>share level</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>user level</em></span>. Which of these two the client receives affects the way the client then tries to authenticate itself. It does not directly affect @@ -77,8 +78,8 @@ the way the client then tries to authenticate itself. It does not directly affec but it fits in with the client/server approach of SMB. In SMB everything is initiated and controlled by the client, and the server can only tell the client what is available and whether an action is allowed. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889062"></a>User Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -We will describe <i class="parameter"><tt>user level</tt></i> security first, as it's simpler. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885276"></a>User Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +We will describe <span class="emphasis"><em>user level</em></span> security first, as it's simpler. In <span class="emphasis"><em>user level</em></span> security, the client will send a <span class="emphasis"><em>session setup</em></span> command directly after the protocol negotiation. This contains a username and password. The server can either accept or reject that @@ -95,13 +96,11 @@ It is also possible for a client to send multiple <span class="emphasis"><em>ses requests. When the server responds, it gives the client a <span class="emphasis"><em>uid</em></span> to use as an authentication tag for that username/password. The client can maintain multiple authentication contexts in this way (WinDD is an example of an application that does this). -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2889156"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2885368"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that sets <span class="emphasis"><em>User Level Security</em></span> is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - security = user -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> This is the default setting since samba-2.2.x. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889195"></a>Share Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885414"></a>Share Level Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Ok, now for share level security. In share level security, the client authenticates itself separately for each share. It will send a password along with each <span class="emphasis"><em>tree connection</em></span> (share mount). It does not explicitly send a @@ -121,104 +120,92 @@ level security. They normally send a valid username but no password. Samba recor this username in a list of <span class="emphasis"><em>possible usernames</em></span>. When the client then does a <span class="emphasis"><em>tree connection</em></span> it also adds to this list the name of the share they try to connect to (useful for home directories) and any users -listed in the <i class="parameter"><tt>user =</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> line. The password is then checked +listed in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2885473"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> line. The password is then checked in turn against these <span class="emphasis"><em>possible usernames</em></span>. If a match is found then the client is authenticated as that user. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2889275"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2885502"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that sets <span class="emphasis"><em>Share Level Security</em></span> is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - security = share -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = share</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> Please note that there are reports that recent MS Windows clients do not like to work with share mode security servers. You are strongly discouraged from using share level security. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889317"></a>Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -When Samba is operating in <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i> mode, +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885551"></a>Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +When Samba is operating in <a class="indexterm" name="id2885562"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain mode, the Samba server has a domain security trust account (a machine account) and will cause all authentication requests to be passed through to the domain controllers. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2889339"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2885582"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Samba as a Domain Member Server </em></span></p><p> This method involves addition of the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - security = domain - workgroup = "name_of_NT_domain" -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> In order for this method to work, the Samba server needs to join the MS Windows NT security domain. This is done as follows: </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p>On the MS Windows NT domain controller, using the Server Manager, add a machine account for the Samba server. - </p></li><li><p>Next, on the Unix/Linux system execute:</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j DOMAIN_NAME -r PDC_NAME</tt></b> (samba-2.x)</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -U administrator%password</tt></b> (samba-3)</p></li></ol></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -As of Samba-2.2.4 the Samba 2.2.x series can auto-join a Windows NT4 style Domain just -by executing: + </p></li><li><p>Next, on the UNIX/Linux system execute:</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -U administrator%password</tt></b></pre></li></ol></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Samba-2.2.4 and later can auto-join a Windows NT4 style Domain just by executing: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> -r <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -j <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> -r <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> \ + -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> </pre><p> -As of Samba-3 the same can be done by executing: +Samba-3 can do the same by executing: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -U Administrator%<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i></tt></b> </pre><p> -It is not necessary with Samba-3 to specify the <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> or the <i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> as it -figures this out from the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. +It is not necessary with Samba-3 to specify the <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN_NAME</tt></i> or the +<i class="replaceable"><tt>PDC_NAME</tt></i> as it figures this out from the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file settings. </p></div><p> -Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard Unix account -for each user in order to assign a uid once the account has been authenticated by +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard UNIX account +for each user in order to assign a UID once the account has been authenticated by the remote Windows DC. This account can be blocked to prevent logons by clients other than -MS Windows through things such as setting an invalid shell in the +MS Windows through means such as setting an invalid shell in the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry. </p><p> An alternative to assigning UIDs to Windows users on a Samba member server is -presented in the <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">Winbind Overview</a> chapter -in this HOWTO collection. +presented in <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts">the chapter about winbind</a>. </p><p> -For more information of being a domain member, see the <a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain -Member</a> section of this Howto. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889568"></a>ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + For more information of being a domain member, see <a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter about domain membership</a>. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885808"></a>ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Both Samba 2.2 and 3.0 can join an Active Directory domain. This is -possible even if the domain is run in native mode. Active Directory in -native mode perfectly allows NT4-style domain members, contrary to +possible if the domain is run in native mode. Active Directory in +native mode perfectly allows NT4-style domain members. This is contrary to popular belief. The only thing that Active Directory in native mode prohibits is Backup Domain Controllers running NT4. </p><p> -If you are running Active Directory starting with Samba 3.0 you can -however join as a native AD member. Why would you want to do that? +If you are using Active Directory, starting with Samba-3 you can +join as a native AD member. Why would you want to do that? Your security policy might prohibit the use of NT-compatible authentication protocols. All your machines are running Windows 2000 -and above and all use full Kerberos. In this case Samba as a NT4-style +and above and all use Kerberos. In this case Samba as a NT4-style domain would still require NT-compatible authentication data. Samba in -AD-member mode can accept Kerberos. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2889598"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> - realm = your.kerberos.REALM - security = ADS -</pre><p> - The following parameter may be required: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - ads server = your.kerberos.server -</pre><p> -Please refer to the <a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> and <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member" title="Samba ADS Domain Membership">Active Directory -Membership</a> sections for more information regarding this configuration option. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889655"></a>Server Security (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +AD-member mode can accept Kerberos tickets. +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2885838"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>realm = your.kerberos.REALM</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = ADS</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +The following parameter may be required: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server = your.kerberos.server</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +Please refer to <a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter on domain membership</a> +for more information regarding this configuration option. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2885909"></a>Server Security (User Level Security)</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Server security mode is a left over from the time when Samba was not capable of acting as a domain member server. It is highly recommended NOT to use this feature. Server security mode has many draw backs. The draw backs include: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Potential Account Lockout on MS Windows NT4/200x password servers</td></tr><tr><td>Lack of assurance that the password server is the one specified</td></tr><tr><td>Does not work with Winbind, particularly needed when storing profiles remotely</td></tr><tr><td>This mode may open connections to the password server, and keep them open for extended periods.</td></tr><tr><td>Security on the Samba server breaks badly when the remote password server suddenly shuts down</td></tr><tr><td>With this mode there is NO security account in the domain that the password server belongs to for the Samba server.</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Potential Account Lockout on MS Windows NT4/200x password servers</p></li><li><p>Lack of assurance that the password server is the one specified</p></li><li><p>Does not work with Winbind, particularly needed when storing profiles remotely</p></li><li><p>This mode may open connections to the password server, and keep them open for extended periods.</p></li><li><p>Security on the Samba server breaks badly when the remote password server suddenly shuts down</p></li><li><p>With this mode there is NO security account in the domain that the password server belongs to for the Samba server.</p></li></ul></div><p> In server security mode the Samba server reports to the client that it is in user level security. The client then does a <span class="emphasis"><em>session setup</em></span> as described earlier. The Samba server takes the username/password that the client sends and attempts to login to the -<i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> by sending exactly the same username/password that +<a class="indexterm" name="id2885982"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> by sending exactly the same username/password that it got from the client. If that server is in user level security and accepts the password, then Samba accepts the clients connection. This allows the Samba server to use another SMB -server as the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>. +server as the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886002"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>. </p><p> You should also note that at the very start of all this, where the server tells the client what security level it is in, it also tells the client if it supports encryption. If it does then it supplies the client with a random cryptkey. The client will then send all passwords in encrypted form. Samba supports this type of encryption by default. </p><p> -The parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> means that Samba reports to clients that +The parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2886030"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server means that Samba reports to clients that it is running in <span class="emphasis"><em>user mode</em></span> but actually passes off all authentication requests to another <span class="emphasis"><em>user mode</em></span> server. This requires an additional -parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> that points to the real authentication server. +parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2886056"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> that points to the real authentication server. That real authentication server can be another Samba server or can be a Windows NT server, the later natively capable of encrypted password support. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> @@ -229,17 +216,13 @@ lookups because the choice of the target authentication server is arbitrary and be determined from a domain name. In essence, a Samba server that is in <span class="emphasis"><em>server security mode</em></span> is operating in what used to be known as workgroup mode. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2889811"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2886099"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em> Using MS Windows NT as an authentication server </em></span></p><p> This method involves the additions of the following parameters in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - encrypt passwords = Yes - security = server - password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_a_DC" -</pre><p> -There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and password pair was valid -or not. One uses the reply information provided as part of the authentication messaging +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = "NetBIOS_name_of_a_DC"</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +There are two ways of identifying whether or not a username and password pair was valid. +One uses the reply information provided as part of the authentication messaging process, the other uses just an error code. </p><p> The down-side of this mode of configuration is the fact that for security reasons Samba @@ -248,9 +231,9 @@ server fails to reject the username and password pair then an alternative mode o identification of validation is used. Where a site uses password lock out after a certain number of failed authentication attempts this will result in user lockouts. </p><p> -Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard Unix account +Use of this mode of authentication does require there to be a standard UNIX account for the user, though this account can be blocked to prevent logons by non-SMB/CIFS clients. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889880"></a>Seamless Windows Network Integration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886191"></a>Password checking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows clients may use encrypted passwords as part of a challenge/response authentication model (a.k.a. NTLMv1 and NTLMv2) or alone, or clear text strings for simple password based authentication. It should be realized that with the SMB protocol, @@ -287,29 +270,26 @@ is definitely not a good idea to re-enable plain text password support in such c The following parameters can be used to work around the issue of Windows 9x clients upper casing usernames and password before transmitting them to the SMB server when using clear text authentication. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDLEVEL" target="_top">password level</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>integer</tt></i> - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#USERNAMELEVEL" target="_top">username level</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>integer</tt></i> -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password level = integer</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>username level = integer</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> By default Samba will lower case the username before attempting to lookup the user in the database of local system accounts. Because UNIX usernames conventionally -only contain lower case character, the <i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> parameter +only contain lower-case character, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886312"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i> parameter is rarely needed. </p><p> -However, passwords on UNIX systems often make use of mixed case characters. +However, passwords on UNIX systems often make use of mixed-case characters. This means that in order for a user on a Windows 9x client to connect to a Samba -server using clear text authentication, the <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> -must be set to the maximum number of upper case letter which <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> -appear is a password. Note that the server OS uses the traditional DES version -of crypt(), a <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> of 8 will result in case +server using clear text authentication, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2886335"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> +must be set to the maximum number of upper case letters which <span class="emphasis"><em>could</em></span> +appear in a password. Note that if the server OS uses the traditional DES version +of crypt(), a <a class="indexterm" name="id2886356"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> of 8 will result in case insensitive passwords as seen from Windows users. This will also result in longer login times as Samba has to compute the permutations of the password string and try them one by one until a match is located (or all combinations fail). </p><p> -The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords where ever +The best option to adopt is to enable support for encrypted passwords wherever Samba is used. Most attempts to apply the registry change to re-enable plain text passwords will eventually lead to user complaints and unhappiness. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890056"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886386"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> We all make mistakes. It is Ok to make mistakes, so long as they are made in the right places and at the right time. A mistake that causes lost productivity is seldom tolerated. A mistake made in a developmental test lab is expected. @@ -319,25 +299,26 @@ on the Samba mailing lists. Many of these are avoidable by doing you homework be a Samba implementation. Some are the result of misunderstanding of the English language. The English language has many turns of phrase that are potentially vague and may be highly confusing to those for whom English is not their native tongue. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890084"></a>What makes Samba a SERVER?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886414"></a>What makes Samba a SERVER?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To some the nature of the Samba <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span> mode is very obvious, but entirely -wrong all the same. It is assumed that <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> means that Samba +wrong all the same. It is assumed that <a class="indexterm" name="id2886429"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server means that Samba will act as a server. Not so! See above - this setting means that Samba will <span class="emphasis"><em>try</em></span> to use another SMB server as its source of user authentication alone. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890117"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i> does NOT really make Samba behave +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886453"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2886471"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain does NOT really make Samba behave as a Domain Controller! This setting means we want Samba to be a domain member! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890146"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Member?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Guess! So many others do. But whatever you do, do NOT think that <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886490"></a>What makes Samba a Domain Member?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Guess! So many others do. But whatever you do, do NOT think that <a class="indexterm" name="id2886500"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user makes Samba act as a domain member. Read the manufacturers manual before the warranty expires! See -the <a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Member</a> section of this Howto for more information. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890179"></a>Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter about domain membership</a> for more information. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886529"></a>Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> Why does server_validate() simply give up rather than re-establishing its connection to the password server? Though I am not fluent in the SMB protocol, perhaps the cluster server process passes along to its client workstation the session key it receives from the password server, which means the password hashes submitted by the client would not work on a subsequent -connection, whose session key would be different. So server_validate() must give up. +connection, whose session key would be different. So server_validate() must give up.</span>” </p><p> -Indeed. That's why security = server is at best a nasty hack. Please use security = domain. -<i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> mode is also known as pass-through authentication. -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="type.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-pdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part II. Server Configuration Basics </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 5. Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + Indeed. That's why <a class="indexterm" name="id2886557"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server is at best a nasty hack. Please use <a class="indexterm" name="id2886571"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2886584"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server mode is also known as pass-through authentication. +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="type.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-pdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part II. Server Configuration Basics </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 5. Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html b/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html index a3bdf439af..f85fdfe3fc 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/StandAloneServer.html @@ -1,9 +1,9 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"><link rel="next" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="domain-member.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ClientConfig.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="StandAloneServer"></a>Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902304">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902501">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902573">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902588">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902638">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902852">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"><link rel="next" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="domain-member.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ClientConfig.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="StandAloneServer"></a>Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893079">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893117">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893191">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893714">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> Stand-Alone servers are independent of Domain Controllers on the network. They are NOT domain members and function more like workgroup servers. In many cases a stand-alone server is configured with a minimum of security control with the intent that all data served will be readily accessible to all users. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902304"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893079"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Stand-Alone servers can be as secure or as insecure as needs dictate. They can have simple or complex configurations. Above all, despite the hoopla about Domain security they remain a very common installation. @@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ that are queued off a single central server. Everyone needs to be able to print to the printers, there is no need to affect any access controls and no files will be served from the print server. Again a share mode stand-alone server makes a great solution. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902501"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893117"></a>Background</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The term <span class="emphasis"><em>stand-alone server</em></span> means that the server will provide local authentication and access control for all resources that are available from it. In general this means that there will be a @@ -42,50 +42,37 @@ local or on a remote server, even if from the Samba protocol perspective the Samba server is NOT a member of a domain security context. </p><p> Through the use of PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) and nsswitch -(the name service switcher) the source of authentication may reside on +(the name service switcher, which maintains the unix user database) the source of authentication may reside on another server. We would be inclined to call this the authentication server. -This means that the Samba server may use the local Unix/Linux system password database +This means that the Samba server may use the local UNIX/Linux system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>), may use a local smbpasswd file, or may use an LDAP back end, or even via PAM and Winbind another CIFS/SMB server for authentication. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902573"></a>Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893191"></a>Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following examples are designed to inspire simplicity. It is too easy to attempt a high level of creativity and to introduce too much complexity in server and network design. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902588"></a>Reference Documentation Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="RefDocServer"></a>Reference Documentation Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Configuration of a read-only data server that EVERYONE can access is very simple. Here is the smb.conf file that will do this. Assume that all the reference documents are stored in the directory /export, that the documents are owned by a user other than nobody. No home directories are shared, that are no users in the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> -Unix system database. This is a very simple system to administer. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - # Global parameters - [global] - workgroup = MYGROUP - netbios name = REFDOCS - security = SHARE - passdb backend = guest - wins server = 192.168.1.1 - - [data] - comment = Data - path = /export - guest only = Yes -</pre><p> +UNIX system database. This is a very simple system to administer. +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2893237"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8.1. smb.conf for Reference Documentation Server</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># Global parameters</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = SHARE</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = 192.168.1.1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[data]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest only = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> In the above example the machine name is set to REFDOCS, the workgroup is set to the name of the local workgroup so that the machine will appear in with systems users are familiar with. The only password backend required is the "guest" backend so as to allow default unprivileged account names to be used. Given that there is a WINS server on this network we do use it. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902638"></a>Central Print Serving</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="SimplePrintServer"></a>Central Print Serving</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Configuration of a simple print server is very simple if you have all the right tools on your system. </p><div class="orderedlist"><p class="title"><b> Assumptions:</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> The print server must require no administration </p></li><li><p> The print spooling and processing system on our print server will be CUPS. - (Please refer to the <a href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">CUPS Printing</a> chapter for more information). + (Please refer to <a href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">the chapter about CUPS</a> for more information). </p></li><li><p> All printers that the print server will service will be network printers. They will be correctly configured, by the administrator, @@ -99,45 +86,27 @@ In this example our print server will spool all incoming print jobs to Samba to the CUPS print processor. Since all incoming connections will be as the anonymous (guest) user, two things will be required: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Enabling Anonymous Printing</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p> - The Unix/Linux system must have a <b class="command">guest</b> account. + The UNIX/Linux system must have a <b class="command">guest</b> account. The default for this is usually the account <b class="command">nobody</b>. To find the correct name to use for your version of Samba do the following: - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -s -v | grep "guest account"</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</pre><p> Then make sure that this account exists in your system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>). </p></li><li><p> The directory into which Samba will spool the file must have write access for the guest account. The following commands will ensure that this directory is available for use: - </p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mkdir /var/spool/samba</tt></b> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown nobody.nobody /var/spool/samba</tt></b> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod a+rwt /var/spool/samba</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p></li></ul></div><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - # Global parameters - [global] - workgroup = MYGROUP - netbios name = PTRSVR1 - security = SHARE - passdb backend = guest - wins server = 192.168.1.1 - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - path = /var/spool/samba - printer admin = root - guest ok = Yes - printable = Yes - printing = cups - use client driver = Yes - browseable = No </pre><p> -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902852"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2893557"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 8.2. smb.conf for anonymous printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># Global parameters</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = SHARE</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = noldor</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = cups</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = No</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893714"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The greatest mistake so often made is to make a network configuration too complex. It pays to use the simplest solution that will meet the needs of the moment. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="domain-member.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ClientConfig.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 7. Domain Membership </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="domain-member.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ClientConfig.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 7. Domain Membership </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html b/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html index 6b520d792a..ffa767e6c9 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/VFS.html @@ -1,26 +1,19 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0"><link rel="next" href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="CUPS-printing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="winbind.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="VFS"></a>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Simo</span> <span class="surname">Sorce</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_skel README</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_netatalk docs</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><span class="contrib">Update for multiple modules</span></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978211">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978229">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978320">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978327">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978365">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978489">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978508">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978645">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978690">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978712">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978768">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978797">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978211"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0"><link rel="next" href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="CUPS-printing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="winbind.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="VFS"></a>Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Simo</span> <span class="surname">Sorce</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_skel README</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Alexander</span> <span class="surname">Bokovoy</span></h3><span class="contrib">original vfs_netatalk docs</span></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stefan</span> <span class="surname">Metzmacher</span></h3><span class="contrib">Update for multiple modules</span></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940177">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940195">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940424">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940432">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940474">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940604">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940622">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940798">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940843">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940865">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940920">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940177"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since Samba-3, there is support for stackable VFS(Virtual File System) modules. Samba passes each request to access the unix file system thru the loaded VFS modules. This chapter covers all the modules that come with the samba source and references to some external modules. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978229"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940195"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If not supplied with your platform distribution binary Samba package you may have problems to compile these modules, as shared libraries are compiled and linked in different ways on different systems. They currently have been tested against GNU/Linux and IRIX. </p><p> To use the VFS modules, create a share similar to the one below. The -important parameter is the <b class="command">vfs objects</b> parameter where +important parameter is the <a class="indexterm" name="id2940216"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i> parameter where you can list one or more VFS modules by name. For example, to log all access to files and put deleted files in a recycle bin: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[audit] - comment = Audited /data directory - path = /data - vfs objects = audit recycle - writeable = yes - browseable = yes -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2940233"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 20.1. smb.conf with VFS modules</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[audit]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Audited /data directory</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects = audit recycle</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> The modules are used in the order in which they are specified. </p><p> @@ -32,46 +25,52 @@ directory in the root directory of the samba installation (usually Some modules can be used twice for the same share. This can be done using a configuration similar to the one below. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[test] - comment = VFS TEST - path = /data - writeable = yes - browseable = yes - vfs objects = example:example1 example example:test - example1: parameter = 1 - example: parameter = 5 - test: parameter = 7 -</pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978320"></a>Included modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978327"></a>audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2940333"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 20.2. smb.conf with multiple VFS modules</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[test]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = VFS TEST</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /data</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects = example:example1 example example:test</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>example1: parameter = 1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>example: parameter = 5</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>test: parameter = 7</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940424"></a>Included modules</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940432"></a>audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A simple module to audit file access to the syslog facility. The following operations are logged: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>share</td></tr><tr><td>connect/disconnect</td></tr><tr><td>directory opens/create/remove</td></tr><tr><td>file open/close/rename/unlink/chmod</td></tr></table><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978365"></a>extd_audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>share</p></li><li><p>connect/disconnect</p></li><li><p>directory opens/create/remove</p></li><li><p>file open/close/rename/unlink/chmod</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940474"></a>extd_audit</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This module is identical with the <span class="emphasis"><em>audit</em></span> module above except that it sends audit logs to both syslog as well as the smbd log file/s. The loglevel for this module is set in the smb.conf file. </p><p> The logging information that will be written to the smbd log file is controlled by - the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. The + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2940498"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. The following information will be recorded: - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2978406"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 20.1. Extended Auditing Log Information</b></p><table summary="Extended Auditing Log Information" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Log Level</th><th align="center">Log Details - File and Directory Operations</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">0</td><td align="left">Creation / Deletion</td></tr><tr><td align="center">1</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Permission Changes</td></tr><tr><td align="center">2</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Perm Change / Open / Close</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978489"></a>fake_perms</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2940521"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 20.1. Extended Auditing Log Information</b></p><table summary="Extended Auditing Log Information" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="center">Log Level</th><th align="center">Log Details - File and Directory Operations</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="center">0</td><td align="left">Creation / Deletion</td></tr><tr><td align="center">1</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Permission Changes</td></tr><tr><td align="center">2</td><td align="left">Create / Delete / Rename / Perm Change / Open / Close</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940604"></a>fake_perms</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This module was created to allow Roaming Profile files and directories to be set (on the Samba server under Unix) as read only. This module will if installed on the Profiles share will report to the client that the Profile files and directories are writable. This satisfies the client even though the files will never be overwritten as the client logs out or shuts down. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978508"></a>recycle</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940622"></a>recycle</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A recycle-bin like module. When used any unlink call will be intercepted and files moved to the recycle - directory instead of being deleted. + directory instead of being deleted. This gives the same + effect as the "Recycle Bin" on Windows computers. </p><p>Supported options: - </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:keeptree</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:versions</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:touch</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:maxsize</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude_dir</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:noversions</span></dt><dd><p>FIXME</p></dd></dl></div><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978645"></a>netatalk</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">recycle:repository</span></dt><dd><p>Relative path of the directory where deleted files should be moved to</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:keeptree</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether the directory structure should + be kept or if the files in the directory that is being + deleted should be kept seperately in the recycle bin. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:versions</span></dt><dd><p>If this option is set, two files + with the same name that are deleted will both + be kept in the recycle bin. Newer deleted versions + of a file will be called "Copy #x of <i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i>".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:touch</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether a file's access + date should be touched when the file is moved to + the recycle bin.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:maxsize</span></dt><dd><p>Files that are larger than the number + of bytes specified by this parameter will + not be put into the recycle bin.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude</span></dt><dd><p>List of files that should not + be put into the recycle bin when deleted, but deleted + in the regular way.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:exclude_dir</span></dt><dd><p>Contains a list of directories. When files from + these directories are deleted, they are not put into the + recycle bin, but deleted in the regular way. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">recycle:noversions</span></dt><dd><p>Opposite of <i class="parameter"><tt>recycle:versions</tt></i>. If both options are specified, this one takes precedence.</p></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940798"></a>netatalk</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A netatalk module, that will ease co-existence of samba and netatalk file sharing services. </p><p>Advantages compared to the old netatalk module: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>it doesn't care about creating of .AppleDouble forks, just keeps them in sync</td></tr><tr><td>if a share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> doesn't contain .AppleDouble item in hide or veto list, it will be added automatically</td></tr></table><p> - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978690"></a>VFS modules available elsewhere</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>it doesn't care about creating of .AppleDouble forks, just keeps them in sync</p></li><li><p>if a share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> doesn't contain .AppleDouble item in hide or veto list, it will be added automatically</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2940843"></a>VFS modules available elsewhere</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section contains a listing of various other VFS modules that have been posted but don't currently reside in the Samba CVS tree for one reason or another (e.g. it is easy for the maintainer @@ -79,7 +78,7 @@ to have his or her own CVS tree). </p><p> No statements about the stability or functionality of any module should be implied due to its presence here. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978712"></a>DatabaseFS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940865"></a>DatabaseFS</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> URL: <a href="http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php" target="_top">http://www.css.tayloru.edu/~elorimer/databasefs/index.php</a> </p><p>By <a href="mailto:elorimer@css.tayloru.edu" target="_top">Eric Lorimer</a>.</p><p> I have created a VFS module which implements a fairly complete read-only @@ -94,12 +93,10 @@ should be implied due to its presence here. Any feedback would be appreciated: comments, suggestions, patches, etc... If nothing else, hopefully it might prove useful for someone else who wishes to create a virtual filesystem. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2978768"></a>vscan</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>URL: <a href="http://www.openantivirus.org/" target="_top">http://www.openantivirus.org/</a></p><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2940920"></a>vscan</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>URL: <a href="http://www.openantivirus.org/" target="_top">http://www.openantivirus.org/</a></p><p> samba-vscan is a proof-of-concept module for Samba, which uses the VFS (virtual file system) features of Samba 2.2.x/3.0 alphaX. Of course, Samba has to be compiled with VFS support. samba-vscan supports various virus scanners and is maintained by Rainer Link. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2978797"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There must be some gotchas we should record here! Jelmer??? -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="CUPS-printing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="winbind.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0 </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="CUPS-printing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="winbind.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0 </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html b/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html index 9ae4797d31..49eb2117ca 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/bugreport.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems"><link rel="next" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="bugreport"></a>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">Someone; Tridge or Karl Auer perhaps?</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 June 1997 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012269">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012491">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012528">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012670">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012778">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012825">Patches</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012269"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please report bugs using +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems"><link rel="next" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="bugreport"></a>Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 27 June 1997 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960613">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960681">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960718">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960926">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2961060">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2961107">Patches</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960613"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Please report bugs using <a href="https://bugzilla.samba.org/" target="_top">bugzilla</a>.</p><p> Please take the time to read this file before you submit a bug report. Also, please see if it has changed between releases, as we @@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ that list that may be able to help you. You may also like to look though the recent mailing list archives, which are conveniently accessible on the Samba web pages at <a href="http://samba.org/samba/" target="_top">http://samba.org/samba/</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012491"></a>General info</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960681"></a>General info</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before submitting a bug report check your config for silly errors. Look in your log files for obvious messages that tell you that you've misconfigured something and run testparm to test your config @@ -32,42 +32,38 @@ This is very important. If you include part of a log file with your bug report then be sure to annotate it with exactly what you were doing on the client at the time, and exactly what the results were. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012528"></a>Debug levels</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960718"></a>Debug levels</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the bug has anything to do with Samba behaving incorrectly as a server (like refusing to open a file) then the log files will probably be very useful. Depending on the problem a log level of between 3 and 10 showing the problem may be appropriate. A higher level gives more detail, but may use too much disk space. </p><p> -To set the debug level use the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in your +To set the debug level use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2960739"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. You may also find it useful to set the log level higher for just one machine and keep separate logs for each machine. -To do this use: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -log level = 10 -log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m -include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m -</pre><p> +To do this add the following lines to your main <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>log level = 10</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>log file = /usr/local/samba/lib/log.%m</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>include = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> then create a file <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i></tt> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine</tt></i> is the name of the client you wish to debug. In that file put any <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> commands you want, for example -<i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> may be useful. This also allows you to +<a class="indexterm" name="id2960830"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> may be useful. This also allows you to experiment with different security systems, protocol levels etc on just one machine. </p><p> -The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> -is synonymous with the parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> that has +The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry <a class="indexterm" name="id2960857"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> +is synonymous with the parameter <a class="indexterm" name="id2960872"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> that has been used in older versions of Samba and is being retained for backwards compatibility of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> files. </p><p> -As the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> value is increased you will record +As the <a class="indexterm" name="id2960897"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> value is increased you will record a significantly increasing level of debugging information. For most debugging operations you may not need a setting higher than <tt class="constant">3</tt>. Nearly all bugs can be tracked at a setting of <tt class="constant">10</tt>, but be prepared for a VERY large volume of log data. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012670"></a>Internal errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960926"></a>Internal errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you get a <span class="errorname">INTERNAL ERROR</span> message in your log files it means that Samba got an unexpected signal while running. It is probably a segmentation fault and almost certainly means a bug in Samba (unless @@ -80,13 +76,13 @@ include it in your bug report. </p><p> You should also detail how to reproduce the problem, if possible. Please make this reasonably detailed. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2960962"></a><p> You may also find that a core file appeared in a <tt class="filename">corefiles</tt> subdirectory of the directory where you keep your samba log files. This file is the most useful tool for tracking down the bug. To use it you do this: -</p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd core</tt></b> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2960984"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2960993"></a><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gdb smbd core</tt></b> </pre><p> adding appropriate paths to smbd and core so gdb can find them. If you don't have gdb then try <b class="userinput"><tt>dbx</tt></b>. Then within the debugger @@ -100,7 +96,7 @@ disassemble the routine that called it) and try to work out exactly where the problem is by looking at the surrounding code. Even if you don't know assembly, including this info in the bug report can be useful. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012778"></a>Attaching to a running process</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961060"></a>Attaching to a running process</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Unfortunately some unixes (in particular some recent linux kernels) refuse to dump a core file if the task has changed uid (which smbd does often). To debug with this sort of system you could try to attach @@ -110,10 +106,10 @@ to the running process using Then use <b class="command">c</b> to continue and try to cause the core dump using the client. The debugger should catch the fault and tell you where it occurred. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012825"></a>Patches</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961107"></a>Patches</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2961114"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2961123"></a><p> The best sort of bug report is one that includes a fix! If you send us patches please use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -u</tt></b> format if your version of diff supports it, otherwise use <b class="userinput"><tt>diff -c4</tt></b>. Make sure you do the diff against a clean version of the source and let me know exactly what version you used. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part VI. Appendixes</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="problems.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Appendixes.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part VI. Appendixes</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html b/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html index d8b85602d9..95cdb0f581 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/compiling.html @@ -1,8 +1,8 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="next" href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Appendixes.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Portability.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="compiling"></a>Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="surname">Someone; Jerry perhaps?</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 22 May 2001 </p></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 18 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3012145">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3012152">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3012182">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3013701">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3013750">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3013886">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014023">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014188">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014280">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014484">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id3014579">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 36. How to compile Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="next" href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 36. How to compile Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Appendixes.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Portability.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="compiling"></a>Chapter 36. How to compile Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 22 May 2001 </p></div><div><p class="pubdate"> 18 March 2003 </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961265">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961282">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961320">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961581">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961644">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961798">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961978">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962144">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962499">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> You can obtain the samba source from the <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">samba website</a>. To obtain a development version, you can download samba from CVS or using rsync. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3012145"></a>Access Samba source code via CVS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3012152"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961265"></a>Access Samba source code via CVS</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2961274"></a><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961282"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba is developed in an open environment. Developers use CVS (Concurrent Versioning System) to "checkin" (also known as "commit") new source code. Samba's various CVS branches can @@ -11,12 +11,12 @@ detailed in this chapter. </p><p> This chapter is a modified version of the instructions found at <a href="http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html" target="_top">http://samba.org/samba/cvs.html</a> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3012182"></a>CVS Access to samba.org</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961320"></a>CVS Access to samba.org</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The machine samba.org runs a publicly accessible CVS repository for access to the source code of several packages, including samba, rsync, distcc, ccache and jitterbug. There are two main ways of accessing the CVS server on this host. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3012198"></a>Access via CVSweb</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961335"></a>Access via CVSweb</h4></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2961344"></a><p> You can access the source code via your favourite WWW browser. This allows you to access the contents of individual files in the repository and also to look at the revision @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ history and commit logs of individual files. You can also ask for a diff listing between any two versions on the repository. </p><p> Use the URL : <a href="http://samba.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb" target="_top">http://samba.org/cgi-bin/cvsweb</a> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3013511"></a>Access via cvs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2961383"></a>Access via cvs</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can also access the source code via a normal cvs client. This gives you much more control over what you can do with the repository and allows you to checkout whole source trees @@ -74,7 +74,7 @@ on this system just substitute the correct package name the following command from within the samba directory: </p><p> <b class="userinput"><tt>cvs update -d -P</tt></b> - </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3013701"></a>Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961581"></a>Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2961589"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2961597"></a><p> pserver.samba.org also exports unpacked copies of most parts of the CVS tree at <a href="ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked" target="_top">ftp://pserver.samba.org/pub/unpacked</a> and also via anonymous rsync at <a href="rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/" target="_top">rsync://pserver.samba.org/ftp/unpacked/</a>. I recommend using rsync rather than ftp. @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ on this system just substitute the correct package name The disadvantage of the unpacked trees is that they do not support automatic merging of local changes like CVS does. rsync access is most convenient for an initial install. - </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3013750"></a>Verifying Samba's PGP signature</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961644"></a>Verifying Samba's PGP signature</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In these days of insecurity, it's strongly recommended that you verify the PGP signature for any source file before installing it. Even if you're not downloading from a mirror site, verifying PGP signatures should be a @@ -91,39 +91,43 @@ standard reflex. </p><p> With that said, go ahead and download the following files: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> -<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wget http://us1.samba.org/samba/ftp/samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> </pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2961705"></a> The first file is the PGP signature for the Samba source file; the other is the Samba public PGP key itself. Import the public PGP key with: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --import samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --import samba-pubkey.asc</tt></b> </pre><p> And verify the Samba source code integrity with: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gzip -d samba-2.2.8a.tar.gz</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --verify samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gzip -d samba-2.2.8a.tar.gz</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>gpg --verify samba-2.2.8a.tar.asc</tt></b> </pre><p> If you receive a message like, "Good signature from Samba Distribution Verification Key..." then all is well. The warnings about trust relationships can be ignored. An example of what you would not want to see would be: -</p><tt class="computeroutput"> +</p><p> +<tt class="computeroutput"> gpg: BAD signature from "Samba Distribution Verification Key" -</tt></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3013886"></a>Building the Binaries</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To do this, first run the program <b class="userinput"><tt>./configure + </tt> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2961798"></a>Building the Binaries</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2961805"></a><p> + To do this, first run the program <b class="userinput"><tt>./configure </tt></b> in the source directory. This should automatically configure Samba for your operating system. If you have unusual - needs then you may wish to run</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure --help - </tt></b></p><p>first to see what special options you can enable. - Then executing</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></p><p>will create the binaries. Once it's successfully - compiled you can use </p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make install</tt></b></p><p>to install the binaries and manual pages. You can - separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installbin - </tt></b></p><p>and</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installman - </tt></b></p><p>Note that if you are upgrading for a previous version + needs then you may wish to run</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>./configure --help +</tt></b></pre><p>first to see what special options you can enable. + Then executing</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2961851"></a><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make</tt></b></pre><p>will create the binaries. Once it's successfully + compiled you can use </p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make install</tt></b></pre><p>to install the binaries and manual pages. You can + separately install the binaries and/or man pages using</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installbin +</tt></b></pre><p>and</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make installman + </tt></b></pre><p>Note that if you are upgrading for a previous version of Samba you might like to know that the old versions of the binaries will be renamed with a ".old" extension. You - can go back to the previous version with</p><p><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make revert - </tt></b></p><p>if you find this version a disaster!</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3014023"></a>Compiling samba with Active Directory support</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>In order to compile samba with ADS support, you need to have installed + can go back to the previous version with</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>make revert +</tt></b></pre><p>if you find this version a disaster!</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2961978"></a>Compiling samba with Active Directory support</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>In order to compile samba with ADS support, you need to have installed on your system:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>the MIT kerberos development libraries (either install from the sources or use a package). The Heimdal libraries will not work.</p></li><li><p>the OpenLDAP development libraries.</p></li></ul></div><p>If your kerberos libraries are in a non-standard location then @@ -135,16 +139,17 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: #define HAVE_LDAP 1 </pre><p>If it doesn't then configure did not find your krb5 libraries or your ldap libraries. Look in <tt class="filename">config.log</tt> to figure - out why and fix it.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3014104"></a>Installing the required packages for Debian</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On Debian you need to install the following packages:</p><p> - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>libkrb5-dev</td></tr><tr><td>krb5-user</td></tr></table><p> - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id3014136"></a>Installing the required packages for RedHat</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On RedHat this means you should have at least: </p><p> - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>krb5-workstation (for kinit)</td></tr><tr><td>krb5-libs (for linking with)</td></tr><tr><td>krb5-devel (because you are compiling from source)</td></tr></table><p> + out why and fix it.</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962059"></a>Installing the required packages for Debian</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On Debian you need to install the following packages:</p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>libkrb5-dev</p></li><li><p>krb5-user</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2962091"></a>Installing the required packages for RedHat</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>On RedHat this means you should have at least: </p><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>krb5-workstation (for kinit)</p></li><li><p>krb5-libs (for linking with)</p></li><li><p>krb5-devel (because you are compiling from source)</p></li></ul></div><p> </p><p>in addition to the standard development environment.</p><p>Note that these are not standard on a RedHat install, and you may need - to get them off CD2.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3014188"></a>Starting the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span></h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>You must choose to start <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> either + to get them off CD2.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2962144"></a>Starting the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span></h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2962165"></a><p>You must choose to start <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> either as daemons or from <span class="application">inetd</span>. Don't try to do both! Either you can put them in <tt class="filename"> inetd.conf</tt> and have them started on demand - by <span class="application">inetd</span>, or you can start them as + by <span class="application">inetd</span> or <span class="application">xinetd</span>, + or you can start them as daemons either from the command line or in <tt class="filename"> /etc/rc.local</tt>. See the man pages for details on the command line options. Take particular care to read @@ -152,7 +157,7 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: Samba. In many cases you must be root.</p><p>The main advantage of starting <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> using the recommended daemon method is that they will respond slightly more quickly to an initial connection - request.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3014280"></a>Starting from inetd.conf</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>The following will be different if + request.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962252"></a>Starting from inetd.conf</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2962260"></a><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>The following will be different if you use NIS, NIS+ or LDAP to distribute services maps.</p></div><p>Look at your <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>. What is defined at port 139/tcp. If nothing is defined then add a line like this:</p><pre class="programlisting">netbios-ssn 139/tcp</pre><p>similarly for 137/udp you should have an entry like:</p><pre class="programlisting">netbios-ns 137/udp</pre><p>Next edit your <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> @@ -161,12 +166,13 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: netbios-ns dgram udp wait root /usr/local/samba/bin/nmbd nmbd </pre><p>The exact syntax of <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> varies between unixes. Look at the other entries in inetd.conf - for a guide.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Some unixes already have entries like netbios_ns + for a guide. </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2962350"></a><p>Some distributions use xinetd instead of inetd. Consult the + xinetd manual for configuration information.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Some unixes already have entries like netbios_ns (note the underscore) in <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt>. You must either edit <tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> to make them consistent. - </p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On many systems you may need to use the - <i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to specify the IP + </p></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2962393"></a><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On many systems you may need to use the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2962405"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to specify the IP address and netmask of your interfaces. Run <span class="application">ifconfig</span> as root if you don't know what the broadcast is for your @@ -177,8 +183,9 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: This means you shouldn't use spaces between the options and arguments, or you should use a script, and start the script from <b class="command">inetd</b>.</p></div><p>Restart <span class="application">inetd</span>, perhaps just send - it a HUP. If you have installed an earlier version of <span class="application">nmbd</span> then - you may need to kill <span class="application">nmbd</span> as well.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3014484"></a>Alternative: starting it as a daemon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>To start the server as a daemon you should create + it a HUP. </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>killall -HUP inetd</tt></b> + </pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2962499"></a>Alternative: starting it as a daemon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2962507"></a><p>To start the server as a daemon you should create a script something like this one, perhaps calling it <tt class="filename">startsmb</tt>.</p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/sh @@ -190,12 +197,4 @@ example of what you would not want to see would be: </p><p>To kill it send a kill signal to the processes <span class="application">nmbd</span> and <span class="application">smbd</span>.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>If you use the SVR4 style init system then you may like to look at the <tt class="filename">examples/svr4-startup</tt> - script to make Samba fit into that system.</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3014579"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> -I'm using gcc 3 and I've compiled Samba-3 from the CVS and the -binaries are very large files (40 Mb and 20 Mb). I've the same result with -<tt class="option">--enable-shared</tt> ? -</span>” -</p><p> -The dwarf format used by GCC 3 for storing debugging symbols is very inefficient. -Strip the binaries, don't compile with -g or compile with -gstabs. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Appendixes.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Portability.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part VI. Appendixes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 37. Portability</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + script to make Samba fit into that system.</p></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Appendixes.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Portability.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part VI. Appendixes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 37. Portability</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html b/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html index ff3099ac72..ea84661d30 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/diagnosis.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="next" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="diagnosis"></a>Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Wed Jan 15</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3006072">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3007931">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3008108">The tests</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3009283">Still having troubles?</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3006072"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="next" href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="diagnosis"></a>Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Wed Jan 15</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2957982">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2958022">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2957982"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This file contains a list of tests you can perform to validate your Samba server. It also tells you what the likely cause of the problem is if it fails any one of these steps. If it passes all these tests @@ -13,7 +13,7 @@ to solve a problem. If you send one of the samba mailing lists an email saying "it doesn't work" and you have not followed this test procedure then you should not be surprised if your email is ignored. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3007931"></a>Assumptions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958022"></a>Assumptions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In all of the tests it is assumed you have a Samba server called BIGSERVER and a PC called ACLIENT both in workgroup TESTGROUP. </p><p> @@ -23,14 +23,7 @@ It is also assumed you know the name of an available share in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. I will assume this share is called <i class="replaceable"><tt>tmp</tt></i>. You can add a <i class="replaceable"><tt>tmp</tt></i> share like this by adding the following to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - -[tmp] - comment = temporary files - path = /tmp - read only = yes - -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2958071"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 33.1. smb.conf with [tmp] share</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = temporary files </tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /tmp</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> These tests assume version 3.0 or later of the samba suite. Some commands shown did not exist in earlier versions. @@ -43,7 +36,7 @@ file points to name servers that really do exist. Also, if you do not have DNS server access for name resolution please check that the settings for your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file results in <b class="command">dns proxy = no</b>. The best way to check this is with <b class="userinput"><tt>testparm smb.conf</tt></b>. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2958171"></a><p> It is helpful to monitor the log files during testing by using the <b class="command">tail -F <i class="replaceable"><tt>log_file_name</tt></i></b> in a separate terminal console (use ctrl-alt-F1 through F6 or multiple terminals in X). @@ -54,7 +47,7 @@ depending on how or if you specified logging in your <tt class="filename">smb.co </p><p> If you make changes to your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file while going through these test, don't forget to restart <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3008108"></a>The tests</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 33.1. Diagnosing your samba server</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2958249"></a>The tests</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 33.1. Diagnosing your samba server</b></p><a class="indexterm" name="id2958265"></a><ol type="1"><li><p> In the directory in which you store your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>testparm smb.conf</tt></b>. If it reports any errors then your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file is faulty. @@ -100,6 +93,8 @@ that file incorrectly. If you installed it as a daemon then check that it is running, and check that the netbios-ssn port is in a LISTEN state using <b class="userinput"><tt>netstat -a</tt></b>. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2958530"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2958538"></a> Some Unix / Linux systems use <b class="command">xinetd</b> in place of <b class="command">inetd</b>. Check your system documentation for the location of the control file/s for your particular system implementation of @@ -116,26 +111,20 @@ files exist. There are a number of reasons for which smbd may refuse or decline a session request. The most common of these involve one or more of the following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - hosts deny = ALL - hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy - bind interfaces only = Yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = ALL</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> In the above, no allowance has been made for any session requests that will automatically translate to the loopback adapter address 127.0.0.1. To solve this problem change these lines to: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - hosts deny = ALL - hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127. -</pre><p> -Do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> use the <b class="command">bind interfaces only</b> parameter where you +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = ALL</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/yy 127.</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +Do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2958698"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> parameter where you may wish to use the samba password change facility, or where <span class="application">smbclient</span> may need to access a local service for name resolution or for local resource -connections. (Note: the <b class="command">bind interfaces only</b> parameter deficiency +connections. (Note: the <a class="indexterm" name="id2958724"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i> parameter deficiency where it will not allow connections to the loopback address will be fixed soon). </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2958744"></a> Another common cause of these two errors is having something already running on port <tt class="constant">139</tt>, such as Samba (ie: <span class="application">smbd</span> is running from <span class="application">inetd</span> already) or @@ -178,20 +167,20 @@ messages from several hosts. If this doesn't give a similar result to the previous test then nmblookup isn't correctly getting your broadcast address through its automatic mechanism. In this case you should experiment with the -<b class="command">interfaces</b> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to manually configure your IP +<a class="indexterm" name="id2958915"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to manually configure your IP address, broadcast and netmask. </p><p> If your PC and server aren't on the same subnet then you will need to -use the <i class="parameter"><tt>-B</tt></i> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs +use the <tt class="option">-B</tt> option to set the broadcast address to that of the PCs subnet. </p><p> This test will probably fail if your subnet mask and broadcast address are not correct. (Refer to TEST 3 notes above). -</p></li><li><p> +</p></li><li><a class="indexterm" name="id2958962"></a><p> Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //BIGSERVER/TMP</tt></b>. You should then be prompted for a password. You should use the password of the account you are logged into the unix box with. If you want to test with -another account then add the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U <i class="replaceable"><tt>accountname</tt></i></tt></i> option to the end of +another account then add the <tt class="option">-U <i class="replaceable"><tt>accountname</tt></i></tt> option to the end of the command line. eg: <b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //bigserver/tmp -Ujohndoe</tt></b> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> @@ -208,14 +197,13 @@ If it says <span class="errorname">bad password</span> then the likely causes ar you have shadow passwords (or some other password system) but didn't compile in support for them in <span class="application">smbd</span> </p></li><li><p> - your <b class="command">valid users</b> configuration is incorrect + your <a class="indexterm" name="id2959084"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i> configuration is incorrect </p></li><li><p> - you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <b class="command">password - level</b> option at a high enough level + you have a mixed case password and you haven't enabled the <a class="indexterm" name="id2959107"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> option at a high enough level </p></li><li><p> - the <b class="command">path =</b> line in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Check it with <span class="application">testparm</span> + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2959129"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> line in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> is incorrect. Check it with <span class="application">testparm</span> </p></li><li><p> - you enabled password encryption but didn't map unix to samba users + you enabled password encryption but didn't map unix to samba users. Run </p><pre class="screen"><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -a <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i></tt></b></pre><p>. </p></li></ol></div><p> Once connected you should be able to use the commands <b class="command">dir</b> <b class="command">get</b> <b class="command">put</b> etc. @@ -265,14 +253,13 @@ installed or your smb.conf is incorrect. make sure your <b class="command">hosts and other config lines in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> are correct. </p><p> It's also possible that the server can't work out what user name to -connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line <i class="parameter"><tt>user = -<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i></tt></i> to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i> section of +connect you as. To see if this is the problem add the line <a class="indexterm" name="id2959420"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i> = username to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[tmp]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> is the username corresponding to the password you typed. If you find this fixes things you may need the username mapping option. </p><p> It might also be the case that your client only sends encrypted passwords -and you have <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = no</tt></i> in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +and you have <a class="indexterm" name="id2959460"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = no in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> Turn it back on to fix. </p></li><li><p> Run the command <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -M <i class="replaceable"><tt>testgroup</tt></i></tt></b> where @@ -283,20 +270,18 @@ master browser for that workgroup. If you don't then the election process has failed. Wait a minute to see if it is just being slow then try again. If it still fails after that then look at the browsing options you have set in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Make -sure you have <i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i> to ensure that +sure you have <a class="indexterm" name="id2959524"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i> = yes to ensure that an election is held at startup. </p></li><li><p> ->From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should +From file manager try to browse the server. Your samba server should appear in the browse list of your local workgroup (or the one you -specified in smb.conf). You should be able to double click on the name +specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>). You should be able to double click on the name of the server and get a list of shares. If you get a "invalid password" error when you do then you are probably running WinNT and it is refusing to browse a server that has no encrypted password capability and is in user level security mode. In this case either set -<i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> AND -<i class="parameter"><tt>password server = Windows_NT_Machine</tt></i> in your -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, or make sure <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i> is +<a class="indexterm" name="id2959575"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server AND +<a class="indexterm" name="id2959589"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> = Windows_NT_Machine in your +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, or make sure <a class="indexterm" name="id2959610"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> is set to "yes". -</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3009283"></a>Still having troubles?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Read the chapter on -<a href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and Solving Problems</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part V. Troubleshooting </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="troubleshooting.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="problems.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part V. Troubleshooting </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html b/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html index 59040dfebc..313c6e0fc7 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/domain-member.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 7. Domain Membership</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-bdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="StandAloneServer.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="domain-member"></a>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2897897">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898012">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898188">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898440">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898636">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898699">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898901">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899283">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899424">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899508">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899872">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899892">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899919">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899951">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 7. Domain Membership</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-bdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="StandAloneServer.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="domain-member"></a>Chapter 7. Domain Membership</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2890490">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891126">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891341">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891414">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892061">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892246">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892373">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892751">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892773">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892816">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892848">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892992">I can't join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> Domain Membership is a subject of vital concern, Samba must be able to participate as a member server in a Microsoft Domain security context, and Samba must be capable of providing Domain machine member trust accounts, @@ -8,12 +8,11 @@ This chapter covers background information pertaining to domain membership, Samba configuration for it, and MS Windows client procedures for joining a domain. Why is this necessary? Because both are areas in which there exists within the current MS Windows networking world and particularly in the -Unix/Linux networking and administration world, a considerable level of +UNIX/Linux networking and administration world, a considerable level of mis-information, incorrect understanding, and a lack of knowledge. Hopefully this chapter will fill the voids. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2897897"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -MS Windows workstations and servers that want to participate in domain -security need to +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890490"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +MS Windows workstations and servers that want to participate in domain security need to be made Domain members. Participating in Domain security is often called <span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span> or <span class="acronym">SSO</span> for short. This chapter describes the process that must be followed to make a workstation @@ -48,7 +47,7 @@ Domain membership has many advantages: client or server, other than the central Domain database (either NT4/Samba SAM style Domain, NT4 Domain that is back ended with an LDAP directory, or via an Active Directory infrastructure) - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2898012"></a>MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="machine-trust-accounts"></a>MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2890621"></a><p> A machine trust account is an account that is used to authenticate a client machine (rather than a user) to the Domain Controller server. In Windows terminology, @@ -73,12 +72,12 @@ as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> A Domain Security Account (stored in the - <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> that has been configured in the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2890675"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> that has been configured in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. The precise nature of the account information that is stored depends on the type of backend database that has been chosen. </p><p> The older format of this data is the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database - which contains the unix login ID, the Unix user identifier (UID), and the + which contains the UNIX login ID, the UNIX user identifier (UID), and the LanMan and NT encrypted passwords. There is also some other information in this file that we do not need to concern ourselves with here. </p><p> @@ -87,17 +86,18 @@ as follows: older <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file did. The extra information enables new user account controls to be used. </p></li><li><p> - A corresponding Unix account, typically stored in + A corresponding UNIX account, typically stored in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. Work is in progress to allow a - simplified mode of operation that does not require Unix user accounts, but + simplified mode of operation that does not require UNIX user accounts, but this may not be a feature of the early releases of Samba-3. </p></li></ul></div><p> -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2890757"></a><p> There are three ways to create machine trust accounts: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - Manual creation from the Unix/Linux command line. Here, both the Samba and - corresponding Unix account are created by hand. + Manual creation from the UNIX/Linux command line. Here, both the Samba and + corresponding UNIX account are created by hand. </p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2890790"></a> Using the MS Windows NT4 Server Manager (either from an NT4 Domain member server, or using the Nexus toolkit available from the Microsoft web site. This tool can be run from any MS Windows machine so long as the user is @@ -105,28 +105,39 @@ There are three ways to create machine trust accounts: </p></li><li><p> "On-the-fly" creation. The Samba machine trust account is automatically created by Samba at the time the client is joined to the domain. - (For security, this is the recommended method.) The corresponding Unix + (For security, this is the recommended method.) The corresponding UNIX account may be created automatically or manually. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898188"></a>Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890821"></a>Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The first step in manually creating a machine trust account is to manually -create the corresponding Unix account in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. +create the corresponding UNIX account in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. This can be done using <b class="command">vipw</b> or another 'add user' command -that is normally used to create new Unix accounts. The following is an example for a Linux based Samba server: -</p><p> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/sbin/useradd -g 100 -d /dev/null -c <i class="replaceable"><tt>"machine nickname"</tt></i> -s /bin/false <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$ </tt></b> +that is normally used to create new UNIX accounts. The following is an example for a Linux based Samba server: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890851"></a> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890859"></a> + + </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/sbin/useradd -g 100 -d /dev/null -c <i class="replaceable"><tt>"machine nickname"</tt></i> \ + -s /bin/false <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$ </tt></b> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>passwd -l <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890921"></a> On *BSD systems, this can be done using the <b class="command">chpass</b> utility: </p><p> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chpass -a "<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$:*:101:100::0:0:Workstation <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin"</tt></b> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chpass -a \ + "<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>$:*:101:100::0:0:Workstation <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i>:/dev/null:/sbin/nologin"</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry will list the machine name with a "$" appended, won't have a password, will have a null shell and no home directory. For example a machine named 'doppy' would have an <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> entry like this: </p><pre class="programlisting"> -doppy$:x:505:501:<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i>:/dev/null:/bin/false +doppy$:x:505:100:<i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i>:/dev/null:/bin/false </pre><p> Above, <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_nickname</tt></i> can be any descriptive name for the client, i.e., BasementComputer. @@ -135,9 +146,10 @@ name of the client to be joined to the domain. The "$" must be appended to the NetBIOS name of the client or Samba will not recognize this as a machine trust account. </p><p> -Now that the corresponding Unix account has been created, the next step is to create +Now that the corresponding UNIX account has been created, the next step is to create the Samba account for the client containing the well-known initial -machine trust account password. This can be done using the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html" target="_top"><b class="command">smbpasswd(8)</b></a> command +machine trust account password. This can be done using the +<b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command as shown here: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> @@ -146,28 +158,32 @@ as shown here: </p><p> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>machine_name</tt></i> is the machine's NetBIOS name. The RID of the new machine account is generated from the UID of -the corresponding Unix account. +the corresponding UNIX account. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Join the client to the domain immediately</h3><p> Manually creating a machine trust account using this method is the equivalent of creating a machine trust account on a Windows NT PDC using + <a class="indexterm" name="id2891100"></a> the <span class="application">Server Manager</span>. From the time at which the account is created to the time which the client joins the domain and changes the password, your domain is vulnerable to an intruder joining your domain using a machine with the same NetBIOS name. A PDC inherently trusts members of the domain and will serve out a large degree of user information to such clients. You have been warned! - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898440"></a>Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891126"></a>Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the machine from which you are trying to manage the domain is an -<span class="application">MS Windows NT4 workstation</span> +<span class="application">MS Windows NT4 workstation or MS Windows 200x / XP Professional</span> then the tool of choice is the package called <b class="command">SRVTOOLS.EXE</b>. -When executed in the target directory this will unpack -<b class="command">SrvMge.exe</b> and <b class="command">UsrMgr.exe</b> (both are -Domain Management tools for MS Windows NT4 workstation. +When executed in the target directory this will unpack <b class="command">SrvMge.exe</b> +and <b class="command">UsrMgr.exe</b> (both are domain management tools for MS Windows NT4 workstation). +</p><p> +If your workstation is a <span class="application">Microsoft Windows 9x/Me</span> family product + you should download the <b class="command">Nexus.exe</b> package from the Microsoft web site. +When executed from the target directory this will unpack the same tools but for use on +this platform. </p><p> -If your workstation is any other MS Windows product you should download the -<b class="command">Nexus.exe</b> package from the Microsoft web site. When executed -from the target directory this will unpack the same tools but for use on -<span class="application">MS Windows 9x/Me/200x/XP</span>. +Further information about these tools may be obtained from the following locations: +<a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;173673" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;173673</a> +<a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;172540" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;172540</a> </p><p> Launch the <b class="command">srvmgr.exe</b> (Server Manager for Domains) and follow these steps: </p><div class="procedure"><p class="title"><b>Procedure 7.1. Server Manager Account Machine Account Management</b></p><ol type="1"><li><p> @@ -187,25 +203,21 @@ Launch the <b class="command">srvmgr.exe</b> (Server Manager for Domains) and fo <span class="guilabel">Add NT Workstation of Server</span>, then enter the machine name in the field provided, then click the <span class="guibutton">Add</span> button. - </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898636"></a>"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891341"></a>"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The second (and recommended) way of creating machine trust accounts is simply to allow the Samba server to create them as needed when the client is joined to the domain. -</p><p>Since each Samba machine trust account requires a corresponding Unix account, a method -for automatically creating the Unix account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the -<a href="smb.conf.5.html#ADDMACHINESCRIPT" target="_top">add machine script</a> option in -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This method is not required, however; corresponding Unix +</p><p>Since each Samba machine trust account requires a corresponding UNIX account, a method +for automatically creating the UNIX account is usually supplied; this requires configuration of the +add machine script option in +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This method is not required, however; corresponding UNIX accounts may also be created manually. </p><p> Below is an example for a RedHat Linux system. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - # <...remainder of parameters...> - add machine script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 -s /bin/false -M %u -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898699"></a>Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># <...remainder of parameters...></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script = /usr/sbin/useradd -d /dev/null -g 100 -s /bin/false -M %u </tt></i></td></tr></table></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891414"></a>Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The procedure for making an MS Windows workstation of server a member of the domain varies with the version of Windows: -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2898711"></a>Windows 200x XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891426"></a>Windows 200x XP Professional</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> When the user elects to make the client a domain member, Windows 200x prompts for an account and password that has privileges to create machine accounts in the domain. A Samba administrative account (i.e., a Samba account that has root privileges on the @@ -219,13 +231,13 @@ with the version of Windows: The name of the account that is used to create domain member machine accounts can be anything the network administrator may choose. If it is other than <span class="emphasis"><em>root</em></span> then this is easily mapped to root using the file pointed to be the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter - <i class="parameter"><tt>username map = /etc/samba/smbusers</tt></i>. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2891478"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i> = /etc/samba/smbusers. </p><p> The session key of the Samba administrative account acts as an encryption key for setting the password of the machine trust account. The machine trust account will be created on-the-fly, or updated if it already exists. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2898779"></a>Windows NT4</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891503"></a>Windows NT4</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the machine trust account was created manually, on the Identification Changes menu enter the domain name, but do not check the box <span class="guilabel">Create a Computer Account in the Domain</span>. @@ -238,8 +250,8 @@ with the version of Windows: Domain</span>. In this case, joining the domain proceeds as above for Windows 2000 (i.e., you must supply a Samba administrative account when prompted). - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2898820"></a>Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Joining a Samba client to a domain is documented in - the <a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server" title="Domain Member Server">Domain Member Server</a> section of this chapter chapter. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2891543"></a>Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>Joining a Samba client to a domain is documented in + <a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server" title="Domain Member Server">the domain member chapter</a>. </p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="domain-member-server"></a>Domain Member Server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This mode of server operation involves the Samba machine being made a member of a domain security context. This means by definition that all user @@ -255,46 +267,38 @@ This can be LDAP (from OpenLDAP), or Sun's iPlanet, of NetWare Directory Server, etc. </em></span> </p><p> -Please refer to the <a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control chapter</a> +Please refer to <a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">the chapter on setting up a PDC</a> for more information regarding how to create a domain machine account for a domain member server as well as for information regarding how to enable the Samba domain member machine to join the domain and to be fully trusted by it. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898901"></a>Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2898912"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 7.1. Assumptions</b></p><table summary="Assumptions" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">SERV1</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Win2K/NT domain name:</td><td align="left">DOM</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's PDC NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">DOMPDC</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's BDC NetBIOS names:</td><td align="left">DOMBDC1 and DOMBDC2</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2891624"></a>Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2891635"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 7.1. Assumptions</b></p><table summary="Assumptions" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">SERV1</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Win2K/NT domain name:</td><td align="left">MIDEARTH</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's PDC NetBIOS name:</td><td align="left">DOMPDC</td></tr><tr><td align="left">Domain's BDC NetBIOS names:</td><td align="left">DOMBDC1 and DOMBDC2</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> First, you must edit your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to tell Samba it should now use domain security. </p><p> -Change (or add) your <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITY" target="_top"> -<i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a> line in the [global] section + Change (or add) your + <a class="indexterm" name="id2891708"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> line in the [global] section of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> to read: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -security = domain -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> -Next change the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> -workgroup</tt></i></a> line in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> +Next change the <a class="indexterm" name="id2891752"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> line in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section to read: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -workgroup = DOM -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> as this is the name of the domain we are joining. </p><p> -You must also have the parameter <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top"> -<i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i></a> set to <tt class="constant">yes +You must also have the parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2891802"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> set to <tt class="constant">yes </tt> in order for your users to authenticate to the NT PDC. </p><p> -Finally, add (or modify) a <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSWORDSERVER" target="_top"> -<i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i></a> line in the [global] +Finally, add (or modify) a <a class="indexterm" name="id2891826"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i> line in the [global] section to read: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2 -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = DOMPDC DOMBDC1 DOMBDC2</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> These are the primary and backup domain controllers Samba will attempt to contact in order to authenticate users. Samba will @@ -306,9 +310,7 @@ Alternatively, if you want smbd to automatically determine the list of Domain controllers to use for authentication, you may set this line to be: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -password server = * -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>password server = *</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> This method allows Samba to use exactly the same mechanism that NT does. This method either broadcasts or uses a WINS database in order to @@ -317,7 +319,7 @@ find domain controllers to authenticate against. In order to actually join the domain, you must run this command: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -S DOMPDC -U<i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator%password</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc join -S DOMPDC -U<i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator%password</tt></i></tt></b> </pre><p> </p><p> If the <tt class="option">-S DOMPDC</tt> argument is not given then @@ -334,8 +336,8 @@ you will see the message: <tt class="computeroutput">Joined domain DOM.</tt> or <tt class="computeroutput">Joined 'SERV1' to realm 'MYREALM'</tt> </p><p> -in your terminal window. See the <a href="net.8.html" target="_top"> -net(8)</a> man page for more details. +in your terminal window. See the +<b class="command">net</b> man page for more details. </p><p> This process joins the server to the domain without having to create the machine trust account on the PDC beforehand. @@ -353,21 +355,25 @@ security for your system, and should be treated as carefully as a shadow password file. </p><p> Finally, restart your Samba daemons and get ready for -clients to begin using domain security! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899283"></a>Why is this better than security = server?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +clients to begin using domain security! The way you can restart your +samba daemons depends on your distribution, but in most cases running +</p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt>/etc/init.d/samba restart +</pre><p> +does the job. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892061"></a>Why is this better than security = server?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Currently, domain security in Samba doesn't free you from -having to create local Unix users to represent the users attaching +having to create local UNIX users to represent the users attaching to your server. This means that if domain user <tt class="constant">DOM\fred </tt> attaches to your domain security Samba server, there needs -to be a local Unix user fred to represent that user in the Unix +to be a local UNIX user fred to represent that user in the UNIX filesystem. This is very similar to the older Samba security mode -<a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSSERVER" target="_top">security = server</a>, +security = server, where Samba would pass through the authentication request to a Windows NT server in the same way as a Windows 95 or Windows 98 server would. </p><p> -Please refer to the <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">Winbind</a> chapter -for information on a system to automatically -assign UNIX uids and gids to Windows NT Domain users and groups. + Please refer to <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts">the chapter on winbind</a> for information on a system +to automatically assign UNIX uids and gids to Windows NT Domain users and groups. </p><p> The advantage to domain-level security is that the authentication in domain-level security is passed down the authenticated @@ -377,11 +383,11 @@ exactly the same way NT servers do (i.e., you can add Samba servers into a resource domain and have the authentication passed on from a resource domain PDC to an account domain PDC). </p><p> -In addition, with <i class="parameter"><tt>security = server</tt></i> every Samba +In addition, with <a class="indexterm" name="id2892116"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = server every Samba daemon on a server has to keep a connection open to the authenticating server for as long as that daemon lasts. This can drain the connection resources on a Microsoft NT server and cause it to run -out of available connections. With <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i>, +out of available connections. With <a class="indexterm" name="id2892135"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain, however, the Samba daemons connect to the PDC/BDC only for as long as is necessary to authenticate the user, and then drop the connection, thus conserving PDC connection resources. @@ -395,41 +401,39 @@ Much of the text of this document was first published in the Web magazine <a href="http://www.linuxworld.com" target="_top">LinuxWorld</a> as the article <a href="http://www.linuxworld.com/linuxworld/lw-1998-10/lw-10-samba.html" target="_top">Doing the NIS/NT Samba</a>. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="ads-member"></a>Samba ADS Domain Membership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="ads-member"></a>Samba ADS Domain Membership</h2></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2892203"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2892211"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2892223"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2892231"></a><p> This is a rough guide to setting up Samba 3.0 with Kerberos authentication against a Windows2000 KDC. A familiarity with Kerberos is assumed. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899424"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892246"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must use at least the following 3 options in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - realm = your.kerberos.REALM - security = ADS - encrypt passwords = yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>realm = your.kerberos.REALM</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = ADS</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> In case samba can't figure out your ads server using your realm name, use the -<i class="parameter"><tt>ads server</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - ads server = your.kerberos.server -</pre><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2892305"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server = your.kerberos.server</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> You do <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> need a smbpasswd file, and older clients will be authenticated as -if <i class="parameter"><tt>security = domain</tt></i>, although it won't do any harm and +if <a class="indexterm" name="id2892352"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = domain, although it won't do any harm and allows you to have local users not in the domain. It is expected that the above required options will change soon when active directory integration will get better. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899508"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892373"></a>Setup your <tt class="filename">/etc/krb5.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The minimal configuration for <tt class="filename">krb5.conf</tt> is: </p><pre class="programlisting"> +[libdefaults] + default_realm = YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM + [realms] - YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { - kdc = your.kerberos.server + YOUR.KERBEROS.REALM = { + kdc = your.kerberos.server } -</pre><p> +</pre><a class="indexterm" name="id2892409"></a><p> Test your config by doing a <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i>@<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i></tt></b> and making sure that your password is accepted by the Win2000 KDC. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The realm must be uppercase or you will get <span class="errorname">Cannot find KDC for -requested realm while getting initial credentials</span> error. +requested realm while getting initial credentials</span> error (Kerberos +is case-sensitive!). </p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Time between the two servers must be synchronized. You will get a <span class="errorname">kinit(v5): Clock skew too great while getting initial credentials</span> @@ -454,13 +458,13 @@ is only needed if you want Kerberos support for <span class="application">smbd</ </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-create-machine-account"></a>Create the computer account</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> As a user that has write permission on the Samba private directory (usually root) run: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net join -U Administrator%password</tt></b> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads join -U Administrator%password</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2899718"></a>Possible errors</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2892592"></a>Possible errors</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">ADS support not compiled in</span></span></dt><dd><p>Samba must be reconfigured (remove config.cache) and recompiled (make clean all install) after the Kerberos libs and headers are installed. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">net join prompts for user name</span></span></dt><dd><p>You need to login to the domain using <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><span class="errorname">net ads join prompts for user name</span></span></dt><dd><p>You need to login to the domain using <b class="userinput"><tt>kinit <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i>@<i class="replaceable"><tt>REALM</tt></i></tt></b>. <i class="replaceable"><tt>USERNAME</tt></i> must be a user who has rights to add a machine to the domain. </p></dd></dl></div><p> @@ -473,41 +477,41 @@ On a Windows 2000 client try <b class="userinput"><tt>net use * \\server\share</ be logged in with Kerberos without needing to know a password. If this fails then run <b class="userinput"><tt>klist tickets</tt></b>. Did you get a ticket for the server? Does it have an encoding type of DES-CBC-MD5 ? -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-smbclient"></a>Testing with <span class="application">smbclient</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="ads-test-smbclient"></a>Testing with <span class="application">smbclient</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2892719"></a><p> On your Samba server try to login to a Win2000 server or your Samba server using <span class="application">smbclient</span> and Kerberos. Use <span class="application">smbclient</span> as usual, but -specify the <i class="parameter"><tt>-k</tt></i> option to choose Kerberos authentication. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899872"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +specify the <tt class="option">-k</tt> option to choose Kerberos authentication. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892751"></a>Notes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You must change administrator password at least once after DC install, to create the right encoding types </p><p> W2k doesn't seem to create the _kerberos._udp and _ldap._tcp in -their defaults DNS setup. Maybe fixed in service packs? -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2899892"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +their defaults DNS setup. Maybe this will be fixed later in service packs. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892773"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the process of adding / deleting / re-adding domain member machine accounts there are many traps for the unwary player and there are many “<span class="quote">little</span>” things that can go wrong. It is particularly interesting how often subscribers on the samba mailing list have concluded after repeated failed attempts to add a machine account that it is necessary to "re-install" MS Windows on t he machine. In truth, it is seldom necessary to reinstall because of this type of problem. The real solution is often very simple, and with understanding of how MS Windows -networking functions. easily overcome. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899919"></a>Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -<span class="emphasis"><em>Problem:</em></span> A Windows workstation was reinstalled. The original domain machine +networking functions easy to overcome. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892816"></a>Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +“<span class="quote"> A Windows workstation was reinstalled. The original domain machine account was deleted and added immediately. The workstation will not join the domain if I use the same machine name. Attempts to add the machine fail with a message that the machine already -exists on the network - I know it doesn't. Why is this failing? +exists on the network - I know it doesn't. Why is this failing?</span>” </p><p> The original name is still in the NetBIOS name cache and must expire after machine account deletion BEFORE adding that same name as a domain member again. The best advice is to delete the old account and then to add the machine with a new name. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899951"></a>Adding Machine to Domain Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Adding a Windows 200x or XP Professional machine to the Samba PDC Domain fails with a +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892848"></a>Adding Machine to Domain Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">Adding a Windows 200x or XP Professional machine to the Samba PDC Domain fails with a message that, <span class="errorname">The machine could not be added at this time, there is a network problem. -Please try again later.</span> Why? + Please try again later.</span> Why?</span>” </p><p> -You should check that there is an <i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> +You should check that there is an <a class="indexterm" name="id2892875"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. If there is not, please add one that is appropriate for your OS platform. If a script -has been defined you will need to debug it's operation. Increase the <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> +has been defined you will need to debug it's operation. Increase the <a class="indexterm" name="id2892900"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file to level 10, then try to rejoin the domain. Check the logs to see which operation is failing. </p><p> @@ -516,13 +520,15 @@ Possible causes include: The script does not actually exist, or could not be located in the path specified. </p><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective Action:</em></span> Fix it. Make sure that when run manually - that the script will add both the Unix system account _and_ the Samba SAM account. + that the script will add both the UNIX system account _and_ the Samba SAM account. </p></li><li><p> - The machine could not be added to the Unix system accounts file <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> + The machine could not be added to the UNIX system accounts file <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> </p><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective Action:</em></span> Check that the machine name is a legal Unix - system account name. ie: If the Unix utility <b class="command">useradd</b> is called + <span class="emphasis"><em>Corrective Action:</em></span> Check that the machine name is a legal UNIX + system account name. ie: If the UNIX utility <b class="command">useradd</b> is called then make sure that the machine name you are trying to add can be added using this tool. <b class="command">Useradd</b> on some systems will not allow any upper case characters nor will it allow spaces in the name. - </p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-bdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="StandAloneServer.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892992"></a>I can't join a Windows 2003 PDC</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Windows 2003 requires SMB signing. Client side SMB signing has + only been implemented partially in Samba 3.0. Set <a class="indexterm" name="id2893004"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>client use spnego</tt></i> = no when communicating + with a windows 2003 server. </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-bdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="StandAloneServer.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html b/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html index 39fb34ce62..39d317e8cf 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/groupmapping.html @@ -1,43 +1,48 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"><link rel="next" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="groupmapping"></a>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jean François</span> <span class="surname">Micouleau</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921449">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921551">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921742">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921806">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921820">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921889">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921981">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921997">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2922057">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases"><link rel="next" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="groupmapping"></a>Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jean François</span> <span class="surname">Micouleau</span></h3></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903416">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903652">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903718">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903732">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903817">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903900">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903915">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903984">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2904010">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2903109"></a><p> Starting with Samba-3, new group mapping functionality is available to create associations - between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. The <i class="parameter"><tt>groupmap</tt></i> subcommand + between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. The <b class="command">groupmap</b> subcommand included with the <span class="application">net</span> tool can be used to manage these associations. </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> The first immediate reason to use the group mapping on a Samba PDC, is that + <a class="indexterm" name="id2903150"></a> the <i class="parameter"><tt>domain admin group</tt></i> has been removed and should no longer be specified in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. This parameter was used to give the listed users membership in the <tt class="constant">Domain Admins</tt> Windows group which gave local admin rights on their workstations (in default configurations). - </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921449"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903181"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba allows the administrator to create MS Windows NT4 / 200x group accounts and to - arbitrarily associate them with Unix/Linux group accounts. - </p><p> - Group accounts can be managed using the MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows 200x MMC tools - so long as appropriate interface scripts have been provided to <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. - </p><p> + arbitrarily associate them with UNIX/Linux group accounts. + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2903197"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2903205"></a><p> + Group accounts can be managed using the MS Windows NT4 or MS Windows 200x / XP Professional MMC tools. + Appropriate interface scripts should be provided in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> if it is desired that UNIX / Linux system + accounts should be automatically created when these tools are used. In the absence of these scripts, and + so long as winbind is running, Samba accounts group accounts that are created using these tools will be + allocated UNIX UIDs/GIDs from the parameters set by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2903232"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i>/<a class="indexterm" name="id2903245"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> settings + in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-group-diag"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 12.1. IDMAP groups</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap-groups.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP groups"></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2903314"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2903322"></a><p> Administrators should be aware that where <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> group interface scripts make - direct calls to the Unix/Linux system tools (eg: the shadow utilities, <b class="command">groupadd</b>, - <b class="command">groupdel</b>, <b class="command">groupmod</b>) then the resulting Unix/Linux group names will be subject + direct calls to the UNIX/Linux system tools (eg: the shadow utilities, <b class="command">groupadd</b>, + <b class="command">groupdel</b>, <b class="command">groupmod</b>) then the resulting UNIX/Linux group names will be subject to any limits imposed by these tools. If the tool does NOT allow upper case characters or space characters, then the creation of an MS Windows NT4 / 200x style group of - <i class="parameter"><tt>Engineering Managers</tt></i> will attempt to create an identically named - Unix/Linux group, an attempt that will of course fail! - </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>Engineering Managers</em></span> will attempt to create an identically named + UNIX/Linux group, an attempt that will of course fail! + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2903374"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2903382"></a><p> There are several possible work-arounds for the operating system tools limitation. One - method is to use a script that generates a name for the Unix/Linux system group that - fits the operating system limits, and that then just passes the Unix/Linux group id (GID) + method is to use a script that generates a name for the UNIX/Linux system group that + fits the operating system limits, and that then just passes the UNIX/Linux group id (GID) back to the calling Samba interface. This will provide a dynamic work-around solution. </p><p> - Another work-around is to manually create a Unix/Linux group, then manually create the + Another work-around is to manually create a UNIX/Linux group, then manually create the MS Windows NT4 / 200x group on the Samba server and then use the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> tool to connect the two to each other. - </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921551"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903416"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> When installing <span class="application">MS Windows NT4 / 200x</span> on a computer, the installation program creates default users and groups, notably the <tt class="constant">Administrators</tt> group, and gives that group privileges necessary privileges to perform essential system tasks. eg: Ability to change the date and time or to kill (or close) any process running on the local machine. - </p><p> + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2903445"></a><p> The 'Administrator' user is a member of the 'Administrators' group, and thus inherits 'Administrators' group privileges. If a 'joe' user is created to be a member of the 'Administrator' group, 'joe' has exactly the same rights as 'Administrator'. @@ -59,49 +64,49 @@ </p></li><li><p> Map this domadm group to the "Domain Admins" group by running the command: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=domadm</tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add ntgroup="Domain Admins" unixgroup=domadm</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2903569"></a><p> The quotes around "Domain Admins" are necessary due to the space in the group name. Also make sure to leave no whitespace surrounding the equal character (=). </p></li></ol></div><p> Now joe, john and mary are domain administrators! - </p><p> + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2903594"></a><p> It is possible to map any arbitrary UNIX group to any Windows NT4 / 200x group as well as making any UNIX group a Windows domain group. For example, if you wanted to include a UNIX group (e.g. acct) in a ACL on a local file or printer on a domain member machine, you would flag that group as a domain group by running the following on the Samba PDC: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup="Accounting" unixgroup=acct</tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap add rid=1000 ntgroup="Accounting" unixgroup=acct</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> Be aware that the RID parameter is a unsigned 32 bit integer that should normally start at 1000. However, this rid must not overlap with any RID assigned - to a user. Verifying this is done differently depending on on the passdb backend + to a user. Verifying this is done differently depending on the passdb backend you are using. Future versions of the tools may perform the verification automatically, but for now the burden is on you. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921742"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903652"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can list the various groups in the mapping database by executing <b class="command">net groupmap list</b>. Here is an example: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b> - System Administrators (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-1002) -> sysadmin - Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -> domadmin - Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -> domuser - Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -> domguest - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net groupmap list</tt></b> +System Administrators (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-1002) -> sysadmin +Domain Admins (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-512) -> domadmin +Domain Users (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-513) -> domuser +Domain Guests (S-1-5-21-2547222302-1596225915-2414751004-514) -> domguest +</pre><p> </p><p> For complete details on <b class="command">net groupmap</b>, refer to the net(8) man page. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921806"></a>Configuration Scripts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903718"></a>Configuration Scripts</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Everyone needs tools. Some of us like to create our own, others prefer to use canned tools (ie: prepared by someone else for general use). - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921820"></a>Sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> add group script</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - A script to great complying group names for use by the Samba group interfaces: + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903732"></a>Sample <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> add group script</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A script to create complying group names for use by the Samba group interfaces: </p><p> -</p><div class="example"><a name="id2921843"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.1. smbgrpadd.sh</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2903754"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 12.1. smbgrpadd.sh</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/bash @@ -120,12 +125,10 @@ exit 0 </pre></div><p> </p><p> The <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> entry for the above script would look like: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - add group script = /path_to_tool/smbgrpadd.sh %g - </pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921889"></a>Script to configure Group Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - In our example we have created a Unix/Linux group called <i class="parameter"><tt>ntadmin</tt></i>. - Our script will create the additional groups <i class="parameter"><tt>Engineers, Marketoids, Gnomes</tt></i>: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script = /path_to_tool/smbgrpadd.sh %g</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903817"></a>Script to configure Group Mapping</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In our example we have created a UNIX/Linux group called <span class="emphasis"><em>ntadmin</em></span>. + Our script will create the additional groups <span class="emphasis"><em>Orks</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>Elves</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>Gnomes</em></span>: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/bash @@ -143,36 +146,51 @@ net groupmap modify ntgroup="Print Operators" unixgroup=lp net groupmap modify ntgroup="Replicators" unixgroup=daemon net groupmap modify ntgroup="Power Users" unixgroup=sys -#groupadd Engineers -#groupadd Marketoids -#groupadd Gnomes +groupadd Orks +groupadd Elves +groupadd Gnomes -#net groupmap add ntgroup="Engineers" unixgroup=Engineers type=d -#net groupmap add ntgroup="Marketoids" unixgroup=Marketoids type=d -#net groupmap add ntgroup="Gnomes" unixgroup=Gnomes type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Orks" unixgroup=Orks type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Elves" unixgroup=Elves type=d +net groupmap add ntgroup="Gnomes" unixgroup=Gnomes type=d </pre><p> </p><p> Of course it is expected that the administrator will modify this to suit local needs. For information regarding the use of the <b class="command">net groupmap</b> tool please refer to the man page. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921981"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2903900"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> At this time there are many little surprises for the unwary administrator. In a real sense it is imperative that every step of automated control scripts must be carefully tested manually before putting them into active service. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921997"></a>Adding Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903915"></a>Adding Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is a common problem when the <b class="command">groupadd</b> is called directly - by the Samba interface script for the <i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i> in + by the Samba interface script for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2903935"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> The most common cause of failure is an attempt to add an MS Windows group account that has either an upper case character and/or a space character in it. </p><p> There are three possible work-arounds. Firstly, use only group names that comply - with the limitations of the Unix/Linux <b class="command">groupadd</b> system tool. + with the limitations of the UNIX/Linux <b class="command">groupadd</b> system tool. The second involves use of the script mentioned earlier in this chapter, and the - third option is to manually create a Unix/Linux group account that can substitute + third option is to manually create a UNIX/Linux group account that can substitute for the MS Windows group name, then use the procedure listed above to map that group to the MS Windows group. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922057"></a>Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2903984"></a>Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2903992"></a><p> Samba-3 does NOT support nested groups from the MS Windows control environment. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2904010"></a>Adding <span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Users</em></span> to the <span class="emphasis"><em>Power Users</em></span> group</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote"> + What must I do to add Domain Users to the Power Users group? + </span>”</p><p> + The Power Users group is a group that is local to each Windows + 200x / XP Professional workstation. You can not add the Domain Users group to the Power Users + group automatically, this must be done on each workstation by logging in as the local workstation + <span class="emphasis"><em>administrator</em></span> and then using click on Start / Control Panel / Users and Passwords + now click on the 'Advanced' tab, then on the 'Advanced' Button. + </p><a class="indexterm" name="id2904048"></a><p> + Now click on 'Groups', then double click on 'Power Users'. This will launch the panel to add users + or groups to the local machine 'Power Uses' group. Click on the 'Add' button, select the domain + from which the 'Domain Users' group is to be added, double click on the 'Domain Users' group, then + click on the 'Ok' button. Note: If a logon box is presented during this process please remember to + enter the connect as DOMAIN\UserName. ie: For the domain MIDEARTH and the user 'root' enter + MIDEARTH\root. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="passdb.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AccessControls.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/install.html b/docs/htmldocs/install.html index 154b9705e1..02264c558d 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/install.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/install.html @@ -1,48 +1,39 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"><link rel="next" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="install"></a>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Karl</span> <span class="surname">Auer</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886868">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2886909">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886946">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887096">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2887140">Try listing the shares available on your - server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887191">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887292">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887355">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887388">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2887401">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887617">I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886868"></a>Obtaining and installing samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"><link rel="previous" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"><link rel="next" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="install"></a>Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Karl</span> <span class="surname">Auer</span></h3></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2883917">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2883961">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2883999">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884191">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2884236">Try listing the shares available on your + server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884294">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884411">Try connecting from another SMB client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884494">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884528">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2884539">Large number of smbd processes</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884640">"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884661">"The network name cannot be found"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2883917"></a>Obtaining and installing samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Binary packages of samba are included in almost any Linux or - Unix distribution. There are also some packages available at + UNIX distribution. There are also some packages available at <a href="http://samba.org/" target="_top">the samba homepage</a>. - </p><p>If you need to compile samba from source, check the - <a href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile SAMBA">appropriate appendix chapter</a>.</p><p>If you have already installed samba, or if your operating system + </p><p>If you need to compile samba from source, check + <a href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile Samba">the chapter about compiling samba from scratch</a>.</p><p>If you have already installed samba, or if your operating system was pre-installed with samba, then you may not need to bother with this chapter. On the other hand, you may want to read this chapter anyhow - for information about updating samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886909"></a>Configuring samba (smb.conf)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + for information about updating samba.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2883961"></a>Configuring samba (smb.conf)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba's configuration is stored in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, that usually resides in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt> or <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt>. You can either edit this file yourself or do it using one of the many graphical tools that are available, such as the web-based interface swat, that is included with samba. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2886946"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2883999"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are sample configuration files in the examples subdirectory in the distribution. I suggest you read them carefully so you can see how the options go together in practice. See the man page for all the options. </p><p> The simplest useful configuration file would be something like this: </p><p> - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - workgroup = MYGROUP - - [homes] - guest ok = no - read only = no - </pre><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2884022"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 2.1. Simplest possible smb.conf file</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> This will allow connections by anyone with an account on the server, using either - their login name or "<i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i>" as the service name. + their login name or <i class="parameter"><tt>homes</tt></i>" as the service name. (Note that the workgroup that Samba must also be set.) </p><p> - Make sure you put the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the same place - you specified in the <tt class="filename">Makefile</tt> (the default is to - look for it in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/</tt>). + Make sure you put the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the correct place + (usually in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba</tt>). </p><p> For more information about security settings for the - <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share please refer to the chapter - <a href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">Securing Samba</a>. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2887041"></a>Test your config file with <b class="command">testparm</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share please refer to + <a href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">"Securing Samba"</a>. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2884137"></a>Test your config file with <b class="command">testparm</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> It's important that you test the validity of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file using the <span class="application">testparm</span> program. If testparm runs OK then it will list the loaded services. If not it will give an error message. @@ -50,7 +41,7 @@ Make sure it runs OK and that the services look reasonable before proceeding. </p><p> Always run testparm again when you change <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>! - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887096"></a>SWAT</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884191"></a>SWAT</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> SWAT is a web-based interface that helps you configure samba. SWAT might not be available in the samba package on your platform, but in a separate package. Please read the swat manpage @@ -66,9 +57,10 @@ machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent in the clear over the wire. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887140"></a>Try listing the shares available on your - server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L - <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>You should get back a list of shares available on + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884236"></a>Try listing the shares available on your + server</h2></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p>You should get back a list of shares available on your server. If you don't then something is incorrectly setup. Note that this method can also be used to see what shares are available on other LanManager clients (such as WfWg).</p><p>If you choose user level security then you may find @@ -76,68 +68,31 @@ See the <b class="command">smbclient</b> man page for details. (you can force it to list the shares without a password by adding the option -U% to the command line. This will not work - with non-Samba servers)</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887191"></a>Try connecting with the unix client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient <i class="replaceable"><tt> - //yourhostname/aservice</tt></i></tt></b></p><p>Typically the <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i> + with non-Samba servers)</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884294"></a>Try connecting with the unix client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient <i class="replaceable"><tt> //yourhostname/aservice</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p>Typically the <i class="replaceable"><tt>yourhostname</tt></i> would be the name of the host where you installed <span class="application">smbd</span>. The <i class="replaceable"><tt>aservice</tt></i> is any service you have defined in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. Try your user name if you just have a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> section in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>For example if your unix host is <i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i> - and your login name is <i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> you would type:</p><p><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //<i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>/<i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> - </tt></b></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887292"></a>Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Try mounting disks. eg:</p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use d: \\servername\service - </tt></b></p><p>Try printing. eg:</p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: - \\servername\spoolservice</tt></b></p><p><tt class="prompt">C:\WINDOWS\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>print filename - </tt></b></p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887355"></a>What If Things Don't Work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Then you might read the file chapter - <a href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">Diagnosis</a> and the - FAQ. If you are still stuck then try to follow - the <a href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and Solving Problems chapter</a> - Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide, - so maybe someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it. </p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887388"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The following questions and issues get raised on the samba mailing list over and over again. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887401"></a>Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -“<span class="quote"> -Site that is running Samba on an AIX box. They are sharing out about 2 terabytes using samba. -Samba was installed using smitty and the binaries. We seem to be experiencing a memory problem -with this box. When I do a <b class="command">svmon -Pu</b> the monitoring program shows that <span class="application">smbd</span> has several -processes of smbd running: -</span>” -</p><p> - “<span class="quote"> -Is samba suppose to start this many different smbd processes? Or does it run as one smbd process? Also -is it normal for it to be taking up this much memory? -</span>” -</p><p> + and your login name is <i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i> you would type:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //<i class="replaceable"><tt>bambi</tt></i>/<i class="replaceable"><tt>fred</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884411"></a>Try connecting from another SMB client</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Try mounting disks. from a DOS, Windows or OS/2 client, eg:</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use d: \\servername\service</tt></b> +</pre><p>Try printing. eg:</p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -Inuse * 4096 = amount of memory being used by this process - - Pid Command Inuse Pin Pgsp Virtual 64-bit Mthrd - 20950 smbd 33098 1906 181 5017 N N - 22262 smbd 9104 1906 5410 - 21060 smbd 9048 1906 181 5479 N N - 25972 smbd 8678 1906 181 5109 N N - 24524 smbd 8674 1906 181 5105 N N - 19262 smbd 8582 1906 181 5013 N N - 20722 smbd 8572 1906 181 5003 N N - 21454 smbd 8572 1906 181 5003 N N - 28946 smbd 8567 1906 181 4996 N N - 24076 smbd 8566 1906 181 4996 N N - 20138 smbd 8566 1906 181 4996 N N - 17608 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 21820 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 26940 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 19884 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 9912 smbd 8565 1906 181 4996 N N - 25800 smbd 8564 1906 181 4995 N N - 20452 smbd 8564 1906 181 4995 N N - 18592 smbd 8562 1906 181 4993 N N - 28216 smbd 8521 1906 181 4954 N N - 19110 smbd 8404 1906 181 4862 N N - - Total memory used: 841,592,832 bytes +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use lpt1: \\servername\spoolservice</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p><p> +</p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>print filename</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884494"></a>What If Things Don't Work?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Then you might read the file chapter <a href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">diagnosis</a> + and the FAQ. If you are still stuck then refer to <a href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">"Analysing and solving problems"</a>. + Samba has been successfully installed at thousands of sites worldwide, + so maybe someone else has hit your problem and has overcome it.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2884528"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The following questions and issues get raised on the samba mailing list over and over again. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884539"></a>Large number of smbd processes</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba consists on three core programs: <span class="application">nmbd</span>, <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">winbindd</span>. <span class="application">nmbd</span> is the name server message daemon, <span class="application">smbd</span> is the server message daemon, <span class="application">winbindd</span> is the daemon that @@ -152,4 +107,9 @@ connection made. That is why you are seeing so many of them, one (1) per client </p><p> <span class="application">winbindd</span> will run as one or two daemons, depending on whether or not it is being run in "split mode" (in which case there will be two instances). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887617"></a>I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Your loopback device isn't working correctly. Make sure it's running. </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884640"></a>"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Your loopback device isn't working correctly. Make sure it's configured properly. The loopback device is an internal (virtual) network device with + the ip address 127.0.0.1. Read your OS documentation for details + on how to configure the loopback on your system.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2884661"></a>"<span class="errorname">The network name cannot be found</span>"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This error can be caused by one of these misconfigurations: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You specified an nonexisting <a class="indexterm" name="id2884686"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> for the share in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> </p></li><li><p>The user you are trying to access the share with does not + have sufficient permissions to access the <a class="indexterm" name="id2884714"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> for the share. Both read (r) and access (x) should be possible.</p></li><li><p>The share you are trying to access does not exist.</p></li></ul></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="IntroSMB.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="introduction.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="FastStart.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html b/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html index 083aeed9f3..73971d2a72 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/integrate-ms-networks.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication"><link rel="next" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="integrate-ms-networks"></a>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (Jan 01 2001) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999705">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999730">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999775">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999831">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999956">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000000">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000042">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000130">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000278">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000323">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000567">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000600">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000624">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000695">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000711">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000742">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000794">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication"><link rel="next" href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="integrate-ms-networks"></a>Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate"> (Jan 01 2001) </p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951812">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951838">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951903">Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951960">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952110">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952153">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952204">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952319">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952629">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952692">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952854">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952886">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952918">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953036">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953052">Pinging works only in one way</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953086">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953137">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2951782"></a><p> This section deals with NetBIOS over TCP/IP name to IP address resolution. If your MS Windows clients are NOT configured to use NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section does not apply to your installation. If your installation involves use of @@ -9,15 +9,15 @@ NetBIOS over TCP/IP then this section may help you to resolve networking problem to NOT run NetBEUI at all. Note also that there is NO such thing as NetBEUI over TCP/IP - the existence of such a protocol is a complete and utter mis-apprehension. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999705"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2951812"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many MS Windows network administrators have never been exposed to basic TCP/IP -networking as it is implemented in a Unix/Linux operating system. Likewise, many Unix and +networking as it is implemented in a UNIX/Linux operating system. Likewise, many UNIX and Linux administrators have not been exposed to the intricacies of MS Windows TCP/IP based networking (and may have no desire to be either). </p><p> This chapter gives a short introduction to the basics of how a name can be resolved to it's IP address for each operating system environment. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999730"></a>Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2951838"></a>Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since the introduction of MS Windows 2000 it is possible to run MS Windows networking without the use of NetBIOS over TCP/IP. NetBIOS over TCP/IP uses UDP port 137 for NetBIOS name resolution and uses TCP port 139 for NetBIOS session services. When NetBIOS over @@ -30,17 +30,19 @@ Name Service or WINS), TCP port 139 AND TCP port 445 (for actual file and print </p></div><p> When NetBIOS over TCP/IP is disabled the use of DNS is essential. Most installations that disable NetBIOS over TCP/IP today use MS Active Directory Service (ADS). ADS requires +<a class="indexterm" name="id2951878"></a> Dynamic DNS with Service Resource Records (SRV RR) and with Incremental Zone Transfers (IXFR). +<a class="indexterm" name="id2951891"></a> Use of DHCP with ADS is recommended as a further means of maintaining central control over client workstation network configuration. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2999775"></a>Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2951903"></a>Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The key configuration files covered in this section are: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999831"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Contains a static list of IP Addresses and names. +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></p></li><li><p><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2951960"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Contains a static list of IP addresses and names. eg: -</p><pre class="screen"> - 127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain - 192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +127.0.0.1 localhost localhost.localdomain +192.168.1.1 bigbox.caldera.com bigbox alias4box </pre><p> The purpose of <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> is to provide a name resolution mechanism so that uses do not need to remember @@ -48,10 +50,10 @@ IP addresses. </p><p> Network packets that are sent over the physical network transport layer communicate not via IP addresses but rather using the Media -Access Control address, or MAC address. IP Addresses are currently +Access Control address, or MAC address. IP addresses are currently 32 bits in length and are typically presented as four (4) decimal numbers that are separated by a dot (or period). eg: 168.192.1.1. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2952009"></a><p> MAC Addresses use 48 bits (or 6 bytes) and are typically represented as two digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons. eg: 40:8e:0a:12:34:56 @@ -84,15 +86,15 @@ MAC addresses only; their own unique address and the address ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff. The reply packet from an ARP request will contain the MAC address and the primary IP address for each interface. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2952082"></a><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file is foundational to all -Unix/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minimum will contain +UNIX/Linux TCP/IP installations and as a minimum will contain the localhost and local network interface IP addresses and the primary names by which they are known within the local machine. This file helps to prime the pump so that a basic level of name resolution can exist before any other method of name resolution becomes available. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2999956"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952110"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/resolv.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This file tells the name resolution libraries: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The name of the domain to which the machine belongs @@ -102,41 +104,41 @@ This file tells the name resolution libraries: </p></li><li><p>The name or IP address of available Domain Name Servers that may be asked to perform name to address translation lookups - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000000"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952153"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2952165"></a><p> <tt class="filename">/etc/host.conf</tt> is the primary means by which the setting in /etc/resolv.conf may be affected. It is a critical configuration file. This file controls the order by which name resolution may proceed. The typical structure is: -</p><pre class="screen"> - order hosts,bind - multi on +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +order hosts,bind +multi on </pre><p> then both addresses should be returned. Please refer to the man page for host.conf for further details. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000042"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952204"></a><tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt></h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2952216"></a><p> This file controls the actual name resolution targets. The file typically has resolver object specifications as follows: -</p><pre class="screen"> - # /etc/nsswitch.conf - # - # Name Service Switch configuration file. - # +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# /etc/nsswitch.conf +# +# Name Service Switch configuration file. +# - passwd: compat - # Alternative entries for password authentication are: - # passwd: compat files nis ldap winbind - shadow: compat - group: compat +passwd: compat +# Alternative entries for password authentication are: +# passwd: compat files nis ldap winbind +shadow: compat +group: compat - hosts: files nis dns - # Alternative entries for host name resolution are: - # hosts: files dns nis nis+ hesiod db compat ldap wins - networks: nis files dns +hosts: files nis dns +# Alternative entries for host name resolution are: +# hosts: files dns nis nis+ hesiod db compat ldap wins +networks: nis files dns - ethers: nis files - protocols: nis files - rpc: nis files - services: nis files +ethers: nis files +protocols: nis files +rpc: nis files +services: nis files </pre><p> Of course, each of these mechanisms requires that the appropriate facilities and/or services are correctly configured. @@ -144,27 +146,27 @@ facilities and/or services are correctly configured. It should be noted that unless a network request/message must be sent, TCP/IP networks are silent. All TCP/IP communications assumes a principal of speaking only when necessary. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2952270"></a><p> Starting with version 2.2.0 samba has Linux support for extensions to the name service switch infrastructure so that linux clients will be able to obtain resolution of MS Windows NetBIOS names to IP Addresses. To gain this functionality Samba needs to be compiled -with appropriate arguments to the make command (ie: <b class="userinput"><tt>make +with appropriate arguments to the make command (i.e.: <b class="userinput"><tt>make nsswitch/libnss_wins.so</tt></b>). The resulting library should then be installed in the <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> directory and the "wins" parameter needs to be added to the "hosts:" line in the <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> file. At this point it -will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by it's NetBIOS +will be possible to ping any MS Windows machine by its NetBIOS machine name, so long as that machine is within the workgroup to which both the samba machine and the MS Windows machine belong. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3000130"></a>Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2952319"></a>Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> MS Windows networking is predicated about the name each machine is given. This name is known variously (and inconsistently) as the "computer name", "machine name", "networking name", "netbios name", -"SMB name". All terms mean the same thing with the exception of +or "SMB name". All terms mean the same thing with the exception of "netbios name" which can apply also to the name of the workgroup or the domain name. The terms "workgroup" and "domain" are really just a -simply name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names +simple name with which the machine is associated. All NetBIOS names are exactly 16 characters in length. The 16th character is reserved. It is used to store a one byte value that indicates service level information for the NetBIOS name that is registered. A NetBIOS machine @@ -172,25 +174,14 @@ name is therefore registered for each service type that is provided by the client/server. </p><p> The following are typical NetBIOS name/service type registrations: -</p><pre class="screen"> - Unique NetBIOS Names: - MACHINENAME<00> = Server Service is running on MACHINENAME - MACHINENAME<03> = Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name) - MACHINENAME<20> = LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME - WORKGROUP<1b> = Domain Master Browser - - Group Names: - WORKGROUP<03> = Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP - WORKGROUP<1c> = Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers - WORKGROUP<1d> = Local Master Browsers - WORKGROUP<1e> = Internet Name Resolvers -</pre><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2952372"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 26.1. Unique NetBIOS names</b></p><table summary="Unique NetBIOS names" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<00></td><td align="justify">Server Service is running on MACHINENAME</td></tr><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<03></td><td align="justify">Generic Machine Name (NetBIOS name)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">MACHINENAME<20></td><td align="justify">LanMan Server service is running on MACHINENAME</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1b></td><td align="justify">Domain Master Browser</td></tr></tbody></table></div><div class="table"><a name="id2952442"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 26.2. Group Names</b></p><table summary="Group Names" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<03></td><td align="justify">Generic Name registered by all members of WORKGROUP</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1c></td><td align="justify">Domain Controllers / Netlogon Servers</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1d></td><td align="justify">Local Master Browsers</td></tr><tr><td align="left">WORKGROUP<1e></td><td align="justify">Internet Name Resolvers</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2952514"></a> It should be noted that all NetBIOS machines register their own names as per the above. This is in vast contrast to TCP/IP installations where traditionally the system administrator will determine in the /etc/hosts or in the DNS database what names are associated with each IP address. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2952529"></a><p> One further point of clarification should be noted, the <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file and the DNS records do not provide the NetBIOS name type information that MS Windows clients depend on to locate the type of service that may @@ -199,8 +190,8 @@ wants to locate a domain logon server. It finds this service and the IP address of a server that provides it by performing a lookup (via a NetBIOS broadcast) for enumeration of all machines that have registered the name type *<1c>. A logon request is then sent to each -IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. Which -ever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services. +IP address that is returned in the enumerated list of IP addresses. +Whichever machine first replies then ends up providing the logon services. </p><p> The name "workgroup" or "domain" really can be confusing since these have the added significance of indicating what is the security @@ -228,7 +219,7 @@ NBT or NetBT, the NetBIOS over TCP/IP. MS Windows machines use a complex array of name resolution mechanisms. Since we are primarily concerned with TCP/IP this demonstration is limited to this area. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000278"></a>The NetBIOS Name Cache</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952629"></a>The NetBIOS Name Cache</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> All MS Windows machines employ an in memory buffer in which is stored the NetBIOS names and IP addresses for all external machines that that machine has communicated with over the @@ -242,11 +233,11 @@ an attempt to exchange a message with that machine will be subject to time-out delays. i.e.: Its name is in the cache, so a name resolution lookup will succeed, but the machine can not respond. This can be frustrating for users - but it is a characteristic of the protocol. -</p><p> +</p><a class="indexterm" name="id2952661"></a><a class="indexterm" name="id2952669"></a><p> The MS Windows utility that allows examination of the NetBIOS name cache is called "nbtstat". The Samba equivalent of this is called <b class="command">nmblookup</b>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000323"></a>The LMHOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952692"></a>The LMHOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2952700"></a><p> This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in <tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains the IP Address and the machine name in matched pairs. The @@ -254,102 +245,103 @@ the IP Address and the machine name in matched pairs. The to IP address mapping. </p><p> It typically looks like: -</p><pre class="screen"> - # Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp. - # - # This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS - # over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98 - # - # This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to NT computernames - # (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line. - # The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the - # corresponding computername. The address and the computername - # should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character - # is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions - # below). - # - # This file is compatible with Microsoft LAN Manager 2.x TCP/IP lmhosts - # files and offers the following extensions: - # - # #PRE - # #DOM:<domain> - # #INCLUDE <filename> - # #BEGIN_ALTERNATE - # #END_ALTERNATE - # \0xnn (non-printing character support) - # - # Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause - # the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are - # not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails. - # - # Following an entry with the "#DOM:<domain>" tag will associate the - # entry with the domain specified by <domain>. This affects how the - # browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload - # the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a - # #PRE to the line. The <domain> is always preloaded although it will not - # be shown when the name cache is viewed. - # - # Specifying "#INCLUDE <filename>" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT) - # software to seek the specified <filename> and parse it as if it were - # local. <filename> is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a - # centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server. - # It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the - # server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive. - # In addition the share "public" in the example below must be in the - # LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to - # be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under - # \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\parameters\nullsessionshares - # in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there. - # - # The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE - # statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include - # will cause the group to succeed. - # - # Finally, non-printing characters can be embedded in mappings by - # first surrounding the NetBIOS name in quotations, then using the - # \0xnn notation to specify a hex value for a non-printing character. - # - # The following example illustrates all of these extensions: - # - # 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC - # 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server - # 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server - # 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include - # - # #BEGIN_ALTERNATE - # #INCLUDE \\localsrv\public\lmhosts - # #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts - # #END_ALTERNATE - # - # In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special - # character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are - # preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used - # to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv" - # system is unavailable. - # - # Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup, - # so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance. - # Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the - # end of this file. -</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000567"></a>HOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +# Copyright (c) 1998 Microsoft Corp. +# +# This is a sample LMHOSTS file used by the Microsoft Wins Client (NetBIOS +# over TCP/IP) stack for Windows98 +# +# This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to NT computernames +# (NetBIOS) names. Each entry should be kept on an individual line. +# The IP address should be placed in the first column followed by the +# corresponding computername. The address and the computername +# should be separated by at least one space or tab. The "#" character +# is generally used to denote the start of a comment (see the exceptions +# below). +# +# This file is compatible with Microsoft LAN Manager 2.x TCP/IP lmhosts +# files and offers the following extensions: +# +# #PRE +# #DOM:<domain> +# #INCLUDE <filename> +# #BEGIN_ALTERNATE +# #END_ALTERNATE +# \0xnn (non-printing character support) +# +# Following any entry in the file with the characters "#PRE" will cause +# the entry to be preloaded into the name cache. By default, entries are +# not preloaded, but are parsed only after dynamic name resolution fails. +# +# Following an entry with the "#DOM:<domain>" tag will associate the +# entry with the domain specified by <domain>. This affects how the +# browser and logon services behave in TCP/IP environments. To preload +# the host name associated with #DOM entry, it is necessary to also add a +# #PRE to the line. The <domain> is always preloaded although it will not +# be shown when the name cache is viewed. +# +# Specifying "#INCLUDE <filename>" will force the RFC NetBIOS (NBT) +# software to seek the specified <filename> and parse it as if it were +# local. <filename> is generally a UNC-based name, allowing a +# centralized lmhosts file to be maintained on a server. +# It is ALWAYS necessary to provide a mapping for the IP address of the +# server prior to the #INCLUDE. This mapping must use the #PRE directive. +# In addition the share "public" in the example below must be in the +# LanManServer list of "NullSessionShares" in order for client machines to +# be able to read the lmhosts file successfully. This key is under +# \machine\system\currentcontrolset\services\lanmanserver\ +# parameters\nullsessionshares +# in the registry. Simply add "public" to the list found there. +# +# The #BEGIN_ and #END_ALTERNATE keywords allow multiple #INCLUDE +# statements to be grouped together. Any single successful include +# will cause the group to succeed. +# +# Finally, non-printing characters can be embedded in mappings by +# first surrounding the NetBIOS name in quotations, then using the +# \0xnn notation to specify a hex value for a non-printing character. +# +# The following example illustrates all of these extensions: +# +# 102.54.94.97 rhino #PRE #DOM:networking #net group's DC +# 102.54.94.102 "appname \0x14" #special app server +# 102.54.94.123 popular #PRE #source server +# 102.54.94.117 localsrv #PRE #needed for the include +# +# #BEGIN_ALTERNATE +# #INCLUDE \\localsrv\public\lmhosts +# #INCLUDE \\rhino\public\lmhosts +# #END_ALTERNATE +# +# In the above example, the "appname" server contains a special +# character in its name, the "popular" and "localsrv" server names are +# preloaded, and the "rhino" server name is specified so it can be used +# to later #INCLUDE a centrally maintained lmhosts file if the "localsrv" +# system is unavailable. +# +# Note that the whole file is parsed including comments on each lookup, +# so keeping the number of comments to a minimum will improve performance. +# Therefore it is not advisable to simply add lmhosts file entries onto the +# end of this file. +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952854"></a>HOSTS file</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This file is usually located in MS Windows NT 4.0 or 2000 in <tt class="filename">C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS\ETC</tt> and contains the IP Address and the IP hostname in matched pairs. It can be used by the name resolution infrastructure in MS Windows, depending on how the TCP/IP environment is configured. This file is in -every way the equivalent of the Unix/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000600"></a>DNS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +every way the equivalent of the UNIX/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/hosts</tt> file. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952886"></a>DNS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2952894"></a><p> This capability is configured in the TCP/IP setup area in the network -configuration facility. If enabled an elaborate name resolution sequence -is followed the precise nature of which is dependant on what the NetBIOS -Node Type parameter is configured to. A Node Type of 0 means use -NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is first used if the name +configuration facility. If enabled, an elaborate name resolution sequence +is followed the precise nature of which is dependant on how the NetBIOS +Node Type parameter is configured. A Node Type of 0 means that +NetBIOS broadcast (over UDP broadcast) is used if the name that is the subject of a name lookup is not found in the NetBIOS name cache. If that fails then DNS, HOSTS and LMHOSTS are checked. If set to Node Type 8, then a NetBIOS Unicast (over UDP Unicast) is sent to the WINS Server to obtain a lookup before DNS, HOSTS, LMHOSTS, or broadcast lookup is used. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000624"></a>WINS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2952918"></a>WINS Lookup</h3></div></div><div></div></div><a class="indexterm" name="id2952927"></a><p> A WINS (Windows Internet Name Server) service is the equivalent of the rfc1001/1002 specified NBNS (NetBIOS Name Server). A WINS server stores the names and IP addresses that are registered by a Windows client @@ -357,24 +349,20 @@ if the TCP/IP setup has been given at least one WINS Server IP Address. </p><p> To configure Samba to be a WINS server the following parameter needs to be added to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="screen"> - wins support = Yes -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = Yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> To configure Samba to use a WINS server the following parameters are needed in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: -</p><pre class="screen"> - wins support = No - wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support = No</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server = xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> where <i class="replaceable"><tt>xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx</tt></i> is the IP address of the WINS server. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3000695"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><p>For information about setting up Samba as a WINS server, read + <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">the chapter on network browsing</a>.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953036"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> TCP/IP network configuration problems find every network administrator sooner or later. The cause can be anything from keyboard mishaps, forgetfulness, simple mistakes, and carelessness. Of course, no one is every deliberately careless! -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000711"></a>My Boomerang Won't Come Back</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Well, the real complaint said, "I can ping my samba server from Windows, but I can - not ping my Windows machine from the samba server." +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953052"></a>Pinging works only in one way</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">I can ping my samba server from Windows, but I can + not ping my Windows machine from the samba server.</span>” </p><p> The Windows machine was at IP Address 192.168.1.2 with netmask 255.255.255.0, the Samba server (Linux) was at IP Address 192.168.1.130 with netmask 255.255.255.128. @@ -382,46 +370,46 @@ carelessness. Of course, no one is every deliberately careless! </p><p> Due to inconsistent netmasks, the Windows machine was on network 192.168.1.0/24, while the Samba server was on network 192.168.1.128/25 - logically a different network. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000742"></a>Very Slow Network Connections</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953086"></a>Very Slow Network Connections</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A common causes of slow network response includes: - </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Client is configured to use DNS and DNS server is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use remote DNS server, but remote connection is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use a WINS server, but there is no WINS server</p></li><li><p>Client is NOT configured to use a WINS server, but there is a WINS server</p></li><li><p>Firewall is filtering our DNS or WINS traffic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id3000794"></a>Samba server name change problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - The name of the samba server was changed, samba was restarted, samba server can not be + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Client is configured to use DNS and DNS server is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use remote DNS server, but remote connection is down</p></li><li><p>Client is configured to use a WINS server, but there is no WINS server</p></li><li><p>Client is NOT configured to use a WINS server, but there is a WINS server</p></li><li><p>Firewall is filtering our DNS or WINS traffic</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953137"></a>Samba server name change problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">The name of the samba server was changed, samba was restarted, samba server can not be pinged by new name from MS Windows NT4 Workstation, but it does still respond to ping using - the old name. Why? + the old name. Why?</span>” </p><p> From this description three (3) things are rather obvious: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>WINS is NOT in use, only broadcast based name resolution is used</p></li><li><p>The samba server was renamed and restarted within the last 10-15 minutes</p></li><li><p>The old samba server name is still in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 Workstation</p></li></ul></div><p> To find what names are present in the NetBIOS name cache on the MS Windows NT4 machine, open a cmd shell, then: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - C:\temp\>nbtstat -n +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>nbtstat -n</tt></b> - NetBIOS Local Name Table + NetBIOS Local Name Table - Name Type Status - ------------------------------------------------ - SLACK <03> UNIQUE Registered - ADMINISTRATOR <03> UNIQUE Registered - SLACK <00> UNIQUE Registered - SARDON <00> GROUP Registered - SLACK <20> UNIQUE Registered - SLACK <1F> UNIQUE Registered + Name Type Status +------------------------------------------------ +FRODO <03> UNIQUE Registered +ADMINSTRATOR <03> UNIQUE Registered +FRODO <00> UNIQUE Registered +SARDON <00> GROUP Registered +FRODO <20> UNIQUE Registered +FRODO <1F> UNIQUE Registered - C:\Temp\>nbtstat -c +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt>nbtstat -c - NetBIOS Remote Cache Name Table + NetBIOS Remote Cache Name Table - Name Type Host Address Life [sec] - -------------------------------------------------------------- - FRODO <20> UNIQUE 192.168.1.1 240 + Name Type Host Address Life [sec] +-------------------------------------------------------------- +GANDALF <20> UNIQUE 192.168.1.1 240 - C:\Temp\> - </pre><p> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt> +</pre><p> </p><p> - In the above example, FRODO is the Samba server and SLACK is the MS Windows NT4 Workstation. - The first listing shows the contents of the Local Name Table (ie: Identity information on + In the above example, GANDALF is the Samba server and FRODO is the MS Windows NT4 Workstation. + The first listing shows the contents of the Local Name Table (i.e.: Identity information on the MS Windows workstation), the second shows the NetBIOS name in the NetBIOS name cache. The name cache contains the remote machines known to this workstation. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pam.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="unicode.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html b/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html index 94419cff04..10cb806270 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/introduction.html @@ -1,5 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part I. General Installation</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="next" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="index.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="introduction"></a>General Installation</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2884330"></a>Preparing Samba for Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part I. General Installation</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="pr02.html" title="Attributions"><link rel="next" href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part I. General Installation</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr02.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="introduction"></a>General Installation</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2817835"></a>Preparing Samba for Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p>This section of the Samba-HOWTO-Collection contains general info on how to install samba and how to configure the parts of samba you will most likely need. -PLEASE read this.</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="IntroSMB.html">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885613">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885824">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2885978">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886047">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886135">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2886209">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="install.html">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886868">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2886909">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2886946">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887096">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2887140">Try listing the shares available on your - server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887191">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887292">Try connecting from a DOS, WfWg, Win9x, WinNT, - Win2k, OS/2, etc... client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887355">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887388">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2887401">Why are so many smbd processes eating memory?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2887617">I'm getting "open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested" in the logs</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="FastStart.html">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2886744">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="index.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">SAMBA Project Documentation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +PLEASE read this.</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>1. <a href="IntroSMB.html">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2817919">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2817978">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818169">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818237">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818345">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818430">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="install.html">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2883917">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2883961">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2883999">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884191">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2884236">Try listing the shares available on your + server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884294">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884411">Try connecting from another SMB client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884494">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884528">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2884539">Large number of smbd processes</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884640">"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884661">"The network name cannot be found"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="FastStart.html">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2884787">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr02.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="IntroSMB.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Attributions </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html b/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html index 4f706aed70..6e09e98de4 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ix01.html @@ -1 +1,39 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Index</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Index</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Further-Resources.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> </td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="index"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id3018533"></a>Index</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="index"></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Further-Resources.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> </td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 41. Further Resources </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> </td></tr></table></div></body></html> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Index</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Index</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Further-Resources.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> </td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="index"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2965347"></a>Index</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="index"><div class="indexdiv"><h3>Symbols</h3><dl><dt>"Domain Admins" group, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903416">Discussion</a></dt><dt>"Domain Users" group, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2904010">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt><dt>"Printers" folder, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932789">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>"raw" printing, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924825">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>/etc/host.conf, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952153">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt>/etc/hosts, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951960">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt>/etc/nsswitch.conf, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952204">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt><dt>8.3</dt><dd><dl><dt>file names, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>A</h3><dl><dt>ACLs, <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dt>Active Directory, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>add group script, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903915">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt>add machine script, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889059">The machine trust account not accessible</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892848">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt>add printer command, <a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>add printer wizard, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt><dt>add user script, <a href="passdb.html#id2899165">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt>addprinter command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>admin users, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2908232">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt>Administrator, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903416">Discussion</a></dt><dt>ADS (see Active Directory)</dt><dt>ads server, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892246">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt>application/cups.vnd-postscript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931837">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt>application/octet-stream, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924971">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928335">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt>application/pdf, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926501">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt>application/postscript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931837">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt>application/vnd.cups-raster, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928581">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt>application/vnd.cups-raw, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924971">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt>auth methods, <a href="passdb.html#id2902952">auth methods does not work</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955156">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>B</h3><dl><dt>bind interfaces only, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>brlock.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>browse list, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897133">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dt>browseable, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>C</h3><dl><dt>case sensitive, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946186">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>chpass, <a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>client use spnego, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892992">I can't join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt><dt>comment, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt>configure, <a href="compiling.html#id2961798">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dt>connections.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>core files, <a href="bugreport.html#id2960926">Internal errors</a></dt><dt>create mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>csc policy, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>CUPS</dt><dd><dl><dt>Page Accounting, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937141">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dt>quotas, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937193">Setting up Quotas</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>CUPS-PPD, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936123">cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</a></dt><dt>cupsaddsmb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930710">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932052">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932180">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932633">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932714">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt>cupsomatic, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926179">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926306">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928022">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936123">cupsomatic, pdqomatic, lpdomatic, directomatic</a></dt><dt>CVS, <a href="compiling.html#id2961265">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>web, <a href="compiling.html#id2961335">Access via CVSweb</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>D</h3><dl><dt>daemon, <a href="compiling.html#id2962499">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt><dt>DDK, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930614">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931030">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt>debug, <a href="bugreport.html#id2960926">Internal errors</a></dt><dt>debug level, <a href="problems.html#id2959768">Debugging with Samba itself</a>, <a href="speed.html#id2964453">Log level</a></dt><dt>debuglevel, <a href="bugreport.html#id2960718">Debug levels</a></dt><dt>default case, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>delete printer command, <a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>deleteprinter command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>DHCP, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951838">Background Information</a></dt><dt>diff, <a href="bugreport.html#id2961107">Patches</a></dt><dt>directory mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>directory security mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>disable spoolss, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>display charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2953454">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt>DNS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894584">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952886">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>Active Directory, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894750">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt><dt>Dynamic, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951838">Background Information</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>dns proxy, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>domain admin group, <a href="groupmapping.html">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dt>domain logons, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887335">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt><dt>domain master, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888272">Domain Network Logon Service</a>, <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890011">Example Configuration</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895844">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt>dont descend, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>dos charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2953454">Samba and charsets</a>, <a href="unicode.html#id2953612">Japanese charsets</a>, <a href="unicode.html#id2953758">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt><dt>dos filemode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>dos filetime resolution, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>dos filetimes, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>E</h3><dl><dt>EMF, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929677">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>encrypt passwords, <a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2899942">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2950929">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>enhanced browsing, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>enumports command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2922594">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt>EPM (see ESP meta packager)</dt><dt>ESC/P, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>ESP</dt><dd><dl><dt>Ghostscript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926306">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt>meta packager, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931030">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt>Print Pro, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929420">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931493">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Extended Attributes, <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>F</h3><dl><dt>fake oplocks, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>File System, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904395">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dt>foomatic, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926179">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926306">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928022">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935871">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936022">Foomatic's strange Name</a></dt><dt>foomatic-rip, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935716">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935871">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936304">The Grand Unification +achieved...</a></dt><dt>force create mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force directory mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force directory security mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force group, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>force security mode, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>force user, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2908232">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a>, <a href="locking.html#id2909231">Beware of Force User</a></dt><dt>ftp, <a href="compiling.html#id2961581">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>G</h3><dl><dt>gdb, <a href="bugreport.html#id2960926">Internal errors</a></dt><dt>GDI, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929677">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>GhostScript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925951">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also PostScript)</dt></dl></dd><dt>Ghostscript</dt><dd><dl><dt>ESP (see ESP GhostScript)</dt></dl></dd><dt>GID, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>GPG, <a href="compiling.html#id2961644">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt>groupadd, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>groupdel, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>groups</dt><dd><dl><dt>domain, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903416">Discussion</a></dt><dt>mapping, <a href="groupmapping.html">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dt>nested, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903984">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>guest account, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897308">Problem resolution</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898121">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt>guest ok, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>H</h3><dl><dt>hide dot files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>hide files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>hide unreadable, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>hide unwriteable files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt>host msdfs, <a href="msdfs.html#id2912546">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>hosts allow, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2910816">Using host based protection</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>hosts deny, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2910816">Using host based protection</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>I</h3><dl><dt>idmap gid, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2951576">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt><dt>idmap uid, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="pam.html#id2951576">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt><dt>ifconfig, <a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>imprints, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt><dt>inetd, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a>, <a href="compiling.html#id2962144">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a>, <a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>Interdomain Trusts, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>completing, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911822">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt>creating, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911721">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dt>Facilities, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911868">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>interfaces, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896045">Multiple interfaces</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a>, <a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt>invalid users, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>IPP, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>K</h3><dl><dt>KDC, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>Kerberos, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dt>kinit, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892373">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>L</h3><dl><dt>ldap admin dn, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap delete dn, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap filter, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap machine suffix, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap passwd sync, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2901824">Password synchronisation</a></dt><dt>ldap ssl, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2901140">Security and sambaSamAccount</a></dt><dt>ldap suffix, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap trust ids, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>ldap user suffix, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a></dt><dt>libnss_wins.so, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952204">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt><dt>Links</dt><dd><dl><dt>hard, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>soft, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>Linuxprinting.org, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935716">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dt>lm announce, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>lm interval, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>LMB (see Local Master Browser)</dt><dt>LMHOSTS, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952692">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt>load printers, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914010">A little Experiment to warn you</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>local master, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt>Local Master Browser, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896081">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt>locking, <a href="locking.html#id2908589">Discussion</a></dt><dt>locking.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>log files</dt><dd><dl><dt>monitoring, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958022">Assumptions</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>log level, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892848">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a>, <a href="VFS.html#id2940474">extd_audit</a>, <a href="bugreport.html#id2960718">Debug levels</a></dt><dt>logon drive, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946726">Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt>logon home, <a href="passdb.html#id2901300">LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945807">Windows 9x / Me User Profiles</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945938">Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946726">Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947427">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt>logon path, <a href="passdb.html#id2901300">LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945938">Mixed Windows 9x / Me and Windows NT4/200x User Profiles</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946186">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946726">Windows NT4 Workstation</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947427">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt>logon script, <a href="passdb.html#id2901300">LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</a></dt><dt>lpadmin, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935716">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937193">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt>lppause command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lpq cache time, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>lpq command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lpresume command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lprm command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>lpstat, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934958">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>M</h3><dl><dt>MAC Addresses, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951960">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt>machine trust accounts, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>creating, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>make, <a href="compiling.html#id2961798">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dt>mangling method, <a href="unicode.html#id2953612">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt>map to guest, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938921">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939149">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt>max print jobs, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>max xmit, <a href="speed.html#id2964393">Max xmit</a></dt><dt>messages.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>MIME, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926501">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926862">Filter Requirements</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928335">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt>min print space, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>msdfs root, <a href="msdfs.html#id2912546">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>N</h3><dl><dt>name resolve order, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>nbtstat, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952629">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt>NetBIOS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2893931">Features and Benefits</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894584">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952319">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dt>NetBIOS-less, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894584">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt>nmblookup, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952629">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt>nt acl support, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2906755">Viewing file ownership</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2906887">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907132">Modifying file or directory permissions</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963891">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt>ntdrivers.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>ntforms.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>NTFS, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904395">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dt>ntprinters.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>O</h3><dl><dt>obey pam restrictions, <a href="pam.html#id2950929">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt>only user, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="securing-samba.html#id2911314">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt><dt>oplock break wait time, <a href="locking.html#id2909323">Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</a>, <a href="locking.html#id2909679">Disabling Kernel OpLocks</a></dt><dt>oplock contention limit, <a href="locking.html#id2909323">Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</a></dt><dt>os level, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895446">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895844">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt>os2 driver map, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963411">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>P</h3><dl><dt>page_log, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937398">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt>passdb backend, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2898749">Technical Information</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2899622">The pdbedit Command</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2900704">Configuring Samba</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2902030">Configuring</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2902796">Users can not logon</a>, <a href="passdb.html#id2902952">auth methods does not work</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955156">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt>password level, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886191">Password checking</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963692">Case handling of passwords</a>, <a href="speed.html#id2964630">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt>password server, <a href="ServerType.html#id2885909">Server Security (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888704">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>patch, <a href="bugreport.html#id2961107">Patches</a></dt><dt>path, <a href="install.html#id2884661">"The network name cannot be found"</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2916027">Print Commands</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917566">Creating the [print$] Share</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2918066">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930169">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937912">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939796">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>PCL, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930255">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dt>PDF, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926092">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt>pdf, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>PDL, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt>PJL, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930255">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931837">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937303">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>point and print, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924894">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928022">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932052">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932789">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>PostScript, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925317">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927043">Prefilters</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930255">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930560">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931030">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also Ghostscript)</dt><dt>RIP, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>PPD, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926092">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928581">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930344">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930400">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930560">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932789">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>CUPS (see CUPS-PPD)</dt></dl></dd><dt>preferred master, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895844">Making Samba the domain master</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>preserve case, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946186">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>print command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2916108">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2916791">Setting up your own Print Commands</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938226">Manual Configuration</a></dt><dt>print ok , <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>printable, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>printcap, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2916108">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923880">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924395">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt>printcap name, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>printer, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>printer admin, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2918333">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2920462">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2920857">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2921063">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924395">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939398">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt>printer name, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt>printing, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2916108">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2916791">Setting up your own Print Commands</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923880">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924395">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938226">Manual Configuration</a></dt><dt>printing.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>PrintPro (see ESP Print Pro)</dt><dt>public, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>Q</h3><dl><dt>queue resume command, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt>queuepause command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt>queueresume command, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>R</h3><dl><dt>read list, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>read only, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt>read raw, <a href="speed.html#id2964483">Read raw</a></dt><dt>read size, <a href="speed.html#id2964343">Read size</a></dt><dt>remote announce, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894896">How Browsing Functions</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896081">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897187">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt>remote browse sync, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894896">How Browsing Functions</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896240">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt><dt>root preexec, <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955990">Logon Scripts</a></dt><dt>rpcclient</dt><dd><dl><dt>adddriver, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932180">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933403">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>enumdrivers, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>enumports, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dt>enumprinters, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934958">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt><dt>getdriver, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933506">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt>getprinter, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933506">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934958">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt><dt>setdriver, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932180">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>rsync, <a href="compiling.html#id2961581">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>S</h3><dl><dt>secrets.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>security, <a href="ServerType.html#id2885157">Samba Security Modes</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2885551">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2885909">Server Security (User Level Security)</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886414">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886453">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886490">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a>, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886529">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887335">Preparing for Domain Control</a>, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888704">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892061">Why is this better than security = server?</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2892246">Setup your smb.conf</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932052">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938787">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a>, <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955156">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a>, <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963639">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt>security mask, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a>, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt>Server Manager, <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>sessionid.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>share_info.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>short preserve case, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a>, <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946186">Windows 9x / Me Profile Setup</a></dt><dt>Short-Cuts, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt>show add printer wizard, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt>SID, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>Single Sign On, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt>smbclient, <a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>socket options, <a href="speed.html#id2964253">Socket options</a></dt><dt>spooling</dt><dd><dl><dt>central, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924770">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt>peer-to-peer, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924770">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>spooling-only, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924825">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt>strict locking, <a href="locking.html#id2908589">Discussion</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>T</h3><dl><dt>TDB, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a>, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935364">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>backing up (see tdbbackup)</dt></dl></dd><dt>tdbbackup, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935579">Using tdbbackup</a></dt><dt>template homedir, <a href="winbind.html#id2943196">Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</a></dt><dt>testparm, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>text/plain, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt>total print jobs, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>U</h3><dl><dt>UDP, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt>UID, <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt>unexpected.tdb, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>(see also TDB)</dt></dl></dd><dt>unix charset, <a href="unicode.html#id2953454">Samba and charsets</a>, <a href="unicode.html#id2953612">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt>use client driver, <a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt>user, <a href="ServerType.html#id2885414">Share Level Security</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>User Manager, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a>, <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912232">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt>useradd, <a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt>username, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>username level, <a href="ServerType.html#id2886191">Password checking</a></dt><dt>username map, <a href="domain-member.html#id2891426">Windows 200x XP Professional</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>V</h3><dl><dt>valid users, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt><dt>veto files, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt><dt>vfs objects, <a href="VFS.html#id2940195">Discussion</a></dt><dt>vipw, <a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>W</h3><dl><dt>winbind separator, <a href="winbind.html#id2942516">Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</a></dt><dt>WINS, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a>, <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952918">WINS Lookup</a></dt><dt>wins hook, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>wins proxy, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt>wins server, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896317">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896504">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt>wins support, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896317">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896504">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt>workgroup, <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888704">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a>, <a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a>, <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897187">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt>write list, <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt>write raw, <a href="speed.html#id2964567">Write raw</a></dt><dt>writeable, <a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a>, <a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt>WYSIWYG, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt></dl></div><div class="indexdiv"><h3>X</h3><dl><dt>X Window System, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt>xinetd, <a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a> (see inetd)</dt><dt>Xprint, <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Further-Resources.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> </td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 41. Further Resources </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> </td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html index b96ddf8ddb..f0a1d02172 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/lmhosts.5.html @@ -18,10 +18,10 @@ 192.9.200.20 NTSERVER#20 192.9.200.21 SAMBASERVER </pre><p>Contains three IP to NetBIOS name mappings. The first - and third will be returned for any queries for the names "TESTPC" - and "SAMBASERVER" respectively, whatever the type component of - the NetBIOS name requested.</p><p>The second mapping will be returned only when the "0x20" name - type for a name "NTSERVER" is queried. Any other name type will not + and third will be returned for any queries for the names "TESTPC" + and "SAMBASERVER" respectively, whatever the type component of + the NetBIOS name requested.</p><p>The second mapping will be returned only when the "0x20" name + type for a name "NTSERVER" is queried. Any other name type will not be resolved.</p><p>The default location of the <tt class="filename">lmhosts</tt> file is in the same directory as the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>, and <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/locking.html b/docs/htmldocs/locking.html index a128cac7ce..07228df19d 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/locking.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/locking.html @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"><link rel="next" href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AccessControls.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="securing-samba.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="locking"></a>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Eric</span> <span class="surname">Roseme</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">HP Oplocks Usage Recommendations Whitepaper<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928216">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928272">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928403">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929049">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929159">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929419">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929649">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929676">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929755">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929785">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929859">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929890">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls"><link rel="next" href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AccessControls.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="securing-samba.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="locking"></a>Chapter 14. File and Record Locking</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Eric</span> <span class="surname">Roseme</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">HP Oplocks Usage Recommendations Whitepaper<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908532">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908589">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908732">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909449">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909569">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909983">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910208">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910237">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910317">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910345">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910419">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910456">Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910479">Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910511">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></div><p> One area which causes trouble for many network administrators is locking. The extent of the problem is readily evident from searches over the internet. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2928216"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2908532"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba provides all the same locking semantics that MS Windows clients expect and that MS Windows NT4 / 200x servers provide also. </p><p> @@ -23,13 +23,13 @@ settings on the MS Windows client. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Sometimes it is necessary to disable locking control settings BOTH on the Samba server as well as on each MS Windows client! -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2928272"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2908589"></a>Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are two types of locking which need to be performed by a SMB server. The first is <span class="emphasis"><em>record locking</em></span> which allows a client to lock a range of bytes in a open file. The second is the <span class="emphasis"><em>deny modes</em></span> that are specified when a file is open. </p><p> -Record locking semantics under Unix is very different from record locking under +Record locking semantics under UNIX are very different from record locking under Windows. Versions of Samba before 2.2 have tried to use the native fcntl() unix system call to implement proper record locking between different Samba clients. This can not be fully correct due to several reasons. The simplest is the fact @@ -40,29 +40,29 @@ many more differences, too many to be listed here. </p><p> Samba 2.2 and above implements record locking completely independent of the underlying unix system. If a byte range lock that the client requests happens -to fall into the range 0-2^31, Samba hands this request down to the Unix system. +to fall into the range 0-2^31, Samba hands this request down to the UNIX system. All other locks can not be seen by unix anyway. </p><p> -Strictly a SMB server should check for locks before every read and write call on -a file. Unfortunately with the way fcntl() works this can be slow and may overstress +Strictly an SMB server should check for locks before every read and write call on +a file. Unfortunately with the way fcntl() works this can be slow and may over-stress the <b class="command">rpc.lockd</b>. It is also almost always unnecessary as clients are supposed to independently make locking calls before reads and writes anyway if locking is important to them. By default Samba only makes locking calls when explicitly asked -to by a client, but if you set <i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking = yes</tt></i> then it +to by a client, but if you set <a class="indexterm" name="id2908656"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking</tt></i> = yes then it will make lock checking calls on every read and write. </p><p> -You can also disable by range locking completely using <i class="parameter"><tt>locking = no</tt></i>. +You can also disable byte range locking completely using <a class="indexterm" name="id2908676"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>locking</tt></i> = no. This is useful for those shares that don't support locking or don't need it (such as cdroms). In this case Samba fakes the return codes of locking calls to tell clients that everything is OK. </p><p> -The second class of locking is the <i class="parameter"><tt>deny modes</tt></i>. These +The second class of locking is the <span class="emphasis"><em>deny modes</em></span>. These are set by an application when it opens a file to determine what types of access should be allowed simultaneously with its open. A client may ask for <tt class="constant">DENY_NONE</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_READ</tt>, <tt class="constant">DENY_WRITE</tt> or <tt class="constant">DENY_ALL</tt>. There are also special compatibility modes called <tt class="constant">DENY_FCB</tt> and <tt class="constant">DENY_DOS</tt>. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2928403"></a>Opportunistic Locking Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2908732"></a>Opportunistic Locking Overview</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Opportunistic locking (Oplocks) is invoked by the Windows file system (as opposed to an API) via registry entries (on the server AND client) for the purpose of enhancing network performance when accessing a file @@ -185,7 +185,7 @@ In mission critical high availability environments, careful attention should be given to opportunistic locking. Ideally, comprehensive testing should be done with all affected applications with oplocks enabled and disabled. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928695"></a>Exclusively Accessed Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909061"></a>Exclusively Accessed Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Opportunistic locking is most effective when it is confined to shares that are exclusively accessed by a single user, or by only one user at a time. Because the true value of opportunistic locking is the local @@ -194,7 +194,7 @@ mechanism will cause a delay. </p><p> Home directories are the most obvious examples of where the performance benefit of opportunistic locking can be safely realized. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928719"></a>Multiple-Accessed Shares or Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909086"></a>Multiple-Accessed Shares or Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> As each additional user accesses a file in a share with opportunistic locking enabled, the potential for delays and resulting perceived poor performance increases. When multiple users are accessing a file on a @@ -206,17 +206,17 @@ of the caching user. As each additional client attempts to access a file with oplocks set, the potential performance improvement is negated and eventually results in a performance bottleneck. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928748"></a>Unix or NFS Client Accessed Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Local Unix and NFS clients access files without a mandatory +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909115"></a>UNIX or NFS Client Accessed Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Local UNIX and NFS clients access files without a mandatory file locking mechanism. Thus, these client platforms are incapable of initiating an oplock break request from the server to a Windows client -that has a file cached. Local Unix or NFS file access can therefore +that has a file cached. Local UNIX or NFS file access can therefore write to a file that has been cached by a Windows client, which exposes the file to likely data corruption. </p><p> -If files are shared between Windows clients, and either local Unix +If files are shared between Windows clients, and either local UNIX or NFS users, then turn opportunistic locking off. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928775"></a>Slow and/or Unreliable Networks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909141"></a>Slow and/or Unreliable Networks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The biggest potential performance improvement for opportunistic locking occurs when the client-side caching of reads and writes delivers the most differential over sending those reads and writes over the wire. @@ -231,7 +231,7 @@ the most advantageous scenario to utilize opportunistic locking. If the network is slow, unreliable, or a WAN, then do not configure opportunistic locking if there is any chance of multiple users regularly opening the same file. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928808"></a>Multi-User Databases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909174"></a>Multi-User Databases</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Multi-user databases clearly pose a risk due to their very nature - they are typically heavily accessed by numerous users at random intervals. Placing a multi-user database on a share with opportunistic @@ -239,7 +239,7 @@ locking enabled will likely result in a locking management bottleneck on the Samba server. Whether the database application is developed in-house or a commercially available product, ensure that the share has opportunistic locking disabled. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928829"></a>PDM Data Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909204"></a>PDM Data Shares</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Process Data Management (PDM) applications such as IMAN, Enovia, and Clearcase, are increasing in usage with Windows client platforms, and therefore SMB data stores. PDM applications manage multi-user @@ -252,8 +252,8 @@ application and PDM server to negotiate and maintain. It is appropriate to eliminate the client OS from any caching tasks, and the server from any oplock management, by disabling opportunistic locking on the share. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928870"></a>Beware of Force User</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba includes an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter called <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> that changes +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909231"></a>Beware of Force User</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba includes an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter called <a class="indexterm" name="id2909250"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> that changes the user accessing a share from the incoming user to whatever user is defined by the smb.conf variable. If opportunistic locking is enabled on a share, the change in user access causes an oplock break to be sent @@ -265,26 +265,26 @@ to overcome the lost oplock break. </p><p> Avoid the combination of the following: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - <i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> share configuration. + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909286"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i> in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> share configuration. </p></li><li><p> Slow or unreliable networks </p></li><li><p> Opportunistic Locking Enabled - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928948"></a>Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909323"></a>Advanced Samba Opportunistic Locking Parameters</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba provides opportunistic locking parameters that allow the administrator to adjust various properties of the oplock mechanism to account for timing and usage levels. These parameters provide good versatility for implementing oplocks in environments where they would likely cause problems. The parameters are: -<i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i>, -<i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i>. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909340"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2909355"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i>. </p><p> For most users, administrators, and environments, if these parameters are required, then the better option is to simply turn oplocks off. The samba SWAT help text for both parameters reads "DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." This is good advice. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2928991"></a>Mission Critical High Availability</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909382"></a>Mission Critical High Availability</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> In mission critical high availability environments, data integrity is often a priority. Complex and expensive configurations are implemented to ensure that if a client loses connectivity with a file server, a @@ -314,10 +314,10 @@ In mission critical high availability environments, careful attention should be given to opportunistic locking. Ideally, comprehensive testing should be done with all affected applications with oplocks enabled and disabled. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929049"></a>Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2909449"></a>Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Opportunistic Locking is a unique Windows file locking feature. It is not really file locking, but is included in most discussions of Windows -file locking, so is considered a defacto locking feature. +file locking, so is considered a de facto locking feature. Opportunistic Locking is actually part of the Windows client file caching mechanism. It is not a particularly robust or reliable feature when implemented on the variety of customized networks that exist in @@ -348,7 +348,7 @@ file locking with the under lying OS, SGI IRIX and Linux are the only two OS's t oplock aware at this time. </p><p> Unless your system supports kernel oplocks, you should disable oplocks if you are -accessing the same files from both Unix/Linux and SMB clients. Regardless, oplocks should +accessing the same files from both UNIX/Linux and SMB clients. Regardless, oplocks should always be disabled if you are sharing a database file (e.g., Microsoft Access) between multiple clients, as any break the first client receives will affect synchronisation of the entire file (not just the single record), which will result in a noticeable performance @@ -364,29 +364,23 @@ of your client sending oplock breaks and will instead want to disable oplocks fo </p><p> Another factor to consider is the perceived performance of file access. If oplocks provide no measurable speed benefit on your network, it might not be worth the hassle of dealing with them. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929159"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2909569"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In the following we examine two distinct aspects of Samba locking controls. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2929172"></a>Disabling Oplocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909582"></a>Disabling Oplocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can disable oplocks on a per-share basis with the following: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[acctdata] - oplocks = False - level2 oplocks = False -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[acctdata]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks = False</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>level2 oplocks = False</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> The default oplock type is Level1. Level2 Oplocks are enabled on a per-share basis in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> Alternately, you could disable oplocks on a per-file basis within the share: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - veto oplock files = /*.mdb/*.MDB/*.dbf/*.DBF/ -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /*.mdb/*.MDB/*.dbf/*.DBF/</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> If you are experiencing problems with oplocks as apparent from Samba's log entries, you may want to play it safe and disable oplocks and level2 oplocks. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2929235"></a>Disabling Kernel OpLocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2909679"></a>Disabling Kernel OpLocks</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Kernel OpLocks is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that notifies Samba (if the UNIX kernel has the capability to send a Windows client an oplock break) when a UNIX process is attempting to open the file that is @@ -399,10 +393,7 @@ send an oplock break, then the kernel oplocks parameter enables Samba to send the oplock break. Kernel oplocks are enabled on a per-server basis in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] -kernel oplocks = yes -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> The default is "no". </p><p> Veto OpLocks is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that identifies specific files for @@ -417,24 +408,15 @@ caching without the risk of data corruption. Veto Oplocks can be enabled on a per-share basis, or globally for the entire server, in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"><font color="red"><title>Example Veto OpLock Settings</title></font> -[global] - veto oplock files = /filename.htm/*.txt/ - -[share_name] - veto oplock files = /*.exe/filename.ext/ -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2909772"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 14.1. Share with some files oplocked</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /filename.htm/*.txt/</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files = /*.exe/filename.ext/</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> </p><p> -<span class="emphasis"><em>Oplock break wait time</em></span> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that adjusts the time + <a class="indexterm" name="id2909826"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that adjusts the time interval for Samba to reply to an oplock break request. Samba recommends "DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." Oplock Break Wait Time can only be configured globally in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - oplock break wait time = 0 (default) -</pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time = 0 (default)</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Oplock break contention limit</em></span> is an <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter that limits the response of the Samba server to grant an oplock if the configured @@ -444,14 +426,8 @@ HAVE READ AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE." Oplock Break Contention Limit can be enable on a per-share basis, or globally for the entire server, in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - oplock break contention limit = 2 (default) - -[share_name] - oplock break contention limit = 2 (default) -</pre><p> -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929419"></a>MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2909930"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 14.2. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break contention limit = 2 (default)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[share_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break contention limit = 2 (default)</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2909983"></a>MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is a known issue when running applications (like Norton Anti-Virus) on a Windows 2000/ XP workstation computer that can affect any application attempting to access shared database files across a network. This is a result of a default setting configured in the Windows 2000/XP @@ -543,7 +519,7 @@ An illustration of how level II oplocks work: station holds any oplock on the file. Because the workstations can have no cached writes or locks at this point, they need not respond to the break-to-none advisory; all they need do is invalidate locally cashed read-ahead data. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929649"></a>Workstation Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910208"></a>Workstation Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanWorkstation\Parameters @@ -552,7 +528,7 @@ An illustration of how level II oplocks work: </pre><p> Indicates whether the redirector should use opportunistic-locking (oplock) performance enhancement. This parameter should be disabled only to isolate problems. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929676"></a>Server Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910237"></a>Server Service Entries</h3></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> \HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\System\ CurrentControlSet\Services\LanmanServer\Parameters @@ -581,8 +557,8 @@ the server disables raw I/O and opportunistic locking for this connection. Specifies the time that the server waits for a client to respond to an oplock break request. Smaller values can allow detection of crashed clients more quickly but can potentially cause loss of cached data. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929755"></a>Persistent Data Corruption</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you have applied all of the settings discussed in this paper but data corruption problems +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910317"></a>Persistent Data Corruption</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you have applied all of the settings discussed in this chapter but data corruption problems and other symptoms persist, here are some additional things to check out: </p><p> We have credible reports from developers that faulty network hardware, such as a single @@ -592,7 +568,7 @@ rebuild the data files in question. This involves creating a new data file with same definition as the file to be rebuilt and transferring the data from the old file to the new one. There are several known methods for doing this that can be found in our Knowledge Base. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929785"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910345"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> In some sites locking problems surface as soon as a server is installed, in other sites locking problems may not surface for a long time. Almost without exception, when a locking problem does surface it will cause embarrassment and potential data corruption. @@ -622,18 +598,23 @@ so far: report on https://bugzilla.samba.org without delay. Make sure that you give as much information as you possibly can to help isolate the cause and to allow reproduction of the problem (an essential step in problem isolation and correction). - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2929859"></a>locking.tdb error messages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - > We are seeing lots of errors in the samba logs like: - > - > tdb(/usr/local/samba_2.2.7/var/locks/locking.tdb): rec_read bad magic - > 0x4d6f4b61 at offset=36116 - > - > What do these mean? - </pre><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910419"></a>locking.tdb error messages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + We are seeing lots of errors in the samba logs like: +</span>” +</p><pre class="programlisting"> +tdb(/usr/local/samba_2.2.7/var/locks/locking.tdb): rec_read bad magic + 0x4d6f4b61 at offset=36116 +</pre><p> +“<span class="quote"> + What do these mean? + </span>” </p><p> Corrupted tdb. Stop all instances of smbd, delete locking.tdb, restart smbd. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2929890"></a>Additional Reading</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910456"></a>Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>This is a bug in Windows XP. More information can be + found in <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/?id=812937" target="_top">Microsoft Knowledge Base article 812937</a>.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910479"></a>Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">It sometimes takes approximately 35 seconds to delete files over the network after XP SP1 has been applied</span>”</p><p>This is a bug in Windows XP. More information can be + found in <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/?id=811492" target="_top"> + Microsoft Knowledge Base article 811492</a>.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910511"></a>Additional Reading</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> You may want to check for an updated version of this white paper on our Web site from time to time. Many of our white papers are updated as information changes. For those papers, the Last Edited date is always at the top of the paper. @@ -653,4 +634,4 @@ Microsoft Corporation, April 2001, <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default </p><p> Microsoft Knowledge Base Article Q129202 "PC Ext: Explanation of Opportunistic Locking on Windows NT", Microsoft Corporation, April 1995, <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;Q129202</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AccessControls.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="securing-samba.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 15. Securing Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="AccessControls.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="securing-samba.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 15. Securing Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/log2pcap.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/log2pcap.1.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..c84bbdbb4d --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/log2pcap.1.html @@ -0,0 +1,29 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>log2pcap</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="log2pcap.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>log2pcap — Extract network traces from Samba log files</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">log2pcap</tt> [-h] [-q] [logfile] [pcap_file]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">log2pcap</b> reads in a + samba log file and generates a pcap file (readable + by most sniffers, such as ethereal or tcpdump) based on the packet + dumps in the log file.</p><p>The log file must have a <i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> + of at least <tt class="constant">5</tt> to get the SMB header/parameters + right, <tt class="constant">10</tt> to get the first 512 data bytes of the + packet and <tt class="constant">50</tt> to get the whole packet. + </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-h</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is + specified the output file will be a + hex dump, in a format that is readable + by the <span class="application">text2pcap</span> utility.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-q</span></dt><dd><p>Be quiet. No warning messages about missing + or incomplete data will be given.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">logfile</span></dt><dd><p> + Samba log file. log2pcap will try to read the log from stdin + if the log file is not specified. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">pcap_file</span></dt><dd><p> + Name of the output file to write the pcap (or hexdump) data to. + If this argument is not specified, output data will be written + to stdout. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>Extract all network traffic from all samba log files:</p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">$</tt> cat /var/log/* | log2pcap > trace.pcap + </pre><p>Convert to pcap using text2pcap:</p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">$</tt> log2pcap -h samba.log | text2pcap -T 139,139 - trace.pcap + </pre></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Only SMB data is extracted from the samba logs, no LDAP, + NetBIOS lookup or other data.</p><p>The generated TCP and IP headers don't contain a valid + checksum.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="text2pcap.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">text2pcap</span>(1)</span></a>, <a href="ethereal.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ethereal</span>(1)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities + were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed + by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar + to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>This manpage was written by Jelmer Vernooij.</p></div></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/migration.html b/docs/htmldocs/migration.html index b8027a62ea..36b6edb0b1 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/migration.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/migration.html @@ -1 +1 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part IV. Migration and Updating</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options"><link rel="next" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SambaHA.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="migration"></a>Migration and Updating</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>30. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id3001684">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id3001709">Obsolete configuration options</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id3003319">Password Backend</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="NT4Migration.html">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3001339">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3001368">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004043">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004381">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004462">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id3004704">Samba Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="SWAT.html">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3003929">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3003963">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006322">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006435">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006499">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006604">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006669">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006733">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006781">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006833">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id3006856">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SambaHA.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 29. High Availability Options </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part IV. Migration and Updating</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options"><link rel="next" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SambaHA.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="migration"></a>Migration and Updating</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>30. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954094">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954229">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954244">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954370">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954767">Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954842">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954849">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955083">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955133">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955156">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955274">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955299">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="NT4Migration.html">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955644">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955669">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956108">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956323">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956414">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956670">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="SWAT.html">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957030">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957079">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957316">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957428">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957493">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957601">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957665">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957730">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957777">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957829">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957853">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SambaHA.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 29. High Availability Options </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/mount.cifs.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/mount.cifs.8.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..766e00fd11 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/mount.cifs.8.html @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>mount.cifs</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="mount.cifs.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>mount.cifs — mount using the Common Internet File System (CIFS)</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">mount.cifs</tt> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>mount.cifs mounts a Linux CIFS filesystem. It +is usually invoked indirectly by +the <a href="mount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount</span>(8)</span></a> command when using the +"-t cifs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must +support the cifs filesystem. The CIFS protocol is the successor to the +SMB protocol and is supported by most Windows servers and many other +commercial servers and Network Attached Storage appliances as well as +by the popular Open Source server Samba. + </p><p> + The mount.cifs utility attaches the UNC name (exported network resource) to + the local directory <span class="emphasis"><em>mount-point</em></span>. It is possible to set the mode for mount.cifs to +setuid root to allow non-root users to mount shares to directories for which they +have write permission. + </p><p> + Options to <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> are specified as a comma-separated +list of key=value pairs. It is possible to send options other +than those listed here, assuming that cifs supports them. If +you get mount failures, check your kernel log for errors on +unknown options. + </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> is a daemon. After mounting it keeps running until + the mounted resource is unmounted (usually via the umount utility) + </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">username=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the username to connect as. If + this is not given, then the environment variable <span class="emphasis"><em>USER</em></span> is used. This option can also take the +form "user%password" or "user/workgroup" or +"user/workgroup%password" to allow the password and workgroup +to be specified as part of the username. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">password=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the CIFS password. If this +option is not given then the environment variable +<span class="emphasis"><em>PASSWD</em></span> is used. If it can find +no password <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> will prompt +for a passeword, unless the guest option is +given. +</p><p>Note that password which contain the arguement delimiter +character (i.e. a comma ',') will failed to be parsed correctly +on the command line. However, the same password defined +in the PASSWD environment variable or a credentials file (see +below) will be read correctly. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term">credentials=<i class="replaceable"><tt>filename</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> + specifies a file that contains a username + and/or password. The format of the file is: + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +.nf + username = <i class="replaceable"><tt>value</tt></i> + password = <i class="replaceable"><tt>value</tt></i> +.fi +</pre><p> +This is preferred over having passwords in plaintext in a +shared file, such as <tt class="filename">/etc/fstab</tt>. Be sure to protect any +credentials file properly. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">uid=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>sets the uid that will own all files on + the mounted filesystem. + It may be specified as either a username or a numeric uid. + This parameter is ignored when the target server supports + the CIFS Unix extensions.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">gid=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>sets the gid that will own all files on +the mounted filesystem. +It may be specified as either a groupname or a numeric +gid. This parameter is ignored when the target server supports +the CIFS Unix extensions. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">port=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>sets the port number on the server to attempt to contact to negotiate +CIFS support. If the CIFS server is not listening on this port or +if it is not specified, the default ports will be tried i.e. +port 445 is tried and if no response then port 139 is tried. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">file_mode=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>If the server does not support the CIFS Unix extensions this + overrides default file mode which will be used locally.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">dir_mode=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>If the server does not support the CIFS Unix extensions this + overrides the default mode for directories. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ip=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>sets the destination host or IP address.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">domain=<i class="replaceable"><tt>arg</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>sets the domain (workgroup) of the user </p></dd><dt><span class="term">guest</span></dt><dd><p>don't prompt for a password </p></dd><dt><span class="term">ro</span></dt><dd><p>mount read-only</p></dd><dt><span class="term">rw</span></dt><dd><p>mount read-write</p></dd><dt><span class="term">rsize</span></dt><dd><p>default network read size</p></dd><dt><span class="term">wsize</span></dt><dd><p>default network write size</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ENVIRONMENT VARIABLES</h2><p> + The variable <span class="emphasis"><em>USER</em></span> may contain the username of the +person using the client. This information is used only if the +protocol level is high enough to support session-level +passwords. The variable can be used to set both username and +password by using the format username%password. + </p><p> + The variable <span class="emphasis"><em>PASSWD</em></span> may contain the password of the +person using the client. This information is used only if the +protocol level is high enough to support session-level +passwords. + </p><p> + The variable <span class="emphasis"><em>PASSWD_FILE</em></span> may contain the pathname +of a file to read the password from. A single line of input is +read and used as the password. + </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p> +The primary mechanism for making configuration changes and for reading +debug information for the cifs vfs is via the Linux /proc filesystem. +In the directory /proc/fs/cifs are various configuration files and +pseudo files which can display debug information. For more +information see the kernel file fs/cifs/README +</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p>Passwords and other options containing , can not be handled. +For passwords an alternative way of passing them is in a credentials +file or in the PASSWD environment.</p><p>The credentials file does not handle usernames or passwords with + leading space.</p><p> +Note that the typical response to a bug report is suggestion +to try the latest version first. So please try doing that first, +and always include which versions you use of relevant software +when reporting bugs (minimum: samba, kernel, distribution) +</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of + the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p> + Documentation/filesystems/cifs.txt and fs/cifs/README in the linux kernel + source tree may contain additional options and information. +</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>Steve French</p><p>The syntax and manpage were loosely based on that of smbmount. It + was converted to Docbook/XML by Jelmer Vernooij.</p><p>The current maintainer of the Linux cifs vfs and the userspace + tool <span class="emphasis"><em>mount.cifs</em></span> is <a href="mailto:sfrench@samba.org" target="_top">Steve French</a>. + The <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">SAMBA Mailing list</a> + is the preferred place to ask questions regarding these programs. + </p></div></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html b/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html index d01b8f4c5d..9fdf906ed0 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/msdfs.html @@ -1,24 +1,22 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"><link rel="next" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="msdfs"></a>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Shirish</span> <span class="surname">Kalele</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team & Veritas Software<br></span><div class="address"><p><br> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"><link rel="next" href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="msdfs"></a>Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Shirish</span> <span class="surname">Kalele</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team & Veritas Software<br></span><div class="address"><p><br> <tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org</a>></tt><br> - </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 Jul 2000</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2933279">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2934931">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2933279"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">12 Jul 2000</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2912546">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2912820">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912546"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Distributed File System (or DFS) provides a means of separating the logical view of files and directories that users see from the actual physical locations of these resources on the network. It allows for higher availability, smoother storage expansion, load balancing etc. </p><p> - For information about DFS, refer to - <a href="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp" target="_top"> - Microsoft documentation at http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp</a>. + For information about DFS, refer to the +<a href="http://www.microsoft.com/NTServer/nts/downloads/winfeatures/NTSDistrFile/AdminGuide.asp" target="_top">Microsoft documentation</a>. </p><p> - This document explains how to host a DFS tree on a Unix machine (for DFS-aware + This document explains how to host a DFS tree on a UNIX machine (for DFS-aware clients to browse) using Samba. </p><p> - To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the <i class="parameter"><tt>--with-msdfs</tt></i> + To enable SMB-based DFS for Samba, configure it with the <tt class="option">--with-msdfs</tt> option. Once built, a Samba server can be made a DFS server by setting the global - boolean <a href="smb.conf.5.html#HOSTMSDFS" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> host msdfs</tt></i></a> - parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf </tt> file. You designate a share as a DFS - root using the share level boolean <a href="smb.conf.5.html#MSDFSROOT" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt> - msdfs root</tt></i></a> parameter. A DFS root directory on Samba hosts DFS + boolean <a class="indexterm" name="id2912593"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i> + parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. You designate a share as a DFS + root using the share level boolean <a class="indexterm" name="id2912615"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i> parameter. A DFS root directory on Samba hosts DFS links in the form of symbolic links that point to other servers. For example, a symbolic link <tt class="filename">junction->msdfs:storage1\share1</tt> in the share directory acts as the DFS junction. When DFS-aware clients attempt to access the junction link, @@ -27,23 +25,14 @@ DFS trees on Samba work with all DFS-aware clients ranging from Windows 95 to 200x. </p><p> Here's an example of setting up a DFS tree on a Samba server. - </p><pre class="programlisting"> -# The smb.conf file: -[global] - netbios name = SMOKEY - host msdfs = yes - -[dfs] - path = /export/dfsroot - msdfs root = yes - </pre><p>In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our dfs links to + </p><div class="example"><a name="id2912656"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 17.1. smb.conf with DFS configured</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = GANDALF</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[dfs]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /export/dfsroot</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p>In the /export/dfsroot directory we set up our DFS links to other servers on the network.</p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /export/dfsroot</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown root /export/dfsroot</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</tt></b> - </pre><p>You should set up the permissions and ownership of +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cd /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown root /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chmod 755 /export/dfsroot</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:storageA\\shareA linka</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>ln -s msdfs:serverB\\share,serverC\\share linkb</tt></b> +</pre><p>You should set up the permissions and ownership of the directory acting as the DFS root such that only designated users can create, delete or modify the msdfs links. Also note that symlink names should be all lowercase. This limitation exists @@ -52,11 +41,11 @@ network shares you want, and start Samba.</p><p>Users on DFS-aware clients can now browse the DFS tree on the Samba server at \\samba\dfs. Accessing links linka or linkb (which appear as directories to the client) - takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934931"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows clients need to be rebooted - if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a dfs + takes users directly to the appropriate shares on the network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912820"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows clients need to be rebooted + if a previously mounted non-dfs share is made a DFS root or vice versa. A better way is to introduce a - new share and make it the dfs root.</p></li><li><p>Currently there's a restriction that msdfs + new share and make it the DFS root.</p></li><li><p>Currently there's a restriction that msdfs symlink names should all be lowercase.</p></li><li><p>For security purposes, the directory acting as the root of the DFS tree should have ownership and permissions set so that only designated users can - modify the symbolic links in the directory.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + modify the symbolic links in the directory.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html index 13e4be81be..a98700e42f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/net.8.html @@ -24,16 +24,15 @@ Defaults to trying 445 first, then 139. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n <primary NetBIOS name></span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical -to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS -name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command +to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id2796900"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +However, a command line setting will take precedence over settings in -<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s <configuration file></span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s <configuration file></span></dt><dd><p>The file specified contains the configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S server</span></dt><dd><p> Name of target server. You should specify either @@ -54,12 +53,18 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>TIME</h3><p>The <b class="command">NET TIME</b> command allows you to view the time on a remote server +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797170"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>CHANGESECRETPW</h3><p>This command allows the Samba machine account password to be set from an external application +to a machine account password that has already been stored in Active Directory. DO NOT USE this command +unless you know exactly what you are doing. The use of this command requires that the force flag (-f) +be used also. There will be NO command prompt. Whatever information is piped into stdin, either by +typing at the command line or otherwise, will be stored as the literal machine password. Do NOT use +this without care and attention as it will overwrite a legitimate machine password without warning. +YOU HAVE BEEN WARNED. +</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>TIME</h3><p>The <b class="command">NET TIME</b> command allows you to view the time on a remote server or synchronise the time on the local server with the time on the remote server.</p><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME</h4><p>Without any options, the <b class="command">NET TIME</b> command displays the time on the remote server. -</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME SYSTEM</h4><p> Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <b class="command">/bin/date</b></p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME SET</h4><p>Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on +</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME SYSTEM</h4><p>Displays the time on the remote server in a format ready for <b class="command">/bin/date</b></p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME SET</h4><p>Tries to set the date and time of the local server to that on the remote server using <b class="command">/bin/date</b>. </p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>TIME ZONE</h4><p>Displays the timezone in hours from GMT on the remote computer.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>[RPC|ADS] JOIN [TYPE] [-U username[%password]] [options]</h3><p> Join a domain. If the account already exists on the server, and [TYPE] is MEMBER, the machine will attempt to join automatically. @@ -104,8 +109,8 @@ can be controlled using 'NET CACHE'.</p><p>All the timeout parameters support th List all current items in the cache. </p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>CACHE FLUSH</h4><p>Remove all the current items from the cache.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GETLOCALSID [DOMAIN]</h3><p>Print the SID of the specified domain, or if the parameter is omitted, the SID of the domain the local server is in.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>SETLOCALSID S-1-5-21-x-y-z</h3><p>Sets domain sid for the local server to the specified SID.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GROUPMAP</h3><p>Manage the mappings between Windows group SIDs and UNIX groups. -Parameters take the for "parameter=value". Common options include:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>unixgroup - Name of the UNIX group</p></li><li><p>ntgroup - Name of the Windows NT group (must be - resolvable to a SID</p></li><li><p>rid - Unsigned 32-bit integer</p></li><li><p>sid - Full SID in the form of "S-1-..."</p></li><li><p>type - Type of the group; either 'domain', 'local', +Parameters take the for "parameter=value". Common options include:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>unixgroup - Name of the UNIX group</p></li><li><p>ntgroup - Name of the Windows NT group (must be + resolvable to a SID</p></li><li><p>rid - Unsigned 32-bit integer</p></li><li><p>sid - Full SID in the form of "S-1-..."</p></li><li><p>type - Type of the group; either 'domain', 'local', or 'builtin'</p></li><li><p>comment - Freeform text description of the group</p></li></ul></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP ADD</h4><p>Add a new group mapping entry</p><p>net groupmap add {rid=int|sid=string} unixgroup=string [type={domain|local|builtin}] [ntgroup=string] [comment=string]</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP DELETE</h4><p>Delete a group mapping entry</p><p>net groupmap delete {ntgroup=string|sid=SID}</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP MODIFY</h4><p>Update en existing group entry</p><p>net groupmap modify {ntgroup=string|sid=SID} [unixgroup=string] [comment=string] [type={domain|local}</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>GROUPMAP LIST</h4><p>List existing group mapping entries</p><p>net groupmap list [verbose] [ntgroup=string] [sid=SID]</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>MAXRID</h3><p>Prints out the highest RID currently in use on the local server (by the active 'passdb backend'). </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>RPC INFO</h3><p>Print information about the domain of the remote server, @@ -131,7 +136,7 @@ local server. Can only be run an a BDC. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>GETSID</h3><p>Fetch domain SID and store it in the local <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS LEAVE</h3><p>Make the remote host leave the domain it is part of. </p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS STATUS</h3><p>Print out status of machine account of the local machine in ADS. Prints out quite some debug info. Aimed at developers, regular users should use <b class="command">NET ADS TESTJOIN</b>.</p></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS PRINTER</h3><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>ADS PRINTER INFO [<i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i>] [<i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>]</h4><p> -Lookup info for <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i> on <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>. The printer name defaults to "*", the +Lookup info for <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i> on <i class="replaceable"><tt>SERVER</tt></i>. The printer name defaults to "*", the server name defaults to the local host.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>ADS PRINTER PUBLISH <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i></h4><p>Publish specified printer using ADS.</p></div><div class="refsect3" lang="en"><h4>ADS PRINTER REMOVE <i class="replaceable"><tt>PRINTER</tt></i></h4><p>Remove specified printer from ADS directory.</p></div></div><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>ADS SEARCH <i class="replaceable"><tt>EXPRESSION</tt></i> <i class="replaceable"><tt>ATTRIBUTES...</tt></i></h3><p>Perform a raw LDAP search on a ADS server and dump the results. The expression is a standard LDAP search expression, and the attributes are a list of LDAP fields to show in the results.</p><p>Example: <b class="userinput"><tt>net ads search '(objectCategory=group)' sAMAccountName</tt></b> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html index c282bde89d..f3e514fa77 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/nmbd.8.html @@ -4,12 +4,12 @@ those produced by SMB/CIFS clients such as Windows 95/98/ME, Windows NT, Windows 2000, Windows XP and LanManager clients. It also participates in the browsing protocols which make up the - Windows "Network Neighborhood" view.</p><p>SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to + Windows "Network Neighborhood" view.</p><p>SMB/CIFS clients, when they start up, may wish to locate an SMB/CIFS server. That is, they wish to know what IP number a specified host is using.</p><p>Amongst other services, <b class="command">nmbd</b> will listen for such requests, and if its own NetBIOS name is specified it will respond with the IP number of the host it - is running on. Its "own NetBIOS name" is by + is running on. Its "own NetBIOS name" is by default the primary DNS name of the host it is running on, but this can be overridden with the <span class="emphasis"><em>-n</em></span> option (see OPTIONS below). Thus <b class="command">nmbd</b> will @@ -42,7 +42,7 @@ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter causes <b class="command">nmbd</b> to log to standard output rather than a file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is specified it causes the - server to run "interactively", not as a daemon, even if the + server to run "interactively", not as a daemon, even if the server is executed on the command line of a shell. Setting this parameter negates the implicit daemon mode when run from the command line. <b class="command">nmbd</b> also logs to standard @@ -51,8 +51,7 @@ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-H <filename></span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS lmhosts file. The lmhosts file is a list of NetBIOS names to IP addresses that is loaded by the nmbd server and used via the name - resolution mechanism <a href="smb.conf.5.html#nameresolveorder" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve - order</tt></i></a> described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> to resolve any + resolution mechanism <a class="indexterm" name="id2797065"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a> described in <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> to resolve any NetBIOS name queries needed by the server. Note that the contents of this file are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> used by <b class="command">nmbd</b> to answer any name queries. @@ -67,8 +66,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -82,10 +80,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797372"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p <UDP port number></span></dt><dd><p>UDP port number is a positive integer value. This option changes the default UDP port number (normally 137) @@ -94,29 +91,26 @@ never removed by the client. won't need help!</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the <b class="command">inetd</b> meta-daemon, this file must contain suitable startup information for the - meta-daemon. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">install</a> document - for details. + meta-daemon. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/rc</tt></span></dt><dd><p>or whatever initialization script your system uses).</p><p>If running the server as a daemon at startup, this file will need to contain an appropriate startup - sequence for the server. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</a> document - for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If running the server via the + sequence for the server.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If running the server via the meta-daemon <b class="command">inetd</b>, this file must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn) to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp). - See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</a> - document for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file. Other common places that systems install this file are <tt class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>When run as a WINS server (see the - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINSSUPPORT" target="_top"><tt class="constant">wins support</tt></a> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2797588"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page), <b class="command">nmbd</b> will store the WINS database in the file <tt class="filename">wins.dat</tt> in the <tt class="filename">var/locks</tt> directory configured under wherever Samba was configured to install itself.</p><p>If <b class="command">nmbd</b> is acting as a <span class="emphasis"><em> - browse master</em></span> (see the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER" target="_top"><tt class="constant">local master</tt></a> + browse master</em></span> (see the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797657"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> man page, <b class="command">nmbd</b> will store the browsing database in the file <tt class="filename">browse.dat </tt> in the <tt class="filename">var/locks</tt> directory diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html index 46c17ce706..10131752b3 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/nmblookup.1.html @@ -6,9 +6,9 @@ are done over UDP.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-M</span></dt><dd><p>Searches for a master browser by looking up the NetBIOS name <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> with a type of <tt class="constant">0x1d</tt>. If <i class="replaceable"><tt> - name</tt></i> is "-" then it does a lookup on the special name + name</tt></i> is "-" then it does a lookup on the special name <tt class="constant">__MSBROWSE__</tt>. Please note that in order to - use the name "-", you need to make sure "-" isn't parsed as an + use the name "-", you need to make sure "-" isn't parsed as an argument, e.g. use : <b class="userinput"><tt>nmblookup -M -- -</tt></b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R</span></dt><dd><p>Set the recursion desired bit in the packet to do a recursive lookup. This is used when sending a name @@ -28,10 +28,10 @@ </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-A</span></dt><dd><p>Interpret <i class="replaceable"><tt>name</tt></i> as an IP Address and do a node status query on this address.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n <primary NetBIOS name></span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical -to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS -name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command +to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id2799960"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +However, a command line setting will take precedence over settings in -<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i <scope></span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i <scope></span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that <b class="command">nmblookup</b> will use to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are @@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the servers NetBIOS name, it causes the client to log on using the servers local SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket options</span></dt><dd><p>TCP socket options to set on the client socket. See the socket options parameter in -the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page for the list of valid +the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page for the list of valid options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B <broadcast address></span></dt><dd><p>Send the query to the given broadcast address. Without this option the default behavior of nmblookup is to send the @@ -59,8 +59,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -74,10 +73,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2800366"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T</span></dt><dd><p>This causes any IP addresses found in the lookup to be looked up via a reverse DNS lookup into a diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/ntlm_auth.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/ntlm_auth.1.html index d2ee979d4d..27dfee1a0f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/ntlm_auth.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/ntlm_auth.1.html @@ -17,8 +17,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -32,10 +31,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2799954"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/optional.html b/docs/htmldocs/optional.html index 1c300521bc..bd76a344f8 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/optional.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/optional.html @@ -1,26 +1,35 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part III. Advanced Configuration</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="optional"></a>Advanced Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2901731"></a>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part III. Advanced Configuration</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide"><link rel="next" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="optional"></a>Advanced Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2893806"></a>Valuable Nuts and Bolts Information</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba has several features that you might want or might not want to use. The chapters in this part each cover specific Samba features. -</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>10. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903558">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903637">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903747">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903764">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2903926">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904058">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904194">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904320">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904541">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904811">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904967">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2904984">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905013">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905122">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905183">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905341">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905540">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905565">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905650">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905663">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905730">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905867">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2905914">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906021">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906100">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906720">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906735">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2906764">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910308">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910636">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910700">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910954">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911009">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911041">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911306">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911458">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911494">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911534">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911641">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911668">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913185">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913989">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913997">Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2914012">Users are being added to the wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2914072">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="groupmapping.html">Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921449">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921551">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921742">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921806">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921820">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921889">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921981">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2921997">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2922057">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920271">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920308">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920326">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with Unix File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920583">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920678">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2920894">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922074">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922346">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922591">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922807">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2922879">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923178">MS Windows Access Control Lists and Unix Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923186">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923224">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923303">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923425">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923653">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2923805">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask - parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924134">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute - mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924210">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924224">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2924604">I have set force user and Samba still makes root the owner of all the files - I touch!</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="locking.html">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928216">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928272">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2928403">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929049">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929159">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929419">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929649">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929676">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929755">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929785">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929859">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2929890">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="securing-samba.html">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931943">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931976">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932050">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932069">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932140">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932191">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932244">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932300">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932362">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932402">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932426">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932444">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932469">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933376">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933404">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933488">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933501">NT4 as the Trusting Domain (ie. creating the trusted account)</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933586">NT4 as the Trusted Domain (ie. creating trusted account's password)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933622">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933649">Samba-3 as the Trusting Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933790">Samba-3 as the Trusted Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933922">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2933937">Tell me about Trust Relationships using Samba</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="msdfs.html">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2933279">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2934931">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="printing.html">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934522">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934590">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934627">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934698">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935615">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935946">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936054">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936147">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936216">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936305">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936612">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936715">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936728">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937111">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937440">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937660">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937711">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938236">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938516">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938681">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938833">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938945">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939016">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939247">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939408">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939503">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939686">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with -rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941408">"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941428">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941626">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941915">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942010">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942152">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942185">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942622">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942924">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943168">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a -different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943267">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943612">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943683">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943705">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943751">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943792">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943811">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943835">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943987">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944316">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944362">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944531">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944545">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944558">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944591">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953785">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953792">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953845">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953900">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2953979">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954122">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954205">More complex smb.conf Settings for -CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954322">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954343">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954370">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing -with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954406">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954465">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for -application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954626">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954719">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing -with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954794">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on Unix</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954839">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2954940">Unix Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955028">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955125">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955238">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955308">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955397">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955420">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955560">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955747">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2955864">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956034">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956120">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956222">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956377">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956434">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956519">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956831">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956944">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2956960">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957012">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957066">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957282">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957510">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and -native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957666">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2957897">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958024">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958100">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958116">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958155">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958227">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958289">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print -Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958310">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958474">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958550">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use -PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958605">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958646">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958712">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958729">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958763">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958784">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958811">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel -Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958865"> Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958884">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2958976">Prepare your smb.conf for -cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959022">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959220">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959278">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959310">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for -WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959360">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959582">What are the Benefits of using the "CUPS PostScript Driver for -Windows NT/2k/XP" as compared to the Adobe Driver?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959764">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2959865">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960092">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960186">How to recognize if cupsaddsm completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960273">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960308">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960361">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960474">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the -Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960608">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using -rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960723">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960836">Understanding the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2960925">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961015">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961177">Manual Commandline Driver Installation in 15 little Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961830">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2961930">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962033">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962103">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962165">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962224">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962290">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2962398">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963027">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963488">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963519">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963551">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963592">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963663">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963765">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963836">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963884">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2963899">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964092">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964138">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964221">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964281">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964299">When not to use Samba to print to -CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964316">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964352">Where to find Documentation</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964364">How to ask for Help</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964377">Where to find Help</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964391">Appendix</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964398">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached -Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964612">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2964919">Trouble Shooting Guidelines to fix typical Samba printing -Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2966041">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="VFS.html">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978211">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978229">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978320">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978327">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978365">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978489">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978508">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978645">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978690">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978712">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978768">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2978797">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="winbind.html">Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979695">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979724">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979795">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979856">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979886">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979914">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979949">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979971">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980108">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980179">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980214">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980242">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980271">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980346">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980438">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2982058">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2982077">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984570">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984759">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984858">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2984876">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2985087">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2985283">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2985316">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="PolicyMgmt.html">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2984380">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2984435">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986217">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986312">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986445">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986697">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986798">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986819">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986839">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2986883">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2987030">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2987044">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988251">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988285">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988326">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2988731">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989902">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2989967">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990232">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990290">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990336">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990356">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2990504">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991058">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991562">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991575">How does one set up roaming profiles for just one (or a few) user/s or group/s?</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991638">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2991859">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="pam.html">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995804">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996071">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996089">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996760">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997062">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997119">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997203">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997570">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997583">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999705">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999730">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999775">Name Resolution in a pure Unix/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999831">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2999956">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000000">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000042">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000130">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000278">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000323">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000567">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000600">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000624">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000695">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000711">My Boomerang Won't Come Back</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000742">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id3000794">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="unicode.html">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001913">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002114">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002184">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002284">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002329">Japanese charsets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="Backup.html">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id3001533">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id3001557">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="SambaHA.html">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id3003099">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>10. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2893931">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894333">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894584">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894750">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894896">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895446">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895844">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896022">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896045">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896081">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896240">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896317">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896504">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896761">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896787">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896875">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896889">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896967">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897133">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897187">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897308">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897396">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898078">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898092">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898121">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898166">I get an Unable to browse the network error</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898446">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898460">Backwards Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898561">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898749">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898874">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899165">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899351">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899622">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899860">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899902">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899942">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2900055">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2900089">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2901940">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902790">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902796">Users can not logon</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902841">Users being added to wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902952">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="groupmapping.html">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903416">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903652">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903718">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903732">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903817">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903900">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903915">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903984">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2904010">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904266">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904395">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904735">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904829">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905040">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906251">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906323">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906623">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906631">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906675">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906755">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906887">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907132">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907693">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907788">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907802">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2908232">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2908284">MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="locking.html">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908532">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908589">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908732">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909449">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909569">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909983">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910208">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910237">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910317">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910345">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910419">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910456">Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910479">Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910511">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="securing-samba.html">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910685">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910722">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910796">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910816">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910915">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910975">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911042">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911098">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911187">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911245">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911271">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911289">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911314">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911605">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911633">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911721">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911750">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911822">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911868">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912046">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912232">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912370">NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912476">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="msdfs.html">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2912546">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2912820">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="printing.html">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2912941">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913045">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913083">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913154">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913718">A simple Configuration to Print</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913883">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914010">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914370">Extended Sample Configuration to Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914701">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916027">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916108">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916791">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917131">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917292">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917453">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917566">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918066">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918239">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918333">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918531">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920241">Client Driver Install Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920260">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920462">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920763">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920857">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921029">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921063">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921530">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922136">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a +different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922236">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922594">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922687">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922712">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922768">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922810">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922828">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922853">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923008">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923342">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923388">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923561">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923575">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923582">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923615">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923750">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923756">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923811">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923880">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924213">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924395">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924750">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924770">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924825">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924894">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924971">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925317">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925951">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926092">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926179">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926285">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926306">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926501">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926862">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927043">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927153">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927264">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927459">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927523">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927675">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928022">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928168">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928183">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928246">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928335">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928581">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929083">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929420">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929572">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929667">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929677">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929741">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929936">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930169">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930255">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930344">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930400">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930476">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930493">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930538">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930560">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930614">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930637">Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930710">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930811">Prepare your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931030">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931268">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931460">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931493">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931837">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932052">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932180">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932551">How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932633">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932714">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932789">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932953">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933288">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933403">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933506">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934958">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935364">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935456">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935520">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935579">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935716">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935871">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936640">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937141">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937193">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937258">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937303">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937398">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937516">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937592">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937648">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937662">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937912">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937974">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938226">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938284">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938356">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938656">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938758">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938765">Win9x client can't install driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938787">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938835">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938893">Client can't connect to Samba printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938921">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939149">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939202">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939219">Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939249">Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939258">Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939297">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939331">"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939354">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939398">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939689">Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939734">cupsaddsmb does not work + with newly installed printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939796">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939905">Printer named "lp" +intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different +ones</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939953">Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940008">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="VFS.html">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940177">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940195">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940424">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940432">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940474">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940604">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940622">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940798">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940843">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940865">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940920">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="winbind.html">Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941150">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941246">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941324">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941400">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941431">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941460">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941493">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941516">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941652">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941724">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941757">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941785">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941792">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941859">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941953">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943561">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943580">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943633">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943742">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943772">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943871">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943888">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944129">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944368">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944401">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="PolicyMgmt.html">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944479">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944538">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944652">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944748">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944880">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945132">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945238">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945277">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945301">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945346">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945496">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945511">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945611">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945646">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945686">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946178">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947427">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947512">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947770">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947828">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947873">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947893">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948045">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948600">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949100">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949130">Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949201">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949414">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="pam.html">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949695">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949942">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949960">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2950624">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2950929">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951007">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951091">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951474">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951487">pam_winbind problem</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951576">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951812">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951838">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951903">Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951960">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952110">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952153">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952204">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952319">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952629">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952692">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952854">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952886">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952918">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953036">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953052">Pinging works only in one way</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953086">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953137">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="unicode.html">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953342">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953385">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953454">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953583">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953612">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953751">Common errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953758">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="Backup.html">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2953871">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2953885">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="SambaHA.html">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id2953955">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ClientConfig.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pam.html b/docs/htmldocs/pam.html index a0221b57e0..8edbdb26ca 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/pam.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pam.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"><link rel="next" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pam"></a>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2995804">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996071">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996089">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2996760">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997062">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997119">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997203">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997570">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2997583">pam_winbind problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management"><link rel="next" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="pam"></a>Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Stephen</span> <span class="surname">Langasek</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949695">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949942">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949960">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2950624">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2950929">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951007">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951091">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951474">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951487">pam_winbind problem</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951576">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> This chapter you should help you to deploy winbind based authentication on any PAM enabled -Unix/Linux system. Winbind can be used to enable user level application access authentication +UNIX/Linux system. Winbind can be used to enable user level application access authentication from any MS Windows NT Domain, MS Windows 200x Active Directory based domain, or any Samba based domain environment. It will also help you to configure PAM based local host access controls that are appropriate to your Samba configuration. @@ -8,9 +8,9 @@ controls that are appropriate to your Samba configuration. In addition to knowing how to configure winbind into PAM, you will learn generic PAM management possibilities and in particular how to deploy tools like pam_smbpass.so to your advantage. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -The use of Winbind require more than PAM configuration alone. Please refer to <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind">the Winbind chapter</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2995804"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -A number of Unix systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the xxxxBSD family and Linux, +The use of Winbind require more than PAM configuration alone. Please refer to <a href="winbind.html" title="Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts">the Winbind chapter</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949695"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A number of UNIX systems (eg: Sun Solaris), as well as the xxxxBSD family and Linux, now utilize the Pluggable Authentication Modules (PAM) facility to provide all authentication, authorization and resource control services. Prior to the introduction of PAM, a decision to use an alternative to the system password database (<tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>) @@ -23,38 +23,38 @@ authentication/authorization infrastructure. PAM is configured either through o <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.conf</tt> (Solaris), or by editing individual files that are located in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt>. </p><p> -On PAM enabled Unix/Linux systems it is an easy matter to configure the system to use any +On PAM enabled UNIX/Linux systems it is an easy matter to configure the system to use any authentication backend, so long as the appropriate dynamically loadable library modules are available for it. The backend may be local to the system, or may be centralised on a remote server. </p><p> PAM support modules are available for: -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt></span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> - There are several PAM modules that interact with this standard Unix user +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>:</span></dt><dd><p> + There are several PAM modules that interact with this standard UNIX user database. The most common are called: pam_unix.so, pam_unix2.so, pam_pwdb.so and pam_userdb.so. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Kerberos</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Kerberos:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_krb5.so module allows the use of any Kerberos compliant server. This tool is used to access MIT Kerberos, Heimdal Kerberos, and potentially Microsoft Active Directory (if enabled). - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LDAP</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">LDAP:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_ldap.so module allows the use of any LDAP v2 or v3 compatible backend server. Commonly used LDAP backend servers include: OpenLDAP v2.0 and v2.1, Sun ONE iDentity server, Novell eDirectory server, Microsoft Active Directory. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NetWare Bindery</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NetWare Bindery:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_ncp_auth.so module allows authentication off any bindery enabled NetWare Core Protocol based server. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Password</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Password:</span></dt><dd><p> This module, called pam_smbpass.so, will allow user authentication off the passdb backend that is configured in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Server</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SMB Server:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_smb_auth.so module is the original MS Windows networking authentication tool. This module has been somewhat outdated by the Winbind module. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Winbind</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Winbind:</span></dt><dd><p> The pam_winbind.so module allows Samba to obtain authentication from any MS Windows Domain Controller. It can just as easily be used to authenticate users for access to any PAM enabled application. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RADIUS</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">RADIUS:</span></dt><dd><p> There is a PAM RADIUS (Remote Access Dial-In User Service) authentication module. In most cases the administrator will need to locate the source code for this tool and compile and install it themselves. RADIUS protocols are @@ -67,12 +67,12 @@ of distributed samba domain controllers that can provide wide are network bandwi efficient authentication services for PAM capable systems. In effect, this allows the deployment of centrally managed and maintained distributed authentication from a single user account database. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2996071"></a>Technical Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2949942"></a>Technical Discussion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> PAM is designed to provide the system administrator with a great deal of flexibility in configuration of the privilege granting applications of their system. The local configuration of system security controlled by PAM is contained in one of two places: either the single system file, /etc/pam.conf; or the /etc/pam.d/ directory. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996089"></a>PAM Configuration Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2949960"></a>PAM Configuration Syntax</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In this section we discuss the correct syntax of and generic options respected by entries to these files. PAM specific tokens in the configuration file are case insensitive. The module paths, however, are case sensitive since they indicate a file's name and reflect the case dependence of typical file-systems. @@ -87,32 +87,31 @@ default location then it is not necessary to specify the path. In the case of Linux, the default location is <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt>. If the module is located outside the default then the path must be specified as: </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> auth required /other_path/pam_strange_module.so </pre><p> -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996146"></a>Anatomy of <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> Entries</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950018"></a>Anatomy of <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> Entries</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The remaining information in this subsection was taken from the documentation of the Linux-PAM project. For more information on PAM, see -<a href="http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/" target="_top"> -http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam</a> The Official Linux-PAM home page. +<a href="http://ftp.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/" target="_top">The Official Linux-PAM home page</a> </p><p> A general configuration line of the /etc/pam.conf file has the following form: </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> service-name module-type control-flag module-path args </pre><p> </p><p> Below, we explain the meaning of each of these tokens. The second (and more recently adopted) way of configuring Linux-PAM is via the contents of the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> directory. Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this method. -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">service-name</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">service-name:</span></dt><dd><p> The name of the service associated with this entry. Frequently the service name is the conventional name of the given application. For example, `ftpd', `rlogind' and `su', etc. . </p><p> There is a special service-name, reserved for defining a default authentication mechanism. It has the name `OTHER' and may be specified in either lower or upper case characters. Note, when there is a module specified for a named service, the `OTHER' entries are ignored. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-type</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-type:</span></dt><dd><p> One of (currently) four types of module. The four types are as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>auth:</em></span> this module type provides two aspects of authenticating the user. @@ -134,7 +133,7 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me <span class="emphasis"><em>password:</em></span> this last module type is required for updating the authentication token associated with the user. Typically, there is one module for each `challenge/response' based authentication (auth) module-type. - </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">control-flag</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></li></ul></div></dd><dt><span class="term">control-flag:</span></dt><dd><p> The control-flag is used to indicate how the PAM library will react to the success or failure of the module it is associated with. Since modules can be stacked (modules of the same type execute in series, one after another), the control-flags determine the relative importance of each module. The application @@ -178,9 +177,9 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me The more elaborate (newer) syntax is much more specific and gives the administrator a great deal of control over how the user is authenticated. This form of the control flag is delimited with square brackets and consists of a series of value=action tokens: - </p><pre class="screen"> - [value1=action1 value2=action2 ...] - </pre><p> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> +[value1=action1 value2=action2 ...] +</pre><p> Here, value1 is one of the following return values: success; open_err; symbol_err; service_err; system_err; buf_err; perm_denied; auth_err; cred_insufficient; authinfo_unavail; user_unknown; maxtries; new_authtok_reqd; acct_expired; session_err; cred_unavail; cred_expired; cred_err; no_module_data; conv_err; @@ -235,7 +234,7 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me <span class="emphasis"><em>[ ... value=action ... ]</em></span> control syntax, it is possible for an application to be configured to support binary prompts with compliant clients, but to gracefully fall over into an alternative authentication mode for older, legacy, applications. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-path</span></dt><dd><p>-</p><p> + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">module-path:</span></dt><dd><p> The path-name of the dynamically loadable object file; the pluggable module itself. If the first character of the module path is `/', it is assumed to be a complete path. If this is not the case, the given module path is appended to the default module path: <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt> (but see the notes above). @@ -246,7 +245,7 @@ Once we have explained the meaning of the above tokens, we will describe this me to syslog(3). For a list of generic options see the next section. </p><p> Note, if you wish to include spaces in an argument, you should surround that argument with square brackets. For example: - </p><pre class="screen"> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> squid auth required pam_mysql.so user=passwd_query passwd=mada \ db=eminence [query=select user_name from internet_service where \ user_name='%u' and password=PASSWORD('%p') and \ @@ -254,19 +253,19 @@ squid auth required pam_mysql.so user=passwd_query passwd=mada \ </pre><p> Note, when using this convention, you can include `[' characters inside the string, and if you wish to include a `]' character inside the string that will survive the argument parsing, you should use `\['. In other words: - </p><pre class="screen"> + </p><pre class="programlisting"> [..[..\]..] --> ..[..].. </pre><p> Any line in (one of) the configuration file(s), that is not formatted correctly, will generally tend (erring on the side of caution) to make the authentication process fail. A corresponding error is written to the system log files with a call to syslog(3). - </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2996760"></a>Example System Configurations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2950624"></a>Example System Configurations</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following is an example <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> configuration file. This example had all options been uncommented is probably not usable as it stacks many conditions before allowing successful completion of the login process. Essentially all conditions can be disabled by commenting them out except the calls to <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996790"></a>PAM: original login config</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="screen"> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950655"></a>PAM: original login config</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `login' service # @@ -281,10 +280,10 @@ session required pam_pwdb.so # session optional pam_lastlog.so # password required pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password required pam_pwdb.so shadow md5 -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2996817"></a>PAM: login using pam_smbpass</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2950683"></a>PAM: login using pam_smbpass</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> PAM allows use of replaceable modules. Those available on a sample system include: </p><p><tt class="prompt">$</tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/bin/ls /lib/security</tt></b> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> pam_access.so pam_ftp.so pam_limits.so pam_ncp_auth.so pam_rhosts_auth.so pam_stress.so pam_cracklib.so pam_group.so pam_listfile.so @@ -308,7 +307,7 @@ hashes. This database is stored in either <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/private/smbpasswd</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt>, or in <tt class="filename">/etc/samba.d/smbpasswd</tt>, depending on the -Samba implementation for your Unix/Linux system. The +Samba implementation for your UNIX/Linux system. The <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass.so</tt> module is provided by Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the <tt class="option">--with-pam_smbpass</tt> options when running Samba's @@ -316,7 +315,7 @@ Samba version 2.2.1 or later. It can be compiled by specifying the on the <tt class="filename">pam_smbpass</tt> module, see the documentation in the <tt class="filename">source/pam_smbpass</tt> directory of the Samba source distribution. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `login' service # @@ -327,7 +326,7 @@ password required pam_smbpass.so nodelay </pre><p> The following is the PAM configuration file for a particular Linux system. The default condition uses <tt class="filename">pam_pwdb.so</tt>. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service # @@ -341,7 +340,7 @@ smbpasswd database even for basic samba authentication. Such a decision could also be made for the passwd program and would thus allow the smbpasswd passwords to be changed using the passwd program. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # The PAM configuration file for the `samba' service # @@ -360,24 +359,24 @@ authentication to be configured in a single central file. The on the basis that it allows for easier administration. As with all issues in life though, every decision makes trade-offs, so you may want examine the PAM documentation for further helpful information. -</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2997062"></a>smb.conf PAM Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -There is an option in smb.conf called <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS" target="_top">obey pam restrictions</a>. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2950929"></a>smb.conf PAM Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There is an option in smb.conf called <a class="indexterm" name="id2950938"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i>. The following is from the on-line help for this option in SWAT; </p><p> -When Samba-3 is configured to enable PAM support (i.e. +When Samba is configured to enable PAM support (i.e. <tt class="option">--with-pam</tt>), this parameter will control whether or not Samba should obey PAM's account and session management directives. The default behavior is to use PAM for clear text authentication only and to ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of -<a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt passwords = yes</a>. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2950969"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes. The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB password encryption. -</p><p>Default: <i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions = no</tt></i></p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2997119"></a>Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><p>Default: <a class="indexterm" name="id2950990"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i> = no</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2951007"></a>Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> All operating systems depend on the provision of users credentials acceptable to the platform. -Unix requires the provision of a user identifier (UID) as well as a group identifier (GID). +UNIX requires the provision of a user identifier (UID) as well as a group identifier (GID). These are both simple integer type numbers that are obtained from a password backend such as <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>. </p><p> @@ -401,7 +400,7 @@ Microsoft Active Directory Service (ADS) in so far as reduction of wide area net The rid to unix id database is the only location where the user and group mappings are stored by winbindd. If this file is deleted or corrupted, there is no way for winbindd to determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user and group rids. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2997203"></a>Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2951091"></a>Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> pam_smbpass is a PAM module which can be used on conforming systems to keep the smbpasswd (Samba password) database in sync with the unix password file. PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) is an API supported @@ -414,24 +413,23 @@ concerned about the presence of suid root binaries on your system, it is recommended that you use pam_winbind instead. </p><p> Options recognized by this module are as follows: -</p><div class="table"><a name="id2997236"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 25.1. Options recognized by pam_smbpass</b></p><table summary="Options recognized by pam_smbpass" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">debug</td><td align="left">log more debugging info</td></tr><tr><td align="left">audit</td><td align="left">like debug, but also logs unknown usernames</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_first_pass</td><td align="left">don't prompt the user for passwords; take them from PAM_ items instead</td></tr><tr><td align="left">try_first_pass</td><td align="left">try to get the password from a previous PAM module, fall back to prompting the user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_authtok</td><td align="left">like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set. (intended for stacking password modules only)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">not_set_pass</td><td align="left">don't make passwords used by this module available to other modules.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nodelay</td><td align="left">don't insert ~1 second delays on authentication failure.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nullok</td><td align="left">null passwords are allowed.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nonull</td><td align="left">null passwords are not allowed. Used to override the Samba configuration.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">migrate</td><td align="left">only meaningful in an "auth" context; used to update smbpasswd file with a password used for successful authentication.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">smbconf=<i class="replaceable"><tt>file</tt></i></td><td align="left">specify an alternate path to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="table"><a name="id2951123"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 25.1. Options recognized by pam_smbpass</b></p><table summary="Options recognized by pam_smbpass" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left">debug</td><td align="justify">log more debugging info</td></tr><tr><td align="left">audit</td><td align="justify">like debug, but also logs unknown usernames</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_first_pass</td><td align="justify">don't prompt the user for passwords; take them from PAM_ items instead</td></tr><tr><td align="left">try_first_pass</td><td align="justify">try to get the password from a previous PAM module, fall back to prompting the user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">use_authtok</td><td align="justify">like try_first_pass, but *fail* if the new PAM_AUTHTOK has not been previously set. (intended for stacking password modules only)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">not_set_pass</td><td align="justify">don't make passwords used by this module available to other modules.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nodelay</td><td align="justify">don't insert ~1 second delays on authentication failure.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nullok</td><td align="justify">null passwords are allowed.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nonull</td><td align="justify">null passwords are not allowed. Used to override the Samba configuration.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">migrate</td><td align="justify">only meaningful in an "auth" context; used to update smbpasswd file with a password used for successful authentication.</td></tr><tr><td align="left">smbconf=<i class="replaceable"><tt>file</tt></i></td><td align="justify">specify an alternate path to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> -Thanks go to the following people: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><a href="mailto:morgan@transmeta.com" target="_top">Andrew Morgan</a>, for providing the Linux-PAM - framework, without which none of this would have happened</td></tr><tr><td><a href="gafton@redhat.com" target="_top">Christian Gafton</a> and Andrew Morgan again, for the - pam_pwdb module upon which pam_smbpass was originally based</td></tr><tr><td><a href="lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">Luke Leighton</a> for being receptive to the idea, +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="mailto:morgan@transmeta.com" target="_top">Andrew Morgan</a>, for providing the Linux-PAM + framework, without which none of this would have happened</p></li><li><p><a href="mailto:gafton@redhat.com" target="_top">Christian Gafton</a> and Andrew Morgan again, for the + pam_pwdb module upon which pam_smbpass was originally based</p></li><li><p><a href="mailto:lkcl@switchboard.net" target="_top">Luke Leighton</a> for being receptive to the idea, and for the occasional good-natured complaint about the project's status - that keep me working on it :)</td></tr></table><p>. + that keep me working on it :)</p></li></ul></div><p>. </p><p> The following are examples of the use of pam_smbpass.so in the format of Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/</tt> files structure. Those wishing to implement this tool on other platforms will need to adapt this appropriately. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2997436"></a>Password Synchronisation Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2951339"></a>Password Synchronisation Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to make sure private/smbpasswd is kept in sync when /etc/passwd (/etc/shadow) is changed. Useful when an expired password might be changed by an application (such as ssh). -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # password-sync # @@ -442,13 +440,13 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass password required pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass session required pam_unix.so -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2997469"></a>Password Migration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2951372"></a>Password Migration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration that shows the use of pam_smbpass to migrate from plaintext to encrypted passwords for Samba. Unlike other methods, this can be used for users who have never connected to Samba shares: password migration takes place when users ftp in, login using ssh, pop their mail, etc. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # password-migration # @@ -461,11 +459,11 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass session required pam_unix.so -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2997504"></a>Mature Password Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2951407"></a>Mature Password Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration for a 'mature' smbpasswd installation. private/smbpasswd is fully populated, and we consider it an error if -the smbpasswd doesn't exist or doesn't match the Unix password. -</p><pre class="screen"> +the smbpasswd doesn't exist or doesn't match the UNIX password. +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # password-mature # @@ -476,11 +474,11 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password requisite pam_unix.so shadow md5 use_authtok try_first_pass password required pam_smbpass.so use_authtok use_first_pass session required pam_unix.so -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2997536"></a>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2951440"></a>Kerberos Password Integration Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> A sample PAM configuration that shows pam_smbpass used together with pam_krb5. This could be useful on a Samba PDC that is also a member of a Kerberos realm. -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> #%PAM-1.0 # kdc-pdc # @@ -492,13 +490,15 @@ password requisite pam_cracklib.so retry=3 password optional pam_smbpass.so nullok use_authtok try_first_pass password required pam_krb5.so use_authtok try_first_pass session required pam_krb5.so -</pre></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2997570"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</pre></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2951474"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> PAM can be a very fickle and sensitive to configuration glitches. Here we look at a few cases from the Samba mailing list. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2997583"></a>pam_winbind problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - I have the following PAM configuration: +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2951487"></a>pam_winbind problem</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + I have the following PAM configuration: + </span>” </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> auth required /lib/security/pam_securetty.so auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass nullok @@ -508,15 +508,58 @@ account required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth account required /lib/security/pam_winbind.so password required /lib/security/pam_stack.so service=system-auth </pre><p> -</p><p> + </p><p> + “<span class="quote"> When I open a new console with [ctrl][alt][F1], then I cant log in with my user "pitie". I've tried with user "scienceu+pitie" also. +</span>” </p><p> - Answer: The problem may lie with your inclusion of <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack.so + The problem may lie with your inclusion of <i class="parameter"><tt>pam_stack.so service=system-auth</tt></i>. That file often contains a lot of stuff that may duplicate what you're already doing. Try commenting out the pam_stack lines for auth and account and see if things work. If they do, look at <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt> and copy only what you need from it into your <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/login</tt> file. Alternatively, if you want all services to use winbind, you can put the winbind-specific stuff in <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/system-auth</tt>. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2951576"></a>Winbind is not resolving users and groups</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote"> + My smb.conf file is correctly configured. I have specified + <a class="indexterm" name="id2951590"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i> = 12000, + and <a class="indexterm" name="id2951604"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i> = 3000-3500 + and <b class="command">winbind</b> is running. When I do the following it all works fine. +</span>” + </p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -u</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+maryo +MIDEARTH+jackb +MIDEARTH+ameds +... +MIDEARTH+root + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>wbinfo -g</tt></b> +MIDEARTH+Domain Users +MIDEARTH+Domain Admins +MIDEARTH+Domain Guests +... +MIDEARTH+Accounts + +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent passwd</tt></b> +root:x:0:0:root:/root:/bin/bash +bin:x:1:1:bin:/bin:/bin/bash +... +maryo:x:15000:15003:Mary Orville:/home/MIDEARTH/maryo:/bin/false +</pre><p> + “<span class="quote"> + But the following command just fails: +</span>” +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>chown 'maryo' a_file</tt></b> +chown: `maryo': invalid user +</pre><p> +“<span class="quote"> +This is driving me nuts! What can be wrong? +</span>” + </p><p> + Your system is likely running <b class="command">nscd</b>, the name service + caching daemon. Shut it down, do NOT restart it! You will find your problem resolved. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ProfileMgmt.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html b/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html index 2c68f50c87..4d5432fd70 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/passdb.html @@ -1,26 +1,27 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide"><link rel="next" href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="groupmapping.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="passdb"></a>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Olivier (lem)</span> <span class="surname">Lemaire</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IDEALX<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 24, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910308">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910636">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910700">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2910954">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911009">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911041">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911306">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911458">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911494">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911534">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911641">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2911668">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913185">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913989">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2913997">Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2914012">Users are being added to the wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2914072">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> -Samba-3 implements a new capability to work concurrently with multiple account backends. -The possible new combinations of password backends allows Samba-3 a degree of flexibility +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide"><link rel="next" href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="groupmapping.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="passdb"></a>Chapter 11. Account Information Databases</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jeremy</span> <span class="surname">Allison</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org">jra@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Olivier (lem)</span> <span class="surname">Lemaire</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">IDEALX<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 24, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898446">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898460">Backwards Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898561">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898749">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898874">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899165">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899351">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899622">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899860">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899902">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899942">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2900055">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2900089">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2901940">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902790">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902796">Users can not logon</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902841">Users being added to wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902952">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +Samba 3 implements a new capability to work concurrently with multiple account backends. +The possible new combinations of password backends allows Samba 3 a degree of flexibility and scalability that previously could be achieved only with MS Windows Active Directory. This chapter describes the new functionality and how to get the most out of it. </p><p> In the course of development of Samba-3, a number of requests were received to provide the ability to migrate MS Windows NT4 SAM accounts to Samba-3 without the need to provide -matching Unix/Linux accounts. We called this the <span class="emphasis"><em>Non Unix Accounts (NUA)</em></span> +matching UNIX/Linux accounts. We called this the <span class="emphasis"><em>Non UNIX Accounts (NUA)</em></span> capability. The intent was that an administrator could decide to use the <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> -backend and by simply specifying <span class="emphasis"><em>"passdb backend = tdbsam_nua, guest"</em></span> -this would allow Samba-3 to implement a solution that did not use Unix accounts per se. Late +backend and by simply specifying <a class="indexterm" name="id2898413"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam_nua +this would allow Samba-3 to implement a solution that did not use UNIX accounts per se. Late in the development cycle, the team doing this work hit upon some obstacles that prevents this solution from being used. Given the delays with Samba-3 release a decision was made to NOT deliver this functionality until a better method of recognising NT Group SIDs from NT User SIDs could be found. This feature may thus return during the life cycle for the Samba-3 series. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -Samba-3.0.0 does NOT support Non-Unix Account (NUA) operation. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910308"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 does NOT support Non-UNIX Account (NUA) operation for user accounts. +Samba-3 does support NUA operation for machine accounts. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2898446"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 provides for complete backwards compatibility with Samba-2.2.x functionality as follows: -</p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>Backwards Compatibility Backends</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">Plain Text:</span></dt><dd><p> - This option uses nothing but the Unix/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898460"></a>Backwards Compatibility Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Plain Text:</span></dt><dd><p> + This option uses nothing but the UNIX/Linux <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> style back end. On systems that have PAM (Pluggable Authentication Modules) support all PAM modules are supported. The behaviour is just as it was with Samba-2.2.x, and the protocol limitations imposed by MS Windows clients @@ -42,13 +43,9 @@ as follows: This option is provided primarily as a migration tool, although there is no reason to force migration at this time. Note that this tool will eventually be deprecated. - </p></dd></dl></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898561"></a>New Backends</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: -</p><div class="variablelist"><p class="title"><b>New Backends</b></p><dl><dt><span class="term">guest:</span></dt><dd><p> - This is <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> required as the last backend specified. - It provides the ability to handle guest account requirements for access to - resources like <i class="parameter"><tt>IPC$</tt></i> which is used for browsing. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">tdbsam:</span></dt><dd><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">tdbsam:</span></dt><dd><p> This backend provides a rich database backend for local servers. This backend is NOT suitable for multiple domain controller (ie: PDC + one or more BDC) installations. @@ -90,10 +87,7 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: The xmlsam option can be useful for account migration between database backends or backups. Use of this tool will allow the data to be edited before migration into another backend format. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">nisplussam:</span></dt><dd><p> - The NIS+ based passdb backend. Takes name NIS domain as an - optional argument. Only works with Sun NIS+ servers. - </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910636"></a>Technical Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2898749"></a>Technical Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Old windows clients send plain text passwords over the wire. Samba can check these passwords by crypting them and comparing them to the hash stored in the unix user database. </p><p> @@ -108,10 +102,10 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: In addition to differently encrypted passwords, windows also stores certain data for each user that is not stored in a unix user database. e.g: workstations the user may logon from, the location where the users' profile is stored, and so on. Samba retrieves and stores this - information using a <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Commonly available backends are LDAP, plain text + information using a <a class="indexterm" name="id2898789"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Commonly available backends are LDAP, plain text file, MySQL and nisplus. For more information, see the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> regarding the - <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> parameter. - </p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910700"></a>Important Notes About Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2898812"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> parameter. + </p><div class="figure"><a name="idmap-diag"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 11.1. IDMAP</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/idmap.png" width="270" alt="IDMAP"></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2898874"></a>Important Notes About Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The unix and SMB password encryption techniques seem similar on the surface. This similarity is, however, only skin deep. The unix scheme typically sends clear text passwords over the network when logging in. This is bad. The SMB encryption scheme @@ -135,12 +129,12 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: </p><p> The following versions of MS Windows do not support full domain security protocols, although they may log onto a domain environment: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>MS DOS Network client 3.0 with the basic network redirector installed</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 95 with the network redirector update installed</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 98 [se]</td></tr><tr><td>Windows Me</td></tr></table><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>MS DOS Network client 3.0 with the basic network redirector installed</p></li><li><p>Windows 95 with the network redirector update installed</p></li><li><p>Windows 98 [se]</p></li><li><p>Windows Me</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> MS Windows XP Home does not have facilities to become a domain member and it can not participate in domain logons. </p></div><p> The following versions of MS Windows fully support domain security protocols. - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Windows NT 3.5x</td></tr><tr><td>Windows NT 4.0</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 2000 Professional</td></tr><tr><td>Windows 200x Server/Advanced Server</td></tr><tr><td>Windows XP Professional</td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Windows NT 3.5x</p></li><li><p>Windows NT 4.0</p></li><li><p>Windows 2000 Professional</p></li><li><p>Windows 200x Server/Advanced Server</p></li><li><p>Windows XP Professional</p></li></ul></div><p> All current release of Microsoft SMB/CIFS clients support authentication via the SMB Challenge/Response mechanism described here. Enabling clear text authentication does not disable the ability of the client to participate in encrypted authentication. @@ -153,7 +147,7 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: (broken) only the cached (encrypted) password will be sent to the resource server to affect a auto-reconnect. If the resource server does not support encrypted passwords the auto-reconnect will fail. <span class="emphasis"><em>USE OF ENCRYPTED PASSWORDS IS STRONGLY ADVISED.</em></span> - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2910863"></a>Advantages of Encrypted Passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not passed across + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2899068"></a>Advantages of Encrypted Passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not passed across the network. Someone using a network sniffer cannot just record passwords going to the SMB server.</p></li><li><p>Plain text passwords are not stored anywhere in memory or on disk.</p></li><li><p>WinNT doesn't like talking to a server @@ -164,32 +158,44 @@ Samba-3 introduces the following new password backend capabilities: only things you can do to stop this is to use SMB encryption. </p></li><li><p>Encrypted password support allows automatic share (resource) reconnects.</p></li><li><p>Encrypted passwords are essential for PDC/BDC - operation.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2910917"></a>Advantages of non-encrypted passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not kept + operation.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2899128"></a>Advantages of non-encrypted passwords</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Plain text passwords are not kept on disk, and are NOT cached in memory. </p></li><li><p>Uses same password file as other unix services such as login and ftp</p></li><li><p>Use of other services (such as telnet and ftp) which send plain text passwords over the net, so sending them for SMB - isn't such a big deal.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910954"></a>Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and Unix</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Every operation in Unix/Linux requires a user identifier (UID), just as in + isn't such a big deal.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899165"></a>Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Every operation in UNIX/Linux requires a user identifier (UID), just as in MS Windows NT4 / 200x this requires a Security Identifier (SID). Samba provides - two means for mapping an MS Windows user to a Unix/Linux UID. + two means for mapping an MS Windows user to a UNIX/Linux UID. </p><p> Firstly, all Samba SAM (Security Account Manager database) accounts require - a Unix/Linux UID that the account will map to. As users are added to the account - information database, Samba-3 will call the <i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> - interface to add the account to the Samba host OS. In essence, all accounts in + a UNIX/Linux UID that the account will map to. As users are added to the account + information database, Samba will call the <a class="indexterm" name="id2899188"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> + interface to add the account to the Samba host OS. In essence all accounts in the local SAM require a local user account. </p><p> - The second way to affect Windows SID to Unix UID mapping is via the + The second way to affect Windows SID to UNIX UID mapping is via the <span class="emphasis"><em>idmap uid, idmap gid</em></span> parameters in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Please refer to the man page for information about these parameters. These parameters are essential when mapping users from a remote SAM server. - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911009"></a>Account Management Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba-3 provides two (2) tools for management of User and machine accounts. These tools are + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="idmapbackend"></a>Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba-3 has a special facility that makes it possible to maintain identical UIDs and GIDs + on all servers in a distributed network. A distributed network is one where there exists + a PDC, one or more BDCs and/or one or more domain member servers. Why is this important? + This is important if files are being shared over more than one protocol (eg: NFS) and where + users are copying files across UNIX/Linux systems using tools such as <b class="command">rsync</b>. + </p><p> + The special facility is enabled using a parameter called <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i>. + The default setting for this parameter is an empty string. Administrators should NOT set this + parameter except when an LDAP based passdb backend is in use. An example of use is: + </p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="idmapbackendexample"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.1. </b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam://ldap-server.quenya.org:636</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="acctmgmttools"></a>Account Management Tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba provides two (2) tools for management of User and machine accounts. These tools are called <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> and <b class="command">pdbedit</b>. A third tool is under development but is NOT expected to ship in time for Samba-3.0.0. The new tool will be a TCL/TK GUI tool that looks much like the MS Windows NT4 Domain User Manager - hopefully this will be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911041"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899351"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The smbpasswd utility is a utility similar to the <b class="command">passwd</b> or <b class="command">yppasswd</b> programs. It maintains the two 32 byte password fields in the passdb backend. @@ -203,19 +209,19 @@ be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. if changing an NT Domain user's password). </p><p> <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> can be used to: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>add</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>delete</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>enable</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>disable</em></span> user or machine accounts</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>set to NULL</em></span> user passwords</td></tr><tr><td><span class="emphasis"><em>manage interdomain trust accounts</em></span></td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>add</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>delete</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>enable</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>disable</em></span> user or machine accounts</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>set to NULL</em></span> user passwords</p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>manage interdomain trust accounts</em></span></p></li></ul></div><p> To run smbpasswd as a normal user just type: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">Old SMB password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Old SMB password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> For <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> type old value here - or hit return if there was no old password - </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">Repeat New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Repeat New SMB Password: </tt><b class="userinput"><tt><i class="replaceable"><tt>new secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> If the old value does not match the current value stored for that user, or the two new values do not match each other, then the password will not be changed. @@ -235,10 +241,10 @@ be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. </p><p> For more details on using <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> refer to the man page (the definitive reference). - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911306"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>pdbedit</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899622"></a>The <span class="emphasis"><em>pdbedit</em></span> Command</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <b class="command">pdbedit</b> is a tool that can be used only by root. It is used to manage the passdb backend. <b class="command">pdbedit</b> can be used to: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>add, remove or modify user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>listing user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>migrate user accounts</td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>add, remove or modify user accounts</p></li><li><p>listing user accounts</p></li><li><p>migrate user accounts</p></li></ul></div><p> The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> tool is the only one that can manage the account security and policy settings. It is capable of all operations that smbpasswd can do as well as a super set of them. @@ -250,50 +256,60 @@ be announced in time for the Samba-3.0.1 release. The following is an example of the user account information that is stored in a tdbsam password backend. This listing was produced by running: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv met</tt></b> - Unix username: met - NT username: - Account Flags: [UX ] - User SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-2004 - Primary Group SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-1201 - Full Name: Melissa E Terpstra - Home Directory: \\frodo\met\Win9Profile - HomeDir Drive: H: - Logon Script: scripts\logon.bat - Profile Path: \\frodo\Profiles\met - Domain: MIDEARTH - Account desc: - Workstations: melbelle - Munged dial: - Logon time: 0 - Logoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT - Kickoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT - Password last set: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT - Password can change: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT - Password must change: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT - </pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911458"></a>Password Backends</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba-3 offers the greatest flexibility in backend account database design of any SMB/CIFS server +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -Lv met</tt></b> +UNIX username: met +NT username: +Account Flags: [UX ] +User SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-2004 +Primary Group SID: S-1-5-21-1449123459-1407424037-3116680435-1201 +Full Name: Melissa E Terpstra +Home Directory: \\frodo\met\Win9Profile +HomeDir Drive: H: +Logon Script: scripts\logon.bat +Profile Path: \\frodo\Profiles\met +Domain: MIDEARTH +Account desc: +Workstations: melbelle +Munged dial: +Logon time: 0 +Logoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +Kickoff time: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +Password last set: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT +Password can change: Sat, 14 Dec 2002 14:37:03 GMT +Password must change: Mon, 18 Jan 2038 20:14:07 GMT +</pre><p> + The <b class="command">pdbedit</b> tool allows migration of authentication (account) + databases from one backend to another. For example: To migrate accounts from an + old <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> database to a <i class="parameter"><tt>tdbsam</tt></i> + backend: + </p><div class="procedure"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Set the <a class="indexterm" name="id2899790"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = tdbsam, smbpasswd. + </p></li><li><p> + Execute: +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -i smbpassed -e tdbsam</tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></li><li><p> + Now remove the <i class="parameter"><tt>smbpasswd</tt></i> from the passdb backend + configuration in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. + </p></li></ol></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2899860"></a>Password Backends</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba offers the greatest flexibility in backend account database design of any SMB/CIFS server technology available today. The flexibility is immediately obvious as one begins to explore this capability. </p><p> It is possible to specify not only multiple different password backends, but even multiple backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[globals] - passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/passdb.tdb, \ - tdbsam:/etc/samba/old-passdb.tdb, guest -</pre><p> -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911494"></a>Plain Text</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/passdb.tdb, tdbsam:/etc/samba/old-passdb.tdb</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899902"></a>Plain Text</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Older versions of Samba retrieved user information from the unix user database and eventually some other fields from the file <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smbpasswd</tt> or <tt class="filename">/etc/smbpasswd</tt>. When password encryption is disabled, no SMB specific data is stored at all. Instead all operations are conducted via the way that the Samba host OS will access its <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> database. eg: On Linux systems that is done via PAM. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911534"></a>smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - Traditionally, when configuring <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt - passwords = yes</a> in Samba's <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, user account + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2899942"></a>smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Traditionally, when configuring <a class="indexterm" name="id2899952"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i> = yes in Samba's <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, user account information such as username, LM/NT password hashes, password change times, and account flags have been stored in the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd(5)</tt> file. There are several disadvantages to this approach for sites with very large numbers of users (counted @@ -319,10 +335,10 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: is commonly referred to as the samdb interface (previously this was called the passdb API, and is still so named in the Samba CVS trees). </p><p> - Samba-3 provides an enhanced set of passdb backends that overcome the deficiencies + Samba provides an enhanced set of passdb backends that overcome the deficiencies of the smbpasswd plain text database. These are tdbsam, ldapsam, and xmlsam. Of these ldapsam will be of most interest to large corporate or enterprise sites. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911641"></a>tdbsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba can store user and machine account data in a "TDB" (Trivial Database). + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900055"></a>tdbsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba can store user and machine account data in a "TDB" (Trivial Database). Using this backend doesn't require any additional configuration. This backend is recommended for new installations that do not require LDAP. </p><p> @@ -330,7 +346,7 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: that have 250 or more users. Additionally, tdbsam is not capable of scaling for use in sites that require PDB/BDC implementations that requires replication of the account database. Clearly, for reason of scalability, the use of ldapsam should be encouraged. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911668"></a>ldapsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2900089"></a>ldapsam</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a few points to stress that the ldapsam does not provide. The LDAP support referred to in the this documentation does not include: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>A means of retrieving user account information from @@ -353,28 +369,30 @@ backends of the same type. For example, to use two different tdbsam databases: and has a working directory server already installed. For more information on LDAP architectures and Directories, please refer to the following sites. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>OpenLDAP - <a href="http://www.openldap.org/" target="_top">http://www.openldap.org/</a></p></li><li><p>iPlanet Directory Server - - <a href="http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory" target="_top">http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory</a></p></li></ul></div><p> + <a href="http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory" target="_top">http://iplanet.netscape.com/directory</a></p></li></ul></div><p> Two additional Samba resources which may prove to be helpful are </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The <a href="http://www.unav.es/cti/ldap-smb/ldap-smb-3-howto.html" target="_top">Samba-PDC-LDAP-HOWTO</a> maintained by Ignacio Coupeau.</p></li><li><p>The NT migration scripts from <a href="http://samba.idealx.org/" target="_top">IDEALX</a> that are geared to manage users and group in such a Samba-LDAP Domain Controller configuration. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911821"></a>Supported LDAP Servers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900244"></a>Supported LDAP Servers</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The LDAP ldapsam code has been developed and tested using the OpenLDAP 2.0 and 2.1 server and client libraries. The same code should work with Netscape's Directory Server and client SDK. However, there are bound to be compile errors and bugs. These should not be hard to fix. Please submit fixes via <a href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs">Bug reporting facility</a>. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911847"></a>Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900270"></a>Schema and Relationship to the RFC 2307 posixAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba 3.0 includes the necessary schema file for OpenLDAP 2.0 in <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP/samba.schema</tt>. The sambaSamAccount objectclass is given here: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> -objectclass ( 1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.3 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY - DESC 'Samba Auxiliary Account' - MUST ( uid $ rid ) - MAY ( cn $ lmPassword $ ntPassword $ pwdLastSet $ logonTime $ - logoffTime $ kickoffTime $ pwdCanChange $ pwdMustChange $ acctFlags $ - displayName $ smbHome $ homeDrive $ scriptPath $ profilePath $ - description $ userWorkstations $ primaryGroupID $ domain )) +objectclass ( 1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.6 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY + DESC 'Samba 3.0 Auxiliary SAM Account' + MUST ( uid $ sambaSID ) + MAY ( cn $ sambaLMPassword $ sambaNTPassword $ sambaPwdLastSet $ + sambaLogonTime $ sambaLogoffTime $ sambaKickoffTime $ + sambaPwdCanChange $ sambaPwdMustChange $ sambaAcctFlags $ + displayName $ sambaHomePath $ sambaHomeDrive $ sambaLogonScript $ + sambaProfilePath $ description $ sambaUserWorkstations $ + sambaPrimaryGroupSID $ sambaDomainName )) </pre><p> </p><p> The <tt class="filename">samba.schema</tt> file has been formatted for OpenLDAP 2.0/2.1. @@ -398,7 +416,7 @@ objectclass ( 1.3.6.1.4.1.7165.2.2.3 NAME 'sambaSamAccount' SUP top AUXILIARY and functioning correctly. This division of information makes it possible to store all Samba account information in LDAP, but still maintain UNIX account information in NIS while the network is transitioning to a full LDAP infrastructure. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2911953"></a>OpenLDAP configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900380"></a>OpenLDAP configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To include support for the sambaSamAccount object in an OpenLDAP directory server, first copy the samba.schema file to slapd's configuration directory. The samba.schema file can be found in the directory <tt class="filename">examples/LDAP</tt> @@ -432,7 +450,7 @@ include /etc/openldap/schema/nis.schema like in the following example, to speed up searches made on sambaSamAccount objectclasses (and possibly posixAccount and posixGroup as well). </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> # Indices to maintain ## required by OpenLDAP index objectclass eq @@ -459,7 +477,7 @@ index default sub Create the new index by executing: </p><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -./sbin/slapindex -f slapd.conf +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt>./sbin/slapindex -f slapd.conf </pre><p> </p><p> Remember to restart slapd after making these changes: @@ -467,34 +485,34 @@ index default sub </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/etc/init.d/slapd restart</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2912141"></a>Initialise the LDAP database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900576"></a>Initialise the LDAP database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before you can add accounts to the LDAP database you must create the account containers that they will be stored in. The following LDIF file should be modified to match your needs (ie: Your DNS entries, etc.). </p><p> -</p><pre class="screen"> +</p><pre class="programlisting"> # Organization for Samba Base -dn: dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: dc=quenya,dc=org objectclass: dcObject objectclass: organization -dc: plainjoe -o: Terpstra Org Network +dc: quenya +o: Quenya Org Network description: The Samba-3 Network LDAP Example # Organizational Role for Directory Management -dn: cn=Manager,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: cn=Manager,dc=quenya,dc=org objectclass: organizationalRole cn: Manager description: Directory Manager # Setting up container for users -dn: ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org objectclass: top objectclass: organizationalUnit ou: People # Setting up admin handle for People OU -dn: cn=admin,ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org +dn: cn=admin,ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org cn: admin objectclass: top objectclass: organizationalRole @@ -516,70 +534,39 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Before Samba can access the LDAP server you need to store the LDAP admin password into the Samba-3 <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> database by: - </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> - </pre><p> - </p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2912270"></a>Configuring Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2900704"></a>Configuring Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following parameters are available in smb.conf only if your version of samba was built with LDAP support. Samba automatically builds with LDAP support if the LDAP libraries are found. - </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND" target="_top">passdb backend = ldapsam:url</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSSL" target="_top">ldap ssl</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN" target="_top">ldap admin dn</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPSUFFIX" target="_top">ldap suffix</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPFILTER" target="_top">ldap filter</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPMACHINSUFFIX" target="_top">ldap machine suffix</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPUSERSUFFIX" target="_top">ldap user suffix</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPDELETEDN" target="_top">ldap delete dn</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPPASSWDSYNC" target="_top">ldap passwd sync</a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPTRUSTIDS" target="_top">ldap trust ids</a></p></li></ul></div><p> + </p><p>LDAP related smb.conf options: + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900721"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> = ldapsam:url, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900737"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900750"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900764"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900777"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900791"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900805"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900819"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900833"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i>, + <a class="indexterm" name="id2900847"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap trust ids</tt></i>. + </p><p> These are described in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page and so will not be repeated here. However, a sample smb.conf file for use with an LDAP directory could appear as </p><p> -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -## /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf -[global] - security = user - encrypt passwords = yes - - netbios name = TASHTEGO - workgroup = NARNIA - - # ldap related parameters - - # define the DN to use when binding to the directory servers - # The password for this DN is not stored in smb.conf. Rather it - # must be set by using 'smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secretpw</tt></i>' to store the - # passphrase in the secrets.tdb file. If the "ldap admin dn" values - # change, this password will need to be reset. - ldap admin dn = "cn=Samba Manager,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org" - - # Define the SSL option when connecting to the directory - # ('off', 'start tls', or 'on' (default)) - ldap ssl = start tls - - # syntax: passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://server-name[:port] - passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://funball.samba.org, guest - - # smbpasswd -x delete the entire dn-entry - ldap delete dn = no - - # the machine and user suffix added to the base suffix - # wrote WITHOUT quotes. NULL suffixes by default - ldap user suffix = ou=People - ldap machine suffix = ou=Systems - - # Trust unix account information in LDAP - # (see the smb.conf manpage for details) - ldap trust ids = Yes - - # specify the base DN to use when searching the directory - ldap suffix = "ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org" - - # generally the default ldap search filter is ok - # ldap filter = "(&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaSamAccount))" -</pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2912468"></a>Accounts and Groups management</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2900879"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 11.2. Configuration with LDAP</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = TASHTEGO</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = NARNIA</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># ldap related parameters</td></tr><tr><td># define the DN to use when binding to the directory servers</td></tr><tr><td># The password for this DN is not stored in smb.conf. Rather it</td></tr><tr><td># must be set by using 'smbpasswd -w <i class="replaceable"><tt>secretpw</tt></i>' to store the</td></tr><tr><td># passphrase in the secrets.tdb file. If the "ldap admin dn" values</td></tr><tr><td># change, this password will need to be reset.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn = "cn=Samba Manager,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org"</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Define the SSL option when connecting to the directory</td></tr><tr><td># ('off', 'start tls', or 'on' (default))</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = start tls</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># syntax: passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://server-name[:port]</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam:ldap://funball.samba.org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># smbpasswd -x delete the entire dn-entry</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># the machine and user suffix added to the base suffix</td></tr><tr><td># wrote WITHOUT quotes. NULL suffixes by default</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix = ou=People</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix = ou=Systems</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># Trust unix account information in LDAP</td></tr><tr><td># (see the smb.conf manpage for details)</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap trust ids = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># specify the base DN to use when searching the directory</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix = "ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org"</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># generally the default ldap search filter is ok</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter = "(&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaSamAccount))"</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901104"></a>Accounts and Groups management</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> As users accounts are managed through the sambaSamAccount objectclass, you should modify your existing administration tools to deal with sambaSamAccount attributes. </p><p> Machines accounts are managed with the sambaSamAccount objectclass, just like users accounts. However, it's up to you to store those accounts in a different tree of your LDAP namespace: you should use - "ou=Groups,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" to store groups and - "ou=People,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" to store users. Just configure your + "ou=Groups,dc=quenya,dc=org" to store groups and + "ou=People,dc=quenya,dc=org" to store users. Just configure your NSS and PAM accordingly (usually, in the /etc/ldap.conf configuration file). </p><p> @@ -587,7 +574,7 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz groups. This means that Samba makes use of the posixGroup objectclass. For now, there is no NT-like group system management (global and local groups). - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2912505"></a>Security and sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901140"></a>Security and sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are two important points to remember when discussing the security of sambaSamAccount entries in the directory. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Never</em></span> retrieve the lmPassword or @@ -598,13 +585,13 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz on the details of LM/NT password hashes, refer to the <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database</a> section of this chapter. </p><p> - To remedy the first security issue, the <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter defaults - to require an encrypted session (<i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = on</tt></i>) using + To remedy the first security issue, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2901200"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameter defaults + to require an encrypted session (<a class="indexterm" name="id2901222"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = on) using the default port of <tt class="constant">636</tt> when contacting the directory server. When using an OpenLDAP server, it is possible to use the use the StartTLS LDAP extended operation in the place of LDAPS. In either case, you are strongly discouraged to disable this security - (<i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl = off</tt></i>). + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2901244"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i> = off). </p><p> Note that the LDAPS protocol is deprecated in favor of the LDAPv3 StartTLS extended operation. However, the OpenLDAP library still provides support for @@ -617,84 +604,83 @@ userPassword: {SSHA}c3ZM9tBaBo9autm1dL3waDS21+JSfQVz </p><pre class="programlisting"> ## allow the "ldap admin dn" access, but deny everyone else access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword - by dn="cn=Samba Admin,ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org" write + by dn="cn=Samba Admin,ou=people,dc=quenya,dc=org" write by * none </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2912642"></a>LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901300"></a>LDAP special attributes for sambaSamAccounts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The sambaSamAccount objectclass is composed of the following attributes: </p><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2912659"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.1. Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</b></p><table summary="Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt></td><td align="left">the LANMAN password 16-byte hash stored as a character - representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt></td><td align="left">the NT password hash 16-byte stored as a character - representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">pwdLastSet</tt></td><td align="left">The integer time in seconds since 1970 when the - <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> attributes were last set. - </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">acctFlags</tt></td><td align="left">string of 11 characters surrounded by square brackets [] + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2901317"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.1. Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</b></p><table summary="Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><tbody><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLMPassword</tt></td><td align="justify">the LANMAN password 16-byte hash stored as a character +representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaNTPassword</tt></td><td align="justify">the NT password hash 16-byte stored as a character + representation of a hexadecimal string.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdLastSet</tt></td><td align="justify">The integer time in seconds since 1970 when the + <tt class="constant">sambaLMPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">sambaNTPassword</tt> attributes were last set. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaAcctFlags</tt></td><td align="justify">string of 11 characters surrounded by square brackets [] representing account flags such as U (user), W(workstation), X(no password expiration), I(Domain trust account), H(Home dir required), S(Server trust account), - and D(disabled).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">logonTime</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">logoffTime</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">kickoffTime</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">pwdCanChange</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">pwdMustChange</tt></td><td align="left">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">homeDrive</tt></td><td align="left">specifies the drive letter to which to map the - UNC path specified by homeDirectory. The drive letter must be specified in the form "X:" + and D(disabled).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogonTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogoffTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaKickoffTime</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdCanChange</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPwdMustChange</tt></td><td align="justify">Integer value currently unused</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaHomeDrive</tt></td><td align="justify">specifies the drive letter to which to map the + UNC path specified by sambaHomePath. The drive letter must be specified in the form "X:" where X is the letter of the drive to map. Refer to the "logon drive" parameter in the - smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">scriptPath</tt></td><td align="left">The scriptPath property specifies the path of + smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaLogonScript</tt></td><td align="justify">The sambaLogonScript property specifies the path of the user's logon script, .CMD, .EXE, or .BAT file. The string can be null. The path - is relative to the netlogon share. Refer to the "logon script" parameter in the - smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">profilePath</tt></td><td align="left">specifies a path to the user's profile. + is relative to the netlogon share. Refer to the <a class="indexterm" name="id2901492"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i> parameter in the + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaProfilePath</tt></td><td align="justify">specifies a path to the user's profile. This value can be a null string, a local absolute path, or a UNC path. Refer to the - "logon path" parameter in the smb.conf(5) man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">smbHome</tt></td><td align="left">The homeDirectory property specifies the path of - the home directory for the user. The string can be null. If homeDrive is set and specifies - a drive letter, homeDirectory should be a UNC path. The path must be a network - UNC path of the form <tt class="filename">\\server\share\directory</tt>. This value can be a null string. - Refer to the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information. - </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">userWorkstation</tt></td><td align="left">character string value currently unused. - </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">rid</tt></td><td align="left">the integer representation of the user's relative identifier - (RID).</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">primaryGroupID</tt></td><td align="left">the relative identifier (RID) of the primary group - of the user.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">domain</tt></td><td align="left">domain the user is part of.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2901527"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaHomePath</tt></td><td align="justify">The sambaHomePath property specifies the path of +the home directory for the user. The string can be null. If sambaHomeDrive is set and specifies +a drive letter, sambaHomePath should be a UNC path. The path must be a network +UNC path of the form <tt class="filename">\\server\share\directory</tt>. This value can be a null string. +Refer to the <b class="command">logon home</b> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for more information. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaUserWorkstations</tt></td><td align="justify">character string value currently unused. + </td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaSID</tt></td><td align="justify">The security identifier(SID) of the user. The windows equivalent of unix uid's.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaPrimaryGroupSID</tt></td><td align="justify">the relative identifier (RID) of the primary group + of the user.</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><tt class="constant">sambaDomainName</tt></td><td align="justify">domain the user is part of.</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> The majority of these parameters are only used when Samba is acting as a PDC of a domain (refer to the <a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Samba as a primary domain controller</a> chapter for details on how to configure Samba as a Primary Domain Controller). The following four attributes are only stored with the sambaSamAccount entry if the values are non-default values: - </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>smbHome</td></tr><tr><td>scriptPath</td></tr><tr><td>logonPath</td></tr><tr><td>homeDrive</td></tr></table><p> + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>sambaHomePath</p></li><li><p>sambaLogonScript</p></li><li><p>sambaProfilePath</p></li><li><p>sambaHomeDrive</p></li></ul></div><p> These attributes are only stored with the sambaSamAccount entry if the values are non-default values. For example, assume TASHTEGO has now been - configured as a PDC and that <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\%L\%u</tt></i> was defined in + configured as a PDC and that <a class="indexterm" name="id2901683"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> = \\%L\%u was defined in its <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. When a user named "becky" logons to the domain, - the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> string is expanded to \\TASHTEGO\becky. + the <a class="indexterm" name="id2901708"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> string is expanded to \\TASHTEGO\becky. If the smbHome attribute exists in the entry "uid=becky,ou=people,dc=samba,dc=org", this value is used. However, if this attribute does not exist, then the value - of the <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter is used in its place. Samba + of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2901732"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i> parameter is used in its place. Samba will only write the attribute value to the directory entry if the value is something other than the default (e.g. <tt class="filename">\\MOBY\becky</tt>). - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913008"></a>Example LDIF Entries for a sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901758"></a>Example LDIF Entries for a sambaSamAccount</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following is a working LDIF with the inclusion of the posixAccount objectclass: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> - dn: uid=guest2, ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org - ntPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 - pwdMustChange: 2147483647 - primaryGroupID: 1201 - lmPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE - pwdLastSet: 1010179124 - logonTime: 0 + dn: uid=guest2, ou=people,dc=quenya,dc=org + sambaNTPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 + sambaPwdMustChange: 2147483647 + sambaPrimaryGroupSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-513 + sambaNTPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE + sambaPwdLastSet: 1010179124 + sambaLogonTime: 0 objectClass: sambaSamAccount uid: guest2 - kickoffTime: 2147483647 - acctFlags: [UX ] - logoffTime: 2147483647 - rid: 19006 - pwdCanChange: 0 + sambaKickoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaAcctFlags: [UX ] + sambaLogoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5006 + sambaPwdCanChange: 0 </pre><p> </p><p> The following is an LDIF entry for using both the sambaSamAccount and posixAccount objectclasses: </p><p> </p><pre class="programlisting"> - dn: uid=gcarter, ou=people,dc=plainjoe,dc=org - logonTime: 0 + dn: uid=gcarter, ou=people,dc=quenya,dc=org + sambaLogonTime: 0 displayName: Gerald Carter - lmPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE - primaryGroupID: 1201 + sambaLMPassword: 552902031BEDE9EFAAD3B435B51404EE + sambaPrimaryGroupSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-1201 objectClass: posixAccount objectClass: sambaSamAccount - acctFlags: [UX ] + sambaAcctFlags: [UX ] userPassword: {crypt}BpM2ej8Rkzogo uid: gcarter uidNumber: 9000 @@ -702,60 +688,59 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword loginShell: /bin/bash logoffTime: 2147483647 gidNumber: 100 - kickoffTime: 2147483647 - pwdLastSet: 1010179230 - rid: 19000 + sambaKickoffTime: 2147483647 + sambaPwdLastSet: 1010179230 + sambaSID: S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004 homeDirectory: /home/tashtego/gcarter - pwdCanChange: 0 - pwdMustChange: 2147483647 - ntPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 + sambaPwdCanChange: 0 + sambaPwdMustChange: 2147483647 + sambaNTPassword: 878D8014606CDA29677A44EFA1353FC7 </pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913071"></a>Password synchronisation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901824"></a>Password synchronisation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since version 3.0 samba can update the non-samba (LDAP) password stored with an account. When using pam_ldap, this allows changing both unix and windows passwords at once. - </p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i> options can have the following values:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">yes</span></dt><dd><p>When the user changes his password, update + </p><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2901842"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i> options can have the following values:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">yes</span></dt><dd><p>When the user changes his password, update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt>, <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt> - and the <tt class="constant">password</tt> fields.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">no</span></dt><dd><p>Only update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">only</span></dt><dd><p>Only update the LDAP password and let the LDAP server worry - about the other fields. This option is only available when the LDAP server supports LDAP_EXOP_X_MODIFY_PASSWD. </p></dd></dl></div><p>More information can be found in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPPASSWDSYNC" target="_top">smb.conf</a> manpage. - </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913185"></a>MySQL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + and the <tt class="constant">password</tt> fields.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">no</span></dt><dd><p>Only update <tt class="constant">ntPassword</tt> and <tt class="constant">lmPassword</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">only</span></dt><dd><p>Only update the LDAP password and let the LDAP server worry about the other fields. This option is only available on some LDAP servers. <sup>[<a name="id2901925" href="#ftn.id2901925">3</a>]</sup></p></dd></dl></div><p>More information can be found in the smb.conf manpage. + </p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2901940"></a>MySQL</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every so often someone will come along with a great new idea. Storing of user accounts in an SQL backend is one of them. Those who want to do this are in the best position to know what the specific benefits are to them. This may sound like a cop-out, but in truth we can not attempt to document every nitty little detail why certain things of marginal utility to the bulk of Samba users might make sense to the rest. In any case, the following instructions should help the determined SQL user to implement a working system. - </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913204"></a>Creating the database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2901962"></a>Creating the database</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You either can set up your own table and specify the field names to pdb_mysql (see below for the column names) or use the default table. The file <tt class="filename">examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt> contains the correct queries to create the required tables. Use the command : - </p><pre class="screen"><tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mysql -u<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> -h<i class="replaceable"><tt>hostname</tt></i> -p<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i> \ -<i class="replaceable"><tt>databasename</tt></i> < <tt class="filename">/path/to/samba/examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt></tt></b></pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913268"></a>Configuring</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>This plugin lacks some good documentation, but here is some short info:</p><p>Add a the following to the <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> variable in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - passdb backend = [other-plugins] mysql:identifier [other-plugins] - </pre><p> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>mysql -u<i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> -h<i class="replaceable"><tt>hostname</tt></i> -p<i class="replaceable"><tt>password</tt></i> \ +<i class="replaceable"><tt>databasename</tt></i> < <tt class="filename">/path/to/samba/examples/pdb/mysql/mysql.dump</tt></tt></b> +</pre><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2902030"></a>Configuring</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>This plugin lacks some good documentation, but here is some short info:</p><p>Add a the following to the <a class="indexterm" name="id2902046"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> variable in your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = [other-plugins] mysql:identifier [other-plugins]</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> </p><p>The identifier can be any string you like, as long as it doesn't collide with the identifiers of other plugins or other instances of pdb_mysql. If you - specify multiple pdb_mysql.so entries in <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>, you also need to + specify multiple pdb_mysql.so entries in <a class="indexterm" name="id2902089"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>, you also need to use different identifiers! </p><p> Additional options can be given through the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section. </p><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2913346"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.2. Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql host</td><td align="left">host name, defaults to 'localhost'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql password</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql user</td><td align="left">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql database</td><td align="left">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:mysql port</td><td align="left">defaults to 3306</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:table</td><td align="left">Name of the table containing users</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2902128"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.2. Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="justify">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">mysql host</td><td align="justify">host name, defaults to 'localhost'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql password</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql user</td><td align="justify">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql database</td><td align="justify">defaults to 'samba'</td></tr><tr><td align="left">mysql port</td><td align="justify">defaults to 3306</td></tr><tr><td align="left">table</td><td align="justify">Name of the table containing users</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><div class="warning" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Warning</h3><p> Since the password for the MySQL user is stored in the - <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, you should make the the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file + <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, you should make the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file readable only to the user that runs Samba This is considered a security bug and will be fixed soon. </p></div><p>Names of the columns in this table (I've added column types those columns should have first):</p><p> - </p><div class="table"><a name="id2913471"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.3. MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Type</th><th align="left">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">identifier:logon time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:logoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:kickoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:pass last set time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:pass can change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:pass must change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">unix username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:domain column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT domain user is part of</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:nt username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:fullname column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Full name of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:home dir column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Unix homedir path</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:dir drive column</td><td align="left">varchar(2)</td><td align="left">Directory drive path (eg: 'H:')</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:logon script column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Batch file to run on client side when logging on</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:profile path column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Path of profile</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:acct desc column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Some ASCII NT user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:workstations column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">Workstations user can logon to (or NULL for all)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown string column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">unknown string</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:munged dial column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:user sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT user SID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:group sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">NT group ID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:lanman pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">encrypted lanman password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:nt pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">encrypted nt passwd</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:plain pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="left">plaintext password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:acct control column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">nt user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown 3 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:logon divs column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:hours len column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown 5 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">identifier:unknown 6 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="left">unknown</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2902260"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 11.3. MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</b></p><table summary="MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="left"><col align="justify"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Field</th><th align="left">Type</th><th align="justify">Contents</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">logon time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">logoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">kickoff time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass last set time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass can change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">pass must change time column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify"> </td></tr><tr><td align="left">username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">unix username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">domain column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT domain user is part of</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nt username column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT username</td></tr><tr><td align="left">fullname column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Full name of user</td></tr><tr><td align="left">home dir column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">UNIX homedir path</td></tr><tr><td align="left">dir drive column</td><td align="left">varchar(2)</td><td align="justify">Directory drive path (eg: 'H:')</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon script column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Batch file to run on client side when logging on</td></tr><tr><td align="left">profile path column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Path of profile</td></tr><tr><td align="left">acct desc column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Some ASCII NT user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">workstations column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">Workstations user can logon to (or NULL for all)</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown string column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">unknown string</td></tr><tr><td align="left">munged dial column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">user sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT user SID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">group sid column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">NT group ID</td></tr><tr><td align="left">lanman pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">encrypted lanman password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">nt pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">encrypted nt passwd</td></tr><tr><td align="left">plain pass column</td><td align="left">varchar(255)</td><td align="justify">plaintext password</td></tr><tr><td align="left">acct control column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">nt user data</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 3 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">logon divs column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">hours len column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">?</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 5 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">unknown</td></tr><tr><td align="left">unknown 6 column</td><td align="left">int(9)</td><td align="justify">unknown</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> </p><p> Eventually, you can put a colon (:) after the name of each column, which should specify the column to update when updating the table. You can also specify nothing behind the colon - then the data from the field will not be updated. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913850"></a>Using plaintext passwords or encrypted password</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2902649"></a>Using plaintext passwords or encrypted password</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> I strongly discourage the use of plaintext passwords, however, you can use them: </p><p> If you would like to use plaintext passwords, set @@ -765,7 +750,7 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword </p><p> If you use encrypted passwords, set the 'identifier:plain pass column' to 'NULL' (without the quotes). This is the default. - </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2913881"></a>Getting non-column data from the table</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2902679"></a>Getting non-column data from the table</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> It is possible to have not all data in the database and making some 'constant'. </p><p> For example, you can set 'identifier:fullname column' to : @@ -780,33 +765,21 @@ access to attrs=lmPassword,ntPassword </p><p> To import data, use: <tt class="prompt">$ </tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>pdbedit -i xml:filename</tt></b> - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2913989"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913997"></a>Users can not logon - Users not in Samba SAM</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - People forget to put their users in their backend and then complain Samba won't authorize them. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914012"></a>Users are being added to the wrong backend database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2902790"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902796"></a>Users can not logon</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I've installed samba, but now I can't log on with my unix account!</span>”</p><p>Make sure your user has been added to the current samba <a class="indexterm" name="id2902813"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>. Read the section <a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools" title="Account Management Tools">Account Management Tools</a> for details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902841"></a>Users being added to wrong backend database</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A few complaints have been received from users that just moved to Samba-3. The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file entries were causing problems, new accounts were being added to the old smbpasswd file, not to the tdbsam passdb.tdb file: </p><p> - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - [globals] - ... - passdb backend = smbpasswd, tdbsam, guest - ... - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = smbpasswd, tdbsam</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table><p> </p><p> Samba will add new accounts to the first entry in the <span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend</em></span> parameter entry. If you want to update to the tdbsam, then change the entry to: </p><p> - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - [globals] - ... - passdb backend = tdbsam, smbpasswd, guest - ... - </pre><p> - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914072"></a>auth methods does not work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> - If you explicitly set an 'auth methods' parameter, guest must be specified as the first - entry on the line. Eg: <i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods = guest sam</tt></i>. + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = tdbsam, smbpasswd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr></table><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2902952"></a>auth methods does not work</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + If you explicitly set an <a class="indexterm" name="id2902963"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> parameter, guest must be specified as the first + entry on the line. Eg: <a class="indexterm" name="id2902979"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i> = guest sam. </p><p> - This is the exact opposite of the requirement for the <i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backed</tt></i> + This is the exact opposite of the requirement for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2902998"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i> option, where it must be the <span class="emphasis"><em>LAST</em></span> parameter on the line. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="groupmapping.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div></div><div class="footnotes"><br><hr width="100" align="left"><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2901925" href="#id2901925">3</a>] </sup>Only when the LDAP server supports LDAP_EXOP_X_MODIFY_PASSWD</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="groupmapping.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html index 368a6911b7..39a901923f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pdbedit.8.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pdbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pdbedit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pdbedit — manage the SAM database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">pdbedit</tt> [-L] [-v] [-w] [-u username] [-f fullname] [-h homedir] [-D drive] [-S script] [-p profile] [-a] [-m] [-x] [-i passdb-backend] [-e passdb-backend] [-b passdb-backend] [-g] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-P account-policy] [-C value]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>pdbedit</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="pdbedit.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>pdbedit — manage the SAM database</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">pdbedit</tt> [-L] [-v] [-w] [-u username] [-f fullname] [-h homedir] [-D drive] [-S script] [-p profile] [-a] [-m] [-r] [-x] [-i passdb-backend] [-e passdb-backend] [-b passdb-backend] [-g] [-d debuglevel] [-s configfile] [-P account-policy] [-C value] [-c account-control]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The pdbedit program is used to manage the users accounts stored in the sam database and can only be run by root.</p><p>The pdbedit tool uses the passdb modular interface and is independent from the kind of users database used (currently there are smbpasswd, ldap, nis+ and tdb based and more can be added @@ -31,7 +31,7 @@ Home Directory: \\BERSERKER\samba HomeDir Drive: Logon Script: Profile Path: \\BERSERKER\profile -</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-w</span></dt><dd><p>This option sets the "smbpasswd" listing format. +</pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-w</span></dt><dd><p>This option sets the "smbpasswd" listing format. It will make pdbedit list the users in the database, printing out the account fields in a format compatible with the <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file format. (see the @@ -44,18 +44,18 @@ samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:[UX operations and <span class="emphasis"><em>optional</em></span> in list operations.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-f fullname</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifing a user account. It will specify the user's full - name. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-f "Simo Sorce"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h homedir</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or + name. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-f "Simo Sorce"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h homedir</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifing a user account. It will specify the user's home - directory network path.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-h "\\\\BERSERKER\\sorce"</b> + directory network path.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-h "\\\\BERSERKER\\sorce"</b> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-D drive</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifing a user account. It will specify the windows drive - letter to be used to map the home directory.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-d "H:"</b> + letter to be used to map the home directory.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-d "H:"</b> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S script</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifing a user account. It will specify the user's logon - script path.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-s "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon\\sorce.bat"</b> + script path.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-s "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon\\sorce.bat"</b> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p profile</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifing a user account. It will specify the user's profile - directory.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-p "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon"</b> + directory.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">-p "\\\\BERSERKER\\netlogon"</b> </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-G SID|rid</span></dt><dd><p> This option can be used while adding or modifying a user account. It will specify the users' new primary group SID (Security Identifier) or @@ -65,7 +65,7 @@ samba:45:0F2B255F7B67A7A9AAD3B435B51404EE:BC281CE3F53B6A5146629CD4751D3490:[UX rid. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-U S-1-5-21-2447931902-1787058256-3961074038-5004</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c account-control</span></dt><dd><p>This option can be used while adding or modifying a user account. It will specify the users' account control property. Possible flags that can be set are: N, D, H, L, X. - </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-c "[X ]"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to add a user into the + </p><p>Example: <b class="command">-c "[X ]"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to add a user into the database. This command needs a user name specified with the -u switch. When adding a new user, pdbedit will also ask for the password to be used.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -a -u sorce</b> @@ -94,12 +94,12 @@ retype new password applies to the group mapping instead of the user database.</p><p>This option will ease migration from one passdb backend to another and will ease backing up.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-b passdb-backend</span></dt><dd><p>Use a different default passdb backend. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -b xml:/root/pdb-backup.xml -l</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term">-P account-policy</span></dt><dd><p>Display an account policy</p><p>Valid policies are: minimum password age, reset count minutes, disconnect time, user must logon to change password, password history, lockout duration, min password length, - maximum password age and bad lockout attempt.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt"</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> + maximum password age and bad lockout attempt.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt"</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> account policy value for bad lockout attempt is 0 </pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-C account-policy-value</span></dt><dd><p>Sets an account policy to a specified value. This option may only be used in conjunction with the <i class="parameter"><tt>-P</tt></i> option. - </p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt" -C 3</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> + </p><p>Example: <b class="command">pdbedit -P "bad lockout attempt" -C 3</b></p><pre class="programlisting"> account policy value for bad lockout attempt was 0 account policy value for bad lockout attempt is now 3 </pre></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. @@ -109,8 +109,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -124,10 +123,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2800732"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NOTES</h2><p>This command may be used only by root.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">samba</span>(7)</span></a></p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pr01.html b/docs/htmldocs/pr01.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..193564ca32 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pr01.html @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Legal Notice</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="next" href="pr02.html" title="Attributions"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Legal Notice</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-doc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr02.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2869898"></a>Legal Notice</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This documentation is distributed under the GNU General Public License (GPL) +version 2. A copy of the license is included with the Samba source +distribution. A copy can be found on-line at <a href="http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt" target="_top">http://www.fsf.org/licenses/gpl.txt</a> +</p></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-doc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr02.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">SAMBA Project Documentation </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Attributions</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/pr02.html b/docs/htmldocs/pr02.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..08a02a7142 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/pr02.html @@ -0,0 +1 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Attributions</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="pr01.html" title="Legal Notice"><link rel="next" href="introduction.html" title="Part I. General Installation"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Attributions</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr01.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="introduction.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="preface" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="id2869923"></a>Attributions</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p><a href="IntroSMB.html" title="Chapter 1. Introduction to Samba">Introduction to Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>David Lechnyr <<a href="mailto:david@lechnyr.com" target="_top">david@lechnyr.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="install.html" title="Chapter 2. How to Install and Test SAMBA">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Karl Auer</p></li></ul></div><p><a href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes">Server Types and Security Modes</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org" target="_top">dbannon@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control">Backup Domain Control</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Volker Lendecke <<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE" target="_top">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="StandAloneServer.html" title="Chapter 8. Stand-Alone Servers">Stand-Alone Servers</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="ClientConfig.html" title="Chapter 9. MS Windows Network Configuration Guide">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Databases</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Olivier (lem) Lemaire <<a href="mailto:olem@IDEALX.org" target="_top">olem@IDEALX.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jean François Micouleau</p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="AccessControls.html" title="Chapter 13. File, Directory and Share Access Controls">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>> (drawing) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking">File and Record Locking</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jeremy Allison <<a href="mailto:jra@samba.org" target="_top">jra@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Eric Roseme <<a href="mailto:eric.roseme@hp.com" target="_top">eric.roseme@hp.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="securing-samba.html" title="Chapter 15. Securing Samba">Securing Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Rafal Szczesniak <<a href="mailto:mimir@samba.org" target="_top">mimir@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>> (drawing) </p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net" target="_top">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Shirish Kalele <<a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="printing.html" title="Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support">Classical Printing Support</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de" target="_top">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Kurt Pfeifle <<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de" target="_top">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></p></li><li><p>Ciprian Vizitiu <<a href="mailto:CVizitiu@gbif.org" target="_top">CVizitiu@gbif.org</a>> (drawings) </p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>> (drawings) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules">Stackable VFS modules</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Tim Potter</p></li><li><p>Simo Sorce (original vfs_skel README) </p></li><li><p>Alexander Bokovoy (original vfs_netatalk docs) </p></li><li><p>Stefan Metzmacher (Update for multiple modules) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management">Advanced Network Management</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">System and Account Policies</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management">Desktop Profile Management</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="pam.html" title="Chapter 25. PAM based Distributed Authentication">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Stephen Langasek <<a href="mailto:vorlon@netexpress.net" target="_top">vorlon@netexpress.net</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode/Charsets</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>TAKAHASHI Motonobu <<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com" target="_top">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques">Samba Backup Techniques</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="SambaHA.html" title="Chapter 29. High Availability Options">High Availability Options</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html" title="Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist">The Samba checklist</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="problems.html" title="Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Gerald (Jerry) Carter <<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">jerry@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>David Bannon <<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org" target="_top">dbannon@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs">Reporting Bugs</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="compiling.html" title="Chapter 36. How to compile Samba">How to compile Samba</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Andrew Tridgell <<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org" target="_top">tridge@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="Portability.html" title="Chapter 37. Portability">Portability</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>Jim McDonough <<a href="mailto:jmcd@us.ibm.com" target="_top">jmcd@us.ibm.com</a>> (OS/2) </p></li></ul></div><p><a href="speed.html" title="Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning">Samba Performance Tuning</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Paul Cochrane <<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk" target="_top">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></p></li><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>John H. Terpstra <<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">jht@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div><p><a href="Further-Resources.html" title="Chapter 41. Further Resources">Further Resources</a></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Jelmer R. Vernooij <<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">jelmer@samba.org</a>></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="pr01.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="introduction.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Legal Notice </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Part I. General Installation</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/printing.html b/docs/htmldocs/printing.html index 089bba6e0f..2b0abb56e6 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/printing.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/printing.html @@ -1,12 +1,11 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"><link rel="next" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 32, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934522">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934590">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934627">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2934698">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935615">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2935946">Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936054">Parameters no longer in use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936147">A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936216">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936305">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936612">Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936715">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2936728">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937111">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937440">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937660">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2937711">Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938236">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938516">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938681">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938833">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2938945">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939016">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939247">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939408">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939503">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2939686">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with -rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941408">"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941428">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941626">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2941915">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942010">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942152">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942185">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942622">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2942924">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943168">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a -different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943267">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943612">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943683">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943705">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943751">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943792">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943811">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943835">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2943987">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944316">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944362">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944531">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944545">Common Errors and Problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944558">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2944591">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934522"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="msdfs.html" title="Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba"><link rel="next" href="CUPS-printing.html" title="Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="printing"></a>Chapter 18. Classical Printing Support</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Kurt</span> <span class="surname">Pfeifle</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname"> Danka Deutschland GmbH <br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:kpfeifle@danka.de">kpfeifle@danka.de</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 31, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2912941">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913045">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913083">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913154">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913718">A simple Configuration to Print</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913883">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914010">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914370">Extended Sample Configuration to Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914701">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916027">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916108">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916791">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917131">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917292">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917453">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917566">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918066">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918239">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918333">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918531">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920241">Client Driver Install Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920260">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920462">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920763">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920857">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921029">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921063">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921530">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922136">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a +different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922236">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922594">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922687">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922712">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922768">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922810">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922828">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922853">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923008">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923342">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923388">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923561">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923575">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923582">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923615">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2912941"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Printing is often a mission-critical service for the users. Samba can provide this service reliably and seamlessly for a client network consisting of Windows workstations. </p><p> -A Samba-3.0 print service may be run on a Standalone or a Domain +A Samba print service may be run on a Standalone or a Domain member server, side by side with file serving functions, or on a dedicated print server. It can be made as tight or as loosely secured as needs dictate. Configurations may be simple or complex. Available @@ -30,24 +29,24 @@ implemented by the more traditional UNIX (BSD- and System V-style) printing systems. Many things apply to CUPS, the newer Common UNIX Printing System, too; so if you use CUPS, you might be tempted to jump to the next chapter -- but you will certainly miss a few things if you -do so. Better read this chapter too. +do so. Better to read this chapter too. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Most of the given examples have been verified on Windows XP Professional clients. Where this document describes the responses to commands given, bear in mind that Windows 2000 clients are very similar, but may differ in details. Windows NT is somewhat different again. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2934590"></a>Technical Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2913045"></a>Technical Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba's printing support always relies on the installed print -subsystem of the Unix OS it runs on. Samba is a "middleman". It takes +subsystem of the UNIX OS it runs on. Samba is a "middleman". It takes printfiles from Windows (or other SMB) clients and passes them to the real printing system for further processing. Therefore it needs to -"talk" to two sides: to the Windows print clients and to the Unix +"talk" to two sides: to the Windows print clients and to the UNIX printing system. Hence we must differentiate between the various client OS types each of which behave differently, as well as the various UNIX print subsystems, which themselves have different features and are accessed differently. This part of the Samba HOWTO -Collection deals with the "traditional" way of Unix printing first; +Collection deals with the "traditional" way of UNIX printing first; the next chapter covers in great detail the more modern <span class="emphasis"><em>Common UNIX Printing System</em></span> (CUPS). @@ -55,15 +54,15 @@ the next chapter covers in great detail the more modern </p><div class="important" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Important</h3><p>CUPS users, be warned: don't just jump on to the next chapter. You might miss important information contained only here!</p></div><p> -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934627"></a>What happens if you send a Job from a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913083"></a>What happens if you send a Job from a Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To successfully print a job from a Windows client via a Samba print server to a UNIX printer, there are 6 (potentially 7) stages: -</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Windows opens a connection to the printershare</p></li><li><p>Samba must authenticate the user</p></li><li><p>Windows sends a copy of the printfile over the network +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>Windows opens a connection to the printer share</p></li><li><p>Samba must authenticate the user</p></li><li><p>Windows sends a copy of the printfile over the network into Samba's spooling area</p></li><li><p>Windows closes the connection again</p></li><li><p>Samba invokes the print command to hand the file over -to the UNIX print subsystem's spooling area</p></li><li><p>The Unix print subsystem processes the print +to the UNIX print subsystem's spooling area</p></li><li><p>The UNIX print subsystem processes the print job</p></li><li><p>The printfile may need to be explicitly deleted -from the Samba spooling area.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2934698"></a>Printing Related Configuration Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +from the Samba spooling area.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913154"></a>Printing Related Configuration Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of configuration parameters in controlling Samba's printing behaviour. Please also refer to the man page for smb.conf to @@ -71,74 +70,65 @@ acquire an overview about these. As with other parameters, there are Global Level (tagged with a "<span class="emphasis"><em>G</em></span>" in the listings) and Service Level ("<span class="emphasis"><em>S</em></span>") parameters. </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">Service Level Parameters</span></dt><dd><p>These <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> go into the -<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of -. In this case they define the default +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. +In this case they define the default behaviour of all individual or service level shares (provided those don't have a different setting defined for the same parameter, thus overriding the global default).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">Global Parameters</span></dt><dd><p>These <span class="emphasis"><em>may not</em></span> go into individual shares. If they go in by error, the "testparm" utility can discover -this (if you run it) and tell you so.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935615"></a>Parameters Recommended for Use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters directly -related to printing are used in Samba-3. See also the +this (if you run it) and tell you so.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913251"></a>Parameters Recommended for Use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters directly +related to printing are used in Samba. See also the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page for detailed explanations: -</p><p><b>List of printing related parameters in Samba-3. </b> -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Global level parameters:</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name (G), printcap (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (G)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> - -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><p class="title"><b>Service level parameters:</b></p><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>print command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printable (S), print ok (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name (S), printer (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = [cups|bsd|lprng...] (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><p>Global level parameters: <a class="indexterm" name="id2913280"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913295"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913310"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913324"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913338"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913352"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913366"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913380"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913394"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913407"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913422"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913436"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i>. +</p><p>Service level parameters: <a class="indexterm" name="id2913454"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913468"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913481"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913496"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913509"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913523"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913537"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913551"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913565"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913579"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913593"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print ok </tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913606"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i>, <a class="indexterm" name="id2913621"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913634"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913648"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = [cups|bsd|lprng...], +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913662"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913676"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command</tt></i>, +<a class="indexterm" name="id2913690"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i>. </p><p> Samba's printing support implements the Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls (MS-RPC) methods for printing. These are used by Windows NT (and later) print servers. The old "LanMan" protocol is still supported as a fallback resort, and for older clients to use. More details will follow further beneath. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2935946"></a>Parameters for Backwards Compatibility</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Two new parameters that were added in Samba 2.2.2, are still present -in Samba-3.0. Both of these options are described in the -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page and are disabled by -default. <span class="emphasis"><em>Use them with caution!</em></span> -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss(G)</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> This is -provided for better support of Samba 2.0.x backwards capability. It -will disable Samba's support for MS-RPC printing and yield identical -printing behaviour to Samba 2.0.x.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (G)</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> was provided -for using local printer drivers on Windows NT/2000 clients. It does -not apply to Windows 95/98/ME clients.</p></dd></dl></div><p><b>Parameters "for backward compatibility only", use with caution. </b> -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936054"></a>Parameters no longer in use</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba users upgrading from 2.2.x to 3.0 need to be aware that some -previously available settings are no longer supported (as was -announced some time ago). Here is a list of them: -</p><p><b>"old" parameters, removed in Samba-3. </b> -The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters have been -deprecated already in Samba 2.2 and are now completely removed from -Samba-3. You cannot use them in new 3.0 installations: - -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs (G)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>postscript (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver (S)</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location (S)</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p> -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936147"></a>A simple Configuration to Print with Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2913718"></a>A simple Configuration to Print</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Here is a very simple example configuration for print related settings -in the file. If you compare it with your -own system's , you probably find some +in the file. If you compare it with your own system's , you probably find some additional parameters included there (as pre-configured by your OS vendor). Further below is a discussion and explanation of the parameters. Note, that this example doesn't use many parameters. However, in many environments these are enough to provide a valid - which enables all clients to print. -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - printing = bsd - load printers = yes - - [printers] - path = /var/spool/samba - printable = yes - public = yes - writable = no -</pre><p> -This is only an example configuration. Many settings, if not -explicitly set to a specific value, are used and set by Samba -implicitly to its own default, because these have been compiled in. -To see all settings, let root use the <b class="command">testparm</b> -utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> also gives warnings if you have -mis-configured certain things. Its complete output is easily 340 lines -and more. You may want to pipe it through a pager program. +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file which enables all clients to print. +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2913746"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.1. Simple configuration with BSD printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +This is only an example configuration. Samba assigns default values to all +configuration parameters. On the whole the defaults are conservative and +sensible. When a parameter is specified in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file this overwrites +the default value. The <b class="command">testparm</b> utility when run as root +is capable of reporting all setting, both default as well as <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file +settings. <b class="command">Testparm</b> gives warnings for all mis-configured +settings. The complete output is easily 340 lines and more, so you may want +to pipe it through a pager program. </p><p> The syntax for the configuration file is easy to grasp. You should know that is not very picky about its @@ -147,7 +137,7 @@ reminder: It even tolerates some spelling errors (like "browsable" instead of "browseable"). Most spelling is case-insensitive. Also, you can use "Yes|No" or "True|False" for boolean settings. Lists of names may be separated by commas, spaces or tabs. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936216"></a>Verification of "Settings in Use" with <b class="command">testparm</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2913883"></a>Verification of "Settings in Use" with <b class="command">testparm</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To see all (or at least most) printing related settings in Samba, including the implicitly used ones, try the command outlined below (hit "ENTER" twice!). It greps for all occurrences of "lp", "print", @@ -198,20 +188,20 @@ as shown above: You can easily verify which settings were implicitly added by Samba's default behaviour. <span class="emphasis"><em>Don't forget about this point: it may be important in your future dealings with Samba.</em></span> -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> testparm in Samba-3.0 behaves differently from 2.2.x: used +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> testparm in samba 3 behaves differently from 2.2.x: used without the "-v" switch it only shows you the settings actually written into ! To see the complete -configuration used, add the "-v" parameter to testparm.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936305"></a>A little Experiment to warn you</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +configuration used, add the "-v" parameter to testparm.</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914010"></a>A little Experiment to warn you</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Should you need to troubleshoot at any stage, please always come back to this point first and verify if "testparm" shows the parameters you expect! To give you an example from personal experience as a warning, -try to just "comment out" the <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>" +try to just "comment out" the <a class="indexterm" name="id2914020"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i>" parameter. If your 2.2.x system behaves like mine, you'll see this: </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt>grep "load printers" /etc/samba/smb.conf # load printers = Yes - # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!! - + # This setting is commented ooouuuuut!! + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt>testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf | egrep "(load printers)" load printers = Yes @@ -232,7 +222,7 @@ any more... at least not by this ;-) </pre><p> Only when setting the parameter explicitly to -"<i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = No</tt></i>" +"<a class="indexterm" name="id2914136"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = No" would Samba recognize my intentions. So my strong advice is: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Never rely on "commented out" parameters!</p></li><li><p>Always set it up explicitly as you intend it to behave.</p></li><li><p>Use <b class="command">testparm</b> to uncover hidden @@ -258,7 +248,7 @@ ask <b class="command">testparm</b> what the Samba print configuration would be, if you used this minimalistic file as your real : </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt> testparm -v /etc/samba/smb.conf-minimal | egrep "(print|lpq|spool|driver|ports|[)"</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm -v smb.conf-minimal | egrep "(print|lpq|spool|driver|ports|[)"</tt></b> Processing section "[printers]" WARNING: [printers] service MUST be printable! No path in service printers - using /tmp @@ -291,8 +281,8 @@ testparm issued 2 warnings: <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section as printable, and</p></li><li><p>because we didn't tell it which spool directory to use.</p></li></ul></div><p> -However, this was not fatal, and Samba-3.0 will default to values that -will work here. But, please!, don't rely on this and don't use this +However, this was not fatal, and samba will default to values that +will work here. Please, don't rely on this and don't use this example! This was only meant to make you careful to design and specify your setup to be what you really want it to be. The outcome on your system may vary for some parameters, since you may have a Samba built @@ -304,61 +294,20 @@ comment sign at the front). At first I regarded this as a bug in my Samba version(s). But the man page states: “<span class="quote">Internal whitespace in a parameter value is retained verbatim.</span>” This means that a line consisting of, for example, -</p><pre class="screen"> -printing = lprng #This defines LPRng as the printing system" -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td># This defines LPRng as the printing system"</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = lprng</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> will regard the whole of the string after the "=" sign as the value you want to define. And this is an invalid value that will be ignored, and a default value used instead.] -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936612"></a>Extended Sample Configuration to Print with Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Here we show a more verbose example configuration for print related -settings in an . Below is a discussion +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914370"></a>Extended Sample Configuration to Print</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + In <a href="printing.html#extbsdpr" title="Example 18.2. Extended configuration with BSD printing">the extended BSD configuration example</a> we show a more verbose example configuration for print related + settings in BSD-printing style environment . Below is a discussion and explanation of the various parameters. We chose to use BSD-style printing here, because we guess it is still the most commonly used system on legacy Linux installations (new installs now predominantly have CUPS, which is discussed entirely in the next chapter of this document). Note, that this example explicitly names many parameters -which don't need to be stated because they are set by default. You -might be able to do with a leaner .</p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> -if you read access it with the Samba Web Administration Tool (SWAT), -and then write it to disk again, it will be optimized in a way such -that it doesn't contain any superfluous parameters and comments. SWAT -organizes the file for best performance. Remember that each smbd -re-reads the Samba configuration once a minute, and that each -connection spawns an smbd process of its own, so it is not a bad idea -to optimize the in environments with -hundreds or thousands of clients.</p></div><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - printing = bsd - load printers = yes - show add printer wizard = yes - printcap name = /etc/printcap - printer admin = @ntadmin, root - total print jobs = 100 - lpq cache time = 20 - use client driver = no - - [printers] - comment = All Printers - printable = yes - path = /var/spool/samba - browseable = no - guest ok = yes - public = yes - read only = yes - writable = no - - [my_printer_name] - comment = Printer with Restricted Access - path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer - printer admin = kurt - browseable = yes - printable = yes - writeable = no - hosts allow = 0.0.0.0 - hosts deny = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60 - guest ok = no -</pre><p> +which don't need to be specified because they are set by default. You +might be able to do with a leaner <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p><div class="example"><a name="extbsdpr"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.2. Extended configuration with BSD printing</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = /etc/printcap</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin, root</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs = 100</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time = 20</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All Printers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writable = no </tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[my_printer_name]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer with Restricted Access</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 0.0.0.0</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = turbo_xp, 10.160.50.23, 10.160.51.60</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> This <span class="emphasis"><em>also</em></span> is only an example configuration. You may not find all the settings in your own (as pre-configured by your OS @@ -368,31 +317,31 @@ default, because these have been compiled in. To see all settings, let root use the <b class="command">testparm</b> utility. <b class="command">testparm</b> also gives warnings if you have mis-configured certain things.. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2936715"></a>Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2914701"></a>Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Following is a discussion of the settings from above shown example. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2936728"></a>The [global] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2914714"></a>The [global] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section is one of 4 special sections (along with [<i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>...) It contains all parameters which apply to the server as a whole. It is the place for parameters which -have only a "global" meaning (G). It may also contain service level -parameters (S) which then define default settings for all other +have only a "global" meaning. It may also contain service level +parameters which then define default settings for all other sections and shares. This way you can simplify the configuration and avoid setting the same value repeatedly. (Within each individual section or share you may however override these globally set "share level" settings and specify other values). -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this causes Samba to use default print commands +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2914781"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd</span></dt><dd><p> this causes Samba to use default print commands applicable for the BSD (a.k.a. RFC 1179 style or LPR/LPD) printing system. In general, the "printing" parameter informs Samba about the print subsystem it should expect. Samba supports CUPS, LPD, LPRNG, SYSV, HPUX, AIX, QNX and PLP. Each of these systems defaults to a -different <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> (and other queue control -commands).</p><div class="caution" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Caution</h3><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is +different <a class="indexterm" name="id2914801"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> (and other queue control +commands).</p><div class="caution" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Caution</h3><p>The <a class="indexterm" name="id2914838"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter is normally a service level parameter. Since it is included here in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section, it will take effect for all -printer shares that are not defined differently. Samba-3.0 no longer -supports the SOFTQ printing system.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba to create automatically all +printer shares that are not defined differently. Samba 3 no longer +supports the SOFTQ printing system.</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2914868"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba to create automatically all available printer shares. "Available" printer shares are discovered by scanning the printcap file. All created printer shares are also loaded for browsing. If you use this parameter, you do not need to specify @@ -401,8 +350,7 @@ share will clone the configuration options found in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section. (A <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers = no</tt></i> setting will allow you to specify each UNIX printer you want to share separately, leaving out some you don't want to be -publicly visible and available). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = -yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this setting is normally +publicly visible and available). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2914927"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes </span></dt><dd><p> this setting is normally enabled by default (even if the parameter is not written into the ). It makes the <span class="guiicon">Add Printer Wizard</span> icon show up in the <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder of the Samba host's @@ -413,38 +361,38 @@ will not suffice!). The Add Printer Wizard lets you upload printer drivers to the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share and associate it with a printer (if the respective queue exists there before the action), or exchange a printer's driver against any other previously -uploaded driver. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs = 100</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this setting sets the upper limit to 100 print jobs +uploaded driver. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2914996"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i> = 100</span></dt><dd><p> this setting sets the upper limit to 100 print jobs being active on the Samba server at any one time. Should a client submit a job which exceeds this number, a “<span class="quote">no more space available on server</span>” type of error message will be returned by Samba to the client. A setting of "0" (the default) means there is <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span> limit at all! -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name = /etc/printcap</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba where to look for a list of +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915035"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i> = /etc/printcap</span></dt><dd><p> this tells Samba where to look for a list of available printer names. (If you use CUPS, make sure that a printcap file is written: this is controlled by the "Printcap" directive of <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt>). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> members of the ntadmin group should be able to add +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915072"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = @ntadmin</span></dt><dd><p> members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set printer properties ("ntadmin" is only an example name, it needs to be a valid UNIX group name); root is implicitly always a -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. The "@" sign precedes group names in +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915102"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. The "@" sign precedes group names in . A printer admin can do anything to printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC -(see below). Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> +(see below). Note that the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915124"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter is normally a share level parameter, so you may associate different groups to different printer shares in larger installations, -if you use the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter on the +if you use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915141"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter on the share levels). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time = 20</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this controls the cache time for the results of the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915159"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i> = 20</span></dt><dd><p> this controls the cache time for the results of the lpq command. It prevents the lpq command being called too often and reduces load on a heavily used print server. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, this setting only +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915186"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, this setting only takes effect for Win NT/2k/XP clients (and not for Win 95/98/ME). Its default value is <tt class="constant">No</tt> (or <tt class="constant">False</tt>). It must <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be enabled on print shares (with a <tt class="constant">yes</tt> or <tt class="constant">true</tt> setting) which have valid drivers installed on the Samba server! For more detailed explanations see the man page of <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937111"></a>The [printers] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915245"></a>The [printers] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is the second special section. If a section with this name appears in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>, users are able to connect to any printer specified in the Samba host's printcap file, @@ -454,41 +402,40 @@ section as a general convenience shortcut to share all printers with minimal configuration. It is also a container for settings which should apply as default to all printers. (For more details see the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page.) Settings inside this -container must be share level parameters (S). -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = All printers</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the <i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> is shown next to +container must be share level parameters. +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915287"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = All printers</span></dt><dd><p> the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915307"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> is shown next to the share if a client queries the server, either via <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span> or with the <b class="command">net view</b> command to list available shares. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> please note well, that the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915340"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> please note well, that the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> service <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be declared as printable. If you specify otherwise, smbd will refuse to load at startup. This parameter allows connected clients to open, write to and submit spool files into the -directory specified with the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter for +directory specified with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915374"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter for this service. It is used by Samba to differentiate printer shares from -file shares. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this must point to a directory used by Samba to spool +file shares. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915394"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba</span></dt><dd><p>this must point to a directory used by Samba to spool incoming print files. <span class="emphasis"><em>It must not be the same as the spool directory specified in the configuration of your UNIX print subsystem!</em></span> The path would typically point to a directory which is world writeable, with the "sticky" bit set to it. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is always set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> if -<i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i>. It makes the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915428"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> this is always set to <tt class="constant">no</tt> if +<a class="indexterm" name="id2915453"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes. It makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer]</tt></i> share itself invisible in the list of available shares in a <b class="command">net view</b> command or in the Explorer browse list. (Note that you will of course see the individual printers). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915487"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> if set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then no password is required to connect to the printers service. Access will be granted with the -privileges of the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. On many systems the +privileges of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915513"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. On many systems the guest account will map to a user named "nobody". This user is in the UNIX passwd file with an empty password, but with no valid UNIX login. (Note: on some systems the guest account might not have the privilege to be able to print. Test this by logging in as your guest user using <b class="command">su - guest</b> and run a system print command like -</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>lpr -P printername /etc/motd</tt></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>public = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is a synonym for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = -yes</tt></i>. Since we have <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i>, +</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>lpr -P printername /etc/motd</tt></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915562"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>public</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> this is a synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id2915582"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes. Since we have <a class="indexterm" name="id2915596"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes, it really doesn't need to be here! (This leads to the interesting question: “<span class="quote">What, if I by accident have to contradictory settings for the same share?</span>” The answer is: the last one encountered by @@ -497,16 +444,16 @@ complain about different settings of the same parameter for the same share! You can test this by setting up multiple lines for the "guest account" parameter with different usernames, and then run testparm to see which one is actually used by Samba.) -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this normally (for other types of shares) prevents +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915632"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>this normally (for other types of shares) prevents users creating or modifying files in the service's directory. However, in a "printable" service, it is <span class="emphasis"><em>always</em></span> allowed to write to the directory (if user privileges allow the connection), but only via print spooling operations. "Normal" write operations are not -allowed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> -synonym for <i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i> -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937440"></a>Any [my_printer_name] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +allowed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915669"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> +synonym for <a class="indexterm" name="id2915689"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2915706"></a>Any [my_printer_name] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If a section appears in the , which is -tagged as <i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i>, Samba presents it as +tagged as <a class="indexterm" name="id2915717"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes, Samba presents it as a printer share to its clients. Note, that Win95/98/ME clients may have problems with connecting or loading printer drivers if the share name has more than 8 characters! Also be very careful if you give a @@ -515,37 +462,36 @@ client's connection request to a certain sharename, Samba always tries to find file shares with that name first; if it finds one, it will connect to this and will never ultimately connect to a printer with the same name! -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer with Restricted Access</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the comment says it all. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> here we set the spooling area for this printer to +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915747"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Printer with Restricted Access</span></dt><dd><p> the comment says it all. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915772"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /var/spool/samba_my_printer</span></dt><dd><p> here we set the spooling area for this printer to another directory than the default. It is not a requirement to set it differently, but the option is available. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = kurt</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the printer admin definition is different for this +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915799"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> = kurt</span></dt><dd><p> the printer admin definition is different for this explicitly defined printer share from the general <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> share. It is not a requirement; we did it to show that it is possible if you want it. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> we also made this printer browseable (so that the +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915832"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p> we also made this printer browseable (so that the clients may conveniently find it when browsing the <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span>). -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 10.160.50.,10.160.51.</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>here we exercise a certain degree of access control -by using the <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> parameters. Note, that +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915866"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915889"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p>see explanation in last subsection. +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915913"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> = 10.160.50.,10.160.51.</span></dt><dd><p>here we exercise a certain degree of access control +by using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2915935"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and <a class="indexterm" name="id2915949"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> parameters. Note, that this is not by any means a safe bet. It is not a way to secure your printers. This line accepts all clients from a certain subnet in a first evaluation of access control -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = turbo_xp,10.160.50.23,10.160.51.60 -</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>all listed hosts are not allowed here (even if they +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2915970"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> = turbo_xp,10.160.50.23,10.160.51.60</span></dt><dd><p>all listed hosts are not allowed here (even if they belong to the "allowed subnets"). As you can see, you could name IP addresses as well as NetBIOS hostnames here. -</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this printer is not open for the guest account! -</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937660"></a>Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916003"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p>this printer is not open for the guest account! +</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916027"></a>Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In each section defining a printer (or in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i> section), a <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter may be defined. It sets a command to process the files which have been placed into the Samba print spool directory for that printer. (That spool directory was, if you -remember, set up with the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> +remember, set up with the <a class="indexterm" name="id2916055"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter). Typically, this command will submit the spool file to the Samba host's print subsystem, using the suitable system print command. But there is no requirement that this needs to be the @@ -557,24 +503,24 @@ your own print commands (or even develop print command shell scripts), make sure you pay attention to the need to remove the files from the Samba spool directory. Otherwise your hard disk may soon suffer from shortage of free space. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2937711"></a>Default Print Commands for various Unix Print Subsystems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916108"></a>Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You learned earlier on, that Samba in most cases uses its built-in settings for many parameters if it can not find an explicitly stated one in its configuration file. The same is true for the -<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>. The default print command varies -depending on the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing =...</tt></i> parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916122"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i>. The default print command varies +depending on the <a class="indexterm" name="id2916138"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter setting. In the commands listed below, you will notice some parameters of the form <span class="emphasis"><em>%X</em></span> where <span class="emphasis"><em>X</em></span> is <span class="emphasis"><em>p, s, J</em></span> etc. These letters stand for "printername", "spoolfile" and "job ID" respectively. They are explained in more detail further below. Here is an overview (excluding the special case of CUPS, which is discussed in the next chapter): -</p><div class="informaltable"><table border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">If this setting is active...</th><th align="left">...this is used in lieu of an explicit command:</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lpr -r -P%p %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -c -P%p %s; rm %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -r -P%p -s %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpstat -o%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">lprm -P%p %j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = sysv|hpux</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing = qnx</tt></i></td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> +</p><div class="informaltable"><table border="1"><colgroup><col><col></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">If this setting is active...</th><th align="left">...this is used in lieu of an explicit command:</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916224"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lpr -r -P%p %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916254"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -c -P%p %s; rm %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916286"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">print command is <b class="command">lp -r -P%p -s %s</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916317"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916348"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpstat -o%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916378"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lpq command is <b class="command">lpq -P%p</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916408"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">lprm -P%p %j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916439"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916470"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lprm command is <b class="command">cancel %p-%j</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916500"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lppause command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H hold</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916531"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916556"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lppause command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916582"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = bsd|aix|lprng|plp</td><td align="left">lpresume command is <b class="command">lp -i %p-%j -H resume</b></td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916613"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = sysv|hpux</td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr><tr><td align="left"><a class="indexterm" name="id2916638"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> = qnx</td><td align="left">lpresume command (...is empty)</td></tr></tbody></table></div><p> We excluded the special CUPS case here, because it is discussed in the next chapter. Just a short summary. For <i class="parameter"><tt>printing = CUPS</tt></i>: If SAMBA is compiled against libcups, it uses the CUPS API to submit jobs, etc. (It is a good idea also to set -<i class="parameter"><tt>printcap = cups</tt></i> in case your +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916676"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i> = cups in case your <tt class="filename">cupsd.conf</tt> is set to write its autogenerated printcap file to an unusual place). Otherwise Samba maps to the System V printing commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it uses @@ -597,9 +543,9 @@ check which command takes effect. Then check that this command is adequate and actually works for your installed print subsystem. It is always a good idea to explicitly set up your configuration files the way you want them to work and not rely on any built-in defaults. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938236"></a>Setting up your own Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2916791"></a>Setting up your own Print Commands</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> After a print job has finished spooling to a service, the -<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> will be used by Samba via a +<a class="indexterm" name="id2916802"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> will be used by Samba via a <span class="emphasis"><em>system()</em></span> call to process the spool file. Usually the command specified will submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem. But there is no requirement at all that this must @@ -652,22 +598,16 @@ expand the included environment variables as usual. (The syntax to include a UNIX environment variable <i class="parameter"><tt>$variable</tt></i> in or in the Samba print command is <i class="parameter"><tt>%$variable</tt></i>.) To give you a working -<i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> example, the following will log a +<a class="indexterm" name="id2917032"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> example, the following will log a print job to <tt class="filename">/tmp/print.log</tt>, print the file, then remove it. Note that ';' is the usual separator for commands in shell scripts: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - - print command = echo Printing %s >> /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s - -</pre><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = echo Printing %s >> /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> You may have to vary your own command considerably from this example depending on how you normally print files on your system. The default -for the <i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter varies depending on the setting of -the <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter. Another example is: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s -</pre></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2938516"></a>Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +for the <a class="indexterm" name="id2917081"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i> parameter varies depending on the setting of +the <a class="indexterm" name="id2917098"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i> parameter. Another example is: +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript %p %s</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2917131"></a>Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before version 2.2.0, Samba's print server support for Windows clients was limited to the level of <span class="emphasis"><em>LanMan</em></span> printing calls. This is the same protocol level as Windows 9x PCs offer when @@ -682,16 +622,14 @@ The additional functionality provided by the new SPOOLSS support includes: 95/98/NT/2000 clients upon demand (<span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>); </p></li><li><p>Uploading of printer drivers via the Windows NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span> (APW) or the -<span class="emphasis"><em>Imprints</em></span> tool set (refer to <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net</a>); +<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">Imprints</a> tool set. </p></li><li><p>Support for the native MS-RPC printing calls such as -StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See the MSDN documentation -at <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">http://msdn.microsoft.com/</a> -for more information on the Win32 printing API);</p></li><li><p>Support for NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Access Control + StartDocPrinter, EnumJobs(), etc... (See the <a href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/" target="_top">MSDN documentation</a> for more information on the Win32 printing API);</p></li><li><p>Support for NT <span class="emphasis"><em>Access Control Lists</em></span> (ACL) on printer objects;</p></li><li><p>Improved support for printer queue manipulation through the use of internal databases for spooled job information (implemented by various <tt class="filename">*.tdb</tt> files).</p></li></ul></div><p> -One other benefit of an update is this: Samba-3 is able to publish +One other benefit of an update is this: Samba 3 is able to publish all its printers in Active Directory (or LDAP)! </p><p> One slight difference is here: it is possible on a Windows NT print @@ -708,7 +646,7 @@ default permissions assigned by Windows NT to a printer gives the "Print" permissions to the well-known <span class="emphasis"><em>Everyone</em></span> group. (The older clients of type Win9x can only print to "shared" printers). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938681"></a>Client Drivers on Samba Server for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917292"></a>Client Drivers on Samba Server for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There is still confusion about what all this means: <span class="emphasis"><em>Is it or is it not a requirement for printer drivers to be installed on a Samba host in order to support printing from Windows clients?</em></span> The @@ -743,10 +681,10 @@ does not use these uploaded drivers in any way to process spooled files</em></span>. Drivers are utilized entirely by the clients, who download and install them via the "Point'n'Print" mechanism supported by Samba. The clients use these drivers to generate print files in the -format the printer (or the Unix print system) requires. Print files -received by Samba are handed over to the Unix printing system, which +format the printer (or the UNIX print system) requires. Print files +received by Samba are handed over to the UNIX printing system, which is responsible for all further processing, if needed. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938833"></a>The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba-3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><b> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917453"></a>The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><b> <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> vs. <i class="parameter"><tt>[printer$]</tt></i> . </b> Versions of Samba prior to 2.2 made it possible to use a share @@ -762,7 +700,7 @@ files associated with that printer. Another parameter named <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> provided a means of defining the printer driver name to be sent to the client. These parameters, including the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i> parameter, -are now removed and can not be used in installations of Samba-3.0. +are now removed and can not be used in installations of samba-3. Now the share name <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is used for the location of downloadable printer drivers. It is taken from the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service created by Windows NT PCs when @@ -772,7 +710,7 @@ access (in the context of its ACLs) in order to support printer driver down- and uploads. Don't fear -- this does not mean Windows 9x clients are thrown aside now. They can use Samba's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share support just fine. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2938945"></a>Creating the [print$] Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917566"></a>Creating the [print$] Share</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order to support the up- and downloading of printer driver files, you must first configure a file share named <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i>. The "public" name of this share is @@ -786,42 +724,25 @@ add the global parameters and create the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> file share (of course, some of the parameter values, such as 'path' are arbitrary and should be replaced with appropriate values for your site): -</p><pre class="screen"> - [global] - ; members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set - ; printer properties. root is implicitly always a 'printer admin'. - printer admin = @ntadmin - [....] - - [printers] - [....] - - [print$] - comment = Printer Driver Download Area - path = /etc/samba/drivers - browseable = yes - guest ok = yes - read only = yes - write list = @ntadmin, root -</pre><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2917613"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 18.3. [print\$] example</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># members of the ntadmin group should be able to add drivers and set</td></tr><tr><td># printer properties. root is implicitly always a 'printer admin'.</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin = @ntadmin</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[printers]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Driver Download Area</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/drivers</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = @ntadmin, root</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> Of course, you also need to ensure that the directory named by the -<i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter exists on the Unix file system. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939016"></a>Parameters in the [print$] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2917739"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter exists on the UNIX file system. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2917756"></a>Parameters in the [print$] Section</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> is a special section in . It contains settings relevant to potential printer driver download and local installation by clients. -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Printer Driver -Download Area</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> the comment appears next to the share name if it is +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917784"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i> = Printer Driver + Download Area</span></dt><dd><p> the comment appears next to the share name if it is listed in a share list (usually Windows clients won't see it often but it will also appear up in a <b class="command">smbclient -L sambaserver -</b> output). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /etc/samba/printers</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this is the path to the location of the Windows +</b> output). </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917819"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> = /etc/samba/printers</span></dt><dd><p> this is the path to the location of the Windows driver file deposit from the UNIX point of -view.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = no</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> this makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share +view.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917844"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i> = no</span></dt><dd><p> this makes the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share "invisible" in Network Neighbourhood to clients. However, you can still "mount" it from any client using the <b class="command">net use g:\\sambaserver\print$</b> command in a "DOS box" or the "Connect network drive" menu from Windows -Explorer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>this gives read only access to this share for all +Explorer.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917889"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>this gives read only access to this share for all guest users. Access may be used to download and install printer drivers on clients. The requirement for <i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = yes</tt></i> depends upon how your site is configured. If users @@ -834,13 +755,13 @@ validated by the Domain Controller in order to logon to the Windows NT session), then guest access is not necessary. Of course, in a workgroup environment where you just want to be able to print without worrying about silly accounts and security, then configure the share -for guest access. You'll probably want to add <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest -= Bad User</tt></i> in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section +for guest access. You'll probably want to add <a class="indexterm" name="id2917936"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = Bad User in the +<i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section as well. Make sure you understand what this parameter does before using it. -</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>as we don't want everybody to upload driver files (or +</p></div></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917963"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i> = yes</span></dt><dd><p>as we don't want everybody to upload driver files (or even change driver settings) we tagged this share as not -writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = @ntadmin,root</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> was made +writeable.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2917990"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i> = @ntadmin,root</span></dt><dd><p>since the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> was made read only by the previous setting, we need to create a "write list" also. UNIX groups (denoted with a leading "@" character) and users listed here are allowed write access (as an exception to the general @@ -849,13 +770,13 @@ share. Normally you will want to only name administrative level user accounts in this setting. Check the file system permissions to make sure these accounts can copy files to the share. If this is a non-root account, then the account should also be mentioned in the global -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin </tt></i> parameter. See the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918045"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin </tt></i> parameter. See the man page for more information on -configuring file shares. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939247"></a>Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +configuring file shares. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918066"></a>Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order for a Windows NT print server to support the downloading of driver files by multiple client architectures, you must create several subdirectories within the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> service -(i.e. the Unix directory named by the <i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> +(i.e. the UNIX directory named by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918085"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i> parameter). These correspond to each of the supported client architectures. Samba follows this model as well. Just like the name of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share itself, the subdirectories @@ -890,7 +811,7 @@ client workstation. Open <span class="guiicon">Network Neighbourhood</span> or Once you have located the server, navigate to its <span class="guiicon">Printers and Faxes</span> folder. You should see an initial listing of printers that matches the printer shares defined on your Samba host. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2939408"></a>Installing Drivers into [print$]</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2918239"></a>Installing Drivers into [print$]</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> You have successfully created the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share in ? And Samba has re-read its configuration? Good. But you are not yet ready to take off. The @@ -908,11 +829,11 @@ Properties</em></span> and <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></s from any Windows NT/2k/XP client workstation.</p></li></ul></div><p> The latter option is probably the easier one (even if the only entrance to this realm seems a little bit weird at first). -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939503"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918333"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The initial listing of printers in the Samba host's <span class="guiicon">Printers</span> folder accessed from a client's Explorer -will have no real printer driver assigned to them. By default, in -Samba-3 (as in 2.2.1 and later) this driver name is set to a NULL +will have no real printer driver assigned to them. By default +this driver name is set to a NULL string. This must be changed now. The local <span class="emphasis"><em>Add Printer Wizard</em></span>, run from NT/2000/XP clients, will help us in this task. @@ -943,18 +864,18 @@ Once the APW is started, the procedure is exactly the same as the one you are familiar with in Windows (we assume here that you are familiar with the printer driver installations procedure on Windows NT). Make sure your connection is in fact setup as a user with -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> privileges (if in doubt, use +<a class="indexterm" name="id2918468"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> privileges (if in doubt, use <b class="command">smbstatus</b> to check for this). If you wish to install printer drivers for client operating systems other than <span class="application">Windows NT x86</span>, you will need to use the <span class="guilabel">Sharing</span> tab of the printer properties dialog. </p><p> Assuming you have connected with an administrative (or root) account -(as named by the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter), +(as named by the <a class="indexterm" name="id2918510"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> parameter), you will also be able to modify other printer properties such as ACLs and default device settings using this dialog. For the default device settings, please consider the advice given further below. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2939686"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2918531"></a>Setting Drivers for existing Printers with <b class="command">rpcclient</b></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The second way to install printer drivers into <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and set them up in a valid way can be @@ -969,7 +890,7 @@ time with the <b class="command">setdriver</b> subcommand.</p></li></ol></div><p> We will provide detailed hints for each of these steps in the next few paragraphs. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2939795"></a>Identifying the Driver Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2918640"></a>Identifying the Driver Files</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To find out about the driver files, you have two options: you could investigate the driver CD which comes with your printer. Study the <tt class="filename">*.inf</tt> file on the CD, if it is contained. This @@ -1017,35 +938,35 @@ create scripts to automate the procedure for a large number of printers and drivers. Note the different quotes used to overcome the different spaces in between words: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' -c 'getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3' TURBO_XP</tt></b> - cmd = getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3 +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -U'Danka%xxxx' -c \ + 'getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3' TURBO_XP</tt></b> +cmd = getdriver "Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)" 3 - [Windows NT x86] - Printer Driver Info 3: - Version: [2] - Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)] - Architecture: [Windows NT x86] - Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.DLL] - Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.ppd] - Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.DLL] - Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.HLP] +[Windows NT x86] +Printer Driver Info 3: + Version: [2] + Driver Name: [Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)] + Architecture: [Windows NT x86] + Driver Path: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.DLL] + Datafile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.ppd] + Configfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.DLL] + Helpfile: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01U_de.HLP] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.INI] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.dat] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.cat] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hre] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.vnd] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hlp] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01Aux.dll] - Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.NTF] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.INI] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.dat] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.cat] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hre] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.vnd] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.hlp] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01Aux.dll] + Dependentfiles: [C:\WINNT\System32\spool\DRIVERS\W32X86\2\HDNIS01_de.NTF] - Monitorname: [] - Defaultdatatype: [] - + Monitorname: [] + Defaultdatatype: [] </pre><p> You may notice, that this driver has quite a big number of <span class="guilabel">Dependentfiles</span> (I know worse cases however). Also, @@ -1072,7 +993,7 @@ Windows 2000 changed this. While it still can use the Kernel Mode drivers (if this is enabled by the Admin), its native mode for printer drivers is User Mode execution. This requires drivers designed for this. These type of drivers install into the "3" subdirectory. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940123"></a>Collecting the Driver Files from a Windows Host's +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919003"></a>Collecting the Driver Files from a Windows Host's [print$] Share</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Now we need to collect all the driver files we identified. in our previous step. Where do we get them from? Well, why not retrieve them @@ -1085,15 +1006,15 @@ listing is edited to include linebreaks for readability: <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //TURBO_XP/print\$ -U'Danka%xxxx' \ -c 'cd W32X86/2;mget HD*_de.* \ hd*ppd Hd*_de.* Hddm*dll HDN*Aux.DLL'</tt></b> - added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Got a positive name query response from 10.160.50.8 ( 10.160.50.8 ) - Domain=[DEVELOPMENT] OS=[Windows 5.1] Server=[Windows 2000 LAN Manager] - <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.ABD? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>n</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.def? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> - getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def of size 428 as Hddm91c1_de.def (22.0 kb/s) (average 22.0 kb/s) - <tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.DLL? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> - getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL of size 876544 as Hddm91c1_de.DLL (737.3 kb/s) (average 737.3 kb/s) - [...] +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.50.8 ( 10.160.50.8 ) +Domain=[DEVELOPMENT] OS=[Windows 5.1] Server=[Windows 2000 LAN Manager] +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.ABD? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>n</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.def? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> +getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.def of size 428 as Hddm91c1_de.def +<tt class="prompt">Get file Hddm91c1_de.DLL? </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>y</tt></b> +getting file \W32X86\2\Hddm91c1_de.DLL of size 876544 as Hddm91c1_de.DLL +[...] </pre><p> After this command is complete, the files are in our current local @@ -1108,7 +1029,7 @@ files for these architectures are in the WIN40/0/ subdir. Once we are complete, we can run <b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> to store the collected files on the Samba server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940276"></a>Depositing the Driver Files into [print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919153"></a>Depositing the Driver Files into [print$]</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> So, now we are going to put the driver files into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. Remember, the UNIX path to this share has been defined previously in your @@ -1129,7 +1050,8 @@ running <b class="command">getdriver</b> against the original store the files into a <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba/UNIX</em></span> print server's <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share... </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U'root%xxxx' -c 'cd W32X86; put HDNIS01_de.DLL; \ + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U'root%xxxx' -c \ + 'cd W32X86; put HDNIS01_de.DLL; \ put Hddm91c1_de.ppd; put HDNIS01U_de.DLL; \ put HDNIS01U_de.HLP; put Hddm91c1_de.DLL; \ put Hddm91c1_de.INI; put Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL; \ @@ -1138,26 +1060,25 @@ store the files into a <span class="emphasis"><em>Samba/UNIX</em></span> print s put Hddm91c1_de.vnd; put Hddm91c1_de.hlp; \ put Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP; put HDNIS01Aux.dll; \ put HDNIS01_de.NTF'</tt></b> - added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] - putting file HDNIS01_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.DLL (4465.5 kb/s) (average 4465.5 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.ppd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.ppd (12876.8 kb/s) (average 4638.9 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01U_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.DLL (20249.8 kb/s) (average 5828.3 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01U_de.HLP as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.HLP (9652.8 kb/s) (average 5899.8 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.DLL (23777.7 kb/s) (average 10400.6 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.INI as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.INI (98.6 kb/s) (average 10329.0 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL (22931.5 kb/s) (average 10501.7 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat (2462.8 kb/s) (average 10393.0 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat (4925.3 kb/s) (average 10356.3 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.def as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.def (417.9 kb/s) (average 10290.1 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.hre as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hre (22571.3 kb/s) (average 11338.5 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.vnd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.vnd (3384.6 kb/s) (average 10754.3 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de.hlp as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hlp (18406.8 kb/s) (average 10839.8 kb/s) - putting file Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP (20278.3 kb/s) (average 11386.3 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01Aux.dll as \W32X86\HDNIS01Aux.dll (14994.6 kb/s) (average 11405.2 kb/s) - putting file HDNIS01_de.NTF as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.NTF (23390.2 kb/s) (average 13170.8 kb/s) - +added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +putting file HDNIS01_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.ppd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.ppd +putting file HDNIS01U_de.DLL as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.DLL +putting file HDNIS01U_de.HLP as \W32X86\HDNIS01U_de.HLP +putting file Hddm91c1_de.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.INI as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.INI +putting file Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL as \W32X86\Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL +putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat +putting file Hddm91c1_de.dat as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.dat +putting file Hddm91c1_de.def as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.def +putting file Hddm91c1_de.hre as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hre +putting file Hddm91c1_de.vnd as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.vnd +putting file Hddm91c1_de.hlp as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de.hlp +putting file Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP as \W32X86\Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP +putting file HDNIS01Aux.dll as \W32X86\HDNIS01Aux.dll +putting file HDNIS01_de.NTF as \W32X86\HDNIS01_de.NTF </pre><p> Phewww -- that was a lot of typing! Most drivers are a lot smaller -- many only having 3 generic PostScript driver files plus 1 PPD. Note, @@ -1169,47 +1090,47 @@ re-location will automatically be done by the don't forget to also put the files for the Win95/98/ME architecture into the <tt class="filename">WIN40/</tt> subdirectory should you need them). -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940512"></a>Check if the Driver Files are there (with smbclient)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919348"></a>Check if the Driver Files are there (with smbclient)</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> For now we verify that our files are there. This can be done with <b class="command">smbclient</b> too (but of course you can log in via SSH also and do this through a standard UNIX shell access too): </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' -c 'cd W32X86; pwd; dir; cd 2; pwd; dir'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -U 'root%xxxx' \ + -c 'cd W32X86; pwd; dir; cd 2; pwd; dir'</tt></b> added interface ip=10.160.51.60 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] +Got a positive name query response from 10.160.51.162 ( 10.160.51.162 ) +Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] - Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ - . D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 - .. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003 - 2 D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 - HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 - 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available - - Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\ - . D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 - .. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 - ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 - laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003 - ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 - ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 - PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003 - 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available +Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ +. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +.. D 0 Thu Apr 10 23:47:40 2003 +2 D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 +HDNIS01Aux.dll A 15356 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL A 46966 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01_de.DLL A 434400 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01_de.NTF A 790404 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.DLL A 876544 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.INI A 101 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.dat A 5044 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.def A 428 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.hlp A 37699 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.hre A 323584 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.ppd A 26373 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de.vnd A 45056 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01U_de.DLL A 165888 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +HDNIS01U_de.HLP A 19770 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 +Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP A 228417 Sun May 4 03:58:59 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available +Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\2\ +. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:18 2003 +.. D 0 Sun May 4 03:56:35 2003 +ADOBEPS5.DLL A 434400 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +laserjet4.ppd A 9639 Thu Apr 24 01:05:32 2003 +ADOBEPSU.DLL A 109568 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +ADOBEPSU.HLP A 18082 Sat May 3 23:18:45 2003 +PDFcreator2.PPD A 15746 Sun Apr 20 22:24:07 2003 + 40976 blocks of size 262144. 709 blocks available </pre><p> Notice that there are already driver files present in the <tt class="filename">2</tt> subdir (probably from a previous @@ -1222,7 +1143,7 @@ Point'n'Print. The reason is: Samba doesn't know yet that these files are something special, namely <span class="emphasis"><em>printer driver files</em></span> and it doesn't know yet to which print queue(s) these driver files belong. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940672"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919464"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with <b class="command">adddriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> So, next you must tell Samba about the special category of the files you just uploaded into the <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share. This @@ -1231,21 +1152,23 @@ prompt Samba to register the driver files into its internal TDB database files. The following command and its output has been edited, again, for readability: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" "dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ - Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ - NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ - Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ - Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF, \ - Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS</tt></b> + <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ +"dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ +Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ + NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF, \ + Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS</tt></b> - cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" "dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL: \ - HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ - Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ - Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" +cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ +"dm9110:HDNIS01_de.DLL:Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL: \ + HDNIS01U_de.HLP:NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP" - Printer Driver dm9110 successfully installed. +Printer Driver dm9110 successfully installed. </pre><p> After this step the driver should be recognized by Samba on the print @@ -1257,7 +1180,7 @@ files successfully, but render the driver unworkable. So take care! Hints about the syntax of the adddriver command are in the man page. The CUPS printing chapter of this HOWTO collection provides a more detailed description, if you should need it. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940772"></a>Check how Driver Files have been moved after +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919577"></a>Check how Driver Files have been moved after <b class="command">adddriver</b> finished</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> One indication for Samba's recognition of the files as driver files is the <tt class="computeroutput">successfully installed</tt> message. @@ -1266,9 +1189,9 @@ Another one is the fact, that our files have been moved by the subdirectory. You can check this again with <b class="command">smbclient</b>: </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -Uroot%xxxx -c 'cd W32X86;dir;pwd;cd 2;dir;pwd'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient //SAMBA-CUPS/print\$ -Uroot%xx -c 'cd W32X86;dir;pwd;cd 2;dir;pwd'</tt></b> added interface ip=10.160.51.162 bcast=10.160.51.255 nmask=255.255.252.0 - Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[Unix] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] + Domain=[CUPS-PRINT] OS=[UNIX] Server=[Samba 2.2.7a] Current directory is \\SAMBA-CUPS\print$\W32X86\ . D 0 Sun May 4 04:32:48 2003 @@ -1305,7 +1228,7 @@ subdirectory. You can check this again with </pre><p> Another verification is that the timestamp of the printing TDB files is now updated (and possibly their filesize has increased). -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2940941"></a>Check if the Driver is recognized by Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919746"></a>Check if the Driver is recognized by Samba</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Now the driver should be registered with Samba. We can easily verify this, and will do so in a moment. However, this driver is <span class="emphasis"><em>not yet</em></span> associated with a particular @@ -1349,19 +1272,19 @@ time. Our new driver only shows up for <span class="application">Windows NT 4.0 or 2000</span>. To have it present for <span class="application">Windows 95, 98 and ME</span> you'll have to repeat the whole procedure with the WIN40 architecture and subdirectory. -</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2941145"></a>A side note: you are not bound to specific driver names</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2919954"></a>A side note: you are not bound to specific driver names</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> You can name the driver as you like. If you repeat the <b class="command">adddriver</b> step, with the same files as before, but with a different driver name, it will work the same: </p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient -Uroot%xxxx \ - -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ - "myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ - Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ - NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ - Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ - Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ - HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS + -c 'adddriver "Windows NT x86" \ + "myphantasydrivername:HDNIS01_de.DLL: \ + Hddm91c1_de.ppd:HDNIS01U_de.DLL:HDNIS01U_de.HLP: \ + NULL:RAW:Hddm91c1_de.DLL,Hddm91c1_de.INI, \ + Hddm91c1_de.dat,Hddm91c1_de.def,Hddm91c1_de.hre, \ + Hddm91c1_de.vnd,Hddm91c1_de.hlp,Hddm91c1KMMin.DLL, \ + HDNIS01Aux.dll,HDNIS01_de.NTF,Hddm91c1_de_reg.HLP' SAMBA-CUPS </tt></b> cmd = adddriver "Windows NT x86" @@ -1383,7 +1306,7 @@ repeatedly. Each run "consumes" the files you had put into the respective subdirectories. So you <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> precede an <b class="command">smbclient ... put</b> command before each <b class="command">rpcclient ... adddriver</b>" command. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2941256"></a>La Grande Finale: Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2920088"></a>Running <b class="command">rpcclient</b> with <b class="command">setdriver</b></h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba still needs to know <span class="emphasis"><em>which</em></span> printer's driver this is. It needs to create a mapping of the driver to a printer, and @@ -1413,20 +1336,19 @@ known to Samba already. A bug in 2.2.x prevented Samba from recognizing freshly installed printers. You had to restart Samba, or at least send a HUP signal to all running smbd processes to work around this: -<b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</tt></b>. </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941408"></a>"The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating" (Client Driver Install -Procedure)</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<b class="userinput"><tt>kill -HUP `pidof smbd`</tt></b>. </p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2920241"></a>Client Driver Install Procedure</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A famous philosopher said once: “<span class="quote">The Proof of the Pudding lies in the Eating</span>”. The proof for our setup lies in the printing. So let's install the printer driver onto the client PCs. This is not as straightforward as it may seem. Read on. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941428"></a>The first Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920260"></a>The first Client Driver Installation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Especially important is the installation onto the first client PC (for each architectural platform separately). Once this is done correctly, all further clients are easy to setup and shouldn't need further attention. What follows is a description for the recommended first procedure. You work now from a client workstation. First you should guarantee that your connection is not unwittingly mapped to -<i class="parameter"><tt>bad user</tt></i> "nobody". In a DOS box type: +<span class="emphasis"><em>bad user</em></span> "nobody". In a DOS box type: </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>net use \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\print$ /user:root</tt></b></p><p> Replace root, if needed, by another valid <i class="replaceable"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> user as given in the definition. @@ -1462,7 +1384,7 @@ Data" set is still incomplete. </p><p> You must now make sure that a valid "Device Mode" is set for the driver. Don't fear -- we will explain now what that means. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941626"></a>IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920462"></a>IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In order for a printer to be truly usable by a Windows NT/2K/XP client, it must possess: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> generated by @@ -1489,7 +1411,7 @@ This can be achieved by accessing the drivers remotely from an NT (or 2k/XP) client, as is discussed in the next paragraphs. </p><p> Be aware, that a valid Device Mode can only be initiated by a -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (the reason should be +<a class="indexterm" name="id2920558"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>, or root (the reason should be obvious). Device Modes can only correctly be set by executing the printer driver program itself. Since Samba can not execute this Win32 platform driver code, it sets this field initially to NULL (which is @@ -1534,7 +1456,7 @@ properties. Others may crash the client's spooler service. So use this parameter with caution. It is always better to have the client generate a valid device mode for the printer and store it on the server for you. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941915"></a>Further Client Driver Install Procedures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920763"></a>Further Client Driver Install Procedures</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every further driver may be done by any user, along the lines described above: Browse network, open printers folder on Samba server, right-click printer and choose <span class="guimenuitem">Connect...</span>. Once @@ -1554,12 +1476,12 @@ rundll32 shell32.dll,Control_RunDLL MAIN.CPL @2 You can enter the commands either inside a <span class="guilabel">DOS box</span> window or in the <span class="guimenuitem">Run command...</span> field from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span> menu. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942010"></a>Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2920857"></a>Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> After you installed the driver on the Samba server (in its <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share, you should always make sure that your first client installation completes correctly. Make it a habit for yourself to build that the very first connection from a client as -<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. This is to make sure that: +<a class="indexterm" name="id2920879"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>. This is to make sure that: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> a first valid <span class="emphasis"><em>Device Mode</em></span> is really initialized (see above for more explanation details), and that</p></li><li><p> the default print settings of your printer for all @@ -1573,20 +1495,23 @@ set to <span class="emphasis"><em>Letter</em></span>, when you are all using </p><p> To connect as root to a Samba printer, try this command from a Windows 2K/XP DOS box command prompt: -</p><p><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>"</tt></b> +</p><pre class="screen"> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>runas /netonly /user:root "rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t3 /n + \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printername</tt></i>"</tt></b> +</pre><p> </p><p> You will be prompted for root's Samba-password; type it, wait a few seconds, click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Defaults...</span> and proceed to set the job options as should be used as defaults by all clients. Alternatively, instead of root you can name one other member -of the <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admins</tt></i> from the setting. +of the <a class="indexterm" name="id2921000"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> from the setting. </p><p> Now all the other users downloading and installing the driver the same way (called <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span>) will have the same defaults set for them. If you miss this step you'll get a lot of helpdesk calls from your users. But maybe you like to talk to people.... ;-) -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2942152"></a>Other Gotchas</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2921029"></a>Other Gotchas</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Your driver is installed. It is ready for <span class="emphasis"><em>Point'n'Print</em></span> installation by the clients now. You <span class="emphasis"><em>may</em></span> have tried to download and use it @@ -1596,7 +1521,7 @@ example, suppose you didn't manage to "set the defaults" on the printer, as advised in the preceding paragraphs? And your users complain about various issues (such as “<span class="quote">We need to set the paper size for each job from Letter to A4 and it won't store it!</span>”) -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942185"></a>Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921063"></a>Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The last sentence might be viewed with mixed feelings by some users and admins. They have struggled for hours and hours and couldn't arrive at a point were their settings seemed to be saved. It is not their @@ -1651,7 +1576,7 @@ either. However, only the last one, which you arrived at with steps C.1.-6. will permanently save any settings which will then become the defaults for new users. If you want all clients to have the same defaults, you need to conduct these steps as administrator -(<i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in ) +(<a class="indexterm" name="id2921360"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i> in ) <span class="emphasis"><em>before</em></span> a client downloads the driver (the clients can later set their own <span class="emphasis"><em>per-user defaults</em></span> by following the procedures <span class="emphasis"><em>A.</em></span> @@ -1685,7 +1610,7 @@ to see the tab with the <span class="guilabel">Printing Preferences...</span> button (the one which doesn't set system-wide defaults). You can start the commands from inside a DOS box" or from the <span class="guimenu">Start</span> -- <span class="guimenuitem">Run...</span> menu. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942622"></a>Supporting large Numbers of Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921530"></a>Supporting large Numbers of Printers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> One issue that has arisen during the recent development phase of Samba is the need to support driver downloads for 100's of printers. Using Windows NT APW here is somewhat awkward (to say the least). If you @@ -1735,7 +1660,8 @@ following is an example of how this could be accomplished: </pre><p> </p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> "<i class="replaceable"><tt>Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)</tt></i>"'</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>rpcclient <i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-CUPS</tt></i> -U root%<i class="replaceable"><tt>secret</tt></i> -c \ + 'setdriver <i class="replaceable"><tt>dm9110</tt></i> "<i class="replaceable"><tt>Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS)</tt></i>"'</tt></b> cmd = setdriver dm9110 Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PPD) Successfully set dm9110 to driver Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS). </pre><p> @@ -1745,7 +1671,8 @@ following is an example of how this could be accomplished: cmd = enumprinters flags:[0x800000] name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] - description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS),110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,Heidelberg Digimaster 9110 (PS),\ + 110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] [....] </pre><p> @@ -1761,7 +1688,8 @@ following is an example of how this could be accomplished: cmd = enumprinters flags:[0x800000] name:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110] - description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,myphantasydrivername,110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] + description:[\\SAMBA-CUPS\dm9110,myphantasydrivername,\ + 110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] comment:[110ppm HiVolume DANKA Stuttgart] [....] </pre><p> @@ -1772,7 +1700,7 @@ commas in the "description" field). After the <b class="command">setdriver</b> command succeeded, all is well. (The CUPS Printing chapter has more info about the installation of printer drivers with the help of <b class="command">rpcclient</b>). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2942924"></a>Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2921841"></a>Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> By default, Samba exhibits all printer shares defined in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> in the <span class="guiicon">Printers...</span> folder. Also located in this folder @@ -1780,29 +1708,29 @@ is the Windows NT Add Printer Wizard icon. The APW will be shown only if: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>...the connected user is able to successfully execute an <b class="command">OpenPrinterEx(\\server)</b> with administrative -privileges (i.e. root or <i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>). +privileges (i.e. root or <a class="indexterm" name="id2921887"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i>). </p><div class="tip" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Tip</h3><p> Try this from a Windows 2K/XP DOS box command prompt: </p><p><b class="userinput"><tt> runas /netonly /user:root rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /p /t0 /n \\<i class="replaceable"><tt>SAMBA-SERVER</tt></i>\<i class="replaceable"><tt>printersharename</tt></i> </tt></b></p><p> and click on <span class="guibutton">Printing Preferences...</span> </p></div></li><li><p>... contains the setting -<i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard = yes</tt></i> (the +<a class="indexterm" name="id2921942"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i> = yes (the default).</p></li></ul></div><p> The APW can do various things: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>upload a new driver to the Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> share;</p></li><li><p>associate an uploaded driver with an existing (but still "driverless") print queue;</p></li><li><p>exchange the currently used driver for an existing print queue with one that has been uploaded before;</p></li><li><p>add an entirely new printer to the Samba host (only in -conjunction with a working <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i>; -a corresponding <i class="parameter"><tt>delete printer command</tt></i> for +conjunction with a working <a class="indexterm" name="id2922001"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i>; +a corresponding <a class="indexterm" name="id2922017"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>delete printer command</tt></i> for removing entries from the <span class="guiicon">Printers...</span> folder may be provided too)</p></li></ul></div><p> The last one (add a new printer) requires more effort than the previous ones. In order to use the APW to successfully add a printer -to a Samba server, the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> must +to a Samba server, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2922045"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> must have a defined value. The program hook must successfully add the -printer to the Unix print system (i.e. to +printer to the UNIX print system (i.e. to <tt class="filename">/etc/printcap</tt>, <tt class="filename">/etc/cups/printers.conf</tt> or other appropriate files) and to if necessary. @@ -1812,13 +1740,11 @@ exist, smbd will execute the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> and reparse to the to attempt to locate the new printer share. If the share is still not defined, an error of <span class="errorname">Access Denied</span> is -returned to the client. Note that the <i class="parameter"><tt>add printer -command</tt></i> is executed under the context of the connected -user, not necessarily a root account. A <i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest = bad -user</tt></i> may have connected you unwittingly under the wrong +returned to the client. Note that the <a class="indexterm" name="id2922095"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add printer command</tt></i> is executed under the context of the connected +user, not necessarily a root account. A <a class="indexterm" name="id2922111"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i> = bad user may have connected you unwittingly under the wrong privilege; you should check it by using the <b class="command">smbstatus</b> command. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943168"></a>Weird Error Message <span class="errorname">Cannot connect under a +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922136"></a>Weird Error Message <span class="errorname">Cannot connect under a different Name</span></h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Once you are connected with the wrong credentials, there is no means to reverse the situation other than to close all Explorer windows, and @@ -1848,7 +1774,7 @@ message. You close all Explorer Windows and start it again. You try to connect - and this times it works! Windows seems to cache connection info somewhere and doesn't keep it up to date (if you are unlucky you might need to reboot to get rid of the error message). -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943267"></a>Be careful when assembling Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922236"></a>Be careful when assembling Driver Files</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> You need to be very careful when you take notes about the files and belonging to a particular driver. Don't confuse the files for driver version "0" (for Win95/98/ME, going into @@ -1989,7 +1915,7 @@ In my example were even more differences than shown here. Conclusion: you must be very careful to select the correct driver files for each driver version. Don't rely on the names alone. Don't interchange files belonging to different driver versions. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943612"></a>Samba and Printer Ports</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922594"></a>Samba and Printer Ports</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Windows NT/2000 print servers associate a port with each printer. These normally take the form of <tt class="filename">LPT1:</tt>, <tt class="filename">COM1:</tt>, <tt class="filename">FILE:</tt>, etc. Samba @@ -2008,20 +1934,20 @@ multiple ports as a form of load balancing or fail over. If you require that multiple ports be defined for some reason or another (“<span class="quote">My users and my Boss should not know that they are working with Samba</span>”), possesses a -<i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> which can be used to define +<a class="indexterm" name="id2922668"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> which can be used to define an external program that generates a listing of ports on a system. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943683"></a>Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922687"></a>Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> So - printing works, but there are still problems. Most jobs print well, some don't print at all. Some jobs have problems with fonts, which don't look good at all. Some jobs print fast, and some are dead-slow. We can't cover it all; but we want to encourage you to read the little paragraph about "Avoiding the wrong PostScript Driver Settings" in the CUPS Printing part of this document. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943705"></a>The Imprints Toolset</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2922712"></a>The Imprints Toolset</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Imprints tool set provides a UNIX equivalent of the Windows NT Add Printer Wizard. For complete information, please refer to the Imprints web site -at<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a> +at <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a> as well as the documentation included with the imprints source distribution. This section will only provide a brief introduction to the features of Imprints. @@ -2034,20 +1960,20 @@ coordinate your efforts on the samba-technical mailing list. The toolset is still in usable form; but only for a series of older printer models, where there are prepared packages to use. Packages for more up to date print devices are needed if Imprints should have a -future.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943751"></a>What is Imprints?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +future.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922768"></a>What is Imprints?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Imprints is a collection of tools for supporting these goals: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Providing a central repository information regarding Windows NT and 95/98 printer driver packages</p></li><li><p>Providing the tools necessary for creating the Imprints printer driver packages.</p></li><li><p>Providing an installation client which will obtain printer drivers from a central internet (or intranet) Imprints Server repository and install them on remote Samba and Windows NT4 print -servers.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943792"></a>Creating Printer Driver Packages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +servers.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922810"></a>Creating Printer Driver Packages</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The process of creating printer driver packages is beyond the scope of this document (refer to Imprints.txt also included with the Samba distribution for more information). In short, an Imprints driver package is a gzipped tarball containing the driver files, related INF files, and a control file needed by the installation client. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943811"></a>The Imprints Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922828"></a>The Imprints Server</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Imprints server is really a database server that may be queried via standard HTTP mechanisms. Each printer entry in the database has an associated URL for the actual downloading of the package. Each @@ -2055,7 +1981,7 @@ package is digitally signed via GnuPG which can be used to verify that package downloaded is actually the one referred in the Imprints database. It is strongly recommended that this security check <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> be disabled. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943835"></a>The Installation Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2922853"></a>The Installation Client</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> More information regarding the Imprints installation client is available in the <tt class="filename">Imprints-Client-HOWTO.ps</tt> file included with the imprints source package. @@ -2096,7 +2022,7 @@ if is has not already been installed? The way of sidestepping this limitation is to require that all Imprints printer driver packages include both the Intel Windows NT and 95/98 printer drivers and that NT driver is installed first. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943987"></a>Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923008"></a>Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The following MS Knowledge Base article may be of some help if you need to handle Windows 2000 clients: <span class="emphasis"><em>How to Add Printers with No User Interaction in Windows 2000.</em></span> ( <a href="http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105" target="_top">http://support.microsoft.com/default.aspx?scid=kb;en-us;189105</a> @@ -2121,13 +2047,7 @@ printers via Samba, but works for Windows-based print servers too): <b class="userinput"><tt>rundll32 printui.dll,PrintUIEntry /y /n "\\sambacupsserver\infotec2105-PS"</tt></b> </pre><p> Here is a list of the used commandline parameters: -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">/dn</span></dt><dd><p>deletes a network printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/q</span></dt><dd><p>quiet modus</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/n</span></dt><dd><p>names a printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/in</span></dt><dd><p>adds a network printer connection</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/y</span></dt><dd><p>sets printer as default printer</p></dd></dl></div><p> -I have tested this with a Samba 2.2.7a and a Samba-3alpha24 -installation and Windows XP Professional clients. Note that this -specific command set works with network print queues (installing -local print queues requires different parameters, but this is of no -interest here). -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Line 1 deletes a possibly existing previous network +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">/dn</span></dt><dd><p>deletes a network printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/q</span></dt><dd><p>quiet modus</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/n</span></dt><dd><p>names a printer</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/in</span></dt><dd><p>adds a network printer connection</p></dd><dt><span class="term">/y</span></dt><dd><p>sets printer as default printer</p></dd></dl></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Line 1 deletes a possibly existing previous network printer <span class="emphasis"><em>infotec2105-IPDS</em></span> (which had used native Windows drivers with LPRng that were removed from the server which was converted to CUPS). The <b class="command">/q</b> at the end eliminates @@ -2171,7 +2091,7 @@ at logon time will not really be noticeable. Printers can be centrally added, changed, and deleted at will on the server with no user intervention required on the clients (you just need to keep the logon scripts up to date). -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944316"></a>The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923342"></a>The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <b class="command">addprinter</b> command can be configured to be a shell script or program executed by Samba. It is triggered by running the APW from a client against the Samba print server. The APW asks the @@ -2183,7 +2103,7 @@ on legacy systems, or execute the <b class="command">lpadmin</b> command on more modern systems) and create the associated share in , then the APW will in effect really create a new printer on Samba and the UNIX print subsystem! -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944362"></a>Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923388"></a>Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The basic "NT-style" printer driver management has not changed considerably in 3.0 over the 2.2.x releases (apart from many small improvements). Here migration should be quite easy, especially if you @@ -2194,14 +2114,13 @@ is more of an effort. Please read the appropriate release notes and the HOWTO Collection for 2.2. You can follow several paths. Here are possible scenarios for migration: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You need to study and apply the new Windows NT printer -and driver support. Previously used parameters "<i class="parameter"><tt>printer -driver file</tt></i>", " <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i>" and -"<i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i>" are no longer +and driver support. Previously used parameters <i class="parameter"><tt>printer +driver file</tt></i>, <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver</tt></i> and +<i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver location</tt></i> are no longer supported.</p></li><li><p>If you want to take advantage of WinNT printer driver support you also need to migrate the Win9x/ME drivers to the new setup.</p></li><li><p>An existing <tt class="filename">printers.def</tt> file -(the one specified in the now removed parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>printer -driver file = ...</tt></i>) will work no longer with Samba-3.0. In + (the one specified in the now removed parameter <i class="parameter"><tt>printer driver file</tt></i>) will work no longer with samba 3. In 3.0, smbd attempts to locate a Win9x/ME driver files for the printer in <i class="parameter"><tt>[print$]</tt></i> and additional settings in the TDB and only there; if it fails it will <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> (as 2.2.x @@ -2217,24 +2136,21 @@ only solution is to use the Windows NT APW to install the NT drivers and the 9x drivers. This can be scripted using smbclient and rpcclient. See the Imprints installation client at: </p><p> -<a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top"><span class="emphasis"><em>http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</em></span></a> + <a href="http://imprints.sourceforge.net/" target="_top">http://imprints.sourceforge.net/</a> </p><p> for an example. See also the discussion of rpcclient usage in the -"CUPS Printing" section.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944531"></a>Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +"CUPS Printing" section.</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923561"></a>Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> We will publish an update to this section shortly. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2944545"></a>Common Errors and Problems</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Here are a few typical errors and problems people have -encountered. You can avoid them. Read on. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944558"></a>I give my root password but I don't get access</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Don't confuse the root password which is valid for the Unix system +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2923575"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923582"></a>I give my root password but I don't get access</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Don't confuse the root password which is valid for the UNIX system (and in most cases stored in the form of a one-way hash in a file named <tt class="filename">/etc/shadow</tt>) with the password used to authenticate against Samba!. Samba doesn't know the UNIX password; for root to access Samba resources via Samba-type access, a Samba account for root must be created first. This is often done with the <b class="command">smbpasswd</b> command. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2944591"></a>My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Don't use the existing Unix print system spool directory for the Samba +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2923615"></a>My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Don't use the existing UNIX print system spool directory for the Samba spool directory. It may seem convenient and a saving of space, but it only leads to problems. The two <span class="emphasis"><em>must</em></span> be separate. -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="msdfs.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="CUPS-printing.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 17. Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 19. CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/problems.html b/docs/htmldocs/problems.html index 6628a7d8fe..24ddc7c02c 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/problems.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/problems.html @@ -1,11 +1,16 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist"><link rel="next" href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="diagnosis.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="bugreport.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="problems"></a>Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 Apr 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id3010907">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011048">Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011333">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011378">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011530">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="troubleshooting.html" title="Part V. Troubleshooting"><link rel="previous" href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist"><link rel="next" href="bugreport.html" title="Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="diagnosis.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="bugreport.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="problems"></a>Chapter 34. Analysing and solving samba problems</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">8 Apr 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959747">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959768">Debugging with Samba itself</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959894">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959915">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959968">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960285">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960326">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960484">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></div><p> There are many sources of information available in the form of mailing lists, RFC's and documentation. The docs that come with the samba distribution contain very good explanations of -general SMB topics such as browsing.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3010907"></a>Diagnostics tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +general SMB topics such as browsing.</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2959747"></a>Diagnostics tools</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>With SMB networking, it is often not immediately clear what +the cause is of a certain problem. Samba itself provides rather +useful information, but in some cases you might have to fall back +to using a <span class="emphasis"><em>sniffer</em></span>. A sniffer is a program that +listens on your LAN, analyses the data sent on it and displays it +on the screen.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959768"></a>Debugging with Samba itself</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> One of the best diagnostic tools for debugging problems is Samba itself. You can use the <tt class="option">-d option</tt> for both <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> to specify what -<i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i> at which to run. See the man pages on smbd, nmbd and +<a class="indexterm" name="id2959799"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i> at which to run. See the man pages on smbd, nmbd and smb.conf for more information on debugging options. The debug level can range from 1 (the default) to 10 (100 for debugging passwords). </p><p> @@ -24,14 +29,19 @@ typing in your password, you can attach gdb and continue. </p><p> Some useful samba commands worth investigating: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm | more</tt></b> - <tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</tt></b> -</pre><p> -An SMB enabled version of tcpdump is available from -<a href="http://www.tcpdump.org/" target="_top">http://www.tcpdup.org/</a>. -Ethereal, another good packet sniffer for Unix and Win32 -hosts, can be downloaded from <a href="http://www.ethereal.com/" target="_top">http://www.ethereal.com</a>. -</p><p> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>testparm | more</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">$ </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>smbclient -L //{netbios name of server}</tt></b> +</pre></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959894"></a>Tcpdump</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p><a href="http://www.tcpdump.org/" target="_top">Tcpdump</a> was the first +unix sniffer with SMB support. It is a command-line utility and +nowadays, it's SMB support is somewhat less then that of ethereal +and tethereal.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959915"></a>Ethereal</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<a href="http://www.ethereal.com/" target="_top">Ethereal</a> is a graphical +sniffer, available for both unix (Gtk) and Windows. Ethereal's +SMB support is very good.</p><p>For details on the use of ethereal, read the well-written +ethereal User Guide.</p><p> +Listen for data on ports 137, 138, 139 and 445. E.g. +use the filter <b class="userinput"><tt>port 137 or port 138 or port 139 or port 445</tt></b>.</p><p>A console version of ethereal is available as well and is called +<b class="command">tethereal</b>.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2959968"></a>The Windows Network Monitor</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> For tracing things on the Microsoft Windows NT, Network Monitor (aka. netmon) is available on the Microsoft Developer Network CD's, the Windows NT Server install CD and the SMS CD's. The version of @@ -41,7 +51,7 @@ The version on the NT Server install CD will only allow monitoring of network traffic directed to the local NT box and broadcasts on the local subnet. Be aware that Ethereal can read and write netmon formatted files. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011048"></a>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2959989"></a>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Installing netmon on an NT workstation requires a couple of steps. The following are for installing Netmon V4.00.349, which comes with Microsoft Windows NT Server 4.0, on Microsoft Windows NT @@ -74,17 +84,17 @@ Now copy the files from the NT Server in <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\Syste to <tt class="filename">%SYSTEMROOT%\System32\netmon\*.*</tt> on the Workstation and set permissions as you deem appropriate for your site. You will need administrative rights on the NT box to run netmon. -</p><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2960258"></a>Installing 'Network Monitor' on an 9x Workstation</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> To install Netmon on a Windows 9x box install the network monitor agent from the Windows 9x CD (<tt class="filename">\admin\nettools\netmon</tt>). There is a readme file located with the netmon driver files on the CD if you need information on how to do this. Copy the files from a working Netmon installation. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011333"></a>Useful URLs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960285"></a>Useful URLs</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>See how Scott Merrill simulates a BDC behavior at <a href="http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html" target="_top"> http://www.skippy.net/linux/smb-howto.html</a>. </p></li><li><p>FTP site for older SMB specs: <a href="ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/" target="_top"> - ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011378"></a>Getting help from the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + ftp://ftp.microsoft.com/developr/drg/CIFS/</a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960326"></a>Getting help from the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of Samba related mailing lists. Go to <a href="http://samba.org" target="_top">http://samba.org</a>, click on your nearest mirror and then click on <b class="command">Support</b> and then click on <b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. @@ -94,10 +104,10 @@ For questions relating to Samba TNG go to It has been requested that you don't post questions about Samba-TNG to the main stream Samba lists.</p><p> If you post a message to one of the lists please observe the following guide lines : -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Always remember that the developers are volunteers, they are not paid and they never guarantee to produce a particular feature at a particular time. Any time lines are 'best guess' and nothing more. -</p></li><li><p> Always mention what version of samba you are using and what +</p></li><li><p>Always mention what version of samba you are using and what operating system its running under. You should probably list the relevant sections of your <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, at least the options in [global] that affect PDC support.</p></li><li><p>In addition to the version, if you obtained Samba via @@ -118,12 +128,11 @@ error messages.</p></li><li><p>(Possibly) If you have a complete netmon trace ( the pipe to the error ) you can send the *.CAP file as well.</p></li><li><p>Please think carefully before attaching a document to an email. Consider pasting the relevant parts into the body of the message. The samba mailing lists go to a huge number of people, do they all need a copy of your -smb.conf in their attach directory?</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3011530"></a>How to get off the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To have your name removed from a samba mailing list, go to the +smb.conf in their attach directory?</p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2960484"></a>How to get off the mailing lists</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>To have your name removed from a samba mailing list, go to the same place you went to to get on it. Go to <a href="http://lists.samba.org/" target="_top">http://lists.samba.org</a>, click on your nearest mirror and then click on <b class="command">Support</b> and -then click on <b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. Or perhaps see -<a href="http://lists.samba.org/mailman/roster/samba-ntdom" target="_top">here</a> +then click on <b class="command"> Samba related mailing lists</b>. </p><p> Please don't post messages to the list asking to be removed, you will just be referred to the above address (unless that process failed in some way...) -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="diagnosis.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="bugreport.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 33. The Samba checklist </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="diagnosis.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="troubleshooting.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="bugreport.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 33. The Samba checklist </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 35. Reporting Bugs</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html index 47c4d914a5..e1ff391cbc 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/rpcclient.1.html @@ -5,10 +5,9 @@ have now written scripts around it to manage Windows NT clients from their UNIX workstation. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">server</span></dt><dd><p>NetBIOS name of Server to which to connect. The server can be any SMB/CIFS server. The name is - resolved using the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NAMERESOLVEORDER" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a> line from <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c|--command='command string'</span></dt><dd><p>execute semicolon separated commands (listed + resolved using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2799808"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a> line from <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c|--command='command string'</span></dt><dd><p>execute semicolon separated commands (listed below)) </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I IP-address</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>IP address</tt></i> is the address of the server to connect to. - It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </p><p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named + It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </p><p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution mechanism described above in the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i> parameter above. Using this parameter will force the client @@ -22,8 +21,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -37,10 +35,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2800110"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal password prompt from the client to the user. This is useful when @@ -73,10 +70,10 @@ via the <b class="command">ps</b> command. To be safe always allow <b class="command">rpcclient</b> to prompt for a password and type it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n <primary NetBIOS name></span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical -to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS -name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command +to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id2800321"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +However, a command line setting will take precedence over settings in -<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i <scope></span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i <scope></span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that <b class="command">nmblookup</b> will use to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are @@ -88,7 +85,7 @@ smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the servers NetBIOS name, it causes the client to log on using the servers local SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket options</span></dt><dd><p>TCP socket options to set on the client socket. See the socket options parameter in -the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page for the list of valid +the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page for the list of valid options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><div class="refsect2" lang="en"><h3>LSARPC</h3><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">lsaquery</span></dt><dd><p>Query info policy</p></dd><dt><span class="term">lookupsids</span></dt><dd><p>Resolve a list of SIDs to usernames. @@ -111,10 +108,10 @@ Help File Name:\ Language Monitor Name:\ Default Data Type:\ Comma Separated list of Files -</pre><p>Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </p><p>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors +</pre><p>Any empty fields should be enter as the string "NULL". </p><p>Samba does not need to support the concept of Print Monitors since these only apply to local printers whose driver can make use of a bi-directional link for communication. This field should - be "NULL". On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a + be "NULL". On a remote NT print server, the Print Monitor for a driver must already be installed prior to adding the driver or else the RPC will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">addprinter <printername> <sharename> <drivername> <port></span></dt><dd><p> @@ -158,9 +155,9 @@ Comma Separated list of Files Execute a GetPrinterDriverDirectory() RPC to retrieve the SMB share name and subdirectory for storing printer driver files for a given architecture. Possible - values for <i class="parameter"><tt>arch</tt></i> are "Windows 4.0" - (for Windows 95/98), "Windows NT x86", "Windows NT PowerPC", "Windows - Alpha_AXP", and "Windows NT R4000". </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getprinter <printername></span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve the current printer information. This command + values for <i class="parameter"><tt>arch</tt></i> are "Windows 4.0" + (for Windows 95/98), "Windows NT x86", "Windows NT PowerPC", "Windows + Alpha_AXP", and "Windows NT R4000". </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getprinter <printername></span></dt><dd><p>Retrieve the current printer information. This command corresponds to the GetPrinter() MS Platform SDK function. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">getprintprocdir</span></dt><dd><p>Get print processor diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html index 4c2045642d..c3be7504e2 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-bdc.html @@ -1,22 +1,21 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-bdc"></a>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Volker</span> <span class="surname">Lendecke</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896028">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896201">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896230">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896450">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896471">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896497">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896542">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896645">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896706">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896719">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896750">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896783">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896828">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control"><link rel="next" href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-bdc"></a>Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Volker</span> <span class="surname">Lendecke</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE">Volker.Lendecke@SerNet.DE</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889347">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889536">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889565">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889816">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889836">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889863">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889908">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890011">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890167">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890181">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890212">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890238">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890283">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p> Before you continue reading in this section, please make sure that you are comfortable -with configuring a Samba Domain Controller as described in the -<a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a> chapter. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896028"></a>Features And Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +with configuring a Samba Domain Controller as described in <a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">chapter on setting up Samba as a PDC</a>. +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889347"></a>Features And Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is one of the most difficult chapters to summarise. It does not matter what we say here for someone will still draw conclusions and / or approach the Samba-Team with expectations that are either not yet capable of being delivered, or that can be achieved far more -effectively using a totally different approach. Since this HOWTO is already so large and -extensive, we have taken the decision to provide sufficient (but not comprehensive) -information regarding Backup Domain Control. In the event that you should have a persistent -concern that is not addressed in this HOWTO document then please email +effectively using a totally different approach. In the event that you should have a persistent +concern that is not addressed in this book then please email <a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John H Terpstra</a> clearly setting out your requirements and / or question and we will do our best to provide a solution. </p><p> Samba-3 is capable of acting as a Backup Domain Controller to another Samba Primary Domain -Controller. A Samba-3 PDC can operate with an LDAP Account backend. The Samba-3 BDC can -operate with a slave LDAP server for the Account backend. This effectively gives samba a high -degree of scalability. This is a very sweet (nice) solution for large organisations. +Controller. A Samba-3 PDC can operate with an LDAP Account backend. The LDAP backend can be +either a common master LDAP server, or a slave server. The use of a slave LDAP server has the +benefit that when the master is down clients may still be able to log onto the network. +This effectively gives samba a high degree of scalability iand is a very sweet (nice) solution +for large organisations. </p><p> While it is possible to run a Samba-3 BDC with non-LDAP backend, the administrator will need to figure out precisely what is the best way to replicate (copy / distribute) the @@ -41,8 +40,9 @@ lets consider each possible option and look at the pro's and con's for each theo </p><p> Arguments Against: Complexity </p></li><li><p> - Passdb Backend is tdbsam based, BDCs use cron based "net rpc vampire" to - suck down the Accounts database from the PDC + Passdb Backend is tdbsam based, BDCs use cron based <span class="emphasis"><em>net rpc vampire</em></span> to + obtain the Accounts database from the PDC and place them into the Samba SAM. + <span class="emphasis"><em>net rpc vampire</em></span> is a Samba function of the "net" command. </p><p> Arguments For: It would be a nice solution </p><p> @@ -63,7 +63,7 @@ lets consider each possible option and look at the pro's and con's for each theo Arguments Against: All machine trust accounts and user accounts will be locally maintained. Domain users will NOT be able to roam from office to office. This is a broken and flawed solution. Do NOT do this. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896201"></a>Essential Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889536"></a>Essential Background Information</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> A Domain Controller is a machine that is able to answer logon requests from network workstations. Microsoft LanManager and IBM LanServer were two early products that provided this capability. The technology has become known as the LanMan Netlogon service. @@ -73,7 +73,7 @@ and with it a new form of the network logon service that has extended functional This service became known as the NT NetLogon Service. The nature of this service has changed with the evolution of MS Windows NT and today provides a very complex array of services that are implemented over a complex spectrum of technologies. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896230"></a>MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889565"></a>MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Whenever a user logs into a Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional Workstation, the workstation connects to a Domain Controller (authentication server) to validate the username and password that the user entered are valid. If the information entered @@ -131,32 +131,29 @@ one of the BDCs can be promoted to a PDC. If this happens while the original PDC line then it is automatically demoted to a BDC. This is an important aspect of Domain Controller management. The tool that is used to affect a promotion or a demotion is the Server Manager for Domains. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2896379"></a>Example PDC Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2889716"></a>Example PDC Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since version 2.2 Samba officially supports domain logons for all current Windows Clients, including Windows NT4, 2003 and XP Professional. For samba to be enabled as a PDC some parameters in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> have to be set: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - workgroup = SAMBA - domain master = yes - domain logons = yes -</pre><p> -Several other things like a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> and a <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share also need to be set along with +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2889747"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.1. Minimal smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +Several other things like a <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> and a +<i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share also need to be set along with settings for the profile path, the users home drive, etc.. This will not be covered in this -chapter, for more information please refer to the chapter on <a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">Domain Control</a>. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896450"></a>Active Directory Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +chapter, for more information please refer to <a href="samba-pdc.html" title="Chapter 5. Domain Control">the chapter about samba as a PDC</a>. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889816"></a>Active Directory Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> As of the release of MS Windows 2000 and Active Directory, this information is now stored in a directory that can be replicated and for which partial or full administrative control can be delegated. Samba-3 is NOT able to be a Domain Controller within an Active Directory tree, and it can not be an Active Directory server. This means that Samba-3 also can NOT act as a Backup Domain Controller to an Active Directory Domain Controller. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896471"></a>What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889836"></a>What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every machine that is a Domain Controller for the domain SAMBA has to register the NetBIOS group name SAMBA<#1c> with the WINS server and/or by broadcast on the local network. The PDC also registers the unique NetBIOS name SAMBA<#1b> with the WINS server. The name type <#1b> name is normally reserved for the Domain Master Browser, a role that has nothing to do with anything related to authentication, but the Microsoft Domain implementation requires the domain master browser to be on the same machine as the PDC. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896497"></a>How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889863"></a>How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> An MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional workstation in the domain SAMBA that wants a local user to be authenticated has to find the domain controller for SAMBA. It does this by doing a NetBIOS name query for the group name SAMBA<#1c>. It assumes that each @@ -164,22 +161,22 @@ of the machines it gets back from the queries is a domain controller and can ans requests. To not open security holes both the workstation and the selected domain controller authenticate each other. After that the workstation sends the user's credentials (name and password) to the local Domain Controller, for validation. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896542"></a>Backup Domain Controller Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2889908"></a>Backup Domain Controller Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Several things have to be done: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> The domain SID has to be the same on the PDC and the BDC. This used to be stored in the file private/MACHINE.SID. This file is not created - anymore since Samba 2.2.5 or even earlier. Nowadays the domain SID is - stored in the file private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb + since Samba 2.2.5. Nowadays the domain SID is stored in the file + private/secrets.tdb. Simply copying the secrets.tdb from the PDC to the BDC does not work, as the BDC would generate a new SID for itself and override the domain SID with this new BDC SID.</p><p> To retrieve the domain SID from the PDC or an existing BDC and store it in the secrets.tdb, execute: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc getsid</tt></b> - </pre></li><li><p> - The Unix user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net rpc getsid</tt></b> +</pre></li><li><p> + The UNIX user database has to be synchronized from the PDC to the BDC. This means that both the /etc/passwd and /etc/group have to be replicated from the PDC to the BDC. This can be done manually whenever changes are made, or the PDC is set up as a NIS master @@ -199,23 +196,30 @@ Several things have to be done: BDC. This can be done manually whenever login scripts are changed, or it can be done automatically together with the smbpasswd synchronization. - </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896645"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890011"></a>Example Configuration</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Finally, the BDC has to be found by the workstations. This can be done by setting: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - workgroup = SAMBA - domain master = no - domain logons = yes -</pre><p> -in the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> of the BDC. This makes the BDC +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2890026"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 6.2. Minimal setup for being a BDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldapsam://slave-ldap.quenya.org</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +In the <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i>-section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> of the BDC. This makes the BDC only register the name SAMBA<#1c> with the WINS server. This is no problem as the name SAMBA<#1c> is a NetBIOS group name that is meant to -be registered by more than one machine. The parameter 'domain master = -no' forces the BDC not to register SAMBA<#1b> which as a unique NetBIOS +be registered by more than one machine. The parameter +<a class="indexterm" name="id2890094"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = no +forces the BDC not to register SAMBA<#1b> which as a unique NetBIOS name is reserved for the Primary Domain Controller. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2896706"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><p> +The <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> will redirect the <b class="command">winbindd</b> utility to +use the LDAP database to resolve all UIDs and GIDs for UNIX accounts. +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Samba-3 has introduced a new ID mapping facility. One of the features of this facility is that it +allows greater flexibility in how user and group IDs are handled in respect of NT Domain User and Group +SIDs. One of the new facilities provides for explicitly ensuring that UNIX / Linux UID and GID values +will be consistent on the PDC, all BDCs and all Domain Member servers. The parameter that controls this +is called <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i>. Please refer to the man page for <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information +regarding it's behaviour. Do NOT set this parameter except where an LDAP backend (ldapsam) is in use. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2890167"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> As this is a rather new area for Samba there are not many examples that we may refer to. Keep watching for updates to this section. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896719"></a>Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890181"></a>Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This problem will occur when occur when the passdb (SAM) files are copied from a central server but the local Backup Domain Controllers. Local machine trust account password updates are not copied back to the central server. The newer machine account password is then over @@ -226,18 +230,15 @@ to proceed and the account expiry error will be reported. </p><p> The solution: use a more robust passdb backend, such as the ldapsam backend, setting up an slave LDAP server for each BDC, and a master LDAP server for the PDC. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896750"></a>Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890212"></a>Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> With version 2.2, no. The native NT4 SAM replication protocols have not yet been fully implemented. The Samba Team is working on understanding and implementing the protocols, -but this work has not been finished for version 2.2. -</p><p> -With version 3.0, the work on both the replication protocols and a suitable storage -mechanism has progressed, and some form of NT4 BDC support is expected soon. +but this work has not been finished for Samba-3. </p><p> -Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes. The main reason for implementing a +Can I get the benefits of a BDC with Samba? Yes, but only to a Samba PDC. The main reason for implementing a BDC is availability. If the PDC is a Samba machine, a second Samba machine can be set up to service logon requests whenever the PDC is down. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896783"></a>How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890238"></a>How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Replication of the smbpasswd file is sensitive. It has to be done whenever changes to the SAM are made. Every user's password change is done in the smbpasswd file and has to be replicated to the BDC. So replicating the smbpasswd file very often is necessary. @@ -251,9 +252,9 @@ to type a password. As said a few times before, use of this method is broken and flawed. Machine trust accounts will go out of sync, resulting in a very broken domain. This method is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> recommended. Try using LDAP instead. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2896828"></a>Can I do this all with LDAP?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2890283"></a>Can I do this all with LDAP?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> The simple answer is YES. Samba's pdb_ldap code supports binding to a replica LDAP server, and will also follow referrals and rebind to the master if it ever needs to make a modification to the database. (Normally BDCs are read only, so this will not occur often). -</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 5. Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 7. Domain Membership</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="samba-pdc.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="domain-member.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 5. Domain Control </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 7. Domain Membership</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-doc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-doc.html new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..f5dfd49888 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-doc.html @@ -0,0 +1,72 @@ +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>SAMBA Project Documentation</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><meta name="description" content=" +This book is a collection of HOWTOs added to Samba documentation over the years. +Samba is always under development, and so is its' documentation. This release of the +documentation represents a major revision or layout as well as contents. +The most recent version of this document can be found at +http://www.samba.org/ +on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to +Jelmer Vernooij, +John H. Terpstra or +Gerald (Jerry) Carter. + +The Samba-Team would like to express sincere thanks to the many people who have with +or without their knowledge contributed to this update. The size and scope of this +project would not have been possible without significant community contribution. A not +insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obtained +from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. +Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTOs - they are a source of inspiration and +application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. +"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="next" href="pr01.html" title="Legal Notice"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">SAMBA Project Documentation</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr01.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="book" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="Samba-HOWTO-Collection"></a>SAMBA Project Documentation</h1></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><h4 class="editedby">Edited by</h4><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><h3 class="editor"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">Monday April 21, 2003</p></div><div><div class="abstract"><p class="title"><b>Abstract</b></p><p> +This book is a collection of HOWTOs added to Samba documentation over the years. +Samba is always under development, and so is its' documentation. This release of the +documentation represents a major revision or layout as well as contents. +The most recent version of this document can be found at +<a href="http://www.samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> +on the "Documentation" page. Please send updates to +<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org" target="_top">Jelmer Vernooij</a>, +<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org" target="_top">John H. Terpstra</a> or +<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org" target="_top">Gerald (Jerry) Carter</a>. +</p><p> +The Samba-Team would like to express sincere thanks to the many people who have with +or without their knowledge contributed to this update. The size and scope of this +project would not have been possible without significant community contribution. A not +insignificant number of ideas for inclusion (if not content itself) has been obtained +from a number of Unofficial HOWTOs - to each such author a big "Thank-you" is also offered. +Please keep publishing your Unofficial HOWTOs - they are a source of inspiration and +application knowledge that is most to be desired by many Samba users and administrators. +</p></div></div></div><div></div><hr></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="pr01.html">Legal Notice</a></dt><dt><a href="pr02.html">Attributions</a></dt><dt>I. <a href="introduction.html">General Installation</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>1. <a href="IntroSMB.html">Introduction to Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2817919">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2817978">Terminology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818169">Related Projects</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818237">SMB Methodology</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818345">Epilogue</a></dt><dt><a href="IntroSMB.html#id2818430">Miscellaneous</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>2. <a href="install.html">How to Install and Test SAMBA</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2883917">Obtaining and installing samba</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2883961">Configuring samba (smb.conf)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2883999">Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884191">SWAT</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="install.html#id2884236">Try listing the shares available on your + server</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884294">Try connecting with the unix client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884411">Try connecting from another SMB client</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884494">What If Things Don't Work?</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884528">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="install.html#id2884539">Large number of smbd processes</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884640">"open_oplock_ipc: Failed to get local UDP socket for address 100007f. Error was Cannot assign requested"</a></dt><dt><a href="install.html#id2884661">"The network name cannot be found"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>3. <a href="FastStart.html">Fast Start for the Impatient</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="FastStart.html#id2884787">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>II. <a href="type.html">Server Configuration Basics</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>4. <a href="ServerType.html">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2884977">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885071">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885157">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885276">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885414">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885551">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885808">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885909">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886191">Password checking</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886386">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886414">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886453">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886490">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886529">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="samba-pdc.html">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2886861">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887076">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887090">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887335">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887717">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888205">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888257">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888272">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888704">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888850">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888857">'$' cannot be included in machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888916">Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888975">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889059">The machine trust account not accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889131">Account disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889164">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889186">Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="samba-bdc.html">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889347">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889536">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889565">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889816">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889836">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889863">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889908">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890011">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890167">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890181">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890212">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890238">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890283">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="domain-member.html">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2890490">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891126">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891341">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891414">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892061">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892246">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892373">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892751">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892773">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892816">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892848">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892992">I can't join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="StandAloneServer.html">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893079">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893117">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893191">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893714">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="ClientConfig.html">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2893778">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>III. <a href="optional.html">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>10. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html">Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2893931">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894019">What is Browsing?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894333">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894349">NetBIOS over TCP/IP</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894584">TCP/IP - without NetBIOS</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894750">DNS and Active Directory</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2894896">How Browsing Functions</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB">Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895446">Setting up DOMAIN Browsing</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browse-force-master">Forcing Samba to be the master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895844">Making Samba the domain master</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896022">Note about broadcast addresses</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896045">Multiple interfaces</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896081">Use of the Remote Announce parameter</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896240">Use of the Remote Browse Sync parameter</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896317">WINS - The Windows Internetworking Name Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896504">Setting up a WINS server</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896761">WINS Replication</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896787">Static WINS Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896875">Helpful Hints</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896889">Windows Networking Protocols</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2896967">Name Resolution Order</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897133">Technical Overview of browsing</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897187">Browsing support in Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897308">Problem resolution</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897396">Browsing across subnets</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898078">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898092">How can one flush the Samba NetBIOS name cache without restarting Samba?</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898121">My client reports "This server is not configured to list shared resources"</a></dt><dt><a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2898166">I get an Unable to browse the network error</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>11. <a href="passdb.html">Account Information Databases</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898446">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898460">Backwards Compatibility Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898561">New Backends</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898749">Technical Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2898874">Important Notes About Security</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899165">Mapping User Identifiers between MS Windows and UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#idmapbackend">Mapping Common UIDs/GIDs on Distributed Machines</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#acctmgmttools">Account Management Tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899351">The smbpasswd Command</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899622">The pdbedit Command</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899860">Password Backends</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899902">Plain Text</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2899942">smbpasswd - Encrypted Password Database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2900055">tdbsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2900089">ldapsam</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2901940">MySQL</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#XMLpassdb">XML</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902790">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902796">Users can not logon</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902841">Users being added to wrong backend database</a></dt><dt><a href="passdb.html#id2902952">auth methods does not work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>12. <a href="groupmapping.html">Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903181">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903416">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903652">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903718">Configuration Scripts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903732">Sample smb.conf add group script</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903817">Script to configure Group Mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903900">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903915">Adding Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2903984">Adding MS Windows Groups to MS Windows Groups Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="groupmapping.html#id2904010">Adding Domain Users to the Power Users group</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>13. <a href="AccessControls.html">File, Directory and Share Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904266">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904395">File System Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904431">MS Windows NTFS Comparison with UNIX File Systems</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904735">Managing Directories</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2904829">File and Directory Access Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905040">Share Definition Access Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905070">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905491">File and Directory Permissions Based Controls</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2905871">Miscellaneous Controls</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906251">Access Controls on Shares</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906323">Share Permissions Management</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906623">MS Windows Access Control Lists and UNIX Interoperability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906631">Managing UNIX permissions Using NT Security Dialogs</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906675">Viewing File Security on a Samba Share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906755">Viewing file ownership</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2906887">Viewing File or Directory Permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907132">Modifying file or directory permissions</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907296">Interaction with the standard Samba create mask + parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907693">Interaction with the standard Samba file attribute mapping</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907788">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2907802">Users can not write to a public share</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2908232">I have set force user but Samba still makes root the owner of all the files I touch!</a></dt><dt><a href="AccessControls.html#id2908284">MS Word with Samba changes owner of file</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>14. <a href="locking.html">File and Record Locking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908532">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908589">Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2908732">Opportunistic Locking Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909449">Samba Opportunistic Locking Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909569">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2909983">MS Windows Opportunistic Locking and Caching Controls</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910208">Workstation Service Entries</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910237">Server Service Entries</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910317">Persistent Data Corruption</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910345">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910419">locking.tdb error messages</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910456">Problems saving files in MS Office on Windows XP</a></dt><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910479">Long delays deleting files over network with XP SP1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="locking.html#id2910511">Additional Reading</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>15. <a href="securing-samba.html">Securing Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910685">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910722">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910796">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910816">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910915">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910975">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911042">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911098">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911187">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911245">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911271">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911289">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911314">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>16. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Interdomain Trust Relationships</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911605">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911633">Trust Relationship Background</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911721">Native MS Windows NT4 Trusts Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911750">Creating an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911822">Completing an NT4 Domain Trust</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2911868">Inter-Domain Trust Facilities</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912046">Configuring Samba NT-style Domain Trusts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#samba-trusted-domain">Samba as the Trusted Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912232">Samba as the Trusting Domain</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912370">NT4-style Domain Trusts with Windows 2000</a></dt><dt><a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#id2912476">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>17. <a href="msdfs.html">Hosting a Microsoft Distributed File System tree on Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2912546">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="msdfs.html#id2912820">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>18. <a href="printing.html">Classical Printing Support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2912941">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913045">Technical Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913083">What happens if you send a Job from a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913154">Printing Related Configuration Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913251">Parameters Recommended for Use</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913718">A simple Configuration to Print</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2913883">Verification of "Settings in Use" with testparm</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914010">A little Experiment to warn you</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914370">Extended Sample Configuration to Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914701">Detailed Explanation of the Example's Settings</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2914714">The [global] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2915245">The [printers] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2915706">Any [my_printer_name] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916027">Print Commands</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916108">Default Print Commands for various UNIX Print Subsystems</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2916791">Setting up your own Print Commands</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917131">Innovations in Samba Printing since 2.2</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917292">Client Drivers on Samba Server for Point'n'Print</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917453">The [printer$] Section is removed from Samba 3</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917566">Creating the [print$] Share</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2917756">Parameters in the [print$] Section</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918066">Subdirectory Structure in [print$]</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918239">Installing Drivers into [print$]</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918333">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with a Client GUI</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2918531">Setting Drivers for existing Printers with +rpcclient</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920241">Client Driver Install Procedure</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920260">The first Client Driver Installation</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920462">IMPORTANT! Setting Device Modes on new Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920763">Further Client Driver Install Procedures</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2920857">Always make first Client Connection as root or "printer admin"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921029">Other Gotchas</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921063">Setting Default Print Options for the Client Drivers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921530">Supporting large Numbers of Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2921841">Adding new Printers with the Windows NT APW</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922136">Weird Error Message Cannot connect under a +different Name</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922236">Be careful when assembling Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922594">Samba and Printer Ports</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922687">Avoiding the most common Misconfigurations of the Client Driver</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922712">The Imprints Toolset</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922768">What is Imprints?</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922810">Creating Printer Driver Packages</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922828">The Imprints Server</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2922853">The Installation Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923008">Add Network Printers at Logon without User Interaction</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923342">The addprinter command</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923388">Migration of "Classical" printing to Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923561">Publishing Printer Information in Active Directory or LDAP</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923575">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923582">I give my root password but I don't get access</a></dt><dt><a href="printing.html#id2923615">My printjobs get spooled into the spooling directory, but then get lost</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html">CUPS Printing Support in Samba 3.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923750">Introduction</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923756">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923811">Overview</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923880">Basic Configuration of CUPS support</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2923972">Linking of smbd with libcups.so</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924213">Simple smb.conf Settings for CUPS</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924395">More complex smb.conf Settings for +CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924750">Advanced Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924770">Central spooling vs. "Peer-to-Peer" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924825">CUPS/Samba as a "spooling-only" Print Server; "raw" printing +with Vendor Drivers on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924894">Driver Installation Methods on Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924971">Explicitly enable "raw" printing for +application/octet-stream!</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925177">Three familiar Methods for driver upload plus a new one</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925317">Using CUPS/Samba in an advanced Way -- intelligent printing +with PostScript Driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#gdipost">GDI on Windows -- PostScript on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925497">Windows Drivers, GDI and EMF</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925650">UNIX Printfile Conversion and GUI Basics</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#post-and-ghost">PostScript and Ghostscript</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2925951">Ghostscript -- the Software RIP for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926092">PostScript Printer Description (PPD) Specification</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926179">CUPS can use all Windows-formatted Vendor PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926285">CUPS also uses PPDs for non-PostScript Printers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926306">The CUPS Filtering Architecture</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926501">MIME types and CUPS Filters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926707">MIME type Conversion Rules</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2926862">Filter Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927043">Prefilters</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927153">pstops</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927264">pstoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927459">imagetops and imagetoraster</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927523">rasterto [printers specific]</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2927675">CUPS Backends</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928022">cupsomatic/Foomatic -- how do they fit into the Picture?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928168">The Complete Picture</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928183">mime.convs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928246">"Raw" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928335">"application/octet-stream" printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928581">PostScript Printer Descriptions (PPDs) for non-PS Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928848">Difference between cupsomatic/foomatic-rip and +native CUPS printing</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929083">Examples for filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929420">Sources of CUPS drivers / PPDs</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929572">Printing with Interface Scripts</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929667">Network printing (purely Windows)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929677">From Windows Clients to an NT Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929741">Driver Execution on the Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929818">Driver Execution on the Server</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929936">Network Printing (Windows clients -- UNIX/Samba Print +Servers)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2929956">From Windows Clients to a CUPS/Samba Print Server</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930169">Samba receiving Jobfiles and passing them to CUPS</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930255">Network PostScript RIP: CUPS Filters on Server -- clients use +PostScript Driver with CUPS-PPDs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930344">PPDs for non-PS Printers on UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930400">PPDs for non-PS Printers on Windows</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930476">Windows Terminal Servers (WTS) as CUPS Clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930493">Printer Drivers running in "Kernel Mode" cause many +Problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930538">Workarounds impose Heavy Limitations</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930560">CUPS: a "Magical Stone"?</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930614">PostScript Drivers with no major problems -- even in Kernel +Mode</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930637">Setting up CUPS for driver Download</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930710">cupsaddsmb: the unknown Utility</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930811">Prepare your smb.conf for cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931030">CUPS Package of "PostScript Driver for WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931268">Recognize the different Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931460">Acquiring the Adobe Driver Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931493">ESP Print Pro Package of "PostScript Driver for +WinNT/2k/XP"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931562">Caveats to be considered</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2931837">Benefits of using "CUPS PostScript Driver for +Windows NT/2k/XP" instead of Adobe Driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932052">Run "cupsaddsmb" (quiet Mode)</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932180">Run "cupsaddsmb" with verbose Output</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932401">Understanding cupsaddsmb</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932551">How to recognize if cupsaddsmb completed successfully</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932633">cupsaddsmb with a Samba PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932714">cupsaddsmb Flowchart</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932789">Installing the PostScript Driver on a Client</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2932953">Avoiding critical PostScript Driver Settings on the +Client</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933086">Installing PostScript Driver Files manually (using +rpcclient)</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933288">A Check of the rpcclient man Page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933403">Understanding the rpcclient man page</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933506">Producing an Example by querying a Windows Box</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933674">What is required for adddriver and setdriver to succeed</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2933889">Manual Driver Installation in 15 Steps</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2934958">Troubleshooting revisited</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935118">The printing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935364">Trivial DataBase Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935456">Binary Format</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935520">Losing *.tdb Files</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935579">Using tdbbackup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935716">CUPS Print Drivers from Linuxprinting.org</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2935871">foomatic-rip and Foomatic explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2936640">foomatic-rip and Foomatic-PPD Download and Installation</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937141">Page Accounting with CUPS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937193">Setting up Quotas</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937258">Correct and incorrect Accounting</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937303">Adobe and CUPS PostScript Drivers for Windows Clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937398">The page_log File Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937516">Possible Shortcomings</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937592">Future Developments</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937648">Other Accounting Tools</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937662">Additional Material</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937912">Auto-Deletion or Preservation of CUPS Spool Files</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2937974">CUPS Configuration Settings explained</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938069">Pre-conditions</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938226">Manual Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938284">In Case of Trouble.....</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938356">Printing from CUPS to Windows attached +Printers</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938656">More CUPS filtering Chains</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938758">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938765">Win9x client can't install driver</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938787">"cupsaddsmb" keeps asking for root password in + neverending loop</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938835">"cupsaddsmb" gives "No PPD file for printer..." + message while PPD file is present</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938893">Client can't connect to Samba printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2938921">Can't reconnect to Samba under new account + from Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939149">Avoid being connected to the Samba server as the + "wrong" user</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939202">Upgrading to CUPS drivers from Adobe drivers on + NT/2K/XP clients gives problems</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939219">Can't use "cupsaddsmb" on Samba server which is + a PDC</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939249">Deleted Win2K printer driver is still shown</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939258">Win2K/XP "Local Security + Policies"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939297">WinXP clients: "Administrator can not install + printers for all local users"</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939331">"Print Change Notify" functions on + NT-clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939354">WinXP-SP1</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939398">Print options for all users can't be set on Win2K/XP</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939689">Most common blunders in driver + settings on Windows clients</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939734">cupsaddsmb does not work + with newly installed printer</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939796">Permissions on +/var/spool/samba/ get reset after each +reboot</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939905">Printer named "lp" +intermittently swallows jobs and spits out completely different +ones</a></dt><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2939953">Location of Adobe PostScript driver files necessary for "cupsaddsmb"</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2940008">An Overview of the CUPS Printing Processes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>20. <a href="VFS.html">Stackable VFS modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940177">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940195">Discussion</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940424">Included modules</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940432">audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940474">extd_audit</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940604">fake_perms</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940622">recycle</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940798">netatalk</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940843">VFS modules available elsewhere</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940865">DatabaseFS</a></dt><dt><a href="VFS.html#id2940920">vscan</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>21. <a href="winbind.html">Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941150">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941246">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941324">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941400">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941431">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941460">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941493">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941516">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941652">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941724">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941757">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941785">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941792">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941859">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941953">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943561">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943580">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943633">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>22. <a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Advanced Network Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943742">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943772">Remote Server Administration</a></dt><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943871">Remote Desktop Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2943888">Remote Management from NoMachines.Com</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944129">Network Logon Script Magic</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944368">Adding printers without user intervention</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html#id2944401">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>23. <a href="PolicyMgmt.html">System and Account Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944479">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944538">Creating and Managing System Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944652">Windows 9x/Me Policies</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944748">Windows NT4 Style Policy Files</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2944880">MS Windows 200x / XP Professional Policies</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945132">Managing Account/User Policies</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945238">Samba Editreg Toolset</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945277">Windows NT4/200x</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945301">Samba PDC</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945346">System Startup and Logon Processing Overview</a></dt><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945496">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="PolicyMgmt.html#id2945511">Policy Does Not Work</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>24. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html">Desktop Profile Management</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945611">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945646">Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2945686">Samba Configuration for Profile Handling</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2946178">Windows Client Profile Configuration Information</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947427">Sharing Profiles between W9x/Me and NT4/200x/XP workstations</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947512">Profile Migration from Windows NT4/200x Server to Samba</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947770">Mandatory profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947828">Creating/Managing Group Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947873">Default Profile for Windows Users</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2947893">MS Windows 9x/Me</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948045">MS Windows NT4 Workstation</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948600">MS Windows 200x/XP</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949100">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949130">Setting up roaming profiles for just a few user's or group's?</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949201">Can NOT use Roaming Profiles</a></dt><dt><a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2949414">Changing the default profile</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>25. <a href="pam.html">PAM based Distributed Authentication</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949695">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949942">Technical Discussion</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2949960">PAM Configuration Syntax</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2950624">Example System Configurations</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2950929">smb.conf PAM Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951007">Remote CIFS Authentication using winbindd.so</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951091">Password Synchronization using pam_smbpass.so</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951474">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951487">pam_winbind problem</a></dt><dt><a href="pam.html#id2951576">Winbind is not resolving users and groups</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>26. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951812">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951838">Background Information</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951903">Name Resolution in a pure UNIX/Linux world</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2951960">/etc/hosts</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952110">/etc/resolv.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952153">/etc/host.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952204">/etc/nsswitch.conf</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952319">Name resolution as used within MS Windows networking</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952629">The NetBIOS Name Cache</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952692">The LMHOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952854">HOSTS file</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952886">DNS Lookup</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952918">WINS Lookup</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953036">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953052">Pinging works only in one way</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953086">Very Slow Network Connections</a></dt><dt><a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2953137">Samba server name change problem</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>27. <a href="unicode.html">Unicode/Charsets</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953342">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953385">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953454">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953583">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953612">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953751">Common errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953758">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>28. <a href="Backup.html">Samba Backup Techniques</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2953871">Note</a></dt><dt><a href="Backup.html#id2953885">Features and Benefits</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>29. <a href="SambaHA.html">High Availability Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SambaHA.html#id2953955">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>IV. <a href="migration.html">Migration and Updating</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>30. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html">Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954094">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954229">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954244">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954370">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954767">Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954842">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954849">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955083">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955133">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955156">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955274">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955299">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>31. <a href="NT4Migration.html">Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955644">Planning and Getting Started</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2955669">Objectives</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956108">Steps In Migration Process</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956323">Migration Options</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956414">Planning for Success</a></dt><dt><a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956670">Samba-3 Implementation Choices</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>32. <a href="SWAT.html">SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957030">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957079">Enabling SWAT for use</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957316">Securing SWAT through SSL</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957428">The SWAT Home Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957493">Global Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957601">Share Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957665">Printers Settings</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957730">The SWAT Wizard</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957777">The Status Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957829">The View Page</a></dt><dt><a href="SWAT.html#id2957853">The Password Change Page</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>V. <a href="troubleshooting.html">Troubleshooting</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>33. <a href="diagnosis.html">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2957982">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2958022">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="problems.html">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959747">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959768">Debugging with Samba itself</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959894">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959915">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959968">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960285">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960326">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960484">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="bugreport.html">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960613">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960681">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960718">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960926">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2961060">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2961107">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>VI. <a href="Appendixes.html">Appendixes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt>36. <a href="compiling.html">How to compile Samba</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961265">Access Samba source code via CVS</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961282">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961320">CVS Access to samba.org</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961581">Accessing the samba sources via rsync and ftp</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961644">Verifying Samba's PGP signature</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961798">Building the Binaries</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2961978">Compiling samba with Active Directory support</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962144">Starting the smbd and nmbd</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962252">Starting from inetd.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="compiling.html#id2962499">Alternative: starting it as a daemon</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>37. <a href="Portability.html">Portability</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962662">HPUX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962750">SCO UNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962780">DNIX</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962953">RedHat Linux Rembrandt-II</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2962995">AIX</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963002">Sequential Read Ahead</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963029">Solaris</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Portability.html#id2963036">Locking improvements</a></dt><dt><a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9">Winbind on Solaris 9</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>38. <a href="Other-Clients.html">Samba and other CIFS clients</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963189">Macintosh clients?</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963267">OS2 Client</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963275">Configuring OS/2 Warp Connect or + OS/2 Warp 4 as a client for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963359">Configuring OS/2 Warp 3 (not Connect), + OS/2 1.2, 1.3 or 2.x for Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963411">Printer driver download for for OS/2 clients?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963512">Windows for Workgroups</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963519">Latest TCP/IP stack from Microsoft</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963610">Delete .pwl files after password change</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963639">Configuring WfW password handling</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963692">Case handling of passwords</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963730">Use TCP/IP as default protocol</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963747">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963794">Windows '95/'98</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963867">Speed improvement</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963891">Windows 2000 Service Pack 2</a></dt><dt><a href="Other-Clients.html#id2964079">Windows NT 3.1</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>39. <a href="speed.html">Samba Performance Tuning</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964209">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964253">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964343">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964393">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964453">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964483">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964567">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964630">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964659">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964684">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964716">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>40. <a href="DNSDHCP.html">DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="DNSDHCP.html#id2964821">Note</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>41. <a href="Further-Resources.html">Further Resources</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2964888">Websites</a></dt><dt><a href="Further-Resources.html#id2965278">Related updates from Microsoft</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt><a href="ix01.html">Index</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-figures"><p><b>List of Figures</b></p><dl><dt>5.1. <a href="samba-pdc.html#domain-example">An Example Domain</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#browsing1">Cross subnet browsing example</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="passdb.html#idmap-diag">IDMAP</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="groupmapping.html#idmap-group-diag">IDMAP groups</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="AccessControls.html#access1">Overview of unix permissions field</a></dt><dt>16.1. <a href="InterdomainTrusts.html#trusts1">Trusts overview</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small1">Windows Printing to a local Printer</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small2">Printing to a Postscript Printer</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small3">Ghostscript as a RIP for non-postscript printers</a></dt><dt>19.4. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small4">Prefiltering in CUPS to form Postscript</a></dt><dt>19.5. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small5">Adding Device-specific Print Options</a></dt><dt>19.6. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small6">Postscript to intermediate Raster format</a></dt><dt>19.7. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small7">CUPS-raster production using Ghostscript</a></dt><dt>19.8. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small8">Image format to CUPS-raster format conversion</a></dt><dt>19.9. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small9">Raster to Printer Specific formats</a></dt><dt>19.10. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small10">cupsomatic/foomatic processing versus Native CUPS</a></dt><dt>19.11. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#pdftosocket">PDF to socket chain</a></dt><dt>19.12. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#pdftoepsonusb">PDF to USB chain</a></dt><dt>19.13. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small11">Print Driver execution on the Client</a></dt><dt>19.14. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small12">Print Driver execution on the Server</a></dt><dt>19.15. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small13">Printing via CUPS/samba server</a></dt><dt>19.16. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#small14">cupsaddsmb flowchart</a></dt><dt>19.17. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups1">Filtering chain 1</a></dt><dt>19.18. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#cups2">Filtering chain with cupsomatic</a></dt><dt>19.19. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#a_small">CUPS Printing Overview</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-tables"><p><b>List of Tables</b></p><dl><dt>7.1. <a href="domain-member.html#id2891635">Assumptions</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897579">Browse subnet example 1</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897692">Browse subnet example 2</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897805">Browse subnet example 3</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2897922">Browse subnet example 4</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="passdb.html#id2901317">Attributes in the sambaSamAccount objectclass (LDAP)</a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="passdb.html#id2902128">Basic smb.conf options for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>11.3. <a href="passdb.html#id2902260">MySQL field names for MySQL passdb backend</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904754">Managing directories with unix and windows</a></dt><dt>13.2. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905157">User and Group Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.3. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905512">File and Directory Permission Based Controls</a></dt><dt>13.4. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2905893">Other Controls</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2928665">PPD's shipped with CUPS</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="VFS.html#id2940521">Extended Auditing Log Information</a></dt><dt>24.1. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948397">User Shell Folder registry keys default values</a></dt><dt>24.2. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948541">Defaults of profile settings registry keys</a></dt><dt>24.3. <a href="ProfileMgmt.html#id2948802">Defaults of default user profile paths registry keys</a></dt><dt>25.1. <a href="pam.html#id2951123">Options recognized by pam_smbpass</a></dt><dt>26.1. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952372">Unique NetBIOS names</a></dt><dt>26.2. <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html#id2952442">Group Names</a></dt><dt>30.1. <a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954868">TDB File Descriptions</a></dt><dt>31.1. <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956338">The 3 Major Site Types</a></dt><dt>31.2. <a href="NT4Migration.html#id2956485">Nature of the Conversion Choices</a></dt></dl></div><div class="list-of-examples"><p><b>List of Examples</b></p><dl><dt>2.1. <a href="install.html#id2884022">Simplest possible smb.conf file</a></dt><dt>5.1. <a href="samba-pdc.html#pdc-example">smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>5.2. <a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888328">smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>6.1. <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889747">Minimal smb.conf for being a PDC</a></dt><dt>6.2. <a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890026">Minimal setup for being a BDC</a></dt><dt>8.1. <a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893237">smb.conf for Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt>8.2. <a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893557">smb.conf for anonymous printing</a></dt><dt>10.1. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895160">Domain master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.2. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895251">Local master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.3. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895389">smb.conf for not being a master browser</a></dt><dt>10.4. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895495">Local master browser smb.conf</a></dt><dt>10.5. <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#id2895612">smb.conf for not being a master browser</a></dt><dt>11.1. <a href="passdb.html#idmapbackendexample"></a></dt><dt>11.2. <a href="passdb.html#id2900879">Configuration with LDAP</a></dt><dt>12.1. <a href="groupmapping.html#id2903754">smbgrpadd.sh</a></dt><dt>13.1. <a href="AccessControls.html#id2904965">Example File</a></dt><dt>14.1. <a href="locking.html#id2909772">Share with some files oplocked</a></dt><dt>14.2. <a href="locking.html#id2909930"></a></dt><dt>17.1. <a href="msdfs.html#id2912656">smb.conf with DFS configured</a></dt><dt>18.1. <a href="printing.html#id2913746">Simple configuration with BSD printing</a></dt><dt>18.2. <a href="printing.html#extbsdpr">Extended configuration with BSD printing</a></dt><dt>18.3. <a href="printing.html#id2917613">[print\$] example</a></dt><dt>19.1. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924241">Simplest printing-related smb.conf</a></dt><dt>19.2. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2924426">Overriding global CUPS settings for one printer</a></dt><dt>19.3. <a href="CUPS-printing.html#id2930838">smb.conf for cupsaddsmb usage</a></dt><dt>20.1. <a href="VFS.html#id2940233">smb.conf with VFS modules</a></dt><dt>20.2. <a href="VFS.html#id2940333">smb.conf with multiple VFS modules</a></dt><dt>21.1. <a href="winbind.html#id2942349">smb.conf for winbind set-up</a></dt><dt>33.1. <a href="diagnosis.html#id2958071">smb.conf with [tmp] share</a></dt><dt>38.1. <a href="Other-Clients.html#id2963963">Minimal profile share</a></dt></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"> </td><td width="20%" align="center"> </td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="pr01.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top"> </td><td width="20%" align="center"> </td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Legal Notice</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html index 930315b3f5..aab2d4207c 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba-pdc.html @@ -1,8 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 5. Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"><link rel="next" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 5. Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-pdc"></a>Chapter 5. Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2891986">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892290">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892306">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892517">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892837">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893136">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893157">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893173">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893499">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893607">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893614">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893653">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." -or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893703">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893773">The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893836">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893863">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p><b><span class="emphasis"><em>The Essence of Learning:</em></span> </b> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 5. Domain Control</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="type.html" title="Part II. Server Configuration Basics"><link rel="previous" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"><link rel="next" href="samba-bdc.html" title="Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 5. Domain Control</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="samba-pdc"></a>Chapter 5. Domain Control</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">David</span> <span class="surname">Bannon</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:dbannon@samba.org">dbannon@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2886861">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887076">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887090">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887335">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887717">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888205">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888257">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888272">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888704">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888850">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888857">'$' cannot be included in machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888916">Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888975">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889059">The machine trust account not accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889131">Account disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889164">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889186">Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><p><b><span class="emphasis"><em>The Essence of Learning:</em></span> </b> There are many who approach MS Windows networking with incredible misconceptions. That's OK, because it gives the rest of us plenty of opportunity to be of assistance. Those who really want help would be well advised to become familiar with information @@ -10,18 +6,18 @@ that is already available. </p><p> The reader is advised NOT to tackle this section without having first understood and mastered some basics. MS Windows networking is not particularly forgiving of -misconfiguration. Users of MS Windows networking are likely to complain bitterly -of persistent niggles that may be caused by broken network or system configuration. +misconfiguration. Users of MS Windows networking are likely to complain +of persistent niggles that may be caused by a broken network configuration. To a great many people however, MS Windows networking starts with a domain controller that in some magical way is expected to solve all ills. -</p><p> +</p><div class="figure"><a name="domain-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Figure 5.1. An Example Domain</b></p><div class="mediaobject"><img src="projdoc/imagefiles/domain.png" width="270" alt="An Example Domain"></div></div><p> From the Samba mailing list one can readily identify many common networking issues. If you are not clear on the following subjects, then it will do much good to read the sections of this HOWTO that deal with it. These are the most common causes of MS Windows networking problems: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Basic TCP/IP configuration</td></tr><tr><td>NetBIOS name resolution</td></tr><tr><td>Authentication configuration</td></tr><tr><td>User and Group configuration</td></tr><tr><td>Basic File and Directory Permission Control in Unix/Linux</td></tr><tr><td>Understanding of how MS Windows clients interoperate in a network - environment</td></tr></table><p> -Do not be put off; on the surface of it MS Windows networking seems so simple that any fool +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Basic TCP/IP configuration</p></li><li><p>NetBIOS name resolution</p></li><li><p>Authentication configuration</p></li><li><p>User and Group configuration</p></li><li><p>Basic File and Directory Permission Control in UNIX/Linux</p></li><li><p>Understanding of how MS Windows clients interoperate in a network + environment</p></li></ul></div><p> +Do not be put off; on the surface of it MS Windows networking seems so simple that anyone can do it. In fact, it is not a good idea to set up an MS Windows network with inadequate training and preparation. But let's get our first indelible principle out of the way: <span class="emphasis"><em>It is perfectly OK to make mistakes!</em></span> In the right place and at @@ -32,7 +28,7 @@ burden on an organisation. Where is the right place to make mistakes? Only out of harm's way! If you are going to make mistakes, then please do this on a test network, away from users and in such a way as to not inflict pain on others. Do your learning on a test network. -</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2891986"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2886861"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>What is the key benefit of Microsoft Domain security?</em></span> </p><p> In a word, <span class="emphasis"><em>Single Sign On</em></span>, or SSO for short. To many, this is the holy @@ -43,13 +39,18 @@ and they will be able to log onto the network and access resources (shares, file as if they are sitting at their home (personal) workstation. This is a feature of the Domain security protocols. </p><p> -The benefits of Domain security are fully available to those sites that deploy a Samba PDC. +The benefits of Domain security are available to those sites that deploy a Samba PDC. +A Domain provides a unique network security identifier (SID). Domain user and group security +identifiers are comprised of the network SID plus a relative identifier (RID) that is unique to +the account. User and Group SIDs (the network SID plus the RID) can be used to create Access Control +Lists (ACLs) attached to network resources to provide organizational access control. UNIX systems +know only of local security identifiers. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Network clients of an MS Windows Domain security environment must be Domain members to be able to gain access to the advanced features provided. Domain membership involves more than just setting the workgroup name to the Domain name. It requires the creation of a Domain trust account for the workstation (called a machine account). Please refer to the chapter on -<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> for more information. +<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">setting up samba as a domain member</a> for more information. </p></div><p> The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -57,8 +58,7 @@ The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: </p></li><li><p> Adding users via the User Manager for Domains. This can be done on any MS Windows client using the Nexus toolkit that is available from Microsoft's web site. - At some later date Samba-3 may get support for the use of the Microsoft Management - Console for user management. + Samba-3 supports the use of the Microsoft Management Console for user management. </p></li><li><p> Introduces replaceable and multiple user account (authentication) back ends. In the case where the back end is placed in an LDAP database, @@ -72,14 +72,18 @@ The following functionalities are new to the Samba-3 release: The following functionalities are NOT provided by Samba-3: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> SAM replication with Windows NT4 Domain Controllers - (i.e. a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa) + (i.e. a Samba PDC and a Windows NT BDC or vice versa). This means samba + cannot operate as a BDC when the PDC is Microsoft-based or + replicate account data to Windows-BDC's. </p></li><li><p> Acting as a Windows 2000 Domain Controller (i.e. Kerberos and Active Directory) - In point of fact, Samba-3 DOES have some Active Directory Domain Control ability that is at this time purely experimental <span class="emphasis"><em>AND</em></span> that is certain to change as it becomes a fully supported feature some time - during the Samba-3 (or later) life cycle. + during the Samba-3 (or later) life cycle. However, Active Directory is + more then just SMB - it's also LDAP, Kerberos, DHCP and other protocols + (with proprietary extensions, of course). </p></li></ul></div><p> Windows 9x / Me / XP Home clients are not true members of a domain for reasons outlined in this chapter. The protocol for support of Windows 9x / Me style network (domain) logons @@ -88,67 +92,33 @@ for some time. These clients use the old LanMan Network Logon facilities that ar in Samba since approximately the Samba-1.9.15 series. </p><p> Samba-3 has an implementation of group mapping between Windows NT groups -and Unix groups (this is really quite complicated to explain in a short space). This is -discussed more fully in the <a href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and Unix Groups">Group Mapping</a> chapter. +and UNIX groups (this is really quite complicated to explain in a short space). This is +discussed more fully in <a href="groupmapping.html" title="Chapter 12. Mapping MS Windows and UNIX Groups">the chapter on group mapping</a>. </p><p> Samba-3, like an MS Windows NT4 PDC or a Windows 200x Active Directory, needs to store -user and machine trust account information in a suitable backend data store. With Samba-3 -there can be multiple back-ends for this including: -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd</em></span> - the plain ASCII file stored used by - earlier versions of Samba. This file configuration option requires - a Unix/Linux system account for EVERY entry (ie: both for user and for - machine accounts). This file will be located in the <span class="emphasis"><em>private</em></span> - directory (default is /usr/local/samba/lib/private or on linux /etc/samba). - </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>tdbsam</em></span> - a binary database backend that will be - stored in the <span class="emphasis"><em>private</em></span> directory in a file called - <span class="emphasis"><em>passdb.tdb</em></span>. The key benefit of this binary format - file is that it can store binary objects that can not be accommodated - in the traditional plain text smbpasswd file. These permit the extended - account controls that MS Windows NT4 and later also have. - </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>ldapsam</em></span> - An LDAP based back-end. Permits the - LDAP server to be specified. eg: ldap://localhost or ldap://frodo.murphy.com. - Like the tdbsam, ldapsam permits the storing of extended account attributes - for control of things like: Permitted access times, password activation and - expiry, permitted points of access (workstation names), per user profile - location, and much more. - </p></li><li><p> - <span class="emphasis"><em>ldapsam_compat</em></span> - An LDAP back-end that maintains backwards - compatibility with the behaviour of samba-2.2.x. You should use this in the process - of migrating from samba-2.2.x to samba-3 if you do not want to rebuild your LDAP - database. - </p></li></ul></div><p> -Read the chapter about <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database</a> for details -regarding the choices available and how to configure them. -</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> -The new tdbsam and ldapsam account backends store substantially more information than -smbpasswd is capable of. The new backend database includes capacity to specify -per user settings for many parameters, over-riding global settings given in the -<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. eg: logon drive, logon home, logon path, etc. -Thus, with samba-3 it is possible to have a default system configuration for profiles, -and on a per user basis to over-ride this for those users who should not be subject -to the default configuration. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892290"></a>Basics of Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +user and machine trust account information in a suitable backend data store. +Refer <a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts" title="MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts">to the section on machine trust accounts</a>. With Samba-3 there can be multiple +back-ends for this. A complete discussion of account database backends can be found in +<a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter on Account Information Databases</a>. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887076"></a>Basics of Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Over the years, public perceptions of what Domain Control really is has taken on an almost mystical nature. Before we branch into a brief overview of Domain Control, there are three basic types of domain controllers: -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892306"></a>Domain Controller Types</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887090"></a>Domain Controller Types</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Primary Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>Backup Domain Controller</p></li><li><p>ADS Domain Controller</p></li></ul></div><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>Primary Domain Controller</em></span> or PDC plays an important role in the MS -Windows NT4 and Windows 200x Domain Control architecture, but not in the manner that so many -expect. There is folk lore that dictates that because of it's role in the MS Windows -network, the PDC should be the most powerful and most capable machine in the network. +Windows NT4. In Windows 200x Domain Control architecture this role is held by domain controllers. +There is folk lore that dictates that because of it's role in the MS Windows +network, the domain controllers should be the most powerful and most capable machine in the network. As strange as it may seem to say this here, good over all network performance dictates that -the entire infrastructure needs to be balanced. It is advisable to invest more in the Backup -Domain Controllers and Stand-Alone (or Domain Member) servers than in the PDC. +the entire infrastructure needs to be balanced. It is advisable to invest more in Stand-Alone +(or Domain Member) servers than in the domain controllers. </p><p> -In the case of MS Windows NT4 style domains, it is the PDC seeds the Domain Control database, -a part of the Windows registry called the SAM (Security Account Manager). It plays a key +In the case of MS Windows NT4 style domains, it is the PDC that initiates a new Domain Control database. +This forms a part of the Windows registry called the SAM (Security Account Manager). It plays a key part in NT4 type domain user authentication and in synchronisation of the domain authentication database with Backup Domain Controllers. </p><p> -With MS Windows 200x Server based Active Directory domains, one domain controller seeds a potential +With MS Windows 200x Server based Active Directory domains, one domain controller initiates a potential hierarchy of domain controllers, each with their own area of delegated control. The master domain controller has the ability to override any down-stream controller, but a down-line controller has control only over it's down-line. With Samba-3 this functionality can be implemented using an @@ -156,9 +126,7 @@ LDAP based user and machine account back end. </p><p> New to Samba-3 is the ability to use a back-end database that holds the same type of data as the NT4 style SAM (Security Account Manager) database (one of the registry files). -The Samba-3 SAM can be specified via the smb.conf file parameter -<i class="parameter"><tt>passwd backend</tt></i> and valid options include -<span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam, nisplussam, xmlsam, mysqlsam, guest</em></span>. +<sup>[<a name="id2887167" href="#ftn.id2887167">1</a>]</sup> </p><p> The <span class="emphasis"><em>Backup Domain Controller</em></span> or BDC plays a key role in servicing network authentication requests. The BDC is biased to answer logon requests in preference to the PDC. @@ -182,11 +150,14 @@ excluding the SAM replication components. However, please be aware that Samba-3 MS Windows 200x domain control protocols also. </p><p> At this time any appearance that Samba-3 is capable of acting as an -<span class="emphasis"><em>ADS Domain Controller</em></span> is limited and experimental in nature. +<span class="emphasis"><em>Domain Controller</em></span> in native ADS mode is limited and experimental in nature. This functionality should not be used until the Samba-Team offers formal support for it. At such a time, the documentation will be revised to duly reflect all configuration and -management requirements. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2892517"></a>Preparing for Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +management requirements. Samba can act as a NT4-style DC in a Windows 2000/XP +environment. However, there are certain compromises: + +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>No machine policy files</p></li><li><p>No Group Policy Objects</p></li><li><p>No synchronously executed AD logon scripts</p></li><li><p>Can't use ANY Active Directory management tools to manage users and machines</p></li><li><p>Registry changes tattoo the main registry, while with AD they do NOT. ie: Leave permanent changes in effect</p></li><li><p>Without AD you can not peprform the function of exporting specific applications to specific users or groups</p></li></ul></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2887335"></a>Preparing for Domain Control</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are two ways that MS Windows machines may interact with each other, with other servers, and with Domain Controllers: Either as <span class="emphasis"><em>Stand-Alone</em></span> systems, more commonly called <span class="emphasis"><em>Workgroup</em></span> members, or as full participants in a security system, @@ -208,23 +179,22 @@ Domain it triggers a machine password change. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> When running a Domain all MS Windows NT / 200x / XP Professional clients should be configured as full Domain Members - IF A SECURE NETWORK IS WANTED. If the machine is NOT made a member of the -Domain, then it will operate like a workgroup (stand-alone) machine. Please refer the -<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">Domain Membership</a> chapter for information regarding - HOW to make your MS Windows clients Domain members. +Domain, then it will operate like a workgroup (stand-alone) machine. Please refer to +<a href="domain-member.html" title="Chapter 7. Domain Membership">the chapter on domain membership</a> for information regarding HOW to make your MS Windows clients Domain members. </p></div><p> The following are necessary for configuring Samba-3 as an MS Windows NT4 style PDC for MS Windows NT4 / 200x / XP clients. -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</td></tr><tr><td>Correct designation of the Server Role (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>)</td></tr><tr><td>Consistent configuration of Name Resolution (See chapter on <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Browsing</a> and on - <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">MS Windows network Integration</a>)</td></tr><tr><td>Domain logons for Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional clients</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of Roaming Profiles or explicit configuration to force local profile usage</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of Network/System Policies</td></tr><tr><td>Adding and managing domain user accounts</td></tr><tr><td>Configuring MS Windows client machines to become domain members</td></tr></table><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</p></li><li><p>Correct designation of the Server Role (<a class="indexterm" name="id2887441"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user)</p></li><li><p>Consistent configuration of Name Resolution (See chapter on <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">Network Browsing</a> and on + <a href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba">Integrating Unix into Windows networks</a>)</p></li><li><p>Domain logons for Windows NT4 / 200x / XP Professional clients</p></li><li><p>Configuration of Roaming Profiles or explicit configuration to force local profile usage</p></li><li><p>Configuration of Network/System Policies</p></li><li><p>Adding and managing domain user accounts</p></li><li><p>Configuring MS Windows client machines to become domain members</p></li></ul></div><p> The following provisions are required to serve MS Windows 9x / Me Clients: -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</td></tr><tr><td>Correct designation of the Server Role (<i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>)</td></tr><tr><td>Network Logon Configuration (Since Windows 9x / XP Home are not technically domain - members, they do not really participate in the security aspects of Domain logons as such)</td></tr><tr><td>Roaming Profile Configuration</td></tr><tr><td>Configuration of System Policy handling</td></tr><tr><td>Installation of the Network driver "Client for MS Windows Networks" and configuration - to log onto the domain</td></tr><tr><td>Placing Windows 9x / Me clients in user level security - if it is desired to allow - all client share access to be controlled according to domain user / group identities.</td></tr><tr><td>Adding and managing domain user accounts</td></tr></table><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Configuration of basic TCP/IP and MS Windows Networking</p></li><li><p>Correct designation of the Server Role (<a class="indexterm" name="id2887534"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user)</p></li><li><p>Network Logon Configuration (Since Windows 9x / XP Home are not technically domain + members, they do not really participate in the security aspects of Domain logons as such)</p></li><li><p>Roaming Profile Configuration</p></li><li><p>Configuration of System Policy handling</p></li><li><p>Installation of the Network driver "Client for MS Windows Networks" and configuration + to log onto the domain</p></li><li><p>Placing Windows 9x / Me clients in user level security - if it is desired to allow + all client share access to be controlled according to domain user / group identities.</p></li><li><p>Adding and managing domain user accounts</p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> Roaming Profiles and System/Network policies are advanced network administration topics that are covered in the <a href="ProfileMgmt.html" title="Chapter 24. Desktop Profile Management">Profile Management</a> and -<a href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">Policy Management</a> chapters of this document. However, these are not necessarily specific -to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking concepts. +<a href="PolicyMgmt.html" title="Chapter 23. System and Account Policies">Policy Management</a> chapters of this document. However, these are not +necessarily specific to a Samba PDC as much as they are related to Windows NT networking concepts. </p></div><p> A Domain Controller is an SMB/CIFS server that: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> @@ -239,120 +209,86 @@ A Domain Controller is an SMB/CIFS server that: Provides a share called NETLOGON </p></li></ul></div><p> For Samba to provide these is rather easy to configure. Each Samba Domain Controller must provide -the NETLOGON service which Samba calls the <span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span> functionality +the NETLOGON service which Samba calls the <a class="indexterm" name="id2887666"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i> functionality (after the name of the parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file). Additionally, one (1) server in a Samba-3 -Domain must advertise itself as the domain master browser. This causes the Primary Domain Controller +Domain must advertise itself as the domain master browser<sup>[<a name="id2887690" href="#ftn.id2887690">2</a>]</sup>. This causes the Primary Domain Controller to claim domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies it as a domain master browser for its given domain/workgroup. Local master browsers in the same domain/workgroup on broadcast-isolated subnets then ask for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area network. Browser clients will then contact their local master browser, and will receive the domain-wide browse list, instead of just the list for their broadcast-isolated subnet. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2892837"></a>Domain Control - Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2887717"></a>Domain Control - Example Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The first step in creating a working Samba PDC is to understand the parameters necessary -in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Here we attempt to explain the parameters that are covered in -the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. -</p><p> -Here is an example <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for acting as a PDC: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - ; Basic server settings - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NETBIOSNAME" target="_top">netbios name</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>POGO</tt></i> - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WORKGROUP" target="_top">workgroup</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>NARNIA</tt></i> - - ; User and Machine Account Backends - ; Choices are: tdbsam, smbpasswd, ldapsam, mysqlsam, xmlsam, guest - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PASSDBBACKEND" target="_top">passdb backend</a> = ldapsam, guest - - ; we should act as the domain and local master browser - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OSLEVEL" target="_top">os level</a> = 64 - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PERFERREDMASTER" target="_top">preferred master</a> = yes - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINMASTER" target="_top">domain master</a> = yes - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOCALMASTER" target="_top">local master</a> = yes - - ; security settings (must user security = user) - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#SECURITYEQUALSUSER" target="_top">security</a> = user - - ; encrypted passwords are a requirement for a PDC (default = Yes) - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS" target="_top">encrypt passwords</a> = yes - - ; support domain logons - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DOMAINLOGONS" target="_top">domain logons</a> = yes - - ; where to store user profiles? - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONPATH" target="_top">logon path</a> = \\%N\profiles\%u - - ; where is a user's home directory and where should it be mounted at? - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONDRIVE" target="_top">logon drive</a> = H: - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONHOME" target="_top">logon home</a> = \\homeserver\%u\winprofile - - ; specify a generic logon script for all users - ; this is a relative **DOS** path to the [netlogon] share - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LOGONSCRIPT" target="_top">logon script</a> = logon.cmd - - ; necessary share for domain controller - [netlogon] - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH" target="_top">path</a> = /usr/local/samba/lib/netlogon - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY" target="_top">read only</a> = yes - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#WRITELIST" target="_top">write list</a> = <i class="replaceable"><tt>ntadmin</tt></i> - - ; share for storing user profiles - [profiles] - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#PATH" target="_top">path</a> = /export/smb/ntprofile - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#READONLY" target="_top">read only</a> = no - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#CREATEMASK" target="_top">create mask</a> = 0600 - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#DIRECTORYMASK" target="_top">directory mask</a> = 0700 -</pre><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. An example <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for acting as a PDC can be found in the example +<a href="samba-pdc.html#pdc-example" title="Example 5.1. smb.conf for being a PDC">for being a PDC</a>. +</p><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="pdc-example"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5.1. smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = BELERIAND</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend = ldapsam, guest</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>os level = 33</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>local master = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path = \\%N\profiles\%u</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive = H:</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home = \\homeserver\%u\winprofile</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script = logon.cmd</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>write list = ntadmin</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[profiles]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/profiles</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>read only = no</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask = 0600</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask = 0700</tt></i></td></tr></table></div><p> +</p><p> +The basic options shown above are explained as follows: +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">passdb backend</span></dt><dd><p> + This contains all the user and group account information. Acceptable values for a PDC + are: <span class="emphasis"><em>smbpasswd, tdbsam, ldapsam</em></span>. The 'guest' entry provides needed + default accounts.</p><p> + Where is is intended to use backup domain controllers (BDCs) the only logical choice is + to use LDAP so that the passdb backend can be distributed. The tdbsam and smbpasswd files + can not effectively be distributed and therefore should not be used. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Domain Control Parameters</span></dt><dd><p> + The parameters <span class="emphasis"><em>os level, preferred master, domain master, security, + encrypt passwords, domain logons</em></span> play a central role in assuring domain + control and network logon support.</p><p> + The <span class="emphasis"><em>os level</em></span> must be set at or above a value of 32. A domain controller + must be the domain master browser, must be set in <span class="emphasis"><em>user</em></span> mode security, + must support Microsoft compatible encrypted passwords, and must provide the network logon + service (domain logons). Encrypted passwords must be enabled, for more details on how + to do this, refer to <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter on account information databases</a>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Environment Parameters</span></dt><dd><p> + The parameters <span class="emphasis"><em>logon path, logon home, logon drive, logon script</em></span> are + environment support settings that help to facilitate client logon operations and that help + to provide automated control facilities to ease network management overheads. Please refer + to the man page information for these parameters. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">NETLOGON Share</span></dt><dd><p> + The NETLOGON share plays a central role in domain logon and domain membership support. + This share is provided on all Microsoft domain controllers. It is used to provide logon + scripts, to store Group Policy files (NTConfig.POL), as well as to locate other common + tools that may be needed for logon processing. This is an essential share on a domain controller. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">PROFILE Share</span></dt><dd><p> + This share is used to store user desktop profiles. Eash user must have a directory at the root + of this share. This directory must be write enabled for the user and must be globally read enabled. + Samba-3 has a VFS module called 'fake_permissions' that may be installed on this share. This will + allow a Samba administrator to make the directory read only to everyone. Of course this is useful + only after the profile has been properly created. + </p></dd></dl></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> The above parameters make for a full set of parameters that may define the server's mode -of operation. The following parameters are the essentials alone: - -</p><pre class="programlisting"> - workgroup = NARNIA - domain logons = Yes - domain master = Yes - security = User -</pre><p> - -The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for a -more complete environment. -</p></div><p> -There are a couple of points to emphasize in the above configuration. -</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> - Encrypted passwords must be enabled. For more details on how - to do this, refer to <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">Account Information Database chapter</a>. - </p></li><li><p> - The server must support domain logons and have a - <i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i> share - </p></li><li><p> - The server must be the domain master browser in order for Windows - client to locate the server as a DC. Please refer to the various - Network Browsing documentation included with this distribution for - details. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893136"></a>Samba ADS Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Samba-3 is not and can not act as an Active Directory Server. It can not truly function as +of operation. The following <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> parameters are the essentials alone: +</p><p> +</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name = BELERIAND</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup = MIDEARTH</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>security = User</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> +</p><p> +The additional parameters shown in the longer listing above just makes for +more complete explanation. +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888205"></a>Samba ADS Domain Control</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Samba-3 is not, and can not act as, an Active Directory Server. It can not truly function as an Active Directory Primary Domain Controller. The protocols for some of the functionality -the Active Directory Domain Controllers is have been partially implemented on an experimental -only basis. Please do NOT expect Samba-3 to support these protocols - nor should you depend -on any such functionality either now or in the future. The Samba-Team may well remove such -experimental features or may change their behaviour. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893157"></a>Domain and Network Logon Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The subject of Network or Domain Logons is discussed here because it rightly forms +the Active Directory Domain Controllers has been partially implemented on an experimental +only basis. Please do NOT expect Samba-3 to support these protocols. Do not depend +on any such functionality either now or in the future. The Samba-Team may remove these +experimental features or may change their behaviour. This is mentioned for the benefit of those +who have discovered secret capabilities in samba-3 and who have asked when this functionality will be +completed. The answer is: Maybe or maybe never! +</p><p> +To be sure: Samba-3 is designed to provide most of the functionality that Microsoft Windows NT4 style +domain controllers have. Samba-3 does NOT have all the capabilities of Windows NT4, but it does have +a number of features that Windows NT4 domain contollers do not have. In short, Samba-3 is not NT4 and it +is not Windows Server 200x and it is not an Active Directory server. We hope this is plain and simple +enough for all to understand. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888257"></a>Domain and Network Logon Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The subject of Network or Domain Logons is discussed here because it forms an integral part of the essential functionality that is provided by a Domain Controller. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893173"></a>Domain Network Logon Service</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888272"></a>Domain Network Logon Service</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> All Domain Controllers must run the netlogon service (<span class="emphasis"><em>domain logons</em></span> -in Samba). One Domain Controller must be configured with <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = Yes</tt></i> -(the Primary Domain Controller); on ALL Backup Domain Controllers <i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = No</tt></i> +in Samba). One Domain Controller must be configured with <a class="indexterm" name="id2888289"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = Yes +(the Primary Domain Controller); on ALL Backup Domain Controllers <a class="indexterm" name="id2888305"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i> = No must be set. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893206"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><pre class="programlisting"> - [global] - domain logons = Yes - domain master = (Yes on PDC, No on BDCs) - - [netlogon] - comment = Network Logon Service - path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon - guest ok = Yes - browseable = No -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893226"></a>The Special Case of MS Windows XP Home Edition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888321"></a>Example Configuration</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="example"><a name="id2888328"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 5.2. smb.conf for being a PDC</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master = (Yes on PDC, No on BDCs)</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[netlogon]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>comment = Network Logon Service</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>path = /var/lib/samba/netlogon</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok = Yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable = No</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888412"></a>The Special Case of MS Windows XP Home Edition</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> MS Windows XP Home Edition does not have the ability to join any type of Domain security facility. Unlike, MS Windows 9x / Me, MS Windows XP Home Edition also completely lacks the ability to log onto a network. @@ -364,8 +300,10 @@ MS Windows XP Professional. </p><p> Now that this has been said, please do NOT ask the mailing list, or email any of the Samba-Team members with your questions asking how to make this work. It can't be done. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2893261"></a>The Special Case of Windows 9x / Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same thing in terms of network +If it can be done, then to do so would violate your software license agreement with +Microsoft, and we recommend that you do not do that. +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2888450"></a>The Special Case of Windows 9x / Me</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +A domain and a workgroup are exactly the same in terms of network browsing. The difference is that a distributable authentication database is associated with a domain, for secure login access to a network. Also, different access rights can be granted to users if they @@ -386,7 +324,7 @@ which are the focus of this section. When an SMB client in a domain wishes to logon, it broadcasts requests for a logon server. The first one to reply gets the job, and validates its password using whatever mechanism the Samba administrator has installed. -It is possible (but very stupid) to create a domain where the user +It is possible (but ill advised ) to create a domain where the user database is not shared between servers, i.e. they are effectively workgroup servers advertising themselves as participating in a domain. This demonstrates how authentication is quite different from but closely @@ -437,14 +375,17 @@ The main difference between a PDC and a Windows 9x logon server configuration is </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> Password encryption is not required for a Windows 9x logon server. But note that beginning with MS Windows 98 the default setting is that plain-text - password support has been disabled. It can be re-enabled with the registry + password support is disabled. It can be re-enabled with the registry changes that are documented in the chapter on Policies. </p></li><li><p> Windows 9x/ME clients do not require and do not use machine trust accounts. </p></li></ul></div><p> A Samba PDC will act as a Windows 9x logon server; after all, it does provide the network logon services that MS Windows 9x / Me expect to find. -</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893499"></a>Security Mode and Master Browsers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +Use of plain-text passwords is strongly discouraged. Where used they are easily detected +using a sniffer tool to examine network traffic. +</p></div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888704"></a>Security Mode and Master Browsers</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a few comments to make in order to tie up some loose ends. There has been much debate over the issue of whether or not it is ok to configure Samba as a Domain Controller in security @@ -461,24 +402,25 @@ are two distinctly different functions), it is not a good idea to do so. You should remember that the DC must register the DOMAIN<#1b> NetBIOS name. This is the name used by Windows clients to locate the DC. Windows clients do not distinguish between the DC and the DMB. +A DMB is a Domain Master Browser - see <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html#DMB" title="Setting up WORKGROUP Browsing">Domain Master Browser</a>. For this reason, it is very wise to configure the Samba DC as the DMB. </p><p> Now back to the issue of configuring a Samba DC to use a mode other -than <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>. If a Samba host is configured to use +than <a class="indexterm" name="id2888773"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. If a Samba host is configured to use another SMB server or DC in order to validate user connection requests, then it is a fact that some other machine on the network -(the <i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>) knows more about the user than the Samba host. +(the <a class="indexterm" name="id2888790"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i>) knows more about the user than the Samba host. 99% of the time, this other host is a domain controller. Now -in order to operate in domain mode security, the <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> parameter +in order to operate in domain mode security, the <a class="indexterm" name="id2888808"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i> parameter must be set to the name of the Windows NT domain (which already has a domain controller). If the domain does NOT already have a Domain Controller then you do not yet have a Domain! </p><p> Configuring a Samba box as a DC for a domain that already by definition has a PDC is asking for trouble. Therefore, you should always configure the Samba DC -to be the DMB for its domain and set <i class="parameter"><tt>security = user</tt></i>. +to be the DMB for its domain and set <a class="indexterm" name="id2888832"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = user. This is the only officially supported mode of operation. -</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2893607"></a>Common Problems and Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893614"></a>I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2888850"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888857"></a>'$' cannot be included in machine name</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> A 'machine account', (typically) stored in <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt>, takes the form of the machine name with a '$' appended. FreeBSD (and other BSD systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name. @@ -486,24 +428,26 @@ systems?) won't create a user with a '$' in their name. The problem is only in the program used to make the entry. Once made, it works perfectly. Create a user without the '$'. Then use <b class="command">vipw</b> to edit the entry, adding the '$'. Or create the whole entry with vipw if you like; make sure you use a unique User ID! -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893653"></a>I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." +</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> +The UNIX tool <b class="command">vipw</b> is a common tool for directly editting the <tt class="filename">/etc/passwd</tt> file. +</p></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888916"></a>Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</span>”</p><p> This happens if you try to create a machine trust account from the machine itself and already have a connection (e.g. mapped drive) to a share (or IPC$) on the Samba PDC. The following command will remove all network drive connections: </p><pre class="screen"> - <tt class="prompt">C:\WINNT\></tt> <b class="userinput"><tt>net use * /d</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">C:\> </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net use * /d</tt></b> </pre><p> Further, if the machine is already a 'member of a workgroup' that is the same name as the domain you are joining (bad idea) you will get this message. Change the workgroup name to something else, it does not matter what, reboot, and try again. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893703"></a>The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2888975"></a>The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">I joined the domain successfully but after upgrading to a newer version of the Samba code I get the message, <span class="errorname">The system can not log you on (C000019B), Please try again or consult your -system administrator</span> when attempting to logon. +system administrator</span> when attempting to logon.</span>” </p><p> This occurs when the domain SID stored in the secrets.tdb database is changed. The most common cause of a change in domain SID is when @@ -518,14 +462,18 @@ The reset or change the domain SID you can use the net command as follows: <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net getlocalsid 'OLDNAME'</tt></b> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>net setlocalsid 'SID'</tt></b> </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893773"></a>The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> -When I try to join the domain I get the message <span class="errorname">The machine account +</p><p> +Workstation machine trust accounts work only with the Domain (or network) SID. If this SID changes +then domain members (workstations) will not be able to log onto the domain. The original Domain SID +can be recovered from the secrets.tdb file. The alternative is to visit each workstation to re-join +it to the domain. +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889059"></a>The machine trust account not accessible</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + “<span class="quote">When I try to join the domain I get the message <span class="errorname">The machine account for this computer either does not exist or is not accessible</span>. What's -wrong? +wrong?</span>” </p><p> This problem is caused by the PDC not having a suitable machine trust account. -If you are using the <i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> method to create +If you are using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2889085"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i> method to create accounts then this would indicate that it has not worked. Ensure the domain admin user system is working. </p><p> @@ -541,10 +489,22 @@ Some people have also reported that inconsistent subnet masks between the Samba server and the NT client can cause this problem. Make sure that these are consistent for both client and server. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893836"></a>When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889131"></a>Account disabled</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, + I get a message about my account being disabled.</span>”</p><p> Enable the user accounts with <b class="userinput"><tt>smbpasswd -e <i class="replaceable"><tt>username</tt></i> </tt></b>, this is normally done as an account is created. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2893863"></a>Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889164"></a>Domain Controller Unavailable</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</span>”</p><p> A domain controller has to announce on the network who it is. This usually takes a while. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2889186"></a>Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>After successfully joining the domain user logons fail with one of two messages:</p><p>One to the effect that the domain controller can not be found, the other claiming that the + account does not exist in the domain or that the password is incorrect.</p><p>This may be due to incompatible settings between + the Windows client and the Samba-3 server for <span class="emphasis"><em>schannel</em></span> (secure channel) settings + or <span class="emphasis"><em>smb signing</em></span> settings. Check your samba settings for <span class="emphasis"><em> + client schannel, server schannel, client signing, server signing</em></span> by executing: + <b class="command">testparm -v | more</b> and looking for the value of these parameters. + </p><p> + Also use the Microsoft Management Console - Local Security Settings. This tool is available from the + Control Panel. The Policy settings are found in the Local Policies / Securty Options area and are prefixed by + <span class="emphasis"><em>Secure Channel: ..., and Digitally sign ...</em></span>. + </p><p> + It is important that these be set consistently with the Samba-3 server settings. + </p></div></div><div class="footnotes"><br><hr width="100" align="left"><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2887167" href="#id2887167">1</a>] </sup>See also <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter on Account Information Databases</a>.</p></div><div class="footnote"><p><sup>[<a name="ftn.id2887690" href="#id2887690">2</a>] </sup>See also <a href="NetworkBrowsing.html" title="Chapter 10. Samba / MS Windows Network Browsing Guide">the chapter about network browsing</a></p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="ServerType.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="type.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="samba-bdc.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 6. Backup Domain Control</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html b/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html index 222bdee995..a0e5b8937c 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba.7.html @@ -57,7 +57,9 @@ </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="profiles.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">profiles</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">profiles</b> is a command-line utility that can be used to replace all occurences of a certain SID with another SID. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfstest.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfstest</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">vfstest</b> is a utility + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="log2pcap.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">log2pcap</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">log2pcap</b> is a utility + for generating pcap trace files from Samba log + files.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="vfstest.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">vfstest</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">vfstest</b> is a utility that can be used to test vfs modules.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="ntlm_auth.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">ntlm_auth</span>(1)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">ntlm_auth</b> is a helper-utility for external programs wanting to do NTLM-authentication. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbumount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbumount</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="smbmount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmount</span>(8)</span></a></span></dt><dd><p><b class="command">smbmount</b>,<b class="command">smbmnt</b> and <b class="command">smbmnt</b> are commands that can be used to diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/samba.css b/docs/htmldocs/samba.css new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3d926e8e74 --- /dev/null +++ b/docs/htmldocs/samba.css @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +BODY { + font-family: helvetica, arial, lucida sans, sans-serif; + background-color: white; +} + +H1, H2, H3 { + color: blue; + font-size: 120%; + padding: 2px; + margin-top: 0px; +} + +H1 { + background-color: #EEEEFF; + color: blue; +} + +H2 { + background-color: #DDDDFF; + color: blue; +} + +H3 { + background-color: #CCCCFF; + color: blue; +} + +H4 { + color: blue; +} + +TR.qandadiv TD { + padding-top: 1em; +} + +DIV.navhead { + font-size: 80%; +} + +A:link { + color: #36F; +} + +A:visited { + color: #96C; +} + +A:active { + color: #F63; +} + +TR.question { + color: #33C; + font-weight: bold; +} + +TR.question TD { + padding-top: 1em; +} + +DIV.variablelist { + padding-left: 2em; + color: #33C; +} + +P { + color: black; +} + +DIV.note, DIV.warning, DIV.caution, DIV.tip, DIV.important { + border: dashed 1px; + background-color: #EEEEFF; + width: 40em; +} + +PRE.programlisting, PRE.screen { + border: #630 1px dashed; + color: #630; +} + diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html b/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html index a790816d02..492780765e 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/securing-samba.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking"><link rel="next" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 15. Securing Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="locking.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="securing-samba"></a>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 26, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931943">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2931976">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932050">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932069">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932140">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932191">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932244">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932300">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932362">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932402">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932426">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932444">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2932469">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2931943"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="locking.html" title="Chapter 14. File and Record Locking"><link rel="next" href="InterdomainTrusts.html" title="Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 15. Securing Samba</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="locking.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="securing-samba"></a>Chapter 15. Securing Samba</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">May 26, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910685">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910722">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910796">Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910816">Using host based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910915">User based protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2910975">Using interface protection</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911042">Using a firewall</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911098">Using a IPC$ share deny</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911187">NTLMv2 Security</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911245">Upgrading Samba</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911271">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911289">Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</a></dt><dt><a href="securing-samba.html#id2911314">Why can users access home directories of other users?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910685"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> This note was attached to the Samba 2.2.8 release notes as it contained an important security fix. The information contained here applies to Samba installations in general. @@ -10,7 +10,7 @@ on it!" Security concerns are just like that: You need to know a little about the subject to appreciate how obvious most of it really is. The challenge for most of us is to discover that first morsel of knowledge with which we may unlock the secrets of the masters. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2931976"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910722"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are three level at which security principals must be observed in order to render a site at least moderately secure. These are: the perimeter firewall, the configuration of the host server that is running Samba, and Samba itself. @@ -22,58 +22,50 @@ Samba may be secured from connections that originate from outside the local netw done using <span class="emphasis"><em>host based protection</em></span> (using samba's implementation of a technology known as "tcpwrappers", or it may be done be using <span class="emphasis"><em>interface based exclusion</em></span> so that <span class="application">smbd</span> will bind only to specifically permitted interfaces. It is also -possible to set specific share or resource based exclusions, eg: on the <i class="parameter"><tt>IPC$</tt></i> -auto-share. The <i class="parameter"><tt>IPC$</tt></i> share is used for browsing purposes as well as to establish +possible to set specific share or resource based exclusions, eg: on the <i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i> +auto-share. The <i class="parameter"><tt>[IPC$]</tt></i> share is used for browsing purposes as well as to establish TCP/IP connections. </p><p> Another method by which Samba may be secured is by way of setting Access Control Entries in an Access Control List on the shares themselves. This is discussed in the chapter on File, Directory and Share Access Control. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932050"></a>Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2910796"></a>Technical Discussion of Protective Measures and Issues</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The key challenge of security is the fact that protective measures suffice at best only to close the door on known exploits and breach techniques. Never assume that because you have followed these few measures that the Samba server is now an impenetrable fortress! Given the history of information systems so far, it is only a matter of time before someone will find yet another vulnerability. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932069"></a>Using host based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910816"></a>Using host based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> In many installations of Samba the greatest threat comes for outside your immediate network. By default Samba will accept connections from any host, which means that if you run an insecure version of Samba on a host that is directly connected to the Internet you can be especially vulnerable. </p><p> - One of the simplest fixes in this case is to use the <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and - <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> options in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file to only + One of the simplest fixes in this case is to use the <a class="indexterm" name="id2910838"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> and + <a class="indexterm" name="id2910852"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i> options in the Samba <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> configuration file to only allow access to your server from a specific range of hosts. An example might be: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - hosts allow = 127.0.0.1 192.168.2.0/24 192.168.3.0/24 - hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0 - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 127.0.0.1 192.168.2.0/24 192.168.3.0/24</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> The above will only allow SMB connections from 'localhost' (your own computer) and from the two private networks 192.168.2 and 192.168.3. All other connections will be refused as soon as the client sends its first packet. The refusal will be marked as a <span class="errorname">not listening on called name</span> error. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932140"></a>User based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910915"></a>User based protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you want to restrict access to your server to valid users only then the following - method may be of use. In the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> <i class="parameter"><tt>[globals]</tt></i> section put: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - valid users = @smbusers, jacko - </pre><p> + method may be of use. In the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> <i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i> section put: + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users = @smbusers, jacko</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> What this does is, it restricts all server access to either the user <span class="emphasis"><em>jacko</em></span> or to members of the system group <span class="emphasis"><em>smbusers</em></span>. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932191"></a>Using interface protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2910975"></a>Using interface protection</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> By default Samba will accept connections on any network interface that it finds on your system. That means if you have a ISDN line or a PPP connection to the Internet then Samba will accept connections on those links. This may not be what you want. </p><p> You can change this behaviour using options like the following: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - interfaces = eth* lo - bind interfaces only = yes - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces = eth* lo</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only = yes</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> This tells Samba to only listen for connections on interfaces with a name starting with 'eth' such as eth0, eth1, plus on the loopback interface called 'lo'. The name you will need to use depends on what @@ -85,7 +77,7 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. connection refused reply. In that case no Samba code is run at all as the operating system has been told not to pass connections from that interface to any samba process. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932244"></a>Using a firewall</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911042"></a>Using a firewall</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Many people use a firewall to deny access to services that they don't want exposed outside their network. This can be a very good idea, although I would recommend using it in conjunction with the above @@ -98,7 +90,7 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. The last one is important as many older firewall setups may not be aware of it, given that this port was only added to the protocol in recent years. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932300"></a>Using a IPC$ share deny</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911098"></a>Using a IPC$ share deny</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If the above methods are not suitable, then you could also place a more specific deny on the IPC$ share that is used in the recently discovered security hole. This allows you to offer access to other @@ -106,11 +98,7 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. hosts. </p><p> To do that you could use: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> -[ipc$] - hosts allow = 192.168.115.0/24 127.0.0.1 - hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0 - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[ipc$]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow = 192.168.115.0/24 127.0.0.1</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny = 0.0.0.0/0</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> this would tell Samba that IPC$ connections are not allowed from anywhere but the two listed places (localhost and a local subnet). Connections to other shares would still be allowed. As the @@ -125,42 +113,44 @@ before someone will find yet another vulnerability. </p><p> This is not recommended unless you cannot use one of the other methods listed above for some reason. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932362"></a>NTLMv2 Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911187"></a>NTLMv2 Security</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> To configure NTLMv2 authentication the following registry keys are worth knowing about: </p><p> - </p><pre class="screen"> + </p><pre class="screen"> [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa] "lmcompatibilitylevel"=dword:00000003 - + </pre><p> + </p><p> 0x3 - Send NTLMv2 response only. Clients will use NTLMv2 authentication, use NTLMv2 session security if the server supports it. Domain controllers accept LM, NTLM and NTLMv2 authentication. - + </p><p> + </p><pre class="screen"> [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Lsa\MSV1_0] "NtlmMinClientSec"=dword:00080000 - + </pre><p> + </p><p> 0x80000 - NTLMv2 session security. If either NtlmMinClientSec or NtlmMinServerSec is set to 0x80000, the connection will fail if NTLMv2 session security is not negotiated. - </pre><p> - </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932402"></a>Upgrading Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911245"></a>Upgrading Samba</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Please check regularly on <a href="http://www.samba.org/" target="_top">http://www.samba.org/</a> for updates and important announcements. Occasionally security releases are made and it is highly recommended to upgrade Samba when a security vulnerability -is discovered. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2932426"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +is discovered. Check with your OS vendor for OS specific upgrades. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2911271"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> If all of samba and host platform configuration were really as intuitive as one might like then this section would not be necessary. Security issues are often vexing for a support person to resolve, not because of the complexity of the problem, but for reason that most administrators who post what turns out to be a security problem request are totally convinced that the problem is with Samba. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932444"></a>Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911289"></a>Smbclient works on localhost, but the network is dead</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This is a very common problem. Red Hat Linux (as do others) will install a default firewall. With the default firewall in place only traffic on the loopback adapter (IP address 127.0.0.1) will be allowed through the firewall. </p><p> The solution is either to remove the firewall (stop it) or to modify the firewall script to allow SMB networking traffic through. See section above in this chapter. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2932469"></a>Why can users access home directories of other users?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2911314"></a>Why can users access home directories of other users?</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> “<span class="quote"> We are unable to keep individual users from mapping to any other user's home directory once they have supplied a valid password! They only need @@ -189,18 +179,14 @@ out to be a security problem request are totally convinced that the problem is w the policies and permissions he or she desires. </p><p> Samba does allow the setup you require when you have set the - <i class="parameter"><tt>only user = yes</tt></i> option on the share, is that you have not set the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2911373"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i> = yes option on the share, is that you have not set the valid users list for the share. </p><p> Note that only user works in conjunction with the users= list, so to get the behavior you require, add the line : - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - users = %S - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>users = %S</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> this is equivalent to: - </p><pre class="programlisting"> - valid users = %S - </pre><p> + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users = %S</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> to the definition of the <i class="parameter"><tt>[homes]</tt></i> share, as recommended in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> man page. - </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="locking.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 14. File and Record Locking </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="locking.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="InterdomainTrusts.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 14. File and Record Locking </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 16. Interdomain Trust Relationships</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html index f22afa5884..b6eb609bb0 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smb.conf.5.html @@ -21,7 +21,7 @@ values, but is preserved in string values. Some items such as create modes are numeric.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</h2><p>Each section in the configuration file (except for the [global] section) describes a shared resource (known - as a "share"). The section name is the name of the + as a "share"). The section name is the name of the shared resource and the parameters within the section define the shares attributes.</p><p>There are three special sections, [global], [homes] and [printers], which are @@ -38,14 +38,14 @@ privileges in this case.</p><p>Sections other than guest services will require a password to access them. The client provides the username. As older clients only provide passwords and not usernames, you may specify a list - of usernames to check against the password using the "user =" + of usernames to check against the password using the "user =" option in the share definition. For modern clients such as Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000, this should not be necessary.</p><p>Note that the access rights granted by the server are masked by the access rights granted to the specified or guest UNIX user by the host system. The server does not grant more access than the host system grants.</p><p>The following sample section defines a file space share. The user has write access to the path <tt class="filename">/home/bar</tt>. - The share is accessed via the share name "foo":</p><pre class="screen"> + The share is accessed via the share name "foo":</p><pre class="screen"> <tt class="computeroutput"> [foo] path = /home/bar @@ -83,7 +83,7 @@ for your PCs than for UNIX access.</p><p>This is a fast and simple way to give a large number of clients access to their home directories with a minimum of fuss.</p><p>A similar process occurs if the requested section - name is "homes", except that the share name is not + name is "homes", except that the share name is not changed to that of the requesting user. This method of using the [homes] section works well if different users share a client PC.</p><p>The [homes] section can specify all the parameters @@ -147,8 +147,8 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... components (if there are more than one) are separated by vertical bar symbols ('|').</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what printers are defined on the system you may be able to use - "printcap name = lpstat" to automatically obtain a list - of printers. See the "printcap name" option + "printcap name = lpstat" to automatically obtain a list + of printers. See the "printcap name" option for more details.</p></div></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>PARAMETERS</h2><p>parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</p><p>Some parameters are specific to the [global] section (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>security</em></span>). Some parameters are usable in all sections (e.g., <span class="emphasis"><em>create mode</em></span>). All others @@ -164,16 +164,16 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... not create best bedfellows, but at least you can find them! Where there are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer to the preferred synonym.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</h2><p>Many of the strings that are settable in the config file - can take substitutions. For example the option "path = - /tmp/%u" would be interpreted as "path = - /tmp/john" if the user connected with the username john.</p><p>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below, + can take substitutions. For example the option "path = + /tmp/%u" would be interpreted as "path = + /tmp/john" if the user connected with the username john.</p><p>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below, but there are some general substitutions which apply whenever they might be relevant. These are:</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">%U</span></dt><dd><p>session user name (the user name that the client wanted, not necessarily the same as the one they got).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%G</span></dt><dd><p>primary group name of %U.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%h</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet hostname that Samba is running on.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%m</span></dt><dd><p>the NetBIOS name of the client machine (very useful).</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%L</span></dt><dd><p>the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you to change your config based on what the client calls you. Your - server can have a "dual personality".</p><p>Note that this parameter is not available when Samba listens + server can have a "dual personality".</p><p>Note that this parameter is not available when Samba listens on port 445, as clients no longer send this information </p></dd><dt><span class="term">%M</span></dt><dd><p>the Internet name of the client machine. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">%R</span></dt><dd><p>the selected protocol level after protocol negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS, @@ -182,7 +182,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... machine. Only some are recognized, and those may not be 100% reliable. It currently recognizes Samba, WfWg, Win95, WinNT and Win2k. Anything else will be known as - "UNKNOWN". If it gets it wrong then sending a level + "UNKNOWN". If it gets it wrong then sending a level 3 log to <a href="mailto:samba@samba.org" target="_top">samba@samba.org </a> should allow it to be fixed.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%I</span></dt><dd><p>The IP address of the client machine.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%T</span></dt><dd><p>the current date and time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%D</span></dt><dd><p>Name of the domain or workgroup of the current user.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%$(<i class="replaceable"><tt>envvar</tt></i>)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the environment variable <i class="replaceable"><tt>envar</tt></i>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>The following substitutes apply only to some configuration options(only those @@ -193,33 +193,33 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... not compiled Samba with the <span class="emphasis"><em>--with-automount</em></span> option then this value will be the same as %L.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">%p</span></dt><dd><p>the path of the service's home directory, obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. The NIS auto.map entry - is split up as "%N:%p".</p></dd></dl></div><p>There are some quite creative things that can be done - with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="NAMEMANGLINGSECT"></a><h2>NAME MANGLING</h2><p>Samba supports "name mangling" so that DOS and + is split up as "%N:%p".</p></dd></dl></div><p>There are some quite creative things that can be done + with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="NAMEMANGLINGSECT"></a><h2>NAME MANGLING</h2><p>Samba supports "name mangling" so that DOS and Windows clients can use files that don't conform to the 8.3 format. It can also be set to adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.</p><p>There are several options that control the way mangling is performed, and they are grouped here rather than listed separately. For the defaults look at the output of the testparm program. </p><p>All of these options can be set separately for each service (or globally, of course). </p><p>The options are: </p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">mangle case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p> controls if names that have characters that - aren't of the "default" case are mangled. For example, - if this is yes then a name like "Mail" would be mangled. + aren't of the "default" case are mangled. For example, + if this is yes then a name like "Mail" would be mangled. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">case sensitive = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls whether filenames are case sensitive. If they aren't then Samba must do a filename search and match on passed names. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>no</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">default case = upper/lower</span></dt><dd><p>controls what the default case is for new filenames. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>lower</em></span>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls if new files are created with the case that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the - "default" case. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>. + "default" case. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">short preserve case = yes/no</span></dt><dd><p>controls if new files which conform to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are created - upper case, or if they are forced to be the "default" - case. This option can be use with "preserve case = yes" + upper case, or if they are forced to be the "default" + case. This option can be use with "preserve case = yes" to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short names are lowercased. Default <span class="emphasis"><em>yes</em></span>.</p></dd></dl></div><p>By default, Samba 3.0 has the same semantics as a Windows NT server, in that it is case insensitive but case preserving.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><a name="VALIDATIONSECT"></a><h2>NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</h2><p>There are a number of ways in which a user can connect to a service. The server uses the following steps in determining if it will allow a connection to a specified service. If all the steps fail, then the connection request is rejected. However, if one of the - steps succeeds, then the following steps are not checked.</p><p>If the service is marked "guest only = yes" and the - server is running with share-level security ("security = share") + steps succeeds, then the following steps are not checked.</p><p>If the service is marked "guest only = yes" and the + server is running with share-level security ("security = share") then steps 1 to 5 are skipped.</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p>If the client has passed a username/password pair and that username/password pair is validated by the UNIX system's password programs then the connection is made as that @@ -232,23 +232,28 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... they match then the connection is allowed as the corresponding user.</p></li><li><p>If the client has previously validated a username/password pair with the server and the client has passed - the validation token then that username is used. </p></li><li><p>If a "user = " field is given in the + the validation token then that username is used. </p></li><li><p>If a "user = " field is given in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file for the service and the client has supplied a password, and that password matches (according to the UNIX system's password checking) with one of the usernames - from the "user =" field then the connection is made as - the username in the "user =" line. If one - of the username in the "user =" list begins with a + from the "user =" field then the connection is made as + the username in the "user =" line. If one + of the username in the "user =" list begins with a '@' then that name expands to a list of names in the group of the same name.</p></li><li><p>If the service is a guest service then a - connection is made as the username given in the "guest - account =" for the service, irrespective of the + connection is made as the username given in the "guest + account =" for the service, irrespective of the supplied password.</p></li></ol></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMPLETE LIST OF GLOBAL PARAMETERS</h2><p>Here is a list of all global parameters. See the section of - each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="#ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>abort shutdown script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDMACHINESCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDSHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDUSERSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add user to group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>algorithmic rid base</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"><i class="parameter"><tt>allow trusted domains</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ANNOUNCEAS"><i class="parameter"><tt>announce as</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ANNOUNCEVERSION"><i class="parameter"><tt>announce version</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#AUTHMETHODS"><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#AUTOSERVICES"><i class="parameter"><tt>auto services</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BINDINTERFACESONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BROWSELIST"><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>change notify timeout</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CHANGESHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTUSESPNEGO"><i class="parameter"><tt>client use spnego</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CONFIGFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>config file</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEADTIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>dead time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug hires timestamp</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGPID"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug pid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug timestamp</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGUID"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULT"><i class="parameter"><tt>default</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULTSERVICE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default service</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETESHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user from group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEUSERSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DFREECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>dfree command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DISABLENETBIOS"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable netbios</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DISABLESPOOLSS"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DISPLAYCHARSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DNSPROXY"><i class="parameter"><tt>dns proxy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOMAINLOGONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOMAINMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSCHARSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENHANCEDBROWSING"><i class="parameter"><tt>enhanced browsing</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GETWDCACHE"><i class="parameter"><tt>getwd cache</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDELOCALUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide local users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOMEDIRMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>homedir map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTMSDFS"><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"><i class="parameter"><tt>hostname lookups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTSEQUIV"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#IDMAPGID"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#IDMAPUID"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INCLUDE"><i class="parameter"><tt>include</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INTERFACES"><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#KEEPALIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>keepalive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#KERNELOPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LANMANAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>lanman auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LARGEREADWRITE"><i class="parameter"><tt>large readwrite</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPADMINDN"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPDELETEDN"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPFILTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPPASSWDSYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap port</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPSSL"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPSUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPTRUSTIDS"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap trust ids</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPUSERSUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LMANNOUNCE"><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LMINTERVAL"><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOADPRINTERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCALMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock dir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKSPINCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin count</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKSPINTIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>log file</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONDRIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONHOME"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONPATH"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPQCACHETIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>machine password timeout</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLINGSTACK"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling stack</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLINGPREFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling prefix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLINGMETHOD"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPTOGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXDISKSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>max disk size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXLOGSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXMUX"><i class="parameter"><tt>max mux</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXOPENFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>max open files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXPROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max protocol</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXSMBDPROCESSES"><i class="parameter"><tt>max smbd processes</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXTTL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max ttl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXWINSTTL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max wins ttl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXXMIT"><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MESSAGECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>message command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPASSWDLENGTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>min passwd length</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPASSWORDLENGTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>min password length</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>min protocol</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINWINSTTL"><i class="parameter"><tt>min wins ttl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NAMECACHETIMEOUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>name cache timeout</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NAMERESOLVEORDER"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NETBIOSALIASES"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios aliases</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NETBIOSNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NETBIOSSCOPE"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios scope</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NISHOMEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>nis homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"><i class="parameter"><tt>non unix account range</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTLMAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>ntlm auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTPIPESUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>nt pipe support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTSTATUSSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>nt status support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NULLPASSWORDS"><i class="parameter"><tt>null passwords</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OS2DRIVERMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OSLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><i class="parameter"><tt>pam password change</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PANICACTION"><i class="parameter"><tt>panic action</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>paranoid server security</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSDBBACKEND"><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWDCHAT"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWDCHATDEBUG"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat debug</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWDPROGRAM"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWORDLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWORDSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PIDDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>pid directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREFEREDMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>prefered master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREFERREDMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRELOAD"><i class="parameter"><tt>preload</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRELOADMODULES"><i class="parameter"><tt>preload modules</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTCAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRIVATEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>private dir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>protocol</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READBMPX"><i class="parameter"><tt>read bmpx</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READRAW"><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#REALM"><i class="parameter"><tt>realm</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#REMOTEANNOUNCE"><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#REMOTEBROWSESYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#RESTRICTANONYMOUS"><i class="parameter"><tt>restrict anonymous</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>root</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>root dir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SERVERSCHANNEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SERVERSTRING"><i class="parameter"><tt>server string</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SETPRIMARYGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>set primary group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SMBPASSWDFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>smb passwd file</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SMBPORTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>smb ports</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SOCKETADDRESS"><i class="parameter"><tt>socket address</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SOCKETOPTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SOURCEENVIRONMENT"><i class="parameter"><tt>source environment</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STATCACHE"><i class="parameter"><tt>stat cache</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STATCACHESIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>stat cache size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRIPDOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>strip dot</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SYSLOG"><i class="parameter"><tt>syslog</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SYSLOGONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>syslog only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TEMPLATESHELL"><i class="parameter"><tt>template shell</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TIMEOFFSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>time offset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TIMESERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>time server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TIMESTAMPLOGS"><i class="parameter"><tt>timestamp logs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TOTALPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNICODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>unicode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNIXCHARSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNIXEXTENSIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix extensions</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UPDATEENCRYPTED"><i class="parameter"><tt>update encrypted</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USEMMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>use mmap</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERNAMELEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERNAMEMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USESPNEGO"><i class="parameter"><tt>use spnego</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UTMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UTMPDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDCACHETIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDENUMGROUPS"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDENUMUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDGID"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDSEPARATOR"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDUID"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDUSEDDEFAULTDOMAIN"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind used default domain</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSHOOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins hook</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSPARTNER"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins partner</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSPROXY"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins proxy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WORKGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITERAW"><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WTMPDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>wtmp directory</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMPLETE LIST OF SERVICE PARAMETERS</h2><p>Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section on - each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="#ADMINUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ALLOWHOSTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>allow hosts</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#AVAILABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>available</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BLOCKINGLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>blocking locks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BLOCKSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>block size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BROWSABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>browsable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BROWSEABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CASESENSITIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CASESIGNAMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>casesignames</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#COMMENT"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#COPY"><i class="parameter"><tt>copy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CREATEMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CREATEMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>create mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CSCPOLICY"><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULTCASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULTDEVMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default devmode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEREADONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete readonly</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEVETOFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete veto files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DENYHOSTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>deny hosts</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DONTDESCEND"><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSFILEMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filemode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetime resolution</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSFILETIMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetimes</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#EXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>exec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>fake directory create times</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FAKEOPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>fake oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FOLLOWSYMLINKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>follow symlinks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCECREATEMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCESECURITYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEUSER"><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FSTYPE"><i class="parameter"><tt>fstype</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>group</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEDOTFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide dot files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDESPECIALFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide special files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEUNREADABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unreadable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unwriteable files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTSALLOW"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTSDENY"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INHERITACLS"><i class="parameter"><tt>inherit acls</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>inherit permissions</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INVALIDUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LEVEL2OPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>level2 oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKING"><i class="parameter"><tt>locking</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPPAUSECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPQCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPRESUMECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPRMCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAGICOUTPUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>magic output</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAGICSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>magic script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLECASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangle case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLEDMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLEDNAMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled names</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLINGCHAR"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling char</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPACLINHERIT"><i class="parameter"><tt>map acl inherit</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPARCHIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>map archive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPHIDDEN"><i class="parameter"><tt>map hidden</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPSYSTEM"><i class="parameter"><tt>map system</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXCONNECTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXREPORTEDPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max reported print jobs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPRINTSPACE"><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MSDFSPROXY"><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs proxy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MSDFSROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTACLSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ONLYGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>only guest</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ONLYUSER"><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PATH"><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#POSIXLOCKING"><i class="parameter"><tt>posix locking</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#POSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRESERVECASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTCAPNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTERADMIN"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTERNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTING"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>print ok</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PUBLIC"><i class="parameter"><tt>public</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READLIST"><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTPOSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>root postexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTPREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec close</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SECURITYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SETDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>set directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHAREMODES"><i class="parameter"><tt>share modes</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHORTPRESERVECASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRICTALLOCATE"><i class="parameter"><tt>strict allocate</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRICTLOCKING"><i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRICTSYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>strict sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SYNCALWAYS"><i class="parameter"><tt>sync always</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USECLIENTDRIVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USER"><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USESENDFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>use sendfile</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#-VALID"><i class="parameter"><tt>-valid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VALIDUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VETOFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VETOOPLOCKFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VFSOBJECT"><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs object</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VFSOBJECTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VOLUME"><i class="parameter"><tt>volume</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WIDELINKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>writable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITEABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITECACHESIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>write cache size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITELIST"><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITEOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>write ok</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a name="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a>abort shutdown script (G)</span></dt><dd><p><span class="emphasis"><em>This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</em></span> + each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="#ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>abort shutdown script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDMACHINESCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add machine script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDSHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDUSERSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADDUSERTOGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>add user to group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ALGORITHMICRIDBASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>algorithmic rid base</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"><i class="parameter"><tt>allow trusted domains</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ANNOUNCEAS"><i class="parameter"><tt>announce as</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ANNOUNCEVERSION"><i class="parameter"><tt>announce version</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#AUTHMETHODS"><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#AUTOSERVICES"><i class="parameter"><tt>auto services</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BINDINTERFACESONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BROWSELIST"><i class="parameter"><tt>browse list</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>change notify timeout</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CHANGESHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>change share command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTLANMANAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>client lanman auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTNTLMV2AUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>client ntlmv2 auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTPLAINTEXTAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>client plaintext auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTSCHANNEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTSIGNING"><i class="parameter"><tt>client signing</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CLIENTUSESPNEGO"><i class="parameter"><tt>client use spnego</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CONFIGFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>config file</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEADTIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>deadtime</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug hires timestamp</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGPID"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug pid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug timestamp</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEBUGUID"><i class="parameter"><tt>debug uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULT"><i class="parameter"><tt>default</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULTSERVICE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default service</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETESHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEUSERFROMGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user from group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEUSERSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete user script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DFREECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>dfree command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DISABLENETBIOS"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable netbios</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DISABLESPOOLSS"><i class="parameter"><tt>disable spoolss</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DISPLAYCHARSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DNSPROXY"><i class="parameter"><tt>dns proxy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOMAINLOGONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>domain logons</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOMAINMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>domain master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSCHARSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENABLERIDALGORITHM"><i class="parameter"><tt>enable rid algorithm</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><i class="parameter"><tt>encrypt passwords</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENHANCEDBROWSING"><i class="parameter"><tt>enhanced browsing</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GETQUOTACOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>get quota command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GETWDCACHE"><i class="parameter"><tt>getwd cache</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDELOCALUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide local users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOMEDIRMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>homedir map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTMSDFS"><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"><i class="parameter"><tt>hostname lookups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTSEQUIV"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#IDMAPBACKEND"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#IDMAPGID"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#IDMAPUID"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INCLUDE"><i class="parameter"><tt>include</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INTERFACES"><i class="parameter"><tt>interfaces</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#KEEPALIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>keepalive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#KERNELCHANGENOTIFY"><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel change notify</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#KERNELOPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LANMANAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>lanman auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LARGEREADWRITE"><i class="parameter"><tt>large readwrite</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPADMINDN"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPDELETEDN"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap delete dn</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPFILTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap filter</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPGROUPSUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap group suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPIDMAPSUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap machine suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPPASSWDSYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap passwd sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap port</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPSSL"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap ssl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPSUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LDAPUSERSUFFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap user suffix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LMANNOUNCE"><i class="parameter"><tt>lm announce</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LMINTERVAL"><i class="parameter"><tt>lm interval</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOADPRINTERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCALMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>local master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock dir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKSPINCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin count</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKSPINTIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>log file</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONDRIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon drive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONHOME"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONPATH"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon path</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOGONSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>logon script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPQCACHETIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>machine password timeout</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLEDSTACK"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled stack</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLEPREFIX"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangle prefix</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLINGMETHOD"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPTOGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>map to guest</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXDISKSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>max disk size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXLOGSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXMUX"><i class="parameter"><tt>max mux</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXOPENFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>max open files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXPROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max protocol</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXSMBDPROCESSES"><i class="parameter"><tt>max smbd processes</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXTTL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max ttl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXWINSTTL"><i class="parameter"><tt>max wins ttl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXXMIT"><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MESSAGECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>message command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPASSWDLENGTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>min passwd length</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPASSWORDLENGTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>min password length</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>min protocol</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINWINSTTL"><i class="parameter"><tt>min wins ttl</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NAMECACHETIMEOUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>name cache timeout</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NAMERESOLVEORDER"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NETBIOSALIASES"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios aliases</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NETBIOSNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NETBIOSSCOPE"><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios scope</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NISHOMEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>nis homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTLMAUTH"><i class="parameter"><tt>ntlm auth</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTPIPESUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>nt pipe support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTSTATUSSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>nt status support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NULLPASSWORDS"><i class="parameter"><tt>null passwords</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock break wait time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OS2DRIVERMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>os2 driver map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OSLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>os level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><i class="parameter"><tt>pam password change</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PANICACTION"><i class="parameter"><tt>panic action</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>paranoid server security</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSDBBACKEND"><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWDCHAT"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWDCHATDEBUG"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat debug</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWDPROGRAM"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd program</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWORDLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PASSWORDSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PIDDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>pid directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREFEREDMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>prefered master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREFERREDMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>preferred master</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRELOAD"><i class="parameter"><tt>preload</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRELOADMODULES"><i class="parameter"><tt>preload modules</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTCAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRIVATEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>private dir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PROTOCOL"><i class="parameter"><tt>protocol</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READBMPX"><i class="parameter"><tt>read bmpx</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READRAW"><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#REALM"><i class="parameter"><tt>realm</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#REMOTEANNOUNCE"><i class="parameter"><tt>remote announce</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#REMOTEBROWSESYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>remote browse sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#RESTRICTANONYMOUS"><i class="parameter"><tt>restrict anonymous</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>root</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>root dir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SECURITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SERVERSCHANNEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SERVERSIGNING"><i class="parameter"><tt>server signing</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SERVERSTRING"><i class="parameter"><tt>server string</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SETPRIMARYGROUPSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>set primary group script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SETQUOTACOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>set quota command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><i class="parameter"><tt>show add printer wizard</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SMBPASSWDFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>smb passwd file</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SMBPORTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>smb ports</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SOCKETADDRESS"><i class="parameter"><tt>socket address</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SOCKETOPTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SOURCEENVIRONMENT"><i class="parameter"><tt>source environment</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STATCACHE"><i class="parameter"><tt>stat cache</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRIPDOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>strip dot</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SYSLOG"><i class="parameter"><tt>syslog</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SYSLOGONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>syslog only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TEMPLATEPRIMARYGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>template primary group</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TEMPLATESHELL"><i class="parameter"><tt>template shell</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TIMEOFFSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>time offset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TIMESERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>time server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#TIMESTAMPLOGS"><i class="parameter"><tt>timestamp logs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNICODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>unicode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNIXCHARSET"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNIXEXTENSIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix extensions</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UPDATEENCRYPTED"><i class="parameter"><tt>update encrypted</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USEMMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>use mmap</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERNAMELEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt>username level</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERNAMEMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USESPNEGO"><i class="parameter"><tt>use spnego</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UTMP"><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#UTMPDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>utmp directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDCACHETIME"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDENABLELOCALACCOUNTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enable local accounts</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDENUMGROUPS"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDENUMUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDGID"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDSEPARATOR"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDTRUSTEDDOMAINSONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind trusted domains only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDUID"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind use default domain</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSHOOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins hook</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSPARTNERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins partners</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSPROXY"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins proxy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins server</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WINSSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>wins support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WORKGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITERAW"><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WTMPDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>wtmp directory</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMPLETE LIST OF SERVICE PARAMETERS</h2><p>Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section on + each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="#ACLCOMPATIBILITY"><i class="parameter"><tt>acl compatibility</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ADMINUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>admin users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ALLOWHOSTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>allow hosts</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#AVAILABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>available</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BLOCKINGLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>blocking locks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BLOCKSIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>block size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BROWSABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>browsable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#BROWSEABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>browseable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CASESENSITIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>case sensitive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CASESIGNAMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>casesignames</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#COMMENT"><i class="parameter"><tt>comment</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#COPY"><i class="parameter"><tt>copy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CREATEMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>create mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CREATEMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>create mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#CSCPOLICY"><i class="parameter"><tt>csc policy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULTCASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DEFAULTDEVMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default devmode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEREADONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete readonly</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DELETEVETOFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete veto files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DENYHOSTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>deny hosts</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory security mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DONTDESCEND"><i class="parameter"><tt>dont descend</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSFILEMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filemode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetime resolution</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#DOSFILETIMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos filetimes</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#EXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>exec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>fake directory create times</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FAKEOPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>fake oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FOLLOWSYMLINKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>follow symlinks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCECREATEMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force create mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>force group</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCESECURITYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt>force security mode</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FORCEUSER"><i class="parameter"><tt>force user</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#FSTYPE"><i class="parameter"><tt>fstype</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>group</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#GUESTONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEDOTFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide dot files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDESPECIALFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide special files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEUNREADABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unreadable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HIDEUNWRITEABLEFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>hide unwriteable files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTSALLOW"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#HOSTSDENY"><i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INHERITACLS"><i class="parameter"><tt>inherit acls</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INHERITPERMISSIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>inherit permissions</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#INVALIDUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>invalid users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LEVEL2OPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>level2 oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LOCKING"><i class="parameter"><tt>locking</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPPAUSECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lppause command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPQCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpq command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPRESUMECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lpresume command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#LPRMCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>lprm command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAGICOUTPUT"><i class="parameter"><tt>magic output</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAGICSCRIPT"><i class="parameter"><tt>magic script</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLECASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangle case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLEDMAP"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled map</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLEDNAMES"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangled names</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MANGLINGCHAR"><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling char</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPACLINHERIT"><i class="parameter"><tt>map acl inherit</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPARCHIVE"><i class="parameter"><tt>map archive</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPHIDDEN"><i class="parameter"><tt>map hidden</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAPSYSTEM"><i class="parameter"><tt>map system</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXCONNECTIONS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MAXREPORTEDPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max reported print jobs</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MINPRINTSPACE"><i class="parameter"><tt>min print space</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MSDFSPROXY"><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs proxy</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#MSDFSROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt>msdfs root</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#NTACLSUPPORT"><i class="parameter"><tt>nt acl support</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ONLYGUEST"><i class="parameter"><tt>only guest</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ONLYUSER"><i class="parameter"><tt>only user</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplock contention limit</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#OPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PATH"><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#POSIXLOCKING"><i class="parameter"><tt>posix locking</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#POSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRESERVECASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preserve case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTCAPNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>printcap name</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>print command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTER"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTERADMIN"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer admin</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTERNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTING"><i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PRINTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>print ok</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PROFILEACLS"><i class="parameter"><tt>profile acls</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#PUBLIC"><i class="parameter"><tt>public</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>queuepause command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>queueresume command</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READLIST"><i class="parameter"><tt>read list</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#READONLY"><i class="parameter"><tt>read only</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTPOSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>root postexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTPREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>root preexec close</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SECURITYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>security mask</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SETDIRECTORY"><i class="parameter"><tt>set directory</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHAREMODES"><i class="parameter"><tt>share modes</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SHORTPRESERVECASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>short preserve case</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRICTALLOCATE"><i class="parameter"><tt>strict allocate</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRICTLOCKING"><i class="parameter"><tt>strict locking</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#STRICTSYNC"><i class="parameter"><tt>strict sync</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#SYNCALWAYS"><i class="parameter"><tt>sync always</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USECLIENTDRIVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>use client driver</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USER"><i class="parameter"><tt>user</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERNAME"><i class="parameter"><tt>username</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#USESENDFILE"><i class="parameter"><tt>use sendfile</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#-VALID"><i class="parameter"><tt>-valid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VALIDUSERS"><i class="parameter"><tt>valid users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VETOFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>veto files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VETOOPLOCKFILES"><i class="parameter"><tt>veto oplock files</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VFSOBJECT"><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs object</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VFSOBJECTS"><i class="parameter"><tt>vfs objects</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#VOLUME"><i class="parameter"><tt>volume</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WIDELINKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>writable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITEABLE"><i class="parameter"><tt>writeable</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITECACHESIZE"><i class="parameter"><tt>write cache size</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITELIST"><i class="parameter"><tt>write list</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="#WRITEOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>write ok</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a name="ABORTSHUTDOWNSCRIPT"></a>abort shutdown script (G)</span></dt><dd><p><span class="emphasis"><em>This parameter only exists in the HEAD cvs branch</em></span> This a full path name to a script called by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> that should stop a shutdown procedure issued by the <a href="#SHUTDOWNSCRIPT"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i></a>.</p><p>This command will be run as user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>None</em></span>.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">abort shutdown script = /sbin/shutdown -c</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"></a>add group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run + <i class="parameter"><tt>shutdown script</tt></i></a>.</p><p>This command will be run as user.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>None</em></span>.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">abort shutdown script = /sbin/shutdown -c</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ACLCOMPATIBILITY"></a>acl compatibility (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies what OS ACL semantics should + be compatible with. Possible values are <span class="emphasis"><em>winnt</em></span> for Windows NT 4, + <span class="emphasis"><em>win2k</em></span> for Windows 2000 and above and <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>. + If you specify <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, the value for this parameter + will be based upon the version of the client. There should + be no reason to change this parameter from the default.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">acl compatibility = Auto</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">acl compatibility = win2k</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDGROUPSCRIPT"></a>add group script (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is the full pathname to a script that will be run <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when a new group is requested. It will expand any <i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> to the group name passed. This script is only useful for installations using the Windows NT @@ -264,7 +269,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... machines -c Machine -d /dev/null -s /bin/false %u</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"></a>addprinter command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, The MS Add Printer Wizard (APW) icon is now also available in the - "Printers..." folder displayed a share listing. The APW + "Printers..." folder displayed a share listing. The APW allows for printers to be add remotely to a Samba or Windows NT/2000 print server.</p><p>For a Samba host this means that the printer must be physically added to the underlying printing system. The <i class="parameter"><tt>add @@ -275,15 +280,15 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... shared by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i> is automatically invoked with the following parameter (in order):</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>printer name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>share name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>port name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>driver name</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>location</tt></i></p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>Windows 9x driver location</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>All parameters are filled in from the PRINTER_INFO_2 structure sent - by the Windows NT/2000 client with one exception. The "Windows 9x - driver location" parameter is included for backwards compatibility + by the Windows NT/2000 client with one exception. The "Windows 9x + driver location" parameter is included for backwards compatibility only. The remaining fields in the structure are generated from answers to the APW questions.</p><p>Once the <i class="parameter"><tt>addprinter command</tt></i> has been executed, <b class="command">smbd</b> will reparse the <tt class="filename"> smb.conf</tt> to determine if the share defined by the APW exists. If the sharename is still invalid, then <b class="command">smbd </b> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</p><p> - The "add printer command" program can output a single line of text, + The "add printer command" program can output a single line of text, which Samba will set as the port the new printer is connected to. If this line isn't output, Samba won't reload its printer shares. </p><p>See also <a href="#DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt> @@ -322,7 +327,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... created for all users accessing files on this server. For sites that use Windows NT account databases as their primary user database creating these users and keeping the user list in sync with the - Windows NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows <a href="smbd.8.html" target="_top">smbd</a> to create the required UNIX users + Windows NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows smbd to create the required UNIX users <span class="emphasis"><em>ON DEMAND</em></span> when a user accesses the Samba server.</p><p>In order to use this option, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> be set to <i class="parameter"><tt>security = share</tt></i> and <i class="parameter"><tt>add user script</tt></i> must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX @@ -367,7 +372,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i></a> option is set to <tt class="constant">server</tt> or <tt class="constant">domain</tt>. If it is set to no, then attempts to connect to a resource from - a domain or workgroup other than the one which <a href="smbd.8.html" target="_top">smbd</a> is running + a domain or workgroup other than the one which smbd is running in will fail, even if that domain is trusted by the remote server doing the authentication.</p><p>This is useful if you only want your Samba server to serve resources to users in the domain it is a member of. As @@ -378,8 +383,8 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... Samba server even if they do not have an account in DOMA. This can make implementing a security boundary difficult.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">allow trusted domains = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ANNOUNCEAS"></a>announce as (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This specifies what type of server <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse list. By default this is set to Windows NT. The valid options - are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"), - "NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server, + are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"), + "NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server, Windows NT Workstation, Windows 95 and Windows for Workgroups respectively. Do not change this parameter unless you have a specific need to stop Samba appearing as an NT server as this @@ -402,7 +407,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... method of authentication for remote domain users; deprecated in favour of winbind method), <tt class="constant">trustdomain</tt> (authenticate trusted users by contacting the remote DC directly from smbd; deprecated in favour of winbind method).</p><p>Default: <b class="command">auth methods = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">auth methods = guest sam winbind</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AUTOSERVICES"></a>auto services (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a synonym for the <a href="#PRELOAD"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>preload</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AVAILABLE"></a>available (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If + <i class="parameter"><tt>preload</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="AVAILABLE"></a>available (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If <i class="parameter"><tt>available = no</tt></i>, then <span class="emphasis"><em>ALL</em></span> attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures are logged.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">available = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BINDINTERFACESONLY"></a>bind interfaces only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This global parameter allows the Samba admin @@ -410,7 +415,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... affects file service <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and name service <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> in a slightly different ways.</p><p>For name service it causes <b class="command">nmbd</b> to bind to ports 137 and 138 on the interfaces listed in the <a href="#INTERFACES">interfaces</a> parameter. <b class="command">nmbd</b> also - binds to the "all addresses" interface (0.0.0.0) + binds to the "all addresses" interface (0.0.0.0) on ports 137 and 138 for the purposes of reading broadcast messages. If this option is not set then <b class="command">nmbd</b> will service name requests on all of these sockets. If <i class="parameter"><tt>bind interfaces @@ -447,7 +452,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> to determine if they are running. Not adding <span class="emphasis"><em>127.0.0.1</em></span> will cause <b class="command"> smbd</b> and <b class="command">nmbd</b> to always show - "not running" even if they really are. This can prevent <b class="command"> + "not running" even if they really are. This can prevent <b class="command"> swat</b> from starting/stopping/restarting <b class="command">smbd</b> and <b class="command">nmbd</b>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">bind interfaces only = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="BLOCKINGLOCKS"></a>blocking locks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the behavior of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> when given a request by a client @@ -474,7 +479,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... a client doing a <b class="command">NetServerEnum</b> call. Normally set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>. You should never need to change this.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">browse list = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CASESENSITIVE"></a>case sensitive (S)</span></dt><dd><p>See the discussion in the section <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">case sensitive = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CASESIGNAMES"></a>casesignames (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#CASESENSITIVE">case sensitive</a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"></a>change notify timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This SMB allows a client to tell a server to - "watch" a particular directory for any changes and only reply to + "watch" a particular directory for any changes and only reply to the SMB request when a change has occurred. Such constant scanning of a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon only performs such a scan on each requested directory once every <i class="parameter"><tt>change notify @@ -499,17 +504,49 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... with the new share. </p></li></ul></div><p> This parameter is only used modify existing file shares definitions. To modify - printer shares, use the "Printers..." folder as seen when browsing the Samba host. + printer shares, use the "Printers..." folder as seen when browsing the Samba host. </p><p> See also <a href="#ADDSHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>add share command</tt></i></a>, <a href="#DELETESHARECOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>delete share command</tt></i></a>. - </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">change share command = /usr/local/bin/addshare</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTUSESPNEGO"></a>client use spnego (G)</span></dt><dd><p> This variable controls controls whether samba clients will try + </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">change share command = /usr/local/bin/addshare</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTLANMANAUTH"></a>client lanman auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> and other samba client + tools will attempt to authenticate itself to servers using the + weaker LANMAN password hash. If disabled, only server which support NT + password hashes (e.g. Windows NT/2000, Samba, etc... but not + Windows 95/98) will be able to be connected from the Samba client.</p><p>The LANMAN encrypted response is easily broken, due to it's + case-insensitive nature, and the choice of algorithm. Clients + without Windows 95/98 servers are advised to disable + this option. </p><p>Disabling this option will also disable the <b class="command">client plaintext auth</b> option</p><p>Likewise, if the <b class="command">client ntlmv2 + auth</b> parameter is enabled, then only NTLMv2 logins will be + attempted. Not all servers support NTLMv2, and most will require + special configuration to us it.</p><p>Default : <b class="command">client lanman auth = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTNTLMV2AUTH"></a>client ntlmv2 auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbclient.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to + authenticate itself to servers using the NTLMv2 encrypted password + response.</p><p>If enabled, only an NTLMv2 and LMv2 response (both much more + secure than earlier versions) will be sent. Many servers + (including NT4 < SP4, Win9x and Samba 2.2) are not compatible with + NTLMv2. </p><p>If disabled, an NTLM response (and possibly a LANMAN response) + will be sent by the client, depending on the value of <b class="command">client lanman auth</b>. </p><p>Note that some sites (particularly + those following 'best practice' security polices) only allow NTLMv2 + responses, and not the weaker LM or NTLM.</p><p>Default : <b class="command">client ntlmv2 auth = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTPLAINTEXTAUTH"></a>client plaintext auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether a client should send a plaintext + password if the server does not support encrypted passwords.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">client plaintext auth = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTSCHANNEL"></a>client schannel (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the client offers or even + demands the use of the netlogon schannel. + <i class="parameter"><tt>client schannel = no</tt></i> does not + offer the schannel, <i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel = + auto</tt></i> offers the schannel but does not + enforce it, and <i class="parameter"><tt>server schannel = + yes</tt></i> denies access if the server is not + able to speak netlogon schannel. </p><p>Default: <b class="command">client schannel = auto</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">client schannel = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTSIGNING"></a>client signing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the client offers or requires + the server it talks to to use SMB signing. Possible values + are <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>mandatory</em></span> + and <span class="emphasis"><em>disabled</em></span>. + </p><p>When set to auto, SMB signing is offered, but not enforced. + When set to mandatory, SMB signing is required and if set + to disabled, SMB signing is not offered either.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">client signing = auto</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="CLIENTUSESPNEGO"></a>client use spnego (G)</span></dt><dd><p> This variable controls controls whether samba clients will try to use Simple and Protected NEGOciation (as specified by rfc2478) with WindowsXP and Windows2000 servers to agree upon an authentication mechanism. - SPNEGO client support with Sign and Seal is currently broken, so - you might want to turn this option off when doing joins to - Windows 2003 domains. + SPNEGO client support for SMB Signing is currently broken, so + you might want to turn this option off when operating with + Windows 2003 domain controllers in particular. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>client use spnego = yes</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COMMENT"></a>comment (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a text field that is seen next to a share when a client does a queries the server, either via the network neighborhood or via <b class="command">net view</b> to list what shares @@ -523,7 +560,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... the new config file.</p><p>This option takes the usual substitutions, which can be very useful.</p><p>If the config file doesn't exist then it won't be loaded (allowing you to special case the config files of just a few - clients).</p><p>Example: <b class="command">config file = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COPY"></a>copy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows you to "clone" service + clients).</p><p>Example: <b class="command">config file = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="COPY"></a>copy (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter allows you to "clone" service entries. The specified service is simply duplicated under the current service's name. Any parameters specified in the current section will override those in the section being copied.</p><p>This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and @@ -556,7 +593,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... policy</em></span>, and specifies how clients capable of offline caching will cache the files in the share. The valid values are: manual, documents, programs, disable.</p><p>These values correspond to those used on Windows servers.</p><p>For example, shares containing roaming profiles can have - offline caching disabled using <b class="command">csc policy = disable</b>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">csc policy = manual</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">csc policy = programs</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEADTIME"></a>dead time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer) + offline caching disabled using <b class="command">csc policy = disable</b>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">csc policy = manual</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">csc policy = programs</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEADTIME"></a>deadtime (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer) represents the number of minutes of inactivity before a connection is considered dead, and it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes effect if the number of open files is zero.</p><p>This is useful to stop a server's resources being @@ -569,7 +606,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... boolean parameter adds microsecond resolution to the timestamp message header when turned on.</p><p>Note that the parameter <a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt> debug timestamp</tt></i></a> must be on for this to have an - effect.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">debug hires timestamp = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGLEVEL"></a>debug level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#LOGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt> + effect.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">debug hires timestamp = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGLEVEL"></a>debuglevel (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#LOGLEVEL"><i class="parameter"><tt> log level</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DEBUGPID"></a>debug pid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When using only one log file for more then one forked <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>-process there may be hard to follow which process outputs which message. This boolean parameter @@ -619,8 +656,8 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... <i class="parameter"><tt>read-only</tt></i></a> service.</p><p>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed to equal that of the requested service, this is very useful as it allows you to use macros like <i class="parameter"><tt>%S</tt></i> to make - a wildcard service.</p><p>Note also that any "_" characters in the name of the service - used in the default service will get mapped to a "/". This allows for + a wildcard service.</p><p>Note also that any "_" characters in the name of the service + used in the default service will get mapped to a "/". This allows for interesting things.</p><p>Example:</p><pre class="programlisting"> [global] default service = pub @@ -641,7 +678,7 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... from the print system and from <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. </p><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> is automatically called with only one parameter: <i class="parameter"><tt> - "printer name"</tt></i>.</p><p>Once the <i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> has + "printer name"</tt></i>.</p><p>Once the <i class="parameter"><tt>deleteprinter command</tt></i> has been executed, <b class="command">smbd</b> will reparse the <tt class="filename"> smb.conf</tt> to associated printer no longer exists. If the sharename is still valid, then <b class="command">smbd @@ -703,8 +740,8 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... should only be used on systems where a problem occurs with the internal disk space calculations. This has been known to happen with Ultrix, but may occur with other operating systems. The - symptom that was seen was an error of "Abort Retry - Ignore" at the end of each directory listing.</p><p>This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to + symptom that was seen was an error of "Abort Retry + Ignore" at the end of each directory listing.</p><p>This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to calculate the total disk space and amount available with an external routine. The example below gives a possible script that might fulfill this function.</p><p>The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating @@ -718,10 +755,10 @@ alias|alias|alias|alias... determining the disk capacity and remaining space will be used. </em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">dfree command = /usr/local/samba/bin/dfree</b></p><p>Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:</p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/sh -df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' +df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' </pre><p>or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):</p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/sh -/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}' +/usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}' </pre><p>Note that you may have to replace the command names with full path names on some systems.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORY"></a>directory (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#PATH"><i class="parameter"><tt>path</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DIRECTORYMASK"></a>directory mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is the octal modes which are used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX directories.</p><p>When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are @@ -756,7 +793,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' meaning a user is allowed to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a directory.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, - so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. + so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave it as the default of <tt class="constant">0777</tt>.</p><p>See also the <a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt> force directory security mode</tt></i></a>, <a href="#SECURITYMASK"> @@ -820,7 +857,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' of interest to clients or are infinitely deep (recursive). This parameter allows you to specify a comma-delimited list of directories that the server should always show as empty.</p><p>Note that Samba can be very fussy about the exact format - of the "dont descend" entries. For example you may need <tt class="filename"> + of the "dont descend" entries. For example you may need <tt class="filename"> ./proc</tt> instead of just <tt class="filename">/proc</tt>. Experimentation is the best policy :-) </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none (i.e., all directories are OK to descend)</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">dont descend = /proc,/dev</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="DOSCHARSET"></a>dos charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>DOS SMB clients assume the server has @@ -857,11 +894,18 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' timestamp on a file if the user <b class="command">smbd</b> is acting on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option to <tt class="constant"> yes</tt> allows DOS semantics and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will change the file - timestamp as DOS requires.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">dos filetimes = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"></a>encrypt passwords (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords + timestamp as DOS requires.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">dos filetimes = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENABLERIDALGORITHM"></a>enable rid algorithm (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to control whether or not smbd in Samba 3.0 should fallback + to the algorithm used by Samba 2.2 to generate user and group RIDs. The longterm + development goal is to remove the algorithmic mappings of RIDs altogether, but + this has proved to be difficult. This parameter is mainly provided so that + developers can turn the algorithm on and off and see what breaks. This parameter + should not be disabled by non-developers because certain features in Samba will fail + to work without it. + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">enable rid algorithm = <yes></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"></a>encrypt passwords (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords will be negotiated with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and above and also Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords unless a registry entry is changed. To use encrypted passwords in - Samba see the chapter "User Database" in the Samba HOWTO Collection. </p><p>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly + Samba see the chapter "User Database" in the Samba HOWTO Collection. </p><p>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> must either have access to a local <a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> file (see the <a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a> program for information on how to set up and maintain this file), or set the <a href="#SECURITY">security = [server|domain|ads]</a> parameter which @@ -877,16 +921,16 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' workgroups not disappearing from browse lists. Due to the restrictions of the browse protocols these enhancements can cause a empty workgroup to stay around forever which can be annoying.</p><p>In general you should leave this option enabled as it makes - cross-subnet browse propagation much more reliable.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">enhanced browsing = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"></a>enumports command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign + cross-subnet browse propagation much more reliable.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">enhanced browsing = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"></a>enumports command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign to UNIX hosts. Under Windows NT/2000 print servers, a port is associated with a port monitor and generally takes the form of a local port (i.e. LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:) or a remote port (i.e. LPD Port Monitor, etc...). By default, Samba has only one - port defined--<tt class="constant">"Samba Printer Port"</tt>. Under + port defined--<tt class="constant">"Samba Printer Port"</tt>. Under Windows NT/2000, all printers must have a valid port name. If you wish to have a list of ports displayed (<b class="command">smbd </b> does not use a port name for anything) other than - the default <tt class="constant">"Samba Printer Port"</tt>, you + the default <tt class="constant">"Samba Printer Port"</tt>, you can define <i class="parameter"><tt>enumports command</tt></i> to point to a program which should generate a list of ports, one per line, to standard output. This listing will then be used in response @@ -968,7 +1012,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a directory without restrictions.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, - so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. + so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave it set as 0000.</p><p>See also the <a href="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt> directory security mask</tt></i></a>, <a href="#SECURITYMASK"> @@ -1005,7 +1049,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' and allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file, with no restrictions.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, - so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. + so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave this set to 0000.</p><p>See also the <a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><i class="parameter"><tt> force directory security mode</tt></i></a>, @@ -1017,7 +1061,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' as using it incorrectly can cause security problems.</p><p>This user name only gets used once a connection is established. Thus clients still need to connect as a valid user and supply a valid password. Once connected, all file operations will be performed - as the "forced user", no matter what username the client connected + as the "forced user", no matter what username the client connected as. This can be very useful.</p><p>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter also causes the primary group of the forced user to be used as the primary group for all file activity. Prior to 2.0.5 the primary group was left @@ -1027,7 +1071,13 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' for a share. The default type is <tt class="constant">NTFS</tt> for compatibility with Windows NT but this can be changed to other strings such as <tt class="constant">Samba</tt> or <tt class="constant">FAT - </tt> if required.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">fstype = NTFS</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">fstype = Samba</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETWDCACHE"></a>getwd cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a + </tt> if required.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">fstype = NTFS</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">fstype = Samba</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETQUOTACOMMAND"></a>get quota command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">get quota command</b> should only be used + whenever there is no operating system API available from the OS that + samba can use.</p><p>This parameter should specify the path to a script that + queries the quota information for the specified + user/group for the partition that + the specified directory is on.</p><p>Such a script should take 3 arguments:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>directory</p></li><li><p>type of query</p></li><li><p>uid of user or gid of group</p></li></ul></div><p>The type of query can be one of :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>1 - user quotas</p></li><li><p>2 - user default quotas (uid = -1)</p></li><li><p>3 - group quotas</p></li><li><p>4 - group default quotas (gid = -1)</p></li></ul></div><p>This script should print its output according to the following format:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Line 1 - quota flags (0 = no quotas, 1 = quotas enabled, 2 = quotas enabled and enforced)</p></li><li><p>Line 2 - number of currently used blocks</p></li><li><p>Line 3 - the softlimit number of blocks</p></li><li><p>Line 4 - the hardlimit number of blocks</p></li><li><p>Line 5 - currently used number of inodes</p></li><li><p>Line 6 - the softlimit number of inodes</p></li><li><p>Line 7 - the hardlimit number of inodes</p></li><li><p>Line 8(optional) - the number of bytes in a block(default is 1024)</p></li></ul></div><p>See also the <a href="#SETQUOTACOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>set quota command</tt></i></a> parameter. + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">get quota command = </b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">get quota command = /usr/local/sbin/query_quota</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GETWDCACHE"></a>getwd cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a caching algorithm will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd() calls. This can have a significant impact on performance, especially when the <a href="#WIDELINKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i> @@ -1037,17 +1087,17 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' guest ok</tt></i></a> (see below). Whatever privileges this user has will be available to any client connecting to the guest service. Typically this user will exist in the password file, but will not - have a valid login. The user account "ftp" is often a good choice + have a valid login. The user account "ftp" is often a good choice for this parameter. If a username is specified in a given service, the specified username overrides this one. - </p><p>One some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not + </p><p>One some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not be able to print. Use another account in this case. You should test this by trying to log in as your guest user (perhaps by using the <b class="command">su -</b> command) and trying to print using the system print command such as <b class="command">lpr(1)</b> or <b class="command"> lp(1)</b>.</p><p>This parameter does not accept % macros, because many parts of the system require this value to be - constant for correct operation.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>specified at compile time, usually "nobody"</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">guest account = ftp</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTOK"></a>guest ok (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt> for + constant for correct operation.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>specified at compile time, usually "nobody"</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">guest account = ftp</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="GUESTOK"></a>guest ok (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt> for a service, then no password is required to connect to the service. Privileges will be those of the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt> guest account</tt></i></a>.</p><p>This paramater nullifies the benifits of setting @@ -1102,7 +1152,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' to browse Dfs trees hosted on the server.</p><p>See also the <a href="#MSDFSROOT"><i class="parameter"><tt> msdfs root</tt></i></a> share level parameter. For more information on setting up a Dfs tree on Samba, - refer to <a href="msdfs_setup.html" target="_top">msdfs_setup.html</a>. + refer to <a href="#">???</a>. </p><p>Default: <b class="command">host msdfs = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTNAMELOOKUPS"></a>hostname lookups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether samba should use (expensive) hostname lookups or use the ip addresses instead. An example place where hostname lookups are currently used is when checking @@ -1122,7 +1172,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts deny</tt></i></a> option.</p><p>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and by netgroup names if your system supports netgroups. The <span class="emphasis"><em>EXCEPT</em></span> keyword can also be used to limit a - wildcard list. The following examples may provide some help:</p><p>Example 1: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.*; except one</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</b></p><p>Example 2: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</b></p><p>Example 3: allow a couple of hosts</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</b></p><p>Example 4: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but + wildcard list. The following examples may provide some help:</p><p>Example 1: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.*; except one</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</b></p><p>Example 2: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</b></p><p>Example 3: allow a couple of hosts</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</b></p><p>Example 4: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but deny access from one particular host</p><p><b class="command">hosts allow = @foonet</b></p><p><b class="command">hosts deny = pirate</b></p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</p></div><p>See <a href="testparm.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">testparm</span>(1)</span></a> for a way of testing your host access to see if it does what you expect.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">allow hosts = 150.203.5. myhost.mynet.edu.au</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="HOSTSDENY"></a>hosts deny (S)</span></dt><dd><p>The opposite of <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts allow</tt></i> - hosts listed here are <span class="emphasis"><em>NOT</em></span> permitted access to @@ -1142,7 +1192,13 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' <i class="parameter"><tt>hosts equiv</tt></i> option be only used if you really know what you are doing, or perhaps on a home network where you trust your spouse and kids. And only if you <span class="emphasis"><em>really</em></span> trust - them :-).</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>no host equivalences</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">hosts equiv = /etc/hosts.equiv</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPGID"></a>idmap gid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The idmap gid parameter specifies the range of group ids that are allocated for + them :-).</p></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>no host equivalences</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">hosts equiv = /etc/hosts.equiv</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPBACKEND"></a>idmap backend (G)</span></dt><dd><p> + The purpose of the idmap backend parameter is to allow idmap to NOT use the local idmap + tdb file to obtain SID to UID / GID mappings, but instead to obtain them from a common + LDAP backend. This way all domain members and controllers will have the same UID and GID + to SID mappings. This avoids the risk of UID / GID inconsistencies across UNIX / Linux + systems that are sharing information over protocols other than SMB/CIFS (ie: NFS). + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">idmap backend = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">idmap backend = ldap:ldap://ldapslave.example.com</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPGID"></a>idmap gid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The idmap gid parameter specifies the range of group ids that are allocated for the purpose of mapping UNX groups to NT group SIDs. This range of group ids should have no existing local or NIS groups within it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>The availability of an idmap gid range is essential for correct operation of all group mapping.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">idmap gid = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">idmap gid = 10000-20000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="IDMAPUID"></a>idmap uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The idmap uid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are allocated for use @@ -1185,11 +1241,11 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' interfaces except 127.0.0.1 that are broadcast capable.</p><p>The option takes a list of interface strings. Each string can be in any of the following forms:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>a network interface name (such as eth0). This may include shell-like wildcards so eth* will match - any interface starting with the substring "eth"</p></li><li><p>an IP address. In this case the netmask is + any interface starting with the substring "eth"</p></li><li><p>an IP address. In this case the netmask is determined from the list of interfaces obtained from the - kernel</p></li><li><p>an IP/mask pair. </p></li><li><p>a broadcast/mask pair.</p></li></ul></div><p>The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such + kernel</p></li><li><p>an IP/mask pair. </p></li><li><p>a broadcast/mask pair.</p></li></ul></div><p>The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such as 24 for a C class network) or a full netmask in dotted - decimal form.</p><p>The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted + decimal form.</p><p>The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted decimal IP address or a hostname which will be looked up via the OS's normal hostname resolution mechanisms.</p><p>For example, the following line:</p><p><b class="command">interfaces = eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0</b></p><p>would configure three network interfaces corresponding to the eth0 device and IP addresses 192.168.2.10 and 192.168.3.10. @@ -1218,7 +1274,12 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' a client is still present and responding.</p><p>Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket being used has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it (see <a href="#SOCKETOPTIONS"> <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i></a>). - Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">keepalive = 300</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">keepalive = 600</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELOPLOCKS"></a>kernel oplocks (G)</span></dt><dd><p>For UNIXes that support kernel based <a href="#OPLOCKS"> + Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">keepalive = 300</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">keepalive = 600</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELCHANGENOTIFY"></a>kernel change notify (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether Samba should ask the + kernel for change notifications in directories so that + SMB clients can refresh whenever the data on the server changes. + </p><p>This parameter is only usd when your kernel supports + change notification to user programs, using the F_NOTIFY fcntl. + </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>Yes</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="KERNELOPLOCKS"></a>kernel oplocks (G)</span></dt><dd><p>For UNIXes that support kernel based <a href="#OPLOCKS"> <i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks</tt></i></a> (currently only IRIX and the Linux 2.4 kernel), this parameter allows the use of them to be turned on or off.</p><p>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <i class="parameter"><tt>oplocks @@ -1263,7 +1324,12 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' The default is to match the login name with the <tt class="constant">uid</tt> attribute for all entries matching the <tt class="constant">sambaAccount</tt> objectclass. Note that this filter should only return one entry. - </p><p>Default: <b class="command">ldap filter = (&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaAccount))</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"></a>ldap machine suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>It specifies where machines should be added to the ldap tree.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"></a>ldap passwd sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to define whether + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">ldap filter = (&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaAccount))</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPGROUPSUFFIX"></a>ldap group suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters specifies the suffix that is + used for groups when these are added to the LDAP directory. + If this parameter is unset, the value of <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> will be used instead.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em>dc=samba,ou=Groups</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPIDMAPSUFFIX"></a>ldap idmap suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters specifies the suffix that is + used when storing idmap mappings. If this parameter + is unset, the value of <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap suffix</tt></i> + will be used instead.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p><p>Example: <span class="emphasis"><em>dc=samba,ou=Idmap</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPMACHINESUFFIX"></a>ldap machine suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>It specifies where machines should be added to the ldap tree.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPPASSWDSYNC"></a>ldap passwd sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to define whether or not Samba should sync the LDAP password with the NT and LM hashes for normal accounts (NOT for workstation, server or domain trusts) on a password @@ -1295,16 +1361,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' tree. Can be overriden by <b class="command">ldap user suffix</b> and <b class="command">ldap machine suffix</b>. It also used as the base dn for all ldap - searches. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPTRUSTIDS"></a>ldap trust ids (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Normally, Samba validates each entry in the LDAP server - against getpwnam(). This allows LDAP to be used for Samba with - the unix system using NIS (for example) and also ensures that - Samba does not present accounts that do not otherwise exist. - </p><p>This option is used to disable this functionality, and - instead to rely on the presence of the appropriate attributes - in LDAP directly, which can result in a significant performance - boost in some situations. Setting this option to yes effectivly - assumes that the local machine is running <b class="command">nss_ldap</b> against the same LDAP - server.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">ldap trust ids = No</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"></a>ldap user suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>It specifies where users are added to the tree.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"></a>level2 oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether Samba supports + searches. </p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LDAPUSERSUFFIX"></a>ldap user suffix (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies where users are added to the tree. + If this parameter is not specified, the value from <b class="command">ldap suffix</b>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none</em></span></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"></a>level2 oplocks (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether Samba supports level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share.</p><p>Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients that have an oplock on a file to downgrade from a read-write oplock to a read-only oplock once a second client opens the file (instead @@ -1315,7 +1373,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' for many accesses of files that are not commonly written (such as application .EXE files).</p><p>Once one of the clients which have a read-only oplock writes to the file all clients are notified (no reply is needed - or waited for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and + or waited for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and delete any read-ahead caches.</p><p>It is recommended that this parameter be turned on to speed access to shared executables.</p><p>For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.</p><p>Currently, if <a href="#KERNELOPLOCKS"><i class="parameter"><tt>kernel oplocks</tt></i></a> are supported then level2 oplocks are @@ -1376,7 +1434,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' in case the lock could later be aquired. This behavior is used to support PC database formats such as MS Access and FoxPro. - </p><p>Default: <b class="command">lock spin count = 2</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKSPINTIME"></a>lock spin time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The time in microseconds that smbd should + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">lock spin count = 3</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOCKSPINTIME"></a>lock spin time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The time in microseconds that smbd should pause before attempting to gain a failed lock. See <a href="#LOCKSPINCOUNT"><i class="parameter"><tt>lock spin count</tt></i></a> for more details.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">lock spin time = 10</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGFILE"></a>log file (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the name @@ -1407,14 +1465,14 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i>. This broke <b class="command">net use /home</b> but allowed profiles outside the home directory. The current implementation is correct, and can be used for profiles if you use the above trick.</p><p>This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon - server.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">logon home = "\\%N\%U"</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">logon home = "\\remote_smb_server\%U"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONPATH"></a>logon path (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the home directory + server.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">logon home = "\\%N\%U"</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">logon home = "\\remote_smb_server\%U"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="LOGONPATH"></a>logon path (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the home directory where roaming profiles (NTuser.dat etc files for Windows NT) are stored. Contrary to previous versions of these manual pages, it has nothing to do with Win 9X roaming profiles. To find out how to handle roaming profiles for Win 9X system, see the <a href="#LOGONHOME"> <i class="parameter"><tt>logon home</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine. It also - specifies the directory from which the "Application Data", + specifies the directory from which the "Application Data", (<tt class="filename">desktop</tt>, <tt class="filename">start menu</tt>, <tt class="filename">network neighborhood</tt>, <tt class="filename">programs</tt> and other folders, and their contents, are loaded and displayed on @@ -1443,8 +1501,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' suggested command would be to add <b class="command">NET TIME \\SERVER /SET /YES</b>, to force every machine to synchronize clocks with the same time server. Another use would be to add <b class="command">NET USE - U: \\SERVER\UTILS</b> for commonly used utilities, or <b class="command"> - NET USE Q: \\SERVER\ISO9001_QA</b> for example.</p><p>Note that it is particularly important not to allow write + U: \\SERVER\UTILS</b> for commonly used utilities, or </p><pre class="screen"> + <b class="userinput"><tt>NET USE Q: \\SERVER\ISO9001_QA</tt></b></pre><p> for example.</p><p>Note that it is particularly important not to allow write access to the [netlogon] share, or to grant users write permission on the batch files in a secure environment, as this would allow the batch files to be arbitrarily modified and security to be @@ -1519,8 +1577,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' </tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>depends on the setting of <i class="parameter"><tt>printing </tt></i></em></span></p><p>Example 1: <b class="command">lprm command = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j</b></p><p>Example 2: <b class="command">lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"></a>machine password timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>If a Samba server is a member of a Windows NT Domain (see the <a href="#SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">security = domain</a>) - parameter) then periodically a running <a href="smbd.8.html" target="_top"> - smbd(8)</a> process will try and change the MACHINE ACCOUNT + parameter) then periodically a running smbd + process will try and change the MACHINE ACCOUNT PASSWORD stored in the TDB called <tt class="filename">private/secrets.tdb </tt>. This parameter specifies how often this password will be changed, in seconds. The default is one week (expressed in @@ -1552,12 +1610,12 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' you would use:</p><p><b class="command">mangled map = (*.html *.htm)</b></p><p>One very useful case is to remove the annoying <tt class="filename">;1 </tt> off the ends of filenames on some CDROMs (only visible under some UNIXes). To do this use a map of (*;1 *;).</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>no mangled map</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangled map = (*;1 *;)</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEDNAMES"></a>mangled names (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX - should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible, + should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible, or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a> for details on how to control the mangling process.</p><p>If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters before the rightmost dot of the filename are preserved, forced to upper case, and appear as the first (up to) five characters - of the mangled name.</p></li><li><p>A tilde "~" is appended to the first part of the mangled + of the mangled name.</p></li><li><p>A tilde "~" is appended to the first part of the mangled name, followed by a two-character unique sequence, based on the original root name (i.e., the original filename minus its final extension). The final extension is included in the hash calculation @@ -1569,9 +1627,9 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' extension of the mangled name. The final extension is defined as that part of the original filename after the rightmost dot. If there are no dots in the filename, the mangled name will have no extension (except - in the case of "hidden files" - see below).</p></li><li><p>Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be + in the case of "hidden files" - see below).</p></li><li><p>Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be presented as DOS hidden files. The mangled name will be created as - for other filenames, but with the leading dot removed and "___" as + for other filenames, but with the leading dot removed and "___" as its extension regardless of actual original extension (that's three underscores).</p></li></ul></div><p>The two-digit hash value consists of upper case alphanumeric characters.</p><p>This algorithm can cause name collisions only if files in a directory share the same first five alphanumeric characters. @@ -1579,7 +1637,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' copied between UNIX directories from Windows/DOS while retaining the long UNIX filename. UNIX files can be renamed to a new extension from Windows/DOS and will retain the same basename. Mangled names - do not change between sessions.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangled names = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGSTACK"></a>mangling stack (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the number of mangled names + do not change between sessions.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangled names = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEDSTACK"></a>mangled stack (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls the number of mangled names that should be cached in the Samba server <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>This stack is a list of recently mangled base names (extensions are only maintained if they are longer than 3 characters or contains upper case characters).</p><p>The larger this value, the more likely it is that mangled @@ -1587,17 +1645,19 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' However, large stack sizes will slow most directory accesses. Smaller stacks save memory in the server (each stack element costs 256 bytes). </p><p>It is not possible to absolutely guarantee correct long - filenames, so be prepared for some surprises!</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangled stack = 50</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangled stack = 100</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGPREFIX"></a>mangling prefix (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the number of prefix + filenames, so be prepared for some surprises!</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangled stack = 50</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangled stack = 100</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLEPREFIX"></a>mangle prefix (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the number of prefix characters from the original name used when generating the mangled names. A larger value will give a weaker hash and therefore more name collisions. The minimum - value is 1 and the maximum value is 6.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangle prefix = 1</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangle prefix = 4</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGCHAR"></a>mangling char (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what character is used as + value is 1 and the maximum value is 6.</p><p> + mangle prefix is effective only when mangling method is hash2. + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangle prefix = 1</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangle prefix = 4</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGCHAR"></a>mangling char (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what character is used as the <span class="emphasis"><em>magic</em></span> character in <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">name mangling</a>. The default is a '~' but this may interfere with some software. Use this option to set - it to whatever you prefer.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangling char = ~</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangling char = ^</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGMETHOD"></a>mangling method (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the algorithm used for the generating - the mangled names. Can take two different values, "hash" and - "hash2". "hash" is the default and is the algorithm that has been - used in Samba for many years. "hash2" is a newer and considered + it to whatever you prefer. This is effective only when mangling method is hash.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">mangling char = ~</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">mangling char = ^</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MANGLINGMETHOD"></a>mangling method (G)</span></dt><dd><p> controls the algorithm used for the generating + the mangled names. Can take two different values, "hash" and + "hash2". "hash" is the default and is the algorithm that has been + used in Samba for many years. "hash2" is a newer and considered a better algorithm (generates less collisions) in the names. However, many Win32 applications store the mangled names and so changing to the new algorithm must not be done @@ -1638,18 +1698,18 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' with an invalid password are treated as a guest login and mapped into the <a href="#GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</a>. Note that this can cause problems as it means that any user incorrectly typing - their password will be silently logged on as "guest" - and + their password will be silently logged on as "guest" - and will not know the reason they cannot access files they think they should - there will have been no message given to them that they got their password wrong. Helpdesk services will <span class="emphasis"><em>hate</em></span> you if you set the <i class="parameter"><tt>map to - guest</tt></i> parameter this way :-).</p></li></ul></div><p>Note that this parameter is needed to set up "Guest" + guest</tt></i> parameter this way :-).</p></li></ul></div><p>Note that this parameter is needed to set up "Guest" share services when using <i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> modes other than share. This is because in these modes the name of the resource being requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after the server has successfully authenticated the client so the server cannot make authentication decisions at the correct time (connection - to the share) for "Guest" shares.</p><p>For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this + to the share) for "Guest" shares.</p><p>For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this parameter maps to the old compile-time setting of the <tt class="constant"> GUEST_SESSSETUP</tt> value in local.h.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">map to guest = Never</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">map to guest = Bad User</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXCONNECTIONS"></a>max connections (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the number of simultaneous connections to a service to be limited. If <i class="parameter"><tt>max connections</tt></i> is greater than 0 then connections @@ -1679,8 +1739,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' by the UNIX per-process file descriptor limit rather than this parameter so you should never need to touch this parameter.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">max open files = 10000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXPRINTJOBS"></a>max print jobs (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of jobs allowable in a Samba printer queue at any given moment. - If this number is exceeded, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will remote "Out of Space" to the client. - See all <a href="#TOTALPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>total + If this number is exceeded, <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will remote "Out of Space" to the client. + See all <a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i></a>. </p><p>Default: <b class="command">max print jobs = 1000</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">max print jobs = 5000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXPROTOCOL"></a>max protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest protocol level that will be supported by the server.</p><p>Possible values are :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">CORE</tt>: Earliest version. No @@ -1697,7 +1757,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' A value of zero means there is no limit on the number of print jobs reported. - See all <a href="#TOTALPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>total + See all <a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>total print jobs</tt></i></a> and <a href="#MAXPRINTJOBS"><i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i></a> parameters. </p><p>Default: <b class="command">max reported print jobs = 0</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">max reported print jobs = 1000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"></a>max smbd processes (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter limits the maximum number of <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> processes concurrently running on a system and is intended @@ -1779,16 +1839,15 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' Dfs links are specified in the share directory by symbolic links of the form <tt class="filename">msdfs:serverA\\shareA,serverB\\shareB</tt> and so on. For more information on setting up a Dfs tree - on Samba, refer to <a href="msdfs.html" target="_top">"Hosting a Microsoft - Distributed File System tree on Samba"</a> document.</p><p>See also <a href="#HOSTMSDFS"><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i></a></p><p>Default: <b class="command">msdfs root = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"></a>name cache timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the number of seconds it takes before + on Samba, refer to <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>See also <a href="#HOSTMSDFS"><i class="parameter"><tt>host msdfs</tt></i></a></p><p>Default: <b class="command">msdfs root = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMECACHETIMEOUT"></a>name cache timeout (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the number of seconds it takes before entries in samba's hostname resolve cache time out. If the timeout is set to 0. the caching is disabled. </p><p>Default: <b class="command">name cache timeout = 660</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">name cache timeout = 0</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NAMERESOLVEORDER"></a>name resolve order (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option is used by the programs in the Samba suite to determine what naming services to use and in what order to resolve host names to IP addresses. Its main purpose to is to control how netbios name resolution is performed. The option takes a space - separated string of name resolution options.</p><p>The options are: "lmhosts", "host", - "wins" and "bcast". They cause names to be + separated string of name resolution options.</p><p>The options are: "lmhosts", "host", + "wins" and "bcast". They cause names to be resolved as follows:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt> : Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html" target="_top">lmhosts(5)</a> for details) then @@ -1811,7 +1870,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' first, followed by a broadcast attempt, followed by a normal system hostname lookup.</p><p>When Samba is functioning in ADS security mode (<b class="command">security = ads</b>) it is advised to use following settings for <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>:</p><p><b class="command">name resolve order = wins bcast</b></p><p>DC lookups will still be done via DNS, but fallbacks to netbios names will - not inundate your DNS servers with needless querys for DOMAIN<0x1c> lookups.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSALIASES"></a>netbios aliases (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of NetBIOS names that <a href="nmbd.8.html" target="_top">nmbd(8)</a> will + not inundate your DNS servers with needless querys for DOMAIN<0x1c> lookups.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NETBIOSALIASES"></a>netbios aliases (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of NetBIOS names that nmbd will advertise as additional names by which the Samba server is known. This allows one machine to appear in browse lists under multiple names. If a machine is acting as a browse server or logon server none of these names will be advertised as either browse server or logon @@ -1842,16 +1901,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' <i class="parameter"><tt>homedir map</tt></i></a> and return the server listed there.</p><p>Note that for this option to work there must be a working NIS system and the Samba server with this option must also - be a logon server.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">nis homedir = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NONUNIXACCOUNTRANGE"></a>non unix account range (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The non unix account range parameter specifies - the range of 'user ids' that are allocated by the various 'non unix - account' passdb backends. These backends allow - the storage of passwords for users who don't exist in /etc/passwd. - This is most often used for machine account creation. - This range of ids should have no existing local or NIS users within - it as strange conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>These userids never appear on the system and Samba will never - 'become' these users. They are used only to ensure that the algorithmic - RID mapping does not conflict with normal users. - </p></div><p>Default: <b class="command">non unix account range = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">non unix account range = 10000-20000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTACLSUPPORT"></a>nt acl support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map + be a logon server.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">nis homedir = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTACLSUPPORT"></a>nt acl support (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to map UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists. This parameter was formally a global parameter in releases prior to 2.2.2.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">nt acl support = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="NTLMAUTH"></a>ntlm auth (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines whether or not <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will attempt to @@ -1926,9 +1976,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' names to OS/2 printer driver names. The format is:</p><p><nt driver name> = <os2 driver name>.<device name></p><p>For example, a valid entry using the HP LaserJet 5 printer driver would appear as <b class="command">HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP LaserJet 5L</b>.</p><p>The need for the file is due to the printer driver namespace - problem described in the <a href="printing.html" target="_top">Samba - Printing HOWTO</a>. For more details on OS/2 clients, please - refer to the OS2-Client-HOWTO containing in the Samba documentation.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">os2 driver map = <empty string></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OSLEVEL"></a>os level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This integer value controls what level Samba + problem described in <a href="#">???</a>. For more details on OS/2 clients, please + refer to <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">os2 driver map = <empty string></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="OSLEVEL"></a>os level (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This integer value controls what level Samba advertises itself as for browse elections. The value of this parameter determines whether <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <i class="parameter"><tt> @@ -1947,7 +1996,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' <a href="#PASSWDCHAT"><i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat</tt></i></a> parameter for most setups.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">pam password change = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PANICACTION"></a>panic action (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a Samba developer option that allows a system command to be called when either <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> or <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> crashes. This is usually used to - draw attention to the fact that a problem occurred.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">panic action = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">panic action = "/bin/sleep 90000"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"></a>paranoid server security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest + draw attention to the fact that a problem occurred.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">panic action = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">panic action = "/bin/sleep 90000"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PARANOIDSERVERSECURITY"></a>paranoid server security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Some version of NT 4.x allow non-guest users with a bad passowrd. When this option is enabled, samba will not use a broken NT 4.x server as password server, but instead complain to the logs and exit. @@ -1978,12 +2027,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' The MySQL based passdb backend. Takes an identifier as argument. Read the Samba HOWTO Collection for configuration details. - </p></li><li><p><b class="command">guest</b> - - Very simple backend that only provides one user: the guest user. - Only maps the NT guest user to the <i class="parameter"><tt>guest account</tt></i>. - Required in pretty much all situations. </p></li></ul></div><p> - </p><p>Default: <b class="command">passdb backend = smbpasswd</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb smbpasswd:/etc/samba/smbpasswd guest</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passdb backend = ldapsam:ldaps://ldap.example.com guest</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passdb backend = mysql:my_plugin_args tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb guest</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHAT"></a>passwd chat (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This string controls the <span class="emphasis"><em>"chat"</em></span> + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">passdb backend = smbpasswd</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passdb backend = tdbsam:/etc/samba/private/passdb.tdb smbpasswd:/etc/samba/smbpasswd</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passdb backend = ldapsam:ldaps://ldap.example.com</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passdb backend = mysql:my_plugin_args tdbsam</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHAT"></a>passwd chat (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This string controls the <span class="emphasis"><em>"chat"</em></span> conversation that takes places between <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> and the local password changing program to change the user's password. The string describes a sequence of response-receive pairs that <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> uses to determine what to send to the @@ -2005,7 +2050,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' give line-feed, carriage-return, tab and space. The chat sequence string can also contain a '*' which matches any sequence of characters. Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces in them into a single string.</p><p>If the send string in any part of the chat sequence is a full - stop ".", then no string is sent. Similarly, if the + stop ".", then no string is sent. Similarly, if the expect string is a full stop then no string is expected.</p><p>If the <a href="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><i class="parameter"><tt>pam password change</tt></i></a> parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, the chat pairs may be matched in any order, and success is determined by the PAM result, @@ -2015,9 +2060,9 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' passwd program</tt></i></a> ,<a href="#PASSWDCHATDEBUG"> <i class="parameter"><tt>passwd chat debug</tt></i></a> and <a href="#PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"> <i class="parameter"><tt>pam password change</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">passwd chat = *new*password* %n\\n - *new*password* %n\\n *changed*</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\\n - "*Enter NEW password*" %n\\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\\n - "*Password changed*"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"></a>passwd chat debug (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script + *new*password* %n\\n *changed*</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\\n + "*Enter NEW password*" %n\\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\\n + "*Password changed*"</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"></a>passwd chat debug (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script parameter is run in <span class="emphasis"><em>debug</em></span> mode. In this mode the strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed in the <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> log with a @@ -2041,8 +2086,8 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' it.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that if the <i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i> parameter is set to <tt class="constant">yes </tt> then this program is called <span class="emphasis"><em>AS ROOT</em></span> - before the SMB password in the <a href="smbpasswd.5.html" target="_top"><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a> - </a> file is changed. If this UNIX password change fails, then + before the SMB password in the smbpasswd + file is changed. If this UNIX password change fails, then <b class="command">smbd</b> will fail to change the SMB password also (this is by design).</p><p>If the <i class="parameter"><tt>unix password sync</tt></i> parameter is set this parameter <span class="emphasis"><em>MUST USE ABSOLUTE PATHS</em></span> @@ -2057,10 +2102,10 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' family of operating systems. These clients upper case clear text passwords even when NT LM 0.12 selected by the protocol negotiation request/response.</p><p>This parameter defines the maximum number of characters - that may be upper case in passwords.</p><p>For example, say the password given was "FRED". If <i class="parameter"><tt> + that may be upper case in passwords.</p><p>For example, say the password given was "FRED". If <i class="parameter"><tt> password level</tt></i> is set to 1, the following combinations - would be tried if "FRED" failed:</p><p>"Fred", "fred", "fRed", "frEd","freD"</p><p>If <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> was set to 2, - the following combinations would also be tried: </p><p>"FRed", "FrEd", "FreD", "fREd", "fReD", "frED", ..</p><p>And so on.</p><p>The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely + would be tried if "FRED" failed:</p><p>"Fred", "fred", "fRed", "frEd","freD"</p><p>If <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> was set to 2, + the following combinations would also be tried: </p><p>"FRed", "FrEd", "FreD", "fREd", "fReD", "frED", ..</p><p>And so on.</p><p>The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely it is that a mixed case password will be matched against a single case password. However, you should be aware that use of this parameter reduces security and increases the time taken to @@ -2080,7 +2125,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' parameter <a href="#NAMERESOLVEORDER"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a> and so may resolved by any method and order described in that parameter.</p><p>The password server must be a machine capable of using - the "LM1.2X002" or the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, and it must be in + the "LM1.2X002" or the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, and it must be in user level security mode.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>Using a password server means your UNIX box (running Samba) is only as secure as your password server. <span class="emphasis"><em>DO NOT CHOOSE A PASSWORD SERVER THAT YOU DON'T COMPLETELY TRUST</em></span>. @@ -2145,11 +2190,11 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' whenever the service is disconnected. It takes the usual substitutions. The command may be run as the root on some systems.</p><p>An interesting example may be to unmount server - resources:</p><p><b class="command">postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</b></p><p>See also <a href="#PREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none (no command executed)</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">postexec = echo \"%u disconnected from %S from %m (%I)\" >> /tmp/log</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXEC"></a>preexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever + resources:</p><p><b class="command">postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</b></p><p>See also <a href="#PREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none (no command executed)</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">postexec = echo \"%u disconnected from %S from %m (%I)\" >> /tmp/log</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXEC"></a>preexec (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies a command to be run whenever the service is connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.</p><p>An interesting example is to send the users a welcome message every time they log in. Maybe a message of the day? Here - is an example:</p><p><b class="command">preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" | /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' & </b></p><p>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</p><p>See also <a href="#PREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i></a> and <a href="#POSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec - </tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none (no command executed)</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">preexec = echo \"%u connected to %S from %m (%I)\" >> /tmp/log</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXECCLOSE"></a>preexec close (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero + is an example:</p><p><b class="command">preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" | /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' & </b></p><p>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</p><p>See also <a href="#PREEXECCLOSE"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i></a> and <a href="#POSTEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>postexec + </tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>none (no command executed)</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">preexec = echo \"%u connected to %S from %m (%I)\" >> /tmp/log</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREEXECCLOSE"></a>preexec close (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero return code from <a href="#PREEXEC"><i class="parameter"><tt>preexec </tt></i></a> should close the service being connected to.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">preexec close = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREFEREDMASTER"></a>prefered master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#PREFERREDMASTER"><i class="parameter"><tt> preferred master</tt></i></a> for people who cannot spell :-).</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PREFERREDMASTER"></a>preferred master (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls if @@ -2171,8 +2216,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' printcap file loaded then the <a href="#LOADPRINTERS"> <i class="parameter"><tt>load printers</tt></i></a> option is easier.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>no preloaded services</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">preload = fred lp colorlp</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRELOADMODULES"></a>preload modules (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of paths to modules that should be loaded into smbd before a client connects. This improves - the speed of smbd when reacting to new connections somewhat. </p><p>It is recommended to only use this option on heavy-performance - servers.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">preload modules = </b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">preload modules = /usr/lib/samba/passdb/mysql.so+++ </b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRESERVECASE"></a>preserve case (S)</span></dt><dd><p> This controls if new filenames are created + the speed of smbd when reacting to new connections somewhat. </p><p>Default: <b class="command">preload modules = </b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">preload modules = /usr/lib/samba/passdb/mysql.so+++ </b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRESERVECASE"></a>preserve case (S)</span></dt><dd><p> This controls if new filenames are created with the case that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the <a href="#DEFAULTCASE"><i class="parameter"><tt>default case </tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">preserve case = yes</b></p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a> for a fuller discussion.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRINTABLE"></a>printable (S)</span></dt><dd><p>If this parameter is <tt class="constant">yes</tt>, then @@ -2189,7 +2233,7 @@ df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}' </b>. This should be supplemented by an addtional setting <a href="#PRINTING">printing = cups</a> in the [global] section. <b class="command">printcap name = cups</b> will use the - "dummy" printcap created by CUPS, as specified in your CUPS + "dummy" printcap created by CUPS, as specified in your CUPS configuration file. </p><p>On System V systems that use <b class="command">lpstat</b> to list available printers you can use <b class="command">printcap name = lpstat @@ -2272,7 +2316,30 @@ print5|My Printer 5 <i class="parameter"><tt>printable</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PRIVATEDIR"></a>private dir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameters defines the directory smbd will use for storing such files as <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> and <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt>. - </p><p>Default :<b class="command">private dir = ${prefix}/private</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROTOCOL"></a>protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#MAXPROTOCOL"> + </p><p>Default :<b class="command">private dir = ${prefix}/private</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROFILEACLS"></a>profile acls (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> + This boolean parameter was added to fix the problems that people have been + having with storing user profiles on Samba shares from Windows 2000 or + Windows XP clients. New versions of Windows 2000 or Windows XP service + packs do security ACL checking on the owner and ability to write of the + profile directory stored on a local workstation when copied from a Samba + share. +</p><p>When not in domain mode with winbindd then the security info copied + onto the local workstation has no meaning to the logged in user (SID) on + that workstation so the profile storing fails. Adding this parameter + onto a share used for profile storage changes two things about the + returned Windows ACL. Firstly it changes the owner and group owner + of all reported files and directories to be BUILTIN\\Administrators, + BUILTIN\\Users respectively (SIDs S-1-5-32-544, S-1-5-32-545). Secondly + it adds an ACE entry of "Full Control" to the SID BUILTIN\\Users to + every returned ACL. This will allow any Windows 2000 or XP workstation + user to access the profile.</p><p>Note that if you have multiple users logging + on to a workstation then in order to prevent them from being able to access + each others profiles you must remove the "Bypass traverse checking" advanced + user right. This will prevent access to other users profile directories as + the top level profile directory (named after the user) is created by the + workstation profile code and has an ACL restricting entry to the directory + tree to the owning user. +</p><p>Default: <b class="command">profile acls = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PROTOCOL"></a>protocol (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#MAXPROTOCOL"> <i class="parameter"><tt>max protocol</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="PUBLIC"></a>public (S)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#GUESTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"></a>queuepause command (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the command to be executed on the server host in order to pause the printer queue.</p><p>This command should be a program or script which takes @@ -2297,8 +2364,8 @@ print5|My Printer 5 path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the server.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>depends on the setting of <a href="#PRINTING"> <i class="parameter"><tt>printing</tt></i></a></em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">queuepause command = enable %p</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READBMPX"></a>read bmpx (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether - <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will support the "Read - Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used and defaults to + <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will support the "Read + Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used and defaults to <tt class="constant">no</tt>. You should never need to set this parameter.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">read bmpx = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="READLIST"></a>read list (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a list of users that are given read-only access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then @@ -2349,8 +2416,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5 the <a href="#WORKGROUP"><i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup</tt></i></a> parameter is used instead.</p><p>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses - of known browse masters if your network config is that stable.</p><p>See the documentation file <a href="improved-browsing.html" target="_top">BROWSING</a> - in the <tt class="filename">docs/</tt> directory.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">remote announce = <empty string></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"></a>remote browse sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to periodically request + of known browse masters if your network config is that stable.</p><p>See <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">remote announce = <empty string></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"></a>remote browse sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to setup <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> to periodically request synchronization of browse lists with the master browser of a Samba server that is on a remote segment. This option will allow you to gain browse lists for multiple workgroups across routed networks. This @@ -2384,20 +2450,20 @@ print5|My Printer 5 by setting <a href="#GUESTOK"><i class="parameter"><tt>guest ok</tt></i> = yes</a> on any share. </p></div><p>Default: <b class="command">restrict anonymous = 0</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOT"></a>root (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#ROOTDIRECTORY"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory"</tt></i></a>. + <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory"</tt></i></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTDIR"></a>root dir (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#ROOTDIRECTORY"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory"</tt></i></a>. + <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory"</tt></i></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="ROOTDIRECTORY"></a>root directory (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The server will <b class="command">chroot()</b> (i.e. Change its root directory) to this directory on startup. This is not strictly necessary for secure operation. Even without it the server will deny access to files not in one of the service entries. It may also check for, and deny access to, soft links to other - parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use ".." in file names + parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use ".." in file names to access other directories (depending on the setting of the <a href="#WIDELINKS"> <i class="parameter"><tt>wide links</tt></i></a> parameter). </p><p>Adding a <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> entry other - than "/" adds an extra level of security, but at a price. It + than "/" adds an extra level of security, but at a price. It absolutely ensures that no access is given to files not in the sub-tree specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>root directory</tt></i> option, <span class="emphasis"><em>including</em></span> some files needed for @@ -2421,7 +2487,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5 preexec</tt></i></a> and <a href="#PREEXECCLOSE"> <i class="parameter"><tt>preexec close</tt></i></a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">root preexec close = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SECURITY"></a>security (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option affects how clients respond to Samba and is one of the most important settings in the <tt class="filename"> - smb.conf</tt> file.</p><p>The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to + smb.conf</tt> file.</p><p>The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to protocol negotiations with <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide based on this bit whether (and how) to transfer user and password information to the server.</p><p>The default is <b class="command">security = user</b>, as this is @@ -2432,8 +2498,8 @@ print5|My Printer 5 <b class="command">security = share</b> mainly because that was the only option at one stage.</p><p>There is a bug in WfWg that has relevance to this setting. When in user or server level security a WfWg client - will totally ignore the password you type in the "connect - drive" dialog box. This makes it very difficult (if not impossible) + will totally ignore the password you type in the "connect + drive" dialog box. This makes it very difficult (if not impossible) to connect to a Samba service as anyone except the user that you are logged into WfWg as.</p><p>If your PCs use usernames that are the same as their usernames on the UNIX machine then you will want to use @@ -2487,7 +2553,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5 in share-level security as to which UNIX username will eventually be used in granting access.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION"> NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = USER</em></span></p><p>This is the default security setting in Samba 3.0. - With user-level security a client must first "log-on" with a + With user-level security a client must first "log-on" with a valid username and password (which can be mapped using the <a href="#USERNAMEMAP"> <i class="parameter"><tt>username map</tt></i></a> parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"> @@ -2536,7 +2602,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5 does not support them. However note that if encrypted passwords have been negotiated then Samba cannot revert back to checking the UNIX password file, it must have a valid <tt class="filename">smbpasswd</tt> file to check - users against. See the chapter about the User Database in the Samba HOWTO Collection for details on how to set this up.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> this mode of operation has + users against. See the chapter about the User Database in the Samba HOWTO Collection for details on how to set this up.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>This mode of operation has significant pitfalls, due to the fact that is activly initiates a man-in-the-middle attack on the remote SMB server. In particular, this mode of operation can cause significant resource consuption on @@ -2544,11 +2610,11 @@ print5|My Printer 5 of the user's session. Furthermore, if this connection is lost, there is no way to reestablish it, and futher authenticaions to the Samba server may fail. (From a single client, till it disconnects). - </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that from the client's point of + </p></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>From the client's point of view <b class="command">security = server</b> is the same as <b class="command">security = user</b>. It only affects how the server deals with the authentication, it does - not in any way affect what the client sees.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that the name of the resource being + not in any way affect what the client sees.</p></div><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that the name of the resource being requested is <span class="emphasis"><em>not</em></span> sent to the server until after the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing @@ -2558,6 +2624,13 @@ print5|My Printer 5 </a> parameter for details on doing this.</p><p>See also the section <a href="#VALIDATIONSECT" title="NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION"> NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</a>.</p><p>See also the <a href="#PASSWORDSERVER"><i class="parameter"><tt>password server</tt></i></a> parameter and the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"> + <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p><a name="SECURITYEQUALSADS"></a><span class="emphasis"><em>SECURITY = ADS</em></span></p><p>In this mode, Samba will act as a domain member in an ADS realm. To operate + in this mode, the machine running Samba will need to have Kerberos installed + and configured and Samba will need to be joined to the ADS realm using the + net utility. </p><p>Note that this mode does NOT make Samba operate as a Active Directory Domain + Controller. </p><p>Read the chapter about Domain Membership in the HOWTO for details.</p><p>See also the <a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>ads server + </tt></i></a> parameter, the <a href="#REALM"><i class="parameter"><tt>realm + </tt></i></a> paramter and the <a href="#ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"> <i class="parameter"><tt>encrypted passwords</tt></i></a> parameter.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">security = USER</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">security = DOMAIN</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SECURITYMASK"></a>security mask (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security @@ -2570,7 +2643,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5 </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Note</em></span> that users who can access the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction, so it is primarily useful for standalone - "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will + "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave it set to <tt class="constant">0777</tt>.</p><p>See also the <a href="#FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"> <i class="parameter"><tt>force directory security mode</tt></i></a>, <a href="#DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><i class="parameter"><tt>directory @@ -2586,7 +2659,13 @@ print5|My Printer 5 for Windows NT4 before SP4.</p><p>Please note that with this set to <i class="parameter"><tt>no</tt></i> you will have to apply the WindowsXP requireSignOrSeal-Registry patch found in - the docs/Registry subdirectory.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">server schannel = auto</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">server schannel = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSTRING"></a>server string (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in print + the docs/Registry subdirectory.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">server schannel = auto</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">server schannel = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSIGNING"></a>server signing (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls whether the server offers or requires + the client it talks to to use SMB signing. Possible values + are <span class="emphasis"><em>auto</em></span>, <span class="emphasis"><em>mandatory</em></span> + and <span class="emphasis"><em>disabled</em></span>. + </p><p>When set to auto, SMB signing is offered, but not enforced. + When set to mandatory, SMB signing is required and if set + to disabled, SMB signing is not offered either.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">client signing = False</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SERVERSTRING"></a>server string (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This controls what string will show up in the printer comment box in print manager and next to the IPC connection in <b class="command">net view</b>. It can be any string that you wish to show to your users.</p><p>It also sets what will appear in browse lists next to the machine name.</p><p>A <i class="parameter"><tt>%v</tt></i> will be replaced with the Samba @@ -2604,7 +2683,13 @@ print5|My Printer 5 vampire</b>. <i class="parameter"><tt>%u</tt></i> will be replaced with the user whose primary group is to be set. <i class="parameter"><tt>%g</tt></i> will be replaced with the group to - set.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>No default value</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">set primary group script = /usr/sbin/usermod -g '%g' '%u'</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHAREMODES"></a>share modes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This enables or disables the honoring of + set.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>No default value</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">set primary group script = /usr/sbin/usermod -g '%g' '%u'</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SETQUOTACOMMAND"></a>set quota command (G)</span></dt><dd><p>The <b class="command">set quota command</b> should only be used + whenever there is no operating system API available from the OS that + samba can use.</p><p>This parameter should specify the path to a script that + can set quota for the specified arguments.</p><p>The specified script should take the following arguments:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>1 - quota type + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="circle"><li><p>1 - user quotas</p></li><li><p>2 - user default quotas (uid = -1)</p></li><li><p>3 - group quotas</p></li><li><p>4 - group default quotas (gid = -1)</p></li></ul></div><p> + </p></li><li><p>2 - id (uid for user, gid for group, -1 if N/A)</p></li><li><p>3 - quota state (0 = disable, 1 = enable, 2 = enable and enforce)</p></li><li><p>4 - block softlimit</p></li><li><p>5 - block hardlimit</p></li><li><p>6 - inode softlimit</p></li><li><p>7 - inode hardlimit</p></li><li><p>8(optional) - block size, defaults to 1024</p></li></ul></div><p>The script should output at least one line of data.</p><p>See also the <a href="#GETQUOTACOMMAND"><i class="parameter"><tt>get quota command</tt></i></a> parameter. + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">set quota command = </b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">set quota command = /usr/local/sbin/set_quota</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHAREMODES"></a>share modes (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This enables or disables the honoring of the <i class="parameter"><tt>share modes</tt></i> during a file open. These modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or write access to a file.</p><p>These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so @@ -2622,7 +2707,7 @@ print5|My Printer 5 </tt></i></a>. This option can be use with <a href="#PRESERVECASE"><b class="command">preserve case = yes</b> </a> to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short names are lowered. </p><p>See the section on <a href="#NAMEMANGLINGSECT" title="NAME MANGLING">NAME MANGLING</a>.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">short preserve case = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"></a>show add printer wizard (G)</span></dt><dd><p>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support - for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will + for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will appear on Samba hosts in the share listing. Normally this folder will contain an icon for the MS Add Printer Wizard (APW). However, it is possible to disable this feature regardless of the level of privilege @@ -2648,13 +2733,13 @@ print5|My Printer 5 switch <span class="emphasis"><em>-r</em></span>. It means reboot after shutdown for NT.</p></li><li><p><i class="parameter"><tt>%f</tt></i> will be substituted with the switch <span class="emphasis"><em>-f</em></span>. It means force the shutdown - even if applications do not respond for NT.</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>None</em></span>.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">abort shutdown script = /usr/local/samba/sbin/shutdown %m %t %r %f</b></p><p>Shutdown script example: + even if applications do not respond for NT.</p></li></ul></div><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>None</em></span>.</p><p>Example: <b class="command">shutdown script = /usr/local/samba/sbin/shutdown %m %t %r %f</b></p><p>Shutdown script example: </p><pre class="programlisting"> #!/bin/bash $time=0 -let "time/60" -let "time++" +let "time/60" +let "time++" /sbin/shutdown $3 $4 +$time $1 & </pre><p> @@ -2675,7 +2760,7 @@ Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background. suggest you read the appropriate documentation for your operating system first (perhaps <b class="command">man setsockopt</b> will help).</p><p>You may find that on some systems Samba will say - "Unknown socket option" when you supply an option. This means you + "Unknown socket option" when you supply an option. This means you either incorrectly typed it or you need to add an include file to includes.h for your OS. If the latter is the case please send the patch to <a href="mailto:samba-technical@samba.org" target="_top"> @@ -2690,15 +2775,13 @@ Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background. might be:</p><p><b class="command">socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</b></p><p>If you have a local network then you could try:</p><p><b class="command">socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY TCP_NODELAY</b></p><p>If you are on a wide area network then perhaps try setting IPTOS_THROUGHPUT. </p><p>Note that several of the options may cause your Samba server to fail completely. Use these options with caution!</p><p>Default: <b class="command">socket options = TCP_NODELAY</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="SOURCEENVIRONMENT"></a>source environment (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter causes Samba to set environment - variables as per the content of the file named.</p><p>If the value of this parameter starts with a "|" character + variables as per the content of the file named.</p><p>If the value of this parameter starts with a "|" character then Samba will treat that value as a pipe command to open and will set the environment variables from the output of the pipe.</p><p>The contents of the file or the output of the pipe should be formatted as the output of the standard Unix <b class="command">env(1)</b> command. This is of the form:</p><p>Example environment entry:</p><p><b class="command">SAMBA_NETBIOS_NAME = myhostname</b></p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>No default value</em></span></p><p>Examples: <b class="command">source environment = |/etc/smb.conf.sh</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">source environment = /usr/local/smb_env_vars</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STATCACHE"></a>stat cache (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will use a cache in order to speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should never need - to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">stat cache = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STATCACHESIZE"></a>stat cache size (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines the number of - entries in the <i class="parameter"><tt>stat cache</tt></i>. You should - never need to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">stat cache size = 50</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTALLOCATE"></a>strict allocate (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of + to change this parameter.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">stat cache = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="STRICTALLOCATE"></a>strict allocate (S)</span></dt><dd><p>This is a boolean that controls the handling of disk space allocation in the server. When this is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> the server will change from UNIX behaviour of not committing real disk storage blocks when a file is extended to the Windows behaviour @@ -2755,23 +2838,17 @@ Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background. string <i class="parameter"><tt>%D</tt></i> is present it is substituted with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the string <i class="parameter"><tt>%U</tt></i> is present it - is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">template homedir = /home/%D/%U</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATESHELL"></a>template shell (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT + is substituted with the user's Windows NT user name.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">template homedir = /home/%D/%U</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATEPRIMARYGROUP"></a>template primary group (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This option defines the default primary group for + each user created by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>'s local account management + functions (similar to the 'add user script'). + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">template primary group = nobody</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TEMPLATESHELL"></a>template shell (G)</span></dt><dd><p>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT user, the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon uses this parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">template shell = /bin/false</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMEOFFSET"></a>time offset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add to the normal GMT to local time conversion. This is useful if you are serving a lot of PCs that have incorrect daylight saving time handling.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">time offset = 0</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">time offset = 60</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMESERVER"></a>time server (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter determines if <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> advertises itself as a time server to Windows clients.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">time server = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TIMESTAMPLOGS"></a>timestamp logs (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Synonym for <a href="#DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><i class="parameter"><tt> - debug timestamp</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="TOTALPRINTJOBS"></a>total print jobs (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter accepts an integer value which defines - a limit on the maximum number of print jobs that will be accepted - system wide at any given time. If a print job is submitted - by a client which will exceed this number, then <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a> will return an - error indicating that no space is available on the server. The - default value of 0 means that no such limit exists. This parameter - can be used to prevent a server from exceeding its capacity and is - designed as a printing throttle. See also <a href="#MAXPRINTJOBS"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>max print jobs</tt></i></a>. - </p><p>Default: <b class="command">total print jobs = 0</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">total print jobs = 5000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNICODE"></a>unicode (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether Samba should try + debug timestamp</tt></i></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNICODE"></a>unicode (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies whether Samba should try to use unicode on the wire by default. Note: This does NOT mean that samba will assume that the unix machine uses unicode! </p><p>Default: <b class="command">unicode = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXCHARSET"></a>unix charset (G)</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies the charset the unix machine @@ -2782,7 +2859,7 @@ Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background. These extensions enable Samba to better serve UNIX CIFS clients by supporting features such as symbolic links, hard links, etc... These extensions require a similarly enabled client, and are of - no current use to Windows clients.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">unix extensions = no</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"></a>unix password sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba + no current use to Windows clients.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">unix extensions = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"></a>unix password sync (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba attempts to synchronize the UNIX password with the SMB password when the encrypted SMB password in the smbpasswd file is changed. If this is set to <tt class="constant">yes</tt> the program specified in the <i class="parameter"><tt>passwd @@ -2826,7 +2903,7 @@ Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background. logged on user. If the user possesses local administator rights but not root privilegde on the Samba host (often the case), the OpenPrinterEx() call will fail. The result is that the client will - now display an "Access Denied; Unable to connect" message + now display an "Access Denied; Unable to connect" message in the printer queue window (even though jobs may successfully be printed). </p><p>If this parameter is enabled for a printer, then any attempt to open the printer with the PRINTER_ACCESS_ADMINISTER right is mapped @@ -2910,8 +2987,8 @@ Shutdown does not return so we need to launch it in background. to the UNIX name <tt class="constant">sys</tt> you would use:</p><p><b class="command">sys = @system</b></p><p>You can have as many mappings as you like in a username map file.</p><p>If your system supports the NIS NETGROUP option then the netgroup database is checked before the <tt class="filename">/etc/group </tt> database for matching groups.</p><p>You can map Windows usernames that have spaces in them - by using double quotes around the name. For example:</p><p><b class="command">tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</b></p><p>would map the windows username "Andrew Tridgell" to the - unix username "tridge".</p><p>The following example would map mary and fred to the + by using double quotes around the name. For example:</p><p><b class="command">tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</b></p><p>would map the windows username "Andrew Tridgell" to the + unix username "tridge".</p><p>The following example would map mary and fred to the unix user sys, and map the rest to guest. Note the use of the '!' to tell Samba to stop processing if it gets a match on that line.</p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -3032,7 +3109,13 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/ that Samba has to do in order to perform the link checks.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">wide links = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDCACHETIME"></a>winbind cache time (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the number of seconds the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon will cache user and group information before querying a Windows NT server - again.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind cache type = 15</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"></a>winbind enum groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be necessary to suppress + again.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind cache type = 300</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENABLELOCALACCOUNTS"></a>winbind enable local accounts (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter controls whether or not winbindd + will act as a stand in replacement for the various account + management hooks in smb.conf (e.g. 'add user script'). + If enabled, winbindd will support the creation of local + users and groups as another source of UNIX account information + available via getpwnam() or getgrgid(), etc... + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind enable local accounts = yes</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"></a>winbind enum groups (G)</span></dt><dd><p>On large installations using <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> it may be necessary to suppress the enumeration of groups through the <b class="command">setgrent()</b>, <b class="command">getgrent()</b> and <b class="command">endgrent()</b> group of system calls. If @@ -3060,10 +3143,16 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/ and <tt class="filename">nss_winbind.so</tt> modules for UNIX services. </p><p>Please note that setting this parameter to + causes problems with group membership at least on glibc systems, as the character + - is used as a special character for NIS in /etc/group.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind separator = '\'</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">winbind separator = +</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUID"></a>winbind uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is now an alias for <b class="command">idmap uid</b></p><p>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are allocated by the + is used as a special character for NIS in /etc/group.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind separator = '\'</b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">winbind separator = +</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDTRUSTEDDOMAINSONLY"></a>winbind trusted domains only (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is designed to allow Samba servers that + are members of a Samba controlled domain to use UNIX accounts + distributed vi NIS, rsync, or LDAP as the uid's for winbindd users + in the hosts primary domain. Therefore, the user 'SAMBA\user1' would + be mapped to the account 'user1' in /etc/passwd instead of allocating + a new uid for him or her. + </p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind trusted domains only = <no></b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUID"></a>winbind uid (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter is now an alias for <b class="command">idmap uid</b></p><p>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of user ids that are allocated by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon. This range of ids should have no existing local or NIS users within it as strange - conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind uid = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">winbind uid = 10000-20000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUSEDDEFAULTDOMAIN"></a>winbind used default domain (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether the + conflicts can occur otherwise.</p><p>Default: <b class="command">winbind uid = <empty string></b></p><p>Example: <b class="command">winbind uid = 10000-20000</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"></a>winbind use default domain (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies whether the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon should operate on users without domain component in their username. Users without a domain component are treated as is part of the winbindd server's own @@ -3075,11 +3164,11 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/ dynamic update of external name resolution databases such as dynamic DNS.</p><p>The wins hook parameter specifies the name of a script or executable that will be called as follows:</p><p><b class="command">wins_hook operation name nametype ttl IP_list</b></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>The first argument is the operation and is - one of "add", "delete", or - "refresh". In most cases the operation + one of "add", "delete", or + "refresh". In most cases the operation can be ignored as the rest of the parameters provide sufficient information. Note that - "refresh" may sometimes be called when + "refresh" may sometimes be called when the name has not previously been added, in that case it should be treated as an add.</p></li><li><p>The second argument is the NetBIOS name. If the name is not a legal name then the wins hook is not called. @@ -3090,7 +3179,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/ addresses currently registered for that name. If this list is empty then the name should be deleted.</p></li></ul></div><p>An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update program <b class="command">nsupdate</b> is provided in the examples - directory of the Samba source code. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSPARTNER"></a>wins partner (G)</span></dt><dd><p>A space separated list of partners' IP addresses for + directory of the Samba source code. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSPARTNERS"></a>wins partners (G)</span></dt><dd><p>A space separated list of partners' IP addresses for WINS replication. WINS partners are always defined as push/pull partners as defining only one way WINS replication is unreliable. WINS replication is currently experimental and unreliable between @@ -3106,7 +3195,7 @@ veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/ seperated from the ip address by a colon. </p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p>You need to set up Samba to point to a WINS server if you have multiple subnets and wish cross-subnet - browsing to work correctly.</p></div><p>See the documentation file <a href="improved-browsing.html" target="_top">Browsing</a> in the samba howto collection.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>not enabled</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">wins server = mary:192.9.200.1 fred:192.168.3.199 mary:192.168.2.61</b></p><p>For this example when querying a certain name, 192.19.200.1 will + browsing to work correctly.</p></div><p>See the <a href="#">???</a>.</p><p>Default: <span class="emphasis"><em>not enabled</em></span></p><p>Example: <b class="command">wins server = mary:192.9.200.1 fred:192.168.3.199 mary:192.168.2.61</b></p><p>For this example when querying a certain name, 192.19.200.1 will be asked first and if that doesn't respond 192.168.2.61. If either of those doesn't know the name 192.168.3.199 will be queried. </p><p>Example: <b class="command">wins server = 192.9.200.1 192.168.2.61</b></p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a name="WINSSUPPORT"></a>wins support (G)</span></dt><dd><p>This boolean controls if the <a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html index d7c5fed1b5..1c3cc5a2d3 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbcacls.1.html @@ -10,10 +10,10 @@ only the ones specified on the command line. All other ACLs are erased. Note that the ACL specified must contain at least a revision, type, owner and group for the call to succeed. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U username</span></dt><dd><p>Specifies a username used to connect to the - specified service. The username may be of the form "username" in + specified service. The username may be of the form "username" in which case the user is prompted to enter in a password and the workgroup specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file is - used, or "username%password" or "DOMAIN\username%password" and the + used, or "username%password" or "DOMAIN\username%password" and the password and workgroup names are used as provided. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-C name</span></dt><dd><p>The owner of a file or directory can be changed to the name given using the <i class="parameter"><tt>-C</tt></i> option. The name can be a sid in the form S-1-x-y-z or a name resolved @@ -34,8 +34,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -49,10 +48,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2800108"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>ACL FORMAT</h2><p>The format of an ACL is one or more ACL entries separated by either commas or newlines. An ACL entry is one of the following: </p><pre class="programlisting"> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html index ecb85d6e85..1ee5fd26da 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbclient.1.html @@ -84,12 +84,7 @@ messages. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p port</span></dt><dd><p>This number is the TCP port number that will be used when making connections to the server. The standard (well-known) TCP port number for an SMB/CIFS server is 139, which is the - default. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l logfilename</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, <i class="replaceable"><tt>logfilename</tt></i> specifies a base filename - into which operational data from the running client will be - logged. </p><p>The default base name is specified at compile time.</p><p>The base name is used to generate actual log file names. - For example, if the name specified was "log", the debug file - would be <tt class="filename">log.client</tt>.</p><p>The log file generated is never removed by the client. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. + default. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I IP-address</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>IP address</tt></i> is the address of the server to connect to. It should be specified in standard "a.b.c.d" notation. </p><p>Normally the client would attempt to locate a named SMB/CIFS server by looking it up via the NetBIOS name resolution @@ -126,8 +121,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -141,9 +135,8 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797426"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension <tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal @@ -177,10 +170,10 @@ via the <b class="command">ps</b> command. To be safe always allow <b class="command">rpcclient</b> to prompt for a password and type it in directly. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n <primary NetBIOS name></span></dt><dd><p>This option allows you to override the NetBIOS name that Samba uses for itself. This is identical -to setting the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#netbiosname" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>NetBIOS -name</tt></i></a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. However, a command +to setting the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797632"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>netbios name</tt></i> parameter in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. +However, a command line setting will take precedence over settings in -<a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i <scope></span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that +<tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i <scope></span></dt><dd><p>This specifies a NetBIOS scope that <b class="command">nmblookup</b> will use to communicate with when generating NetBIOS names. For details on the use of NetBIOS scopes, see rfc1001.txt and rfc1002.txt. NetBIOS scopes are @@ -192,7 +185,7 @@ smb.conf. If the domain specified is the same as the servers NetBIOS name, it causes the client to log on using the servers local SAM (as opposed to the Domain SAM). </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O socket options</span></dt><dd><p>TCP socket options to set on the client socket. See the socket options parameter in -the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> manual page for the list of valid +the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page for the list of valid options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-T tar options</span></dt><dd><p>smbclient may be used to create <b class="command">tar(1) </b> compatible backups of all the files on an SMB/CIFS share. The secondary tar flags that can be given to this option diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html index 21344b9ade..e7ccd27f26 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbcontrol.1.html @@ -5,8 +5,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Run interactively. Individual commands of the form destination message-type parameters can be entered @@ -58,7 +57,9 @@ compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Run interactiv talloc(pool) memory usage by the specified daemon/process. Available for both smbd and nmbd.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">drvupgrade</span></dt><dd><p>Force clients of printers using specified driver to update their local version of the driver. Can only be - sent to smbd.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of + sent to smbd.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">reload-config</span></dt><dd><p>Force daemon to reload smb.conf configuration file. Can be sent + to <tt class="constant">smbd</tt>, <tt class="constant">nmbd</tt>, or <tt class="constant">winbindd</tt>. + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="nmbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">nmbd</span>(8)</span></a> and <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbcquotas.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbcquotas.1.html index 468edd1d61..59dcd106ed 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbcquotas.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbcquotas.1.html @@ -14,8 +14,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -29,9 +28,8 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2796846"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension <tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html index 5b71bd7196..291ddbc0f6 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbd.8.html @@ -54,8 +54,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -69,9 +68,8 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2796921"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension <tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. @@ -82,7 +80,8 @@ never removed by the client. file will be created for informational and debug messages from the running server. The log file generated is never removed by the server although - its size may be controlled by the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#maxlogsize" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i></a> + its size may be controlled by the + <a class="indexterm" name="id2797022"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>max log size</tt></i> option in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. <span class="emphasis"><em>Beware:</em></span> If the directory specified does not exist, <b class="command">smbd</b> will log to the default debug log location defined at compile time. @@ -104,18 +103,15 @@ never removed by the client. in the above situation.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If the server is to be run by the <b class="command">inetd</b> meta-daemon, this file must contain suitable startup information for the - meta-daemon. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</a> - document for details. + meta-daemon. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/rc</tt></span></dt><dd><p>or whatever initialization script your system uses).</p><p>If running the server as a daemon at startup, this file will need to contain an appropriate startup - sequence for the server. See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</a> - document for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If running the server via the + sequence for the server. </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/services</tt></span></dt><dd><p>If running the server via the meta-daemon <b class="command">inetd</b>, this file must contain a mapping of service name (e.g., netbios-ssn) to service port (e.g., 139) and protocol type (e.g., tcp). - See the <a href="install.html" target="_top">"How to Install and Test SAMBA"</a> - document for details.</p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file. Other common places that systems + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is the default location of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> server configuration file. Other common places that systems install this file are <tt class="filename">/usr/samba/lib/smb.conf</tt> and <tt class="filename">/etc/samba/smb.conf</tt>.</p><p>This file describes all the services the server is to make available to clients. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> for more information.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>LIMITATIONS</h2><p>On some systems <b class="command">smbd</b> cannot change uid back @@ -131,8 +127,7 @@ never removed by the client. is not specific to the server, however.</p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>PAM INTERACTION</h2><p>Samba uses PAM for authentication (when presented with a plaintext password), for account checking (is this account disabled?) and for session management. The degree too which samba supports PAM is restricted - by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#OBEYPAMRESRICTIONS" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>obey - pam restricions</tt></i></a> <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> paramater. When this is set, the following restrictions apply: + by the limitations of the SMB protocol and the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797347"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>obey pam restrictions</tt></i> <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> paramater. When this is set, the following restrictions apply: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>Account Validation</em></span>: All accesses to a samba server are checked against PAM to see if the account is vaild, not disabled and is permitted to diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html index 233dee51d7..64968b5de7 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbmount.8.html @@ -1,14 +1,14 @@ <html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbmount</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbmount.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbmount — mount an smbfs filesystem</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbmount</tt> {service} {mount-point} [-o options]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p><b class="command">smbmount</b> mounts a Linux SMB filesystem. It is usually invoked as <b class="command">mount.smbfs</b> by the <a href="mount.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">mount</span>(8)</span></a> command when using the - "-t smbfs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must + "-t smbfs" option. This command only works in Linux, and the kernel must support the smbfs filesystem. </p><p>Options to <b class="command">smbmount</b> are specified as a comma-separated list of key=value pairs. It is possible to send options other than those listed here, assuming that smbfs supports them. If you get mount failures, check your kernel log for errors on unknown options.</p><p><b class="command">smbmount</b> is a daemon. After mounting it keeps running until the mounted smbfs is umounted. It will log things that happen - when in daemon mode using the "machine name" smbmount, so + when in daemon mode using the "machine name" smbmount, so typically this output will end up in <tt class="filename">log.smbmount</tt>. The <b class="command"> smbmount</b> process may also be called mount.smbfs.</p><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> <b class="command">smbmount</b> calls <a href="smbmnt.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbmnt</span>(8)</span></a> to do the actual mount. You @@ -16,8 +16,8 @@ that it can be found. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">username=<arg></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the username to connect as. If this is not given, then the environment variable <tt class="envar"> USER</tt> is used. This option can also take the - form "user%password" or "user/workgroup" or - "user/workgroup%password" to allow the password and workgroup + form "user%password" or "user/workgroup" or + "user/workgroup%password" to allow the password and workgroup to be specified as part of the username.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">password=<arg></span></dt><dd><p>specifies the SMB password. If this option is not given then the environment variable <tt class="envar">PASSWD</tt> is used. If it can find diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html index 556b637f4f..feb899f946 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.5.html @@ -19,8 +19,8 @@ Note that this password hash is regarded as weak as it is vulnerable to dictionary attacks and if two users choose the same password this entry will be identical (i.e. the password - is not "salted" as the UNIX password is). If the user has a - null password this field will contain the characters "NO PASSWORD" + is not "salted" as the UNIX password is). If the user has a + null password this field will contain the characters "NO PASSWORD" as the start of the hex string. If the hex string is equal to 32 'X' characters then the user's account is marked as <tt class="constant">disabled</tt> and the user will not be able to @@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ password and uses a much higher quality hashing algorithm. However, it is still the case that if two users choose the same password this entry will be identical (i.e. the password is - not "salted" as the UNIX password is). </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING !!</em></span>. Note that, due to + not "salted" as the UNIX password is). </p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>WARNING !!</em></span>. Note that, due to the challenge-response nature of the SMB/CIFS authentication protocol, anyone with a knowledge of this password hash will be able to impersonate the user on the network. For this @@ -59,20 +59,21 @@ 13 characters in length (including the '[' and ']' characters). The contents of this field may be any of the following characters: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>U</em></span> - This means - this is a "User" account, i.e. an ordinary user. Only User + this is a "User" account, i.e. an ordinary user. Only User and Workstation Trust accounts are currently supported in the smbpasswd file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>N</em></span> - This means the account has no password (the passwords in the fields LANMAN Password Hash and NT Password Hash are ignored). Note that this will only allow users to log on with no password if the <i class="parameter"><tt> - null passwords</tt></i> parameter is set in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#NULLPASSWORDS" target="_top"><a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a></a> config file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - This means the account + null passwords</tt></i> parameter is set in the + <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> config file. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>D</em></span> - This means the account is disabled and no SMB/CIFS logins will be allowed for this user. </p></li><li><p><span class="emphasis"><em>W</em></span> - This means this account - is a "Workstation Trust" account. This kind of account is used + is a "Workstation Trust" account. This kind of account is used in the Samba PDC code stream to allow Windows NT Workstations and Servers to join a Domain hosted by a Samba PDC. </p></li></ul></div><p>Other flags may be added as the code is extended in future. The rest of this field space is filled in with spaces. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">Last Change Time</span></dt><dd><p>This field consists of the time the account was last modified. It consists of the characters 'LCT-' (standing for - "Last Change Time") followed by a numeric encoding of the UNIX time + "Last Change Time") followed by a numeric encoding of the UNIX time in seconds since the epoch (1970) that the last change was made. </p></dd></dl></div><p>All other colon separated fields are ignored at this time.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(8)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>, and diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html index 7612fdd775..7c98e4b080 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbpasswd.8.html @@ -16,7 +16,7 @@ for their new password twice, to ensure that the new password was typed correctly. No passwords will be echoed on the screen whilst being typed. If you have a blank SMB password (specified by - the string "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd file) then just press + the string "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd file) then just press the <Enter> key when asked for your old password. </p><p>smbpasswd can also be used by a normal user to change their SMB password on remote machines, such as Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers. See the (<i class="parameter"><tt>-r</tt></i>) and <i class="parameter"><tt>-U</tt></i> options @@ -64,10 +64,10 @@ HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n</span></dt><dd><p>This option specifies that the username following should have their password set to null (i.e. a blank password) in - the local smbpasswd file. This is done by writing the string "NO - PASSWORD" as the first part of the first password stored in the + the local smbpasswd file. This is done by writing the string "NO + PASSWORD" as the first part of the first password stored in the smbpasswd file. </p><p>Note that to allow users to logon to a Samba server once - the password has been set to "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd + the password has been set to "NO PASSWORD" in the smbpasswd file the administrator must set the following parameter in the [global] section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file : </p><p><b class="command">null passwords = yes</b></p><p>This option is only available when running smbpasswd as root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r remote machine name</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows a user to specify what machine @@ -89,7 +89,7 @@ a real password database so it is not possible to change passwords specifying a Win95/98 machine as remote machine target. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R name resolve order</span></dt><dd><p>This option allows the user of smbpasswd to determine what name resolution services to use when looking up the NetBIOS - name of the host being connected to. </p><p>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They + name of the host being connected to. </p><p>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They cause names to be resolved as follows: </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt>: Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <a href="lmhosts.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">lmhosts</span>(5)</span></a> for details) then @@ -127,8 +127,7 @@ has been configured to use the experimental <b class="command">--with-ldapsam</b> option. The <i class="parameter"><tt>-w</tt></i> switch is used to specify the password to be used with the - <a href="smb.conf.5.html#LDAPADMINDN" target="_top"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin - dn</tt></i></a>. Note that the password is stored in + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800537"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i></a>. Note that the password is stored in the <tt class="filename">secrets.tdb</tt> and is keyed off of the admin's DN. This means that if the value of <i class="parameter"><tt>ldap admin dn</tt></i> ever changes, the password will need to be @@ -148,10 +147,8 @@ smbd</b> running on the local machine by specifying either <i class="parameter"><tt>allow hosts</tt></i> or <i class="parameter"><tt>deny hosts</tt></i> entry in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file and neglecting to - allow "localhost" access to the smbd. </p><p>In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba - has been set up to use encrypted passwords. See the document <a href="pwencrypt.html" target="_top"> - "LanMan and NT Password Encryption in Samba"</a> in the docs directory for details - on how to do this. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities + allow "localhost" access to the smbd. </p><p>In addition, the smbpasswd command is only useful if Samba + has been set up to use encrypted passwords. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>SEE ALSO</h2><p><a href="smbpasswd.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbpasswd</span>(5)</span></a>, <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a>.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>AUTHOR</h2><p>The original Samba software and related utilities were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</p><p>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer. diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html index 935576af6b..d1360d849d 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbsh.1.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbsh</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbsh.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbsh — Allows access to Windows NT filesystem +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbsh</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbsh.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbsh — Allows access to remote SMB shares using UNIX commands</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbsh</tt> [-W workgroup] [-U username] [-P prefix] [-R <name resolve order>] [-d <debug level>] [-l logfile] [-L libdir]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbsh</b> allows you to access an NT filesystem using UNIX commands such as <b class="command">ls</b>, <b class="command"> egrep</b>, and <b class="command">rcp</b>. You must use a @@ -19,8 +19,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -34,12 +33,11 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R <name resolve order></span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to determine what naming +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2796897"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-R <name resolve order></span></dt><dd><p>This option is used to determine what naming services and in what order to resolve host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space-separated -string of different name resolution options.</p><p>The options are: "lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". +string of different name resolution options.</p><p>The options are: "lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They cause names to be resolved as follows :</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><tt class="constant">lmhosts</tt>: Lookup an IP address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has no name type attached to the @@ -67,11 +65,11 @@ parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally connected subnet. </p></li></ul></div><p>If this parameter is not set then the name resolve order -defined in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file parameter -(<i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i>) will be used. </p><p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast. Without -this parameter or any entry in the <i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order -</tt></i> parameter of the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file, the name resolution methods -will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L libdir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the location of the +defined in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file parameter +(<a class="indexterm" name="id2797172"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a>) will be used. +</p><p>The default order is lmhosts, host, wins, bcast. Without +this parameter or any entry in the <a class="indexterm" name="id2797198"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>name resolve order</tt></i></a> parameter of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file, the name +resolution methods will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L libdir</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter specifies the location of the shared libraries used by <b class="command">smbsh</b>. The default value is specified at compile time. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLES</h2><p>To use the <b class="command">smbsh</b> command, execute <b class="command"> @@ -93,7 +91,7 @@ will be attempted in this order. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L libdir</span cd</b> command to change directories, <b class="command">vi</b> to edit files, and <b class="command">rcp</b> to copy files.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>VERSION</h2><p>This man page is correct for version 3.0 of the Samba suite.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>BUGS</h2><p><b class="command">smbsh</b> works by intercepting the standard libc calls with the dynamically loaded versions in <tt class="filename"> - smbwrapper.o</tt>. Not all calls have been "wrapped", so + smbwrapper.o</tt>. Not all calls have been "wrapped", so some programs may not function correctly under <b class="command">smbsh </b>.</p><p>Programs which are not dynamically linked cannot make use of <b class="command">smbsh</b>'s functionality. Most versions diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html index 186f30ebcf..7366ab458f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbspool.8.html @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ are position-dependent for compatibility with the Common UNIX Printing System, but you can use smbspool with any printing system or from a program or script.</p><p><span class="emphasis"><em>DEVICE URI</em></span></p><p>smbspool specifies the destination using a Uniform Resource - Identifier ("URI") with a method of "smb". This string can take + Identifier ("URI") with a method of "smb". This string can take a number of forms:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>smb://server/printer</p></li><li><p>smb://workgroup/server/printer</p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@server/printer</p></li><li><p>smb://username:password@workgroup/server/printer</p></li></ul></div><p>smbspool tries to get the URI from argv[0]. If argv[0] contains the name of the program then it looks in the <tt class="envar"> DEVICE_URI</tt> environment variable.</p><p>Programs using the <b class="command">exec(2)</b> functions can diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html index c1be6234c3..99b152e75c 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbstatus.1.html @@ -7,8 +7,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -22,9 +21,8 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2796685"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension <tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v|--verbose</span></dt><dd><p>gives verbose output.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-L|--locks</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to only list locks.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B|--byterange</span></dt><dd><p>causes smbstatus to include byte range locks. diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html index 30058d1860..95aabf1bc3 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbtar.1.html @@ -2,7 +2,7 @@ directly to UNIX tape drives</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbtar</tt> [-r] [-i] [-a] [-v] {-s server} [-p password] [-x services] [-X] [-N filename] [-b blocksize] [-d directory] [-l loglevel] [-u user] [-t tape] {filenames}</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbtar</b> is a very small shell script on top of <a href="smbclient.1.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbclient</span>(1)</span></a> which dumps SMB shares directly to tape.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-s server</span></dt><dd><p>The SMB/CIFS server that the share resides upon.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-x service</span></dt><dd><p>The share name on the server to connect to. - The default is "backup".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-X</span></dt><dd><p>Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar + The default is "backup".</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-X</span></dt><dd><p>Exclude mode. Exclude filenames... from tar create or restore. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d directory</span></dt><dd><p>Change to initial <i class="parameter"><tt>directory </tt></i> before restoring / backing up files. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-v</span></dt><dd><p>Verbose mode.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p password</span></dt><dd><p>The password to use to access a share. Default: none </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u user</span></dt><dd><p>The user id to connect as. Default: diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/smbtree.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/smbtree.1.html index 6cf24ddf91..cc683838dd 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/smbtree.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/smbtree.1.html @@ -1,6 +1,6 @@ <html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>smbtree</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="smbtree.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>smbtree — A text based smb network browser </p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">smbtree</tt> [-b] [-D] [-S]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">smbtree</b> is a smb browser program - in text mode. It is similar to the "Network Neighborhood" found + in text mode. It is similar to the "Network Neighborhood" found on Windows computers. It prints a tree with all the known domains, the servers in those domains and the shares on the servers. @@ -17,8 +17,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -32,10 +31,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2799845"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N</span></dt><dd><p>If specified, this parameter suppresses the normal password prompt from the client to the user. This is useful when diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/speed.html b/docs/htmldocs/speed.html index 626d5e0193..47f19abb70 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/speed.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/speed.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients"><link rel="next" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="speed"></a>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Cochrane</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Dundee Limb Fitting Centre<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018768">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018812">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018887">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018931">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3018984">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019007">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019064">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019106">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019127">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019154">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id3019185">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018768"></a>Comparisons</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="Appendixes.html" title="Part VI. Appendixes"><link rel="previous" href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients"><link rel="next" href="DNSDHCP.html" title="Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part VI. Appendixes</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="speed"></a>Chapter 39. Samba Performance Tuning</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Paul</span> <span class="surname">Cochrane</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Dundee Limb Fitting Centre<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk">paulc@dth.scot.nhs.uk</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964209">Comparisons</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964253">Socket options</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964343">Read size</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964393">Max xmit</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964453">Log level</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964483">Read raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964567">Write raw</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964630">Slow Logins</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964659">Client tuning</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964684">Samba performance problem due changing kernel</a></dt><dt><a href="speed.html#id2964716">Corrupt tdb Files</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964209"></a>Comparisons</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> The Samba server uses TCP to talk to the client. Thus if you are trying to see if it performs well you should really compare it to programs that use the same protocol. The most readily available @@ -20,14 +20,14 @@ suspect the biggest factor is not Samba vs some other system but the hardware and drivers used on the various systems. Given similar hardware Samba should certainly be competitive in speed with other systems. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018812"></a>Socket options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964253"></a>Socket options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> There are a number of socket options that can greatly affect the performance of a TCP based server like Samba. </p><p> The socket options that Samba uses are settable both on the command line with the <tt class="option">-O</tt> option, or in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file. </p><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page describes how +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2964287"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> section of the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> manual page describes how to set these and gives recommendations. </p><p> Getting the socket options right can make a big difference to your @@ -36,11 +36,11 @@ much. The correct settings are very dependent on your local network. </p><p> The socket option TCP_NODELAY is the one that seems to make the biggest single difference for most networks. Many people report that -adding <i class="parameter"><tt>socket options = TCP_NODELAY</tt></i> doubles the read +adding <a class="indexterm" name="id2964323"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>socket options</tt></i> = TCP_NODELAY doubles the read performance of a Samba drive. The best explanation I have seen for this is that the Microsoft TCP/IP stack is slow in sending tcp ACKs. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018887"></a>Read size</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The option <i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i> affects the overlap of disk +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964343"></a>Read size</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The option <a class="indexterm" name="id2964353"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read size</tt></i> affects the overlap of disk reads/writes with network reads/writes. If the amount of data being transferred in several of the SMB commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and SMBreadbraw) is larger than this value then the server begins writing @@ -56,10 +56,10 @@ The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation has been done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely that the best value will vary greatly between systems anyway. A value over 65536 is pointless and will cause you to allocate memory unnecessarily. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018931"></a>Max xmit</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -At startup the client and server negotiate a <i class="parameter"><tt>maximum transmit</tt></i> size, +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964393"></a>Max xmit</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + At startup the client and server negotiate a <i class="parameter"><tt>maximum transmit</tt></i> size, which limits the size of nearly all SMB commands. You can set the -maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit = </tt></i> option +maximum size that Samba will negotiate using the <a class="indexterm" name="id2964414"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>max xmit</tt></i> option in <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt>. Note that this is the maximum size of SMB requests that Samba will accept, but not the maximum size that the *client* will accept. The client maximum receive size is sent to Samba by the client and Samba @@ -70,41 +70,41 @@ clients may perform better with a smaller transmit unit. Trying values of less than 2048 is likely to cause severe problems. </p><p> In most cases the default is the best option. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3018984"></a>Log level</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -If you set the log level (also known as <i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i>) higher than 2 +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964453"></a>Log level</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +If you set the log level (also known as <a class="indexterm" name="id2964463"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>debug level</tt></i>) higher than 2 then you may suffer a large drop in performance. This is because the server flushes the log file after each operation, which can be very expensive. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3019007"></a>Read raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964483"></a>Read raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2964492"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency file read operation. A server may choose to not support it, -however. and Samba makes support for <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> optional, with it +however. and Samba makes support for <a class="indexterm" name="id2964510"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> optional, with it being enabled by default. </p><p> -In some cases clients don't handle <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> very well and actually +In some cases clients don't handle <a class="indexterm" name="id2964528"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> very well and actually get lower performance using it than they get using the conventional read operations. </p><p> -So you might like to try <i class="parameter"><tt>read raw = no</tt></i> and see what happens on your +So you might like to try <a class="indexterm" name="id2964549"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>read raw</tt></i> = no and see what happens on your network. It might lower, raise or not affect your performance. Only testing can really tell. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3019064"></a>Write raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964567"></a>Write raw</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +The <a class="indexterm" name="id2964577"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> operation is designed to be an optimised, low-latency file write operation. A server may choose to not support it, -however. and Samba makes support for <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> optional, with it +however. and Samba makes support for <a class="indexterm" name="id2964594"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> optional, with it being enabled by default. </p><p> -Some machines may find <i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> slower than normal write, in which +Some machines may find <a class="indexterm" name="id2964613"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>write raw</tt></i> slower than normal write, in which case you may wish to change this option. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3019106"></a>Slow Logins</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964630"></a>Slow Logins</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Slow logins are almost always due to the password checking time. Using -the lowest practical <i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> will improve things. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3019127"></a>Client tuning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +the lowest practical <a class="indexterm" name="id2964641"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>password level</tt></i> will improve things. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964659"></a>Client tuning</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Often a speed problem can be traced to the client. The client (for example Windows for Workgroups) can often be tuned for better TCP performance. Check the sections on the various clients in <a href="Other-Clients.html" title="Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients">Samba and Other Clients</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3019154"></a>Samba performance problem due changing kernel</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964684"></a>Samba performance problem due changing kernel</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Hi everyone. I am running Gentoo on my server and samba 2.2.8a. Recently I changed kernel version from linux-2.4.19-gentoo-r10 to linux-2.4.20-wolk4.0s. And now I have performance issue with samba. Ok @@ -119,7 +119,7 @@ Grab mii-tool and check the duplex settings on the NIC. My guess is that it is a link layer issue, not an application layer problem. Also run ifconfig and verify that the framing error, collisions, etc... look normal for ethernet. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3019185"></a>Corrupt tdb Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2964716"></a>Corrupt tdb Files</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Well today it happened, Our first major problem using samba. Our samba PDC server has been hosting 3 TB of data to our 500+ users [Windows NT/XP] for the last 3 years using samba, no problem. @@ -137,4 +137,4 @@ Q2) What I also would like to mention is that the service latency seems a lot lower then before the locks cleanup, any ideas on keeping it top notch? </p><p> A2) Yes! Same answer as for Q1! -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="Other-Clients.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="Appendixes.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="DNSDHCP.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 38. Samba and other CIFS clients </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 40. DNS and DHCP Configuration Guide</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html index e0719dce3d..a7f2eaaf5b 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/swat.8.html @@ -19,8 +19,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -34,10 +33,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2796899"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>INSTALLATION</h2><p>Swat is included as binary package with most distributions. The @@ -62,7 +60,7 @@ never removed by the client. and <tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt> you need to send a HUP signal to inetd. To do this use <b class="command">kill -1 PID </b> where PID is the process ID of the inetd daemon. </p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>LAUNCHING</h2><p>To launch SWAT just run your favorite web browser and - point it at "http://localhost:901/".</p><p>Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected + point it at "http://localhost:901/".</p><p>Note that you can attach to SWAT from any IP connected machine but connecting from a remote machine leaves your connection open to password sniffing as passwords will be sent in the clear over the wire. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/inetd.conf</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This file must contain suitable startup diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html index ff7d4efd33..b63483d5de 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/testprns.1.html @@ -1,11 +1,11 @@ <html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>testprns</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="testprns.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>testprns — check printer name for validity with smbd</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">testprns</tt> {printername} [printcapname]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">testprns</b> is a very simple test program to determine whether a given printer name is valid for use in - a service to be provided by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>"Valid" in this context means "can be found in the - printcap specified". This program is very stupid - so stupid in + a service to be provided by <a href="smbd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smbd</span>(8)</span></a>.</p><p>"Valid" in this context means "can be found in the + printcap specified". This program is very stupid - so stupid in fact that it would be wisest to always specify the printcap file to use. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">printername</span></dt><dd><p>The printer name to validate.</p><p>Printer names are taken from the first field in each record in the printcap file, single printer names and sets - of aliases separated by vertical bars ("|") are recognized. + of aliases separated by vertical bars ("|") are recognized. Note that no validation or checking of the printcap syntax is done beyond that required to extract the printer name. It may be that the print spooling system is more forgiving or less @@ -16,9 +16,9 @@ specified at compile time. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>FILES</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><tt class="filename">/etc/printcap</tt></span></dt><dd><p>This is usually the default printcap file to scan. See <tt class="filename">printcap (5)</tt>. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DIAGNOSTICS</h2><p>If a printer is found to be valid, the message - "Printer name <printername> is valid" will be + "Printer name <printername> is valid" will be displayed. </p><p>If a printer is found to be invalid, the message - "Printer name <printername> is not valid" will be + "Printer name <printername> is not valid" will be displayed. </p><p>All messages that would normally be logged during operation of the Samba daemons are logged by this program to the file <tt class="filename">test.log</tt> in the current directory. The diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html b/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html index 582beeb6b0..d18399caeb 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/troubleshooting.html @@ -1 +1 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part V. Troubleshooting</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool"><link rel="next" href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SWAT.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="diagnosis.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="troubleshooting"></a>Troubleshooting</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>33. <a href="diagnosis.html">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3006072">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3007931">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3008108">The tests</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id3009283">Still having troubles?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="problems.html">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id3010907">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011048">Installing 'Network Monitor' on an NT Workstation or a Windows 9x box</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011333">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011378">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id3011530">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="bugreport.html">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012269">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012491">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012528">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012670">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012778">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id3012825">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SWAT.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="diagnosis.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part V. Troubleshooting</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="SWAT.html" title="Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool"><link rel="next" href="diagnosis.html" title="Chapter 33. The Samba checklist"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part V. Troubleshooting</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SWAT.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="diagnosis.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="troubleshooting"></a>Troubleshooting</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>33. <a href="diagnosis.html">The Samba checklist</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2957982">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2958022">Assumptions</a></dt><dt><a href="diagnosis.html#id2958249">The tests</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>34. <a href="problems.html">Analysing and solving samba problems</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959747">Diagnostics tools</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959768">Debugging with Samba itself</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959894">Tcpdump</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959915">Ethereal</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2959968">The Windows Network Monitor</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960285">Useful URLs</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960326">Getting help from the mailing lists</a></dt><dt><a href="problems.html#id2960484">How to get off the mailing lists</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>35. <a href="bugreport.html">Reporting Bugs</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960613">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960681">General info</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960718">Debug levels</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2960926">Internal errors</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2961060">Attaching to a running process</a></dt><dt><a href="bugreport.html#id2961107">Patches</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="SWAT.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="diagnosis.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 32. SWAT - The Samba Web Administration Tool </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 33. The Samba checklist</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/type.html b/docs/htmldocs/type.html index 209c177a0b..5322995de4 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/type.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/type.html @@ -1,9 +1,5 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part II. Server Configuration Basics</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient"><link rel="next" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="type"></a>Server Configuration Basics</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2886812"></a>First Steps in Server Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Part II. Server Configuration Basics</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="previous" href="FastStart.html" title="Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient"><link rel="next" href="ServerType.html" title="Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Part II. Server Configuration Basics</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center"> </th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="part" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="type"></a>Server Configuration Basics</h1></div></div><div></div></div><div class="partintro" lang="en"><div><div><div><h1 class="title"><a name="id2884814"></a>First Steps in Server Configuration</h1></div></div><div></div></div><p> Samba can operate in various modes within SMB networks. This HOWTO section contains information on configuring samba to function as the type of server your network requires. Please read this section carefully. -</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>4. <a href="ServerType.html">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888767">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888862">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2888947">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889062">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889195">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889317">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889568">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889655">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2889880">Seamless Windows Network Integration</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890056">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890084">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890117">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890146">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2890179">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="samba-pdc.html">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2891986">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892290">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892306">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892517">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2892837">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893136">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893157">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893173">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893499">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893607">Common Problems and Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893614">I cannot include a '$' in a machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893653">I get told "You already have a connection to the Domain...." -or "Cannot join domain, the credentials supplied conflict with an -existing set.." when creating a machine trust account.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893703">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893773">The machine trust account for this computer either does not -exist or is not accessible.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893836">When I attempt to login to a Samba Domain from a NT4/W2K workstation, -I get a message about my account being disabled.</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2893863">Until a few minutes after Samba has started, clients get the error "Domain Controller Unavailable"</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="samba-bdc.html">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896028">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896201">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896230">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896450">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896471">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896497">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896542">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896645">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896706">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896719">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896750">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896783">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2896828">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="domain-member.html">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2897897">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898012">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898188">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898440">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898636">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898699">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2898901">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899283">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899424">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899508">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899872">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899892">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899919">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2899951">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="StandAloneServer.html">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902304">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902501">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902573">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902588">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902638">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2902852">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="ClientConfig.html">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2901966">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="index.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +</p><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt>4. <a href="ServerType.html">Server Types and Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2884977">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885071">Server Types</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885157">Samba Security Modes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885276">User Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885414">Share Level Security</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885551">Domain Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885808">ADS Security Mode (User Level Security)</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2885909">Server Security (User Level Security)</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886191">Password checking</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886386">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886414">What makes Samba a SERVER?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886453">What makes Samba a Domain Controller?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886490">What makes Samba a Domain Member?</a></dt><dt><a href="ServerType.html#id2886529">Constantly Losing Connections to Password Server</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>5. <a href="samba-pdc.html">Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2886861">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887076">Basics of Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887090">Domain Controller Types</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887335">Preparing for Domain Control</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2887717">Domain Control - Example Configuration</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888205">Samba ADS Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888257">Domain and Network Logon Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888272">Domain Network Logon Service</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888704">Security Mode and Master Browsers</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888850">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888857">'$' cannot be included in machine name</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888916">Joining domain fails because of existing machine account</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2888975">The system can not log you on (C000019B)....</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889059">The machine trust account not accessible</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889131">Account disabled</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889164">Domain Controller Unavailable</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-pdc.html#id2889186">Can not log onto domain member workstation after joining domain</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>6. <a href="samba-bdc.html">Backup Domain Control</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889347">Features And Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889536">Essential Background Information</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889565">MS Windows NT4 Style Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889816">Active Directory Domain Control</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889836">What qualifies a Domain Controller on the network?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889863">How does a Workstation find its domain controller?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2889908">Backup Domain Controller Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890011">Example Configuration</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890167">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890181">Machine Accounts keep expiring, what can I do?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890212">Can Samba be a Backup Domain Controller to an NT4 PDC?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890238">How do I replicate the smbpasswd file?</a></dt><dt><a href="samba-bdc.html#id2890283">Can I do this all with LDAP?</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>7. <a href="domain-member.html">Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2890490">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#machine-trust-accounts">MS Windows Workstation/Server Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2890821">Manual Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891126">Using NT4 Server Manager to Add Machine Accounts to the Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891341">"On-the-Fly" Creation of Machine Trust Accounts</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891414">Making an MS Windows Workstation or Server a Domain Member</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#domain-member-server">Domain Member Server</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2891624">Joining an NT4 type Domain with Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892061">Why is this better than security = server?</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-member">Samba ADS Domain Membership</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892246">Setup your smb.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892373">Setup your /etc/krb5.conf</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-create-machine-account">Create the computer account</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-server">Test your server setup</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#ads-test-smbclient">Testing with smbclient</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892751">Notes</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892773">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892816">Can Not Add Machine Back to Domain</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892848">Adding Machine to Domain Fails</a></dt><dt><a href="domain-member.html#id2892992">I can't join a Windows 2003 PDC</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></dd><dt>8. <a href="StandAloneServer.html">Stand-Alone Servers</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893079">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893117">Background</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893191">Example Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#RefDocServer">Reference Documentation Server</a></dt><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#SimplePrintServer">Central Print Serving</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="StandAloneServer.html#id2893714">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></dd><dt>9. <a href="ClientConfig.html">MS Windows Network Configuration Guide</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="ClientConfig.html#id2893778">Note</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="FastStart.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="samba-doc.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="ServerType.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 3. Fast Start for the Impatient </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 4. Server Types and Security Modes</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html b/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html index a971602e81..a4f568576d 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/unicode.html @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba"><link rel="next" href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Backup.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unicode"></a>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">TAKAHASHI</span> <span class="surname">Motonobu</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 March 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3001913">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002114">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002184">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002284">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id3002329">Japanese charsets</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001913"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="integrate-ms-networks.html" title="Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba"><link rel="next" href="Backup.html" title="Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Backup.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="unicode"></a>Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">TAKAHASHI</span> <span class="surname">Motonobu</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:monyo@home.monyo.com">monyo@home.monyo.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 March 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953342">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953385">What are charsets and unicode?</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953454">Samba and charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953583">Conversion from old names</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953612">Japanese charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953751">Common errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="unicode.html#id2953758">CP850.so can't be found</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953342"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Every industry eventually matures. One of the great areas of maturation is in the focus that has been given over the past decade to make it possible for anyone anywhere to use a computer. It has not always been that way, in fact, not so long @@ -6,14 +6,13 @@ ago it was common for software to be written for exclusive use in the country of origin. </p><p> Of all the effort that has been brought to bear on providing native language support -for all computer users, the efforts of the Openi18n organisation is deserving of -special mention. For more information about Openi18n please refer to: -<a href="">http://www.openi18n.org/</a>. +for all computer users, the efforts of the <a href="http://www.openi18n.org/" target="_top">Openi18n organisation</a> is deserving of +special mention. </p><p> Samba-2.x supported a single locale through a mechanism called <span class="emphasis"><em>codepages</em></span>. Samba-3 is destined to become a truly trans-global file and printer sharing platform. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3002114"></a>What are charsets and unicode?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953385"></a>What are charsets and unicode?</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> Computers communicate in numbers. In texts, each number will be translated to a corresponding letter. The meaning that will be assigned to a certain number depends on the <span class="emphasis"><em>character set(charset) @@ -30,45 +29,39 @@ is more then all possible characters one could think of. They are called multibyte charsets (because they use more then one byte to store one character). </p><p> -A standardised multibyte charset is unicode, info is available at -<a href="http://www.unicode.org/" target="_top">www.unicode.org</a>. -A big advantage of using a multibyte charset is that you only need one; no -need to make sure two computers use the same charset when they are + A standardised multibyte charset is <a href="http://www.unicode.org/" target="_top">unicode</a>. +A big advantage of using a multibyte charset is that you only need one; there +is no need to make sure two computers use the same charset when they are communicating. -</p><p>Old windows clients used to use single-byte charsets, named +</p><p>Old windows clients use single-byte charsets, named 'codepages' by Microsoft. However, there is no support for negotiating the charset to be used in the smb protocol. Thus, you -have to make sure you are using the same charset when talking to an old client. +have to make sure you are using the same charset when talking to an older client. Newer clients (Windows NT, 2K, XP) talk unicode over the wire. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3002184"></a>Samba and charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953454"></a>Samba and charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> As of samba 3.0, samba can (and will) talk unicode over the wire. Internally, samba knows of three kinds of character sets: -</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> +</p><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2953476"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p> This is the charset used internally by your operating system. - The default is <tt class="constant">ASCII</tt>, which is fine for most - systems. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba will use to print messages + The default is <tt class="constant">UTF-8</tt>, which is fine for most + systems. The default in previous samba releases was <tt class="constant">ASCII</tt>. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2953514"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>display charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba will use to print messages on your screen. It should generally be the same as the <b class="command">unix charset</b>. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba uses when communicating with + </p></dd><dt><span class="term"><a class="indexterm" name="id2953548"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i></span></dt><dd><p>This is the charset samba uses when communicating with DOS and Windows 9x clients. It will talk unicode to all newer clients. The default depends on the charsets you have installed on your system. Run <b class="command">testparm -v | grep "dos charset"</b> to see what the default is on your system. - </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3002284"></a>Conversion from old names</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Because previous samba versions did not do any charset conversion, + </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953583"></a>Conversion from old names</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Because previous samba versions did not do any charset conversion, characters in filenames are usually not correct in the unix charset but only -for the local charset used by the DOS/Windows clients.</p><p>The following script from Steve Langasek converts all -filenames from CP850 to the iso8859-15 charset.</p><p> -<tt class="prompt">#</tt><b class="userinput"><tt>find <i class="replaceable"><tt>/path/to/share</tt></i> -type f -exec bash -c 'CP="{}"; ISO=`echo -n "$CP" | iconv -f cp850 \ - -t iso8859-15`; if [ "$CP" != "$ISO" ]; then mv "$CP" "$ISO"; fi' \; -</tt></b> -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3002329"></a>Japanese charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba doesn't work correctly with Japanese charsets yet. Here are -points of attention when setting it up:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You should set <i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method = -hash</tt></i></p></li><li><p>There are various iconv() implementations around and not +for the local charset used by the DOS/Windows clients.</p><p>Bjoern Jacke has written a utility named <a href="http://j3e.de/linux/convmv/" target="_top">convm</a> that can convert whole directory + structures to different charsets with one single command. +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953612"></a>Japanese charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Samba doesn't work correctly with Japanese charsets yet. Here are +points of attention when setting it up:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>You should set <a class="indexterm" name="id2953633"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>mangling method</tt></i> = hash</p></li><li><p>There are various iconv() implementations around and not all of them work equally well. glibc2's iconv() has a critical problem in CP932. libiconv-1.8 works with CP932 but still has some problems and -does not work with EUC-JP.</p></li><li><p>You should set <i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset = CP932</tt></i>, not -Shift_JIS, SJIS...</p></li><li><p>Currently only <i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset = CP932</tt></i> +does not work with EUC-JP.</p></li><li><p>You should set <a class="indexterm" name="id2953663"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i> = CP932, not +Shift_JIS, SJIS...</p></li><li><p>Currently only <a class="indexterm" name="id2953683"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = CP932 will work (but still has some problems...) because of iconv() issues. -<i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset = EUC-JP</tt></i> doesn't work well because of -iconv() issues.</p></li><li><p>Currently Samba 3.0 does not support <i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset -= UTF8-MAC/CAP/HEX/JIS*</tt></i></p></li></ul></div><p>More information (in Japanese) is available at: <a href="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html" target="_top">http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html</a>.</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Backup.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +<a class="indexterm" name="id2953699"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = EUC-JP doesn't work well because of +iconv() issues.</p></li><li><p>Currently Samba 3.0 does not support <a class="indexterm" name="id2953718"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>unix charset</tt></i> = UTF8-MAC/CAP/HEX/JIS*</p></li></ul></div><p>More information (in Japanese) is available at: <a href="http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html" target="_top">http://www.atmarkit.co.jp/flinux/special/samba3/samba3a.html</a>.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2953751"></a>Common errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2953758"></a>CP850.so can't be found</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>“<span class="quote">Samba is complaining about a missing <tt class="filename">CP850.so</tt> file</span>”.</p><p>CP850 is the default <a class="indexterm" name="id2953783"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i>. The <a class="indexterm" name="id2953797"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>dos charset</tt></i> is used to convert data to the codepage used by your dos clients. If you don't have any dos clients, you can safely ignore this message. </p><p>CP850 should be supported by your local iconv implementation. Make sure you have all the required packages installed. If you compiled samba from source, make sure configure found iconv.</p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="integrate-ms-networks.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="Backup.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 26. Integrating MS Windows networks with Samba </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 28. Samba Backup Techniques</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html b/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html index ac559fa129..e7c1c61234 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/upgrading-to-3.0.html @@ -1,19 +1,176 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="next" href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="migration.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NT4Migration.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="upgrading-to-3.0"></a>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">25 October 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id3001684">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id3001709">Obsolete configuration options</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id3003319">Password Backend</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001684"></a>Charsets</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>You might experience problems with special characters -when communicating with old DOS clients. Codepage -support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter -<a href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode support</a> for details. -</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3001709"></a>Obsolete configuration options</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -In 3.0, the following configuration options have been removed. -</p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td>printer driver (replaced by new driver procedures) </td></tr><tr><td>printer driver file (replaced by new driver procedures)</td></tr><tr><td>printer driver location (replaced by new driver procedures)</td></tr><tr><td>use rhosts</td></tr><tr><td>postscript</td></tr><tr><td>client code page (replaced by dos charset)</td></tr><tr><td>vfs path</td></tr><tr><td>vfs options</td></tr></table></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id3003319"></a>Password Backend</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Effective with the release of samba-3 it is now imperative that the password backend -be correctly defined in smb.conf. -</p><p> -Those migrating from samba-2.x with plaintext password support need the following: -<span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend = guest</em></span>. -</p><p> -Those migrating from samba-2.x with encrypted password support should add to smb.conf -<span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend = smbpasswd, guest</em></span>. -</p><p> -LDAP using Samba-2.x systems can continue to operate with the following entry -<span class="emphasis"><em>passdb backend = ldapsam_compat, guest</em></span>. -</p></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="migration.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NT4Migration.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part IV. Migration and Updating </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</td></tr></table></div></body></html> +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="previous" href="migration.html" title="Part IV. Migration and Updating"><link rel="next" href="NT4Migration.html" title="Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="migration.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part IV. Migration and Updating</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NT4Migration.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="upgrading-to-3.0"></a>Chapter 30. Upgrading from Samba-2.x to Samba-3.0.0</h2></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Gerald</span> <span class="othername">(Jerry)</span> <span class="surname">Carter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jerry@samba.org">jerry@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">June 30, 2003</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954094">New Features in Samba-3</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954229">Configuration Parameter Changes</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954244">Removed Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954370">New Parameters</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954767">Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954842">New Functionality</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2954849">Databases</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955083">Changes in Behavior</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955133">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955156">Passdb Backends and Authentication</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955274">Charsets</a></dt><dt><a href="upgrading-to-3.0.html#id2955299">LDAP</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954094"></a>New Features in Samba-3</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +Major new features: +</p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Active Directory support. This release is able to join a ADS realm + as a member server and authenticate users using LDAP/kerberos. + </p></li><li><p> + Unicode support. Samba will now negotiate UNICODE on the wire and + internally there is now a much better infrastructure for multi-byte + and UNICODE character sets. + </p></li><li><p> + New authentication system. The internal authentication system has + been almost completely rewritten. Most of the changes are internal, + but the new auth system is also very configurable. + </p></li><li><p> + New filename mangling system. The filename mangling system has been + completely rewritten. An internal database now stores mangling maps + persistently. This needs lots of testing. + </p></li><li><p> + New "net" command. A new "net" command has been added. It is + somewhat similar to the "net" command in windows. Eventually we + plan to replace a bunch of other utilities (such as smbpasswd) + with subcommands in "net", at the moment only a few things are + implemented. + </p></li><li><p> + Samba now negotiates NT-style status32 codes on the wire. This + improves error handling a lot. + </p></li><li><p> + Better Windows 2000/XP/2003 printing support including publishing + printer attributes in active directory + </p></li><li><p> + New loadable RPC modules + </p></li><li><p> + New dual-daemon winbindd support (-B) for better performance + </p></li><li><p> + Support for migrating from a Windows NT 4.0 domain to a Samba + domain and maintaining user, group and domain SIDs + </p></li><li><p> + Support for establishing trust relationships with Windows NT 4.0 + domain controllers + </p></li><li><p> + Initial support for a distributed Winbind architecture using + an LDAP directory for storing SID to uid/gid mappings + </p></li><li><p> + Major updates to the Samba documentation tree. + </p></li></ol></div><p> +Plus lots of other improvements! +</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954229"></a>Configuration Parameter Changes</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> +This section contains a brief listing of changes to smb.conf options +in the 3.0.0 release. Please refer to the smb.conf(5) man page for +complete descriptions of new or modified parameters. +</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954244"></a>Removed Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>(order alphabetically):</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>admin log </p></li><li><p>alternate permissions </p></li><li><p>character set </p></li><li><p>client codepage </p></li><li><p>code page directory </p></li><li><p>coding system </p></li><li><p>domain admin group </p></li><li><p>domain guest group </p></li><li><p>force unknown acl user </p></li><li><p>nt smb support </p></li><li><p>post script </p></li><li><p>printer driver </p></li><li><p>printer driver file </p></li><li><p>printer driver location </p></li><li><p>status </p></li><li><p>total print jobs </p></li><li><p>use rhosts </p></li><li><p>valid chars </p></li><li><p>vfs options </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954370"></a>New Parameters</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>(new parameters have been grouped by function):</p><p>Remote management</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>abort shutdown script </p></li><li><p>shutdown script </p></li></ul></div><p>User and Group Account Management</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>add group script </p></li><li><p>add machine script </p></li><li><p>add user to group script </p></li><li><p>algorithmic rid base </p></li><li><p>delete group script </p></li><li><p>delete user from group script </p></li><li><p>passdb backend </p></li><li><p>set primary group script </p></li></ul></div><p>Authentication</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>auth methods </p></li><li><p>ads server </p></li><li><p>realm </p></li></ul></div><p>Protocol Options</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>client lanman auth </p></li><li><p>client NTLMv2 auth </p></li><li><p>client schannel </p></li><li><p>client signing </p></li><li><p>client use spnego </p></li><li><p>disable netbios </p></li><li><p>ntlm auth </p></li><li><p>paranoid server security </p></li><li><p>server schannel </p></li><li><p>smb ports </p></li><li><p>use spnego </p></li></ul></div><p>File Service</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>get quota command </p></li><li><p>hide special files </p></li><li><p>hide unwriteable files </p></li><li><p>hostname lookups </p></li><li><p>kernel change notify </p></li><li><p>mangle prefix </p></li><li><p>msdfs proxy </p></li><li><p>set quota command </p></li><li><p>use sendfile </p></li><li><p>vfs objects </p></li></ul></div><p>Printing</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>max reported print jobs </p></li></ul></div><p>UNICODE and Character Sets</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>display charset </p></li><li><p>dos charset </p></li><li><p>unicode </p></li><li><p>unix charset </p></li></ul></div><p>SID to uid/gid Mappings</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>idmap backend </p></li><li><p>idmap gid </p></li><li><p>idmap only </p></li><li><p>idmap uid </p></li></ul></div><p>LDAP</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ldap delete dn </p></li><li><p>ldap group suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap idmap suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap machine suffix </p></li><li><p>ldap passwd sync </p></li><li><p>ldap trust ids </p></li><li><p>ldap user suffix </p></li></ul></div><p>General Configuration</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>preload modules </p></li><li><p>privatedir </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954767"></a>Modified Parameters (changes in behavior):</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>encrypt passwords (enabled by default) </p></li><li><p>mangling method (set to 'hash2' by default) </p></li><li><p>passwd chat </p></li><li><p>passwd program </p></li><li><p>restrict anonymous (integer value) </p></li><li><p>security (new 'ads' value) </p></li><li><p>strict locking (enabled by default) </p></li><li><p>winbind cache time (increased to 5 minutes) </p></li><li><p>winbind uid (deprecated in favor of 'idmap uid') </p></li><li><p>winbind gid (deprecated in favor of 'idmap gid') </p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2954842"></a>New Functionality</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2954849"></a>Databases</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section contains brief descriptions of any new databases + introduced in Samba 3.0. Please remember to backup your existing + ${lock directory}/*tdb before upgrading to Samba 3.0. Samba will + upgrade databases as they are opened (if necessary), but downgrading + from 3.0 to 2.2 is an unsupported path. + </p><div class="table"><a name="id2954868"></a><p class="title"><b>Table 30.1. TDB File Descriptions</b></p><table summary="TDB File Descriptions" border="1"><colgroup><col align="left"><col align="justify"><col align="left"></colgroup><thead><tr><th align="left">Name</th><th align="justify">Description</th><th align="center">Backup?</th></tr></thead><tbody><tr><td align="left">account_policy</td><td align="justify">User policy settings</td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">gencache</td><td align="justify">Generic caching db</td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">group_mapping</td><td align="justify"><p>Mapping table from Windows groups/SID to unix groups</p></td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">idmap</td><td align="justify"><p>new ID map table from SIDS to UNIX uids/gids</p></td><td align="left">yes</td></tr><tr><td align="left">namecache</td><td align="justify">Name resolution cache entries</td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">netlogon_unigrp</td><td align="justify"><p>Cache of universal group membership obtained when operating + as a member of a Windows domain</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">printing/*.tdb</td><td align="justify"><p>Cached output from 'lpq command' created on a per print + service basis</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr><tr><td align="left">registry</td><td align="justify"><p>Read-only samba registry skeleton that provides support for + exporting various db tables via the winreg RPCs</p></td><td align="left">no</td></tr></tbody></table></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955083"></a>Changes in Behavior</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following issues are known changes in behavior between Samba 2.2 and + Samba 3.0 that may affect certain installations of Samba. + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + When operating as a member of a Windows domain, Samba 2.2 would + map any users authenticated by the remote DC to the 'guest account' + if a uid could not be obtained via the getpwnam() call. Samba 3.0 + rejects the connection as NT_STATUS_LOGON_FAILURE. There is no + current work around to re-establish the 2.2 behavior. + </p></li><li><p> + When adding machines to a Samba 2.2 controlled domain, the + 'add user script' was used to create the UNIX identity of the + machine trust account. Samba 3.0 introduces a new 'add machine + script' that must be specified for this purpose. Samba 3.0 will + not fall back to using the 'add user script' in the absence of + an 'add machine script' + </p></li></ol></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955133"></a>Charsets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You might experience problems with special characters when communicating with old DOS + clients. Codepage support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter + <a href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode support</a> for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955156"></a>Passdb Backends and Authentication</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + There have been a few new changes that Samba administrators should be + aware of when moving to Samba 3.0. + </p><div class="orderedlist"><ol type="1"><li><p> + Encrypted passwords have been enabled by default in order to + inter-operate better with out-of-the-box Windows client + installations. This does mean that either (a) a samba account + must be created for each user, or (b) 'encrypt passwords = no' + must be explicitly defined in smb.conf. + </p></li><li><p> + Inclusion of new <a class="indexterm" name="id2955194"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>security</tt></i> = ads option for integration + with an Active Directory domain using the native Windows + Kerberos 5 and LDAP protocols. + </p></li></ol></div><p> + Samba 3.0 also includes the possibility of setting up chains + of authentication methods + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2955217"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>auth methods</tt></i>) and account + storage backends + (<a class="indexterm" name="id2955232"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>passdb backend</tt></i>). + Please refer to the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> + man page and <a href="passdb.html" title="Chapter 11. Account Information Databases">the chapter about account information databases</a> for details. While both parameters assume sane default + values, it is likely that you will need to understand what the + values actually mean in order to ensure Samba operates correctly. + </p><p> + Certain functions of the smbpasswd(8) tool have been split between the + new smbpasswd(8) utility, the net(8) tool, and the new pdbedit(8) + utility. See the respective man pages for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955274"></a>Charsets</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + You might experience problems with special characters when communicating with old DOS + clients. Codepage support has changed in samba 3.0. Read the chapter + <a href="unicode.html" title="Chapter 27. Unicode/Charsets">Unicode support</a> for details. + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2955299"></a>LDAP</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + This section outlines the new features affecting Samba / LDAP integration. + </p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955311"></a>New Schema</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + A new object class (sambaSamAccount) has been introduced to replace + the old sambaAccount. This change aids us in the renaming of attributes + to prevent clashes with attributes from other vendors. There is a + conversion script (examples/LDAP/convertSambaAccount) to modify and LDIF + file to the new schema. + </p><p> + Example: + </p><pre class="screen"> + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt>ldapsearch .... -b "ou=people,dc=..." > old.ldif + <tt class="prompt">$ </tt>convertSambaAccount <DOM SID> old.ldif new.ldif + </pre><p> + The <DOM SID> can be obtained by running 'net getlocalsid <DOMAINNAME> + on the Samba PDC as root. + </p><p> + The old sambaAccount schema may still be used by specifying the + "ldapsam_compat" passdb backend. However, the sambaAccount and + associated attributes have been moved to the historical section of + the schema file and must be uncommented before use if needed. + The 2.2 object class declaration for a sambaAccount has not changed + in the 3.0 samba.schema file. + </p><p> + Other new object classes and their uses include: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + sambaDomain - domain information used to allocate rids + for users and groups as necessary. The attributes are added + in 'ldap suffix' directory entry automatically if + an idmap uid/gid range has been set and the 'ldapsam' + passdb backend has been selected. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaGroupMapping - an object representing the + relationship between a posixGroup and a Windows + group/SID. These entries are stored in the 'ldap + group suffix' and managed by the 'net groupmap' command. + </p></li><li><p> + sambaUnixIdPool - created in the 'ldap idmap suffix' entry + automatically and contains the next available 'idmap uid' and + 'idmap gid' + </p></li><li><p> + sambaIdmapEntry - object storing a mapping between a + SID and a UNIX uid/gid. These objects are created by the + idmap_ldap module as needed. + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955433"></a>New Suffix for Searching</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + The following new smb.conf parameters have been added to aid in directing + certain LDAP queries when 'passdb backend = ldapsam://...' has been + specified. + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>ldap suffix - used to search for user and computer accounts</p></li><li><p>ldap user suffix - used to store user accounts</p></li><li><p>ldap machine suffix - used to store machine trust accounts</p></li><li><p>ldap group suffix - location of posixGroup/sambaGroupMapping entries</p></li><li><p>ldap idmap suffix - location of sambaIdmapEntry objects</p></li></ul></div><p> + If an 'ldap suffix' is defined, it will be appended to all of the + remaining sub-suffix parameters. In this case, the order of the suffix + listings in smb.conf is important. Always place the 'ldap suffix' first + in the list. + </p><p> + Due to a limitation in Samba's smb.conf parsing, you should not surround + the DN's with quotation marks. + </p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2955500"></a>IdMap LDAP support</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Samba 3.0 supports an ldap backend for the idmap subsystem. The + following options would inform Samba that the idmap table should be + stored on the directory server onterose in the "ou=idmap,dc=plainjoe, + dc=org" partition. + </p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend = ldap:ldap://onterose/</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>ldap idmap suffix = ou=idmap,dc=plainjoe,dc=org</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid = 40000-50000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid = 40000-50000</tt></i></td></tr></table><p> + This configuration allows winbind installations on multiple servers to + share a uid/gid number space, thus avoiding the interoperability problems + with NFS that were present in Samba 2.2. + </p></div></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="migration.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="migration.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="NT4Migration.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Part IV. Migration and Updating </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 31. Migration from NT4 PDC to Samba-3 PDC</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html index 7b124c070f..2cfbfad283 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/vfstest.1.html @@ -14,8 +14,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -29,10 +28,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2799859"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>COMMANDS</h2><p><span class="emphasis"><em>VFS COMMANDS</em></span></p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><b class="command">load <module.so></b> - Load specified VFS module </p></li><li><p><b class="command">populate <char> <size></b> - Populate a data buffer with the specified data </p></li><li><p><b class="command">showdata [<offset> <len>]</b> - Show data currently in data buffer diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html b/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html index 4aa9ddab12..f5f5af0a27 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/wbinfo.1.html @@ -1,22 +1,32 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>wbinfo</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="wbinfo.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>wbinfo — Query information from winbind daemon</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">wbinfo</tt> [-u] [-g] [-N netbios-name] [-I ip] [-n name] [-s sid] [-U uid] [-G gid] [-S sid] [-Y sid] [-t] [-m] [--sequence] [-r user] [-a user%password] [--set-auth-user user%password] [--get-auth-user] [-p]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <b class="command">wbinfo</b> program queries and returns information +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>wbinfo</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="wbinfo.1"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>wbinfo — Query information from winbind daemon</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">wbinfo</tt> [-a user%password] [-c username] [-C groupname] [--domain domain] [-I ip] [-s sid] [-u] [-U uid] [-g] [--get-auth-user] [-G gid] [-m] [-n name] [-N netbios-name] [-o user:group] [-O user:group] [-p] [-r user] [--set-auth-user user%password] [--sequence] [-S sid] [-t] [-x username] [-X groupname] [-Y sid]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This tool is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p>The <b class="command">wbinfo</b> program queries and returns information created and used by the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon. </p><p>The <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon must be configured and running for the <b class="command">wbinfo</b> program to be able - to return information.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-u</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all users available - in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains - will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign - user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> - .</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all groups available + to return information.</p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>OPTIONS</h2><div class="variablelist"><dl><dt><span class="term">-a username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Attempt to authenticate a user via winbindd. + This checks both authenticaion methods and reports its results. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-c user</span></dt><dd><p>Create a local winbind user. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-C group</span></dt><dd><p>Create a local winbindd group. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--domain name</span></dt><dd><p>This parameter sets the domain on which any specified + operations will performed. If special domain name '.' is used to represent + the current domain to which winbindd belongs. Currently only the + <tt class="option">--sequence</tt>, + <tt class="option">-u</tt>, and <tt class="option">-g</tt> options honor this parameter. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-g</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all groups available in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Groups in all trusted domains will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign group ids to any groups that have not already been - seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N name</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-N</tt></i> option - queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to query the WINS - server for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name - specified by the <i class="parameter"><tt>name</tt></i> parameter. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I ip</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-I</tt></i> option + seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a>. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--get-auth-user</span></dt><dd><p>Print username and password used by winbindd + during session setup to a domain controller. Username + and password can be set using '-A'. Only available for + root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-G gid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX group id to a Windows + NT SID. If the gid specified does not refer to one within + the idmap gid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-I ip</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-I</tt></i> option queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to send a node status request to get the NetBIOS name associated with the IP address specified by the <i class="parameter"><tt>ip</tt></i> parameter. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m</span></dt><dd><p>Produce a list of domains trusted by the + Windows NT server <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts + when resolving names. This list does not include the Windows + NT domain the server is a Primary Domain Controller for. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-n name</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-n</tt></i> option queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> for the SID associated with the name specified. Domain names can be specified @@ -24,40 +34,43 @@ For example CWDOM1/Administrator refers to the Administrator user in the domain CWDOM1. If no domain is specified then the domain used is the one specified in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> <i class="parameter"><tt>workgroup - </tt></i> parameter. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s sid</span></dt><dd><p>Use <i class="parameter"><tt>-s</tt></i> to resolve + </tt></i> parameter. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-N name</span></dt><dd><p>The <i class="parameter"><tt>-N</tt></i> option + queries <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> to query the WINS + server for the IP address associated with the NetBIOS name + specified by the <i class="parameter"><tt>name</tt></i> parameter. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-o user:group</span></dt><dd><p>Add a winbindd local group as a secondary group + for the specified winbindd local user. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-O user:group</span></dt><dd><p>Remove a winbindd local group as a secondary group + for the specified winbindd local user. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p</span></dt><dd><p>Check whether winbindd is still alive. + Prints out either 'succeeded' or 'failed'. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r username</span></dt><dd><p>Try to obtain the list of UNIX group ids + to which the user belongs. This only works for users + defined on a Domain Controller. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-s sid</span></dt><dd><p>Use <i class="parameter"><tt>-s</tt></i> to resolve a SID to a name. This is the inverse of the <i class="parameter"><tt>-n </tt></i> option above. SIDs must be specified as ASCII strings in the traditional Microsoft format. For example, - S-1-5-21-1455342024-3071081365-2475485837-500. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U uid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX user id to a Windows NT - SID. If the uid specified does not refer to one within - the winbind uid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-G gid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX group id to a Windows - NT SID. If the gid specified does not refer to one within - the winbind gid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX user id. If the SID - does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-Y sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID - does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then - the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t</span></dt><dd><p>Verify that the workstation trust account - created when the Samba server is added to the Windows NT - domain is working. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-m</span></dt><dd><p>Produce a list of domains trusted by the - Windows NT server <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> contacts - when resolving names. This list does not include the Windows - NT domain the server is a Primary Domain Controller for. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--sequence</span></dt><dd><p>Show sequence numbers of - all known domains</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-r username</span></dt><dd><p>Try to obtain the list of UNIX group ids - to which the user belongs. This only works for users - defined on a Domain Controller. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-a username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Attempt to authenticate a user via winbindd. - This checks both authenticaion methods and reports its results. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--set-auth-user username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Store username and password used by winbindd + S-1-5-21-1455342024-3071081365-2475485837-500. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--set-auth-user username%password</span></dt><dd><p>Store username and password used by winbindd during session setup to a domain controller. This enables winbindd to operate in a Windows 2000 domain with Restrict Anonymous turned on (a.k.a. Permissions compatiable with Windows 2000 servers only). - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--get-auth-user</span></dt><dd><p>Print username and password used by winbindd - during session setup to a domain controller. Username - and password can be set using '-A'. Only available for - root.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-p</span></dt><dd><p>Check whether winbindd is still alive. - Prints out either 'succeeded' or 'failed'. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">--sequence</span></dt><dd><p>Show sequence numbers of + all known domains</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-S sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX user id. If the SID + does not correspond to a UNIX user mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-t</span></dt><dd><p>Verify that the workstation trust account + created when the Samba server is added to the Windows NT + domain is working. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-u</span></dt><dd><p>This option will list all users available + in the Windows NT domain for which the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is operating in. Users in all trusted domains + will also be listed. Note that this operation does not assign + user ids to any users that have not already been seen by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> + .</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-U uid</span></dt><dd><p>Try to convert a UNIX user id to a Windows NT + SID. If the uid specified does not refer to one within + the idmap uid range then the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-x user</span></dt><dd><p>Delete an existing local winbind user. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-X group</span></dt><dd><p>Delete an existing local winbindd group. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-Y sid</span></dt><dd><p>Convert a SID to a UNIX group id. If the SID + does not correspond to a UNIX group mapped by <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> then + the operation will fail. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-V</span></dt><dd><p>Prints the version number for <b class="command">smbd</b>.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXIT STATUS</h2><p>The wbinfo program returns 0 if the operation succeeded, or 1 if the operation failed. If the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> daemon is not working <b class="command">wbinfo</b> will always return diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html b/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html index 567e882367..1ee1de9f2f 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/winbind.html @@ -1,14 +1,38 @@ -<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="index.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"><link rel="next" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="winbind"></a>Chapter 21. Integrated Logon Support using Winbind</h2></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Naag</span> <span class="surname">Mummaneni</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">27 June 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979695">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979724">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979795">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979856">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979886">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979914">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979949">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2979971">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980108">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980179">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980214">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980242">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980271">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980346">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2980438">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2982058">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2982077">Common Errors</a></dt></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979695"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through - a unified logon has been considered a "holy grail" in heterogeneous - computing environments for a long time. We present - <span class="emphasis"><em>winbind</em></span>, a component of the Samba suite - of programs as a solution to the unified logon problem. Winbind - uses a UNIX implementation - of Microsoft RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name - Service Switch to allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate - as UNIX users on a UNIX machine. This paper describes the winbind - system, explaining the functionality it provides, how it is configured, - and how it works internally.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979724"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have +<html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"><link rel="home" href="samba-doc.html" title="SAMBA Project Documentation"><link rel="up" href="optional.html" title="Part III. Advanced Configuration"><link rel="previous" href="VFS.html" title="Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules"><link rel="next" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html" title="Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="navheader"><table width="100%" summary="Navigation header"><tr><th colspan="3" align="center">Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</th></tr><tr><td width="20%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><th width="60%" align="center">Part III. Advanced Configuration</th><td width="20%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr></table><hr></div><div class="chapter" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title"><a name="winbind"></a>Chapter 21. Winbind: Use of Domain Accounts</h2></div><div><div class="authorgroup"><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Tim</span> <span class="surname">Potter</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tpot@linuxcare.com.au">tpot@linuxcare.com.au</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Andrew</span> <span class="surname">Tridgell</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:tridge@samba.org">tridge@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Naag</span> <span class="surname">Mummaneni</span></h3><span class="contrib">Notes for Solaris</span><div class="affiliation"><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:getnag@rediffmail.com">getnag@rediffmail.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="surname">Trostel</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">SNAP<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com">jtrostel@snapserver.com</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">Jelmer</span> <span class="othername">R.</span> <span class="surname">Vernooij</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">The Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jelmer@samba.org">jelmer@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div><div class="author"><h3 class="author"><span class="firstname">John</span> <span class="othername">H.</span> <span class="surname">Terpstra</span></h3><div class="affiliation"><span class="orgname">Samba Team<br></span><div class="address"><p><tt class="email"><<a href="mailto:jht@samba.org">jht@samba.org</a>></tt></p></div></div></div></div></div><div><p class="pubdate">27 June 2002</p></div></div><div></div></div><div class="toc"><p><b>Table of Contents</b></p><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941150">Features and Benefits</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941246">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941324">What Winbind Provides</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941400">Target Uses</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941431">How Winbind Works</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941460">Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941493">Microsoft Active Directory Services</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941516">Name Service Switch</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941652">Pluggable Authentication Modules</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941724">User and Group ID Allocation</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941757">Result Caching</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941785">Installation and Configuration</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941792">Introduction</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941859">Requirements</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2941953">Testing Things Out</a></dt></dl></dd><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943561">Conclusion</a></dt><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943580">Common Errors</a></dt><dd><dl><dt><a href="winbind.html#id2943633">NSCD Problem Warning</a></dt></dl></dd></dl></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941150"></a>Features and Benefits</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> + Integration of UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT through a unified logon has + been considered a "holy grail" in heterogeneous computing environments for + a long time. + </p><p> + There is one other facility without which UNIX and Microsoft Windows network + interoperability would suffer greatly. It is imperative that there be a + mechanism for sharing files across UNIX systems and to be able to assign + domain user and group ownerships with integrity. + </p><p> + <span class="emphasis"><em>winbind</em></span> is a component of the Samba suite of programs + solves the unified logon problem. Winbind uses a UNIX implementation of Microsoft + RPC calls, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and the Name Service Switch to + allow Windows NT domain users to appear and operate as UNIX users on a UNIX + machine. This chapter describes the winbind system, explaining the functionality + it provides, how it is configured, and how it works internally. + </p><p> + Winbind provides three separate functions: + </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + Authentication of user credentials (via PAM) + </p></li><li><p> + Identity resolution (via NSS)` + </p></li><li><p> + Windindd maintains a database called winbind_idmap.tdb in which it stores + mappings between UNIX UIDs / GIDs and NT SIDs. This mapping is used only + for users and groups that do not have a local UID/GID. It stored the UID/GID + allocated from the idmap uid/gid range that it has mapped to the NT SID. + If <i class="parameter"><tt>idmap backend</tt></i> has been specified as ldapsam:url + then instead of using a local mapping winbindd will obtain this information + from the LDAP database. + </p></li></ul></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + If winbindd is not running, then smbd (which calls winbindd) will fall back to + using purely local information from /etc/passwd and /etc/group and no dynamic + mapping will be used. + </p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941246"></a>Introduction</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>It is well known that UNIX and Microsoft Windows NT have different models for representing user and group information and use different technologies for implementing them. This fact has made it difficult to integrate the two systems in a satisfactory @@ -29,7 +53,7 @@ tasks for the system administrator when maintaining users and groups on either system. The winbind system provides a simple and elegant solution to all three components of the unified logon - problem.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979795"></a>What Winbind Provides</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by + problem.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941324"></a>What Winbind Provides</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind unifies UNIX and Windows NT account management by allowing a UNIX box to become a full member of a NT domain. Once this is done the UNIX box will see NT users and groups as if they were native UNIX users and groups, allowing the NT domain @@ -53,7 +77,7 @@ to provide authentication via a NT domain to any PAM enabled applications. This capability solves the problem of synchronizing passwords between systems since all passwords are stored in a single - location (on the domain controller).</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979856"></a>Target Uses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an + location (on the domain controller).</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941400"></a>Target Uses</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind is targeted at organizations that have an existing NT based domain infrastructure into which they wish to put UNIX workstations or servers. Winbind will allow these organizations to deploy UNIX workstations without having to @@ -63,12 +87,12 @@ be used is as a central part of UNIX based appliances. Appliances that provide file and print services to Microsoft based networks will be able to use Winbind to provide seamless integration of - the appliance into the domain.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2979886"></a>How Winbind Works</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system is designed around a client/server + the appliance into the domain.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941431"></a>How Winbind Works</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system is designed around a client/server architecture. A long running <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon listens on a UNIX domain socket waiting for requests to arrive. These requests are generated by the NSS and PAM clients and processed sequentially.</p><p>The technologies used to implement winbind are described - in detail below.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979914"></a>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway + in detail below.</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941460"></a>Microsoft Remote Procedure Calls</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Over the last few years, efforts have been underway by various Samba Team members to decode various aspects of the Microsoft Remote Procedure Call (MSRPC) system. This system is used for most network related operations between @@ -81,7 +105,7 @@ users or groups. Other MSRPC calls can be used to authenticate NT domain users and to change user passwords. By directly querying a Windows PDC for user and group information, winbind maps the - NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979949"></a>Microsoft Active Directory Services</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + NT account information onto UNIX user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941493"></a>Microsoft Active Directory Services</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Since late 2001, Samba has gained the ability to interact with Microsoft Windows 2000 using its 'Native Mode' protocols, rather than the NT4 RPC services. @@ -90,7 +114,7 @@ same way as a Win2k client would, and in so doing provide a much more efficient and effective winbind implementation. - </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2979971"></a>Name Service Switch</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is + </p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941516"></a>Name Service Switch</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>The Name Service Switch, or NSS, is a feature that is present in many UNIX operating systems. It allows system information such as hostnames, mail aliases and user information to be resolved from different sources. For example, a standalone @@ -112,7 +136,7 @@ the C library looks in <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> for a line which matches the service type being requested, for example the "passwd" service type is used when user or group names - are looked up. This config line species which implementations + are looked up. This config line specifies which implementations of that service should be tried and in what order. If the passwd config line is:</p><pre class="programlisting"> passwd: files example @@ -127,7 +151,7 @@ passwd: files example is to put <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> in <tt class="filename">/lib/</tt> then add "winbind" into <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> at the appropriate place. The C library will then call Winbind to - resolve user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980108"></a>Pluggable Authentication Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM, + resolve user and group names.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941652"></a>Pluggable Authentication Modules</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>Pluggable Authentication Modules, also known as PAM, is a system for abstracting authentication and authorization technologies. With a PAM module it is possible to specify different authentication methods for different system applications without @@ -152,7 +176,7 @@ passwd: files example is copied to <tt class="filename">/lib/security/</tt> and the PAM control files for relevant services are updated to allow authentication via winbind. See the PAM documentation - for more details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980179"></a>User and Group ID Allocation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>When a user or group is created under Windows NT + for more details.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941724"></a>User and Group ID Allocation</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>When a user or group is created under Windows NT is it allocated a numerical relative identifier (RID). This is slightly different to UNIX which has a range of numbers that are used to identify users, and the same range in which to identify @@ -165,7 +189,7 @@ passwd: files example time, winbind will have mapped all Windows NT users and groups to UNIX user ids and group ids.</p><p>The results of this mapping are stored persistently in an ID mapping database held in a tdb database). This ensures that - RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980214"></a>Result Caching</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>An active system can generate a lot of user and group + RIDs are mapped to UNIX IDs in a consistent way.</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941757"></a>Result Caching</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p>An active system can generate a lot of user and group name lookups. To reduce the network cost of these lookups winbind uses a caching scheme based on the SAM sequence number supplied by NT domain controllers. User or group information returned @@ -176,23 +200,12 @@ passwd: files example the PDC and compared against the sequence number of the cached entry. If the sequence numbers do not match, then the cached information is discarded and up to date information is requested directly - from the PDC.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2980242"></a>Installation and Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p> -Many thanks to John Trostel <a href="mailto:jtrostel@snapserver.com" target="_top">jtrostel@snapserver.com</a> -for providing the HOWTO for this section. -</p><p> -This HOWTO describes how to get winbind services up and running -to control access and authenticate users on your Linux box using -the winbind services which come with SAMBA 3.0. -</p><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980271"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + from the PDC.</p></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2941785"></a>Installation and Configuration</h2></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941792"></a>Introduction</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> This section describes the procedures used to get winbind up and -running on a RedHat 7.1 system. Winbind is capable of providing access +running. Winbind is capable of providing access and authentication control for Windows Domain users through an NT or Win2K PDC for 'regular' services, such as telnet a nd ftp, as well for SAMBA services. -</p><p> -This HOWTO has been written from a 'RedHat-centric' perspective, so if -you are using another distribution, you may have to modify the instructions -somewhat to fit the way your distribution works. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> <span class="emphasis"><em>Why should I to this?</em></span> </p><p>This allows the SAMBA administrator to rely on the @@ -208,7 +221,7 @@ somewhat to fit the way your distribution works. SAMBA server, this HOWTO is for you. That said, I am no NT or PAM expert, so you may find a better or easier way to accomplish these tasks. - </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980346"></a>Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> + </p></li></ul></div></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941859"></a>Requirements</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you have a Samba configuration file that you are currently using... <span class="emphasis"><em>BACK IT UP!</em></span> If your system already uses PAM, <span class="emphasis"><em>back up the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> directory @@ -235,33 +248,18 @@ winbind modules, you should have at least the pam libraries resident on your system. For recent RedHat systems (7.1, for instance), that means <tt class="filename">pam-0.74-22</tt>. For best results, it is helpful to also install the development packages in <tt class="filename">pam-devel-0.74-22</tt>. -</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2980438"></a>Testing Things Out</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2941953"></a>Testing Things Out</h3></div></div><div></div></div><p> Before starting, it is probably best to kill off all the SAMBA related daemons running on your server. Kill off all <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> processes that may be running. To use PAM, you will want to make sure that you have the -standard PAM package (for RedHat) which supplies the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> +standard PAM package which supplies the <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d</tt> directory structure, including the pam modules are used by pam-aware services, several pam libraries, and the <tt class="filename">/usr/doc</tt> and <tt class="filename">/usr/man</tt> entries for pam. Winbind built better in SAMBA if the pam-devel package was also installed. This package includes the header files needed to compile pam-aware applications. -</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980500"></a>Configure and compile SAMBA</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> -The configuration and compilation of SAMBA is pretty straightforward. -The first three steps may not be necessary depending upon -whether or not you have previously built the Samba binaries. -</p><pre class="screen"> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">autoconf</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make clean</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">rm config.cache</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">./configure</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make</b> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="command">make install</b> -</pre><p> -This will, by default, install SAMBA in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba</tt>. -See the main SAMBA documentation if you want to install SAMBA somewhere else. -It will also build the winbindd executable and libraries. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980613"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf</tt> and the +</p><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942015"></a>Configure <tt class="filename">nsswitch.conf</tt> and the winbind libraries on Linux and Solaris</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> The libraries needed to run the <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon through nsswitch need to be copied to their proper locations, so @@ -296,7 +294,7 @@ is faster (and you don't need to reboot) if you do it manually: </p><p> This makes <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind</tt> available to winbindd and echos back a check to you. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980820"></a>NSS Winbind on AIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>(This section is only for those running AIX)</p><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942224"></a>NSS Winbind on AIX</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p>(This section is only for those running AIX)</p><p> The winbind AIX identification module gets built as libnss_winbind.so in the nsswitch directory of the samba source. This file can be copied to /usr/lib/security, and the AIX naming convention would indicate that it @@ -316,40 +314,25 @@ Programming Concepts for AIX": <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_ Chapter 18. Loadable Authentication Module Programming Interface</a> and more information on administering the modules at <a href="http://publibn.boulder.ibm.com/doc_link/en_US/a_doc_lib/aixbman/baseadmn/iandaadmin.htm" target="_top"> "System Management Guide: Operating System and Devices"</a>. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2980900"></a>Configure smb.conf</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942302"></a>Configure smb.conf</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Several parameters are needed in the smb.conf file to control the behavior of <span class="application">winbindd</span>. Configure <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> These are described in more detail in the <a href="winbindd.8.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">winbindd</span>(8)</span></a> man page. My <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file was modified to include the following entries in the [global] section: -</p><pre class="programlisting"> -[global] - <...> - # separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR" target="_top">winbind separator</a> = + - # use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDUID" target="_top">idmap uid</a> = 10000-20000 - # use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDGID" target="_top">idmap gid</a> = 10000-20000 - # allow enumeration of winbind users and groups - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS" target="_top">winbind enum users</a> = yes - <a href="winbindd.8.html#WINBINDENUMGROUP" target="_top">winbind enum groups</a> = yes - # give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access) - <a href="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR" target="_top">template homedir</a> = /home/winnt/%D/%U - <a href="winbindd.8.html#TEMPLATESHELL" target="_top">template shell</a> = /bin/bash -</pre></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2981017"></a>Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="example"><a name="id2942349"></a><p class="title"><b>Example 21.1. smb.conf for winbind set-up</b></p><table class="simplelist" border="0" summary="Simple list"><tr><td> </td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>[global]</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td>...</td></tr><tr><td># separate domain and username with '+', like DOMAIN+username</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator = +</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># use uids from 10000 to 20000 for domain users</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid = 10000-20000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># use gids from 10000 to 20000 for domain groups</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid = 10000-20000</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># allow enumeration of winbind users and groups</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups = yes</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td># give winbind users a real shell (only needed if they have telnet access)</td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir = /home/winnt/%D/%U</tt></i></td></tr><tr><td><i class="parameter"><tt>template shell = /bin/bash</tt></i></td></tr></table></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942460"></a>Join the SAMBA server to the PDC domain</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Enter the following command to make the SAMBA server join the PDC domain, where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> is the name of your Windows domain and <i class="replaceable"><tt>Administrator</tt></i> is a domain user who has administrative privileges in the domain. </p><p> -<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/net join -S PDC -U Administrator</tt></b> +<tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>/usr/local/samba/bin/net rpc join -S PDC -U Administrator</tt></b> </p><p> The proper response to the command should be: "Joined the domain <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i>" where <i class="replaceable"><tt>DOMAIN</tt></i> is your DOMAIN name. -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2981071"></a>Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942516"></a>Start up the winbindd daemon and test it!</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> Eventually, you will want to modify your smb startup script to automatically invoke the winbindd daemon when the other parts of SAMBA start, but it is possible to test out just the winbind @@ -391,8 +374,7 @@ your PDC. For example, I get the following response: CEO+krbtgt CEO+TsInternetUser </pre><p> -Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind -separator</tt></i> is '+'. + Obviously, I have named my domain 'CEO' and my <a class="indexterm" name="id2942662"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i> is '+'. </p><p> You can do the same sort of thing to get group information from the PDC: @@ -421,7 +403,7 @@ directories and default shells. The same thing can be done for groups with the command </p><p> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>getent group</tt></b> -</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2981312"></a>Fix the init.d startup scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981320"></a>Linux</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2942766"></a>Fix the init.d startup scripts</h4></div></div><div></div></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2942773"></a>Linux</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemon needs to start up after the <span class="application">smbd</span> and <span class="application">nmbd</span> daemons are running. To accomplish this task, you need to modify the startup scripts of your system. @@ -487,7 +469,7 @@ stop() { echo "" return $RETVAL } -</pre></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981482"></a>Solaris</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind doesn't work on Solaris 9, see the <a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9" title="Winbind on Solaris 9">Portability</a> chapter for details.</p><p>On Solaris, you need to modify the +</pre></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2942942"></a>Solaris</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind doesn't work on Solaris 9, see the <a href="Portability.html#winbind-solaris9" title="Winbind on Solaris 9">Portability</a> chapter for details.</p><p>On Solaris, you need to modify the <tt class="filename">/etc/init.d/samba.server</tt> startup script. It usually only starts smbd and nmbd but should now start winbindd too. If you have samba installed in <tt class="filename">/usr/local/samba/bin</tt>, @@ -550,11 +532,11 @@ in the script above with: </p><pre class="programlisting"> /usr/local/samba/bin/winbindd -B </pre><p> -</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981600"></a>Restarting</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2943053"></a>Restarting</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you restart the <span class="application">smbd</span>, <span class="application">nmbd</span>, and <span class="application">winbindd</span> daemons at this point, you should be able to connect to the samba server as a domain member just as if you were a local user. -</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2981637"></a>Configure Winbind and PAM</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div></div><div class="sect3" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h4 class="title"><a name="id2943089"></a>Configure Winbind and PAM</h4></div></div><div></div></div><p> If you have made it this far, you know that winbindd and samba are working together. If you want to use winbind to provide authentication for other services, keep reading. The pam configuration files need to be altered in @@ -574,7 +556,7 @@ your other pam security modules. On my RedHat system, this was the modules reside in <tt class="filename">/usr/lib/security</tt>. </p><p> <tt class="prompt">root# </tt><b class="userinput"><tt>cp ../samba/source/nsswitch/pam_winbind.so /lib/security</tt></b> -</p><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981743"></a>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2943196"></a>Linux/FreeBSD-specific PAM configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/samba</tt> file does not need to be changed. I just left this file as it was: </p><pre class="programlisting"> @@ -601,7 +583,7 @@ have individual directories for the domain users already present on the server, or change the home directory template to a general directory for all domain users. These can be easily set using the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> global entry -<i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i>. +<a class="indexterm" name="id2943302"></a><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i>. </p><p> The <tt class="filename">/etc/pam.d/ftp</tt> file can be changed to allow winbind ftp access in a manner similar to the @@ -634,10 +616,10 @@ same way. It now looks like this: In this case, I added the </p><pre class="programlisting">auth sufficient /lib/security/pam_winbind.so</pre><p> lines as before, but also added the </p><pre class="programlisting">required pam_securetty.so</pre><p> above it, to disallow root logins over the network. I also added a -<b class="command">sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</b> +</p><pre class="programlisting">sufficient /lib/security/pam_unix.so use_first_pass</pre><p> line after the <b class="command">winbind.so</b> line to get rid of annoying double prompts for passwords. -</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2981966"></a>Solaris-specific configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> +</p></div><div class="sect4" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h5 class="title"><a name="id2943437"></a>Solaris-specific configuration</h5></div></div><div></div></div><p> The /etc/pam.conf needs to be changed. I changed this file so that my Domain users can logon both locally as well as telnet.The following are the changes that I made.You can customize the pam.conf file as per your requirements,but @@ -709,15 +691,15 @@ annoying double prompts for passwords. </p><p> Now restart your Samba and try connecting through your application that you configured in the pam.conf. -</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2982058"></a>Conclusion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service +</p></div></div></div></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943561"></a>Conclusion</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>The winbind system, through the use of the Name Service Switch, Pluggable Authentication Modules, and appropriate Microsoft RPC calls have allowed us to provide seamless integration of Microsoft Windows NT domain users on a UNIX system. The result is a great reduction in the administrative - cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2982077"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current + cost of running a mixed UNIX and NT network.</p></div><div class="sect1" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h2 class="title" style="clear: both"><a name="id2943580"></a>Common Errors</h2></div></div><div></div></div><p>Winbind has a number of limitations in its current released version that we hope to overcome in future releases:</p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p>Winbind is currently only available for - the Linux, Solaris and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating + the Linux, Solaris, AIX and IRIX operating systems, although ports to other operating systems are certainly possible. For such ports to be feasible, we require the C library of the target operating system to support the Name Service Switch and Pluggable Authentication @@ -729,4 +711,11 @@ configured in the pam.conf. containing this information is corrupted or destroyed.</p></li><li><p>Currently the winbind PAM module does not take into account possible workstation and logon time restrictions that may be been set for Windows NT users, this is - instead up to the PDC to enforce.</p></li></ul></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="index.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</td></tr></table></div></body></html> + instead up to the PDC to enforce.</p></li></ul></div><div class="sect2" lang="en"><div class="titlepage"><div><div><h3 class="title"><a name="id2943633"></a>NSCD Problem Warning</h3></div></div><div></div></div><div class="note" style="margin-left: 0.5in; margin-right: 0.5in;"><h3 class="title">Note</h3><p> + Do NOT under ANY circumstances run <b class="command">nscd</b> on any system + on which <b class="command">winbind</b> is running. + </p></div><p> + If <b class="command">nscd</b> is running on the UNIX/Linux system, then + even though NSSWITCH is correctly configured it will NOT be possible to resolve + domain users and groups for file and directory controls. + </p></div></div></div><div class="navfooter"><hr><table width="100%" summary="Navigation footer"><tr><td width="40%" align="left"><a accesskey="p" href="VFS.html">Prev</a> </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="u" href="optional.html">Up</a></td><td width="40%" align="right"> <a accesskey="n" href="AdvancedNetworkManagement.html">Next</a></td></tr><tr><td width="40%" align="left" valign="top">Chapter 20. Stackable VFS modules </td><td width="20%" align="center"><a accesskey="h" href="samba-doc.html">Home</a></td><td width="40%" align="right" valign="top"> Chapter 22. Advanced Network Management</td></tr></table></div></body></html> diff --git a/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html b/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html index c1a64d6a00..7b2d6e0261 100644 --- a/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html +++ b/docs/htmldocs/winbindd.8.html @@ -1,5 +1,5 @@ <html><head><meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1"><title>winbindd</title><link rel="stylesheet" href="samba.css" type="text/css"><meta name="generator" content="DocBook XSL Stylesheets V1.60.1"></head><body bgcolor="white" text="black" link="#0000FF" vlink="#840084" alink="#0000FF"><div class="refentry" lang="en"><a name="winbindd.8"></a><div class="titlepage"><div></div><div></div></div><div class="refnamediv"><h2>Name</h2><p>winbindd — Name Service Switch daemon for resolving names - from NT servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">winbindd</tt> [-F] [-S] [-i] [-B] [-d <debug level>] [-s <smb config file>] [-n]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">winbindd</b> is a daemon that provides + from NT servers</p></div><div class="refsynopsisdiv"><h2>Synopsis</h2><div class="cmdsynopsis"><p><tt class="command">winbindd</tt> [-F] [-S] [-i] [-Y] [-d <debug level>] [-s <smb config file>] [-n]</p></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>DESCRIPTION</h2><p>This program is part of the <a href="Samba.7.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">Samba</span>(7)</span></a> suite.</p><p><b class="command">winbindd</b> is a daemon that provides a service for the Name Service Switch capability that is present in most modern C libraries. The Name Service Switch allows user and system information to be obtained from different databases @@ -55,8 +55,7 @@ configuration details required by the server. The information in this file includes server-specific information such as what printcap file to use, as well as descriptions of all the services that the server is -to provide. See <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"><tt class="filename"> -smb.conf(5)</tt></a> for more information. +to provide. See <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> for more information. The default configuration file name is determined at compile time.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-d|--debug=debuglevel</span></dt><dd><p><i class="replaceable"><tt>debuglevel</tt></i> is an integer from 0 to 10. The default value if this parameter is @@ -70,10 +69,9 @@ amounts of log data, and should only be used when investigating a problem. Levels above 3 are designed for use only by developers and generate HUGE amounts of log data, most of which is extremely cryptic.</p><p>Note that specifying this parameter here will -override the <a href="smb.conf.5.html#loglevel" target="_top">log -level</a> parameter in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html" target="_top"> -<tt class="filename">smb.conf(5)</tt></a> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension -<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is +override the <a class="indexterm" name="id2800127"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>log level</tt></i></a> parameter +in the <tt class="filename">smb.conf</tt> file.</p></dd><dt><span class="term">-l|--logfile=logbasename</span></dt><dd><p>File name for log/debug files. The extension +<tt class="constant">".client"</tt> will be appended. The log file is never removed by the client. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-h|--help</span></dt><dd><p>Print a summary of command line options. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-i</span></dt><dd><p>Tells <b class="command">winbindd</b> to not @@ -88,11 +86,10 @@ never removed by the client. slower. The results will however be more accurate, since results from the cache might not be up-to-date. This might also temporarily hang winbindd if the DC doesn't respond. - </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-B</span></dt><dd><p>Dual daemon mode. This means winbindd will run - as 2 threads. The first will answer all requests from the cache, - thus making responses to clients faster. The other will - update the cache for the query that the first has just responded. - Advantage of this is that responses stay accurate and are faster. + </p></dd><dt><span class="term">-Y</span></dt><dd><p>Single daemon mode. This means winbindd will run + as a single process (the mode of operation in Samba 2.2). Winbindd's + default behavior is to launch a child process that is responsible for + updating expired cache entries. </p></dd></dl></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>NAME AND ID RESOLUTION</h2><p>Users and groups on a Windows NT server are assigned a relative id (rid) which is unique for the domain when the user or group is created. To convert the Windows NT user or group @@ -110,16 +107,16 @@ never removed by the client. determine which user and group ids correspond to Windows NT user and group rids. </p></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>CONFIGURATION</h2><p>Configuration of the <b class="command">winbindd</b> daemon is done through configuration parameters in the <a href="smb.conf.5.html"><span class="citerefentry"><span class="refentrytitle">smb.conf</span>(5)</span></a> file. All parameters should be specified in the - [global] section of smb.conf. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDSEPARATOR" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUID" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDGID" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDCACHETIME" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMUSERS" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDENUMGROUPS" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATEHOMEDIR" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#TEMPLATESHELL" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>template shell</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p><a href="smb.conf.5.html#WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN" target="_top"> - <i class="parameter"><tt>winbind use default domain</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus + [global] section of smb.conf. </p><div class="itemizedlist"><ul type="disc"><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800484"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind separator</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800509"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap uid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800532"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>idmap gid</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800556"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind cache time</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800581"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum users</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800606"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind enum groups</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800630"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>template homedir</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800655"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>template shell</tt></i></a></p></li><li><p> + <a class="indexterm" name="id2800679"></a><a href="#"><i class="parameter"><tt>winbind use default domain</tt></i></a></p></li></ul></div></div><div class="refsect1" lang="en"><h2>EXAMPLE SETUP</h2><p>To setup winbindd for user and group lookups plus authentication from a domain controller use something like the following setup. This was tested on a RedHat 6.2 Linux box. </p><p>In <tt class="filename">/etc/nsswitch.conf</tt> put the following: @@ -138,7 +135,7 @@ auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok </b></p><p>The next step is to join the domain. To do that use the <b class="command">net</b> program like this: </p><p><b class="command">net join -S PDC -U Administrator</b></p><p>The username after the <i class="parameter"><tt>-U</tt></i> can be any Domain user that has administrator privileges on the machine. - Substitute the name or IP of your PDC for "PDC".</p><p>Next copy <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> to + Substitute the name or IP of your PDC for "PDC".</p><p>Next copy <tt class="filename">libnss_winbind.so</tt> to <tt class="filename">/lib</tt> and <tt class="filename">pam_winbind.so </tt> to <tt class="filename">/lib/security</tt>. A symbolic link needs to be made from <tt class="filename">/lib/libnss_winbind.so</tt> to @@ -152,8 +149,8 @@ auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok winbind cache time = 10 template shell = /bin/bash template homedir = /home/%D/%U - winbind uid = 10000-20000 - winbind gid = 10000-20000 + idmap uid = 10000-20000 + idmap gid = 10000-20000 workgroup = DOMAIN security = domain password server = * @@ -179,7 +176,7 @@ auth required /lib/security/pam_pwdb.so use_first_pass shadow nullok apply any parameter changes to the running version of winbindd. This signal also clears any cached user and group information. The list of other domains trusted - by winbindd is also reloaded. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SIGUSR1</span></dt><dd><p>The SIGUSR1 signal will cause <b class="command"> + by winbindd is also reloaded. </p></dd><dt><span class="term">SIGUSR2</span></dt><dd><p>The SIGUSR2 signal will cause <b class="command"> winbindd</b> to write status information to the winbind log file including information about the number of user and group ids allocated by <b class="command">winbindd</b>.</p><p>Log files are stored in the filename specified by the |